diff options
| -rw-r--r-- | .gitattributes | 3 | ||||
| -rw-r--r-- | 464-0.txt | 9378 | ||||
| -rw-r--r-- | 464-0.zip | bin | 0 -> 243509 bytes | |||
| -rw-r--r-- | 464-h.zip | bin | 0 -> 303582 bytes | |||
| -rw-r--r-- | 464-h/464-h.htm | 10833 | ||||
| -rw-r--r-- | 464-h/images/p0b.jpg | bin | 0 -> 44885 bytes | |||
| -rw-r--r-- | 464-h/images/p0s.jpg | bin | 0 -> 5853 bytes | |||
| -rw-r--r-- | 464-h/images/p252.jpg | bin | 0 -> 5751 bytes | |||
| -rw-r--r-- | LICENSE.txt | 11 | ||||
| -rw-r--r-- | README.md | 2 | ||||
| -rw-r--r-- | old/sseas10.txt | 10040 | ||||
| -rw-r--r-- | old/sseas10.zip | bin | 0 -> 241081 bytes | |||
| -rw-r--r-- | old/sseas10h.htm | 9701 | ||||
| -rw-r--r-- | old/sseas10h.zip | bin | 0 -> 243018 bytes |
14 files changed, 39968 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/.gitattributes b/.gitattributes new file mode 100644 index 0000000..6833f05 --- /dev/null +++ b/.gitattributes @@ -0,0 +1,3 @@ +* text=auto +*.txt text +*.md text diff --git a/464-0.txt b/464-0.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000..a5b3e07 --- /dev/null +++ b/464-0.txt @@ -0,0 +1,9378 @@ +The Project Gutenberg eBook, In the South Seas, by Robert Louis Stevenson + + +This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with +almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or +re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included +with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org + + + + + +Title: In the South Seas + + +Author: Robert Louis Stevenson + + + +Release Date: November 16, 2012 [eBook #464] +[This file was first posted on January 23, 1996] + +Language: English + +Character set encoding: UTF-8 + + +***START OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK IN THE SOUTH SEAS*** + + +Transcribed from the 1908 Chatto & Windus edition by David Price, email +ccx074@pglaf.org + + + + + + IN THE SOUTH SEAS + + + BEING AN ACCOUNT OF EXPERIENCES AND + OBSERVATIONS IN THE MARQUESAS, PAUMOTUS + AND GILBERT ISLANDS IN THE COURSE OF + TWO CRUSES, ON THE YACHT ‘CASCO’ (1888) + AND THE SCHOONER ‘EQUATOR’ (1889) + + BY + ROBERT LOUIS STEVENSON + + [Picture: Decorative graphic] + + FINE-PAPER EDITION + + * * * * * + + LONDON + CHATTO & WINDUS + 1908 + + * * * * * + + _All rights resverved_ + + + + +CONTENTS + + PART 1: THE MARQUESAS +CHAPTER + I. AN ISLAND LANDFALL + II. MAKING FRIENDS + III. THE MAROON + IV. DEATH + V. DEPOPULATION + VI. CHIEFS AND TAPUS + VII. HATIHEU + VIII. THE PORT OF ENTRY + IX. THE HOUSE OF TEMOANA + X. A PORTRAIT AND A STORY + XI. LONG-PIG—A CANNIBAL HIGH PLACE + XII. THE STORY OF A PLANTATION + XIII. CHARACTERS + XIV. IN A CANNIBAL VALLEY + XV. THE TWO CHIEFS OF ATUONA + PART II: THE PAUMOTUS + I. THE DANGEROUS ARCHIPELAGO—ATOLLS AT A DISTANCE + II. FAKARAVA: AN ATOLL AT HAND + III. A HOUSE TO LET IN A LOW ISLAND + IV. TRAITS AND SECTS IN THE PAUMOTUS + V. A PAUMOTUAN FUNERAL + VI. GRAVEYARD STORIES + PART III: THE GILBERTS + I. BUTARITARI + II. THE FOUR BROTHERS + III. AROUND OUR HOUSE + IV. A TALE OF A TAPU + V. A TALE OF A TAPU—_continued_ + VI. THE FIVE DAYS’ FESTIVAL + VII. HUSBAND AND WIFE + PART IV: THE GILBERTS—APEMAMA + I. THE KING OF APEMAMA: THE ROYAL TRADER + II. THE KING OF APEMAMA: FOUNDATION OF EQUATOR TOWN + III. THE KING OF APEMAMA: THE PALACE OF MANY WOMEN + IV. THE KING OF APEMAMA: EQUATOR TOWN AND THE PALACE + V. KING AND COMMONS + VI. THE KING OF APEMAMA: DEVIL-WORK + VII. THE KING OF APEMAMA + +PART 1: THE MARQUESAS + + +CHAPTER I—AN ISLAND LANDFALL + + +For nearly ten years my health had been declining; and for some while +before I set forth upon my voyage, I believed I was come to the +afterpiece of life, and had only the nurse and undertaker to expect. It +was suggested that I should try the South Seas; and I was not unwilling +to visit like a ghost, and be carried like a bale, among scenes that had +attracted me in youth and health. I chartered accordingly Dr. Merrit’s +schooner yacht, the _Casco_, seventy-four tons register; sailed from San +Francisco towards the end of June 1888, visited the eastern islands, and +was left early the next year at Honolulu. Hence, lacking courage to +return to my old life of the house and sick-room, I set forth to leeward +in a trading schooner, the _Equator_, of a little over seventy tons, +spent four months among the atolls (low coral islands) of the Gilbert +group, and reached Samoa towards the close of ’89. By that time +gratitude and habit were beginning to attach me to the islands; I had +gained a competency of strength; I had made friends; I had learned new +interests; the time of my voyages had passed like days in fairyland; and +I decided to remain. I began to prepare these pages at sea, on a third +cruise, in the trading steamer _Janet Nicoll_. If more days are granted +me, they shall be passed where I have found life most pleasant and man +most interesting; the axes of my black boys are already clearing the +foundations of my future house; and I must learn to address readers from +the uttermost parts of the sea. + +That I should thus have reversed the verdict of Lord Tennyson’s hero is +less eccentric than appears. Few men who come to the islands leave them; +they grow grey where they alighted; the palm shades and the trade-wind +fans them till they die, perhaps cherishing to the last the fancy of a +visit home, which is rarely made, more rarely enjoyed, and yet more +rarely repeated. No part of the world exerts the same attractive power +upon the visitor, and the task before me is to communicate to fireside +travellers some sense of its seduction, and to describe the life, at sea +and ashore, of many hundred thousand persons, some of our own blood and +language, all our contemporaries, and yet as remote in thought and habit +as Rob Roy or Barbarossa, the Apostles or the Cæsars. + +The first experience can never be repeated. The first love, the first +sunrise, the first South Sea island, are memories apart and touched a +virginity of sense. On the 28th of July 1888 the moon was an hour down +by four in the morning. In the east a radiating centre of brightness +told of the day; and beneath, on the skyline, the morning bank was +already building, black as ink. We have all read of the swiftness of the +day’s coming and departure in low latitudes; it is a point on which the +scientific and sentimental tourist are at one, and has inspired some +tasteful poetry. The period certainly varies with the season; but here +is one case exactly noted. Although the dawn was thus preparing by four, +the sun was not up till six; and it was half-past five before we could +distinguish our expected islands from the clouds on the horizon. Eight +degrees south, and the day two hours a-coming. The interval was passed +on deck in the silence of expectation, the customary thrill of landfall +heightened by the strangeness of the shores that we were then +approaching. Slowly they took shape in the attenuating darkness. +Ua-huna, piling up to a truncated summit, appeared the first upon the +starboard bow; almost abeam arose our destination, Nuka-hiva, whelmed in +cloud; and betwixt and to the southward, the first rays of the sun +displayed the needles of Ua-pu. These pricked about the line of the +horizon; like the pinnacles of some ornate and monstrous church, they +stood there, in the sparkling brightness of the morning, the fit +signboard of a world of wonders. + +Not one soul aboard the _Casco_ had set foot upon the islands, or knew, +except by accident, one word of any of the island tongues; and it was +with something perhaps of the same anxious pleasure as thrilled the bosom +of discoverers that we drew near these problematic shores. The land +heaved up in peaks and rising vales; it fell in cliffs and buttresses; +its colour ran through fifty modulations in a scale of pearl and rose and +olive; and it was crowned above by opalescent clouds. The suffusion of +vague hues deceived the eye; the shadows of clouds were confounded with +the articulations of the mountains; and the isle and its unsubstantial +canopy rose and shimmered before us like a single mass. There was no +beacon, no smoke of towns to be expected, no plying pilot. Somewhere, in +that pale phantasmagoria of cliff and cloud, our haven lay concealed; and +somewhere to the east of it—the only sea-mark given—a certain headland, +known indifferently as Cape Adam and Eve, or Cape Jack and Jane, and +distinguished by two colossal figures, the gross statuary of nature. +These we were to find; for these we craned and stared, focused glasses, +and wrangled over charts; and the sun was overhead and the land close +ahead before we found them. To a ship approaching, like the _Casco_, +from the north, they proved indeed the least conspicuous features of a +striking coast; the surf flying high above its base; strange, austere, +and feathered mountains rising behind; and Jack and Jane, or Adam and +Eve, impending like a pair of warts above the breakers. + +Thence we bore away along shore. On our port beam we might hear the +explosions of the surf; a few birds flew fishing under the prow; there +was no other sound or mark of life, whether of man or beast, in all that +quarter of the island. Winged by her own impetus and the dying breeze, +the _Casco_ skimmed under cliffs, opened out a cove, showed us a beach +and some green trees, and flitted by again, bowing to the swell. The +trees, from our distance, might have been hazel; the beach might have +been in Europe; the mountain forms behind modelled in little from the +Alps, and the forest which clustered on their ramparts a growth no more +considerable than our Scottish heath. Again the cliff yawned, but now +with a deeper entry; and the _Casco_, hauling her wind, began to slide +into the bay of Anaho. The cocoa-palm, that giraffe of vegetables, so +graceful, so ungainly, to the European eye so foreign, was to be seen +crowding on the beach, and climbing and fringing the steep sides of +mountains. Rude and bare hills embraced the inlet upon either hand; it +was enclosed to the landward by a bulk of shattered mountains. In every +crevice of that barrier the forest harboured, roosting and nestling there +like birds about a ruin; and far above, it greened and roughened the +razor edges of the summit. + +Under the eastern shore, our schooner, now bereft of any breeze, +continued to creep in: the smart creature, when once under way, appearing +motive in herself. From close aboard arose the bleating of young lambs; +a bird sang in the hillside; the scent of the land and of a hundred +fruits or flowers flowed forth to meet us; and, presently, a house or two +appeared, standing high upon the ankles of the hills, and one of these +surrounded with what seemed a garden. These conspicuous habitations, +that patch of culture, had we but known it, were a mark of the passage of +whites; and we might have approached a hundred islands and not found +their parallel. It was longer ere we spied the native village, standing +(in the universal fashion) close upon a curve of beach, close under a +grove of palms; the sea in front growling and whitening on a concave arc +of reef. For the cocoa-tree and the island man are both lovers and +neighbours of the surf. ‘The coral waxes, the palm grows, but man +departs,’ says the sad Tahitian proverb; but they are all three, so long +as they endure, co-haunters of the beach. The mark of anchorage was a +blow-hole in the rocks, near the south-easterly corner of the bay. +Punctually to our use, the blow-hole spouted; the schooner turned upon +her heel; the anchor plunged. It was a small sound, a great event; my +soul went down with these moorings whence no windlass may extract nor any +diver fish it up; and I, and some part of my ship’s company, were from +that hour the bondslaves of the isles of Vivien. + +Before yet the anchor plunged a canoe was already paddling from the +hamlet. It contained two men: one white, one brown and tattooed across +the face with bands of blue, both in immaculate white European clothes: +the resident trader, Mr. Regler, and the native chief, Taipi-Kikino. +‘Captain, is it permitted to come on board?’ were the first words we +heard among the islands. Canoe followed canoe till the ship swarmed with +stalwart, six-foot men in every stage of undress; some in a shirt, some +in a loin-cloth, one in a handkerchief imperfectly adjusted; some, and +these the more considerable, tattooed from head to foot in awful +patterns; some barbarous and knived; one, who sticks in my memory as +something bestial, squatting on his hams in a canoe, sucking an orange +and spitting it out again to alternate sides with ape-like vivacity—all +talking, and we could not understand one word; all trying to trade with +us who had no thought of trading, or offering us island curios at prices +palpably absurd. There was no word of welcome; no show of civility; no +hand extended save that of the chief and Mr. Regler. As we still +continued to refuse the proffered articles, complaint ran high and rude; +and one, the jester of the party, railed upon our meanness amid jeering +laughter. Amongst other angry pleasantries—‘Here is a mighty fine ship,’ +said he, ‘to have no money on board!’ I own I was inspired with sensible +repugnance; even with alarm. The ship was manifestly in their power; we +had women on board; I knew nothing of my guests beyond the fact that they +were cannibals; the Directory (my only guide) was full of timid cautions; +and as for the trader, whose presence might else have reassured me, were +not whites in the Pacific the usual instigators and accomplices of native +outrage? When he reads this confession, our kind friend, Mr. Regler, can +afford to smile. + +Later in the day, as I sat writing up my journal, the cabin was filled +from end to end with Marquesans: three brown-skinned generations, +squatted cross-legged upon the floor, and regarding me in silence with +embarrassing eyes. The eyes of all Polynesians are large, luminous, and +melting; they are like the eyes of animals and some Italians. A kind of +despair came over me, to sit there helpless under all these staring orbs, +and be thus blocked in a corner of my cabin by this speechless crowd: and +a kind of rage to think they were beyond the reach of articulate +communication, like furred animals, or folk born deaf, or the dwellers of +some alien planet. + +To cross the Channel is, for a boy of twelve, to change heavens; to cross +the Atlantic, for a man of twenty-four, is hardly to modify his diet. +But I was now escaped out of the shadow of the Roman empire, under whose +toppling monuments we were all cradled, whose laws and letters are on +every hand of us, constraining and preventing. I was now to see what men +might be whose fathers had never studied Virgil, had never been conquered +by Cæsar, and never been ruled by the wisdom of Gaius or Papinian. By +the same step I had journeyed forth out of that comfortable zone of +kindred languages, where the curse of Babel is so easy to be remedied; +and my new fellow-creatures sat before me dumb like images. Methought, +in my travels, all human relation was to be excluded; and when I returned +home (for in those days I still projected my return) I should have but +dipped into a picture-book without a text. Nay, and I even questioned if +my travels should be much prolonged; perhaps they were destined to a +speedy end; perhaps my subsequent friend, Kauanui, whom I remarked there, +sitting silent with the rest, for a man of some authority, might leap +from his hams with an ear-splitting signal, the ship be carried at a +rush, and the ship’s company butchered for the table. + +There could be nothing more natural than these apprehensions, nor +anything more groundless. In my experience of the islands, I had never +again so menacing a reception; were I to meet with such to-day, I should +be more alarmed and tenfold more surprised. The majority of Polynesians +are easy folk to get in touch with, frank, fond of notice, greedy of the +least affection, like amiable, fawning dogs; and even with the +Marquesans, so recently and so imperfectly redeemed from a blood-boltered +barbarism, all were to become our intimates, and one, at least, was to +mourn sincerely our departure. + + + +CHAPTER II—MAKING FRIENDS + + +The impediment of tongues was one that I particularly over-estimated. +The languages of Polynesia are easy to smatter, though hard to speak with +elegance. And they are extremely similar, so that a person who has a +tincture of one or two may risk, not without hope, an attempt upon the +others. + +And again, not only is Polynesian easy to smatter, but interpreters +abound. Missionaries, traders, and broken white folk living on the +bounty of the natives, are to be found in almost every isle and hamlet; +and even where these are unserviceable, the natives themselves have often +scraped up a little English, and in the French zone (though far less +commonly) a little French-English, or an efficient pidgin, what is called +to the westward ‘Beach-la-Mar,’ comes easy to the Polynesian; it is now +taught, besides, in the schools of Hawaii; and from the multiplicity of +British ships, and the nearness of the States on the one hand and the +colonies on the other, it may be called, and will almost certainly +become, the tongue of the Pacific. I will instance a few examples. I +met in Majuro a Marshall Island boy who spoke excellent English; this he +had learned in the German firm in Jaluit, yet did not speak one word of +German. I heard from a gendarme who had taught school in Rapa-iti that +while the children had the utmost difficulty or reluctance to learn +French, they picked up English on the wayside, and as if by accident. On +one of the most out-of-the-way atolls in the Carolines, my friend Mr. +Benjamin Hird was amazed to find the lads playing cricket on the beach +and talking English; and it was in English that the crew of the _Janet +Nicoll_, a set of black boys from different Melanesian islands, +communicated with other natives throughout the cruise, transmitted +orders, and sometimes jested together on the fore-hatch. But what struck +me perhaps most of all was a word I heard on the verandah of the Tribunal +at Noumea. A case had just been heard—a trial for infanticide against an +ape-like native woman; and the audience were smoking cigarettes as they +awaited the verdict. An anxious, amiable French lady, not far from +tears, was eager for acquittal, and declared she would engage the +prisoner to be her children’s nurse. The bystanders exclaimed at the +proposal; the woman was a savage, said they, and spoke no language. +‘_Mais_, _vous savez_,’ objected the fair sentimentalist; ‘_ils +apprennent si vite l’anglais_!’ + +But to be able to speak to people is not all. And in the first stage of +my relations with natives I was helped by two things. To begin with, I +was the show-man of the _Casco_. She, her fine lines, tall spars, and +snowy decks, the crimson fittings of the saloon, and the white, the gilt, +and the repeating mirrors of the tiny cabin, brought us a hundred +visitors. The men fathomed out her dimensions with their arms, as their +fathers fathomed out the ships of Cook; the women declared the cabins +more lovely than a church; bouncing Junos were never weary of sitting in +the chairs and contemplating in the glass their own bland images; and I +have seen one lady strip up her dress, and, with cries of wonder and +delight, rub herself bare-breeched upon the velvet cushions. Biscuit, +jam, and syrup was the entertainment; and, as in European parlours, the +photograph album went the round. This sober gallery, their everyday +costumes and physiognomies, had become transformed, in three weeks’ +sailing, into things wonderful and rich and foreign; alien faces, +barbaric dresses, they were now beheld and fingered, in the swerving +cabin, with innocent excitement and surprise. Her Majesty was often +recognised, and I have seen French subjects kiss her photograph; Captain +Speedy—in an Abyssinian war-dress, supposed to be the uniform of the +British army—met with much acceptance; and the effigies of Mr. Andrew +Lang were admired in the Marquesas. There is the place for him to go +when he shall be weary of Middlesex and Homer. + +It was perhaps yet more important that I had enjoyed in my youth some +knowledge of our Scots folk of the Highlands and the Islands. Not much +beyond a century has passed since these were in the same convulsive and +transitionary state as the Marquesans of to-day. In both cases an alien +authority enforced, the clans disarmed, the chiefs deposed, new customs +introduced, and chiefly that fashion of regarding money as the means and +object of existence. The commercial age, in each, succeeding at a bound +to an age of war abroad and patriarchal communism at home. In one the +cherished practice of tattooing, in the other a cherished costume, +proscribed. In each a main luxury cut off: beef, driven under cloud of +night from Lowland pastures, denied to the meat-loving Highlander; +long-pig, pirated from the next village, to the man-eating Kanaka. The +grumbling, the secret ferment, the fears and resentments, the alarms and +sudden councils of Marquesan chiefs, reminded me continually of the days +of Lovat and Struan. Hospitality, tact, natural fine manners, and a +touchy punctilio, are common to both races: common to both tongues the +trick of dropping medial consonants. Here is a table of two widespread +Polynesian words:— + + _House_. _Love_. + {12} +Tahitian FARE AROHA +New Zealand WHARE +Samoan FALE TALOFA +Manihiki FALE ALOHA +Hawaiian HALE ALOHA +Marquesan HA’E KAOHA + +The elision of medial consonants, so marked in these Marquesan instances, +is no less common both in Gaelic and the Lowland Scots. Stranger still, +that prevalent Polynesian sound, the so-called catch, written with an +apostrophe, and often or always the gravestone of a perished consonant, +is to be heard in Scotland to this day. When a Scot pronounces water, +better, or bottle—_wa’er_, _be’er_, or _bo’le_—the sound is precisely +that of the catch; and I think we may go beyond, and say, that if such a +population could be isolated, and this mispronunciation should become the +rule, it might prove the first stage of transition from _t_ to _k_, which +is the disease of Polynesian languages. The tendency of the Marquesans, +however, is to urge against consonants, or at least on the very common +letter _l_, a war of mere extermination. A hiatus is agreeable to any +Polynesian ear; the ear even of the stranger soon grows used to these +barbaric voids; but only in the Marquesan will you find such names as +_Haaii_ and _Paaaeua_, when each individual vowel must be separately +uttered. + +These points of similarity between a South Sea people and some of my own +folk at home ran much in my head in the islands; and not only inclined me +to view my fresh acquaintances with favour, but continually modified my +judgment. A polite Englishman comes to-day to the Marquesans and is +amazed to find the men tattooed; polite Italians came not long ago to +England and found our fathers stained with woad; and when I paid the +return visit as a little boy, I was highly diverted with the backwardness +of Italy: so insecure, so much a matter of the day and hour, is the +pre-eminence of race. It was so that I hit upon a means of communication +which I recommend to travellers. When I desired any detail of savage +custom, or of superstitious belief, I cast back in the story of my +fathers, and fished for what I wanted with some trait of equal barbarism: +Michael Scott, Lord Derwentwater’s head, the second-sight, the Water +Kelpie,—each of these I have found to be a killing bait; the black bull’s +head of Stirling procured me the legend of _Rahero_; and what I knew of +the Cluny Macphersons, or the Appin Stewarts, enabled me to learn, and +helped me to understand, about the _Tevas_ of Tahiti. The native was no +longer ashamed, his sense of kinship grew warmer, and his lips were +opened. It is this sense of kinship that the traveller must rouse and +share; or he had better content himself with travels from the blue bed to +the brown. And the presence of one Cockney titterer will cause a whole +party to walk in clouds of darkness. + +The hamlet of Anaho stands on a margin of flat land between the west of +the beach and the spring of the impending mountains. A grove of palms, +perpetually ruffling its green fans, carpets it (as for a triumph) with +fallen branches, and shades it like an arbour. A road runs from end to +end of the covert among beds of flowers, the milliner’s shop of the +community; and here and there, in the grateful twilight, in an air filled +with a diversity of scents, and still within hearing of the surf upon the +reef, the native houses stand in scattered neighbourhood. The same word, +as we have seen, represents in many tongues of Polynesia, with scarce a +shade of difference, the abode of man. But although the word be the +same, the structure itself continually varies; and the Marquesan, among +the most backward and barbarous of islanders, is yet the most +commodiously lodged. The grass huts of Hawaii, the birdcage houses of +Tahiti, or the open shed, with the crazy Venetian blinds, of the polite +Samoan—none of these can be compared with the Marquesan _paepae-hae_, or +dwelling platform. The paepae is an oblong terrace built without cement +or black volcanic stone, from twenty to fifty feet in length, raised from +four to eight feet from the earth, and accessible by a broad stair. +Along the back of this, and coming to about half its width, runs the open +front of the house, like a covered gallery: the interior sometimes neat +and almost elegant in its bareness, the sleeping space divided off by an +endlong coaming, some bright raiment perhaps hanging from a nail, and a +lamp and one of White’s sewing-machines the only marks of civilization. +On the outside, at one end of the terrace, burns the cooking-fire under a +shed; at the other there is perhaps a pen for pigs; the remainder is the +evening lounge and _al fresco_ banquet-hall of the inhabitants. To some +houses water is brought down the mountains in bamboo pipes, perforated +for the sake of sweetness. With the Highland comparison in my mind, I +was struck to remember the sluttish mounds of turf and stone in which I +have sat and been entertained in the Hebrides and the North Islands. Two +things, I suppose, explain the contrast. In Scotland wood is rare, and +with materials so rude as turf and stone the very hope of neatness is +excluded. And in Scotland it is cold. Shelter and a hearth are needs so +pressing that a man looks not beyond; he is out all day after a bare +bellyful, and at night when he saith, ‘Aha, it is warm!’ he has not +appetite for more. Or if for something else, then something higher; a +fine school of poetry and song arose in these rough shelters, and an air +like ‘_Lochaber no more_’ is an evidence of refinement more convincing, +as well as more imperishable, than a palace. + +To one such dwelling platform a considerable troop of relatives and +dependants resort. In the hour of the dusk, when the fire blazes, and +the scent of the cooked breadfruit fills the air, and perhaps the lamp +glints already between the pillars and the house, you shall behold them +silently assemble to this meal, men, women, and children; and the dogs +and pigs frisk together up the terrace stairway, switching rival tails. +The strangers from the ship were soon equally welcome: welcome to dip +their fingers in the wooden dish, to drink cocoanuts, to share the +circulating pipe, and to hear and hold high debate about the misdeeds of +the French, the Panama Canal, or the geographical position of San +Francisco and New Yo’ko. In a Highland hamlet, quite out of reach of any +tourist, I have met the same plain and dignified hospitality. + +I have mentioned two facts—the distasteful behaviour of our earliest +visitors, and the case of the lady who rubbed herself upon the +cushions—which would give a very false opinion of Marquesan manners. The +great majority of Polynesians are excellently mannered; but the Marquesan +stands apart, annoying and attractive, wild, shy, and refined. If you +make him a present he affects to forget it, and it must be offered him +again at his going: a pretty formality I have found nowhere else. A hint +will get rid of any one or any number; they are so fiercely proud and +modest; while many of the more lovable but blunter islanders crowd upon a +stranger, and can be no more driven off than flies. A slight or an +insult the Marquesan seems never to forget. I was one day talking by the +wayside with my friend Hoka, when I perceived his eyes suddenly to flash +and his stature to swell. A white horseman was coming down the mountain, +and as he passed, and while he paused to exchange salutations with +myself, Hoka was still staring and ruffling like a gamecock. It was a +Corsican who had years before called him _cochon sauvage—coçon chauvage_, +as Hoka mispronounced it. With people so nice and so touchy, it was +scarce to be supposed that our company of greenhorns should not blunder +into offences. Hoka, on one of his visits, fell suddenly in a brooding +silence, and presently after left the ship with cold formality. When he +took me back into favour, he adroitly and pointedly explained the nature +of my offence: I had asked him to sell cocoa-nuts; and in Hoka’s view +articles of food were things that a gentleman should give, not sell; or +at least that he should not sell to any friend. On another occasion I +gave my boat’s crew a luncheon of chocolate and biscuits. I had sinned, +I could never learn how, against some point of observance; and though I +was drily thanked, my offerings were left upon the beach. But our worst +mistake was a slight we put on Toma, Hoka’s adoptive father, and in his +own eyes the rightful chief of Anaho. In the first place, we did not +call upon him, as perhaps we should, in his fine new European house, the +only one in the hamlet. In the second, when we came ashore upon a visit +to his rival, Taipi-Kikino, it was Toma whom we saw standing at the head +of the beach, a magnificent figure of a man, magnificently tattooed; and +it was of Toma that we asked our question: ‘Where is the chief?’ ‘What +chief?’ cried Toma, and turned his back on the blasphemers. Nor did he +forgive us. Hoka came and went with us daily; but, alone I believe of +all the countryside, neither Toma nor his wife set foot on board the +_Casco_. The temptation resisted it is hard for a European to compute. +The flying city of Laputa moored for a fortnight in St. James’s Park +affords but a pale figure of the _Casco_ anchored before Anaho; for the +Londoner has still his change of pleasures, but the Marquesan passes to +his grave through an unbroken uniformity of days. + +On the afternoon before it was intended we should sail, a valedictory +party came on board: nine of our particular friends equipped with gifts +and dressed as for a festival. Hoka, the chief dancer and singer, the +greatest dandy of Anaho, and one of the handsomest young fellows in the +world-sullen, showy, dramatic, light as a feather and strong as an ox—it +would have been hard, on that occasion, to recognise, as he sat there +stooped and silent, his face heavy and grey. It was strange to see the +lad so much affected; stranger still to recognise in his last gift one of +the curios we had refused on the first day, and to know our friend, so +gaily dressed, so plainly moved at our departure, for one of the +half-naked crew that had besieged and insulted us on our arrival: +strangest of all, perhaps, to find, in that carved handle of a fan, the +last of those curiosities of the first day which had now all been given +to us by their possessors—their chief merchandise, for which they had +sought to ransom us as long as we were strangers, which they pressed on +us for nothing as soon as we were friends. The last visit was not long +protracted. One after another they shook hands and got down into their +canoe; when Hoka turned his back immediately upon the ship, so that we +saw his face no more. Taipi, on the other hand, remained standing and +facing us with gracious valedictory gestures; and when Captain Otis +dipped the ensign, the whole party saluted with their hats. This was the +farewell; the episode of our visit to Anaho was held concluded; and +though the _Casco_ remained nearly forty hours at her moorings, not one +returned on board, and I am inclined to think they avoided appearing on +the beach. This reserve and dignity is the finest trait of the +Marquesan. + + + +CHAPTER III—THE MAROON + + +Of the beauties of Anaho books might be written. I remember waking about +three, to find the air temperate and scented. The long swell brimmed +into the bay, and seemed to fill it full and then subside. Gently, +deeply, and silently the _Casco_ rolled; only at times a block piped like +a bird. Oceanward, the heaven was bright with stars and the sea with +their reflections. If I looked to that side, I might have sung with the +Hawaiian poet: + + _Ua maomao ka lani_, _ua kahaea luna_, + _Ua pipi ka maka o ka hoku_. + (The heavens were fair, they stretched above, + Many were the eyes of the stars.) + +And then I turned shoreward, and high squalls were overhead; the +mountains loomed up black; and I could have fancied I had slipped ten +thousand miles away and was anchored in a Highland loch; that when the +day came, it would show pine, and heather, and green fern, and roofs of +turf sending up the smoke of peats; and the alien speech that should next +greet my ears must be Gaelic, not Kanaka. + +And day, when it came, brought other sights and thoughts. I have watched +the morning break in many quarters of the world; it has been certainly +one of the chief joys of my existence, and the dawn that I saw with most +emotion shone upon the bay of Anaho. The mountains abruptly overhang the +port with every variety of surface and of inclination, lawn, and cliff, +and forest. Not one of these but wore its proper tint of saffron, of +sulphur, of the clove, and of the rose. The lustre was like that of +satin; on the lighter hues there seemed to float an efflorescence; a +solemn bloom appeared on the more dark. The light itself was the +ordinary light of morning, colourless and clean; and on this ground of +jewels, pencilled out the least detail of drawing. Meanwhile, around the +hamlet, under the palms, where the blue shadow lingered, the red coals of +cocoa husk and the light trails of smoke betrayed the awakening business +of the day; along the beach men and women, lads and lasses, were +returning from the bath in bright raiment, red and blue and green, such +as we delighted to see in the coloured little pictures of our childhood; +and presently the sun had cleared the eastern hill, and the glow of the +day was over all. + +The glow continued and increased, the business, from the main part, +ceased before it had begun. Twice in the day there was a certain stir of +shepherding along the seaward hills. At times a canoe went out to fish. +At times a woman or two languidly filled a basket in the cotton patch. +At times a pipe would sound out of the shadow of a house, ringing the +changes on its three notes, with an effect like _Que le jour me dure_, +repeated endlessly. Or at times, across a corner of the bay, two natives +might communicate in the Marquesan manner with conventional whistlings. +All else was sleep and silence. The surf broke and shone around the +shores; a species of black crane fished in the broken water; the black +pigs were continually galloping by on some affair; but the people might +never have awaked, or they might all be dead. + +My favourite haunt was opposite the hamlet, where was a landing in a cove +under a lianaed cliff. The beach was lined with palms and a tree called +the purao, something between the fig and mulberry in growth, and bearing +a flower like a great yellow poppy with a maroon heart. In places rocks +encroached upon the sand; the beach would be all submerged; and the surf +would bubble warmly as high as to my knees, and play with cocoa-nut husks +as our more homely ocean plays with wreck and wrack and bottles. As the +reflux drew down, marvels of colour and design streamed between my feet; +which I would grasp at, miss, or seize: now to find them what they +promised, shells to grace a cabinet or be set in gold upon a lady’s +finger; now to catch only _maya_ of coloured sand, pounded fragments and +pebbles, that, as soon as they were dry, became as dull and homely as the +flints upon a garden path. I have toiled at this childish pleasure for +hours in the strong sun, conscious of my incurable ignorance; but too +keenly pleased to be ashamed. Meanwhile, the blackbird (or his tropical +understudy) would be fluting in the thickets overhead. + +A little further, in the turn of the bay, a streamlet trickled in the +bottom of a den, thence spilling down a stair of rock into the sea. The +draught of air drew down under the foliage in the very bottom of the den, +which was a perfect arbour for coolness. In front it stood open on the +blue bay and the _Casco_ lying there under her awning and her cheerful +colours. Overhead was a thatch of puraos, and over these again palms +brandished their bright fans, as I have seen a conjurer make himself a +halo out of naked swords. For in this spot, over a neck of low land at +the foot of the mountains, the trade-wind streams into Anaho Bay in a +flood of almost constant volume and velocity, and of a heavenly coolness. + +It chanced one day that I was ashore in the cove, with Mrs. Stevenson and +the ship’s cook. Except for the _Casco_ lying outside, and a crane or +two, and the ever-busy wind and sea, the face of the world was of a +prehistoric emptiness; life appeared to stand stock-still, and the sense +of isolation was profound and refreshing. On a sudden, the trade-wind, +coming in a gust over the isthmus, struck and scattered the fans of the +palms above the den; and, behold! in two of the tops there sat a native, +motionless as an idol and watching us, you would have said, without a +wink. The next moment the tree closed, and the glimpse was gone. This +discovery of human presences latent overhead in a place where we had +supposed ourselves alone, the immobility of our tree-top spies, and the +thought that perhaps at all hours we were similarly supervised, struck us +with a chill. Talk languished on the beach. As for the cook (whose +conscience was not clear), he never afterwards set foot on shore, and +twice, when the _Casco_ appeared to be driving on the rocks, it was +amusing to observe that man’s alacrity; death, he was persuaded, awaiting +him upon the beach. It was more than a year later, in the Gilberts, that +the explanation dawned upon myself. The natives were drawing palm-tree +wine, a thing forbidden by law; and when the wind thus suddenly revealed +them, they were doubtless more troubled than ourselves. + +At the top of the den there dwelt an old, melancholy, grizzled man of the +name of Tari (Charlie) Coffin. He was a native of Oahu, in the Sandwich +Islands; and had gone to sea in his youth in the American whalers; a +circumstance to which he owed his name, his English, his down-east twang, +and the misfortune of his innocent life. For one captain, sailing out of +New Bedford, carried him to Nuka-hiva and marooned him there among the +cannibals. The motive for this act was inconceivably small; poor Tari’s +wages, which were thus economised, would scarce have shook the credit of +the New Bedford owners. And the act itself was simply murder. Tari’s +life must have hung in the beginning by a hair. In the grief and terror +of that time, it is not unlikely he went mad, an infirmity to which he +was still liable; or perhaps a child may have taken a fancy to him and +ordained him to be spared. He escaped at least alive, married in the +island, and when I knew him was a widower with a married son and a +granddaughter. But the thought of Oahu haunted him; its praise was for +ever on his lips; he beheld it, looking back, as a place of ceaseless +feasting, song, and dance; and in his dreams I daresay he revisits it +with joy. I wonder what he would think if he could be carried there +indeed, and see the modern town of Honolulu brisk with traffic, and the +palace with its guards, and the great hotel, and Mr. Berger’s band with +their uniforms and outlandish instruments; or what he would think to see +the brown faces grown so few and the white so many; and his father’s land +sold, for planting sugar, and his father’s house quite perished, or +perhaps the last of them struck leprous and immured between the surf and +the cliffs on Molokai? So simply, even in South Sea Islands, and so +sadly, the changes come. + +Tari was poor, and poorly lodged. His house was a wooden frame, run up +by Europeans; it was indeed his official residence, for Tari was the +shepherd of the promontory sheep. I can give a perfect inventory of its +contents: three kegs, a tin biscuit-box, an iron saucepan, several +cocoa-shell cups, a lantern, and three bottles, probably containing oil; +while the clothes of the family and a few mats were thrown across the +open rafters. Upon my first meeting with this exile he had conceived for +me one of the baseless island friendships, had given me nuts to drink, +and carried me up the den ‘to see my house’—the only entertainment that +he had to offer. He liked the ‘Amelican,’ he said, and the ‘Inglisman,’ +but the ‘Flessman’ was his abhorrence; and he was careful to explain that +if he had thought us ‘Fless,’ we should have had none of his nuts, and +never a sight of his house. His distaste for the French I can partly +understand, but not at all his toleration of the Anglo-Saxon. The next +day he brought me a pig, and some days later one of our party going +ashore found him in act to bring a second. We were still strange to the +islands; we were pained by the poor man’s generosity, which he could ill +afford, and, by a natural enough but quite unpardonable blunder, we +refused the pig. Had Tari been a Marquesan we should have seen him no +more; being what he was, the most mild, long-suffering, melancholy man, +he took a revenge a hundred times more painful. Scarce had the canoe +with the nine villagers put off from their farewell before the _Casco_ +was boarded from the other side. It was Tari; coming thus late because +he had no canoe of his own, and had found it hard to borrow one; coming +thus solitary (as indeed we always saw him), because he was a stranger in +the land, and the dreariest of company. The rest of my family basely +fled from the encounter. I must receive our injured friend alone; and +the interview must have lasted hard upon an hour, for he was loath to +tear himself away. ‘You go ’way. I see you no more—no, sir!’ he +lamented; and then looking about him with rueful admiration, ‘This goodee +ship—no, sir!—goodee ship!’ he would exclaim: the ‘no, sir,’ thrown out +sharply through the nose upon a rising inflection, an echo from New +Bedford and the fallacious whaler. From these expressions of grief and +praise, he would return continually to the case of the rejected pig. ‘I +like give present all ’e same you,’ he complained; ‘only got pig: you no +take him!’ He was a poor man; he had no choice of gifts; he had only a +pig, he repeated; and I had refused it. I have rarely been more wretched +than to see him sitting there, so old, so grey, so poor, so hardly +fortuned, of so rueful a countenance, and to appreciate, with growing +keenness, the affront which I had so innocently dealt him; but it was one +of those cases in which speech is vain. + +Tari’s son was smiling and inert; his daughter-in-law, a girl of sixteen, +pretty, gentle, and grave, more intelligent than most Anaho women, and +with a fair share of French; his grandchild, a mite of a creature at the +breast. I went up the den one day when Tari was from home, and found the +son making a cotton sack, and madame suckling mademoiselle. When I had +sat down with them on the floor, the girl began to question me about +England; which I tried to describe, piling the pan and the cocoa shells +one upon another to represent the houses, and explaining, as best I was +able, and by word and gesture, the over-population, the hunger, and the +perpetual toil. ‘_Pas de cocotiers_? _pas do popoi_?’ she asked. I told +her it was too cold, and went through an elaborate performance, shutting +out draughts, and crouching over an imaginary fire, to make sure she +understood. But she understood right well; remarked it must be bad for +the health, and sat a while gravely reflecting on that picture of +unwonted sorrows. I am sure it roused her pity, for it struck in her +another thought always uppermost in the Marquesan bosom; and she began +with a smiling sadness, and looking on me out of melancholy eyes, to +lament the decease of her own people. ‘_Ici pas de Kanaques_,’ said she; +and taking the baby from her breast, she held it out to me with both her +hands. ‘_Tenez_—a little baby like this; then dead. All the Kanaques +die. Then no more.’ The smile, and this instancing by the girl-mother +of her own tiny flesh and blood, affected me strangely; they spoke of so +tranquil a despair. Meanwhile the husband smilingly made his sack; and +the unconscious babe struggled to reach a pot of raspberry jam, +friendship’s offering, which I had just brought up the den; and in a +perspective of centuries I saw their case as ours, death coming in like a +tide, and the day already numbered when there should be no more Beretani, +and no more of any race whatever, and (what oddly touched me) no more +literary works and no more readers. + + + +CHAPTER IV—DEATH + + +The thought of death, I have said, is uppermost in the mind of the +Marquesan. It would be strange if it were otherwise. The race is +perhaps the handsomest extant. Six feet is about the middle height of +males; they are strongly muscled, free from fat, swift in action, +graceful in repose; and the women, though fatter and duller, are still +comely animals. To judge by the eye, there is no race more viable; and +yet death reaps them with both hands. When Bishop Dordillon first came +to Tai-o-hae, he reckoned the inhabitants at many thousands; he was but +newly dead, and in the same bay Stanislao Moanatini counted on his +fingers eight residual natives. Or take the valley of Hapaa, known to +readers of Herman Melville under the grotesque misspelling of Hapar. +There are but two writers who have touched the South Seas with any +genius, both Americans: Melville and Charles Warren Stoddard; and at the +christening of the first and greatest, some influential fairy must have +been neglected: ‘He shall be able to see,’ ‘He shall be able to tell,’ +‘He shall be able to charm,’ said the friendly godmothers; ‘But he shall +not be able to hear,’ exclaimed the last. The tribe of Hapaa is said to +have numbered some four hundred, when the small-pox came and reduced them +by one-fourth. Six months later a woman developed tubercular +consumption; the disease spread like a fire about the valley, and in less +than a year two survivors, a man and a woman, fled from that new-created +solitude. A similar Adam and Eve may some day wither among new races, +the tragic residue of Britain. When I first heard this story the date +staggered me; but I am now inclined to think it possible. Early in the +year of my visit, for example, or late the year before, a first case of +phthisis appeared in a household of seventeen persons, and by the month +of August, when the tale was told me, one soul survived, and that was a +boy who had been absent at his schooling. And depopulation works both +ways, the doors of death being set wide open, and the door of birth +almost closed. Thus, in the half-year ending July 1888 there were twelve +deaths and but one birth in the district of the Hatiheu. Seven or eight +more deaths were to be looked for in the ordinary course; and M. Aussel, +the observant gendarme, knew of but one likely birth. At this rate it is +no matter of surprise if the population in that part should have declined +in forty years from six thousand to less than four hundred; which are, +once more on the authority of M. Aussel, the estimated figures. And the +rate of decline must have even accelerated towards the end. + +A good way to appreciate the depopulation is to go by land from Anaho to +Hatiheu on the adjacent bay. The road is good travelling, but cruelly +steep. We seemed scarce to have passed the deserted house which stands +highest in Anaho before we were looking dizzily down upon its roof; the +_Casco_ well out in the bay, and rolling for a wager, shrank visibly; and +presently through the gap of Tari’s isthmus, Ua-huna was seen to hang +cloudlike on the horizon. Over the summit, where the wind blew really +chill, and whistled in the reed-like grass, and tossed the grassy fell of +the pandanus, we stepped suddenly, as through a door, into the next vale +and bay of Hatiheu. A bowl of mountains encloses it upon three sides. +On the fourth this rampart has been bombarded into ruins, runs down to +seaward in imminent and shattered crags, and presents the one practicable +breach of the blue bay. The interior of this vessel is crowded with +lovely and valuable trees,—orange, breadfruit, mummy-apple, cocoa, the +island chestnut, and for weeds, the pine and the banana. Four perennial +streams water and keep it green; and along the dell, first of one, then +of another, of these, the road, for a considerable distance, descends +into this fortunate valley. The song of the waters and the familiar +disarray of boulders gave us a strong sense of home, which the exotic +foliage, the daft-like growth of the pandanus, the buttressed trunk of +the banyan, the black pigs galloping in the bush, and the architecture of +the native houses dissipated ere it could be enjoyed. + +The houses on the Hatiheu side begin high up; higher yet, the more +melancholy spectacle of empty paepaes. When a native habitation is +deserted, the superstructure—pandanus thatch, wattle, unstable tropical +timber—speedily rots, and is speedily scattered by the wind. Only the +stones of the terrace endure; nor can any ruin, cairn, or standing stone, +or vitrified fort present a more stern appearance of antiquity. We must +have passed from six to eight of these now houseless platforms. On the +main road of the island, where it crosses the valley of Taipi, Mr. +Osbourne tells me they are to be reckoned by the dozen; and as the roads +have been made long posterior to their erection, perhaps to their +desertion, and must simply be regarded as lines drawn at random through +the bush, the forest on either hand must be equally filled with these +survivals: the gravestones of whole families. Such ruins are tapu {29} +in the strictest sense; no native must approach them; they have become +outposts of the kingdom of the grave. It might appear a natural and +pious custom in the hundreds who are left, the rearguard of perished +thousands, that their feet should leave untrod these hearthstones of +their fathers. I believe, in fact, the custom rests on different and +more grim conceptions. But the house, the grave, and even the body of +the dead, have been always particularly honoured by Marquesans. Until +recently the corpse was sometimes kept in the family and daily oiled and +sunned, until, by gradual and revolting stages, it dried into a kind of +mummy. Offerings are still laid upon the grave. In Traitor’s Bay, Mr. +Osbourne saw a man buy a looking-glass to lay upon his son’s. And the +sentiment against the desecration of tombs, thoughtlessly ruffled in the +laying down of the new roads, is a chief ingredient in the native hatred +for the French. + +The Marquesan beholds with dismay the approaching extinction of his race. +The thought of death sits down with him to meat, and rises with him from +his bed; he lives and breathes under a shadow of mortality awful to +support; and he is so inured to the apprehension that he greets the +reality with relief. He does not even seek to support a disappointment; +at an affront, at a breach of one of his fleeting and communistic +love-affairs, he seeks an instant refuge in the grave. Hanging is now +the fashion. I heard of three who had hanged themselves in the west end +of Hiva-oa during the first half of 1888; but though this be a common +form of suicide in other parts of the South Seas, I cannot think it will +continue popular in the Marquesas. Far more suitable to Marquesan +sentiment is the old form of poisoning with the fruit of the eva, which +offers to the native suicide a cruel but deliberate death, and gives time +for those decencies of the last hour, to which he attaches such +remarkable importance. The coffin can thus be at hand, the pigs killed, +the cry of the mourners sounding already through the house; and then it +is, and not before, that the Marquesan is conscious of achievement, his +life all rounded in, his robes (like Cæsar’s) adjusted for the final act. +Praise not any man till he is dead, said the ancients; envy not any man +till you hear the mourners, might be the Marquesan parody. The coffin, +though of late introduction, strangely engages their attention. It is to +the mature Marquesan what a watch is to the European schoolboy. For ten +years Queen Vaekehu had dunned the fathers; at last, but the other day, +they let her have her will, gave her her coffin, and the woman’s soul is +at rest. I was told a droll instance of the force of this preoccupation. +The Polynesians are subject to a disease seemingly rather of the will +than of the body. I was told the Tahitians have a word for it, +_erimatua_, but cannot find it in my dictionary. A gendarme, M. Nouveau, +has seen men beginning to succumb to this insubstantial malady, has +routed them from their houses, turned them on to do their trick upon the +roads, and in two days has seen them cured. But this other remedy is +more original: a Marquesan, dying of this discouragement—perhaps I should +rather say this acquiescence—has been known, at the fulfilment of his +crowning wish, on the mere sight of that desired hermitage, his coffin—to +revive, recover, shake off the hand of death, and be restored for years +to his occupations—carving tikis (idols), let us say, or braiding old +men’s beards. From all this it may be conceived how easily they meet +death when it approaches naturally. I heard one example, grim and +picturesque. In the time of the small-pox in Hapaa, an old man was +seized with the disease; he had no thought of recovery; had his grave dug +by a wayside, and lived in it for near a fortnight, eating, drinking, and +smoking with the passers-by, talking mostly of his end, and equally +unconcerned for himself and careless of the friends whom he infected. + +This proneness to suicide, and loose seat in life, is not peculiar to the +Marquesan. What is peculiar is the widespread depression and acceptance +of the national end. Pleasures are neglected, the dance languishes, the +songs are forgotten. It is true that some, and perhaps too many, of them +are proscribed; but many remain, if there were spirit to support or to +revive them. At the last feast of the Bastille, Stanislao Moanatini shed +tears when he beheld the inanimate performance of the dancers. When the +people sang for us in Anaho, they must apologise for the smallness of +their repertory. They were only young folk present, they said, and it +was only the old that knew the songs. The whole body of Marquesan poetry +and music was being suffered to die out with a single dispirited +generation. The full import is apparent only to one acquainted with +other Polynesian races; who knows how the Samoan coins a fresh song for +every trifling incident, or who has heard (on Penrhyn, for instance) a +band of little stripling maids from eight to twelve keep up their +minstrelsy for hours upon a stretch, one song following another without +pause. In like manner, the Marquesan, never industrious, begins now to +cease altogether from production. The exports of the group decline out +of all proportion even with the death-rate of the islanders. ‘The coral +waxes, the palm grows, and man departs,’ says the Marquesan; and he folds +his hands. And surely this is nature. Fond as it may appear, we labour +and refrain, not for the rewards of any single life, but with a timid eye +upon the lives and memories of our successors; and where no one is to +succeed, of his own family, or his own tongue, I doubt whether +Rothschilds would make money or Cato practise virtue. It is natural, +also, that a temporary stimulus should sometimes rouse the Marquesan from +his lethargy. Over all the landward shore of Anaho cotton runs like a +wild weed; man or woman, whoever comes to pick it, may earn a dollar in +the day; yet when we arrived, the trader’s store-house was entirely +empty; and before we left it was near full. So long as the circus was +there, so long as the _Casco_ was yet anchored in the bay, it behoved +every one to make his visit; and to this end every woman must have a new +dress, and every man a shirt and trousers. Never before, in Mr. Regler’s +experience, had they displayed so much activity. + +In their despondency there is an element of dread. The fear of ghosts +and of the dark is very deeply written in the mind of the Polynesian; not +least of the Marquesan. Poor Taipi, the chief of Anaho, was condemned to +ride to Hatiheu on a moonless night. He borrowed a lantern, sat a long +while nerving himself for the adventure, and when he at last departed, +wrung the _Cascos_ by the hand as for a final separation. Certain +presences, called Vehinehae, frequent and make terrible the nocturnal +roadside; I was told by one they were like so much mist, and as the +traveller walked into them dispersed and dissipated; another described +them as being shaped like men and having eyes like cats; from none could +I obtain the smallest clearness as to what they did, or wherefore they +were dreaded. We may be sure at least they represent the dead; for the +dead, in the minds of the islanders, are all-pervasive. ‘When a native +says that he is a man,’ writes Dr. Codrington, ‘he means that he is a man +and not a ghost; not that he is a man and not a beast. The intelligent +agents of this world are to his mind the men who are alive, and the +ghosts the men who are dead.’ Dr. Codrington speaks of Melanesia; from +what I have learned his words are equally true of the Polynesian. And +yet more. Among cannibal Polynesians a dreadful suspicion rests +generally on the dead; and the Marquesans, the greatest cannibals of all, +are scarce likely to be free from similar beliefs. I hazard the guess +that the Vehinehae are the hungry spirits of the dead, continuing their +life’s business of the cannibal ambuscade, and lying everywhere unseen, +and eager to devour the living. Another superstition I picked up through +the troubled medium of Tari Coffin’s English. The dead, he told me, came +and danced by night around the paepae of their former family; the family +were thereupon overcome by some emotion (but whether of pious sorrow or +of fear I could not gather), and must ‘make a feast,’ of which fish, pig, +and popoi were indispensable ingredients. So far this is clear enough. +But here Tari went on to instance the new house of Toma and the +house-warming feast which was just then in preparation as instances in +point. Dare we indeed string them together, and add the case of the +deserted ruin, as though the dead continually besieged the paepaes of the +living: were kept at arm’s-length, even from the first foundation, only +by propitiatory feasts, and, so soon as the fire of life went out upon +the hearth, swarmed back into possession of their ancient seat? + +I speak by guess of these Marquesan superstitions. On the cannibal ghost +I shall return elsewhere with certainty. And it is enough, for the +present purpose, to remark that the men of the Marquesas, from whatever +reason, fear and shrink from the presence of ghosts. Conceive how this +must tell upon the nerves in islands where the number of the dead already +so far exceeds that of the living, and the dead multiply and the living +dwindle at so swift a rate. Conceive how the remnant huddles about the +embers of the fire of life; even as old Red Indians, deserted on the +march and in the snow, the kindly tribe all gone, the last flame +expiring, and the night around populous with wolves. + + + +CHAPTER V—DEPOPULATION + + +Over the whole extent of the South Seas, from one tropic to another, we +find traces of a bygone state of over-population, when the resources of +even a tropical soil were taxed, and even the improvident Polynesian +trembled for the future. We may accept some of the ideas of Mr. Darwin’s +theory of coral islands, and suppose a rise of the sea, or the subsidence +of some former continental area, to have driven into the tops of the +mountains multitudes of refugees. Or we may suppose, more soberly, a +people of sea-rovers, emigrants from a crowded country, to strike upon +and settle island after island, and as time went on to multiply +exceedingly in their new seats. In either case the end must be the same; +soon or late it must grow apparent that the crew are too numerous, and +that famine is at hand. The Polynesians met this emergent danger with +various expedients of activity and prevention. A way was found to +preserve breadfruit by packing it in artificial pits; pits forty feet in +depth and of proportionate bore are still to be seen, I am told, in the +Marquesas; and yet even these were insufficient for the teeming people, +and the annals of the past are gloomy with famine and cannibalism. Among +the Hawaiians—a hardier people, in a more exacting climate—agriculture +was carried far; the land was irrigated with canals; and the fish-ponds +of Molokai prove the number and diligence of the old inhabitants. +Meanwhile, over all the island world, abortion and infanticide prevailed. +On coral atolls, where the danger was most plainly obvious, these were +enforced by law and sanctioned by punishment. On Vaitupu, in the +Ellices, only two children were allowed to a couple; on Nukufetau, but +one. On the latter the punishment was by fine; and it is related that +the fine was sometimes paid, and the child spared. + +This is characteristic. For no people in the world are so fond or so +long-suffering with children—children make the mirth and the adornment of +their homes, serving them for playthings and for picture-galleries. +‘Happy is the man that has his quiver full of them.’ The stray bastard +is contended for by rival families; and the natural and the adopted +children play and grow up together undistinguished. The spoiling, and I +may almost say the deification, of the child, is nowhere carried so far +as in the eastern islands; and furthest, according to my opportunities of +observation, in the Paumotu group, the so-called Low or Dangerous +Archipelago. I have seen a Paumotuan native turn from me with +embarrassment and disaffection because I suggested that a brat would be +the better for a beating. It is a daily matter in some eastern islands +to see a child strike or even stone its mother, and the mother, so far +from punishing, scarce ventures to resist. In some, when his child was +born, a chief was superseded and resigned his name; as though, like a +drone, he had then fulfilled the occasion of his being. And in some the +lightest words of children had the weight of oracles. Only the other +day, in the Marquesas, if a child conceived a distaste to any stranger, I +am assured the stranger would be slain. And I shall have to tell in +another place an instance of the opposite: how a child in Manihiki having +taken a fancy to myself, her adoptive parents at once accepted the +situation and loaded me with gifts. + +With such sentiments the necessity for child-destruction would not fail +to clash, and I believe we find the trace of divided feeling in the +Tahitian brotherhood of Oro. At a certain date a new god was added to +the Society-Island Olympus, or an old one refurbished and made popular. +Oro was his name, and he may be compared with the Bacchus of the +ancients. His zealots sailed from bay to bay, and from island to island; +they were everywhere received with feasting; wore fine clothes; sang, +danced, acted; gave exhibitions of dexterity and strength; and were the +artists, the acrobats, the bards, and the harlots of the group. Their +life was public and epicurean; their initiation a mystery; and the +highest in the land aspired to join the brotherhood. If a couple stood +next in line to a high-chieftaincy, they were suffered, on grounds of +policy, to spare one child; all other children, who had a father or a +mother in the company of Oro, stood condemned from the moment of +conception. A freemasonry, an agnostic sect, a company of artists, its +members all under oath to spread unchastity, and all forbidden to leave +offspring—I do not know how it may appear to others, but to me the design +seems obvious. Famine menacing the islands, and the needful remedy +repulsive, it was recommended to the native mind by these trappings of +mystery, pleasure, and parade. This is the more probable, and the +secret, serious purpose of the institution appears the more plainly, if +it be true that, after a certain period of life, the obligation of the +votary was changed; at first, bound to be profligate: afterwards, +expected to be chaste. + +Here, then, we have one side of the case. Man-eating among kindly men, +child-murder among child-lovers, industry in a race the most idle, +invention in a race the least progressive, this grim, pagan +salvation-army of the brotherhood of Oro, the report of early voyagers, +the widespread vestiges of former habitation, and the universal tradition +of the islands, all point to the same fact of former crowding and alarm. +And to-day we are face to face with the reverse. To-day in the +Marquesas, in the Eight Islands of Hawaii, in Mangareva, in Easter +Island, we find the same race perishing like flies. Why this change? +Or, grant that the coming of the whites, the change of habits, and the +introduction of new maladies and vices, fully explain the depopulation, +why is that depopulation not universal? The population of Tahiti, after +a period of alarming decrease, has again become stationary. I hear of a +similar result among some Maori tribes; in many of the Paumotus a slight +increase is to be observed; and the Samoans are to-day as healthy and at +least as fruitful as before the change. Grant that the Tahitians, the +Maoris, and the Paumotuans have become inured to the new conditions; and +what are we to make of the Samoans, who have never suffered? + +Those who are acquainted only with a single group are apt to be ready +with solutions. Thus I have heard the mortality of the Maoris attributed +to their change of residence—from fortified hill-tops to the low, marshy +vicinity of their plantations. How plausible! And yet the Marquesans +are dying out in the same houses where their fathers multiplied. Or take +opium. The Marquesas and Hawaii are the two groups the most infected +with this vice; the population of the one is the most civilised, that of +the other by far the most barbarous, of Polynesians; and they are two of +those that perish the most rapidly. Here is a strong case against opium. +But let us take unchastity, and we shall find the Marquesas and Hawaii +figuring again upon another count. Thus, Samoans are the most chaste of +Polynesians, and they are to this day entirely fertile; Marquesans are +the most debauched: we have seen how they are perishing; Hawaiians are +notoriously lax, and they begin to be dotted among deserts. So here is a +case stronger still against unchastity; and here also we have a +correction to apply. Whatever the virtues of the Tahitian, neither +friend nor enemy dares call him chaste; and yet he seems to have outlived +the time of danger. One last example: syphilis has been plausibly +credited with much of the sterility. But the Samoans are, by all +accounts, as fruitful as at first; by some accounts more so; and it is +not seriously to be argued that the Samoans have escaped syphilis. + +These examples show how dangerous it is to reason from any particular +cause, or even from many in a single group. I have in my eye an able and +amiable pamphlet by the Rev. S. E. Bishop: ‘Why are the Hawaiians Dying +Out?’ Any one interested in the subject ought to read this tract, which +contains real information; and yet Mr. Bishop’s views would have been +changed by an acquaintance with other groups. Samoa is, for the moment, +the main and the most instructive exception to the rule. The people are +the most chaste and one of the most temperate of island peoples. They +have never been tried and depressed with any grave pestilence. Their +clothing has scarce been tampered with; at the simple and becoming tabard +of the girls, Tartuffe, in many another island, would have cried out; for +the cool, healthy, and modest lava-lava or kilt, Tartuffe has managed in +many another island to substitute stifling and inconvenient trousers. +Lastly, and perhaps chiefly, so far from their amusements having been +curtailed, I think they have been, upon the whole, extended. The +Polynesian falls easily into despondency: bereavement, disappointment, +the fear of novel visitations, the decay or proscription of ancient +pleasures, easily incline him to be sad; and sadness detaches him from +life. The melancholy of the Hawaiian and the emptiness of his new life +are striking; and the remark is yet more apposite to the Marquesas. In +Samoa, on the other hand, perpetual song and dance, perpetual games, +journeys, and pleasures, make an animated and a smiling picture of the +island life. And the Samoans are to-day the gayest and the best +entertained inhabitants of our planet. The importance of this can +scarcely be exaggerated. In a climate and upon a soil where a livelihood +can be had for the stooping, entertainment is a prime necessity. It is +otherwise with us, where life presents us with a daily problem, and there +is a serious interest, and some of the heat of conflict, in the mere +continuing to be. So, in certain atolls, where there is no great gaiety, +but man must bestir himself with some vigour for his daily bread, public +health and the population are maintained; but in the lotos islands, with +the decay of pleasures, life itself decays. It is from this point of +view that we may instance, among other causes of depression, the decay of +war. We have been so long used in Europe to that dreary business of war +on the great scale, trailing epidemics and leaving pestilential corpses +in its train, that we have almost forgotten its original, the most +healthful, if not the most humane, of all field sports—hedge-warfare. +From this, as well as from the rest of his amusements and interests, the +islander, upon a hundred islands, has been recently cut off. And to +this, as well as to so many others, the Samoan still makes good a special +title. + +Upon the whole, the problem seems to me to stand thus:—Where there have +been fewest changes, important or unimportant, salutary or hurtful, there +the race survives. Where there have been most, important or unimportant, +salutary or hurtful, there it perishes. Each change, however small, +augments the sum of new conditions to which the race has to become +inured. There may seem, _a priori_, no comparison between the change +from ‘sour toddy’ to bad gin, and that from the island kilt to a pair of +European trousers. Yet I am far from persuaded that the one is any more +hurtful than the other; and the unaccustomed race will sometimes die of +pin-pricks. We are here face to face with one of the difficulties of the +missionary. In Polynesian islands he easily obtains pre-eminent +authority; the king becomes his _mairedupalais_; he can proscribe, he can +command; and the temptation is ever towards too much. Thus (by all +accounts) the Catholics in Mangareva, and thus (to my own knowledge) the +Protestants in Hawaii, have rendered life in a more or less degree +unliveable to their converts. And the mild, uncomplaining creatures +(like children in a prison) yawn and await death. It is easy to blame +the missionary. But it is his business to make changes. It is surely +his business, for example, to prevent war; and yet I have instanced war +itself as one of the elements of health. On the other hand, it were, +perhaps, easy for the missionary to proceed more gently, and to regard +every change as an affair of weight. I take the average missionary; I am +sure I do him no more than justice when I suppose that he would hesitate +to bombard a village, even in order to convert an archipelago. +Experience begins to show us (at least in Polynesian islands) that change +of habit is bloodier than a bombardment. + +There is one point, ere I have done, where I may go to meet criticism. I +have said nothing of faulty hygiene, bathing during fevers, mistaken +treatment of children, native doctoring, or abortion—all causes +frequently adduced. And I have said nothing of them because they are +conditions common to both epochs, and even more efficient in the past +than in the present. Was it not the same with unchastity, it may be +asked? Was not the Polynesian always unchaste? Doubtless he was so +always: doubtless he is more so since the coming of his remarkably chaste +visitors from Europe. Take the Hawaiian account of Cook: I have no doubt +it is entirely fair. Take Krusenstern’s candid, almost innocent, +description of a Russian man-of-war at the Marquesas; consider the +disgraceful history of missions in Hawaii itself, where (in the war of +lust) the American missionaries were once shelled by an English +adventurer, and once raided and mishandled by the crew of an American +warship; add the practice of whaling fleets to call at the Marquesas, and +carry off a complement of women for the cruise; consider, besides, how +the whites were at first regarded in the light of demi-gods, as appears +plainly in the reception of Cook upon Hawaii; and again, in the story of +the discovery of Tutuila, when the really decent women of Samoa +prostituted themselves in public to the French; and bear in mind how it +was the custom of the adventurers, and we may almost say the business of +the missionaries, to deride and infract even the most salutary tapus. +Here we see every engine of dissolution directed at once against a virtue +never and nowhere very strong or popular; and the result, even in the +most degraded islands, has been further degradation. Mr. Lawes, the +missionary of Savage Island, told me the standard of female chastity had +declined there since the coming of the whites. In heathen time, if a +girl gave birth to a bastard, her father or brother would dash the infant +down the cliffs; and to-day the scandal would be small. Or take the +Marquesas. Stanislao Moanatini told me that in his own recollection, the +young were strictly guarded; they were not suffered so much as to look +upon one another in the street, but passed (so my informant put it) like +dogs; and the other day the whole school-children of Nuka-hiva and Ua-pu +escaped in a body to the woods, and lived there for a fortnight in +promiscuous liberty. Readers of travels may perhaps exclaim at my +authority, and declare themselves better informed. I should prefer the +statement of an intelligent native like Stanislao (even if it stood +alone, which it is far from doing) to the report of the most honest +traveller. A ship of war comes to a haven, anchors, lands a party, +receives and returns a visit, and the captain writes a chapter on the +manners of the island. It is not considered what class is mostly seen. +Yet we should not be pleased if a Lascar foremast hand were to judge +England by the ladies who parade Ratcliffe Highway, and the gentlemen who +share with them their hire. Stanislao’s opinion of a decay of virtue +even in these unvirtuous islands has been supported to me by others; his +very example, the progress of dissolution amongst the young, is adduced +by Mr. Bishop in Hawaii. And so far as Marquesans are concerned, we +might have hazarded a guess of some decline in manners. I do not think +that any race could ever have prospered or multiplied with such as now +obtain; I am sure they would have been never at the pains to count +paternal kinship. It is not possible to give details; suffice it that +their manners appear to be imitated from the dreams of ignorant and +vicious children, and their debauches persevered in until energy, reason, +and almost life itself are in abeyance. + + + +CHAPTER VI—CHIEFS AND TAPUS + + +We used to admire exceedingly the bland and gallant manners of the chief +called Taipi-Kikino. An elegant guest at table, skilled in the use of +knife and fork, a brave figure when he shouldered a gun and started for +the woods after wild chickens, always serviceable, always ingratiating +and gay, I would sometimes wonder where he found his cheerfulness. He +had enough to sober him, I thought, in his official budget. His +expenses—for he was always seen attired in virgin white—must have by far +exceeded his income of six dollars in the year, or say two shillings a +month. And he was himself a man of no substance; his house the poorest +in the village. It was currently supposed that his elder brother, +Kauanui, must have helped him out. But how comes it that the elder +brother should succeed to the family estate, and be a wealthy commoner, +and the younger be a poor man, and yet rule as chief in Anaho? That the +one should be wealthy, and the other almost indigent is probably to be +explained by some adoption; for comparatively few children are brought up +in the house or succeed to the estates of their natural begetters. That +the one should be chief instead of the other must be explained (in a very +Irish fashion) on the ground that neither of them is a chief at all. + +Since the return and the wars of the French, many chiefs have been +deposed, and many so-called chiefs appointed. We have seen, in the same +house, one such upstart drinking in the company of two such extruded +island Bourbons, men, whose word a few years ago was life and death, now +sunk to be peasants like their neighbours. So when the French overthrew +hereditary tyrants, dubbed the commons of the Marquesas freeborn citizens +of the republic, and endowed them with a vote for a _conseiller-général_ +at Tahiti, they probably conceived themselves upon the path to +popularity; and so far from that, they were revolting public sentiment. +The deposition of the chiefs was perhaps sometimes needful; the +appointment of others may have been needful also; it was at least a +delicate business. The Government of George II. exiled many Highland +magnates. It never occurred to them to manufacture substitutes; and if +the French have been more bold, we have yet to see with what success. + +Our chief at Anaho was always called, he always called himself, +Taipi-Kikino; and yet that was not his name, but only the wand of his +false position. As soon as he was appointed chief, his name—which +signified, if I remember exactly, _Prince born among flowers_—fell in +abeyance, and he was dubbed instead by the expressive byword, +Taipi-Kikino—_Highwater man-of-no-account_—or, Englishing more boldly, +_Beggar on horseback_—a witty and a wicked cut. A nickname in Polynesia +destroys almost the memory of the original name. To-day, if we were +Polynesians, Gladstone would be no more heard of. We should speak of and +address our Nestor as the Grand Old Man, and it is so that himself would +sign his correspondence. Not the prevalence, then, but the significancy +of the nickname is to be noted here. The new authority began with small +prestige. Taipi has now been some time in office; from all I saw he +seemed a person very fit. He is not the least unpopular, and yet his +power is nothing. He is a chief to the French, and goes to breakfast +with the Resident; but for any practical end of chieftaincy a rag doll +were equally efficient. + +We had been but three days in Anaho when we received the visit of the +chief of Hatiheu, a man of weight and fame, late leader of a war upon the +French, late prisoner in Tahiti, and the last eater of long-pig in +Nuka-hiva. Not many years have elapsed since he was seen striding on the +beach of Anaho, a dead man’s arm across his shoulder. ‘So does Kooamua +to his enemies!’ he roared to the passers-by, and took a bite from the +raw flesh. And now behold this gentleman, very wisely replaced in office +by the French, paying us a morning visit in European clothes. He was the +man of the most character we had yet seen: his manners genial and +decisive, his person tall, his face rugged, astute, formidable, and with +a certain similarity to Mr. Gladstone’s—only for the brownness of the +skin, and the high-chief’s tattooing, all one side and much of the other +being of an even blue. Further acquaintance increased our opinion of his +sense. He viewed the _Casco_ in a manner then quite new to us, examining +her lines and the running of the gear; to a piece of knitting on which +one of the party was engaged, he must have devoted ten minutes’ patient +study; nor did he desist before he had divined the principles; and he was +interested even to excitement by a type-writer, which he learned to work. +When he departed he carried away with him a list of his family, with his +own name printed by his own hand at the bottom. I should add that he was +plainly much of a humorist, and not a little of a humbug. He told us, +for instance, that he was a person of exact sobriety; such being the +obligation of his high estate: the commons might be sots, but the chief +could not stoop so low. And not many days after he was to be observed in +a state of smiling and lop-sided imbecility, the _Casco_ ribbon upside +down on his dishonoured hat. + +But his business that morning in Anaho is what concerns us here. The +devil-fish, it seems, were growing scarce upon the reef; it was judged +fit to interpose what we should call a close season; for that end, in +Polynesia, a tapu (vulgarly spelt ‘taboo’) has to be declared, and who +was to declare it? Taipi might; he ought; it was a chief part of his +duty; but would any one regard the inhibition of a Beggar on Horse-back? +He might plant palm branches: it did not in the least follow that the +spot was sacred. He might recite the spell: it was shrewdly supposed the +spirits would not hearken. And so the old, legitimate cannibal must ride +over the mountains to do it for him; and the respectable official in +white clothes could but look on and envy. At about the same time, though +in a different manner, Kooamua established a forest law. It was observed +the cocoa-palms were suffering, for the plucking of green nuts +impoverishes and at last endangers the tree. Now Kooamua could tapu the +reef, which was public property, but he could not tapu other people’s +palms; and the expedient adopted was interesting. He tapu’d his own +trees, and his example was imitated over all Hatiheu and Anaho. I fear +Taipi might have tapu’d all that he possessed and found none to follow +him. So much for the esteem in which the dignity of an appointed chief +is held by others; a single circumstance will show what he thinks of it +himself. I never met one, but he took an early opportunity to explain +his situation. True, he was only an appointed chief when I beheld him; +but somewhere else, perhaps upon some other isle, he was a chieftain by +descent: upon which ground, he asked me (so to say it) to excuse his +mushroom honours. + +It will be observed with surprise that both these tapus are for +thoroughly sensible ends. With surprise, I say, because the nature of +that institution is much misunderstood in Europe. It is taken usually in +the sense of a meaningless or wanton prohibition, such as that which +to-day prevents women in some countries from smoking, or yesterday +prevented any one in Scotland from taking a walk on Sunday. The error is +no less natural than it is unjust. The Polynesians have not been trained +in the bracing, practical thought of ancient Rome; with them the idea of +law has not been disengaged from that of morals or propriety; so that +tapu has to cover the whole field, and implies indifferently that an act +is criminal, immoral, against sound public policy, unbecoming or (as we +say) ‘not in good form.’ Many tapus were in consequence absurd enough, +such as those which deleted words out of the language, and particularly +those which related to women. Tapu encircled women upon all hands. Many +things were forbidden to men; to women we may say that few were +permitted. They must not sit on the paepae; they must not go up to it by +the stair; they must not eat pork; they must not approach a boat; they +must not cook at a fire which any male had kindled. The other day, after +the roads were made, it was observed the women plunged along margin +through the bush, and when they came to a bridge waded through the water: +roads and bridges were the work of men’s hands, and tapu for the foot of +women. Even a man’s saddle, if the man be native, is a thing no +self-respecting lady dares to use. Thus on the Anaho side of the island, +only two white men, Mr. Regler and the gendarme, M. Aussel, possess +saddles; and when a woman has a journey to make she must borrow from one +or other. It will be noticed that these prohibitions tend, most of them, +to an increased reserve between the sexes. Regard for female chastity is +the usual excuse for these disabilities that men delight to lay upon +their wives and mothers. Here the regard is absent; and behold the women +still bound hand and foot with meaningless proprieties! The women +themselves, who are survivors of the old regimen, admit that in those +days life was not worth living. And yet even then there were exceptions. +There were female chiefs and (I am assured) priestesses besides; nice +customs curtseyed to great dames, and in the most sacred enclosure of a +High Place, Father Siméon Delmar was shown a stone, and told it was the +throne of some well-descended lady. How exactly parallel is this with +European practice, when princesses were suffered to penetrate the +strictest cloister, and women could rule over a land in which they were +denied the control of their own children. + +But the tapu is more often the instrument of wise and needful +restrictions. We have seen it as the organ of paternal government. It +serves besides to enforce, in the rare case of some one wishing to +enforce them, rights of private property. Thus a man, weary of the +coming and going of Marquesan visitors, tapus his door; and to this day +you may see the palm-branch signal, even as our great-grandfathers saw +the peeled wand before a Highland inn. Or take another case. Anaho is +known as ‘the country without popoi.’ The word popoi serves in different +islands to indicate the main food of the people: thus, in Hawaii, it +implies a preparation of taro; in the Marquesas, of breadfruit. And a +Marquesan does not readily conceive life possible without his favourite +diet. A few years ago a drought killed the breadfruit trees and the +bananas in the district of Anaho; and from this calamity, and the +open-handed customs of the island, a singular state of things arose. +Well-watered Hatiheu had escaped the drought; every householder of Anaho +accordingly crossed the pass, chose some one in Hatiheu, ‘gave him his +name’—an onerous gift, but one not to be rejected—and from this +improvised relative proceeded to draw his supplies, for all the world as +though he had paid for them. Hence a continued traffic on the road. +Some stalwart fellow, in a loin-cloth, and glistening with sweat, may be +seen at all hours of the day, a stick across his bare shoulders, tripping +nervously under a double burthen of green fruits. And on the far side of +the gap a dozen stone posts on the wayside in the shadow of a grove mark +the breathing-space of the popoi-carriers. A little back from the beach, +and not half a mile from Anaho, I was the more amazed to find a cluster +of well-doing breadfruits heavy with their harvest. ‘Why do you not take +these?’ I asked. ‘Tapu,’ said Hoka; and I thought to myself (after the +manner of dull travellers) what children and fools these people were to +toil over the mountain and despoil innocent neighbours when the staff of +life was thus growing at their door. I was the more in error. In the +general destruction these surviving trees were enough only for the family +of the proprietor, and by the simple expedient of declaring a tapu he +enforced his right. + +The sanction of the tapu is superstitious; and the punishment of +infraction either a wasting or a deadly sickness. A slow disease follows +on the eating of tapu fish, and can only be cured with the bones of the +same fish burned with the due mysteries. The cocoa-nut and breadfruit +tapu works more swiftly. Suppose you have eaten tapu fruit at the +evening meal, at night your sleep will be uneasy; in the morning, +swelling and a dark discoloration will have attacked your neck, whence +they spread upward to the face; and in two days, unless the cure be +interjected, you must die. This cure is prepared from the rubbed leaves +of the tree from which the patient stole; so that he cannot be saved +without confessing to the Tahuku the person whom he wronged. In the +experience of my informant, almost no tapu had been put in use, except +the two described: he had thus no opportunity to learn the nature and +operation of the others; and, as the art of making them was jealously +guarded amongst the old men, he believed the mystery would soon die out. +I should add that he was no Marquesan, but a Chinaman, a resident in the +group from boyhood, and a reverent believer in the spells which he +described. White men, amongst whom Ah Fu included himself, were exempt; +but he had a tale of a Tahitian woman, who had come to the Marquesas, +eaten tapu fish, and, although uninformed of her offence and danger, had +been afflicted and cured exactly like a native. + +Doubtless the belief is strong; doubtless, with this weakly and fanciful +race, it is in many cases strong enough to kill; it should be strong +indeed in those who tapu their trees secretly, so that they may detect a +depredator by his sickness. Or, perhaps, we should understand the idea +of the hidden tapu otherwise, as a politic device to spread uneasiness +and extort confessions: so that, when a man is ailing, he shall ransack +his brain for any possible offence, and send at once for any proprietor +whose rights he has invaded. ‘Had you hidden a tapu?’ we may conceive +him asking; and I cannot imagine the proprietor gainsaying it; and this +is perhaps the strangest feature of the system—that it should be regarded +from without with such a mental and implicit awe, and, when examined from +within, should present so many apparent evidences of design. + +We read in Dr. Campbell’s _Poenamo_ of a New Zealand girl, who was +foolishly told that she had eaten a tapu yam, and who instantly sickened, +and died in the two days of simple terror. The period is the same as in +the Marquesas; doubtless the symptoms were so too. How singular to +consider that a superstition of such sway is possibly a manufactured +article; and that, even if it were not originally invented, its details +have plainly been arranged by the authorities of some Polynesian Scotland +Yard. Fitly enough, the belief is to-day—and was probably always—far +from universal. Hell at home is a strong deterrent with some; a passing +thought with others; with others, again, a theme of public mockery, not +always well assured; and so in the Marquesas with the tapu. Mr. Regler +has seen the two extremes of scepticism and implicit fear. In the tapu +grove he found one fellow stealing breadfruit, cheerful and impudent as a +street arab; and it was only on a menace of exposure that he showed +himself the least discountenanced. The other case was opposed in every +point. Mr. Regler asked a native to accompany him upon a voyage; the man +went gladly enough, but suddenly perceiving a dead tapu fish in the +bottom of the boat, leaped back with a scream; nor could the promise of a +dollar prevail upon him to advance. + +The Marquesan, it will be observed, adheres to the old idea of the local +circumscription of beliefs and duties. Not only are the whites exempt +from consequences; but their transgressions seem to be viewed without +horror. It was Mr. Regler who had killed the fish; yet the devout native +was not shocked at Mr. Regler—only refused to join him in his boat. A +white is a white: the servant (so to speak) of other and more liberal +gods; and not to be blamed if he profit by his liberty. The Jews were +perhaps the first to interrupt this ancient comity of faiths; and the +Jewish virus is still strong in Christianity. All the world must respect +our tapus, or we gnash our teeth. + + + +CHAPTER VII—HATIHEU + + +The bays of Anaho and Hatiheu are divided at their roots by the +knife-edge of a single hill—the pass so often mentioned; but this isthmus +expands to the seaward in a considerable peninsula: very bare and grassy; +haunted by sheep and, at night and morning, by the piercing cries of the +shepherds; wandered over by a few wild goats; and on its sea-front +indented with long, clamorous caves, and faced with cliffs of the colour +and ruinous outline of an old peat-stack. In one of these echoing and +sunless gullies we saw, clustered like sea-birds on a splashing ledge, +shrill as sea-birds in their salutation to the passing boat, a group of +fisherwomen, stripped to their gaudy under-clothes. (The clash of the +surf and the thin female voices echo in my memory.) We had that day a +native crew and steersman, Kauanui; it was our first experience of +Polynesian seamanship, which consists in hugging every point of land. +There is no thought in this of saving time, for they will pull a long way +in to skirt a point that is embayed. It seems that, as they can never +get their houses near enough the surf upon the one side, so they can +never get their boats near enough upon the other. The practice in bold +water is not so dangerous as it looks—the reflex from the rocks sending +the boat off. Near beaches with a heavy run of sea, I continue to think +it very hazardous, and find the composure of the natives annoying to +behold. We took unmingled pleasure, on the way out, to see so near at +hand the beach and the wonderful colours of the surf. On the way back, +when the sea had risen and was running strong against us, the fineness of +the steersman’s aim grew more embarrassing. As we came abreast of the +sea-front, where the surf broke highest, Kauanui embraced the occasion to +light his pipe, which then made the circuit of the boat—each man taking a +whiff or two, and, ere he passed it on, filling his lungs and cheeks with +smoke. Their faces were all puffed out like apples as we came abreast of +the cliff foot, and the bursting surge fell back into the boat in +showers. At the next point ‘cocanetti’ was the word, and the stroke +borrowed my knife, and desisted from his labours to open nuts. These +untimely indulgences may be compared to the tot of grog served out before +a ship goes into action. + +My purpose in this visit led me first to the boys’ school, for Hatiheu is +the university of the north islands. The hum of the lesson came out to +meet us. Close by the door, where the draught blew coolest, sat the lay +brother; around him, in a packed half-circle, some sixty high-coloured +faces set with staring eyes; and in the background of the barn-like room +benches were to be seen, and blackboards with sums on them in chalk. The +brother rose to greet us, sensibly humble. Thirty years he had been +there, he said, and fingered his white locks as a bashful child pulls out +his pinafore. ‘_Et point de résultats_, _monsieur_, _presque pas de +résultats_.’ He pointed to the scholars: ‘You see, sir, all the youth of +Nuka-hiva and Ua-pu. Between the ages of six and fifteen this is all +that remains; and it is but a few years since we had a hundred and twenty +from Nuka-hiva alone. _Oui_, _monsieur_, _cela se dépérit_.’ Prayers, +and reading and writing, prayers again and arithmetic, and more prayers +to conclude: such appeared to be the dreary nature of the course. For +arithmetic all island people have a natural taste. In Hawaii they make +good progress in mathematics. In one of the villages on Majuro, and +generally in the Marshall group, the whole population sit about the +trader when he is weighing copra, and each on his own slate takes down +the figures and computes the total. The trader, finding them so apt, +introduced fractions, for which they had been taught no rule. At first +they were quite gravelled but ultimately, by sheer hard thinking, +reasoned out the result, and came one after another to assure the trader +he was right. Not many people in Europe could have done the like. The +course at Hatiheu is therefore less dispiriting to Polynesians than a +stranger might have guessed; and yet how bald it is at best! I asked the +brother if he did not tell them stories, and he stared at me; if he did +not teach them history, and he said, ‘O yes, they had a little Scripture +history—from the New Testament’; and repeated his lamentations over the +lack of results. I had not the heart to put more questions; I could but +say it must be very discouraging, and resist the impulse to add that it +seemed also very natural. He looked up—‘My days are far spent,’ he said; +‘heaven awaits me.’ May that heaven forgive me, but I was angry with the +old man and his simple consolation. For think of his opportunity! The +youth, from six to fifteen, are taken from their homes by Government, +centralised at Hatiheu, where they are supported by a weekly tax of food; +and, with the exception of one month in every year, surrendered wholly to +the direction of the priests. Since the escapade already mentioned the +holiday occurs at a different period for the girls and for the boys; so +that a Marquesan brother and sister meet again, after their education is +complete, a pair of strangers. It is a harsh law, and highly unpopular; +but what a power it places in the hands of the instructors, and how +languidly and dully is that power employed by the mission! Too much +concern to make the natives pious, a design in which they all confess +defeat, is, I suppose, the explanation of their miserable system. But +they might see in the girls’ school at Tai-o-hae, under the brisk, +housewifely sisters, a different picture of efficiency, and a scene of +neatness, airiness, and spirited and mirthful occupation that should +shame them into cheerier methods. The sisters themselves lament their +failure. They complain the annual holiday undoes the whole year’s work; +they complain particularly of the heartless indifference of the girls. +Out of so many pretty and apparently affectionate pupils whom they have +taught and reared, only two have ever returned to pay a visit of +remembrance to their teachers. These, indeed, come regularly, but the +rest, so soon as their school-days are over, disappear into the woods +like captive insects. It is hard to imagine anything more discouraging; +and yet I do not believe these ladies need despair. For a certain +interval they keep the girls alive and innocently busy; and if it be at +all possible to save the race, this would be the means. No such praise +can be given to the boys’ school at Hatiheu. The day is numbered already +for them all; alike for the teacher and the scholars death is girt; he is +afoot upon the march; and in the frequent interval they sit and yawn. +But in life there seems a thread of purpose through the least +significant; the drowsiest endeavour is not lost, and even the school at +Hatiheu may be more useful than it seems. + +Hatiheu is a place of some pretensions. The end of the bay towards Anaho +may be called the civil compound, for it boasts the house of Kooamua, and +close on the beach, under a great tree, that of the gendarme, M. Armand +Aussel, with his garden, his pictures, his books, and his excellent +table, to which strangers are made welcome. No more singular contrast is +possible than between the gendarmerie and the priesthood, who are besides +in smouldering opposition and full of mutual complaints. A priest’s +kitchen in the eastern islands is a depressing spot to see; and many, or +most of them, make no attempt to keep a garden, sparsely subsisting on +their rations. But you will never dine with a gendarme without smacking +your lips; and M. Aussel’s home-made sausage and the salad from his +garden are unforgotten delicacies. Pierre Loti may like to know that he +is M. Aussel’s favourite author, and that his books are read in the fit +scenery of Hatiheu bay. + +The other end is all religious. It is here that an overhanging and +tip-tilted horn, a good sea-mark for Hatiheu, bursts naked from the +verdure of the climbing forest, and breaks down shoreward in steep +taluses and cliffs. From the edge of one of the highest, perhaps seven +hundred or a thousand feet above the beach, a Virgin looks +insignificantly down, like a poor lost doll, forgotten there by a giant +child. This laborious symbol of the Catholics is always strange to +Protestants; we conceive with wonder that men should think it worth while +to toil so many days, and clamber so much about the face of precipices, +for an end that makes us smile; and yet I believe it was the wise Bishop +Dordillon who chose the place, and I know that those who had a hand in +the enterprise look back with pride upon its vanquished dangers. The +boys’ school is a recent importation; it was at first in Tai-o-hae, +beside the girls’; and it was only of late, after their joint escapade, +that the width of the island was interposed between the sexes. But +Hatiheu must have been a place of missionary importance from before. +About midway of the beach no less than three churches stand grouped in a +patch of bananas, intermingled with some pine-apples. Two are of wood: +the original church, now in disuse; and a second that, for some +mysterious reason, has never been used. The new church is of stone, with +twin towers, walls flangeing into buttresses, and sculptured front. The +design itself is good, simple, and shapely; but the character is all in +the detail, where the architect has bloomed into the sculptor. It is +impossible to tell in words of the angels (although they are more like +winged archbishops) that stand guard upon the door, of the cherubs in the +corners, of the scapegoat gargoyles, or the quaint and spirited relief, +where St. Michael (the artist’s patron) makes short work of a protesting +Lucifer. We were never weary of viewing the imagery, so innocent, +sometimes so funny, and yet in the best sense—in the sense of inventive +gusto and expression—so artistic. I know not whether it was more strange +to find a building of such merit in a corner of a barbarous isle, or to +see a building so antique still bright with novelty. The architect, a +French lay brother, still alive and well, and meditating fresh +foundations, must have surely drawn his descent from a master-builder in +the age of the cathedrals; and it was in looking on the church of Hatiheu +that I seemed to perceive the secret charm of mediæval sculpture; that +combination of the childish courage of the amateur, attempting all +things, like the schoolboy on his slate, with the manly perseverance of +the artist who does not know when he is conquered. + +I had always afterwards a strong wish to meet the architect, Brother +Michel; and one day, when I was talking with the Resident in Tai-o-hae +(the chief port of the island), there were shown in to us an old, worn, +purblind, ascetic-looking priest, and a lay brother, a type of all that +is most sound in France, with a broad, clever, honest, humorous +countenance, an eye very large and bright, and a strong and healthy body +inclining to obesity. But that his blouse was black and his face shaven +clean, you might pick such a man to-day, toiling cheerfully in his own +patch of vines, from half a dozen provinces of France; and yet he had +always for me a haunting resemblance to an old kind friend of my boyhood, +whom I name in case any of my readers should share with me that +memory—Dr. Paul, of the West Kirk. Almost at the first word I was sure +it was my architect, and in a moment we were deep in a discussion of +Hatiheu church. Brother Michel spoke always of his labours with a +twinkle of humour, underlying which it was possible to spy a serious +pride, and the change from one to another was often very human and +diverting. ‘_Et vos gargouilles moyen-âge_,’ cried I; ‘_comme elles sont +originates_!’ ‘_N’est-ce pas_? _Elles sont bien drôles_!’ he said, +smiling broadly; and the next moment, with a sudden gravity: ‘_Cependant +il y en a une qui a une patte de cassé_; _il faut que je voie cela_.’ I +asked if he had any model—a point we much discussed. ‘_Non_,’ said he +simply; ‘_c’est une église idéale_.’ The relievo was his favourite +performance, and very justly so. The angels at the door, he owned, he +would like to destroy and replace. ‘_Ils n’ont pas de vie_, _ils +manquent de vie_. _Vous devriez voir mon église à la Dominique_; _j’ai +là une Vierge qui est vraiment gentille_.’ ‘Ah,’ I cried, ‘they told me +you had said you would never build another church, and I wrote in my +journal I could not believe it.’ ‘_Oui_, _j’aimerais bien en fairs une +autre_,’ he confessed, and smiled at the confession. An artist will +understand how much I was attracted by this conversation. There is no +bond so near as a community in that unaffected interest and slightly +shame-faced pride which mark the intelligent man enamoured of an art. He +sees the limitations of his aim, the defects of his practice; he smiles +to be so employed upon the shores of death, yet sees in his own devotion +something worthy. Artists, if they had the same sense of humour with the +Augurs, would smile like them on meeting, but the smile would not be +scornful. + +I had occasion to see much of this excellent man. He sailed with us from +Tai-o-hae to Hiva-oa, a dead beat of ninety miles against a heavy sea. +It was what is called a good passage, and a feather in the _Casco’s_ cap; +but among the most miserable forty hours that any one of us had ever +passed. We were swung and tossed together all that time like shot in a +stage thunder-box. The mate was thrown down and had his head cut open; +the captain was sick on deck; the cook sick in the galley. Of all our +party only two sat down to dinner. I was one. I own that I felt +wretchedly; and I can only say of the other, who professed to feel quite +well, that she fled at an early moment from the table. It was in these +circumstances that we skirted the windward shore of that indescribable +island of Ua-pu; viewing with dizzy eyes the coves, the capes, the +breakers, the climbing forests, and the inaccessible stone needles that +surmount the mountains. The place persists, in a dark corner of our +memories, like a piece of the scenery of nightmares. The end of this +distressful passage, where we were to land our passengers, was in a +similar vein of roughness. The surf ran high on the beach at Taahauku; +the boat broached-to and capsized; and all hands were submerged. Only +the brother himself, who was well used to the experience, skipped ashore, +by some miracle of agility, with scarce a sprinkling. Thenceforward, +during our stay at Hiva-oa, he was our cicerone and patron; introducing +us, taking us excursions, serving us in every way, and making himself +daily more beloved. + +Michel Blanc had been a carpenter by trade; had made money and retired, +supposing his active days quite over; and it was only when he found +idleness dangerous that he placed his capital and acquirements at the +service of the mission. He became their carpenter, mason, architect, and +engineer; added sculpture to his accomplishments, and was famous for his +skill in gardening. He wore an enviable air of having found a port from +life’s contentions and lying there strongly anchored; went about his +business with a jolly simplicity; complained of no lack of +results—perhaps shyly thinking his own statuary result enough; and was +altogether a pattern of the missionary layman. + + + +CHAPTER VIII—THE PORT OF ENTRY + + +The port—the mart, the civil and religious capital of these rude +islands—is called Tai-o-hae, and lies strung along the beach of a +precipitous green bay in Nuka-hiva. It was midwinter when we came +thither, and the weather was sultry, boisterous, and inconstant. Now the +wind blew squally from the land down gaps of splintered precipice; now, +between the sentinel islets of the entry, it came in gusts from seaward. +Heavy and dark clouds impended on the summits; the rain roared and +ceased; the scuppers of the mountain gushed; and the next day we would +see the sides of the amphitheatre bearded with white falls. Along the +beach the town shows a thin file of houses, mostly white, and all +ensconced in the foliage of an avenue of green puraos; a pier gives +access from the sea across the belt of breakers; to the eastward there +stands, on a projecting bushy hill, the old fort which is now the +calaboose, or prison; eastward still, alone in a garden, the Residency +flies the colours of France. Just off Calaboose Hill, the tiny +Government schooner rides almost permanently at anchor, marks eight bells +in the morning (there or thereabout) with the unfurling of her flag, and +salutes the setting sun with the report of a musket. + +Here dwell together, and share the comforts of a club (which may be +enumerated as a billiard-board, absinthe, a map of the world on +Mercator’s projection, and one of the most agreeable verandahs in the +tropics), a handful of whites of varying nationality, mostly French +officials, German and Scottish merchant clerks, and the agents of the +opium monopoly. There are besides three tavern-keepers, the shrewd Scot +who runs the cotton gin-mill, two white ladies, and a sprinkling of +people ‘on the beach’—a South Sea expression for which there is no exact +equivalent. It is a pleasant society, and a hospitable. But one man, +who was often to be seen seated on the logs at the pier-head, merits a +word for the singularity of his history and appearance. Long ago, it +seems, he fell in love with a native lady, a High Chiefess in Ua-pu. +She, on being approached, declared she could never marry a man who was +untattooed; it looked so naked; whereupon, with some greatness of soul, +our hero put himself in the hands of the Tahukus, and, with still +greater, persevered until the process was complete. He had certainly to +bear a great expense, for the Tahuku will not work without reward; and +certainly exquisite pain. Kooamua, high chief as he was, and one of the +old school, was only part tattooed; he could not, he told us with lively +pantomime, endure the torture to an end. Our enamoured countryman was +more resolved; he was tattooed from head to foot in the most approved +methods of the art; and at last presented himself before his mistress a +new man. The fickle fair one could never behold him from that day except +with laughter. For my part, I could never see the man without a kind of +admiration; of him it might be said, if ever of any, that he had loved +not wisely, but too well. + +The Residency stands by itself, Calaboose Hill screening it from the +fringe of town along the further bay. The house is commodious, with wide +verandahs; all day it stands open, back and front, and the trade blows +copiously over its bare floors. On a week-day the garden offers a scene +of most untropical animation, half a dozen convicts toiling there +cheerfully with spade and barrow, and touching hats and smiling to the +visitor like old attached family servants. On Sunday these are gone, and +nothing to be seen but dogs of all ranks and sizes peacefully slumbering +in the shady grounds; for the dogs of Tai-o-hae are very courtly-minded, +and make the seat of Government their promenade and place of siesta. In +front and beyond, a strip of green down loses itself in a low wood of +many species of acacia; and deep in the wood a ruinous wall encloses the +cemetery of the Europeans. English and Scottish sleep there, and +Scandinavians, and French _maîtres de manœuvres_ and _maîtres ouvriers_: +mingling alien dust. Back in the woods, perhaps, the blackbird, or (as +they call him there) the island nightingale, will be singing home +strains; and the ceaseless requiem of the surf hangs on the ear. I have +never seen a resting-place more quiet; but it was a long thought how far +these sleepers had all travelled, and from what diverse homes they had +set forth, to lie here in the end together. + +On the summit of its promontory hill, the calaboose stands all day with +doors and window-shutters open to the trade. On my first visit a dog was +the only guardian visible. He, indeed, rose with an attitude so menacing +that I was glad to lay hands on an old barrel-hoop; and I think the +weapon must have been familiar, for the champion instantly retreated, and +as I wandered round the court and through the building, I could see him, +with a couple of companions, humbly dodging me about the corners. The +prisoners’ dormitory was a spacious, airy room, devoid of any furniture; +its whitewashed walls covered with inscriptions in Marquesan and rude +drawings: one of the pier, not badly done; one of a murder; several of +French soldiers in uniform. There was one legend in French: ‘_Je n’est_’ +(sic) ‘_pas le sou_.’ From this noontide quietude it must not be +supposed the prison was untenanted; the calaboose at Tai-o-hae does a +good business. But some of its occupants were gardening at the +Residency, and the rest were probably at work upon the streets, as free +as our scavengers at home, although not so industrious. On the approach +of evening they would be called in like children from play; and the +harbour-master (who is also the jailer) would go through the form of +locking them up until six the next morning. Should a prisoner have any +call in town, whether of pleasure or affairs, he has but to unhook the +window-shutters; and if he is back again, and the shutter decently +replaced, by the hour of call on the morrow, he may have met the +harbour-master in the avenue, and there will be no complaint, far less +any punishment. But this is not all. The charming French Resident, M. +Delaruelle, carried me one day to the calaboose on an official visit. In +the green court, a very ragged gentleman, his legs deformed with the +island elephantiasis, saluted us smiling. ‘One of our political +prisoners—an insurgent from Raiatea,’ said the Resident; and then to the +jailer: ‘I thought I had ordered him a new pair of trousers.’ Meanwhile +no other convict was to be seen—‘_Eh bien_,’ said the Resident, ‘_où sont +vos prisonniers_?’ ‘_Monsieur le Résident_,’ replied the jailer, +saluting with soldierly formality, ‘_comme c’est jour de fête_, _je les +ai laissé aller à la chasse_.’ They were all upon the mountains hunting +goats! Presently we came to the quarters of the women, likewise +deserted—‘_Où sont vos bonnes femmes_?’ asked the Resident; and the +jailer cheerfully responded: ‘_Je crois_, _Monsieur le Résident_, +_qu’elles sont allées quelquepart faire une visite_.’ It had been the +design of M. Delaruelle, who was much in love with the whimsicalities of +his small realm, to elicit something comical; but not even he expected +anything so perfect as the last. To complete the picture of convict life +in Tai-o-hae, it remains to be added that these criminals draw a salary +as regularly as the President of the Republic. Ten sous a day is their +hire. Thus they have money, food, shelter, clothing, and, I was about to +write, their liberty. The French are certainly a good-natured people, +and make easy masters. They are besides inclined to view the Marquesans +with an eye of humorous indulgence. ‘They are dying, poor devils!’ said +M. Delaruelle: ‘the main thing is to let them die in peace.’ And it was +not only well said, but I believe expressed the general thought. Yet +there is another element to be considered; for these convicts are not +merely useful, they are almost essential to the French existence. With a +people incurably idle, dispirited by what can only be called endemic +pestilence, and inflamed with ill-feeling against their new masters, +crime and convict labour are a godsend to the Government. + +Theft is practically the sole crime. Originally petty pilferers, the men +of Tai-o-hae now begin to force locks and attack strong-boxes. Hundreds +of dollars have been taken at a time; though, with that redeeming +moderation so common in Polynesian theft, the Marquesan burglar will +always take a part and leave a part, sharing (so to speak) with the +proprietor. If it be Chilian coin—the island currency—he will escape; if +the sum is in gold, French silver, or bank-notes, the police wait until +the money begins to come in circulation, and then easily pick out their +man. And now comes the shameful part. In plain English, the prisoner is +tortured until he confesses and (if that be possible) restores the money. +To keep him alone, day and night, in the black hole, is to inflict on the +Marquesan torture inexpressible. Even his robberies are carried on in +the plain daylight, under the open sky, with the stimulus of enterprise, +and the countenance of an accomplice; his terror of the dark is still +insurmountable; conceive, then, what he endures in his solitary dungeon; +conceive how he longs to confess, become a full-fledged convict, and be +allowed to sleep beside his comrades. While we were in Tai-o-hae a thief +was under prevention. He had entered a house about eight in the morning, +forced a trunk, and stolen eleven hundred francs; and now, under the +horrors of darkness, solitude, and a bedevilled cannibal imagination, he +was reluctantly confessing and giving up his spoil. From one cache, +which he had already pointed out, three hundred francs had been +recovered, and it was expected that he would presently disgorge the rest. +This would be ugly enough if it were all; but I am bound to say, because +it is a matter the French should set at rest, that worse is continually +hinted. I heard that one man was kept six days with his arms bound +backward round a barrel; and it is the universal report that every +gendarme in the South Seas is equipped with something in the nature of a +thumbscrew. I do not know this. I never had the face to ask any of the +gendarmes—pleasant, intelligent, and kindly fellows—with whom I have been +intimate, and whose hospitality I have enjoyed; and perhaps the tale +reposes (as I hope it does) on a misconstruction of that ingenious +cat’s-cradle with which the French agent of police so readily secures a +prisoner. But whether physical or moral, torture is certainly employed; +and by a barbarous injustice, the state of accusation (in which a man may +very well be innocently placed) is positively painful; the state of +conviction (in which all are supposed guilty) is comparatively free, and +positively pleasant. Perhaps worse still,—not only the accused, but +sometimes his wife, his mistress, or his friend, is subjected to the same +hardships. I was admiring, in the tapu system, the ingenuity of native +methods of detection; there is not much to admire in those of the French, +and to lock up a timid child in a dark room, and, if he proved obstinate, +lock up his sister in the next, is neither novel nor humane. + +The main occasion of these thefts is the new vice of opium-eating. ‘Here +nobody ever works, and all eat opium,’ said a gendarme; and Ah Fu knew a +woman who ate a dollar’s worth in a day. The successful thief will give +a handful of money to each of his friends, a dress to a woman, pass an +evening in one of the taverns of Tai-o-hae, during which he treats all +comers, produce a big lump of opium, and retire to the bush to eat and +sleep it off. A trader, who did not sell opium, confessed to me that he +was at his wit’s end. ‘I do not sell it, but others do,’ said he. ‘The +natives only work to buy it; if they walk over to me to sell their +cotton, they have just to walk over to some one else to buy their opium +with my money. And why should they be at the bother of two walks? There +is no use talking,’ he added—‘opium is the currency of this country.’ + +The man under prevention during my stay at Tai-o-hae lost patience while +the Chinese opium-seller was being examined in his presence. ‘Of course +he sold me opium!’ he broke out; ‘all the Chinese here sell opium. It +was only to buy opium that I stole; it is only to buy opium that anybody +steals. And what you ought to do is to let no opium come here, and no +Chinamen.’ This is precisely what is done in Samoa by a native +Government; but the French have bound their own hands, and for forty +thousand francs sold native subjects to crime and death. This horrid +traffic may be said to have sprung up by accident. It was Captain Hart +who had the misfortune to be the means of beginning it, at a time when +his plantations flourished in the Marquesas, and he found a difficulty in +keeping Chinese coolies. To-day the plantations are practically deserted +and the Chinese gone; but in the meanwhile the natives have learned the +vice, the patent brings in a round sum, and the needy Government at +Papeete shut their eyes and open their pockets. Of course, the patentee +is supposed to sell to Chinamen alone; equally of course, no one could +afford to pay forty thousand francs for the privilege of supplying a +scattered handful of Chinese; and every one knows the truth, and all are +ashamed of it. French officials shake their heads when opium is +mentioned; and the agents of the farmer blush for their employment. +Those that live in glass houses should not throw stones; as a subject of +the British crown, I am an unwilling shareholder in the largest opium +business under heaven. But the British case is highly complicated; it +implies the livelihood of millions; and must be reformed, when it can be +reformed at all, with prudence. This French business, on the other hand, +is a nostrum and a mere excrescence. No native industry was to be +encouraged: the poison is solemnly imported. No native habit was to be +considered: the vice has been gratuitously introduced. And no creature +profits, save the Government at Papeete—the not very enviable gentlemen +who pay them, and the Chinese underlings who do the dirty work. + + + +CHAPTER IX—THE HOUSE OF TEMOANA + + +The history of the Marquesas is, of late years, much confused by the +coming and going of the French. At least twice they have seized the +archipelago, at least once deserted it; and in the meanwhile the natives +pursued almost without interruption their desultory cannibal wars. +Through these events and changing dynasties, a single considerable figure +may be seen to move: that of the high chief, a king, Temoana. Odds and +ends of his history came to my ears: how he was at first a convert to the +Protestant mission; how he was kidnapped or exiled from his native land, +served as cook aboard a whaler, and was shown, for small charge, in +English seaports; how he returned at last to the Marquesas, fell under +the strong and benign influence of the late bishop, extended his +influence in the group, was for a while joint ruler with the prelate, and +died at last the chief supporter of Catholicism and the French. His +widow remains in receipt of two pounds a month from the French +Government. Queen she is usually called, but in the official almanac she +figures as ‘_Madame Vaekehu_, _Grande Chefesse_.’ His son (natural or +adoptive, I know not which), Stanislao Moanatini, chief of Akaui, serves +in Tai-o-hae as a kind of Minister of Public Works; and the daughter of +Stanislao is High Chiefess of the southern island of Tauata. These, +then, are the greatest folk of the archipelago; we thought them also the +most estimable. This is the rule in Polynesia, with few exceptions; the +higher the family, the better the man—better in sense, better in manners, +and usually taller and stronger in body. A stranger advances blindfold. +He scrapes acquaintance as he can. Save the tattoo in the Marquesas, +nothing indicates the difference of rank; and yet almost invariably we +found, after we had made them, that our friends were persons of station. +I have said ‘usually taller and stronger.’ I might have been more +absolute,—over all Polynesia, and a part of Micronesia, the rule holds +good; the great ones of the isle, and even of the village, are greater of +bone and muscle, and often heavier of flesh, than any commoner. The +usual explanation—that the high-born child is more industriously +shampooed, is probably the true one. In New Caledonia, at least, where +the difference does not exist, has never been remarked, the practice of +shampooing seems to be itself unknown. Doctors would be well employed in +a study of the point. + +Vaekehu lives at the other end of the town from the Residency, beyond the +buildings of the mission. Her house is on the European plan: a table in +the midst of the chief room; photographs and religious pictures on the +wall. It commands to either hand a charming vista: through the front +door, a peep of green lawn, scurrying pigs, the pendent fans of the +coco-palm and splendour of the bursting surf: through the back, mounting +forest glades and coronals of precipice. Here, in the strong +thorough-draught, Her Majesty received us in a simple gown of print, and +with no mark of royalty but the exquisite finish of her tattooed mittens, +the elaboration of her manners, and the gentle falsetto in which all the +highly refined among Marquesan ladies (and Vaekehu above all others) +delight to sing their language. An adopted daughter interpreted, while +we gave the news, and rehearsed by name our friends of Anaho. As we +talked, we could see, through the landward door, another lady of the +household at her toilet under the green trees; who presently, when her +hair was arranged, and her hat wreathed with flowers, appeared upon the +back verandah with gracious salutations. + +Vaekehu is very deaf; ‘_merci_’ is her only word of French; and I do not +know that she seemed clever. An exquisite, kind refinement, with a shade +of quietism, gathered perhaps from the nuns, was what chiefly struck us. +Or rather, upon that first occasion, we were conscious of a sense as of +district-visiting on our part, and reduced evangelical gentility on the +part of our hostess. The other impression followed after she was more at +ease, and came with Stanislao and his little girl to dine on board the +_Casco_. She had dressed for the occasion: wore white, which very well +became her strong brown face; and sat among us, eating or smoking her +cigarette, quite cut off from all society, or only now and then included +through the intermediary of her son. It was a position that might have +been ridiculous, and she made it ornamental; making believe to hear and +to be entertained; her face, whenever she met our eyes, lighting with the +smile of good society; her contributions to the talk, when she made any, +and that was seldom, always complimentary and pleasing. No attention was +paid to the child, for instance, but what she remarked and thanked us +for. Her parting with each, when she came to leave, was gracious and +pretty, as had been every step of her behaviour. When Mrs. Stevenson +held out her hand to say good-bye, Vaekehu took it, held it, and a moment +smiled upon her; dropped it, and then, as upon a kindly after-thought, +and with a sort of warmth of condescension, held out both hands and +kissed my wife upon both cheeks. Given the same relation of years and of +rank, the thing would have been so done on the boards of the _Comédie +Française_; just so might Madame Brohan have warmed and condescended to +Madame Broisat in the _Marquis de Villemer_. It was my part to accompany +our guests ashore: when I kissed the little girl good-bye at the pier +steps, Vaekehu gave a cry of gratification, reached down her hand into +the boat, took mine, and pressed it with that flattering softness which +seems the coquetry of the old lady in every quarter of the earth. The +next moment she had taken Stanislao’s arm, and they moved off along the +pier in the moonlight, leaving me bewildered. This was a queen of +cannibals; she was tattooed from hand to foot, and perhaps the greatest +masterpiece of that art now extant, so that a while ago, before she was +grown prim, her leg was one of the sights of Tai-o-hae; she had been +passed from chief to chief; she had been fought for and taken in war; +perhaps, being so great a lady, she had sat on the high place, and +throned it there, alone of her sex, while the drums were going twenty +strong and the priests carried up the blood-stained baskets of long-pig. +And now behold her, out of that past of violence and sickening feasts, +step forth, in her age, a quiet, smooth, elaborate old lady, such as you +might find at home (mittened also, but not often so well-mannered) in a +score of country houses. Only Vaekehu’s mittens were of dye, not of +silk; and they had been paid for, not in money, but the cooked flesh of +men. It came in my mind with a clap, what she could think of it herself, +and whether at heart, perhaps, she might not regret and aspire after the +barbarous and stirring past. But when I asked Stanislao—‘Ah!’ said he, +‘she is content; she is religious, she passes all her days with the +sisters.’ + +Stanislao (Stanislaos, with the final consonant evaded after the +Polynesian habit) was sent by Bishop Dordillon to South America, and +there educated by the fathers. His French is fluent, his talk sensible +and spirited, and in his capacity of ganger-in-chief, he is of excellent +service to the French. With the prestige of his name and family, and +with the stick when needful, he keeps the natives working and the roads +passable. Without Stanislao and the convicts, I am in doubt what would +become of the present regimen in Nuka-hiva; whether the highways might +not be suffered to close up, the pier to wash away, and the Residency to +fall piecemeal about the ears of impotent officials. And yet though the +hereditary favourer, and one of the chief props of French authority, he +has always an eye upon the past. He showed me where the old public place +had stood, still to be traced by random piles of stone; told me how great +and fine it was, and surrounded on all sides by populous houses, whence, +at the beating of the drums, the folk crowded to make holiday. The +drum-beat of the Polynesian has a strange and gloomy stimulation for the +nerves of all. White persons feel it—at these precipitate sounds their +hearts beat faster; and, according to old residents, its effect on the +natives was extreme. Bishop Dordillon might entreat; Temoana himself +command and threaten; at the note of the drum wild instincts triumphed. +And now it might beat upon these ruins, and who should assemble? The +houses are down, the people dead, their lineage extinct; and the +sweepings and fugitives of distant bays and islands encamp upon their +graves. The decline of the dance Stanislao especially laments. ‘_Chaque +pays a ses coutumes_,’ said he; but in the report of any gendarme, +perhaps corruptly eager to increase the number of _délits_ and the +instruments of his own power, custom after custom is placed on the +expurgatorial index. ‘_Tenez_, _une danse qui n’est pas permise_,’ said +Stanislao: ‘_je ne sais pas pourquoi_, _elle est très jolie_, _elle va +comme ça_,’ and sticking his umbrella upright in the road, he sketched +the steps and gestures. All his criticisms of the present, all his +regrets for the past, struck me as temperate and sensible. The short +term of office of the Resident he thought the chief defect of the +administration; that officer having scarce begun to be efficient ere he +was recalled. I thought I gathered, too, that he regarded with some fear +the coming change from a naval to a civil governor. I am sure at least +that I regard it so myself; for the civil servants of France have never +appeared to any foreigner as at all the flower of their country, while +her naval officers may challenge competition with the world. In all his +talk, Stanislao was particular to speak of his own country as a land of +savages; and when he stated an opinion of his own, it was with some +apologetic preface, alleging that he was ‘a savage who had travelled.’ +There was a deal, in this elaborate modesty, of honest pride. Yet there +was something in the precaution that saddened me; and I could not but +fear he was only forestalling a taunt that he had heard too often. + +I recall with interest two interviews with Stanislao. The first was a +certain afternoon of tropic rain, which we passed together in the +verandah of the club; talking at times with heightened voices as the +showers redoubled overhead, passing at times into the billiard-room, to +consult, in the dim, cloudy daylight, that map of the world which forms +its chief adornment. He was naturally ignorant of English history, so +that I had much of news to communicate. The story of Gordon I told him +in full, and many episodes of the Indian Mutiny, Lucknow, the second +battle of Cawn-pore, the relief of Arrah, the death of poor +Spottis-woode, and Sir Hugh Rose’s hotspur, midland campaign. He was +intent to hear; his brown face, strongly marked with small-pox, kindled +and changed with each vicissitude. His eyes glowed with the reflected +light of battle; his questions were many and intelligent, and it was +chiefly these that sent us so often to the map. But it is of our parting +that I keep the strongest sense. We were to sail on the morrow, and the +night had fallen, dark, gusty, and rainy, when we stumbled up the hill to +bid farewell to Stanislao. He had already loaded us with gifts; but more +were waiting. We sat about the table over cigars and green cocoa-nuts; +claps of wind blew through the house and extinguished the lamp, which was +always instantly relighted with a single match; and these recurrent +intervals of darkness were felt as a relief. For there was something +painful and embarrassing in the kindness of that separation. ‘_Ah_, +_vous devriez rester ici_, _mon cher ami_!’ cried Stanislao. ‘_Vous êtes +les gens qu’il faut pour les Kanaques_; _vous êtes doux_, _vous et votre +famille_; _vous seriez obéis dans toutes les îles_.’ We had been civil; +not always that, my conscience told me, and never anything beyond; and +all this to-do is a measure, not of our considerateness, but of the want +of it in others. The rest of the evening, on to Vaekehu’s and back as +far as to the pier, Stanislao walked with my arm and sheltered me with +his umbrella; and after the boat had put off, we could still distinguish, +in the murky darkness, his gestures of farewell. His words, if there +were any, were drowned by the rain and the loud surf. + +I have mentioned presents, a vexed question in the South Seas; and one +which well illustrates the common, ignorant habit of regarding races in a +lump. In many quarters the Polynesian gives only to receive. I have +visited islands where the population mobbed me for all the world like +dogs after the waggon of cat’s-meat; and where the frequent proposition, +‘You my pleni (friend),’ or (with more of pathos) ‘You all ’e same my +father,’ must be received with hearty laughter and a shout. And perhaps +everywhere, among the greedy and rapacious, a gift is regarded as a sprat +to catch a whale. It is the habit to give gifts and to receive returns, +and such characters, complying with the custom, will look to it nearly +that they do not lose. But for persons of a different stamp the +statement must be reversed. The shabby Polynesian is anxious till he has +received the return gift; the generous is uneasy until he has made it. +The first is disappointed if you have not given more than he; the second +is miserable if he thinks he has given less than you. This is my +experience; if it clash with that of others, I pity their fortune, and +praise mine: the circumstances cannot change what I have seen, nor lessen +what I have received. And indeed I find that those who oppose me often +argue from a ground of singular presumptions; comparing Polynesians with +an ideal person, compact of generosity and gratitude, whom I never had +the pleasure of encountering; and forgetting that what is almost poverty +to us is wealth almost unthinkable to them. I will give one instance: I +chanced to speak with consideration of these gifts of Stanislao’s with a +certain clever man, a great hater and contemner of Kanakas. ‘Well! what +were they?’ he cried. ‘A pack of old men’s beards. Trash!’ And the +same gentleman, some half an hour later, being upon a different train of +thought, dwelt at length on the esteem in which the Marquesans held that +sort of property, how they preferred it to all others except land, and +what fancy prices it would fetch. Using his own figures, I computed +that, in this commodity alone, the gifts of Vaekehu and Stanislao +represented between two and three hundred dollars; and the queen’s +official salary is of two hundred and forty in the year. + +But generosity on the one hand, and conspicuous meanness on the other, +are in the South Seas, as at home, the exception. It is neither with any +hope of gain, nor with any lively wish to please, that the ordinary +Polynesian chooses and presents his gifts. A plain social duty lies +before him, which he performs correctly, but without the least +enthusiasm. And we shall best understand his attitude of mind, if we +examine our own to the cognate absurdity of marriage presents. There we +give without any special thought of a return; yet if the circumstance +arise, and the return be withheld, we shall judge ourselves insulted. We +give them usually without affection, and almost never with a genuine +desire to please; and our gift is rather a mark of our own status than a +measure of our love to the recipients. So in a great measure and with +the common run of the Polynesians; their gifts are formal; they imply no +more than social recognition; and they are made and reciprocated, as we +pay and return our morning visits. And the practice of marking and +measuring events and sentiments by presents is universal in the island +world. A gift plays with them the part of stamp and seal; and has +entered profoundly into the mind of islanders. Peace and war, marriage, +adoption and naturalisation, are celebrated or declared by the acceptance +or the refusal of gifts; and it is as natural for the islander to bring a +gift as for us to carry a card-case. + + + +CHAPTER X—A PORTRAIT AND A STORY + + +I have had occasion several times to name the late bishop, Father +Dordillon, ‘Monseigneur,’ as he is still almost universally called, +Vicar-Apostolic of the Marquesas and Bishop of Cambysopolis _in +partibus_. Everywhere in the islands, among all classes and races, this +fine, old, kindly, cheerful fellow is remembered with affection and +respect. His influence with the natives was paramount. They reckoned +him the highest of men—higher than an admiral; brought him their money to +keep; took his advice upon their purchases; nor would they plant trees +upon their own land till they had the approval of the father of the +islands. During the time of the French exodus he singly represented +Europe, living in the Residency, and ruling by the hand of Temoana. The +first roads were made under his auspices and by his persuasion. The old +road between Hatiheu and Anaho was got under way from either side on the +ground that it would be pleasant for an evening promenade, and brought to +completion by working on the rivalry of the two villages. The priest +would boast in Hatiheu of the progress made in Anaho, and he would tell +the folk of Anaho, ‘If you don’t take care, your neighbours will be over +the hill before you are at the top.’ It could not be so done to-day; it +could then; death, opium, and depopulation had not gone so far; and the +people of Hatiheu, I was told, still vied with each other in fine attire, +and used to go out by families, in the cool of the evening, boat-sailing +and racing in the bay. There seems some truth at least in the common +view, that this joint reign of Temoana and the bishop was the last and +brief golden age of the Marquesas. But the civil power returned, the +mission was packed out of the Residency at twenty-four hours’ notice, new +methods supervened, and the golden age (whatever it quite was) came to an +end. It is the strongest proof of Father Dordillon’s prestige that it +survived, seemingly without loss, this hasty deposition. + +His method with the natives was extremely mild. Among these barbarous +children he still played the part of the smiling father; and he was +careful to observe, in all indifferent matters, the Marquesan etiquette. +Thus, in the singular system of artificial kinship, the bishop had been +adopted by Vaekehu as a grandson; Miss Fisher, of Hatiheu, as a daughter. +From that day, Monseigneur never addressed the young lady except as his +mother, and closed his letters with the formalities of a dutiful son. +With Europeans he could be strict, even to the extent of harshness. He +made no distinction against heretics, with whom he was on friendly terms; +but the rules of his own Church he would see observed; and once at least +he had a white man clapped in jail for the desecration of a saint’s day. +But even this rigour, so intolerable to laymen, so irritating to +Protestants, could not shake his popularity. We shall best conceive him +by examples nearer home; we may all have known some divine of the old +school in Scotland, a literal Sabbatarian, a stickler for the letter of +the law, who was yet in private modest, innocent, genial and mirthful. +Much such a man, it seems, was Father Dordillon. And his popularity bore +a test yet stronger. He had the name, and probably deserved it, of a +shrewd man in business and one that made the mission pay. Nothing so +much stirs up resentment as the inmixture in commerce of religious +bodies; but even rival traders spoke well of Monseigneur. + +His character is best portrayed in the story of the days of his decline. +A time came when, from the failure of sight, he must desist from his +literary labours: his Marquesan hymns, grammars, and dictionaries; his +scientific papers, lives of saints, and devotional poetry. He cast about +for a new interest: pitched on gardening, and was to be seen all day, +with spade and water-pot, in his childlike eagerness, actually running +between the borders. Another step of decay, and he must leave his garden +also. Instantly a new occupation was devised, and he sat in the mission +cutting paper flowers and wreaths. His diocese was not great enough for +his activity; the churches of the Marquesas were papered with his +handiwork, and still he must be making more. ‘Ah,’ said he, smiling, +‘when I am dead what a fine time you will have clearing out my trash!’ +He had been dead about six months; but I was pleased to see some of his +trophies still exposed, and looked upon them with a smile: the tribute +(if I have read his cheerful character aright) which he would have +preferred to any useless tears. Disease continued progressively to +disable him; he who had clambered so stalwartly over the rude rocks of +the Marquesas, bringing peace to warfaring clans, was for some time +carried in a chair between the mission and the church, and at last +confined to bed, impotent with dropsy, and tormented with bed-sores and +sciatica. Here he lay two months without complaint; and on the 11th +January 1888, in the seventy-ninth year of his life, and the +thirty-fourth of his labours in the Marquesas, passed away. + +Those who have a taste for hearing missions, Protestant or Catholic, +decried, must seek their pleasure elsewhere than in my pages. Whether +Catholic or Protestant, with all their gross blots, with all their +deficiency of candour, of humour, and of common sense, the missionaries +are the best and the most useful whites in the Pacific. This is a +subject which will follow us throughout; but there is one part of it that +may conveniently be treated here. The married and the celibate +missionary, each has his particular advantage and defect. The married +missionary, taking him at the best, may offer to the native what he is +much in want of—a higher picture of domestic life; but the woman at his +elbow tends to keep him in touch with Europe and out of touch with +Polynesia, and to perpetuate, and even to ingrain, parochial decencies +far best forgotten. The mind of the female missionary tends, for +instance, to be continually busied about dress. She can be taught with +extreme difficulty to think any costume decent but that to which she grew +accustomed on Clapham Common; and to gratify this prejudice, the native +is put to useless expense, his mind is tainted with the morbidities of +Europe, and his health is set in danger. The celibate missionary, on the +other hand, and whether at best or worst, falls readily into native ways +of life; to which he adds too commonly what is either a mark of celibate +man at large, or an inheritance from mediæval saints—I mean slovenly +habits and an unclean person. There are, of course, degrees in this; and +the sister (of course, and all honour to her) is as fresh as a lady at a +ball. For the diet there is nothing to be said—it must amaze and shock +the Polynesian—but for the adoption of native habits there is much. +‘_Chaque pays a ses coutumes_,’ said Stanislao; these it is the +missionary’s delicate task to modify; and the more he can do so from +within, and from a native standpoint, the better he will do his work; and +here I think the Catholics have sometimes the advantage; in the Vicariate +of Dordillon, I am sure they had it. I have heard the bishop blamed for +his indulgence to the natives, and above all because he did not rage with +sufficient energy against cannibalism. It was a part of his policy to +live among the natives like an elder brother; to follow where he could; +to lead where it was necessary; never to drive; and to encourage the +growth of new habits, instead of violently rooting up the old. And it +might be better, in the long-run, if this policy were always followed. + +It might be supposed that native missionaries would prove more indulgent, +but the reverse is found to be the case. The new broom sweeps clean; and +the white missionary of to-day is often embarrassed by the bigotry of his +native coadjutor. What else should we expect? On some islands, sorcery, +polygamy, human sacrifice, and tobacco-smoking have been prohibited, the +dress of the native has been modified, and himself warned in strong terms +against rival sects of Christianity; all by the same man, at the same +period of time, and with the like authority. By what criterion is the +convert to distinguish the essential from the unessential? He swallows +the nostrum whole; there has been no play of mind, no instruction, and, +except for some brute utility in the prohibitions, no advance. To call +things by their proper names, this is teaching superstition. It is +unfortunate to use the word; so few people have read history, and so many +have dipped into little atheistic manuals, that the majority will rush to +a conclusion, and suppose the labour lost. And far from that: These +semi-spontaneous superstitions, varying with the sect of the original +evangelist and the customs of the island, are found in practice to be +highly fructifying; and in particular those who have learned and who go +forth again to teach them offer an example to the world. The best +specimen of the Christian hero that I ever met was one of these native +missionaries. He had saved two lives at the risk of his own; like +Nathan, he had bearded a tyrant in his hour of blood; when a whole white +population fled, he alone stood to his duty; and his behaviour under +domestic sorrow with which the public has no concern filled the beholder +with sympathy and admiration. A poor little smiling laborious man he +looked; and you would have thought he had nothing in him but that of +which indeed he had too much—facile good-nature. {86} + +It chances that the only rivals of Monseigneur and his mission in the +Marquesas were certain of these brown-skinned evangelists, natives from +Hawaii. I know not what they thought of Father Dordillon: they are the +only class I did not question; but I suspect the prelate to have regarded +them askance, for he was eminently human. During my stay at Tai-o-hae, +the time of the yearly holiday came round at the girls’ school; and a +whole fleet of whale-boats came from Ua-pu to take the daughters of that +island home. On board of these was Kauwealoha, one of the pastors, a +fine, rugged old gentleman, of that leonine type so common in Hawaii. He +paid me a visit in the _Casco_, and there entertained me with a tale of +one of his colleagues, Kekela, a missionary in the great cannibal isle of +Hiva-oa. It appears that shortly after a kidnapping visit from a +Peruvian slaver, the boats of an American whaler put into a bay upon that +island, were attacked, and made their escape with difficulty, leaving +their mate, a Mr. Whalon, in the hands of the natives. The captive, with +his arms bound behind his back, was cast into a house; and the chief +announced the capture to Kekela. And here I begin to follow the version +of Kauwealoha; it is a good specimen of Kanaka English; and the reader is +to conceive it delivered with violent emphasis and speaking pantomime. + +‘“I got ’Melican mate,” the chief he say. “What you go do ’Melican +mate?” Kekela he say. “I go make fire, I go kill, I go eat him,” he say; +“you come to-mollow eat piece.” “I no _want_ eat ’Melican mate!” Kekela +he say; “why you want?” “This bad shippee, this slave shippee,” the +chief he say. “One time a shippee he come from Pelu, he take away plenty +Kanaka, he take away my son. ’Melican mate he bad man. I go eat him; +you eat piece.” “I no _want_ eat ’Melican mate!” Kekela he say; and he +_cly_—all night he cly! To-mollow Kekela he get up, he put on blackee +coat, he go see chief; he see Missa Whela, him hand tie’ like this. +(_Pantomime_.) Kekela he cly. He say chief:—“Chief, you like things of +mine? you like whale-boat?” “Yes,” he say. “You like file-a’m?” +(fire-arms). “Yes,” he say. “You like blackee coat?” “Yes,” he say. +Kekela he take Missa Whela by he shoul’a’ (shoulder), he take him light +out house; he give chief he whale-boat, he file-a’m, he blackee coat. He +take Missa Whela he house, make him sit down with he wife and chil’en. +Missa Whela all-the-same pelison (prison); he wife, he chil’en in +Amelica; he cly—O, he cly. Kekela he solly. One day Kekela he see ship. +(_Pantomime_.) He say Missa Whela, “Ma’ Whala?” Missa Whela he say, +“Yes.” Kanaka they begin go down beach. Kekela he get eleven Kanaka, +get oa’ (oars), get evely thing. He say Missa Whela, “Now you go quick.” +They jump in whale-boat. “Now you low!” Kekela he say: “you low quick, +quick!” (_Violent pantomime_, _and a change indicating that the narrator +has left the boat and returned to the beach_.) All the Kanaka they say, +“How! ’Melican mate he go away?”—jump in boat; low afta. (_Violent +pantomime_, _and change again to boat_.) Kekela he say, “Low quick!”’ + +Here I think Kauwealoha’s pantomime had confused me; I have no more of +his _ipsissima verba_; and can but add, in my own less spirited manner, +that the ship was reached, Mr. Whalon taken aboard, and Kekela returned +to his charge among the cannibals. But how unjust it is to repeat the +stumblings of a foreigner in a language only partly acquired! A +thoughtless reader might conceive Kauwealoha and his colleague to be a +species of amicable baboon; but I have here the anti-dote. In return for +his act of gallant charity, Kekela was presented by the American +Government with a sum of money, and by President Lincoln personally with +a gold watch. From his letter of thanks, written in his own tongue, I +give the following extract. I do not envy the man who can read it +without emotion. + + ‘When I saw one of your countrymen, a citizen of your great nation, + ill-treated, and about to be baked and eaten, as a pig is eaten, I + ran to save him, full of pity and grief at the evil deed of these + benighted people. I gave my boat for the stranger’s life. This boat + came from James Hunnewell, a gift of friendship. It became the + ransom of this countryman of yours, that he might not be eaten by the + savages who knew not Jehovah. This was Mr. Whalon, and the date, + Jan. 14, 1864. + + ‘As to this friendly deed of mine in saving Mr. Whalon, its seed came + from your great land, and was brought by certain of your countrymen, + who had received the love of God. It was planted in Hawaii, and I + brought it to plant in this land and in these dark regions, that they + might receive the root of all that is good and true, which is _love_. + + ‘1. Love to Jehovah. + + ‘2. Love to self. + + ‘3. Love to our neighbour. + + ‘If a man have a sufficiency of these three, he is good and holy, + like his God, Jehovah, in his triune character (Father, Son, and Holy + Ghost), one-three, three-one. If he have two and wants one, it is + not well; and if he have one and wants two, indeed, is not well; but + if he cherishes all three, then is he holy, indeed, after the manner + of the Bible. + + ‘This is a great thing for your great nation to boast of, before all + the nations of the earth. From your great land a most precious seed + was brought to the land of darkness. It was planted here, not by + means of guns and men-of-war and threatening. It was planted by + means of the ignorant, the neglected, the despised. Such was the + introduction of the word of the Almighty God into this group of + Nuuhiwa. Great is my debt to Americans, who have taught me all + things pertaining to this life and to that which is to come. + + ‘How shall I repay your great kindness to me? Thus David asked of + Jehovah, and thus I ask of you, the President of the United States. + This is my only payment—that which I have received of the Lord, + love—(aloha).’ + + + +CHAPTER XI—LONG-PIG—A CANNIBAL HIGH PLACE + + +Nothing more strongly arouses our disgust than cannibalism, nothing so +surely unmortars a society; nothing, we might plausibly argue, will so +harden and degrade the minds of those that practise it. And yet we +ourselves make much the same appearance in the eyes of the Buddhist and +the vegetarian. We consume the carcasses of creatures of like appetites, +passions, and organs with ourselves; we feed on babes, though not our +own; and the slaughter-house resounds daily with screams of pain and +fear. We distinguish, indeed; but the unwillingness of many nations to +eat the dog, an animal with whom we live on terms of the next intimacy, +shows how precariously the distinction is grounded. The pig is the main +element of animal food among the islands; and I had many occasions, my +mind being quickened by my cannibal surroundings, to observe his +character and the manner of his death. Many islanders live with their +pigs as we do with our dogs; both crowd around the hearth with equal +freedom; and the island pig is a fellow of activity, enterprise, and +sense. He husks his own cocoa-nuts, and (I am told) rolls them into the +sun to burst; he is the terror of the shepherd. Mrs. Stevenson, senior, +has seen one fleeing to the woods with a lamb in his mouth; and I saw +another come rapidly (and erroneously) to the conclusion that the _Casco_ +was going down, and swim through the flush water to the rail in search of +an escape. It was told us in childhood that pigs cannot swim; I have +known one to leap overboard, swim five hundred yards to shore, and return +to the house of his original owner. I was once, at Tautira, a pig-master +on a considerable scale; at first, in my pen, the utmost good feeling +prevailed; a little sow with a belly-ache came and appealed to us for +help in the manner of a child; and there was one shapely black boar, whom +we called Catholicus, for he was a particular present from the Catholics +of the village, and who early displayed the marks of courage and +friendliness; no other animal, whether dog or pig, was suffered to +approach him at his food, and for human beings he showed a full measure +of that toadying fondness so common in the lower animals, and possibly +their chief title to the name. One day, on visiting my piggery, I was +amazed to see Catholicus draw back from my approach with cries of terror; +and if I was amazed at the change, I was truly embarrassed when I learnt +its reason. One of the pigs had been that morning killed; Catholicus had +seen the murder, he had discovered he was dwelling in the shambles, and +from that time his confidence and his delight in life were ended. We +still reserved him a long while, but he could not endure the sight of any +two-legged creature, nor could we, under the circumstances, encounter his +eye without confusion. I have assisted besides, by the ear, at the act +of butchery itself; the victim’s cries of pain I think I could have +borne, but the execution was mismanaged, and his expression of terror was +contagious: that small heart moved to the same tune with ours. Upon such +‘dread foundations’ the life of the European reposes, and yet the +European is among the less cruel of races. The paraphernalia of murder, +the preparatory brutalities of his existence, are all hid away; an +extreme sensibility reigns upon the surface; and ladies will faint at the +recital of one tithe of what they daily expect of their butchers. Some +will be even crying out upon me in their hearts for the coarseness of +this paragraph. And so with the island cannibals. They were not cruel; +apart from this custom, they are a race of the most kindly; rightly +speaking, to cut a man’s flesh after he is dead is far less hateful than +to oppress him whilst he lives; and even the victims of their appetite +were gently used in life and suddenly and painlessly despatched at last. +In island circles of refinement it was doubtless thought bad taste to +expatiate on what was ugly in the practice. + +Cannibalism is traced from end to end of the Pacific, from the Marquesas +to New Guinea, from New Zealand to Hawaii, here in the lively haunt of +its exercise, there by scanty but significant survivals. Hawaii is the +most doubtful. We find cannibalism chronicled in Hawaii, only in the +history of a single war, where it seems to have been thought exception, +as in the case of mountain outlaws, such as fell by the hand of Theseus. +In Tahiti, a single circumstance survived, but that appears conclusive. +In historic times, when human oblation was made in the marae, the eyes of +the victim were formally offered to the chief: a delicacy to the leading +guest. All Melanesia appears tainted. In Micronesia, in the Marshalls, +with which my acquaintance is no more than that of a tourist, I could +find no trace at all; and even in the Gilbert zone I long looked and +asked in vain. I was told tales indeed of men who had been eaten in a +famine; but these were nothing to my purpose, for the same thing is done +under the same stress by all kindreds and generations of men. At last, +in some manuscript notes of Dr. Turner’s, which I was allowed to consult +at Malua, I came on one damning evidence: on the island of Onoatoa the +punishment for theft was to be killed and eaten. How shall we account +for the universality of the practice over so vast an area, among people +of such varying civilisation, and, with whatever intermixture, of such +different blood? What circumstance is common to them all, but that they +lived on islands destitute, or very nearly so, of animal food? I can +never find it in my appetite that man was meant to live on vegetables +only. When our stores ran low among the islands, I grew to weary for the +recurrent day when economy allowed us to open another tin of miserable +mutton. And in at least one ocean language, a particular word denotes +that a man is ‘hungry for fish,’ having reached that stage when +vegetables can no longer satisfy, and his soul, like those of the Hebrews +in the desert, begins to lust after flesh-pots. Add to this the +evidences of over-population and imminent famine already adduced, and I +think we see some ground of indulgence for the island cannibal. + +It is right to look at both sides of any question; but I am far from +making the apology of this worse than bestial vice. The higher +Polynesian races, such as the Tahitians, Hawaiians, and Samoans, had one +and all outgrown, and some of them had in part forgot, the practice, +before Cook or Bougainville had shown a top-sail in their waters. It +lingered only in some low islands where life was difficult to maintain, +and among inveterate savages like the New-Zealanders or the Marquesans. +The Marquesans intertwined man-eating with the whole texture of their +lives; long-pig was in a sense their currency and sacrament; it formed +the hire of the artist, illustrated public events, and was the occasion +and attraction of a feast. To-day they are paying the penalty of this +bloody commixture. The civil power, in its crusade against man-eating, +has had to examine one after another all Marquesan arts and pleasures, +has found them one after another tainted with a cannibal element, and one +after another has placed them on the proscript list. Their art of +tattooing stood by itself, the execution exquisite, the designs most +beautiful and intricate; nothing more handsomely sets off a handsome man; +it may cost some pain in the beginning, but I doubt if it be near so +painful in the long-run, and I am sure it is far more becoming than the +ignoble European practice of tight-lacing among women. And now it has +been found needful to forbid the art. Their songs and dances were +numerous (and the law has had to abolish them by the dozen). They now +face empty-handed the tedium of their uneventful days; and who shall pity +them? The least rigorous will say that they were justly served. + +Death alone could not satisfy Marquesan vengeance: the flesh must be +eaten. The chief who seized Mr. Whalon preferred to eat him; and he +thought he had justified the wish when he explained it was a vengeance. +Two or three years ago, the people of a valley seized and slew a wretch +who had offended them. His offence, it is to be supposed, was dire; they +could not bear to leave their vengeance incomplete, and, under the eyes +of the French, they did not dare to hold a public festival. The body was +accordingly divided; and every man retired to his own house to consummate +the rite in secret, carrying his proportion of the dreadful meat in a +Swedish match-box. The barbarous substance of the drama and the European +properties employed offer a seizing contrast to the imagination. Yet +more striking is another incident of the very year when I was there +myself, 1888. In the spring, a man and woman skulked about the +school-house in Hiva-oa till they found a particular child alone. Him +they approached with honeyed words and carneying manners—‘You are +So-and-so, son of So-and-so?’ they asked; and caressed and beguiled him +deeper in the woods. Some instinct woke in the child’s bosom, or some +look betrayed the horrid purpose of his deceivers. He sought to break +from them; he screamed; and they, casting off the mask, seized him the +more strongly and began to run. His cries were heard; his schoolmates, +playing not far off, came running to the rescue; and the sinister couple +fled and vanished in the woods. They were never identified; no +prosecution followed; but it was currently supposed they had some grudge +against the boy’s father, and designed to eat him in revenge. All over +the islands, as at home among our own ancestors, it will be observed that +the avenger takes no particular heed to strike an individual. A family, +a class, a village, a whole valley or island, a whole race of mankind, +share equally the guilt of any member. So, in the above story, the son +was to pay the penalty for his father; so Mr. Whalon, the mate of an +American whaler, was to bleed and be eaten for the misdeeds of a Peruvian +slaver. I am reminded of an incident in Jaluit in the Marshall group, +which was told me by an eye-witness, and which I tell here again for the +strangeness of the scene. Two men had awakened the animosity of the +Jaluit chiefs; and it was their wives who were selected to be punished. +A single native served as executioner. Early in the morning, in the face +of a large concourse of spectators, he waded out upon the reef between +his victims. These neither complained nor resisted; accompanied their +destroyer patiently; stooped down, when they had waded deep enough, at +his command; and he (laying one hand upon the shoulders of each) held +them under water till they drowned. Doubtless, although my informant did +not tell me so, their families would be lamenting aloud upon the beach. + +It was from Hatiheu that I paid my first visit to a cannibal high place. + +The day was sultry and clouded. Drenching tropical showers succeeded +bursts of sweltering sunshine. The green pathway of the road wound +steeply upward. As we went, our little schoolboy guide a little ahead of +us, Father Simeon had his portfolio in his hand, and named the trees for +me, and read aloud from his notes the abstract of their virtues. +Presently the road, mounting, showed us the vale of Hatiheu, on a larger +scale; and the priest, with occasional reference to our guide, pointed +out the boundaries and told me the names of the larger tribes that lived +at perpetual war in the old days: one on the north-east, one along the +beach, one behind upon the mountain. With a survivor of this latter clan +Father Simeon had spoken; until the pacification he had never been to the +sea’s edge, nor, if I remember exactly, eaten of sea-fish. Each in its +own district, the septs lived cantoned and beleaguered. One step without +the boundaries was to affront death. If famine came, the men must out to +the woods to gather chestnuts and small fruits; even as to this day, if +the parents are backward in their weekly doles, school must be broken up +and the scholars sent foraging. But in the old days, when there was +trouble in one clan, there would be activity in all its neighbours; the +woods would be laid full of ambushes; and he who went after vegetables +for himself might remain to be a joint for his hereditary foes. Nor was +the pointed occasion needful. A dozen different natural signs and social +junctures called this people to the war-path and the cannibal hunt. Let +one of chiefly rank have finished his tattooing, the wife of one be near +upon her time, two of the debauching streams have deviated nearer on the +beach of Hatiheu, a certain bird have been heard to sing, a certain +ominous formation of cloud observed above the northern sea; and instantly +the arms were oiled, and the man-hunters swarmed into the wood to lay +their fratricidal ambuscades. It appears besides that occasionally, +perhaps in famine, the priest would shut himself in his house, where he +lay for a stated period like a person dead. When he came forth it was to +run for three days through the territory of the clan, naked and starving, +and to sleep at night alone in the high place. It was now the turn of +the others to keep the house, for to encounter the priest upon his rounds +was death. On the eve of the fourth day the time of the running was +over; the priest returned to his roof, the laymen came forth, and in the +morning the number of the victims was announced. I have this tale of the +priest on one authority—I think a good one,—but I set it down with +diffidence. The particulars are so striking that, had they been true, I +almost think I must have heard them oftener referred to. Upon one point +there seems to be no question: that the feast was sometimes furnished +from within the clan. In times of scarcity, all who were not protected +by their family connections—in the Highland expression, all the commons +of the clan—had cause to tremble. It was vain to resist, it was useless +to flee. They were begirt upon all hands by cannibals; and the oven was +ready to smoke for them abroad in the country of their foes, or at home +in the valley of their fathers. + +At a certain corner of the road our scholar-guide struck off to his left +into the twilight of the forest. We were now on one of the ancient +native roads, plunged in a high vault of wood, and clambering, it seemed, +at random over boulders and dead trees; but the lad wound in and out and +up and down without a check, for these paths are to the natives as marked +as the king’s highway is to us; insomuch that, in the days of the +man-hunt, it was their labour rather to block and deface than to improve +them. In the crypt of the wood the air was clammy and hot and cold; +overhead, upon the leaves, the tropical rain uproariously poured, but +only here and there, as through holes in a leaky roof, a single drop +would fall, and make a spot upon my mackintosh. Presently the huge trunk +of a banyan hove in sight, standing upon what seemed the ruins of an +ancient fort; and our guide, halting and holding forth his arm, announced +that we had reached the _paepae tapu_. + +_Paepae_ signifies a floor or platform such as a native house is built +on; and even such a paepae—a paepae hae—may be called a paepae tapu in a +lesser sense when it is deserted and becomes the haunt of spirits; but +the public high place, such as I was now treading, was a thing on a great +scale. As far as my eyes could pierce through the dark undergrowth, the +floor of the forest was all paved. Three tiers of terrace ran on the +slope of the hill; in front, a crumbling parapet contained the main +arena; and the pavement of that was pierced and parcelled out with +several wells and small enclosures. No trace remained of any +superstructure, and the scheme of the amphitheatre was difficult to +seize. I visited another in Hiva-oa, smaller but more perfect, where it +was easy to follow rows of benches, and to distinguish isolated seats of +honour for eminent persons; and where, on the upper platform, a single +joist of the temple or dead-house still remained, its uprights richly +carved. In the old days the high place was sedulously tended. No tree +except the sacred banyan was suffered to encroach upon its grades, no +dead leaf to rot upon the pavement. The stones were smoothly set, and I +am told they were kept bright with oil. On all sides the guardians lay +encamped in their subsidiary huts to watch and cleanse it. No other foot +of man was suffered to draw near; only the priest, in the days of his +running, came there to sleep—perhaps to dream of his ungodly errand; but, +in the time of the feast, the clan trooped to the high place in a body, +and each had his appointed seat. There were places for the chiefs, the +drummers, the dancers, the women, and the priests. The drums—perhaps +twenty strong, and some of them twelve feet high—continuously throbbed in +time. In time the singers kept up their long-drawn, lugubrious, +ululating song; in time, too, the dancers, tricked out in singular +finery, stepped, leaped, swayed, and gesticulated—their plumed fingers +fluttering in the air like butterflies. The sense of time, in all these +ocean races, is extremely perfect; and I conceive in such a festival that +almost every sound and movement fell in one. So much the more +unanimously must have grown the agitation of the feasters; so much the +more wild must have been the scene to any European who could have beheld +them there, in the strong sun and the strong shadow of the banyan, rubbed +with saffron to throw in a more high relief the arabesque of the tattoo; +the women bleached by days of confinement to a complexion almost +European; the chiefs crowned with silver plumes of old men’s beards and +girt with kirtles of the hair of dead women. All manner of island food +was meanwhile spread for the women and the commons; and, for those who +were privileged to eat of it, there were carried up to the dead-house the +baskets of long-pig. It is told that the feasts were long kept up; the +people came from them brutishly exhausted with debauchery, and the chiefs +heavy with their beastly food. There are certain sentiments which we +call emphatically human—denying the honour of that name to those who lack +them. In such feasts—particularly where the victim has been slain at +home, and men banqueted on the poor clay of a comrade with whom they had +played in infancy, or a woman whose favours they had shared—the whole +body of these sentiments is outraged. To consider it too closely is to +understand, if not to excuse, the fervours of self-righteous old +ship-captains, who would man their guns, and open fire in passing, on a +cannibal island. + +And yet it was strange. There, upon the spot, as I stood under the high, +dripping vault of the forest, with the young priest on the one hand, in +his kilted gown, and the bright-eyed Marquesan schoolboy on the other, +the whole business appeared infinitely distant, and fallen in the cold +perspective and dry light of history. The bearing of the priest, +perhaps, affected me. He smiled; he jested with the boy, the heir both of +these feasters and their meat; he clapped his hands, and gave me a stave +of one of the old, ill-omened choruses. Centuries might have come and +gone since this slimy theatre was last in operation; and I beheld the +place with no more emotion than I might have felt in visiting Stonehenge. +In Hiva-oa, as I began to appreciate that the thing was still living and +latent about my footsteps, and that it was still within the bounds of +possibility that I might hear the cry of the trapped victim, my historic +attitude entirely failed, and I was sensible of some repugnance for the +natives. But here, too, the priests maintained their jocular attitude: +rallying the cannibals as upon an eccentricity rather absurd than +horrible; seeking, I should say, to shame them from the practice by +good-natured ridicule, as we shame a child from stealing sugar. We may +here recognise the temperate and sagacious mind of Bishop Dordillon. + + + +CHAPTER XII—THE STORY OF A PLANTATION + + +Taahauku, on the south-westerly coast of the island of Hiva-oa—Tahuku, +say the slovenly whites—may be called the port of Atuona. It is a narrow +and small anchorage, set between low cliffy points, and opening above +upon a woody valley: a little French fort, now disused and deserted, +overhangs the valley and the inlet. Atuona itself, at the head of the +next bay, is framed in a theatre of mountains, which dominate the more +immediate settling of Taahauku and give the salient character of the +scene. They are reckoned at no higher than four thousand feet; but +Tahiti with eight thousand, and Hawaii with fifteen, can offer no such +picture of abrupt, melancholy alps. In the morning, when the sun falls +directly on their front, they stand like a vast wall: green to the +summit, if by any chance the summit should be clear—water-courses here +and there delineated on their face, as narrow as cracks. Towards +afternoon, the light falls more obliquely, and the sculpture of the range +comes in relief, huge gorges sinking into shadow, huge, tortuous +buttresses standing edged with sun. At all hours of the day they strike +the eye with some new beauty, and the mind with the same menacing gloom. + +The mountains, dividing and deflecting the endless airy deluge of the +Trade, are doubtless answerable for the climate. A strong draught of +wind blew day and night over the anchorage. Day and night the same +fantastic and attenuated clouds fled across the heavens, the same dusky +cap of rain and vapour fell and rose on the mountain. The land-breezes +came very strong and chill, and the sea, like the air, was in perpetual +bustle. The swell crowded into the narrow anchorage like sheep into a +fold; broke all along both sides, high on the one, low on the other; kept +a certain blowhole sounding and smoking like a cannon; and spent itself +at last upon the beach. + +On the side away from Atuona, the sheltering promontory was a nursery of +coco-trees. Some were mere infants, none had attained to any size, none +had yet begun to shoot skyward with that whip-like shaft of the mature +palm. In the young trees the colour alters with the age and growth. Now +all is of a grass-like hue, infinitely dainty; next the rib grows golden, +the fronds remaining green as ferns; and then, as the trunk continues to +mount and to assume its final hue of grey, the fans put on manlier and +more decided depths of verdure, stand out dark upon the distance, glisten +against the sun, and flash like silver fountains in the assault of the +wind. In this young wood of Taahauku, all these hues and combinations +were exampled and repeated by the score. The trees grew pleasantly +spaced upon a hilly sward, here and there interspersed with a rack for +drying copra, or a tumble-down hut for storing it. Every here and there +the stroller had a glimpse of the _Casco_ tossing in the narrow anchorage +below; and beyond he had ever before him the dark amphitheatre of the +Atuona mountains and the cliffy bluff that closes it to seaward. The +trade-wind moving in the fans made a ceaseless noise of summer rain; and +from time to time, with the sound of a sudden and distant drum-beat, the +surf would burst in a sea-cave. + +At the upper end of the inlet, its low, cliffy lining sinks, at both +sides, into a beach. A copra warehouse stands in the shadow of the +shoreside trees, flitted about for ever by a clan of dwarfish swallows; +and a line of rails on a high wooden staging bends back into the mouth of +the valley. Walking on this, the new-landed traveller becomes aware of a +broad fresh-water lagoon (one arm of which he crosses), and beyond, of a +grove of noble palms, sheltering the house of the trader, Mr. Keane. +Overhead, the cocos join in a continuous and lofty roof; blackbirds are +heard lustily singing; the island cock springs his jubilant rattle and +airs his golden plumage; cow-bells sound far and near in the grove; and +when you sit in the broad verandah, lulled by this symphony, you may say +to yourself, if you are able: ‘Better fifty years of Europe . . .’ +Farther on, the floor of the valley is flat and green, and dotted here +and there with stripling coco-palms. Through the midst, with many +changes of music, the river trots and brawls; and along its course, where +we should look for willows, puraos grow in clusters, and make shadowy +pools after an angler’s heart. A vale more rich and peaceful, sweeter +air, a sweeter voice of rural sounds, I have found nowhere. One +circumstance alone might strike the experienced: here is a convenient +beach, deep soil, good water, and yet nowhere any paepaes, nowhere any +trace of island habitation. + +It is but a few years since this valley was a place choked with jungle, +the debatable land and battle-ground of cannibals. Two clans laid claim +to it—neither could substantiate the claim, and the roads lay desert, or +were only visited by men in arms. It is for this very reason that it +wears now so smiling an appearance: cleared, planted, built upon, +supplied with railways, boat-houses, and bath-houses. For, being no +man’s land, it was the more readily ceded to a stranger. The stranger +was Captain John Hart: Ima Hati, ‘Broken-arm,’ the natives call him, +because when he first visited the islands his arm was in a sling. +Captain Hart, a man of English birth, but an American subject, had +conceived the idea of cotton culture in the Marquesas during the American +War, and was at first rewarded with success. His plantation at Anaho was +highly productive; island cotton fetched a high price, and the natives +used to debate which was the stronger power, Ima Hati or the French: +deciding in favour of the captain, because, though the French had the +most ships, he had the more money. + +He marked Taahauku for a suitable site, acquired it, and offered the +superintendence to Mr. Robert Stewart, a Fifeshire man, already some time +in the islands, who had just been ruined by a war on Tauata. Mr. Stewart +was somewhat averse to the adventure, having some acquaintance with +Atuona and its notorious chieftain, Moipu. He had once landed there, he +told me, about dusk, and found the remains of a man and woman partly +eaten. On his starting and sickening at the sight, one of Moipu’s young +men picked up a human foot, and provocatively staring at the stranger, +grinned and nibbled at the heel. None need be surprised if Mr. Stewart +fled incontinently to the bush, lay there all night in a great horror of +mind, and got off to sea again by daylight on the morrow. ‘It was always +a bad place, Atuona,’ commented Mr. Stewart, in his homely Fifeshire +voice. In spite of this dire introduction, he accepted the captain’s +offer, was landed at Taahauku with three Chinamen, and proceeded to clear +the jungle. + +War was pursued at that time, almost without interval, between the men of +Atuona and the men of Haamau; and one day, from the opposite sides of the +valley, battle—or I should rather say the noise of battle—raged all the +afternoon: the shots and insults of the opposing clans passing from hill +to hill over the heads of Mr. Stewart and his Chinamen. There was no +genuine fighting; it was like a bicker of schoolboys, only some fool had +given the children guns. One man died of his exertions in running, the +only casualty. With night the shots and insults ceased; the men of +Haamau withdrew; and victory, on some occult principle, was scored to +Moipu. Perhaps, in consequence, there came a day when Moipu made a +feast, and a party from Haamau came under safe-conduct to eat of it. +These passed early by Taahauku, and some of Moipu’s young men were there +to be a guard of honour. They were not long gone before there came down +from Haamau, a man, his wife, and a girl of twelve, their daughter, +bringing fungus. Several Atuona lads were hanging round the store; but +the day being one of truce none apprehended danger. The fungus was +weighed and paid for; the man of Haamau proposed he should have his axe +ground in the bargain; and Mr. Stewart demurring at the trouble, some of +the Atuona lads offered to grind it for him, and set it on the wheel. +While the axe was grinding, a friendly native whispered Mr. Stewart to +have a care of himself, for there was trouble in hand; and, all at once, +the man of Haamau was seized, and his head and arm stricken from his +body, the head at one sweep of his own newly sharpened axe. In the first +alert, the girl escaped among the cotton; and Mr. Stewart, having thrust +the wife into the house and locked her in from the outside, supposed the +affair was over. But the business had not passed without noise, and it +reached the ears of an older girl who had loitered by the way, and who +now came hastily down the valley, crying as she came for her father. +Her, too, they seized and beheaded; I know not what they had done with +the axe, it was a blunt knife that served their butcherly turn upon the +girl; and the blood spurted in fountains and painted them from head to +foot. Thus horrible from crime, the party returned to Atuona, carrying +the heads to Moipu. It may be fancied how the feast broke up; but it is +notable that the guests were honourably suffered to retire. These passed +back through Taahauku in extreme disorder; a little after the valley +began to be overrun with shouting and triumphing braves; and a letter of +warning coming at the same time to Mr. Stewart, he and his Chinamen took +refuge with the Protestant missionary in Atuona. That night the store +was gutted, and the bodies cast in a pit and covered with leaves. Three +days later the schooner had come in; and things appearing quieter, Mr. +Stewart and the captain landed in Taahauku to compute the damage and to +view the grave, which was already indicated by the stench. While they +were so employed, a party of Moipu’s young men, decked with red flannel +to indicate martial sentiments, came over the hills from Atuona, dug up +the bodies, washed them in the river, and carried them away on sticks. +That night the feast began. + +Those who knew Mr. Stewart before this experience declare the man to be +quite altered. He stuck, however, to his post; and somewhat later, when +the plantation was already well established, and gave employment to sixty +Chinamen and seventy natives, he found himself once more in dangerous +times. The men of Haamau, it was reported, had sworn to plunder and +erase the settlement; letters came continually from the Hawaiian +missionary, who acted as intelligence department; and for six weeks Mr. +Stewart and three other whites slept in the cotton-house at night in a +rampart of bales, and (what was their best defence) ostentatiously +practised rifle-shooting by day upon the beach. Natives were often there +to watch them; the practice was excellent; and the assault was never +delivered—if it ever was intended, which I doubt, for the natives are +more famous for false rumours than for deeds of energy. I was told the +late French war was a case in point; the tribes on the beach accusing +those in the mountains of designs which they had never the hardihood to +entertain. And the same testimony to their backwardness in open battle +reached me from all sides. Captain Hart once landed after an engagement +in a certain bay; one man had his hand hurt, an old woman and two +children had been slain; and the captain improved the occasion by +poulticing the hand, and taunting both sides upon so wretched an affair. +It is true these wars were often merely formal—comparable with duels to +the first blood. Captain Hart visited a bay where such a war was being +carried on between two brothers, one of whom had been thought wanting in +civility to the guests of the other. About one-half of the population +served day about on alternate sides, so as to be well with each when the +inevitable peace should follow. The forts of the belligerents were over +against each other, and close by. Pigs were cooking. Well-oiled braves, +with well-oiled muskets, strutted on the paepae or sat down to feast. No +business, however needful, could be done, and all thoughts were supposed +to be centred in this mockery of war. A few days later, by a regrettable +accident, a man was killed; it was felt at once the thing had gone too +far, and the quarrel was instantly patched up. But the more serious wars +were prosecuted in a similar spirit; a gift of pigs and a feast made +their inevitable end; the killing of a single man was a great victory, +and the murder of defenceless solitaries counted a heroic deed. + +The foot of the cliffs, about all these islands, is the place of fishing. +Between Taahauku and Atuona we saw men, but chiefly women, some nearly +naked, some in thin white or crimson dresses, perched in little surf-beat +promontories—the brown precipice overhanging them, and the convolvulus +overhanging that, as if to cut them off the more completely from +assistance. There they would angle much of the morning; and as fast as +they caught any fish, eat them, raw and living, where they stood. It was +such helpless ones that the warriors from the opposite island of Tauata +slew, and carried home and ate, and were thereupon accounted mighty men +of valour. Of one such exploit I can give the account of an eye-witness. +‘Portuguese Joe,’ Mr. Keane’s cook, was once pulling an oar in an Atuona +boat, when they spied a stranger in a canoe with some fish and a piece of +tapu. The Atuona men cried upon him to draw near and have a smoke. He +complied, because, I suppose, he had no choice; but he knew, poor devil, +what he was coming to, and (as Joe said) ‘he didn’t seem to care about +the smoke.’ A few questions followed, as to where he came from, and what +was his business. These he must needs answer, as he must needs draw at +the unwelcome pipe, his heart the while drying in his bosom. And then, +of a sudden, a big fellow in Joe’s boat leaned over, plucked the stranger +from his canoe, struck him with a knife in the neck—inward and downward, +as Joe showed in pantomime more expressive than his words—and held him +under water, like a fowl, until his struggles ceased. Whereupon the +long-pig was hauled on board, the boat’s head turned about for Atuona, +and these Marquesan braves pulled home rejoicing. Moipu was on the beach +and rejoiced with them on their arrival. Poor Joe toiled at his oar that +day with a white face, yet he had no fear for himself. ‘They were very +good to me—gave me plenty grub: never wished to eat white man,’ said he. + +If the most horrible experience was Mr. Stewart’s, it was Captain Hart +himself who ran the nearest danger. He had bought a piece of land from +Timau, chief of a neighbouring bay, and put some Chinese there to work. +Visiting the station with one of the Godeffroys, he found his Chinamen +trooping to the beach in terror: Timau had driven them out, seized their +effects, and was in war attire with his young men. A boat was despatched +to Taahauku for reinforcement; as they awaited her return, they could +see, from the deck of the schooner, Timau and his young men dancing the +war-dance on the hill-top till past twelve at night; and so soon as the +boat came (bringing three gendarmes, armed with chassepots, two white men +from Taahauku station, and some native warriors) the party set out to +seize the chief before he should awake. Day was not come, and it was a +very bright moonlight morning, when they reached the hill-top where (in a +house of palm-leaves) Timau was sleeping off his debauch. The assailants +were fully exposed, the interior of the hut quite dark; the position far +from sound. The gendarmes knelt with their pieces ready, and Captain +Hart advanced alone. As he drew near the door he heard the snap of a gun +cocking from within, and in sheer self-defence—there being no other +escape—sprang into the house and grappled Timau. ‘Timau, come with me!’ +he cried. But Timau—a great fellow, his eyes blood-red with the abuse of +kava, six foot three in stature—cast him on one side; and the captain, +instantly expecting to be either shot or brained, discharged his pistol +in the dark. When they carried Timau out at the door into the moonlight, +he was already dead, and, upon this unlooked-for termination of their +sally, the whites appeared to have lost all conduct, and retreated to the +boats, fired upon by the natives as they went. Captain Hart, who almost +rivals Bishop Dordillon in popularity, shared with him the policy of +extreme indulgence to the natives, regarding them as children, making +light of their defects, and constantly in favour of mild measures. The +death of Timau has thus somewhat weighed upon his mind; the more so, as +the chieftain’s musket was found in the house unloaded. To a less +delicate conscience the matter will seem light. If a drunken savage +elects to cock a fire-arm, a gentleman advancing towards him in the open +cannot wait to make sure if it be charged. + +I have touched on the captain’s popularity. It is one of the things that +most strikes a stranger in the Marquesas. He comes instantly on two +names, both new to him, both locally famous, both mentioned by all with +affection and respect—the bishop’s and the captain’s. It gave me a +strong desire to meet with the survivor, which was subsequently +gratified—to the enrichment of these pages. Long after that again, in +the Place Dolorous—Molokai—I came once more on the traces of that +affectionate popularity. There was a blind white leper there, an old +sailor—‘an old tough,’ he called himself—who had long sailed among the +eastern islands. Him I used to visit, and, being fresh from the scenes +of his activity, gave him the news. This (in the true island style) was +largely a chronicle of wrecks; and it chanced I mentioned the case of one +not very successful captain, and how he had lost a vessel for Mr. Hart; +thereupon the blind leper broke forth in lamentation. ‘Did he lose a +ship of John Hart’s?’ he cried; ‘poor John Hart! Well, I’m sorry it was +Hart’s,’ with needless force of epithet, which I neglect to reproduce. + +Perhaps, if Captain Hart’s affairs had continued to prosper, his +popularity might have been different. Success wins glory, but it kills +affection, which misfortune fosters. And the misfortune which overtook +the captain’s enterprise was truly singular. He was at the top of his +career. Ile Masse belonged to him, given by the French as an indemnity +for the robberies at Taahauku. But the Ile Masse was only suitable for +cattle; and his two chief stations were Anaho, in Nuka-hiva, facing the +north-east, and Taahauku in Hiva-oa, some hundred miles to the southward, +and facing the south-west. Both these were on the same day swept by a +tidal wave, which was not felt in any other bay or island of the group. +The south coast of Hiva-oa was bestrewn with building timber and +camphor-wood chests, containing goods; which, on the promise of a +reasonable salvage, the natives very honestly brought back, the chests +apparently not opened, and some of the wood after it had been built into +their houses. But the recovery of such jetsam could not affect the +result. It was impossible the captain should withstand this partiality +of fortune; and with his fall the prosperity of the Marquesas ended. +Anaho is truly extinct, Taahauku but a shadow of itself; nor has any new +plantation arisen in their stead. + + + +CHAPTER XIII—CHARACTERS + + +There was a certain traffic in our anchorage at Atuona; different indeed +from the dead inertia and quiescence of the sister island, Nuka-hiva. +Sails were seen steering from its mouth; now it would be a whale-boat +manned with native rowdies, and heavy with copra for sale; now perhaps a +single canoe come after commodities to buy. The anchorage was besides +frequented by fishers; not only the lone females perched in niches of the +cliff, but whole parties, who would sometimes camp and build a fire upon +the beach, and sometimes lie in their canoes in the midst of the haven +and jump by turns in the water; which they would cast eight or nine feet +high, to drive, as we supposed, the fish into their nets. The goods the +purchasers came to buy were sometimes quaint. I remarked one outrigger +returning with a single ham swung from a pole in the stern. And one day +there came into Mr. Keane’s store a charming lad, excellently mannered, +speaking French correctly though with a babyish accent; very handsome +too, and much of a dandy, as was shown not only in his shining raiment, +but by the nature of his purchases. These were five ship-biscuits, a +bottle of scent, and two balls of washing blue. He was from Tauata, +whither he returned the same night in an outrigger, daring the deep with +these young-ladyish treasures. The gross of the native passengers were +more ill-favoured: tall, powerful fellows, well tattooed, and with +disquieting manners. Something coarse and jeering distinguished them, +and I was often reminded of the slums of some great city. One night, as +dusk was falling, a whale-boat put in on that part of the beach where I +chanced to be alone. Six or seven ruffianly fellows scrambled out; all +had enough English to give me ‘good-bye,’ which was the ordinary +salutation; or ‘good-morning,’ which they seemed to regard as an +intensitive; jests followed, they surrounded me with harsh laughter and +rude looks, and I was glad to move away. I had not yet encountered Mr. +Stewart, or I should have been reminded of his first landing at Atuona +and the humorist who nibbled at the heel. But their neighbourhood +depressed me; and I felt, if I had been there a castaway and out of reach +of help, my heart would have been sick. + +Nor was the traffic altogether native. While we lay in the anchorage +there befell a strange coincidence. A schooner was observed at sea and +aiming to enter. We knew all the schooners in the group, but this +appeared larger than any; she was rigged, besides, after the English +manner; and, coming to an anchor some way outside the _Casco_, showed at +last the blue ensign. There were at that time, according to rumour, no +fewer than four yachts in the Pacific; but it was strange that any two of +them should thus lie side by side in that outlandish inlet: stranger +still that in the owner of the _Nyanza_, Captain Dewar, I should find a +man of the same country and the same county with myself, and one whom I +had seen walking as a boy on the shores of the Alpes Maritimes. + +We had besides a white visitor from shore, who came and departed in a +crowded whale-boat manned by natives; having read of yachts in the Sunday +papers, and being fired with the desire to see one. Captain Chase, they +called him, an old whaler-man, thickset and white-bearded, with a strong +Indiana drawl; years old in the country, a good backer in battle, and one +of those dead shots whose practice at the target struck terror in the +braves of Haamau. Captain Chase dwelt farther east in a bay called +Hanamate, with a Mr. M’Callum; or rather they had dwelt together once, +and were now amicably separated. The captain is to be found near one end +of the bay, in a wreck of a house, and waited on by a Chinese. At the +point of the opposing corner another habitation stands on a tall paepae. +The surf runs there exceeding heavy, seas of seven and eight feet high +bursting under the walls of the house, which is thus continually filled +with their clamour, and rendered fit only for solitary, or at least for +silent, inmates. Here it is that Mr. M’Callum, with a Shakespeare and a +Burns, enjoys the society of the breakers. His name and his Burns +testify to Scottish blood; but he is an American born, somewhere far +east; followed the trade of a ship-carpenter; and was long employed, the +captain of a hundred Indians, breaking up wrecks about Cape Flattery. +Many of the whites who are to be found scattered in the South Seas +represent the more artistic portion of their class; and not only enjoy +the poetry of that new life, but came there on purpose to enjoy it. I +have been shipmates with a man, no longer young, who sailed upon that +voyage, his first time to sea, for the mere love of Samoa; and it was a +few letters in a newspaper that sent him on that pilgrimage. Mr. +M’Callum was another instance of the same. He had read of the South +Seas; loved to read of them; and let their image fasten in his heart: +till at length he could refrain no longer—must set forth, a new Rudel, +for that unseen homeland—and has now dwelt for years in Hiva-oa, and will +lay his bones there in the end with full content; having no desire to +behold again the places of his boyhood, only, perhaps—once, before he +dies—the rude and wintry landscape of Cape Flattery. Yet he is an active +man, full of schemes; has bought land of the natives; has planted five +thousand coco-palms; has a desert island in his eye, which he desires to +lease, and a schooner in the stocks, which he has laid and built himself, +and even hopes to finish. Mr. M’Callum and I did not meet, but, like +gallant troubadours, corresponded in verse. I hope he will not consider +it a breach of copyright if I give here a specimen of his muse. He and +Bishop Dordillon are the two European bards of the Marquesas. + + ‘Sail, ho! Ahoy! _Casco_, + First among the pleasure fleet + That came around to greet + These isles from San Francisco, + + And first, too; only one + Among the literary men + That this way has ever been— + Welcome, then, to Stevenson. + + Please not offended be + At this little notice + Of the _Casco_, Captain Otis, + With the novelist’s family. + + _Avoir une voyage magnifical_ + Is our wish sincere, + That you’ll have from here + _Allant sur la Grande Pacifical_.’ + +But our chief visitor was one Mapiao, a great Tahuku—which seems to mean +priest, wizard, tattooer, practiser of any art, or, in a word, esoteric +person—and a man famed for his eloquence on public occasions and witty +talk in private. His first appearance was typical of the man. He came +down clamorous to the eastern landing, where the surf was running very +high; scorned all our signals to go round the bay; carried his point, was +brought aboard at some hazard to our skiff, and set down in one corner of +the cockpit to his appointed task. He had been hired, as one cunning in +the art, to make my old men’s beards into a wreath: what a wreath for +Celia’s arbour! His own beard (which he carried, for greater safety, in +a sailor’s knot) was not merely the adornment of his age, but a +substantial piece of property. One hundred dollars was the estimated +value; and as Brother Michel never knew a native to deposit a greater sum +with Bishop Dordillon, our friend was a rich man in virtue of his chin. +He had something of an East Indian cast, but taller and stronger: his +nose hooked, his face narrow, his forehead very high, the whole +elaborately tattooed. I may say I have never entertained a guest so +trying. In the least particular he must be waited on; he would not go to +the scuttle-butt for water; he would not even reach to get the glass, it +must be given him in his hand; if aid were denied him, he would fold his +arms, bow his head, and go without: only the work would suffer. Early +the first forenoon he called aloud for biscuit and salmon; biscuit and +ham were brought; he looked on them inscrutably, and signed they should +be set aside. A number of considerations crowded on my mind; how the +sort of work on which he was engaged was probably tapu in a high degree; +should by rights, perhaps, be transacted on a tapu platform which no +female might approach; and it was possible that fish might be the +essential diet. Some salted fish I therefore brought him, and along with +that a glass of rum: at sight of which Mapiao displayed extraordinary +animation, pointed to the zenith, made a long speech in which I picked up +_umati_—the word for the sun—and signed to me once more to place these +dainties out of reach. At last I had understood, and every day the +programme was the same. At an early period of the morning his dinner +must be set forth on the roof of the house and at a proper distance, full +in view but just out of reach; and not until the fit hour, which was the +point of noon, would the artificer partake. This solemnity was the cause +of an absurd misadventure. He was seated plaiting, as usual, at the +beards, his dinner arrayed on the roof, and not far off a glass of water +standing. It appears he desired to drink; was of course far too great a +gentleman to rise and get the water for himself; and spying Mrs. +Stevenson, imperiously signed to her to hand it. The signal was +misunderstood; Mrs. Stevenson was, by this time, prepared for any +eccentricity on the part of our guest; and instead of passing him the +water, flung his dinner overboard. I must do Mapiao justice: all +laughed, but his laughter rang the loudest. + +These troubles of service were at worst occasional; the embarrassment of +the man’s talk incessant. He was plainly a practised conversationalist; +the nicety of his inflections, the elegance of his gestures, and the fine +play of his expression, told us that. We, meanwhile, sat like aliens in +a playhouse; we could see the actors were upon some material business and +performing well, but the plot of the drama remained undiscoverable. +Names of places, the name of Captain Hart, occasional disconnected words, +tantalised without enlightening us; and the less we understood, the more +gallantly, the more copiously, and with still the more explanatory +gestures, Mapiao returned to the assault. We could see his vanity was on +the rack; being come to a place where that fine jewel of his +conversational talent could earn him no respect; and he had times of +despair when he desisted from the endeavour, and instants of irritation +when he regarded us with unconcealed contempt. Yet for me, as the +practitioner of some kindred mystery to his own, he manifested to the +last a measure of respect. As we sat under the awning in opposite +corners of the cockpit, he braiding hairs from dead men’s chins, I +forming runes upon a sheet of folio paper, he would nod across to me as +one Tahuku to another, or, crossing the cockpit, study for a while my +shapeless scrawl and encourage me with a heartfelt ‘_mitai_!—good!’ So +might a deaf painter sympathise far off with a musician, as the slave and +master of some uncomprehended and yet kindred art. A silly trade, he +doubtless considered it; but a man must make allowance for +barbarians—_chaque pays a ses coutumes_—and he felt the principle was +there. + +The time came at last when his labours, which resembled those rather of +Penelope than Hercules, could be no more spun out, and nothing remained +but to pay him and say farewell. After a long, learned argument in +Marquesan, I gathered that his mind was set on fish-hooks; with three of +which, and a brace of dollars, I thought he was not ill rewarded for +passing his forenoons in our cockpit, eating, drinking, delivering his +opinions, and pressing the ship’s company into his menial service. For +all that, he was a man of so high a bearing, and so like an uncle of my +own who should have gone mad and got tattooed, that I applied to him, +when we were both on shore, to know if he were satisfied. ‘_Mitai +ehipe_?’ I asked. And he, with rich unction, offering at the same time +his hand—‘_Mitai ehipe_, _mitai kaehae_; _kaoha nui_!’—or, to translate +freely: ‘The ship is good, the victuals are up to the mark, and we part +in friendship.’ Which testimonial uttered, he set off along the beach +with his head bowed and the air of one deeply injured. + +I saw him go, on my side, with relief. It would be more interesting to +learn how our relation seemed to Mapiao. His exigence, we may suppose, +was merely loyal. He had been hired by the ignorant to do a piece of +work; and he was bound that he would do it the right way. Countless +obstacles, continual ignorant ridicule, availed not to dissuade him. He +had his dinner laid out; watched it, as was fit, the while he worked; ate +it at the fit hour; was in all things served and waited on; and could +take his hire in the end with a clear conscience, telling himself the +mystery was performed duly, the beards rightfully braided, and we (in +spite of ourselves) correctly served. His view of our stupidity, even +he, the mighty talker, must have lacked language to express. He never +interfered with my Tahuku work; civilly praised it, idle as it seemed; +civilly supposed that I was competent in my own mystery: such being the +attitude of the intelligent and the polite. And we, on the other +hand—who had yet the most to gain or lose, since the product was to be +ours—who had professed our disability by the very act of hiring him to do +it—were never weary of impeding his own more important labours, and +sometimes lacked the sense and the civility to refrain from laughter. + + + +CHAPTER XIV—IN A CANNIBAL VALLEY + + +The road from Taahauku to Atuona skirted the north-westerly side of the +anchorage, somewhat high up, edged, and sometimes shaded, by the splendid +flowers of the _flamboyant_—its English name I do not know. At the turn +of the hand, Atuona came in view: a long beach, a heavy and loud breach +of surf, a shore-side village scattered among trees, and the guttered +mountains drawing near on both sides above a narrow and rich ravine. Its +infamous repute perhaps affected me; but I thought it the loveliest, and +by far the most ominous and gloomy, spot on earth. Beautiful it surely +was; and even more salubrious. The healthfulness of the whole group is +amazing; that of Atuona almost in the nature of a miracle. In Atuona, a +village planted in a shore-side marsh, the houses standing everywhere +intermingled with the pools of a taro-garden, we find every condition of +tropical danger and discomfort; and yet there are not even mosquitoes—not +even the hateful day-fly of Nuka-hiva—and fever, and its concomitant, the +island fe’efe’e, {122} are unknown. + +This is the chief station of the French on the man-eating isle of +Hiva-oa. The sergeant of gendarmerie enjoys the style of the +vice-resident, and hoists the French colours over a quite extensive +compound. A Chinaman, a waif from the plantation, keeps a restaurant in +the rear quarters of the village; and the mission is well represented by +the sister’s school and Brother Michel’s church. Father Orens, a +wonderful octogenarian, his frame scarce bowed, the fire of his eye +undimmed, has lived, and trembled, and suffered in this place since 1843. +Again and again, when Moipu had made coco-brandy, he has been driven from +his house into the woods. ‘A mouse that dwelt in a cat’s ear’ had a more +easy resting-place; and yet I have never seen a man that bore less mark +of years. He must show us the church, still decorated with the bishop’s +artless ornaments of paper—the last work of industrious old hands, and +the last earthly amusement of a man that was much of a hero. In the +sacristy we must see his sacred vessels, and, in particular, a vestment +which was a ‘_vraie curiosité_,’ because it had been given by a gendarme. +To the Protestant there is always something embarrassing in the eagerness +with which grown and holy men regard these trifles; but it was touching +and pretty to see Orens, his aged eyes shining in his head, display his +sacred treasures. + +_August_ 26.—The vale behind the village, narrowing swiftly to a mere +ravine, was choked with profitable trees. A river gushed in the midst. +Overhead, the tall coco-palms made a primary covering; above that, from +one wall of the mountain to another, the ravine was roofed with cloud; so +that we moved below, amid teeming vegetation, in a covered house of heat. +On either hand, at every hundred yards, instead of the houseless, +disembowelling paepaes of Nuka-hiva, populous houses turned out their +inhabitants to cry ‘Kaoha!’ to the passers-by. The road, too, was busy: +strings of girls, fair and foul, as in less favoured countries; men +bearing breadfruit; the sisters, with a little guard of pupils; a fellow +bestriding a horse—passed and greeted us continually; and now it was a +Chinaman who came to the gate of his flower-yard, and gave us ‘Good-day’ +in excellent English; and a little farther on it would be some natives +who set us down by the wayside, made us a feast of mummy-apple, and +entertained us as we ate with drumming on a tin case. With all this fine +plenty of men and fruit, death is at work here also. The population, +according to the highest estimate, does not exceed six hundred in the +whole vale of Atuona; and yet, when I once chanced to put the question, +Brother Michel counted up ten whom he knew to be sick beyond recovery. +It was here, too, that I could at last gratify my curiosity with the +sight of a native house in the very article of dissolution. It had +fallen flat along the paepae, its poles sprawling ungainly; the rains and +the mites contended against it; what remained seemed sound enough, but +much was gone already; and it was easy to see how the insects consumed +the walls as if they had been bread, and the air and the rain ate into +them like vitriol. + +A little ahead of us, a young gentleman, very well tattooed, and dressed +in a pair of white trousers and a flannel shirt, had been marching +unconcernedly. Of a sudden, without apparent cause, he turned back, took +us in possession, and led us undissuadably along a by-path to the river’s +edge. There, in a nook of the most attractive amenity, he bade us to sit +down: the stream splashing at our elbow, a shock of nondescript greenery +enshrining us from above; and thither, after a brief absence, he brought +us a cocoa-nut, a lump of sandal-wood, and a stick he had begun to carve: +the nut for present refreshment, the sandal-wood for a precious gift, and +the stick—in the simplicity of his vanity—to harvest premature praise. +Only one section was yet carved, although the whole was pencil-marked in +lengths; and when I proposed to buy it, Poni (for that was the artist’s +name) recoiled in horror. But I was not to be moved, and simply refused +restitution, for I had long wondered why a people who displayed, in their +tattooing, so great a gift of arabesque invention, should display it +nowhere else. Here, at last, I had found something of the same talent in +another medium; and I held the incompleteness, in these days of +world-wide brummagem, for a happy mark of authenticity. Neither my +reasons nor my purpose had I the means of making clear to Poni; I could +only hold on to the stick, and bid the artist follow me to the +gendarmerie, where I should find interpreters and money; but we gave him, +in the meanwhile, a boat-call in return for his sandal-wood. As he came +behind us down the vale he sounded upon this continually. And +continually, from the wayside houses, there poured forth little groups of +girls in crimson, or of men in white. And to these must Poni pass the +news of who the strangers were, of what they had been doing, of why it +was that Poni had a boat-whistle; and of why he was now being haled to +the vice-residency, uncertain whether to be punished or rewarded, +uncertain whether he had lost a stick or made a bargain, but hopeful on +the whole, and in the meanwhile highly consoled by the boat-whistle. +Whereupon he would tear himself away from this particular group of +inquirers, and once more we would hear the shrill call in our wake. + +_August_ 27.—I made a more extended circuit in the vale with Brother +Michel. We were mounted on a pair of sober nags, suitable to these rude +paths; the weather was exquisite, and the company in which I found myself +no less agreeable than the scenes through which I passed. We mounted at +first by a steep grade along the summit of one of those twisted spurs +that, from a distance, mark out provinces of sun and shade upon the +mountain-side. The ground fell away on either hand with an extreme +declivity. From either hand, out of profound ravines, mounted the song +of falling water and the smoke of household fires. Here and there the +hills of foliage would divide, and our eye would plunge down upon one of +these deep-nested habitations. And still, high in front, arose the +precipitous barrier of the mountain, greened over where it seemed that +scarce a harebell could find root, barred with the zigzags of a human +road where it seemed that not a goat could scramble. And in truth, for +all the labour that it cost, the road is regarded even by the Marquesans +as impassable; they will not risk a horse on that ascent; and those who +lie to the westward come and go in their canoes. I never knew a hill to +lose so little on a near approach: a consequence, I must suppose, of its +surprising steepness. When we turned about, I was amazed to behold so +deep a view behind, and so high a shoulder of blue sea, crowned by the +whale-like island of Motane. And yet the wall of mountain had not +visibly dwindled, and I could even have fancied, as I raised my eyes to +measure it, that it loomed higher than before. + +We struck now into covert paths, crossed and heard more near at hand the +bickering of the streams, and tasted the coolness of those recesses where +the houses stood. The birds sang about us as we descended. All along +our path my guide was being hailed by voices: ‘Mikaël—Kaoha, Mikaël!’ +From the doorstep, from the cotton-patch, or out of the deep grove of +island-chestnuts, these friendly cries arose, and were cheerily answered +as we passed. In a sharp angle of a glen, on a rushing brook and under +fathoms of cool foliage, we struck a house upon a well-built paepae, the +fire brightly burning under the popoi-shed against the evening meal; and +here the cries became a chorus, and the house folk, running out, obliged +us to dismount and breathe. It seemed a numerous family: we saw eight at +least; and one of these honoured me with a particular attention. This +was the mother, a woman naked to the waist, of an aged countenance, but +with hair still copious and black, and breasts still erect and youthful. +On our arrival I could see she remarked me, but instead of offering any +greeting, disappeared at once into the bush. Thence she returned with +two crimson flowers. ‘Good-bye!’ was her salutation, uttered not without +coquetry; and as she said it she pressed the flowers into my +hand—‘Good-bye! I speak Inglis.’ It was from a whaler-man, who (she +informed me) was ‘a plenty good chap,’ that she had learned my language; +and I could not but think how handsome she must have been in these times +of her youth, and could not but guess that some memories of the dandy +whaler-man prompted her attentions to myself. Nor could I refrain from +wondering what had befallen her lover; in the rain and mire of what +sea-ports he had tramped since then; in what close and garish +drinking-dens had found his pleasure; and in the ward of what infirmary +dreamed his last of the Marquesas. But she, the more fortunate, lived on +in her green island. The talk, in this lost house upon the mountains, +ran chiefly upon Mapiao and his visits to the _Casco_: the news of which +had probably gone abroad by then to all the island, so that there was no +paepae in Hiva-oa where they did not make the subject of excited comment. + +Not much beyond we came upon a high place in the foot of the ravine. Two +roads divided it, and met in the midst. Save for this intersection the +amphitheatre was strangely perfect, and had a certain ruder air of things +Roman. Depths of foliage and the bulk of the mountain kept it in a +grateful shadow. On the benches several young folk sat clustered or +apart. One of these, a girl perhaps fourteen years of age, buxom and +comely, caught the eye of Brother Michel. Why was she not at school?—she +was done with school now. What was she doing here?—she lived here now. +Why so?—no answer but a deepening blush. There was no severity in +Brother Michel’s manner; the girl’s own confusion told her story. ‘_Elle +a honte_,’ was the missionary’s comment, as we rode away. Near by in the +stream, a grown girl was bathing naked in a goyle between two +stepping-stones; and it amused me to see with what alacrity and real +alarm she bounded on her many-coloured under-clothes. Even in these +daughters of cannibals shame was eloquent. + +It is in Hiva-oa, owing to the inveterate cannibalism of the natives, +that local beliefs have been most rudely trodden underfoot. It was here +that three religious chiefs were set under a bridge, and the women of the +valley made to defile over their heads upon the road-way: the poor, +dishonoured fellows sitting there (all observers agree) with streaming +tears. Not only was one road driven across the high place, but two roads +intersected in its midst. There is no reason to suppose that the last +was done of purpose, and perhaps it was impossible entirely to avoid the +numerous sacred places of the islands. But these things are not done +without result. I have spoken already of the regard of Marquesans for +the dead, making (as it does) so strange a contrast with their unconcern +for death. Early on this day’s ride, for instance, we encountered a +petty chief, who inquired (of course) where we were going, and suggested +by way of amendment. ‘Why do you not rather show him the cemetery?’ I +saw it; it was but newly opened, the third within eight years. They are +great builders here in Hiva-oa; I saw in my ride paepaes that no European +dry-stone mason could have equalled, the black volcanic stones were laid +so justly, the corners were so precise, the levels so true; but the +retaining-wall of the new graveyard stood apart, and seemed to be a work +of love. The sentiment of honour for the dead is therefore not extinct. +And yet observe the consequence of violently countering men’s opinions. +Of the four prisoners in Atuona gaol, three were of course thieves; the +fourth was there for sacrilege. He had levelled up a piece of the +graveyard—to give a feast upon, as he informed the court—and declared he +had no thought of doing wrong. Why should he? He had been forced at the +point of the bayonet to destroy the sacred places of his own piety; when +he had recoiled from the task, he had been jeered at for a superstitious +fool. And now it is supposed he will respect our European superstitions +as by second nature. + + + +CHAPTER XV—THE TWO CHIEFS OF ATUONA + + +It had chanced (as the _Casco_ beat through the Bordelais Straits for +Taahauku) she approached on one board very near the land in the opposite +isle of Tauata, where houses were to be seen in a grove of tall +coco-palms. Brother Michel pointed out the spot. ‘I am at home now,’ +said he. ‘I believe I have a large share in these cocoa-nuts; and in +that house madame my mother lives with her two husbands!’ ‘With two +husbands?’ somebody inquired. ‘_C’est ma honte_,’ replied the brother +drily. + +A word in passing on the two husbands. I conceive the brother to have +expressed himself loosely. It seems common enough to find a native lady +with two consorts; but these are not two husbands. The first is still +the husband; the wife continues to be referred to by his name; and the +position of the coadjutor, or _pikio_, although quite regular, appears +undoubtedly subordinate. We had opportunities to observe one household +of the sort. The _pikio_ was recognised; appeared openly along with the +husband when the lady was thought to be insulted, and the pair made +common cause like brothers. At home the inequality was more apparent. +The husband sat to receive and entertain visitors; the _pikio_ was +running the while to fetch cocoa-nuts like a hired servant, and I +remarked he was sent on these errands in preference even to the son. +Plainly we have here no second husband; plainly we have the tolerated +lover. Only, in the Marquesas, instead of carrying his lady’s fan and +mantle, he must turn his hand to do the husband’s housework. + +The sight of Brother Michel’s family estate led the conversation for some +while upon the method and consequence of artificial kinship. Our +curiosity became extremely whetted; the brother offered to have the whole +of us adopted, and some two days later we became accordingly the children +of Paaaeua, appointed chief of Atuona. I was unable to be present at the +ceremony, which was primitively simple. The two Mrs. Stevensons and Mr. +Osbourne, along with Paaaeua, his wife, and an adopted child of theirs, +son of a shipwrecked Austrian, sat down to an excellent island meal, of +which the principal and the only necessary dish was pig. A concourse +watched them through the apertures of the house; but none, not even +Brother Michel, might partake; for the meal was sacramental, and either +creative or declaratory of the new relationship. In Tahiti things are +not so strictly ordered; when Ori and I ‘made brothers,’ both our +families sat with us at table, yet only he and I, who had eaten with +intention were supposed to be affected by the ceremony. For the adoption +of an infant I believe no formality to be required; the child is handed +over by the natural parents, and grows up to inherit the estates of the +adoptive. Presents are doubtless exchanged, as at all junctures of +island life, social or international; but I never heard of any +banquet—the child’s presence at the daily board perhaps sufficing. We +may find the rationale in the ancient Arabian idea that a common diet +makes a common blood, with its derivative axiom that ‘he is the father +who gives the child its morning draught.’ In the Marquesan practice, the +sense would thus be evanescent; from the Tahitian, a mere survival, it +will have entirely fled. An interesting parallel will probably occur to +many of my readers. + +What is the nature of the obligation assumed at such a festival? It will +vary with the characters of those engaged, and with the circumstances of +the case. Thus it would be absurd to take too seriously our adoption at +Atuona. On the part of Paaaeua it was an affair of social ambition; when +he agreed to receive us in his family the man had not so much as seen us, +and knew only that we were inestimably rich and travelled in a floating +palace. We, upon our side, ate of his baked meats with no true _animus +affiliandi_, but moved by the single sentiment of curiosity. The affair +was formal, and a matter of parade, as when in Europe sovereigns call +each other cousin. Yet, had we stayed at Atuona, Paaaeua would have held +himself bound to establish us upon his land, and to set apart young men +for our service, and trees for our support. I have mentioned the +Austrian. He sailed in one of two sister ships, which left the Clyde in +coal; both rounded the Horn, and both, at several hundred miles of +distance, though close on the same point of time, took fire at sea on the +Pacific. One was destroyed; the derelict iron frame of the second, after +long, aimless cruising, was at length recovered, refitted, and hails +to-day from San Francisco. A boat’s crew from one of these disasters +reached, after great hardships, the isle of Hiva-oa. Some of these men +vowed they would never again confront the chances of the sea; but alone +of them all the Austrian has been exactly true to his engagement, remains +where he landed, and designs to die where he has lived. Now, with such a +man, falling and taking root among islanders, the processes described may +be compared to a gardener’s graft. He passes bodily into the native +stock; ceases wholly to be alien; has entered the commune of the blood, +shares the prosperity and consideration of his new family, and is +expected to impart with the same generosity the fruits of his European +skill and knowledge. It is this implied engagement that so frequently +offends the ingrafted white. To snatch an immediate advantage—to get +(let us say) a station for his store—he will play upon the native custom +and become a son or a brother for the day, promising himself to cast down +the ladder by which he shall have ascended, and repudiate the kinship so +soon as it shall grow burdensome. And he finds there are two parties to +the bargain. Perhaps his Polynesian relative is simple, and conceived +the blood-bond literally; perhaps he is shrewd, and himself entered the +covenant with a view to gain. And either way the store is ravaged, the +house littered with lazy natives; and the richer the man grows, the more +numerous, the more idle, and the more affectionate he finds his native +relatives. Most men thus circumstanced contrive to buy or brutally +manage to enforce their independence; but many vegetate without hope, +strangled by parasites. + +We had no cause to blush with Brother Michel. Our new parents were kind, +gentle, well-mannered, and generous in gifts; the wife was a most +motherly woman, the husband a man who stood justly high with his +employers. Enough has been said to show why Moipu should be deposed; and +in Paaaeua the French had found a reputable substitute. He went always +scrupulously dressed, and looked the picture of propriety, like a dark, +handsome, stupid, and probably religious young man hot from a European +funeral. In character he seemed the ideal of what is known as the good +citizen. He wore gravity like an ornament. None could more nicely +represent the desired character as an appointed chief, the outpost of +civilisation and reform. And yet, were the French to go and native +manners to revive, fancy beholds him crowned with old men’s beards and +crowding with the first to a man-eating festival. But I must not seem to +be unjust to Paaaeua. His respectability went deeper than the skin; his +sense of the becoming sometimes nerved him for unexpected rigours. + +One evening Captain Otis and Mr. Osbourne were on shore in the village. +All was agog; dancing had begun; it was plain it was to be a night of +festival, and our adventurers were overjoyed at their good fortune. A +strong fall of rain drove them for shelter to the house of Paaaeua, where +they were made welcome, wiled into a chamber, and shut in. Presently the +rain took off, the fun was to begin in earnest, and the young bloods of +Atuona came round the house and called to my fellow-travellers through +the interstices of the wall. Late into the night the calls were +continued and resumed, and sometimes mingled with taunts; late into the +night the prisoners, tantalised by the noises of the festival, renewed +their efforts to escape. But all was vain; right across the door lay +that god-fearing householder, Paaaeua, feigning sleep; and my friends had +to forego their junketing. In this incident, so delightfully European, +we thought we could detect three strands of sentiment. In the first +place, Paaaeua had a charge of souls: these were young men, and he judged +it right to withhold them from the primrose path. Secondly, he was a +public character, and it was not fitting that his guests should +countenance a festival of which he disapproved. So might some strict +clergyman at home address a worldly visitor: ‘Go to the theatre if you +like, but, by your leave, not from my house!’ Thirdly, Paaaeua was a man +jealous, and with some cause (as shall be shown) for jealousy; and the +feasters were the satellites of his immediate rival, Moipu. + +For the adoption had caused much excitement in the village; it made the +strangers popular. Paaaeua, in his difficult posture of appointed chief, +drew strength and dignity from their alliance, and only Moipu and his +followers were malcontent. For some reason nobody (except myself) +appears to dislike Moipu. Captain Hart, who has been robbed and +threatened by him; Father Orens, whom he has fired at, and repeatedly +driven to the woods; my own family, and even the French officials—all +seemed smitten with an irrepressible affection for the man. His fall had +been made soft; his son, upon his death, was to succeed Paaaeua in the +chieftaincy; and he lived, at the time of our visit, in the shoreward +part of the village in a good house, and with a strong following of young +men, his late braves and pot-hunters. In this society, the coming of the +_Casco_, the adoption, the return feast on board, and the presents +exchanged between the whites and their new parents, were doubtless +eagerly and bitterly canvassed. It was felt that a few years ago the +honours would have gone elsewhere. In this unwonted business, in this +reception of some hitherto undreamed-of and outlandish potentate—some +Prester John or old Assaracus—a few years back it would have been the +part of Moipu to play the hero and the host, and his young men would have +accompanied and adorned the various celebrations as the acknowledged +leaders of society. And now, by a malign vicissitude of fortune, Moipu +must sit in his house quite unobserved; and his young men could but look +in at the door while their rivals feasted. Perhaps M. Grévy felt a touch +of bitterness towards his successor when he beheld him figure on the +broad stage of the centenary of eighty-nine; the visit of the _Casco_ +which Moipu had missed by so few years was a more unusual occasion in +Atuona than a centenary in France; and the dethroned chief determined to +reassert himself in the public eye. + +Mr. Osbourne had gone into Atuona photographing; the population of the +village had gathered together for the occasion on the place before the +church, and Paaaeua, highly delighted with this new appearance of his +family, played the master of ceremonies. The church had been taken, with +its jolly architect before the door; the nuns with their pupils; sundry +damsels in the ancient and singularly unbecoming robes of tapa; and +Father Orens in the midst of a group of his parishioners. I know not +what else was in hand, when the photographer became aware of a sensation +in the crowd, and, looking around, beheld a very noble figure of a man +appear upon the margin of a thicket and stroll nonchalantly near. The +nonchalance was visibly affected; it was plain he came there to arouse +attention, and his success was instant. He was introduced; he was civil, +he was obliging, he was always ineffably superior and certain of himself; +a well-graced actor. It was presently suggested that he should appear in +his war costume; he gracefully consented; and returned in that strange, +inappropriate and ill-omened array (which very well became his handsome +person) to strut in a circle of admirers, and be thenceforth the centre +of photography. Thus had Moipu effected his introduction, as by +accident, to the white strangers, made it a favour to display his finery, +and reduced his rival to a secondary _rôle_ on the theatre of the +disputed village. Paaaeua felt the blow; and, with a spirit which we +never dreamed he could possess, asserted his priority. It was found +impossible that day to get a photograph of Moipu alone; for whenever he +stood up before the camera his successor placed himself unbidden by his +side, and gently but firmly held to his position. The portraits of the +pair, Jacob and Esau, standing shoulder to shoulder, one in his careful +European dress, one in his barbaric trappings, figure the past and +present of their island. A graveyard with its humble crosses would be +the aptest symbol of the future. + +We are all impressed with the belief that Moipu had planned his campaign +from the beginning to the end. It is certain that he lost no time in +pushing his advantage. Mr. Osbourne was inveigled to his house; various +gifts were fished out of an old sea-chest; Father Orens was called into +service as interpreter, and Moipu formally proposed to ‘make brothers’ +with Mata-Galahi—Glass-Eyes,—the not very euphonious name under which Mr. +Osbourne passed in the Marquesas. The feast of brotherhood took place on +board the _Casco_. Paaaeua had arrived with his family, like a plain +man; and his presents, which had been numerous, had followed one another, +at intervals through several days. Moipu, as if to mark at every point +the opposition, came with a certain feudal pomp, attended by retainers +bearing gifts of all descriptions, from plumes of old men’s beard to +little, pious, Catholic engravings. + +I had met the man before this in the village, and detested him on sight; +there was something indescribably raffish in his looks and ways that +raised my gorge; and when man-eating was referred to, and he laughed a +low, cruel laugh, part boastful, part bashful, like one reminded of some +dashing peccadillo, my repugnance was mingled with nausea. This is no +very human attitude, nor one at all becoming in a traveller. And, seen +more privately, the man improved. Something negroid in character and +face was still displeasing; but his ugly mouth became attractive when he +smiled, his figure and bearing were certainly noble, and his eyes superb. +In his appreciation of jams and pickles, in is delight in the +reverberating mirrors of the dining cabin, and consequent endless +repetition of Moipus and Mata-Galahis, he showed himself engagingly a +child. And yet I am not sure; and what seemed childishness may have been +rather courtly art. His manners struck me as beyond the mark; they were +refined and caressing to the point of grossness, and when I think of the +serene absent-mindedness with which he first strolled in upon our party, +and then recall him running on hands and knees along the cabin sofas, +pawing the velvet, dipping into the beds, and bleating commendatory +‘_mitais_’ with exaggerated emphasis, like some enormous over-mannered +ape, I feel the more sure that both must have been calculated. And I +sometimes wonder next, if Moipu were quite alone in this polite +duplicity, and ask myself whether the _Casco_ were quite so much admired +in the Marquesas as our visitors desired us to suppose. + +I will complete this sketch of an incurable cannibal grandee with two +incongruous traits. His favourite morsel was the human hand, of which he +speaks to-day with an ill-favoured lustfulness. And when he said +good-bye to Mrs. Stevenson, holding her hand, viewing her with tearful +eyes, and chanting his farewell improvisation in the falsetto of +Marquesan high society, he wrote upon her mind a sentimental impression +which I try in vain to share. + + + + +PART II: THE PAUMOTUS + + +CHAPTER I—THE DANGEROUS ARCHIPELAGO—ATOLLS AT A DISTANCE + + +In the early morning of 4th September a whale-boat manned by natives +dragged us down the green lane of the anchorage and round the spouting +promontory. On the shore level it was a hot, breathless, and yet crystal +morning; but high overhead the hills of Atuona were all cowled in cloud, +and the ocean-river of the trades streamed without pause. As we crawled +from under the immediate shelter of the land, we reached at last the +limit of their influence. The wind fell upon our sails in puffs, which +strengthened and grew more continuous; presently the _Casco_ heeled down +to her day’s work; the whale-boat, quite outstripped, clung for a noisy +moment to her quarter; the stipulated bread, rum, and tobacco were passed +in; a moment more and the boat was in our wake, and our late pilots were +cheering our departure. + +This was the more inspiriting as we were bound for scenes so different, +and though on a brief voyage, yet for a new province of creation. That +wide field of ocean, called loosely the South Seas, extends from tropic +to tropic, and from perhaps 123 degrees W. to 150 degrees E., a +parallelogram of one hundred degrees by forty-seven, where degrees are +the most spacious. Much of it lies vacant, much is closely sown with +isles, and the isles are of two sorts. No distinction is so continually +dwelt upon in South Sea talk as that between the ‘low’ and the ‘high’ +island, and there is none more broadly marked in nature. The Himalayas +are not more different from the Sahara. On the one hand, and chiefly in +groups of from eight to a dozen, volcanic islands rise above the sea; few +reach an altitude of less than 4000 feet; one exceeds 13,000; their tops +are often obscured in cloud, they are all clothed with various forests, +all abound in food, and are all remarkable for picturesque and solemn +scenery. On the other hand, we have the atoll; a thing of problematic +origin and history, the reputed creature of an insect apparently +unidentified; rudely annular in shape; enclosing a lagoon; rarely +extending beyond a quarter of a mile at its chief width; often rising at +its highest point to less than the stature of a man—man himself, the rat +and the land crab, its chief inhabitants; not more variously supplied +with plants; and offering to the eye, even when perfect, only a ring of +glittering beach and verdant foliage, enclosing and enclosed by the blue +sea. + +In no quarter are the atolls so thickly congregated, in none are they so +varied in size from the greatest to the least, and in none is navigation +so beset with perils, as in that archipelago that we were now to thread. +The huge system of the trades is, for some reason, quite confounded by +this multiplicity of reefs, the wind intermits, squalls are frequent from +the west and south-west, hurricanes are known. The currents are, +besides, inextricably intermixed; dead reckoning becomes a farce; the +charts are not to be trusted; and such is the number and similarity of +these islands that, even when you have picked one up, you may be none the +wiser. The reputation of the place is consequently infamous; insurance +offices exclude it from their field, and it was not without misgiving +that my captain risked the _Casco_ in such waters. I believe, indeed, it +is almost understood that yachts are to avoid this baffling archipelago; +and it required all my instances—and all Mr. Otis’s private taste for +adventure—to deflect our course across its midst. + +For a few days we sailed with a steady trade, and a steady westerly +current setting us to leeward; and toward sundown of the seventh it was +supposed we should have sighted Takaroa, one of Cook’s so-called King +George Islands. The sun set; yet a while longer the old +moon—semi-brilliant herself, and with a silver belly, which was her +successor—sailed among gathering clouds; she, too, deserted us; stars of +every degree of sheen, and clouds of every variety of form disputed the +sub-lustrous night; and still we gazed in vain for Takaroa. The mate +stood on the bowsprit, his tall grey figure slashing up and down against +the stars, and still + + ‘nihil astra praeter + Vidit et undas. + +The rest of us were grouped at the port anchor davit, staring with no +less assiduity, but with far less hope on the obscure horizon. Islands +we beheld in plenty, but they were of ‘such stuff as dreams are made on,’ +and vanished at a wink, only to appear in other places; and by and by not +only islands, but refulgent and revolving lights began to stud the +darkness; lighthouses of the mind or of the wearied optic nerve, solemnly +shining and winking as we passed. At length the mate himself despaired, +scrambled on board again from his unrestful perch, and announced that we +had missed our destination. He was the only man of practice in these +waters, our sole pilot, shipped for that end at Tai-o-hae. If he +declared we had missed Takaroa, it was not for us to quarrel with the +fact, but, if we could, to explain it. We had certainly run down our +southing. Our canted wake upon the sea and our somewhat drunken-looking +course upon the chart both testified with no less certainty to an +impetuous westward current. We had no choice but to conclude we were +again set down to leeward; and the best we could do was to bring the +_Casco_ to the wind, keep a good watch, and expect morning. + +I slept that night, as was then my somewhat dangerous practice, on deck +upon the cockpit bench. A stir at last awoke me, to see all the eastern +heaven dyed with faint orange, the binnacle lamp already dulled against +the brightness of the day, and the steersman leaning eagerly across the +wheel. ‘There it is, sir!’ he cried, and pointed in the very eyeball of +the dawn. For awhile I could see nothing but the bluish ruins of the +morning bank, which lay far along the horizon, like melting icebergs. +Then the sun rose, pierced a gap in these _débris_ of vapours, and +displayed an inconsiderable islet, flat as a plate upon the sea, and +spiked with palms of disproportioned altitude. + +So far, so good. Here was certainly an atoll; and we were certainly got +among the archipelago. But which? And where? The isle was too small +for either Takaroa: in all our neighbourhood, indeed, there was none so +inconsiderable, save only Tikei; and Tikei, one of Roggewein’s so-called +Pernicious Islands, seemed beside the question. At that rate, instead of +drifting to the west, we must have fetched up thirty miles to windward. +And how about the current? It had been setting us down, by observation, +all these days: by the deflection of our wake, it should be setting us +down that moment. When had it stopped? When had it begun again? and +what kind of torrent was that which had swept us eastward in the +interval? To these questions, so typical of navigation in that range of +isles, I have no answer. Such were at least the facts; Tikei our island +turned out to be; and it was our first experience of the dangerous +archipelago, to make our landfall thirty miles out. + +The sight of Tikei, thrown direct against the splendour of the morning, +robbed of all its colour, and deformed with disproportioned trees like +bristles on a broom, had scarce prepared us to be much in love with +atolls. Later the same day we saw under more fit conditions the island +of Taiaro. _Lost in the Sea_ is possibly the meaning of the name. And +it was so we saw it; lost in blue sea and sky: a ring of white beach, +green underwood, and tossing palms, gem-like in colour; of a fairy, of a +heavenly prettiness. The surf ran all around it, white as snow, and +broke at one point, far to seaward, on what seems an uncharted reef. +There was no smoke, no sign of man; indeed, the isle is not inhabited, +only visited at intervals. And yet a trader (Mr. Narii Salmon) was +watching from the shore and wondering at the unexpected ship. I have +spent since then long months upon low islands; I know the tedium of their +undistinguished days; I know the burden of their diet. With whatever +envy we may have looked from the deck on these green coverts, it was with +a tenfold greater that Mr. Salmon and his comrades saw us steer, in our +trim ship, to seaward. + +The night fell lovely in the extreme. After the moon went down, the +heaven was a thing to wonder at for stars. And as I lay in the cockpit +and looked upon the steersman I was haunted by Emerson’s verses: + + ‘And the lone seaman all the night + Sails astonished among stars.’ + +By this glittering and imperfect brightness, about four bells in the +first watch we made our third atoll, Raraka. The low line of the isle +lay straight along the sky; so that I was at first reminded of a towpath, +and we seemed to be mounting some engineered and navigable stream. +Presently a red star appeared, about the height and brightness of a +danger signal, and with that my simile was changed; we seemed rather to +skirt the embankment of a railway, and the eye began to look +instinctively for the telegraph-posts, and the ear to expect the coming +of a train. Here and there, but rarely, faint tree-tops broke the level. +And the sound of the surf accompanied us, now in a drowsy monotone, now +with a menacing swing. + +The isle lay nearly east and west, barring our advance on Fakarava. We +must, therefore, hug the coast until we gained the western end, where, +through a passage eight miles wide, we might sail southward between +Raraka and the next isle, Kauehi. We had the wind free, a lightish air; +but clouds of an inky blackness were beginning to arise, and at times it +lightened—without thunder. Something, I know not what, continually set +us up upon the island. We lay more and more to the nor’ard; and you +would have thought the shore copied our manœuvre and outsailed us. Once +and twice Raraka headed us again—again, in the sea fashion, the quite +innocent steersman was abused—and again the _Casco_ kept away. Had I +been called on, with no more light than that of our experience, to draw +the configuration of that island, I should have shown a series of +bow-window promontories, each overlapping the other to the nor’ard, and +the trend of the land from the south-east to the north-west, and behold, +on the chart it lay near east and west in a straight line. + +We had but just repeated our manœuvre and kept away—for not more than +five minutes the railway embankment had been lost to view and the surf to +hearing—when I was aware of land again, not only on the weather bow, but +dead ahead. I played the part of the judicious landsman, holding my +peace till the last moment; and presently my mariners perceived it for +themselves. + +‘Land ahead!’ said the steersman. + +‘By God, it’s Kauehi!’ cried the mate. + +And so it was. And with that I began to be sorry for cartographers. We +were scarce doing three and a half; and they asked me to believe that (in +five minutes) we had dropped an island, passed eight miles of open water, +and run almost high and dry upon the next. But my captain was more sorry +for himself to be afloat in such a labyrinth; laid the _Casco_ to, with +the log line up and down, and sat on the stern rail and watched it till +the morning. He had enough of night in the Paumotus. + +By daylight on the 9th we began to skirt Kauehi, and had now an +opportunity to see near at hand the geography of atolls. Here and there, +where it was high, the farther side loomed up; here and there the near +side dipped entirely and showed a broad path of water into the lagoon; +here and there both sides were equally abased, and we could look right +through the discontinuous ring to the sea horizon on the south. +Conceive, on a vast scale, the submerged hoop of the duck-hunter, trimmed +with green rushes to conceal his head—water within, water without—you +have the image of the perfect atoll. Conceive one that has been partly +plucked of its rush fringe; you have the atoll of Kauehi. And for either +shore of it at closer quarters, conceive the line of some old Roman +highway traversing a wet morass, and here sunk out of view and there +re-arising, crowned with a green tuft of thicket; only instead of the +stagnant waters of a marsh, the live ocean now boiled against, now buried +the frail barrier. Last night’s impression in the dark was thus +confirmed by day, and not corrected. We sailed indeed by a mere causeway +in the sea, of nature’s handiwork, yet of no greater magnitude than many +of the works of man. + +The isle was uninhabited; it was all green brush and white sand, set in +transcendently blue water; even the coco-palms were rare, though some of +these completed the bright harmony of colour by hanging out a fan of +golden yellow. For long there was no sign of life beyond the vegetable, +and no sound but the continuous grumble of the surf. In silence and +desertion these fair shores slipped past, and were submerged and rose +again with clumps of thicket from the sea. And then a bird or two +appeared, hovering and crying; swiftly these became more numerous, and +presently, looking ahead, we were aware of a vast effervescence of winged +life. In this place the annular isle was mostly under water, carrying +here and there on its submerged line a wooded islet. Over one of these +the birds hung and flew with an incredible density like that of gnats or +hiving bees; the mass flashed white and black, and heaved and quivered, +and the screaming of the creatures rose over the voice of the surf in a +shrill clattering whirr. As you descend some inland valley a not +dissimilar sound announces the nearness of a mill and pouring river. +Some stragglers, as I said, came to meet our approach; a few still hung +about the ship as we departed. The crying died away, the last pair of +wings was left behind, and once more the low shores of Kauehi streamed +past our eyes in silence like a picture. I supposed at the time that the +birds lived, like ants or citizens, concentred where we saw them. I have +been told since (I know not if correctly) that the whole isle, or much of +it, is similarly peopled; and that the effervescence at a single spot +would be the mark of a boat’s crew of egg-hunters from one of the +neighbouring inhabited atolls. So that here at Kauehi, as the day before +at Taiaro, the _Casco_ sailed by under the fire of unsuspected eyes. And +one thing is surely true, that even on these ribbons of land an army +might lie hid and no passing mariner divine its presence. + + + +CHAPTER II—FAKARAVA: AN ATOLL AT HAND + + +By a little before noon we were running down the coast of our +destination, Fakarava: the air very light, the sea near smooth; though +still we were accompanied by a continuous murmur from the beach, like the +sound of a distant train. The isle is of a huge longitude, the enclosed +lagoon thirty miles by ten or twelve, and the coral tow-path, which they +call the land, some eighty or ninety miles by (possibly) one furlong. +That part by which we sailed was all raised; the underwood excellently +green, the topping wood of coco-palms continuous—a mark, if I had known +it, of man’s intervention. For once more, and once more unconsciously, +we were within hail of fellow-creatures, and that vacant beach was but a +pistol-shot from the capital city of the archipelago. But the life of an +atoll, unless it be enclosed, passes wholly on the shores of the lagoon; +it is there the villages are seated, there the canoes ply and are drawn +up; and the beach of the ocean is a place accursed and deserted, the fit +scene only for wizardry and shipwreck, and in the native belief a +haunting ground of murderous spectres. + +By and by we might perceive a breach in the low barrier; the woods +ceased; a glittering point ran into the sea, tipped with an emerald shoal +the mark of entrance. As we drew near we met a little run of sea—the +private sea of the lagoon having there its origin and end, and here, in +the jaws of the gateway, trying vain conclusions with the more majestic +heave of the Pacific. The _Casco_ scarce avowed a shock; but there are +times and circumstances when these harbour mouths of inland basins vomit +floods, deflecting, burying, and dismasting ships. For, conceive a +lagoon perfectly sealed but in the one point, and that of merely +navigable width; conceive the tide and wind to have heaped for hours +together in that coral fold a superfluity of waters, and the tide to +change and the wind fall—the open sluice of some great reservoirs at home +will give an image of the unstemmable effluxion. + +We were scarce well headed for the pass before all heads were craned over +the rail. For the water, shoaling under our board, became changed in a +moment to surprising hues of blue and grey; and in its transparency the +coral branched and blossomed, and the fish of the inland sea cruised +visibly below us, stained and striped, and even beaked like parrots. I +have paid in my time to view many curiosities; never one so curious as +that first sight over the ship’s rail in the lagoon of Fakarava. But let +not the reader be deceived with hope. I have since entered, I suppose, +some dozen atolls in different parts of the Pacific, and the experience +has never been repeated. That exquisite hue and transparency of +submarine day, and these shoals of rainbow fish, have not enraptured me +again. + +Before we could raise our eyes from that engaging spectacle the schooner +had slipped betwixt the pierheads of the reef, and was already quite +committed to the sea within. The containing shores are so little +erected, and the lagoon itself is so great, that, for the more part, it +seemed to extend without a check to the horizon. Here and there, indeed, +where the reef carried an inlet, like a signet-ring upon a finger, there +would be a pencilling of palms; here and there, the green wall of wood +ran solid for a length of miles; and on the port hand, under the highest +grove of trees, a few houses sparkled white—Rotoava, the metropolitan +settlement of the Paumotus. Hither we beat in three tacks, and came to +an anchor close in shore, in the first smooth water since we had left San +Francisco, five fathoms deep, where a man might look overboard all day at +the vanishing cable, the coral patches, and the many-coloured fish. + +Fakarava was chosen to be the seat of Government from nautical +considerations only. It is eccentrically situate; the productions, even +for a low island, poor; the population neither many nor—for Low +Islanders—industrious. But the lagoon has two good passages, one to +leeward, one to windward, so that in all states of the wind it can be +left and entered, and this advantage, for a government of scattered +islands, was decisive. A pier of coral, landing-stairs, a harbour light +upon a staff and pillar, and two spacious Government bungalows in a +handsome fence, give to the northern end of Rotoava a great air of +consequence. This is confirmed on the one hand by an empty prison, on +the other by a gendarmerie pasted over with hand-bills in Tahitian, +land-law notices from Papeete, and republican sentiments from Paris, +signed (a little after date) ‘Jules Grévy, _Perihidente_.’ Quite at the +far end a belfried Catholic chapel concludes the town; and between, on a +smooth floor of white coral sand and under the breezy canopy of +coco-palms, the houses of the natives stand irregularly scattered, now +close on the lagoon for the sake of the breeze, now back under the palms +for love of shadow. + +Not a soul was to be seen. But for the thunder of the surf on the far +side, it seemed you might have heard a pin drop anywhere about that +capital city. There was something thrilling in the unexpected silence, +something yet more so in the unexpected sound. Here before us a sea +reached to the horizon, rippling like an inland mere; and behold! close +at our back another sea assaulted with assiduous fury the reverse of the +position. At night the lantern was run up and lit a vacant pier. In one +house lights were seen and voices heard, where the population (I was +told) sat playing cards. A little beyond, from deep in the darkness of +the palm-grove, we saw the glow and smelt the aromatic odour of a coal of +cocoa-nut husk, a relic of the evening kitchen. Crickets sang; some +shrill thing whistled in a tuft of weeds; and the mosquito hummed and +stung. There was no other trace that night of man, bird, or insect in +the isle. The moon, now three days old, and as yet but a silver crescent +on a still visible sphere, shone through the palm canopy with vigorous +and scattered lights. The alleys where we walked were smoothed and +weeded like a boulevard; here and there were plants set out; here and +there dusky cottages clustered in the shadow, some with verandahs. A +public garden by night, a rich and fashionable watering-place in a +by-season, offer sights and vistas not dissimilar. And still, on the one +side, stretched the lapping mere, and from the other the deep sea still +growled in the night. But it was most of all on board, in the dead +hours, when I had been better sleeping, that the spell of Fakarava seized +and held me. The moon was down. The harbour lantern and two of the +greater planets drew vari-coloured wakes on the lagoon. From shore the +cheerful watch-cry of cocks rang out at intervals above the organ-point +of surf. And the thought of this depopulated capital, this protracted +thread of annular island with its crest of coco-palms and fringe of +breakers, and that tranquil inland sea that stretched before me till it +touched the stars, ran in my head for hours with delight. + +So long as I stayed upon that isle these thoughts were constant. I lay +down to sleep, and woke again with an unblunted sense of my surroundings. +I was never weary of calling up the image of that narrow causeway, on +which I had my dwelling, lying coiled like a serpent, tail to mouth, in +the outrageous ocean, and I was never weary of passing—a mere +quarter-deck parade—from the one side to the other, from the shady, +habitable shores of the lagoon to the blinding desert and uproarious +breakers of the opposite beach. The sense of insecurity in such a thread +of residence is more than fanciful. Hurricanes and tidal waves over-leap +these humble obstacles; Oceanus remembers his strength, and, where houses +stood and palms flourished, shakes his white beard again over the barren +coral. Fakarava itself has suffered; the trees immediately beyond my +house were all of recent replantation; and Anaa is only now recovered +from a heavier stroke. I knew one who was then dwelling in the isle. He +told me that he and two ship captains walked to the sea beach. There for +a while they viewed the oncoming breakers, till one of the captains +clapped suddenly his hand before his eyes and cried aloud that he could +endure no longer to behold them. This was in the afternoon; in the dark +hours of the night the sea burst upon the island like a flood; the +settlement was razed all but the church and presbytery; and, when day +returned, the survivors saw themselves clinging in an abattis of uprooted +coco-palms and ruined houses. + +Danger is but a small consideration. But men are more nicely sensible of +a discomfort; and the atoll is a discomfortable home. There are some, +and these probably ancient, where a deep soil has formed and the most +valuable fruit-trees prosper. I have walked in one, with equal +admiration and surprise, through a forest of huge breadfruits, eating +bananas and stumbling among taro as I went. This was in the atoll of +Namorik in the Marshall group, and stands alone in my experience. To +give the opposite extreme, which is yet far more near the average, I will +describe the soil and productions of Fakarava. The surface of that +narrow strip is for the more part of broken coral lime-stone, like +volcanic clinkers, and excruciating to the naked foot; in some atolls, I +believe, not in Fakarava, it gives a fine metallic ring when struck. +Here and there you come upon a bank of sand, exceeding fine and white, +and these parts are the least productive. The plants (such as they are) +spring from and love the broken coral, whence they grow with that +wonderful verdancy that makes the beauty of the atoll from the sea. The +coco-palm in particular luxuriates in that stern _solum_, striking down +his roots to the brackish, percolated water, and bearing his green head +in the wind with every evidence of health and pleasure. And yet even the +coco-palm must be helped in infancy with some extraneous nutriment, and +through much of the low archipelago there is planted with each nut a +piece of ship’s biscuit and a rusty nail. The pandanus comes next in +importance, being also a food tree; and he, too, does bravely. A green +bush called _miki_ runs everywhere; occasionally a purao is seen; and +there are several useless weeds. According to M. Cuzent, the whole +number of plants on an atoll such as Fakarava will scarce exceed, even if +it reaches to, one score. Not a blade of grass appears; not a grain of +humus, save when a sack or two has been imported to make the semblance of +a garden; such gardens as bloom in cities on the window-sill. Insect +life is sometimes dense; a cloud o’ mosquitoes, and, what is far worse, a +plague of flies blackening our food, has sometimes driven us from a meal +on Apemama; and even in Fakarava the mosquitoes were a pest. The land +crab may be seen scuttling to his hole, and at night the rats besiege the +houses and the artificial gardens. The crab is good eating; possibly so +is the rat; I have not tried. Pandanus fruit is made, in the Gilberts, +into an agreeable sweetmeat, such as a man may trifle with at the end of +a long dinner; for a substantial meal I have no use for it. The rest of +the food-supply, in a destitute atoll such as Fakarava, can be summed up +in the favourite jest of the archipelago—cocoa-nut beefsteak. Cocoa-nut +green, cocoa-nut ripe, cocoa-nut germinated; cocoa-nut to eat and +cocoa-nut to drink; cocoa-nut raw and cooked, cocoa-nut hot and cold—such +is the bill of fare. And some of the entrées are no doubt delicious. +The germinated nut, cooked in the shell and eaten with a spoon, forms a +good pudding; cocoa-nut milk—the expressed juice of a ripe nut, not the +water of a green one—goes well in coffee, and is a valuable adjunct in +cookery through the South Seas; and cocoa-nut salad, if you be a +millionaire, and can afford to eat the value of a field of corn for your +dessert, is a dish to be remembered with affection. But when all is done +there is a sameness, and the Israelites of the low islands murmur at +their manna. + +The reader may think I have forgot the sea. The two beaches do certainly +abound in life, and they are strangely different. In the lagoon the +water shallows slowly on a bottom of the fine slimy sand, dotted with +clumps of growing coral. Then comes a strip of tidal beach on which the +ripples lap. In the coral clumps the great holy-water clam (_Tridacna_) +grows plentifully; a little deeper lie the beds of the pearl-oyster and +sail the resplendent fish that charmed us at our entrance; and these are +all more or less vigorously coloured. But the other shells are white +like lime, or faintly tinted with a little pink, the palest possible +display; many of them dead besides, and badly rolled. On the ocean side, +on the mounds of the steep beach, over all the width of the reef right +out to where the surf is bursting, in every cranny, under every scattered +fragment of the coral, an incredible plenty of marine life displays the +most wonderful variety and brilliancy of hues. The reef itself has no +passage of colour but is imitated by some shell. Purple and red and +white, and green and yellow, pied and striped and clouded, the living +shells wear in every combination the livery of the dead reef—if the reef +be dead—so that the eye is continually baffled and the collector +continually deceived. I have taken shells for stones and stones for +shells, the one as often as the other. A prevailing character of the +coral is to be dotted with small spots of red, and it is wonderful how +many varieties of shell have adopted the same fashion and donned the +disguise of the red spot. A shell I had found in plenty in the Marquesas +I found here also unchanged in all things else, but there were the red +spots. A lively little crab wore the same markings. The case of the +hermit or soldier crab was more conclusive, being the result of conscious +choice. This nasty little wrecker, scavenger, and squatter has learned +the value of a spotted house; so it be of the right colour he will choose +the smallest shard, tuck himself in a mere corner of a broken whorl, and +go about the world half naked; but I never found him in this imperfect +armour unless it was marked with the red spot. + +Some two hundred yards distant is the beach of the lagoon. Collect the +shells from each, set them side by side, and you would suppose they came +from different hemispheres; the one so pale, the other so brilliant; the +one prevalently white, the other of a score of hues, and infected with +the scarlet spot like a disease. This seems the more strange, since the +hermit crabs pass and repass the island, and I have met them by the +Residency well, which is about central, journeying either way. Without +doubt many of the shells in the lagoon are dead. But why are they dead? +Without doubt the living shells have a very different background set for +imitation. But why are these so different? We are only on the threshold +of the mysteries. + +Either beach, I have said, abounds with life. On the sea-side and in +certain atolls this profusion of vitality is even shocking: the rock +under foot is mined with it. I have broken off—notably in Funafuti and +Arorai {156}—great lumps of ancient weathered rock that rang under my +blows like iron, and the fracture has been full of pendent worms as long +as my hand, as thick as a child’s finger, of a slightly pinkish white, +and set as close as three or even four to the square inch. Even in the +lagoon, where certain shell-fish seem to sicken, others (it is notorious) +prosper exceedingly and make the riches of these islands. Fish, too, +abound; the lagoon is a closed fish-pond, such as might rejoice the fancy +of an abbot; sharks swarm there, and chiefly round the passages, to feast +upon this plenty, and you would suppose that man had only to prepare his +angle. Alas! it is not so. Of these painted fish that came in hordes +about the entering _Casco_, some bore poisonous spines, and others were +poisonous if eaten. The stranger must refrain, or take his chance of +painful and dangerous sickness. The native, on his own isle, is a safe +guide; transplant him to the next, and he is helpless as yourself. For +it is a question both of time and place. A fish caught in a lagoon may +be deadly; the same fish caught the same day at sea, and only a few +hundred yards without the passage, will be wholesome eating: in a +neighbouring isle perhaps the case will be reversed; and perhaps a +fortnight later you shall be able to eat of them indifferently from +within and from without. According to the natives, these bewildering +vicissitudes are ruled by the movement of the heavenly bodies. The +beautiful planet Venus plays a great part in all island tales and +customs; and among other functions, some of them more awful, she +regulates the season of good fish. With Venus in one phase, as we had +her, certain fish were poisonous in the lagoon: with Venus in another, +the same fish was harmless and a valued article of diet. White men +explain these changes by the phases of the coral. + +It adds a last touch of horror to the thought of this precarious annular +gangway in the sea, that even what there is of it is not of honest rock, +but organic, part alive, part putrescent; even the clean sea and the +bright fish about it poisoned, the most stubborn boulder burrowed in by +worms, the lightest dust venomous as an apothecary’s drugs. + + + +CHAPTER III—A HOUSE TO LET IN A LOW ISLAND + + +Never populous, it was yet by a chapter of accidents that I found the +island so deserted that no sound of human life diversified the hours; +that we walked in that trim public garden of a town, among closed houses, +without even a lodging-bill in a window to prove some tenancy in the back +quarters; and, when we visited the Government bungalow, that Mr. Donat, +acting Vice-Resident, greeted us alone, and entertained us with cocoa-nut +punches in the Sessions Hall and seat of judgment of that widespread +archipelago, our glasses standing arrayed with summonses and census +returns. The unpopularity of a late Vice-Resident had begun the movement +of exodus, his native employés resigning court appointments and retiring +each to his own coco-patch in the remoter districts of the isle. Upon +the back of that, the Governor in Papeete issued a decree: All land in +the Paumotus must be defined and registered by a certain date. Now, the +folk of the archipelago are half nomadic; a man can scarce be said to +belong to a particular atoll; he belongs to several, perhaps holds a +stake and counts cousinship in half a score; and the inhabitants of +Rotoava in particular, man, woman, and child, and from the gendarme to +the Mormon prophet and the schoolmaster, owned—I was going to say +land—owned at least coral blocks and growing coco-palms in some adjacent +isle. Thither—from the gendarme to the babe in arms, the pastor followed +by his flock, the schoolmaster carrying along with him his scholars, and +the scholars with their books and slates—they had taken ship some two +days previous to our arrival, and were all now engaged disputing +boundaries. Fancy overhears the shrillness of their disputation mingle +with the surf and scatter sea-fowl. It was admirable to observe the +completeness of their flight, like that of hibernating birds; nothing +left but empty houses, like old nests to be reoccupied in spring; and +even the harmless necessary dominie borne with them in their +transmigration. Fifty odd set out, and only seven, I was informed, +remained. But when I made a feast on board the _Casco_, more than seven, +and nearer seven times seven, appeared to be my guests. Whence they +appeared, how they were summoned, whither they vanished when the feast +was eaten, I have no guess. In view of Low Island tales, and that awful +frequentation which makes men avoid the seaward beaches of an atoll, some +two score of those that ate with us may have returned, for the occasion, +from the kingdom of the dead. + +It was this solitude that put it in our minds to hire a house, and +become, for the time being, indwellers of the isle—a practice I have ever +since, when it was possible, adhered to. Mr. Donat placed us, with that +intent, under the convoy of one Taniera Mahinui, who combined the +incongruous characters of catechist and convict. The reader may smile, +but I affirm he was well qualified for either part. For that of convict, +first of all, by a good substantial felony, such as in all lands casts +the perpetrator in chains and dungeons. Taniera was a man of birth—the +chief a while ago, as he loved to tell, of a district in Anaa of 800 +souls. In an evil hour it occurred to the authorities in Papeete to +charge the chiefs with the collection of the taxes. It is a question if +much were collected; it is certain that nothing was handed on; and +Taniera, who had distinguished himself by a visit to Papeete and some +high living in restaurants, was chosen for the scapegoat. The reader +must understand that not Taniera but the authorities in Papeete were +first in fault. The charge imposed was disproportioned. I have not yet +heard of any Polynesian capable of such a burden; honest and upright +Hawaiians—one in particular, who was admired even by the whites as an +inflexible magistrate—have stumbled in the narrow path of the trustee. +And Taniera, when the pinch came, scorned to denounce accomplices; others +had shared the spoil, he bore the penalty alone. He was condemned in +five years. The period, when I had the pleasure of his friendship, was +not yet expired; he still drew prison rations, the sole and not unwelcome +reminder of his chains, and, I believe, looked forward to the date of his +enfranchisement with mere alarm. For he had no sense of shame in the +position; complained of nothing but the defective table of his place of +exile; regretted nothing but the fowls and eggs and fish of his own more +favoured island. And as for his parishioners, they did not think one +hair the less of him. A schoolboy, mulcted in ten thousand lines of +Greek and dwelling sequestered in the dormitories, enjoys unabated +consideration from his fellows. So with Taniera: a marked man, not a +dishonoured; having fallen under the lash of the unthinkable gods; a Job, +perhaps, or say a Taniera in the den of lions. Songs are likely made and +sung about this saintly Robin Hood. On the other hand, he was even +highly qualified for his office in the Church; being by nature a grave, +considerate, and kindly man; his face rugged and serious, his smile +bright; the master of several trades, a builder both of boats and houses; +endowed with a fine pulpit voice; endowed besides with such a gift of +eloquence that at the grave of the late chief of Fakarava he set all the +assistants weeping. I never met a man of a mind more ecclesiastical; he +loved to dispute and to inform himself of doctrine and the history of +sects; and when I showed him the cuts in a volume of Chambers’s +_Encyclopædia_—except for one of an ape—reserved his whole enthusiasm for +cardinals’ hats, censers, candlesticks, and cathedrals. Methought when +he looked upon the cardinal’s hat a voice said low in his ear: ‘Your foot +is on the ladder.’ + +Under the guidance of Taniera we were soon installed in what I believe to +have been the best-appointed private house in Fakarava. It stood just +beyond the church in an oblong patch of cultivation. More than three +hundred sacks of soil were imported from Tahiti for the Residency garden; +and this must shortly be renewed, for the earth blows away, sinks in +crevices of the coral, and is sought for at last in vain. I know not how +much earth had gone to the garden of my villa; some at least, for an +alley of prosperous bananas ran to the gate, and over the rest of the +enclosure, which was covered with the usual clinker-like fragments of +smashed coral, not only coco-palms and mikis but also fig-trees +flourished, all of a delicious greenness. Of course there was no blade +of grass. In front a picket fence divided us from the white road, the +palm-fringed margin of the lagoon, and the lagoon itself, reflecting +clouds by day and stars by night. At the back, a bulwark of uncemented +coral enclosed us from the narrow belt of bush and the nigh ocean beach +where the seas thundered, the roar and wash of them still humming in the +chambers of the house. + +This itself was of one story, verandahed front and back. It contained +three rooms, three sewing-machines, three sea-chests, chairs, tables, a +pair of beds, a cradle, a double-barrelled gun, a pair of enlarged +coloured photographs, a pair of coloured prints after Wilkie and +Mulready, and a French lithograph with the legend: ‘_Le brigade du +Général Lepasset brûlant son drapeau devant Metz_.’ Under the stilts of +the house a stove was rusting, till we drew it forth and put it in +commission. Not far off was the burrow in the coral whence we supplied +ourselves with brackish water. There was live stock, besides, on the +estate—cocks and hens and a brace of ill-regulated cats, whom Taniera +came every morning with the sun to feed on grated cocoa-nut. His voice +was our regular réveille, ringing pleasantly about the garden: +‘Pooty—pooty—poo—poo—poo!’ + +Far as we were from the public offices, the nearness of the chapel made +our situation what is called eligible in advertisements, and gave us a +side look on some native life. Every morning, as soon as he had fed the +fowls, Taniera set the bell agoing in the small belfry; and the faithful, +who were not very numerous, gathered to prayers. I was once present: it +was the Lord’s day, and seven females and eight males composed the +congregation. A woman played precentor, starting with a longish note; +the catechist joined in upon the second bar; and then the faithful in a +body. Some had printed hymn-books which they followed; some of the rest +filled up with ‘eh—eh—eh,’ the Paumotuan tol-de-rol. After the hymn, we +had an antiphonal prayer or two; and then Taniera rose from the front +bench, where he had been sitting in his catechist’s robes, passed within +the altar-rails, opened his Tahitian Bible, and began to preach from +notes. I understood one word—the name of God; but the preacher managed +his voice with taste, used rare and expressive gestures, and made a +strong impression of sincerity. The plain service, the vernacular Bible, +the hymn-tunes mostly on an English pattern—‘God save the Queen,’ I was +informed, a special favourite,—all, save some paper flowers upon the +altar, seemed not merely but austerely Protestant. It is thus the +Catholics have met their low island proselytes half-way. + +Taniera had the keys of our house; it was with him I made my bargain, if +that could be called a bargain in which all was remitted to my +generosity; it was he who fed the cats and poultry, he who came to call +and pick a meal with us like an acknowledged friend; and we long fondly +supposed he was our landlord. This belief was not to bear the test of +experience; and, as my chapter has to relate, no certainty succeeded it. + +We passed some days of airless quiet and great heat; shell-gatherers were +warned from the ocean beach, where sunstroke waited them from ten till +four; the highest palm hung motionless, there was no voice audible but +that of the sea on the far side. At last, about four of a certain +afternoon, long cat’s-paws flawed the face of the lagoon; and presently +in the tree-tops there awoke the grateful bustle of the trades, and all +the houses and alleys of the island were fanned out. To more than one +enchanted ship, that had lain long becalmed in view of the green shore, +the wind brought deliverance; and by daylight on the morrow a schooner +and two cutters lay moored in the port of Rotoava. Not only in the outer +sea, but in the lagoon itself, a certain traffic woke with the reviving +breeze; and among the rest one François, a half-blood, set sail with the +first light in his own half-decked cutter. He had held before a court +appointment; being, I believe, the Residency sweeper-out. Trouble +arising with the unpopular Vice-Resident, he had thrown his honours down, +and fled to the far parts of the atoll to plant cabbages—or at least +coco-palms. Thence he was now driven by such need as even a Cincinnatus +must acknowledge, and fared for the capital city, the seat of his late +functions, to exchange half a ton of copra for necessary flour. And +here, for a while, the story leaves to tell of his voyaging. + +It must tell, instead, of our house, where, toward seven at night, the +catechist came suddenly in with his pleased air of being welcome; armed +besides with a considerable bunch of keys. These he proceeded to try on +the sea-chests, drawing each in turn from its place against the wall. +Heads of strangers appeared in the doorway and volunteered suggestions. +All in vain. Either they were the wrong keys or the wrong boxes, or the +wrong man was trying them. For a little Taniera fumed and fretted; then +had recourse to the more summary method of the hatchet; one of the chests +was broken open, and an armful of clothing, male and female, baled out +and handed to the strangers on the verandah. + +These were François, his wife, and their child. About eight a.m., in the +midst of the lagoon, their cutter had capsized in jibbing. They got her +righted, and though she was still full of water put the child on board. +The mainsail had been carried away, but the jib still drew her sluggishly +along, and François and the woman swam astern and worked the rudder with +their hands. The cold was cruel; the fatigue, as time went on, became +excessive; and in that preserve of sharks, fear hunted them. Again and +again, François, the half-breed, would have desisted and gone down; but +the woman, whole blood of an amphibious race, still supported him with +cheerful words. I am reminded of a woman of Hawaii who swam with her +husband, I dare not say how many miles, in a high sea, and came ashore at +last with his dead body in her arms. It was about five in the evening, +after nine hours’ swimming, that François and his wife reached land at +Rotoava. The gallant fight was won, and instantly the more childish side +of native character appears. They had supped, and told and retold their +story, dripping as they came; the flesh of the woman, whom Mrs. Stevenson +helped to shift, was cold as stone; and François, having changed to a dry +cotton shirt and trousers, passed the remainder of the evening on my +floor and between open doorways, in a thorough draught. Yet François, +the son of a French father, speaks excellent French himself and seems +intelligent. + +It was our first idea that the catechist, true to his evangelical +vocation, was clothing the naked from his superfluity. Then it came out +that François was but dealing with his own. The clothes were his, so was +the chest, so was the house. François was in fact the landlord. Yet you +observe he had hung back on the verandah while Taniera tried his +’prentice hand upon the locks: and even now, when his true character +appeared, the only use he made of the estate was to leave the clothes of +his family drying on the fence. Taniera was still the friend of the +house, still fed the poultry, still came about us on his daily visits, +François, during the remainder of his stay, holding bashfully aloof. And +there was stranger matter. Since François had lost the whole load of his +cutter, the half ton of copra, an axe, bowls, knives, and clothes—since +he had in a manner to begin the world again, and his necessary flour was +not yet bought or paid for—I proposed to advance him what he needed on +the rent. To my enduring amazement he refused, and the reason he gave—if +that can be called a reason which but darkens counsel—was that Taniera +was his friend. His friend, you observe; not his creditor. I inquired +into that, and was assured that Taniera, an exile in a strange isle, +might possibly be in debt himself, but certainly was no man’s creditor. + +Very early one morning we were awakened by a bustling presence in the +yard, and found our camp had been surprised by a tall, lean old native +lady, dressed in what were obviously widow’s weeds. You could see at a +glance she was a notable woman, a housewife, sternly practical, alive +with energy, and with fine possibilities of temper. Indeed, there was +nothing native about her but the skin; and the type abounds, and is +everywhere respected, nearer home. It did us good to see her scour the +grounds, examining the plants and chickens; watering, feeding, trimming +them; taking angry, purpose-like possession. When she neared the house +our sympathy abated; when she came to the broken chest I wished I were +elsewhere. We had scarce a word in common; but her whole lean body spoke +for her with indignant eloquence. ‘My chest!’ it cried, with a stress on +the possessive. ‘My chest—broken open! This is a fine state of things!’ +I hastened to lay the blame where it belonged—on François and his +wife—and found I had made things worse instead of better. She repeated +the names at first with incredulity, then with despair. A while she +seemed stunned, next fell to disembowelling the box, piling the goods on +the floor, and visibly computing the extent of François’s ravages; and +presently after she was observed in high speech with Taniera, who seemed +to hang an ear like one reproved. + +Here, then, by all known marks, should be my land-lady at last; here was +every character of the proprietor fully developed. Should I not approach +her on the still depending question of my rent? I carried the point to +an adviser. ‘Nonsense!’ he cried. ‘That’s the old woman, the mother. +It doesn’t belong to her. I believe that’s the man the house belongs +to,’ and he pointed to one of the coloured photographs on the wall. On +this I gave up all desire of understanding; and when the time came for me +to leave, in the judgment-hall of the archipelago, and with the awful +countenance of the acting Governor, I duly paid my rent to Taniera. He +was satisfied, and so was I. But what had he to do with it? Mr. Donat, +acting magistrate and a man of kindred blood, could throw no light upon +the mystery; a plain private person, with a taste for letters, cannot be +expected to do more. + + + +CHAPTER IV—TRAITS AND SECTS IN THE PAUMOTUS + + +The most careless reader must have remarked a change of air since the +Marquesas. The house, crowded with effects, the bustling housewife +counting her possessions, the serious, indoctrinated island pastor, the +long fight for life in the lagoon: here are traits of a new world. I +read in a pamphlet (I will not give the author’s name) that the Marquesan +especially resembles the Paumotuan. I should take the two races, though +so near in neighbourhood, to be extremes of Polynesian diversity. The +Marquesan is certainly the most beautiful of human races, and one of the +tallest—the Paumotuan averaging a good inch shorter, and not even +handsome; the Marquesan open-handed, inert, insensible to religion, +childishly self-indulgent—the Paumotuan greedy, hardy, enterprising, a +religious disputant, and with a trace of the ascetic character. + +Yet a few years ago, and the people of the archipelago were crafty +savages. Their isles might be called sirens’ isles, not merely from the +attraction they exerted on the passing mariner, but from the perils that +awaited him on shore. Even to this day, in certain outlying islands, +danger lingers; and the civilized Paumotuan dreads to land and hesitates +to accost his backward brother. But, except in these, to-day the peril +is a memory. When our generation were yet in the cradle and playroom it +was still a living fact. Between 1830 and 1840, Hao, for instance, was a +place of the most dangerous approach, where ships were seized and crews +kidnapped. As late as 1856, the schooner _Sarah Ann_ sailed from Papeete +and was seen no more. She had women on board, and children, the +captain’s wife, a nursemaid, a baby, and the two young sons of a Captain +Steven on their way to the mainland for schooling. All were supposed to +have perished in a squall. A year later, the captain of the _Julia_, +coasting along the island variously called Bligh, Lagoon, and Tematangi +saw armed natives follow the course of his schooner, clad in +many-coloured stuffs. Suspicion was at once aroused; the mother of the +lost children was profuse of money; and one expedition having found the +place deserted, and returned content with firing a few shots, she raised +and herself accompanied another. None appeared to greet or to oppose +them; they roamed a while among abandoned huts and empty thickets; then +formed two parties and set forth to beat, from end to end, the pandanus +jungle of the island. One man remained alone by the landing-place—Teina, +a chief of Anaa, leader of the armed natives who made the strength of the +expedition. Now that his comrades were departed this way and that, on +their laborious exploration, the silence fell profound; and this silence +was the ruin of the islanders. A sound of stones rattling caught the ear +of Teina. He looked, thinking to perceive a crab, and saw instead the +brown hand of a human being issue from a fissure in the ground. A shout +recalled the search parties and announced their doom to the buried +caitiffs. In the cave below, sixteen were found crouching among human +bones and singular and horrid curiosities. One was a head of golden +hair, supposed to be a relic of the captain’s wife; another was half of +the body of a European child, sun-dried and stuck upon a stick, doubtless +with some design of wizardry. + +The Paumotuan is eager to be rich. He saves, grudges, buries money, +fears not work. For a dollar each, two natives passed the hours of +daylight cleaning our ship’s copper. It was strange to see them so +indefatigable and so much at ease in the water—working at times with +their pipes lighted, the smoker at times submerged and only the glowing +bowl above the surface; it was stranger still to think they were next +congeners to the incapable Marquesan. But the Paumotuan not only saves, +grudges, and works, he steals besides; or, to be more precise, he +swindles. He will never deny a debt, he only flees his creditor. He is +always keen for an advance; so soon as he has fingered it he disappears. +He knows your ship; so soon as it nears one island, he is off to another. +You may think you know his name; he has already changed it. Pursuit in +that infinity of isles were fruitless. The result can be given in a +nutshell. It has been actually proposed in a Government report to secure +debts by taking a photograph of the debtor; and the other day in Papeete +credits on the Paumotus to the amount of sixteen thousand pounds were +sold for less than forty—_quatre cent mille francs pour moins de mille +francs_. Even so, the purchase was thought hazardous; and only the man +who made it and who had special opportunities could have dared to give so +much. + +The Paumotuan is sincerely attached to those of his own blood and +household. A touching affection sometimes unites wife and husband. +Their children, while they are alive, completely rule them; after they +are dead, their bones or their mummies are often jealously preserved and +carried from atoll to atoll in the wanderings of the family. I was told +there were many houses in Fakarava with the mummy of a child locked in a +sea-chest; after I heard it, I would glance a little jealously at those +by my own bed; in that cupboard, also, it was possible there was a tiny +skeleton. + +The race seems in a fair way to survive. From fifteen islands, whose +rolls I had occasion to consult, I found a proportion of 59 births to 47 +deaths for 1887. Dropping three out of the fifteen, there remained for +the other twelve the comfortable ratio of 50 births to 32 deaths. Long +habits of hardship and activity doubtless explain the contrast with +Marquesan figures. But the Paumotuan displays, besides, a certain +concern for health and the rudiments of a sanitary discipline. Public +talk with these free-spoken people plays the part of the Contagious +Diseases Act; in-comers to fresh islands anxiously inquire if all be +well; and syphilis, when contracted, is successfully treated with +indigenous herbs. Like their neighbours of Tahiti, from whom they have +perhaps imbibed the error, they regard leprosy with comparative +indifference, elephantiasis with disproportionate fear. But, unlike +indeed to the Tahitian, their alarm puts on the guise of self-defence. +Any one stricken with this painful and ugly malady is confined to the +ends of villages, denied the use of paths and highways, and condemned to +transport himself between his house and coco-patch by water only, his +very footprint being held infectious. Fe’efe’e, being a creature of +marshes and the sequel of malarial fever, is not original in atolls. On +the single isle of Makatea, where the lagoon is now a marsh, the disease +has made a home. Many suffer; they are excluded (if Mr. Wilmot be right) +from much of the comfort of society; and it is believed they take a +secret vengeance. The defections of the sick are considered highly +poisonous. Early in the morning, it is narrated, aged and malicious +persons creep into the sleeping village, and stealthily make water at the +doors of the houses of young men. Thus they propagate disease; thus they +breathe on and obliterate comeliness and health, the objects of their +envy. Whether horrid fact or more abominable legend, it equally depicts +that something bitter and energetic which distinguishes Paumotuan man. + +The archipelago is divided between two main religions, Catholic and +Mormon. They front each other proudly with a false air of permanence; +yet are but shapes, their membership in a perpetual flux. The Mormon +attends mass with devotion: the Catholic sits attentive at a Mormon +sermon, and to-morrow each may have transferred allegiance. One man had +been a pillar of the Church of Rome for fifteen years; his wife dying, he +decided that must be a poor religion that could not save a man his wife, +and turned Mormon. According to one informant, Catholicism was the more +fashionable in health, but on the approach of sickness it was judged +prudent to secede. As a Mormon, there were five chances out of six you +might recover; as a Catholic, your hopes were small; and this opinion is +perhaps founded on the comfortable rite of unction. + +We all know what Catholics are, whether in the Paumotus or at home. But +the Paumotuan Mormon seemed a phenomenon apart. He marries but the one +wife, uses the Protestant Bible, observes Protestant forms of worship, +forbids the use of liquor and tobacco, practises adult baptism by +immersion, and after every public sin, rechristens the backslider. I +advised with Mahinui, whom I found well informed in the history of the +American Mormons, and he declared against the least connection. ‘_Pour +moi_,’ said he, with a fine charity, ‘_les Mormons ici un petit +Catholiques_.’ Some months later I had an opportunity to consult an +orthodox fellow-countryman, an old dissenting Highlander, long settled in +Tahiti, but still breathing of the heather of Tiree. ‘Why do they call +themselves Mormons?’ I asked. ‘My dear, and that is my question!’ he +exclaimed. ‘For by all that I can hear of their doctrine, I have nothing +to say against it, and their life, it is above reproach.’ And for all +that, Mormons they are, but of the earlier sowing: the so-called +Josephites, the followers of Joseph Smith, the opponents of Brigham +Young. + +Grant, then, the Mormons to be Mormons. Fresh points at once arise: What +are the Israelites? and what the Kanitus? For a long while back the sect +had been divided into Mormons proper and so-called Israelites, I never +could hear why. A few years since there came a visiting missionary of +the name of Williams, who made an excellent collection, and retired, +leaving fresh disruption imminent. Something irregular (as I was told) +in his way of ‘opening the service’ had raised partisans and enemies; the +church was once more rent asunder; and a new sect, the Kanitu, issued +from the division. Since then Kanitus and Israelites, like the +Cameronians and the United Presbyterians, have made common cause; and the +ecclesiastical history of the Paumotus is, for the moment, uneventful. +There will be more doing before long, and these isles bid fair to be the +Scotland of the South. Two things I could never learn. The nature of +the innovations of the Rev. Mr. Williams none would tell me, and of the +meaning of the name Kanitu none had a guess. It was not Tahitian, it was +not Marquesan; it formed no part of that ancient speech of the Paumotus, +now passing swiftly into obsolescence. One man, a priest, God bless him! +said it was the Latin for a little dog. I have found it since as the +name of a god in New Guinea; it must be a bolder man than I who should +hint at a connection. Here, then, is a singular thing: a brand-new sect, +arising by popular acclamation, and a nonsense word invented for its +name. + +The design of mystery seems obvious, and according to a very intelligent +observer, Mr. Magee of Mangareva, this element of the mysterious is a +chief attraction of the Mormon Church. It enjoys some of the status of +Freemasonry at home, and there is for the convert some of the +exhilaration of adventure. Other attractions are certainly conjoined. +Perpetual rebaptism, leading to a succession of baptismal feasts, is +found, both from the social and the spiritual side, a pleasing feature. +More important is the fact that all the faithful enjoy office; perhaps +more important still, the strictness of the discipline. ‘The veto on +liquor,’ said Mr. Magee, ‘brings them plenty members.’ There is no doubt +these islanders are fond of drink, and no doubt they refrain from the +indulgence; a bout on a feast-day, for instance, may be followed by a +week or a month of rigorous sobriety. Mr. Wilmot attributes this to +Paumotuan frugality and the love of hoarding; it goes far deeper. I have +mentioned that I made a feast on board the _Casco_. To wash down ship’s +bread and jam, each guest was given the choice of rum or syrup, and out +of the whole number only one man voted—in a defiant tone, and amid shouts +of mirth—for ‘Trum’! This was in public. I had the meanness to repeat +the experiment, whenever I had a chance, within the four walls of my +house; and three at least, who had refused at the festival, greedily +drank rum behind a door. But there were others thoroughly consistent. I +said the virtues of the race were bourgeois and puritan; and how +bourgeois is this! how puritanic! how Scottish! and how Yankee!—the +temptation, the resistance, the public hypocritical conformity, the +Pharisees, the Holy Willies, and the true disciples. With such a people +the popularity of an ascetic Church appears legitimate; in these strict +rules, in this perpetual supervision, the weak find their advantage, the +strong a certain pleasure; and the doctrine of rebaptism, a clean bill +and a fresh start, will comfort many staggering professors. + +There is yet another sect, or what is called a sect—no doubt +improperly—that of the Whistlers. Duncan Cameron, so clear in favour of +the Mormons, was no less loud in condemnation of the Whistlers. Yet I do +not know; I still fancy there is some connection, perhaps fortuitous, +probably disavowed. Here at least are some doings in the house of an +Israelite clergyman (or prophet) in the island of Anaa, of which I am +equally sure that Duncan would disclaim and the Whistlers hail them for +an imitation of their own. My informant, a Tahitian and a Catholic, +occupied one part of the house; the prophet and his family lived in the +other. Night after night the Mormons, in the one end, held their evening +sacrifice of song; night after night, in the other, the wife of the +Tahitian lay awake and listened to their singing with amazement. At +length she could contain herself no longer, woke her husband, and asked +him what he heard. ‘I hear several persons singing hymns,’ said he. +‘Yes,’ she returned, ‘but listen again! Do you not hear something +supernatural?’ His attention thus directed, he was aware of a strange +buzzing voice—and yet he declared it was beautiful—which justly +accompanied the singers. The next day he made inquiries. ‘It is a +spirit,’ said the prophet, with entire simplicity, ‘which has lately made +a practice of joining us at family worship.’ It did not appear the thing +was visible, and like other spirits raised nearer home in these +degenerate days, it was rudely ignorant, at first could only buzz, and +had only learned of late to bear a part correctly in the music. + +The performances of the Whistlers are more business-like. Their meetings +are held publicly with open doors, all being ‘cordially invited to +attend.’ The faithful sit about the room—according to one informant, +singing hymns; according to another, now singing and now whistling; the +leader, the wizard—let me rather say, the medium—sits in the midst, +enveloped in a sheet and silent; and presently, from just above his head, +or sometimes from the midst of the roof, an aerial whistling proceeds, +appalling to the inexperienced. This, it appears, is the language of the +dead; its purport is taken down progressively by one of the experts, +writing, I was told, ‘as fast as a telegraph operator’; and the +communications are at last made public. They are of the baldest +triviality; a schooner is, perhaps, announced, some idle gossip reported +of a neighbour, or if the spirit shall have been called to consultation +on a case of sickness, a remedy may be suggested. One of these, +immersion in scalding water, not long ago proved fatal to the patient. +The whole business is very dreary, very silly, and very European; it has +none of the picturesque qualities of similar conjurations in New Zealand; +it seems to possess no kernel of possible sense, like some that I shall +describe among the Gilbert islanders. Yet I was told that many hardy, +intelligent natives were inveterate Whistlers. ‘Like Mahinui?’ I asked, +willing to have a standard; and I was told ‘Yes.’ Why should I wonder? +Men more enlightened than my convict-catechist sit down at home to +follies equally sterile and dull. + +The medium is sometimes female. It was a woman, for instance, who +introduced these practices on the north coast of Taiarapu, to the scandal +of her own connections, her brother-in-law in particular declaring she +was drunk. But what shocked Tahiti might seem fit enough in the +Paumotus, the more so as certain women there possess, by the gift of +nature, singular and useful powers. They say they are honest, +well-intentioned ladies, some of them embarrassed by their weird +inheritance. And indeed the trouble caused by this endowment is so +great, and the protection afforded so infinitesimally small, that I +hesitate whether to call it a gift or a hereditary curse. You may rob +this lady’s coco-patch, steal her canoes, burn down her house, and slay +her family scatheless; but one thing you must not do: you must not lay a +hand upon her sleeping-mat, or your belly will swell, and you can only be +cured by the lady or her husband. Here is the report of an eye-witness, +Tasmanian born, educated, a man who has made money—certainly no fool. In +1886 he was present in a house on Makatea, where two lads began to +skylark on the mats, and were (I think) ejected. Instantly after, their +bellies began to swell; pains took hold on them; all manner of island +remedies were exhibited in vain, and rubbing only magnified their +sufferings. The man of the house was called, explained the nature of the +visitation, and prepared the cure. A cocoa-nut was husked, filled with +herbs, and with all the ceremonies of a launch, and the utterance of +spells in the Paumotuan language, committed to the sea. From that moment +the pains began to grow more easy and the swelling to subside. The +reader may stare. I can assure him, if he moved much among old residents +of the archipelago, he would be driven to admit one thing of two—either +that there is something in the swollen bellies or nothing in the evidence +of man. + +I have not met these gifted ladies; but I had an experience of my own, +for I have played, for one night only, the part of the whistling spirit. +It had been blowing wearily all day, but with the fall of night the wind +abated, and the moon, which was then full, rolled in a clear sky. We +went southward down the island on the side of the lagoon, walking through +long-drawn forest aisles of palm, and on a floor of snowy sand. No life +was abroad, nor sound of life; till in a clear part of the isle we spied +the embers of a fire, and not far off, in a dark house, heard natives +talking softly. To sit without a light, even in company, and under +cover, is for a Paumotuan a somewhat hazardous extreme. The whole +scene—the strong moonlight and crude shadows on the sand, the scattered +coals, the sound of the low voices from the house, and the lap of the +lagoon along the beach—put me (I know not how) on thoughts of +superstition. I was barefoot, I observed my steps were noiseless, and +drawing near to the dark house, but keeping well in shadow, began to +whistle. ‘The Heaving of the Lead’ was my air—no very tragic piece. +With the first note the conversation and all movement ceased; silence +accompanied me while I continued; and when I passed that way on my return +I found the lamp was lighted in the house, but the tongues were still +mute. All night, as I now think, the wretches shivered and were silent. +For indeed, I had no guess at the time at the nature and magnitude of the +terrors I inflicted, or with what grisly images the notes of that old +song had peopled the dark house. + + + +CHAPTER V—A PAUMOTUAN FUNERAL + + +No, I had no guess of these men’s terrors. Yet I had received ere that a +hint, if I had understood; and the occasion was a funeral. + +A little apart in the main avenue of Rotoava, in a low hut of leaves that +opened on a small enclosure, like a pigsty on a pen, an old man dwelt +solitary with his aged wife. Perhaps they were too old to migrate with +the others; perhaps they were too poor, and had no possessions to +dispute. At least they had remained behind; and it thus befell that they +were invited to my feast. I dare say it was quite a piece of politics in +the pigsty whether to come or not to come, and the husband long swithered +between curiosity and age, till curiosity conquered, and they came, and +in the midst of that last merrymaking death tapped him on the shoulder. +For some days, when the sky was bright and the wind cool, his mat would +be spread in the main highway of the village, and he was to be seen lying +there inert, a mere handful of a man, his wife inertly seated by his +head. They seemed to have outgrown alike our needs and faculties; they +neither spoke nor listened; they suffered us to pass without a glance; +the wife did not fan, she seemed not to attend upon her husband, and the +two poor antiques sat juxtaposed under the high canopy of palms, the +human tragedy reduced to its bare elements, a sight beyond pathos, +stirring a thrill of curiosity. And yet there was one touch of the +pathetic haunted me: that so much youth and expectation should have run +in these starved veins, and the man should have squandered all his lees +of life on a pleasure party. + +On the morning of 17th September the sufferer died, and, time pressing, +he was buried the same day at four. The cemetery lies to seaward behind +Government House; broken coral, like so much road-metal, forms the +surface; a few wooden crosses, a few inconsiderable upright stones, +designate graves; a mortared wall, high enough to lean on, rings it +about; a clustering shrub surrounds it with pale leaves. Here was the +grave dug that morning, doubtless by uneasy diggers, to the sound of the +nigh sea and the cries of sea-birds; meanwhile the dead man waited in his +house, and the widow and another aged woman leaned on the fence before +the door, no speech upon their lips, no speculation in their eyes. + +Sharp at the hour the procession was in march, the coffin wrapped in +white and carried by four bearers; mourners behind—not many, for not many +remained in Rotoava, and not many in black, for these were poor; the men +in straw hats, white coats, and blue trousers or the gorgeous +parti-coloured pariu, the Tahitian kilt; the women, with a few +exceptions, brightly habited. Far in the rear came the widow, painfully +carrying the dead man’s mat; a creature aged beyond humanity, to the +likeness of some missing link. + +The dead man had been a Mormon; but the Mormon clergyman was gone with +the rest to wrangle over boundaries in the adjacent isle, and a layman +took his office. Standing at the head of the open grave, in a white coat +and blue pariu, his Tahitian Bible in his hand and one eye bound with a +red handkerchief, he read solemnly that chapter in Job which has been +read and heard over the bones of so many of our fathers, and with a good +voice offered up two prayers. The wind and the surf bore a burthen. By +the cemetery gate a mother in crimson suckled an infant rolled in blue. +In the midst the widow sat upon the ground and polished one of the +coffin-stretchers with a piece of coral; a little later she had turned +her back to the grave and was playing with a leaf. Did she understand? +God knows. The officiant paused a moment, stooped, and gathered and +threw reverently on the coffin a handful of rattling coral. Dust to +dust: but the grains of this dust were gross like cherries, and the true +dust that was to follow sat near by, still cohering (as by a miracle) in +the tragic semblance of a female ape. + +So far, Mormon or not, it was a Christian funeral. The well-known +passage had been read from Job, the prayers had been rehearsed, the grave +was filled, the mourners straggled homeward. With a little coarser grain +of covering earth, a little nearer outcry of the sea, a stronger glare of +sunlight on the rude enclosure, and some incongruous colours of attire, +the well-remembered form had been observed. + +By rights it should have been otherwise. The mat should have been buried +with its owner; but, the family being poor, it was thriftily reserved for +a fresh service. The widow should have flung herself upon the grave and +raised the voice of official grief, the neighbours have chimed in, and +the narrow isle rung for a space with lamentation. But the widow was +old; perhaps she had forgotten, perhaps never understood, and she played +like a child with leaves and coffin-stretchers. In all ways my guest was +buried with maimed rites. Strange to think that his last conscious +pleasure was the _Casco_ and my feast; strange to think that he had +limped there, an old child, looking for some new good. And the good +thing, rest, had been allotted him. + +But though the widow had neglected much, there was one part she must not +utterly neglect. She came away with the dispersing funeral; but the dead +man’s mat was left behind upon the grave, and I learned that by set of +sun she must return to sleep there. This vigil is imperative. From +sundown till the rising of the morning star the Paumotuan must hold his +watch above the ashes of his kindred. Many friends, if the dead have +been a man of mark, will keep the watchers company; they will be well +supplied with coverings against the weather; I believe they bring food, +and the rite is persevered in for two weeks. Our poor survivor, if, +indeed, she properly survived, had little to cover, and few to sit with +her; on the night of the funeral a strong squall chased her from her +place of watch; for days the weather held uncertain and outrageous; and +ere seven nights were up she had desisted, and returned to sleep in her +low roof. That she should be at the pains of returning for so short a +visit to a solitary house, that this borderer of the grave should fear a +little wind and a wet blanket, filled me at the time with musings. I +could not say she was indifferent; she was so far beyond me in experience +that the court of my criticism waived jurisdiction; but I forged excuses, +telling myself she had perhaps little to lament, perhaps suffered much, +perhaps understood nothing. And lo! in the whole affair there was no +question whether of tenderness or piety, and the sturdy return of this +old remnant was a mark either of uncommon sense or of uncommon fortitude. + +Yet one thing had occurred that partly set me on the trail. I have said +the funeral passed much as at home. But when all was over, when we were +trooping in decent silence from the graveyard gate and down the path to +the settlement, a sudden inbreak of a different spirit startled and +perhaps dismayed us. Two people walked not far apart in our procession: +my friend Mr. Donat—Donat-Rimarau: ‘Donat the much-handed’—acting +Vice-Resident, present ruler of the archipelago, by far the man of chief +importance on the scene, but known besides for one of an unshakable good +temper; and a certain comely, strapping young Paumotuan woman, the +comeliest on the isle, not (let us hope) the bravest or the most polite. +Of a sudden, ere yet the grave silence of the funeral was broken, she +made a leap at the Resident, with pointed finger, shrieked a few words, +and fell back again with a laughter, not a natural mirth. ‘What did she +say to you?’ I asked. ‘She did not speak to _me_,’ said Donat, a shade +perturbed; ‘she spoke to the ghost of the dead man.’ And the purport of +her speech was this: ‘See there! Donat will be a fine feast for you +to-night.’ + +‘M. Donat called it a jest,’ I wrote at the time in my diary. ‘It seemed +to me more in the nature of a terrified conjuration, as though she would +divert the ghost’s attention from herself. A cannibal race may well have +cannibal phantoms.’ The guesses of the traveller appear foredoomed to be +erroneous; yet in these I was precisely right. The woman had stood by in +terror at the funeral, being then in a dread spot, the graveyard. She +looked on in terror to the coming night, with that ogre, a new spirit, +loosed upon the isle. And the words she had cried in Donat’s face were +indeed a terrified conjuration, basely to shield herself, basely to +dedicate another in her stead. One thing is to be said in her excuse. +Doubtless she partly chose Donat because he was a man of great +good-nature, but partly, too, because he was a man of the half-caste. +For I believe all natives regard white blood as a kind of talisman +against the powers of hell. In no other way can they explain the +unpunished recklessness of Europeans. + + + +CHAPTER VI—GRAVEYARD STORIES + + +With my superstitious friend, the islander, I fear I am not wholly frank, +often leading the way with stories of my own, and being always a grave +and sometimes an excited hearer. But the deceit is scarce mortal, since +I am as pleased to hear as he to tell, as pleased with the story as he +with the belief; and, besides, it is entirely needful. For it is scarce +possible to exaggerate the extent and empire of his superstitions; they +mould his life, they colour his thinking; and when he does not speak to +me of ghosts, and gods, and devils, he is playing the dissembler and +talking only with his lips. With thoughts so different, one must indulge +the other; and I would rather that I should indulge his superstition than +he my incredulity. Of one thing, besides, I may be sure: Let me indulge +it as I please, I shall not hear the whole; for he is already on his +guard with me, and the amount of the lore is boundless. + +I will give but a few instances at random, chiefly from my own doorstep +in Upolu, during the past month (October 1890). One of my workmen was +sent the other day to the banana patch, there to dig; this is a hollow of +the mountain, buried in woods, out of all sight and cry of mankind; and +long before dusk Lafaele was back again beside the cook-house with +embarrassed looks; he dared not longer stay alone, he was afraid of +‘spirits in the bush.’ It seems these are the souls of the unburied +dead, haunting where they fell, and wearing woodland shapes of pig, or +bird, or insect; the bush is full of them, they seem to eat nothing, slay +solitary wanderers apparently in spite, and at times, in human form, go +down to villages and consort with the inhabitants undetected. So much I +learned a day or so after, walking in the bush with a very intelligent +youth, a native. It was a little before noon; a grey day and squally; +and perhaps I had spoken lightly. A dark squall burst on the side of the +mountain; the woods shook and cried; the dead leaves rose from the ground +in clouds, like butterflies; and my companion came suddenly to a full +stop. He was afraid, he said, of the trees falling; but as soon as I had +changed the subject of our talk he proceeded with alacrity. A day or two +before a messenger came up the mountain from Apia with a letter; I was in +the bush, he must await my return, then wait till I had answered: and +before I was done his voice sounded shrill with terror of the coming +night and the long forest road. These are the commons. Take the chiefs. +There has been a great coming and going of signs and omens in our group. +One river ran down blood; red eels were captured in another; an unknown +fish was thrown upon the coast, an ominous word found written on its +scales. So far we might be reading in a monkish chronicle; now we come +on a fresh note, at once modern and Polynesian. The gods of Upolu and +Savaii, our two chief islands, contended recently at cricket. Since then +they are at war. Sounds of battle are heard to roll along the coast. A +woman saw a man swim from the high seas and plunge direct into the bush; +he was no man of that neighbourhood; and it was known he was one of the +gods, speeding to a council. Most perspicuous of all, a missionary on +Savaii, who is also a medical man, was disturbed late in the night by +knocking; it was no hour for the dispensary, but at length he woke his +servant and sent him to inquire; the servant, looking from a window, +beheld crowds of persons, all with grievous wounds, lopped limbs, broken +heads, and bleeding bullet-holes; but when the door was opened all had +disappeared. They were gods from the field of battle. Now these reports +have certainly significance; it is not hard to trace them to political +grumblers or to read in them a threat of coming trouble; from that merely +human side I found them ominous myself. But it was the spiritual side of +their significance that was discussed in secret council by my rulers. I +shall best depict this mingled habit of the Polynesian mind by two +connected instances. I once lived in a village, the name of which I do +not mean to tell. The chief and his sister were persons perfectly +intelligent: gentlefolk, apt of speech. The sister was very religious, a +great church-goer, one that used to reprove me if I stayed away; I found +afterwards that she privately worshipped a shark. The chief himself was +somewhat of a freethinker; at the least, a latitudinarian: he was a man, +besides, filled with European knowledge and accomplishments; of an +impassive, ironical habit; and I should as soon have expected +superstition in Mr. Herbert Spencer. Hear the sequel. I had discovered +by unmistakable signs that they buried too shallow in the village +graveyard, and I took my friend, as the responsible authority, to task. +‘There is something wrong about your graveyard,’ said I, ‘which you must +attend to, or it may have very bad results.’ ‘Something wrong? What is +it?’ he asked, with an emotion that surprised me. ‘If you care to go +along there any evening about nine o’clock you can see for yourself,’ +said I. He stepped backward. ‘A ghost!’ he cried. + +In short, in the whole field of the South Seas, there is not one to blame +another. Half blood and whole, pious and debauched, intelligent and +dull, all men believe in ghosts, all men combine with their recent +Christianity fear of and a lingering faith in the old island deities. +So, in Europe, the gods of Olympus slowly dwindled into village bogies; +so to-day, the theological Highlander sneaks from under the eye of the +Free Church divine to lay an offering by a sacred well. + +I try to deal with the whole matter here because of a particular quality +in Paumotuan superstitions. It is true I heard them told by a man with a +genius for such narrations. Close about our evening lamp, within sound +of the island surf, we hung on his words, thrilling. The reader, in far +other scenes, must listen close for the faint echo. + +This bundle of weird stories sprang from the burial and the woman’s +selfish conjuration. I was dissatisfied with what I heard, harped upon +questions, and struck at last this vein of metal. It is from sundown to +about four in the morning that the kinsfolk camp upon the grave; and +these are the hours of the spirits’ wanderings. At any time of the +night—it may be earlier, it may be later—a sound is to be heard below, +which is the noise of his liberation; at four sharp, another and a louder +marks the instant of the re-imprisonment; between-whiles, he goes his +malignant rounds. ‘Did you ever see an evil spirit?’ was once asked of a +Paumotuan. ‘Once.’ ‘Under what form?’ ‘It was in the form of a crane.’ +‘And how did you know that crane to be a spirit?’ was asked. ‘I will +tell you,’ he answered; and this was the purport of his inconclusive +narrative. His father had been dead nearly a fortnight; others had +wearied of the watch; and as the sun was setting, he found himself by the +grave alone. It was not yet dark, rather the hour of the afterglow, when +he was aware of a snow-white crane upon the coral mound; presently more +cranes came, some white, some black; then the cranes vanished, and he saw +in their place a white cat, to which there was silently joined a great +company of cats of every hue conceivable; then these also disappeared, +and he was left astonished. + +This was an anodyne appearance. Take instead the experience of +Rua-a-mariterangi on the isle of Katiu. He had a need for some pandanus, +and crossed the isle to the sea-beach, where it chiefly flourishes. The +day was still, and Rua was surprised to hear a crashing sound among the +thickets, and then the fall of a considerable tree. Here must be some +one building a canoe; and he entered the margin of the wood to find and +pass the time of day with this chance neighbour. The crashing sounded +more at hand; and then he was aware of something drawing swiftly near +among the tree-tops. It swung by its heels downward, like an ape, so +that its hands were free for murder; it depended safely by the slightest +twigs; the speed of its coming was incredible; and soon Rua recognised it +for a corpse, horrible with age, its bowels hanging as it came. Prayer +was the weapon of Christian in the Valley of the Shadow, and it is to +prayer that Rua-a-mariterangi attributes his escape. No merely human +expedition had availed. + +This demon was plainly from the grave; yet you will observe he was abroad +by day. And inconsistent as it may seem with the hours of the night +watch and the many references to the rising of the morning star, it is no +singular exception. I could never find a case of another who had seen +this ghost, diurnal and arboreal in its habits; but others have heard the +fall of the tree, which seems the signal of its coming. Mr. Donat was +once pearling on the uninhabited isle of Haraiki. It was a day without a +breath of wind, such as alternate in the archipelago with days of +contumelious breezes. The divers were in the midst of the lagoon upon +their employment; the cook, a boy of ten, was over his pots in the camp. +Thus were all souls accounted for except a single native who accompanied +Donat into the wood in quest of sea-fowls’ eggs. In a moment, out of the +stillness, came the sound of the fall of a great tree. Donat would have +passed on to find the cause. ‘No,’ cried his companion, ‘that was no +tree. It was something _not right_. Let us go back to camp.’ Next +Sunday the divers were turned on, all that part of the isle was +thoroughly examined, and sure enough no tree had fallen. A little later +Mr. Donat saw one of his divers flee from a similar sound, in similar +unaffected panic, on the same isle. But neither would explain, and it +was not till afterwards, when he met with Rua, that he learned the +occasion of their terrors. + +But whether by day or night, the purpose of the dead in these abhorred +activities is still the same. In Samoa, my informant had no idea of the +food of the bush spirits; no such ambiguity would exist in the mind of a +Paumotuan. In that hungry archipelago, living and dead must alike toil +for nutriment; and the race having been cannibal in the past, the spirits +are so still. When the living ate the dead, horrified nocturnal +imagination drew the shocking inference that the dead might eat the +living. Doubtless they slay men, doubtless even mutilate them, in mere +malice. Marquesan spirits sometimes tear out the eyes of travellers; but +even that may be more practical than appears, for the eye is a cannibal +dainty. And certainly the root-idea of the dead, at least in the far +eastern islands, is to prowl for food. It was as a dainty morsel for a +meal that the woman denounced Donat at the funeral. There are spirits +besides who prey in particular not on the bodies but on the souls of the +dead. The point is clearly made in a Tahitian story. A child fell sick, +grew swiftly worse, and at last showed signs of death. The mother +hastened to the house of a sorcerer, who lived hard by. ‘You are yet in +time,’ said he; ‘a spirit has just run past my door carrying the soul of +your child wrapped in the leaf of a purao; but I have a spirit stronger +and swifter who will run him down ere he has time to eat it.’ Wrapped in +a leaf: like other things edible and corruptible. + +Or take an experience of Mr. Donat’s on the island of Anaa. It was a +night of a high wind, with violent squalls; his child was very sick, and +the father, though he had gone to bed, lay wakeful, hearkening to the +gale. All at once a fowl was violently dashed on the house wall. +Supposing he had forgot to put it in shelter with the rest, Donat arose, +found the bird (a cock) lying on the verandah, and put it in the +hen-house, the door of which he securely fastened. Fifteen minutes later +the business was repeated, only this time, as it was being dashed against +the wall, the bird crew. Again Donat replaced it, examining the +hen-house thoroughly and finding it quite perfect; as he was so engaged +the wind puffed out his light, and he must grope back to the door a good +deal shaken. Yet a third time the bird was dashed upon the wall; a third +time Donat set it, now near dead, beside its mates; and he was scarce +returned before there came a rush, like that of a furious strong man, +against the door, and a whistle as loud as that of a railway engine rang +about the house. The sceptical reader may here detect the finger of the +tempest; but the women gave up all for lost and clustered on the beds +lamenting. Nothing followed, and I must suppose the gale somewhat +abated, for presently after a chief came visiting. He was a bold man to +be abroad so late, but doubtless carried a bright lantern. And he was +certainly a man of counsel, for as soon as he heard the details of these +disturbances he was in a position to explain their nature. ‘Your child,’ +said he, ‘must certainly die. This is the evil spirit of our island who +lies in wait to eat the spirits of the newly dead.’ And then he went on +to expatiate on the strangeness of the spirit’s conduct. He was not +usually, he explained, so open of assault, but sat silent on the +house-top waiting, in the guise of a bird, while within the people tended +the dying and bewailed the dead, and had no thought of peril. But when +the day came and the doors were opened, and men began to go abroad, +blood-stains on the wall betrayed the tragedy. + +This is the quality I admire in Paumotuan legend. In Tahiti the +spirit-eater is said to assume a vesture which has much more of pomp, but +how much less of horror. It has been seen by all sorts and conditions, +native and foreign; only the last insist it is a meteor. My authority +was not so sure. He was riding with his wife about two in the morning; +both were near asleep, and the horses not much better. It was a +brilliant and still night, and the road wound over a mountain, near by a +deserted marae (old Tahitian temple). All at once the appearance passed +above them: a form of light; the head round and greenish; the body long, +red, and with a focus of yet redder brilliancy about the midst. A +buzzing hoot accompanied its passage; it flew direct out of one marae, +and direct for another down the mountain side. And this, as my informant +argued, is suggestive. For why should a mere meteor frequent the altars +of abominable gods? The horses, I should say, were equally dismayed with +their riders. Now I am not dismayed at all—not even agreeably. Give me +rather the bird upon the house-top and the morning blood-gouts on the +wall. + +But the dead are not exclusive in their diet. They carry with them to +the grave, in particular, the Polynesian taste for fish, and enter at +times with the living into a partnership in fishery. Rua-a-mariterangi +is again my authority; I feel it diminishes the credit of the fact, but +how it builds up the image of this inveterate ghost-seer! He belongs to +the miserably poor island of Taenga, yet his father’s house was always +well supplied. As Rua grew up he was called at last to go a-fishing with +this fortunate parent. They rowed the lagoon at dusk, to an unlikely +place, and the lay down in the stern, and the father began vainly to cast +his line over the bows. It is to be supposed that Rua slept; and when he +awoke there was the figure of another beside his father, and his father +was pulling in the fish hand over hand. ‘Who is that man, father?’ Rua +asked. ‘It is none of your business,’ said the father; and Rua supposed +the stranger had swum off to them from shore. Night after night they +fared into the lagoon, often to the most unlikely places; night after +night the stranger would suddenly be seen on board, and as suddenly be +missed; and morning after morning the canoe returned laden with fish. +‘My father is a very lucky man,’ thought Rua. At last, one fine day, +there came first one boat party and then another, who must be +entertained; father and son put off later than usual into the lagoon; and +before the canoe was landed it was four o’clock, and the morning star was +close on the horizon. Then the stranger appeared seized with some +distress; turned about, showing for the first time his face, which was +that of one long dead, with shining eyes; stared into the east, set the +tips of his fingers to his mouth like one a-cold, uttered a strange, +shuddering sound between a whistle and a moan—a thing to freeze the +blood; and, the day-star just rising from the sea, he suddenly was not. +Then Rua understood why his father prospered, why his fishes rotted early +in the day, and why some were always carried to the cemetery and laid +upon the graves. My informant is a man not certainly averse to +superstition, but he keeps his head, and takes a certain superior +interest, which I may be allowed to call scientific. The last point +reminding him of some parallel practice in Tahiti, he asked Rua if the +fish were left, or carried home again after a formal dedication. It +appears old Mariterangi practised both methods; sometimes treating his +shadowy partner to a mere oblation, sometimes honestly leaving his fish +to rot upon the grave. + +It is plain we have in Europe stories of a similar complexion; and the +Polynesian _varua ino_ or _aitu o le vao_ is clearly the near kinsman of +the Transylvanian vampire. Here is a tale in which the kinship appears +broadly marked. On the atoll of Penrhyn, then still partly savage, a +certain chief was long the salutary terror of the natives. He died, he +was buried; and his late neighbours had scarce tasted the delights of +licence ere his ghost appeared about the village. Fear seized upon all; +a council was held of the chief men and sorcerers; and with the approval +of the Rarotongan missionary, who was as frightened as the rest, and in +the presence of several whites—my friend Mr. Ben Hird being one—the grave +was opened, deepened until water came, and the body re-interred face +down. The still recent staking of suicides in England and the +decapitation of vampires in the east of Europe form close parallels. + +So in Samoa only the spirits of the unburied awake fear. During the late +war many fell in the bush; their bodies, sometimes headless, were brought +back by native pastors and interred; but this (I know not why) was +insufficient, and the spirit still lingered on the theatre of death. +When peace returned a singular scene was enacted in many places, and +chiefly round the high gorges of Lotoanuu, where the struggle was long +centred and the loss had been severe. Kinswomen of the dead came +carrying a mat or sheet and guided by survivors of the fight. The place +of death was earnestly sought out; the sheet was spread upon the ground; +and the women, moved with pious anxiety, sat about and watched it. If +any living thing alighted it was twice brushed away; upon the third +coming it was known to be the spirit of the dead, was folded in, carried +home and buried beside the body; and the aitu rested. The rite was +practised beyond doubt in simple piety; the repose of the soul was its +object: its motive, reverent affection. The present king disowns indeed +all knowledge of a dangerous aitu; he declares the souls of the unburied +were only wanderers in limbo, lacking an entrance to the proper country +of the dead, unhappy, nowise hurtful. And this severely classic opinion +doubtless represents the views of the enlightened. But the flight of my +Lafaele marks the grosser terrors of the ignorant. + +This belief in the exorcising efficacy of funeral rites perhaps explains +a fact, otherwise amazing, that no Polynesian seems at all to share our +European horror of human bones and mummies. Of the first they made their +cherished ornaments; they preserved them in houses or in mortuary caves; +and the watchers of royal sepulchres dwelt with their children among the +bones of generations. The mummy, even in the making, was as little +feared. In the Marquesas, on the extreme coast, it was made by the +household with continual unction and exposure to the sun; in the +Carolines, upon the farthest west, it is still cured in the smoke of the +family hearth. Head-hunting, besides, still lives around my doorstep in +Samoa. And not ten years ago, in the Gilberts, the widow must disinter, +cleanse, polish, and thenceforth carry about her, by day and night, the +head of her dead husband. In all these cases we may suppose the process, +whether of cleansing or drying, to have fully exorcised the aitu. + +But the Paumotuan belief is more obscure. Here the man is duly buried, +and he has to be watched. He is duly watched, and the spirit goes abroad +in spite of watches. Indeed, it is not the purpose of the vigils to +prevent these wanderings; only to mollify by polite attention the +inveterate malignity of the dead. Neglect (it is supposed) may irritate +and thus invite his visits, and the aged and weakly sometimes balance +risks and stay at home. Observe, it is the dead man’s kindred and next +friends who thus deprecate his fury with nocturnal watchings. Even the +placatory vigil is held perilous, except in company, and a boy was +pointed out to me in Rotoava, because he had watched alone by his own +father. Not the ties of the dead, nor yet their proved character, affect +the issue. A late Resident, who died in Fakarava of sunstroke, was +beloved in life and is still remembered with affection; none the less his +spirit went about the island clothed with terrors, and the neighbourhood +of Government House was still avoided after dark. We may sum up the +cheerful doctrine thus: All men become vampires, and the vampire spares +none. And here we come face to face with a tempting inconsistency. For +the whistling spirits are notoriously clannish; I understood them to wait +upon and to enlighten kinsfolk only, and that the medium was always of +the race of the communicating spirit. Here, then, we have the bonds of +the family, on the one hand, severed at the hour of death; on the other, +helpfully persisting. + +The child’s soul in the Tahitian tale was wrapped in leaves. It is the +spirits of the newly dead that are the dainty. When they are slain, the +house is stained with blood. Rua’s dead fisherman was decomposed; so—and +horribly—was his arboreal demon. The spirit, then, is a thing material; +and it is by the material ensigns of corruption that he is distinguished +from the living man. This opinion is widespread, adds a gross terror to +the more ugly Polynesian tales, and sometimes defaces the more engaging +with a painful and incongruous touch. I will give two examples +sufficiently wide apart, one from Tahiti, one from Samoa. + +And first from Tahiti. A man went to visit the husband of his sister, +then some time dead. In her life the sister had been dainty in the +island fashion, and went always adorned with a coronet of flowers. In +the midst of the night the brother awoke and was aware of a heavenly +fragrance going to and fro in the dark house. The lamp I must suppose to +have burned out; no Tahitian would have lain down without one lighted. A +while he lay wondering and delighted; then called upon the rest. ‘Do +none of you smell flowers?’ he asked. ‘O,’ said his brother-in-law, ‘we +are used to that here.’ The next morning these two men went walking, and +the widower confessed that his dead wife came about the house +continually, and that he had even seen her. She was shaped and dressed +and crowned with flowers as in her lifetime; only she moved a few inches +above the earth with a very easy progress, and flitted dryshod above the +surface of the river. And now comes my point: It was always in a back +view that she appeared; and these brothers-in-law, debating the affair, +agreed that this was to conceal the inroads of corruption. + +Now for the Samoan story. I owe it to the kindness of Dr. F. Otto +Sierich, whose collection of folk-tales I expect with a high degree of +interest. A man in Manu’a was married to two wives and had no issue. He +went to Savaii, married there a third, and was more fortunate. When his +wife was near her time he remembered he was in a strange island, like a +poor man; and when his child was born he must be shamed for lack of +gifts. It was in vain his wife dissuaded him. He returned to his father +in Manu’a seeking help; and with what he could get he set off in the +night to re-embark. Now his wives heard of his coming; they were +incensed that he did not stay to visit them; and on the beach, by his +canoe, intercepted and slew him. Now the third wife lay asleep in +Savaii;—her babe was born and slept by her side; and she was awakened by +the spirit of her husband. ‘Get up,’ he said, ‘my father is sick in +Manu’a and we must go to visit him.’ ‘It is well,’ said she; ‘take you +the child, while I carry its mats.’ ‘I cannot carry the child,’ said the +spirit; ‘I am too cold from the sea.’ When they were got on board the +canoe the wife smelt carrion. ‘How is this?’ she said. ‘What have you +in the canoe that I should smell carrion?’ ‘It is nothing in the canoe,’ +said the spirit. ‘It is the land-wind blowing down the mountains, where +some beast lies dead.’ It appears it was still night when they reached +Manu’a—the swiftest passage on record—and as they entered the reef the +bale-fires burned in the village. Again she asked him to carry the +child; but now he need no more dissemble. ‘I cannot carry your child,’ +said he, ‘for I am dead, and the fires you see are burning for my +funeral.’ + +The curious may learn in Dr. Sierich’s book the unexpected sequel of the +tale. Here is enough for my purpose. Though the man was but new dead, +the ghost was already putrefied, as though putrefaction were the mark and +of the essence of a spirit. The vigil on the Paumotuan grave does not +extend beyond two weeks, and they told me this period was thought to +coincide with that of the resolution of the body. The ghost always +marked with decay—the danger seemingly ending with the process of +dissolution—here is tempting matter for the theorist. But it will not +do. The lady of the flowers had been long dead, and her spirit was still +supposed to bear the brand of perishability. The Resident had been more +than a fortnight buried, and his vampire was still supposed to go the +rounds. + +Of the lost state of the dead, from the lurid Mangaian legend, in which +infernal deities hocus and destroy the souls of all, to the various +submarine and aerial limbos where the dead feast, float idle, or resume +the occupations of their life on earth, it would be wearisome to tell. +One story I give, for it is singular in itself, is well-known in Tahiti, +and has this of interest, that it is post-Christian, dating indeed from +but a few years back. A princess of the reigning house died; was +transported to the neighbouring isle of Raiatea; fell there under the +empire of a spirit who condemned her to climb coco-palms all day and +bring him the nuts; was found after some time in this miserable servitude +by a second spirit, one of her own house; and by him, upon her +lamentations, reconveyed to Tahiti, where she found her body still waked, +but already swollen with the approaches of corruption. It is a lively +point in the tale that, on the sight of this dishonoured tabernacle, the +princess prayed she might continue to be numbered with the dead. But it +seems it was too late, her spirit was replaced by the least dignified of +entrances, and her startled family beheld the body move. The seemingly +purgatorial labours, the helpful kindred spirit, and the horror of the +princess at the sight of her tainted body, are all points to be remarked. + +The truth is, the tales are not necessarily consistent in themselves; and +they are further darkened for the stranger by an ambiguity of language. +Ghosts, vampires, spirits, and gods are all confounded. And yet I seem +to perceive that (with exceptions) those whom we would count gods were +less maleficent. Permanent spirits haunt and do murder in corners of +Samoa; but those legitimate gods of Upolu and Savaii, whose wars and +cricketings of late convulsed society, I did not gather to be dreaded, or +not with a like fear. The spirit of Aana that ate souls is certainly a +fearsome inmate; but the high gods, even of the archipelago, seem +helpful. Mahinui—from whom our convict-catechist had been named—the +spirit of the sea, like a Proteus endowed with endless avatars, came to +the assistance of the shipwrecked and carried them ashore in the guise of +a ray fish. The same divinity bore priests from isle to isle about the +archipelago, and by his aid, within the century, persons have been seen +to fly. The tutelar deity of each isle is likewise helpful, and by a +particular form of wedge-shaped cloud on the horizon announces the coming +of a ship. + +To one who conceives of these atolls, so narrow, so barren, so beset with +sea, here would seem a superfluity of ghostly denizens. And yet there +are more. In the various brackish pools and ponds, beautiful women with +long red hair are seen to rise and bathe; only (timid as mice) on the +first sound of feet upon the coral they dive again for ever. They are +known to be healthy and harmless living people, dwellers of an +underworld; and the same fancy is current in Tahiti, where also they have +the hair red. _Tetea_ is the Tahitian name; the Paumotuan, _Mokurea_. + + + + +PART III: THE GILBERTS + + +CHAPTER I—BUTARITARI + + +At Honolulu we had said farewell to the _Casco_ and to Captain Otis, and +our next adventure was made in changed conditions. Passage was taken for +myself, my wife, Mr. Osbourne, and my China boy, Ah Fu, on a pigmy +trading schooner, the _Equator_, Captain Dennis Reid; and on a certain +bright June day in 1889, adorned in the Hawaiian fashion with the +garlands of departure, we drew out of port and bore with a fair wind for +Micronesia. + +The whole extent of the South Seas is a desert of ships; more especially +that part where we were now to sail. No post runs in these islands; +communication is by accident; where you may have designed to go is one +thing, where you shall be able to arrive another. It was my hope, for +instance, to have reached the Carolines, and returned to the light of day +by way of Manila and the China ports; and it was in Samoa that we were +destined to re-appear and be once more refreshed with the sight of +mountains. Since the sunset faded from the peaks of Oahu six months had +intervened, and we had seen no spot of earth so high as an ordinary +cottage. Our path had been still on the flat sea, our dwellings upon +unerected coral, our diet from the pickle-tub or out of tins; I had +learned to welcome shark’s flesh for a variety; and a mountain, an onion, +an Irish potato or a beef-steak, had been long lost to sense and dear to +aspiration. + +The two chief places of our stay, Butaritari and Apemama, lie near the +line; the latter within thirty miles. Both enjoy a superb ocean climate, +days of blinding sun and bracing wind, nights of a heavenly brightness. +Both are somewhat wider than Fakarava, measuring perhaps (at the widest) +a quarter of a mile from beach to beach. In both, a coarse kind of +_taro_ thrives; its culture is a chief business of the natives, and the +consequent mounds and ditches make miniature scenery and amuse the eye. +In all else they show the customary features of an atoll: the low +horizon, the expanse of the lagoon, the sedge-like rim of palm-tops, the +sameness and smallness of the land, the hugely superior size and interest +of sea and sky. Life on such islands is in many points like life on +shipboard. The atoll, like the ship, is soon taken for granted; and the +islanders, like the ship’s crew, become soon the centre of attention. +The isles are populous, independent, seats of kinglets, recently +civilised, little visited. In the last decade many changes have crept +in; women no longer go unclothed till marriage; the widow no longer +sleeps at night and goes abroad by day with the skull of her dead +husband; and, fire-arms being introduced, the spear and the shark-tooth +sword are sold for curiosities. Ten years ago all these things and +practices were to be seen in use; yet ten years more, and the old society +will have entirely vanished. We came in a happy moment to see its +institutions still erect and (in Apemama) scarce decayed. + +Populous and independent—warrens of men, ruled over with some rustic +pomp—such was the first and still the recurring impression of these tiny +lands. As we stood across the lagoon for the town of Butaritari, a +stretch of the low shore was seen to be crowded with the brown roofs of +houses; those of the palace and king’s summer parlour (which are of +corrugated iron) glittered near one end conspicuously bright; the royal +colours flew hard by on a tall flagstaff; in front, on an artificial +islet, the gaol played the part of a martello. Even upon this first and +distant view, the place had scarce the air of what it truly was, a +village; rather of that which it was also, a petty metropolis, a city +rustic and yet royal. + +The lagoon is shoal. The tide being out, we waded for some quarter of a +mile in tepid shallows, and stepped ashore at last into a flagrant +stagnancy of sun and heat. The lee side of a line island after noon is +indeed a breathless place; on the ocean beach the trade will be still +blowing, boisterous and cool; out in the lagoon it will be blowing also, +speeding the canoes; but the screen of bush completely intercepts it from +the shore, and sleep and silence and companies of mosquitoes brood upon +the towns. + +We may thus be said to have taken Butaritari by surprise. A few +inhabitants were still abroad in the north end, at which we landed. As +we advanced, we were soon done with encounter, and seemed to explore a +city of the dead. Only, between the posts of open houses, we could see +the townsfolk stretched in the siesta, sometimes a family together veiled +in a mosquito-net, sometimes a single sleeper on a platform like a corpse +on a bier. + +The houses were of all dimensions, from those of toys to those of +churches. Some might hold a battalion, some were so minute they could +scarce receive a pair of lovers; only in the playroom, when the toys are +mingled, do we meet such incongruities of scale. Many were open sheds; +some took the form of roofed stages; others were walled and the walls +pierced with little windows. A few were perched on piles in the lagoon; +the rest stood at random on a green, through which the roadway made a +ribbon of sand, or along the embankments of a sheet of water like a +shallow dock. One and all were the creatures of a single tree; palm-tree +wood and palm-tree leaf their materials; no nail had been driven, no +hammer sounded, in their building, and they were held together by +lashings of palm-tree sinnet. + +In the midst of the thoroughfare, the church stands like an island, a +lofty and dim house with rows of windows; a rich tracery of framing +sustains the roof; and through the door at either end the street shows in +a vista. The proportions of the place, in such surroundings, and built +of such materials, appeared august; and we threaded the nave with a +sentiment befitting visitors in a cathedral. Benches run along either +side. In the midst, on a crazy dais, two chairs stand ready for the king +and queen when they shall choose to worship; over their heads a hoop, +apparently from a hogshead, depends by a strip of red cotton; and the +hoop (which hangs askew) is dressed with streamers of the same material, +red and white. + +This was our first advertisement of the royal dignity, and presently we +stood before its seat and centre. The palace is built of imported wood +upon a European plan; the roof of corrugated iron, the yard enclosed with +walls, the gate surmounted by a sort of lych-house. It cannot be called +spacious; a labourer in the States is sometimes more commodiously lodged; +but when we had the chance to see it within, we found it was enriched +(beyond all island expectation) with coloured advertisements and cuts +from the illustrated papers. Even before the gate some of the treasures +of the crown stand public: a bell of a good magnitude, two pieces of +cannon, and a single shell. The bell cannot be rung nor the guns fired; +they are curiosities, proofs of wealth, a part of the parade of the +royalty, and stand to be admired like statues in a square. A straight +gut of water like a canal runs almost to the palace door; the containing +quay-walls excellently built of coral; over against the mouth, by what +seems an effect of landscape art, the martello-like islet of the gaol +breaks the lagoon. Vassal chiefs with tribute, neighbour monarchs come +a-roving, might here sail in, view with surprise these extensive public +works, and be awed by these mouths of silent cannon. It was impossible +to see the place and not to fancy it designed for pageantry. But the +elaborate theatre then stood empty; the royal house deserted, its doors +and windows gaping; the whole quarter of the town immersed in silence. +On the opposite bank of the canal, on a roofed stage, an ancient +gentleman slept publicly, sole visible inhabitant; and beyond on the +lagoon a canoe spread a striped lateen, the sole thing moving. + +The canal is formed on the south by a pier or causeway with a parapet. +At the far end the parapet stops, and the quay expands into an oblong +peninsula in the lagoon, the breathing-place and summer parlour of the +king. The midst is occupied by an open house or permanent marquee—called +here a maniapa, or, as the word is now pronounced, a maniap’—at the +lowest estimation forty feet by sixty. The iron roof, lofty but +exceedingly low-browed, so that a woman must stoop to enter, is supported +externally on pillars of coral, within by a frame of wood. The floor is +of broken coral, divided in aisles by the uprights of the frame; the +house far enough from shore to catch the breeze, which enters freely and +disperses the mosquitoes; and under the low eaves the sun is seen to +glitter and the waves to dance on the lagoon. + +It was now some while since we had met any but slumberers; and when we +had wandered down the pier and stumbled at last into this bright shed, we +were surprised to find it occupied by a society of wakeful people, some +twenty souls in all, the court and guardsmen of Butaritari. The court +ladies were busy making mats; the guardsmen yawned and sprawled. Half a +dozen rifles lay on a rock and a cutlass was leaned against a pillar: the +armoury of these drowsy musketeers. At the far end, a little closed +house of wood displayed some tinsel curtains, and proved, upon +examination, to be a privy on the European model. In front of this, upon +some mats, lolled Tebureimoa, the king; behind him, on the panels of the +house, two crossed rifles represented fasces. He wore pyjamas which +sorrowfully misbecame his bulk; his nose was hooked and cruel, his body +overcome with sodden corpulence, his eye timorous and dull: he seemed at +once oppressed with drowsiness and held awake by apprehension: a pepper +rajah muddled with opium, and listening for the march of a Dutch army, +looks perhaps not otherwise. We were to grow better acquainted, and +first and last I had the same impression; he seemed always drowsy, yet +always to hearken and start; and, whether from remorse or fear, there is +no doubt he seeks a refuge in the abuse of drugs. + +The rajah displayed no sign of interest in our coming. But the queen, +who sat beside him in a purple sacque, was more accessible; and there was +present an interpreter so willing that his volubility became at last the +cause of our departure. He had greeted us upon our entrance:—‘That is +the honourable King, and I am his interpreter,’ he had said, with more +stateliness than truth. For he held no appointment in the court, seemed +extremely ill-acquainted with the island language, and was present, like +ourselves, upon a visit of civility. Mr. Williams was his name: an +American darkey, runaway ship’s cook, and bar-keeper at _The Land we Live +in_ tavern, Butaritari. I never knew a man who had more words in his +command or less truth to communicate; neither the gloom of the monarch, +nor my own efforts to be distant, could in the least abash him; and when +the scene closed, the darkey was left talking. + +The town still slumbered, or had but just begun to turn and stretch +itself; it was still plunged in heat and silence. So much the more vivid +was the impression that we carried away of the house upon the islet, the +Micronesian Saul wakeful amid his guards, and his unmelodious David, Mr. +Williams, chattering through the drowsy hours. + + + +CHAPTER II—THE FOUR BROTHERS + + +The kingdom of Tebureimoa includes two islands, Great and Little Makin; +some two thousand subjects pay him tribute, and two semi-independent +chieftains do him qualified homage. The importance of the office is +measured by the man; he may be a nobody, he may be absolute; and both +extremes have been exemplified within the memory of residents. + +On the death of king Tetimararoa, Tebureimoa’s father, Nakaeia, the +eldest son, succeeded. He was a fellow of huge physical strength, +masterful, violent, with a certain barbaric thrift and some intelligence +of men and business. Alone in his islands, it was he who dealt and +profited; he was the planter and the merchant; and his subjects toiled +for his behoof in servitude. When they wrought long and well their +taskmaster declared a holiday, and supplied and shared a general debauch. +The scale of his providing was at times magnificent; six hundred dollars’ +worth of gin and brandy was set forth at once; the narrow land resounded +with the noise of revelry: and it was a common thing to see the subjects +(staggering themselves) parade their drunken sovereign on the fore-hatch +of a wrecked vessel, king and commons howling and singing as they went. +At a word from Nakaeia’s mouth the revel ended; Makin became once more an +isle of slaves and of teetotalers; and on the morrow all the population +must be on the roads or in the taro-patches toiling under his bloodshot +eye. + +The fear of Nakaeia filled the land. No regularity of justice was +affected; there was no trial, there were no officers of the law; it seems +there was but one penalty, the capital; and daylight assault and midnight +murder were the forms of process. The king himself would play the +executioner: and his blows were dealt by stealth, and with the help and +countenance of none but his own wives. These were his oarswomen; one +that caught a crab, he slew incontinently with the tiller; thus +disciplined, they pulled him by night to the scene of his vengeance, +which he would then execute alone and return well-pleased with his +connubial crew. The inmates of the harem held a station hard for us to +conceive. Beasts of draught, and driven by the fear of death, they were +yet implicitly trusted with their sovereign’s life; they were still wives +and queens, and it was supposed that no man should behold their faces. +They killed by the sight like basilisks; a chance view of one of those +boatwomen was a crime to be wiped out with blood. In the days of Nakaeia +the palace was beset with some tall coco-palms which commanded the +enclosure. It chanced one evening, while Nakaeia sat below at supper +with his wives, that the owner of the grove was in a tree-top drawing +palm-tree wine; it chanced that he looked down, and the king at the same +moment looking up, their eyes encountered. Instant flight preserved the +involuntary criminal. But during the remainder of that reign he must +lurk and be hid by friends in remote parts of the isle; Nakaeia hunted +him without remission, although still in vain; and the palms, accessories +to the fact, were ruthlessly cut down. Such was the ideal of wifely +purity in an isle where nubile virgins went naked as in paradise. And +yet scandal found its way into Nakaeia’s well-guarded harem. He was at +that time the owner of a schooner, which he used for a pleasure-house, +lodging on board as she lay anchored; and thither one day he summoned a +new wife. She was one that had been sealed to him; that is to say (I +presume), that he was married to her sister, for the husband of an elder +sister has the call of the cadets. She would be arrayed for the +occasion; she would come scented, garlanded, decked with fine mats and +family jewels, for marriage, as her friends supposed; for death, as she +well knew. ‘Tell me the man’s name, and I will spare you,’ said Nakaeia. +But the girl was staunch; she held her peace, saved her lover and the +queens strangled her between the mats. + +Nakaeia was feared; it does not appear that he was hated. Deeds that +smell to us of murder wore to his subjects the reverend face of justice; +his orgies made him popular; natives to this day recall with respect the +firmness of his government; and even the whites, whom he long opposed and +kept at arm’s-length, give him the name (in the canonical South Sea +phrase) of ‘a perfect gentleman when sober.’ + +When he came to lie, without issue, on the bed of death, he summoned his +next brother, Nanteitei, made him a discourse on royal policy, and warned +him he was too weak to reign. The warning was taken to heart, and for +some while the government moved on the model of Nakaeia’s. Nanteitei +dispensed with guards, and walked abroad alone with a revolver in a +leather mail-bag. To conceal his weakness he affected a rude silence; +you might talk to him all day; advice, reproof, appeal, and menace alike +remained unanswered. + +The number of his wives was seventeen, many of them heiresses; for the +royal house is poor, and marriage was in these days a chief means of +buttressing the throne. Nakaeia kept his harem busy for himself; +Nanteitei hired it out to others. In his days, for instance, Messrs. +Wightman built a pier with a verandah at the north end of the town. The +masonry was the work of the seventeen queens, who toiled and waded there +like fisher lasses; but the man who was to do the roofing durst not begin +till they had finished, lest by chance he should look down and see them. + +It was perhaps the last appearance of the harem gang. For some time +already Hawaiian missionaries had been seated at Butaritari—Maka and +Kanoa, two brave childlike men. Nakaeia would none of their doctrine; he +was perhaps jealous of their presence; being human, he had some affection +for their persons. In the house, before the eyes of Kanoa, he slew with +his own hand three sailors of Oahu, crouching on their backs to knife +them, and menacing the missionary if he interfered; yet he not only +spared him at the moment, but recalled him afterwards (when he had fled) +with some expressions of respect. Nanteitei, the weaker man, fell more +completely under the spell. Maka, a light-hearted, lovable, yet in his +own trade very rigorous man, gained and improved an influence on the king +which soon grew paramount. Nanteitei, with the royal house, was publicly +converted; and, with a severity which liberal missionaries disavow, the +harem was at once reduced. It was a compendious act. The throne was +thus impoverished, its influence shaken, the queen’s relatives mortified, +and sixteen chief women (some of great possessions) cast in a body on the +market. I have been shipmates with a Hawaiian sailor who was +successively married to two of these _impromptu_ widows, and successively +divorced by both for misconduct. That two great and rich ladies (for +both of these were rich) should have married ‘a man from another island’ +marks the dissolution of society. The laws besides were wholly +remodelled, not always for the better. I love Maka as a man; as a +legislator he has two defects: weak in the punishment of crime, stern to +repress innocent pleasures. + +War and revolution are the common successors of reform; yet Nanteitei +died (of an overdose of chloroform), in quiet possession of the throne, +and it was in the reign of the third brother, Nabakatokia, a man brave in +body and feeble of character, that the storm burst. The rule of the high +chiefs and notables seems to have always underlain and perhaps alternated +with monarchy. The Old Men (as they were called) have a right to sit +with the king in the Speak House and debate: and the king’s chief +superiority is a form of closure—‘The Speaking is over.’ After the long +monocracy of Nakaeia and the changes of Nanteitei, the Old Men were +doubtless grown impatient of obscurity, and they were beyond question +jealous of the influence of Maka. Calumny, or rather caricature, was +called in use; a spoken cartoon ran round society; Maka was reported to +have said in church that the king was the first man in the island and +himself the second; and, stung by the supposed affront, the chiefs broke +into rebellion and armed gatherings. In the space of one forenoon the +throne of Nakaeia was humbled in the dust. The king sat in the maniap’ +before the palace gate expecting his recruits; Maka by his side, both +anxious men; and meanwhile, in the door of a house at the north entry of +the town, a chief had taken post and diverted the succours as they came. +They came singly or in groups, each with his gun or pistol slung about +his neck. ‘Where are you going?’ asked the chief. ‘The king called us,’ +they would reply. ‘Here is your place. Sit down,’ returned the chief. +With incredible disloyalty, all obeyed; and sufficient force being thus +got together from both sides, Nabakatokia was summoned and surrendered. +About this period, in almost every part of the group, the kings were +murdered; and on Tapituea, the skeleton of the last hangs to this day in +the chief Speak House of the isle, a menace to ambition. Nabakatokia was +more fortunate; his life and the royal style were spared to him, but he +was stripped of power. The Old Men enjoyed a festival of public +speaking; the laws were continually changed, never enforced; the commons +had an opportunity to regret the merits of Nakaeia; and the king, denied +the resource of rich marriages and the service of a troop of wives, fell +not only in disconsideration but in debt. + +He died some months before my arrival on the islands, and no one +regretted him; rather all looked hopefully to his successor. This was by +repute the hero of the family. Alone of the four brothers, he had issue, +a grown son, Natiata, and a daughter three years old; it was to him, in +the hour of the revolution, that Nabakatokia turned too late for help; +and in earlier days he had been the right hand of the vigorous Nakaeia. +Nontemat’, _Mr. Corpse_, was his appalling nickname, and he had earned it +well. Again and again, at the command of Nakaeia, he had surrounded +houses in the dead of night, cut down the mosquito bars and butchered +families. Here was the hand of iron; here was Nakaeia _redux_. He came, +summoned from the tributary rule of Little Makin: he was installed, he +proved a puppet and a trembler, the unwieldy shuttlecock of orators; and +the reader has seen the remains of him in his summer parlour under the +name of Tebureimoa. + +The change in the man’s character was much commented on in the island, +and variously explained by opium and Christianity. To my eyes, there +seemed no change at all, rather an extreme consistency. Mr. Corpse was +afraid of his brother: King Tebureimoa is afraid of the Old Men. Terror +of the first nerved him for deeds of desperation; fear of the second +disables him for the least act of government. He played his part of +bravo in the past, following the line of least resistance, butchering +others in his own defence: to-day, grown elderly and heavy, a convert, a +reader of the Bible, perhaps a penitent, conscious at least of +accumulated hatreds, and his memory charged with images of violence and +blood, he capitulates to the Old Men, fuddles himself with opium, and +sits among his guards in dreadful expectation. The same cowardice that +put into his hand the knife of the assassin deprives him of the sceptre +of a king. + +A tale that I was told, a trifling incident that fell in my observation, +depicts him in his two capacities. A chief in Little Makin asked, in an +hour of lightness, ‘Who is Kaeia?’ A bird carried the saying; and +Nakaeia placed the matter in the hands of a committee of three. Mr. +Corpse was chairman; the second commissioner died before my arrival; the +third was yet alive and green, and presented so venerable an appearance +that we gave him the name of Abou ben Adhem. Mr. Corpse was troubled +with a scruple; the man from Little Makin was his adopted brother; in +such a case it was not very delicate to appear at all, to strike the blow +(which it seems was otherwise expected of him) would be worse than +awkward. ‘I will strike the blow,’ said the venerable Abou; and Mr. +Corpse (surely with a sigh) accepted the compromise. The quarry was +decoyed into the bush; he was set to carrying a log; and while his arms +were raised Abou ripped up his belly at a blow. Justice being thus done, +the commission, in a childish horror, turned to flee. But their victim +recalled them to his side. ‘You need not run away now,’ he said. ‘You +have done this thing to me. Stay.’ He was some twenty minutes dying, +and his murderers sat with him the while: a scene for Shakespeare. All +the stages of a violent death, the blood, the failing voice, the +decomposing features, the changed hue, are thus present in the memory of +Mr. Corpse; and since he studied them in the brother he betrayed, he has +some reason to reflect on the possibilities of treachery. I was never +more sure of anything than the tragic quality of the king’s thoughts; and +yet I had but the one sight of him at unawares. I had once an errand for +his ear. It was once more the hour of the siesta; but there were +loiterers abroad, and these directed us to a closed house on the bank of +the canal where Tebureimoa lay unguarded. We entered without ceremony, +being in some haste. He lay on the floor upon a bed of mats, reading in +his Gilbert Island Bible with compunction. On our sudden entrance the +unwieldy man reared himself half-sitting so that the Bible rolled on the +floor, stared on us a moment with blank eyes, and, having recognised his +visitors, sank again upon the mats. So Eglon looked on Ehud. + +The justice of facts is strange, and strangely just; Nakaeia, the author +of these deeds, died at peace discoursing on the craft of kings; his tool +suffers daily death for his enforced complicity. Not the nature, but the +congruity of men’s deeds and circumstances damn and save them; and +Tebureimoa from the first has been incongruously placed. At home, in a +quiet bystreet of a village, the man had been a worthy carpenter, and, +even bedevilled as he is, he shows some private virtues. He has no +lands, only the use of such as are impignorate for fines; he cannot +enrich himself in the old way by marriages; thrift is the chief pillar of +his future, and he knows and uses it. Eleven foreign traders pay him a +patent of a hundred dollars, some two thousand subjects pay capitation at +the rate of a dollar for a man, half a dollar for a woman, and a shilling +for a child: allowing for the exchange, perhaps a total of three hundred +pounds a year. He had been some nine months on the throne: had bought +his wife a silk dress and hat, figure unknown, and himself a uniform at +three hundred dollars; had sent his brother’s photograph to be enlarged +in San Francisco at two hundred and fifty dollars; had greatly reduced +that brother’s legacy of debt and had still sovereigns in his pocket. An +affectionate brother, a good economist; he was besides a handy carpenter, +and cobbled occasionally on the woodwork of the palace. It is not +wonderful that Mr. Corpse has virtues; that Tebureimoa should have a +diversion filled me with surprise. + + + +CHAPTER III—AROUND OUR HOUSE + + +When we left the palace we were still but seafarers ashore; and within +the hour we had installed our goods in one of the six foreign houses of +Butaritari, namely, that usually occupied by Maka, the Hawaiian +missionary. Two San Francisco firms are here established, Messrs. +Crawford and Messrs. Wightman Brothers; the first hard by the palace of +the mid town, the second at the north entry; each with a store and +bar-room. Our house was in the Wightman compound, betwixt the store and +bar, within a fenced enclosure. Across the road a few native houses +nestled in the margin of the bush, and the green wall of palms rose +solid, shutting out the breeze. A little sandy cove of the lagoon ran in +behind, sheltered by a verandah pier, the labour of queens’ hands. Here, +when the tide was high, sailed boats lay to be loaded; when the tide was +low, the boats took ground some half a mile away, and an endless series +of natives descended the pier stair, tailed across the sand in strings +and clusters, waded to the waist with the bags of copra, and loitered +backward to renew their charge. The mystery of the copra trade tormented +me, as I sat and watched the profits drip on the stair and the sands. + +In front, from shortly after four in the morning until nine at night, the +folk of the town streamed by us intermittingly along the road: families +going up the island to make copra on their lands; women bound for the +bush to gather flowers against the evening toilet; and, twice a day, the +toddy-cutters, each with his knife and shell. In the first grey of the +morning, and again late in the afternoon, these would straggle past about +their tree-top business, strike off here and there into the bush, and +vanish from the face of the earth. At about the same hour, if the tide +be low in the lagoon, you are likely to be bound yourself across the +island for a bath, and may enter close at their heels alleys of the palm +wood. Right in front, although the sun is not yet risen, the east is +already lighted with preparatory fires, and the huge accumulations of the +trade-wind cloud glow with and heliograph the coming day. The breeze is +in your face; overhead in the tops of the palms, its playthings, it +maintains a lively bustle; look where you will, above or below, there is +no human presence, only the earth and shaken forest. And right overhead +the song of an invisible singer breaks from the thick leaves; from +farther on a second tree-top answers; and beyond again, in the bosom of +the woods, a still more distant minstrel perches and sways and sings. +So, all round the isle, the toddy-cutters sit on high, and are rocked by +the trade, and have a view far to seaward, where they keep watch for +sails, and like huge birds utter their songs in the morning. They sing +with a certain lustiness and Bacchic glee; the volume of sound and the +articulate melody fall unexpected from the tree-top, whence we anticipate +the chattering of fowls. And yet in a sense these songs also are but +chatter; the words are ancient, obsolete, and sacred; few comprehend +them, perhaps no one perfectly; but it was understood the cutters ‘prayed +to have good toddy, and sang of their old wars.’ The prayer is at least +answered; and when the foaming shell is brought to your door, you have a +beverage well ‘worthy of a grace.’ All forenoon you may return and +taste; it only sparkles, and sharpens, and grows to be a new drink, not +less delicious; but with the progress of the day the fermentation +quickens and grows acid; in twelve hours it will be yeast for bread, in +two days more a devilish intoxicant, the counsellor of crime. + +The men are of a marked Arabian cast of features, often bearded and +mustached, often gaily dressed, some with bracelets and anklets, all +stalking hidalgo-like, and accepting salutations with a haughty lip. The +hair (with the dandies of either sex) is worn turban-wise in a frizzled +bush; and like the daggers of the Japanese a pointed stick (used for a +comb) is thrust gallantly among the curls. The women from this bush of +hair look forth enticingly: the race cannot be compared with the Tahitian +for female beauty; I doubt even if the average be high; but some of the +prettiest girls, and one of the handsomest women I ever saw, were +Gilbertines. Butaritari, being the commercial centre of the group, is +Europeanised; the coloured sacque or the white shift are common wear, the +latter for the evening; the trade hat, loaded with flowers, fruit, and +ribbons, is unfortunately not unknown; and the characteristic female +dress of the Gilberts no longer universal. The _ridi_ is its name: a +cutty petticoat or fringe of the smoked fibre of cocoa-nut leaf, not +unlike tarry string: the lower edge not reaching the mid-thigh, the upper +adjusted so low upon the haunches that it seems to cling by accident. A +sneeze, you think, and the lady must surely be left destitute. ‘The +perilous, hairbreadth ridi’ was our word for it; and in the conflict that +rages over women’s dress it has the misfortune to please neither side, +the prudish condemning it as insufficient, the more frivolous finding it +unlovely in itself. Yet if a pretty Gilbertine would look her best, that +must be her costume. In that and naked otherwise, she moves with an +incomparable liberty and grace and life, that marks the poetry of +Micronesia. Bundle her in a gown, the charm is fled, and she wriggles +like an Englishwoman. + +Towards dusk the passers-by became more gorgeous. The men broke out in +all the colours of the rainbow—or at least of the trade-room,—and both +men and women began to be adorned and scented with new flowers. A small +white blossom is the favourite, sometimes sown singly in a woman’s hair +like little stars, now composed in a thick wreath. With the night, the +crowd sometimes thickened in the road, and the padding and brushing of +bare feet became continuous; the promenades mostly grave, the silence +only interrupted by some giggling and scampering of girls; even the +children quiet. At nine, bed-time struck on a bell from the cathedral, +and the life of the town ceased. At four the next morning the signal is +repeated in the darkness, and the innocent prisoners set free; but for +seven hours all must lie—I was about to say within doors, of a place +where doors, and even walls, are an exception—housed, at least, under +their airy roofs and clustered in the tents of the mosquito-nets. +Suppose a necessary errand to occur, suppose it imperative to send +abroad, the messenger must then go openly, advertising himself to the +police with a huge brand of cocoa-nut, which flares from house to house +like a moving bonfire. Only the police themselves go darkling, and grope +in the night for misdemeanants. I used to hate their treacherous +presence; their captain in particular, a crafty old man in white, lurked +nightly about my premises till I could have found it in my heart to beat +him. But the rogue was privileged. + +Not one of the eleven resident traders came to town, no captain cast +anchor in the lagoon, but we saw him ere the hour was out. This was +owing to our position between the store and the bar—the _Sans Souci_, as +the last was called. Mr. Rick was not only Messrs. Wightman’s manager, +but consular agent for the States; Mrs. Rick was the only white woman on +the island, and one of the only two in the archipelago; their house +besides, with its cool verandahs, its bookshelves, its comfortable +furniture, could not be rivalled nearer than Jaluit or Honolulu. Every +one called in consequence, save such as might be prosecuting a South Sea +quarrel, hingeing on the price of copra and the odd cent, or perhaps a +difference about poultry. Even these, if they did not appear upon the +north, would be presently visible to the southward, the _Sans Souci_ +drawing them as with cords. In an island with a total population of +twelve white persons, one of the two drinking-shops might seem +superfluous: but every bullet has its billet, and the double +accommodation of Butaritari is found in practice highly convenient by the +captains and the crews of ships: _The Land we Live in_ being tacitly +resigned to the forecastle, the _Sans Souci_ tacitly reserved for the +afterguard. So aristocratic were my habits, so commanding was my fear of +Mr. Williams, that I have never visited the first; but in the other, +which was the club or rather the casino of the island, I regularly passed +my evenings. It was small, but neatly fitted, and at night (when the +lamp was lit) sparkled with glass and glowed with coloured pictures like +a theatre at Christmas. The pictures were advertisements, the glass +coarse enough, the carpentry amateur; but the effect, in that incongruous +isle, was of unbridled luxury and inestimable expense. Here songs were +sung, tales told, tricks performed, games played. The Ricks, ourselves, +Norwegian Tom the bar-keeper, a captain or two from the ships, and +perhaps three or four traders come down the island in their boats or by +the road on foot, made up the usual company. The traders, all bred to +the sea, take a humorous pride in their new business; ‘South Sea +Merchants’ is the title they prefer. ‘We are all sailors +here’—‘Merchants, if you please’—‘_South Sea_ Merchants,’—was a piece of +conversation endlessly repeated, that never seemed to lose in savour. We +found them at all times simple, genial, gay, gallant, and obliging; and, +across some interval of time, recall with pleasure the traders of +Butaritari. There was one black sheep indeed. I tell of him here where +he lived, against my rule; for in this case I have no measure to +preserve, and the man is typical of a class of ruffians that once +disgraced the whole field of the South Seas, and still linger in the +rarely visited isles of Micronesia. He had the name on the beach of ‘a +perfect gentleman when sober,’ but I never saw him otherwise than drunk. +The few shocking and savage traits of the Micronesian he has singled out +with the skill of a collector, and planted in the soil of his original +baseness. He has been accused and acquitted of a treacherous murder; and +has since boastfully owned it, which inclines me to suppose him innocent. +His daughter is defaced by his erroneous cruelty, for it was his wife he +had intended to disfigure, and in the darkness of the night and the +frenzy of coco-brandy, fastened on the wrong victim. The wife has since +fled and harbours in the bush with natives; and the husband still demands +from deaf ears her forcible restoration. The best of his business is to +make natives drink, and then advance the money for the fine upon a +lucrative mortgage. ‘Respect for whites’ is the man’s word: ‘What is the +matter with this island is the want of respect for whites.’ On his way +to Butaritari, while I was there, he spied his wife in the bush with +certain natives and made a dash to capture her; whereupon one of her +companions drew a knife and the husband retreated: ‘Do you call that +proper respect for whites?’ he cried. At an early stage of the +acquaintance we proved our respect for his kind of white by forbidding +him our enclosure under pain of death. Thenceforth he lingered often in +the neighbourhood with I knew not what sense of envy or design of +mischief; his white, handsome face (which I beheld with loathing) looked +in upon us at all hours across the fence; and once, from a safe distance, +he avenged himself by shouting a recondite island insult, to us quite +inoffensive, on his English lips incredibly incongruous. + +Our enclosure, round which this composite of degradations wandered, was +of some extent. In one corner was a trellis with a long table of rough +boards. Here the Fourth of July feast had been held not long before with +memorable consequences, yet to be set forth; here we took our meals; here +entertained to a dinner the king and notables of Makin. In the midst was +the house, with a verandah front and back, and three is rooms within. In +the verandah we slung our man-of-war hammocks, worked there by day, and +slept at night. Within were beds, chairs, a round table, a fine hanging +lamp, and portraits of the royal family of Hawaii. Queen Victoria proves +nothing; Kalakaua and Mrs. Bishop are diagnostic; and the truth is we +were the stealthy tenants of the parsonage. On the day of our arrival +Maka was away; faithless trustees unlocked his doors; and the dear +rigorous man, the sworn foe of liquor and tobacco, returned to find his +verandah littered with cigarettes and his parlour horrible with bottles. +He made but one condition—on the round table, which he used in the +celebration of the sacraments, he begged us to refrain from setting +liquor; in all else he bowed to the accomplished fact, refused rent, +retired across the way into a native house, and, plying in his boat, beat +the remotest quarters of the isle for provender. He found us pigs—I +could not fancy where—no other pigs were visible; he brought us fowls and +taro; when we gave our feast to the monarch and gentry, it was he who +supplied the wherewithal, he who superintended the cooking, he who asked +grace at table, and when the king’s health was proposed, he also started +the cheering with an English hip-hip-hip. There was never a more +fortunate conception; the heart of the fatted king exulted in his bosom +at the sound. + +Take him for all in all, I have never known a more engaging creature than +this parson of Butaritari: his mirth, his kindness, his noble, friendly +feelings, brimmed from the man in speech and gesture. He loved to +exaggerate, to act and overact the momentary part, to exercise his lungs +and muscles, and to speak and laugh with his whole body. He had the +morning cheerfulness of birds and healthy children; and his humour was +infectious. We were next neighbours and met daily, yet our salutations +lasted minutes at a stretch—shaking hands, slapping shoulders, capering +like a pair of Merry-Andrews, laughing to split our sides upon some +pleasantry that would scarce raise a titter in an infant-school. It +might be five in the morning, the toddy-cutters just gone by, the road +empty, the shade of the island lying far on the lagoon: and the +ebullition cheered me for the day. + +Yet I always suspected Maka of a secret melancholy—these jubilant +extremes could scarce be constantly maintained. He was besides long, and +lean, and lined, and corded, and a trifle grizzled; and his Sabbath +countenance was even saturnine. On that day we made a procession to the +church, or (as I must always call it) the cathedral: Maka (a blot on the +hot landscape) in tall hat, black frock-coat, black trousers; under his +arm the hymn-book and the Bible; in his face, a reverent gravity:—beside +him Mary his wife, a quiet, wise, and handsome elderly lady, seriously +attired:—myself following with singular and moving thoughts. Long +before, to the sound of bells and streams and birds, through a green +Lothian glen, I had accompanied Sunday by Sunday a minister in whose +house I lodged; and the likeness, and the difference, and the series of +years and deaths, profoundly touched me. In the great, dusky, palm-tree +cathedral the congregation rarely numbered thirty: the men on one side, +the women on the other, myself posted (for a privilege) amongst the +women, and the small missionary contingent gathered close around the +platform, we were lost in that round vault. The lessons were read +antiphonally, the flock was catechised, a blind youth repeated weekly a +long string of psalms, hymns were sung—I never heard worse singing,—and +the sermon followed. To say I understood nothing were untrue; there were +points that I learned to expect with certainty; the name of Honolulu, +that of Kalakaua, the word Cap’n-man-o’-wa’, the word ship, and a +description of a storm at sea, infallibly occurred; and I was not seldom +rewarded with the name of my own Sovereign in the bargain. The rest was +but sound to the ears, silence for the mind: a plain expanse of tedium, +rendered unbearable by heat, a hard chair, and the sight through the wide +doors of the more happy heathen on the green. Sleep breathed on my +joints and eyelids, sleep hummed in my ears; it reigned in the dim +cathedral. The congregation stirred and stretched; they moaned, they +groaned aloud; they yawned upon a singing note, as you may sometimes hear +a dog when he has reached the tragic bitterest of boredom. In vain the +preacher thumped the table; in vain he singled and addressed by name +particular hearers. I was myself perhaps a more effective excitant; and +at least to one old gentleman the spectacle of my successful struggles +against sleep—and I hope they were successful—cheered the flight of time. +He, when he was not catching flies or playing tricks upon his neighbours, +gloated with a fixed, truculent eye upon the stages of my agony; and +once, when the service was drawing towards a close, he winked at me +across the church. + +I write of the service with a smile; yet I was always there—always with +respect for Maka, always with admiration for his deep seriousness, his +burning energy, the fire of his roused eye, the sincere and various +accents of his voice. To see him weekly flogging a dead horse and +blowing a cold fire was a lesson in fortitude and constancy. It may be a +question whether if the mission were fully supported, and he was set free +from business avocations, more might not result; I think otherwise +myself; I think not neglect but rigour has reduced his flock, that rigour +which has once provoked a revolution, and which to-day, in a man so +lively and engaging, amazes the beholder. No song, no dance, no tobacco, +no liquor, no alleviative of life—only toil and church-going; so says a +voice from his face; and the face is the face of the Polynesian Esau, but +the voice is the voice of a Jacob from a different world. And a +Polynesian at the best makes a singular missionary in the Gilberts, +coming from a country recklessly unchaste to one conspicuously strict; +from a race hag-ridden with bogies to one comparatively bold against the +terrors of the dark. The thought was stamped one morning in my mind, +when I chanced to be abroad by moonlight, and saw all the town lightless, +but the lamp faithfully burning by the missionary’s bed. It requires no +law, no fire, and no scouting police, to withhold Maka and his countrymen +from wandering in the night unlighted. + + + +CHAPTER IV—A TALE OF A TAPU + + +On the morrow of our arrival (Sunday, 14th July 1889) our photographers +were early stirring. Once more we traversed a silent town; many were yet +abed and asleep; some sat drowsily in their open houses; there was no +sound of intercourse or business. In that hour before the shadows, the +quarter of the palace and canal seemed like a landing-place in the +_Arabian Nights_ or from the classic poets; here were the fit destination +of some ‘faery frigot,’ here some adventurous prince might step ashore +among new characters and incidents; and the island prison, where it +floated on the luminous face of the lagoon, might have passed for the +repository of the Grail. In such a scene, and at such an hour, the +impression received was not so much of foreign travel—rather of past +ages; it seemed not so much degrees of latitude that we had crossed, as +centuries of time that we had re-ascended; leaving, by the same steps, +home and to-day. A few children followed us, mostly nude, all silent; in +the clear, weedy waters of the canal some silent damsels waded, baring +their brown thighs; and to one of the maniap’s before the palace gate we +were attracted by a low but stirring hum of speech. + +The oval shed was full of men sitting cross-legged. The king was there +in striped pyjamas, his rear protected by four guards with Winchesters, +his air and bearing marked by unwonted spirit and decision; tumblers and +black bottles went the round; and the talk, throughout loud, was general +and animated. I was inclined at first to view this scene with suspicion. +But the hour appeared unsuitable for a carouse; drink was besides +forbidden equally by the law of the land and the canons of the church; +and while I was yet hesitating, the king’s rigorous attitude disposed of +my last doubt. We had come, thinking to photograph him surrounded by his +guards, and at the first word of the design his piety revolted. We were +reminded of the day—the Sabbath, in which thou shalt take no +photographs—and returned with a flea in our ear, bearing the rejected +camera. + +At church, a little later, I was struck to find the throne unoccupied. +So nice a Sabbatarian might have found the means to be present; perhaps +my doubts revived; and before I got home they were transformed to +certainties. Tom, the bar-keeper of the _Sans Souci_, was in +conversation with two emissaries from the court. The ‘keen,’ they said, +wanted ‘din,’ failing which ‘perandi.’ {231} No din, was Tom’s reply, +and no perandi; but ‘pira’ if they pleased. It seems they had no use for +beer, and departed sorrowing. + +‘Why, what is the meaning of all this?’ I asked. ‘Is the island on the +spree?’ + +Such was the fact. On the 4th of July a feast had been made, and the +king, at the suggestion of the whites, had raised the tapu against +liquor. There is a proverb about horses; it scarce applies to the +superior animal, of whom it may be rather said, that any one can start +him drinking, not any twenty can prevail on him to stop. The tapu, +raised ten days before, was not yet re-imposed; for ten days the town had +been passing the bottle or lying (as we had seen it the afternoon before) +in hoggish sleep; and the king, moved by the Old Men and his own +appetites, continued to maintain the liberty, to squander his savings on +liquor, and to join in and lead the debauch. The whites were the authors +of this crisis; it was upon their own proposal that the freedom had been +granted at the first; and for a while, in the interests of trade, they +were doubtless pleased it should continue. That pleasure had now +sometime ceased; the bout had been prolonged (it was conceded) unduly; +and it now began to be a question how it might conclude. Hence Tom’s +refusal. Yet that refusal was avowedly only for the moment, and it was +avowedly unavailing; the king’s foragers, denied by Tom at the _Sans +Souci_, would be supplied at _The Land we Live in_ by the gobbling Mr. +Williams. + +The degree of the peril was not easy to measure at the time, and I am +inclined to think now it was easy to exaggerate. Yet the conduct of +drunkards even at home is always matter for anxiety; and at home our +populations are not armed from the highest to the lowest with revolvers +and repeating rifles, neither do we go on a debauch by the whole +townful—and I might rather say, by the whole polity—king, magistrates, +police, and army joining in one common scene of drunkenness. It must be +thought besides that we were here in barbarous islands, rarely visited, +lately and partly civilised. First and last, a really considerable +number of whites have perished in the Gilberts, chiefly through their own +misconduct; and the natives have displayed in at least one instance a +disposition to conceal an accident under a butchery, and leave nothing +but dumb bones. This last was the chief consideration against a sudden +closing of the bars; the bar-keepers stood in the immediate breach and +dealt direct with madmen; too surly a refusal might at any moment +precipitate a blow, and the blow might prove the signal for a massacre. + +_Monday_, 15th.—At the same hour we returned to the same muniap’. Kümmel +(of all drinks) was served in tumblers; in the midst sat the crown +prince, a fatted youth, surrounded by fresh bottles and busily plying the +corkscrew; and king, chief, and commons showed the loose mouth, the +uncertain joints, and the blurred and animated eye of the early drinker. +It was plain we were impatiently expected; the king retired with alacrity +to dress, the guards were despatched after their uniforms; and we were +left to await the issue of these preparations with a shedful of tipsy +natives. The orgie had proceeded further than on Sunday. The day +promised to be of great heat; it was already sultry, the courtiers were +already fuddled; and still the kümmel continued to go round, and the +crown prince to play butler. Flemish freedom followed upon Flemish +excess; and a funny dog, a handsome fellow, gaily dressed, and with a +full turban of frizzed hair, delighted the company with a humorous +courtship of a lady in a manner not to be described. It was our +diversion, in this time of waiting, to observe the gathering of the +guards. They have European arms, European uniforms, and (to their +sorrow) European shoes. We saw one warrior (like Mars) in the article of +being armed; two men and a stalwart woman were scarce strong enough to +boot him; and after a single appearance on parade the army is crippled +for a week. + +At last, the gates under the king’s house opened; the army issued, one +behind another, with guns and epaulettes; the colours stooped under the +gateway; majesty followed in his uniform bedizened with gold lace; +majesty’s wife came next in a hat and feathers, and an ample trained silk +gown; the royal imps succeeded; there stood the pageantry of Makin +marshalled on its chosen theatre. Dickens might have told how serious +they were; how tipsy; how the king melted and streamed under his cocked +hat; how he took station by the larger of his two cannons—austere, +majestic, but not truly vertical; how the troops huddled, and were +straightened out, and clubbed again; how they and their firelocks raked +at various inclinations like the masts of ships; and how an amateur +photographer reviewed, arrayed, and adjusted them, to see his +dispositions change before he reached the camera. + +The business was funny to see; I do not know that it is graceful to laugh +at; and our report of these transactions was received on our return with +the shaking of grave heads. + +The day had begun ill; eleven hours divided us from sunset; and at any +moment, on the most trifling chance, the trouble might begin. The +Wightman compound was in a military sense untenable, commanded on three +sides by houses and thick bush; the town was computed to contain over a +thousand stand of excellent new arms; and retreat to the ships, in the +case of an alert, was a recourse not to be thought of. Our talk that +morning must have closely reproduced the talk in English garrisons before +the Sepoy mutiny; the sturdy doubt that any mischief was in prospect, the +sure belief that (should any come) there was nothing left but to go down +fighting, the half-amused, half-anxious attitude of mind in which we were +awaiting fresh developments. + +The kümmel soon ran out; we were scarce returned before the king had +followed us in quest of more. Mr. Corpse was now divested of his more +awful attitude, the lawless bulk of him again encased in striped pyjamas; +a guardsman brought up the rear with his rifle at the trail: and his +majesty was further accompanied by a Rarotongan whalerman and the playful +courtier with the turban of frizzed hair. There was never a more lively +deputation. The whalerman was gapingly, tearfully tipsy: the courtier +walked on air; the king himself was even sportive. Seated in a chair in +the Ricks’ sitting-room, he bore the brunt of our prayers and menaces +unmoved. He was even rated, plied with historic instances, threatened +with the men-of-war, ordered to restore the tapu on the spot—and nothing +in the least affected him. It should be done to-morrow, he said; to-day +it was beyond his power, to-day he durst not. ‘Is that royal?’ cried +indignant Mr. Rick. No, it was not royal; had the king been of a royal +character we should ourselves have held a different language; and royal +or not, he had the best of the dispute. The terms indeed were hardly +equal; for the king was the only man who could restore the tapu, but the +Ricks were not the only people who sold drink. He had but to hold his +ground on the first question, and they were sure to weaken on the second. +A little struggle they still made for the fashion’s sake; and then one +exceedingly tipsy deputation departed, greatly rejoicing, a case of +brandy wheeling beside them in a barrow. The Rarotongan (whom I had +never seen before) wrung me by the hand like a man bound on a far voyage. +‘My dear frien’!’ he cried, ‘good-bye, my dear frien’!’—tears of kümmel +standing in his eyes; the king lurched as he went, the courtier ambled,—a +strange party of intoxicated children to be entrusted with that barrowful +of madness. + +You could never say the town was quiet; all morning there was a ferment +in the air, an aimless movement and congregation of natives in the +street. But it was not before half-past one that a sudden hubbub of +voices called us from the house, to find the whole white colony already +gathered on the spot as by concerted signal. The _Sans Souci_ was +overrun with rabble, the stair and verandah thronged. From all these +throats an inarticulate babbling cry went up incessantly; it sounded like +the bleating of young lambs, but angrier. In the road his royal highness +(whom I had seen so lately in the part of butler) stood crying upon Tom; +on the top step, tossed in the hurly-burly, Tom was shouting to the +prince. Yet a while the pack swayed about the bar, vociferous. Then +came a brutal impulse; the mob reeled, and returned, and was rejected; +the stair showed a stream of heads; and there shot into view, through the +disbanding ranks, three men violently dragging in their midst a fourth. +By his hair and his hands, his head forced as low as his knees, his face +concealed, he was wrenched from the verandah and whisked along the road +into the village, howling as he disappeared. Had his face been raised, +we should have seen it bloodied, and the blood was not his own. The +courtier with the turban of frizzed hair had paid the costs of this +disturbance with the lower part of one ear. + +So the brawl passed with no other casualty than might seem comic to the +inhumane. Yet we looked round on serious faces and—a fact that spoke +volumes—Tom was putting up the shutters on the bar. Custom might go +elsewhere, Mr. Williams might profit as he pleased, but Tom had had +enough of bar-keeping for that day. Indeed the event had hung on a hair. +A man had sought to draw a revolver—on what quarrel I could never learn, +and perhaps he himself could not have told; one shot, when the room was +so crowded, could scarce have failed to take effect; where many were +armed and all tipsy, it could scarce have failed to draw others; and the +woman who spied the weapon and the man who seized it may very well have +saved the white community. + +The mob insensibly melted from the scene; and for the rest of the day our +neighbourhood was left in peace and a good deal in solitude. But the +tranquillity was only local; _din_ and_ perandi_ still flowed in other +quarters: and we had one more sight of Gilbert Island violence. In the +church, where we had wandered photographing, we were startled by a sudden +piercing outcry. The scene, looking forth from the doors of that great +hall of shadow, was unforgettable. The palms, the quaint and scattered +houses, the flag of the island streaming from its tall staff, glowed with +intolerable sunshine. In the midst two women rolled fighting on the +grass. The combatants were the more easy to be distinguished, because +the one was stripped to the _ridi_ and the other wore a holoku (sacque) +of some lively colour. The first was uppermost, her teeth locked in her +adversary’s face, shaking her like a dog; the other impotently fought and +scratched. So for a moment we saw them wallow and grapple there like +vermin; then the mob closed and shut them in. + +It was a serious question that night if we should sleep ashore. But we +were travellers, folk that had come far in quest of the adventurous; on +the first sign of an adventure it would have been a singular +inconsistency to have withdrawn; and we sent on board instead for our +revolvers. Mindful of Taahauku, Mr. Rick, Mr. Osbourne, and Mrs. +Stevenson held an assault of arms on the public highway, and fired at +bottles to the admiration of the natives. Captain Reid of the _Equator_ +stayed on shore with us to be at hand in case of trouble, and we retired +to bed at the accustomed hour, agreeably excited by the day’s events. +The night was exquisite, the silence enchanting; yet as I lay in my +hammock looking on the strong moonshine and the quiescent palms, one ugly +picture haunted me of the two women, the naked and the clad, locked in +that hostile embrace. The harm done was probably not much, yet I could +have looked on death and massacre with less revolt. The return to these +primeval weapons, the vision of man’s beastliness, of his ferality, +shocked in me a deeper sense than that with which we count the cost of +battles. There are elements in our state and history which it is a +pleasure to forget, which it is perhaps the better wisdom not to dwell +on. Crime, pestilence, and death are in the day’s work; the imagination +readily accepts them. It instinctively rejects, on the contrary, +whatever shall call up the image of our race upon its lowest terms, as +the partner of beasts, beastly itself, dwelling pell-mell and +hugger-mugger, hairy man with hairy woman, in the caves of old. And yet +to be just to barbarous islanders we must not forget the slums and dens +of our cities; I must not forget that I have passed dinnerward through +Soho, and seen that which cured me of my dinner. + + + +CHAPTER V—A TALE OF A TAPU—_continued_ + + +_Tuesday_, _July_ 16.—It rained in the night, sudden and loud, in Gilbert +Island fashion. Before the day, the crowing of a cock aroused me and I +wandered in the compound and along the street. The squall was blown by, +the moon shone with incomparable lustre, the air lay dead as in a room, +and yet all the isle sounded as under a strong shower, the eaves thickly +pattering, the lofty palms dripping at larger intervals and with a louder +note. In this bold nocturnal light the interior of the houses lay +inscrutable, one lump of blackness, save when the moon glinted under the +roof, and made a belt of silver, and drew the slanting shadows of the +pillars on the floor. Nowhere in all the town was any lamp or ember; not +a creature stirred; I thought I was alone to be awake; but the police +were faithful to their duty; secretly vigilant, keeping account of time; +and a little later, the watchman struck slowly and repeatedly on the +cathedral bell; four o’clock, the warning signal. It seemed strange +that, in a town resigned to drunkenness and tumult, curfew and réveille +should still be sounded and still obeyed. + +The day came, and brought little change. The place still lay silent; the +people slept, the town slept. Even the few who were awake, mostly women +and children, held their peace and kept within under the strong shadow of +the thatch, where you must stop and peer to see them. Through the +deserted streets, and past the sleeping houses, a deputation took its way +at an early hour to the palace; the king was suddenly awakened, and must +listen (probably with a headache) to unpalatable truths. Mrs. Rick, +being a sufficient mistress of that difficult tongue, was spokeswoman; +she explained to the sick monarch that I was an intimate personal friend +of Queen Victoria’s; that immediately on my return I should make her a +report upon Butaritari; and that if my house should have been again +invaded by natives, a man-of-war would be despatched to make reprisals. +It was scarce the fact—rather a just and necessary parable of the fact, +corrected for latitude; and it certainly told upon the king. He was much +affected; he had conceived the notion (he said) that I was a man of some +importance, but not dreamed it was as bad as this; and the missionary +house was tapu’d under a fine of fifty dollars. + +So much was announced on the return of the deputation; not any more; and +I gathered subsequently that much more had passed. The protection gained +was welcome. It had been the most annoying and not the least alarming +feature of the day before, that our house was periodically filled with +tipsy natives, twenty or thirty at a time, begging drink, fingering our +goods, hard to be dislodged, awkward to quarrel with. Queen Victoria’s +friend (who was soon promoted to be her son) was free from these +intrusions. Not only my house, but my neighbourhood as well, was left in +peace; even on our walks abroad we were guarded and prepared for; and, +like great persons visiting a hospital, saw only the fair side. For the +matter of a week we were thus suffered to go out and in and live in a +fool’s paradise, supposing the king to have kept his word, the tapu to be +revived and the island once more sober. + +_Tuesday_, _July_ 23.—We dined under a bare trellis erected for the +Fourth of July; and here we used to linger by lamplight over coffee and +tobacco. In that climate evening approaches without sensible chill; the +wind dies out before sunset; heaven glows a while and fades, and darkens +into the blueness of the tropical night; swiftly and insensibly the +shadows thicken, the stars multiply their number; you look around you and +the day is gone. It was then that we would see our Chinaman draw near +across the compound in a lurching sphere of light, divided by his +shadows; and with the coming of the lamp the night closed about the +table. The faces of the company, the spars of the trellis, stood out +suddenly bright on a ground of blue and silver, faintly designed with +palm-tops and the peaked roofs of houses. Here and there the gloss upon +a leaf, or the fracture of a stone, returned an isolated sparkle. All +else had vanished. We hung there, illuminated like a galaxy of stars _in +vacuo_; we sat, manifest and blind, amid the general ambush of the +darkness; and the islanders, passing with light footfalls and low voices +in the sand of the road, lingered to observe us, unseen. + +On Tuesday the dusk had fallen, the lamp had just been brought, when a +missile struck the table with a rattling smack and rebounded past my ear. +Three inches to one side and this page had never been written; for the +thing travelled like a cannon ball. It was supposed at the time to be a +nut, though even at the time I thought it seemed a small one and fell +strangely. + +_Wednesday_, _July_ 24.—The dusk had fallen once more, and the lamp been +just brought out, when the same business was repeated. And again the +missile whistled past my ear. One nut I had been willing to accept; a +second, I rejected utterly. A cocoa-nut does not come slinging along on +a windless evening, making an angle of about fifteen degrees with the +horizon; cocoa-nuts do not fall on successive nights at the same hour and +spot; in both cases, besides, a specific moment seemed to have been +chosen, that when the lamp was just carried out, a specific person +threatened, and that the head of the family. I may have been right or +wrong, but I believed I was the mark of some intimidation; believed the +missile was a stone, aimed not to hit, but to frighten. + +No idea makes a man more angry. I ran into the road, where the natives +were as usual promenading in the dark; Maka joined me with a lantern; and +I ran from one to another, glared in quite innocent faces, put useless +questions, and proffered idle threats. Thence I carried my wrath (which +was worthy the son of any queen in history) to the Ricks. They heard me +with depression, assured me this trick of throwing a stone into a family +dinner was not new; that it meant mischief, and was of a piece with the +alarming disposition of the natives. And then the truth, so long +concealed from us, came out. The king had broken his promise, he had +defied the deputation; the tapu was still dormant, _The Land we Live in_ +still selling drink, and that quarter of the town disturbed and menaced +by perpetual broils. But there was worse ahead: a feast was now +preparing for the birthday of the little princess; and the tributary +chiefs of Kuma and Little Makin were expected daily. Strong in a +following of numerous and somewhat savage clansmen, each of these was +believed, like a Douglas of old, to be of doubtful loyalty. Kuma (a +little pot-bellied fellow) never visited the palace, never entered the +town, but sat on the beach on a mat, his gun across his knees, parading +his mistrust and scorn; Karaiti of Makin, although he was more bold, was +not supposed to be more friendly; and not only were these vassals jealous +of the throne, but the followers on either side shared in the animosity. +Brawls had already taken place; blows had passed which might at any +moment be repaid in blood. Some of the strangers were already here and +already drinking; if the debauch continued after the bulk of them had +come, a collision, perhaps a revolution, was to be expected. + +The sale of drink is in this group a measure of the jealousy of traders; +one begins, the others are constrained to follow; and to him who has the +most gin, and sells it the most recklessly, the lion’s share of copra is +assured. It is felt by all to be an extreme expedient, neither safe, +decent, nor dignified. A trader on Tarawa, heated by an eager rivalry, +brought many cases of gin. He told me he sat afterwards day and night in +his house till it was finished, not daring to arrest the sale, not +venturing to go forth, the bush all round him filled with howling +drunkards. At night, above all, when he was afraid to sleep, and heard +shots and voices about him in the darkness, his remorse was black. + +‘My God!’ he reflected, ‘if I was to lose my life on such a wretched +business!’ Often and often, in the story of the Gilberts, this scene has +been repeated; and the remorseful trader sat beside his lamp, longing for +the day, listening with agony for the sound of murder, registering +resolutions for the future. For the business is easy to begin, but +hazardous to stop. The natives are in their way a just and law-abiding +people, mindful of their debts, docile to the voice of their own +institutions; when the tapu is re-enforced they will cease drinking; but +the white who seeks to antedate the movement by refusing liquor does so +at his peril. + +Hence, in some degree, the anxiety and helplessness of Mr. Rick. He and +Tom, alarmed by the rabblement of the _Sans Souci_, had stopped the sale; +they had done so without danger, because _The Land we Live in_ still +continued selling; it was claimed, besides, that they had been the first +to begin. What step could be taken? Could Mr. Rick visit Mr. Muller +(with whom he was not on terms) and address him thus: ‘I was getting +ahead of you, now you are getting ahead of me, and I ask you to forego +your profit. I got my place closed in safety, thanks to your continuing; +but now I think you have continued long enough. I begin to be alarmed; +and because I am afraid I ask you to confront a certain danger’? It was +not to be thought of. Something else had to be found; and there was one +person at one end of the town who was at least not interested in copra. +There was little else to be said in favour of myself as an ambassador. I +had arrived in the Wightman schooner, I was living in the Wightman +compound, I was the daily associate of the Wightman coterie. It was +egregious enough that I should now intrude unasked in the private affairs +of Crawford’s agent, and press upon him the sacrifice of his interests +and the venture of his life. But bad as I might be, there was none +better; since the affair of the stone I was, besides, sharp-set to be +doing, the idea of a delicate interview attracted me, and I thought it +policy to show myself abroad. + +The night was very dark. There was service in the church, and the +building glimmered through all its crevices like a dim Kirk Allowa’. I +saw few other lights, but was indistinctly aware of many people stirring +in the darkness, and a hum and sputter of low talk that sounded stealthy. +I believe (in the old phrase) my beard was sometimes on my shoulder as I +went. Muller’s was but partly lighted, and quite silent, and the gate +was fastened. I could by no means manage to undo the latch. No wonder, +since I found it afterwards to be four or five feet long—a fortification +in itself. As I still fumbled, a dog came on the inside and sniffed +suspiciously at my hands, so that I was reduced to calling ‘House ahoy!’ +Mr. Muller came down and put his chin across the paling in the dark. +‘Who is that?’ said he, like one who has no mind to welcome strangers. + +‘My name is Stevenson,’ said I. + +‘O, Mr. Stevens! I didn’t know you. Come inside.’ We stepped into the +dark store, when I leaned upon the counter and he against the wall. All +the light came from the sleeping-room, where I saw his family being put +to bed; it struck full in my face, but Mr. Muller stood in shadow. No +doubt he expected what was Coming, and sought the advantage of position; +but for a man who wished to persuade and had nothing to conceal, mine was +the preferable. + +‘Look here,’ I began, ‘I hear you are selling to the natives.’ + +‘Others have done that before me,’ he returned pointedly. + +‘No doubt,’ said I, ‘and I have nothing to do with the past, but the +future. I want you to promise you will handle these spirits carefully.’ + +‘Now what is your motive in this?’ he asked, and then, with a sneer, ‘Are +you afraid of your life?’ + +‘That is nothing to the purpose,’ I replied. ‘I know, and you know, +these spirits ought not to be used at all.’ + +‘Tom and Mr. Rick have sold them before.’ + +‘I have nothing to do with Tom and Mr. Rick. All I know is I have heard +them both refuse.’ + +‘No, I suppose you have nothing to do with them. Then you are just +afraid of your life.’ + +‘Come now,’ I cried, being perhaps a little stung, ‘you know in your +heart I am asking a reasonable thing. I don’t ask you to lose your +profit—though I would prefer to see no spirits brought here, as you +would—’ + +‘I don’t say I wouldn’t. I didn’t begin this,’ he interjected. + +‘No, I don’t suppose you did,’ said I. ‘And I don’t ask you to lose; I +ask you to give me your word, man to man, that you will make no native +drunk.’ + +Up to now Mr. Muller had maintained an attitude very trying to my temper; +but he had maintained it with difficulty, his sentiment being all upon my +side; and here he changed ground for the worse. ‘It isn’t me that +sells,’ said he. + +‘No, it’s that nigger,’ I agreed. ‘But he’s yours to buy and sell; you +have your hand on the nape of his neck; and I ask you—I have my wife +here—to use the authority you have.’ + +He hastily returned to his old ward. ‘I don’t deny I could if I wanted,’ +said he. ‘But there’s no danger, the natives are all quiet. You’re just +afraid of your life.’ + +I do not like to be called a coward, even by implication; and here I lost +my temper and propounded an untimely ultimatum. ‘You had better put it +plain,’ I cried. ‘Do you mean to refuse me what I ask?’ + +‘I don’t want either to refuse it or grant it,’ he replied. + +‘You’ll find you have to do the one thing or the other, and right now!’ I +cried, and then, striking into a happier vein, ‘Come,’ said I, ‘you’re a +better sort than that. I see what’s wrong with you—you think I came from +the opposite camp. I see the sort of man you are, and you know that what +I ask is right.’ + +Again he changed ground. ‘If the natives get any drink, it isn’t safe to +stop them,’ he objected. + +‘I’ll be answerable for the bar,’ I said. ‘We are three men and four +revolvers; we’ll come at a word, and hold the place against the village.’ + +‘You don’t know what you’re talking about; it’s too dangerous!’ he cried. + +‘Look here,’ said I, ‘I don’t mind much about losing that life you talk +so much of; but I mean to lose it the way I want to, and that is, putting +a stop to all this beastliness.’ + +He talked a while about his duty to the firm; I minded not at all, I was +secure of victory. He was but waiting to capitulate, and looked about +for any potent to relieve the strain. In the gush of light from the +bedroom door I spied a cigar-holder on the desk. ‘That is well +coloured,’ said I. + +‘Will you take a cigar?’ said he. + +I took it and held it up unlighted. ‘Now,’ said I, ‘you promise me.’ + +‘I promise you you won’t have any trouble from natives that have drunk at +my place,’ he replied. + +‘That is all I ask,’ said I, and showed it was not by immediately +offering to try his stock. + +So far as it was anyway critical our interview here ended. Mr. Muller +had thenceforth ceased to regard me as an emissary from his rivals, +dropped his defensive attitude, and spoke as he believed. I could make +out that he would already, had he dared, have stopped the sale himself. +Not quite daring, it may be imagined how he resented the idea of +interference from those who had (by his own statement) first led him on, +then deserted him in the breach, and now (sitting themselves in safety) +egged him on to a new peril, which was all gain to them, all loss to him! +I asked him what he thought of the danger from the feast. + +‘I think worse of it than any of you,’ he answered. ‘They were shooting +around here last night, and I heard the balls too. I said to myself, +“That’s bad.” What gets me is why you should be making this row up at +your end. I should be the first to go.’ + +It was a thoughtless wonder. The consolation of being second is not +great; the fact, not the order of going—there was our concern. + +Scott talks moderately of looking forward to a time of fighting ‘with a +feeling that resembled pleasure.’ The resemblance seems rather an +identity. In modern life, contact is ended; man grows impatient of +endless manœuvres; and to approach the fact, to find ourselves where we +can push an advantage home, and stand a fair risk, and see at last what +we are made of, stirs the blood. It was so at least with all my family, +who bubbled with delight at the approach of trouble; and we sat deep into +the night like a pack of schoolboys, preparing the revolvers and +arranging plans against the morrow. It promised certainly to be a busy +and eventful day. The Old Men were to be summoned to confront me on the +question of the tapu; Muller might call us at any moment to garrison his +bar; and suppose Muller to fail, we decided in a family council to take +that matter into our own hands, _The Land we Live in_ at the pistol’s +mouth, and with the polysyllabic Williams, dance to a new tune. As I +recall our humour I think it would have gone hard with the mulatto. + +_Wednesday_, _July_ 24.—It was as well, and yet it was disappointing that +these thunder-clouds rolled off in silence. Whether the Old Men recoiled +from an interview with Queen Victoria’s son, whether Muller had secretly +intervened, or whether the step flowed naturally from the fears of the +king and the nearness of the feast, the tapu was early that morning +re-enforced; not a day too soon, from the manner the boats began to +arrive thickly, and the town was filled with the big rowdy vassals of +Karaiti. + +The effect lingered for some time on the minds of the traders; it was +with the approval of all present that I helped to draw up a petition to +the United States, praying for a law against the liquor trade in the +Gilberts; and it was at this request that I added, under my own name, a +brief testimony of what had passed;—useless pains; since the whole +reposes, probably unread and possibly unopened, in a pigeon-hole at +Washington. + +_Sunday_, _July_ 28.—This day we had the afterpiece of the debauch. The +king and queen, in European clothes, and followed by armed guards, +attended church for the first time, and sat perched aloft in a precarious +dignity under the barrel-hoops. Before sermon his majesty clambered from +the dais, stood lopsidedly upon the gravel floor, and in a few words +abjured drinking. The queen followed suit with a yet briefer allocution. +All the men in church were next addressed in turn; each held up his right +hand, and the affair was over—throne and church were reconciled. + + + +CHAPTER VI—THE FIVE DAYS’ FESTIVAL + + +_Thursday_, _July_ 25.—The street was this day much enlivened by the +presence of the men from Little Makin; they average taller than +Butaritarians, and being on a holiday, went wreathed with yellow leaves +and gorgeous in vivid colours. They are said to be more savage, and to +be proud of the distinction. Indeed, it seemed to us they swaggered in +the town, like plaided Highlanders upon the streets of Inverness, +conscious of barbaric virtues. + +In the afternoon the summer parlour was observed to be packed with +people; others standing outside and stooping to peer under the eaves, +like children at home about a circus. It was the Makin company, +rehearsing for the day of competition. Karaiti sat in the front row +close to the singers, where we were summoned (I suppose in honour of +Queen Victoria) to join him. A strong breathless heat reigned under the +iron roof, and the air was heavy with the scent of wreaths. The singers, +with fine mats about their loins, cocoa-nut feathers set in rings upon +their fingers, and their heads crowned with yellow leaves, sat on the +floor by companies. A varying number of soloists stood up for different +songs; and these bore the chief part in the music. But the full force of +the companies, even when not singing, contributed continuously to the +effect, and marked the ictus of the measure, mimicking, grimacing, +casting up their heads and eyes, fluttering the feathers on their +fingers, clapping hands, or beating (loud as a kettledrum) on the left +breast; the time was exquisite, the music barbarous, but full of +conscious art. I noted some devices constantly employed. A sudden +change would be introduced (I think of key) with no break of the measure, +but emphasised by a sudden dramatic heightening of the voice and a +swinging, general gesticulation. The voices of the soloists would begin +far apart in a rude discord, and gradually draw together to a unison; +which, when, they had reached, they were joined and drowned by the full +chorus. The ordinary, hurried, barking unmelodious movement of the +voices would at times be broken and glorified by a psalm-like strain of +melody, often well constructed, or seeming so by contrast. There was +much variety of measure, and towards the end of each piece, when the fun +became fast and furious, a recourse to this figure— + + [Picture: Music. It means two/four time with quaver, quaver, crotchet + repeated for three bars] + +It is difficult to conceive what fire and devilry they get into these +hammering finales; all go together, voices, hands, eyes, leaves, and +fluttering finger-rings; the chorus swings to the eye, the song throbs on +the ear; the faces are convulsed with enthusiasm and effort. + +Presently the troop stood up in a body, the drums forming a half-circle +for the soloists, who were sometimes five or even more in number. The +songs that followed were highly dramatic; though I had none to give me +any explanation, I would at times make out some shadowy but decisive +outline of a plot; and I was continually reminded of certain quarrelsome +concerted scenes in grand operas at home; just so the single voices issue +from and fall again into the general volume; just so do the performers +separate and crowd together, brandish the raised hand, and roll the eye +to heaven—or the gallery. Already this is beyond the Thespian model; the +art of this people is already past the embryo: song, dance, drums, +quartette and solo—it is the drama full developed although still in +miniature. Of all so-called dancing in the South Seas, that which I saw +in Butaritari stands easily the first. The _hula_, as it may be viewed +by the speedy globe-trotter in Honolulu, is surely the most dull of man’s +inventions, and the spectator yawns under its length as at a college +lecture or a parliamentary debate. But the Gilbert Island dance leads on +the mind; it thrills, rouses, subjugates; it has the essence of all art, +an unexplored imminent significance. Where so many are engaged, and +where all must make (at a given moment) the same swift, elaborate, and +often arbitrary movement, the toil of rehearsal is of course extreme. +But they begin as children. A child and a man may often be seen together +in a maniap’: the man sings and gesticulates, the child stands before him +with streaming tears and tremulously copies him in act and sound; it is +the Gilbert Island artist learning (as all artists must) his art in +sorrow. + +I may seem to praise too much; here is a passage from my wife’s diary, +which proves that I was not alone in being moved, and completes the +picture:—‘The conductor gave the cue, and all the dancers, waving their +arms, swaying their bodies, and clapping their breasts in perfect time, +opened with an introductory. The performers remained seated, except two, +and once three, and twice a single soloist. These stood in the group, +making a slight movement with the feet and rhythmical quiver of the body +as they sang. There was a pause after the introductory, and then the +real business of the opera—for it was no less—began; an opera where every +singer was an accomplished actor. The leading man, in an impassioned +ecstasy which possessed him from head to foot, seemed transfigured; once +it was as though a strong wind had swept over the stage—their arms, their +feathered fingers thrilling with an emotion that shook my nerves as well: +heads and bodies followed like a field of grain before a gust. My blood +came hot and cold, tears pricked my eyes, my head whirled, I felt an +almost irresistible impulse to join the dancers. One drama, I think, I +very nearly understood. A fierce and savage old man took the solo part. +He sang of the birth of a prince, and how he was tenderly rocked in his +mother’s arms; of his boyhood, when he excelled his fellows in swimming, +climbing, and all athletic sports; of his youth, when he went out to sea +with his boat and fished; of his manhood, when he married a wife who +cradled a son of his own in her arms. Then came the alarm of war, and a +great battle, of which for a time the issue was doubtful; but the hero +conquered, as he always does, and with a tremendous burst of the victors +the piece closed. There were also comic pieces, which caused great +amusement. During one, an old man behind me clutched me by the arm, +shook his finger in my face with a roguish smile, and said something with +a chuckle, which I took to be the equivalent of “O, you women, you women; +it is true of you all!” I fear it was not complimentary. At no time was +there the least sign of the ugly indecency of the eastern islands. All +was poetry pure and simple. The music itself was as complex as our own, +though constructed on an entirely different basis; once or twice I was +startled by a bit of something very like the best English sacred music, +but it was only for an instant. At last there was a longer pause, and +this time the dancers were all on their feet. As the drama went on, the +interest grew. The performers appealed to each other, to the audience, +to the heaven above; they took counsel with each other, the conspirators +drew together in a knot; it was just an opera, the drums coming in at +proper intervals, the tenor, baritone, and bass all where they should +be—except that the voices were all of the same calibre. A woman once +sang from the back row with a very fine contralto voice spoilt by being +made artificially nasal; I notice all the women affect that +unpleasantness. At one time a boy of angelic beauty was the soloist; and +at another, a child of six or eight, doubtless an infant phenomenon being +trained, was placed in the centre. The little fellow was desperately +frightened and embarrassed at first, but towards the close warmed up to +his work and showed much dramatic talent. The changing expressions on +the faces of the dancers were so speaking, that it seemed a great +stupidity not to understand them.’ + +Our neighbour at this performance, Karaiti, somewhat favours his +Butaritarian majesty in shape and feature, being, like him, portly, +bearded, and Oriental. In character he seems the reverse: alert, +smiling, jovial, jocular, industrious. At home in his own island, he +labours himself like a slave, and makes his people labour like a +slave-driver. He takes an interest in ideas. George the trader told him +about flying-machines. ‘Is that true, George?’ he asked. ‘It is in the +papers,’ replied George. ‘Well,’ said Karaiti, ‘if that man can do it +with machinery, I can do it without’; and he designed and made a pair of +wings, strapped them on his shoulders, went to the end of a pier, +launched himself into space, and fell bulkily into the sea. His wives +fished him out, for his wings hindered him in swimming. ‘George,’ said +he, pausing as he went up to change, ‘George, you lie.’ He had eight +wives, for his small realm still follows ancient customs; but he showed +embarrassment when this was mentioned to my wife. ‘Tell her I have only +brought one here,’ he said anxiously. Altogether the Black Douglas +pleased us much; and as we heard fresh details of the king’s uneasiness, +and saw for ourselves that all the weapons in the summer parlour had been +hid, we watched with the more admiration the cause of all this anxiety +rolling on his big legs, with his big smiling face, apparently unarmed, +and certainly unattended, through the hostile town. The Red Douglas, +pot-bellied Kuma, having perhaps heard word of the debauch, remained upon +his fief; his vassals thus came uncommanded to the feast, and swelled the +following of Karaiti. + +_Friday_, _July_ 26.—At night in the dark, the singers of Makin paraded +in the road before our house and sang the song of the princess. ‘This is +the day; she was born to-day; Nei Kamaunave was born to-day—a beautiful +princess, Queen of Butaritari.’ So I was told it went in endless +iteration. The song was of course out of season, and the performance +only a rehearsal. But it was a serenade besides; a delicate attention to +ourselves from our new friend, Karaiti. + +_Saturday_, _July_ 27.—We had announced a performance of the magic +lantern to-night in church; and this brought the king to visit us. In +honour of the Black Douglas (I suppose) his usual two guardsmen were now +increased to four; and the squad made an outlandish figure as they +straggled after him, in straw hats, kilts and jackets. Three carried +their arms reversed, the butts over their shoulders, the muzzles menacing +the king’s plump back; the fourth had passed his weapon behind his neck, +and held it there with arms extended like a backboard. The visit was +extraordinarily long. The king, no longer galvanised with gin, said and +did nothing. He sat collapsed in a chair and let a cigar go out. It was +hot, it was sleepy, it was cruel dull; there was no resource but to spy +in the countenance of Tebureimoa for some remaining trait of _Mr. Corpse_ +the butcher. His hawk nose, crudely depressed and flattened at the +point, did truly seem to us to smell of midnight murder. When he took +his leave, Maka bade me observe him going down the stair (or rather +ladder) from the verandah. ‘Old man,’ said Maka. ‘Yes,’ said I, ‘and +yet I suppose not old man.’ ‘Young man,’ returned Maka, ‘perhaps fo’ty.’ +And I have heard since he is most likely younger. + +While the magic lantern was showing, I skulked without in the dark. The +voice of Maka, excitedly explaining the Scripture slides, seemed to fill +not the church only, but the neighbourhood. All else was silent. +Presently a distant sound of singing arose and approached; and a +procession drew near along the road, the hot clean smell of the men and +women striking in my face delightfully. At the corner, arrested by the +voice of Maka and the lightening and darkening of the church, they +paused. They had no mind to go nearer, that was plain. They were Makin +people, I believe, probably staunch heathens, contemners of the +missionary and his works. Of a sudden, however, a man broke from their +company, took to his heels, and fled into the church; next moment three +had followed him; the next it was a covey of near upon a score, all +pelting for their lives. So the little band of the heathen paused +irresolute at the corner, and melted before the attractions of a magic +lantern, like a glacier in spring. The more staunch vainly taunted the +deserters; three fled in a guilty silence, but still fled; and when at +length the leader found the wit or the authority to get his troop in +motion and revive the singing, it was with much diminished forces that +they passed musically on up the dark road. + +Meanwhile inside the luminous pictures brightened and faded. I stood for +some while unobserved in the rear of the spectators, when I could hear +just in front of me a pair of lovers following the show with interest, +the male playing the part of interpreter and (like Adam) mingling +caresses with his lecture. The wild animals, a tiger in particular, and +that old school-treat favourite, the sleeper and the mouse, were hailed +with joy; but the chief marvel and delight was in the gospel series. +Maka, in the opinion of his aggrieved wife, did not properly rise to the +occasion. ‘What is the matter with the man? Why can’t he talk?’ she +cried. The matter with the man, I think, was the greatness of the +opportunity; he reeled under his good fortune; and whether he did ill or +well, the exposure of these pious ‘phantoms’ did as a matter of fact +silence in all that part of the island the voice of the scoffer. ‘Why +then,’ the word went round, ‘why then, the Bible is true!’ And on our +return afterwards we were told the impression was yet lively, and those +who had seen might be heard telling those who had not, ‘O yes, it is all +true; these things all happened, we have seen the pictures.’ The +argument is not so childish as it seems; for I doubt if these islanders +are acquainted with any other mode of representation but photography; so +that the picture of an event (on the old melodrama principle that ‘the +camera cannot lie, Joseph,’) would appear strong proof of its occurrence. +The fact amused us the more because our slides were some of them +ludicrously silly, and one (Christ before Pilate) was received with +shouts of merriment, in which even Maka was constrained to join. + +_Sunday_, _July_ 28.—Karaiti came to ask for a repetition of the +‘phantoms’—this was the accepted word—and, having received a promise, +turned and left my humble roof without the shadow of a salutation. I +felt it impolite to have the least appearance of pocketing a slight; the +times had been too difficult, and were still too doubtful; and Queen +Victoria’s son was bound to maintain the honour of his house. Karaiti +was accordingly summoned that evening to the Ricks, where Mrs. Rick fell +foul of him in words, and Queen Victoria’s son assailed him with +indignant looks. I was the ass with the lion’s skin; I could not roar in +the language of the Gilbert Islands; but I could stare. Karaiti declared +he had meant no offence; apologised in a sound, hearty, gentlemanly +manner; and became at once at his ease. He had in a dagger to examine, +and announced he would come to price it on the morrow, to-day being +Sunday; this nicety in a heathen with eight wives surprised me. The +dagger was ‘good for killing fish,’ he said roguishly; and was supposed +to have his eye upon fish upon two legs. It is at least odd that in +Eastern Polynesia fish was the accepted euphemism for the human +sacrifice. Asked as to the population of his island, Karaiti called out +to his vassals who sat waiting him outside the door, and they put it at +four hundred and fifty; but (added Karaiti jovially) there will soon be +plenty more, for all the women are in the family way. Long before we +separated I had quite forgotten his offence. He, however, still bore it +in mind; and with a very courteous inspiration returned early on the next +day, paid us a long visit, and punctiliously said farewell when he +departed. + +_Monday_, _July_ 29.—The great day came round at last. In the first +hours the night was startled by the sound of clapping hands and the chant +of Nei Kamaunava; its melancholy, slow, and somewhat menacing measures +broken at intervals by a formidable shout. The little morsel of humanity +thus celebrated in the dark hours was observed at midday playing on the +green entirely naked, and equally unobserved and unconcerned. + +The summer parlour on its artificial islet, relieved against the +shimmering lagoon, and shimmering itself with sun and tinned iron, was +all day crowded about by eager men and women. Within, it was boxed full +of islanders, of any age and size, and in every degree of nudity and +finery. So close we squatted, that at one time I had a mighty handsome +woman on my knees, two little naked urchins having their feet against my +back. There might be a dame in full attire of _holoku_ and hat and +flowers; and her next neighbour might the next moment strip some little +rag of a shift from her fat shoulders and come out a monument of flesh, +painted rather than covered by the hairbreadth _ridi_. Little ladies who +thought themselves too great to appear undraped upon so high a festival +were seen to pause outside in the bright sunshine, their miniature ridis +in their hand; a moment more and they were full-dressed and entered the +concert-room. + +At either end stood up to sing, or sat down to rest, the alternate +companies of singers; Kuma and Little Makin on the north, Butaritari and +its conjunct hamlets on the south; both groups conspicuous in barbaric +bravery. In the midst, between these rival camps of troubadours, a bench +was placed; and here the king and queen throned it, some two or three +feet above the crowded audience on the floor—Tebureimoa as usual in his +striped pyjamas with a satchel strapped across one shoulder, doubtless +(in the island fashion) to contain his pistols; the queen in a purple +_holoku_, her abundant hair let down, a fan in her hand. The bench was +turned facing to the strangers, a piece of well-considered civility; and +when it was the turn of Butaritari to sing, the pair must twist round on +the bench, lean their elbows on the rail, and turn to us the spectacle of +their broad backs. The royal couple occasionally solaced themselves with +a clay pipe; and the pomp of state was further heightened by the rifles +of a picket of the guard. + +With this kingly countenance, and ourselves squatted on the ground, we +heard several songs from one side or the other. Then royalty and its +guards withdrew, and Queen Victoria’s son and daughter-in-law were +summoned by acclamation to the vacant throne. Our pride was perhaps a +little modified when we were joined on our high places by a certain +thriftless loafer of a white; and yet I was glad too, for the man had a +smattering of native, and could give me some idea of the subject of the +songs. One was patriotic, and dared Tembinok’ of Apemama, the terror of +the group, to an invasion. One mixed the planting of taro and the +harvest-home. Some were historical, and commemorated kings and the +illustrious chances of their time, such as a bout of drinking or a war. +One, at least, was a drama of domestic interest, excellently played by +the troop from Makin. It told the story of a man who has lost his wife, +at first bewails her loss, then seeks another: the earlier strains (or +acts) are played exclusively by men; but towards the end a woman appears, +who has just lost her husband; and I suppose the pair console each other, +for the finale seemed of happy omen. Of some of the songs my informant +told me briefly they were ‘like about the _weemen_’; this I could have +guessed myself. Each side (I should have said) was strengthened by one +or two women. They were all soloists, did not very often join in the +performance, but stood disengaged at the back part of the stage, and +looked (in _ridi_, necklace, and dressed hair) for all the world like +European ballet-dancers. When the song was anyway broad these ladies +came particularly to the front; and it was singular to see that, after +each entry, the _première danseuse_ pretended to be overcome by shame, as +though led on beyond what she had meant, and her male assistants made a +feint of driving her away like one who had disgraced herself. Similar +affectations accompany certain truly obscene dances of Samoa, where they +are very well in place. Here it was different. The words, perhaps, in +this free-spoken world, were gross enough to make a carter blush; and the +most suggestive feature was this feint of shame. For such parts the +women showed some disposition; they were pert, they were neat, they were +acrobatic, they were at times really amusing, and some of them were +pretty. But this is not the artist’s field; there is the whole width of +heaven between such capering and ogling, and the strange rhythmic +gestures, and strange, rapturous, frenzied faces with which the best of +the male dancers held us spellbound through a Gilbert Island ballet. + +Almost from the first it was apparent that the people of the city were +defeated. I might have thought them even good, only I had the other +troop before my eyes to correct my standard, and remind me continually of +‘the little more, and how much it is.’ Perceiving themselves worsted, +the choir of Butaritari grew confused, blundered, and broke down; amid +this hubbub of unfamiliar intervals I should not myself have recognised +the slip, but the audience were quick to catch it, and to jeer. To crown +all, the Makin company began a dance of truly superlative merit. I know +not what it was about, I was too much absorbed to ask. In one act a part +of the chorus, squealing in some strange falsetto, produced very much the +effect of our orchestra; in another, the dancers, leaping like +jumping-jacks, with arms extended, passed through and through each +other’s ranks with extraordinary speed, neatness, and humour. A more +laughable effect I never saw; in any European theatre it would have +brought the house down, and the island audience roared with laughter and +applause. This filled up the measure for the rival company, and they +forgot themselves and decency. After each act or figure of the ballet, +the performers pause a moment standing, and the next is introduced by the +clapping of hands in triplets. Not until the end of the whole ballet do +they sit down, which is the signal for the rivals to stand up. But now +all rules were to be broken. During the interval following on this great +applause, the company of Butaritari leaped suddenly to their feet and +most unhandsomely began a performance of their own. It was strange to +see the men of Makin staring; I have seen a tenor in Europe stare with +the same blank dignity into a hissing theatre; but presently, to my +surprise, they sobered down, gave up the unsung remainder of their +ballet, resumed their seats, and suffered their ungallant adversaries to +go on and finish. Nothing would suffice. Again, at the first interval, +Butaritari unhandsomely cut in; Makin, irritated in turn, followed the +example; and the two companies of dancers remained permanently standing, +continuously clapping hands, and regularly cutting across each other at +each pause. I expected blows to begin with any moment; and our position +in the midst was highly unstrategical. But the Makin people had a better +thought; and upon a fresh interruption turned and trooped out of the +house. We followed them, first because these were the artists, second +because they were guests and had been scurvily ill-used. A large +population of our neighbours did the same, so that the causeway was +filled from end to end by the procession of deserters; and the Butaritari +choir was left to sing for its own pleasure in an empty house, having +gained the point and lost the audience. It was surely fortunate that +there was no one drunk; but, drunk or sober, where else would a scene so +irritating have concluded without blows? + +The last stage and glory of this auspicious day was of our own +providing—the second and positively the last appearance of the phantoms. +All round the church, groups sat outside, in the night, where they could +see nothing; perhaps ashamed to enter, certainly finding some shadowy +pleasure in the mere proximity. Within, about one-half of the great shed +was densely packed with people. In the midst, on the royal dais, the +lantern luminously smoked; chance rays of light struck out the earnest +countenance of our Chinaman grinding the hand-organ; a fainter glimmer +showed off the rafters and their shadows in the hollow of the roof; the +pictures shone and vanished on the screen; and as each appeared, there +would run a hush, a whisper, a strong shuddering rustle, and a chorus of +small cries among the crowd. There sat by me the mate of a wrecked +schooner. ‘They would think this a strange sight in Europe or the +States,’ said he, ‘going on in a building like this, all tied with bits +of string.’ + + + +CHAPTER VII—HUSBAND AND WIFE + + +The trader accustomed to the manners of Eastern Polynesia has a lesson to +learn among the Gilberts. The _ridi_ is but a spare attire; as late as +thirty years back the women went naked until marriage; within ten years +the custom lingered; and these facts, above all when heard in +description, conveyed a very false idea of the manners of the group. A +very intelligent missionary described it (in its former state) as a +‘Paradise of naked women’ for the resident whites. It was at least a +platonic Paradise, where Lothario ventured at his peril. Since 1860, +fourteen whites have perished on a single island, all for the same cause, +all found where they had no business, and speared by some indignant +father of a family; the figure was given me by one of their +contemporaries who had been more prudent and survived. The strange +persistence of these fourteen martyrs might seem to point to monomania or +a series of romantic passions; gin is the more likely key. The poor +buzzards sat alone in their houses by an open case; they drank; their +brain was fired; they stumbled towards the nearest houses on chance; and +the dart went through their liver. In place of a Paradise the trader +found an archipelago of fierce husbands and of virtuous women. ‘Of +course if you wish to make love to them, it’s the same as anywhere else,’ +observed a trader innocently; but he and his companions rarely so choose. + +The trader must be credited with a virtue: he often makes a kind and +loyal husband. Some of the worst beachcombers in the Pacific, some of +the last of the old school, have fallen in my path, and some of them were +admirable to their native wives, and one made a despairing widower. The +position of a trader’s wife in the Gilberts is, besides, unusually +enviable. She shares the immunities of her husband. Curfew in +Butaritari sounds for her in vain. Long after the bell is rung and the +great island ladies are confined for the night to their own roof, this +chartered libertine may scamper and giggle through the deserted streets +or go down to bathe in the dark. The resources of the store are at her +hand; she goes arrayed like a queen, and feasts delicately everyday upon +tinned meats. And she who was perhaps of no regard or station among +natives sits with captains, and is entertained on board of schooners. +Five of these privileged dames were some time our neighbours. Four were +handsome skittish lasses, gamesome like children, and like children +liable to fits of pouting. They wore dresses by day, but there was a +tendency after dark to strip these lendings and to career and squall +about the compound in the aboriginal _ridi_. Games of cards were +continually played, with shells for counters; their course was much +marred by cheating; and the end of a round (above all if a man was of the +party) resolved itself into a scrimmage for the counters. The fifth was +a matron. It was a picture to see her sail to church on a Sunday, a +parasol in hand, a nursemaid following, and the baby buried in a trade +hat and armed with a patent feeding-bottle. The service was enlivened by +her continual supervision and correction of the maid. It was impossible +not to fancy the baby was a doll, and the church some European playroom. +All these women were legitimately married. It is true that the +certificate of one, when she proudly showed it, proved to run thus, that +she was ‘married for one night,’ and her gracious partner was at liberty +to ‘send her to hell’ the next morning; but she was none the wiser or the +worse for the dastardly trick. Another, I heard, was married on a work +of mine in a pirated edition; it answered the purpose as well as a Hall +Bible. Notwithstanding all these allurements of social distinction, rare +food and raiment, a comparative vacation from toil, and legitimate +marriage contracted on a pirated edition, the trader must sometimes seek +long before he can be mated. While I was in the group one had been eight +months on the quest, and he was still a bachelor. + +Within strictly native society the old laws and practices were harsh, but +not without a certain stamp of high-mindedness. Stealthy adultery was +punished with death; open elopement was properly considered virtue in +comparison, and compounded for a fine in land. The male adulterer alone +seems to have been punished. It is correct manners for a jealous man to +hang himself; a jealous woman has a different remedy—she bites her rival. +Ten or twenty years ago it was a capital offence to raise a woman’s +_ridi_; to this day it is still punished with a heavy fine; and the +garment itself is still symbolically sacred. Suppose a piece of land to +be disputed in Butaritari, the claimant who shall first hang a _ridi_ on +the tapu-post has gained his cause, since no one can remove or touch it +but himself. + +The _ridi_ was the badge not of the woman but the wife, the mark not of +her sex but of her station. It was the collar on the slave’s neck, the +brand on merchandise. The adulterous woman seems to have been spared; +were the husband offended, it would be a poor consolation to send his +draught cattle to the shambles. Karaiti, to this day, calls his eight +wives ‘his horses,’ some trader having explained to him the employment of +these animals on farms; and Nanteitei hired out his wives to do +mason-work. Husbands, at least when of high rank, had the power of life +and death; even whites seem to have possessed it; and their wives, when +they had transgressed beyond forgiveness, made haste to pronounce the +formula of deprecation—_I Kana Kim_. This form of words had so much +virtue that a condemned criminal repeating it on a particular day to the +king who had condemned him, must be instantly released. It is an offer +of abasement, and, strangely enough, the reverse—the imitation—is a +common vulgar insult in Great Britain to this day. I give a scene +between a trader and his Gilbert Island wife, as it was told me by the +husband, now one of the oldest residents, but then a freshman in the +group. + +‘Go and light a fire,’ said the trader, ‘and when I have brought this oil +I will cook some fish.’ The woman grunted at him, island fashion. ‘I am +not a pig that you should grunt at me,’ said he. + +‘I know you are not a pig,’ said the woman, ‘neither am I your slave.’ + +‘To be sure you are not my slave, and if you do not care to stop with me, +you had better go home to your people,’ said he. ‘But in the mean time +go and light the fire; and when I have brought this oil I will cook some +fish.’ + +She went as if to obey; and presently when the trader looked she had +built a fire so big that the cook-house was catching in flames. + +‘_I Kana Kim_!’ she cried, as she saw him coming; but he recked not, and +hit her with a cooking-pot. The leg pierced her skull, blood spouted, it +was thought she was a dead woman, and the natives surrounded the house in +a menacing expectation. Another white was present, a man of older +experience. ‘You will have us both killed if you go on like this,’ he +cried. ‘She had said _I Kana Kim_!’ If she had not said _I Kana Kim_ he +might have struck her with a caldron. It was not the blow that made the +crime, but the disregard of an accepted formula. + +Polygamy, the particular sacredness of wives, their semi-servile state, +their seclusion in kings’ harems, even their privilege of biting, all +would seem to indicate a Mohammedan society and the opinion of the +soullessness of woman. And not so in the least. It is a mere +appearance. After you have studied these extremes in one house, you may +go to the next and find all reversed, the woman the mistress, the man +only the first of her thralls. The authority is not with the husband as +such, nor the wife as such. It resides in the chief or the chief-woman; +in him or her who has inherited the lands of the clan, and stands to the +clansman in the place of parent, exacting their service, answerable for +their fines. There is but the one source of power and the one ground of +dignity—rank. The king married a chief-woman; she became his menial, and +must work with her hands on Messrs. Wightman’s pier. The king divorced +her; she regained at once her former state and power. She married the +Hawaiian sailor, and behold the man is her flunkey and can be shown the +door at pleasure. Nay, and such low-born lords are even corrected +physically, and, like grown but dutiful children, must endure the +discipline. + +We were intimate in one such household, that of Nei Takauti and Nan Tok’; +I put the lady first of necessity. During one week of fool’s paradise, +Mrs. Stevenson had gone alone to the sea-side of the island after shells. +I am very sure the proceeding was unsafe; and she soon perceived a man +and woman watching her. Do what she would, her guardians held her +steadily in view; and when the afternoon began to fall, and they thought +she had stayed long enough, took her in charge, and by signs and broken +English ordered her home. On the way the lady drew from her earring-hole +a clay pipe, the husband lighted it, and it was handed to my unfortunate +wife, who knew not how to refuse the incommodious favour; and when they +were all come to our house, the pair sat down beside her on the floor, +and improved the occasion with prayer. From that day they were our +family friends; bringing thrice a day the beautiful island garlands of +white flowers, visiting us any evening, and frequently carrying us down +to their own maniap’ in return, the woman leading Mrs. Stevenson by the +hand like one child with another. + +Nan Tok’, the husband, was young, extremely handsome, of the most +approved good humour, and suffering in his precarious station from +suppressed high spirits. Nei Takauti, the wife, was getting old; her +grown son by a former marriage had just hanged himself before his +mother’s eyes in despair at a well-merited rebuke. Perhaps she had never +been beautiful, but her face was full of character, her eye of sombre +fire. She was a high chief-woman, but by a strange exception for a +person of her rank, was small, spare, and sinewy, with lean small hands +and corded neck. Her full dress of an evening was invariably a white +chemise—and for adornment, green leaves (or sometimes white blossoms) +stuck in her hair and thrust through her huge earring-holes. The husband +on the contrary changed to view like a kaleidoscope. Whatever pretty +thing my wife might have given to Nei Takauti—a string of beads, a +ribbon, a piece of bright fabric—appeared the next evening on the person +of Nan Tok’. It was plain he was a clothes-horse; that he wore livery; +that, in a word, he was his wife’s wife. They reversed the parts indeed, +down to the least particular; it was the husband who showed himself the +ministering angel in the hour of pain, while the wife displayed the +apathy and heartlessness of the proverbial man. + +When Nei Takauti had a headache Nan Tok’ was full of attention and +concern. When the husband had a cold and a racking toothache the wife +heeded not, except to jeer. It is always the woman’s part to fill and +light the pipe; Nei Takauti handed hers in silence to the wedded page; +but she carried it herself, as though the page were not entirely trusted. +Thus she kept the money, but it was he who ran the errands, anxiously +sedulous. A cloud on her face dimmed instantly his beaming looks; on an +early visit to their maniap’ my wife saw he had cause to be wary. Nan +Tok’ had a friend with him, a giddy young thing, of his own age and sex; +and they had worked themselves into that stage of jocularity when +consequences are too often disregarded. Nei Takauti mentioned her own +name. Instantly Nan Tok’ held up two fingers, his friend did likewise, +both in an ecstasy of slyness. It was plain the lady had two names; and +from the nature of their merriment, and the wrath that gathered on her +brow, there must be something ticklish in the second. The husband +pronounced it; a well-directed cocoa-nut from the hand of his wife caught +him on the side of the head, and the voices and the mirth of these +indiscreet young gentlemen ceased for the day. + +The people of Eastern Polynesia are never at a loss; their etiquette is +absolute and plenary; in every circumstance it tells them what to do and +how to do it. The Gilbertines are seemingly more free, and pay for their +freedom (like ourselves) in frequent perplexity. This was often the case +with the topsy-turvy couple. We had once supplied them during a visit +with a pipe and tobacco; and when they had smoked and were about to +leave, they found themselves confronted with a problem: should they take +or leave what remained of the tobacco? The piece of plug was taken up, +it was laid down again, it was handed back and forth, and argued over, +till the wife began to look haggard and the husband elderly. They ended +by taking it, and I wager were not yet clear of the compound before they +were sure they had decided wrong. Another time they had been given each +a liberal cup of coffee, and Nan Tok’ with difficulty and disaffection +made an end of his. Nei Takauti had taken some, she had no mind for +more, plainly conceived it would be a breach of manners to set down the +cup unfinished, and ordered her wedded retainer to dispose of what was +left. ‘I have swallowed all I can, I cannot swallow more, it is a +physical impossibility,’ he seemed to say; and his stern officer +reiterated her commands with secret imperative signals. Luckless dog! +but in mere humanity we came to the rescue and removed the cup. + +I cannot but smile over this funny household; yet I remember the good +souls with affection and respect. Their attention to ourselves was +surprising. The garlands are much esteemed, the blossoms must be sought +far and wide; and though they had many retainers to call to their aid, we +often saw themselves passing afield after the blossoms, and the wife +engaged with her own in putting them together. It was no want of only +that disregard so incident to husbands, that made Nei Takauti despise the +sufferings of Nan Tok’. When my wife was unwell she proved a diligent +and kindly nurse; and the pair, to the extreme embarrassment of the +sufferer, became fixtures in the sick-room. This rugged, capable, +imperious old dame, with the wild eyes, had deep and tender qualities: +her pride in her young husband it seemed that she dissembled, fearing +possibly to spoil him; and when she spoke of her dead son there came +something tragic in her face. But I seemed to trace in the Gilbertines a +virility of sense and sentiment which distinguishes them (like their +harsh and uncouth language) from their brother islanders in the east. + + + + +PART IV: THE GILBERTS—APEMAMA + + +CHAPTER I—THE KING OF APEMAMA: THE ROYAL TRADER + + +There is one great personage in the Gilberts: Tembinok’ of Apemama: +solely conspicuous, the hero of song, the butt of gossip. Through the +rest of the group the kings are slain or fallen in tutelage: Tembinok’ +alone remains, the last tyrant, the last erect vestige of a dead society. +The white man is everywhere else, building his houses, drinking his gin, +getting in and out of trouble with the weak native governments. There is +only one white on Apemama, and he on sufferance, living far from court, +and hearkening and watching his conduct like a mouse in a cat’s ear. +Through all the other islands a stream of native visitors comes and goes, +travelling by families, spending years on the grand tour. Apemama alone +is left upon one side, the tourist dreading to risk himself within the +clutch of Tembinok’. And fear of the same Gorgon follows and troubles +them at home. Maiana once paid him tribute; he once fell upon and seized +Nonuti: first steps to the empire of the archipelago. A British warship +coming on the scene, the conqueror was driven to disgorge, his career +checked in the outset, his dear-bought armoury sunk in his own lagoon. +But the impression had been made; periodical fear of him still shakes the +islands; rumour depicts him mustering his canoes for a fresh onfall; +rumour can name his destination; and Tembinok’ figures in the patriotic +war-songs of the Gilberts like Napoleon in those of our grandfathers. + +We were at sea, bound from Mariki to Nonuti and Tapituea, when the wind +came suddenly fair for Apemama. The course was at once changed; all +hands were turned-to to clean ship, the decks holy-stoned, all the cabin +washed, the trade-room overhauled. In all our cruising we never saw the +_Equator_ so smart as she was made for Tembinok’. Nor was Captain Reid +alone in these coquetries; for, another schooner chancing to arrive +during my stay in Apemama, I found that she also was dandified for the +occasion. And the two cases stand alone in my experience of South Sea +traders. + +We had on board a family of native tourists, from the grandsire to the +babe in arms, trying (against an extraordinary series of ill-luck) to +regain their native island of Peru. {275} Five times already they had +paid their fare and taken ship; five times they had been disappointed, +dropped penniless upon strange islands, or carried back to Butaritari, +whence they sailed. This last attempt had been no better-starred; their +provisions were exhausted. Peru was beyond hope, and they had cheerfully +made up their minds to a fresh stage of exile in Tapituea or Nonuti. +With this slant of wind their random destination became once more +changed; and like the Calendar’s pilot, when the ‘black mountains’ hove +in view, they changed colour and beat upon their breasts. Their camp, +which was on deck in the ship’s waist, resounded with complaint. They +would be set to work, they must become slaves, escape was hopeless, they +must live and toil and die in Apemama, in the tyrant’s den. With this +sort of talk they so greatly terrified their children, that one (a big +hulking boy) must at last be torn screaming from the schooner’s side. +And their fears were wholly groundless. I have little doubt they were +not suffered to be idle; but I can vouch for it that they were kindly and +generously used. For, the matter of a year later, I was once more +shipmate with these inconsistent wanderers on board the _Janet Nicoll_. +Their fare was paid by Tembinok’; they who had gone ashore from the +_Equator_ destitute, reappeared upon the _Janet_ with new clothes, laden +with mats and presents, and bringing with them a magazine of food, on +which they lived like fighting-cocks throughout the voyage; I saw them at +length repatriated, and I must say they showed more concern on quitting +Apemama than delight at reaching home. + +We entered by the north passage (Sunday, September 1st), dodging among +shoals. It was a day of fierce equatorial sunshine; but the breeze was +strong and chill; and the mate, who conned the schooner from the +cross-trees, returned shivering to the deck. The lagoon was thick with +many-tinted wavelets; a continuous roaring of the outer sea overhung the +anchorage; and the long, hollow crescent of palm ruffled and sparkled in +the wind. Opposite our berth the beach was seen to be surmounted for +some distance by a terrace of white coral seven or eight feet high and +crowned in turn by the scattered and incongruous buildings of the palace. +The village adjoins on the south, a cluster of high-roofed maniap’s. And +village and palace seemed deserted. + +We were scarce yet moored, however, before distant and busy figures +appeared upon the beach, a boat was launched, and a crew pulled out to us +bringing the king’s ladder. Tembinok’ had once an accident; has feared +ever since to entrust his person to the rotten chandlery of South Sea +traders; and devised in consequence a frame of wood, which is brought on +board a ship as soon as she appears, and remains lashed to her side until +she leave. The boat’s crew, having applied this engine, returned at once +to shore. They might not come on board; neither might we land, or not +without danger of offence; the king giving pratique in person. An +interval followed, during which dinner was delayed for the great man—the +prelude of the ladder, giving us some notion of his weighty body and +sensible, ingenious character, had highly whetted our curiosity; and it +was with something like excitement that we saw the beach and terrace +suddenly blacken with attendant vassals, the king and party embark, the +boat (a man-of-war gig) come flying towards us dead before the wind, and +the royal coxswain lay us cleverly aboard, mount the ladder with a +jealous diffidence, and descend heavily on deck. + +Not long ago he was overgrown with fat, obscured to view, and a burthen +to himself. Captains visiting the island advised him to walk; and though +it broke the habits of a life and the traditions of his rank, he +practised the remedy with benefit. His corpulence is now portable; you +would call him lusty rather than fat; but his gait is still dull, +stumbling, and elephantine. He neither stops nor hastens, but goes about +his business with an implacable deliberation. We could never see him and +not be struck with his extraordinary natural means for the theatre: a +beaked profile like Dante’s in the mask, a mane of long black hair, the +eye brilliant, imperious, and inquiring: for certain parts, and to one +who could have used it, the face was a fortune. His voice matched it +well, being shrill, powerful, and uncanny, with a note like a sea-bird’s. +Where there are no fashions, none to set them, few to follow them if they +were set, and none to criticise, he dresses—as Sir Charles Grandison +lived—‘to his own heart.’ Now he wears a woman’s frock, now a naval +uniform; now (and more usually) figures in a masquerade costume of his +own design: trousers and a singular jacket with shirt tails, the cut and +fit wonderful for island workmanship, the material always handsome, +sometimes green velvet, sometimes cardinal red silk. This masquerade +becomes him admirably. In the woman’s frock he looks ominous and weird +beyond belief. I see him now come pacing towards me in the cruel sun, +solitary, a figure out of Hoffmann. + +A visit on board ship, such as that at which we now assisted, makes a +chief part and by far the chief diversion of the life of Tembinok’. He +is not only the sole ruler, he is the sole merchant of his triple +kingdom, Apemama, Aranuka, and Kuria, well-planted islands. The taro +goes to the chiefs, who divide as they please among their immediate +adherents; but certain fish, turtles—which abound in Kuria,—and the whole +produce of the coco-palm, belong exclusively to Tembinok’. ‘A’ cobra +{279a} berong me,’ observed his majesty with a wave of his hand; and he +counts and sells it by the houseful. ‘You got copra, king?’ I have heard +a trader ask. ‘I got two, three outches,’ {279b} his majesty replied: ‘I +think three.’ Hence the commercial importance of Apemama, the trade of +three islands being centred there in a single hand; hence it is that so +many whites have tried in vain to gain or to preserve a footing; hence +ships are adorned, cooks have special orders, and captains array +themselves in smiles, to greet the king. If he be pleased with his +welcome and the fare he may pass days on board, and, every day, and +sometimes every hour, will be of profit to the ship. He oscillates +between the cabin, where he is entertained with strange meats, and the +trade-room, where he enjoys the pleasures of shopping on a scale to match +his person. A few obsequious attendants squat by the house door, +awaiting his least signal. In the boat, which has been suffered to drop +astern, one or two of his wives lie covered from the sun under mats, +tossed by the short sea of the lagoon, and enduring agonies of heat and +tedium. This severity is now and then relaxed and the wives allowed on +board. Three or four were thus favoured on the day of our arrival: +substantial ladies airily attired in _ridis_. Each had a share of copra, +her _peculium_, to dispose of for herself. The display in the +trade-room—hats, ribbbons, dresses, scents, tins of salmon—the pride of +the eye and the lust of the flesh—tempted them in vain. They had but the +one idea—tobacco, the island currency, tantamount to minted gold; +returned to shore with it, burthened but rejoicing; and late into the +night, on the royal terrace, were to be seen counting the sticks by +lamplight in the open air. + +The king is no such economist. He is greedy of things new and foreign. +House after house, chest after chest, in the palace precinct, is already +crammed with clocks, musical boxes, blue spectacles, umbrellas, knitted +waistcoats, bolts of stuff, tools, rifles, fowling-pieces, medicines, +European foods, sewing-machines, and, what is more extraordinary, stoves: +all that ever caught his eye, tickled his appetite, pleased him for its +use, or puzzled him with its apparent inutility. And still his lust is +unabated. He is possessed by the seven devils of the collector. He +hears a thing spoken of, and a shadow comes on his face. ‘I think I no +got him,’ he will say; and the treasures he has seem worthless in +comparison. If a ship be bound for Apemama, the merchant racks his brain +to hit upon some novelty. This he leaves carelessly in the main cabin or +partly conceals in his own berth, so that the king shall spy it for +himself. ‘How much you want?’ inquires Tembinok’, passing and pointing. +‘No, king; that too dear,’ returns the trader. ‘I think I like him,’ +says the king. This was a bowl of gold-fish. On another occasion it was +scented soap. ‘No, king; that cost too much,’ said the trader; ‘too good +for a Kanaka.’ ‘How much you got? I take him all,’ replied his majesty, +and became the lord of seventeen boxes at two dollars a cake. Or again, +the merchant feigns the article is not for sale, is private property, an +heirloom or a gift; and the trick infallibly succeeds. Thwart the king +and you hold him. His autocratic nature rears at the affront of +opposition. He accepts it for a challenge; sets his teeth like a hunter +going at a fence; and with no mark of emotion, scarce even of interest, +stolidly piles up the price. Thus, for our sins, he took a fancy to my +wife’s dressing-bag, a thing entirely useless to the man, and sadly +battered by years of service. Early one forenoon he came to our house, +sat down, and abruptly offered to purchase it. I told him I sold +nothing, and the bag at any rate was a present from a friend; but he was +acquainted with these pretexts from of old, and knew what they were worth +and how to meet them. Adopting what I believe is called ‘the object +method,’ he drew out a bag of English gold, sovereigns and +half-sovereigns, and began to lay them one by one in silence on the +table; at each fresh piece reading our faces with a look. In vain I +continued to protest I was no trader; he deigned not to reply. There +must have been twenty pounds on the table, he was still going on, and +irritation had begun to mingle with our embarrassment, when a happy idea +came to our delivery. Since his majesty thought so much of the bag, we +said, we must beg him to accept it as a present. It was the most +surprising turn in Tembinok’s experience. He perceived too late that his +persistence was unmannerly; hung his head a while in silence; then, +lifting up a sheepish countenance, ‘I ‘shamed,’ said the tyrant. It was +the first and the last time we heard him own to a flaw in his behaviour. +Half an hour after he sent us a camphor-wood chest worth only a few +dollars—but then heaven knows what Tembinok’ had paid for it. + +Cunning by nature, and versed for forty years in the government of men, +it must not be supposed that he is cheated blindly, or has resigned +himself without resistance to be the milch-cow of the passing trader. +His efforts have been even heroic. Like Nakaeia of Makin, he has owned +schooners. More fortunate than Nakaeia, he has found captains. Ships of +his have sailed as far as to the colonies. He has trafficked direct, in +his own bottoms, with New Zealand. And even so, even there, the +world-enveloping dishonesty of the white man prevented him; his profit +melted, his ship returned in debt, the money for the insurance was +embezzled, and when the _Coronet_ came to be lost, he was astonished to +find he had lost all. At this he dropped his weapons; owned he might as +hopefully wrestle with the winds of heaven; and like an experienced +sheep, submitted his fleece thenceforward to the shearers. He is the +last man in the world to waste anger on the incurable; accepts it with +cynical composure; asks no more in those he deals with than a certain +decency of moderation; drives as good a bargain as he can; and when he +considers he is more than usually swindled, writes it in his memory +against the merchant’s name. He once ran over to me a list of captains +and supercargoes with whom he had done business, classing them under +three heads: ‘He cheat a litty’—‘He cheat plenty’—and ‘I think he cheat +too much.’ For the first two classes he expressed perfect toleration; +sometimes, but not always, for the third. I was present when a certain +merchant was turned about his business, and was the means (having a +considerable influence ever since the bag) of patching up the dispute. +Even on the day of our arrival there was like to have been a hitch with +Captain Reid: the ground of which is perhaps worth recital. Among goods +exported specially for Tembinok’ there is a beverage known (and labelled) +as Hennessy’s brandy. It is neither Hennessy, nor even brandy; is about +the colour of sherry, but is not sherry; tastes of kirsch, and yet +neither is it kirsch. The king, at least, has grown used to this amazing +brand, and rather prides himself upon the taste; and any substitution is +a double offence, being at once to cheat him and to cast a doubt upon his +palate. A similar weakness is to be observed in all connoisseurs. Now +the last case sold by the _Equator_ was found to contain a different and +I would fondly fancy a superior distillation; and the conversation opened +very black for Captain Reid. But Tembinok’ is a moderate man. He was +reminded and admitted that all men were liable to error, even himself; +accepted the principle that a fault handsomely acknowledged should be +condoned; and wound the matter up with this proposal: ‘Tuppoti {283} I +mi’take, you ’peakee me. Tuppoti you mi’take, I ’peakee you. Mo’ +betta.’ + +After dinner and supper in the cabin, a glass or two of ‘Hennetti’—the +genuine article this time, with the kirsch bouquet,—and five hours’ +lounging on the trade-room counter, royalty embarked for home. Three +tacks grounded the boat before the palace; the wives were carried ashore +on the backs of vassals; Tembinok’ stepped on a railed platform like a +steamer’s gangway, and was borne shoulder high through the shallows, up +the beach, and by an inclined plane, paved with pebbles, to the glaring +terrace where he dwells. + + + +CHAPTER II—THE KING OF APEMAMA: FOUNDATION OF EQUATOR TOWN + + +Our first sight of Tembinok’ was a matter of concern, almost alarm, to my +whole party. We had a favour to seek; we must approach in the proper +courtly attitude of a suitor; and must either please him or fail in the +main purpose of our voyage. It was our wish to land and live in Apemama, +and see more near at hand the odd character of the man and the odd (or +rather ancient) condition of his island. In all other isles of the South +Seas a white man may land with his chest, and set up house for a +lifetime, if he choose, and if he have the money or the trade; no +hindrance is conceivable. But Apemama is a close island, lying there in +the sea with closed doors; the king himself, like a vigilant officer, +ready at the wicket to scrutinise and reject intrenching visitors. Hence +the attraction of our enterprise; not merely because it was a little +difficult, but because this social quarantine, a curiosity in itself, has +been the preservative of others. + +Tembinok’, like most tyrants, is a conservative; like many conservatives, +he eagerly welcomes new ideas, and, except in the field of politics, +leans to practical reform. When the missionaries came, professing a +knowledge of the truth, he readily received them; attended their worship, +acquired the accomplishment of public prayer, and made himself a student +at their feet. It is thus—it is by the cultivation of similar passing +chances—that he has learned to read, to write, to cipher, and to speak +his queer, personal English, so different from ordinary ‘Beach de Mar,’ +so much more obscure, expressive, and condensed. His education attended +to, he found time to become critical of the new inmates. Like Nakaeia of +Makin, he is an admirer of silence in the island; broods over it like a +great ear; has spies who report daily; and had rather his subjects sang +than talked. The service, and in particular the sermon, were thus sure +to become offences: ‘Here, in my island, _I_ ’peak,’ he once observed to +me. ‘My chieps no ’peak—do what I talk.’ He looked at the missionary, +and what did he see? ‘See Kanaka ’peak in a big outch!’ he cried, with a +strong ring of sarcasm. Yet he endured the subversive spectacle, and +might even have continued to endure it, had not a fresh point arisen. He +looked again, to employ his own figure; and the Kanaka was no longer +speaking, he was doing worse—he was building a copra-house. The king was +touched in his chief interests; revenue and prerogative were threatened. +He considered besides (and some think with him) that trade is +incompatible with the missionary claims. ‘Tuppoti mitonary think “good +man”: very good. Tuppoti he think “cobra”: no good. I send him away +ship.’ Such was his abrupt history of the evangelist in Apemama. + +Similar deportations are common: ‘I send him away ship’ is the epitaph of +not a few, his majesty paying the exile’s fare to the next place of call. +For instance, being passionately fond of European food, he has several +times added to his household a white cook, and one after another these +have been deported. They, on their side, swear they were not paid their +wages; he, on his, that they robbed and swindled him beyond endurance: +both perhaps justly. A more important case was that of an agent, +despatched (as I heard the story) by a firm of merchants to worm his way +into the king’s good graces, become, if possible, premier, and handle the +copra in the interest of his employers. He obtained authority to land, +practised his fascinations, was patiently listened to by Tembinok’, +supposed himself on the highway to success; and behold! when the next +ship touched at Apemama, the would-be premier was flung into a boat—had +on board—his fare paid, and so good-bye. But it is needless to multiply +examples; the proof of the pudding is in the eating. When we came to +Apemama, of so many white men who have scrambled for a place in that rich +market, one remained—a silent, sober, solitary, niggardly recluse, of +whom the king remarks, ‘I think he good; he no ’peak.’ + +I was warned at the outset we might very well fail in our design: yet +never dreamed of what proved to be the fact, that we should be left +four-and-twenty hours in suspense and come within an ace of ultimate +rejection. Captain Reid had primed himself; no sooner was the king on +board, and the Hennetti question amicably settled, than he proceeded to +express my request and give an abstract of my claims and virtues. The +gammon about Queen Victoria’s son might do for Butaritari; it was out of +the question here; and I now figured as ‘one of the Old Men of England,’ +a person of deep knowledge, come expressly to visit Tembinok’s dominion, +and eager to report upon it to the no less eager Queen Victoria. The +king made no shadow of an answer, and presently began upon a different +subject. We might have thought that he had not heard, or not understood; +only that we found ourselves the subject of a constant study. As we sat +at meals, he took us in series and fixed upon each, for near a minute at +a time, the same hard and thoughtful stare. As he thus looked he seemed +to forget himself, the subject and the company, and to become absorbed in +the process of his thought; the look was wholly impersonal; I have seen +the same in the eyes of portrait-painters. The counts upon which whites +have been deported are mainly four: cheating Tembinok’, meddling overmuch +with copra, which is the source of his wealth, and one of the sinews of +his power, _’peaking_, and political intrigue. I felt guiltless upon +all; but how to show it? I would not have taken copra in a gift: how to +express that quality by my dinner-table bearing? The rest of the party +shared my innocence and my embarrassment. They shared also in my +mortification when after two whole meal-times and the odd moments of an +afternoon devoted to this reconnoitring, Tembinok’ took his leave in +silence. Next morning, the same undisguised study, the same silence, was +resumed; and the second day had come to its maturity before I was +informed abruptly that I had stood the ordeal. ‘I look your eye. You +good man. You no lie,’ said the king: a doubtful compliment to a writer +of romance. Later he explained he did not quite judge by the eye only, +but the mouth as well. ‘Tuppoti I see man,’ he explained. ‘I no tavvy +good man, bad man. I look eye, look mouth. Then I tavvy. Look _eye_, +look mouth,’ he repeated. And indeed in our case the mouth had the most +to do with it, and it was by our talk that we gained admission to the +island; the king promising himself (and I believe really amassing) a vast +amount of useful knowledge ere we left. + +The terms of our admission were as follows: We were to choose a site, and +the king should there build us a town. His people should work for us, +but the king only was to give them orders. One of his cooks should come +daily to help mine, and to learn of him. In case our stores ran out, he +would supply us, and be repaid on the return of the _Equator_. On the +other hand, he was to come to meals with us when so inclined; when he +stayed at home, a dish was to be sent him from our table; and I solemnly +engaged to give his subjects no liquor or money (both of which they are +forbidden to possess) and no tobacco, which they were to receive only +from the royal hand. I think I remember to have protested against the +stringency of this last article; at least, it was relaxed, and when a man +worked for me I was allowed to give him a pipe of tobacco on the +premises, but none to take away. + +The site of Equator City—we named our city for the schooner—was soon +chosen. The immediate shores of the lagoon are windy and blinding; +Tembinok’ himself is glad to grope blue-spectacled on his terrace; and we +fled the neighbourhood of the red _conjunctiva_, the suppurating eyeball, +and the beggar who pursues and beseeches the passing foreigner for eye +wash. Behind the town the country is diversified; here open, sandy, +uneven, and dotted with dwarfish palms; here cut up with taro trenches, +deep and shallow, and, according to the growth of the plants, presenting +now the appearance of a sandy tannery, now of an alleyed and green +garden. A path leads towards the sea, mounting abruptly to the main +level of the island—twenty or even thirty feet, although Findlay gives +five; and just hard by the top of the rise, where the coco-palms begin to +be well grown, we found a grove of pandanus, and a piece of soil +pleasantly covered with green underbush. A well was not far off under a +rustic well-house; nearer still, in a sandy cup of the land, a pond where +we might wash our clothes. The place was out of the wind, out of the +sun, and out of sight of the village. It was shown to the king, and the +town promised for the morrow. + +The morrow came, Mr. Osbourne landed, found nothing done, and carried his +complaint to Tembinok’. He heard it, rose, called for a Winchester, +stepped without the royal palisade, and fired two shots in the air. A +shot in the air is the first Apemama warning; it has the force of a +proclamation in more loquacious countries; and his majesty remarked +agreeably that it would make his labourers ‘mo’ bright.’ In less than +thirty minutes, accordingly, the men had mustered, the work was begun, +and we were told that we might bring our baggage when we pleased. + +It was two in the afternoon ere the first boat was beached, and the long +procession of chests and crates and sacks began to straggle through the +sandy desert towards Equator Town. The grove of pandanus was practically +a thing of the past. Fire surrounded and smoke rose in the green +underbush. In a wide circuit the axes were still crashing. Those very +advantages for which the place was chosen, it had been the king’s first +idea to abolish; and in the midst of this devastation there stood already +a good-sized maniap’ and a small closed house. A mat was spread near by +for Tembinok’; here he sat superintending, in cardinal red, a pith helmet +on his head, a meerschaum pipe in his mouth, a wife stretched at his back +with custody of the matches and tobacco. Twenty or thirty feet in front +of him the bulk of the workers squatted on the ground; some of the bush +here survived and in this the commons sat nearly to their shoulders, and +presented only an arc of brown faces, black heads, and attentive eyes +fixed on his majesty. Long pauses reigned, during which the subjects +stared and the king smoked. Then Tembinok’ would raise his voice and +speak shrilly and briefly. There was never a response in words; but if +the speech were jesting, there came by way of answer discreet, obsequious +laughter—such laughter as we hear in schoolrooms; and if it were +practical, the sudden uprising and departure of the squad. Twice they so +disappeared, and returned with further elements of the city: a second +house and a second maniap’. It was singular to spy, far off through the +coco stems, the silent oncoming of the maniap’, at first (it seemed) +swimming spontaneously in the air—but on a nearer view betraying under +the eaves many score of moving naked legs. In all the affair servile +obedience was no less remarkable than servile deliberation. The gang had +here mustered by the note of a deadly weapon; the man who looked on was +the unquestioned master of their lives; and except for civility, they +bestirred themselves like so many American hotel clerks. The spectator +was aware of an unobtrusive yet invincible inertia, at which the skipper +of a trading dandy might have torn his hair. + +Yet the work was accomplished. By dusk, when his majesty withdrew, the +town was founded and complete, a new and ruder Amphion having called it +from nothing with three cracks of a rifle. And the next morning the same +conjurer obliged us with a further miracle: a mystic rampart fencing us, +so that the path which ran by our doors became suddenly impassable, the +inhabitants who had business across the isle must fetch a wide circuit, +and we sat in the midst in a transparent privacy, seeing, seen, but +unapproachable, like bees in a glass hive. The outward and visible sign +of this glamour was no more than a few ragged coco-leaf garlands round +the stems of the outlying palms; but its significance reposed on the +tremendous sanction of the tapu and the guns of Tembinok’. + +We made our first meal that night in the improvised city, where we were +to stay two months, and which—so soon as we had done with it—was to +vanish in a day as it appeared, its elements returning whence they came, +the tapu raised, the traffic on the path resumed, the sun and the moon +peering in vain between the palm-trees for the bygone work, the wind +blowing over an empty site. Yet the place, which is now only an episode +in some memories, seemed to have been built, and to be destined to +endure, for years. It was a busy hamlet. One of the maniap’s we made +our dining-room, one the kitchen. The houses we reserved for sleeping. +They were on the admirable Apemama plan: out and away the best house in +the South Seas; standing some three feet above the ground on posts; the +sides of woven flaps, which can be raised to admit light and air, or +lowered to shut out the wind and the rain: airy, healthy, clean, and +watertight. We had a hen of a remarkable kind: almost unique in my +experience, being a hen that occasionally laid eggs. Not far off, Mrs. +Stevenson tended a garden of salad and shalots. The salad was devoured +by the hen—which was her bane. The shalots were served out a leaf at a +time, and welcomed and relished like peaches. Toddy and green cocoa-nuts +were brought us daily. We once had a present of fish from the king, and +once of a turtle. Sometimes we shot so-called plover along on the shore, +sometimes wild chicken in the bush. The rest of our diet was from tins. + +Our occupations were very various. While some of the party would be away +sketching, Mr. Osbourne and I hammered away at a novel. We read Gibbon +and Carlyle aloud; we blew on flageolets, we strummed on guitars; we took +photographs by the light of the sun, the moon, and flash-powder; +sometimes we played cards. Pot-hunting engaged a part of our leisure. I +have myself passed afternoons in the exciting but innocuous pursuit of +winged animals with a revolver; and it was fortunate there were better +shots of the party, and fortunate the king could lend us a more suitable +weapon, in the form of an excellent fowling-piece, or our spare diet had +been sparer still. + +Night was the time to see our city, after the moon was up, after the +lamps were lighted, and so long as the fire sparkled in the cook-house. +We suffered from a plague of flies and mosquitoes, comparable to that of +Egypt; our dinner-table (lent, like all our furniture, by the king) must +be enclosed in a tent of netting, our citadel and refuge; and this became +all luminous, and bulged and beaconed under the eaves, like the globe of +some monstrous lamp under the margin of its shade. Our cabins, the sides +being propped at a variety of inclinations, spelled out strange, angular +patterns of brightness. In his roofed and open kitchen, Ah Fu was to be +seen by lamp and firelight, dabbling among pots. Over all, there fell in +the season an extraordinary splendour of mellow moonshine. The sand +sparkled as with the dust of diamonds; the stars had vanished. At +intervals, a dusky night-bird, slow and low flying, passed in the +colonnade of the tree stems and uttered a hoarse croaking cry. + + + +CHAPTER III—THE KING OF APEMAMA: THE PALACE OF MANY WOMEN + + +The palace, or rather the ground which it includes, is several acres in +extent. A terrace encloses it toward the lagoon; on the side of the +land, a palisade with several gates. These are scarce intended for +defence; a man, if he were strong, might easily pluck down the palisade; +he need not be specially active to leap from the beach upon the terrace. +There is no parade of guards, soldiers, or weapons; the armoury is under +lock and key; and the only sentinels are certain inconspicuous old women +lurking day and night before the gates. By day, these crones were often +engaged in boiling syrup or the like household occupation; by night, they +lay ambushed in the shadow or crouched along the palisade, filling the +office of eunuchs to this harem, sole guards upon a tyrant life. + +Female wardens made a fit outpost for this palace of many women. Of the +number of the king’s wives I have no guess; and but a loose idea of their +function. He himself displayed embarrassment when they were referred to +as his wives, called them himself ‘my pamily,’ and explained they were +his ‘cutcheons’—cousins. We distinguished four of the crowd: the king’s +mother; his sister, a grave, trenchant woman, with much of her brother’s +intelligence; the queen proper, to whom (and to whom alone) my wife was +formally presented; and the favourite of the hour, a pretty, graceful +girl, who sat with the king daily, and once (when he shed tears) consoled +him with caresses. I am assured that even with her his relations are +platonic. In the background figured a multitude of ladies, the lean, the +plump, and the elephantine, some in sacque frocks, some in the +hairbreadth _ridi_; high-born and low, slave and mistress; from the queen +to the scullion, from the favourite to the scraggy sentries at the +palisade. Not all of these of course are of ‘my pamily,’—many are mere +attendants; yet a surprising number shared the responsibility of the +king’s trust. These were key-bearers, treasurers, wardens of the +armoury, the napery, and the stores. Each knew and did her part to +admiration. Should anything be required—a particular gun, perhaps, or a +particular bolt of stuff,—the right queen was summoned; she came bringing +the right chest, opened it in the king’s presence, and displayed her +charge in perfect preservation—the gun cleaned and oiled, the goods duly +folded. Without delay or haste, and with the minimum of speech, the +whole great establishment turned on wheels like a machine. Nowhere have +I seen order more complete and pervasive. And yet I was always reminded +of Norse tales of trolls and ogres who kept their hearts buried in the +ground for the mere safety, and must confide the secret to their wives. +For these weapons are the life of Tembinok’. He does not aim at +popularity; but drives and braves his subjects, with a simplicity of +domination which it is impossible not to admire, hard not to sympathise +with. Should one out of so many prove faithless, should the armoury be +secretly unlocked, should the crones have dozed by the palisade and the +weapons find their way unseen into the village, revolution would be +nearly certain, death the most probable result, and the spirit of the +tyrant of Apemama flit to rejoin his predecessors of Mariki and Tapituea. +Yet those whom he so trusts are all women, and all rivals. + +There is indeed a ministry and staff of males: cook, steward, carpenter, +and supercargoes: the hierarchy of a schooner. The spies, ‘his majesty’s +daily papers,’ as we called them, come every morning to report, and go +again. The cook and steward are concerned with the table only. The +supercargoes, whose business it is to keep tally of the copra at three +pounds a month and a percentage, are rarely in the palace; and two at +least are in the other islands. The carpenter, indeed, shrewd and jolly +old Rubam—query, Reuben?—promoted on my last visit to the greater dignity +of governor, is daily present, altering, extending, embellishing, +pursuing the endless series of the king’s inventions; and his majesty +will sometimes pass an afternoon watching and talking with Rubam at his +work. But the males are still outsiders; none seems to be armed, none is +entrusted with a key; by dusk they are all usually departed from the +palace; and the weight of the monarchy and of the monarch’s life reposes +unshared on the women. + +Here is a household unlike, indeed, to one of ours; more unlike still to +the Oriental harem: that of an elderly childless man, his days menaced, +dwelling alone amid a bevy of women of all ages, ranks, and +relationships,—the mother, the sister, the cousin, the legitimate wife, +the concubine, the favourite, the eldest born, and she of yesterday; he, +in their midst, the only master, the only male, the sole dispenser of +honours, clothes, and luxuries, the sole mark of multitudinous ambitions +and desires. I doubt if you could find a man in Europe so bold as to +attempt this piece of tact and government. And seemingly Tembinok’ +himself had trouble in the beginning. I hear of him shooting at a wife +for some levity on board a schooner. Another, on some more serious +offence, he slew outright; he exposed her body in an open box, and (to +make the warning more memorable) suffered it to putrefy before the palace +gate. Doubtless his growing years have come to his assistance; for upon +so large a scale it is more easy to play the father than the husband. +And to-day, at least to the eye of a stranger, all seems to go smoothly, +and the wives to be proud of their trust, proud of their rank, and proud +of their cunning lord. + +I conceived they made rather a hero of the man. A popular master in a +girls’ school might, perhaps, offer a figure of his preponderating +station. But then the master does not eat, sleep, live, and wash his +dirty linen in the midst of his admirers; he escapes, he has a room of +his own, he leads a private life; if he had nothing else, he has the +holidays, and the more unhappy Tembinok’ is always on the stage and on +the stretch. + +In all my coming and going, I never heard him speak harshly or express +the least displeasure. An extreme, rather heavy, benignity—the benignity +of one sure to be obeyed—marked his demeanour; so that I was at times +reminded of Samual Richardson in his circle of admiring women. The wives +spoke up and seemed to volunteer opinions, like our wives at home—or, +say, like doting but respectable aunts. Altogether, I conclude that he +rules his seraglio much more by art than terror; and those who give a +different account (and who have none of them enjoyed my opportunities of +observation) perhaps failed to distinguish between degrees of rank, +between ‘my pamily’ and the hangers-on, laundresses, and prostitutes. + +A notable feature is the evening game of cards when lamps are set forth +upon the terrace, and ‘I and my pamily’ play for tobacco by the hour. It +is highly characteristic of Tembinok’ that he must invent a game for +himself; highly characteristic of his worshipping household that they +should swear by the absurd invention. It is founded on poker, played +with the honours out of many packs, and inconceivably dreary. But I have +a passion for all games, studied it, and am supposed to be the only white +who ever fairly grasped its principle: a fact for which the wives (with +whom I was not otherwise popular) admired me with acclamation. It was +impossible to be deceived; this was a genuine feeling: they were proud of +their private game, had been cut to the quick by the want of interest +shown in it by others, and expanded under the flattery of my attention. +Tembinok’ puts up a double stake, and receives in return two hands to +choose from: a shallow artifice which the wives (in all these years) have +not yet fathomed. He himself, when talking with me privately, made not +the least secret that he was secure of winning; and it was thus he +explained his recent liberality on board the _Equator_. He let the wives +buy their own tobacco, which pleased them at the moment. He won it back +at cards, which made him once more, and without fresh expense, that which +he ought to be,—the sole fount of all indulgences. And he summed the +matter up in that phrase with which he almost always concludes any +account of his policy: ‘Mo’ betta.’ + +The palace compound is laid with broken coral, excruciating to the eyes +and the bare feet, but exquisitely raked and weeded. A score or more of +buildings lie in a sort of street along the palisade and scattered on the +margin of the terrace; dwelling-houses for the wives and the attendants, +storehouses for the king’s curios and treasures, spacious maniap’s for +feast or council, some on pillars of wood, some on piers of masonry. One +was still in hand, a new invention, the king’s latest born: a European +frame-house built for coolness inside a lofty maniap’: its roof planked +like a ship’s deck to be a raised, shady, and yet private promenade. It +was here the king spent hours with Rubam; here I would sometimes join +them; the place had a most singular appearance; and I must say I was +greatly taken with the fancy, and joined with relish in the counsels of +the architects. + +Suppose we had business with his majesty by day: we strolled over the +sand and by the dwarfish palms, exchanged a ‘_Kõnamaori_’ with the crone +on duty, and entered the compound. The wide sheet of coral glared before +us deserted; all having stowed themselves in dark canvas from the excess +of room. I have gone to and fro in that labyrinth of a place, seeking +the king; and the only breathing creature I could find was when I peered +under the eaves of a maniap’, and saw the brawny body of one of the wives +stretched on the floor, a naked Amazon plunged in noiseless slumber. If +it were still the hour of the ‘morning papers’ the quest would be more +easy, the half-dozen obsequious, sly dogs squatting on the ground outside +a house, crammed as far as possible in its narrow shadow, and turning to +the king a row of leering faces. Tembinok’ would be within, the flaps of +the cabin raised, the trade blowing through, hearing their report. Like +journalists nearer home, when the day’s news were scanty, these would +make the more of it in words; and I have known one to fill up a barren +morning with an imaginary conversation of two dogs. Sometimes the king +deigns to laugh, sometimes to question or jest with them, his voice +sounding shrilly from the cabin. By his side he may have the +heir-apparent, Paul, his nephew and adopted son, six years old, stark +naked, and a model of young human beauty. And there will always be the +favourite and perhaps two other wives awake; four more lying supine under +mats and whelmed in slumber. Or perhaps we came later, fell on a more +private hour, and found Tembinok’ retired in the house with the +favourite, an earthenware spittoon, a leaden inkpot, and a commercial +ledger. In the last, lying on his belly, he writes from day to day the +uneventful history of his reign; and when thus employed he betrayed a +touch of fretfulness on interruption with which I was well able to +sympathise. The royal annalist once read me a page or so, translating as +he went; but the passage being genealogical, and the author boggling +extremely in his version, I own I have been sometimes better entertained. +Nor does he confine himself to prose, but touches the lyre, too, in his +leisure moments, and passes for the chief bard of his kingdom, as he is +its sole public character, leading architect, and only merchant. + +His competence, however, does not reach to music; and his verses, when +they are ready, are taught to a professional musician, who sets them and +instructs the chorus. Asked what his songs were about, Tembinok’ +replied, ‘Sweethearts and trees and the sea. Not all the same true, all +the same lie.’ For a condensed view of lyrical poetry (except that he +seems to have forgot the stars and flowers) this would be hard to mend. +These multifarious occupations bespeak (in a native and an absolute +prince) unusual activity of mind. + +The palace court at noon is a spot to be remembered with awe, the visitor +scrambling there, on the loose stones, through a splendid nightmare of +light and heat; but the sweep of the wind delivers it from flies and +mosquitoes; and with the set of sun it became heavenly. I remember it +best on moonless nights. The air was like a bath of milk. Countless +shining stars were overhead, the lagoon paved with them. Herds of wives +squatted by companies on the gravel, softly chatting. Tembinok’ would +doff his jacket, and sit bare and silent, perhaps meditating songs; the +favourite usually by him, silent also. Meanwhile in the midst of the +court, the palace lanterns were being lit and marshalled in rank upon the +ground—six or eight square yards of them; a sight that gave one strange +ideas of the number of ‘my pamily’: such a sight as may be seen about +dusk in a corner of some great terminus at home. Presently these fared +off into all corners of the precinct, lighting the last labours of the +day, lighting one after another to their rest that prodigious company of +women. A few lingered in the middle of the court for the card-party, and +saw the honours shuffled and dealt, and Tembinok’ deliberating between +his two; hands, and the queens losing their tobacco. Then these also +were scattered and extinguished; and their place was taken by a great +bonfire, the night-light of the palace. When this was no more, smaller +fires burned likewise at the gates. These were tended by the crones, +unseen, unsleeping—not always unheard. Should any approach in the dark +hours, a guarded alert made the circuit of the palisade; each sentry +signalled her neighbour with a stone; the rattle of falling pebbles +passed and died away; and the wardens of Tembinok’ crouched in their +places silent as before. + + + +CHAPTER IV—THE KING OF APEMAMA: EQUATOR TOWN AND THE PALACE + + +Five persons were detailed to wait upon us. Uncle Parker, who brought us +toddy and green nuts, was an elderly, almost an old man, with the +spirits, the industry, and the morals of a boy of ten. His face was +ancient, droll, and diabolical, the skin stretched over taut sinews, like +a sail on the guide-rope; and he smiled with every muscle of his head. +His nuts must be counted every day, or he would deceive us in the tale; +they must be daily examined, or some would prove to be unhusked; nothing +but the king’s name, and scarcely that, would hold him to his duty. +After his toils were over he was given a pipe, matches, and tobacco, and +sat on the floor in the maniap’ to smoke. He would not seem to move from +his position, and yet every day, when the things fell to be returned the +plug had disappeared; he had found the means to conceal it in the roof, +whence he could radiantly produce it on the morrow. Although this piece +of legerdemain was performed regularly before three or four pairs of +eyes, we could never catch him in the fact; although we searched after he +was gone, we could never find the tobacco. Such were the diversions of +Uncle Parker, a man nearing sixty. But he was punished according unto +his deeds: Mrs. Stevenson took a fancy to paint him, and the sufferings +of the sitter were beyond description. + +Three lasses came from the palace to do our washing and racket with Ah +Fu. They were of the lowest class, hangers-on kept for the convenience +of merchant skippers, probably low-born, perhaps out-islanders, with +little refinement whether of manner or appearance, but likely and jolly +enough wenches in their way. We called one _Guttersnipe_, for you may +find her image in the slums of any city; the same lean, dark-eyed, eager, +vulgar face, the same sudden, hoarse guffaws, the same forward and yet +anxious manner, as with a tail of an eye on the policeman: only the +policeman here was a live king, and his truncheon a rifle. I doubt if +you could find anywhere out of the islands, or often there, the parallel +of _Fatty_, a mountain of a girl, who must have weighed near as many +stones as she counted summers, could have given a good account of a +life-guardsman, had the face of a baby, and applied her vast mechanical +forces almost exclusively to play. But they were all three of the same +merry spirit. Our washing was conducted in a game of romps; and they +fled and pursued, and splashed, and pelted, and rolled each other in the +sand, and kept up a continuous noise of cries and laughter like holiday +children. Indeed, and however strange their own function in that austere +establishment, were they not escaped for the day from the largest and +strictest Ladies’ School in the South Seas? + +Our fifth attendant was no less a person than the royal cook. He was +strikingly handsome both in face and body, lazy as a slave, and insolent +as a butcher’s boy. He slept and smoked on our premises in various +graceful attitudes; but so far from helping Ah Fu, he was not at the +pains to watch him. It may be said of him that he came to learn, and +remained to teach; and his lessons were at times difficult to stomach. +For example, he was sent to fill a bucket from the well. About half-way +he found my wife watering her onions, changed buckets with her, and +leaving her the empty, returned to the kitchen with the full. On another +occasion he was given a dish of dumplings for the king, was told they +must be eaten hot, and that he should carry them as fast as possible. +The wretch set off at the rate of about a mile in the hour, head in air, +toes turned out. My patience, after a month of trial, failed me at the +sight. I pursued, caught him by his two big shoulders, and thrusting him +before me, ran with him down the hill, over the sands, and through the +applauding village, to the Speak House, where the king was then holding a +pow-wow. He had the impudence to pretend he was internally injured by my +violence, and to profess serious apprehensions for his life. + +All this we endured; for the ways of Tembinok’ are summary, and I was not +yet ripe to take a hand in the man’s death. But in the meanwhile, here +was my unfortunate China boy slaving for the pair, and presently he fell +sick. I was now in the position of Cimondain Lantenac, and indeed all +the characters in _Quatre-Vingt-Treize_: to continue to spare the guilty, +I must sacrifice the innocent. I took the usual course and tried to save +both, with the usual consequence of failure. Well rehearsed, I went down +to the palace, found the king alone, and obliged him with a vast amount +of rigmarole. The cook was too old to learn: I feared he was not making +progress; how if we had a boy instead?—boys were more teachable. It was +all in vain; the king pierced through my disguises to the root of the +fact; saw that the cook had desperately misbehaved; and sat a while +glooming. ‘I think he tavvy too much,’ he said at last, with grim +concision; and immediately turned the talk to other subjects. The same +day another high officer, the steward, appeared in the cook’s place, and, +I am bound to say, proved civil and industrious. + +As soon as I left, it seems the king called for a Winchester and strolled +outside the palisade, awaiting the defaulter. That day Tembinok’ wore +the woman’s frock; as like as not, his make-up was completed by a pith +helmet and blue spectacles. Conceive the glaring stretch of sandhills, +the dwarf palms with their noon-day shadows, the line of the palisade, +the crone sentries (each by a small clear fire) cooking syrup on their +posts—and this chimæra waiting with his deadly engine. To him, enter at +last the cook, strolling down the sandhill from Equator Town, listless, +vain and graceful; with no thought of alarm. As soon as he was well +within range, the travestied monarch fired the six shots over his head, +at his feet, and on either hand of him: the second Apemama warning, +startling in itself, fatal in significance, for the next time his majesty +will aim to hit. I am told the king is a crack shot; that when he aims +to kill, the grave may be got ready; and when he aims to miss, misses by +so near a margin that the culprit tastes six times the bitterness of +death. The effect upon the cook I had an opportunity of seeing for +myself. My wife and I were returning from the sea-side of the island, +when we spied one coming to meet us at a very quick, disordered pace, +between a walk and a run. As we drew nearer we saw it was the cook, +beside himself with some emotion, his usual warm, mulatto colour declined +into a bluish pallor. He passed us without word or gesture, staring on +us with the face of a Satan, and plunged on across the wood for the +unpeopled quarter of the island and the long, desert beach, where he +might rage to and fro unseen, and froth out the vials of his wrath, fear, +and humiliation. Doubtless in the curses that he there uttered to the +bursting surf and the tropic birds, the name of the Kaupoi—the rich +man—was frequently repeated. I had made him the laughing-stock of the +village in the affair of the king’s dumplings; I had brought him by my +machinations into disgrace and the immediate jeopardy of his days; last, +and perhaps bitterest, he had found me there by the way to spy upon him +in the hour of his disorder. + +Time passed, and we saw no more of him. The season of the full moon came +round, when a man thinks shame to lie sleeping; and I continued until +late—perhaps till twelve or one in the morning—to walk on the bright sand +and in the tossing shadow of the palms. I played, as I wandered, on a +flageolet, which occupied much of my attention; the fans overhead rattled +in the wind with a metallic chatter; and a bare foot falls at any rate +almost noiseless on that shifting soil. Yet when I got back to Equator +Town, where all the lights were out, and my wife (who was still awake, +and had been looking forth) asked me who it was that followed me, I +thought she spoke in jest. ‘Not at all,’ she said. ‘I saw him twice as +you passed, walking close at your heels. He only left you at the corner +of the maniap’; he must be still behind the cook-house.’ Thither I +ran—like a fool, without any weapon—and came face to face with the cook. +He was within my tapu-line, which was death in itself; he could have no +business there at such an hour but either to steal or to kill; guilt made +him timorous; and he turned and fled before me in the night in silence. +As he went I kicked him in that place where honour lies, and he gave +tongue faintly like an injured mouse. At the moment I daresay he +supposed it was a deadly instrument that touched him. + +What had the man been after? I have found my music better qualified to +scatter than to collect an audience. Amateur as I was, I could not +suppose him interested in my reading of the _Carnival of Venice_, or that +he would deny himself his natural rest to follow my variations on _The +Ploughboy_. And whatever his design, it was impossible I should suffer +him to prowl by night among the houses. A word to the king, and the man +were not, his case being far beyond pardon. But it is one thing to kill +a man yourself; quite another to bear tales behind his back and have him +shot by a third party; and I determined to deal with the fellow in some +method of my own. I told Ah Fu the story, and bade him fetch me the cook +whenever he should find him. I had supposed this would be a matter of +difficulty; and far from that, he came of his own accord: an act really +of desperation, since his life hung by my silence, and the best he could +hope was to be forgotten. Yet he came with an assured countenance, +volunteered no apology or explanation, complained of injuries received, +and pretended he was unable to sit down. I suppose I am the weakest man +God made; I had kicked him in the least vulnerable part of his big +carcase; my foot was bare, and I had not even hurt my foot. Ah Fu could +not control his merriment. On my side, knowing what must be the nature +of his apprehensions, I found in so much impudence a kind of gallantry, +and secretly admired the man. I told him I should say nothing of his +night’s adventure to the king; that I should still allow him, when he had +an errand, to come within my tapu-line by day; but if ever I found him +there after the set of the sun I would shoot him on the spot; and to the +proof showed him a revolver. He must have been incredibly relieved; but +he showed no sign of it, took himself off with his usual dandy +nonchalance, and was scarce seen by us again. + +These five, then, with the substitution of the steward for the cook, came +and went, and were our only visitors. The circle of the tapu held at +arm’s-length the inhabitants of the village. As for ‘my pamily,’ they +dwelt like nuns in their enclosure; only once have I met one of them +abroad, and she was the king’s sister, and the place in which I found her +(the island infirmary) was very likely privileged. There remains only +the king to be accounted for. He would come strolling over, always +alone, a little before a meal-time, take a chair, and talk and eat with +us like an old family friend. Gilbertine etiquette appears defective on +the point of leave-taking. It may be remembered we had trouble in the +matter with Karaiti; and there was something childish and disconcerting +in Tembinok’s abrupt ‘I want go home now,’ accompanied by a kind of +ducking rise, and followed by an unadorned retreat. It was the only blot +upon his manners, which were otherwise plain, decent, sensible, and +dignified. He never stayed long nor drank much, and copied our behaviour +where he perceived it to differ from his own. Very early in the day, for +instance, he ceased eating with his knife. It was plain he was +determined in all things to wring profit from our visit, and chiefly upon +etiquette. The quality of his white visitors puzzled and concerned him; +he would bring up name after name, and ask if its bearer were a ‘big +chiep,’ or even a ‘chiep’ at all—which, as some were my excellent good +friends, and none were actually born in the purple, became at times +embarrassing. He was struck to learn that our classes were +distinguishable by their speech, and that certain words (for instance) +were tapu on the quarter-deck of a man-of-war; and he begged in +consequence that we should watch and correct him on the point. We were +able to assure him that he was beyond correction. His vocabulary is apt +and ample to an extraordinary degree. God knows where he collected it, +but by some instinct or some accident he has avoided all profane or gross +expressions. ‘Obliged,’ ‘stabbed,’ ‘gnaw,’ ‘lodge,’ ‘power,’ ‘company,’ +‘slender,’ ‘smooth,’ and ‘wonderful,’ are a few of the unexpected words +that enrich his dialect. Perhaps what pleased him most was to hear about +saluting the quarter-deck of a man-of-war. In his gratitude for this +hint he became fulsome. ‘Schooner cap’n no tell me,’ he cried; ‘I think +no tavvy! You tavvy too much; tavvy ’teama’, tavvy man-a-wa’. I think +you tavvy everything.’ Yet he gravelled me often enough with his +perpetual questions; and the false Mr. Barlow stood frequently exposed +before the royal Sandford. I remember once in particular. We were +showing the magic-lantern; a slide of Windsor Castle was put in, and I +told him there was the ‘outch’ of Victoreea. ‘How many pathom he high?’ +he asked, and I was dumb before him. It was the builder, the +indefatigable architect of palaces, that spoke; collector though he was, +he did not collect useless information; and all his questions had a +purpose. After etiquette, government, law, the police, money, and +medicine were his chief interests—things vitally important to himself as +a king and the father of his people. It was my part not only to supply +new information, but to correct the old. ‘My patha he tell me,’ or +‘White man he tell me,’ would be his constant beginning; ‘You think he +lie?’ Sometimes I thought he did. Tembinok’ once brought me a +difficulty of this kind, which I was long of comprehending. A schooner +captain had told him of Captain Cook; the king was much interested in the +story; and turned for more information—not to Mr. Stephen’s Dictionary, +not to the _Britannica_, but to the Bible in the Gilbert Island version +(which consists chiefly of the New Testament and the Psalms). Here he +sought long and earnestly; Paul he found, and Festus and Alexander the +coppersmith: no word of Cook. The inference was obvious: the explorer +was a myth. So hard it is, even for a man of great natural parts like +Tembinok’, to grasp the ideas of a new society and culture. + + + +CHAPTER V—KING AND COMMONS + + +We saw but little of the commons of the isle. At first we met them at +the well, where they washed their linen and we drew water for the table. +The combination was distasteful; and, having a tyrant at command, we +applied to the king and had the place enclosed in our tapu. It was one +of the few favours which Tembinok’ visibly boggled about granting, and it +may be conceived how little popular it made the strangers. Many +villagers passed us daily going afield; but they fetched a wide circuit +round our tapu, and seemed to avert their looks. At times we went +ourselves into the village—a strange place. Dutch by its canals, +Oriental by the height and steepness of the roofs, which looked at dusk +like temples; but we were rarely called into a house: no welcome, no +friendship, was offered us; and of home life we had but the one view: the +waking of a corpse, a frigid, painful scene: the widow holding on her lap +the cold, bluish body of her husband, and now partaking of the +refreshments which made the round of the company, now weeping and kissing +the pale mouth. (‘I fear you feel this affliction deeply,’ said the +Scottish minister. ‘Eh, sir, and that I do!’ replied the widow. ‘I’ve +been greetin’ a’ nicht; an’ noo I’m just gaun to sup this bit parritch, +and then I’ll begin an’ greet again.’) In our walks abroad I have always +supposed the islanders avoided us, perhaps from distaste, perhaps by +order; and those whom we met we took generally by surprise. The surface +of the isle is diversified with palm groves, thickets, and romantic +dingles four feet deep, relics of old taro plantation; and it is thus +possible to stumble unawares on folk resting or hiding from their work. +About pistol-shot from our township there lay a pond in the bottom of a +jungle; here the maids of the isle came to bathe, and were several times +alarmed by our intrusion. Not for them are the bright cold rivers of +Tahiti or Upolu, not for them to splash and laugh in the hour of the dusk +with a villageful of gay companions; but to steal here solitary, to +crouch in a place like a cow-wallow, and wash (if that can be called +washing) in lukewarm mud, brown as their own skins. Other, but still +rare, encounters occur to my memory. I was several times arrested by a +tender sound in the bush of voices talking, soft as flutes and with quiet +intonations. Hope told a flattering tale; I put aside the leaves; and +behold! in place of the expected dryads, a pair of all too solid ladies +squatting over a clay pipe in the ungraceful _ridi_. The beauty of the +voice and the eye was all that remained to those vast dames; but that of +the voice was indeed exquisite. It is strange I should have never heard +a more winning sound of speech, yet the dialect should be one remarkable +for violent, ugly, and outlandish vocables; so that Tembinok’ himself +declared it made him weary, and professed to find repose in talking +English. + +The state of this folk, of whom I saw so little, I can merely guess at. +The king himself explains the situation with some art. ‘No; I no pay +them,’ he once said. ‘I give them tobacco. They work for me _all the +same brothers_.’ It is true there was a brother once in Arden! But we +prefer the shorter word. They bear every servile mark,—levity like a +child’s, incurable idleness, incurious content. The insolence of the +cook was a trait of his own; not so his levity, which he shared with the +innocent Uncle Parker. With equal unconcern both gambolled under the +shadow of the gallows, and took liberties with death that might have +surprised a careless student of man’s nature. I wrote of Parker that he +behaved like a boy of ten: what was he else, being a slave of sixty? He +had passed all his years in school, fed, clad, thought for, commanded; +and had grown familiar and coquetted with the fear of punishment. By +terror you may drive men long, but not far. Here, in Apemama, they work +at the constant and the instant peril of their lives; and are plunged in +a kind of lethargy of laziness. It is common to see one go afield in his +stiff mat ungirt, so that he walks elbows-in like a trussed fowl; and +whatsoever his right hand findeth to do, the other must be off duty +holding on his clothes. It is common to see two men carrying between +them on a pole a single bucket of water. To make two bites of a cherry +is good enough: to make two burthens of a soldier’s kit, for a distance +of perhaps half a furlong, passes measure. Woman, being the less +childish animal, is less relaxed by servile conditions. Even in the +king’s absence, even when they were alone, I have seen Apemama women work +with constancy. But the outside to be hoped for in a man is that he may +attack his task in little languid fits, and lounge between-whiles. So I +have seen a painter, with his pipe going, and a friend by the studio +fireside. You might suppose the race to lack civility, even vitality, +until you saw them in the dance. Night after night, and sometimes day +after day, they rolled out their choruses in the great Speak House—solemn +andantes and adagios, led by the clapped hand, and delivered with an +energy that shook the roof. The time was not so slow, though it was slow +for the islands; but I have chosen rather to indicate the effect upon the +hearer. Their music had a church-like character from near at hand, and +seemed to European ears more regular than the run of island music. Twice +I have heard a discord regularly solved. From farther off, heard at +Equator Town for instance, the measures rose and fell and crepitated like +the barking of hounds in a distant kennel. + +The slaves are certainly not overworked—children of ten do more without +fatigue—and the Apemama labourers have holidays, when the singing begins +early in the afternoon. The diet is hard; copra and a sweetmeat of +pounded pandanus are the only dishes I observed outside the palace; but +there seems no defect in quantity, and the king shares with them his +turtles. Three came in a boat from Kuria during our stay; one was kept +for the palace, one sent to us, one presented to the village. It is the +habit of the islanders to cook the turtle in its carapace; we had been +promised the shells, and we asked a tapu on this foolish practice. The +face of Tembinok’ darkened and he answered nothing. Hesitation in the +question of the well I could understand, for water is scarce on a low +island; that he should refuse to interfere upon a point of cookery was +more than I had dreamed of; and I gathered (rightly or wrongly) that he +was scrupulous of touching in the least degree the private life and +habits of his slaves. So that even here, in full despotism, public +opinion has weight; even here, in the midst of slavery, freedom has a +corner. + +Orderly, sober, and innocent, life flows in the isle from day to day as +in a model plantation under a model planter. It is impossible to doubt +the beneficence of that stern rule. A curious politeness, a soft and +gracious manner, something effeminate and courtly, distinguishes the +islanders of Apemama; it is talked of by all the traders, it was felt +even by residents so little beloved as ourselves, and noticeable even in +the cook, and even in that scoundrel’s hours of insolence. The king, +with his manly and plain bearing, stood out alone; you might say he was +the only Gilbert Islander in Apemama. Violence, so common in Butaritari, +seems unknown. So are theft and drunkenness. I am assured the +experiment has been made of leaving sovereigns on the beach before the +village; they lay there untouched. In all our time on the island I was +but once asked for drink. This was by a mighty plausible fellow, wearing +European clothes and speaking excellent English—Tamaiti his name, or, as +the whites have now corrupted it, ‘Tom White’: one of the king’s +supercargoes at three pounds a month and a percentage, a medical man +besides, and in his private hours a wizard. He found me one day in the +outskirts of the village, in a secluded place, hot and private, where the +taro-pits are deep and the plants high. Here he buttonholed me, and, +looking about him like a conspirator, inquired if I had gin. + +I told him I had. He remarked that gin was forbidden, lauded the +prohibition a while, and then went on to explain that he was a doctor, or +‘dogstar’ as he pronounced the word, that gin was necessary to him for +his medical infusions, that he was quite out of it, and that he would be +obliged to me for some in a bottle. I told him I had passed the king my +word on landing; but since his case was so exceptional, I would go down +to the palace at once, and had no doubt that Tembinok’ would set me free. +Tom White was immediately overwhelmed with embarrassment and terror, +besought me in the most moving terms not to betray him, and fled my +neighbourhood. He had none of the cook’s valour; it was weeks before he +dared to meet my eye; and then only by the order of the king and on +particular business. + +The more I viewed and admired this triumph of firm rule, the more I was +haunted and troubled by a problem, the problem (perhaps) of to-morrow for +ourselves. Here was a people protected from all serious misfortune, +relieved of all serious anxieties, and deprived of what we call our +liberty. Did they like it? and what was their sentiment toward the +ruler? The first question I could not of course ask, nor perhaps the +natives answer. Even the second was delicate; yet at last, and under +charming and strange circumstances, I found my opportunity to put it and +a man to reply. It was near the full of the moon, with a delicious +breeze; the isle was bright as day—to sleep would have been sacrilege; +and I walked in the bush, playing my pipe. It must have been the sound +of what I am pleased to call my music that attracted in my direction +another wanderer of the night. This was a young man attired in a fine +mat, and with a garland on his hair, for he was new come from dancing and +singing in the public hall; and his body, his face, and his eyes were all +of an enchanting beauty. Every here and there in the Gilberts youths are +to be found of this absurd perfection; I have seen five of us pass half +an hour in admiration of a boy at Mariki; and Te Kop (my friend in the +fine mat and garland) I had already several times remarked, and long ago +set down as the loveliest animal in Apemama. The philtre of admiration +must be very strong, or these natives specially susceptible to its +effects, for I have scarce ever admired a person in the islands but what +he has sought my particular acquaintance. So it was with Te Kop. He led +me to the ocean side; and for an hour or two we sat smoking and talking +on the resplendent sand and under the ineffable brightness of the moon. +My friend showed himself very sensible of the beauty and amenity of the +hour. ‘Good night! Good wind!’ he kept exclaiming, and as he said the +words he seemed to hug myself. I had long before invented such +reiterated expressions of delight for a character (Felipe, in the story +of _Olalla_) intended to be partly bestial. But there was nothing +bestial in Te Kop; only a childish pleasure in the moment. He was no +less pleased with his companion, or was good enough to say so; honoured +me, before he left, by calling me Te Kop; apostrophised me as ‘My name!’ +with an intonation exquisitely tender, laying his hand at the same time +swiftly on my knee; and after we had risen, and our paths began to +separate in the bush, twice cried to me with a sort of gentle ecstasy, ‘I +like you too much!’ From the beginning he had made no secret of his +terror of the king; would not sit down nor speak above a whisper till he +had put the whole breadth of the isle between himself and his monarch, +then harmlessly asleep; and even there, even within a stone-cast of the +outer sea, our talk covered by the sound of the surf and the rattle of +the wind among the palms, continued to speak guardedly, softening his +silver voice (which rang loud enough in the chorus) and looking about him +like a man in fear of spies. The strange thing is that I should have +beheld him no more. In any other island in the whole South Seas, if I +had advanced half as far with any native, he would have been at my door +next morning, bringing and expecting gifts. But Te Kop vanished in the +bush for ever. My house, of course, was unapproachable; but he knew +where to find me on the ocean beach, where I went daily. I was the +_Kaupoi_, the rich man; my tobacco and trade were known to be endless: he +was sure of a present. I am at a loss how to explain his behaviour, +unless it be supposed that he recalled with terror and regret a passage +in our interview. Here it is: + +‘The king, he good man?’ I asked. + +‘Suppose he like you, he good man,’ replied Te Kop: ‘no like, no good.’ + +That is one way of putting it, of course. Te Kop himself was probably no +favourite, for he scarce appealed to my judgment as a type of industry. +And there must be many others whom the king (to adhere to the formula) +does not like. Do these unfortunates like the king? Or is not rather +the repulsion mutual? and the conscientious Tembinok’, like the +conscientious Braxfield before him, and many other conscientious rulers +and judges before either, surrounded by a considerable body of +‘grumbletonians’? Take the cook, for instance, when he passed us by, +blue with rage and terror. He was very wroth with me; I think by all the +old principles of human nature he was not very well pleased with his +sovereign. It was the rich man he sought to waylay: I think it must have +been by the turn of a hair that it was not the king he waylaid instead. +And the king gives, or seems to give, plenty of opportunities; day and +night he goes abroad alone, whether armed or not I can but guess; and the +taro-patches, where his business must so often carry him, seem designed +for assassination. The case of the cook was heavy indeed to my +conscience. I did not like to kill my enemy at second-hand; but had I a +right to conceal from the king, who had trusted me, the dangerous secret +character of his attendant? And suppose the king should fall, what would +be the fate of the king’s friends? It was our opinion at the time that +we should pay dear for the closing of the well; that our breath was in +the king’s nostrils; that if the king should by any chance be bludgeoned +in a taro-patch, the philosophical and musical inhabitants of Equator +Town might lay aside their pleasant instruments, and betake themselves to +what defence they had, with a very dim prospect of success. These +speculations were forced upon us by an incident which I am ashamed to +betray. The schooner _H. L. Haseltine_ (since capsized at sea, with the +loss of eleven lives) put into Apemama in a good hour for us, who had +near exhausted our supplies. The king, after his habit, spent day after +day on board; the gin proved unhappily to his taste; he brought a store +of it ashore with him; and for some time the sole tyrant of the isle was +half-seas-over. He was not drunk—the man is not a drunkard, he has +always stores of liquor at hand, which he uses with moderation,—but he +was muzzy, dull, and confused. He came one day to lunch with us, and +while the cloth was being laid fell asleep in his chair. His confusion, +when he awoke and found he had been detected, was equalled by our +uneasiness. When he was gone we sat and spoke of his peril, which we +thought to be in some degree our own; of how easily the man might be +surprised in such a state by _grumbletonians_; of the strange scenes that +would follow—the royal treasures and stores at the mercy of the rabble, +the palace overrun, the garrison of women turned adrift. And as we +talked we were startled by a gun-shot and a sudden, barbaric outcry. I +believe we all changed colour; but it was only the king firing at a dog +and the chorus striking up in the Speak House. A day or two later I +learned the king was very sick; went down, diagnosed the case; and took +at once the highest medical degree by the exhibition of bicarbonate of +soda. Within the hour Richard was himself again; and I found him at the +unfinished house, enjoying the double pleasure of directing Rubam and +making a dinner of cocoa-nut dumplings, and all eagerness to have the +formula of this new sort of _pain-killer_—for _pain-killer_ in the +islands is the generic name of medicine. So ended the king’s modest +spree and our anxiety. + +On the face of things, I ought to say, loyalty appeared unshaken. When +the schooner at last returned for us, after much experience of baffling +winds, she brought a rumour that Tebureimoa had declared war on Apemama. +Tembinok’ became a new man; his face radiant; his attitude, as I saw him +preside over a council of chiefs in one of the palace maniap’s, eager as +a boy’s; his voice sounding abroad, shrill and jubilant, over half the +compound. War is what he wants, and here was his chance. The English +captain, when he flung his arms in the lagoon, had forbidden him (except +in one case) all military adventures in the future: here was the case +arrived. All morning the council sat; men were drilled, arms were +bought, the sound of firing disturbed the afternoon; the king devised and +communicated to me his plan of campaign, which was highly elaborate and +ingenious, but perhaps a trifle fine-spun for the rough and random +vicissitudes of war. And in all this bustle the temper of the people +appeared excellent, an unwonted animation in every face, and even Uncle +Parker burning with military zeal. + +Of course it was a false alarm. Tebureimoa had other fish to fry. The +ambassador who accompanied us on our return to Butaritari found him +retired to a small island on the reef, in a huff with the Old Men, a tiff +with the traders, and more fear of insurrection at home than appetite for +wars abroad. The plenipotentiary had been placed under my protection; +and we solemnly saluted when we met. He proved an excellent fisherman, +and caught bonito over the ship’s side. He pulled a good oar, and made +himself useful for a whole fiery afternoon, towing the becalmed _Equator_ +off Mariki. He went to his post and did no good. He returned home +again, having done no harm. _O si sic omnes_! + + + +CHAPTER VI—THE KING OF APEMAMA: DEVIL-WORK + + +The ocean beach of Apemama was our daily resort. The coast is broken by +shallow bays. The reef is detached, elevated, and includes a lagoon +about knee-deep, the unrestful spending-basin of the surf. The beach is +now of fine sand, now of broken coral. The trend of the coast being +convex, scarce a quarter of a mile of it is to be seen at once; the land +being so low, the horizon appears within a stone-cast; and the narrow +prospect enhances the sense of privacy. Man avoids the place—even his +footprints are uncommon; but a great number of birds hover and pipe there +fishing, and leave crooked tracks upon the sand. Apart from these, the +only sound (and I was going to say the only society), is that of the +breakers on the reef. + +On each projection of the coast, the bank of coral clinkers immediately +above the beach has been levelled, and a pillar built, perhaps +breast-high. These are not sepulchral; all the dead being buried on the +inhabited side of the island, close to men’s houses, and (what is worse) +to their wells. I was told they were to protect the isle against inroads +from the sea—divine or diabolical martellos, probably sacred to Taburik, +God of Thunder. + +The bay immediately opposite Equator Town, which we called Fu Bay, in +honour of our cook, was thus fortified on either horn. It was well +sheltered by the reef, the enclosed water clear and tranquil, the +enclosing beach curved like a horseshoe, and both steep and broad. The +path debouched about the midst of the re-entrant angle, the woods +stopping some distance inland. In front, between the fringe of the wood +and the crown of the beach, there had been designed a regular figure, +like the court for some new variety of tennis, with borders of round +stones imbedded, and pointed at the angles with low posts, likewise of +stone. This was the king’s Pray Place. When he prayed, what he prayed +for, and to whom he addressed his supplications I could never learn. The +ground was tapu. + +In the angle, by the mouth of the path, stood a deserted maniap’. Near +by there had been a house before our coming, which was now transported +and figured for the moment in Equator Town. It had been, and it would be +again when we departed, the residence of the guardian and wizard of the +spot—Tamaiti. Here, in this lone place, within sound of the sea, he had +his dwelling and uncanny duties. I cannot call to mind another case of a +man living on the ocean side of any open atoll; and Tamaiti must have had +strong nerves, the greater confidence in his own spells, or, what I +believe to be the truth, an enviable scepticism. Whether Tamaiti had any +guardianship of the Pray Place I never heard. But his own particular +chapel stood farther back in the fringe of the wood. It was a tree of +respectable growth. Around it there was drawn a circle of stones like +those that enclosed the Pray Place; in front, facing towards the sea, a +stone of a much greater size, and somewhat hollowed, like a piscina, +stood close against the trunk; in front of that again a conical pile of +gravel. In the hollow of what I have called the piscina (though it +proved to be a magic seat) lay an offering of green cocoa-nuts; and when +you looked up you found the boughs of the tree to be laden with strange +fruit: palm-branches elaborately plaited, and beautiful models of canoes, +finished and rigged to the least detail. The whole had the appearance of +a mid-summer and sylvan Christmas-tree _al fresco_. Yet we were already +well enough acquainted in the Gilberts to recognise it, at the first +sight, for a piece of wizardry, or, as they say in the group, of +Devil-work. + +The plaited palms were what we recognised. We had seen them before on +Apaiang, the most christianised of all these islands; where excellent Mr. +Bingham lived and laboured and has left golden memories; whence all the +education in the northern Gilberts traces its descent; and where we were +boarded by little native Sunday-school misses in clean frocks, with +demure faces, and singing hymns as to the manner born. + +Our experience of Devil-work at Apaiang had been as follows:—It chanced +we were benighted at the house of Captain Tierney. My wife and I lodged +with a Chinaman some half a mile away; and thither Captain Reid and a +native boy escorted us by torch-light. On the way the torch went out, +and we took shelter in a small and lonely Christian chapel to rekindle +it. Stuck in the rafters of the chapel was a branch of knotted palm. +‘What is that?’ I asked. ‘O, that’s Devil-work,’ said the Captain. ‘And +what is Devil-work?’ I inquired. ‘If you like, I’ll show you some when +we get to Johnnie’s,’ he replied. ‘Johnnie’s’ was a quaint little house +upon the crest of the beach, raised some three feet on posts, approached +by stairs; part walled, part trellised. Trophies of +advertisement-photographs were hung up within for decoration. There was +a table and a recess-bed, in which Mrs. Stevenson slept; while I camped +on the matted floor with Johnnie, Mrs. Johnnie, her sister, and the +devil’s own regiment of cockroaches. Hither was summoned an old witch, +who looked the part to horror. The lamp was set on the floor; the crone +squatted on the threshold, a green palm-branch in her hand, the light +striking full on her aged features and picking out behind her, from the +black night, timorous faces of spectators. Our sorceress began with a +chanted incantation; it was in the old tongue, for which I had no +interpreter; but ever and again there ran among the crowd outside that +laugh which every traveller in the islands learns so soon to +recognise,—the laugh of terror. Doubtless these half-Christian folk were +shocked, these half-heathen folk alarmed. Chench or Taburik thus +invoked, we put our questions; the witch knotted the leaves, here a leaf +and there a leaf, plainly on some arithmetical system; studied the result +with great apparent contention of mind; and gave the answers. Sidney +Colvin was in robust health and gone a journey; and we should have a fair +wind upon the morrow: that was the result of our consultation, for which +we paid a dollar. The next day dawned cloudless and breathless; but I +think Captain Reid placed a secret reliance on the sibyl, for the +schooner was got ready for sea. By eight the lagoon was flawed with long +cat’s-paws, and the palms tossed and rustled; before ten we were clear of +the passage and skimming under all plain sail, with bubbling scuppers. +So we had the breeze, which was well worth a dollar in itself; but the +bulletin about my friend in England proved, some six months later, when I +got my mail, to have been groundless. Perhaps London lies beyond the +horizon of the island gods. + +Tembinok’, in his first dealings, showed himself sternly averse from +superstition: and had not the _Equator_ delayed, we might have left the +island and still supposed him an agnostic. It chanced one day, however, +that he came to our maniap’, and found Mrs. Stevenson in the midst of a +game of patience. She explained the game as well as she was able, and +wound up jocularly by telling him this was her devil-work, and if she +won, the _Equator_ would arrive next day. Tembinok’ must have drawn a +long breath; we were not so high-and-dry after all; he need no longer +dissemble, and he plunged at once into confessions. He made devil-work +every day, he told us, to know if ships were coming in; and thereafter +brought us regular reports of the results. It was surprising how +regularly he was wrong; but he always had an explanation ready. There +had been some schooner in the offing out of view; but either she was not +bound for Apemama, or had changed her course, or lay becalmed. I used to +regard the king with veneration as he thus publicly deceived himself. I +saw behind him all the fathers of the Church, all the philosophers and +men of science of the past; before him, all those that are to come; +himself in the midst; the whole visionary series bowed over the same task +of welding incongruities. To the end Tembinok’ spoke reluctantly of the +island gods and their worship, and I learned but little. Taburik is the +god of thunder, and deals in wind and weather. A while since there were +wizards who could call him down in the form of lightning. ‘My patha he +tell me he see: you think he lie?’ Tienti—pronounced something like +‘Chench,’ and identified by his majesty with the devil—sends and removes +bodily sickness. He is whistled for in the Paumotuan manner, and is said +to appear; but the king has never seen him. The doctors treat disease by +the aid of Chench: eclectic Tembinok’ at the same time administering +‘pain-killer’ from his medicine-chest, so as to give the sufferer both +chances. ‘I think mo’ betta,’ observed his majesty, with more than his +usual self-approval. Apparently the gods are not jealous, and placidly +enjoy both shrine and priest in common. On Tamaiti’s medicine-tree, for +instance, the model canoes are hung up _ex voto_ for a prosperous voyage, +and must therefore be dedicated to Taburik, god of the weather; but the +stone in front is the place of sick folk come to pacify Chench. + +It chanced, by great good luck, that even as we spoke of these affairs, I +found myself threatened with a cold. I do not suppose I was ever glad of +a cold before, or shall ever be again; but the opportunity to see the +sorcerers at work was priceless, and I called in the faculty of Apemama. +They came in a body, all in their Sunday’s best and hung with wreaths and +shells, the insignia of the devil-worker. Tamaiti I knew already: +Terutak’ I saw for the first time—a tall, lank, raw-boned, serious +North-Sea fisherman turned brown; and there was a third in their company +whose name I never heard, and who played to Tamaiti the part of +_famulus_. Tamaiti took me in hand first, and led me, conversing +agreeably, to the shores of Fu Bay. The _famulus_ climbed a tree for +some green cocoa-nuts. Tamaiti himself disappeared a while in the bush +and returned with coco tinder, dry leaves, and a spray of waxberry. I +was placed on the stone, with my back to the tree and my face to +windward; between me and the gravel-heap one of the green nuts was set; +and then Tamaiti (having previously bared his feet, for he had come in +canvas shoes, which tortured him) joined me within the magic circle, +hollowed out the top of the gravel-heap, built his fire in the bottom, +and applied a match: it was one of Bryant and May’s. The flame was slow +to catch, and the irreverent sorcerer filled in the time with talk of +foreign places—of London, and ‘companies,’ and how much money they had; +of San Francisco, and the nefarious fogs, ‘all the same smoke,’ which had +been so nearly the occasion of his death. I tried vainly to lead him to +the matter in hand. ‘Everybody make medicine,’ he said lightly. And +when I asked him if he were himself a good practitioner—‘No savvy,’ he +replied, more lightly still. At length the leaves burst in a flame, +which he continued to feed; a thick, light smoke blew in my face, and the +flames streamed against and scorched my clothes. He in the meanwhile +addressed, or affected to address, the evil spirit, his lips moving fast, +but without sound; at the same time he waved in the air and twice struck +me on the breast with his green spray. So soon as the leaves were +consumed the ashes were buried, the green spray was imbedded in the +gravel, and the ceremony was at an end. + +A reader of the _Arabian Nights_ felt quite at home. Here was the +suffumigation; here was the muttering wizard; here was the desert place +to which Aladdin was decoyed by the false uncle. But they manage these +things better in fiction. The effect was marred by the levity of the +magician, entertaining his patient with small talk like an affable +dentist, and by the incongruous presence of Mr. Osbourne with a camera. +As for my cold, it was neither better nor worse. + +I was now handed over to Terutak’, the leading practitioner or medical +baronet of Apemama. His place is on the lagoon side of the island, hard +by the palace. A rail of light wood, some two feet high, encloses an +oblong piece of gravel like the king’s Pray Place; in the midst is a +green tree; below, a stone table bears a pair of boxes covered with a +fine mat; and in front of these an offering of food, a cocoa-nut, a piece +of taro or a fish, is placed daily. On two sides the enclosure is lined +with maniap’s; and one of our party, who had been there to sketch, had +remarked a daily concourse of people and an extraordinary number of sick +children; for this is in fact the infirmary of Apemama. The doctor and +myself entered the sacred place alone; the boxes and the mat were +displaced; and I was enthroned in their stead upon the stone, facing once +more to the east. For a while the sorcerer remained unseen behind me, +making passes in the air with a branch of palm. Then he struck lightly +on the brim of my straw hat; and this blow he continued to repeat at +intervals, sometimes brushing instead my arm and shoulder. I have had +people try to mesmerise me a dozen times, and never with the least +result. But at the first tap—on a quarter no more vital than my +hat-brim, and from nothing more virtuous than a switch of palm wielded by +a man I could not even see—sleep rushed upon me like an armed man. My +sinews fainted, my eyes closed, my brain hummed, with drowsiness. I +resisted, at first instinctively, then with a certain flurry of despair, +in the end successfully; if that were indeed success which enabled me to +scramble to my feet, to stumble home somnambulous, to cast myself at once +upon my bed, and sink at once into a dreamless stupor. When I awoke my +cold was gone. So I leave a matter that I do not understand. + +Meanwhile my appetite for curiosities (not usually very keen) had been +strangely whetted by the sacred boxes. They were of pandanus wood, +oblong in shape, with an effect of pillaring along the sides like straw +work, lightly fringed with hair or fibre and standing on four legs. The +outside was neat as a toy; the inside a mystery I was resolved to +penetrate. But there was a lion in the path. I might not approach +Terutak’, since I had promised to buy nothing in the island; I dared not +have recourse to the king, for I had already received from him more gifts +than I knew how to repay. In this dilemma (the schooner being at last +returned) we hit on a device. Captain Reid came forward in my stead, +professed an unbridled passion for the boxes, and asked and obtained +leave to bargain for them with the wizard. That same afternoon the +captain and I made haste to the infirmary, entered the enclosure, raised +the mat, and had begun to examine the boxes at our leisure, when +Terutak’s wife bounced out of one of the nigh houses, fell upon us, swept +up the treasures, and was gone. There was never a more absolute +surprise. She came, she took, she vanished, we had not a guess whither; +and we remained, with foolish looks and laughter on the empty field. +Such was the fit prologue of our memorable bargaining. + +Presently Terutak’ came, bringing Tamaiti along with him, both smiling; +and we four squatted without the rail. In the three maniap’s of the +infirmary a certain audience was gathered: the family of a sick child +under treatment, the king’s sister playing cards, a pretty girl, who +swore I was the image of her father; in all perhaps a score. Terutak’s +wife had returned (even as she had vanished) unseen, and now sat, +breathless and watchful, by her husband’s side. Perhaps some rumour of +our quest had gone abroad, or perhaps we had given the alert by our +unseemly freedom: certain, at least, that in the faces of all present, +expectation and alarm were mingled. + +Captain Reid announced, without preface or disguise, that I was come to +purchase; Terutak’, with sudden gravity, refused to sell. He was +pressed; he persisted. It was explained we only wanted one: no matter, +two were necessary for the healing of the sick. He was rallied, he was +reasoned with: in vain. He sat there, serious and still, and refused. +All this was only a preliminary skirmish; hitherto no sum of money had +been mentioned; but now the captain brought his great guns to bear. He +named a pound, then two, then three. Out of the maniap’s one person +after another came to join the group, some with mere excitement, others +with consternation in their faces. The pretty girl crept to my side; it +was then that—surely with the most artless flattery—she informed me of my +likeness to her father. Tamaiti the infidel sat with hanging head and +every mark of dejection. Terutak’ streamed with sweat, his eye was +glazed, his face wore a painful rictus, his chest heaved like that of one +spent with running. The man must have been by nature covetous; and I +doubt if ever I saw moral agony more tragically displayed. His wife by +his side passionately encouraged his resistance. + +And now came the charge of the old guard. The captain, making a skip, +named the surprising figure of five pounds. At the word the maniap’s +were emptied. The king’s sister flung down her cards and came to the +front to listen, a cloud on her brow. The pretty girl beat her breast +and cried with wearisome iteration that if the box were hers I should +have it. Terutak’s wife was beside herself with pious fear, her face +discomposed, her voice (which scarce ceased from warning and +encouragement) shrill as a whistle. Even Terutak’ lost that image-like +immobility which he had hitherto maintained. He rocked on his mat, threw +up his closed knees alternately, and struck himself on the breast after +the manner of dancers. But he came gold out of the furnace; and with +what voice was left him continued to reject the bribe. + +And now came a timely interjection. ‘Money will not heal the sick,’ +observed the king’s sister sententiously; and as soon as I heard the +remark translated my eyes were unsealed, and I began to blush for my +employment. Here was a sick child, and I sought, in the view of its +parents, to remove the medicine-box. Here was the priest of a religion, +and I (a heathen millionaire) was corrupting him to sacrilege. Here was +a greedy man, torn in twain betwixt greed and conscience; and I sat by +and relished, and lustfully renewed his torments. _Ave_, _Cæsar_! +Smothered in a corner, dormant but not dead, we have all the one touch of +nature: an infant passion for the sand and blood of the arena. So I +brought to an end my first and last experience of the joys of the +millionaire, and departed amid silent awe. Nowhere else can I expect to +stir the depths of human nature by an offer of five pounds; nowhere else, +even at the expense of millions, could I hope to see the evil of riches +stand so legibly exposed. Of all the bystanders, none but the king’s +sister retained any memory of the gravity and danger of the thing in +hand. Their eyes glowed, the girl beat her breast, in senseless animal +excitement. Nothing was offered them; they stood neither to gain nor to +lose; at the mere name and wind of these great sums Satan possessed them. + +From this singular interview I went straight to the palace; found the +king; confessed what I had been doing; begged him, in my name, to +compliment Terutak’ on his virtue, and to have a similar box made for me +against the return of the schooner. Tembinok’, Rubam, and one of the +Daily Papers—him we used to call ‘the Facetiæ Column’—laboured for a +while of some idea, which was at last intelligibly delivered. They +feared I thought the box would cure me; whereas, without the wizard, it +was useless; and when I was threatened with another cold I should do +better to rely on pain-killer. I explained I merely wished to keep it in +my ‘outch’ as a thing made in Apemama and these honest men were much +relieved. + +Late the same evening, my wife, crossing the isle to windward, was aware +of singing in the bush. Nothing is more common in that hour and place +than the jubilant carol of the toddy-cutter, swinging high overhead, +beholding below him the narrow ribbon of the isle, the surrounding field +of ocean, and the fires of the sunset. But this was of a graver +character, and seemed to proceed from the ground-level. Advancing a +little in the thicket, Mrs. Stevenson saw a clear space, a fine mat +spread in the midst, and on the mat a wreath of white flowers and one of +the devil-work boxes. A woman—whom we guess to have been Mrs. +Terutak’—sat in front, now drooping over the box like a mother over a +cradle, now lifting her face and directing her song to heaven. A passing +toddy-cutter told my wife that she was praying. Probably she did not so +much pray as deprecate; and perhaps even the ceremony was one of +disenchantment. For the box was already doomed; it was to pass from its +green medicine-tree, reverend precinct, and devout attendants; to be +handled by the profane; to cross three seas; to come to land under the +foolscap of St. Paul’s; to be domesticated within the hail of Lillie +Bridge; there to be dusted by the British housemaid, and to take perhaps +the roar of London for the voice of the outer sea along the reef. Before +even we had finished dinner Chench had begun his journey, and one of the +newspapers had already placed the box upon my table as the gift of +Tembinok’. + +I made haste to the palace, thanked the king, but offered to restore the +box, for I could not bear that the sick of the island should be made to +suffer. I was amazed by his reply. Terutak’, it appeared, had still +three or four in reserve against an accident; and his reluctance, and the +dread painted at first on every face, was not in the least occasioned by +the prospect of medical destitution, but by the immediate divinity of +Chench. How much more did I respect the king’s command, which had been +able to extort in a moment and for nothing a sacrilegious favour that I +had in vain solicited with millions! But now I had a difficult task in +front of me; it was not in my view that Terutak’ should suffer by his +virtue; and I must persuade the king to share my opinion, to let me +enrich one of his subjects, and (what was yet more delicate) to pay for +my present. Nothing shows the king in a more becoming light than the +fact that I succeeded. He demurred at the principle; he exclaimed, when +he heard it, at the sum. ‘Plenty money!’ cried he, with contemptuous +displeasure. But his resistance was never serious; and when he had blown +off his ill-humour—‘A’ right,’ said he. ‘You give him. Mo’ betta.’ + +Armed with this permission, I made straight for the infirmary. The night +was now come, cool, dark, and starry. On a mat hard by a clear fire of +wood and coco shell, Terutak’ lay beside his wife. Both were smiling; +the agony was over, the king’s command had reconciled (I must suppose) +their agitating scruples; and I was bidden to sit by them and share the +circulating pipe. I was a little moved myself when I placed five gold +sovereigns in the wizard’s hand; but there was no sign of emotion in +Terutak’ as he returned them, pointed to the palace, and named Tembinok’. +It was a changed scene when I had managed to explain. Terutak’, long, +dour Scots fisherman as he was, expressed his satisfaction within bounds; +but the wife beamed; and there was an old gentleman present—her father, I +suppose—who seemed nigh translated. His eyes stood out of his head; +‘_Kaupoi_, _Kaupoi_—rich, rich!’ ran on his lips like a refrain; and he +could not meet my eye but what he gurgled into foolish laughter. + +I might now go home, leaving that fire-lit family party gloating over +their new millions, and consider my strange day. I had tried and +rewarded the virtue of Terutak’. I had played the millionaire, had +behaved abominably, and then in some degree repaired my thoughtlessness. +And now I had my box, and could open it and look within. It contained a +miniature sleeping-mat and a white shell. Tamaiti, interrogated next day +as to the shell, explained it was not exactly Chench, but a cell, or +body, which he would at times inhabit. Asked why there was a +sleeping-mat, he retorted indignantly, ‘Why have you mats?’ And this was +the sceptical Tamaiti! But island scepticism is never deeper than the +lips. + + + +CHAPTER VII—THE KING OF APEMAMA + + +Thus all things on the island, even the priests of the gods, obey the +word of Tembinok’. He can give and take, and slay, and allay the +scruples of the conscientious, and do all things (apparently) but +interfere in the cookery of a turtle. ‘I got power’ is his favourite +word; it interlards his conversation; the thought haunts him and is ever +fresh; and when be has asked and meditates of foreign countries, he looks +up with a smile and reminds you, ‘_I_ got _Power_.’ Nor is his delight +only in the possession, but in the exercise. He rejoices in the crooked +and violent paths of kingship like a strong man to run a race, or like an +artist in his art. To feel, to use his power, to embellish his island +and the picture of the island life after a private ideal, to milk the +island vigorously, to extend his singular museum—these employ +delightfully the sum of his abilities. I never saw a man more patently +in the right trade. + +It would be natural to suppose this monarchy inherited intact through +generations. And so far from that, it is a thing of yesterday. I was +already a boy at school while Apemama was yet republican, ruled by a +noisy council of Old Men, and torn with incurable feuds. And Tembinok’ +is no Bourbon; rather the son of a Napoleon. Of course he is well-born. +No man need aspire high in the isles of the Pacific unless his pedigree +be long and in the upper regions mythical. And our king counts +cousinship with most of the high families in the archipelago, and traces +his descent to a shark and a heroic woman. Directed by an oracle, she +swam beyond sight of land to meet her revolting paramour, and received at +sea the seed of a predestined family. ‘I think lie,’ is the king’s +emphatic commentary; yet he is proud of the legend. From this +illustrious beginning the fortunes of the race must have declined; and +Teñkoruti, the grandfather of Tembinok’, was the chief of a village at +the north end of the island. Kuria and Aranuka were yet independent; +Apemama itself the arena of devastating feuds. Through this perturbed +period of history the figure of Teñkoruti stalks memorable. In war he +was swift and bloody; several towns fell to his spear, and the +inhabitants were butchered to a man. In civil life this arrogance was +unheard of. When the council of Old Men was summoned, he went to the +Speak House, delivered his mind, and left without waiting to be answered. +Wisdom had spoken: let others opine according to their folly. He was +feared and hated, and this was his pleasure. He was no poet; he cared +not for arts or knowledge. ‘My gran’patha one thing savvy, savvy pight,’ +observed the king. In some lull of their own disputes the Old Men of +Apemama adventured on the conquest of Apemama; and this unlicked Caius +Marcius was elected general of the united troops. Success attended him; +the islands were reduced, and Teñkoruti returned to his own government, +glorious and detested. He died about 1860, in the seventieth year of his +age and the full odour of unpopularity. He was tall and lean, says his +grandson, looked extremely old, and ‘walked all the same young man.’ The +same observer gave me a significant detail. The survivors of that rough +epoch were all defaced with spearmarks; there was none on the body of +this skilful fighter. ‘I see old man, no got a spear,’ said the king. + +Teñkoruti left two sons, Tembaitake and Tembinatake. Tembaitake, our +king’s father, was short, middling stout, a poet, a good genealogist, and +something of a fighter; it seems he took himself seriously, and was +perhaps scarce conscious that he was in all things the creature and +nursling of his brother. There was no shadow of dispute between the +pair: the greater man filled with alacrity and content the second place; +held the breach in war, and all the portfolios in the time of peace; and, +when his brother rated him, listened in silence, looking on the ground. +Like Teñkoruti, he was tall and lean and a swift talker—a rare trait in +the islands. He possessed every accomplishment. He knew sorcery, he was +the best genealogist of his day, he was a poet, he could dance and make +canoes and armour; and the famous mast of Apemama, which ran one joint +higher than the mainmast of a full-rigged ship, was of his conception and +design. But these were avocations, and the man’s trade was war. ‘When +my uncle go make wa’, he laugh,’ said Tembinok’. He forbade the use of +field fortification, that protractor of native hostilities; his men must +fight in the open, and win or be beaten out of hand; his own activity +inspired his followers; and the swiftness of his blows beat down, in one +lifetime, the resistance of three islands. He made his brother +sovereign, he left his nephew absolute. ‘My uncle make all smooth,’ said +Tembinok’. ‘I mo’ king than my patha: I got power,’ he said, with +formidable relish. + +Such is the portrait of the uncle drawn by the nephew. I can set beside +it another by a different artist, who has often—I may say +always—delighted me with his romantic taste in narrative, but not +always—and I may say not often—persuaded me of his exactitude. I have +already denied myself the use of so much excellent matter from the same +source, that I begin to think it time to reward good resolution; and his +account of Tembinatake agrees so well with the king’s, that it may very +well be (what I hope it is) the record of a fact, and not (what I +suspect) the pleasing exercise of an imagination more than sailorly. A., +for so I had perhaps better call him, was walking up the island after +dusk, when he came on a lighted village of some size, was directed to the +chief’s house, and asked leave to rest and smoke a pipe. ‘You will sit +down, and smoke a pipe, and wash, and eat, and sleep,’ replied the chief, +‘and to-morrow you will go again.’ Food was brought, prayers were held +(for this was in the brief day of Christianity), and the chief himself +prayed with eloquence and seeming sincerity. All evening A. sat and +admired the man by the firelight. He was six feet high, lean, with the +appearance of many years, and an extraordinary air of breeding and +command. ‘He looked like a man who would kill you laughing,’ said A., in +singular echo of one of the king’s expressions. And again: ‘I had been +reading the Musketeer books, and he reminded me of Aramis.’ Such is the +portrait of Tembinatake, drawn by an expert romancer. + +We had heard many tales of ‘my patha’; never a word of my uncle till two +days before we left. As the time approached for our departure Tembinok’ +became greatly changed; a softer, a more melancholy, and, in particular, +a more confidential man appeared in his stead. To my wife he contrived +laboriously to explain that though he knew he must lose his father in the +course of nature, he had not minded nor realised it till the moment came; +and that now he was to lose us he repeated the experience. We showed +fireworks one evening on the terrace. It was a heavy business; the sense +of separation was in all our minds, and the talk languished. The king +was specially affected, sat disconsolate on his mat, and often sighed. +Of a sudden one of the wives stepped forth from a cluster, came and +kissed him in silence, and silently went again. It was just such a +caress as we might give to a disconsolate child, and the king received it +with a child’s simplicity. Presently after we said good-night and +withdrew; but Tembinok’ detained Mr. Osbourne, patting the mat by his +side and saying: ‘Sit down. I feel bad, I like talk.’ Osbourne sat down +by him. ‘You like some beer?’ said he; and one of the wives produced a +bottle. The king did not partake, but sat sighing and smoking a +meerschaum pipe. ‘I very sorry you go,’ he said at last. ‘Miss Stlevens +he good man, woman he good man, boy he good man; all good man. Woman he +smart all the same man. My woman’ (glancing towards his wives) ‘he good +woman, no very smart. I think Miss Stlevens he is chiep all the same +cap’n man-o-wa’. I think Miss Stlevens he rich man all the same me. All +go schoona. I very sorry. My patha he go, my uncle he go, my cutcheons +he go, Miss Stlevens he go: all go. You no see king cry before. King +all the same man: feel bad, he cry. I very sorry.’ + +In the morning it was the common topic in the village that the king had +wept. To me he said: ‘Last night I no can ’peak: too much here,’ laying +his hand upon his bosom. ‘Now you go away all the same my pamily. My +brothers, my uncle go away. All the same.’ This was said with a +dejection almost passionate. And it was the first time I had heard him +name his uncle, or indeed employ the word. The same day he sent me a +present of two corselets, made in the island fashion of plaited fibre, +heavy and strong. One had been worn by Teñkoruti, one by Tembaitake; and +the gift being gratefully received, he sent me, on the return of his +messengers, a third—that of Tembinatake. My curiosity was roused; I +begged for information as to the three wearers; and the king entered with +gusto into the details already given. Here was a strange thing, that he +should have talked so much of his family, and not once mentioned that +relative of whom he was plainly the most proud. Nay, more: he had +hitherto boasted of his father; thenceforth he had little to say of him; +and the qualities for which he had praised him in the past were now +attributed where they were due,—to the uncle. A confusion might be +natural enough among islanders, who call all the sons of their +grandfather by the common name of father. But this was not the case with +Tembinok’. Now the ice was broken the word uncle was perpetually in his +mouth; he who had been so ready to confound was now careful to +distinguish; and the father sank gradually into a self-complacent +ordinary man, while the uncle rose to his true stature as the hero and +founder of the race. + +The more I heard and the more I considered, the more this mystery of +Tembinok’s behaviour puzzled and attracted me. And the explanation, when +it came, was one to strike the imagination of a dramatist. Tembinok’ had +two brothers. One, detected in private trading, was banished, then +forgiven, lives to this day in the island, and is the father of the +heir-apparent, Paul. The other fell beyond forgiveness. I have heard it +was a love-affair with one of the king’s wives, and the thing is highly +possible in that romantic archipelago. War was attempted to be levied; +but Tembinok’ was too swift for the rebels, and the guilty brother +escaped in a canoe. He did not go alone. Tembinatake had a hand in the +rebellion, and the man who had gained a kingdom for a weakling brother +was banished by that brother’s son. The fugitives came to shore in other +islands, but Tembinok’ remains to this day ignorant of their fate. + +So far history. And now a moment for conjecture. Tembinok’ confused +habitually, not only the attributes and merits of his father and his +uncle, but their diverse personal appearance. Before he had even spoken, +or thought to speak, of Tembinatake, he had told me often of a tall, lean +father, skilled in war, and his own schoolmaster in genealogy and island +arts. How if both were fathers, one natural, one adoptive? How if the +heir of Tembaitake, like the heir of Tembinok’ himself, were not a son, +but an adopted nephew? How if the founder of the monarchy, while he +worked for his brother, worked at the same time for the child of his +loins? How if on the death of Tembaitake, the two stronger +natures, father and son, king and kingmaker, clashed, and Tembinok’, when +he drove out his uncle, drove out the author of his days? Here is at +least a tragedy four-square. + +The king took us on board in his own gig, dressed for the occasion in the +naval uniform. He had little to say, he refused refreshments, shook us +briefly by the hand, and went ashore again. That night the palm-tops of +Apemama had dipped behind the sea, and the schooner sailed solitary under +the stars. + + * * * * * + + THE END. + + * * * * * + + BILLING AND SONS, LTD., PRINTERS, GUILDFORD + + * * * * * + + + + +FOOTNOTES + + +{12} Where that word is used as a salutation I give that form. + +{29} In English usually written ‘taboo’: ‘tapu’ is the correct Tahitian +form.—[ED.] + +{86} The reference is to Maka, the Gawaiian missionary, at Butaritari in +the Gilberts. + +{122} Elephantiasis. + +{156} Arorai is in the Gilberts, Funafuti in the Ellice Islands.—ED. + +{231} Gin and brandy. + +{275} In the Gilbert group. + +{279a} Copra: the dried kernel of the cocoa-nut, the chief article of +commerce throughout the Pacific Islands. + +{279b} Houses. + +{283} Suppose. + + + + +***END OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK IN THE SOUTH SEAS*** + + +******* This file should be named 464-0.txt or 464-0.zip ******* + + +This and all associated files of various formats will be found in: +http://www.gutenberg.org/dirs/4/6/464 + + + +Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions +will be renamed. + +Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no +one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation +(and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without +permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules, +set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to +copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to +protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project +Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you +charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you +do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the +rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose +such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and +research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do +practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is +subject to the trademark license, especially commercial +redistribution. + + + +*** START: FULL LICENSE *** + +THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE +PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK + +To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free +distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work +(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project +Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project +Gutenberg-tm License available with this file or online at + www.gutenberg.org/license. + + +Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm +electronic works + +1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm +electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to +and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property +(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all +the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy +all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession. +If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project +Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the +terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or +entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8. + +1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be +used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who +agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few +things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works +even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See +paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project +Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement +and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic +works. See paragraph 1.E below. + +1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the Foundation" +or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project +Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the +collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an +individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are +located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from +copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative +works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg +are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project +Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by +freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of +this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with +the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by +keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project +Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others. + +1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern +what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in +a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check +the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement +before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or +creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project +Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning +the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United +States. + +1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg: + +1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate +access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently +whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the +phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the phrase "Project +Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed, +copied or distributed: + +This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with +almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or +re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included +with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org + +1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived +from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is +posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied +and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees +or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work +with the phrase "Project Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the +work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1 +through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the +Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or +1.E.9. + +1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted +with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution +must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional +terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked +to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the +permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work. + +1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm +License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this +work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm. + +1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this +electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without +prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with +active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project +Gutenberg-tm License. + +1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary, +compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any +word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or +distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than +"Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official version +posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org), +you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a +copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon +request, of the work in its original "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other +form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm +License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1. + +1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying, +performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works +unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9. + +1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing +access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided +that + +- You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from + the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method + you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is + owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he + has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the + Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments + must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you + prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax + returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and + sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the + address specified in Section 4, "Information about donations to + the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation." + +- You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies + you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he + does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm + License. You must require such a user to return or + destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium + and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of + Project Gutenberg-tm works. + +- You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any + money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the + electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days + of receipt of the work. + +- You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free + distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works. + +1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm +electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set +forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from +both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael +Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the +Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below. + +1.F. + +1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable +effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread +public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm +collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic +works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain +"Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or +corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual +property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a +computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by +your equipment. + +1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right +of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project +Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project +Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project +Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all +liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal +fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT +LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE +PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE +TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE +LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR +INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH +DAMAGE. + +1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a +defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can +receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a +written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you +received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with +your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with +the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a +refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity +providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to +receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy +is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further +opportunities to fix the problem. + +1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth +in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS', WITH NO OTHER +WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO +WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE. + +1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied +warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages. +If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the +law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be +interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by +the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any +provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions. + +1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the +trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone +providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance +with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production, +promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works, +harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees, +that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do +or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm +work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any +Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause. + + +Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm + +Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of +electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers +including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists +because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from +people in all walks of life. + +Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the +assistance they need are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's +goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will +remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project +Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure +and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations. +To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation +and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4 +and the Foundation information page at www.gutenberg.org + + +Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive +Foundation + +The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit +501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the +state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal +Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification +number is 64-6221541. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg +Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent +permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws. + +The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S. +Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered +throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at 809 +North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887. Email +contact links and up to date contact information can be found at the +Foundation's web site and official page at www.gutenberg.org/contact + +For additional contact information: + Dr. Gregory B. Newby + Chief Executive and Director + gbnewby@pglaf.org + +Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg +Literary Archive Foundation + +Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide +spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of +increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be +freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest +array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations +($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt +status with the IRS. + +The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating +charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United +States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a +considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up +with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations +where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To +SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any +particular state visit www.gutenberg.org/donate + +While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we +have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition +against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who +approach us with offers to donate. + +International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make +any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from +outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff. + +Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation +methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other +ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations. +To donate, please visit: www.gutenberg.org/donate + + +Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic +works. + +Professor Michael S. Hart was the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm +concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared +with anyone. For forty years, he produced and distributed Project +Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support. + +Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed +editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S. +unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily +keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition. + +Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility: + + www.gutenberg.org + +This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm, +including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary +Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to +subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks. diff --git a/464-0.zip b/464-0.zip Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000..71d8a96 --- /dev/null +++ b/464-0.zip diff --git a/464-h.zip b/464-h.zip Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000..0a318e5 --- /dev/null +++ b/464-h.zip diff --git a/464-h/464-h.htm b/464-h/464-h.htm new file mode 100644 index 0000000..c889e29 --- /dev/null +++ b/464-h/464-h.htm @@ -0,0 +1,10833 @@ +<!DOCTYPE html + PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD XHTML 1.0 Strict//EN" + "http://www.w3.org/TR/xhtml1/DTD/xhtml1-strict.dtd"> +<html xmlns="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xml:lang="en" lang="en"> +<head> +<meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=US-ASCII" /> +<title>In the South Seas, by Robert Louis Stevenson</title> + <style type="text/css"> +/*<![CDATA[ XML blockout */ +<!-- + P { margin-top: .75em; + margin-bottom: .75em; + } + P.gutsumm { margin-left: 5%;} + P.poetry {margin-left: 3%; } + .GutSmall { font-size: 0.7em; } + H1, H2 { + text-align: center; + margin-top: 2em; + margin-bottom: 2em; + } + H3, H4, H5 { + text-align: center; + margin-top: 1em; + margin-bottom: 1em; + } + BODY{margin-left: 10%; + margin-right: 10%; + } + table { border-collapse: collapse; } +table {margin-left:auto; margin-right:auto;} + td { vertical-align: top; border: 1px solid black;} + td p { margin: 0.2em; } + .blkquot {margin-left: 4em; margin-right: 4em;} /* block indent */ + + .smcap {font-variant: small-caps;} + + .pagenum {position: absolute; + left: 92%; + font-size: small; + text-align: right; + font-weight: normal; + color: gray; + } + img { border: none; } + img.dc { float: left; width: 50px; height: 50px; } + p.gutindent { margin-left: 2em; } + div.gapspace { height: 0.8em; } + div.gapline { height: 0.8em; width: 100%; border-top: 1px solid;} + div.gapmediumline { height: 0.3em; width: 40%; margin-left:30%; + border-top: 1px solid; } + div.gapmediumdoubleline { height: 0.3em; width: 40%; margin-left:30%; + border-top: 1px solid; border-bottom: 1px solid;} + div.gapshortdoubleline { height: 0.3em; width: 20%; + margin-left: 40%; border-top: 1px solid; + border-bottom: 1px solid; } + div.gapdoubleline { height: 0.3em; width: 50%; + margin-left: 25%; border-top: 1px solid; + border-bottom: 1px solid;} + div.gapshortline { height: 0.3em; width: 20%; margin-left:40%; + border-top: 1px solid; } + .citation {vertical-align: super; + font-size: .8em; + text-decoration: none;} + img.floatleft { float: left; + margin-right: 1em; + margin-top: 0.5em; margin-bottom: 0.5em; } + img.floatright { float: right; + margin-left: 1em; margin-top: 0.5em; + margin-bottom: 0.5em; } + img.clearcenter {display: block; + margin-left: auto; + margin-right: auto; margin-top: 0.5em; + margin-bottom: 0.5em} + --> + /* XML end ]]>*/ + </style> +</head> +<body> +<pre> + +The Project Gutenberg eBook, In the South Seas, by Robert Louis Stevenson + + +This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with +almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or +re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included +with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org + + + + + +Title: In the South Seas + + +Author: Robert Louis Stevenson + + + +Release Date: November 16, 2012 [eBook #464] +[This file was first posted on January 23, 1996] + +Language: English + +Character set encoding: ISO-646-US (US-ASCII) + + +***START OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK IN THE SOUTH SEAS*** +</pre> +<p>Transcribed from the 1908 Chatto & Windus edition by David +Price, email ccx074@pglaf.org</p> +<h1>IN THE SOUTH SEAS</h1> +<p style="text-align: center"><span class="GutSmall">BEING AN +ACCOUNT OF EXPERIENCES AND</span><br /> +<span class="GutSmall">OBSERVATIONS IN THE MARQUESAS, +PAUMOTUS</span><br /> +<span class="GutSmall">AND GILBERT ISLANDS IN THE COURSE +OF</span><br /> +<span class="GutSmall">TWO CRUSES, ON THE YACHT +‘CASCO’ (1888)</span><br /> +<span class="GutSmall">AND THE SCHOONER ‘EQUATOR’ +(1889)</span></p> +<p style="text-align: center"><span class="GutSmall">BY</span><br +/> +ROBERT LOUIS STEVENSON</p> +<p style="text-align: center"> +<a href="images/p0b.jpg"> +<img alt= +"Decorative graphic" +title= +"Decorative graphic" +src="images/p0s.jpg" /> +</a></p> +<p style="text-align: center">FINE-PAPER EDITION</p> +<div class="gapspace"> </div> +<p style="text-align: center">LONDON<br /> +CHATTO & WINDUS<br /> +1908</p> +<div class="gapspace"> </div> +<p style="text-align: center"><i>All rights resverved</i></p> +<h2>CONTENTS</h2> +<table> +<tr> +<td colspan="2"><p style="text-align: center">PART 1: THE +MARQUESAS</p> +</td> +</tr> +<tr> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">CHAPTER</span></p> +</td> +<td><p> </p> +</td> +</tr> +<tr> +<td><p style="text-align: right"><span +class="GutSmall">I.</span></p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">AN ISLAND LANDFALL</span></p> +</td> +</tr> +<tr> +<td><p style="text-align: right"><span +class="GutSmall">II.</span></p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">MAKING FRIENDS</span></p> +</td> +</tr> +<tr> +<td><p style="text-align: right"><span +class="GutSmall">III.</span></p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">THE MAROON</span></p> +</td> +</tr> +<tr> +<td><p style="text-align: right"><span +class="GutSmall">IV.</span></p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">DEATH</span></p> +</td> +</tr> +<tr> +<td><p style="text-align: right"><span +class="GutSmall">V.</span></p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">DEPOPULATION</span></p> +</td> +</tr> +<tr> +<td><p style="text-align: right"><span +class="GutSmall">VI.</span></p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">CHIEFS AND TAPUS</span></p> +</td> +</tr> +<tr> +<td><p style="text-align: right"><span +class="GutSmall">VII.</span></p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">HATIHEU</span></p> +</td> +</tr> +<tr> +<td><p style="text-align: right"><span +class="GutSmall">VIII.</span></p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">THE PORT OF ENTRY</span></p> +</td> +</tr> +<tr> +<td><p style="text-align: right"><span +class="GutSmall">IX.</span></p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">THE HOUSE OF TEMOANA</span></p> +</td> +</tr> +<tr> +<td><p style="text-align: right"><span +class="GutSmall">X.</span></p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">A PORTRAIT AND A STORY</span></p> +</td> +</tr> +<tr> +<td><p style="text-align: right"><span +class="GutSmall">XI.</span></p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">LONG-PIG—A CANNIBAL HIGH +PLACE</span></p> +</td> +</tr> +<tr> +<td><p style="text-align: right"><span +class="GutSmall">XII.</span></p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">THE STORY OF A +PLANTATION</span></p> +</td> +</tr> +<tr> +<td><p style="text-align: right"><span +class="GutSmall">XIII.</span></p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">CHARACTERS</span></p> +</td> +</tr> +<tr> +<td><p style="text-align: right"><span +class="GutSmall">XIV.</span></p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">IN A CANNIBAL VALLEY</span></p> +</td> +</tr> +<tr> +<td><p style="text-align: right"><span +class="GutSmall">XV.</span></p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">THE TWO CHIEFS OF ATUONA</span></p> +</td> +</tr> +<tr> +<td colspan="2"><p style="text-align: center">PART II: THE +PAUMOTUS</p> +</td> +</tr> +<tr> +<td><p style="text-align: right"><span +class="GutSmall">I.</span></p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">THE DANGEROUS +ARCHIPELAGO—ATOLLS AT A DISTANCE</span></p> +</td> +</tr> +<tr> +<td><p style="text-align: right"><span +class="GutSmall">II.</span></p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">FAKARAVA: AN ATOLL AT +HAND</span></p> +</td> +</tr> +<tr> +<td><p style="text-align: right"><span +class="GutSmall">III.</span></p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">A HOUSE TO LET IN A LOW +ISLAND</span></p> +</td> +</tr> +<tr> +<td><p style="text-align: right"><span +class="GutSmall">IV.</span></p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">TRAITS AND SECTS IN THE +PAUMOTUS</span></p> +</td> +</tr> +<tr> +<td><p style="text-align: right"><span +class="GutSmall">V.</span></p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">A PAUMOTUAN FUNERAL</span></p> +</td> +</tr> +<tr> +<td><p style="text-align: right"><span +class="GutSmall">VI.</span></p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">GRAVEYARD STORIES</span></p> +</td> +</tr> +<tr> +<td colspan="2"><p style="text-align: center">PART III: THE +GILBERTS</p> +</td> +</tr> +<tr> +<td><p style="text-align: right"><span +class="GutSmall">I.</span></p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">BUTARITARI</span></p> +</td> +</tr> +<tr> +<td><p style="text-align: right"><span +class="GutSmall">II.</span></p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">THE FOUR BROTHERS</span></p> +</td> +</tr> +<tr> +<td><p style="text-align: right"><span +class="GutSmall">III.</span></p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">AROUND OUR HOUSE</span></p> +</td> +</tr> +<tr> +<td><p style="text-align: right"><span +class="GutSmall">IV.</span></p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">A TALE OF A TAPU</span></p> +</td> +</tr> +<tr> +<td><p style="text-align: right"><span +class="GutSmall">V.</span></p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">A TALE OF A TAPU—</span><span +class="GutSmall"><i>continued</i></span></p> +</td> +</tr> +<tr> +<td><p style="text-align: right"><span +class="GutSmall">VI.</span></p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">THE FIVE DAYS’ +FESTIVAL</span></p> +</td> +</tr> +<tr> +<td><p style="text-align: right"><span +class="GutSmall">VII.</span></p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">HUSBAND AND WIFE</span></p> +</td> +</tr> +<tr> +<td colspan="2"><p style="text-align: center">PART IV: THE +GILBERTS—APEMAMA</p> +</td> +</tr> +<tr> +<td><p style="text-align: right"><span +class="GutSmall">I.</span></p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">THE KING OF APEMAMA: THE ROYAL +TRADER</span></p> +</td> +</tr> +<tr> +<td><p style="text-align: right"><span +class="GutSmall">II.</span></p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">THE KING OF APEMAMA: FOUNDATION OF +EQUATOR TOWN</span></p> +</td> +</tr> +<tr> +<td><p style="text-align: right"><span +class="GutSmall">III.</span></p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">THE KING OF APEMAMA: THE PALACE OF +MANY WOMEN</span></p> +</td> +</tr> +<tr> +<td><p style="text-align: right"><span +class="GutSmall">IV.</span></p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">THE KING OF APEMAMA: EQUATOR TOWN +AND THE PALACE</span></p> +</td> +</tr> +<tr> +<td><p style="text-align: right"><span +class="GutSmall">V.</span></p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">KING AND COMMONS</span></p> +</td> +</tr> +<tr> +<td><p style="text-align: right"><span +class="GutSmall">VI.</span></p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">THE KING OF APEMAMA: +DEVIL-WORK</span></p> +</td> +</tr> +<tr> +<td><p style="text-align: right"><span +class="GutSmall">VII.</span></p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">THE KING OF APEMAMA</span></p> +</td> +</tr> +</table> +<h2>PART 1: THE MARQUESAS</h2> +<h3>CHAPTER I—AN ISLAND LANDFALL</h3> +<p>For nearly ten years my health had been declining; and for +some while before I set forth upon my voyage, I believed I was +come to the afterpiece of life, and had only the nurse and +undertaker to expect. It was suggested that I should try +the South Seas; and I was not unwilling to visit like a ghost, +and be carried like a bale, among scenes that had attracted me in +youth and health. I chartered accordingly Dr. +Merrit’s schooner yacht, the <i>Casco</i>, seventy-four +tons register; sailed from San Francisco towards the end of June +1888, visited the eastern islands, and was left early the next +year at Honolulu. Hence, lacking courage to return to my +old life of the house and sick-room, I set forth to leeward in a +trading schooner, the <i>Equator</i>, of a little over seventy +tons, spent four months among the atolls (low coral islands) of +the Gilbert group, and reached Samoa towards the close of +’89. By that time gratitude and habit were beginning +to attach me to the islands; I had gained a competency of +strength; I had made friends; I had learned new interests; the +time of my voyages had passed like days in fairyland; and I +decided to remain. I began to prepare these pages at sea, +on a third cruise, in the trading steamer <i>Janet +Nicoll</i>. If more days are granted me, they shall be +passed where I have found life most pleasant and man most +interesting; the axes of my black boys are already clearing the +foundations of my future house; and I must learn to address +readers from the uttermost parts of the sea.</p> +<p>That I should thus have reversed the verdict of Lord +Tennyson’s hero is less eccentric than appears. Few +men who come to the islands leave them; they grow grey where they +alighted; the palm shades and the trade-wind fans them till they +die, perhaps cherishing to the last the fancy of a visit home, +which is rarely made, more rarely enjoyed, and yet more rarely +repeated. No part of the world exerts the same attractive +power upon the visitor, and the task before me is to communicate +to fireside travellers some sense of its seduction, and to +describe the life, at sea and ashore, of many hundred thousand +persons, some of our own blood and language, all our +contemporaries, and yet as remote in thought and habit as Rob Roy +or Barbarossa, the Apostles or the Cæsars.</p> +<p>The first experience can never be repeated. The first +love, the first sunrise, the first South Sea island, are memories +apart and touched a virginity of sense. On the 28th of July +1888 the moon was an hour down by four in the morning. In +the east a radiating centre of brightness told of the day; and +beneath, on the skyline, the morning bank was already building, +black as ink. We have all read of the swiftness of the +day’s coming and departure in low latitudes; it is a point +on which the scientific and sentimental tourist are at one, and +has inspired some tasteful poetry. The period certainly +varies with the season; but here is one case exactly noted. +Although the dawn was thus preparing by four, the sun was not up +till six; and it was half-past five before we could distinguish +our expected islands from the clouds on the horizon. Eight +degrees south, and the day two hours a-coming. The interval +was passed on deck in the silence of expectation, the customary +thrill of landfall heightened by the strangeness of the shores +that we were then approaching. Slowly they took shape in +the attenuating darkness. Ua-huna, piling up to a truncated +summit, appeared the first upon the starboard bow; almost abeam +arose our destination, Nuka-hiva, whelmed in cloud; and betwixt +and to the southward, the first rays of the sun displayed the +needles of Ua-pu. These pricked about the line of the +horizon; like the pinnacles of some ornate and monstrous church, +they stood there, in the sparkling brightness of the morning, the +fit signboard of a world of wonders.</p> +<p>Not one soul aboard the <i>Casco</i> had set foot upon the +islands, or knew, except by accident, one word of any of the +island tongues; and it was with something perhaps of the same +anxious pleasure as thrilled the bosom of discoverers that we +drew near these problematic shores. The land heaved up in +peaks and rising vales; it fell in cliffs and buttresses; its +colour ran through fifty modulations in a scale of pearl and rose +and olive; and it was crowned above by opalescent clouds. +The suffusion of vague hues deceived the eye; the shadows of +clouds were confounded with the articulations of the mountains; +and the isle and its unsubstantial canopy rose and shimmered +before us like a single mass. There was no beacon, no smoke +of towns to be expected, no plying pilot. Somewhere, in +that pale phantasmagoria of cliff and cloud, our haven lay +concealed; and somewhere to the east of it—the only +sea-mark given—a certain headland, known indifferently as +Cape Adam and Eve, or Cape Jack and Jane, and distinguished by +two colossal figures, the gross statuary of nature. These +we were to find; for these we craned and stared, focused glasses, +and wrangled over charts; and the sun was overhead and the land +close ahead before we found them. To a ship approaching, +like the <i>Casco</i>, from the north, they proved indeed the +least conspicuous features of a striking coast; the surf flying +high above its base; strange, austere, and feathered mountains +rising behind; and Jack and Jane, or Adam and Eve, impending like +a pair of warts above the breakers.</p> +<p>Thence we bore away along shore. On our port beam we +might hear the explosions of the surf; a few birds flew fishing +under the prow; there was no other sound or mark of life, whether +of man or beast, in all that quarter of the island. Winged +by her own impetus and the dying breeze, the <i>Casco</i> skimmed +under cliffs, opened out a cove, showed us a beach and some green +trees, and flitted by again, bowing to the swell. The +trees, from our distance, might have been hazel; the beach might +have been in Europe; the mountain forms behind modelled in little +from the Alps, and the forest which clustered on their ramparts a +growth no more considerable than our Scottish heath. Again +the cliff yawned, but now with a deeper entry; and the +<i>Casco</i>, hauling her wind, began to slide into the bay of +Anaho. The cocoa-palm, that giraffe of vegetables, so +graceful, so ungainly, to the European eye so foreign, was to be +seen crowding on the beach, and climbing and fringing the steep +sides of mountains. Rude and bare hills embraced the inlet +upon either hand; it was enclosed to the landward by a bulk of +shattered mountains. In every crevice of that barrier the +forest harboured, roosting and nestling there like birds about a +ruin; and far above, it greened and roughened the razor edges of +the summit.</p> +<p>Under the eastern shore, our schooner, now bereft of any +breeze, continued to creep in: the smart creature, when once +under way, appearing motive in herself. From close aboard +arose the bleating of young lambs; a bird sang in the hillside; +the scent of the land and of a hundred fruits or flowers flowed +forth to meet us; and, presently, a house or two appeared, +standing high upon the ankles of the hills, and one of these +surrounded with what seemed a garden. These conspicuous +habitations, that patch of culture, had we but known it, were a +mark of the passage of whites; and we might have approached a +hundred islands and not found their parallel. It was longer +ere we spied the native village, standing (in the universal +fashion) close upon a curve of beach, close under a grove of +palms; the sea in front growling and whitening on a concave arc +of reef. For the cocoa-tree and the island man are both +lovers and neighbours of the surf. ‘The coral waxes, +the palm grows, but man departs,’ says the sad Tahitian +proverb; but they are all three, so long as they endure, +co-haunters of the beach. The mark of anchorage was a +blow-hole in the rocks, near the south-easterly corner of the +bay. Punctually to our use, the blow-hole spouted; the +schooner turned upon her heel; the anchor plunged. It was a +small sound, a great event; my soul went down with these moorings +whence no windlass may extract nor any diver fish it up; and I, +and some part of my ship’s company, were from that hour the +bondslaves of the isles of Vivien.</p> +<p>Before yet the anchor plunged a canoe was already paddling +from the hamlet. It contained two men: one white, one brown +and tattooed across the face with bands of blue, both in +immaculate white European clothes: the resident trader, Mr. +Regler, and the native chief, Taipi-Kikino. ‘Captain, +is it permitted to come on board?’ were the first words we +heard among the islands. Canoe followed canoe till the ship +swarmed with stalwart, six-foot men in every stage of undress; +some in a shirt, some in a loin-cloth, one in a handkerchief +imperfectly adjusted; some, and these the more considerable, +tattooed from head to foot in awful patterns; some barbarous and +knived; one, who sticks in my memory as something bestial, +squatting on his hams in a canoe, sucking an orange and spitting +it out again to alternate sides with ape-like vivacity—all +talking, and we could not understand one word; all trying to +trade with us who had no thought of trading, or offering us +island curios at prices palpably absurd. There was no word +of welcome; no show of civility; no hand extended save that of +the chief and Mr. Regler. As we still continued to refuse +the proffered articles, complaint ran high and rude; and one, the +jester of the party, railed upon our meanness amid jeering +laughter. Amongst other angry +pleasantries—‘Here is a mighty fine ship,’ said +he, ‘to have no money on board!’ I own I was +inspired with sensible repugnance; even with alarm. The +ship was manifestly in their power; we had women on board; I knew +nothing of my guests beyond the fact that they were cannibals; +the Directory (my only guide) was full of timid cautions; and as +for the trader, whose presence might else have reassured me, were +not whites in the Pacific the usual instigators and accomplices +of native outrage? When he reads this confession, our kind +friend, Mr. Regler, can afford to smile.</p> +<p>Later in the day, as I sat writing up my journal, the cabin +was filled from end to end with Marquesans: three brown-skinned +generations, squatted cross-legged upon the floor, and regarding +me in silence with embarrassing eyes. The eyes of all +Polynesians are large, luminous, and melting; they are like the +eyes of animals and some Italians. A kind of despair came +over me, to sit there helpless under all these staring orbs, and +be thus blocked in a corner of my cabin by this speechless crowd: +and a kind of rage to think they were beyond the reach of +articulate communication, like furred animals, or folk born deaf, +or the dwellers of some alien planet.</p> +<p>To cross the Channel is, for a boy of twelve, to change +heavens; to cross the Atlantic, for a man of twenty-four, is +hardly to modify his diet. But I was now escaped out of the +shadow of the Roman empire, under whose toppling monuments we +were all cradled, whose laws and letters are on every hand of us, +constraining and preventing. I was now to see what men +might be whose fathers had never studied Virgil, had never been +conquered by Cæsar, and never been ruled by the wisdom of +Gaius or Papinian. By the same step I had journeyed forth +out of that comfortable zone of kindred languages, where the +curse of Babel is so easy to be remedied; and my new +fellow-creatures sat before me dumb like images. Methought, +in my travels, all human relation was to be excluded; and when I +returned home (for in those days I still projected my return) I +should have but dipped into a picture-book without a text. +Nay, and I even questioned if my travels should be much +prolonged; perhaps they were destined to a speedy end; perhaps my +subsequent friend, Kauanui, whom I remarked there, sitting silent +with the rest, for a man of some authority, might leap from his +hams with an ear-splitting signal, the ship be carried at a rush, +and the ship’s company butchered for the table.</p> +<p>There could be nothing more natural than these apprehensions, +nor anything more groundless. In my experience of the +islands, I had never again so menacing a reception; were I to +meet with such to-day, I should be more alarmed and tenfold more +surprised. The majority of Polynesians are easy folk to get +in touch with, frank, fond of notice, greedy of the least +affection, like amiable, fawning dogs; and even with the +Marquesans, so recently and so imperfectly redeemed from a +blood-boltered barbarism, all were to become our intimates, and +one, at least, was to mourn sincerely our departure.</p> +<h3>CHAPTER II—MAKING FRIENDS</h3> +<p>The impediment of tongues was one that I particularly +over-estimated. The languages of Polynesia are easy to +smatter, though hard to speak with elegance. And they are +extremely similar, so that a person who has a tincture of one or +two may risk, not without hope, an attempt upon the others.</p> +<p>And again, not only is Polynesian easy to smatter, but +interpreters abound. Missionaries, traders, and broken +white folk living on the bounty of the natives, are to be found +in almost every isle and hamlet; and even where these are +unserviceable, the natives themselves have often scraped up a +little English, and in the French zone (though far less commonly) +a little French-English, or an efficient pidgin, what is called +to the westward ‘Beach-la-Mar,’ comes easy to the +Polynesian; it is now taught, besides, in the schools of Hawaii; +and from the multiplicity of British ships, and the nearness of +the States on the one hand and the colonies on the other, it may +be called, and will almost certainly become, the tongue of the +Pacific. I will instance a few examples. I met in +Majuro a Marshall Island boy who spoke excellent English; this he +had learned in the German firm in Jaluit, yet did not speak one +word of German. I heard from a gendarme who had taught +school in Rapa-iti that while the children had the utmost +difficulty or reluctance to learn French, they picked up English +on the wayside, and as if by accident. On one of the most +out-of-the-way atolls in the Carolines, my friend Mr. Benjamin +Hird was amazed to find the lads playing cricket on the beach and +talking English; and it was in English that the crew of the +<i>Janet Nicoll</i>, a set of black boys from different +Melanesian islands, communicated with other natives throughout +the cruise, transmitted orders, and sometimes jested together on +the fore-hatch. But what struck me perhaps most of all was +a word I heard on the verandah of the Tribunal at Noumea. A +case had just been heard—a trial for infanticide against an +ape-like native woman; and the audience were smoking cigarettes +as they awaited the verdict. An anxious, amiable French +lady, not far from tears, was eager for acquittal, and declared +she would engage the prisoner to be her children’s +nurse. The bystanders exclaimed at the proposal; the woman +was a savage, said they, and spoke no language. +‘<i>Mais</i>, <i>vous savez</i>,’ objected the fair +sentimentalist; ‘<i>ils apprennent si vite +l’anglais</i>!’</p> +<p>But to be able to speak to people is not all. And in the +first stage of my relations with natives I was helped by two +things. To begin with, I was the show-man of the +<i>Casco</i>. She, her fine lines, tall spars, and snowy +decks, the crimson fittings of the saloon, and the white, the +gilt, and the repeating mirrors of the tiny cabin, brought us a +hundred visitors. The men fathomed out her dimensions with +their arms, as their fathers fathomed out the ships of Cook; the +women declared the cabins more lovely than a church; bouncing +Junos were never weary of sitting in the chairs and contemplating +in the glass their own bland images; and I have seen one lady +strip up her dress, and, with cries of wonder and delight, rub +herself bare-breeched upon the velvet cushions. Biscuit, +jam, and syrup was the entertainment; and, as in European +parlours, the photograph album went the round. This sober +gallery, their everyday costumes and physiognomies, had become +transformed, in three weeks’ sailing, into things wonderful +and rich and foreign; alien faces, barbaric dresses, they were +now beheld and fingered, in the swerving cabin, with innocent +excitement and surprise. Her Majesty was often recognised, +and I have seen French subjects kiss her photograph; Captain +Speedy—in an Abyssinian war-dress, supposed to be the +uniform of the British army—met with much acceptance; and +the effigies of Mr. Andrew Lang were admired in the +Marquesas. There is the place for him to go when he shall +be weary of Middlesex and Homer.</p> +<p>It was perhaps yet more important that I had enjoyed in my +youth some knowledge of our Scots folk of the Highlands and the +Islands. Not much beyond a century has passed since these +were in the same convulsive and transitionary state as the +Marquesans of to-day. In both cases an alien authority +enforced, the clans disarmed, the chiefs deposed, new customs +introduced, and chiefly that fashion of regarding money as the +means and object of existence. The commercial age, in each, +succeeding at a bound to an age of war abroad and patriarchal +communism at home. In one the cherished practice of +tattooing, in the other a cherished costume, proscribed. In +each a main luxury cut off: beef, driven under cloud of night +from Lowland pastures, denied to the meat-loving Highlander; +long-pig, pirated from the next village, to the man-eating +Kanaka. The grumbling, the secret ferment, the fears and +resentments, the alarms and sudden councils of Marquesan chiefs, +reminded me continually of the days of Lovat and Struan. +Hospitality, tact, natural fine manners, and a touchy punctilio, +are common to both races: common to both tongues the trick of +dropping medial consonants. Here is a table of two +widespread Polynesian words:—</p> +<table> +<tr> +<td><p> </p> +</td> +<td><p style="text-align: center"><i>House</i>.</p> +</td> +<td><p style="text-align: center"><i>Love</i>. <a +name="citation12"></a><a href="#footnote12" +class="citation">[12]</a></p> +</td> +</tr> +<tr> +<td><p>Tahitian</p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">FARE</span></p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">AROHA</span></p> +</td> +</tr> +<tr> +<td><p>New Zealand</p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">WHARE</span></p> +</td> +<td><p> </p> +</td> +</tr> +<tr> +<td><p>Samoan</p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">FALE</span></p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">TALOFA</span></p> +</td> +</tr> +<tr> +<td><p>Manihiki</p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">FALE</span></p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">ALOHA</span></p> +</td> +</tr> +<tr> +<td><p>Hawaiian</p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">HALE</span></p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">ALOHA</span></p> +</td> +</tr> +<tr> +<td><p>Marquesan</p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">HA’E</span></p> +</td> +<td><p><span class="GutSmall">KAOHA</span></p> +</td> +</tr> +</table> +<p>The elision of medial consonants, so marked in these Marquesan +instances, is no less common both in Gaelic and the Lowland +Scots. Stranger still, that prevalent Polynesian sound, the +so-called catch, written with an apostrophe, and often or always +the gravestone of a perished consonant, is to be heard in +Scotland to this day. When a Scot pronounces water, better, +or bottle—<i>wa’er</i>, <i>be’er</i>, or +<i>bo’le</i>—the sound is precisely that of the +catch; and I think we may go beyond, and say, that if such a +population could be isolated, and this mispronunciation should +become the rule, it might prove the first stage of transition +from <i>t</i> to <i>k</i>, which is the disease of Polynesian +languages. The tendency of the Marquesans, however, is to +urge against consonants, or at least on the very common letter +<i>l</i>, a war of mere extermination. A hiatus is +agreeable to any Polynesian ear; the ear even of the stranger +soon grows used to these barbaric voids; but only in the +Marquesan will you find such names as <i>Haaii</i> and +<i>Paaaeua</i>, when each individual vowel must be separately +uttered.</p> +<p>These points of similarity between a South Sea people and some +of my own folk at home ran much in my head in the islands; and +not only inclined me to view my fresh acquaintances with favour, +but continually modified my judgment. A polite Englishman +comes to-day to the Marquesans and is amazed to find the men +tattooed; polite Italians came not long ago to England and found +our fathers stained with woad; and when I paid the return visit +as a little boy, I was highly diverted with the backwardness of +Italy: so insecure, so much a matter of the day and hour, is the +pre-eminence of race. It was so that I hit upon a means of +communication which I recommend to travellers. When I +desired any detail of savage custom, or of superstitious belief, +I cast back in the story of my fathers, and fished for what I +wanted with some trait of equal barbarism: Michael Scott, Lord +Derwentwater’s head, the second-sight, the Water +Kelpie,—each of these I have found to be a killing bait; +the black bull’s head of Stirling procured me the legend of +<i>Rahero</i>; and what I knew of the Cluny Macphersons, or the +Appin Stewarts, enabled me to learn, and helped me to understand, +about the <i>Tevas</i> of Tahiti. The native was no longer +ashamed, his sense of kinship grew warmer, and his lips were +opened. It is this sense of kinship that the traveller must +rouse and share; or he had better content himself with travels +from the blue bed to the brown. And the presence of one +Cockney titterer will cause a whole party to walk in clouds of +darkness.</p> +<p>The hamlet of Anaho stands on a margin of flat land between +the west of the beach and the spring of the impending +mountains. A grove of palms, perpetually ruffling its green +fans, carpets it (as for a triumph) with fallen branches, and +shades it like an arbour. A road runs from end to end of +the covert among beds of flowers, the milliner’s shop of +the community; and here and there, in the grateful twilight, in +an air filled with a diversity of scents, and still within +hearing of the surf upon the reef, the native houses stand in +scattered neighbourhood. The same word, as we have seen, +represents in many tongues of Polynesia, with scarce a shade of +difference, the abode of man. But although the word be the +same, the structure itself continually varies; and the Marquesan, +among the most backward and barbarous of islanders, is yet the +most commodiously lodged. The grass huts of Hawaii, the +birdcage houses of Tahiti, or the open shed, with the crazy +Venetian blinds, of the polite Samoan—none of these can be +compared with the Marquesan <i>paepae-hae</i>, or dwelling +platform. The paepae is an oblong terrace built without +cement or black volcanic stone, from twenty to fifty feet in +length, raised from four to eight feet from the earth, and +accessible by a broad stair. Along the back of this, and +coming to about half its width, runs the open front of the house, +like a covered gallery: the interior sometimes neat and almost +elegant in its bareness, the sleeping space divided off by an +endlong coaming, some bright raiment perhaps hanging from a nail, +and a lamp and one of White’s sewing-machines the only +marks of civilization. On the outside, at one end of the +terrace, burns the cooking-fire under a shed; at the other there +is perhaps a pen for pigs; the remainder is the evening lounge +and <i>al fresco</i> banquet-hall of the inhabitants. To +some houses water is brought down the mountains in bamboo pipes, +perforated for the sake of sweetness. With the Highland +comparison in my mind, I was struck to remember the sluttish +mounds of turf and stone in which I have sat and been entertained +in the Hebrides and the North Islands. Two things, I +suppose, explain the contrast. In Scotland wood is rare, +and with materials so rude as turf and stone the very hope of +neatness is excluded. And in Scotland it is cold. +Shelter and a hearth are needs so pressing that a man looks not +beyond; he is out all day after a bare bellyful, and at night +when he saith, ‘Aha, it is warm!’ he has not appetite +for more. Or if for something else, then something higher; +a fine school of poetry and song arose in these rough shelters, +and an air like ‘<i>Lochaber no more</i>’ is an +evidence of refinement more convincing, as well as more +imperishable, than a palace.</p> +<p>To one such dwelling platform a considerable troop of +relatives and dependants resort. In the hour of the dusk, +when the fire blazes, and the scent of the cooked breadfruit +fills the air, and perhaps the lamp glints already between the +pillars and the house, you shall behold them silently assemble to +this meal, men, women, and children; and the dogs and pigs frisk +together up the terrace stairway, switching rival tails. +The strangers from the ship were soon equally welcome: welcome to +dip their fingers in the wooden dish, to drink cocoanuts, to +share the circulating pipe, and to hear and hold high debate +about the misdeeds of the French, the Panama Canal, or the +geographical position of San Francisco and New Yo’ko. +In a Highland hamlet, quite out of reach of any tourist, I have +met the same plain and dignified hospitality.</p> +<p>I have mentioned two facts—the distasteful behaviour of +our earliest visitors, and the case of the lady who rubbed +herself upon the cushions—which would give a very false +opinion of Marquesan manners. The great majority of +Polynesians are excellently mannered; but the Marquesan stands +apart, annoying and attractive, wild, shy, and refined. If +you make him a present he affects to forget it, and it must be +offered him again at his going: a pretty formality I have found +nowhere else. A hint will get rid of any one or any number; +they are so fiercely proud and modest; while many of the more +lovable but blunter islanders crowd upon a stranger, and can be +no more driven off than flies. A slight or an insult the +Marquesan seems never to forget. I was one day talking by +the wayside with my friend Hoka, when I perceived his eyes +suddenly to flash and his stature to swell. A white +horseman was coming down the mountain, and as he passed, and +while he paused to exchange salutations with myself, Hoka was +still staring and ruffling like a gamecock. It was a +Corsican who had years before called him <i>cochon +sauvage—coçon chauvage</i>, as Hoka mispronounced +it. With people so nice and so touchy, it was scarce to be +supposed that our company of greenhorns should not blunder into +offences. Hoka, on one of his visits, fell suddenly in a +brooding silence, and presently after left the ship with cold +formality. When he took me back into favour, he adroitly +and pointedly explained the nature of my offence: I had asked him +to sell cocoa-nuts; and in Hoka’s view articles of food +were things that a gentleman should give, not sell; or at least +that he should not sell to any friend. On another occasion +I gave my boat’s crew a luncheon of chocolate and +biscuits. I had sinned, I could never learn how, against +some point of observance; and though I was drily thanked, my +offerings were left upon the beach. But our worst mistake +was a slight we put on Toma, Hoka’s adoptive father, and in +his own eyes the rightful chief of Anaho. In the first +place, we did not call upon him, as perhaps we should, in his +fine new European house, the only one in the hamlet. In the +second, when we came ashore upon a visit to his rival, +Taipi-Kikino, it was Toma whom we saw standing at the head of the +beach, a magnificent figure of a man, magnificently tattooed; and +it was of Toma that we asked our question: ‘Where is the +chief?’ ‘What chief?’ cried Toma, and +turned his back on the blasphemers. Nor did he forgive +us. Hoka came and went with us daily; but, alone I believe +of all the countryside, neither Toma nor his wife set foot on +board the <i>Casco</i>. The temptation resisted it is hard +for a European to compute. The flying city of Laputa moored +for a fortnight in St. James’s Park affords but a pale +figure of the <i>Casco</i> anchored before Anaho; for the +Londoner has still his change of pleasures, but the Marquesan +passes to his grave through an unbroken uniformity of days.</p> +<p>On the afternoon before it was intended we should sail, a +valedictory party came on board: nine of our particular friends +equipped with gifts and dressed as for a festival. Hoka, +the chief dancer and singer, the greatest dandy of Anaho, and one +of the handsomest young fellows in the world-sullen, showy, +dramatic, light as a feather and strong as an ox—it would +have been hard, on that occasion, to recognise, as he sat there +stooped and silent, his face heavy and grey. It was strange +to see the lad so much affected; stranger still to recognise in +his last gift one of the curios we had refused on the first day, +and to know our friend, so gaily dressed, so plainly moved at our +departure, for one of the half-naked crew that had besieged and +insulted us on our arrival: strangest of all, perhaps, to find, +in that carved handle of a fan, the last of those curiosities of +the first day which had now all been given to us by their +possessors—their chief merchandise, for which they had +sought to ransom us as long as we were strangers, which they +pressed on us for nothing as soon as we were friends. The +last visit was not long protracted. One after another they +shook hands and got down into their canoe; when Hoka turned his +back immediately upon the ship, so that we saw his face no +more. Taipi, on the other hand, remained standing and +facing us with gracious valedictory gestures; and when Captain +Otis dipped the ensign, the whole party saluted with their +hats. This was the farewell; the episode of our visit to +Anaho was held concluded; and though the <i>Casco</i> remained +nearly forty hours at her moorings, not one returned on board, +and I am inclined to think they avoided appearing on the +beach. This reserve and dignity is the finest trait of the +Marquesan.</p> +<h3>CHAPTER III—THE MAROON</h3> +<p>Of the beauties of Anaho books might be written. I +remember waking about three, to find the air temperate and +scented. The long swell brimmed into the bay, and seemed to +fill it full and then subside. Gently, deeply, and silently +the <i>Casco</i> rolled; only at times a block piped like a +bird. Oceanward, the heaven was bright with stars and the +sea with their reflections. If I looked to that side, I +might have sung with the Hawaiian poet:</p> +<blockquote><p><i>Ua maomao ka lani</i>, <i>ua kahaea +luna</i>,<br /> +<i>Ua pipi ka maka o ka hoku</i>.<br /> +(The heavens were fair, they stretched above,<br /> +Many were the eyes of the stars.)</p> +</blockquote> +<p>And then I turned shoreward, and high squalls were overhead; +the mountains loomed up black; and I could have fancied I had +slipped ten thousand miles away and was anchored in a Highland +loch; that when the day came, it would show pine, and heather, +and green fern, and roofs of turf sending up the smoke of peats; +and the alien speech that should next greet my ears must be +Gaelic, not Kanaka.</p> +<p>And day, when it came, brought other sights and +thoughts. I have watched the morning break in many quarters +of the world; it has been certainly one of the chief joys of my +existence, and the dawn that I saw with most emotion shone upon +the bay of Anaho. The mountains abruptly overhang the port +with every variety of surface and of inclination, lawn, and +cliff, and forest. Not one of these but wore its proper +tint of saffron, of sulphur, of the clove, and of the rose. +The lustre was like that of satin; on the lighter hues there +seemed to float an efflorescence; a solemn bloom appeared on the +more dark. The light itself was the ordinary light of +morning, colourless and clean; and on this ground of jewels, +pencilled out the least detail of drawing. Meanwhile, +around the hamlet, under the palms, where the blue shadow +lingered, the red coals of cocoa husk and the light trails of +smoke betrayed the awakening business of the day; along the beach +men and women, lads and lasses, were returning from the bath in +bright raiment, red and blue and green, such as we delighted to +see in the coloured little pictures of our childhood; and +presently the sun had cleared the eastern hill, and the glow of +the day was over all.</p> +<p>The glow continued and increased, the business, from the main +part, ceased before it had begun. Twice in the day there +was a certain stir of shepherding along the seaward hills. +At times a canoe went out to fish. At times a woman or two +languidly filled a basket in the cotton patch. At times a +pipe would sound out of the shadow of a house, ringing the +changes on its three notes, with an effect like <i>Que le jour me +dure</i>, repeated endlessly. Or at times, across a corner +of the bay, two natives might communicate in the Marquesan manner +with conventional whistlings. All else was sleep and +silence. The surf broke and shone around the shores; a +species of black crane fished in the broken water; the black pigs +were continually galloping by on some affair; but the people +might never have awaked, or they might all be dead.</p> +<p>My favourite haunt was opposite the hamlet, where was a +landing in a cove under a lianaed cliff. The beach was +lined with palms and a tree called the purao, something between +the fig and mulberry in growth, and bearing a flower like a great +yellow poppy with a maroon heart. In places rocks +encroached upon the sand; the beach would be all submerged; and +the surf would bubble warmly as high as to my knees, and play +with cocoa-nut husks as our more homely ocean plays with wreck +and wrack and bottles. As the reflux drew down, marvels of +colour and design streamed between my feet; which I would grasp +at, miss, or seize: now to find them what they promised, shells +to grace a cabinet or be set in gold upon a lady’s finger; +now to catch only <i>maya</i> of coloured sand, pounded fragments +and pebbles, that, as soon as they were dry, became as dull and +homely as the flints upon a garden path. I have toiled at +this childish pleasure for hours in the strong sun, conscious of +my incurable ignorance; but too keenly pleased to be +ashamed. Meanwhile, the blackbird (or his tropical +understudy) would be fluting in the thickets overhead.</p> +<p>A little further, in the turn of the bay, a streamlet trickled +in the bottom of a den, thence spilling down a stair of rock into +the sea. The draught of air drew down under the foliage in +the very bottom of the den, which was a perfect arbour for +coolness. In front it stood open on the blue bay and the +<i>Casco</i> lying there under her awning and her cheerful +colours. Overhead was a thatch of puraos, and over these +again palms brandished their bright fans, as I have seen a +conjurer make himself a halo out of naked swords. For in +this spot, over a neck of low land at the foot of the mountains, +the trade-wind streams into Anaho Bay in a flood of almost +constant volume and velocity, and of a heavenly coolness.</p> +<p>It chanced one day that I was ashore in the cove, with Mrs. +Stevenson and the ship’s cook. Except for the +<i>Casco</i> lying outside, and a crane or two, and the ever-busy +wind and sea, the face of the world was of a prehistoric +emptiness; life appeared to stand stock-still, and the sense of +isolation was profound and refreshing. On a sudden, the +trade-wind, coming in a gust over the isthmus, struck and +scattered the fans of the palms above the den; and, behold! in +two of the tops there sat a native, motionless as an idol and +watching us, you would have said, without a wink. The next +moment the tree closed, and the glimpse was gone. This +discovery of human presences latent overhead in a place where we +had supposed ourselves alone, the immobility of our tree-top +spies, and the thought that perhaps at all hours we were +similarly supervised, struck us with a chill. Talk +languished on the beach. As for the cook (whose conscience +was not clear), he never afterwards set foot on shore, and twice, +when the <i>Casco</i> appeared to be driving on the rocks, it was +amusing to observe that man’s alacrity; death, he was +persuaded, awaiting him upon the beach. It was more than a +year later, in the Gilberts, that the explanation dawned upon +myself. The natives were drawing palm-tree wine, a thing +forbidden by law; and when the wind thus suddenly revealed them, +they were doubtless more troubled than ourselves.</p> +<p>At the top of the den there dwelt an old, melancholy, grizzled +man of the name of Tari (Charlie) Coffin. He was a native +of Oahu, in the Sandwich Islands; and had gone to sea in his +youth in the American whalers; a circumstance to which he owed +his name, his English, his down-east twang, and the misfortune of +his innocent life. For one captain, sailing out of New +Bedford, carried him to Nuka-hiva and marooned him there among +the cannibals. The motive for this act was inconceivably +small; poor Tari’s wages, which were thus economised, would +scarce have shook the credit of the New Bedford owners. And +the act itself was simply murder. Tari’s life must +have hung in the beginning by a hair. In the grief and +terror of that time, it is not unlikely he went mad, an infirmity +to which he was still liable; or perhaps a child may have taken a +fancy to him and ordained him to be spared. He escaped at +least alive, married in the island, and when I knew him was a +widower with a married son and a granddaughter. But the +thought of Oahu haunted him; its praise was for ever on his lips; +he beheld it, looking back, as a place of ceaseless feasting, +song, and dance; and in his dreams I daresay he revisits it with +joy. I wonder what he would think if he could be carried +there indeed, and see the modern town of Honolulu brisk with +traffic, and the palace with its guards, and the great hotel, and +Mr. Berger’s band with their uniforms and outlandish +instruments; or what he would think to see the brown faces grown +so few and the white so many; and his father’s land sold, +for planting sugar, and his father’s house quite perished, +or perhaps the last of them struck leprous and immured between +the surf and the cliffs on Molokai? So simply, even in +South Sea Islands, and so sadly, the changes come.</p> +<p>Tari was poor, and poorly lodged. His house was a wooden +frame, run up by Europeans; it was indeed his official residence, +for Tari was the shepherd of the promontory sheep. I can +give a perfect inventory of its contents: three kegs, a tin +biscuit-box, an iron saucepan, several cocoa-shell cups, a +lantern, and three bottles, probably containing oil; while the +clothes of the family and a few mats were thrown across the open +rafters. Upon my first meeting with this exile he had +conceived for me one of the baseless island friendships, had +given me nuts to drink, and carried me up the den ‘to see +my house’—the only entertainment that he had to +offer. He liked the ‘Amelican,’ he said, and +the ‘Inglisman,’ but the ‘Flessman’ was +his abhorrence; and he was careful to explain that if he had +thought us ‘Fless,’ we should have had none of his +nuts, and never a sight of his house. His distaste for the +French I can partly understand, but not at all his toleration of +the Anglo-Saxon. The next day he brought me a pig, and some +days later one of our party going ashore found him in act to +bring a second. We were still strange to the islands; we +were pained by the poor man’s generosity, which he could +ill afford, and, by a natural enough but quite unpardonable +blunder, we refused the pig. Had Tari been a Marquesan we +should have seen him no more; being what he was, the most mild, +long-suffering, melancholy man, he took a revenge a hundred times +more painful. Scarce had the canoe with the nine villagers +put off from their farewell before the <i>Casco</i> was boarded +from the other side. It was Tari; coming thus late because +he had no canoe of his own, and had found it hard to borrow one; +coming thus solitary (as indeed we always saw him), because he +was a stranger in the land, and the dreariest of company. +The rest of my family basely fled from the encounter. I +must receive our injured friend alone; and the interview must +have lasted hard upon an hour, for he was loath to tear himself +away. ‘You go ’way. I see you no +more—no, sir!’ he lamented; and then looking about +him with rueful admiration, ‘This goodee ship—no, +sir!—goodee ship!’ he would exclaim: the ‘no, +sir,’ thrown out sharply through the nose upon a rising +inflection, an echo from New Bedford and the fallacious +whaler. From these expressions of grief and praise, he +would return continually to the case of the rejected pig. +‘I like give present all ’e same you,’ he +complained; ‘only got pig: you no take him!’ He +was a poor man; he had no choice of gifts; he had only a pig, he +repeated; and I had refused it. I have rarely been more +wretched than to see him sitting there, so old, so grey, so poor, +so hardly fortuned, of so rueful a countenance, and to +appreciate, with growing keenness, the affront which I had so +innocently dealt him; but it was one of those cases in which +speech is vain.</p> +<p>Tari’s son was smiling and inert; his daughter-in-law, a +girl of sixteen, pretty, gentle, and grave, more intelligent than +most Anaho women, and with a fair share of French; his +grandchild, a mite of a creature at the breast. I went up +the den one day when Tari was from home, and found the son making +a cotton sack, and madame suckling mademoiselle. When I had +sat down with them on the floor, the girl began to question me +about England; which I tried to describe, piling the pan and the +cocoa shells one upon another to represent the houses, and +explaining, as best I was able, and by word and gesture, the +over-population, the hunger, and the perpetual toil. +‘<i>Pas de cocotiers</i>? <i>pas do popoi</i>?’ she +asked. I told her it was too cold, and went through an +elaborate performance, shutting out draughts, and crouching over +an imaginary fire, to make sure she understood. But she +understood right well; remarked it must be bad for the health, +and sat a while gravely reflecting on that picture of unwonted +sorrows. I am sure it roused her pity, for it struck in her +another thought always uppermost in the Marquesan bosom; and she +began with a smiling sadness, and looking on me out of melancholy +eyes, to lament the decease of her own people. +‘<i>Ici pas de Kanaques</i>,’ said she; and taking +the baby from her breast, she held it out to me with both her +hands. ‘<i>Tenez</i>—a little baby like this; +then dead. All the Kanaques die. Then no +more.’ The smile, and this instancing by the +girl-mother of her own tiny flesh and blood, affected me +strangely; they spoke of so tranquil a despair. Meanwhile +the husband smilingly made his sack; and the unconscious babe +struggled to reach a pot of raspberry jam, friendship’s +offering, which I had just brought up the den; and in a +perspective of centuries I saw their case as ours, death coming +in like a tide, and the day already numbered when there should be +no more Beretani, and no more of any race whatever, and (what +oddly touched me) no more literary works and no more readers.</p> +<h3>CHAPTER IV—DEATH</h3> +<p>The thought of death, I have said, is uppermost in the mind of +the Marquesan. It would be strange if it were +otherwise. The race is perhaps the handsomest extant. +Six feet is about the middle height of males; they are strongly +muscled, free from fat, swift in action, graceful in repose; and +the women, though fatter and duller, are still comely +animals. To judge by the eye, there is no race more viable; +and yet death reaps them with both hands. When Bishop +Dordillon first came to Tai-o-hae, he reckoned the inhabitants at +many thousands; he was but newly dead, and in the same bay +Stanislao Moanatini counted on his fingers eight residual +natives. Or take the valley of Hapaa, known to readers of +Herman Melville under the grotesque misspelling of Hapar. +There are but two writers who have touched the South Seas with +any genius, both Americans: Melville and Charles Warren Stoddard; +and at the christening of the first and greatest, some +influential fairy must have been neglected: ‘He shall be +able to see,’ ‘He shall be able to tell,’ +‘He shall be able to charm,’ said the friendly +godmothers; ‘But he shall not be able to hear,’ +exclaimed the last. The tribe of Hapaa is said to have +numbered some four hundred, when the small-pox came and reduced +them by one-fourth. Six months later a woman developed +tubercular consumption; the disease spread like a fire about the +valley, and in less than a year two survivors, a man and a woman, +fled from that new-created solitude. A similar Adam and Eve +may some day wither among new races, the tragic residue of +Britain. When I first heard this story the date staggered +me; but I am now inclined to think it possible. Early in +the year of my visit, for example, or late the year before, a +first case of phthisis appeared in a household of seventeen +persons, and by the month of August, when the tale was told me, +one soul survived, and that was a boy who had been absent at his +schooling. And depopulation works both ways, the doors of +death being set wide open, and the door of birth almost +closed. Thus, in the half-year ending July 1888 there were +twelve deaths and but one birth in the district of the +Hatiheu. Seven or eight more deaths were to be looked for +in the ordinary course; and M. Aussel, the observant gendarme, +knew of but one likely birth. At this rate it is no matter +of surprise if the population in that part should have declined +in forty years from six thousand to less than four hundred; which +are, once more on the authority of M. Aussel, the estimated +figures. And the rate of decline must have even accelerated +towards the end.</p> +<p>A good way to appreciate the depopulation is to go by land +from Anaho to Hatiheu on the adjacent bay. The road is good +travelling, but cruelly steep. We seemed scarce to have +passed the deserted house which stands highest in Anaho before we +were looking dizzily down upon its roof; the <i>Casco</i> well +out in the bay, and rolling for a wager, shrank visibly; and +presently through the gap of Tari’s isthmus, Ua-huna was +seen to hang cloudlike on the horizon. Over the summit, +where the wind blew really chill, and whistled in the reed-like +grass, and tossed the grassy fell of the pandanus, we stepped +suddenly, as through a door, into the next vale and bay of +Hatiheu. A bowl of mountains encloses it upon three +sides. On the fourth this rampart has been bombarded into +ruins, runs down to seaward in imminent and shattered crags, and +presents the one practicable breach of the blue bay. The +interior of this vessel is crowded with lovely and valuable +trees,—orange, breadfruit, mummy-apple, cocoa, the island +chestnut, and for weeds, the pine and the banana. Four +perennial streams water and keep it green; and along the dell, +first of one, then of another, of these, the road, for a +considerable distance, descends into this fortunate valley. +The song of the waters and the familiar disarray of boulders gave +us a strong sense of home, which the exotic foliage, the +daft-like growth of the pandanus, the buttressed trunk of the +banyan, the black pigs galloping in the bush, and the +architecture of the native houses dissipated ere it could be +enjoyed.</p> +<p>The houses on the Hatiheu side begin high up; higher yet, the +more melancholy spectacle of empty paepaes. When a native +habitation is deserted, the superstructure—pandanus thatch, +wattle, unstable tropical timber—speedily rots, and is +speedily scattered by the wind. Only the stones of the +terrace endure; nor can any ruin, cairn, or standing stone, or +vitrified fort present a more stern appearance of +antiquity. We must have passed from six to eight of these +now houseless platforms. On the main road of the island, +where it crosses the valley of Taipi, Mr. Osbourne tells me they +are to be reckoned by the dozen; and as the roads have been made +long posterior to their erection, perhaps to their desertion, and +must simply be regarded as lines drawn at random through the +bush, the forest on either hand must be equally filled with these +survivals: the gravestones of whole families. Such ruins +are tapu <a name="citation29"></a><a href="#footnote29" +class="citation">[29]</a> in the strictest sense; no native must +approach them; they have become outposts of the kingdom of the +grave. It might appear a natural and pious custom in the +hundreds who are left, the rearguard of perished thousands, that +their feet should leave untrod these hearthstones of their +fathers. I believe, in fact, the custom rests on different +and more grim conceptions. But the house, the grave, and +even the body of the dead, have been always particularly honoured +by Marquesans. Until recently the corpse was sometimes kept +in the family and daily oiled and sunned, until, by gradual and +revolting stages, it dried into a kind of mummy. Offerings +are still laid upon the grave. In Traitor’s Bay, Mr. +Osbourne saw a man buy a looking-glass to lay upon his +son’s. And the sentiment against the desecration of +tombs, thoughtlessly ruffled in the laying down of the new roads, +is a chief ingredient in the native hatred for the French.</p> +<p>The Marquesan beholds with dismay the approaching extinction +of his race. The thought of death sits down with him to +meat, and rises with him from his bed; he lives and breathes +under a shadow of mortality awful to support; and he is so inured +to the apprehension that he greets the reality with relief. +He does not even seek to support a disappointment; at an affront, +at a breach of one of his fleeting and communistic love-affairs, +he seeks an instant refuge in the grave. Hanging is now the +fashion. I heard of three who had hanged themselves in the +west end of Hiva-oa during the first half of 1888; but though +this be a common form of suicide in other parts of the South +Seas, I cannot think it will continue popular in the +Marquesas. Far more suitable to Marquesan sentiment is the +old form of poisoning with the fruit of the eva, which offers to +the native suicide a cruel but deliberate death, and gives time +for those decencies of the last hour, to which he attaches such +remarkable importance. The coffin can thus be at hand, the +pigs killed, the cry of the mourners sounding already through the +house; and then it is, and not before, that the Marquesan is +conscious of achievement, his life all rounded in, his robes +(like Cæsar’s) adjusted for the final act. +Praise not any man till he is dead, said the ancients; envy not +any man till you hear the mourners, might be the Marquesan +parody. The coffin, though of late introduction, strangely +engages their attention. It is to the mature Marquesan what +a watch is to the European schoolboy. For ten years Queen +Vaekehu had dunned the fathers; at last, but the other day, they +let her have her will, gave her her coffin, and the woman’s +soul is at rest. I was told a droll instance of the force +of this preoccupation. The Polynesians are subject to a +disease seemingly rather of the will than of the body. I +was told the Tahitians have a word for it, <i>erimatua</i>, but +cannot find it in my dictionary. A gendarme, M. Nouveau, +has seen men beginning to succumb to this insubstantial malady, +has routed them from their houses, turned them on to do their +trick upon the roads, and in two days has seen them cured. +But this other remedy is more original: a Marquesan, dying of +this discouragement—perhaps I should rather say this +acquiescence—has been known, at the fulfilment of his +crowning wish, on the mere sight of that desired hermitage, his +coffin—to revive, recover, shake off the hand of death, and +be restored for years to his occupations—carving tikis +(idols), let us say, or braiding old men’s beards. +From all this it may be conceived how easily they meet death when +it approaches naturally. I heard one example, grim and +picturesque. In the time of the small-pox in Hapaa, an old +man was seized with the disease; he had no thought of recovery; +had his grave dug by a wayside, and lived in it for near a +fortnight, eating, drinking, and smoking with the passers-by, +talking mostly of his end, and equally unconcerned for himself +and careless of the friends whom he infected.</p> +<p>This proneness to suicide, and loose seat in life, is not +peculiar to the Marquesan. What is peculiar is the +widespread depression and acceptance of the national end. +Pleasures are neglected, the dance languishes, the songs are +forgotten. It is true that some, and perhaps too many, of +them are proscribed; but many remain, if there were spirit to +support or to revive them. At the last feast of the +Bastille, Stanislao Moanatini shed tears when he beheld the +inanimate performance of the dancers. When the people sang +for us in Anaho, they must apologise for the smallness of their +repertory. They were only young folk present, they said, +and it was only the old that knew the songs. The whole body +of Marquesan poetry and music was being suffered to die out with +a single dispirited generation. The full import is apparent +only to one acquainted with other Polynesian races; who knows how +the Samoan coins a fresh song for every trifling incident, or who +has heard (on Penrhyn, for instance) a band of little stripling +maids from eight to twelve keep up their minstrelsy for hours +upon a stretch, one song following another without pause. +In like manner, the Marquesan, never industrious, begins now to +cease altogether from production. The exports of the group +decline out of all proportion even with the death-rate of the +islanders. ‘The coral waxes, the palm grows, and man +departs,’ says the Marquesan; and he folds his hands. +And surely this is nature. Fond as it may appear, we labour +and refrain, not for the rewards of any single life, but with a +timid eye upon the lives and memories of our successors; and +where no one is to succeed, of his own family, or his own tongue, +I doubt whether Rothschilds would make money or Cato practise +virtue. It is natural, also, that a temporary stimulus +should sometimes rouse the Marquesan from his lethargy. +Over all the landward shore of Anaho cotton runs like a wild +weed; man or woman, whoever comes to pick it, may earn a dollar +in the day; yet when we arrived, the trader’s store-house +was entirely empty; and before we left it was near full. So +long as the circus was there, so long as the <i>Casco</i> was yet +anchored in the bay, it behoved every one to make his visit; and +to this end every woman must have a new dress, and every man a +shirt and trousers. Never before, in Mr. Regler’s +experience, had they displayed so much activity.</p> +<p>In their despondency there is an element of dread. The +fear of ghosts and of the dark is very deeply written in the mind +of the Polynesian; not least of the Marquesan. Poor Taipi, +the chief of Anaho, was condemned to ride to Hatiheu on a +moonless night. He borrowed a lantern, sat a long while +nerving himself for the adventure, and when he at last departed, +wrung the <i>Cascos</i> by the hand as for a final +separation. Certain presences, called Vehinehae, frequent +and make terrible the nocturnal roadside; I was told by one they +were like so much mist, and as the traveller walked into them +dispersed and dissipated; another described them as being shaped +like men and having eyes like cats; from none could I obtain the +smallest clearness as to what they did, or wherefore they were +dreaded. We may be sure at least they represent the dead; +for the dead, in the minds of the islanders, are +all-pervasive. ‘When a native says that he is a +man,’ writes Dr. Codrington, ‘he means that he is a +man and not a ghost; not that he is a man and not a beast. +The intelligent agents of this world are to his mind the men who +are alive, and the ghosts the men who are dead.’ Dr. +Codrington speaks of Melanesia; from what I have learned his +words are equally true of the Polynesian. And yet +more. Among cannibal Polynesians a dreadful suspicion rests +generally on the dead; and the Marquesans, the greatest cannibals +of all, are scarce likely to be free from similar beliefs. +I hazard the guess that the Vehinehae are the hungry spirits of +the dead, continuing their life’s business of the cannibal +ambuscade, and lying everywhere unseen, and eager to devour the +living. Another superstition I picked up through the +troubled medium of Tari Coffin’s English. The dead, +he told me, came and danced by night around the paepae of their +former family; the family were thereupon overcome by some emotion +(but whether of pious sorrow or of fear I could not gather), and +must ‘make a feast,’ of which fish, pig, and popoi +were indispensable ingredients. So far this is clear +enough. But here Tari went on to instance the new house of +Toma and the house-warming feast which was just then in +preparation as instances in point. Dare we indeed string +them together, and add the case of the deserted ruin, as though +the dead continually besieged the paepaes of the living: were +kept at arm’s-length, even from the first foundation, only +by propitiatory feasts, and, so soon as the fire of life went out +upon the hearth, swarmed back into possession of their ancient +seat?</p> +<p>I speak by guess of these Marquesan superstitions. On +the cannibal ghost I shall return elsewhere with certainty. +And it is enough, for the present purpose, to remark that the men +of the Marquesas, from whatever reason, fear and shrink from the +presence of ghosts. Conceive how this must tell upon the +nerves in islands where the number of the dead already so far +exceeds that of the living, and the dead multiply and the living +dwindle at so swift a rate. Conceive how the remnant +huddles about the embers of the fire of life; even as old Red +Indians, deserted on the march and in the snow, the kindly tribe +all gone, the last flame expiring, and the night around populous +with wolves.</p> +<h3>CHAPTER V—DEPOPULATION</h3> +<p>Over the whole extent of the South Seas, from one tropic to +another, we find traces of a bygone state of over-population, +when the resources of even a tropical soil were taxed, and even +the improvident Polynesian trembled for the future. We may +accept some of the ideas of Mr. Darwin’s theory of coral +islands, and suppose a rise of the sea, or the subsidence of some +former continental area, to have driven into the tops of the +mountains multitudes of refugees. Or we may suppose, more +soberly, a people of sea-rovers, emigrants from a crowded +country, to strike upon and settle island after island, and as +time went on to multiply exceedingly in their new seats. In +either case the end must be the same; soon or late it must grow +apparent that the crew are too numerous, and that famine is at +hand. The Polynesians met this emergent danger with various +expedients of activity and prevention. A way was found to +preserve breadfruit by packing it in artificial pits; pits forty +feet in depth and of proportionate bore are still to be seen, I +am told, in the Marquesas; and yet even these were insufficient +for the teeming people, and the annals of the past are gloomy +with famine and cannibalism. Among the Hawaiians—a +hardier people, in a more exacting climate—agriculture was +carried far; the land was irrigated with canals; and the +fish-ponds of Molokai prove the number and diligence of the old +inhabitants. Meanwhile, over all the island world, abortion +and infanticide prevailed. On coral atolls, where the +danger was most plainly obvious, these were enforced by law and +sanctioned by punishment. On Vaitupu, in the Ellices, only +two children were allowed to a couple; on Nukufetau, but +one. On the latter the punishment was by fine; and it is +related that the fine was sometimes paid, and the child +spared.</p> +<p>This is characteristic. For no people in the world are +so fond or so long-suffering with children—children make +the mirth and the adornment of their homes, serving them for +playthings and for picture-galleries. ‘Happy is the +man that has his quiver full of them.’ The stray +bastard is contended for by rival families; and the natural and +the adopted children play and grow up together +undistinguished. The spoiling, and I may almost say the +deification, of the child, is nowhere carried so far as in the +eastern islands; and furthest, according to my opportunities of +observation, in the Paumotu group, the so-called Low or Dangerous +Archipelago. I have seen a Paumotuan native turn from me +with embarrassment and disaffection because I suggested that a +brat would be the better for a beating. It is a daily +matter in some eastern islands to see a child strike or even +stone its mother, and the mother, so far from punishing, scarce +ventures to resist. In some, when his child was born, a +chief was superseded and resigned his name; as though, like a +drone, he had then fulfilled the occasion of his being. And +in some the lightest words of children had the weight of +oracles. Only the other day, in the Marquesas, if a child +conceived a distaste to any stranger, I am assured the stranger +would be slain. And I shall have to tell in another place +an instance of the opposite: how a child in Manihiki having taken +a fancy to myself, her adoptive parents at once accepted the +situation and loaded me with gifts.</p> +<p>With such sentiments the necessity for child-destruction would +not fail to clash, and I believe we find the trace of divided +feeling in the Tahitian brotherhood of Oro. At a certain +date a new god was added to the Society-Island Olympus, or an old +one refurbished and made popular. Oro was his name, and he +may be compared with the Bacchus of the ancients. His +zealots sailed from bay to bay, and from island to island; they +were everywhere received with feasting; wore fine clothes; sang, +danced, acted; gave exhibitions of dexterity and strength; and +were the artists, the acrobats, the bards, and the harlots of the +group. Their life was public and epicurean; their +initiation a mystery; and the highest in the land aspired to join +the brotherhood. If a couple stood next in line to a +high-chieftaincy, they were suffered, on grounds of policy, to +spare one child; all other children, who had a father or a mother +in the company of Oro, stood condemned from the moment of +conception. A freemasonry, an agnostic sect, a company of +artists, its members all under oath to spread unchastity, and all +forbidden to leave offspring—I do not know how it may +appear to others, but to me the design seems obvious. +Famine menacing the islands, and the needful remedy repulsive, it +was recommended to the native mind by these trappings of mystery, +pleasure, and parade. This is the more probable, and the +secret, serious purpose of the institution appears the more +plainly, if it be true that, after a certain period of life, the +obligation of the votary was changed; at first, bound to be +profligate: afterwards, expected to be chaste.</p> +<p>Here, then, we have one side of the case. Man-eating +among kindly men, child-murder among child-lovers, industry in a +race the most idle, invention in a race the least progressive, +this grim, pagan salvation-army of the brotherhood of Oro, the +report of early voyagers, the widespread vestiges of former +habitation, and the universal tradition of the islands, all point +to the same fact of former crowding and alarm. And to-day +we are face to face with the reverse. To-day in the +Marquesas, in the Eight Islands of Hawaii, in Mangareva, in +Easter Island, we find the same race perishing like flies. +Why this change? Or, grant that the coming of the whites, +the change of habits, and the introduction of new maladies and +vices, fully explain the depopulation, why is that depopulation +not universal? The population of Tahiti, after a period of +alarming decrease, has again become stationary. I hear of a +similar result among some Maori tribes; in many of the Paumotus a +slight increase is to be observed; and the Samoans are to-day as +healthy and at least as fruitful as before the change. +Grant that the Tahitians, the Maoris, and the Paumotuans have +become inured to the new conditions; and what are we to make of +the Samoans, who have never suffered?</p> +<p>Those who are acquainted only with a single group are apt to +be ready with solutions. Thus I have heard the mortality of +the Maoris attributed to their change of residence—from +fortified hill-tops to the low, marshy vicinity of their +plantations. How plausible! And yet the Marquesans +are dying out in the same houses where their fathers +multiplied. Or take opium. The Marquesas and Hawaii +are the two groups the most infected with this vice; the +population of the one is the most civilised, that of the other by +far the most barbarous, of Polynesians; and they are two of those +that perish the most rapidly. Here is a strong case against +opium. But let us take unchastity, and we shall find the +Marquesas and Hawaii figuring again upon another count. +Thus, Samoans are the most chaste of Polynesians, and they are to +this day entirely fertile; Marquesans are the most debauched: we +have seen how they are perishing; Hawaiians are notoriously lax, +and they begin to be dotted among deserts. So here is a +case stronger still against unchastity; and here also we have a +correction to apply. Whatever the virtues of the Tahitian, +neither friend nor enemy dares call him chaste; and yet he seems +to have outlived the time of danger. One last example: +syphilis has been plausibly credited with much of the +sterility. But the Samoans are, by all accounts, as +fruitful as at first; by some accounts more so; and it is not +seriously to be argued that the Samoans have escaped +syphilis.</p> +<p>These examples show how dangerous it is to reason from any +particular cause, or even from many in a single group. I +have in my eye an able and amiable pamphlet by the Rev. S. E. +Bishop: ‘Why are the Hawaiians Dying Out?’ Any +one interested in the subject ought to read this tract, which +contains real information; and yet Mr. Bishop’s views would +have been changed by an acquaintance with other groups. +Samoa is, for the moment, the main and the most instructive +exception to the rule. The people are the most chaste and +one of the most temperate of island peoples. They have +never been tried and depressed with any grave pestilence. +Their clothing has scarce been tampered with; at the simple and +becoming tabard of the girls, Tartuffe, in many another island, +would have cried out; for the cool, healthy, and modest lava-lava +or kilt, Tartuffe has managed in many another island to +substitute stifling and inconvenient trousers. Lastly, and +perhaps chiefly, so far from their amusements having been +curtailed, I think they have been, upon the whole, +extended. The Polynesian falls easily into despondency: +bereavement, disappointment, the fear of novel visitations, the +decay or proscription of ancient pleasures, easily incline him to +be sad; and sadness detaches him from life. The melancholy +of the Hawaiian and the emptiness of his new life are striking; +and the remark is yet more apposite to the Marquesas. In +Samoa, on the other hand, perpetual song and dance, perpetual +games, journeys, and pleasures, make an animated and a smiling +picture of the island life. And the Samoans are to-day the +gayest and the best entertained inhabitants of our planet. +The importance of this can scarcely be exaggerated. In a +climate and upon a soil where a livelihood can be had for the +stooping, entertainment is a prime necessity. It is +otherwise with us, where life presents us with a daily problem, +and there is a serious interest, and some of the heat of +conflict, in the mere continuing to be. So, in certain +atolls, where there is no great gaiety, but man must bestir +himself with some vigour for his daily bread, public health and +the population are maintained; but in the lotos islands, with the +decay of pleasures, life itself decays. It is from this +point of view that we may instance, among other causes of +depression, the decay of war. We have been so long used in +Europe to that dreary business of war on the great scale, +trailing epidemics and leaving pestilential corpses in its train, +that we have almost forgotten its original, the most healthful, +if not the most humane, of all field +sports—hedge-warfare. From this, as well as from the +rest of his amusements and interests, the islander, upon a +hundred islands, has been recently cut off. And to this, as +well as to so many others, the Samoan still makes good a special +title.</p> +<p>Upon the whole, the problem seems to me to stand +thus:—Where there have been fewest changes, important or +unimportant, salutary or hurtful, there the race survives. +Where there have been most, important or unimportant, salutary or +hurtful, there it perishes. Each change, however small, +augments the sum of new conditions to which the race has to +become inured. There may seem, <i>a priori</i>, no +comparison between the change from ‘sour toddy’ to +bad gin, and that from the island kilt to a pair of European +trousers. Yet I am far from persuaded that the one is any +more hurtful than the other; and the unaccustomed race will +sometimes die of pin-pricks. We are here face to face with +one of the difficulties of the missionary. In Polynesian +islands he easily obtains pre-eminent authority; the king becomes +his <i>mairedupalais</i>; he can proscribe, he can command; and +the temptation is ever towards too much. Thus (by all +accounts) the Catholics in Mangareva, and thus (to my own +knowledge) the Protestants in Hawaii, have rendered life in a +more or less degree unliveable to their converts. And the +mild, uncomplaining creatures (like children in a prison) yawn +and await death. It is easy to blame the missionary. +But it is his business to make changes. It is surely his +business, for example, to prevent war; and yet I have instanced +war itself as one of the elements of health. On the other +hand, it were, perhaps, easy for the missionary to proceed more +gently, and to regard every change as an affair of weight. +I take the average missionary; I am sure I do him no more than +justice when I suppose that he would hesitate to bombard a +village, even in order to convert an archipelago. +Experience begins to show us (at least in Polynesian islands) +that change of habit is bloodier than a bombardment.</p> +<p>There is one point, ere I have done, where I may go to meet +criticism. I have said nothing of faulty hygiene, bathing +during fevers, mistaken treatment of children, native doctoring, +or abortion—all causes frequently adduced. And I have +said nothing of them because they are conditions common to both +epochs, and even more efficient in the past than in the +present. Was it not the same with unchastity, it may be +asked? Was not the Polynesian always unchaste? +Doubtless he was so always: doubtless he is more so since the +coming of his remarkably chaste visitors from Europe. Take +the Hawaiian account of Cook: I have no doubt it is entirely +fair. Take Krusenstern’s candid, almost innocent, +description of a Russian man-of-war at the Marquesas; consider +the disgraceful history of missions in Hawaii itself, where (in +the war of lust) the American missionaries were once shelled by +an English adventurer, and once raided and mishandled by the crew +of an American warship; add the practice of whaling fleets to +call at the Marquesas, and carry off a complement of women for +the cruise; consider, besides, how the whites were at first +regarded in the light of demi-gods, as appears plainly in the +reception of Cook upon Hawaii; and again, in the story of the +discovery of Tutuila, when the really decent women of Samoa +prostituted themselves in public to the French; and bear in mind +how it was the custom of the adventurers, and we may almost say +the business of the missionaries, to deride and infract even the +most salutary tapus. Here we see every engine of +dissolution directed at once against a virtue never and nowhere +very strong or popular; and the result, even in the most degraded +islands, has been further degradation. Mr. Lawes, the +missionary of Savage Island, told me the standard of female +chastity had declined there since the coming of the whites. +In heathen time, if a girl gave birth to a bastard, her father or +brother would dash the infant down the cliffs; and to-day the +scandal would be small. Or take the Marquesas. +Stanislao Moanatini told me that in his own recollection, the +young were strictly guarded; they were not suffered so much as to +look upon one another in the street, but passed (so my informant +put it) like dogs; and the other day the whole school-children of +Nuka-hiva and Ua-pu escaped in a body to the woods, and lived +there for a fortnight in promiscuous liberty. Readers of +travels may perhaps exclaim at my authority, and declare +themselves better informed. I should prefer the statement +of an intelligent native like Stanislao (even if it stood alone, +which it is far from doing) to the report of the most honest +traveller. A ship of war comes to a haven, anchors, lands a +party, receives and returns a visit, and the captain writes a +chapter on the manners of the island. It is not considered +what class is mostly seen. Yet we should not be pleased if +a Lascar foremast hand were to judge England by the ladies who +parade Ratcliffe Highway, and the gentlemen who share with them +their hire. Stanislao’s opinion of a decay of virtue +even in these unvirtuous islands has been supported to me by +others; his very example, the progress of dissolution amongst the +young, is adduced by Mr. Bishop in Hawaii. And so far as +Marquesans are concerned, we might have hazarded a guess of some +decline in manners. I do not think that any race could ever +have prospered or multiplied with such as now obtain; I am sure +they would have been never at the pains to count paternal +kinship. It is not possible to give details; suffice it +that their manners appear to be imitated from the dreams of +ignorant and vicious children, and their debauches persevered in +until energy, reason, and almost life itself are in abeyance.</p> +<h3>CHAPTER VI—CHIEFS AND TAPUS</h3> +<p>We used to admire exceedingly the bland and gallant manners of +the chief called Taipi-Kikino. An elegant guest at table, +skilled in the use of knife and fork, a brave figure when he +shouldered a gun and started for the woods after wild chickens, +always serviceable, always ingratiating and gay, I would +sometimes wonder where he found his cheerfulness. He had +enough to sober him, I thought, in his official budget. His +expenses—for he was always seen attired in virgin +white—must have by far exceeded his income of six dollars +in the year, or say two shillings a month. And he was +himself a man of no substance; his house the poorest in the +village. It was currently supposed that his elder brother, +Kauanui, must have helped him out. But how comes it that +the elder brother should succeed to the family estate, and be a +wealthy commoner, and the younger be a poor man, and yet rule as +chief in Anaho? That the one should be wealthy, and the +other almost indigent is probably to be explained by some +adoption; for comparatively few children are brought up in the +house or succeed to the estates of their natural begetters. +That the one should be chief instead of the other must be +explained (in a very Irish fashion) on the ground that neither of +them is a chief at all.</p> +<p>Since the return and the wars of the French, many chiefs have +been deposed, and many so-called chiefs appointed. We have +seen, in the same house, one such upstart drinking in the company +of two such extruded island Bourbons, men, whose word a few years +ago was life and death, now sunk to be peasants like their +neighbours. So when the French overthrew hereditary +tyrants, dubbed the commons of the Marquesas freeborn citizens of +the republic, and endowed them with a vote for a +<i>conseiller-général</i> at Tahiti, they probably +conceived themselves upon the path to popularity; and so far from +that, they were revolting public sentiment. The deposition +of the chiefs was perhaps sometimes needful; the appointment of +others may have been needful also; it was at least a delicate +business. The Government of George II. exiled many Highland +magnates. It never occurred to them to manufacture +substitutes; and if the French have been more bold, we have yet +to see with what success.</p> +<p>Our chief at Anaho was always called, he always called +himself, Taipi-Kikino; and yet that was not his name, but only +the wand of his false position. As soon as he was appointed +chief, his name—which signified, if I remember exactly, +<i>Prince born among flowers</i>—fell in abeyance, and he +was dubbed instead by the expressive byword, +Taipi-Kikino—<i>Highwater man-of-no-account</i>—or, +Englishing more boldly, <i>Beggar on horseback</i>—a witty +and a wicked cut. A nickname in Polynesia destroys almost +the memory of the original name. To-day, if we were +Polynesians, Gladstone would be no more heard of. We should +speak of and address our Nestor as the Grand Old Man, and it is +so that himself would sign his correspondence. Not the +prevalence, then, but the significancy of the nickname is to be +noted here. The new authority began with small +prestige. Taipi has now been some time in office; from all +I saw he seemed a person very fit. He is not the least +unpopular, and yet his power is nothing. He is a chief to +the French, and goes to breakfast with the Resident; but for any +practical end of chieftaincy a rag doll were equally +efficient.</p> +<p>We had been but three days in Anaho when we received the visit +of the chief of Hatiheu, a man of weight and fame, late leader of +a war upon the French, late prisoner in Tahiti, and the last +eater of long-pig in Nuka-hiva. Not many years have elapsed +since he was seen striding on the beach of Anaho, a dead +man’s arm across his shoulder. ‘So does Kooamua +to his enemies!’ he roared to the passers-by, and took a +bite from the raw flesh. And now behold this gentleman, +very wisely replaced in office by the French, paying us a morning +visit in European clothes. He was the man of the most +character we had yet seen: his manners genial and decisive, his +person tall, his face rugged, astute, formidable, and with a +certain similarity to Mr. Gladstone’s—only for the +brownness of the skin, and the high-chief’s tattooing, all +one side and much of the other being of an even blue. +Further acquaintance increased our opinion of his sense. He +viewed the <i>Casco</i> in a manner then quite new to us, +examining her lines and the running of the gear; to a piece of +knitting on which one of the party was engaged, he must have +devoted ten minutes’ patient study; nor did he desist +before he had divined the principles; and he was interested even +to excitement by a type-writer, which he learned to work. +When he departed he carried away with him a list of his family, +with his own name printed by his own hand at the bottom. I +should add that he was plainly much of a humorist, and not a +little of a humbug. He told us, for instance, that he was a +person of exact sobriety; such being the obligation of his high +estate: the commons might be sots, but the chief could not stoop +so low. And not many days after he was to be observed in a +state of smiling and lop-sided imbecility, the <i>Casco</i> +ribbon upside down on his dishonoured hat.</p> +<p>But his business that morning in Anaho is what concerns us +here. The devil-fish, it seems, were growing scarce upon +the reef; it was judged fit to interpose what we should call a +close season; for that end, in Polynesia, a tapu (vulgarly spelt +‘taboo’) has to be declared, and who was to declare +it? Taipi might; he ought; it was a chief part of his duty; +but would any one regard the inhibition of a Beggar on +Horse-back? He might plant palm branches: it did not in the +least follow that the spot was sacred. He might recite the +spell: it was shrewdly supposed the spirits would not +hearken. And so the old, legitimate cannibal must ride over +the mountains to do it for him; and the respectable official in +white clothes could but look on and envy. At about the same +time, though in a different manner, Kooamua established a forest +law. It was observed the cocoa-palms were suffering, for +the plucking of green nuts impoverishes and at last endangers the +tree. Now Kooamua could tapu the reef, which was public +property, but he could not tapu other people’s palms; and +the expedient adopted was interesting. He tapu’d his +own trees, and his example was imitated over all Hatiheu and +Anaho. I fear Taipi might have tapu’d all that he +possessed and found none to follow him. So much for the +esteem in which the dignity of an appointed chief is held by +others; a single circumstance will show what he thinks of it +himself. I never met one, but he took an early opportunity +to explain his situation. True, he was only an appointed +chief when I beheld him; but somewhere else, perhaps upon some +other isle, he was a chieftain by descent: upon which ground, he +asked me (so to say it) to excuse his mushroom honours.</p> +<p>It will be observed with surprise that both these tapus are +for thoroughly sensible ends. With surprise, I say, because +the nature of that institution is much misunderstood in +Europe. It is taken usually in the sense of a meaningless +or wanton prohibition, such as that which to-day prevents women +in some countries from smoking, or yesterday prevented any one in +Scotland from taking a walk on Sunday. The error is no less +natural than it is unjust. The Polynesians have not been +trained in the bracing, practical thought of ancient Rome; with +them the idea of law has not been disengaged from that of morals +or propriety; so that tapu has to cover the whole field, and +implies indifferently that an act is criminal, immoral, against +sound public policy, unbecoming or (as we say) ‘not in good +form.’ Many tapus were in consequence absurd enough, +such as those which deleted words out of the language, and +particularly those which related to women. Tapu encircled +women upon all hands. Many things were forbidden to men; to +women we may say that few were permitted. They must not sit +on the paepae; they must not go up to it by the stair; they must +not eat pork; they must not approach a boat; they must not cook +at a fire which any male had kindled. The other day, after +the roads were made, it was observed the women plunged along +margin through the bush, and when they came to a bridge waded +through the water: roads and bridges were the work of men’s +hands, and tapu for the foot of women. Even a man’s +saddle, if the man be native, is a thing no self-respecting lady +dares to use. Thus on the Anaho side of the island, only +two white men, Mr. Regler and the gendarme, M. Aussel, possess +saddles; and when a woman has a journey to make she must borrow +from one or other. It will be noticed that these +prohibitions tend, most of them, to an increased reserve between +the sexes. Regard for female chastity is the usual excuse +for these disabilities that men delight to lay upon their wives +and mothers. Here the regard is absent; and behold the +women still bound hand and foot with meaningless +proprieties! The women themselves, who are survivors of the +old regimen, admit that in those days life was not worth +living. And yet even then there were exceptions. +There were female chiefs and (I am assured) priestesses besides; +nice customs curtseyed to great dames, and in the most sacred +enclosure of a High Place, Father Siméon Delmar was shown +a stone, and told it was the throne of some well-descended +lady. How exactly parallel is this with European practice, +when princesses were suffered to penetrate the strictest +cloister, and women could rule over a land in which they were +denied the control of their own children.</p> +<p>But the tapu is more often the instrument of wise and needful +restrictions. We have seen it as the organ of paternal +government. It serves besides to enforce, in the rare case +of some one wishing to enforce them, rights of private +property. Thus a man, weary of the coming and going of +Marquesan visitors, tapus his door; and to this day you may see +the palm-branch signal, even as our great-grandfathers saw the +peeled wand before a Highland inn. Or take another +case. Anaho is known as ‘the country without +popoi.’ The word popoi serves in different islands to +indicate the main food of the people: thus, in Hawaii, it implies +a preparation of taro; in the Marquesas, of breadfruit. And +a Marquesan does not readily conceive life possible without his +favourite diet. A few years ago a drought killed the +breadfruit trees and the bananas in the district of Anaho; and +from this calamity, and the open-handed customs of the island, a +singular state of things arose. Well-watered Hatiheu had +escaped the drought; every householder of Anaho accordingly +crossed the pass, chose some one in Hatiheu, ‘gave him his +name’—an onerous gift, but one not to be +rejected—and from this improvised relative proceeded to +draw his supplies, for all the world as though he had paid for +them. Hence a continued traffic on the road. Some +stalwart fellow, in a loin-cloth, and glistening with sweat, may +be seen at all hours of the day, a stick across his bare +shoulders, tripping nervously under a double burthen of green +fruits. And on the far side of the gap a dozen stone posts +on the wayside in the shadow of a grove mark the breathing-space +of the popoi-carriers. A little back from the beach, and +not half a mile from Anaho, I was the more amazed to find a +cluster of well-doing breadfruits heavy with their harvest. +‘Why do you not take these?’ I asked. +‘Tapu,’ said Hoka; and I thought to myself (after the +manner of dull travellers) what children and fools these people +were to toil over the mountain and despoil innocent neighbours +when the staff of life was thus growing at their door. I +was the more in error. In the general destruction these +surviving trees were enough only for the family of the +proprietor, and by the simple expedient of declaring a tapu he +enforced his right.</p> +<p>The sanction of the tapu is superstitious; and the punishment +of infraction either a wasting or a deadly sickness. A slow +disease follows on the eating of tapu fish, and can only be cured +with the bones of the same fish burned with the due +mysteries. The cocoa-nut and breadfruit tapu works more +swiftly. Suppose you have eaten tapu fruit at the evening +meal, at night your sleep will be uneasy; in the morning, +swelling and a dark discoloration will have attacked your neck, +whence they spread upward to the face; and in two days, unless +the cure be interjected, you must die. This cure is +prepared from the rubbed leaves of the tree from which the +patient stole; so that he cannot be saved without confessing to +the Tahuku the person whom he wronged. In the experience of +my informant, almost no tapu had been put in use, except the two +described: he had thus no opportunity to learn the nature and +operation of the others; and, as the art of making them was +jealously guarded amongst the old men, he believed the mystery +would soon die out. I should add that he was no Marquesan, +but a Chinaman, a resident in the group from boyhood, and a +reverent believer in the spells which he described. White +men, amongst whom Ah Fu included himself, were exempt; but he had +a tale of a Tahitian woman, who had come to the Marquesas, eaten +tapu fish, and, although uninformed of her offence and danger, +had been afflicted and cured exactly like a native.</p> +<p>Doubtless the belief is strong; doubtless, with this weakly +and fanciful race, it is in many cases strong enough to kill; it +should be strong indeed in those who tapu their trees secretly, +so that they may detect a depredator by his sickness. Or, +perhaps, we should understand the idea of the hidden tapu +otherwise, as a politic device to spread uneasiness and extort +confessions: so that, when a man is ailing, he shall ransack his +brain for any possible offence, and send at once for any +proprietor whose rights he has invaded. ‘Had you +hidden a tapu?’ we may conceive him asking; and I cannot +imagine the proprietor gainsaying it; and this is perhaps the +strangest feature of the system—that it should be regarded +from without with such a mental and implicit awe, and, when +examined from within, should present so many apparent evidences +of design.</p> +<p>We read in Dr. Campbell’s <i>Poenamo</i> of a New +Zealand girl, who was foolishly told that she had eaten a tapu +yam, and who instantly sickened, and died in the two days of +simple terror. The period is the same as in the Marquesas; +doubtless the symptoms were so too. How singular to +consider that a superstition of such sway is possibly a +manufactured article; and that, even if it were not originally +invented, its details have plainly been arranged by the +authorities of some Polynesian Scotland Yard. Fitly enough, +the belief is to-day—and was probably always—far from +universal. Hell at home is a strong deterrent with some; a +passing thought with others; with others, again, a theme of +public mockery, not always well assured; and so in the Marquesas +with the tapu. Mr. Regler has seen the two extremes of +scepticism and implicit fear. In the tapu grove he found +one fellow stealing breadfruit, cheerful and impudent as a street +arab; and it was only on a menace of exposure that he showed +himself the least discountenanced. The other case was +opposed in every point. Mr. Regler asked a native to +accompany him upon a voyage; the man went gladly enough, but +suddenly perceiving a dead tapu fish in the bottom of the boat, +leaped back with a scream; nor could the promise of a dollar +prevail upon him to advance.</p> +<p>The Marquesan, it will be observed, adheres to the old idea of +the local circumscription of beliefs and duties. Not only +are the whites exempt from consequences; but their transgressions +seem to be viewed without horror. It was Mr. Regler who had +killed the fish; yet the devout native was not shocked at Mr. +Regler—only refused to join him in his boat. A white +is a white: the servant (so to speak) of other and more liberal +gods; and not to be blamed if he profit by his liberty. The +Jews were perhaps the first to interrupt this ancient comity of +faiths; and the Jewish virus is still strong in +Christianity. All the world must respect our tapus, or we +gnash our teeth.</p> +<h3>CHAPTER VII—HATIHEU</h3> +<p>The bays of Anaho and Hatiheu are divided at their roots by +the knife-edge of a single hill—the pass so often +mentioned; but this isthmus expands to the seaward in a +considerable peninsula: very bare and grassy; haunted by sheep +and, at night and morning, by the piercing cries of the +shepherds; wandered over by a few wild goats; and on its +sea-front indented with long, clamorous caves, and faced with +cliffs of the colour and ruinous outline of an old +peat-stack. In one of these echoing and sunless gullies we +saw, clustered like sea-birds on a splashing ledge, shrill as +sea-birds in their salutation to the passing boat, a group of +fisherwomen, stripped to their gaudy under-clothes. (The +clash of the surf and the thin female voices echo in my +memory.) We had that day a native crew and steersman, +Kauanui; it was our first experience of Polynesian seamanship, +which consists in hugging every point of land. There is no +thought in this of saving time, for they will pull a long way in +to skirt a point that is embayed. It seems that, as they +can never get their houses near enough the surf upon the one +side, so they can never get their boats near enough upon the +other. The practice in bold water is not so dangerous as it +looks—the reflex from the rocks sending the boat off. +Near beaches with a heavy run of sea, I continue to think it very +hazardous, and find the composure of the natives annoying to +behold. We took unmingled pleasure, on the way out, to see +so near at hand the beach and the wonderful colours of the +surf. On the way back, when the sea had risen and was +running strong against us, the fineness of the steersman’s +aim grew more embarrassing. As we came abreast of the +sea-front, where the surf broke highest, Kauanui embraced the +occasion to light his pipe, which then made the circuit of the +boat—each man taking a whiff or two, and, ere he passed it +on, filling his lungs and cheeks with smoke. Their faces +were all puffed out like apples as we came abreast of the cliff +foot, and the bursting surge fell back into the boat in +showers. At the next point ‘cocanetti’ was the +word, and the stroke borrowed my knife, and desisted from his +labours to open nuts. These untimely indulgences may be +compared to the tot of grog served out before a ship goes into +action.</p> +<p>My purpose in this visit led me first to the boys’ +school, for Hatiheu is the university of the north islands. +The hum of the lesson came out to meet us. Close by the +door, where the draught blew coolest, sat the lay brother; around +him, in a packed half-circle, some sixty high-coloured faces set +with staring eyes; and in the background of the barn-like room +benches were to be seen, and blackboards with sums on them in +chalk. The brother rose to greet us, sensibly humble. +Thirty years he had been there, he said, and fingered his white +locks as a bashful child pulls out his pinafore. ‘<i>Et +point de résultats</i>, <i>monsieur</i>, <i>presque pas de +résultats</i>.’ He pointed to the scholars: +‘You see, sir, all the youth of Nuka-hiva and Ua-pu. +Between the ages of six and fifteen this is all that remains; and +it is but a few years since we had a hundred and twenty from +Nuka-hiva alone. <i>Oui</i>, <i>monsieur</i>, <i>cela se +dépérit</i>.’ Prayers, and reading and +writing, prayers again and arithmetic, and more prayers to +conclude: such appeared to be the dreary nature of the +course. For arithmetic all island people have a natural +taste. In Hawaii they make good progress in +mathematics. In one of the villages on Majuro, and +generally in the Marshall group, the whole population sit about +the trader when he is weighing copra, and each on his own slate +takes down the figures and computes the total. The trader, +finding them so apt, introduced fractions, for which they had +been taught no rule. At first they were quite gravelled but +ultimately, by sheer hard thinking, reasoned out the result, and +came one after another to assure the trader he was right. +Not many people in Europe could have done the like. The +course at Hatiheu is therefore less dispiriting to Polynesians +than a stranger might have guessed; and yet how bald it is at +best! I asked the brother if he did not tell them stories, +and he stared at me; if he did not teach them history, and he +said, ‘O yes, they had a little Scripture +history—from the New Testament’; and repeated his +lamentations over the lack of results. I had not the heart +to put more questions; I could but say it must be very +discouraging, and resist the impulse to add that it seemed also +very natural. He looked up—‘My days are far +spent,’ he said; ‘heaven awaits me.’ May +that heaven forgive me, but I was angry with the old man and his +simple consolation. For think of his opportunity! The +youth, from six to fifteen, are taken from their homes by +Government, centralised at Hatiheu, where they are supported by a +weekly tax of food; and, with the exception of one month in every +year, surrendered wholly to the direction of the priests. +Since the escapade already mentioned the holiday occurs at a +different period for the girls and for the boys; so that a +Marquesan brother and sister meet again, after their education is +complete, a pair of strangers. It is a harsh law, and +highly unpopular; but what a power it places in the hands of the +instructors, and how languidly and dully is that power employed +by the mission! Too much concern to make the natives pious, +a design in which they all confess defeat, is, I suppose, the +explanation of their miserable system. But they might see +in the girls’ school at Tai-o-hae, under the brisk, +housewifely sisters, a different picture of efficiency, and a +scene of neatness, airiness, and spirited and mirthful occupation +that should shame them into cheerier methods. The sisters +themselves lament their failure. They complain the annual +holiday undoes the whole year’s work; they complain +particularly of the heartless indifference of the girls. +Out of so many pretty and apparently affectionate pupils whom +they have taught and reared, only two have ever returned to pay a +visit of remembrance to their teachers. These, indeed, come +regularly, but the rest, so soon as their school-days are over, +disappear into the woods like captive insects. It is hard +to imagine anything more discouraging; and yet I do not believe +these ladies need despair. For a certain interval they keep +the girls alive and innocently busy; and if it be at all possible +to save the race, this would be the means. No such praise +can be given to the boys’ school at Hatiheu. The day +is numbered already for them all; alike for the teacher and the +scholars death is girt; he is afoot upon the march; and in the +frequent interval they sit and yawn. But in life there +seems a thread of purpose through the least significant; the +drowsiest endeavour is not lost, and even the school at Hatiheu +may be more useful than it seems.</p> +<p>Hatiheu is a place of some pretensions. The end of the +bay towards Anaho may be called the civil compound, for it boasts +the house of Kooamua, and close on the beach, under a great tree, +that of the gendarme, M. Armand Aussel, with his garden, his +pictures, his books, and his excellent table, to which strangers +are made welcome. No more singular contrast is possible +than between the gendarmerie and the priesthood, who are besides +in smouldering opposition and full of mutual complaints. A +priest’s kitchen in the eastern islands is a depressing +spot to see; and many, or most of them, make no attempt to keep a +garden, sparsely subsisting on their rations. But you will +never dine with a gendarme without smacking your lips; and M. +Aussel’s home-made sausage and the salad from his garden +are unforgotten delicacies. Pierre Loti may like to know +that he is M. Aussel’s favourite author, and that his books +are read in the fit scenery of Hatiheu bay.</p> +<p>The other end is all religious. It is here that an +overhanging and tip-tilted horn, a good sea-mark for Hatiheu, +bursts naked from the verdure of the climbing forest, and breaks +down shoreward in steep taluses and cliffs. From the edge +of one of the highest, perhaps seven hundred or a thousand feet +above the beach, a Virgin looks insignificantly down, like a poor +lost doll, forgotten there by a giant child. This laborious +symbol of the Catholics is always strange to Protestants; we +conceive with wonder that men should think it worth while to toil +so many days, and clamber so much about the face of precipices, +for an end that makes us smile; and yet I believe it was the wise +Bishop Dordillon who chose the place, and I know that those who +had a hand in the enterprise look back with pride upon its +vanquished dangers. The boys’ school is a recent +importation; it was at first in Tai-o-hae, beside the +girls’; and it was only of late, after their joint +escapade, that the width of the island was interposed between the +sexes. But Hatiheu must have been a place of missionary +importance from before. About midway of the beach no less +than three churches stand grouped in a patch of bananas, +intermingled with some pine-apples. Two are of wood: the +original church, now in disuse; and a second that, for some +mysterious reason, has never been used. The new church is +of stone, with twin towers, walls flangeing into buttresses, and +sculptured front. The design itself is good, simple, and +shapely; but the character is all in the detail, where the +architect has bloomed into the sculptor. It is impossible +to tell in words of the angels (although they are more like +winged archbishops) that stand guard upon the door, of the +cherubs in the corners, of the scapegoat gargoyles, or the quaint +and spirited relief, where St. Michael (the artist’s +patron) makes short work of a protesting Lucifer. We were +never weary of viewing the imagery, so innocent, sometimes so +funny, and yet in the best sense—in the sense of inventive +gusto and expression—so artistic. I know not whether +it was more strange to find a building of such merit in a corner +of a barbarous isle, or to see a building so antique still bright +with novelty. The architect, a French lay brother, still +alive and well, and meditating fresh foundations, must have +surely drawn his descent from a master-builder in the age of the +cathedrals; and it was in looking on the church of Hatiheu that I +seemed to perceive the secret charm of mediæval sculpture; +that combination of the childish courage of the amateur, +attempting all things, like the schoolboy on his slate, with the +manly perseverance of the artist who does not know when he is +conquered.</p> +<p>I had always afterwards a strong wish to meet the architect, +Brother Michel; and one day, when I was talking with the Resident +in Tai-o-hae (the chief port of the island), there were shown in +to us an old, worn, purblind, ascetic-looking priest, and a lay +brother, a type of all that is most sound in France, with a +broad, clever, honest, humorous countenance, an eye very large +and bright, and a strong and healthy body inclining to +obesity. But that his blouse was black and his face shaven +clean, you might pick such a man to-day, toiling cheerfully in +his own patch of vines, from half a dozen provinces of France; +and yet he had always for me a haunting resemblance to an old +kind friend of my boyhood, whom I name in case any of my readers +should share with me that memory—Dr. Paul, of the West +Kirk. Almost at the first word I was sure it was my +architect, and in a moment we were deep in a discussion of +Hatiheu church. Brother Michel spoke always of his labours +with a twinkle of humour, underlying which it was possible to spy +a serious pride, and the change from one to another was often +very human and diverting. ‘<i>Et vos gargouilles +moyen-âge</i>,’ cried I; ‘<i>comme elles sont +originates</i>!’ ‘<i>N’est-ce +pas</i>? <i>Elles sont bien drôles</i>!’ he +said, smiling broadly; and the next moment, with a sudden +gravity: ‘<i>Cependant il y en a une qui a une patte de +cassé</i>; <i>il faut que je voie cela</i>.’ I +asked if he had any model—a point we much discussed. +‘<i>Non</i>,’ said he simply; ‘<i>c’est +une église idéale</i>.’ The relievo was +his favourite performance, and very justly so. The angels +at the door, he owned, he would like to destroy and +replace. ‘<i>Ils n’ont pas de vie</i>, <i>ils +manquent de vie</i>. <i>Vous devriez voir mon église +à la Dominique</i>; <i>j’ai là une Vierge qui +est vraiment gentille</i>.’ ‘Ah,’ I +cried, ‘they told me you had said you would never build +another church, and I wrote in my journal I could not believe +it.’ ‘<i>Oui</i>, <i>j’aimerais bien en +fairs une autre</i>,’ he confessed, and smiled at the +confession. An artist will understand how much I was +attracted by this conversation. There is no bond so near as +a community in that unaffected interest and slightly shame-faced +pride which mark the intelligent man enamoured of an art. +He sees the limitations of his aim, the defects of his practice; +he smiles to be so employed upon the shores of death, yet sees in +his own devotion something worthy. Artists, if they had the +same sense of humour with the Augurs, would smile like them on +meeting, but the smile would not be scornful.</p> +<p>I had occasion to see much of this excellent man. He +sailed with us from Tai-o-hae to Hiva-oa, a dead beat of ninety +miles against a heavy sea. It was what is called a good +passage, and a feather in the <i>Casco’s</i> cap; but among +the most miserable forty hours that any one of us had ever +passed. We were swung and tossed together all that time +like shot in a stage thunder-box. The mate was thrown down +and had his head cut open; the captain was sick on deck; the cook +sick in the galley. Of all our party only two sat down to +dinner. I was one. I own that I felt wretchedly; and +I can only say of the other, who professed to feel quite well, +that she fled at an early moment from the table. It was in +these circumstances that we skirted the windward shore of that +indescribable island of Ua-pu; viewing with dizzy eyes the coves, +the capes, the breakers, the climbing forests, and the +inaccessible stone needles that surmount the mountains. The +place persists, in a dark corner of our memories, like a piece of +the scenery of nightmares. The end of this distressful +passage, where we were to land our passengers, was in a similar +vein of roughness. The surf ran high on the beach at +Taahauku; the boat broached-to and capsized; and all hands were +submerged. Only the brother himself, who was well used to +the experience, skipped ashore, by some miracle of agility, with +scarce a sprinkling. Thenceforward, during our stay at +Hiva-oa, he was our cicerone and patron; introducing us, taking +us excursions, serving us in every way, and making himself daily +more beloved.</p> +<p>Michel Blanc had been a carpenter by trade; had made money and +retired, supposing his active days quite over; and it was only +when he found idleness dangerous that he placed his capital and +acquirements at the service of the mission. He became their +carpenter, mason, architect, and engineer; added sculpture to his +accomplishments, and was famous for his skill in gardening. +He wore an enviable air of having found a port from life’s +contentions and lying there strongly anchored; went about his +business with a jolly simplicity; complained of no lack of +results—perhaps shyly thinking his own statuary result +enough; and was altogether a pattern of the missionary +layman.</p> +<h3>CHAPTER VIII—THE PORT OF ENTRY</h3> +<p>The port—the mart, the civil and religious capital of +these rude islands—is called Tai-o-hae, and lies strung +along the beach of a precipitous green bay in Nuka-hiva. It +was midwinter when we came thither, and the weather was sultry, +boisterous, and inconstant. Now the wind blew squally from +the land down gaps of splintered precipice; now, between the +sentinel islets of the entry, it came in gusts from +seaward. Heavy and dark clouds impended on the summits; the +rain roared and ceased; the scuppers of the mountain gushed; and +the next day we would see the sides of the amphitheatre bearded +with white falls. Along the beach the town shows a thin +file of houses, mostly white, and all ensconced in the foliage of +an avenue of green puraos; a pier gives access from the sea +across the belt of breakers; to the eastward there stands, on a +projecting bushy hill, the old fort which is now the calaboose, +or prison; eastward still, alone in a garden, the Residency flies +the colours of France. Just off Calaboose Hill, the tiny +Government schooner rides almost permanently at anchor, marks +eight bells in the morning (there or thereabout) with the +unfurling of her flag, and salutes the setting sun with the +report of a musket.</p> +<p>Here dwell together, and share the comforts of a club (which +may be enumerated as a billiard-board, absinthe, a map of the +world on Mercator’s projection, and one of the most +agreeable verandahs in the tropics), a handful of whites of +varying nationality, mostly French officials, German and Scottish +merchant clerks, and the agents of the opium monopoly. +There are besides three tavern-keepers, the shrewd Scot who runs +the cotton gin-mill, two white ladies, and a sprinkling of people +‘on the beach’—a South Sea expression for which +there is no exact equivalent. It is a pleasant society, and +a hospitable. But one man, who was often to be seen seated +on the logs at the pier-head, merits a word for the singularity +of his history and appearance. Long ago, it seems, he fell +in love with a native lady, a High Chiefess in Ua-pu. She, +on being approached, declared she could never marry a man who was +untattooed; it looked so naked; whereupon, with some greatness of +soul, our hero put himself in the hands of the Tahukus, and, with +still greater, persevered until the process was complete. +He had certainly to bear a great expense, for the Tahuku will not +work without reward; and certainly exquisite pain. Kooamua, +high chief as he was, and one of the old school, was only part +tattooed; he could not, he told us with lively pantomime, endure +the torture to an end. Our enamoured countryman was more +resolved; he was tattooed from head to foot in the most approved +methods of the art; and at last presented himself before his +mistress a new man. The fickle fair one could never behold +him from that day except with laughter. For my part, I +could never see the man without a kind of admiration; of him it +might be said, if ever of any, that he had loved not wisely, but +too well.</p> +<p>The Residency stands by itself, Calaboose Hill screening it +from the fringe of town along the further bay. The house is +commodious, with wide verandahs; all day it stands open, back and +front, and the trade blows copiously over its bare floors. +On a week-day the garden offers a scene of most untropical +animation, half a dozen convicts toiling there cheerfully with +spade and barrow, and touching hats and smiling to the visitor +like old attached family servants. On Sunday these are +gone, and nothing to be seen but dogs of all ranks and sizes +peacefully slumbering in the shady grounds; for the dogs of +Tai-o-hae are very courtly-minded, and make the seat of +Government their promenade and place of siesta. In front +and beyond, a strip of green down loses itself in a low wood of +many species of acacia; and deep in the wood a ruinous wall +encloses the cemetery of the Europeans. English and +Scottish sleep there, and Scandinavians, and French +<i>maîtres de manœuvres</i> and <i>maîtres +ouvriers</i>: mingling alien dust. Back in the woods, +perhaps, the blackbird, or (as they call him there) the island +nightingale, will be singing home strains; and the ceaseless +requiem of the surf hangs on the ear. I have never seen a +resting-place more quiet; but it was a long thought how far these +sleepers had all travelled, and from what diverse homes they had +set forth, to lie here in the end together.</p> +<p>On the summit of its promontory hill, the calaboose stands all +day with doors and window-shutters open to the trade. On my +first visit a dog was the only guardian visible. He, +indeed, rose with an attitude so menacing that I was glad to lay +hands on an old barrel-hoop; and I think the weapon must have +been familiar, for the champion instantly retreated, and as I +wandered round the court and through the building, I could see +him, with a couple of companions, humbly dodging me about the +corners. The prisoners’ dormitory was a spacious, +airy room, devoid of any furniture; its whitewashed walls covered +with inscriptions in Marquesan and rude drawings: one of the +pier, not badly done; one of a murder; several of French soldiers +in uniform. There was one legend in French: ‘<i>Je +n’est</i>’ (sic) ‘<i>pas le +sou</i>.’ From this noontide quietude it must not be +supposed the prison was untenanted; the calaboose at Tai-o-hae +does a good business. But some of its occupants were +gardening at the Residency, and the rest were probably at work +upon the streets, as free as our scavengers at home, although not +so industrious. On the approach of evening they would be +called in like children from play; and the harbour-master (who is +also the jailer) would go through the form of locking them up +until six the next morning. Should a prisoner have any call +in town, whether of pleasure or affairs, he has but to unhook the +window-shutters; and if he is back again, and the shutter +decently replaced, by the hour of call on the morrow, he may have +met the harbour-master in the avenue, and there will be no +complaint, far less any punishment. But this is not +all. The charming French Resident, M. Delaruelle, carried +me one day to the calaboose on an official visit. In the +green court, a very ragged gentleman, his legs deformed with the +island elephantiasis, saluted us smiling. ‘One of our +political prisoners—an insurgent from Raiatea,’ said +the Resident; and then to the jailer: ‘I thought I had +ordered him a new pair of trousers.’ Meanwhile no +other convict was to be seen—‘<i>Eh bien</i>,’ +said the Resident, ‘<i>où sont vos +prisonniers</i>?’ ‘<i>Monsieur le +Résident</i>,’ replied the jailer, saluting with +soldierly formality, ‘<i>comme c’est jour de +fête</i>, <i>je les ai laissé aller à la +chasse</i>.’ They were all upon the mountains hunting +goats! Presently we came to the quarters of the women, +likewise deserted—‘<i>Où sont vos bonnes +femmes</i>?’ asked the Resident; and the jailer cheerfully +responded: ‘<i>Je crois</i>, <i>Monsieur le +Résident</i>, <i>qu’elles sont allées +quelquepart faire une visite</i>.’ It had been the +design of M. Delaruelle, who was much in love with the +whimsicalities of his small realm, to elicit something comical; +but not even he expected anything so perfect as the last. +To complete the picture of convict life in Tai-o-hae, it remains +to be added that these criminals draw a salary as regularly as +the President of the Republic. Ten sous a day is their +hire. Thus they have money, food, shelter, clothing, and, I +was about to write, their liberty. The French are certainly +a good-natured people, and make easy masters. They are +besides inclined to view the Marquesans with an eye of humorous +indulgence. ‘They are dying, poor devils!’ said +M. Delaruelle: ‘the main thing is to let them die in +peace.’ And it was not only well said, but I believe +expressed the general thought. Yet there is another element +to be considered; for these convicts are not merely useful, they +are almost essential to the French existence. With a people +incurably idle, dispirited by what can only be called endemic +pestilence, and inflamed with ill-feeling against their new +masters, crime and convict labour are a godsend to the +Government.</p> +<p>Theft is practically the sole crime. Originally petty +pilferers, the men of Tai-o-hae now begin to force locks and +attack strong-boxes. Hundreds of dollars have been taken at +a time; though, with that redeeming moderation so common in +Polynesian theft, the Marquesan burglar will always take a part +and leave a part, sharing (so to speak) with the +proprietor. If it be Chilian coin—the island +currency—he will escape; if the sum is in gold, French +silver, or bank-notes, the police wait until the money begins to +come in circulation, and then easily pick out their man. +And now comes the shameful part. In plain English, the +prisoner is tortured until he confesses and (if that be possible) +restores the money. To keep him alone, day and night, in +the black hole, is to inflict on the Marquesan torture +inexpressible. Even his robberies are carried on in the +plain daylight, under the open sky, with the stimulus of +enterprise, and the countenance of an accomplice; his terror of +the dark is still insurmountable; conceive, then, what he endures +in his solitary dungeon; conceive how he longs to confess, become +a full-fledged convict, and be allowed to sleep beside his +comrades. While we were in Tai-o-hae a thief was under +prevention. He had entered a house about eight in the +morning, forced a trunk, and stolen eleven hundred francs; and +now, under the horrors of darkness, solitude, and a bedevilled +cannibal imagination, he was reluctantly confessing and giving up +his spoil. From one cache, which he had already pointed +out, three hundred francs had been recovered, and it was expected +that he would presently disgorge the rest. This would be +ugly enough if it were all; but I am bound to say, because it is +a matter the French should set at rest, that worse is continually +hinted. I heard that one man was kept six days with his +arms bound backward round a barrel; and it is the universal +report that every gendarme in the South Seas is equipped with +something in the nature of a thumbscrew. I do not know +this. I never had the face to ask any of the +gendarmes—pleasant, intelligent, and kindly +fellows—with whom I have been intimate, and whose +hospitality I have enjoyed; and perhaps the tale reposes (as I +hope it does) on a misconstruction of that ingenious +cat’s-cradle with which the French agent of police so +readily secures a prisoner. But whether physical or moral, +torture is certainly employed; and by a barbarous injustice, the +state of accusation (in which a man may very well be innocently +placed) is positively painful; the state of conviction (in which +all are supposed guilty) is comparatively free, and positively +pleasant. Perhaps worse still,—not only the accused, +but sometimes his wife, his mistress, or his friend, is subjected +to the same hardships. I was admiring, in the tapu system, +the ingenuity of native methods of detection; there is not much +to admire in those of the French, and to lock up a timid child in +a dark room, and, if he proved obstinate, lock up his sister in +the next, is neither novel nor humane.</p> +<p>The main occasion of these thefts is the new vice of +opium-eating. ‘Here nobody ever works, and all eat +opium,’ said a gendarme; and Ah Fu knew a woman who ate a +dollar’s worth in a day. The successful thief will +give a handful of money to each of his friends, a dress to a +woman, pass an evening in one of the taverns of Tai-o-hae, during +which he treats all comers, produce a big lump of opium, and +retire to the bush to eat and sleep it off. A trader, who +did not sell opium, confessed to me that he was at his +wit’s end. ‘I do not sell it, but others +do,’ said he. ‘The natives only work to buy it; +if they walk over to me to sell their cotton, they have just to +walk over to some one else to buy their opium with my +money. And why should they be at the bother of two +walks? There is no use talking,’ he +added—‘opium is the currency of this +country.’</p> +<p>The man under prevention during my stay at Tai-o-hae lost +patience while the Chinese opium-seller was being examined in his +presence. ‘Of course he sold me opium!’ he +broke out; ‘all the Chinese here sell opium. It was +only to buy opium that I stole; it is only to buy opium that +anybody steals. And what you ought to do is to let no opium +come here, and no Chinamen.’ This is precisely what +is done in Samoa by a native Government; but the French have +bound their own hands, and for forty thousand francs sold native +subjects to crime and death. This horrid traffic may be +said to have sprung up by accident. It was Captain Hart who +had the misfortune to be the means of beginning it, at a time +when his plantations flourished in the Marquesas, and he found a +difficulty in keeping Chinese coolies. To-day the +plantations are practically deserted and the Chinese gone; but in +the meanwhile the natives have learned the vice, the patent +brings in a round sum, and the needy Government at Papeete shut +their eyes and open their pockets. Of course, the patentee +is supposed to sell to Chinamen alone; equally of course, no one +could afford to pay forty thousand francs for the privilege of +supplying a scattered handful of Chinese; and every one knows the +truth, and all are ashamed of it. French officials shake +their heads when opium is mentioned; and the agents of the farmer +blush for their employment. Those that live in glass houses +should not throw stones; as a subject of the British crown, I am +an unwilling shareholder in the largest opium business under +heaven. But the British case is highly complicated; it +implies the livelihood of millions; and must be reformed, when it +can be reformed at all, with prudence. This French +business, on the other hand, is a nostrum and a mere +excrescence. No native industry was to be encouraged: the +poison is solemnly imported. No native habit was to be +considered: the vice has been gratuitously introduced. And +no creature profits, save the Government at Papeete—the not +very enviable gentlemen who pay them, and the Chinese underlings +who do the dirty work.</p> +<h3>CHAPTER IX—THE HOUSE OF TEMOANA</h3> +<p>The history of the Marquesas is, of late years, much confused +by the coming and going of the French. At least twice they +have seized the archipelago, at least once deserted it; and in +the meanwhile the natives pursued almost without interruption +their desultory cannibal wars. Through these events and +changing dynasties, a single considerable figure may be seen to +move: that of the high chief, a king, Temoana. Odds and +ends of his history came to my ears: how he was at first a +convert to the Protestant mission; how he was kidnapped or exiled +from his native land, served as cook aboard a whaler, and was +shown, for small charge, in English seaports; how he returned at +last to the Marquesas, fell under the strong and benign influence +of the late bishop, extended his influence in the group, was for +a while joint ruler with the prelate, and died at last the chief +supporter of Catholicism and the French. His widow remains +in receipt of two pounds a month from the French +Government. Queen she is usually called, but in the +official almanac she figures as ‘<i>Madame Vaekehu</i>, +<i>Grande Chefesse</i>.’ His son (natural or +adoptive, I know not which), Stanislao Moanatini, chief of Akaui, +serves in Tai-o-hae as a kind of Minister of Public Works; and +the daughter of Stanislao is High Chiefess of the southern island +of Tauata. These, then, are the greatest folk of the +archipelago; we thought them also the most estimable. This +is the rule in Polynesia, with few exceptions; the higher the +family, the better the man—better in sense, better in +manners, and usually taller and stronger in body. A +stranger advances blindfold. He scrapes acquaintance as he +can. Save the tattoo in the Marquesas, nothing indicates +the difference of rank; and yet almost invariably we found, after +we had made them, that our friends were persons of station. +I have said ‘usually taller and stronger.’ I +might have been more absolute,—over all Polynesia, and a +part of Micronesia, the rule holds good; the great ones of the +isle, and even of the village, are greater of bone and muscle, +and often heavier of flesh, than any commoner. The usual +explanation—that the high-born child is more industriously +shampooed, is probably the true one. In New Caledonia, at +least, where the difference does not exist, has never been +remarked, the practice of shampooing seems to be itself +unknown. Doctors would be well employed in a study of the +point.</p> +<p>Vaekehu lives at the other end of the town from the Residency, +beyond the buildings of the mission. Her house is on the +European plan: a table in the midst of the chief room; +photographs and religious pictures on the wall. It commands +to either hand a charming vista: through the front door, a peep +of green lawn, scurrying pigs, the pendent fans of the coco-palm +and splendour of the bursting surf: through the back, mounting +forest glades and coronals of precipice. Here, in the +strong thorough-draught, Her Majesty received us in a simple gown +of print, and with no mark of royalty but the exquisite finish of +her tattooed mittens, the elaboration of her manners, and the +gentle falsetto in which all the highly refined among Marquesan +ladies (and Vaekehu above all others) delight to sing their +language. An adopted daughter interpreted, while we gave +the news, and rehearsed by name our friends of Anaho. As we +talked, we could see, through the landward door, another lady of +the household at her toilet under the green trees; who presently, +when her hair was arranged, and her hat wreathed with flowers, +appeared upon the back verandah with gracious salutations.</p> +<p>Vaekehu is very deaf; ‘<i>merci</i>’ is her only +word of French; and I do not know that she seemed clever. +An exquisite, kind refinement, with a shade of quietism, gathered +perhaps from the nuns, was what chiefly struck us. Or +rather, upon that first occasion, we were conscious of a sense as +of district-visiting on our part, and reduced evangelical +gentility on the part of our hostess. The other impression +followed after she was more at ease, and came with Stanislao and +his little girl to dine on board the <i>Casco</i>. She had +dressed for the occasion: wore white, which very well became her +strong brown face; and sat among us, eating or smoking her +cigarette, quite cut off from all society, or only now and then +included through the intermediary of her son. It was a +position that might have been ridiculous, and she made it +ornamental; making believe to hear and to be entertained; her +face, whenever she met our eyes, lighting with the smile of good +society; her contributions to the talk, when she made any, and +that was seldom, always complimentary and pleasing. No +attention was paid to the child, for instance, but what she +remarked and thanked us for. Her parting with each, when +she came to leave, was gracious and pretty, as had been every +step of her behaviour. When Mrs. Stevenson held out her +hand to say good-bye, Vaekehu took it, held it, and a moment +smiled upon her; dropped it, and then, as upon a kindly +after-thought, and with a sort of warmth of condescension, held +out both hands and kissed my wife upon both cheeks. Given +the same relation of years and of rank, the thing would have been +so done on the boards of the <i>Comédie +Française</i>; just so might Madame Brohan have warmed and +condescended to Madame Broisat in the <i>Marquis de +Villemer</i>. It was my part to accompany our guests +ashore: when I kissed the little girl good-bye at the pier steps, +Vaekehu gave a cry of gratification, reached down her hand into +the boat, took mine, and pressed it with that flattering softness +which seems the coquetry of the old lady in every quarter of the +earth. The next moment she had taken Stanislao’s arm, +and they moved off along the pier in the moonlight, leaving me +bewildered. This was a queen of cannibals; she was tattooed +from hand to foot, and perhaps the greatest masterpiece of that +art now extant, so that a while ago, before she was grown prim, +her leg was one of the sights of Tai-o-hae; she had been passed +from chief to chief; she had been fought for and taken in war; +perhaps, being so great a lady, she had sat on the high place, +and throned it there, alone of her sex, while the drums were +going twenty strong and the priests carried up the blood-stained +baskets of long-pig. And now behold her, out of that past +of violence and sickening feasts, step forth, in her age, a +quiet, smooth, elaborate old lady, such as you might find at home +(mittened also, but not often so well-mannered) in a score of +country houses. Only Vaekehu’s mittens were of dye, +not of silk; and they had been paid for, not in money, but the +cooked flesh of men. It came in my mind with a clap, what +she could think of it herself, and whether at heart, perhaps, she +might not regret and aspire after the barbarous and stirring +past. But when I asked Stanislao—‘Ah!’ +said he, ‘she is content; she is religious, she passes all +her days with the sisters.’</p> +<p>Stanislao (Stanislaos, with the final consonant evaded after +the Polynesian habit) was sent by Bishop Dordillon to South +America, and there educated by the fathers. His French is +fluent, his talk sensible and spirited, and in his capacity of +ganger-in-chief, he is of excellent service to the French. +With the prestige of his name and family, and with the stick when +needful, he keeps the natives working and the roads +passable. Without Stanislao and the convicts, I am in doubt +what would become of the present regimen in Nuka-hiva; whether +the highways might not be suffered to close up, the pier to wash +away, and the Residency to fall piecemeal about the ears of +impotent officials. And yet though the hereditary favourer, +and one of the chief props of French authority, he has always an +eye upon the past. He showed me where the old public place +had stood, still to be traced by random piles of stone; told me +how great and fine it was, and surrounded on all sides by +populous houses, whence, at the beating of the drums, the folk +crowded to make holiday. The drum-beat of the Polynesian +has a strange and gloomy stimulation for the nerves of all. +White persons feel it—at these precipitate sounds their +hearts beat faster; and, according to old residents, its effect +on the natives was extreme. Bishop Dordillon might entreat; +Temoana himself command and threaten; at the note of the drum +wild instincts triumphed. And now it might beat upon these +ruins, and who should assemble? The houses are down, the +people dead, their lineage extinct; and the sweepings and +fugitives of distant bays and islands encamp upon their +graves. The decline of the dance Stanislao especially +laments. ‘<i>Chaque pays a ses coutumes</i>,’ +said he; but in the report of any gendarme, perhaps corruptly +eager to increase the number of <i>délits</i> and the +instruments of his own power, custom after custom is placed on +the expurgatorial index. ‘<i>Tenez</i>, <i>une danse +qui n’est pas permise</i>,’ said Stanislao: +‘<i>je ne sais pas pourquoi</i>, <i>elle est très +jolie</i>, <i>elle va comme ça</i>,’ and sticking +his umbrella upright in the road, he sketched the steps and +gestures. All his criticisms of the present, all his +regrets for the past, struck me as temperate and sensible. +The short term of office of the Resident he thought the chief +defect of the administration; that officer having scarce begun to +be efficient ere he was recalled. I thought I gathered, +too, that he regarded with some fear the coming change from a +naval to a civil governor. I am sure at least that I regard +it so myself; for the civil servants of France have never +appeared to any foreigner as at all the flower of their country, +while her naval officers may challenge competition with the +world. In all his talk, Stanislao was particular to speak +of his own country as a land of savages; and when he stated an +opinion of his own, it was with some apologetic preface, alleging +that he was ‘a savage who had travelled.’ There +was a deal, in this elaborate modesty, of honest pride. Yet +there was something in the precaution that saddened me; and I +could not but fear he was only forestalling a taunt that he had +heard too often.</p> +<p>I recall with interest two interviews with Stanislao. +The first was a certain afternoon of tropic rain, which we passed +together in the verandah of the club; talking at times with +heightened voices as the showers redoubled overhead, passing at +times into the billiard-room, to consult, in the dim, cloudy +daylight, that map of the world which forms its chief +adornment. He was naturally ignorant of English history, so +that I had much of news to communicate. The story of Gordon +I told him in full, and many episodes of the Indian Mutiny, +Lucknow, the second battle of Cawn-pore, the relief of Arrah, the +death of poor Spottis-woode, and Sir Hugh Rose’s hotspur, +midland campaign. He was intent to hear; his brown face, +strongly marked with small-pox, kindled and changed with each +vicissitude. His eyes glowed with the reflected light of +battle; his questions were many and intelligent, and it was +chiefly these that sent us so often to the map. But it is +of our parting that I keep the strongest sense. We were to +sail on the morrow, and the night had fallen, dark, gusty, and +rainy, when we stumbled up the hill to bid farewell to +Stanislao. He had already loaded us with gifts; but more +were waiting. We sat about the table over cigars and green +cocoa-nuts; claps of wind blew through the house and extinguished +the lamp, which was always instantly relighted with a single +match; and these recurrent intervals of darkness were felt as a +relief. For there was something painful and embarrassing in +the kindness of that separation. ‘<i>Ah</i>, <i>vous +devriez rester ici</i>, <i>mon cher ami</i>!’ cried +Stanislao. ‘<i>Vous êtes les gens qu’il +faut pour les Kanaques</i>; <i>vous êtes doux</i>, <i>vous +et votre famille</i>; <i>vous seriez obéis dans toutes les +îles</i>.’ We had been civil; not always that, +my conscience told me, and never anything beyond; and all this +to-do is a measure, not of our considerateness, but of the want +of it in others. The rest of the evening, on to +Vaekehu’s and back as far as to the pier, Stanislao walked +with my arm and sheltered me with his umbrella; and after the +boat had put off, we could still distinguish, in the murky +darkness, his gestures of farewell. His words, if there +were any, were drowned by the rain and the loud surf.</p> +<p>I have mentioned presents, a vexed question in the South Seas; +and one which well illustrates the common, ignorant habit of +regarding races in a lump. In many quarters the Polynesian +gives only to receive. I have visited islands where the +population mobbed me for all the world like dogs after the waggon +of cat’s-meat; and where the frequent proposition, +‘You my pleni (friend),’ or (with more of pathos) +‘You all ’e same my father,’ must be received +with hearty laughter and a shout. And perhaps everywhere, +among the greedy and rapacious, a gift is regarded as a sprat to +catch a whale. It is the habit to give gifts and to receive +returns, and such characters, complying with the custom, will +look to it nearly that they do not lose. But for persons of +a different stamp the statement must be reversed. The +shabby Polynesian is anxious till he has received the return +gift; the generous is uneasy until he has made it. The +first is disappointed if you have not given more than he; the +second is miserable if he thinks he has given less than +you. This is my experience; if it clash with that of +others, I pity their fortune, and praise mine: the circumstances +cannot change what I have seen, nor lessen what I have +received. And indeed I find that those who oppose me often +argue from a ground of singular presumptions; comparing +Polynesians with an ideal person, compact of generosity and +gratitude, whom I never had the pleasure of encountering; and +forgetting that what is almost poverty to us is wealth almost +unthinkable to them. I will give one instance: I chanced to +speak with consideration of these gifts of Stanislao’s with +a certain clever man, a great hater and contemner of +Kanakas. ‘Well! what were they?’ he +cried. ‘A pack of old men’s beards. +Trash!’ And the same gentleman, some half an hour +later, being upon a different train of thought, dwelt at length +on the esteem in which the Marquesans held that sort of property, +how they preferred it to all others except land, and what fancy +prices it would fetch. Using his own figures, I computed +that, in this commodity alone, the gifts of Vaekehu and Stanislao +represented between two and three hundred dollars; and the +queen’s official salary is of two hundred and forty in the +year.</p> +<p>But generosity on the one hand, and conspicuous meanness on +the other, are in the South Seas, as at home, the +exception. It is neither with any hope of gain, nor with +any lively wish to please, that the ordinary Polynesian chooses +and presents his gifts. A plain social duty lies before +him, which he performs correctly, but without the least +enthusiasm. And we shall best understand his attitude of +mind, if we examine our own to the cognate absurdity of marriage +presents. There we give without any special thought of a +return; yet if the circumstance arise, and the return be +withheld, we shall judge ourselves insulted. We give them +usually without affection, and almost never with a genuine desire +to please; and our gift is rather a mark of our own status than a +measure of our love to the recipients. So in a great +measure and with the common run of the Polynesians; their gifts +are formal; they imply no more than social recognition; and they +are made and reciprocated, as we pay and return our morning +visits. And the practice of marking and measuring events +and sentiments by presents is universal in the island +world. A gift plays with them the part of stamp and seal; +and has entered profoundly into the mind of islanders. +Peace and war, marriage, adoption and naturalisation, are +celebrated or declared by the acceptance or the refusal of gifts; +and it is as natural for the islander to bring a gift as for us +to carry a card-case.</p> +<h3>CHAPTER X—A PORTRAIT AND A STORY</h3> +<p>I have had occasion several times to name the late bishop, +Father Dordillon, ‘Monseigneur,’ as he is still +almost universally called, Vicar-Apostolic of the Marquesas and +Bishop of Cambysopolis <i>in partibus</i>. Everywhere in +the islands, among all classes and races, this fine, old, kindly, +cheerful fellow is remembered with affection and respect. +His influence with the natives was paramount. They reckoned +him the highest of men—higher than an admiral; brought him +their money to keep; took his advice upon their purchases; nor +would they plant trees upon their own land till they had the +approval of the father of the islands. During the time of +the French exodus he singly represented Europe, living in the +Residency, and ruling by the hand of Temoana. The first +roads were made under his auspices and by his persuasion. +The old road between Hatiheu and Anaho was got under way from +either side on the ground that it would be pleasant for an +evening promenade, and brought to completion by working on the +rivalry of the two villages. The priest would boast in +Hatiheu of the progress made in Anaho, and he would tell the folk +of Anaho, ‘If you don’t take care, your neighbours +will be over the hill before you are at the top.’ It +could not be so done to-day; it could then; death, opium, and +depopulation had not gone so far; and the people of Hatiheu, I +was told, still vied with each other in fine attire, and used to +go out by families, in the cool of the evening, boat-sailing and +racing in the bay. There seems some truth at least in the +common view, that this joint reign of Temoana and the bishop was +the last and brief golden age of the Marquesas. But the +civil power returned, the mission was packed out of the Residency +at twenty-four hours’ notice, new methods supervened, and +the golden age (whatever it quite was) came to an end. It +is the strongest proof of Father Dordillon’s prestige that +it survived, seemingly without loss, this hasty deposition.</p> +<p>His method with the natives was extremely mild. Among +these barbarous children he still played the part of the smiling +father; and he was careful to observe, in all indifferent +matters, the Marquesan etiquette. Thus, in the singular +system of artificial kinship, the bishop had been adopted by +Vaekehu as a grandson; Miss Fisher, of Hatiheu, as a +daughter. From that day, Monseigneur never addressed the +young lady except as his mother, and closed his letters with the +formalities of a dutiful son. With Europeans he could be +strict, even to the extent of harshness. He made no +distinction against heretics, with whom he was on friendly terms; +but the rules of his own Church he would see observed; and once +at least he had a white man clapped in jail for the desecration +of a saint’s day. But even this rigour, so +intolerable to laymen, so irritating to Protestants, could not +shake his popularity. We shall best conceive him by +examples nearer home; we may all have known some divine of the +old school in Scotland, a literal Sabbatarian, a stickler for the +letter of the law, who was yet in private modest, innocent, +genial and mirthful. Much such a man, it seems, was Father +Dordillon. And his popularity bore a test yet +stronger. He had the name, and probably deserved it, of a +shrewd man in business and one that made the mission pay. +Nothing so much stirs up resentment as the inmixture in commerce +of religious bodies; but even rival traders spoke well of +Monseigneur.</p> +<p>His character is best portrayed in the story of the days of +his decline. A time came when, from the failure of sight, +he must desist from his literary labours: his Marquesan hymns, +grammars, and dictionaries; his scientific papers, lives of +saints, and devotional poetry. He cast about for a new +interest: pitched on gardening, and was to be seen all day, with +spade and water-pot, in his childlike eagerness, actually running +between the borders. Another step of decay, and he must +leave his garden also. Instantly a new occupation was +devised, and he sat in the mission cutting paper flowers and +wreaths. His diocese was not great enough for his activity; +the churches of the Marquesas were papered with his handiwork, +and still he must be making more. ‘Ah,’ said +he, smiling, ‘when I am dead what a fine time you will have +clearing out my trash!’ He had been dead about six +months; but I was pleased to see some of his trophies still +exposed, and looked upon them with a smile: the tribute (if I +have read his cheerful character aright) which he would have +preferred to any useless tears. Disease continued +progressively to disable him; he who had clambered so stalwartly +over the rude rocks of the Marquesas, bringing peace to warfaring +clans, was for some time carried in a chair between the mission +and the church, and at last confined to bed, impotent with +dropsy, and tormented with bed-sores and sciatica. Here he +lay two months without complaint; and on the 11th January 1888, +in the seventy-ninth year of his life, and the thirty-fourth of +his labours in the Marquesas, passed away.</p> +<p>Those who have a taste for hearing missions, Protestant or +Catholic, decried, must seek their pleasure elsewhere than in my +pages. Whether Catholic or Protestant, with all their gross +blots, with all their deficiency of candour, of humour, and of +common sense, the missionaries are the best and the most useful +whites in the Pacific. This is a subject which will follow +us throughout; but there is one part of it that may conveniently +be treated here. The married and the celibate missionary, +each has his particular advantage and defect. The married +missionary, taking him at the best, may offer to the native what +he is much in want of—a higher picture of domestic life; +but the woman at his elbow tends to keep him in touch with Europe +and out of touch with Polynesia, and to perpetuate, and even to +ingrain, parochial decencies far best forgotten. The mind +of the female missionary tends, for instance, to be continually +busied about dress. She can be taught with extreme +difficulty to think any costume decent but that to which she grew +accustomed on Clapham Common; and to gratify this prejudice, the +native is put to useless expense, his mind is tainted with the +morbidities of Europe, and his health is set in danger. The +celibate missionary, on the other hand, and whether at best or +worst, falls readily into native ways of life; to which he adds +too commonly what is either a mark of celibate man at large, or +an inheritance from mediæval saints—I mean slovenly +habits and an unclean person. There are, of course, degrees +in this; and the sister (of course, and all honour to her) is as +fresh as a lady at a ball. For the diet there is nothing to +be said—it must amaze and shock the Polynesian—but +for the adoption of native habits there is much. +‘<i>Chaque pays a ses coutumes</i>,’ said Stanislao; +these it is the missionary’s delicate task to modify; and +the more he can do so from within, and from a native standpoint, +the better he will do his work; and here I think the Catholics +have sometimes the advantage; in the Vicariate of Dordillon, I am +sure they had it. I have heard the bishop blamed for his +indulgence to the natives, and above all because he did not rage +with sufficient energy against cannibalism. It was a part +of his policy to live among the natives like an elder brother; to +follow where he could; to lead where it was necessary; never to +drive; and to encourage the growth of new habits, instead of +violently rooting up the old. And it might be better, in +the long-run, if this policy were always followed.</p> +<p>It might be supposed that native missionaries would prove more +indulgent, but the reverse is found to be the case. The new +broom sweeps clean; and the white missionary of to-day is often +embarrassed by the bigotry of his native coadjutor. What +else should we expect? On some islands, sorcery, polygamy, +human sacrifice, and tobacco-smoking have been prohibited, the +dress of the native has been modified, and himself warned in +strong terms against rival sects of Christianity; all by the same +man, at the same period of time, and with the like +authority. By what criterion is the convert to distinguish +the essential from the unessential? He swallows the nostrum +whole; there has been no play of mind, no instruction, and, +except for some brute utility in the prohibitions, no +advance. To call things by their proper names, this is +teaching superstition. It is unfortunate to use the word; +so few people have read history, and so many have dipped into +little atheistic manuals, that the majority will rush to a +conclusion, and suppose the labour lost. And far from that: +These semi-spontaneous superstitions, varying with the sect of +the original evangelist and the customs of the island, are found +in practice to be highly fructifying; and in particular those who +have learned and who go forth again to teach them offer an +example to the world. The best specimen of the Christian +hero that I ever met was one of these native missionaries. +He had saved two lives at the risk of his own; like Nathan, he +had bearded a tyrant in his hour of blood; when a whole white +population fled, he alone stood to his duty; and his behaviour +under domestic sorrow with which the public has no concern filled +the beholder with sympathy and admiration. A poor little +smiling laborious man he looked; and you would have thought he +had nothing in him but that of which indeed he had too +much—facile good-nature. <a name="citation86"></a><a +href="#footnote86" class="citation">[86]</a></p> +<p>It chances that the only rivals of Monseigneur and his mission +in the Marquesas were certain of these brown-skinned evangelists, +natives from Hawaii. I know not what they thought of Father +Dordillon: they are the only class I did not question; but I +suspect the prelate to have regarded them askance, for he was +eminently human. During my stay at Tai-o-hae, the time of +the yearly holiday came round at the girls’ school; and a +whole fleet of whale-boats came from Ua-pu to take the daughters +of that island home. On board of these was Kauwealoha, one +of the pastors, a fine, rugged old gentleman, of that leonine +type so common in Hawaii. He paid me a visit in the +<i>Casco</i>, and there entertained me with a tale of one of his +colleagues, Kekela, a missionary in the great cannibal isle of +Hiva-oa. It appears that shortly after a kidnapping visit +from a Peruvian slaver, the boats of an American whaler put into +a bay upon that island, were attacked, and made their escape with +difficulty, leaving their mate, a Mr. Whalon, in the hands of the +natives. The captive, with his arms bound behind his back, +was cast into a house; and the chief announced the capture to +Kekela. And here I begin to follow the version of +Kauwealoha; it is a good specimen of Kanaka English; and the +reader is to conceive it delivered with violent emphasis and +speaking pantomime.</p> +<p>‘“I got ’Melican mate,” the chief he +say. “What you go do ’Melican mate?” +Kekela he say. “I go make fire, I go kill, I go eat +him,” he say; “you come to-mollow eat +piece.” “I no <i>want</i> eat ’Melican +mate!” Kekela he say; “why you want?” +“This bad shippee, this slave shippee,” the chief he +say. “One time a shippee he come from Pelu, he take +away plenty Kanaka, he take away my son. ’Melican +mate he bad man. I go eat him; you eat piece.” +“I no <i>want</i> eat ’Melican mate!” Kekela he +say; and he <i>cly</i>—all night he cly! To-mollow +Kekela he get up, he put on blackee coat, he go see chief; he see +Missa Whela, him hand tie’ like this. +(<i>Pantomime</i>.) Kekela he cly. He say +chief:—“Chief, you like things of mine? you like +whale-boat?” “Yes,” he say. +“You like file-a’m?” (fire-arms). +“Yes,” he say. “You like blackee +coat?” “Yes,” he say. Kekela he +take Missa Whela by he shoul’a’ (shoulder), he take +him light out house; he give chief he whale-boat, he +file-a’m, he blackee coat. He take Missa Whela he +house, make him sit down with he wife and chil’en. +Missa Whela all-the-same pelison (prison); he wife, he +chil’en in Amelica; he cly—O, he cly. Kekela he +solly. One day Kekela he see ship. +(<i>Pantomime</i>.) He say Missa Whela, “Ma’ +Whala?” Missa Whela he say, “Yes.” +Kanaka they begin go down beach. Kekela he get eleven +Kanaka, get oa’ (oars), get evely thing. He say Missa +Whela, “Now you go quick.” They jump in +whale-boat. “Now you low!” Kekela he say: +“you low quick, quick!” (<i>Violent +pantomime</i>, <i>and a change indicating that the narrator has +left the boat and returned to the beach</i>.) All the +Kanaka they say, “How! ’Melican mate he go +away?”—jump in boat; low afta. (<i>Violent +pantomime</i>, <i>and change again to boat</i>.) Kekela he +say, “Low quick!”’</p> +<p>Here I think Kauwealoha’s pantomime had confused me; I +have no more of his <i>ipsissima verba</i>; and can but add, in +my own less spirited manner, that the ship was reached, Mr. +Whalon taken aboard, and Kekela returned to his charge among the +cannibals. But how unjust it is to repeat the stumblings of +a foreigner in a language only partly acquired! A +thoughtless reader might conceive Kauwealoha and his colleague to +be a species of amicable baboon; but I have here the +anti-dote. In return for his act of gallant charity, Kekela +was presented by the American Government with a sum of money, and +by President Lincoln personally with a gold watch. From his +letter of thanks, written in his own tongue, I give the following +extract. I do not envy the man who can read it without +emotion.</p> +<blockquote><p>‘When I saw one of your countrymen, a +citizen of your great nation, ill-treated, and about to be baked +and eaten, as a pig is eaten, I ran to save him, full of pity and +grief at the evil deed of these benighted people. I gave my +boat for the stranger’s life. This boat came from +James Hunnewell, a gift of friendship. It became the ransom +of this countryman of yours, that he might not be eaten by the +savages who knew not Jehovah. This was Mr. Whalon, and the +date, Jan. 14, 1864.</p> +<p>‘As to this friendly deed of mine in saving Mr. Whalon, +its seed came from your great land, and was brought by certain of +your countrymen, who had received the love of God. It was +planted in Hawaii, and I brought it to plant in this land and in +these dark regions, that they might receive the root of all that +is good and true, which is <i>love</i>.</p> +<p>‘1. Love to Jehovah.</p> +<p>‘2. Love to self.</p> +<p>‘3. Love to our neighbour.</p> +<p>‘If a man have a sufficiency of these three, he is good +and holy, like his God, Jehovah, in his triune character (Father, +Son, and Holy Ghost), one-three, three-one. If he have two +and wants one, it is not well; and if he have one and wants two, +indeed, is not well; but if he cherishes all three, then is he +holy, indeed, after the manner of the Bible.</p> +<p>‘This is a great thing for your great nation to boast +of, before all the nations of the earth. From your great +land a most precious seed was brought to the land of +darkness. It was planted here, not by means of guns and +men-of-war and threatening. It was planted by means of the +ignorant, the neglected, the despised. Such was the +introduction of the word of the Almighty God into this group of +Nuuhiwa. Great is my debt to Americans, who have taught me +all things pertaining to this life and to that which is to +come.</p> +<p>‘How shall I repay your great kindness to me? Thus +David asked of Jehovah, and thus I ask of you, the President of +the United States. This is my only payment—that which +I have received of the Lord, love—(aloha).’</p> +</blockquote> +<h3>CHAPTER XI—LONG-PIG—A CANNIBAL HIGH PLACE</h3> +<p>Nothing more strongly arouses our disgust than cannibalism, +nothing so surely unmortars a society; nothing, we might +plausibly argue, will so harden and degrade the minds of those +that practise it. And yet we ourselves make much the same +appearance in the eyes of the Buddhist and the vegetarian. +We consume the carcasses of creatures of like appetites, +passions, and organs with ourselves; we feed on babes, though not +our own; and the slaughter-house resounds daily with screams of +pain and fear. We distinguish, indeed; but the +unwillingness of many nations to eat the dog, an animal with whom +we live on terms of the next intimacy, shows how precariously the +distinction is grounded. The pig is the main element of +animal food among the islands; and I had many occasions, my mind +being quickened by my cannibal surroundings, to observe his +character and the manner of his death. Many islanders live +with their pigs as we do with our dogs; both crowd around the +hearth with equal freedom; and the island pig is a fellow of +activity, enterprise, and sense. He husks his own +cocoa-nuts, and (I am told) rolls them into the sun to burst; he +is the terror of the shepherd. Mrs. Stevenson, senior, has +seen one fleeing to the woods with a lamb in his mouth; and I saw +another come rapidly (and erroneously) to the conclusion that the +<i>Casco</i> was going down, and swim through the flush water to +the rail in search of an escape. It was told us in +childhood that pigs cannot swim; I have known one to leap +overboard, swim five hundred yards to shore, and return to the +house of his original owner. I was once, at Tautira, a +pig-master on a considerable scale; at first, in my pen, the +utmost good feeling prevailed; a little sow with a belly-ache +came and appealed to us for help in the manner of a child; and +there was one shapely black boar, whom we called Catholicus, for +he was a particular present from the Catholics of the village, +and who early displayed the marks of courage and friendliness; no +other animal, whether dog or pig, was suffered to approach him at +his food, and for human beings he showed a full measure of that +toadying fondness so common in the lower animals, and possibly +their chief title to the name. One day, on visiting my +piggery, I was amazed to see Catholicus draw back from my +approach with cries of terror; and if I was amazed at the change, +I was truly embarrassed when I learnt its reason. One of +the pigs had been that morning killed; Catholicus had seen the +murder, he had discovered he was dwelling in the shambles, and +from that time his confidence and his delight in life were +ended. We still reserved him a long while, but he could not +endure the sight of any two-legged creature, nor could we, under +the circumstances, encounter his eye without confusion. I +have assisted besides, by the ear, at the act of butchery itself; +the victim’s cries of pain I think I could have borne, but +the execution was mismanaged, and his expression of terror was +contagious: that small heart moved to the same tune with +ours. Upon such ‘dread foundations’ the life of +the European reposes, and yet the European is among the less +cruel of races. The paraphernalia of murder, the +preparatory brutalities of his existence, are all hid away; an +extreme sensibility reigns upon the surface; and ladies will +faint at the recital of one tithe of what they daily expect of +their butchers. Some will be even crying out upon me in +their hearts for the coarseness of this paragraph. And so +with the island cannibals. They were not cruel; apart from +this custom, they are a race of the most kindly; rightly +speaking, to cut a man’s flesh after he is dead is far less +hateful than to oppress him whilst he lives; and even the victims +of their appetite were gently used in life and suddenly and +painlessly despatched at last. In island circles of +refinement it was doubtless thought bad taste to expatiate on +what was ugly in the practice.</p> +<p>Cannibalism is traced from end to end of the Pacific, from the +Marquesas to New Guinea, from New Zealand to Hawaii, here in the +lively haunt of its exercise, there by scanty but significant +survivals. Hawaii is the most doubtful. We find +cannibalism chronicled in Hawaii, only in the history of a single +war, where it seems to have been thought exception, as in the +case of mountain outlaws, such as fell by the hand of +Theseus. In Tahiti, a single circumstance survived, but +that appears conclusive. In historic times, when human +oblation was made in the marae, the eyes of the victim were +formally offered to the chief: a delicacy to the leading +guest. All Melanesia appears tainted. In Micronesia, +in the Marshalls, with which my acquaintance is no more than that +of a tourist, I could find no trace at all; and even in the +Gilbert zone I long looked and asked in vain. I was told +tales indeed of men who had been eaten in a famine; but these +were nothing to my purpose, for the same thing is done under the +same stress by all kindreds and generations of men. At +last, in some manuscript notes of Dr. Turner’s, which I was +allowed to consult at Malua, I came on one damning evidence: on +the island of Onoatoa the punishment for theft was to be killed +and eaten. How shall we account for the universality of the +practice over so vast an area, among people of such varying +civilisation, and, with whatever intermixture, of such different +blood? What circumstance is common to them all, but that +they lived on islands destitute, or very nearly so, of animal +food? I can never find it in my appetite that man was meant +to live on vegetables only. When our stores ran low among +the islands, I grew to weary for the recurrent day when economy +allowed us to open another tin of miserable mutton. And in +at least one ocean language, a particular word denotes that a man +is ‘hungry for fish,’ having reached that stage when +vegetables can no longer satisfy, and his soul, like those of the +Hebrews in the desert, begins to lust after flesh-pots. Add +to this the evidences of over-population and imminent famine +already adduced, and I think we see some ground of indulgence for +the island cannibal.</p> +<p>It is right to look at both sides of any question; but I am +far from making the apology of this worse than bestial +vice. The higher Polynesian races, such as the Tahitians, +Hawaiians, and Samoans, had one and all outgrown, and some of +them had in part forgot, the practice, before Cook or +Bougainville had shown a top-sail in their waters. It +lingered only in some low islands where life was difficult to +maintain, and among inveterate savages like the New-Zealanders or +the Marquesans. The Marquesans intertwined man-eating with +the whole texture of their lives; long-pig was in a sense their +currency and sacrament; it formed the hire of the artist, +illustrated public events, and was the occasion and attraction of +a feast. To-day they are paying the penalty of this bloody +commixture. The civil power, in its crusade against +man-eating, has had to examine one after another all Marquesan +arts and pleasures, has found them one after another tainted with +a cannibal element, and one after another has placed them on the +proscript list. Their art of tattooing stood by itself, the +execution exquisite, the designs most beautiful and intricate; +nothing more handsomely sets off a handsome man; it may cost some +pain in the beginning, but I doubt if it be near so painful in +the long-run, and I am sure it is far more becoming than the +ignoble European practice of tight-lacing among women. And +now it has been found needful to forbid the art. Their +songs and dances were numerous (and the law has had to abolish +them by the dozen). They now face empty-handed the tedium +of their uneventful days; and who shall pity them? The +least rigorous will say that they were justly served.</p> +<p>Death alone could not satisfy Marquesan vengeance: the flesh +must be eaten. The chief who seized Mr. Whalon preferred to +eat him; and he thought he had justified the wish when he +explained it was a vengeance. Two or three years ago, the +people of a valley seized and slew a wretch who had offended +them. His offence, it is to be supposed, was dire; they +could not bear to leave their vengeance incomplete, and, under +the eyes of the French, they did not dare to hold a public +festival. The body was accordingly divided; and every man +retired to his own house to consummate the rite in secret, +carrying his proportion of the dreadful meat in a Swedish +match-box. The barbarous substance of the drama and the +European properties employed offer a seizing contrast to the +imagination. Yet more striking is another incident of the +very year when I was there myself, 1888. In the spring, a +man and woman skulked about the school-house in Hiva-oa till they +found a particular child alone. Him they approached with +honeyed words and carneying manners—‘You are +So-and-so, son of So-and-so?’ they asked; and caressed and +beguiled him deeper in the woods. Some instinct woke in the +child’s bosom, or some look betrayed the horrid purpose of +his deceivers. He sought to break from them; he screamed; +and they, casting off the mask, seized him the more strongly and +began to run. His cries were heard; his schoolmates, +playing not far off, came running to the rescue; and the sinister +couple fled and vanished in the woods. They were never +identified; no prosecution followed; but it was currently +supposed they had some grudge against the boy’s father, and +designed to eat him in revenge. All over the islands, as at +home among our own ancestors, it will be observed that the +avenger takes no particular heed to strike an individual. A +family, a class, a village, a whole valley or island, a whole +race of mankind, share equally the guilt of any member. So, +in the above story, the son was to pay the penalty for his +father; so Mr. Whalon, the mate of an American whaler, was to +bleed and be eaten for the misdeeds of a Peruvian slaver. I +am reminded of an incident in Jaluit in the Marshall group, which +was told me by an eye-witness, and which I tell here again for +the strangeness of the scene. Two men had awakened the +animosity of the Jaluit chiefs; and it was their wives who were +selected to be punished. A single native served as +executioner. Early in the morning, in the face of a large +concourse of spectators, he waded out upon the reef between his +victims. These neither complained nor resisted; accompanied +their destroyer patiently; stooped down, when they had waded deep +enough, at his command; and he (laying one hand upon the +shoulders of each) held them under water till they drowned. +Doubtless, although my informant did not tell me so, their +families would be lamenting aloud upon the beach.</p> +<p>It was from Hatiheu that I paid my first visit to a cannibal +high place.</p> +<p>The day was sultry and clouded. Drenching tropical +showers succeeded bursts of sweltering sunshine. The green +pathway of the road wound steeply upward. As we went, our +little schoolboy guide a little ahead of us, Father Simeon had +his portfolio in his hand, and named the trees for me, and read +aloud from his notes the abstract of their virtues. +Presently the road, mounting, showed us the vale of Hatiheu, on a +larger scale; and the priest, with occasional reference to our +guide, pointed out the boundaries and told me the names of the +larger tribes that lived at perpetual war in the old days: one on +the north-east, one along the beach, one behind upon the +mountain. With a survivor of this latter clan Father Simeon +had spoken; until the pacification he had never been to the +sea’s edge, nor, if I remember exactly, eaten of +sea-fish. Each in its own district, the septs lived +cantoned and beleaguered. One step without the boundaries +was to affront death. If famine came, the men must out to +the woods to gather chestnuts and small fruits; even as to this +day, if the parents are backward in their weekly doles, school +must be broken up and the scholars sent foraging. But in +the old days, when there was trouble in one clan, there would be +activity in all its neighbours; the woods would be laid full of +ambushes; and he who went after vegetables for himself might +remain to be a joint for his hereditary foes. Nor was the +pointed occasion needful. A dozen different natural signs +and social junctures called this people to the war-path and the +cannibal hunt. Let one of chiefly rank have finished his +tattooing, the wife of one be near upon her time, two of the +debauching streams have deviated nearer on the beach of Hatiheu, +a certain bird have been heard to sing, a certain ominous +formation of cloud observed above the northern sea; and instantly +the arms were oiled, and the man-hunters swarmed into the wood to +lay their fratricidal ambuscades. It appears besides that +occasionally, perhaps in famine, the priest would shut himself in +his house, where he lay for a stated period like a person +dead. When he came forth it was to run for three days +through the territory of the clan, naked and starving, and to +sleep at night alone in the high place. It was now the turn +of the others to keep the house, for to encounter the priest upon +his rounds was death. On the eve of the fourth day the time +of the running was over; the priest returned to his roof, the +laymen came forth, and in the morning the number of the victims +was announced. I have this tale of the priest on one +authority—I think a good one,—but I set it down with +diffidence. The particulars are so striking that, had they +been true, I almost think I must have heard them oftener referred +to. Upon one point there seems to be no question: that the +feast was sometimes furnished from within the clan. In +times of scarcity, all who were not protected by their family +connections—in the Highland expression, all the commons of +the clan—had cause to tremble. It was vain to resist, +it was useless to flee. They were begirt upon all hands by +cannibals; and the oven was ready to smoke for them abroad in the +country of their foes, or at home in the valley of their +fathers.</p> +<p>At a certain corner of the road our scholar-guide struck off +to his left into the twilight of the forest. We were now on +one of the ancient native roads, plunged in a high vault of wood, +and clambering, it seemed, at random over boulders and dead +trees; but the lad wound in and out and up and down without a +check, for these paths are to the natives as marked as the +king’s highway is to us; insomuch that, in the days of the +man-hunt, it was their labour rather to block and deface than to +improve them. In the crypt of the wood the air was clammy +and hot and cold; overhead, upon the leaves, the tropical rain +uproariously poured, but only here and there, as through holes in +a leaky roof, a single drop would fall, and make a spot upon my +mackintosh. Presently the huge trunk of a banyan hove in +sight, standing upon what seemed the ruins of an ancient fort; +and our guide, halting and holding forth his arm, announced that +we had reached the <i>paepae tapu</i>.</p> +<p><i>Paepae</i> signifies a floor or platform such as a native +house is built on; and even such a paepae—a paepae +hae—may be called a paepae tapu in a lesser sense when it +is deserted and becomes the haunt of spirits; but the public high +place, such as I was now treading, was a thing on a great +scale. As far as my eyes could pierce through the dark +undergrowth, the floor of the forest was all paved. Three +tiers of terrace ran on the slope of the hill; in front, a +crumbling parapet contained the main arena; and the pavement of +that was pierced and parcelled out with several wells and small +enclosures. No trace remained of any superstructure, and +the scheme of the amphitheatre was difficult to seize. I +visited another in Hiva-oa, smaller but more perfect, where it +was easy to follow rows of benches, and to distinguish isolated +seats of honour for eminent persons; and where, on the upper +platform, a single joist of the temple or dead-house still +remained, its uprights richly carved. In the old days the +high place was sedulously tended. No tree except the sacred +banyan was suffered to encroach upon its grades, no dead leaf to +rot upon the pavement. The stones were smoothly set, and I +am told they were kept bright with oil. On all sides the +guardians lay encamped in their subsidiary huts to watch and +cleanse it. No other foot of man was suffered to draw near; +only the priest, in the days of his running, came there to +sleep—perhaps to dream of his ungodly errand; but, in the +time of the feast, the clan trooped to the high place in a body, +and each had his appointed seat. There were places for the +chiefs, the drummers, the dancers, the women, and the +priests. The drums—perhaps twenty strong, and some of +them twelve feet high—continuously throbbed in time. +In time the singers kept up their long-drawn, lugubrious, +ululating song; in time, too, the dancers, tricked out in +singular finery, stepped, leaped, swayed, and +gesticulated—their plumed fingers fluttering in the air +like butterflies. The sense of time, in all these ocean +races, is extremely perfect; and I conceive in such a festival +that almost every sound and movement fell in one. So much +the more unanimously must have grown the agitation of the +feasters; so much the more wild must have been the scene to any +European who could have beheld them there, in the strong sun and +the strong shadow of the banyan, rubbed with saffron to throw in +a more high relief the arabesque of the tattoo; the women +bleached by days of confinement to a complexion almost European; +the chiefs crowned with silver plumes of old men’s beards +and girt with kirtles of the hair of dead women. All manner +of island food was meanwhile spread for the women and the +commons; and, for those who were privileged to eat of it, there +were carried up to the dead-house the baskets of long-pig. +It is told that the feasts were long kept up; the people came +from them brutishly exhausted with debauchery, and the chiefs +heavy with their beastly food. There are certain sentiments +which we call emphatically human—denying the honour of that +name to those who lack them. In such +feasts—particularly where the victim has been slain at +home, and men banqueted on the poor clay of a comrade with whom +they had played in infancy, or a woman whose favours they had +shared—the whole body of these sentiments is +outraged. To consider it too closely is to understand, if +not to excuse, the fervours of self-righteous old ship-captains, +who would man their guns, and open fire in passing, on a cannibal +island.</p> +<p>And yet it was strange. There, upon the spot, as I stood +under the high, dripping vault of the forest, with the young +priest on the one hand, in his kilted gown, and the bright-eyed +Marquesan schoolboy on the other, the whole business appeared +infinitely distant, and fallen in the cold perspective and dry +light of history. The bearing of the priest, perhaps, +affected me. He smiled; he jested with the boy, the heir both of +these feasters and their meat; he clapped his hands, and gave me +a stave of one of the old, ill-omened choruses. Centuries +might have come and gone since this slimy theatre was last in +operation; and I beheld the place with no more emotion than I +might have felt in visiting Stonehenge. In Hiva-oa, as I +began to appreciate that the thing was still living and latent +about my footsteps, and that it was still within the bounds of +possibility that I might hear the cry of the trapped victim, my +historic attitude entirely failed, and I was sensible of some +repugnance for the natives. But here, too, the priests +maintained their jocular attitude: rallying the cannibals as upon +an eccentricity rather absurd than horrible; seeking, I should +say, to shame them from the practice by good-natured ridicule, as +we shame a child from stealing sugar. We may here recognise +the temperate and sagacious mind of Bishop Dordillon.</p> +<h3>CHAPTER XII—THE STORY OF A PLANTATION</h3> +<p>Taahauku, on the south-westerly coast of the island of +Hiva-oa—Tahuku, say the slovenly whites—may be called +the port of Atuona. It is a narrow and small anchorage, set +between low cliffy points, and opening above upon a woody valley: +a little French fort, now disused and deserted, overhangs the +valley and the inlet. Atuona itself, at the head of the +next bay, is framed in a theatre of mountains, which dominate the +more immediate settling of Taahauku and give the salient +character of the scene. They are reckoned at no higher than +four thousand feet; but Tahiti with eight thousand, and Hawaii +with fifteen, can offer no such picture of abrupt, melancholy +alps. In the morning, when the sun falls directly on their +front, they stand like a vast wall: green to the summit, if by +any chance the summit should be clear—water-courses here +and there delineated on their face, as narrow as cracks. +Towards afternoon, the light falls more obliquely, and the +sculpture of the range comes in relief, huge gorges sinking into +shadow, huge, tortuous buttresses standing edged with sun. +At all hours of the day they strike the eye with some new beauty, +and the mind with the same menacing gloom.</p> +<p>The mountains, dividing and deflecting the endless airy deluge +of the Trade, are doubtless answerable for the climate. A +strong draught of wind blew day and night over the +anchorage. Day and night the same fantastic and attenuated +clouds fled across the heavens, the same dusky cap of rain and +vapour fell and rose on the mountain. The land-breezes came +very strong and chill, and the sea, like the air, was in +perpetual bustle. The swell crowded into the narrow +anchorage like sheep into a fold; broke all along both sides, +high on the one, low on the other; kept a certain blowhole +sounding and smoking like a cannon; and spent itself at last upon +the beach.</p> +<p>On the side away from Atuona, the sheltering promontory was a +nursery of coco-trees. Some were mere infants, none had +attained to any size, none had yet begun to shoot skyward with +that whip-like shaft of the mature palm. In the young trees +the colour alters with the age and growth. Now all is of a +grass-like hue, infinitely dainty; next the rib grows golden, the +fronds remaining green as ferns; and then, as the trunk continues +to mount and to assume its final hue of grey, the fans put on +manlier and more decided depths of verdure, stand out dark upon +the distance, glisten against the sun, and flash like silver +fountains in the assault of the wind. In this young wood of +Taahauku, all these hues and combinations were exampled and +repeated by the score. The trees grew pleasantly spaced +upon a hilly sward, here and there interspersed with a rack for +drying copra, or a tumble-down hut for storing it. Every +here and there the stroller had a glimpse of the <i>Casco</i> +tossing in the narrow anchorage below; and beyond he had ever +before him the dark amphitheatre of the Atuona mountains and the +cliffy bluff that closes it to seaward. The trade-wind +moving in the fans made a ceaseless noise of summer rain; and +from time to time, with the sound of a sudden and distant +drum-beat, the surf would burst in a sea-cave.</p> +<p>At the upper end of the inlet, its low, cliffy lining sinks, +at both sides, into a beach. A copra warehouse stands in +the shadow of the shoreside trees, flitted about for ever by a +clan of dwarfish swallows; and a line of rails on a high wooden +staging bends back into the mouth of the valley. Walking on +this, the new-landed traveller becomes aware of a broad +fresh-water lagoon (one arm of which he crosses), and beyond, of +a grove of noble palms, sheltering the house of the trader, Mr. +Keane. Overhead, the cocos join in a continuous and lofty +roof; blackbirds are heard lustily singing; the island cock +springs his jubilant rattle and airs his golden plumage; +cow-bells sound far and near in the grove; and when you sit in +the broad verandah, lulled by this symphony, you may say to +yourself, if you are able: ‘Better fifty years of Europe . +. .’ Farther on, the floor of the valley is flat and +green, and dotted here and there with stripling coco-palms. +Through the midst, with many changes of music, the river trots +and brawls; and along its course, where we should look for +willows, puraos grow in clusters, and make shadowy pools after an +angler’s heart. A vale more rich and peaceful, +sweeter air, a sweeter voice of rural sounds, I have found +nowhere. One circumstance alone might strike the +experienced: here is a convenient beach, deep soil, good water, +and yet nowhere any paepaes, nowhere any trace of island +habitation.</p> +<p>It is but a few years since this valley was a place choked +with jungle, the debatable land and battle-ground of +cannibals. Two clans laid claim to it—neither could +substantiate the claim, and the roads lay desert, or were only +visited by men in arms. It is for this very reason that it +wears now so smiling an appearance: cleared, planted, built upon, +supplied with railways, boat-houses, and bath-houses. For, +being no man’s land, it was the more readily ceded to a +stranger. The stranger was Captain John Hart: Ima Hati, +‘Broken-arm,’ the natives call him, because when he +first visited the islands his arm was in a sling. Captain +Hart, a man of English birth, but an American subject, had +conceived the idea of cotton culture in the Marquesas during the +American War, and was at first rewarded with success. His +plantation at Anaho was highly productive; island cotton fetched +a high price, and the natives used to debate which was the +stronger power, Ima Hati or the French: deciding in favour of the +captain, because, though the French had the most ships, he had +the more money.</p> +<p>He marked Taahauku for a suitable site, acquired it, and +offered the superintendence to Mr. Robert Stewart, a Fifeshire +man, already some time in the islands, who had just been ruined +by a war on Tauata. Mr. Stewart was somewhat averse to the +adventure, having some acquaintance with Atuona and its notorious +chieftain, Moipu. He had once landed there, he told me, +about dusk, and found the remains of a man and woman partly +eaten. On his starting and sickening at the sight, one of +Moipu’s young men picked up a human foot, and provocatively +staring at the stranger, grinned and nibbled at the heel. +None need be surprised if Mr. Stewart fled incontinently to the +bush, lay there all night in a great horror of mind, and got off +to sea again by daylight on the morrow. ‘It was +always a bad place, Atuona,’ commented Mr. Stewart, in his +homely Fifeshire voice. In spite of this dire introduction, +he accepted the captain’s offer, was landed at Taahauku +with three Chinamen, and proceeded to clear the jungle.</p> +<p>War was pursued at that time, almost without interval, between +the men of Atuona and the men of Haamau; and one day, from the +opposite sides of the valley, battle—or I should rather say +the noise of battle—raged all the afternoon: the shots and +insults of the opposing clans passing from hill to hill over the +heads of Mr. Stewart and his Chinamen. There was no genuine +fighting; it was like a bicker of schoolboys, only some fool had +given the children guns. One man died of his exertions in +running, the only casualty. With night the shots and +insults ceased; the men of Haamau withdrew; and victory, on some +occult principle, was scored to Moipu. Perhaps, in +consequence, there came a day when Moipu made a feast, and a +party from Haamau came under safe-conduct to eat of it. +These passed early by Taahauku, and some of Moipu’s young +men were there to be a guard of honour. They were not long +gone before there came down from Haamau, a man, his wife, and a +girl of twelve, their daughter, bringing fungus. Several +Atuona lads were hanging round the store; but the day being one +of truce none apprehended danger. The fungus was weighed +and paid for; the man of Haamau proposed he should have his axe +ground in the bargain; and Mr. Stewart demurring at the trouble, +some of the Atuona lads offered to grind it for him, and set it +on the wheel. While the axe was grinding, a friendly native +whispered Mr. Stewart to have a care of himself, for there was +trouble in hand; and, all at once, the man of Haamau was seized, +and his head and arm stricken from his body, the head at one +sweep of his own newly sharpened axe. In the first alert, +the girl escaped among the cotton; and Mr. Stewart, having thrust +the wife into the house and locked her in from the outside, +supposed the affair was over. But the business had not +passed without noise, and it reached the ears of an older girl +who had loitered by the way, and who now came hastily down the +valley, crying as she came for her father. Her, too, they +seized and beheaded; I know not what they had done with the axe, +it was a blunt knife that served their butcherly turn upon the +girl; and the blood spurted in fountains and painted them from +head to foot. Thus horrible from crime, the party returned +to Atuona, carrying the heads to Moipu. It may be fancied +how the feast broke up; but it is notable that the guests were +honourably suffered to retire. These passed back through +Taahauku in extreme disorder; a little after the valley began to +be overrun with shouting and triumphing braves; and a letter of +warning coming at the same time to Mr. Stewart, he and his +Chinamen took refuge with the Protestant missionary in +Atuona. That night the store was gutted, and the bodies +cast in a pit and covered with leaves. Three days later the +schooner had come in; and things appearing quieter, Mr. Stewart +and the captain landed in Taahauku to compute the damage and to +view the grave, which was already indicated by the stench. +While they were so employed, a party of Moipu’s young men, +decked with red flannel to indicate martial sentiments, came over +the hills from Atuona, dug up the bodies, washed them in the +river, and carried them away on sticks. That night the +feast began.</p> +<p>Those who knew Mr. Stewart before this experience declare the +man to be quite altered. He stuck, however, to his post; +and somewhat later, when the plantation was already well +established, and gave employment to sixty Chinamen and seventy +natives, he found himself once more in dangerous times. The +men of Haamau, it was reported, had sworn to plunder and erase +the settlement; letters came continually from the Hawaiian +missionary, who acted as intelligence department; and for six +weeks Mr. Stewart and three other whites slept in the +cotton-house at night in a rampart of bales, and (what was their +best defence) ostentatiously practised rifle-shooting by day upon +the beach. Natives were often there to watch them; the +practice was excellent; and the assault was never +delivered—if it ever was intended, which I doubt, for the +natives are more famous for false rumours than for deeds of +energy. I was told the late French war was a case in point; +the tribes on the beach accusing those in the mountains of +designs which they had never the hardihood to entertain. +And the same testimony to their backwardness in open battle +reached me from all sides. Captain Hart once landed after +an engagement in a certain bay; one man had his hand hurt, an old +woman and two children had been slain; and the captain improved +the occasion by poulticing the hand, and taunting both sides upon +so wretched an affair. It is true these wars were often +merely formal—comparable with duels to the first +blood. Captain Hart visited a bay where such a war was +being carried on between two brothers, one of whom had been +thought wanting in civility to the guests of the other. +About one-half of the population served day about on alternate +sides, so as to be well with each when the inevitable peace +should follow. The forts of the belligerents were over +against each other, and close by. Pigs were cooking. +Well-oiled braves, with well-oiled muskets, strutted on the +paepae or sat down to feast. No business, however needful, +could be done, and all thoughts were supposed to be centred in +this mockery of war. A few days later, by a regrettable +accident, a man was killed; it was felt at once the thing had +gone too far, and the quarrel was instantly patched up. But +the more serious wars were prosecuted in a similar spirit; a gift +of pigs and a feast made their inevitable end; the killing of a +single man was a great victory, and the murder of defenceless +solitaries counted a heroic deed.</p> +<p>The foot of the cliffs, about all these islands, is the place +of fishing. Between Taahauku and Atuona we saw men, but +chiefly women, some nearly naked, some in thin white or crimson +dresses, perched in little surf-beat promontories—the brown +precipice overhanging them, and the convolvulus overhanging that, +as if to cut them off the more completely from assistance. +There they would angle much of the morning; and as fast as they +caught any fish, eat them, raw and living, where they +stood. It was such helpless ones that the warriors from the +opposite island of Tauata slew, and carried home and ate, and +were thereupon accounted mighty men of valour. Of one such +exploit I can give the account of an eye-witness. +‘Portuguese Joe,’ Mr. Keane’s cook, was once +pulling an oar in an Atuona boat, when they spied a stranger in a +canoe with some fish and a piece of tapu. The Atuona men +cried upon him to draw near and have a smoke. He complied, +because, I suppose, he had no choice; but he knew, poor devil, +what he was coming to, and (as Joe said) ‘he didn’t +seem to care about the smoke.’ A few questions +followed, as to where he came from, and what was his +business. These he must needs answer, as he must needs draw +at the unwelcome pipe, his heart the while drying in his +bosom. And then, of a sudden, a big fellow in Joe’s +boat leaned over, plucked the stranger from his canoe, struck him +with a knife in the neck—inward and downward, as Joe showed +in pantomime more expressive than his words—and held him +under water, like a fowl, until his struggles ceased. +Whereupon the long-pig was hauled on board, the boat’s head +turned about for Atuona, and these Marquesan braves pulled home +rejoicing. Moipu was on the beach and rejoiced with them on +their arrival. Poor Joe toiled at his oar that day with a +white face, yet he had no fear for himself. ‘They +were very good to me—gave me plenty grub: never wished to +eat white man,’ said he.</p> +<p>If the most horrible experience was Mr. Stewart’s, it +was Captain Hart himself who ran the nearest danger. He had +bought a piece of land from Timau, chief of a neighbouring bay, +and put some Chinese there to work. Visiting the station +with one of the Godeffroys, he found his Chinamen trooping to the +beach in terror: Timau had driven them out, seized their effects, +and was in war attire with his young men. A boat was +despatched to Taahauku for reinforcement; as they awaited her +return, they could see, from the deck of the schooner, Timau and +his young men dancing the war-dance on the hill-top till past +twelve at night; and so soon as the boat came (bringing three +gendarmes, armed with chassepots, two white men from Taahauku +station, and some native warriors) the party set out to seize the +chief before he should awake. Day was not come, and it was +a very bright moonlight morning, when they reached the hill-top +where (in a house of palm-leaves) Timau was sleeping off his +debauch. The assailants were fully exposed, the interior of +the hut quite dark; the position far from sound. The +gendarmes knelt with their pieces ready, and Captain Hart +advanced alone. As he drew near the door he heard the snap +of a gun cocking from within, and in sheer +self-defence—there being no other escape—sprang into +the house and grappled Timau. ‘Timau, come with +me!’ he cried. But Timau—a great fellow, his +eyes blood-red with the abuse of kava, six foot three in +stature—cast him on one side; and the captain, instantly +expecting to be either shot or brained, discharged his pistol in +the dark. When they carried Timau out at the door into the +moonlight, he was already dead, and, upon this unlooked-for +termination of their sally, the whites appeared to have lost all +conduct, and retreated to the boats, fired upon by the natives as +they went. Captain Hart, who almost rivals Bishop Dordillon +in popularity, shared with him the policy of extreme indulgence +to the natives, regarding them as children, making light of their +defects, and constantly in favour of mild measures. The +death of Timau has thus somewhat weighed upon his mind; the more +so, as the chieftain’s musket was found in the house +unloaded. To a less delicate conscience the matter will +seem light. If a drunken savage elects to cock a fire-arm, +a gentleman advancing towards him in the open cannot wait to make +sure if it be charged.</p> +<p>I have touched on the captain’s popularity. It is +one of the things that most strikes a stranger in the +Marquesas. He comes instantly on two names, both new to +him, both locally famous, both mentioned by all with affection +and respect—the bishop’s and the +captain’s. It gave me a strong desire to meet with +the survivor, which was subsequently gratified—to the +enrichment of these pages. Long after that again, in the +Place Dolorous—Molokai—I came once more on the traces +of that affectionate popularity. There was a blind white +leper there, an old sailor—‘an old tough,’ he +called himself—who had long sailed among the eastern +islands. Him I used to visit, and, being fresh from the +scenes of his activity, gave him the news. This (in the +true island style) was largely a chronicle of wrecks; and it +chanced I mentioned the case of one not very successful captain, +and how he had lost a vessel for Mr. Hart; thereupon the blind +leper broke forth in lamentation. ‘Did he lose a ship +of John Hart’s?’ he cried; ‘poor John +Hart! Well, I’m sorry it was Hart’s,’ +with needless force of epithet, which I neglect to reproduce.</p> +<p>Perhaps, if Captain Hart’s affairs had continued to +prosper, his popularity might have been different. Success +wins glory, but it kills affection, which misfortune +fosters. And the misfortune which overtook the +captain’s enterprise was truly singular. He was at +the top of his career. Ile Masse belonged to him, given by +the French as an indemnity for the robberies at Taahauku. +But the Ile Masse was only suitable for cattle; and his two chief +stations were Anaho, in Nuka-hiva, facing the north-east, and +Taahauku in Hiva-oa, some hundred miles to the southward, and +facing the south-west. Both these were on the same day +swept by a tidal wave, which was not felt in any other bay or +island of the group. The south coast of Hiva-oa was +bestrewn with building timber and camphor-wood chests, containing +goods; which, on the promise of a reasonable salvage, the natives +very honestly brought back, the chests apparently not opened, and +some of the wood after it had been built into their houses. +But the recovery of such jetsam could not affect the +result. It was impossible the captain should withstand this +partiality of fortune; and with his fall the prosperity of the +Marquesas ended. Anaho is truly extinct, Taahauku but a +shadow of itself; nor has any new plantation arisen in their +stead.</p> +<h3>CHAPTER XIII—CHARACTERS</h3> +<p>There was a certain traffic in our anchorage at Atuona; +different indeed from the dead inertia and quiescence of the +sister island, Nuka-hiva. Sails were seen steering from its +mouth; now it would be a whale-boat manned with native rowdies, +and heavy with copra for sale; now perhaps a single canoe come +after commodities to buy. The anchorage was besides +frequented by fishers; not only the lone females perched in +niches of the cliff, but whole parties, who would sometimes camp +and build a fire upon the beach, and sometimes lie in their +canoes in the midst of the haven and jump by turns in the water; +which they would cast eight or nine feet high, to drive, as we +supposed, the fish into their nets. The goods the +purchasers came to buy were sometimes quaint. I remarked +one outrigger returning with a single ham swung from a pole in +the stern. And one day there came into Mr. Keane’s +store a charming lad, excellently mannered, speaking French +correctly though with a babyish accent; very handsome too, and +much of a dandy, as was shown not only in his shining raiment, +but by the nature of his purchases. These were five +ship-biscuits, a bottle of scent, and two balls of washing +blue. He was from Tauata, whither he returned the same +night in an outrigger, daring the deep with these young-ladyish +treasures. The gross of the native passengers were more +ill-favoured: tall, powerful fellows, well tattooed, and with +disquieting manners. Something coarse and jeering +distinguished them, and I was often reminded of the slums of some +great city. One night, as dusk was falling, a whale-boat +put in on that part of the beach where I chanced to be +alone. Six or seven ruffianly fellows scrambled out; all +had enough English to give me ‘good-bye,’ which was +the ordinary salutation; or ‘good-morning,’ which +they seemed to regard as an intensitive; jests followed, they +surrounded me with harsh laughter and rude looks, and I was glad +to move away. I had not yet encountered Mr. Stewart, or I +should have been reminded of his first landing at Atuona and the +humorist who nibbled at the heel. But their neighbourhood +depressed me; and I felt, if I had been there a castaway and out +of reach of help, my heart would have been sick.</p> +<p>Nor was the traffic altogether native. While we lay in +the anchorage there befell a strange coincidence. A +schooner was observed at sea and aiming to enter. We knew +all the schooners in the group, but this appeared larger than +any; she was rigged, besides, after the English manner; and, +coming to an anchor some way outside the <i>Casco</i>, showed at +last the blue ensign. There were at that time, according to +rumour, no fewer than four yachts in the Pacific; but it was +strange that any two of them should thus lie side by side in that +outlandish inlet: stranger still that in the owner of the +<i>Nyanza</i>, Captain Dewar, I should find a man of the same +country and the same county with myself, and one whom I had seen +walking as a boy on the shores of the Alpes Maritimes.</p> +<p>We had besides a white visitor from shore, who came and +departed in a crowded whale-boat manned by natives; having read +of yachts in the Sunday papers, and being fired with the desire +to see one. Captain Chase, they called him, an old +whaler-man, thickset and white-bearded, with a strong Indiana +drawl; years old in the country, a good backer in battle, and one +of those dead shots whose practice at the target struck terror in +the braves of Haamau. Captain Chase dwelt farther east in a +bay called Hanamate, with a Mr. M’Callum; or rather they +had dwelt together once, and were now amicably separated. +The captain is to be found near one end of the bay, in a wreck of +a house, and waited on by a Chinese. At the point of the +opposing corner another habitation stands on a tall paepae. +The surf runs there exceeding heavy, seas of seven and eight feet +high bursting under the walls of the house, which is thus +continually filled with their clamour, and rendered fit only for +solitary, or at least for silent, inmates. Here it is that +Mr. M’Callum, with a Shakespeare and a Burns, enjoys the +society of the breakers. His name and his Burns testify to +Scottish blood; but he is an American born, somewhere far east; +followed the trade of a ship-carpenter; and was long employed, +the captain of a hundred Indians, breaking up wrecks about Cape +Flattery. Many of the whites who are to be found scattered +in the South Seas represent the more artistic portion of their +class; and not only enjoy the poetry of that new life, but came +there on purpose to enjoy it. I have been shipmates with a +man, no longer young, who sailed upon that voyage, his first time +to sea, for the mere love of Samoa; and it was a few letters in a +newspaper that sent him on that pilgrimage. Mr. +M’Callum was another instance of the same. He had +read of the South Seas; loved to read of them; and let their +image fasten in his heart: till at length he could refrain no +longer—must set forth, a new Rudel, for that unseen +homeland—and has now dwelt for years in Hiva-oa, and will +lay his bones there in the end with full content; having no +desire to behold again the places of his boyhood, only, +perhaps—once, before he dies—the rude and wintry +landscape of Cape Flattery. Yet he is an active man, full +of schemes; has bought land of the natives; has planted five +thousand coco-palms; has a desert island in his eye, which he +desires to lease, and a schooner in the stocks, which he has laid +and built himself, and even hopes to finish. Mr. +M’Callum and I did not meet, but, like gallant troubadours, +corresponded in verse. I hope he will not consider it a +breach of copyright if I give here a specimen of his muse. +He and Bishop Dordillon are the two European bards of the +Marquesas.</p> +<blockquote><p>‘Sail, ho! Ahoy! +<i>Casco</i>,<br /> + First among the pleasure fleet<br /> + That came around to greet<br /> +These isles from San Francisco,</p> +<p>And first, too; only one<br /> + Among the literary men<br /> + That this way has ever been—<br /> +Welcome, then, to Stevenson.</p> +<p>Please not offended be<br /> + At this little notice<br /> + Of the <i>Casco</i>, Captain Otis,<br /> +With the novelist’s family.</p> +<p><i>Avoir une voyage magnifical</i><br /> + Is our wish sincere,<br /> + That you’ll have from here<br /> +<i>Allant sur la Grande Pacifical</i>.’</p> +</blockquote> +<p>But our chief visitor was one Mapiao, a great +Tahuku—which seems to mean priest, wizard, tattooer, +practiser of any art, or, in a word, esoteric person—and a +man famed for his eloquence on public occasions and witty talk in +private. His first appearance was typical of the man. +He came down clamorous to the eastern landing, where the surf was +running very high; scorned all our signals to go round the bay; +carried his point, was brought aboard at some hazard to our +skiff, and set down in one corner of the cockpit to his appointed +task. He had been hired, as one cunning in the art, to make +my old men’s beards into a wreath: what a wreath for +Celia’s arbour! His own beard (which he carried, for +greater safety, in a sailor’s knot) was not merely the +adornment of his age, but a substantial piece of property. +One hundred dollars was the estimated value; and as Brother +Michel never knew a native to deposit a greater sum with Bishop +Dordillon, our friend was a rich man in virtue of his chin. +He had something of an East Indian cast, but taller and stronger: +his nose hooked, his face narrow, his forehead very high, the +whole elaborately tattooed. I may say I have never +entertained a guest so trying. In the least particular he +must be waited on; he would not go to the scuttle-butt for water; +he would not even reach to get the glass, it must be given him in +his hand; if aid were denied him, he would fold his arms, bow his +head, and go without: only the work would suffer. Early the +first forenoon he called aloud for biscuit and salmon; biscuit +and ham were brought; he looked on them inscrutably, and signed +they should be set aside. A number of considerations +crowded on my mind; how the sort of work on which he was engaged +was probably tapu in a high degree; should by rights, perhaps, be +transacted on a tapu platform which no female might approach; and +it was possible that fish might be the essential diet. Some +salted fish I therefore brought him, and along with that a glass +of rum: at sight of which Mapiao displayed extraordinary +animation, pointed to the zenith, made a long speech in which I +picked up <i>umati</i>—the word for the sun—and +signed to me once more to place these dainties out of +reach. At last I had understood, and every day the +programme was the same. At an early period of the morning +his dinner must be set forth on the roof of the house and at a +proper distance, full in view but just out of reach; and not +until the fit hour, which was the point of noon, would the +artificer partake. This solemnity was the cause of an +absurd misadventure. He was seated plaiting, as usual, at +the beards, his dinner arrayed on the roof, and not far off a +glass of water standing. It appears he desired to drink; +was of course far too great a gentleman to rise and get the water +for himself; and spying Mrs. Stevenson, imperiously signed to her +to hand it. The signal was misunderstood; Mrs. Stevenson +was, by this time, prepared for any eccentricity on the part of +our guest; and instead of passing him the water, flung his dinner +overboard. I must do Mapiao justice: all laughed, but his +laughter rang the loudest.</p> +<p>These troubles of service were at worst occasional; the +embarrassment of the man’s talk incessant. He was +plainly a practised conversationalist; the nicety of his +inflections, the elegance of his gestures, and the fine play of +his expression, told us that. We, meanwhile, sat like +aliens in a playhouse; we could see the actors were upon some +material business and performing well, but the plot of the drama +remained undiscoverable. Names of places, the name of +Captain Hart, occasional disconnected words, tantalised without +enlightening us; and the less we understood, the more gallantly, +the more copiously, and with still the more explanatory gestures, +Mapiao returned to the assault. We could see his vanity was +on the rack; being come to a place where that fine jewel of his +conversational talent could earn him no respect; and he had times +of despair when he desisted from the endeavour, and instants of +irritation when he regarded us with unconcealed contempt. +Yet for me, as the practitioner of some kindred mystery to his +own, he manifested to the last a measure of respect. As we +sat under the awning in opposite corners of the cockpit, he +braiding hairs from dead men’s chins, I forming runes upon +a sheet of folio paper, he would nod across to me as one Tahuku +to another, or, crossing the cockpit, study for a while my +shapeless scrawl and encourage me with a heartfelt +‘<i>mitai</i>!—good!’ So might a deaf +painter sympathise far off with a musician, as the slave and +master of some uncomprehended and yet kindred art. A silly +trade, he doubtless considered it; but a man must make allowance +for barbarians—<i>chaque pays a ses coutumes</i>—and +he felt the principle was there.</p> +<p>The time came at last when his labours, which resembled those +rather of Penelope than Hercules, could be no more spun out, and +nothing remained but to pay him and say farewell. After a +long, learned argument in Marquesan, I gathered that his mind was +set on fish-hooks; with three of which, and a brace of dollars, I +thought he was not ill rewarded for passing his forenoons in our +cockpit, eating, drinking, delivering his opinions, and pressing +the ship’s company into his menial service. For all +that, he was a man of so high a bearing, and so like an uncle of +my own who should have gone mad and got tattooed, that I applied +to him, when we were both on shore, to know if he were +satisfied. ‘<i>Mitai ehipe</i>?’ I asked. +And he, with rich unction, offering at the same time his +hand—‘<i>Mitai ehipe</i>, <i>mitai kaehae</i>; +<i>kaoha nui</i>!’—or, to translate freely: +‘The ship is good, the victuals are up to the mark, and we +part in friendship.’ Which testimonial uttered, he +set off along the beach with his head bowed and the air of one +deeply injured.</p> +<p>I saw him go, on my side, with relief. It would be more +interesting to learn how our relation seemed to Mapiao. His +exigence, we may suppose, was merely loyal. He had been +hired by the ignorant to do a piece of work; and he was bound +that he would do it the right way. Countless obstacles, +continual ignorant ridicule, availed not to dissuade him. +He had his dinner laid out; watched it, as was fit, the while he +worked; ate it at the fit hour; was in all things served and +waited on; and could take his hire in the end with a clear +conscience, telling himself the mystery was performed duly, the +beards rightfully braided, and we (in spite of ourselves) +correctly served. His view of our stupidity, even he, the +mighty talker, must have lacked language to express. He +never interfered with my Tahuku work; civilly praised it, idle as +it seemed; civilly supposed that I was competent in my own +mystery: such being the attitude of the intelligent and the +polite. And we, on the other hand—who had yet the +most to gain or lose, since the product was to be ours—who +had professed our disability by the very act of hiring him to do +it—were never weary of impeding his own more important +labours, and sometimes lacked the sense and the civility to +refrain from laughter.</p> +<h3>CHAPTER XIV—IN A CANNIBAL VALLEY</h3> +<p>The road from Taahauku to Atuona skirted the north-westerly +side of the anchorage, somewhat high up, edged, and sometimes +shaded, by the splendid flowers of the +<i>flamboyant</i>—its English name I do not know. At +the turn of the hand, Atuona came in view: a long beach, a heavy +and loud breach of surf, a shore-side village scattered among +trees, and the guttered mountains drawing near on both sides +above a narrow and rich ravine. Its infamous repute perhaps +affected me; but I thought it the loveliest, and by far the most +ominous and gloomy, spot on earth. Beautiful it surely was; +and even more salubrious. The healthfulness of the whole +group is amazing; that of Atuona almost in the nature of a +miracle. In Atuona, a village planted in a shore-side +marsh, the houses standing everywhere intermingled with the pools +of a taro-garden, we find every condition of tropical danger and +discomfort; and yet there are not even mosquitoes—not even +the hateful day-fly of Nuka-hiva—and fever, and its +concomitant, the island fe’efe’e, <a +name="citation122"></a><a href="#footnote122" +class="citation">[122]</a> are unknown.</p> +<p>This is the chief station of the French on the man-eating isle +of Hiva-oa. The sergeant of gendarmerie enjoys the style of +the vice-resident, and hoists the French colours over a quite +extensive compound. A Chinaman, a waif from the plantation, +keeps a restaurant in the rear quarters of the village; and the +mission is well represented by the sister’s school and +Brother Michel’s church. Father Orens, a wonderful +octogenarian, his frame scarce bowed, the fire of his eye +undimmed, has lived, and trembled, and suffered in this place +since 1843. Again and again, when Moipu had made +coco-brandy, he has been driven from his house into the +woods. ‘A mouse that dwelt in a cat’s +ear’ had a more easy resting-place; and yet I have never +seen a man that bore less mark of years. He must show us +the church, still decorated with the bishop’s artless +ornaments of paper—the last work of industrious old hands, +and the last earthly amusement of a man that was much of a +hero. In the sacristy we must see his sacred vessels, and, +in particular, a vestment which was a ‘<i>vraie +curiosité</i>,’ because it had been given by a +gendarme. To the Protestant there is always something +embarrassing in the eagerness with which grown and holy men +regard these trifles; but it was touching and pretty to see +Orens, his aged eyes shining in his head, display his sacred +treasures.</p> +<p><i>August</i> 26.—The vale behind the village, narrowing +swiftly to a mere ravine, was choked with profitable trees. +A river gushed in the midst. Overhead, the tall coco-palms +made a primary covering; above that, from one wall of the +mountain to another, the ravine was roofed with cloud; so that we +moved below, amid teeming vegetation, in a covered house of +heat. On either hand, at every hundred yards, instead of +the houseless, disembowelling paepaes of Nuka-hiva, populous +houses turned out their inhabitants to cry ‘Kaoha!’ +to the passers-by. The road, too, was busy: strings of +girls, fair and foul, as in less favoured countries; men bearing +breadfruit; the sisters, with a little guard of pupils; a fellow +bestriding a horse—passed and greeted us continually; and +now it was a Chinaman who came to the gate of his flower-yard, +and gave us ‘Good-day’ in excellent English; and a +little farther on it would be some natives who set us down by the +wayside, made us a feast of mummy-apple, and entertained us as we +ate with drumming on a tin case. With all this fine plenty +of men and fruit, death is at work here also. The +population, according to the highest estimate, does not exceed +six hundred in the whole vale of Atuona; and yet, when I once +chanced to put the question, Brother Michel counted up ten whom +he knew to be sick beyond recovery. It was here, too, that +I could at last gratify my curiosity with the sight of a native +house in the very article of dissolution. It had fallen +flat along the paepae, its poles sprawling ungainly; the rains +and the mites contended against it; what remained seemed sound +enough, but much was gone already; and it was easy to see how the +insects consumed the walls as if they had been bread, and the air +and the rain ate into them like vitriol.</p> +<p>A little ahead of us, a young gentleman, very well tattooed, +and dressed in a pair of white trousers and a flannel shirt, had +been marching unconcernedly. Of a sudden, without apparent +cause, he turned back, took us in possession, and led us +undissuadably along a by-path to the river’s edge. +There, in a nook of the most attractive amenity, he bade us to +sit down: the stream splashing at our elbow, a shock of +nondescript greenery enshrining us from above; and thither, after +a brief absence, he brought us a cocoa-nut, a lump of +sandal-wood, and a stick he had begun to carve: the nut for +present refreshment, the sandal-wood for a precious gift, and the +stick—in the simplicity of his vanity—to harvest +premature praise. Only one section was yet carved, although +the whole was pencil-marked in lengths; and when I proposed to +buy it, Poni (for that was the artist’s name) recoiled in +horror. But I was not to be moved, and simply refused +restitution, for I had long wondered why a people who displayed, +in their tattooing, so great a gift of arabesque invention, +should display it nowhere else. Here, at last, I had found +something of the same talent in another medium; and I held the +incompleteness, in these days of world-wide brummagem, for a +happy mark of authenticity. Neither my reasons nor my +purpose had I the means of making clear to Poni; I could only +hold on to the stick, and bid the artist follow me to the +gendarmerie, where I should find interpreters and money; but we +gave him, in the meanwhile, a boat-call in return for his +sandal-wood. As he came behind us down the vale he sounded +upon this continually. And continually, from the wayside +houses, there poured forth little groups of girls in crimson, or +of men in white. And to these must Poni pass the news of +who the strangers were, of what they had been doing, of why it +was that Poni had a boat-whistle; and of why he was now being +haled to the vice-residency, uncertain whether to be punished or +rewarded, uncertain whether he had lost a stick or made a +bargain, but hopeful on the whole, and in the meanwhile highly +consoled by the boat-whistle. Whereupon he would tear +himself away from this particular group of inquirers, and once +more we would hear the shrill call in our wake.</p> +<p><i>August</i> 27.—I made a more extended circuit in the +vale with Brother Michel. We were mounted on a pair of +sober nags, suitable to these rude paths; the weather was +exquisite, and the company in which I found myself no less +agreeable than the scenes through which I passed. We +mounted at first by a steep grade along the summit of one of +those twisted spurs that, from a distance, mark out provinces of +sun and shade upon the mountain-side. The ground fell away +on either hand with an extreme declivity. From either hand, +out of profound ravines, mounted the song of falling water and +the smoke of household fires. Here and there the hills of +foliage would divide, and our eye would plunge down upon one of +these deep-nested habitations. And still, high in front, +arose the precipitous barrier of the mountain, greened over where +it seemed that scarce a harebell could find root, barred with the +zigzags of a human road where it seemed that not a goat could +scramble. And in truth, for all the labour that it cost, +the road is regarded even by the Marquesans as impassable; they +will not risk a horse on that ascent; and those who lie to the +westward come and go in their canoes. I never knew a hill +to lose so little on a near approach: a consequence, I must +suppose, of its surprising steepness. When we turned about, +I was amazed to behold so deep a view behind, and so high a +shoulder of blue sea, crowned by the whale-like island of +Motane. And yet the wall of mountain had not visibly +dwindled, and I could even have fancied, as I raised my eyes to +measure it, that it loomed higher than before.</p> +<p>We struck now into covert paths, crossed and heard more near +at hand the bickering of the streams, and tasted the coolness of +those recesses where the houses stood. The birds sang about +us as we descended. All along our path my guide was being +hailed by voices: ‘Mikaël—Kaoha, +Mikaël!’ From the doorstep, from the +cotton-patch, or out of the deep grove of island-chestnuts, these +friendly cries arose, and were cheerily answered as we +passed. In a sharp angle of a glen, on a rushing brook and +under fathoms of cool foliage, we struck a house upon a +well-built paepae, the fire brightly burning under the popoi-shed +against the evening meal; and here the cries became a chorus, and +the house folk, running out, obliged us to dismount and +breathe. It seemed a numerous family: we saw eight at +least; and one of these honoured me with a particular +attention. This was the mother, a woman naked to the waist, +of an aged countenance, but with hair still copious and black, +and breasts still erect and youthful. On our arrival I +could see she remarked me, but instead of offering any greeting, +disappeared at once into the bush. Thence she returned with +two crimson flowers. ‘Good-bye!’ was her +salutation, uttered not without coquetry; and as she said it she +pressed the flowers into my hand—‘Good-bye! I +speak Inglis.’ It was from a whaler-man, who (she +informed me) was ‘a plenty good chap,’ that she had +learned my language; and I could not but think how handsome she +must have been in these times of her youth, and could not but +guess that some memories of the dandy whaler-man prompted her +attentions to myself. Nor could I refrain from wondering +what had befallen her lover; in the rain and mire of what +sea-ports he had tramped since then; in what close and garish +drinking-dens had found his pleasure; and in the ward of what +infirmary dreamed his last of the Marquesas. But she, the +more fortunate, lived on in her green island. The talk, in +this lost house upon the mountains, ran chiefly upon Mapiao and +his visits to the <i>Casco</i>: the news of which had probably +gone abroad by then to all the island, so that there was no +paepae in Hiva-oa where they did not make the subject of excited +comment.</p> +<p>Not much beyond we came upon a high place in the foot of the +ravine. Two roads divided it, and met in the midst. +Save for this intersection the amphitheatre was strangely +perfect, and had a certain ruder air of things Roman. +Depths of foliage and the bulk of the mountain kept it in a +grateful shadow. On the benches several young folk sat +clustered or apart. One of these, a girl perhaps fourteen +years of age, buxom and comely, caught the eye of Brother +Michel. Why was she not at school?—she was done with +school now. What was she doing here?—she lived here +now. Why so?—no answer but a deepening blush. +There was no severity in Brother Michel’s manner; the +girl’s own confusion told her story. ‘<i>Elle a +honte</i>,’ was the missionary’s comment, as we rode +away. Near by in the stream, a grown girl was bathing naked +in a goyle between two stepping-stones; and it amused me to see +with what alacrity and real alarm she bounded on her +many-coloured under-clothes. Even in these daughters of +cannibals shame was eloquent.</p> +<p>It is in Hiva-oa, owing to the inveterate cannibalism of the +natives, that local beliefs have been most rudely trodden +underfoot. It was here that three religious chiefs were set +under a bridge, and the women of the valley made to defile over +their heads upon the road-way: the poor, dishonoured fellows +sitting there (all observers agree) with streaming tears. +Not only was one road driven across the high place, but two roads +intersected in its midst. There is no reason to suppose +that the last was done of purpose, and perhaps it was impossible +entirely to avoid the numerous sacred places of the +islands. But these things are not done without +result. I have spoken already of the regard of Marquesans +for the dead, making (as it does) so strange a contrast with +their unconcern for death. Early on this day’s ride, +for instance, we encountered a petty chief, who inquired (of +course) where we were going, and suggested by way of +amendment. ‘Why do you not rather show him the +cemetery?’ I saw it; it was but newly opened, the +third within eight years. They are great builders here in +Hiva-oa; I saw in my ride paepaes that no European dry-stone +mason could have equalled, the black volcanic stones were laid so +justly, the corners were so precise, the levels so true; but the +retaining-wall of the new graveyard stood apart, and seemed to be +a work of love. The sentiment of honour for the dead is +therefore not extinct. And yet observe the consequence of +violently countering men’s opinions. Of the four +prisoners in Atuona gaol, three were of course thieves; the +fourth was there for sacrilege. He had levelled up a piece +of the graveyard—to give a feast upon, as he informed the +court—and declared he had no thought of doing wrong. +Why should he? He had been forced at the point of the +bayonet to destroy the sacred places of his own piety; when he +had recoiled from the task, he had been jeered at for a +superstitious fool. And now it is supposed he will respect +our European superstitions as by second nature.</p> +<h3>CHAPTER XV—THE TWO CHIEFS OF ATUONA</h3> +<p>It had chanced (as the <i>Casco</i> beat through the Bordelais +Straits for Taahauku) she approached on one board very near the +land in the opposite isle of Tauata, where houses were to be seen +in a grove of tall coco-palms. Brother Michel pointed out +the spot. ‘I am at home now,’ said he. +‘I believe I have a large share in these cocoa-nuts; and in +that house madame my mother lives with her two +husbands!’ ‘With two husbands?’ somebody +inquired. ‘<i>C’est ma honte</i>,’ +replied the brother drily.</p> +<p>A word in passing on the two husbands. I conceive the +brother to have expressed himself loosely. It seems common +enough to find a native lady with two consorts; but these are not +two husbands. The first is still the husband; the wife +continues to be referred to by his name; and the position of the +coadjutor, or <i>pikio</i>, although quite regular, appears +undoubtedly subordinate. We had opportunities to observe +one household of the sort. The <i>pikio</i> was recognised; +appeared openly along with the husband when the lady was thought +to be insulted, and the pair made common cause like +brothers. At home the inequality was more apparent. +The husband sat to receive and entertain visitors; the +<i>pikio</i> was running the while to fetch cocoa-nuts like a +hired servant, and I remarked he was sent on these errands in +preference even to the son. Plainly we have here no second +husband; plainly we have the tolerated lover. Only, in the +Marquesas, instead of carrying his lady’s fan and mantle, +he must turn his hand to do the husband’s housework.</p> +<p>The sight of Brother Michel’s family estate led the +conversation for some while upon the method and consequence of +artificial kinship. Our curiosity became extremely whetted; +the brother offered to have the whole of us adopted, and some two +days later we became accordingly the children of Paaaeua, +appointed chief of Atuona. I was unable to be present at +the ceremony, which was primitively simple. The two Mrs. +Stevensons and Mr. Osbourne, along with Paaaeua, his wife, and an +adopted child of theirs, son of a shipwrecked Austrian, sat down +to an excellent island meal, of which the principal and the only +necessary dish was pig. A concourse watched them through +the apertures of the house; but none, not even Brother Michel, +might partake; for the meal was sacramental, and either creative +or declaratory of the new relationship. In Tahiti things +are not so strictly ordered; when Ori and I ‘made +brothers,’ both our families sat with us at table, yet only +he and I, who had eaten with intention were supposed to be +affected by the ceremony. For the adoption of an infant I +believe no formality to be required; the child is handed over by +the natural parents, and grows up to inherit the estates of the +adoptive. Presents are doubtless exchanged, as at all +junctures of island life, social or international; but I never +heard of any banquet—the child’s presence at the +daily board perhaps sufficing. We may find the rationale in +the ancient Arabian idea that a common diet makes a common blood, +with its derivative axiom that ‘he is the father who gives +the child its morning draught.’ In the Marquesan +practice, the sense would thus be evanescent; from the Tahitian, +a mere survival, it will have entirely fled. An interesting +parallel will probably occur to many of my readers.</p> +<p>What is the nature of the obligation assumed at such a +festival? It will vary with the characters of those +engaged, and with the circumstances of the case. Thus it +would be absurd to take too seriously our adoption at +Atuona. On the part of Paaaeua it was an affair of social +ambition; when he agreed to receive us in his family the man had +not so much as seen us, and knew only that we were inestimably +rich and travelled in a floating palace. We, upon our side, +ate of his baked meats with no true <i>animus affiliandi</i>, but +moved by the single sentiment of curiosity. The affair was +formal, and a matter of parade, as when in Europe sovereigns call +each other cousin. Yet, had we stayed at Atuona, Paaaeua +would have held himself bound to establish us upon his land, and +to set apart young men for our service, and trees for our +support. I have mentioned the Austrian. He sailed in +one of two sister ships, which left the Clyde in coal; both +rounded the Horn, and both, at several hundred miles of distance, +though close on the same point of time, took fire at sea on the +Pacific. One was destroyed; the derelict iron frame of the +second, after long, aimless cruising, was at length recovered, +refitted, and hails to-day from San Francisco. A +boat’s crew from one of these disasters reached, after +great hardships, the isle of Hiva-oa. Some of these men +vowed they would never again confront the chances of the sea; but +alone of them all the Austrian has been exactly true to his +engagement, remains where he landed, and designs to die where he +has lived. Now, with such a man, falling and taking root +among islanders, the processes described may be compared to a +gardener’s graft. He passes bodily into the native +stock; ceases wholly to be alien; has entered the commune of the +blood, shares the prosperity and consideration of his new family, +and is expected to impart with the same generosity the fruits of +his European skill and knowledge. It is this implied +engagement that so frequently offends the ingrafted white. +To snatch an immediate advantage—to get (let us say) a +station for his store—he will play upon the native custom +and become a son or a brother for the day, promising himself to +cast down the ladder by which he shall have ascended, and +repudiate the kinship so soon as it shall grow burdensome. +And he finds there are two parties to the bargain. Perhaps +his Polynesian relative is simple, and conceived the blood-bond +literally; perhaps he is shrewd, and himself entered the covenant +with a view to gain. And either way the store is ravaged, +the house littered with lazy natives; and the richer the man +grows, the more numerous, the more idle, and the more +affectionate he finds his native relatives. Most men thus +circumstanced contrive to buy or brutally manage to enforce their +independence; but many vegetate without hope, strangled by +parasites.</p> +<p>We had no cause to blush with Brother Michel. Our new +parents were kind, gentle, well-mannered, and generous in gifts; +the wife was a most motherly woman, the husband a man who stood +justly high with his employers. Enough has been said to +show why Moipu should be deposed; and in Paaaeua the French had +found a reputable substitute. He went always scrupulously +dressed, and looked the picture of propriety, like a dark, +handsome, stupid, and probably religious young man hot from a +European funeral. In character he seemed the ideal of what +is known as the good citizen. He wore gravity like an +ornament. None could more nicely represent the desired +character as an appointed chief, the outpost of civilisation and +reform. And yet, were the French to go and native manners +to revive, fancy beholds him crowned with old men’s beards +and crowding with the first to a man-eating festival. But I +must not seem to be unjust to Paaaeua. His respectability +went deeper than the skin; his sense of the becoming sometimes +nerved him for unexpected rigours.</p> +<p>One evening Captain Otis and Mr. Osbourne were on shore in the +village. All was agog; dancing had begun; it was plain it +was to be a night of festival, and our adventurers were overjoyed +at their good fortune. A strong fall of rain drove them for +shelter to the house of Paaaeua, where they were made welcome, +wiled into a chamber, and shut in. Presently the rain took +off, the fun was to begin in earnest, and the young bloods of +Atuona came round the house and called to my fellow-travellers +through the interstices of the wall. Late into the night +the calls were continued and resumed, and sometimes mingled with +taunts; late into the night the prisoners, tantalised by the +noises of the festival, renewed their efforts to escape. +But all was vain; right across the door lay that god-fearing +householder, Paaaeua, feigning sleep; and my friends had to +forego their junketing. In this incident, so delightfully +European, we thought we could detect three strands of +sentiment. In the first place, Paaaeua had a charge of +souls: these were young men, and he judged it right to withhold +them from the primrose path. Secondly, he was a public +character, and it was not fitting that his guests should +countenance a festival of which he disapproved. So might +some strict clergyman at home address a worldly visitor: +‘Go to the theatre if you like, but, by your leave, not +from my house!’ Thirdly, Paaaeua was a man jealous, +and with some cause (as shall be shown) for jealousy; and the +feasters were the satellites of his immediate rival, Moipu.</p> +<p>For the adoption had caused much excitement in the village; it +made the strangers popular. Paaaeua, in his difficult +posture of appointed chief, drew strength and dignity from their +alliance, and only Moipu and his followers were malcontent. +For some reason nobody (except myself) appears to dislike +Moipu. Captain Hart, who has been robbed and threatened by +him; Father Orens, whom he has fired at, and repeatedly driven to +the woods; my own family, and even the French officials—all +seemed smitten with an irrepressible affection for the man. +His fall had been made soft; his son, upon his death, was to +succeed Paaaeua in the chieftaincy; and he lived, at the time of +our visit, in the shoreward part of the village in a good house, +and with a strong following of young men, his late braves and +pot-hunters. In this society, the coming of the +<i>Casco</i>, the adoption, the return feast on board, and the +presents exchanged between the whites and their new parents, were +doubtless eagerly and bitterly canvassed. It was felt that +a few years ago the honours would have gone elsewhere. In +this unwonted business, in this reception of some hitherto +undreamed-of and outlandish potentate—some Prester John or +old Assaracus—a few years back it would have been the part +of Moipu to play the hero and the host, and his young men would +have accompanied and adorned the various celebrations as the +acknowledged leaders of society. And now, by a malign +vicissitude of fortune, Moipu must sit in his house quite +unobserved; and his young men could but look in at the door while +their rivals feasted. Perhaps M. Grévy felt a touch +of bitterness towards his successor when he beheld him figure on +the broad stage of the centenary of eighty-nine; the visit of the +<i>Casco</i> which Moipu had missed by so few years was a more +unusual occasion in Atuona than a centenary in France; and the +dethroned chief determined to reassert himself in the public +eye.</p> +<p>Mr. Osbourne had gone into Atuona photographing; the +population of the village had gathered together for the occasion +on the place before the church, and Paaaeua, highly delighted +with this new appearance of his family, played the master of +ceremonies. The church had been taken, with its jolly +architect before the door; the nuns with their pupils; sundry +damsels in the ancient and singularly unbecoming robes of tapa; +and Father Orens in the midst of a group of his +parishioners. I know not what else was in hand, when the +photographer became aware of a sensation in the crowd, and, +looking around, beheld a very noble figure of a man appear upon +the margin of a thicket and stroll nonchalantly near. The +nonchalance was visibly affected; it was plain he came there to +arouse attention, and his success was instant. He was +introduced; he was civil, he was obliging, he was always +ineffably superior and certain of himself; a well-graced +actor. It was presently suggested that he should appear in +his war costume; he gracefully consented; and returned in that +strange, inappropriate and ill-omened array (which very well +became his handsome person) to strut in a circle of admirers, and +be thenceforth the centre of photography. Thus had Moipu +effected his introduction, as by accident, to the white +strangers, made it a favour to display his finery, and reduced +his rival to a secondary <i>rôle</i> on the theatre of the +disputed village. Paaaeua felt the blow; and, with a spirit +which we never dreamed he could possess, asserted his +priority. It was found impossible that day to get a +photograph of Moipu alone; for whenever he stood up before the +camera his successor placed himself unbidden by his side, and +gently but firmly held to his position. The portraits of +the pair, Jacob and Esau, standing shoulder to shoulder, one in +his careful European dress, one in his barbaric trappings, figure +the past and present of their island. A graveyard with its +humble crosses would be the aptest symbol of the future.</p> +<p>We are all impressed with the belief that Moipu had planned +his campaign from the beginning to the end. It is certain +that he lost no time in pushing his advantage. Mr. Osbourne +was inveigled to his house; various gifts were fished out of an +old sea-chest; Father Orens was called into service as +interpreter, and Moipu formally proposed to ‘make +brothers’ with Mata-Galahi—Glass-Eyes,—the not +very euphonious name under which Mr. Osbourne passed in the +Marquesas. The feast of brotherhood took place on board the +<i>Casco</i>. Paaaeua had arrived with his family, like a +plain man; and his presents, which had been numerous, had +followed one another, at intervals through several days. +Moipu, as if to mark at every point the opposition, came with a +certain feudal pomp, attended by retainers bearing gifts of all +descriptions, from plumes of old men’s beard to little, +pious, Catholic engravings.</p> +<p>I had met the man before this in the village, and detested him +on sight; there was something indescribably raffish in his looks +and ways that raised my gorge; and when man-eating was referred +to, and he laughed a low, cruel laugh, part boastful, part +bashful, like one reminded of some dashing peccadillo, my +repugnance was mingled with nausea. This is no very human +attitude, nor one at all becoming in a traveller. And, seen +more privately, the man improved. Something negroid in +character and face was still displeasing; but his ugly mouth +became attractive when he smiled, his figure and bearing were +certainly noble, and his eyes superb. In his appreciation +of jams and pickles, in is delight in the reverberating mirrors +of the dining cabin, and consequent endless repetition of Moipus +and Mata-Galahis, he showed himself engagingly a child. And +yet I am not sure; and what seemed childishness may have been +rather courtly art. His manners struck me as beyond the +mark; they were refined and caressing to the point of grossness, +and when I think of the serene absent-mindedness with which he +first strolled in upon our party, and then recall him running on +hands and knees along the cabin sofas, pawing the velvet, dipping +into the beds, and bleating commendatory +‘<i>mitais</i>’ with exaggerated emphasis, like some +enormous over-mannered ape, I feel the more sure that both must +have been calculated. And I sometimes wonder next, if Moipu +were quite alone in this polite duplicity, and ask myself whether +the <i>Casco</i> were quite so much admired in the Marquesas as +our visitors desired us to suppose.</p> +<p>I will complete this sketch of an incurable cannibal grandee +with two incongruous traits. His favourite morsel was the +human hand, of which he speaks to-day with an ill-favoured +lustfulness. And when he said good-bye to Mrs. Stevenson, +holding her hand, viewing her with tearful eyes, and chanting his +farewell improvisation in the falsetto of Marquesan high society, +he wrote upon her mind a sentimental impression which I try in +vain to share.</p> +<h2>PART II: THE PAUMOTUS</h2> +<h3>CHAPTER I—THE DANGEROUS ARCHIPELAGO—ATOLLS AT A +DISTANCE</h3> +<p>In the early morning of 4th September a whale-boat manned by +natives dragged us down the green lane of the anchorage and round +the spouting promontory. On the shore level it was a hot, +breathless, and yet crystal morning; but high overhead the hills +of Atuona were all cowled in cloud, and the ocean-river of the +trades streamed without pause. As we crawled from under the +immediate shelter of the land, we reached at last the limit of +their influence. The wind fell upon our sails in puffs, +which strengthened and grew more continuous; presently the +<i>Casco</i> heeled down to her day’s work; the whale-boat, +quite outstripped, clung for a noisy moment to her quarter; the +stipulated bread, rum, and tobacco were passed in; a moment more +and the boat was in our wake, and our late pilots were cheering +our departure.</p> +<p>This was the more inspiriting as we were bound for scenes so +different, and though on a brief voyage, yet for a new province +of creation. That wide field of ocean, called loosely the +South Seas, extends from tropic to tropic, and from perhaps 123 +degrees W. to 150 degrees E., a parallelogram of one hundred +degrees by forty-seven, where degrees are the most +spacious. Much of it lies vacant, much is closely sown with +isles, and the isles are of two sorts. No distinction is so +continually dwelt upon in South Sea talk as that between the +‘low’ and the ‘high’ island, and there is +none more broadly marked in nature. The Himalayas are not +more different from the Sahara. On the one hand, and +chiefly in groups of from eight to a dozen, volcanic islands rise +above the sea; few reach an altitude of less than 4000 feet; one +exceeds 13,000; their tops are often obscured in cloud, they are +all clothed with various forests, all abound in food, and are all +remarkable for picturesque and solemn scenery. On the other +hand, we have the atoll; a thing of problematic origin and +history, the reputed creature of an insect apparently +unidentified; rudely annular in shape; enclosing a lagoon; rarely +extending beyond a quarter of a mile at its chief width; often +rising at its highest point to less than the stature of a +man—man himself, the rat and the land crab, its chief +inhabitants; not more variously supplied with plants; and +offering to the eye, even when perfect, only a ring of glittering +beach and verdant foliage, enclosing and enclosed by the blue +sea.</p> +<p>In no quarter are the atolls so thickly congregated, in none +are they so varied in size from the greatest to the least, and in +none is navigation so beset with perils, as in that archipelago +that we were now to thread. The huge system of the trades +is, for some reason, quite confounded by this multiplicity of +reefs, the wind intermits, squalls are frequent from the west and +south-west, hurricanes are known. The currents are, +besides, inextricably intermixed; dead reckoning becomes a farce; +the charts are not to be trusted; and such is the number and +similarity of these islands that, even when you have picked one +up, you may be none the wiser. The reputation of the place +is consequently infamous; insurance offices exclude it from their +field, and it was not without misgiving that my captain risked +the <i>Casco</i> in such waters. I believe, indeed, it is +almost understood that yachts are to avoid this baffling +archipelago; and it required all my instances—and all Mr. +Otis’s private taste for adventure—to deflect our +course across its midst.</p> +<p>For a few days we sailed with a steady trade, and a steady +westerly current setting us to leeward; and toward sundown of the +seventh it was supposed we should have sighted Takaroa, one of +Cook’s so-called King George Islands. The sun set; +yet a while longer the old moon—semi-brilliant herself, and +with a silver belly, which was her successor—sailed among +gathering clouds; she, too, deserted us; stars of every degree of +sheen, and clouds of every variety of form disputed the +sub-lustrous night; and still we gazed in vain for Takaroa. +The mate stood on the bowsprit, his tall grey figure slashing up +and down against the stars, and still</p> + +<blockquote><p> ‘nihil +astra praeter<br /> +Vidit et undas.</p> +</blockquote> +<p>The rest of us were grouped at the port anchor davit, staring +with no less assiduity, but with far less hope on the obscure +horizon. Islands we beheld in plenty, but they were of +‘such stuff as dreams are made on,’ and vanished at a +wink, only to appear in other places; and by and by not only +islands, but refulgent and revolving lights began to stud the +darkness; lighthouses of the mind or of the wearied optic nerve, +solemnly shining and winking as we passed. At length the +mate himself despaired, scrambled on board again from his +unrestful perch, and announced that we had missed our +destination. He was the only man of practice in these +waters, our sole pilot, shipped for that end at Tai-o-hae. +If he declared we had missed Takaroa, it was not for us to +quarrel with the fact, but, if we could, to explain it. We +had certainly run down our southing. Our canted wake upon +the sea and our somewhat drunken-looking course upon the chart +both testified with no less certainty to an impetuous westward +current. We had no choice but to conclude we were again set +down to leeward; and the best we could do was to bring the +<i>Casco</i> to the wind, keep a good watch, and expect +morning.</p> +<p>I slept that night, as was then my somewhat dangerous +practice, on deck upon the cockpit bench. A stir at last +awoke me, to see all the eastern heaven dyed with faint orange, +the binnacle lamp already dulled against the brightness of the +day, and the steersman leaning eagerly across the wheel. +‘There it is, sir!’ he cried, and pointed in the very +eyeball of the dawn. For awhile I could see nothing but the +bluish ruins of the morning bank, which lay far along the +horizon, like melting icebergs. Then the sun rose, pierced +a gap in these <i>débris</i> of vapours, and displayed an +inconsiderable islet, flat as a plate upon the sea, and spiked +with palms of disproportioned altitude.</p> +<p>So far, so good. Here was certainly an atoll; and we +were certainly got among the archipelago. But which? +And where? The isle was too small for either Takaroa: in +all our neighbourhood, indeed, there was none so inconsiderable, +save only Tikei; and Tikei, one of Roggewein’s so-called +Pernicious Islands, seemed beside the question. At that +rate, instead of drifting to the west, we must have fetched up +thirty miles to windward. And how about the current? +It had been setting us down, by observation, all these days: by +the deflection of our wake, it should be setting us down that +moment. When had it stopped? When had it begun again? +and what kind of torrent was that which had swept us eastward in +the interval? To these questions, so typical of navigation +in that range of isles, I have no answer. Such were at +least the facts; Tikei our island turned out to be; and it was +our first experience of the dangerous archipelago, to make our +landfall thirty miles out.</p> +<p>The sight of Tikei, thrown direct against the splendour of the +morning, robbed of all its colour, and deformed with +disproportioned trees like bristles on a broom, had scarce +prepared us to be much in love with atolls. Later the same +day we saw under more fit conditions the island of Taiaro. +<i>Lost in the Sea</i> is possibly the meaning of the name. +And it was so we saw it; lost in blue sea and sky: a ring of +white beach, green underwood, and tossing palms, gem-like in +colour; of a fairy, of a heavenly prettiness. The surf ran +all around it, white as snow, and broke at one point, far to +seaward, on what seems an uncharted reef. There was no +smoke, no sign of man; indeed, the isle is not inhabited, only +visited at intervals. And yet a trader (Mr. Narii Salmon) +was watching from the shore and wondering at the unexpected +ship. I have spent since then long months upon low islands; +I know the tedium of their undistinguished days; I know the +burden of their diet. With whatever envy we may have looked +from the deck on these green coverts, it was with a tenfold +greater that Mr. Salmon and his comrades saw us steer, in our +trim ship, to seaward.</p> +<p>The night fell lovely in the extreme. After the moon +went down, the heaven was a thing to wonder at for stars. +And as I lay in the cockpit and looked upon the steersman I was +haunted by Emerson’s verses:</p> +<blockquote><p>‘And the lone seaman all the night<br /> +Sails astonished among stars.’</p> +</blockquote> +<p>By this glittering and imperfect brightness, about four bells +in the first watch we made our third atoll, Raraka. The low +line of the isle lay straight along the sky; so that I was at +first reminded of a towpath, and we seemed to be mounting some +engineered and navigable stream. Presently a red star +appeared, about the height and brightness of a danger signal, and +with that my simile was changed; we seemed rather to skirt the +embankment of a railway, and the eye began to look instinctively +for the telegraph-posts, and the ear to expect the coming of a +train. Here and there, but rarely, faint tree-tops broke +the level. And the sound of the surf accompanied us, now in +a drowsy monotone, now with a menacing swing.</p> +<p>The isle lay nearly east and west, barring our advance on +Fakarava. We must, therefore, hug the coast until we gained +the western end, where, through a passage eight miles wide, we +might sail southward between Raraka and the next isle, +Kauehi. We had the wind free, a lightish air; but clouds of +an inky blackness were beginning to arise, and at times it +lightened—without thunder. Something, I know not +what, continually set us up upon the island. We lay more +and more to the nor’ard; and you would have thought the +shore copied our manœuvre and outsailed us. Once and twice +Raraka headed us again—again, in the sea fashion, the quite +innocent steersman was abused—and again the <i>Casco</i> +kept away. Had I been called on, with no more light than +that of our experience, to draw the configuration of that island, +I should have shown a series of bow-window promontories, each +overlapping the other to the nor’ard, and the trend of the +land from the south-east to the north-west, and behold, on the +chart it lay near east and west in a straight line.</p> +<p>We had but just repeated our manœuvre and kept +away—for not more than five minutes the railway embankment +had been lost to view and the surf to hearing—when I was +aware of land again, not only on the weather bow, but dead +ahead. I played the part of the judicious landsman, holding +my peace till the last moment; and presently my mariners +perceived it for themselves.</p> +<p>‘Land ahead!’ said the steersman.</p> +<p>‘By God, it’s Kauehi!’ cried the mate.</p> +<p>And so it was. And with that I began to be sorry for +cartographers. We were scarce doing three and a half; and +they asked me to believe that (in five minutes) we had dropped an +island, passed eight miles of open water, and run almost high and +dry upon the next. But my captain was more sorry for +himself to be afloat in such a labyrinth; laid the <i>Casco</i> +to, with the log line up and down, and sat on the stern rail and +watched it till the morning. He had enough of night in the +Paumotus.</p> +<p>By daylight on the 9th we began to skirt Kauehi, and had now +an opportunity to see near at hand the geography of atolls. +Here and there, where it was high, the farther side loomed up; +here and there the near side dipped entirely and showed a broad +path of water into the lagoon; here and there both sides were +equally abased, and we could look right through the discontinuous +ring to the sea horizon on the south. Conceive, on a vast +scale, the submerged hoop of the duck-hunter, trimmed with green +rushes to conceal his head—water within, water +without—you have the image of the perfect atoll. +Conceive one that has been partly plucked of its rush fringe; you +have the atoll of Kauehi. And for either shore of it at +closer quarters, conceive the line of some old Roman highway +traversing a wet morass, and here sunk out of view and there +re-arising, crowned with a green tuft of thicket; only instead of +the stagnant waters of a marsh, the live ocean now boiled +against, now buried the frail barrier. Last night’s +impression in the dark was thus confirmed by day, and not +corrected. We sailed indeed by a mere causeway in the sea, +of nature’s handiwork, yet of no greater magnitude than +many of the works of man.</p> +<p>The isle was uninhabited; it was all green brush and white +sand, set in transcendently blue water; even the coco-palms were +rare, though some of these completed the bright harmony of colour +by hanging out a fan of golden yellow. For long there was +no sign of life beyond the vegetable, and no sound but the +continuous grumble of the surf. In silence and desertion +these fair shores slipped past, and were submerged and rose again +with clumps of thicket from the sea. And then a bird or two +appeared, hovering and crying; swiftly these became more +numerous, and presently, looking ahead, we were aware of a vast +effervescence of winged life. In this place the annular +isle was mostly under water, carrying here and there on its +submerged line a wooded islet. Over one of these the birds +hung and flew with an incredible density like that of gnats or +hiving bees; the mass flashed white and black, and heaved and +quivered, and the screaming of the creatures rose over the voice +of the surf in a shrill clattering whirr. As you descend +some inland valley a not dissimilar sound announces the nearness +of a mill and pouring river. Some stragglers, as I said, +came to meet our approach; a few still hung about the ship as we +departed. The crying died away, the last pair of wings was +left behind, and once more the low shores of Kauehi streamed past +our eyes in silence like a picture. I supposed at the time +that the birds lived, like ants or citizens, concentred where we +saw them. I have been told since (I know not if correctly) +that the whole isle, or much of it, is similarly peopled; and +that the effervescence at a single spot would be the mark of a +boat’s crew of egg-hunters from one of the neighbouring +inhabited atolls. So that here at Kauehi, as the day before +at Taiaro, the <i>Casco</i> sailed by under the fire of +unsuspected eyes. And one thing is surely true, that even +on these ribbons of land an army might lie hid and no passing +mariner divine its presence.</p> +<h3>CHAPTER II—FAKARAVA: AN ATOLL AT HAND</h3> +<p>By a little before noon we were running down the coast of our +destination, Fakarava: the air very light, the sea near smooth; +though still we were accompanied by a continuous murmur from the +beach, like the sound of a distant train. The isle is of a +huge longitude, the enclosed lagoon thirty miles by ten or +twelve, and the coral tow-path, which they call the land, some +eighty or ninety miles by (possibly) one furlong. That part +by which we sailed was all raised; the underwood excellently +green, the topping wood of coco-palms continuous—a mark, if +I had known it, of man’s intervention. For once more, +and once more unconsciously, we were within hail of +fellow-creatures, and that vacant beach was but a pistol-shot +from the capital city of the archipelago. But the life of +an atoll, unless it be enclosed, passes wholly on the shores of +the lagoon; it is there the villages are seated, there the canoes +ply and are drawn up; and the beach of the ocean is a place +accursed and deserted, the fit scene only for wizardry and +shipwreck, and in the native belief a haunting ground of +murderous spectres.</p> +<p>By and by we might perceive a breach in the low barrier; the +woods ceased; a glittering point ran into the sea, tipped with an +emerald shoal the mark of entrance. As we drew near we met +a little run of sea—the private sea of the lagoon having +there its origin and end, and here, in the jaws of the gateway, +trying vain conclusions with the more majestic heave of the +Pacific. The <i>Casco</i> scarce avowed a shock; but there +are times and circumstances when these harbour mouths of inland +basins vomit floods, deflecting, burying, and dismasting +ships. For, conceive a lagoon perfectly sealed but in the +one point, and that of merely navigable width; conceive the tide +and wind to have heaped for hours together in that coral fold a +superfluity of waters, and the tide to change and the wind +fall—the open sluice of some great reservoirs at home will +give an image of the unstemmable effluxion.</p> +<p>We were scarce well headed for the pass before all heads were +craned over the rail. For the water, shoaling under our +board, became changed in a moment to surprising hues of blue and +grey; and in its transparency the coral branched and blossomed, +and the fish of the inland sea cruised visibly below us, stained +and striped, and even beaked like parrots. I have paid in +my time to view many curiosities; never one so curious as that +first sight over the ship’s rail in the lagoon of +Fakarava. But let not the reader be deceived with +hope. I have since entered, I suppose, some dozen atolls in +different parts of the Pacific, and the experience has never been +repeated. That exquisite hue and transparency of submarine +day, and these shoals of rainbow fish, have not enraptured me +again.</p> +<p>Before we could raise our eyes from that engaging spectacle +the schooner had slipped betwixt the pierheads of the reef, and +was already quite committed to the sea within. The +containing shores are so little erected, and the lagoon itself is +so great, that, for the more part, it seemed to extend without a +check to the horizon. Here and there, indeed, where the +reef carried an inlet, like a signet-ring upon a finger, there +would be a pencilling of palms; here and there, the green wall of +wood ran solid for a length of miles; and on the port hand, under +the highest grove of trees, a few houses sparkled +white—Rotoava, the metropolitan settlement of the +Paumotus. Hither we beat in three tacks, and came to an +anchor close in shore, in the first smooth water since we had +left San Francisco, five fathoms deep, where a man might look +overboard all day at the vanishing cable, the coral patches, and +the many-coloured fish.</p> +<p>Fakarava was chosen to be the seat of Government from nautical +considerations only. It is eccentrically situate; the +productions, even for a low island, poor; the population neither +many nor—for Low Islanders—industrious. But the +lagoon has two good passages, one to leeward, one to windward, so +that in all states of the wind it can be left and entered, and +this advantage, for a government of scattered islands, was +decisive. A pier of coral, landing-stairs, a harbour light +upon a staff and pillar, and two spacious Government bungalows in +a handsome fence, give to the northern end of Rotoava a great air +of consequence. This is confirmed on the one hand by an +empty prison, on the other by a gendarmerie pasted over with +hand-bills in Tahitian, land-law notices from Papeete, and +republican sentiments from Paris, signed (a little after date) +‘Jules Grévy, <i>Perihidente</i>.’ Quite +at the far end a belfried Catholic chapel concludes the town; and +between, on a smooth floor of white coral sand and under the +breezy canopy of coco-palms, the houses of the natives stand +irregularly scattered, now close on the lagoon for the sake of +the breeze, now back under the palms for love of shadow.</p> +<p>Not a soul was to be seen. But for the thunder of the +surf on the far side, it seemed you might have heard a pin drop +anywhere about that capital city. There was something +thrilling in the unexpected silence, something yet more so in the +unexpected sound. Here before us a sea reached to the +horizon, rippling like an inland mere; and behold! close at our +back another sea assaulted with assiduous fury the reverse of the +position. At night the lantern was run up and lit a vacant +pier. In one house lights were seen and voices heard, where +the population (I was told) sat playing cards. A little +beyond, from deep in the darkness of the palm-grove, we saw the +glow and smelt the aromatic odour of a coal of cocoa-nut husk, a +relic of the evening kitchen. Crickets sang; some shrill +thing whistled in a tuft of weeds; and the mosquito hummed and +stung. There was no other trace that night of man, bird, or +insect in the isle. The moon, now three days old, and as +yet but a silver crescent on a still visible sphere, shone +through the palm canopy with vigorous and scattered lights. +The alleys where we walked were smoothed and weeded like a +boulevard; here and there were plants set out; here and there +dusky cottages clustered in the shadow, some with +verandahs. A public garden by night, a rich and fashionable +watering-place in a by-season, offer sights and vistas not +dissimilar. And still, on the one side, stretched the +lapping mere, and from the other the deep sea still growled in +the night. But it was most of all on board, in the dead +hours, when I had been better sleeping, that the spell of +Fakarava seized and held me. The moon was down. The +harbour lantern and two of the greater planets drew vari-coloured +wakes on the lagoon. From shore the cheerful watch-cry of +cocks rang out at intervals above the organ-point of surf. +And the thought of this depopulated capital, this protracted +thread of annular island with its crest of coco-palms and fringe +of breakers, and that tranquil inland sea that stretched before +me till it touched the stars, ran in my head for hours with +delight.</p> +<p>So long as I stayed upon that isle these thoughts were +constant. I lay down to sleep, and woke again with an +unblunted sense of my surroundings. I was never weary of +calling up the image of that narrow causeway, on which I had my +dwelling, lying coiled like a serpent, tail to mouth, in the +outrageous ocean, and I was never weary of passing—a mere +quarter-deck parade—from the one side to the other, from +the shady, habitable shores of the lagoon to the blinding desert +and uproarious breakers of the opposite beach. The sense of +insecurity in such a thread of residence is more than +fanciful. Hurricanes and tidal waves over-leap these humble +obstacles; Oceanus remembers his strength, and, where houses +stood and palms flourished, shakes his white beard again over the +barren coral. Fakarava itself has suffered; the trees +immediately beyond my house were all of recent replantation; and +Anaa is only now recovered from a heavier stroke. I knew +one who was then dwelling in the isle. He told me that he +and two ship captains walked to the sea beach. There for a +while they viewed the oncoming breakers, till one of the captains +clapped suddenly his hand before his eyes and cried aloud that he +could endure no longer to behold them. This was in the +afternoon; in the dark hours of the night the sea burst upon the +island like a flood; the settlement was razed all but the church +and presbytery; and, when day returned, the survivors saw +themselves clinging in an abattis of uprooted coco-palms and +ruined houses.</p> +<p>Danger is but a small consideration. But men are more +nicely sensible of a discomfort; and the atoll is a +discomfortable home. There are some, and these probably +ancient, where a deep soil has formed and the most valuable +fruit-trees prosper. I have walked in one, with equal +admiration and surprise, through a forest of huge breadfruits, +eating bananas and stumbling among taro as I went. This was +in the atoll of Namorik in the Marshall group, and stands alone +in my experience. To give the opposite extreme, which is +yet far more near the average, I will describe the soil and +productions of Fakarava. The surface of that narrow strip +is for the more part of broken coral lime-stone, like volcanic +clinkers, and excruciating to the naked foot; in some atolls, I +believe, not in Fakarava, it gives a fine metallic ring when +struck. Here and there you come upon a bank of sand, +exceeding fine and white, and these parts are the least +productive. The plants (such as they are) spring from and +love the broken coral, whence they grow with that wonderful +verdancy that makes the beauty of the atoll from the sea. +The coco-palm in particular luxuriates in that stern +<i>solum</i>, striking down his roots to the brackish, percolated +water, and bearing his green head in the wind with every evidence +of health and pleasure. And yet even the coco-palm must be +helped in infancy with some extraneous nutriment, and through +much of the low archipelago there is planted with each nut a +piece of ship’s biscuit and a rusty nail. The +pandanus comes next in importance, being also a food tree; and +he, too, does bravely. A green bush called <i>miki</i> runs +everywhere; occasionally a purao is seen; and there are several +useless weeds. According to M. Cuzent, the whole number of +plants on an atoll such as Fakarava will scarce exceed, even if +it reaches to, one score. Not a blade of grass appears; not +a grain of humus, save when a sack or two has been imported to +make the semblance of a garden; such gardens as bloom in cities +on the window-sill. Insect life is sometimes dense; a cloud +o’ mosquitoes, and, what is far worse, a plague of flies +blackening our food, has sometimes driven us from a meal on +Apemama; and even in Fakarava the mosquitoes were a pest. +The land crab may be seen scuttling to his hole, and at night the +rats besiege the houses and the artificial gardens. The +crab is good eating; possibly so is the rat; I have not +tried. Pandanus fruit is made, in the Gilberts, into an +agreeable sweetmeat, such as a man may trifle with at the end of +a long dinner; for a substantial meal I have no use for it. +The rest of the food-supply, in a destitute atoll such as +Fakarava, can be summed up in the favourite jest of the +archipelago—cocoa-nut beefsteak. Cocoa-nut green, +cocoa-nut ripe, cocoa-nut germinated; cocoa-nut to eat and +cocoa-nut to drink; cocoa-nut raw and cooked, cocoa-nut hot and +cold—such is the bill of fare. And some of the +entrées are no doubt delicious. The germinated nut, +cooked in the shell and eaten with a spoon, forms a good pudding; +cocoa-nut milk—the expressed juice of a ripe nut, not the +water of a green one—goes well in coffee, and is a valuable +adjunct in cookery through the South Seas; and cocoa-nut salad, +if you be a millionaire, and can afford to eat the value of a +field of corn for your dessert, is a dish to be remembered with +affection. But when all is done there is a sameness, and +the Israelites of the low islands murmur at their manna.</p> +<p>The reader may think I have forgot the sea. The two +beaches do certainly abound in life, and they are strangely +different. In the lagoon the water shallows slowly on a +bottom of the fine slimy sand, dotted with clumps of growing +coral. Then comes a strip of tidal beach on which the +ripples lap. In the coral clumps the great holy-water clam +(<i>Tridacna</i>) grows plentifully; a little deeper lie the beds +of the pearl-oyster and sail the resplendent fish that charmed us +at our entrance; and these are all more or less vigorously +coloured. But the other shells are white like lime, or +faintly tinted with a little pink, the palest possible display; +many of them dead besides, and badly rolled. On the ocean +side, on the mounds of the steep beach, over all the width of the +reef right out to where the surf is bursting, in every cranny, +under every scattered fragment of the coral, an incredible plenty +of marine life displays the most wonderful variety and brilliancy +of hues. The reef itself has no passage of colour but is +imitated by some shell. Purple and red and white, and green +and yellow, pied and striped and clouded, the living shells wear +in every combination the livery of the dead reef—if the +reef be dead—so that the eye is continually baffled and the +collector continually deceived. I have taken shells for +stones and stones for shells, the one as often as the +other. A prevailing character of the coral is to be dotted +with small spots of red, and it is wonderful how many varieties +of shell have adopted the same fashion and donned the disguise of +the red spot. A shell I had found in plenty in the +Marquesas I found here also unchanged in all things else, but +there were the red spots. A lively little crab wore the +same markings. The case of the hermit or soldier crab was +more conclusive, being the result of conscious choice. This +nasty little wrecker, scavenger, and squatter has learned the +value of a spotted house; so it be of the right colour he will +choose the smallest shard, tuck himself in a mere corner of a +broken whorl, and go about the world half naked; but I never +found him in this imperfect armour unless it was marked with the +red spot.</p> +<p>Some two hundred yards distant is the beach of the +lagoon. Collect the shells from each, set them side by +side, and you would suppose they came from different hemispheres; +the one so pale, the other so brilliant; the one prevalently +white, the other of a score of hues, and infected with the +scarlet spot like a disease. This seems the more strange, +since the hermit crabs pass and repass the island, and I have met +them by the Residency well, which is about central, journeying +either way. Without doubt many of the shells in the lagoon +are dead. But why are they dead? Without doubt the +living shells have a very different background set for +imitation. But why are these so different? We are +only on the threshold of the mysteries.</p> +<p>Either beach, I have said, abounds with life. On the +sea-side and in certain atolls this profusion of vitality is even +shocking: the rock under foot is mined with it. I have +broken off—notably in Funafuti and Arorai <a +name="citation156"></a><a href="#footnote156" +class="citation">[156]</a>—great lumps of ancient weathered +rock that rang under my blows like iron, and the fracture has +been full of pendent worms as long as my hand, as thick as a +child’s finger, of a slightly pinkish white, and set as +close as three or even four to the square inch. Even in the +lagoon, where certain shell-fish seem to sicken, others (it is +notorious) prosper exceedingly and make the riches of these +islands. Fish, too, abound; the lagoon is a closed +fish-pond, such as might rejoice the fancy of an abbot; sharks +swarm there, and chiefly round the passages, to feast upon this +plenty, and you would suppose that man had only to prepare his +angle. Alas! it is not so. Of these painted fish that +came in hordes about the entering <i>Casco</i>, some bore +poisonous spines, and others were poisonous if eaten. The +stranger must refrain, or take his chance of painful and +dangerous sickness. The native, on his own isle, is a safe +guide; transplant him to the next, and he is helpless as +yourself. For it is a question both of time and +place. A fish caught in a lagoon may be deadly; the same +fish caught the same day at sea, and only a few hundred yards +without the passage, will be wholesome eating: in a neighbouring +isle perhaps the case will be reversed; and perhaps a fortnight +later you shall be able to eat of them indifferently from within +and from without. According to the natives, these +bewildering vicissitudes are ruled by the movement of the +heavenly bodies. The beautiful planet Venus plays a great +part in all island tales and customs; and among other functions, +some of them more awful, she regulates the season of good +fish. With Venus in one phase, as we had her, certain fish +were poisonous in the lagoon: with Venus in another, the same +fish was harmless and a valued article of diet. White men +explain these changes by the phases of the coral.</p> +<p>It adds a last touch of horror to the thought of this +precarious annular gangway in the sea, that even what there is of +it is not of honest rock, but organic, part alive, part +putrescent; even the clean sea and the bright fish about it +poisoned, the most stubborn boulder burrowed in by worms, the +lightest dust venomous as an apothecary’s drugs.</p> +<h3>CHAPTER III—A HOUSE TO LET IN A LOW ISLAND</h3> +<p>Never populous, it was yet by a chapter of accidents that I +found the island so deserted that no sound of human life +diversified the hours; that we walked in that trim public garden +of a town, among closed houses, without even a lodging-bill in a +window to prove some tenancy in the back quarters; and, when we +visited the Government bungalow, that Mr. Donat, acting +Vice-Resident, greeted us alone, and entertained us with +cocoa-nut punches in the Sessions Hall and seat of judgment of +that widespread archipelago, our glasses standing arrayed with +summonses and census returns. The unpopularity of a late +Vice-Resident had begun the movement of exodus, his native +employés resigning court appointments and retiring each to +his own coco-patch in the remoter districts of the isle. +Upon the back of that, the Governor in Papeete issued a decree: +All land in the Paumotus must be defined and registered by a +certain date. Now, the folk of the archipelago are half +nomadic; a man can scarce be said to belong to a particular +atoll; he belongs to several, perhaps holds a stake and counts +cousinship in half a score; and the inhabitants of Rotoava in +particular, man, woman, and child, and from the gendarme to the +Mormon prophet and the schoolmaster, owned—I was going to +say land—owned at least coral blocks and growing coco-palms +in some adjacent isle. Thither—from the gendarme to +the babe in arms, the pastor followed by his flock, the +schoolmaster carrying along with him his scholars, and the +scholars with their books and slates—they had taken ship +some two days previous to our arrival, and were all now engaged +disputing boundaries. Fancy overhears the shrillness of +their disputation mingle with the surf and scatter +sea-fowl. It was admirable to observe the completeness of +their flight, like that of hibernating birds; nothing left but +empty houses, like old nests to be reoccupied in spring; and even +the harmless necessary dominie borne with them in their +transmigration. Fifty odd set out, and only seven, I was +informed, remained. But when I made a feast on board the +<i>Casco</i>, more than seven, and nearer seven times seven, +appeared to be my guests. Whence they appeared, how they +were summoned, whither they vanished when the feast was eaten, I +have no guess. In view of Low Island tales, and that awful +frequentation which makes men avoid the seaward beaches of an +atoll, some two score of those that ate with us may have +returned, for the occasion, from the kingdom of the dead.</p> +<p>It was this solitude that put it in our minds to hire a house, +and become, for the time being, indwellers of the isle—a +practice I have ever since, when it was possible, adhered +to. Mr. Donat placed us, with that intent, under the convoy +of one Taniera Mahinui, who combined the incongruous characters +of catechist and convict. The reader may smile, but I +affirm he was well qualified for either part. For that of +convict, first of all, by a good substantial felony, such as in +all lands casts the perpetrator in chains and dungeons. +Taniera was a man of birth—the chief a while ago, as he +loved to tell, of a district in Anaa of 800 souls. In an +evil hour it occurred to the authorities in Papeete to charge the +chiefs with the collection of the taxes. It is a question +if much were collected; it is certain that nothing was handed on; +and Taniera, who had distinguished himself by a visit to Papeete +and some high living in restaurants, was chosen for the +scapegoat. The reader must understand that not Taniera but +the authorities in Papeete were first in fault. The charge +imposed was disproportioned. I have not yet heard of any +Polynesian capable of such a burden; honest and upright +Hawaiians—one in particular, who was admired even by the +whites as an inflexible magistrate—have stumbled in the +narrow path of the trustee. And Taniera, when the pinch +came, scorned to denounce accomplices; others had shared the +spoil, he bore the penalty alone. He was condemned in five +years. The period, when I had the pleasure of his +friendship, was not yet expired; he still drew prison rations, +the sole and not unwelcome reminder of his chains, and, I +believe, looked forward to the date of his enfranchisement with +mere alarm. For he had no sense of shame in the position; +complained of nothing but the defective table of his place of +exile; regretted nothing but the fowls and eggs and fish of his +own more favoured island. And as for his parishioners, they +did not think one hair the less of him. A schoolboy, +mulcted in ten thousand lines of Greek and dwelling sequestered +in the dormitories, enjoys unabated consideration from his +fellows. So with Taniera: a marked man, not a dishonoured; +having fallen under the lash of the unthinkable gods; a Job, +perhaps, or say a Taniera in the den of lions. Songs are +likely made and sung about this saintly Robin Hood. On the +other hand, he was even highly qualified for his office in the +Church; being by nature a grave, considerate, and kindly man; his +face rugged and serious, his smile bright; the master of several +trades, a builder both of boats and houses; endowed with a fine +pulpit voice; endowed besides with such a gift of eloquence that +at the grave of the late chief of Fakarava he set all the +assistants weeping. I never met a man of a mind more +ecclesiastical; he loved to dispute and to inform himself of +doctrine and the history of sects; and when I showed him the cuts +in a volume of Chambers’s +<i>Encyclopædia</i>—except for one of an +ape—reserved his whole enthusiasm for cardinals’ +hats, censers, candlesticks, and cathedrals. Methought when +he looked upon the cardinal’s hat a voice said low in his +ear: ‘Your foot is on the ladder.’</p> +<p>Under the guidance of Taniera we were soon installed in what I +believe to have been the best-appointed private house in +Fakarava. It stood just beyond the church in an oblong +patch of cultivation. More than three hundred sacks of soil +were imported from Tahiti for the Residency garden; and this must +shortly be renewed, for the earth blows away, sinks in crevices +of the coral, and is sought for at last in vain. I know not +how much earth had gone to the garden of my villa; some at least, +for an alley of prosperous bananas ran to the gate, and over the +rest of the enclosure, which was covered with the usual +clinker-like fragments of smashed coral, not only coco-palms and +mikis but also fig-trees flourished, all of a delicious +greenness. Of course there was no blade of grass. In +front a picket fence divided us from the white road, the +palm-fringed margin of the lagoon, and the lagoon itself, +reflecting clouds by day and stars by night. At the back, a +bulwark of uncemented coral enclosed us from the narrow belt of +bush and the nigh ocean beach where the seas thundered, the roar +and wash of them still humming in the chambers of the house.</p> +<p>This itself was of one story, verandahed front and back. +It contained three rooms, three sewing-machines, three +sea-chests, chairs, tables, a pair of beds, a cradle, a +double-barrelled gun, a pair of enlarged coloured photographs, a +pair of coloured prints after Wilkie and Mulready, and a French +lithograph with the legend: ‘<i>Le brigade du +Général Lepasset brûlant son drapeau devant +Metz</i>.’ Under the stilts of the house a stove was +rusting, till we drew it forth and put it in commission. +Not far off was the burrow in the coral whence we supplied +ourselves with brackish water. There was live stock, +besides, on the estate—cocks and hens and a brace of +ill-regulated cats, whom Taniera came every morning with the sun +to feed on grated cocoa-nut. His voice was our regular +réveille, ringing pleasantly about the garden: +‘Pooty—pooty—poo—poo—poo!’</p> +<p>Far as we were from the public offices, the nearness of the +chapel made our situation what is called eligible in +advertisements, and gave us a side look on some native +life. Every morning, as soon as he had fed the fowls, +Taniera set the bell agoing in the small belfry; and the +faithful, who were not very numerous, gathered to prayers. +I was once present: it was the Lord’s day, and seven +females and eight males composed the congregation. A woman +played precentor, starting with a longish note; the catechist +joined in upon the second bar; and then the faithful in a +body. Some had printed hymn-books which they followed; some +of the rest filled up with ‘eh—eh—eh,’ +the Paumotuan tol-de-rol. After the hymn, we had an +antiphonal prayer or two; and then Taniera rose from the front +bench, where he had been sitting in his catechist’s robes, +passed within the altar-rails, opened his Tahitian Bible, and +began to preach from notes. I understood one word—the +name of God; but the preacher managed his voice with taste, used +rare and expressive gestures, and made a strong impression of +sincerity. The plain service, the vernacular Bible, the +hymn-tunes mostly on an English pattern—‘God save the +Queen,’ I was informed, a special favourite,—all, +save some paper flowers upon the altar, seemed not merely but +austerely Protestant. It is thus the Catholics have met +their low island proselytes half-way.</p> +<p>Taniera had the keys of our house; it was with him I made my +bargain, if that could be called a bargain in which all was +remitted to my generosity; it was he who fed the cats and +poultry, he who came to call and pick a meal with us like an +acknowledged friend; and we long fondly supposed he was our +landlord. This belief was not to bear the test of +experience; and, as my chapter has to relate, no certainty +succeeded it.</p> +<p>We passed some days of airless quiet and great heat; +shell-gatherers were warned from the ocean beach, where sunstroke +waited them from ten till four; the highest palm hung motionless, +there was no voice audible but that of the sea on the far +side. At last, about four of a certain afternoon, long +cat’s-paws flawed the face of the lagoon; and presently in +the tree-tops there awoke the grateful bustle of the trades, and +all the houses and alleys of the island were fanned out. To +more than one enchanted ship, that had lain long becalmed in view +of the green shore, the wind brought deliverance; and by daylight +on the morrow a schooner and two cutters lay moored in the port +of Rotoava. Not only in the outer sea, but in the lagoon +itself, a certain traffic woke with the reviving breeze; and +among the rest one François, a half-blood, set sail with +the first light in his own half-decked cutter. He had held +before a court appointment; being, I believe, the Residency +sweeper-out. Trouble arising with the unpopular +Vice-Resident, he had thrown his honours down, and fled to the +far parts of the atoll to plant cabbages—or at least +coco-palms. Thence he was now driven by such need as even a +Cincinnatus must acknowledge, and fared for the capital city, the +seat of his late functions, to exchange half a ton of copra for +necessary flour. And here, for a while, the story leaves to +tell of his voyaging.</p> +<p>It must tell, instead, of our house, where, toward seven at +night, the catechist came suddenly in with his pleased air of +being welcome; armed besides with a considerable bunch of +keys. These he proceeded to try on the sea-chests, drawing +each in turn from its place against the wall. Heads of +strangers appeared in the doorway and volunteered +suggestions. All in vain. Either they were the wrong +keys or the wrong boxes, or the wrong man was trying them. +For a little Taniera fumed and fretted; then had recourse to the +more summary method of the hatchet; one of the chests was broken +open, and an armful of clothing, male and female, baled out and +handed to the strangers on the verandah.</p> +<p>These were François, his wife, and their child. +About eight a.m., in the midst of the lagoon, their cutter had +capsized in jibbing. They got her righted, and though she +was still full of water put the child on board. The +mainsail had been carried away, but the jib still drew her +sluggishly along, and François and the woman swam astern +and worked the rudder with their hands. The cold was cruel; +the fatigue, as time went on, became excessive; and in that +preserve of sharks, fear hunted them. Again and again, +François, the half-breed, would have desisted and gone +down; but the woman, whole blood of an amphibious race, still +supported him with cheerful words. I am reminded of a woman +of Hawaii who swam with her husband, I dare not say how many +miles, in a high sea, and came ashore at last with his dead body +in her arms. It was about five in the evening, after nine +hours’ swimming, that François and his wife reached +land at Rotoava. The gallant fight was won, and instantly +the more childish side of native character appears. They +had supped, and told and retold their story, dripping as they +came; the flesh of the woman, whom Mrs. Stevenson helped to +shift, was cold as stone; and François, having changed to +a dry cotton shirt and trousers, passed the remainder of the +evening on my floor and between open doorways, in a thorough +draught. Yet François, the son of a French father, +speaks excellent French himself and seems intelligent.</p> +<p>It was our first idea that the catechist, true to his +evangelical vocation, was clothing the naked from his +superfluity. Then it came out that François was but +dealing with his own. The clothes were his, so was the +chest, so was the house. François was in fact the +landlord. Yet you observe he had hung back on the verandah +while Taniera tried his ’prentice hand upon the locks: and +even now, when his true character appeared, the only use he made +of the estate was to leave the clothes of his family drying on +the fence. Taniera was still the friend of the house, still +fed the poultry, still came about us on his daily visits, +François, during the remainder of his stay, holding +bashfully aloof. And there was stranger matter. Since +François had lost the whole load of his cutter, the half +ton of copra, an axe, bowls, knives, and clothes—since he +had in a manner to begin the world again, and his necessary flour +was not yet bought or paid for—I proposed to advance him +what he needed on the rent. To my enduring amazement he +refused, and the reason he gave—if that can be called a +reason which but darkens counsel—was that Taniera was his +friend. His friend, you observe; not his creditor. I +inquired into that, and was assured that Taniera, an exile in a +strange isle, might possibly be in debt himself, but certainly +was no man’s creditor.</p> +<p>Very early one morning we were awakened by a bustling presence +in the yard, and found our camp had been surprised by a tall, +lean old native lady, dressed in what were obviously +widow’s weeds. You could see at a glance she was a +notable woman, a housewife, sternly practical, alive with energy, +and with fine possibilities of temper. Indeed, there was +nothing native about her but the skin; and the type abounds, and +is everywhere respected, nearer home. It did us good to see +her scour the grounds, examining the plants and chickens; +watering, feeding, trimming them; taking angry, purpose-like +possession. When she neared the house our sympathy abated; +when she came to the broken chest I wished I were +elsewhere. We had scarce a word in common; but her whole +lean body spoke for her with indignant eloquence. ‘My +chest!’ it cried, with a stress on the possessive. +‘My chest—broken open! This is a fine state of +things!’ I hastened to lay the blame where it +belonged—on François and his wife—and found I +had made things worse instead of better. She repeated the +names at first with incredulity, then with despair. A while +she seemed stunned, next fell to disembowelling the box, piling +the goods on the floor, and visibly computing the extent of +François’s ravages; and presently after she was +observed in high speech with Taniera, who seemed to hang an ear +like one reproved.</p> +<p>Here, then, by all known marks, should be my land-lady at +last; here was every character of the proprietor fully +developed. Should I not approach her on the still depending +question of my rent? I carried the point to an +adviser. ‘Nonsense!’ he cried. +‘That’s the old woman, the mother. It +doesn’t belong to her. I believe that’s the man +the house belongs to,’ and he pointed to one of the +coloured photographs on the wall. On this I gave up all +desire of understanding; and when the time came for me to leave, +in the judgment-hall of the archipelago, and with the awful +countenance of the acting Governor, I duly paid my rent to +Taniera. He was satisfied, and so was I. But what had +he to do with it? Mr. Donat, acting magistrate and a man of +kindred blood, could throw no light upon the mystery; a plain +private person, with a taste for letters, cannot be expected to +do more.</p> +<h3>CHAPTER IV—TRAITS AND SECTS IN THE PAUMOTUS</h3> +<p>The most careless reader must have remarked a change of air +since the Marquesas. The house, crowded with effects, the +bustling housewife counting her possessions, the serious, +indoctrinated island pastor, the long fight for life in the +lagoon: here are traits of a new world. I read in a +pamphlet (I will not give the author’s name) that the +Marquesan especially resembles the Paumotuan. I should take +the two races, though so near in neighbourhood, to be extremes of +Polynesian diversity. The Marquesan is certainly the most +beautiful of human races, and one of the tallest—the +Paumotuan averaging a good inch shorter, and not even handsome; +the Marquesan open-handed, inert, insensible to religion, +childishly self-indulgent—the Paumotuan greedy, hardy, +enterprising, a religious disputant, and with a trace of the +ascetic character.</p> +<p>Yet a few years ago, and the people of the archipelago were +crafty savages. Their isles might be called sirens’ +isles, not merely from the attraction they exerted on the passing +mariner, but from the perils that awaited him on shore. +Even to this day, in certain outlying islands, danger lingers; +and the civilized Paumotuan dreads to land and hesitates to +accost his backward brother. But, except in these, to-day +the peril is a memory. When our generation were yet in the +cradle and playroom it was still a living fact. Between +1830 and 1840, Hao, for instance, was a place of the most +dangerous approach, where ships were seized and crews +kidnapped. As late as 1856, the schooner <i>Sarah Ann</i> +sailed from Papeete and was seen no more. She had women on +board, and children, the captain’s wife, a nursemaid, a +baby, and the two young sons of a Captain Steven on their way to +the mainland for schooling. All were supposed to have +perished in a squall. A year later, the captain of the +<i>Julia</i>, coasting along the island variously called Bligh, +Lagoon, and Tematangi saw armed natives follow the course of his +schooner, clad in many-coloured stuffs. Suspicion was at +once aroused; the mother of the lost children was profuse of +money; and one expedition having found the place deserted, and +returned content with firing a few shots, she raised and herself +accompanied another. None appeared to greet or to oppose +them; they roamed a while among abandoned huts and empty +thickets; then formed two parties and set forth to beat, from end +to end, the pandanus jungle of the island. One man remained +alone by the landing-place—Teina, a chief of Anaa, leader +of the armed natives who made the strength of the +expedition. Now that his comrades were departed this way +and that, on their laborious exploration, the silence fell +profound; and this silence was the ruin of the islanders. A +sound of stones rattling caught the ear of Teina. He +looked, thinking to perceive a crab, and saw instead the brown +hand of a human being issue from a fissure in the ground. A +shout recalled the search parties and announced their doom to the +buried caitiffs. In the cave below, sixteen were found +crouching among human bones and singular and horrid +curiosities. One was a head of golden hair, supposed to be +a relic of the captain’s wife; another was half of the body +of a European child, sun-dried and stuck upon a stick, doubtless +with some design of wizardry.</p> +<p>The Paumotuan is eager to be rich. He saves, grudges, +buries money, fears not work. For a dollar each, two +natives passed the hours of daylight cleaning our ship’s +copper. It was strange to see them so indefatigable and so +much at ease in the water—working at times with their pipes +lighted, the smoker at times submerged and only the glowing bowl +above the surface; it was stranger still to think they were next +congeners to the incapable Marquesan. But the Paumotuan not +only saves, grudges, and works, he steals besides; or, to be more +precise, he swindles. He will never deny a debt, he only +flees his creditor. He is always keen for an advance; so +soon as he has fingered it he disappears. He knows your +ship; so soon as it nears one island, he is off to another. +You may think you know his name; he has already changed it. +Pursuit in that infinity of isles were fruitless. The +result can be given in a nutshell. It has been actually +proposed in a Government report to secure debts by taking a +photograph of the debtor; and the other day in Papeete credits on +the Paumotus to the amount of sixteen thousand pounds were sold +for less than forty—<i>quatre cent mille francs pour moins +de mille francs</i>. Even so, the purchase was thought +hazardous; and only the man who made it and who had special +opportunities could have dared to give so much.</p> +<p>The Paumotuan is sincerely attached to those of his own blood +and household. A touching affection sometimes unites wife +and husband. Their children, while they are alive, +completely rule them; after they are dead, their bones or their +mummies are often jealously preserved and carried from atoll to +atoll in the wanderings of the family. I was told there +were many houses in Fakarava with the mummy of a child locked in +a sea-chest; after I heard it, I would glance a little jealously +at those by my own bed; in that cupboard, also, it was possible +there was a tiny skeleton.</p> +<p>The race seems in a fair way to survive. From fifteen +islands, whose rolls I had occasion to consult, I found a +proportion of 59 births to 47 deaths for 1887. Dropping +three out of the fifteen, there remained for the other twelve the +comfortable ratio of 50 births to 32 deaths. Long habits of +hardship and activity doubtless explain the contrast with +Marquesan figures. But the Paumotuan displays, besides, a +certain concern for health and the rudiments of a sanitary +discipline. Public talk with these free-spoken people plays +the part of the Contagious Diseases Act; in-comers to fresh +islands anxiously inquire if all be well; and syphilis, when +contracted, is successfully treated with indigenous herbs. +Like their neighbours of Tahiti, from whom they have perhaps +imbibed the error, they regard leprosy with comparative +indifference, elephantiasis with disproportionate fear. +But, unlike indeed to the Tahitian, their alarm puts on the guise +of self-defence. Any one stricken with this painful and +ugly malady is confined to the ends of villages, denied the use +of paths and highways, and condemned to transport himself between +his house and coco-patch by water only, his very footprint being +held infectious. Fe’efe’e, being a creature of +marshes and the sequel of malarial fever, is not original in +atolls. On the single isle of Makatea, where the lagoon is +now a marsh, the disease has made a home. Many suffer; they +are excluded (if Mr. Wilmot be right) from much of the comfort of +society; and it is believed they take a secret vengeance. +The defections of the sick are considered highly poisonous. +Early in the morning, it is narrated, aged and malicious persons +creep into the sleeping village, and stealthily make water at the +doors of the houses of young men. Thus they propagate +disease; thus they breathe on and obliterate comeliness and +health, the objects of their envy. Whether horrid fact or +more abominable legend, it equally depicts that something bitter +and energetic which distinguishes Paumotuan man.</p> +<p>The archipelago is divided between two main religions, +Catholic and Mormon. They front each other proudly with a +false air of permanence; yet are but shapes, their membership in +a perpetual flux. The Mormon attends mass with devotion: +the Catholic sits attentive at a Mormon sermon, and to-morrow +each may have transferred allegiance. One man had been a +pillar of the Church of Rome for fifteen years; his wife dying, +he decided that must be a poor religion that could not save a man +his wife, and turned Mormon. According to one informant, +Catholicism was the more fashionable in health, but on the +approach of sickness it was judged prudent to secede. As a +Mormon, there were five chances out of six you might recover; as +a Catholic, your hopes were small; and this opinion is perhaps +founded on the comfortable rite of unction.</p> +<p>We all know what Catholics are, whether in the Paumotus or at +home. But the Paumotuan Mormon seemed a phenomenon +apart. He marries but the one wife, uses the Protestant +Bible, observes Protestant forms of worship, forbids the use of +liquor and tobacco, practises adult baptism by immersion, and +after every public sin, rechristens the backslider. I +advised with Mahinui, whom I found well informed in the history +of the American Mormons, and he declared against the least +connection. ‘<i>Pour moi</i>,’ said he, with a +fine charity, ‘<i>les Mormons ici un petit +Catholiques</i>.’ Some months later I had an +opportunity to consult an orthodox fellow-countryman, an old +dissenting Highlander, long settled in Tahiti, but still +breathing of the heather of Tiree. ‘Why do they call +themselves Mormons?’ I asked. ‘My dear, and +that is my question!’ he exclaimed. ‘For by all +that I can hear of their doctrine, I have nothing to say against +it, and their life, it is above reproach.’ And for +all that, Mormons they are, but of the earlier sowing: the +so-called Josephites, the followers of Joseph Smith, the +opponents of Brigham Young.</p> +<p>Grant, then, the Mormons to be Mormons. Fresh points at +once arise: What are the Israelites? and what the Kanitus? +For a long while back the sect had been divided into Mormons +proper and so-called Israelites, I never could hear why. A +few years since there came a visiting missionary of the name of +Williams, who made an excellent collection, and retired, leaving +fresh disruption imminent. Something irregular (as I was +told) in his way of ‘opening the service’ had raised +partisans and enemies; the church was once more rent asunder; and +a new sect, the Kanitu, issued from the division. Since +then Kanitus and Israelites, like the Cameronians and the United +Presbyterians, have made common cause; and the ecclesiastical +history of the Paumotus is, for the moment, uneventful. +There will be more doing before long, and these isles bid fair to +be the Scotland of the South. Two things I could never +learn. The nature of the innovations of the Rev. Mr. +Williams none would tell me, and of the meaning of the name +Kanitu none had a guess. It was not Tahitian, it was not +Marquesan; it formed no part of that ancient speech of the +Paumotus, now passing swiftly into obsolescence. One man, a +priest, God bless him! said it was the Latin for a little +dog. I have found it since as the name of a god in New +Guinea; it must be a bolder man than I who should hint at a +connection. Here, then, is a singular thing: a brand-new +sect, arising by popular acclamation, and a nonsense word +invented for its name.</p> +<p>The design of mystery seems obvious, and according to a very +intelligent observer, Mr. Magee of Mangareva, this element of the +mysterious is a chief attraction of the Mormon Church. It +enjoys some of the status of Freemasonry at home, and there is +for the convert some of the exhilaration of adventure. +Other attractions are certainly conjoined. Perpetual +rebaptism, leading to a succession of baptismal feasts, is found, +both from the social and the spiritual side, a pleasing +feature. More important is the fact that all the faithful +enjoy office; perhaps more important still, the strictness of the +discipline. ‘The veto on liquor,’ said Mr. +Magee, ‘brings them plenty members.’ There is +no doubt these islanders are fond of drink, and no doubt they +refrain from the indulgence; a bout on a feast-day, for instance, +may be followed by a week or a month of rigorous sobriety. +Mr. Wilmot attributes this to Paumotuan frugality and the love of +hoarding; it goes far deeper. I have mentioned that I made +a feast on board the <i>Casco</i>. To wash down +ship’s bread and jam, each guest was given the choice of +rum or syrup, and out of the whole number only one man +voted—in a defiant tone, and amid shouts of mirth—for +‘Trum’! This was in public. I had the +meanness to repeat the experiment, whenever I had a chance, +within the four walls of my house; and three at least, who had +refused at the festival, greedily drank rum behind a door. +But there were others thoroughly consistent. I said the +virtues of the race were bourgeois and puritan; and how bourgeois +is this! how puritanic! how Scottish! and how Yankee!—the +temptation, the resistance, the public hypocritical conformity, +the Pharisees, the Holy Willies, and the true disciples. +With such a people the popularity of an ascetic Church appears +legitimate; in these strict rules, in this perpetual supervision, +the weak find their advantage, the strong a certain pleasure; and +the doctrine of rebaptism, a clean bill and a fresh start, will +comfort many staggering professors.</p> +<p>There is yet another sect, or what is called a sect—no +doubt improperly—that of the Whistlers. Duncan +Cameron, so clear in favour of the Mormons, was no less loud in +condemnation of the Whistlers. Yet I do not know; I still +fancy there is some connection, perhaps fortuitous, probably +disavowed. Here at least are some doings in the house of an +Israelite clergyman (or prophet) in the island of Anaa, of which +I am equally sure that Duncan would disclaim and the Whistlers +hail them for an imitation of their own. My informant, a +Tahitian and a Catholic, occupied one part of the house; the +prophet and his family lived in the other. Night after +night the Mormons, in the one end, held their evening sacrifice +of song; night after night, in the other, the wife of the +Tahitian lay awake and listened to their singing with +amazement. At length she could contain herself no longer, +woke her husband, and asked him what he heard. ‘I +hear several persons singing hymns,’ said he. +‘Yes,’ she returned, ‘but listen again! +Do you not hear something supernatural?’ His +attention thus directed, he was aware of a strange buzzing +voice—and yet he declared it was beautiful—which +justly accompanied the singers. The next day he made +inquiries. ‘It is a spirit,’ said the prophet, +with entire simplicity, ‘which has lately made a practice +of joining us at family worship.’ It did not appear +the thing was visible, and like other spirits raised nearer home +in these degenerate days, it was rudely ignorant, at first could +only buzz, and had only learned of late to bear a part correctly +in the music.</p> +<p>The performances of the Whistlers are more +business-like. Their meetings are held publicly with open +doors, all being ‘cordially invited to attend.’ +The faithful sit about the room—according to one informant, +singing hymns; according to another, now singing and now +whistling; the leader, the wizard—let me rather say, the +medium—sits in the midst, enveloped in a sheet and silent; +and presently, from just above his head, or sometimes from the +midst of the roof, an aerial whistling proceeds, appalling to the +inexperienced. This, it appears, is the language of the +dead; its purport is taken down progressively by one of the +experts, writing, I was told, ‘as fast as a telegraph +operator’; and the communications are at last made +public. They are of the baldest triviality; a schooner is, +perhaps, announced, some idle gossip reported of a neighbour, or +if the spirit shall have been called to consultation on a case of +sickness, a remedy may be suggested. One of these, +immersion in scalding water, not long ago proved fatal to the +patient. The whole business is very dreary, very silly, and +very European; it has none of the picturesque qualities of +similar conjurations in New Zealand; it seems to possess no +kernel of possible sense, like some that I shall describe among +the Gilbert islanders. Yet I was told that many hardy, +intelligent natives were inveterate Whistlers. ‘Like +Mahinui?’ I asked, willing to have a standard; and I was +told ‘Yes.’ Why should I wonder? Men more +enlightened than my convict-catechist sit down at home to follies +equally sterile and dull.</p> +<p>The medium is sometimes female. It was a woman, for +instance, who introduced these practices on the north coast of +Taiarapu, to the scandal of her own connections, her +brother-in-law in particular declaring she was drunk. But +what shocked Tahiti might seem fit enough in the Paumotus, the +more so as certain women there possess, by the gift of nature, +singular and useful powers. They say they are honest, +well-intentioned ladies, some of them embarrassed by their weird +inheritance. And indeed the trouble caused by this +endowment is so great, and the protection afforded so +infinitesimally small, that I hesitate whether to call it a gift +or a hereditary curse. You may rob this lady’s +coco-patch, steal her canoes, burn down her house, and slay her +family scatheless; but one thing you must not do: you must not +lay a hand upon her sleeping-mat, or your belly will swell, and +you can only be cured by the lady or her husband. Here is +the report of an eye-witness, Tasmanian born, educated, a man who +has made money—certainly no fool. In 1886 he was +present in a house on Makatea, where two lads began to skylark on +the mats, and were (I think) ejected. Instantly after, +their bellies began to swell; pains took hold on them; all manner +of island remedies were exhibited in vain, and rubbing only +magnified their sufferings. The man of the house was +called, explained the nature of the visitation, and prepared the +cure. A cocoa-nut was husked, filled with herbs, and with +all the ceremonies of a launch, and the utterance of spells in +the Paumotuan language, committed to the sea. From that +moment the pains began to grow more easy and the swelling to +subside. The reader may stare. I can assure him, if +he moved much among old residents of the archipelago, he would be +driven to admit one thing of two—either that there is +something in the swollen bellies or nothing in the evidence of +man.</p> +<p>I have not met these gifted ladies; but I had an experience of +my own, for I have played, for one night only, the part of the +whistling spirit. It had been blowing wearily all day, but +with the fall of night the wind abated, and the moon, which was +then full, rolled in a clear sky. We went southward down +the island on the side of the lagoon, walking through long-drawn +forest aisles of palm, and on a floor of snowy sand. No +life was abroad, nor sound of life; till in a clear part of the +isle we spied the embers of a fire, and not far off, in a dark +house, heard natives talking softly. To sit without a +light, even in company, and under cover, is for a Paumotuan a +somewhat hazardous extreme. The whole scene—the +strong moonlight and crude shadows on the sand, the scattered +coals, the sound of the low voices from the house, and the lap of +the lagoon along the beach—put me (I know not how) on +thoughts of superstition. I was barefoot, I observed my +steps were noiseless, and drawing near to the dark house, but +keeping well in shadow, began to whistle. ‘The +Heaving of the Lead’ was my air—no very tragic +piece. With the first note the conversation and all +movement ceased; silence accompanied me while I continued; and +when I passed that way on my return I found the lamp was lighted +in the house, but the tongues were still mute. All night, +as I now think, the wretches shivered and were silent. For +indeed, I had no guess at the time at the nature and magnitude of +the terrors I inflicted, or with what grisly images the notes of +that old song had peopled the dark house.</p> +<h3>CHAPTER V—A PAUMOTUAN FUNERAL</h3> +<p>No, I had no guess of these men’s terrors. Yet I +had received ere that a hint, if I had understood; and the +occasion was a funeral.</p> +<p>A little apart in the main avenue of Rotoava, in a low hut of +leaves that opened on a small enclosure, like a pigsty on a pen, +an old man dwelt solitary with his aged wife. Perhaps they +were too old to migrate with the others; perhaps they were too +poor, and had no possessions to dispute. At least they had +remained behind; and it thus befell that they were invited to my +feast. I dare say it was quite a piece of politics in the +pigsty whether to come or not to come, and the husband long +swithered between curiosity and age, till curiosity conquered, +and they came, and in the midst of that last merrymaking death +tapped him on the shoulder. For some days, when the sky was +bright and the wind cool, his mat would be spread in the main +highway of the village, and he was to be seen lying there inert, +a mere handful of a man, his wife inertly seated by his +head. They seemed to have outgrown alike our needs and +faculties; they neither spoke nor listened; they suffered us to +pass without a glance; the wife did not fan, she seemed not to +attend upon her husband, and the two poor antiques sat juxtaposed +under the high canopy of palms, the human tragedy reduced to its +bare elements, a sight beyond pathos, stirring a thrill of +curiosity. And yet there was one touch of the pathetic +haunted me: that so much youth and expectation should have run in +these starved veins, and the man should have squandered all his +lees of life on a pleasure party.</p> +<p>On the morning of 17th September the sufferer died, and, time +pressing, he was buried the same day at four. The cemetery +lies to seaward behind Government House; broken coral, like so +much road-metal, forms the surface; a few wooden crosses, a few +inconsiderable upright stones, designate graves; a mortared wall, +high enough to lean on, rings it about; a clustering shrub +surrounds it with pale leaves. Here was the grave dug that +morning, doubtless by uneasy diggers, to the sound of the nigh +sea and the cries of sea-birds; meanwhile the dead man waited in +his house, and the widow and another aged woman leaned on the +fence before the door, no speech upon their lips, no speculation +in their eyes.</p> +<p>Sharp at the hour the procession was in march, the coffin +wrapped in white and carried by four bearers; mourners +behind—not many, for not many remained in Rotoava, and not +many in black, for these were poor; the men in straw hats, white +coats, and blue trousers or the gorgeous parti-coloured pariu, +the Tahitian kilt; the women, with a few exceptions, brightly +habited. Far in the rear came the widow, painfully carrying +the dead man’s mat; a creature aged beyond humanity, to the +likeness of some missing link.</p> +<p>The dead man had been a Mormon; but the Mormon clergyman was +gone with the rest to wrangle over boundaries in the adjacent +isle, and a layman took his office. Standing at the head of +the open grave, in a white coat and blue pariu, his Tahitian +Bible in his hand and one eye bound with a red handkerchief, he +read solemnly that chapter in Job which has been read and heard +over the bones of so many of our fathers, and with a good voice +offered up two prayers. The wind and the surf bore a +burthen. By the cemetery gate a mother in crimson suckled +an infant rolled in blue. In the midst the widow sat upon +the ground and polished one of the coffin-stretchers with a piece +of coral; a little later she had turned her back to the grave and +was playing with a leaf. Did she understand? God +knows. The officiant paused a moment, stooped, and gathered +and threw reverently on the coffin a handful of rattling +coral. Dust to dust: but the grains of this dust were gross +like cherries, and the true dust that was to follow sat near by, +still cohering (as by a miracle) in the tragic semblance of a +female ape.</p> +<p>So far, Mormon or not, it was a Christian funeral. The +well-known passage had been read from Job, the prayers had been +rehearsed, the grave was filled, the mourners straggled +homeward. With a little coarser grain of covering earth, a +little nearer outcry of the sea, a stronger glare of sunlight on +the rude enclosure, and some incongruous colours of attire, the +well-remembered form had been observed.</p> +<p>By rights it should have been otherwise. The mat should +have been buried with its owner; but, the family being poor, it +was thriftily reserved for a fresh service. The widow +should have flung herself upon the grave and raised the voice of +official grief, the neighbours have chimed in, and the narrow +isle rung for a space with lamentation. But the widow was +old; perhaps she had forgotten, perhaps never understood, and she +played like a child with leaves and coffin-stretchers. In +all ways my guest was buried with maimed rites. Strange to +think that his last conscious pleasure was the <i>Casco</i> and +my feast; strange to think that he had limped there, an old +child, looking for some new good. And the good thing, rest, +had been allotted him.</p> +<p>But though the widow had neglected much, there was one part +she must not utterly neglect. She came away with the +dispersing funeral; but the dead man’s mat was left behind +upon the grave, and I learned that by set of sun she must return +to sleep there. This vigil is imperative. From +sundown till the rising of the morning star the Paumotuan must +hold his watch above the ashes of his kindred. Many +friends, if the dead have been a man of mark, will keep the +watchers company; they will be well supplied with coverings +against the weather; I believe they bring food, and the rite is +persevered in for two weeks. Our poor survivor, if, indeed, +she properly survived, had little to cover, and few to sit with +her; on the night of the funeral a strong squall chased her from +her place of watch; for days the weather held uncertain and +outrageous; and ere seven nights were up she had desisted, and +returned to sleep in her low roof. That she should be at +the pains of returning for so short a visit to a solitary house, +that this borderer of the grave should fear a little wind and a +wet blanket, filled me at the time with musings. I could +not say she was indifferent; she was so far beyond me in +experience that the court of my criticism waived jurisdiction; +but I forged excuses, telling myself she had perhaps little to +lament, perhaps suffered much, perhaps understood nothing. +And lo! in the whole affair there was no question whether of +tenderness or piety, and the sturdy return of this old remnant +was a mark either of uncommon sense or of uncommon fortitude.</p> +<p>Yet one thing had occurred that partly set me on the +trail. I have said the funeral passed much as at +home. But when all was over, when we were trooping in +decent silence from the graveyard gate and down the path to the +settlement, a sudden inbreak of a different spirit startled and +perhaps dismayed us. Two people walked not far apart in our +procession: my friend Mr. Donat—Donat-Rimarau: ‘Donat +the much-handed’—acting Vice-Resident, present ruler +of the archipelago, by far the man of chief importance on the +scene, but known besides for one of an unshakable good temper; +and a certain comely, strapping young Paumotuan woman, the +comeliest on the isle, not (let us hope) the bravest or the most +polite. Of a sudden, ere yet the grave silence of the +funeral was broken, she made a leap at the Resident, with pointed +finger, shrieked a few words, and fell back again with a +laughter, not a natural mirth. ‘What did she say to +you?’ I asked. ‘She did not speak to +<i>me</i>,’ said Donat, a shade perturbed; ‘she spoke +to the ghost of the dead man.’ And the purport of her +speech was this: ‘See there! Donat will be a fine +feast for you to-night.’</p> +<p>‘M. Donat called it a jest,’ I wrote at the time +in my diary. ‘It seemed to me more in the nature of a +terrified conjuration, as though she would divert the +ghost’s attention from herself. A cannibal race may +well have cannibal phantoms.’ The guesses of the +traveller appear foredoomed to be erroneous; yet in these I was +precisely right. The woman had stood by in terror at the +funeral, being then in a dread spot, the graveyard. She +looked on in terror to the coming night, with that ogre, a new +spirit, loosed upon the isle. And the words she had cried +in Donat’s face were indeed a terrified conjuration, basely +to shield herself, basely to dedicate another in her stead. +One thing is to be said in her excuse. Doubtless she partly +chose Donat because he was a man of great good-nature, but +partly, too, because he was a man of the half-caste. For I +believe all natives regard white blood as a kind of talisman +against the powers of hell. In no other way can they +explain the unpunished recklessness of Europeans.</p> +<h3>CHAPTER VI—GRAVEYARD STORIES</h3> +<p>With my superstitious friend, the islander, I fear I am not +wholly frank, often leading the way with stories of my own, and +being always a grave and sometimes an excited hearer. But +the deceit is scarce mortal, since I am as pleased to hear as he +to tell, as pleased with the story as he with the belief; and, +besides, it is entirely needful. For it is scarce possible +to exaggerate the extent and empire of his superstitions; they +mould his life, they colour his thinking; and when he does not +speak to me of ghosts, and gods, and devils, he is playing the +dissembler and talking only with his lips. With thoughts so +different, one must indulge the other; and I would rather that I +should indulge his superstition than he my incredulity. Of +one thing, besides, I may be sure: Let me indulge it as I please, +I shall not hear the whole; for he is already on his guard with +me, and the amount of the lore is boundless.</p> +<p>I will give but a few instances at random, chiefly from my own +doorstep in Upolu, during the past month (October 1890). +One of my workmen was sent the other day to the banana patch, +there to dig; this is a hollow of the mountain, buried in woods, +out of all sight and cry of mankind; and long before dusk Lafaele +was back again beside the cook-house with embarrassed looks; he +dared not longer stay alone, he was afraid of ‘spirits in +the bush.’ It seems these are the souls of the +unburied dead, haunting where they fell, and wearing woodland +shapes of pig, or bird, or insect; the bush is full of them, they +seem to eat nothing, slay solitary wanderers apparently in spite, +and at times, in human form, go down to villages and consort with +the inhabitants undetected. So much I learned a day or so +after, walking in the bush with a very intelligent youth, a +native. It was a little before noon; a grey day and +squally; and perhaps I had spoken lightly. A dark squall +burst on the side of the mountain; the woods shook and cried; the +dead leaves rose from the ground in clouds, like butterflies; and +my companion came suddenly to a full stop. He was afraid, +he said, of the trees falling; but as soon as I had changed the +subject of our talk he proceeded with alacrity. A day or +two before a messenger came up the mountain from Apia with a +letter; I was in the bush, he must await my return, then wait +till I had answered: and before I was done his voice sounded +shrill with terror of the coming night and the long forest +road. These are the commons. Take the chiefs. +There has been a great coming and going of signs and omens in our +group. One river ran down blood; red eels were captured in +another; an unknown fish was thrown upon the coast, an ominous +word found written on its scales. So far we might be +reading in a monkish chronicle; now we come on a fresh note, at +once modern and Polynesian. The gods of Upolu and Savaii, +our two chief islands, contended recently at cricket. Since +then they are at war. Sounds of battle are heard to roll +along the coast. A woman saw a man swim from the high seas +and plunge direct into the bush; he was no man of that +neighbourhood; and it was known he was one of the gods, speeding +to a council. Most perspicuous of all, a missionary on +Savaii, who is also a medical man, was disturbed late in the +night by knocking; it was no hour for the dispensary, but at +length he woke his servant and sent him to inquire; the servant, +looking from a window, beheld crowds of persons, all with +grievous wounds, lopped limbs, broken heads, and bleeding +bullet-holes; but when the door was opened all had +disappeared. They were gods from the field of battle. +Now these reports have certainly significance; it is not hard to +trace them to political grumblers or to read in them a threat of +coming trouble; from that merely human side I found them ominous +myself. But it was the spiritual side of their significance +that was discussed in secret council by my rulers. I shall +best depict this mingled habit of the Polynesian mind by two +connected instances. I once lived in a village, the name of +which I do not mean to tell. The chief and his sister were +persons perfectly intelligent: gentlefolk, apt of speech. +The sister was very religious, a great church-goer, one that used +to reprove me if I stayed away; I found afterwards that she +privately worshipped a shark. The chief himself was +somewhat of a freethinker; at the least, a latitudinarian: he was +a man, besides, filled with European knowledge and +accomplishments; of an impassive, ironical habit; and I should as +soon have expected superstition in Mr. Herbert Spencer. +Hear the sequel. I had discovered by unmistakable signs +that they buried too shallow in the village graveyard, and I took +my friend, as the responsible authority, to task. +‘There is something wrong about your graveyard,’ said +I, ‘which you must attend to, or it may have very bad +results.’ ‘Something wrong? What is +it?’ he asked, with an emotion that surprised me. +‘If you care to go along there any evening about nine +o’clock you can see for yourself,’ said I. He +stepped backward. ‘A ghost!’ he cried.</p> +<p>In short, in the whole field of the South Seas, there is not +one to blame another. Half blood and whole, pious and +debauched, intelligent and dull, all men believe in ghosts, all +men combine with their recent Christianity fear of and a +lingering faith in the old island deities. So, in Europe, +the gods of Olympus slowly dwindled into village bogies; so +to-day, the theological Highlander sneaks from under the eye of +the Free Church divine to lay an offering by a sacred well.</p> +<p>I try to deal with the whole matter here because of a +particular quality in Paumotuan superstitions. It is true I +heard them told by a man with a genius for such narrations. +Close about our evening lamp, within sound of the island surf, we +hung on his words, thrilling. The reader, in far other +scenes, must listen close for the faint echo.</p> +<p>This bundle of weird stories sprang from the burial and the +woman’s selfish conjuration. I was dissatisfied with +what I heard, harped upon questions, and struck at last this vein +of metal. It is from sundown to about four in the morning +that the kinsfolk camp upon the grave; and these are the hours of +the spirits’ wanderings. At any time of the +night—it may be earlier, it may be later—a sound is +to be heard below, which is the noise of his liberation; at four +sharp, another and a louder marks the instant of the +re-imprisonment; between-whiles, he goes his malignant +rounds. ‘Did you ever see an evil spirit?’ was +once asked of a Paumotuan. ‘Once.’ +‘Under what form?’ ‘It was in the form of +a crane.’ ‘And how did you know that crane to +be a spirit?’ was asked. ‘I will tell +you,’ he answered; and this was the purport of his +inconclusive narrative. His father had been dead nearly a +fortnight; others had wearied of the watch; and as the sun was +setting, he found himself by the grave alone. It was not +yet dark, rather the hour of the afterglow, when he was aware of +a snow-white crane upon the coral mound; presently more cranes +came, some white, some black; then the cranes vanished, and he +saw in their place a white cat, to which there was silently +joined a great company of cats of every hue conceivable; then +these also disappeared, and he was left astonished.</p> +<p>This was an anodyne appearance. Take instead the +experience of Rua-a-mariterangi on the isle of Katiu. He +had a need for some pandanus, and crossed the isle to the +sea-beach, where it chiefly flourishes. The day was still, +and Rua was surprised to hear a crashing sound among the +thickets, and then the fall of a considerable tree. Here +must be some one building a canoe; and he entered the margin of +the wood to find and pass the time of day with this chance +neighbour. The crashing sounded more at hand; and then he +was aware of something drawing swiftly near among the +tree-tops. It swung by its heels downward, like an ape, so +that its hands were free for murder; it depended safely by the +slightest twigs; the speed of its coming was incredible; and soon +Rua recognised it for a corpse, horrible with age, its bowels +hanging as it came. Prayer was the weapon of Christian in +the Valley of the Shadow, and it is to prayer that +Rua-a-mariterangi attributes his escape. No merely human +expedition had availed.</p> +<p>This demon was plainly from the grave; yet you will observe he +was abroad by day. And inconsistent as it may seem with the +hours of the night watch and the many references to the rising of +the morning star, it is no singular exception. I could +never find a case of another who had seen this ghost, diurnal and +arboreal in its habits; but others have heard the fall of the +tree, which seems the signal of its coming. Mr. Donat was +once pearling on the uninhabited isle of Haraiki. It was a +day without a breath of wind, such as alternate in the +archipelago with days of contumelious breezes. The divers +were in the midst of the lagoon upon their employment; the cook, +a boy of ten, was over his pots in the camp. Thus were all +souls accounted for except a single native who accompanied Donat +into the wood in quest of sea-fowls’ eggs. In a +moment, out of the stillness, came the sound of the fall of a +great tree. Donat would have passed on to find the +cause. ‘No,’ cried his companion, ‘that +was no tree. It was something <i>not right</i>. Let +us go back to camp.’ Next Sunday the divers were +turned on, all that part of the isle was thoroughly examined, and +sure enough no tree had fallen. A little later Mr. Donat +saw one of his divers flee from a similar sound, in similar +unaffected panic, on the same isle. But neither would +explain, and it was not till afterwards, when he met with Rua, +that he learned the occasion of their terrors.</p> +<p>But whether by day or night, the purpose of the dead in these +abhorred activities is still the same. In Samoa, my +informant had no idea of the food of the bush spirits; no such +ambiguity would exist in the mind of a Paumotuan. In that +hungry archipelago, living and dead must alike toil for +nutriment; and the race having been cannibal in the past, the +spirits are so still. When the living ate the dead, +horrified nocturnal imagination drew the shocking inference that +the dead might eat the living. Doubtless they slay men, +doubtless even mutilate them, in mere malice. Marquesan +spirits sometimes tear out the eyes of travellers; but even that +may be more practical than appears, for the eye is a cannibal +dainty. And certainly the root-idea of the dead, at least +in the far eastern islands, is to prowl for food. It was as +a dainty morsel for a meal that the woman denounced Donat at the +funeral. There are spirits besides who prey in particular +not on the bodies but on the souls of the dead. The point +is clearly made in a Tahitian story. A child fell sick, +grew swiftly worse, and at last showed signs of death. The +mother hastened to the house of a sorcerer, who lived hard +by. ‘You are yet in time,’ said he; ‘a +spirit has just run past my door carrying the soul of your child +wrapped in the leaf of a purao; but I have a spirit stronger and +swifter who will run him down ere he has time to eat +it.’ Wrapped in a leaf: like other things edible and +corruptible.</p> +<p>Or take an experience of Mr. Donat’s on the island of +Anaa. It was a night of a high wind, with violent squalls; +his child was very sick, and the father, though he had gone to +bed, lay wakeful, hearkening to the gale. All at once a +fowl was violently dashed on the house wall. Supposing he +had forgot to put it in shelter with the rest, Donat arose, found +the bird (a cock) lying on the verandah, and put it in the +hen-house, the door of which he securely fastened. Fifteen +minutes later the business was repeated, only this time, as it +was being dashed against the wall, the bird crew. Again +Donat replaced it, examining the hen-house thoroughly and finding +it quite perfect; as he was so engaged the wind puffed out his +light, and he must grope back to the door a good deal +shaken. Yet a third time the bird was dashed upon the wall; +a third time Donat set it, now near dead, beside its mates; and +he was scarce returned before there came a rush, like that of a +furious strong man, against the door, and a whistle as loud as +that of a railway engine rang about the house. The +sceptical reader may here detect the finger of the tempest; but +the women gave up all for lost and clustered on the beds +lamenting. Nothing followed, and I must suppose the gale +somewhat abated, for presently after a chief came visiting. +He was a bold man to be abroad so late, but doubtless carried a +bright lantern. And he was certainly a man of counsel, for +as soon as he heard the details of these disturbances he was in a +position to explain their nature. ‘Your child,’ +said he, ‘must certainly die. This is the evil spirit +of our island who lies in wait to eat the spirits of the newly +dead.’ And then he went on to expatiate on the +strangeness of the spirit’s conduct. He was not +usually, he explained, so open of assault, but sat silent on the +house-top waiting, in the guise of a bird, while within the +people tended the dying and bewailed the dead, and had no thought +of peril. But when the day came and the doors were opened, +and men began to go abroad, blood-stains on the wall betrayed the +tragedy.</p> +<p>This is the quality I admire in Paumotuan legend. In +Tahiti the spirit-eater is said to assume a vesture which has +much more of pomp, but how much less of horror. It has been +seen by all sorts and conditions, native and foreign; only the +last insist it is a meteor. My authority was not so +sure. He was riding with his wife about two in the morning; +both were near asleep, and the horses not much better. It +was a brilliant and still night, and the road wound over a +mountain, near by a deserted marae (old Tahitian temple). +All at once the appearance passed above them: a form of light; +the head round and greenish; the body long, red, and with a focus +of yet redder brilliancy about the midst. A buzzing hoot +accompanied its passage; it flew direct out of one marae, and +direct for another down the mountain side. And this, as my +informant argued, is suggestive. For why should a mere +meteor frequent the altars of abominable gods? The horses, +I should say, were equally dismayed with their riders. Now +I am not dismayed at all—not even agreeably. Give me +rather the bird upon the house-top and the morning blood-gouts on +the wall.</p> +<p>But the dead are not exclusive in their diet. They carry +with them to the grave, in particular, the Polynesian taste for +fish, and enter at times with the living into a partnership in +fishery. Rua-a-mariterangi is again my authority; I feel it +diminishes the credit of the fact, but how it builds up the image +of this inveterate ghost-seer! He belongs to the miserably +poor island of Taenga, yet his father’s house was always +well supplied. As Rua grew up he was called at last to go +a-fishing with this fortunate parent. They rowed the lagoon +at dusk, to an unlikely place, and the lay down in the stern, and +the father began vainly to cast his line over the bows. It +is to be supposed that Rua slept; and when he awoke there was the +figure of another beside his father, and his father was pulling +in the fish hand over hand. ‘Who is that man, +father?’ Rua asked. ‘It is none of your +business,’ said the father; and Rua supposed the stranger +had swum off to them from shore. Night after night they +fared into the lagoon, often to the most unlikely places; night +after night the stranger would suddenly be seen on board, and as +suddenly be missed; and morning after morning the canoe returned +laden with fish. ‘My father is a very lucky +man,’ thought Rua. At last, one fine day, there came +first one boat party and then another, who must be entertained; +father and son put off later than usual into the lagoon; and +before the canoe was landed it was four o’clock, and the +morning star was close on the horizon. Then the stranger +appeared seized with some distress; turned about, showing for the +first time his face, which was that of one long dead, with +shining eyes; stared into the east, set the tips of his fingers +to his mouth like one a-cold, uttered a strange, shuddering sound +between a whistle and a moan—a thing to freeze the blood; +and, the day-star just rising from the sea, he suddenly was +not. Then Rua understood why his father prospered, why his +fishes rotted early in the day, and why some were always carried +to the cemetery and laid upon the graves. My informant is a +man not certainly averse to superstition, but he keeps his head, +and takes a certain superior interest, which I may be allowed to +call scientific. The last point reminding him of some +parallel practice in Tahiti, he asked Rua if the fish were left, +or carried home again after a formal dedication. It appears +old Mariterangi practised both methods; sometimes treating his +shadowy partner to a mere oblation, sometimes honestly leaving +his fish to rot upon the grave.</p> +<p>It is plain we have in Europe stories of a similar complexion; +and the Polynesian <i>varua ino</i> or <i>aitu o le vao</i> is +clearly the near kinsman of the Transylvanian vampire. Here +is a tale in which the kinship appears broadly marked. On +the atoll of Penrhyn, then still partly savage, a certain chief +was long the salutary terror of the natives. He died, he +was buried; and his late neighbours had scarce tasted the +delights of licence ere his ghost appeared about the +village. Fear seized upon all; a council was held of the +chief men and sorcerers; and with the approval of the Rarotongan +missionary, who was as frightened as the rest, and in the +presence of several whites—my friend Mr. Ben Hird being +one—the grave was opened, deepened until water came, and +the body re-interred face down. The still recent staking of +suicides in England and the decapitation of vampires in the east +of Europe form close parallels.</p> +<p>So in Samoa only the spirits of the unburied awake fear. +During the late war many fell in the bush; their bodies, +sometimes headless, were brought back by native pastors and +interred; but this (I know not why) was insufficient, and the +spirit still lingered on the theatre of death. When peace +returned a singular scene was enacted in many places, and chiefly +round the high gorges of Lotoanuu, where the struggle was long +centred and the loss had been severe. Kinswomen of the dead +came carrying a mat or sheet and guided by survivors of the +fight. The place of death was earnestly sought out; the +sheet was spread upon the ground; and the women, moved with pious +anxiety, sat about and watched it. If any living thing +alighted it was twice brushed away; upon the third coming it was +known to be the spirit of the dead, was folded in, carried home +and buried beside the body; and the aitu rested. The rite +was practised beyond doubt in simple piety; the repose of the +soul was its object: its motive, reverent affection. The +present king disowns indeed all knowledge of a dangerous aitu; he +declares the souls of the unburied were only wanderers in limbo, +lacking an entrance to the proper country of the dead, unhappy, +nowise hurtful. And this severely classic opinion doubtless +represents the views of the enlightened. But the flight of +my Lafaele marks the grosser terrors of the ignorant.</p> +<p>This belief in the exorcising efficacy of funeral rites +perhaps explains a fact, otherwise amazing, that no Polynesian +seems at all to share our European horror of human bones and +mummies. Of the first they made their cherished ornaments; +they preserved them in houses or in mortuary caves; and the +watchers of royal sepulchres dwelt with their children among the +bones of generations. The mummy, even in the making, was as +little feared. In the Marquesas, on the extreme coast, it +was made by the household with continual unction and exposure to +the sun; in the Carolines, upon the farthest west, it is still +cured in the smoke of the family hearth. Head-hunting, +besides, still lives around my doorstep in Samoa. And not +ten years ago, in the Gilberts, the widow must disinter, cleanse, +polish, and thenceforth carry about her, by day and night, the +head of her dead husband. In all these cases we may suppose +the process, whether of cleansing or drying, to have fully +exorcised the aitu.</p> +<p>But the Paumotuan belief is more obscure. Here the man +is duly buried, and he has to be watched. He is duly +watched, and the spirit goes abroad in spite of watches. +Indeed, it is not the purpose of the vigils to prevent these +wanderings; only to mollify by polite attention the inveterate +malignity of the dead. Neglect (it is supposed) may +irritate and thus invite his visits, and the aged and weakly +sometimes balance risks and stay at home. Observe, it is +the dead man’s kindred and next friends who thus deprecate +his fury with nocturnal watchings. Even the placatory vigil +is held perilous, except in company, and a boy was pointed out to +me in Rotoava, because he had watched alone by his own +father. Not the ties of the dead, nor yet their proved +character, affect the issue. A late Resident, who died in +Fakarava of sunstroke, was beloved in life and is still +remembered with affection; none the less his spirit went about +the island clothed with terrors, and the neighbourhood of +Government House was still avoided after dark. We may sum +up the cheerful doctrine thus: All men become vampires, and the +vampire spares none. And here we come face to face with a +tempting inconsistency. For the whistling spirits are +notoriously clannish; I understood them to wait upon and to +enlighten kinsfolk only, and that the medium was always of the +race of the communicating spirit. Here, then, we have the +bonds of the family, on the one hand, severed at the hour of +death; on the other, helpfully persisting.</p> +<p>The child’s soul in the Tahitian tale was wrapped in +leaves. It is the spirits of the newly dead that are the +dainty. When they are slain, the house is stained with +blood. Rua’s dead fisherman was decomposed; +so—and horribly—was his arboreal demon. The +spirit, then, is a thing material; and it is by the material +ensigns of corruption that he is distinguished from the living +man. This opinion is widespread, adds a gross terror to the +more ugly Polynesian tales, and sometimes defaces the more +engaging with a painful and incongruous touch. I will give +two examples sufficiently wide apart, one from Tahiti, one from +Samoa.</p> +<p>And first from Tahiti. A man went to visit the husband +of his sister, then some time dead. In her life the sister +had been dainty in the island fashion, and went always adorned +with a coronet of flowers. In the midst of the night the +brother awoke and was aware of a heavenly fragrance going to and +fro in the dark house. The lamp I must suppose to have +burned out; no Tahitian would have lain down without one +lighted. A while he lay wondering and delighted; then +called upon the rest. ‘Do none of you smell +flowers?’ he asked. ‘O,’ said his +brother-in-law, ‘we are used to that here.’ The +next morning these two men went walking, and the widower +confessed that his dead wife came about the house continually, +and that he had even seen her. She was shaped and dressed +and crowned with flowers as in her lifetime; only she moved a few +inches above the earth with a very easy progress, and flitted +dryshod above the surface of the river. And now comes my +point: It was always in a back view that she appeared; and these +brothers-in-law, debating the affair, agreed that this was to +conceal the inroads of corruption.</p> +<p>Now for the Samoan story. I owe it to the kindness of +Dr. F. Otto Sierich, whose collection of folk-tales I expect with +a high degree of interest. A man in Manu’a was +married to two wives and had no issue. He went to Savaii, +married there a third, and was more fortunate. When his +wife was near her time he remembered he was in a strange island, +like a poor man; and when his child was born he must be shamed +for lack of gifts. It was in vain his wife dissuaded +him. He returned to his father in Manu’a seeking +help; and with what he could get he set off in the night to +re-embark. Now his wives heard of his coming; they were +incensed that he did not stay to visit them; and on the beach, by +his canoe, intercepted and slew him. Now the third wife lay +asleep in Savaii;—her babe was born and slept by her side; +and she was awakened by the spirit of her husband. +‘Get up,’ he said, ‘my father is sick in +Manu’a and we must go to visit him.’ ‘It +is well,’ said she; ‘take you the child, while I +carry its mats.’ ‘I cannot carry the +child,’ said the spirit; ‘I am too cold from the +sea.’ When they were got on board the canoe the wife +smelt carrion. ‘How is this?’ she said. +‘What have you in the canoe that I should smell +carrion?’ ‘It is nothing in the canoe,’ +said the spirit. ‘It is the land-wind blowing down +the mountains, where some beast lies dead.’ It +appears it was still night when they reached +Manu’a—the swiftest passage on record—and as +they entered the reef the bale-fires burned in the village. +Again she asked him to carry the child; but now he need no more +dissemble. ‘I cannot carry your child,’ said +he, ‘for I am dead, and the fires you see are burning for +my funeral.’</p> +<p>The curious may learn in Dr. Sierich’s book the +unexpected sequel of the tale. Here is enough for my +purpose. Though the man was but new dead, the ghost was +already putrefied, as though putrefaction were the mark and of +the essence of a spirit. The vigil on the Paumotuan grave +does not extend beyond two weeks, and they told me this period +was thought to coincide with that of the resolution of the +body. The ghost always marked with decay—the danger +seemingly ending with the process of dissolution—here is +tempting matter for the theorist. But it will not do. +The lady of the flowers had been long dead, and her spirit was +still supposed to bear the brand of perishability. The +Resident had been more than a fortnight buried, and his vampire +was still supposed to go the rounds.</p> +<p>Of the lost state of the dead, from the lurid Mangaian legend, +in which infernal deities hocus and destroy the souls of all, to +the various submarine and aerial limbos where the dead feast, +float idle, or resume the occupations of their life on earth, it +would be wearisome to tell. One story I give, for it is +singular in itself, is well-known in Tahiti, and has this of +interest, that it is post-Christian, dating indeed from but a few +years back. A princess of the reigning house died; was +transported to the neighbouring isle of Raiatea; fell there under +the empire of a spirit who condemned her to climb coco-palms all +day and bring him the nuts; was found after some time in this +miserable servitude by a second spirit, one of her own house; and +by him, upon her lamentations, reconveyed to Tahiti, where she +found her body still waked, but already swollen with the +approaches of corruption. It is a lively point in the tale +that, on the sight of this dishonoured tabernacle, the princess +prayed she might continue to be numbered with the dead. But +it seems it was too late, her spirit was replaced by the least +dignified of entrances, and her startled family beheld the body +move. The seemingly purgatorial labours, the helpful +kindred spirit, and the horror of the princess at the sight of +her tainted body, are all points to be remarked.</p> +<p>The truth is, the tales are not necessarily consistent in +themselves; and they are further darkened for the stranger by an +ambiguity of language. Ghosts, vampires, spirits, and gods +are all confounded. And yet I seem to perceive that (with +exceptions) those whom we would count gods were less +maleficent. Permanent spirits haunt and do murder in +corners of Samoa; but those legitimate gods of Upolu and Savaii, +whose wars and cricketings of late convulsed society, I did not +gather to be dreaded, or not with a like fear. The spirit +of Aana that ate souls is certainly a fearsome inmate; but the +high gods, even of the archipelago, seem helpful. +Mahinui—from whom our convict-catechist had been +named—the spirit of the sea, like a Proteus endowed with +endless avatars, came to the assistance of the shipwrecked and +carried them ashore in the guise of a ray fish. The same +divinity bore priests from isle to isle about the archipelago, +and by his aid, within the century, persons have been seen to +fly. The tutelar deity of each isle is likewise helpful, +and by a particular form of wedge-shaped cloud on the horizon +announces the coming of a ship.</p> +<p>To one who conceives of these atolls, so narrow, so barren, so +beset with sea, here would seem a superfluity of ghostly +denizens. And yet there are more. In the various +brackish pools and ponds, beautiful women with long red hair are +seen to rise and bathe; only (timid as mice) on the first sound +of feet upon the coral they dive again for ever. They are +known to be healthy and harmless living people, dwellers of an +underworld; and the same fancy is current in Tahiti, where also +they have the hair red. <i>Tetea</i> is the Tahitian name; +the Paumotuan, <i>Mokurea</i>.</p> +<h2>PART III: THE GILBERTS</h2> +<h3>CHAPTER I—BUTARITARI</h3> +<p>At Honolulu we had said farewell to the <i>Casco</i> and to +Captain Otis, and our next adventure was made in changed +conditions. Passage was taken for myself, my wife, Mr. +Osbourne, and my China boy, Ah Fu, on a pigmy trading schooner, +the <i>Equator</i>, Captain Dennis Reid; and on a certain bright +June day in 1889, adorned in the Hawaiian fashion with the +garlands of departure, we drew out of port and bore with a fair +wind for Micronesia.</p> +<p>The whole extent of the South Seas is a desert of ships; more +especially that part where we were now to sail. No post +runs in these islands; communication is by accident; where you +may have designed to go is one thing, where you shall be able to +arrive another. It was my hope, for instance, to have +reached the Carolines, and returned to the light of day by way of +Manila and the China ports; and it was in Samoa that we were +destined to re-appear and be once more refreshed with the sight +of mountains. Since the sunset faded from the peaks of Oahu +six months had intervened, and we had seen no spot of earth so +high as an ordinary cottage. Our path had been still on the +flat sea, our dwellings upon unerected coral, our diet from the +pickle-tub or out of tins; I had learned to welcome shark’s +flesh for a variety; and a mountain, an onion, an Irish potato or +a beef-steak, had been long lost to sense and dear to +aspiration.</p> +<p>The two chief places of our stay, Butaritari and Apemama, lie +near the line; the latter within thirty miles. Both enjoy a +superb ocean climate, days of blinding sun and bracing wind, +nights of a heavenly brightness. Both are somewhat wider +than Fakarava, measuring perhaps (at the widest) a quarter of a +mile from beach to beach. In both, a coarse kind of +<i>taro</i> thrives; its culture is a chief business of the +natives, and the consequent mounds and ditches make miniature +scenery and amuse the eye. In all else they show the +customary features of an atoll: the low horizon, the expanse of +the lagoon, the sedge-like rim of palm-tops, the sameness and +smallness of the land, the hugely superior size and interest of +sea and sky. Life on such islands is in many points like +life on shipboard. The atoll, like the ship, is soon taken +for granted; and the islanders, like the ship’s crew, +become soon the centre of attention. The isles are +populous, independent, seats of kinglets, recently civilised, +little visited. In the last decade many changes have crept +in; women no longer go unclothed till marriage; the widow no +longer sleeps at night and goes abroad by day with the skull of +her dead husband; and, fire-arms being introduced, the spear and +the shark-tooth sword are sold for curiosities. Ten years +ago all these things and practices were to be seen in use; yet +ten years more, and the old society will have entirely +vanished. We came in a happy moment to see its institutions +still erect and (in Apemama) scarce decayed.</p> +<p>Populous and independent—warrens of men, ruled over with +some rustic pomp—such was the first and still the recurring +impression of these tiny lands. As we stood across the +lagoon for the town of Butaritari, a stretch of the low shore was +seen to be crowded with the brown roofs of houses; those of the +palace and king’s summer parlour (which are of corrugated +iron) glittered near one end conspicuously bright; the royal +colours flew hard by on a tall flagstaff; in front, on an +artificial islet, the gaol played the part of a martello. +Even upon this first and distant view, the place had scarce the +air of what it truly was, a village; rather of that which it was +also, a petty metropolis, a city rustic and yet royal.</p> +<p>The lagoon is shoal. The tide being out, we waded for +some quarter of a mile in tepid shallows, and stepped ashore at +last into a flagrant stagnancy of sun and heat. The lee +side of a line island after noon is indeed a breathless place; on +the ocean beach the trade will be still blowing, boisterous and +cool; out in the lagoon it will be blowing also, speeding the +canoes; but the screen of bush completely intercepts it from the +shore, and sleep and silence and companies of mosquitoes brood +upon the towns.</p> +<p>We may thus be said to have taken Butaritari by +surprise. A few inhabitants were still abroad in the north +end, at which we landed. As we advanced, we were soon done +with encounter, and seemed to explore a city of the dead. +Only, between the posts of open houses, we could see the +townsfolk stretched in the siesta, sometimes a family together +veiled in a mosquito-net, sometimes a single sleeper on a +platform like a corpse on a bier.</p> +<p>The houses were of all dimensions, from those of toys to those +of churches. Some might hold a battalion, some were so +minute they could scarce receive a pair of lovers; only in the +playroom, when the toys are mingled, do we meet such +incongruities of scale. Many were open sheds; some took the +form of roofed stages; others were walled and the walls pierced +with little windows. A few were perched on piles in the +lagoon; the rest stood at random on a green, through which the +roadway made a ribbon of sand, or along the embankments of a +sheet of water like a shallow dock. One and all were the +creatures of a single tree; palm-tree wood and palm-tree leaf +their materials; no nail had been driven, no hammer sounded, in +their building, and they were held together by lashings of +palm-tree sinnet.</p> +<p>In the midst of the thoroughfare, the church stands like an +island, a lofty and dim house with rows of windows; a rich +tracery of framing sustains the roof; and through the door at +either end the street shows in a vista. The proportions of +the place, in such surroundings, and built of such materials, +appeared august; and we threaded the nave with a sentiment +befitting visitors in a cathedral. Benches run along either +side. In the midst, on a crazy dais, two chairs stand ready +for the king and queen when they shall choose to worship; over +their heads a hoop, apparently from a hogshead, depends by a +strip of red cotton; and the hoop (which hangs askew) is dressed +with streamers of the same material, red and white.</p> +<p>This was our first advertisement of the royal dignity, and +presently we stood before its seat and centre. The palace +is built of imported wood upon a European plan; the roof of +corrugated iron, the yard enclosed with walls, the gate +surmounted by a sort of lych-house. It cannot be called +spacious; a labourer in the States is sometimes more commodiously +lodged; but when we had the chance to see it within, we found it +was enriched (beyond all island expectation) with coloured +advertisements and cuts from the illustrated papers. Even +before the gate some of the treasures of the crown stand public: +a bell of a good magnitude, two pieces of cannon, and a single +shell. The bell cannot be rung nor the guns fired; they are +curiosities, proofs of wealth, a part of the parade of the +royalty, and stand to be admired like statues in a square. +A straight gut of water like a canal runs almost to the palace +door; the containing quay-walls excellently built of coral; over +against the mouth, by what seems an effect of landscape art, the +martello-like islet of the gaol breaks the lagoon. Vassal +chiefs with tribute, neighbour monarchs come a-roving, might here +sail in, view with surprise these extensive public works, and be +awed by these mouths of silent cannon. It was impossible to +see the place and not to fancy it designed for pageantry. +But the elaborate theatre then stood empty; the royal house +deserted, its doors and windows gaping; the whole quarter of the +town immersed in silence. On the opposite bank of the +canal, on a roofed stage, an ancient gentleman slept publicly, +sole visible inhabitant; and beyond on the lagoon a canoe spread +a striped lateen, the sole thing moving.</p> +<p>The canal is formed on the south by a pier or causeway with a +parapet. At the far end the parapet stops, and the quay +expands into an oblong peninsula in the lagoon, the +breathing-place and summer parlour of the king. The midst +is occupied by an open house or permanent marquee—called +here a maniapa, or, as the word is now pronounced, a +maniap’—at the lowest estimation forty feet by +sixty. The iron roof, lofty but exceedingly low-browed, so +that a woman must stoop to enter, is supported externally on +pillars of coral, within by a frame of wood. The floor is +of broken coral, divided in aisles by the uprights of the frame; +the house far enough from shore to catch the breeze, which enters +freely and disperses the mosquitoes; and under the low eaves the +sun is seen to glitter and the waves to dance on the lagoon.</p> +<p>It was now some while since we had met any but slumberers; and +when we had wandered down the pier and stumbled at last into this +bright shed, we were surprised to find it occupied by a society +of wakeful people, some twenty souls in all, the court and +guardsmen of Butaritari. The court ladies were busy making +mats; the guardsmen yawned and sprawled. Half a dozen +rifles lay on a rock and a cutlass was leaned against a pillar: +the armoury of these drowsy musketeers. At the far end, a +little closed house of wood displayed some tinsel curtains, and +proved, upon examination, to be a privy on the European +model. In front of this, upon some mats, lolled Tebureimoa, +the king; behind him, on the panels of the house, two crossed +rifles represented fasces. He wore pyjamas which +sorrowfully misbecame his bulk; his nose was hooked and cruel, +his body overcome with sodden corpulence, his eye timorous and +dull: he seemed at once oppressed with drowsiness and held awake +by apprehension: a pepper rajah muddled with opium, and listening +for the march of a Dutch army, looks perhaps not otherwise. +We were to grow better acquainted, and first and last I had the +same impression; he seemed always drowsy, yet always to hearken +and start; and, whether from remorse or fear, there is no doubt +he seeks a refuge in the abuse of drugs.</p> +<p>The rajah displayed no sign of interest in our coming. +But the queen, who sat beside him in a purple sacque, was more +accessible; and there was present an interpreter so willing that +his volubility became at last the cause of our departure. +He had greeted us upon our entrance:—‘That is the +honourable King, and I am his interpreter,’ he had said, +with more stateliness than truth. For he held no +appointment in the court, seemed extremely ill-acquainted with +the island language, and was present, like ourselves, upon a +visit of civility. Mr. Williams was his name: an American +darkey, runaway ship’s cook, and bar-keeper at <i>The Land +we Live in</i> tavern, Butaritari. I never knew a man who +had more words in his command or less truth to communicate; +neither the gloom of the monarch, nor my own efforts to be +distant, could in the least abash him; and when the scene closed, +the darkey was left talking.</p> +<p>The town still slumbered, or had but just begun to turn and +stretch itself; it was still plunged in heat and silence. +So much the more vivid was the impression that we carried away of +the house upon the islet, the Micronesian Saul wakeful amid his +guards, and his unmelodious David, Mr. Williams, chattering +through the drowsy hours.</p> +<h3>CHAPTER II—THE FOUR BROTHERS</h3> +<p>The kingdom of Tebureimoa includes two islands, Great and +Little Makin; some two thousand subjects pay him tribute, and two +semi-independent chieftains do him qualified homage. The +importance of the office is measured by the man; he may be a +nobody, he may be absolute; and both extremes have been +exemplified within the memory of residents.</p> +<p>On the death of king Tetimararoa, Tebureimoa’s father, +Nakaeia, the eldest son, succeeded. He was a fellow of huge +physical strength, masterful, violent, with a certain barbaric +thrift and some intelligence of men and business. Alone in +his islands, it was he who dealt and profited; he was the planter +and the merchant; and his subjects toiled for his behoof in +servitude. When they wrought long and well their taskmaster +declared a holiday, and supplied and shared a general +debauch. The scale of his providing was at times +magnificent; six hundred dollars’ worth of gin and brandy +was set forth at once; the narrow land resounded with the noise +of revelry: and it was a common thing to see the subjects +(staggering themselves) parade their drunken sovereign on the +fore-hatch of a wrecked vessel, king and commons howling and +singing as they went. At a word from Nakaeia’s mouth +the revel ended; Makin became once more an isle of slaves and of +teetotalers; and on the morrow all the population must be on the +roads or in the taro-patches toiling under his bloodshot eye.</p> +<p>The fear of Nakaeia filled the land. No regularity of +justice was affected; there was no trial, there were no officers +of the law; it seems there was but one penalty, the capital; and +daylight assault and midnight murder were the forms of +process. The king himself would play the executioner: and +his blows were dealt by stealth, and with the help and +countenance of none but his own wives. These were his +oarswomen; one that caught a crab, he slew incontinently with the +tiller; thus disciplined, they pulled him by night to the scene +of his vengeance, which he would then execute alone and return +well-pleased with his connubial crew. The inmates of the +harem held a station hard for us to conceive. Beasts of +draught, and driven by the fear of death, they were yet +implicitly trusted with their sovereign’s life; they were +still wives and queens, and it was supposed that no man should +behold their faces. They killed by the sight like +basilisks; a chance view of one of those boatwomen was a crime to +be wiped out with blood. In the days of Nakaeia the palace +was beset with some tall coco-palms which commanded the +enclosure. It chanced one evening, while Nakaeia sat below +at supper with his wives, that the owner of the grove was in a +tree-top drawing palm-tree wine; it chanced that he looked down, +and the king at the same moment looking up, their eyes +encountered. Instant flight preserved the involuntary +criminal. But during the remainder of that reign he must +lurk and be hid by friends in remote parts of the isle; Nakaeia +hunted him without remission, although still in vain; and the +palms, accessories to the fact, were ruthlessly cut down. +Such was the ideal of wifely purity in an isle where nubile +virgins went naked as in paradise. And yet scandal found +its way into Nakaeia’s well-guarded harem. He was at +that time the owner of a schooner, which he used for a +pleasure-house, lodging on board as she lay anchored; and thither +one day he summoned a new wife. She was one that had been +sealed to him; that is to say (I presume), that he was married to +her sister, for the husband of an elder sister has the call of +the cadets. She would be arrayed for the occasion; she +would come scented, garlanded, decked with fine mats and family +jewels, for marriage, as her friends supposed; for death, as she +well knew. ‘Tell me the man’s name, and I will +spare you,’ said Nakaeia. But the girl was staunch; +she held her peace, saved her lover and the queens strangled her +between the mats.</p> +<p>Nakaeia was feared; it does not appear that he was +hated. Deeds that smell to us of murder wore to his +subjects the reverend face of justice; his orgies made him +popular; natives to this day recall with respect the firmness of +his government; and even the whites, whom he long opposed and +kept at arm’s-length, give him the name (in the canonical +South Sea phrase) of ‘a perfect gentleman when +sober.’</p> +<p>When he came to lie, without issue, on the bed of death, he +summoned his next brother, Nanteitei, made him a discourse on +royal policy, and warned him he was too weak to reign. The +warning was taken to heart, and for some while the government +moved on the model of Nakaeia’s. Nanteitei dispensed +with guards, and walked abroad alone with a revolver in a leather +mail-bag. To conceal his weakness he affected a rude +silence; you might talk to him all day; advice, reproof, appeal, +and menace alike remained unanswered.</p> +<p>The number of his wives was seventeen, many of them heiresses; +for the royal house is poor, and marriage was in these days a +chief means of buttressing the throne. Nakaeia kept his +harem busy for himself; Nanteitei hired it out to others. +In his days, for instance, Messrs. Wightman built a pier +with a verandah at the north end of the town. The masonry +was the work of the seventeen queens, who toiled and waded there +like fisher lasses; but the man who was to do the roofing durst +not begin till they had finished, lest by chance he should look +down and see them.</p> +<p>It was perhaps the last appearance of the harem gang. +For some time already Hawaiian missionaries had been seated at +Butaritari—Maka and Kanoa, two brave childlike men. +Nakaeia would none of their doctrine; he was perhaps jealous of +their presence; being human, he had some affection for their +persons. In the house, before the eyes of Kanoa, he slew +with his own hand three sailors of Oahu, crouching on their backs +to knife them, and menacing the missionary if he interfered; yet +he not only spared him at the moment, but recalled him afterwards +(when he had fled) with some expressions of respect. +Nanteitei, the weaker man, fell more completely under the +spell. Maka, a light-hearted, lovable, yet in his own trade +very rigorous man, gained and improved an influence on the king +which soon grew paramount. Nanteitei, with the royal house, +was publicly converted; and, with a severity which liberal +missionaries disavow, the harem was at once reduced. It was +a compendious act. The throne was thus impoverished, its +influence shaken, the queen’s relatives mortified, and +sixteen chief women (some of great possessions) cast in a body on +the market. I have been shipmates with a Hawaiian sailor +who was successively married to two of these <i>impromptu</i> +widows, and successively divorced by both for misconduct. +That two great and rich ladies (for both of these were rich) +should have married ‘a man from another island’ marks +the dissolution of society. The laws besides were wholly +remodelled, not always for the better. I love Maka as a +man; as a legislator he has two defects: weak in the punishment +of crime, stern to repress innocent pleasures.</p> +<p>War and revolution are the common successors of reform; yet +Nanteitei died (of an overdose of chloroform), in quiet +possession of the throne, and it was in the reign of the third +brother, Nabakatokia, a man brave in body and feeble of +character, that the storm burst. The rule of the high +chiefs and notables seems to have always underlain and perhaps +alternated with monarchy. The Old Men (as they were called) +have a right to sit with the king in the Speak House and debate: +and the king’s chief superiority is a form of +closure—‘The Speaking is over.’ After the +long monocracy of Nakaeia and the changes of Nanteitei, the Old +Men were doubtless grown impatient of obscurity, and they were +beyond question jealous of the influence of Maka. Calumny, +or rather caricature, was called in use; a spoken cartoon ran +round society; Maka was reported to have said in church that the +king was the first man in the island and himself the second; and, +stung by the supposed affront, the chiefs broke into rebellion +and armed gatherings. In the space of one forenoon the +throne of Nakaeia was humbled in the dust. The king sat in +the maniap’ before the palace gate expecting his recruits; +Maka by his side, both anxious men; and meanwhile, in the door of +a house at the north entry of the town, a chief had taken post +and diverted the succours as they came. They came singly or +in groups, each with his gun or pistol slung about his +neck. ‘Where are you going?’ asked the +chief. ‘The king called us,’ they would +reply. ‘Here is your place. Sit down,’ +returned the chief. With incredible disloyalty, all obeyed; +and sufficient force being thus got together from both sides, +Nabakatokia was summoned and surrendered. About this +period, in almost every part of the group, the kings were +murdered; and on Tapituea, the skeleton of the last hangs to this +day in the chief Speak House of the isle, a menace to +ambition. Nabakatokia was more fortunate; his life and the +royal style were spared to him, but he was stripped of +power. The Old Men enjoyed a festival of public speaking; +the laws were continually changed, never enforced; the commons +had an opportunity to regret the merits of Nakaeia; and the king, +denied the resource of rich marriages and the service of a troop +of wives, fell not only in disconsideration but in debt.</p> +<p>He died some months before my arrival on the islands, and no +one regretted him; rather all looked hopefully to his +successor. This was by repute the hero of the family. +Alone of the four brothers, he had issue, a grown son, Natiata, +and a daughter three years old; it was to him, in the hour of the +revolution, that Nabakatokia turned too late for help; and in +earlier days he had been the right hand of the vigorous +Nakaeia. Nontemat’, <i>Mr. Corpse</i>, was his +appalling nickname, and he had earned it well. Again and +again, at the command of Nakaeia, he had surrounded houses in the +dead of night, cut down the mosquito bars and butchered +families. Here was the hand of iron; here was Nakaeia +<i>redux</i>. He came, summoned from the tributary rule of +Little Makin: he was installed, he proved a puppet and a +trembler, the unwieldy shuttlecock of orators; and the reader has +seen the remains of him in his summer parlour under the name of +Tebureimoa.</p> +<p>The change in the man’s character was much commented on +in the island, and variously explained by opium and +Christianity. To my eyes, there seemed no change at all, +rather an extreme consistency. Mr. Corpse was afraid of his +brother: King Tebureimoa is afraid of the Old Men. Terror +of the first nerved him for deeds of desperation; fear of the +second disables him for the least act of government. He +played his part of bravo in the past, following the line of least +resistance, butchering others in his own defence: to-day, grown +elderly and heavy, a convert, a reader of the Bible, perhaps a +penitent, conscious at least of accumulated hatreds, and his +memory charged with images of violence and blood, he capitulates +to the Old Men, fuddles himself with opium, and sits among his +guards in dreadful expectation. The same cowardice that put +into his hand the knife of the assassin deprives him of the +sceptre of a king.</p> +<p>A tale that I was told, a trifling incident that fell in my +observation, depicts him in his two capacities. A chief in +Little Makin asked, in an hour of lightness, ‘Who is +Kaeia?’ A bird carried the saying; and Nakaeia placed +the matter in the hands of a committee of three. Mr. Corpse +was chairman; the second commissioner died before my arrival; the +third was yet alive and green, and presented so venerable an +appearance that we gave him the name of Abou ben Adhem. Mr. +Corpse was troubled with a scruple; the man from Little Makin was +his adopted brother; in such a case it was not very delicate to +appear at all, to strike the blow (which it seems was otherwise +expected of him) would be worse than awkward. ‘I will +strike the blow,’ said the venerable Abou; and Mr. Corpse +(surely with a sigh) accepted the compromise. The quarry +was decoyed into the bush; he was set to carrying a log; and +while his arms were raised Abou ripped up his belly at a +blow. Justice being thus done, the commission, in a +childish horror, turned to flee. But their victim recalled +them to his side. ‘You need not run away now,’ +he said. ‘You have done this thing to me. +Stay.’ He was some twenty minutes dying, and his +murderers sat with him the while: a scene for Shakespeare. +All the stages of a violent death, the blood, the failing voice, +the decomposing features, the changed hue, are thus present in +the memory of Mr. Corpse; and since he studied them in the +brother he betrayed, he has some reason to reflect on the +possibilities of treachery. I was never more sure of +anything than the tragic quality of the king’s thoughts; +and yet I had but the one sight of him at unawares. I had +once an errand for his ear. It was once more the hour of +the siesta; but there were loiterers abroad, and these directed +us to a closed house on the bank of the canal where Tebureimoa +lay unguarded. We entered without ceremony, being in some +haste. He lay on the floor upon a bed of mats, reading in +his Gilbert Island Bible with compunction. On our sudden +entrance the unwieldy man reared himself half-sitting so that the +Bible rolled on the floor, stared on us a moment with blank eyes, +and, having recognised his visitors, sank again upon the +mats. So Eglon looked on Ehud.</p> +<p>The justice of facts is strange, and strangely just; Nakaeia, +the author of these deeds, died at peace discoursing on the craft +of kings; his tool suffers daily death for his enforced +complicity. Not the nature, but the congruity of +men’s deeds and circumstances damn and save them; and +Tebureimoa from the first has been incongruously placed. At +home, in a quiet bystreet of a village, the man had been a worthy +carpenter, and, even bedevilled as he is, he shows some private +virtues. He has no lands, only the use of such as are +impignorate for fines; he cannot enrich himself in the old way by +marriages; thrift is the chief pillar of his future, and he knows +and uses it. Eleven foreign traders pay him a patent of a +hundred dollars, some two thousand subjects pay capitation at the +rate of a dollar for a man, half a dollar for a woman, and a +shilling for a child: allowing for the exchange, perhaps a total +of three hundred pounds a year. He had been some nine +months on the throne: had bought his wife a silk dress and hat, +figure unknown, and himself a uniform at three hundred dollars; +had sent his brother’s photograph to be enlarged in San +Francisco at two hundred and fifty dollars; had greatly reduced +that brother’s legacy of debt and had still sovereigns in +his pocket. An affectionate brother, a good economist; he +was besides a handy carpenter, and cobbled occasionally on the +woodwork of the palace. It is not wonderful that Mr. Corpse +has virtues; that Tebureimoa should have a diversion filled me +with surprise.</p> +<h3>CHAPTER III—AROUND OUR HOUSE</h3> +<p>When we left the palace we were still but seafarers ashore; +and within the hour we had installed our goods in one of the six +foreign houses of Butaritari, namely, that usually occupied by +Maka, the Hawaiian missionary. Two San Francisco firms are +here established, Messrs. Crawford and Messrs. Wightman Brothers; +the first hard by the palace of the mid town, the second at the +north entry; each with a store and bar-room. Our house was +in the Wightman compound, betwixt the store and bar, within a +fenced enclosure. Across the road a few native houses +nestled in the margin of the bush, and the green wall of palms +rose solid, shutting out the breeze. A little sandy cove of +the lagoon ran in behind, sheltered by a verandah pier, the +labour of queens’ hands. Here, when the tide was +high, sailed boats lay to be loaded; when the tide was low, the +boats took ground some half a mile away, and an endless series of +natives descended the pier stair, tailed across the sand in +strings and clusters, waded to the waist with the bags of copra, +and loitered backward to renew their charge. The mystery of +the copra trade tormented me, as I sat and watched the profits +drip on the stair and the sands.</p> +<p>In front, from shortly after four in the morning until nine at +night, the folk of the town streamed by us intermittingly along +the road: families going up the island to make copra on their +lands; women bound for the bush to gather flowers against the +evening toilet; and, twice a day, the toddy-cutters, each with +his knife and shell. In the first grey of the morning, and +again late in the afternoon, these would straggle past about +their tree-top business, strike off here and there into the bush, +and vanish from the face of the earth. At about the same +hour, if the tide be low in the lagoon, you are likely to be +bound yourself across the island for a bath, and may enter close +at their heels alleys of the palm wood. Right in front, +although the sun is not yet risen, the east is already lighted +with preparatory fires, and the huge accumulations of the +trade-wind cloud glow with and heliograph the coming day. +The breeze is in your face; overhead in the tops of the palms, +its playthings, it maintains a lively bustle; look where you +will, above or below, there is no human presence, only the earth +and shaken forest. And right overhead the song of an +invisible singer breaks from the thick leaves; from farther on a +second tree-top answers; and beyond again, in the bosom of the +woods, a still more distant minstrel perches and sways and +sings. So, all round the isle, the toddy-cutters sit on +high, and are rocked by the trade, and have a view far to +seaward, where they keep watch for sails, and like huge birds +utter their songs in the morning. They sing with a certain +lustiness and Bacchic glee; the volume of sound and the +articulate melody fall unexpected from the tree-top, whence we +anticipate the chattering of fowls. And yet in a sense +these songs also are but chatter; the words are ancient, +obsolete, and sacred; few comprehend them, perhaps no one +perfectly; but it was understood the cutters ‘prayed to +have good toddy, and sang of their old wars.’ The +prayer is at least answered; and when the foaming shell is +brought to your door, you have a beverage well ‘worthy of a +grace.’ All forenoon you may return and taste; it +only sparkles, and sharpens, and grows to be a new drink, not +less delicious; but with the progress of the day the fermentation +quickens and grows acid; in twelve hours it will be yeast for +bread, in two days more a devilish intoxicant, the counsellor of +crime.</p> +<p>The men are of a marked Arabian cast of features, often +bearded and mustached, often gaily dressed, some with bracelets +and anklets, all stalking hidalgo-like, and accepting salutations +with a haughty lip. The hair (with the dandies of either +sex) is worn turban-wise in a frizzled bush; and like the daggers +of the Japanese a pointed stick (used for a comb) is thrust +gallantly among the curls. The women from this bush of hair +look forth enticingly: the race cannot be compared with the +Tahitian for female beauty; I doubt even if the average be high; +but some of the prettiest girls, and one of the handsomest women +I ever saw, were Gilbertines. Butaritari, being the +commercial centre of the group, is Europeanised; the coloured +sacque or the white shift are common wear, the latter for the +evening; the trade hat, loaded with flowers, fruit, and ribbons, +is unfortunately not unknown; and the characteristic female dress +of the Gilberts no longer universal. The <i>ridi</i> is its +name: a cutty petticoat or fringe of the smoked fibre of +cocoa-nut leaf, not unlike tarry string: the lower edge not +reaching the mid-thigh, the upper adjusted so low upon the +haunches that it seems to cling by accident. A sneeze, you +think, and the lady must surely be left destitute. +‘The perilous, hairbreadth ridi’ was our word for it; +and in the conflict that rages over women’s dress it has +the misfortune to please neither side, the prudish condemning it +as insufficient, the more frivolous finding it unlovely in +itself. Yet if a pretty Gilbertine would look her best, +that must be her costume. In that and naked otherwise, she +moves with an incomparable liberty and grace and life, that marks +the poetry of Micronesia. Bundle her in a gown, the charm +is fled, and she wriggles like an Englishwoman.</p> +<p>Towards dusk the passers-by became more gorgeous. The +men broke out in all the colours of the rainbow—or at least +of the trade-room,—and both men and women began to be +adorned and scented with new flowers. A small white blossom +is the favourite, sometimes sown singly in a woman’s hair +like little stars, now composed in a thick wreath. With the +night, the crowd sometimes thickened in the road, and the padding +and brushing of bare feet became continuous; the promenades +mostly grave, the silence only interrupted by some giggling and +scampering of girls; even the children quiet. At nine, +bed-time struck on a bell from the cathedral, and the life of the +town ceased. At four the next morning the signal is +repeated in the darkness, and the innocent prisoners set free; +but for seven hours all must lie—I was about to say within +doors, of a place where doors, and even walls, are an +exception—housed, at least, under their airy roofs and +clustered in the tents of the mosquito-nets. Suppose a +necessary errand to occur, suppose it imperative to send abroad, +the messenger must then go openly, advertising himself to the +police with a huge brand of cocoa-nut, which flares from house to +house like a moving bonfire. Only the police themselves go +darkling, and grope in the night for misdemeanants. I used +to hate their treacherous presence; their captain in particular, +a crafty old man in white, lurked nightly about my premises till +I could have found it in my heart to beat him. But the +rogue was privileged.</p> +<p>Not one of the eleven resident traders came to town, no +captain cast anchor in the lagoon, but we saw him ere the hour +was out. This was owing to our position between the store +and the bar—the <i>Sans Souci</i>, as the last was +called. Mr. Rick was not only Messrs. Wightman’s +manager, but consular agent for the States; Mrs. Rick was the +only white woman on the island, and one of the only two in the +archipelago; their house besides, with its cool verandahs, its +bookshelves, its comfortable furniture, could not be rivalled +nearer than Jaluit or Honolulu. Every one called in +consequence, save such as might be prosecuting a South Sea +quarrel, hingeing on the price of copra and the odd cent, or +perhaps a difference about poultry. Even these, if they did +not appear upon the north, would be presently visible to the +southward, the <i>Sans Souci</i> drawing them as with +cords. In an island with a total population of twelve white +persons, one of the two drinking-shops might seem superfluous: +but every bullet has its billet, and the double accommodation of +Butaritari is found in practice highly convenient by the captains +and the crews of ships: <i>The Land we Live in</i> being tacitly +resigned to the forecastle, the <i>Sans Souci</i> tacitly +reserved for the afterguard. So aristocratic were my +habits, so commanding was my fear of Mr. Williams, that I have +never visited the first; but in the other, which was the club or +rather the casino of the island, I regularly passed my +evenings. It was small, but neatly fitted, and at night +(when the lamp was lit) sparkled with glass and glowed with +coloured pictures like a theatre at Christmas. The pictures +were advertisements, the glass coarse enough, the carpentry +amateur; but the effect, in that incongruous isle, was of +unbridled luxury and inestimable expense. Here songs were +sung, tales told, tricks performed, games played. The +Ricks, ourselves, Norwegian Tom the bar-keeper, a captain or two +from the ships, and perhaps three or four traders come down the +island in their boats or by the road on foot, made up the usual +company. The traders, all bred to the sea, take a humorous +pride in their new business; ‘South Sea Merchants’ is +the title they prefer. ‘We are all sailors +here’—‘Merchants, if you +please’—‘<i>South Sea</i> +Merchants,’—was a piece of conversation endlessly +repeated, that never seemed to lose in savour. We found +them at all times simple, genial, gay, gallant, and obliging; +and, across some interval of time, recall with pleasure the +traders of Butaritari. There was one black sheep +indeed. I tell of him here where he lived, against my rule; +for in this case I have no measure to preserve, and the man is +typical of a class of ruffians that once disgraced the whole +field of the South Seas, and still linger in the rarely visited +isles of Micronesia. He had the name on the beach of +‘a perfect gentleman when sober,’ but I never saw him +otherwise than drunk. The few shocking and savage traits of +the Micronesian he has singled out with the skill of a collector, +and planted in the soil of his original baseness. He has +been accused and acquitted of a treacherous murder; and has since +boastfully owned it, which inclines me to suppose him +innocent. His daughter is defaced by his erroneous cruelty, +for it was his wife he had intended to disfigure, and in the +darkness of the night and the frenzy of coco-brandy, fastened on +the wrong victim. The wife has since fled and harbours in +the bush with natives; and the husband still demands from deaf +ears her forcible restoration. The best of his business is +to make natives drink, and then advance the money for the fine +upon a lucrative mortgage. ‘Respect for whites’ +is the man’s word: ‘What is the matter with this +island is the want of respect for whites.’ On his way +to Butaritari, while I was there, he spied his wife in the bush +with certain natives and made a dash to capture her; whereupon +one of her companions drew a knife and the husband retreated: +‘Do you call that proper respect for whites?’ he +cried. At an early stage of the acquaintance we proved our +respect for his kind of white by forbidding him our enclosure +under pain of death. Thenceforth he lingered often in the +neighbourhood with I knew not what sense of envy or design of +mischief; his white, handsome face (which I beheld with loathing) +looked in upon us at all hours across the fence; and once, from a +safe distance, he avenged himself by shouting a recondite island +insult, to us quite inoffensive, on his English lips incredibly +incongruous.</p> +<p>Our enclosure, round which this composite of degradations +wandered, was of some extent. In one corner was a trellis +with a long table of rough boards. Here the Fourth of July +feast had been held not long before with memorable consequences, +yet to be set forth; here we took our meals; here entertained to +a dinner the king and notables of Makin. In the midst was +the house, with a verandah front and back, and three is rooms +within. In the verandah we slung our man-of-war hammocks, +worked there by day, and slept at night. Within were beds, +chairs, a round table, a fine hanging lamp, and portraits of the +royal family of Hawaii. Queen Victoria proves nothing; +Kalakaua and Mrs. Bishop are diagnostic; and the truth is we were +the stealthy tenants of the parsonage. On the day of our +arrival Maka was away; faithless trustees unlocked his doors; and +the dear rigorous man, the sworn foe of liquor and tobacco, +returned to find his verandah littered with cigarettes and his +parlour horrible with bottles. He made but one +condition—on the round table, which he used in the +celebration of the sacraments, he begged us to refrain from +setting liquor; in all else he bowed to the accomplished fact, +refused rent, retired across the way into a native house, and, +plying in his boat, beat the remotest quarters of the isle for +provender. He found us pigs—I could not fancy +where—no other pigs were visible; he brought us fowls and +taro; when we gave our feast to the monarch and gentry, it was he +who supplied the wherewithal, he who superintended the cooking, +he who asked grace at table, and when the king’s health was +proposed, he also started the cheering with an English +hip-hip-hip. There was never a more fortunate conception; +the heart of the fatted king exulted in his bosom at the +sound.</p> +<p>Take him for all in all, I have never known a more engaging +creature than this parson of Butaritari: his mirth, his kindness, +his noble, friendly feelings, brimmed from the man in speech and +gesture. He loved to exaggerate, to act and overact the +momentary part, to exercise his lungs and muscles, and to speak +and laugh with his whole body. He had the morning +cheerfulness of birds and healthy children; and his humour was +infectious. We were next neighbours and met daily, yet our +salutations lasted minutes at a stretch—shaking hands, +slapping shoulders, capering like a pair of Merry-Andrews, +laughing to split our sides upon some pleasantry that would +scarce raise a titter in an infant-school. It might be five +in the morning, the toddy-cutters just gone by, the road empty, +the shade of the island lying far on the lagoon: and the +ebullition cheered me for the day.</p> +<p>Yet I always suspected Maka of a secret melancholy—these +jubilant extremes could scarce be constantly maintained. He +was besides long, and lean, and lined, and corded, and a trifle +grizzled; and his Sabbath countenance was even saturnine. +On that day we made a procession to the church, or (as I must +always call it) the cathedral: Maka (a blot on the hot landscape) +in tall hat, black frock-coat, black trousers; under his arm the +hymn-book and the Bible; in his face, a reverent +gravity:—beside him Mary his wife, a quiet, wise, and +handsome elderly lady, seriously attired:—myself following +with singular and moving thoughts. Long before, to the +sound of bells and streams and birds, through a green Lothian +glen, I had accompanied Sunday by Sunday a minister in whose +house I lodged; and the likeness, and the difference, and the +series of years and deaths, profoundly touched me. In the +great, dusky, palm-tree cathedral the congregation rarely +numbered thirty: the men on one side, the women on the other, +myself posted (for a privilege) amongst the women, and the small +missionary contingent gathered close around the platform, we were +lost in that round vault. The lessons were read +antiphonally, the flock was catechised, a blind youth repeated +weekly a long string of psalms, hymns were sung—I never +heard worse singing,—and the sermon followed. To say +I understood nothing were untrue; there were points that I +learned to expect with certainty; the name of Honolulu, that of +Kalakaua, the word Cap’n-man-o’-wa’, the word +ship, and a description of a storm at sea, infallibly occurred; +and I was not seldom rewarded with the name of my own Sovereign +in the bargain. The rest was but sound to the ears, silence +for the mind: a plain expanse of tedium, rendered unbearable by +heat, a hard chair, and the sight through the wide doors of the +more happy heathen on the green. Sleep breathed on my +joints and eyelids, sleep hummed in my ears; it reigned in the +dim cathedral. The congregation stirred and stretched; they +moaned, they groaned aloud; they yawned upon a singing note, as +you may sometimes hear a dog when he has reached the tragic +bitterest of boredom. In vain the preacher thumped the +table; in vain he singled and addressed by name particular +hearers. I was myself perhaps a more effective excitant; +and at least to one old gentleman the spectacle of my successful +struggles against sleep—and I hope they were +successful—cheered the flight of time. He, when he +was not catching flies or playing tricks upon his neighbours, +gloated with a fixed, truculent eye upon the stages of my agony; +and once, when the service was drawing towards a close, he winked +at me across the church.</p> +<p>I write of the service with a smile; yet I was always +there—always with respect for Maka, always with admiration +for his deep seriousness, his burning energy, the fire of his +roused eye, the sincere and various accents of his voice. +To see him weekly flogging a dead horse and blowing a cold fire +was a lesson in fortitude and constancy. It may be a +question whether if the mission were fully supported, and he was +set free from business avocations, more might not result; I think +otherwise myself; I think not neglect but rigour has reduced his +flock, that rigour which has once provoked a revolution, and +which to-day, in a man so lively and engaging, amazes the +beholder. No song, no dance, no tobacco, no liquor, no +alleviative of life—only toil and church-going; so says a +voice from his face; and the face is the face of the Polynesian +Esau, but the voice is the voice of a Jacob from a different +world. And a Polynesian at the best makes a singular +missionary in the Gilberts, coming from a country recklessly +unchaste to one conspicuously strict; from a race hag-ridden with +bogies to one comparatively bold against the terrors of the +dark. The thought was stamped one morning in my mind, when +I chanced to be abroad by moonlight, and saw all the town +lightless, but the lamp faithfully burning by the +missionary’s bed. It requires no law, no fire, and no +scouting police, to withhold Maka and his countrymen from +wandering in the night unlighted.</p> +<h3>CHAPTER IV—A TALE OF A TAPU</h3> +<p>On the morrow of our arrival (Sunday, 14th July 1889) our +photographers were early stirring. Once more we traversed a +silent town; many were yet abed and asleep; some sat drowsily in +their open houses; there was no sound of intercourse or +business. In that hour before the shadows, the quarter of +the palace and canal seemed like a landing-place in the +<i>Arabian Nights</i> or from the classic poets; here were the +fit destination of some ‘faery frigot,’ here some +adventurous prince might step ashore among new characters and +incidents; and the island prison, where it floated on the +luminous face of the lagoon, might have passed for the repository +of the Grail. In such a scene, and at such an hour, the +impression received was not so much of foreign +travel—rather of past ages; it seemed not so much degrees +of latitude that we had crossed, as centuries of time that we had +re-ascended; leaving, by the same steps, home and to-day. A +few children followed us, mostly nude, all silent; in the clear, +weedy waters of the canal some silent damsels waded, baring their +brown thighs; and to one of the maniap’s before the palace +gate we were attracted by a low but stirring hum of speech.</p> +<p>The oval shed was full of men sitting cross-legged. The +king was there in striped pyjamas, his rear protected by four +guards with Winchesters, his air and bearing marked by unwonted +spirit and decision; tumblers and black bottles went the round; +and the talk, throughout loud, was general and animated. I +was inclined at first to view this scene with suspicion. +But the hour appeared unsuitable for a carouse; drink was besides +forbidden equally by the law of the land and the canons of the +church; and while I was yet hesitating, the king’s rigorous +attitude disposed of my last doubt. We had come, thinking +to photograph him surrounded by his guards, and at the first word +of the design his piety revolted. We were reminded of the +day—the Sabbath, in which thou shalt take no +photographs—and returned with a flea in our ear, bearing +the rejected camera.</p> +<p>At church, a little later, I was struck to find the throne +unoccupied. So nice a Sabbatarian might have found the +means to be present; perhaps my doubts revived; and before I got +home they were transformed to certainties. Tom, the +bar-keeper of the <i>Sans Souci</i>, was in conversation with two +emissaries from the court. The ‘keen,’ they +said, wanted ‘din,’ failing which +‘perandi.’ <a name="citation231"></a><a +href="#footnote231" class="citation">[231]</a> No din, was +Tom’s reply, and no perandi; but ‘pira’ if they +pleased. It seems they had no use for beer, and departed +sorrowing.</p> +<p>‘Why, what is the meaning of all this?’ I +asked. ‘Is the island on the spree?’</p> +<p>Such was the fact. On the 4th of July a feast had been +made, and the king, at the suggestion of the whites, had raised +the tapu against liquor. There is a proverb about horses; +it scarce applies to the superior animal, of whom it may be +rather said, that any one can start him drinking, not any twenty +can prevail on him to stop. The tapu, raised ten days +before, was not yet re-imposed; for ten days the town had been +passing the bottle or lying (as we had seen it the afternoon +before) in hoggish sleep; and the king, moved by the Old Men and +his own appetites, continued to maintain the liberty, to squander +his savings on liquor, and to join in and lead the debauch. +The whites were the authors of this crisis; it was upon their own +proposal that the freedom had been granted at the first; and for +a while, in the interests of trade, they were doubtless pleased +it should continue. That pleasure had now sometime ceased; +the bout had been prolonged (it was conceded) unduly; and it now +began to be a question how it might conclude. Hence +Tom’s refusal. Yet that refusal was avowedly only for +the moment, and it was avowedly unavailing; the king’s +foragers, denied by Tom at the <i>Sans Souci</i>, would be +supplied at <i>The Land we Live in</i> by the gobbling Mr. +Williams.</p> +<p>The degree of the peril was not easy to measure at the time, +and I am inclined to think now it was easy to exaggerate. +Yet the conduct of drunkards even at home is always matter for +anxiety; and at home our populations are not armed from the +highest to the lowest with revolvers and repeating rifles, +neither do we go on a debauch by the whole townful—and I +might rather say, by the whole polity—king, magistrates, +police, and army joining in one common scene of +drunkenness. It must be thought besides that we were here +in barbarous islands, rarely visited, lately and partly +civilised. First and last, a really considerable number of +whites have perished in the Gilberts, chiefly through their own +misconduct; and the natives have displayed in at least one +instance a disposition to conceal an accident under a butchery, +and leave nothing but dumb bones. This last was the chief +consideration against a sudden closing of the bars; the +bar-keepers stood in the immediate breach and dealt direct with +madmen; too surly a refusal might at any moment precipitate a +blow, and the blow might prove the signal for a massacre.</p> +<p><i>Monday</i>, 15th.—At the same hour we returned to the +same muniap’. Kümmel (of all drinks) was served +in tumblers; in the midst sat the crown prince, a fatted youth, +surrounded by fresh bottles and busily plying the corkscrew; and +king, chief, and commons showed the loose mouth, the uncertain +joints, and the blurred and animated eye of the early +drinker. It was plain we were impatiently expected; the +king retired with alacrity to dress, the guards were despatched +after their uniforms; and we were left to await the issue of +these preparations with a shedful of tipsy natives. The +orgie had proceeded further than on Sunday. The day +promised to be of great heat; it was already sultry, the +courtiers were already fuddled; and still the kümmel +continued to go round, and the crown prince to play butler. +Flemish freedom followed upon Flemish excess; and a funny dog, a +handsome fellow, gaily dressed, and with a full turban of frizzed +hair, delighted the company with a humorous courtship of a lady +in a manner not to be described. It was our diversion, in +this time of waiting, to observe the gathering of the +guards. They have European arms, European uniforms, and (to +their sorrow) European shoes. We saw one warrior (like +Mars) in the article of being armed; two men and a stalwart woman +were scarce strong enough to boot him; and after a single +appearance on parade the army is crippled for a week.</p> +<p>At last, the gates under the king’s house opened; the +army issued, one behind another, with guns and epaulettes; the +colours stooped under the gateway; majesty followed in his +uniform bedizened with gold lace; majesty’s wife came next +in a hat and feathers, and an ample trained silk gown; the royal +imps succeeded; there stood the pageantry of Makin marshalled on +its chosen theatre. Dickens might have told how serious +they were; how tipsy; how the king melted and streamed under his +cocked hat; how he took station by the larger of his two +cannons—austere, majestic, but not truly vertical; how the +troops huddled, and were straightened out, and clubbed again; how +they and their firelocks raked at various inclinations like the +masts of ships; and how an amateur photographer reviewed, +arrayed, and adjusted them, to see his dispositions change before +he reached the camera.</p> +<p>The business was funny to see; I do not know that it is +graceful to laugh at; and our report of these transactions was +received on our return with the shaking of grave heads.</p> +<p>The day had begun ill; eleven hours divided us from sunset; +and at any moment, on the most trifling chance, the trouble might +begin. The Wightman compound was in a military sense +untenable, commanded on three sides by houses and thick bush; the +town was computed to contain over a thousand stand of excellent +new arms; and retreat to the ships, in the case of an alert, was +a recourse not to be thought of. Our talk that morning must +have closely reproduced the talk in English garrisons before the +Sepoy mutiny; the sturdy doubt that any mischief was in prospect, +the sure belief that (should any come) there was nothing left but +to go down fighting, the half-amused, half-anxious attitude of +mind in which we were awaiting fresh developments.</p> +<p>The kümmel soon ran out; we were scarce returned before +the king had followed us in quest of more. Mr. Corpse was +now divested of his more awful attitude, the lawless bulk of him +again encased in striped pyjamas; a guardsman brought up the rear +with his rifle at the trail: and his majesty was further +accompanied by a Rarotongan whalerman and the playful courtier +with the turban of frizzed hair. There was never a more +lively deputation. The whalerman was gapingly, tearfully +tipsy: the courtier walked on air; the king himself was even +sportive. Seated in a chair in the Ricks’ +sitting-room, he bore the brunt of our prayers and menaces +unmoved. He was even rated, plied with historic instances, +threatened with the men-of-war, ordered to restore the tapu on +the spot—and nothing in the least affected him. It +should be done to-morrow, he said; to-day it was beyond his +power, to-day he durst not. ‘Is that royal?’ +cried indignant Mr. Rick. No, it was not royal; had the +king been of a royal character we should ourselves have held a +different language; and royal or not, he had the best of the +dispute. The terms indeed were hardly equal; for the king +was the only man who could restore the tapu, but the Ricks were +not the only people who sold drink. He had but to hold his +ground on the first question, and they were sure to weaken on the +second. A little struggle they still made for the +fashion’s sake; and then one exceedingly tipsy deputation +departed, greatly rejoicing, a case of brandy wheeling beside +them in a barrow. The Rarotongan (whom I had never seen +before) wrung me by the hand like a man bound on a far +voyage. ‘My dear frien’!’ he cried, +‘good-bye, my dear frien’!’—tears of +kümmel standing in his eyes; the king lurched as he went, +the courtier ambled,—a strange party of intoxicated +children to be entrusted with that barrowful of madness.</p> +<p>You could never say the town was quiet; all morning there was +a ferment in the air, an aimless movement and congregation of +natives in the street. But it was not before half-past one +that a sudden hubbub of voices called us from the house, to find +the whole white colony already gathered on the spot as by +concerted signal. The <i>Sans Souci</i> was overrun with +rabble, the stair and verandah thronged. From all these +throats an inarticulate babbling cry went up incessantly; it +sounded like the bleating of young lambs, but angrier. In +the road his royal highness (whom I had seen so lately in the +part of butler) stood crying upon Tom; on the top step, tossed in +the hurly-burly, Tom was shouting to the prince. Yet a +while the pack swayed about the bar, vociferous. Then came +a brutal impulse; the mob reeled, and returned, and was rejected; +the stair showed a stream of heads; and there shot into view, +through the disbanding ranks, three men violently dragging in +their midst a fourth. By his hair and his hands, his head +forced as low as his knees, his face concealed, he was wrenched +from the verandah and whisked along the road into the village, +howling as he disappeared. Had his face been raised, we +should have seen it bloodied, and the blood was not his +own. The courtier with the turban of frizzed hair had paid +the costs of this disturbance with the lower part of one ear.</p> +<p>So the brawl passed with no other casualty than might seem +comic to the inhumane. Yet we looked round on serious faces +and—a fact that spoke volumes—Tom was putting up the +shutters on the bar. Custom might go elsewhere, Mr. +Williams might profit as he pleased, but Tom had had enough of +bar-keeping for that day. Indeed the event had hung on a +hair. A man had sought to draw a revolver—on what +quarrel I could never learn, and perhaps he himself could not +have told; one shot, when the room was so crowded, could scarce +have failed to take effect; where many were armed and all tipsy, +it could scarce have failed to draw others; and the woman who +spied the weapon and the man who seized it may very well have +saved the white community.</p> +<p>The mob insensibly melted from the scene; and for the rest of +the day our neighbourhood was left in peace and a good deal in +solitude. But the tranquillity was only local; <i>din</i> +and<i> perandi</i> still flowed in other quarters: and we had one +more sight of Gilbert Island violence. In the church, where +we had wandered photographing, we were startled by a sudden +piercing outcry. The scene, looking forth from the doors of +that great hall of shadow, was unforgettable. The palms, +the quaint and scattered houses, the flag of the island streaming +from its tall staff, glowed with intolerable sunshine. In +the midst two women rolled fighting on the grass. The +combatants were the more easy to be distinguished, because the +one was stripped to the <i>ridi</i> and the other wore a holoku +(sacque) of some lively colour. The first was uppermost, +her teeth locked in her adversary’s face, shaking her like +a dog; the other impotently fought and scratched. So for a +moment we saw them wallow and grapple there like vermin; then the +mob closed and shut them in.</p> +<p>It was a serious question that night if we should sleep +ashore. But we were travellers, folk that had come far in +quest of the adventurous; on the first sign of an adventure it +would have been a singular inconsistency to have withdrawn; and +we sent on board instead for our revolvers. Mindful of +Taahauku, Mr. Rick, Mr. Osbourne, and Mrs. Stevenson held an +assault of arms on the public highway, and fired at bottles to +the admiration of the natives. Captain Reid of the +<i>Equator</i> stayed on shore with us to be at hand in case of +trouble, and we retired to bed at the accustomed hour, agreeably +excited by the day’s events. The night was exquisite, +the silence enchanting; yet as I lay in my hammock looking on the +strong moonshine and the quiescent palms, one ugly picture +haunted me of the two women, the naked and the clad, locked in +that hostile embrace. The harm done was probably not much, +yet I could have looked on death and massacre with less +revolt. The return to these primeval weapons, the vision of +man’s beastliness, of his ferality, shocked in me a deeper +sense than that with which we count the cost of battles. +There are elements in our state and history which it is a +pleasure to forget, which it is perhaps the better wisdom not to +dwell on. Crime, pestilence, and death are in the +day’s work; the imagination readily accepts them. It +instinctively rejects, on the contrary, whatever shall call up +the image of our race upon its lowest terms, as the partner of +beasts, beastly itself, dwelling pell-mell and hugger-mugger, +hairy man with hairy woman, in the caves of old. And yet to +be just to barbarous islanders we must not forget the slums and +dens of our cities; I must not forget that I have passed +dinnerward through Soho, and seen that which cured me of my +dinner.</p> +<h3>CHAPTER V—A TALE OF A TAPU—<i>continued</i></h3> +<p><i>Tuesday</i>, <i>July</i> 16.—It rained in the night, +sudden and loud, in Gilbert Island fashion. Before the day, +the crowing of a cock aroused me and I wandered in the compound +and along the street. The squall was blown by, the moon +shone with incomparable lustre, the air lay dead as in a room, +and yet all the isle sounded as under a strong shower, the eaves +thickly pattering, the lofty palms dripping at larger intervals +and with a louder note. In this bold nocturnal light the +interior of the houses lay inscrutable, one lump of blackness, +save when the moon glinted under the roof, and made a belt of +silver, and drew the slanting shadows of the pillars on the +floor. Nowhere in all the town was any lamp or ember; not a +creature stirred; I thought I was alone to be awake; but the +police were faithful to their duty; secretly vigilant, keeping +account of time; and a little later, the watchman struck slowly +and repeatedly on the cathedral bell; four o’clock, the +warning signal. It seemed strange that, in a town resigned +to drunkenness and tumult, curfew and réveille should +still be sounded and still obeyed.</p> +<p>The day came, and brought little change. The place still +lay silent; the people slept, the town slept. Even the few +who were awake, mostly women and children, held their peace and +kept within under the strong shadow of the thatch, where you must +stop and peer to see them. Through the deserted streets, +and past the sleeping houses, a deputation took its way at an +early hour to the palace; the king was suddenly awakened, and +must listen (probably with a headache) to unpalatable +truths. Mrs. Rick, being a sufficient mistress of that +difficult tongue, was spokeswoman; she explained to the sick +monarch that I was an intimate personal friend of Queen +Victoria’s; that immediately on my return I should make her +a report upon Butaritari; and that if my house should have been +again invaded by natives, a man-of-war would be despatched to +make reprisals. It was scarce the fact—rather a just +and necessary parable of the fact, corrected for latitude; and it +certainly told upon the king. He was much affected; he had +conceived the notion (he said) that I was a man of some +importance, but not dreamed it was as bad as this; and the +missionary house was tapu’d under a fine of fifty +dollars.</p> +<p>So much was announced on the return of the deputation; not any +more; and I gathered subsequently that much more had +passed. The protection gained was welcome. It had +been the most annoying and not the least alarming feature of the +day before, that our house was periodically filled with tipsy +natives, twenty or thirty at a time, begging drink, fingering our +goods, hard to be dislodged, awkward to quarrel with. Queen +Victoria’s friend (who was soon promoted to be her son) was +free from these intrusions. Not only my house, but my +neighbourhood as well, was left in peace; even on our walks +abroad we were guarded and prepared for; and, like great persons +visiting a hospital, saw only the fair side. For the matter +of a week we were thus suffered to go out and in and live in a +fool’s paradise, supposing the king to have kept his word, +the tapu to be revived and the island once more sober.</p> +<p><i>Tuesday</i>, <i>July</i> 23.—We dined under a bare +trellis erected for the Fourth of July; and here we used to +linger by lamplight over coffee and tobacco. In that +climate evening approaches without sensible chill; the wind dies +out before sunset; heaven glows a while and fades, and darkens +into the blueness of the tropical night; swiftly and insensibly +the shadows thicken, the stars multiply their number; you look +around you and the day is gone. It was then that we would +see our Chinaman draw near across the compound in a lurching +sphere of light, divided by his shadows; and with the coming of +the lamp the night closed about the table. The faces of the +company, the spars of the trellis, stood out suddenly bright on a +ground of blue and silver, faintly designed with palm-tops and +the peaked roofs of houses. Here and there the gloss upon a +leaf, or the fracture of a stone, returned an isolated +sparkle. All else had vanished. We hung there, +illuminated like a galaxy of stars <i>in vacuo</i>; we sat, +manifest and blind, amid the general ambush of the darkness; and +the islanders, passing with light footfalls and low voices in the +sand of the road, lingered to observe us, unseen.</p> +<p>On Tuesday the dusk had fallen, the lamp had just been +brought, when a missile struck the table with a rattling smack +and rebounded past my ear. Three inches to one side and +this page had never been written; for the thing travelled like a +cannon ball. It was supposed at the time to be a nut, +though even at the time I thought it seemed a small one and fell +strangely.</p> +<p><i>Wednesday</i>, <i>July</i> 24.—The dusk had fallen +once more, and the lamp been just brought out, when the same +business was repeated. And again the missile whistled past +my ear. One nut I had been willing to accept; a second, I +rejected utterly. A cocoa-nut does not come slinging along +on a windless evening, making an angle of about fifteen degrees +with the horizon; cocoa-nuts do not fall on successive nights at +the same hour and spot; in both cases, besides, a specific moment +seemed to have been chosen, that when the lamp was just carried +out, a specific person threatened, and that the head of the +family. I may have been right or wrong, but I believed I +was the mark of some intimidation; believed the missile was a +stone, aimed not to hit, but to frighten.</p> +<p>No idea makes a man more angry. I ran into the road, +where the natives were as usual promenading in the dark; Maka +joined me with a lantern; and I ran from one to another, glared +in quite innocent faces, put useless questions, and proffered +idle threats. Thence I carried my wrath (which was worthy +the son of any queen in history) to the Ricks. They heard +me with depression, assured me this trick of throwing a stone +into a family dinner was not new; that it meant mischief, and was +of a piece with the alarming disposition of the natives. +And then the truth, so long concealed from us, came out. +The king had broken his promise, he had defied the deputation; +the tapu was still dormant, <i>The Land we Live in</i> still +selling drink, and that quarter of the town disturbed and menaced +by perpetual broils. But there was worse ahead: a feast was +now preparing for the birthday of the little princess; and the +tributary chiefs of Kuma and Little Makin were expected +daily. Strong in a following of numerous and somewhat +savage clansmen, each of these was believed, like a Douglas of +old, to be of doubtful loyalty. Kuma (a little pot-bellied +fellow) never visited the palace, never entered the town, but sat +on the beach on a mat, his gun across his knees, parading his +mistrust and scorn; Karaiti of Makin, although he was more bold, +was not supposed to be more friendly; and not only were these +vassals jealous of the throne, but the followers on either side +shared in the animosity. Brawls had already taken place; +blows had passed which might at any moment be repaid in +blood. Some of the strangers were already here and already +drinking; if the debauch continued after the bulk of them had +come, a collision, perhaps a revolution, was to be expected.</p> +<p>The sale of drink is in this group a measure of the jealousy +of traders; one begins, the others are constrained to follow; and +to him who has the most gin, and sells it the most recklessly, +the lion’s share of copra is assured. It is felt by +all to be an extreme expedient, neither safe, decent, nor +dignified. A trader on Tarawa, heated by an eager rivalry, +brought many cases of gin. He told me he sat afterwards day +and night in his house till it was finished, not daring to arrest +the sale, not venturing to go forth, the bush all round him +filled with howling drunkards. At night, above all, when he +was afraid to sleep, and heard shots and voices about him in the +darkness, his remorse was black.</p> +<p>‘My God!’ he reflected, ‘if I was to lose my +life on such a wretched business!’ Often and often, +in the story of the Gilberts, this scene has been repeated; and +the remorseful trader sat beside his lamp, longing for the day, +listening with agony for the sound of murder, registering +resolutions for the future. For the business is easy to +begin, but hazardous to stop. The natives are in their way +a just and law-abiding people, mindful of their debts, docile to +the voice of their own institutions; when the tapu is re-enforced +they will cease drinking; but the white who seeks to antedate the +movement by refusing liquor does so at his peril.</p> +<p>Hence, in some degree, the anxiety and helplessness of Mr. +Rick. He and Tom, alarmed by the rabblement of the <i>Sans +Souci</i>, had stopped the sale; they had done so without danger, +because <i>The Land we Live in</i> still continued selling; it +was claimed, besides, that they had been the first to +begin. What step could be taken? Could Mr. Rick visit +Mr. Muller (with whom he was not on terms) and address him thus: +‘I was getting ahead of you, now you are getting ahead of +me, and I ask you to forego your profit. I got my place +closed in safety, thanks to your continuing; but now I think you +have continued long enough. I begin to be alarmed; and +because I am afraid I ask you to confront a certain +danger’? It was not to be thought of. Something +else had to be found; and there was one person at one end of the +town who was at least not interested in copra. There was +little else to be said in favour of myself as an +ambassador. I had arrived in the Wightman schooner, I was +living in the Wightman compound, I was the daily associate of the +Wightman coterie. It was egregious enough that I should now +intrude unasked in the private affairs of Crawford’s agent, +and press upon him the sacrifice of his interests and the venture +of his life. But bad as I might be, there was none better; +since the affair of the stone I was, besides, sharp-set to be +doing, the idea of a delicate interview attracted me, and I +thought it policy to show myself abroad.</p> +<p>The night was very dark. There was service in the +church, and the building glimmered through all its crevices like +a dim Kirk Allowa’. I saw few other lights, but was +indistinctly aware of many people stirring in the darkness, and a +hum and sputter of low talk that sounded stealthy. I +believe (in the old phrase) my beard was sometimes on my shoulder +as I went. Muller’s was but partly lighted, and quite +silent, and the gate was fastened. I could by no means +manage to undo the latch. No wonder, since I found it +afterwards to be four or five feet long—a fortification in +itself. As I still fumbled, a dog came on the inside and +sniffed suspiciously at my hands, so that I was reduced to +calling ‘House ahoy!’ Mr. Muller came down and +put his chin across the paling in the dark. ‘Who is +that?’ said he, like one who has no mind to welcome +strangers.</p> +<p>‘My name is Stevenson,’ said I.</p> +<p>‘O, Mr. Stevens! I didn’t know you. +Come inside.’ We stepped into the dark store, when I +leaned upon the counter and he against the wall. All the +light came from the sleeping-room, where I saw his family being +put to bed; it struck full in my face, but Mr. Muller stood in +shadow. No doubt he expected what was Coming, and sought +the advantage of position; but for a man who wished to persuade +and had nothing to conceal, mine was the preferable.</p> +<p>‘Look here,’ I began, ‘I hear you are +selling to the natives.’</p> +<p>‘Others have done that before me,’ he returned +pointedly.</p> +<p>‘No doubt,’ said I, ‘and I have nothing to +do with the past, but the future. I want you to promise you +will handle these spirits carefully.’</p> +<p>‘Now what is your motive in this?’ he asked, and +then, with a sneer, ‘Are you afraid of your +life?’</p> +<p>‘That is nothing to the purpose,’ I replied. +‘I know, and you know, these spirits ought not to be used +at all.’</p> +<p>‘Tom and Mr. Rick have sold them before.’</p> +<p>‘I have nothing to do with Tom and Mr. Rick. All I +know is I have heard them both refuse.’</p> +<p>‘No, I suppose you have nothing to do with them. +Then you are just afraid of your life.’</p> +<p>‘Come now,’ I cried, being perhaps a little stung, +‘you know in your heart I am asking a reasonable +thing. I don’t ask you to lose your +profit—though I would prefer to see no spirits brought +here, as you would—’</p> +<p>‘I don’t say I wouldn’t. I +didn’t begin this,’ he interjected.</p> +<p>‘No, I don’t suppose you did,’ said I. +‘And I don’t ask you to lose; I ask you to give me +your word, man to man, that you will make no native +drunk.’</p> +<p>Up to now Mr. Muller had maintained an attitude very trying to +my temper; but he had maintained it with difficulty, his +sentiment being all upon my side; and here he changed ground for +the worse. ‘It isn’t me that sells,’ said +he.</p> +<p>‘No, it’s that nigger,’ I agreed. +‘But he’s yours to buy and sell; you have your hand +on the nape of his neck; and I ask you—I have my wife +here—to use the authority you have.’</p> +<p>He hastily returned to his old ward. ‘I +don’t deny I could if I wanted,’ said he. +‘But there’s no danger, the natives are all +quiet. You’re just afraid of your life.’</p> +<p>I do not like to be called a coward, even by implication; and +here I lost my temper and propounded an untimely ultimatum. +‘You had better put it plain,’ I cried. +‘Do you mean to refuse me what I ask?’</p> +<p>‘I don’t want either to refuse it or grant +it,’ he replied.</p> +<p>‘You’ll find you have to do the one thing or the +other, and right now!’ I cried, and then, striking into a +happier vein, ‘Come,’ said I, ‘you’re a +better sort than that. I see what’s wrong with +you—you think I came from the opposite camp. I see +the sort of man you are, and you know that what I ask is +right.’</p> +<p>Again he changed ground. ‘If the natives get any +drink, it isn’t safe to stop them,’ he objected.</p> +<p>‘I’ll be answerable for the bar,’ I +said. ‘We are three men and four revolvers; +we’ll come at a word, and hold the place against the +village.’</p> +<p>‘You don’t know what you’re talking about; +it’s too dangerous!’ he cried.</p> +<p>‘Look here,’ said I, ‘I don’t mind +much about losing that life you talk so much of; but I mean to +lose it the way I want to, and that is, putting a stop to all +this beastliness.’</p> +<p>He talked a while about his duty to the firm; I minded not at +all, I was secure of victory. He was but waiting to +capitulate, and looked about for any potent to relieve the +strain. In the gush of light from the bedroom door I spied +a cigar-holder on the desk. ‘That is well +coloured,’ said I.</p> +<p>‘Will you take a cigar?’ said he.</p> +<p>I took it and held it up unlighted. ‘Now,’ +said I, ‘you promise me.’</p> +<p>‘I promise you you won’t have any trouble from +natives that have drunk at my place,’ he replied.</p> +<p>‘That is all I ask,’ said I, and showed it was not +by immediately offering to try his stock.</p> +<p>So far as it was anyway critical our interview here +ended. Mr. Muller had thenceforth ceased to regard me as an +emissary from his rivals, dropped his defensive attitude, and +spoke as he believed. I could make out that he would +already, had he dared, have stopped the sale himself. Not +quite daring, it may be imagined how he resented the idea of +interference from those who had (by his own statement) first led +him on, then deserted him in the breach, and now (sitting +themselves in safety) egged him on to a new peril, which was all +gain to them, all loss to him! I asked him what he thought +of the danger from the feast.</p> +<p>‘I think worse of it than any of you,’ he +answered. ‘They were shooting around here last night, +and I heard the balls too. I said to myself, +“That’s bad.” What gets me is why you +should be making this row up at your end. I should be the +first to go.’</p> +<p>It was a thoughtless wonder. The consolation of being +second is not great; the fact, not the order of going—there +was our concern.</p> +<p>Scott talks moderately of looking forward to a time of +fighting ‘with a feeling that resembled +pleasure.’ The resemblance seems rather an +identity. In modern life, contact is ended; man grows +impatient of endless manœuvres; and to approach the fact, +to find ourselves where we can push an advantage home, and stand +a fair risk, and see at last what we are made of, stirs the +blood. It was so at least with all my family, who bubbled +with delight at the approach of trouble; and we sat deep into the +night like a pack of schoolboys, preparing the revolvers and +arranging plans against the morrow. It promised certainly +to be a busy and eventful day. The Old Men were to be +summoned to confront me on the question of the tapu; Muller might +call us at any moment to garrison his bar; and suppose Muller to +fail, we decided in a family council to take that matter into our +own hands, <i>The Land we Live in</i> at the pistol’s +mouth, and with the polysyllabic Williams, dance to a new +tune. As I recall our humour I think it would have gone +hard with the mulatto.</p> +<p><i>Wednesday</i>, <i>July</i> 24.—It was as well, and +yet it was disappointing that these thunder-clouds rolled off in +silence. Whether the Old Men recoiled from an interview +with Queen Victoria’s son, whether Muller had secretly +intervened, or whether the step flowed naturally from the fears +of the king and the nearness of the feast, the tapu was early +that morning re-enforced; not a day too soon, from the manner the +boats began to arrive thickly, and the town was filled with the +big rowdy vassals of Karaiti.</p> +<p>The effect lingered for some time on the minds of the traders; +it was with the approval of all present that I helped to draw up +a petition to the United States, praying for a law against the +liquor trade in the Gilberts; and it was at this request that I +added, under my own name, a brief testimony of what had +passed;—useless pains; since the whole reposes, probably +unread and possibly unopened, in a pigeon-hole at Washington.</p> +<p><i>Sunday</i>, <i>July</i> 28.—This day we had the +afterpiece of the debauch. The king and queen, in European +clothes, and followed by armed guards, attended church for the +first time, and sat perched aloft in a precarious dignity under +the barrel-hoops. Before sermon his majesty clambered from +the dais, stood lopsidedly upon the gravel floor, and in a few +words abjured drinking. The queen followed suit with a yet +briefer allocution. All the men in church were next +addressed in turn; each held up his right hand, and the affair +was over—throne and church were reconciled.</p> +<h3>CHAPTER VI—THE FIVE DAYS’ FESTIVAL</h3> +<p><i>Thursday</i>, <i>July</i> 25.—The street was this day +much enlivened by the presence of the men from Little Makin; they +average taller than Butaritarians, and being on a holiday, went +wreathed with yellow leaves and gorgeous in vivid colours. +They are said to be more savage, and to be proud of the +distinction. Indeed, it seemed to us they swaggered in the +town, like plaided Highlanders upon the streets of Inverness, +conscious of barbaric virtues.</p> +<p>In the afternoon the summer parlour was observed to be packed +with people; others standing outside and stooping to peer under +the eaves, like children at home about a circus. It was the +Makin company, rehearsing for the day of competition. +Karaiti sat in the front row close to the singers, where we were +summoned (I suppose in honour of Queen Victoria) to join +him. A strong breathless heat reigned under the iron roof, +and the air was heavy with the scent of wreaths. The +singers, with fine mats about their loins, cocoa-nut feathers set +in rings upon their fingers, and their heads crowned with yellow +leaves, sat on the floor by companies. A varying number of +soloists stood up for different songs; and these bore the chief +part in the music. But the full force of the companies, +even when not singing, contributed continuously to the effect, +and marked the ictus of the measure, mimicking, grimacing, +casting up their heads and eyes, fluttering the feathers on their +fingers, clapping hands, or beating (loud as a kettledrum) on the +left breast; the time was exquisite, the music barbarous, but +full of conscious art. I noted some devices constantly +employed. A sudden change would be introduced (I think of +key) with no break of the measure, but emphasised by a sudden +dramatic heightening of the voice and a swinging, general +gesticulation. The voices of the soloists would begin far +apart in a rude discord, and gradually draw together to a unison; +which, when, they had reached, they were joined and drowned by +the full chorus. The ordinary, hurried, barking unmelodious +movement of the voices would at times be broken and glorified by +a psalm-like strain of melody, often well constructed, or seeming +so by contrast. There was much variety of measure, and +towards the end of each piece, when the fun became fast and +furious, a recourse to this figure—</p> +<p style="text-align: center"> +<a href="images/p252.jpg"> +<img alt= +"Music. It means two/four time with quaver, quaver, crotchet +repeated for three bars" +title= +"Music. It means two/four time with quaver, quaver, crotchet +repeated for three bars" +src="images/p252.jpg" /> +</a></p> +<p>It is difficult to conceive what fire and devilry they get +into these hammering finales; all go together, voices, hands, +eyes, leaves, and fluttering finger-rings; the chorus swings to +the eye, the song throbs on the ear; the faces are convulsed with +enthusiasm and effort.</p> +<p>Presently the troop stood up in a body, the drums forming a +half-circle for the soloists, who were sometimes five or even +more in number. The songs that followed were highly +dramatic; though I had none to give me any explanation, I would +at times make out some shadowy but decisive outline of a plot; +and I was continually reminded of certain quarrelsome concerted +scenes in grand operas at home; just so the single voices issue +from and fall again into the general volume; just so do the +performers separate and crowd together, brandish the raised hand, +and roll the eye to heaven—or the gallery. Already +this is beyond the Thespian model; the art of this people is +already past the embryo: song, dance, drums, quartette and +solo—it is the drama full developed although still in +miniature. Of all so-called dancing in the South Seas, that +which I saw in Butaritari stands easily the first. The +<i>hula</i>, as it may be viewed by the speedy globe-trotter in +Honolulu, is surely the most dull of man’s inventions, and +the spectator yawns under its length as at a college lecture or a +parliamentary debate. But the Gilbert Island dance leads on +the mind; it thrills, rouses, subjugates; it has the essence of +all art, an unexplored imminent significance. Where so many +are engaged, and where all must make (at a given moment) the same +swift, elaborate, and often arbitrary movement, the toil of +rehearsal is of course extreme. But they begin as +children. A child and a man may often be seen together in a +maniap’: the man sings and gesticulates, the child stands +before him with streaming tears and tremulously copies him in act +and sound; it is the Gilbert Island artist learning (as all +artists must) his art in sorrow.</p> +<p>I may seem to praise too much; here is a passage from my +wife’s diary, which proves that I was not alone in being +moved, and completes the picture:—‘The conductor gave +the cue, and all the dancers, waving their arms, swaying their +bodies, and clapping their breasts in perfect time, opened with +an introductory. The performers remained seated, except +two, and once three, and twice a single soloist. These +stood in the group, making a slight movement with the feet and +rhythmical quiver of the body as they sang. There was a +pause after the introductory, and then the real business of the +opera—for it was no less—began; an opera where every +singer was an accomplished actor. The leading man, in an +impassioned ecstasy which possessed him from head to foot, seemed +transfigured; once it was as though a strong wind had swept over +the stage—their arms, their feathered fingers thrilling +with an emotion that shook my nerves as well: heads and bodies +followed like a field of grain before a gust. My blood came +hot and cold, tears pricked my eyes, my head whirled, I felt an +almost irresistible impulse to join the dancers. One drama, +I think, I very nearly understood. A fierce and savage old +man took the solo part. He sang of the birth of a prince, +and how he was tenderly rocked in his mother’s arms; of his +boyhood, when he excelled his fellows in swimming, climbing, and +all athletic sports; of his youth, when he went out to sea with +his boat and fished; of his manhood, when he married a wife who +cradled a son of his own in her arms. Then came the alarm +of war, and a great battle, of which for a time the issue was +doubtful; but the hero conquered, as he always does, and with a +tremendous burst of the victors the piece closed. There +were also comic pieces, which caused great amusement. +During one, an old man behind me clutched me by the arm, shook +his finger in my face with a roguish smile, and said something +with a chuckle, which I took to be the equivalent of “O, +you women, you women; it is true of you all!” I fear +it was not complimentary. At no time was there the least +sign of the ugly indecency of the eastern islands. All was +poetry pure and simple. The music itself was as complex as +our own, though constructed on an entirely different basis; once +or twice I was startled by a bit of something very like the best +English sacred music, but it was only for an instant. At +last there was a longer pause, and this time the dancers were all +on their feet. As the drama went on, the interest +grew. The performers appealed to each other, to the +audience, to the heaven above; they took counsel with each other, +the conspirators drew together in a knot; it was just an opera, +the drums coming in at proper intervals, the tenor, baritone, and +bass all where they should be—except that the voices were +all of the same calibre. A woman once sang from the back +row with a very fine contralto voice spoilt by being made +artificially nasal; I notice all the women affect that +unpleasantness. At one time a boy of angelic beauty was the +soloist; and at another, a child of six or eight, doubtless an +infant phenomenon being trained, was placed in the centre. +The little fellow was desperately frightened and embarrassed at +first, but towards the close warmed up to his work and showed +much dramatic talent. The changing expressions on the faces +of the dancers were so speaking, that it seemed a great stupidity +not to understand them.’</p> +<p>Our neighbour at this performance, Karaiti, somewhat favours +his Butaritarian majesty in shape and feature, being, like him, +portly, bearded, and Oriental. In character he seems the +reverse: alert, smiling, jovial, jocular, industrious. At +home in his own island, he labours himself like a slave, and +makes his people labour like a slave-driver. He takes an +interest in ideas. George the trader told him about +flying-machines. ‘Is that true, George?’ he +asked. ‘It is in the papers,’ replied +George. ‘Well,’ said Karaiti, ‘if that +man can do it with machinery, I can do it without’; and he +designed and made a pair of wings, strapped them on his +shoulders, went to the end of a pier, launched himself into +space, and fell bulkily into the sea. His wives fished him +out, for his wings hindered him in swimming. +‘George,’ said he, pausing as he went up to change, +‘George, you lie.’ He had eight wives, for his +small realm still follows ancient customs; but he showed +embarrassment when this was mentioned to my wife. +‘Tell her I have only brought one here,’ he said +anxiously. Altogether the Black Douglas pleased us much; +and as we heard fresh details of the king’s uneasiness, and +saw for ourselves that all the weapons in the summer parlour had +been hid, we watched with the more admiration the cause of all +this anxiety rolling on his big legs, with his big smiling face, +apparently unarmed, and certainly unattended, through the hostile +town. The Red Douglas, pot-bellied Kuma, having perhaps +heard word of the debauch, remained upon his fief; his vassals +thus came uncommanded to the feast, and swelled the following of +Karaiti.</p> +<p><i>Friday</i>, <i>July</i> 26.—At night in the dark, the +singers of Makin paraded in the road before our house and sang +the song of the princess. ‘This is the day; she was +born to-day; Nei Kamaunave was born to-day—a beautiful +princess, Queen of Butaritari.’ So I was told it went +in endless iteration. The song was of course out of season, +and the performance only a rehearsal. But it was a serenade +besides; a delicate attention to ourselves from our new friend, +Karaiti.</p> +<p><i>Saturday</i>, <i>July</i> 27.—We had announced a +performance of the magic lantern to-night in church; and this +brought the king to visit us. In honour of the Black +Douglas (I suppose) his usual two guardsmen were now increased to +four; and the squad made an outlandish figure as they straggled +after him, in straw hats, kilts and jackets. Three carried +their arms reversed, the butts over their shoulders, the muzzles +menacing the king’s plump back; the fourth had passed his +weapon behind his neck, and held it there with arms extended like +a backboard. The visit was extraordinarily long. The +king, no longer galvanised with gin, said and did nothing. +He sat collapsed in a chair and let a cigar go out. It was +hot, it was sleepy, it was cruel dull; there was no resource but +to spy in the countenance of Tebureimoa for some remaining trait +of <i>Mr. Corpse</i> the butcher. His hawk nose, crudely +depressed and flattened at the point, did truly seem to us to +smell of midnight murder. When he took his leave, Maka bade +me observe him going down the stair (or rather ladder) from the +verandah. ‘Old man,’ said Maka. +‘Yes,’ said I, ‘and yet I suppose not old +man.’ ‘Young man,’ returned Maka, +‘perhaps fo’ty.’ And I have heard since +he is most likely younger.</p> +<p>While the magic lantern was showing, I skulked without in the +dark. The voice of Maka, excitedly explaining the Scripture +slides, seemed to fill not the church only, but the +neighbourhood. All else was silent. Presently a +distant sound of singing arose and approached; and a procession +drew near along the road, the hot clean smell of the men and +women striking in my face delightfully. At the corner, +arrested by the voice of Maka and the lightening and darkening of +the church, they paused. They had no mind to go nearer, +that was plain. They were Makin people, I believe, probably +staunch heathens, contemners of the missionary and his +works. Of a sudden, however, a man broke from their +company, took to his heels, and fled into the church; next moment +three had followed him; the next it was a covey of near upon a +score, all pelting for their lives. So the little band of +the heathen paused irresolute at the corner, and melted before +the attractions of a magic lantern, like a glacier in +spring. The more staunch vainly taunted the deserters; +three fled in a guilty silence, but still fled; and when at +length the leader found the wit or the authority to get his troop +in motion and revive the singing, it was with much diminished +forces that they passed musically on up the dark road.</p> +<p>Meanwhile inside the luminous pictures brightened and +faded. I stood for some while unobserved in the rear of the +spectators, when I could hear just in front of me a pair of +lovers following the show with interest, the male playing the +part of interpreter and (like Adam) mingling caresses with his +lecture. The wild animals, a tiger in particular, and that +old school-treat favourite, the sleeper and the mouse, were +hailed with joy; but the chief marvel and delight was in the +gospel series. Maka, in the opinion of his aggrieved wife, +did not properly rise to the occasion. ‘What is the +matter with the man? Why can’t he talk?’ she +cried. The matter with the man, I think, was the greatness +of the opportunity; he reeled under his good fortune; and whether +he did ill or well, the exposure of these pious +‘phantoms’ did as a matter of fact silence in all +that part of the island the voice of the scoffer. +‘Why then,’ the word went round, ‘why then, the +Bible is true!’ And on our return afterwards we were +told the impression was yet lively, and those who had seen might +be heard telling those who had not, ‘O yes, it is all true; +these things all happened, we have seen the +pictures.’ The argument is not so childish as it +seems; for I doubt if these islanders are acquainted with any +other mode of representation but photography; so that the picture +of an event (on the old melodrama principle that ‘the +camera cannot lie, Joseph,’) would appear strong proof of +its occurrence. The fact amused us the more because our +slides were some of them ludicrously silly, and one (Christ +before Pilate) was received with shouts of merriment, in which +even Maka was constrained to join.</p> +<p><i>Sunday</i>, <i>July</i> 28.—Karaiti came to ask for a +repetition of the ‘phantoms’—this was the +accepted word—and, having received a promise, turned and +left my humble roof without the shadow of a salutation. I +felt it impolite to have the least appearance of pocketing a +slight; the times had been too difficult, and were still too +doubtful; and Queen Victoria’s son was bound to maintain +the honour of his house. Karaiti was accordingly summoned +that evening to the Ricks, where Mrs. Rick fell foul of him in +words, and Queen Victoria’s son assailed him with indignant +looks. I was the ass with the lion’s skin; I could +not roar in the language of the Gilbert Islands; but I could +stare. Karaiti declared he had meant no offence; apologised +in a sound, hearty, gentlemanly manner; and became at once at his +ease. He had in a dagger to examine, and announced he would +come to price it on the morrow, to-day being Sunday; this nicety +in a heathen with eight wives surprised me. The dagger was +‘good for killing fish,’ he said roguishly; and was +supposed to have his eye upon fish upon two legs. It is at +least odd that in Eastern Polynesia fish was the accepted +euphemism for the human sacrifice. Asked as to the +population of his island, Karaiti called out to his vassals who +sat waiting him outside the door, and they put it at four hundred +and fifty; but (added Karaiti jovially) there will soon be plenty +more, for all the women are in the family way. Long before +we separated I had quite forgotten his offence. He, +however, still bore it in mind; and with a very courteous +inspiration returned early on the next day, paid us a long visit, +and punctiliously said farewell when he departed.</p> +<p><i>Monday</i>, <i>July</i> 29.—The great day came round +at last. In the first hours the night was startled by the +sound of clapping hands and the chant of Nei Kamaunava; its +melancholy, slow, and somewhat menacing measures broken at +intervals by a formidable shout. The little morsel of +humanity thus celebrated in the dark hours was observed at midday +playing on the green entirely naked, and equally unobserved and +unconcerned.</p> +<p>The summer parlour on its artificial islet, relieved against +the shimmering lagoon, and shimmering itself with sun and tinned +iron, was all day crowded about by eager men and women. +Within, it was boxed full of islanders, of any age and size, and +in every degree of nudity and finery. So close we squatted, +that at one time I had a mighty handsome woman on my knees, two +little naked urchins having their feet against my back. +There might be a dame in full attire of <i>holoku</i> and hat and +flowers; and her next neighbour might the next moment strip some +little rag of a shift from her fat shoulders and come out a +monument of flesh, painted rather than covered by the hairbreadth +<i>ridi</i>. Little ladies who thought themselves too great +to appear undraped upon so high a festival were seen to pause +outside in the bright sunshine, their miniature ridis in their +hand; a moment more and they were full-dressed and entered the +concert-room.</p> +<p>At either end stood up to sing, or sat down to rest, the +alternate companies of singers; Kuma and Little Makin on the +north, Butaritari and its conjunct hamlets on the south; both +groups conspicuous in barbaric bravery. In the midst, +between these rival camps of troubadours, a bench was placed; and +here the king and queen throned it, some two or three feet above +the crowded audience on the floor—Tebureimoa as usual in +his striped pyjamas with a satchel strapped across one shoulder, +doubtless (in the island fashion) to contain his pistols; the +queen in a purple <i>holoku</i>, her abundant hair let down, a +fan in her hand. The bench was turned facing to the +strangers, a piece of well-considered civility; and when it was +the turn of Butaritari to sing, the pair must twist round on the +bench, lean their elbows on the rail, and turn to us the +spectacle of their broad backs. The royal couple +occasionally solaced themselves with a clay pipe; and the pomp of +state was further heightened by the rifles of a picket of the +guard.</p> +<p>With this kingly countenance, and ourselves squatted on the +ground, we heard several songs from one side or the other. +Then royalty and its guards withdrew, and Queen Victoria’s +son and daughter-in-law were summoned by acclamation to the +vacant throne. Our pride was perhaps a little modified when +we were joined on our high places by a certain thriftless loafer +of a white; and yet I was glad too, for the man had a smattering +of native, and could give me some idea of the subject of the +songs. One was patriotic, and dared Tembinok’ of +Apemama, the terror of the group, to an invasion. One mixed +the planting of taro and the harvest-home. Some were +historical, and commemorated kings and the illustrious chances of +their time, such as a bout of drinking or a war. One, at +least, was a drama of domestic interest, excellently played by +the troop from Makin. It told the story of a man who has +lost his wife, at first bewails her loss, then seeks another: the +earlier strains (or acts) are played exclusively by men; but +towards the end a woman appears, who has just lost her husband; +and I suppose the pair console each other, for the finale seemed +of happy omen. Of some of the songs my informant told me +briefly they were ‘like about the <i>weemen</i>’; +this I could have guessed myself. Each side (I should have +said) was strengthened by one or two women. They were all +soloists, did not very often join in the performance, but stood +disengaged at the back part of the stage, and looked (in +<i>ridi</i>, necklace, and dressed hair) for all the world like +European ballet-dancers. When the song was anyway broad +these ladies came particularly to the front; and it was singular +to see that, after each entry, the <i>première +danseuse</i> pretended to be overcome by shame, as though led on +beyond what she had meant, and her male assistants made a feint +of driving her away like one who had disgraced herself. +Similar affectations accompany certain truly obscene dances of +Samoa, where they are very well in place. Here it was +different. The words, perhaps, in this free-spoken world, +were gross enough to make a carter blush; and the most suggestive +feature was this feint of shame. For such parts the women +showed some disposition; they were pert, they were neat, they +were acrobatic, they were at times really amusing, and some of +them were pretty. But this is not the artist’s field; +there is the whole width of heaven between such capering and +ogling, and the strange rhythmic gestures, and strange, +rapturous, frenzied faces with which the best of the male dancers +held us spellbound through a Gilbert Island ballet.</p> +<p>Almost from the first it was apparent that the people of the +city were defeated. I might have thought them even good, +only I had the other troop before my eyes to correct my standard, +and remind me continually of ‘the little more, and how much +it is.’ Perceiving themselves worsted, the choir of +Butaritari grew confused, blundered, and broke down; amid this +hubbub of unfamiliar intervals I should not myself have +recognised the slip, but the audience were quick to catch it, and +to jeer. To crown all, the Makin company began a dance of +truly superlative merit. I know not what it was about, I +was too much absorbed to ask. In one act a part of the +chorus, squealing in some strange falsetto, produced very much +the effect of our orchestra; in another, the dancers, leaping +like jumping-jacks, with arms extended, passed through and +through each other’s ranks with extraordinary speed, +neatness, and humour. A more laughable effect I never saw; +in any European theatre it would have brought the house down, and +the island audience roared with laughter and applause. This +filled up the measure for the rival company, and they forgot +themselves and decency. After each act or figure of the +ballet, the performers pause a moment standing, and the next is +introduced by the clapping of hands in triplets. Not until +the end of the whole ballet do they sit down, which is the signal +for the rivals to stand up. But now all rules were to be +broken. During the interval following on this great +applause, the company of Butaritari leaped suddenly to their feet +and most unhandsomely began a performance of their own. It +was strange to see the men of Makin staring; I have seen a tenor +in Europe stare with the same blank dignity into a hissing +theatre; but presently, to my surprise, they sobered down, gave +up the unsung remainder of their ballet, resumed their seats, and +suffered their ungallant adversaries to go on and finish. +Nothing would suffice. Again, at the first interval, +Butaritari unhandsomely cut in; Makin, irritated in turn, +followed the example; and the two companies of dancers remained +permanently standing, continuously clapping hands, and regularly +cutting across each other at each pause. I expected blows +to begin with any moment; and our position in the midst was +highly unstrategical. But the Makin people had a better +thought; and upon a fresh interruption turned and trooped out of +the house. We followed them, first because these were the +artists, second because they were guests and had been scurvily +ill-used. A large population of our neighbours did the +same, so that the causeway was filled from end to end by the +procession of deserters; and the Butaritari choir was left to +sing for its own pleasure in an empty house, having gained the +point and lost the audience. It was surely fortunate that +there was no one drunk; but, drunk or sober, where else would a +scene so irritating have concluded without blows?</p> +<p>The last stage and glory of this auspicious day was of our own +providing—the second and positively the last appearance of +the phantoms. All round the church, groups sat outside, in +the night, where they could see nothing; perhaps ashamed to +enter, certainly finding some shadowy pleasure in the mere +proximity. Within, about one-half of the great shed was +densely packed with people. In the midst, on the royal +dais, the lantern luminously smoked; chance rays of light struck +out the earnest countenance of our Chinaman grinding the +hand-organ; a fainter glimmer showed off the rafters and their +shadows in the hollow of the roof; the pictures shone and +vanished on the screen; and as each appeared, there would run a +hush, a whisper, a strong shuddering rustle, and a chorus of +small cries among the crowd. There sat by me the mate of a +wrecked schooner. ‘They would think this a strange +sight in Europe or the States,’ said he, ‘going on in +a building like this, all tied with bits of string.’</p> +<h3>CHAPTER VII—HUSBAND AND WIFE</h3> +<p>The trader accustomed to the manners of Eastern Polynesia has +a lesson to learn among the Gilberts. The <i>ridi</i> is +but a spare attire; as late as thirty years back the women went +naked until marriage; within ten years the custom lingered; and +these facts, above all when heard in description, conveyed a very +false idea of the manners of the group. A very intelligent +missionary described it (in its former state) as a +‘Paradise of naked women’ for the resident +whites. It was at least a platonic Paradise, where Lothario +ventured at his peril. Since 1860, fourteen whites have +perished on a single island, all for the same cause, all found +where they had no business, and speared by some indignant father +of a family; the figure was given me by one of their +contemporaries who had been more prudent and survived. The +strange persistence of these fourteen martyrs might seem to point +to monomania or a series of romantic passions; gin is the more +likely key. The poor buzzards sat alone in their houses by +an open case; they drank; their brain was fired; they stumbled +towards the nearest houses on chance; and the dart went through +their liver. In place of a Paradise the trader found an +archipelago of fierce husbands and of virtuous women. +‘Of course if you wish to make love to them, it’s the +same as anywhere else,’ observed a trader innocently; but +he and his companions rarely so choose.</p> +<p>The trader must be credited with a virtue: he often makes a +kind and loyal husband. Some of the worst beachcombers in +the Pacific, some of the last of the old school, have fallen in +my path, and some of them were admirable to their native wives, +and one made a despairing widower. The position of a +trader’s wife in the Gilberts is, besides, unusually +enviable. She shares the immunities of her husband. +Curfew in Butaritari sounds for her in vain. Long after the +bell is rung and the great island ladies are confined for the +night to their own roof, this chartered libertine may scamper and +giggle through the deserted streets or go down to bathe in the +dark. The resources of the store are at her hand; she goes +arrayed like a queen, and feasts delicately everyday upon tinned +meats. And she who was perhaps of no regard or station +among natives sits with captains, and is entertained on board of +schooners. Five of these privileged dames were some time +our neighbours. Four were handsome skittish lasses, +gamesome like children, and like children liable to fits of +pouting. They wore dresses by day, but there was a tendency +after dark to strip these lendings and to career and squall about +the compound in the aboriginal <i>ridi</i>. Games of cards +were continually played, with shells for counters; their course +was much marred by cheating; and the end of a round (above all if +a man was of the party) resolved itself into a scrimmage for the +counters. The fifth was a matron. It was a picture to +see her sail to church on a Sunday, a parasol in hand, a +nursemaid following, and the baby buried in a trade hat and armed +with a patent feeding-bottle. The service was enlivened by +her continual supervision and correction of the maid. It +was impossible not to fancy the baby was a doll, and the church +some European playroom. All these women were legitimately +married. It is true that the certificate of one, when she +proudly showed it, proved to run thus, that she was +‘married for one night,’ and her gracious partner was +at liberty to ‘send her to hell’ the next morning; +but she was none the wiser or the worse for the dastardly +trick. Another, I heard, was married on a work of mine in a +pirated edition; it answered the purpose as well as a Hall +Bible. Notwithstanding all these allurements of social +distinction, rare food and raiment, a comparative vacation from +toil, and legitimate marriage contracted on a pirated edition, +the trader must sometimes seek long before he can be mated. +While I was in the group one had been eight months on the quest, +and he was still a bachelor.</p> +<p>Within strictly native society the old laws and practices were +harsh, but not without a certain stamp of high-mindedness. +Stealthy adultery was punished with death; open elopement was +properly considered virtue in comparison, and compounded for a +fine in land. The male adulterer alone seems to have been +punished. It is correct manners for a jealous man to hang +himself; a jealous woman has a different remedy—she bites +her rival. Ten or twenty years ago it was a capital offence +to raise a woman’s <i>ridi</i>; to this day it is still +punished with a heavy fine; and the garment itself is still +symbolically sacred. Suppose a piece of land to be disputed +in Butaritari, the claimant who shall first hang a <i>ridi</i> on +the tapu-post has gained his cause, since no one can remove or +touch it but himself.</p> +<p>The <i>ridi</i> was the badge not of the woman but the wife, +the mark not of her sex but of her station. It was the +collar on the slave’s neck, the brand on merchandise. +The adulterous woman seems to have been spared; were the husband +offended, it would be a poor consolation to send his draught +cattle to the shambles. Karaiti, to this day, calls his +eight wives ‘his horses,’ some trader having +explained to him the employment of these animals on farms; and +Nanteitei hired out his wives to do mason-work. Husbands, +at least when of high rank, had the power of life and death; even +whites seem to have possessed it; and their wives, when they had +transgressed beyond forgiveness, made haste to pronounce the +formula of deprecation—<i>I Kana Kim</i>. This form +of words had so much virtue that a condemned criminal repeating +it on a particular day to the king who had condemned him, must be +instantly released. It is an offer of abasement, and, +strangely enough, the reverse—the imitation—is a +common vulgar insult in Great Britain to this day. I give a +scene between a trader and his Gilbert Island wife, as it was +told me by the husband, now one of the oldest residents, but then +a freshman in the group.</p> +<p>‘Go and light a fire,’ said the trader, ‘and +when I have brought this oil I will cook some fish.’ +The woman grunted at him, island fashion. ‘I am not a +pig that you should grunt at me,’ said he.</p> +<p>‘I know you are not a pig,’ said the woman, +‘neither am I your slave.’</p> +<p>‘To be sure you are not my slave, and if you do not care +to stop with me, you had better go home to your people,’ +said he. ‘But in the mean time go and light the fire; +and when I have brought this oil I will cook some +fish.’</p> +<p>She went as if to obey; and presently when the trader looked +she had built a fire so big that the cook-house was catching in +flames.</p> +<p>‘<i>I Kana Kim</i>!’ she cried, as she saw him +coming; but he recked not, and hit her with a cooking-pot. +The leg pierced her skull, blood spouted, it was thought she was +a dead woman, and the natives surrounded the house in a menacing +expectation. Another white was present, a man of older +experience. ‘You will have us both killed if you go +on like this,’ he cried. ‘She had said <i>I +Kana Kim</i>!’ If she had not said <i>I Kana Kim</i> +he might have struck her with a caldron. It was not the +blow that made the crime, but the disregard of an accepted +formula.</p> +<p>Polygamy, the particular sacredness of wives, their +semi-servile state, their seclusion in kings’ harems, even +their privilege of biting, all would seem to indicate a +Mohammedan society and the opinion of the soullessness of +woman. And not so in the least. It is a mere +appearance. After you have studied these extremes in one +house, you may go to the next and find all reversed, the woman +the mistress, the man only the first of her thralls. The +authority is not with the husband as such, nor the wife as +such. It resides in the chief or the chief-woman; in him or +her who has inherited the lands of the clan, and stands to the +clansman in the place of parent, exacting their service, +answerable for their fines. There is but the one source of +power and the one ground of dignity—rank. The king +married a chief-woman; she became his menial, and must work with +her hands on Messrs. Wightman’s pier. The king +divorced her; she regained at once her former state and +power. She married the Hawaiian sailor, and behold the man +is her flunkey and can be shown the door at pleasure. Nay, +and such low-born lords are even corrected physically, and, like +grown but dutiful children, must endure the discipline.</p> +<p>We were intimate in one such household, that of Nei Takauti +and Nan Tok’; I put the lady first of necessity. +During one week of fool’s paradise, Mrs. Stevenson had gone +alone to the sea-side of the island after shells. I am very +sure the proceeding was unsafe; and she soon perceived a man and +woman watching her. Do what she would, her guardians held +her steadily in view; and when the afternoon began to fall, and +they thought she had stayed long enough, took her in charge, and +by signs and broken English ordered her home. On the way +the lady drew from her earring-hole a clay pipe, the husband +lighted it, and it was handed to my unfortunate wife, who knew +not how to refuse the incommodious favour; and when they were all +come to our house, the pair sat down beside her on the floor, and +improved the occasion with prayer. From that day they were +our family friends; bringing thrice a day the beautiful island +garlands of white flowers, visiting us any evening, and +frequently carrying us down to their own maniap’ in return, +the woman leading Mrs. Stevenson by the hand like one child with +another.</p> +<p>Nan Tok’, the husband, was young, extremely handsome, of +the most approved good humour, and suffering in his precarious +station from suppressed high spirits. Nei Takauti, the +wife, was getting old; her grown son by a former marriage had +just hanged himself before his mother’s eyes in despair at +a well-merited rebuke. Perhaps she had never been +beautiful, but her face was full of character, her eye of sombre +fire. She was a high chief-woman, but by a strange +exception for a person of her rank, was small, spare, and sinewy, +with lean small hands and corded neck. Her full dress of an +evening was invariably a white chemise—and for adornment, +green leaves (or sometimes white blossoms) stuck in her hair and +thrust through her huge earring-holes. The husband on the +contrary changed to view like a kaleidoscope. Whatever +pretty thing my wife might have given to Nei Takauti—a +string of beads, a ribbon, a piece of bright +fabric—appeared the next evening on the person of Nan +Tok’. It was plain he was a clothes-horse; that he +wore livery; that, in a word, he was his wife’s wife. +They reversed the parts indeed, down to the least particular; it +was the husband who showed himself the ministering angel in the +hour of pain, while the wife displayed the apathy and +heartlessness of the proverbial man.</p> +<p>When Nei Takauti had a headache Nan Tok’ was full of +attention and concern. When the husband had a cold and a +racking toothache the wife heeded not, except to jeer. It +is always the woman’s part to fill and light the pipe; Nei +Takauti handed hers in silence to the wedded page; but she +carried it herself, as though the page were not entirely +trusted. Thus she kept the money, but it was he who ran the +errands, anxiously sedulous. A cloud on her face dimmed +instantly his beaming looks; on an early visit to their +maniap’ my wife saw he had cause to be wary. Nan +Tok’ had a friend with him, a giddy young thing, of his own +age and sex; and they had worked themselves into that stage of +jocularity when consequences are too often disregarded. Nei +Takauti mentioned her own name. Instantly Nan Tok’ +held up two fingers, his friend did likewise, both in an ecstasy +of slyness. It was plain the lady had two names; and from +the nature of their merriment, and the wrath that gathered on her +brow, there must be something ticklish in the second. The +husband pronounced it; a well-directed cocoa-nut from the hand of +his wife caught him on the side of the head, and the voices and +the mirth of these indiscreet young gentlemen ceased for the +day.</p> +<p>The people of Eastern Polynesia are never at a loss; their +etiquette is absolute and plenary; in every circumstance it tells +them what to do and how to do it. The Gilbertines are +seemingly more free, and pay for their freedom (like ourselves) +in frequent perplexity. This was often the case with the +topsy-turvy couple. We had once supplied them during a +visit with a pipe and tobacco; and when they had smoked and were +about to leave, they found themselves confronted with a problem: +should they take or leave what remained of the tobacco? The +piece of plug was taken up, it was laid down again, it was handed +back and forth, and argued over, till the wife began to look +haggard and the husband elderly. They ended by taking it, +and I wager were not yet clear of the compound before they were +sure they had decided wrong. Another time they had been +given each a liberal cup of coffee, and Nan Tok’ with +difficulty and disaffection made an end of his. Nei Takauti +had taken some, she had no mind for more, plainly conceived it +would be a breach of manners to set down the cup unfinished, and +ordered her wedded retainer to dispose of what was left. +‘I have swallowed all I can, I cannot swallow more, it is a +physical impossibility,’ he seemed to say; and his stern +officer reiterated her commands with secret imperative +signals. Luckless dog! but in mere humanity we came to the +rescue and removed the cup.</p> +<p>I cannot but smile over this funny household; yet I remember +the good souls with affection and respect. Their attention +to ourselves was surprising. The garlands are much +esteemed, the blossoms must be sought far and wide; and though +they had many retainers to call to their aid, we often saw +themselves passing afield after the blossoms, and the wife +engaged with her own in putting them together. It was no +want of only that disregard so incident to husbands, that made +Nei Takauti despise the sufferings of Nan Tok’. When +my wife was unwell she proved a diligent and kindly nurse; and +the pair, to the extreme embarrassment of the sufferer, became +fixtures in the sick-room. This rugged, capable, imperious +old dame, with the wild eyes, had deep and tender qualities: her +pride in her young husband it seemed that she dissembled, fearing +possibly to spoil him; and when she spoke of her dead son there +came something tragic in her face. But I seemed to trace in +the Gilbertines a virility of sense and sentiment which +distinguishes them (like their harsh and uncouth language) from +their brother islanders in the east.</p> +<h2>PART IV: THE GILBERTS—APEMAMA</h2> +<h3>CHAPTER I—THE KING OF APEMAMA: THE ROYAL TRADER</h3> +<p>There is one great personage in the Gilberts: Tembinok’ +of Apemama: solely conspicuous, the hero of song, the butt of +gossip. Through the rest of the group the kings are slain +or fallen in tutelage: Tembinok’ alone remains, the last +tyrant, the last erect vestige of a dead society. The white +man is everywhere else, building his houses, drinking his gin, +getting in and out of trouble with the weak native +governments. There is only one white on Apemama, and he on +sufferance, living far from court, and hearkening and watching +his conduct like a mouse in a cat’s ear. Through all +the other islands a stream of native visitors comes and goes, +travelling by families, spending years on the grand tour. +Apemama alone is left upon one side, the tourist dreading to risk +himself within the clutch of Tembinok’. And fear of +the same Gorgon follows and troubles them at home. Maiana +once paid him tribute; he once fell upon and seized Nonuti: first +steps to the empire of the archipelago. A British warship +coming on the scene, the conqueror was driven to disgorge, his +career checked in the outset, his dear-bought armoury sunk in his +own lagoon. But the impression had been made; periodical +fear of him still shakes the islands; rumour depicts him +mustering his canoes for a fresh onfall; rumour can name his +destination; and Tembinok’ figures in the patriotic +war-songs of the Gilberts like Napoleon in those of our +grandfathers.</p> +<p>We were at sea, bound from Mariki to Nonuti and Tapituea, when +the wind came suddenly fair for Apemama. The course was at +once changed; all hands were turned-to to clean ship, the decks +holy-stoned, all the cabin washed, the trade-room +overhauled. In all our cruising we never saw the +<i>Equator</i> so smart as she was made for +Tembinok’. Nor was Captain Reid alone in these +coquetries; for, another schooner chancing to arrive during my +stay in Apemama, I found that she also was dandified for the +occasion. And the two cases stand alone in my experience of +South Sea traders.</p> +<p>We had on board a family of native tourists, from the +grandsire to the babe in arms, trying (against an extraordinary +series of ill-luck) to regain their native island of Peru. <a +name="citation275"></a><a href="#footnote275" +class="citation">[275]</a> Five times already they had paid +their fare and taken ship; five times they had been disappointed, +dropped penniless upon strange islands, or carried back to +Butaritari, whence they sailed. This last attempt had been +no better-starred; their provisions were exhausted. Peru +was beyond hope, and they had cheerfully made up their minds to a +fresh stage of exile in Tapituea or Nonuti. With this slant +of wind their random destination became once more changed; and +like the Calendar’s pilot, when the ‘black +mountains’ hove in view, they changed colour and beat upon +their breasts. Their camp, which was on deck in the +ship’s waist, resounded with complaint. They would be +set to work, they must become slaves, escape was hopeless, they +must live and toil and die in Apemama, in the tyrant’s +den. With this sort of talk they so greatly terrified their +children, that one (a big hulking boy) must at last be torn +screaming from the schooner’s side. And their fears +were wholly groundless. I have little doubt they were not +suffered to be idle; but I can vouch for it that they were kindly +and generously used. For, the matter of a year later, I was +once more shipmate with these inconsistent wanderers on board the +<i>Janet Nicoll</i>. Their fare was paid by +Tembinok’; they who had gone ashore from the <i>Equator</i> +destitute, reappeared upon the <i>Janet</i> with new clothes, +laden with mats and presents, and bringing with them a magazine +of food, on which they lived like fighting-cocks throughout the +voyage; I saw them at length repatriated, and I must say they +showed more concern on quitting Apemama than delight at reaching +home.</p> +<p>We entered by the north passage (Sunday, September 1st), +dodging among shoals. It was a day of fierce equatorial +sunshine; but the breeze was strong and chill; and the mate, who +conned the schooner from the cross-trees, returned shivering to +the deck. The lagoon was thick with many-tinted wavelets; a +continuous roaring of the outer sea overhung the anchorage; and +the long, hollow crescent of palm ruffled and sparkled in the +wind. Opposite our berth the beach was seen to be +surmounted for some distance by a terrace of white coral seven or +eight feet high and crowned in turn by the scattered and +incongruous buildings of the palace. The village adjoins on +the south, a cluster of high-roofed maniap’s. And +village and palace seemed deserted.</p> +<p>We were scarce yet moored, however, before distant and busy +figures appeared upon the beach, a boat was launched, and a crew +pulled out to us bringing the king’s ladder. +Tembinok’ had once an accident; has feared ever since to +entrust his person to the rotten chandlery of South Sea traders; +and devised in consequence a frame of wood, which is brought on +board a ship as soon as she appears, and remains lashed to her +side until she leave. The boat’s crew, having applied +this engine, returned at once to shore. They might not come +on board; neither might we land, or not without danger of +offence; the king giving pratique in person. An interval +followed, during which dinner was delayed for the great +man—the prelude of the ladder, giving us some notion of his +weighty body and sensible, ingenious character, had highly +whetted our curiosity; and it was with something like excitement +that we saw the beach and terrace suddenly blacken with attendant +vassals, the king and party embark, the boat (a man-of-war gig) +come flying towards us dead before the wind, and the royal +coxswain lay us cleverly aboard, mount the ladder with a jealous +diffidence, and descend heavily on deck.</p> +<p>Not long ago he was overgrown with fat, obscured to view, and +a burthen to himself. Captains visiting the island advised +him to walk; and though it broke the habits of a life and the +traditions of his rank, he practised the remedy with +benefit. His corpulence is now portable; you would call him +lusty rather than fat; but his gait is still dull, stumbling, and +elephantine. He neither stops nor hastens, but goes about +his business with an implacable deliberation. We could +never see him and not be struck with his extraordinary natural +means for the theatre: a beaked profile like Dante’s in the +mask, a mane of long black hair, the eye brilliant, imperious, +and inquiring: for certain parts, and to one who could have used +it, the face was a fortune. His voice matched it well, +being shrill, powerful, and uncanny, with a note like a +sea-bird’s. Where there are no fashions, none to set +them, few to follow them if they were set, and none to criticise, +he dresses—as Sir Charles Grandison lived—‘to +his own heart.’ Now he wears a woman’s frock, +now a naval uniform; now (and more usually) figures in a +masquerade costume of his own design: trousers and a singular +jacket with shirt tails, the cut and fit wonderful for island +workmanship, the material always handsome, sometimes green +velvet, sometimes cardinal red silk. This masquerade +becomes him admirably. In the woman’s frock he looks +ominous and weird beyond belief. I see him now come pacing +towards me in the cruel sun, solitary, a figure out of +Hoffmann.</p> +<p>A visit on board ship, such as that at which we now assisted, +makes a chief part and by far the chief diversion of the life of +Tembinok’. He is not only the sole ruler, he is the +sole merchant of his triple kingdom, Apemama, Aranuka, and Kuria, +well-planted islands. The taro goes to the chiefs, who +divide as they please among their immediate adherents; but +certain fish, turtles—which abound in Kuria,—and the +whole produce of the coco-palm, belong exclusively to +Tembinok’. ‘A’ cobra <a +name="citation279a"></a><a href="#footnote279a" +class="citation">[279a]</a> berong me,’ observed his +majesty with a wave of his hand; and he counts and sells it by +the houseful. ‘You got copra, king?’ I have +heard a trader ask. ‘I got two, three outches,’ +<a name="citation279b"></a><a href="#footnote279b" +class="citation">[279b]</a> his majesty replied: ‘I think +three.’ Hence the commercial importance of Apemama, +the trade of three islands being centred there in a single hand; +hence it is that so many whites have tried in vain to gain or to +preserve a footing; hence ships are adorned, cooks have special +orders, and captains array themselves in smiles, to greet the +king. If he be pleased with his welcome and the fare he may +pass days on board, and, every day, and sometimes every hour, +will be of profit to the ship. He oscillates between the +cabin, where he is entertained with strange meats, and the +trade-room, where he enjoys the pleasures of shopping on a scale +to match his person. A few obsequious attendants squat by +the house door, awaiting his least signal. In the boat, +which has been suffered to drop astern, one or two of his wives +lie covered from the sun under mats, tossed by the short sea of +the lagoon, and enduring agonies of heat and tedium. This +severity is now and then relaxed and the wives allowed on +board. Three or four were thus favoured on the day of our +arrival: substantial ladies airily attired in <i>ridis</i>. +Each had a share of copra, her <i>peculium</i>, to dispose of for +herself. The display in the trade-room—hats, +ribbbons, dresses, scents, tins of salmon—the pride of the +eye and the lust of the flesh—tempted them in vain. +They had but the one idea—tobacco, the island currency, +tantamount to minted gold; returned to shore with it, burthened +but rejoicing; and late into the night, on the royal terrace, +were to be seen counting the sticks by lamplight in the open +air.</p> +<p>The king is no such economist. He is greedy of things +new and foreign. House after house, chest after chest, in +the palace precinct, is already crammed with clocks, musical +boxes, blue spectacles, umbrellas, knitted waistcoats, bolts of +stuff, tools, rifles, fowling-pieces, medicines, European foods, +sewing-machines, and, what is more extraordinary, stoves: all +that ever caught his eye, tickled his appetite, pleased him for +its use, or puzzled him with its apparent inutility. And +still his lust is unabated. He is possessed by the seven +devils of the collector. He hears a thing spoken of, and a +shadow comes on his face. ‘I think I no got +him,’ he will say; and the treasures he has seem worthless +in comparison. If a ship be bound for Apemama, the merchant +racks his brain to hit upon some novelty. This he leaves +carelessly in the main cabin or partly conceals in his own berth, +so that the king shall spy it for himself. ‘How much +you want?’ inquires Tembinok’, passing and +pointing. ‘No, king; that too dear,’ returns +the trader. ‘I think I like him,’ says the +king. This was a bowl of gold-fish. On another +occasion it was scented soap. ‘No, king; that cost +too much,’ said the trader; ‘too good for a +Kanaka.’ ‘How much you got? I take him +all,’ replied his majesty, and became the lord of seventeen +boxes at two dollars a cake. Or again, the merchant feigns +the article is not for sale, is private property, an heirloom or +a gift; and the trick infallibly succeeds. Thwart the king +and you hold him. His autocratic nature rears at the +affront of opposition. He accepts it for a challenge; sets +his teeth like a hunter going at a fence; and with no mark of +emotion, scarce even of interest, stolidly piles up the +price. Thus, for our sins, he took a fancy to my +wife’s dressing-bag, a thing entirely useless to the man, +and sadly battered by years of service. Early one forenoon +he came to our house, sat down, and abruptly offered to purchase +it. I told him I sold nothing, and the bag at any rate was +a present from a friend; but he was acquainted with these +pretexts from of old, and knew what they were worth and how to +meet them. Adopting what I believe is called ‘the +object method,’ he drew out a bag of English gold, +sovereigns and half-sovereigns, and began to lay them one by one +in silence on the table; at each fresh piece reading our faces +with a look. In vain I continued to protest I was no +trader; he deigned not to reply. There must have been +twenty pounds on the table, he was still going on, and irritation +had begun to mingle with our embarrassment, when a happy idea +came to our delivery. Since his majesty thought so much of +the bag, we said, we must beg him to accept it as a +present. It was the most surprising turn in +Tembinok’s experience. He perceived too late that his +persistence was unmannerly; hung his head a while in silence; +then, lifting up a sheepish countenance, ‘I +‘shamed,’ said the tyrant. It was the first and +the last time we heard him own to a flaw in his behaviour. +Half an hour after he sent us a camphor-wood chest worth only a +few dollars—but then heaven knows what Tembinok’ had +paid for it.</p> +<p>Cunning by nature, and versed for forty years in the +government of men, it must not be supposed that he is cheated +blindly, or has resigned himself without resistance to be the +milch-cow of the passing trader. His efforts have been even +heroic. Like Nakaeia of Makin, he has owned +schooners. More fortunate than Nakaeia, he has found +captains. Ships of his have sailed as far as to the +colonies. He has trafficked direct, in his own bottoms, +with New Zealand. And even so, even there, the +world-enveloping dishonesty of the white man prevented him; his +profit melted, his ship returned in debt, the money for the +insurance was embezzled, and when the <i>Coronet</i> came to be +lost, he was astonished to find he had lost all. At this he +dropped his weapons; owned he might as hopefully wrestle with the +winds of heaven; and like an experienced sheep, submitted his +fleece thenceforward to the shearers. He is the last man in +the world to waste anger on the incurable; accepts it with +cynical composure; asks no more in those he deals with than a +certain decency of moderation; drives as good a bargain as he +can; and when he considers he is more than usually swindled, +writes it in his memory against the merchant’s name. +He once ran over to me a list of captains and supercargoes with +whom he had done business, classing them under three heads: +‘He cheat a litty’—‘He cheat +plenty’—and ‘I think he cheat too +much.’ For the first two classes he expressed perfect +toleration; sometimes, but not always, for the third. I was +present when a certain merchant was turned about his business, +and was the means (having a considerable influence ever since the +bag) of patching up the dispute. Even on the day of our +arrival there was like to have been a hitch with Captain Reid: +the ground of which is perhaps worth recital. Among goods +exported specially for Tembinok’ there is a beverage known +(and labelled) as Hennessy’s brandy. It is neither +Hennessy, nor even brandy; is about the colour of sherry, but is +not sherry; tastes of kirsch, and yet neither is it kirsch. +The king, at least, has grown used to this amazing brand, and +rather prides himself upon the taste; and any substitution is a +double offence, being at once to cheat him and to cast a doubt +upon his palate. A similar weakness is to be observed in +all connoisseurs. Now the last case sold by the +<i>Equator</i> was found to contain a different and I would +fondly fancy a superior distillation; and the conversation opened +very black for Captain Reid. But Tembinok’ is a +moderate man. He was reminded and admitted that all men +were liable to error, even himself; accepted the principle that a +fault handsomely acknowledged should be condoned; and wound the +matter up with this proposal: ‘Tuppoti <a +name="citation283"></a><a href="#footnote283" +class="citation">[283]</a> I mi’take, you ’peakee +me. Tuppoti you mi’take, I ’peakee you. +Mo’ betta.’</p> +<p>After dinner and supper in the cabin, a glass or two of +‘Hennetti’—the genuine article this time, with +the kirsch bouquet,—and five hours’ lounging on the +trade-room counter, royalty embarked for home. Three tacks +grounded the boat before the palace; the wives were carried +ashore on the backs of vassals; Tembinok’ stepped on a +railed platform like a steamer’s gangway, and was borne +shoulder high through the shallows, up the beach, and by an +inclined plane, paved with pebbles, to the glaring terrace where +he dwells.</p> +<h3>CHAPTER II—THE KING OF APEMAMA: FOUNDATION OF EQUATOR +TOWN</h3> +<p>Our first sight of Tembinok’ was a matter of concern, +almost alarm, to my whole party. We had a favour to seek; +we must approach in the proper courtly attitude of a suitor; and +must either please him or fail in the main purpose of our +voyage. It was our wish to land and live in Apemama, and +see more near at hand the odd character of the man and the odd +(or rather ancient) condition of his island. In all other +isles of the South Seas a white man may land with his chest, and +set up house for a lifetime, if he choose, and if he have the +money or the trade; no hindrance is conceivable. But +Apemama is a close island, lying there in the sea with closed +doors; the king himself, like a vigilant officer, ready at the +wicket to scrutinise and reject intrenching visitors. Hence +the attraction of our enterprise; not merely because it was a +little difficult, but because this social quarantine, a curiosity +in itself, has been the preservative of others.</p> +<p>Tembinok’, like most tyrants, is a conservative; like +many conservatives, he eagerly welcomes new ideas, and, except in +the field of politics, leans to practical reform. When the +missionaries came, professing a knowledge of the truth, he +readily received them; attended their worship, acquired the +accomplishment of public prayer, and made himself a student at +their feet. It is thus—it is by the cultivation of +similar passing chances—that he has learned to read, to +write, to cipher, and to speak his queer, personal English, so +different from ordinary ‘Beach de Mar,’ so much more +obscure, expressive, and condensed. His education attended +to, he found time to become critical of the new inmates. +Like Nakaeia of Makin, he is an admirer of silence in the island; +broods over it like a great ear; has spies who report daily; and +had rather his subjects sang than talked. The service, and +in particular the sermon, were thus sure to become offences: +‘Here, in my island, <i>I</i> ’peak,’ he once +observed to me. ‘My chieps no ’peak—do +what I talk.’ He looked at the missionary, and what +did he see? ‘See Kanaka ’peak in a big +outch!’ he cried, with a strong ring of sarcasm. Yet +he endured the subversive spectacle, and might even have +continued to endure it, had not a fresh point arisen. He +looked again, to employ his own figure; and the Kanaka was no +longer speaking, he was doing worse—he was building a +copra-house. The king was touched in his chief interests; +revenue and prerogative were threatened. He considered +besides (and some think with him) that trade is incompatible with +the missionary claims. ‘Tuppoti mitonary think +“good man”: very good. Tuppoti he think +“cobra”: no good. I send him away +ship.’ Such was his abrupt history of the evangelist +in Apemama.</p> +<p>Similar deportations are common: ‘I send him away +ship’ is the epitaph of not a few, his majesty paying the +exile’s fare to the next place of call. For instance, +being passionately fond of European food, he has several times +added to his household a white cook, and one after another these +have been deported. They, on their side, swear they were +not paid their wages; he, on his, that they robbed and swindled +him beyond endurance: both perhaps justly. A more important +case was that of an agent, despatched (as I heard the story) by a +firm of merchants to worm his way into the king’s good +graces, become, if possible, premier, and handle the copra in the +interest of his employers. He obtained authority to land, +practised his fascinations, was patiently listened to by +Tembinok’, supposed himself on the highway to success; and +behold! when the next ship touched at Apemama, the would-be +premier was flung into a boat—had on board—his fare +paid, and so good-bye. But it is needless to multiply +examples; the proof of the pudding is in the eating. When +we came to Apemama, of so many white men who have scrambled for a +place in that rich market, one remained—a silent, sober, +solitary, niggardly recluse, of whom the king remarks, ‘I +think he good; he no ’peak.’</p> +<p>I was warned at the outset we might very well fail in our +design: yet never dreamed of what proved to be the fact, that we +should be left four-and-twenty hours in suspense and come within +an ace of ultimate rejection. Captain Reid had primed +himself; no sooner was the king on board, and the Hennetti +question amicably settled, than he proceeded to express my +request and give an abstract of my claims and virtues. The +gammon about Queen Victoria’s son might do for Butaritari; +it was out of the question here; and I now figured as ‘one +of the Old Men of England,’ a person of deep knowledge, +come expressly to visit Tembinok’s dominion, and eager to +report upon it to the no less eager Queen Victoria. The +king made no shadow of an answer, and presently began upon a +different subject. We might have thought that he had not +heard, or not understood; only that we found ourselves the +subject of a constant study. As we sat at meals, he took us +in series and fixed upon each, for near a minute at a time, the +same hard and thoughtful stare. As he thus looked he seemed +to forget himself, the subject and the company, and to become +absorbed in the process of his thought; the look was wholly +impersonal; I have seen the same in the eyes of +portrait-painters. The counts upon which whites have been +deported are mainly four: cheating Tembinok’, meddling +overmuch with copra, which is the source of his wealth, and one +of the sinews of his power, <i>’peaking</i>, and political +intrigue. I felt guiltless upon all; but how to show +it? I would not have taken copra in a gift: how to express +that quality by my dinner-table bearing? The rest of the +party shared my innocence and my embarrassment. They shared +also in my mortification when after two whole meal-times and the +odd moments of an afternoon devoted to this reconnoitring, +Tembinok’ took his leave in silence. Next morning, +the same undisguised study, the same silence, was resumed; and +the second day had come to its maturity before I was informed +abruptly that I had stood the ordeal. ‘I look your +eye. You good man. You no lie,’ said the king: +a doubtful compliment to a writer of romance. Later he +explained he did not quite judge by the eye only, but the mouth +as well. ‘Tuppoti I see man,’ he +explained. ‘I no tavvy good man, bad man. I +look eye, look mouth. Then I tavvy. Look <i>eye</i>, +look mouth,’ he repeated. And indeed in our case the +mouth had the most to do with it, and it was by our talk that we +gained admission to the island; the king promising himself (and I +believe really amassing) a vast amount of useful knowledge ere we +left.</p> +<p>The terms of our admission were as follows: We were to choose +a site, and the king should there build us a town. His +people should work for us, but the king only was to give them +orders. One of his cooks should come daily to help mine, +and to learn of him. In case our stores ran out, he would +supply us, and be repaid on the return of the +<i>Equator</i>. On the other hand, he was to come to meals +with us when so inclined; when he stayed at home, a dish was to +be sent him from our table; and I solemnly engaged to give his +subjects no liquor or money (both of which they are forbidden to +possess) and no tobacco, which they were to receive only from the +royal hand. I think I remember to have protested against +the stringency of this last article; at least, it was relaxed, +and when a man worked for me I was allowed to give him a pipe of +tobacco on the premises, but none to take away.</p> +<p>The site of Equator City—we named our city for the +schooner—was soon chosen. The immediate shores of the +lagoon are windy and blinding; Tembinok’ himself is glad to +grope blue-spectacled on his terrace; and we fled the +neighbourhood of the red <i>conjunctiva</i>, the suppurating +eyeball, and the beggar who pursues and beseeches the passing +foreigner for eye wash. Behind the town the country is +diversified; here open, sandy, uneven, and dotted with dwarfish +palms; here cut up with taro trenches, deep and shallow, and, +according to the growth of the plants, presenting now the +appearance of a sandy tannery, now of an alleyed and green +garden. A path leads towards the sea, mounting abruptly to +the main level of the island—twenty or even thirty feet, +although Findlay gives five; and just hard by the top of the +rise, where the coco-palms begin to be well grown, we found a +grove of pandanus, and a piece of soil pleasantly covered with +green underbush. A well was not far off under a rustic +well-house; nearer still, in a sandy cup of the land, a pond +where we might wash our clothes. The place was out of the +wind, out of the sun, and out of sight of the village. It +was shown to the king, and the town promised for the morrow.</p> +<p>The morrow came, Mr. Osbourne landed, found nothing done, and +carried his complaint to Tembinok’. He heard it, +rose, called for a Winchester, stepped without the royal +palisade, and fired two shots in the air. A shot in the air +is the first Apemama warning; it has the force of a proclamation +in more loquacious countries; and his majesty remarked agreeably +that it would make his labourers ‘mo’ +bright.’ In less than thirty minutes, accordingly, +the men had mustered, the work was begun, and we were told that +we might bring our baggage when we pleased.</p> +<p>It was two in the afternoon ere the first boat was beached, +and the long procession of chests and crates and sacks began to +straggle through the sandy desert towards Equator Town. The +grove of pandanus was practically a thing of the past. Fire +surrounded and smoke rose in the green underbush. In a wide +circuit the axes were still crashing. Those very advantages +for which the place was chosen, it had been the king’s +first idea to abolish; and in the midst of this devastation there +stood already a good-sized maniap’ and a small closed +house. A mat was spread near by for Tembinok’; here +he sat superintending, in cardinal red, a pith helmet on his +head, a meerschaum pipe in his mouth, a wife stretched at his +back with custody of the matches and tobacco. Twenty or +thirty feet in front of him the bulk of the workers squatted on +the ground; some of the bush here survived and in this the +commons sat nearly to their shoulders, and presented only an arc +of brown faces, black heads, and attentive eyes fixed on his +majesty. Long pauses reigned, during which the subjects +stared and the king smoked. Then Tembinok’ would +raise his voice and speak shrilly and briefly. There was +never a response in words; but if the speech were jesting, there +came by way of answer discreet, obsequious laughter—such +laughter as we hear in schoolrooms; and if it were practical, the +sudden uprising and departure of the squad. Twice they so +disappeared, and returned with further elements of the city: a +second house and a second maniap’. It was singular to +spy, far off through the coco stems, the silent oncoming of the +maniap’, at first (it seemed) swimming spontaneously in the +air—but on a nearer view betraying under the eaves many +score of moving naked legs. In all the affair servile +obedience was no less remarkable than servile deliberation. +The gang had here mustered by the note of a deadly weapon; the +man who looked on was the unquestioned master of their lives; and +except for civility, they bestirred themselves like so many +American hotel clerks. The spectator was aware of an +unobtrusive yet invincible inertia, at which the skipper of a +trading dandy might have torn his hair.</p> +<p>Yet the work was accomplished. By dusk, when his majesty +withdrew, the town was founded and complete, a new and ruder +Amphion having called it from nothing with three cracks of a +rifle. And the next morning the same conjurer obliged us +with a further miracle: a mystic rampart fencing us, so that the +path which ran by our doors became suddenly impassable, the +inhabitants who had business across the isle must fetch a wide +circuit, and we sat in the midst in a transparent privacy, +seeing, seen, but unapproachable, like bees in a glass +hive. The outward and visible sign of this glamour was no +more than a few ragged coco-leaf garlands round the stems of the +outlying palms; but its significance reposed on the tremendous +sanction of the tapu and the guns of Tembinok’.</p> +<p>We made our first meal that night in the improvised city, +where we were to stay two months, and which—so soon as we +had done with it—was to vanish in a day as it appeared, its +elements returning whence they came, the tapu raised, the traffic +on the path resumed, the sun and the moon peering in vain between +the palm-trees for the bygone work, the wind blowing over an +empty site. Yet the place, which is now only an episode in +some memories, seemed to have been built, and to be destined to +endure, for years. It was a busy hamlet. One of the +maniap’s we made our dining-room, one the kitchen. +The houses we reserved for sleeping. They were on the +admirable Apemama plan: out and away the best house in the South +Seas; standing some three feet above the ground on posts; the +sides of woven flaps, which can be raised to admit light and air, +or lowered to shut out the wind and the rain: airy, healthy, +clean, and watertight. We had a hen of a remarkable kind: +almost unique in my experience, being a hen that occasionally +laid eggs. Not far off, Mrs. Stevenson tended a garden of +salad and shalots. The salad was devoured by the +hen—which was her bane. The shalots were served out a +leaf at a time, and welcomed and relished like peaches. +Toddy and green cocoa-nuts were brought us daily. We once +had a present of fish from the king, and once of a turtle. +Sometimes we shot so-called plover along on the shore, sometimes +wild chicken in the bush. The rest of our diet was from +tins.</p> +<p>Our occupations were very various. While some of the +party would be away sketching, Mr. Osbourne and I hammered away +at a novel. We read Gibbon and Carlyle aloud; we blew on +flageolets, we strummed on guitars; we took photographs by the +light of the sun, the moon, and flash-powder; sometimes we played +cards. Pot-hunting engaged a part of our leisure. I +have myself passed afternoons in the exciting but innocuous +pursuit of winged animals with a revolver; and it was fortunate +there were better shots of the party, and fortunate the king +could lend us a more suitable weapon, in the form of an excellent +fowling-piece, or our spare diet had been sparer still.</p> +<p>Night was the time to see our city, after the moon was up, +after the lamps were lighted, and so long as the fire sparkled in +the cook-house. We suffered from a plague of flies and +mosquitoes, comparable to that of Egypt; our dinner-table (lent, +like all our furniture, by the king) must be enclosed in a tent +of netting, our citadel and refuge; and this became all luminous, +and bulged and beaconed under the eaves, like the globe of some +monstrous lamp under the margin of its shade. Our cabins, +the sides being propped at a variety of inclinations, spelled out +strange, angular patterns of brightness. In his roofed and +open kitchen, Ah Fu was to be seen by lamp and firelight, +dabbling among pots. Over all, there fell in the season an +extraordinary splendour of mellow moonshine. The sand +sparkled as with the dust of diamonds; the stars had +vanished. At intervals, a dusky night-bird, slow and low +flying, passed in the colonnade of the tree stems and uttered a +hoarse croaking cry.</p> +<h3>CHAPTER III—THE KING OF APEMAMA: THE PALACE OF MANY +WOMEN</h3> +<p>The palace, or rather the ground which it includes, is several +acres in extent. A terrace encloses it toward the lagoon; +on the side of the land, a palisade with several gates. +These are scarce intended for defence; a man, if he were strong, +might easily pluck down the palisade; he need not be specially +active to leap from the beach upon the terrace. There is no +parade of guards, soldiers, or weapons; the armoury is under lock +and key; and the only sentinels are certain inconspicuous old +women lurking day and night before the gates. By day, these +crones were often engaged in boiling syrup or the like household +occupation; by night, they lay ambushed in the shadow or crouched +along the palisade, filling the office of eunuchs to this harem, +sole guards upon a tyrant life.</p> +<p>Female wardens made a fit outpost for this palace of many +women. Of the number of the king’s wives I have no +guess; and but a loose idea of their function. He himself +displayed embarrassment when they were referred to as his wives, +called them himself ‘my pamily,’ and explained they +were his ‘cutcheons’—cousins. We +distinguished four of the crowd: the king’s mother; his +sister, a grave, trenchant woman, with much of her +brother’s intelligence; the queen proper, to whom (and to +whom alone) my wife was formally presented; and the favourite of +the hour, a pretty, graceful girl, who sat with the king daily, +and once (when he shed tears) consoled him with caresses. I +am assured that even with her his relations are platonic. +In the background figured a multitude of ladies, the lean, the +plump, and the elephantine, some in sacque frocks, some in the +hairbreadth <i>ridi</i>; high-born and low, slave and mistress; +from the queen to the scullion, from the favourite to the scraggy +sentries at the palisade. Not all of these of course are of +‘my pamily,’—many are mere attendants; yet a +surprising number shared the responsibility of the king’s +trust. These were key-bearers, treasurers, wardens of the +armoury, the napery, and the stores. Each knew and did her +part to admiration. Should anything be required—a +particular gun, perhaps, or a particular bolt of stuff,—the +right queen was summoned; she came bringing the right chest, +opened it in the king’s presence, and displayed her charge +in perfect preservation—the gun cleaned and oiled, the +goods duly folded. Without delay or haste, and with the +minimum of speech, the whole great establishment turned on wheels +like a machine. Nowhere have I seen order more complete and +pervasive. And yet I was always reminded of Norse tales of +trolls and ogres who kept their hearts buried in the ground for +the mere safety, and must confide the secret to their +wives. For these weapons are the life of +Tembinok’. He does not aim at popularity; but drives +and braves his subjects, with a simplicity of domination which it +is impossible not to admire, hard not to sympathise with. +Should one out of so many prove faithless, should the armoury be +secretly unlocked, should the crones have dozed by the palisade +and the weapons find their way unseen into the village, +revolution would be nearly certain, death the most probable +result, and the spirit of the tyrant of Apemama flit to rejoin +his predecessors of Mariki and Tapituea. Yet those whom he +so trusts are all women, and all rivals.</p> +<p>There is indeed a ministry and staff of males: cook, steward, +carpenter, and supercargoes: the hierarchy of a schooner. +The spies, ‘his majesty’s daily papers,’ as we +called them, come every morning to report, and go again. +The cook and steward are concerned with the table only. The +supercargoes, whose business it is to keep tally of the copra at +three pounds a month and a percentage, are rarely in the palace; +and two at least are in the other islands. The carpenter, +indeed, shrewd and jolly old Rubam—query, +Reuben?—promoted on my last visit to the greater dignity of +governor, is daily present, altering, extending, embellishing, +pursuing the endless series of the king’s inventions; and +his majesty will sometimes pass an afternoon watching and talking +with Rubam at his work. But the males are still outsiders; +none seems to be armed, none is entrusted with a key; by dusk +they are all usually departed from the palace; and the weight of +the monarchy and of the monarch’s life reposes unshared on +the women.</p> +<p>Here is a household unlike, indeed, to one of ours; more +unlike still to the Oriental harem: that of an elderly childless +man, his days menaced, dwelling alone amid a bevy of women of all +ages, ranks, and relationships,—the mother, the sister, the +cousin, the legitimate wife, the concubine, the favourite, the +eldest born, and she of yesterday; he, in their midst, the only +master, the only male, the sole dispenser of honours, clothes, +and luxuries, the sole mark of multitudinous ambitions and +desires. I doubt if you could find a man in Europe so bold +as to attempt this piece of tact and government. And +seemingly Tembinok’ himself had trouble in the +beginning. I hear of him shooting at a wife for some levity +on board a schooner. Another, on some more serious offence, +he slew outright; he exposed her body in an open box, and (to +make the warning more memorable) suffered it to putrefy before +the palace gate. Doubtless his growing years have come to +his assistance; for upon so large a scale it is more easy to play +the father than the husband. And to-day, at least to the +eye of a stranger, all seems to go smoothly, and the wives to be +proud of their trust, proud of their rank, and proud of their +cunning lord.</p> +<p>I conceived they made rather a hero of the man. A +popular master in a girls’ school might, perhaps, offer a +figure of his preponderating station. But then the master +does not eat, sleep, live, and wash his dirty linen in the midst +of his admirers; he escapes, he has a room of his own, he leads a +private life; if he had nothing else, he has the holidays, and +the more unhappy Tembinok’ is always on the stage and on +the stretch.</p> +<p>In all my coming and going, I never heard him speak harshly or +express the least displeasure. An extreme, rather heavy, +benignity—the benignity of one sure to be +obeyed—marked his demeanour; so that I was at times +reminded of Samual Richardson in his circle of admiring +women. The wives spoke up and seemed to volunteer opinions, +like our wives at home—or, say, like doting but respectable +aunts. Altogether, I conclude that he rules his seraglio +much more by art than terror; and those who give a different +account (and who have none of them enjoyed my opportunities of +observation) perhaps failed to distinguish between degrees of +rank, between ‘my pamily’ and the hangers-on, +laundresses, and prostitutes.</p> +<p>A notable feature is the evening game of cards when lamps are +set forth upon the terrace, and ‘I and my pamily’ +play for tobacco by the hour. It is highly characteristic +of Tembinok’ that he must invent a game for himself; highly +characteristic of his worshipping household that they should +swear by the absurd invention. It is founded on poker, +played with the honours out of many packs, and inconceivably +dreary. But I have a passion for all games, studied it, and +am supposed to be the only white who ever fairly grasped its +principle: a fact for which the wives (with whom I was not +otherwise popular) admired me with acclamation. It was +impossible to be deceived; this was a genuine feeling: they were +proud of their private game, had been cut to the quick by the +want of interest shown in it by others, and expanded under the +flattery of my attention. Tembinok’ puts up a double +stake, and receives in return two hands to choose from: a shallow +artifice which the wives (in all these years) have not yet +fathomed. He himself, when talking with me privately, made +not the least secret that he was secure of winning; and it was +thus he explained his recent liberality on board the +<i>Equator</i>. He let the wives buy their own tobacco, +which pleased them at the moment. He won it back at cards, +which made him once more, and without fresh expense, that which +he ought to be,—the sole fount of all indulgences. +And he summed the matter up in that phrase with which he almost +always concludes any account of his policy: ‘Mo’ +betta.’</p> +<p>The palace compound is laid with broken coral, excruciating to +the eyes and the bare feet, but exquisitely raked and +weeded. A score or more of buildings lie in a sort of +street along the palisade and scattered on the margin of the +terrace; dwelling-houses for the wives and the attendants, +storehouses for the king’s curios and treasures, spacious +maniap’s for feast or council, some on pillars of wood, +some on piers of masonry. One was still in hand, a new +invention, the king’s latest born: a European frame-house +built for coolness inside a lofty maniap’: its roof planked +like a ship’s deck to be a raised, shady, and yet private +promenade. It was here the king spent hours with Rubam; +here I would sometimes join them; the place had a most singular +appearance; and I must say I was greatly taken with the fancy, +and joined with relish in the counsels of the architects.</p> +<p>Suppose we had business with his majesty by day: we strolled +over the sand and by the dwarfish palms, exchanged a +‘<i>Kõnamaori</i>’ with the crone on duty, and +entered the compound. The wide sheet of coral glared before +us deserted; all having stowed themselves in dark canvas from the +excess of room. I have gone to and fro in that labyrinth of +a place, seeking the king; and the only breathing creature I +could find was when I peered under the eaves of a maniap’, +and saw the brawny body of one of the wives stretched on the +floor, a naked Amazon plunged in noiseless slumber. If it +were still the hour of the ‘morning papers’ the quest +would be more easy, the half-dozen obsequious, sly dogs squatting +on the ground outside a house, crammed as far as possible in its +narrow shadow, and turning to the king a row of leering +faces. Tembinok’ would be within, the flaps of the +cabin raised, the trade blowing through, hearing their +report. Like journalists nearer home, when the day’s +news were scanty, these would make the more of it in words; and I +have known one to fill up a barren morning with an imaginary +conversation of two dogs. Sometimes the king deigns to +laugh, sometimes to question or jest with them, his voice +sounding shrilly from the cabin. By his side he may have +the heir-apparent, Paul, his nephew and adopted son, six years +old, stark naked, and a model of young human beauty. And +there will always be the favourite and perhaps two other wives +awake; four more lying supine under mats and whelmed in +slumber. Or perhaps we came later, fell on a more private +hour, and found Tembinok’ retired in the house with the +favourite, an earthenware spittoon, a leaden inkpot, and a +commercial ledger. In the last, lying on his belly, he +writes from day to day the uneventful history of his reign; and +when thus employed he betrayed a touch of fretfulness on +interruption with which I was well able to sympathise. The +royal annalist once read me a page or so, translating as he went; +but the passage being genealogical, and the author boggling +extremely in his version, I own I have been sometimes better +entertained. Nor does he confine himself to prose, but +touches the lyre, too, in his leisure moments, and passes for the +chief bard of his kingdom, as he is its sole public character, +leading architect, and only merchant.</p> +<p>His competence, however, does not reach to music; and his +verses, when they are ready, are taught to a professional +musician, who sets them and instructs the chorus. Asked +what his songs were about, Tembinok’ replied, +‘Sweethearts and trees and the sea. Not all the same +true, all the same lie.’ For a condensed view of +lyrical poetry (except that he seems to have forgot the stars and +flowers) this would be hard to mend. These multifarious +occupations bespeak (in a native and an absolute prince) unusual +activity of mind.</p> +<p>The palace court at noon is a spot to be remembered with awe, +the visitor scrambling there, on the loose stones, through a +splendid nightmare of light and heat; but the sweep of the wind +delivers it from flies and mosquitoes; and with the set of sun it +became heavenly. I remember it best on moonless +nights. The air was like a bath of milk. Countless +shining stars were overhead, the lagoon paved with them. +Herds of wives squatted by companies on the gravel, softly +chatting. Tembinok’ would doff his jacket, and sit +bare and silent, perhaps meditating songs; the favourite usually +by him, silent also. Meanwhile in the midst of the court, +the palace lanterns were being lit and marshalled in rank upon +the ground—six or eight square yards of them; a sight that +gave one strange ideas of the number of ‘my pamily’: +such a sight as may be seen about dusk in a corner of some great +terminus at home. Presently these fared off into all +corners of the precinct, lighting the last labours of the day, +lighting one after another to their rest that prodigious company +of women. A few lingered in the middle of the court for the +card-party, and saw the honours shuffled and dealt, and +Tembinok’ deliberating between his two; hands, and the +queens losing their tobacco. Then these also were scattered +and extinguished; and their place was taken by a great bonfire, +the night-light of the palace. When this was no more, +smaller fires burned likewise at the gates. These were +tended by the crones, unseen, unsleeping—not always +unheard. Should any approach in the dark hours, a guarded +alert made the circuit of the palisade; each sentry signalled her +neighbour with a stone; the rattle of falling pebbles passed and +died away; and the wardens of Tembinok’ crouched in their +places silent as before.</p> +<h3>CHAPTER IV—THE KING OF APEMAMA: EQUATOR TOWN AND THE +PALACE</h3> +<p>Five persons were detailed to wait upon us. Uncle +Parker, who brought us toddy and green nuts, was an elderly, +almost an old man, with the spirits, the industry, and the morals +of a boy of ten. His face was ancient, droll, and +diabolical, the skin stretched over taut sinews, like a sail on +the guide-rope; and he smiled with every muscle of his +head. His nuts must be counted every day, or he would +deceive us in the tale; they must be daily examined, or some +would prove to be unhusked; nothing but the king’s name, +and scarcely that, would hold him to his duty. After his +toils were over he was given a pipe, matches, and tobacco, and +sat on the floor in the maniap’ to smoke. He would +not seem to move from his position, and yet every day, when the +things fell to be returned the plug had disappeared; he had found +the means to conceal it in the roof, whence he could radiantly +produce it on the morrow. Although this piece of +legerdemain was performed regularly before three or four pairs of +eyes, we could never catch him in the fact; although we searched +after he was gone, we could never find the tobacco. Such +were the diversions of Uncle Parker, a man nearing sixty. +But he was punished according unto his deeds: Mrs. Stevenson took +a fancy to paint him, and the sufferings of the sitter were +beyond description.</p> +<p>Three lasses came from the palace to do our washing and racket +with Ah Fu. They were of the lowest class, hangers-on kept +for the convenience of merchant skippers, probably low-born, +perhaps out-islanders, with little refinement whether of manner +or appearance, but likely and jolly enough wenches in their +way. We called one <i>Guttersnipe</i>, for you may find her +image in the slums of any city; the same lean, dark-eyed, eager, +vulgar face, the same sudden, hoarse guffaws, the same forward +and yet anxious manner, as with a tail of an eye on the +policeman: only the policeman here was a live king, and his +truncheon a rifle. I doubt if you could find anywhere out +of the islands, or often there, the parallel of <i>Fatty</i>, a +mountain of a girl, who must have weighed near as many stones as +she counted summers, could have given a good account of a +life-guardsman, had the face of a baby, and applied her vast +mechanical forces almost exclusively to play. But they were +all three of the same merry spirit. Our washing was +conducted in a game of romps; and they fled and pursued, and +splashed, and pelted, and rolled each other in the sand, and kept +up a continuous noise of cries and laughter like holiday +children. Indeed, and however strange their own function in +that austere establishment, were they not escaped for the day +from the largest and strictest Ladies’ School in the South +Seas?</p> +<p>Our fifth attendant was no less a person than the royal +cook. He was strikingly handsome both in face and body, +lazy as a slave, and insolent as a butcher’s boy. He +slept and smoked on our premises in various graceful attitudes; +but so far from helping Ah Fu, he was not at the pains to watch +him. It may be said of him that he came to learn, and +remained to teach; and his lessons were at times difficult to +stomach. For example, he was sent to fill a bucket from the +well. About half-way he found my wife watering her onions, +changed buckets with her, and leaving her the empty, returned to +the kitchen with the full. On another occasion he was given +a dish of dumplings for the king, was told they must be eaten +hot, and that he should carry them as fast as possible. The +wretch set off at the rate of about a mile in the hour, head in +air, toes turned out. My patience, after a month of trial, +failed me at the sight. I pursued, caught him by his two +big shoulders, and thrusting him before me, ran with him down the +hill, over the sands, and through the applauding village, to the +Speak House, where the king was then holding a pow-wow. He +had the impudence to pretend he was internally injured by my +violence, and to profess serious apprehensions for his life.</p> +<p>All this we endured; for the ways of Tembinok’ are +summary, and I was not yet ripe to take a hand in the man’s +death. But in the meanwhile, here was my unfortunate China +boy slaving for the pair, and presently he fell sick. I was +now in the position of Cimondain Lantenac, and indeed all the +characters in <i>Quatre-Vingt-Treize</i>: to continue to spare +the guilty, I must sacrifice the innocent. I took the usual +course and tried to save both, with the usual consequence of +failure. Well rehearsed, I went down to the palace, found +the king alone, and obliged him with a vast amount of +rigmarole. The cook was too old to learn: I feared he was +not making progress; how if we had a boy instead?—boys were +more teachable. It was all in vain; the king pierced +through my disguises to the root of the fact; saw that the cook +had desperately misbehaved; and sat a while glooming. +‘I think he tavvy too much,’ he said at last, with +grim concision; and immediately turned the talk to other +subjects. The same day another high officer, the steward, +appeared in the cook’s place, and, I am bound to say, +proved civil and industrious.</p> +<p>As soon as I left, it seems the king called for a Winchester +and strolled outside the palisade, awaiting the defaulter. +That day Tembinok’ wore the woman’s frock; as like as +not, his make-up was completed by a pith helmet and blue +spectacles. Conceive the glaring stretch of sandhills, the +dwarf palms with their noon-day shadows, the line of the +palisade, the crone sentries (each by a small clear fire) cooking +syrup on their posts—and this chimæra waiting with +his deadly engine. To him, enter at last the cook, +strolling down the sandhill from Equator Town, listless, vain and +graceful; with no thought of alarm. As soon as he was well +within range, the travestied monarch fired the six shots over his +head, at his feet, and on either hand of him: the second Apemama +warning, startling in itself, fatal in significance, for the next +time his majesty will aim to hit. I am told the king is a +crack shot; that when he aims to kill, the grave may be got +ready; and when he aims to miss, misses by so near a margin that +the culprit tastes six times the bitterness of death. The +effect upon the cook I had an opportunity of seeing for +myself. My wife and I were returning from the sea-side of +the island, when we spied one coming to meet us at a very quick, +disordered pace, between a walk and a run. As we drew +nearer we saw it was the cook, beside himself with some emotion, +his usual warm, mulatto colour declined into a bluish +pallor. He passed us without word or gesture, staring on us +with the face of a Satan, and plunged on across the wood for the +unpeopled quarter of the island and the long, desert beach, where +he might rage to and fro unseen, and froth out the vials of his +wrath, fear, and humiliation. Doubtless in the curses that +he there uttered to the bursting surf and the tropic birds, the +name of the Kaupoi—the rich man—was frequently +repeated. I had made him the laughing-stock of the village +in the affair of the king’s dumplings; I had brought him by +my machinations into disgrace and the immediate jeopardy of his +days; last, and perhaps bitterest, he had found me there by the +way to spy upon him in the hour of his disorder.</p> +<p>Time passed, and we saw no more of him. The season of +the full moon came round, when a man thinks shame to lie +sleeping; and I continued until late—perhaps till twelve or +one in the morning—to walk on the bright sand and in the +tossing shadow of the palms. I played, as I wandered, on a +flageolet, which occupied much of my attention; the fans overhead +rattled in the wind with a metallic chatter; and a bare foot +falls at any rate almost noiseless on that shifting soil. +Yet when I got back to Equator Town, where all the lights were +out, and my wife (who was still awake, and had been looking +forth) asked me who it was that followed me, I thought she spoke +in jest. ‘Not at all,’ she said. ‘I +saw him twice as you passed, walking close at your heels. +He only left you at the corner of the maniap’; he must be +still behind the cook-house.’ Thither I +ran—like a fool, without any weapon—and came face to +face with the cook. He was within my tapu-line, which was +death in itself; he could have no business there at such an hour +but either to steal or to kill; guilt made him timorous; and he +turned and fled before me in the night in silence. As he +went I kicked him in that place where honour lies, and he gave +tongue faintly like an injured mouse. At the moment I +daresay he supposed it was a deadly instrument that touched +him.</p> +<p>What had the man been after? I have found my music +better qualified to scatter than to collect an audience. +Amateur as I was, I could not suppose him interested in my +reading of the <i>Carnival of Venice</i>, or that he would deny +himself his natural rest to follow my variations on <i>The +Ploughboy</i>. And whatever his design, it was impossible I +should suffer him to prowl by night among the houses. A +word to the king, and the man were not, his case being far beyond +pardon. But it is one thing to kill a man yourself; quite +another to bear tales behind his back and have him shot by a +third party; and I determined to deal with the fellow in some +method of my own. I told Ah Fu the story, and bade him +fetch me the cook whenever he should find him. I had +supposed this would be a matter of difficulty; and far from that, +he came of his own accord: an act really of desperation, since +his life hung by my silence, and the best he could hope was to be +forgotten. Yet he came with an assured countenance, +volunteered no apology or explanation, complained of injuries +received, and pretended he was unable to sit down. I +suppose I am the weakest man God made; I had kicked him in the +least vulnerable part of his big carcase; my foot was bare, and I +had not even hurt my foot. Ah Fu could not control his +merriment. On my side, knowing what must be the nature of +his apprehensions, I found in so much impudence a kind of +gallantry, and secretly admired the man. I told him I +should say nothing of his night’s adventure to the king; +that I should still allow him, when he had an errand, to come +within my tapu-line by day; but if ever I found him there after +the set of the sun I would shoot him on the spot; and to the +proof showed him a revolver. He must have been incredibly +relieved; but he showed no sign of it, took himself off with his +usual dandy nonchalance, and was scarce seen by us again.</p> +<p>These five, then, with the substitution of the steward for the +cook, came and went, and were our only visitors. The circle +of the tapu held at arm’s-length the inhabitants of the +village. As for ‘my pamily,’ they dwelt like +nuns in their enclosure; only once have I met one of them abroad, +and she was the king’s sister, and the place in which I +found her (the island infirmary) was very likely +privileged. There remains only the king to be accounted +for. He would come strolling over, always alone, a little +before a meal-time, take a chair, and talk and eat with us like +an old family friend. Gilbertine etiquette appears +defective on the point of leave-taking. It may be +remembered we had trouble in the matter with Karaiti; and there +was something childish and disconcerting in Tembinok’s +abrupt ‘I want go home now,’ accompanied by a kind of +ducking rise, and followed by an unadorned retreat. It was +the only blot upon his manners, which were otherwise plain, +decent, sensible, and dignified. He never stayed long nor +drank much, and copied our behaviour where he perceived it to +differ from his own. Very early in the day, for instance, +he ceased eating with his knife. It was plain he was +determined in all things to wring profit from our visit, and +chiefly upon etiquette. The quality of his white visitors +puzzled and concerned him; he would bring up name after name, and +ask if its bearer were a ‘big chiep,’ or even a +‘chiep’ at all—which, as some were my excellent +good friends, and none were actually born in the purple, became +at times embarrassing. He was struck to learn that our +classes were distinguishable by their speech, and that certain +words (for instance) were tapu on the quarter-deck of a +man-of-war; and he begged in consequence that we should watch and +correct him on the point. We were able to assure him that +he was beyond correction. His vocabulary is apt and ample +to an extraordinary degree. God knows where he collected +it, but by some instinct or some accident he has avoided all +profane or gross expressions. ‘Obliged,’ +‘stabbed,’ ‘gnaw,’ ‘lodge,’ +‘power,’ ‘company,’ +‘slender,’ ‘smooth,’ and +‘wonderful,’ are a few of the unexpected words that +enrich his dialect. Perhaps what pleased him most was to +hear about saluting the quarter-deck of a man-of-war. In +his gratitude for this hint he became fulsome. +‘Schooner cap’n no tell me,’ he cried; ‘I +think no tavvy! You tavvy too much; tavvy +’teama’, tavvy man-a-wa’. I think you +tavvy everything.’ Yet he gravelled me often enough with +his perpetual questions; and the false Mr. Barlow stood +frequently exposed before the royal Sandford. I remember +once in particular. We were showing the magic-lantern; a +slide of Windsor Castle was put in, and I told him there was the +‘outch’ of Victoreea. ‘How many pathom he +high?’ he asked, and I was dumb before him. It was +the builder, the indefatigable architect of palaces, that spoke; +collector though he was, he did not collect useless information; +and all his questions had a purpose. After etiquette, +government, law, the police, money, and medicine were his chief +interests—things vitally important to himself as a king and +the father of his people. It was my part not only to supply +new information, but to correct the old. ‘My patha he +tell me,’ or ‘White man he tell me,’ would be +his constant beginning; ‘You think he lie?’ +Sometimes I thought he did. Tembinok’ once brought me +a difficulty of this kind, which I was long of +comprehending. A schooner captain had told him of Captain +Cook; the king was much interested in the story; and turned for +more information—not to Mr. Stephen’s Dictionary, not +to the <i>Britannica</i>, but to the Bible in the Gilbert Island +version (which consists chiefly of the New Testament and the +Psalms). Here he sought long and earnestly; Paul he found, +and Festus and Alexander the coppersmith: no word of Cook. +The inference was obvious: the explorer was a myth. So hard +it is, even for a man of great natural parts like +Tembinok’, to grasp the ideas of a new society and +culture.</p> +<h3>CHAPTER V—KING AND COMMONS</h3> +<p>We saw but little of the commons of the isle. At first +we met them at the well, where they washed their linen and we +drew water for the table. The combination was distasteful; +and, having a tyrant at command, we applied to the king and had +the place enclosed in our tapu. It was one of the few +favours which Tembinok’ visibly boggled about granting, and +it may be conceived how little popular it made the +strangers. Many villagers passed us daily going afield; but +they fetched a wide circuit round our tapu, and seemed to avert +their looks. At times we went ourselves into the +village—a strange place. Dutch by its canals, +Oriental by the height and steepness of the roofs, which looked +at dusk like temples; but we were rarely called into a house: no +welcome, no friendship, was offered us; and of home life we had +but the one view: the waking of a corpse, a frigid, painful +scene: the widow holding on her lap the cold, bluish body of her +husband, and now partaking of the refreshments which made the +round of the company, now weeping and kissing the pale +mouth. (‘I fear you feel this affliction +deeply,’ said the Scottish minister. ‘Eh, sir, +and that I do!’ replied the widow. ‘I’ve +been greetin’ a’ nicht; an’ noo I’m just +gaun to sup this bit parritch, and then I’ll begin +an’ greet again.’) In our walks abroad I have +always supposed the islanders avoided us, perhaps from distaste, +perhaps by order; and those whom we met we took generally by +surprise. The surface of the isle is diversified with palm +groves, thickets, and romantic dingles four feet deep, relics of +old taro plantation; and it is thus possible to stumble unawares +on folk resting or hiding from their work. About +pistol-shot from our township there lay a pond in the bottom of a +jungle; here the maids of the isle came to bathe, and were +several times alarmed by our intrusion. Not for them are +the bright cold rivers of Tahiti or Upolu, not for them to splash +and laugh in the hour of the dusk with a villageful of gay +companions; but to steal here solitary, to crouch in a place like +a cow-wallow, and wash (if that can be called washing) in +lukewarm mud, brown as their own skins. Other, but still +rare, encounters occur to my memory. I was several times +arrested by a tender sound in the bush of voices talking, soft as +flutes and with quiet intonations. Hope told a flattering +tale; I put aside the leaves; and behold! in place of the +expected dryads, a pair of all too solid ladies squatting over a +clay pipe in the ungraceful <i>ridi</i>. The beauty of the +voice and the eye was all that remained to those vast dames; but +that of the voice was indeed exquisite. It is strange I +should have never heard a more winning sound of speech, yet the +dialect should be one remarkable for violent, ugly, and +outlandish vocables; so that Tembinok’ himself declared it +made him weary, and professed to find repose in talking +English.</p> +<p>The state of this folk, of whom I saw so little, I can merely +guess at. The king himself explains the situation with some +art. ‘No; I no pay them,’ he once said. +‘I give them tobacco. They work for me <i>all the +same brothers</i>.’ It is true there was a brother +once in Arden! But we prefer the shorter word. They +bear every servile mark,—levity like a child’s, +incurable idleness, incurious content. The insolence of the +cook was a trait of his own; not so his levity, which he shared +with the innocent Uncle Parker. With equal unconcern both +gambolled under the shadow of the gallows, and took liberties +with death that might have surprised a careless student of +man’s nature. I wrote of Parker that he behaved like +a boy of ten: what was he else, being a slave of sixty? He +had passed all his years in school, fed, clad, thought for, +commanded; and had grown familiar and coquetted with the fear of +punishment. By terror you may drive men long, but not +far. Here, in Apemama, they work at the constant and the +instant peril of their lives; and are plunged in a kind of +lethargy of laziness. It is common to see one go afield in +his stiff mat ungirt, so that he walks elbows-in like a trussed +fowl; and whatsoever his right hand findeth to do, the other must +be off duty holding on his clothes. It is common to see two +men carrying between them on a pole a single bucket of +water. To make two bites of a cherry is good enough: to +make two burthens of a soldier’s kit, for a distance of +perhaps half a furlong, passes measure. Woman, being the +less childish animal, is less relaxed by servile +conditions. Even in the king’s absence, even when +they were alone, I have seen Apemama women work with +constancy. But the outside to be hoped for in a man is that +he may attack his task in little languid fits, and lounge +between-whiles. So I have seen a painter, with his pipe +going, and a friend by the studio fireside. You might +suppose the race to lack civility, even vitality, until you saw +them in the dance. Night after night, and sometimes day +after day, they rolled out their choruses in the great Speak +House—solemn andantes and adagios, led by the clapped hand, +and delivered with an energy that shook the roof. The time +was not so slow, though it was slow for the islands; but I have +chosen rather to indicate the effect upon the hearer. Their +music had a church-like character from near at hand, and seemed +to European ears more regular than the run of island music. +Twice I have heard a discord regularly solved. From farther +off, heard at Equator Town for instance, the measures rose and +fell and crepitated like the barking of hounds in a distant +kennel.</p> +<p>The slaves are certainly not overworked—children of ten +do more without fatigue—and the Apemama labourers have +holidays, when the singing begins early in the afternoon. +The diet is hard; copra and a sweetmeat of pounded pandanus are +the only dishes I observed outside the palace; but there seems no +defect in quantity, and the king shares with them his +turtles. Three came in a boat from Kuria during our stay; +one was kept for the palace, one sent to us, one presented to the +village. It is the habit of the islanders to cook the +turtle in its carapace; we had been promised the shells, and we +asked a tapu on this foolish practice. The face of +Tembinok’ darkened and he answered nothing. +Hesitation in the question of the well I could understand, for +water is scarce on a low island; that he should refuse to +interfere upon a point of cookery was more than I had dreamed of; +and I gathered (rightly or wrongly) that he was scrupulous of +touching in the least degree the private life and habits of his +slaves. So that even here, in full despotism, public +opinion has weight; even here, in the midst of slavery, freedom +has a corner.</p> +<p>Orderly, sober, and innocent, life flows in the isle from day +to day as in a model plantation under a model planter. It +is impossible to doubt the beneficence of that stern rule. +A curious politeness, a soft and gracious manner, something +effeminate and courtly, distinguishes the islanders of Apemama; +it is talked of by all the traders, it was felt even by residents +so little beloved as ourselves, and noticeable even in the cook, +and even in that scoundrel’s hours of insolence. The +king, with his manly and plain bearing, stood out alone; you +might say he was the only Gilbert Islander in Apemama. +Violence, so common in Butaritari, seems unknown. So are +theft and drunkenness. I am assured the experiment has been +made of leaving sovereigns on the beach before the village; they +lay there untouched. In all our time on the island I was +but once asked for drink. This was by a mighty plausible +fellow, wearing European clothes and speaking excellent +English—Tamaiti his name, or, as the whites have now +corrupted it, ‘Tom White’: one of the king’s +supercargoes at three pounds a month and a percentage, a medical +man besides, and in his private hours a wizard. He found me +one day in the outskirts of the village, in a secluded place, hot +and private, where the taro-pits are deep and the plants +high. Here he buttonholed me, and, looking about him like a +conspirator, inquired if I had gin.</p> +<p>I told him I had. He remarked that gin was forbidden, +lauded the prohibition a while, and then went on to explain that +he was a doctor, or ‘dogstar’ as he pronounced the +word, that gin was necessary to him for his medical infusions, +that he was quite out of it, and that he would be obliged to me +for some in a bottle. I told him I had passed the king my +word on landing; but since his case was so exceptional, I would +go down to the palace at once, and had no doubt that +Tembinok’ would set me free. Tom White was +immediately overwhelmed with embarrassment and terror, besought +me in the most moving terms not to betray him, and fled my +neighbourhood. He had none of the cook’s valour; it +was weeks before he dared to meet my eye; and then only by the +order of the king and on particular business.</p> +<p>The more I viewed and admired this triumph of firm rule, the +more I was haunted and troubled by a problem, the problem +(perhaps) of to-morrow for ourselves. Here was a people +protected from all serious misfortune, relieved of all serious +anxieties, and deprived of what we call our liberty. Did +they like it? and what was their sentiment toward the +ruler? The first question I could not of course ask, nor +perhaps the natives answer. Even the second was delicate; +yet at last, and under charming and strange circumstances, I +found my opportunity to put it and a man to reply. It was +near the full of the moon, with a delicious breeze; the isle was +bright as day—to sleep would have been sacrilege; and I +walked in the bush, playing my pipe. It must have been the +sound of what I am pleased to call my music that attracted in my +direction another wanderer of the night. This was a young +man attired in a fine mat, and with a garland on his hair, for he +was new come from dancing and singing in the public hall; and his +body, his face, and his eyes were all of an enchanting +beauty. Every here and there in the Gilberts youths are to +be found of this absurd perfection; I have seen five of us pass +half an hour in admiration of a boy at Mariki; and Te Kop (my +friend in the fine mat and garland) I had already several times +remarked, and long ago set down as the loveliest animal in +Apemama. The philtre of admiration must be very strong, or +these natives specially susceptible to its effects, for I have +scarce ever admired a person in the islands but what he has +sought my particular acquaintance. So it was with Te +Kop. He led me to the ocean side; and for an hour or two we +sat smoking and talking on the resplendent sand and under the +ineffable brightness of the moon. My friend showed himself +very sensible of the beauty and amenity of the hour. +‘Good night! Good wind!’ he kept exclaiming, and as +he said the words he seemed to hug myself. I had long +before invented such reiterated expressions of delight for a +character (Felipe, in the story of <i>Olalla</i>) intended to be +partly bestial. But there was nothing bestial in Te Kop; +only a childish pleasure in the moment. He was no less +pleased with his companion, or was good enough to say so; +honoured me, before he left, by calling me Te Kop; apostrophised +me as ‘My name!’ with an intonation exquisitely +tender, laying his hand at the same time swiftly on my knee; and +after we had risen, and our paths began to separate in the bush, +twice cried to me with a sort of gentle ecstasy, ‘I like +you too much!’ From the beginning he had made no +secret of his terror of the king; would not sit down nor speak +above a whisper till he had put the whole breadth of the isle +between himself and his monarch, then harmlessly asleep; and even +there, even within a stone-cast of the outer sea, our talk +covered by the sound of the surf and the rattle of the wind among +the palms, continued to speak guardedly, softening his silver +voice (which rang loud enough in the chorus) and looking about +him like a man in fear of spies. The strange thing is that +I should have beheld him no more. In any other island in +the whole South Seas, if I had advanced half as far with any +native, he would have been at my door next morning, bringing and +expecting gifts. But Te Kop vanished in the bush for +ever. My house, of course, was unapproachable; but he knew +where to find me on the ocean beach, where I went daily. I +was the <i>Kaupoi</i>, the rich man; my tobacco and trade were +known to be endless: he was sure of a present. I am at a +loss how to explain his behaviour, unless it be supposed that he +recalled with terror and regret a passage in our interview. +Here it is:</p> +<p>‘The king, he good man?’ I asked.</p> +<p>‘Suppose he like you, he good man,’ replied Te +Kop: ‘no like, no good.’</p> +<p>That is one way of putting it, of course. Te Kop himself +was probably no favourite, for he scarce appealed to my judgment +as a type of industry. And there must be many others whom +the king (to adhere to the formula) does not like. Do these +unfortunates like the king? Or is not rather the repulsion +mutual? and the conscientious Tembinok’, like the +conscientious Braxfield before him, and many other conscientious +rulers and judges before either, surrounded by a considerable +body of ‘grumbletonians’? Take the cook, for +instance, when he passed us by, blue with rage and terror. +He was very wroth with me; I think by all the old principles of +human nature he was not very well pleased with his +sovereign. It was the rich man he sought to waylay: I think +it must have been by the turn of a hair that it was not the king +he waylaid instead. And the king gives, or seems to give, +plenty of opportunities; day and night he goes abroad alone, +whether armed or not I can but guess; and the taro-patches, where +his business must so often carry him, seem designed for +assassination. The case of the cook was heavy indeed to my +conscience. I did not like to kill my enemy at second-hand; +but had I a right to conceal from the king, who had trusted me, +the dangerous secret character of his attendant? And +suppose the king should fall, what would be the fate of the +king’s friends? It was our opinion at the time that +we should pay dear for the closing of the well; that our breath +was in the king’s nostrils; that if the king should by any +chance be bludgeoned in a taro-patch, the philosophical and +musical inhabitants of Equator Town might lay aside their +pleasant instruments, and betake themselves to what defence they +had, with a very dim prospect of success. These +speculations were forced upon us by an incident which I am +ashamed to betray. The schooner <i>H. L. Haseltine</i> +(since capsized at sea, with the loss of eleven lives) put into +Apemama in a good hour for us, who had near exhausted our +supplies. The king, after his habit, spent day after day on +board; the gin proved unhappily to his taste; he brought a store +of it ashore with him; and for some time the sole tyrant of the +isle was half-seas-over. He was not drunk—the man is +not a drunkard, he has always stores of liquor at hand, which he +uses with moderation,—but he was muzzy, dull, and +confused. He came one day to lunch with us, and while the +cloth was being laid fell asleep in his chair. His +confusion, when he awoke and found he had been detected, was +equalled by our uneasiness. When he was gone we sat and +spoke of his peril, which we thought to be in some degree our +own; of how easily the man might be surprised in such a state by +<i>grumbletonians</i>; of the strange scenes that would +follow—the royal treasures and stores at the mercy of the +rabble, the palace overrun, the garrison of women turned +adrift. And as we talked we were startled by a gun-shot and +a sudden, barbaric outcry. I believe we all changed colour; +but it was only the king firing at a dog and the chorus striking +up in the Speak House. A day or two later I learned the +king was very sick; went down, diagnosed the case; and took at +once the highest medical degree by the exhibition of bicarbonate +of soda. Within the hour Richard was himself again; and I +found him at the unfinished house, enjoying the double pleasure +of directing Rubam and making a dinner of cocoa-nut dumplings, +and all eagerness to have the formula of this new sort of +<i>pain-killer</i>—for <i>pain-killer</i> in the islands is +the generic name of medicine. So ended the king’s +modest spree and our anxiety.</p> +<p>On the face of things, I ought to say, loyalty appeared +unshaken. When the schooner at last returned for us, after +much experience of baffling winds, she brought a rumour that +Tebureimoa had declared war on Apemama. Tembinok’ +became a new man; his face radiant; his attitude, as I saw him +preside over a council of chiefs in one of the palace +maniap’s, eager as a boy’s; his voice sounding +abroad, shrill and jubilant, over half the compound. War is +what he wants, and here was his chance. The English +captain, when he flung his arms in the lagoon, had forbidden him +(except in one case) all military adventures in the future: here +was the case arrived. All morning the council sat; men were +drilled, arms were bought, the sound of firing disturbed the +afternoon; the king devised and communicated to me his plan of +campaign, which was highly elaborate and ingenious, but perhaps a +trifle fine-spun for the rough and random vicissitudes of +war. And in all this bustle the temper of the people +appeared excellent, an unwonted animation in every face, and even +Uncle Parker burning with military zeal.</p> +<p>Of course it was a false alarm. Tebureimoa had other +fish to fry. The ambassador who accompanied us on our +return to Butaritari found him retired to a small island on the +reef, in a huff with the Old Men, a tiff with the traders, and +more fear of insurrection at home than appetite for wars +abroad. The plenipotentiary had been placed under my +protection; and we solemnly saluted when we met. He proved +an excellent fisherman, and caught bonito over the ship’s +side. He pulled a good oar, and made himself useful for a +whole fiery afternoon, towing the becalmed <i>Equator</i> off +Mariki. He went to his post and did no good. He +returned home again, having done no harm. <i>O si sic +omnes</i>!</p> +<h3>CHAPTER VI—THE KING OF APEMAMA: DEVIL-WORK</h3> +<p>The ocean beach of Apemama was our daily resort. The +coast is broken by shallow bays. The reef is detached, +elevated, and includes a lagoon about knee-deep, the unrestful +spending-basin of the surf. The beach is now of fine sand, +now of broken coral. The trend of the coast being convex, +scarce a quarter of a mile of it is to be seen at once; the land +being so low, the horizon appears within a stone-cast; and the +narrow prospect enhances the sense of privacy. Man avoids +the place—even his footprints are uncommon; but a great +number of birds hover and pipe there fishing, and leave crooked +tracks upon the sand. Apart from these, the only sound (and +I was going to say the only society), is that of the breakers on +the reef.</p> +<p>On each projection of the coast, the bank of coral clinkers +immediately above the beach has been levelled, and a pillar +built, perhaps breast-high. These are not sepulchral; all +the dead being buried on the inhabited side of the island, close +to men’s houses, and (what is worse) to their wells. +I was told they were to protect the isle against inroads from the +sea—divine or diabolical martellos, probably sacred to +Taburik, God of Thunder.</p> +<p>The bay immediately opposite Equator Town, which we called Fu +Bay, in honour of our cook, was thus fortified on either +horn. It was well sheltered by the reef, the enclosed water +clear and tranquil, the enclosing beach curved like a horseshoe, +and both steep and broad. The path debouched about the +midst of the re-entrant angle, the woods stopping some distance +inland. In front, between the fringe of the wood and the +crown of the beach, there had been designed a regular figure, +like the court for some new variety of tennis, with borders of +round stones imbedded, and pointed at the angles with low posts, +likewise of stone. This was the king’s Pray +Place. When he prayed, what he prayed for, and to whom he +addressed his supplications I could never learn. The ground +was tapu.</p> +<p>In the angle, by the mouth of the path, stood a deserted +maniap’. Near by there had been a house before our +coming, which was now transported and figured for the moment in +Equator Town. It had been, and it would be again when we +departed, the residence of the guardian and wizard of the +spot—Tamaiti. Here, in this lone place, within sound +of the sea, he had his dwelling and uncanny duties. I +cannot call to mind another case of a man living on the ocean +side of any open atoll; and Tamaiti must have had strong nerves, +the greater confidence in his own spells, or, what I believe to +be the truth, an enviable scepticism. Whether Tamaiti had +any guardianship of the Pray Place I never heard. But his +own particular chapel stood farther back in the fringe of the +wood. It was a tree of respectable growth. Around it +there was drawn a circle of stones like those that enclosed the +Pray Place; in front, facing towards the sea, a stone of a much +greater size, and somewhat hollowed, like a piscina, stood close +against the trunk; in front of that again a conical pile of +gravel. In the hollow of what I have called the piscina +(though it proved to be a magic seat) lay an offering of green +cocoa-nuts; and when you looked up you found the boughs of the +tree to be laden with strange fruit: palm-branches elaborately +plaited, and beautiful models of canoes, finished and rigged to +the least detail. The whole had the appearance of a +mid-summer and sylvan Christmas-tree <i>al fresco</i>. Yet +we were already well enough acquainted in the Gilberts to +recognise it, at the first sight, for a piece of wizardry, or, as +they say in the group, of Devil-work.</p> +<p>The plaited palms were what we recognised. We had seen +them before on Apaiang, the most christianised of all these +islands; where excellent Mr. Bingham lived and laboured and has +left golden memories; whence all the education in the northern +Gilberts traces its descent; and where we were boarded by little +native Sunday-school misses in clean frocks, with demure faces, +and singing hymns as to the manner born.</p> +<p>Our experience of Devil-work at Apaiang had been as +follows:—It chanced we were benighted at the house of +Captain Tierney. My wife and I lodged with a Chinaman some +half a mile away; and thither Captain Reid and a native boy +escorted us by torch-light. On the way the torch went out, +and we took shelter in a small and lonely Christian chapel to +rekindle it. Stuck in the rafters of the chapel was a +branch of knotted palm. ‘What is that?’ I +asked. ‘O, that’s Devil-work,’ said the +Captain. ‘And what is Devil-work?’ I +inquired. ‘If you like, I’ll show you some when +we get to Johnnie’s,’ he replied. +‘Johnnie’s’ was a quaint little house upon the +crest of the beach, raised some three feet on posts, approached +by stairs; part walled, part trellised. Trophies of +advertisement-photographs were hung up within for +decoration. There was a table and a recess-bed, in which +Mrs. Stevenson slept; while I camped on the matted floor with +Johnnie, Mrs. Johnnie, her sister, and the devil’s own +regiment of cockroaches. Hither was summoned an old witch, +who looked the part to horror. The lamp was set on the +floor; the crone squatted on the threshold, a green palm-branch +in her hand, the light striking full on her aged features and +picking out behind her, from the black night, timorous faces of +spectators. Our sorceress began with a chanted incantation; +it was in the old tongue, for which I had no interpreter; but +ever and again there ran among the crowd outside that laugh which +every traveller in the islands learns so soon to +recognise,—the laugh of terror. Doubtless these +half-Christian folk were shocked, these half-heathen folk +alarmed. Chench or Taburik thus invoked, we put our +questions; the witch knotted the leaves, here a leaf and there a +leaf, plainly on some arithmetical system; studied the result +with great apparent contention of mind; and gave the +answers. Sidney Colvin was in robust health and gone a +journey; and we should have a fair wind upon the morrow: that was +the result of our consultation, for which we paid a dollar. +The next day dawned cloudless and breathless; but I think Captain +Reid placed a secret reliance on the sibyl, for the schooner was +got ready for sea. By eight the lagoon was flawed with long +cat’s-paws, and the palms tossed and rustled; before ten we +were clear of the passage and skimming under all plain sail, with +bubbling scuppers. So we had the breeze, which was well +worth a dollar in itself; but the bulletin about my friend in +England proved, some six months later, when I got my mail, to +have been groundless. Perhaps London lies beyond the +horizon of the island gods.</p> +<p>Tembinok’, in his first dealings, showed himself sternly +averse from superstition: and had not the <i>Equator</i> delayed, +we might have left the island and still supposed him an +agnostic. It chanced one day, however, that he came to our +maniap’, and found Mrs. Stevenson in the midst of a game of +patience. She explained the game as well as she was able, +and wound up jocularly by telling him this was her devil-work, +and if she won, the <i>Equator</i> would arrive next day. +Tembinok’ must have drawn a long breath; we were not so +high-and-dry after all; he need no longer dissemble, and he +plunged at once into confessions. He made devil-work every +day, he told us, to know if ships were coming in; and thereafter +brought us regular reports of the results. It was +surprising how regularly he was wrong; but he always had an +explanation ready. There had been some schooner in the +offing out of view; but either she was not bound for Apemama, or +had changed her course, or lay becalmed. I used to regard +the king with veneration as he thus publicly deceived +himself. I saw behind him all the fathers of the Church, +all the philosophers and men of science of the past; before him, +all those that are to come; himself in the midst; the whole +visionary series bowed over the same task of welding +incongruities. To the end Tembinok’ spoke reluctantly +of the island gods and their worship, and I learned but +little. Taburik is the god of thunder, and deals in wind +and weather. A while since there were wizards who could +call him down in the form of lightning. ‘My patha he +tell me he see: you think he lie?’ +Tienti—pronounced something like ‘Chench,’ and +identified by his majesty with the devil—sends and removes +bodily sickness. He is whistled for in the Paumotuan +manner, and is said to appear; but the king has never seen +him. The doctors treat disease by the aid of Chench: +eclectic Tembinok’ at the same time administering +‘pain-killer’ from his medicine-chest, so as to give +the sufferer both chances. ‘I think mo’ +betta,’ observed his majesty, with more than his usual +self-approval. Apparently the gods are not jealous, and +placidly enjoy both shrine and priest in common. On +Tamaiti’s medicine-tree, for instance, the model canoes are +hung up <i>ex voto</i> for a prosperous voyage, and must +therefore be dedicated to Taburik, god of the weather; but the +stone in front is the place of sick folk come to pacify +Chench.</p> +<p>It chanced, by great good luck, that even as we spoke of these +affairs, I found myself threatened with a cold. I do not +suppose I was ever glad of a cold before, or shall ever be again; +but the opportunity to see the sorcerers at work was priceless, +and I called in the faculty of Apemama. They came in a +body, all in their Sunday’s best and hung with wreaths and +shells, the insignia of the devil-worker. Tamaiti I knew +already: Terutak’ I saw for the first time—a tall, +lank, raw-boned, serious North-Sea fisherman turned brown; and +there was a third in their company whose name I never heard, and +who played to Tamaiti the part of <i>famulus</i>. Tamaiti +took me in hand first, and led me, conversing agreeably, to the +shores of Fu Bay. The <i>famulus</i> climbed a tree for +some green cocoa-nuts. Tamaiti himself disappeared a while +in the bush and returned with coco tinder, dry leaves, and a +spray of waxberry. I was placed on the stone, with my back +to the tree and my face to windward; between me and the +gravel-heap one of the green nuts was set; and then Tamaiti +(having previously bared his feet, for he had come in canvas +shoes, which tortured him) joined me within the magic circle, +hollowed out the top of the gravel-heap, built his fire in the +bottom, and applied a match: it was one of Bryant and +May’s. The flame was slow to catch, and the +irreverent sorcerer filled in the time with talk of foreign +places—of London, and ‘companies,’ and how much +money they had; of San Francisco, and the nefarious fogs, +‘all the same smoke,’ which had been so nearly the +occasion of his death. I tried vainly to lead him to the +matter in hand. ‘Everybody make medicine,’ he +said lightly. And when I asked him if he were himself a +good practitioner—‘No savvy,’ he replied, more +lightly still. At length the leaves burst in a flame, which +he continued to feed; a thick, light smoke blew in my face, and +the flames streamed against and scorched my clothes. He in +the meanwhile addressed, or affected to address, the evil spirit, +his lips moving fast, but without sound; at the same time he +waved in the air and twice struck me on the breast with his green +spray. So soon as the leaves were consumed the ashes were +buried, the green spray was imbedded in the gravel, and the +ceremony was at an end.</p> +<p>A reader of the <i>Arabian Nights</i> felt quite at +home. Here was the suffumigation; here was the muttering +wizard; here was the desert place to which Aladdin was decoyed by +the false uncle. But they manage these things better in +fiction. The effect was marred by the levity of the +magician, entertaining his patient with small talk like an +affable dentist, and by the incongruous presence of Mr. Osbourne +with a camera. As for my cold, it was neither better nor +worse.</p> +<p>I was now handed over to Terutak’, the leading +practitioner or medical baronet of Apemama. His place is on +the lagoon side of the island, hard by the palace. A rail +of light wood, some two feet high, encloses an oblong piece of +gravel like the king’s Pray Place; in the midst is a green +tree; below, a stone table bears a pair of boxes covered with a +fine mat; and in front of these an offering of food, a cocoa-nut, +a piece of taro or a fish, is placed daily. On two sides +the enclosure is lined with maniap’s; and one of our party, +who had been there to sketch, had remarked a daily concourse of +people and an extraordinary number of sick children; for this is +in fact the infirmary of Apemama. The doctor and myself +entered the sacred place alone; the boxes and the mat were +displaced; and I was enthroned in their stead upon the stone, +facing once more to the east. For a while the sorcerer +remained unseen behind me, making passes in the air with a branch +of palm. Then he struck lightly on the brim of my straw +hat; and this blow he continued to repeat at intervals, sometimes +brushing instead my arm and shoulder. I have had people try +to mesmerise me a dozen times, and never with the least +result. But at the first tap—on a quarter no more +vital than my hat-brim, and from nothing more virtuous than a +switch of palm wielded by a man I could not even see—sleep +rushed upon me like an armed man. My sinews fainted, my +eyes closed, my brain hummed, with drowsiness. I resisted, +at first instinctively, then with a certain flurry of despair, in +the end successfully; if that were indeed success which enabled +me to scramble to my feet, to stumble home somnambulous, to cast +myself at once upon my bed, and sink at once into a dreamless +stupor. When I awoke my cold was gone. So I leave a +matter that I do not understand.</p> +<p>Meanwhile my appetite for curiosities (not usually very keen) +had been strangely whetted by the sacred boxes. They were +of pandanus wood, oblong in shape, with an effect of pillaring +along the sides like straw work, lightly fringed with hair or +fibre and standing on four legs. The outside was neat as a +toy; the inside a mystery I was resolved to penetrate. But +there was a lion in the path. I might not approach +Terutak’, since I had promised to buy nothing in the +island; I dared not have recourse to the king, for I had already +received from him more gifts than I knew how to repay. In +this dilemma (the schooner being at last returned) we hit on a +device. Captain Reid came forward in my stead, professed an +unbridled passion for the boxes, and asked and obtained leave to +bargain for them with the wizard. That same afternoon the +captain and I made haste to the infirmary, entered the enclosure, +raised the mat, and had begun to examine the boxes at our +leisure, when Terutak’s wife bounced out of one of the nigh +houses, fell upon us, swept up the treasures, and was gone. +There was never a more absolute surprise. She came, she +took, she vanished, we had not a guess whither; and we remained, +with foolish looks and laughter on the empty field. Such +was the fit prologue of our memorable bargaining.</p> +<p>Presently Terutak’ came, bringing Tamaiti along with +him, both smiling; and we four squatted without the rail. +In the three maniap’s of the infirmary a certain audience +was gathered: the family of a sick child under treatment, the +king’s sister playing cards, a pretty girl, who swore I was +the image of her father; in all perhaps a score. +Terutak’s wife had returned (even as she had vanished) +unseen, and now sat, breathless and watchful, by her +husband’s side. Perhaps some rumour of our quest had +gone abroad, or perhaps we had given the alert by our unseemly +freedom: certain, at least, that in the faces of all present, +expectation and alarm were mingled.</p> +<p>Captain Reid announced, without preface or disguise, that I +was come to purchase; Terutak’, with sudden gravity, +refused to sell. He was pressed; he persisted. It was +explained we only wanted one: no matter, two were necessary for +the healing of the sick. He was rallied, he was reasoned +with: in vain. He sat there, serious and still, and +refused. All this was only a preliminary skirmish; hitherto +no sum of money had been mentioned; but now the captain brought +his great guns to bear. He named a pound, then two, then +three. Out of the maniap’s one person after another +came to join the group, some with mere excitement, others with +consternation in their faces. The pretty girl crept to my +side; it was then that—surely with the most artless +flattery—she informed me of my likeness to her +father. Tamaiti the infidel sat with hanging head and every +mark of dejection. Terutak’ streamed with sweat, his +eye was glazed, his face wore a painful rictus, his chest heaved +like that of one spent with running. The man must have been +by nature covetous; and I doubt if ever I saw moral agony more +tragically displayed. His wife by his side passionately +encouraged his resistance.</p> +<p>And now came the charge of the old guard. The captain, +making a skip, named the surprising figure of five pounds. +At the word the maniap’s were emptied. The +king’s sister flung down her cards and came to the front to +listen, a cloud on her brow. The pretty girl beat her +breast and cried with wearisome iteration that if the box were +hers I should have it. Terutak’s wife was beside +herself with pious fear, her face discomposed, her voice (which +scarce ceased from warning and encouragement) shrill as a +whistle. Even Terutak’ lost that image-like +immobility which he had hitherto maintained. He rocked on +his mat, threw up his closed knees alternately, and struck +himself on the breast after the manner of dancers. But he +came gold out of the furnace; and with what voice was left him +continued to reject the bribe.</p> +<p>And now came a timely interjection. ‘Money will +not heal the sick,’ observed the king’s sister +sententiously; and as soon as I heard the remark translated my +eyes were unsealed, and I began to blush for my employment. +Here was a sick child, and I sought, in the view of its parents, +to remove the medicine-box. Here was the priest of a +religion, and I (a heathen millionaire) was corrupting him to +sacrilege. Here was a greedy man, torn in twain betwixt +greed and conscience; and I sat by and relished, and lustfully +renewed his torments. <i>Ave</i>, <i>Cæsar</i>! +Smothered in a corner, dormant but not dead, we have all the one +touch of nature: an infant passion for the sand and blood of the +arena. So I brought to an end my first and last experience +of the joys of the millionaire, and departed amid silent +awe. Nowhere else can I expect to stir the depths of human +nature by an offer of five pounds; nowhere else, even at the +expense of millions, could I hope to see the evil of riches stand +so legibly exposed. Of all the bystanders, none but the +king’s sister retained any memory of the gravity and danger +of the thing in hand. Their eyes glowed, the girl beat her +breast, in senseless animal excitement. Nothing was offered +them; they stood neither to gain nor to lose; at the mere name +and wind of these great sums Satan possessed them.</p> +<p>From this singular interview I went straight to the palace; +found the king; confessed what I had been doing; begged him, in +my name, to compliment Terutak’ on his virtue, and to have +a similar box made for me against the return of the +schooner. Tembinok’, Rubam, and one of the Daily +Papers—him we used to call ‘the Facetiæ +Column’—laboured for a while of some idea, which was +at last intelligibly delivered. They feared I thought the +box would cure me; whereas, without the wizard, it was useless; +and when I was threatened with another cold I should do better to +rely on pain-killer. I explained I merely wished to keep it +in my ‘outch’ as a thing made in Apemama and these +honest men were much relieved.</p> +<p>Late the same evening, my wife, crossing the isle to windward, +was aware of singing in the bush. Nothing is more common in +that hour and place than the jubilant carol of the toddy-cutter, +swinging high overhead, beholding below him the narrow ribbon of +the isle, the surrounding field of ocean, and the fires of the +sunset. But this was of a graver character, and seemed to +proceed from the ground-level. Advancing a little in the +thicket, Mrs. Stevenson saw a clear space, a fine mat spread in +the midst, and on the mat a wreath of white flowers and one of +the devil-work boxes. A woman—whom we guess to have +been Mrs. Terutak’—sat in front, now drooping over +the box like a mother over a cradle, now lifting her face and +directing her song to heaven. A passing toddy-cutter told +my wife that she was praying. Probably she did not so much +pray as deprecate; and perhaps even the ceremony was one of +disenchantment. For the box was already doomed; it was to +pass from its green medicine-tree, reverend precinct, and devout +attendants; to be handled by the profane; to cross three seas; to +come to land under the foolscap of St. Paul’s; to be +domesticated within the hail of Lillie Bridge; there to be dusted +by the British housemaid, and to take perhaps the roar of London +for the voice of the outer sea along the reef. Before even +we had finished dinner Chench had begun his journey, and one of +the newspapers had already placed the box upon my table as the +gift of Tembinok’.</p> +<p>I made haste to the palace, thanked the king, but offered to +restore the box, for I could not bear that the sick of the island +should be made to suffer. I was amazed by his reply. +Terutak’, it appeared, had still three or four in reserve +against an accident; and his reluctance, and the dread painted at +first on every face, was not in the least occasioned by the +prospect of medical destitution, but by the immediate divinity of +Chench. How much more did I respect the king’s +command, which had been able to extort in a moment and for +nothing a sacrilegious favour that I had in vain solicited with +millions! But now I had a difficult task in front of me; it +was not in my view that Terutak’ should suffer by his +virtue; and I must persuade the king to share my opinion, to let +me enrich one of his subjects, and (what was yet more delicate) +to pay for my present. Nothing shows the king in a more +becoming light than the fact that I succeeded. He demurred +at the principle; he exclaimed, when he heard it, at the +sum. ‘Plenty money!’ cried he, with +contemptuous displeasure. But his resistance was never +serious; and when he had blown off his +ill-humour—‘A’ right,’ said he. +‘You give him. Mo’ betta.’</p> +<p>Armed with this permission, I made straight for the +infirmary. The night was now come, cool, dark, and +starry. On a mat hard by a clear fire of wood and coco +shell, Terutak’ lay beside his wife. Both were +smiling; the agony was over, the king’s command had +reconciled (I must suppose) their agitating scruples; and I was +bidden to sit by them and share the circulating pipe. I was +a little moved myself when I placed five gold sovereigns in the +wizard’s hand; but there was no sign of emotion in +Terutak’ as he returned them, pointed to the palace, and +named Tembinok’. It was a changed scene when I had +managed to explain. Terutak’, long, dour Scots +fisherman as he was, expressed his satisfaction within bounds; +but the wife beamed; and there was an old gentleman +present—her father, I suppose—who seemed nigh +translated. His eyes stood out of his head; +‘<i>Kaupoi</i>, <i>Kaupoi</i>—rich, rich!’ ran +on his lips like a refrain; and he could not meet my eye but what +he gurgled into foolish laughter.</p> +<p>I might now go home, leaving that fire-lit family party +gloating over their new millions, and consider my strange +day. I had tried and rewarded the virtue of +Terutak’. I had played the millionaire, had behaved +abominably, and then in some degree repaired my +thoughtlessness. And now I had my box, and could open it +and look within. It contained a miniature sleeping-mat and +a white shell. Tamaiti, interrogated next day as to the +shell, explained it was not exactly Chench, but a cell, or body, +which he would at times inhabit. Asked why there was a +sleeping-mat, he retorted indignantly, ‘Why have you +mats?’ And this was the sceptical Tamaiti! But +island scepticism is never deeper than the lips.</p> +<h3>CHAPTER VII—THE KING OF APEMAMA</h3> +<p>Thus all things on the island, even the priests of the gods, +obey the word of Tembinok’. He can give and take, and +slay, and allay the scruples of the conscientious, and do all +things (apparently) but interfere in the cookery of a +turtle. ‘I got power’ is his favourite word; it +interlards his conversation; the thought haunts him and is ever +fresh; and when be has asked and meditates of foreign countries, +he looks up with a smile and reminds you, ‘<i>I</i> got +<i>Power</i>.’ Nor is his delight only in the +possession, but in the exercise. He rejoices in the crooked +and violent paths of kingship like a strong man to run a race, or +like an artist in his art. To feel, to use his power, to +embellish his island and the picture of the island life after a +private ideal, to milk the island vigorously, to extend his +singular museum—these employ delightfully the sum of his +abilities. I never saw a man more patently in the right +trade.</p> +<p>It would be natural to suppose this monarchy inherited intact +through generations. And so far from that, it is a thing of +yesterday. I was already a boy at school while Apemama was +yet republican, ruled by a noisy council of Old Men, and torn +with incurable feuds. And Tembinok’ is no Bourbon; +rather the son of a Napoleon. Of course he is +well-born. No man need aspire high in the isles of the +Pacific unless his pedigree be long and in the upper regions +mythical. And our king counts cousinship with most of the +high families in the archipelago, and traces his descent to a +shark and a heroic woman. Directed by an oracle, she swam +beyond sight of land to meet her revolting paramour, and received +at sea the seed of a predestined family. ‘I think +lie,’ is the king’s emphatic commentary; yet he is +proud of the legend. From this illustrious beginning the +fortunes of the race must have declined; and Teñkoruti, +the grandfather of Tembinok’, was the chief of a village at +the north end of the island. Kuria and Aranuka were yet +independent; Apemama itself the arena of devastating feuds. +Through this perturbed period of history the figure of +Teñkoruti stalks memorable. In war he was swift and +bloody; several towns fell to his spear, and the inhabitants were +butchered to a man. In civil life this arrogance was +unheard of. When the council of Old Men was summoned, he +went to the Speak House, delivered his mind, and left without +waiting to be answered. Wisdom had spoken: let others opine +according to their folly. He was feared and hated, and this +was his pleasure. He was no poet; he cared not for arts or +knowledge. ‘My gran’patha one thing savvy, +savvy pight,’ observed the king. In some lull of +their own disputes the Old Men of Apemama adventured on the +conquest of Apemama; and this unlicked Caius Marcius was elected +general of the united troops. Success attended him; the +islands were reduced, and Teñkoruti returned to his own +government, glorious and detested. He died about 1860, in +the seventieth year of his age and the full odour of +unpopularity. He was tall and lean, says his grandson, +looked extremely old, and ‘walked all the same young +man.’ The same observer gave me a significant +detail. The survivors of that rough epoch were all defaced +with spearmarks; there was none on the body of this skilful +fighter. ‘I see old man, no got a spear,’ said +the king.</p> +<p>Teñkoruti left two sons, Tembaitake and +Tembinatake. Tembaitake, our king’s father, was +short, middling stout, a poet, a good genealogist, and something +of a fighter; it seems he took himself seriously, and was perhaps +scarce conscious that he was in all things the creature and +nursling of his brother. There was no shadow of dispute +between the pair: the greater man filled with alacrity and +content the second place; held the breach in war, and all the +portfolios in the time of peace; and, when his brother rated him, +listened in silence, looking on the ground. Like +Teñkoruti, he was tall and lean and a swift talker—a +rare trait in the islands. He possessed every +accomplishment. He knew sorcery, he was the best +genealogist of his day, he was a poet, he could dance and make +canoes and armour; and the famous mast of Apemama, which ran one +joint higher than the mainmast of a full-rigged ship, was of his +conception and design. But these were avocations, and the +man’s trade was war. ‘When my uncle go make +wa’, he laugh,’ said Tembinok’. He +forbade the use of field fortification, that protractor of native +hostilities; his men must fight in the open, and win or be beaten +out of hand; his own activity inspired his followers; and the +swiftness of his blows beat down, in one lifetime, the resistance +of three islands. He made his brother sovereign, he left +his nephew absolute. ‘My uncle make all +smooth,’ said Tembinok’. ‘I mo’ +king than my patha: I got power,’ he said, with formidable +relish.</p> +<p>Such is the portrait of the uncle drawn by the nephew. I +can set beside it another by a different artist, who has +often—I may say always—delighted me with his romantic +taste in narrative, but not always—and I may say not +often—persuaded me of his exactitude. I have already +denied myself the use of so much excellent matter from the same +source, that I begin to think it time to reward good resolution; +and his account of Tembinatake agrees so well with the +king’s, that it may very well be (what I hope it is) the +record of a fact, and not (what I suspect) the pleasing exercise +of an imagination more than sailorly. A., for so I had +perhaps better call him, was walking up the island after dusk, +when he came on a lighted village of some size, was directed to +the chief’s house, and asked leave to rest and smoke a +pipe. ‘You will sit down, and smoke a pipe, and wash, +and eat, and sleep,’ replied the chief, ‘and +to-morrow you will go again.’ Food was brought, +prayers were held (for this was in the brief day of +Christianity), and the chief himself prayed with eloquence and +seeming sincerity. All evening A. sat and admired the man +by the firelight. He was six feet high, lean, with the +appearance of many years, and an extraordinary air of breeding +and command. ‘He looked like a man who would kill you +laughing,’ said A., in singular echo of one of the +king’s expressions. And again: ‘I had been +reading the Musketeer books, and he reminded me of +Aramis.’ Such is the portrait of Tembinatake, drawn +by an expert romancer.</p> +<p>We had heard many tales of ‘my patha’; never a +word of my uncle till two days before we left. As the time +approached for our departure Tembinok’ became greatly +changed; a softer, a more melancholy, and, in particular, a more +confidential man appeared in his stead. To my wife he +contrived laboriously to explain that though he knew he must lose +his father in the course of nature, he had not minded nor +realised it till the moment came; and that now he was to lose us +he repeated the experience. We showed fireworks one evening +on the terrace. It was a heavy business; the sense of +separation was in all our minds, and the talk languished. +The king was specially affected, sat disconsolate on his mat, and +often sighed. Of a sudden one of the wives stepped forth +from a cluster, came and kissed him in silence, and silently went +again. It was just such a caress as we might give to a +disconsolate child, and the king received it with a child’s +simplicity. Presently after we said good-night and +withdrew; but Tembinok’ detained Mr. Osbourne, patting the +mat by his side and saying: ‘Sit down. I feel bad, I +like talk.’ Osbourne sat down by him. +‘You like some beer?’ said he; and one of the wives +produced a bottle. The king did not partake, but sat +sighing and smoking a meerschaum pipe. ‘I very sorry +you go,’ he said at last. ‘Miss Stlevens he +good man, woman he good man, boy he good man; all good man. +Woman he smart all the same man. My woman’ (glancing +towards his wives) ‘he good woman, no very smart. I +think Miss Stlevens he is chiep all the same cap’n +man-o-wa’. I think Miss Stlevens he rich man all the +same me. All go schoona. I very sorry. My patha +he go, my uncle he go, my cutcheons he go, Miss Stlevens he go: +all go. You no see king cry before. King all the same +man: feel bad, he cry. I very sorry.’</p> +<p>In the morning it was the common topic in the village that the +king had wept. To me he said: ‘Last night I no can +’peak: too much here,’ laying his hand upon his +bosom. ‘Now you go away all the same my pamily. +My brothers, my uncle go away. All the same.’ +This was said with a dejection almost passionate. And it +was the first time I had heard him name his uncle, or indeed +employ the word. The same day he sent me a present of two +corselets, made in the island fashion of plaited fibre, heavy and +strong. One had been worn by Teñkoruti, one by +Tembaitake; and the gift being gratefully received, he sent me, +on the return of his messengers, a third—that of +Tembinatake. My curiosity was roused; I begged for +information as to the three wearers; and the king entered with +gusto into the details already given. Here was a strange +thing, that he should have talked so much of his family, and not +once mentioned that relative of whom he was plainly the most +proud. Nay, more: he had hitherto boasted of his father; +thenceforth he had little to say of him; and the qualities for +which he had praised him in the past were now attributed where +they were due,—to the uncle. A confusion might be +natural enough among islanders, who call all the sons of their +grandfather by the common name of father. But this was not +the case with Tembinok’. Now the ice was broken the +word uncle was perpetually in his mouth; he who had been so ready +to confound was now careful to distinguish; and the father sank +gradually into a self-complacent ordinary man, while the uncle +rose to his true stature as the hero and founder of the race.</p> +<p>The more I heard and the more I considered, the more this +mystery of Tembinok’s behaviour puzzled and attracted +me. And the explanation, when it came, was one to strike +the imagination of a dramatist. Tembinok’ had two +brothers. One, detected in private trading, was banished, +then forgiven, lives to this day in the island, and is the father +of the heir-apparent, Paul. The other fell beyond +forgiveness. I have heard it was a love-affair with one of +the king’s wives, and the thing is highly possible in that +romantic archipelago. War was attempted to be levied; but +Tembinok’ was too swift for the rebels, and the guilty +brother escaped in a canoe. He did not go alone. +Tembinatake had a hand in the rebellion, and the man who had +gained a kingdom for a weakling brother was banished by that +brother’s son. The fugitives came to shore in other +islands, but Tembinok’ remains to this day ignorant of +their fate.</p> +<p>So far history. And now a moment for conjecture. +Tembinok’ confused habitually, not only the attributes and +merits of his father and his uncle, but their diverse personal +appearance. Before he had even spoken, or thought to speak, +of Tembinatake, he had told me often of a tall, lean father, +skilled in war, and his own schoolmaster in genealogy and island +arts. How if both were fathers, one natural, one +adoptive? How if the heir of Tembaitake, like the heir of +Tembinok’ himself, were not a son, but an adopted +nephew? How if the founder of the monarchy, while he worked +for his brother, worked at the same time for the child of his +loins? How if on the +death of Tembaitake, the two stronger natures, father and son, +king and kingmaker, clashed, and Tembinok’, when he drove +out his uncle, drove out the author of his days? Here is at +least a tragedy four-square.</p> +<p>The king took us on board in his own gig, dressed for the +occasion in the naval uniform. He had little to say, he +refused refreshments, shook us briefly by the hand, and went +ashore again. That night the palm-tops of Apemama had +dipped behind the sea, and the schooner sailed solitary under the +stars.</p> +<div class="gapspace"> </div> +<p style="text-align: center">THE END.</p> +<div class="gapmediumline"> </div> +<p style="text-align: center"><span class="GutSmall">BILLING AND +SONS, LTD., PRINTERS, GUILDFORD</span></p> +<div class="gapspace"> </div> +<h2>FOOTNOTES</h2> +<p><a name="footnote12"></a><a href="#citation12" +class="footnote">[12]</a> Where that word is used as a +salutation I give that form.</p> +<p><a name="footnote29"></a><a href="#citation29" +class="footnote">[29]</a> In English usually written +‘taboo’: ‘tapu’ is the correct Tahitian +form.—[<span class="smcap">Ed.</span>]</p> +<p><a name="footnote86"></a><a href="#citation86" +class="footnote">[86]</a> The reference is to Maka, the +Gawaiian missionary, at Butaritari in the Gilberts.</p> +<p><a name="footnote122"></a><a href="#citation122" +class="footnote">[122]</a> Elephantiasis.</p> +<p><a name="footnote156"></a><a href="#citation156" +class="footnote">[156]</a> Arorai is in the Gilberts, +Funafuti in the Ellice Islands.—<span +class="smcap">Ed.</span></p> +<p><a name="footnote231"></a><a href="#citation231" +class="footnote">[231]</a> Gin and brandy.</p> +<p><a name="footnote275"></a><a href="#citation275" +class="footnote">[275]</a> In the Gilbert group.</p> +<p><a name="footnote279a"></a><a href="#citation279a" +class="footnote">[279a]</a> Copra: the dried kernel of the +cocoa-nut, the chief article of commerce throughout the Pacific +Islands.</p> +<p><a name="footnote279b"></a><a href="#citation279b" +class="footnote">[279b]</a> Houses.</p> +<p><a name="footnote283"></a><a href="#citation283" +class="footnote">[283]</a> Suppose.</p> +<p>***END OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK IN THE SOUTH SEAS***</p> +<pre> + + +***** This file should be named 464-h.htm or 464-h.zip****** + + +This and all associated files of various formats will be found in: +http://www.gutenberg.org/dirs/4/6/464 + + + +Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions +will be renamed. + +Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no +one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation +(and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without +permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules, +set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to +copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to +protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project +Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you +charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you +do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the +rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose +such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and +research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do +practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is +subject to the trademark license, especially commercial +redistribution. + + + +*** START: FULL LICENSE *** + +THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE +PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK + +To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free +distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work +(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project +Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project +Gutenberg-tm License available with this file or online at + www.gutenberg.org/license. + + +Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm +electronic works + +1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm +electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to +and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property +(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all +the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy +all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession. +If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project +Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the +terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or +entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8. + +1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be +used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who +agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few +things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works +even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See +paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project +Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement +and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic +works. See paragraph 1.E below. + +1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the Foundation" +or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project +Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the +collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an +individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are +located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from +copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative +works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg +are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project +Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by +freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of +this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with +the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by +keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project +Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others. + +1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern +what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in +a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check +the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement +before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or +creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project +Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning +the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United +States. + +1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg: + +1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate +access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently +whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the +phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the phrase "Project +Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed, +copied or distributed: + +This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with +almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or +re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included +with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org + +1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived +from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is +posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied +and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees +or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work +with the phrase "Project Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the +work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1 +through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the +Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or +1.E.9. + +1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted +with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution +must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional +terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked +to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the +permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work. + +1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm +License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this +work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm. + +1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this +electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without +prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with +active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project +Gutenberg-tm License. + +1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary, +compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any +word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or +distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than +"Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official version +posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org), +you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a +copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon +request, of the work in its original "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other +form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm +License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1. + +1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying, +performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works +unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9. + +1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing +access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided +that + +- You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from + the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method + you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is + owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he + has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the + Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments + must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you + prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax + returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and + sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the + address specified in Section 4, "Information about donations to + the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation." + +- You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies + you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he + does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm + License. You must require such a user to return or + destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium + and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of + Project Gutenberg-tm works. + +- You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any + money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the + electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days + of receipt of the work. + +- You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free + distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works. + +1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm +electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set +forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from +both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael +Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the +Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below. + +1.F. + +1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable +effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread +public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm +collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic +works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain +"Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or +corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual +property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a +computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by +your equipment. + +1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right +of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project +Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project +Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project +Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all +liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal +fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT +LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE +PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE +TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE +LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR +INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH +DAMAGE. + +1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a +defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can +receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a +written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you +received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with +your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with +the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a +refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity +providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to +receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy +is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further +opportunities to fix the problem. + +1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth +in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS', WITH NO OTHER +WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO +WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE. + +1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied +warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages. +If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the +law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be +interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by +the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any +provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions. + +1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the +trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone +providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance +with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production, +promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works, +harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees, +that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do +or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm +work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any +Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause. + + +Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm + +Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of +electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers +including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists +because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from +people in all walks of life. + +Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the +assistance they need are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's +goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will +remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project +Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure +and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations. +To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation +and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4 +and the Foundation information page at www.gutenberg.org + + +Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive +Foundation + +The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit +501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the +state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal +Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification +number is 64-6221541. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg +Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent +permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws. + +The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S. +Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered +throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at 809 +North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887. Email +contact links and up to date contact information can be found at the +Foundation's web site and official page at www.gutenberg.org/contact + +For additional contact information: + Dr. Gregory B. Newby + Chief Executive and Director + gbnewby@pglaf.org + +Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg +Literary Archive Foundation + +Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide +spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of +increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be +freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest +array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations +($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt +status with the IRS. + +The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating +charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United +States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a +considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up +with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations +where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To +SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any +particular state visit www.gutenberg.org/donate + +While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we +have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition +against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who +approach us with offers to donate. + +International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make +any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from +outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff. + +Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation +methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other +ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations. +To donate, please visit: www.gutenberg.org/donate + + +Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic +works. + +Professor Michael S. Hart was the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm +concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared +with anyone. For forty years, he produced and distributed Project +Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support. + +Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed +editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S. +unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily +keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition. + +Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility: + + www.gutenberg.org + +This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm, +including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary +Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to +subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks. +</pre></body> +</html> diff --git a/464-h/images/p0b.jpg b/464-h/images/p0b.jpg Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000..19f5487 --- /dev/null +++ b/464-h/images/p0b.jpg diff --git a/464-h/images/p0s.jpg b/464-h/images/p0s.jpg Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000..d0621f2 --- /dev/null +++ b/464-h/images/p0s.jpg diff --git a/464-h/images/p252.jpg b/464-h/images/p252.jpg Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000..1290b8e --- /dev/null +++ b/464-h/images/p252.jpg diff --git a/LICENSE.txt b/LICENSE.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000..6312041 --- /dev/null +++ b/LICENSE.txt @@ -0,0 +1,11 @@ +This eBook, including all associated images, markup, improvements, +metadata, and any other content or labor, has been confirmed to be +in the PUBLIC DOMAIN IN THE UNITED STATES. + +Procedures for determining public domain status are described in +the "Copyright How-To" at https://www.gutenberg.org. + +No investigation has been made concerning possible copyrights in +jurisdictions other than the United States. Anyone seeking to utilize +this eBook outside of the United States should confirm copyright +status under the laws that apply to them. diff --git a/README.md b/README.md new file mode 100644 index 0000000..2bf059f --- /dev/null +++ b/README.md @@ -0,0 +1,2 @@ +Project Gutenberg (https://www.gutenberg.org) public repository for +eBook #464 (https://www.gutenberg.org/ebooks/464) diff --git a/old/sseas10.txt b/old/sseas10.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000..9e1f8d3 --- /dev/null +++ b/old/sseas10.txt @@ -0,0 +1,10040 @@ +The Project Gutenberg EBook of In the South Seas, by Robert Louis Stevenson +(#20 in our series by Robert Louis Stevenson) + +Copyright laws are changing all over the world. Be sure to check the +copyright laws for your country before downloading or redistributing +this or any other Project Gutenberg eBook. + +This header should be the first thing seen when viewing this Project +Gutenberg file. Please do not remove it. Do not change or edit the +header without written permission. + +Please read the "legal small print," and other information about the +eBook and Project Gutenberg at the bottom of this file. Included is +important information about your specific rights and restrictions in +how the file may be used. You can also find out about how to make a +donation to Project Gutenberg, and how to get involved. + + +**Welcome To The World of Free Plain Vanilla Electronic Texts** + +**eBooks Readable By Both Humans and By Computers, Since 1971** + +*****These eBooks Were Prepared By Thousands of Volunteers!***** + + +Title: In the South Seas + +Author: Robert Louis Stevenson + +Release Date: March, 1996 [EBook #464] +[This file was first posted on January 23, 1996] +[Most recently updated: August 18, 2002] + +Edition: 10 + +Language: English + +Character set encoding: ASCII + +*** START OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK, IN THE SOUTH SEAS *** + + + + +Transcribed from the 1908 Chatto & Windus edition by David Price, +email ccx074@coventry.ac.uk + + + + +IN THE SOUTH SEAS + + + + +PART 1: THE MARQUESAS + + + + +CHAPTER I--AN ISLAND LANDFALL + + + +For nearly ten years my health had been declining; and for some +while before I set forth upon my voyage, I believed I was come to +the afterpiece of life, and had only the nurse and undertaker to +expect. It was suggested that I should try the South Seas; and I +was not unwilling to visit like a ghost, and be carried like a +bale, among scenes that had attracted me in youth and health. I +chartered accordingly Dr. Merrit's schooner yacht, the Casco, +seventy-four tons register; sailed from San Francisco towards the +end of June 1888, visited the eastern islands, and was left early +the next year at Honolulu. Hence, lacking courage to return to my +old life of the house and sick-room, I set forth to leeward in a +trading schooner, the Equator, of a little over seventy tons, spent +four months among the atolls (low coral islands) of the Gilbert +group, and reached Samoa towards the close of '89. By that time +gratitude and habit were beginning to attach me to the islands; I +had gained a competency of strength; I had made friends; I had +learned new interests; the time of my voyages had passed like days +in fairyland; and I decided to remain. I began to prepare these +pages at sea, on a third cruise, in the trading steamer Janet +Nicoll. If more days are granted me, they shall be passed where I +have found life most pleasant and man most interesting; the axes of +my black boys are already clearing the foundations of my future +house; and I must learn to address readers from the uttermost parts +of the sea. + +That I should thus have reversed the verdict of Lord Tennyson's +hero is less eccentric than appears. Few men who come to the +islands leave them; they grow grey where they alighted; the palm +shades and the trade-wind fans them till they die, perhaps +cherishing to the last the fancy of a visit home, which is rarely +made, more rarely enjoyed, and yet more rarely repeated. No part +of the world exerts the same attractive power upon the visitor, and +the task before me is to communicate to fireside travellers some +sense of its seduction, and to describe the life, at sea and +ashore, of many hundred thousand persons, some of our own blood and +language, all our contemporaries, and yet as remote in thought and +habit as Rob Roy or Barbarossa, the Apostles or the Caesars. + +The first experience can never be repeated. The first love, the +first sunrise, the first South Sea island, are memories apart and +touched a virginity of sense. On the 28th of July 1888 the moon +was an hour down by four in the morning. In the east a radiating +centre of brightness told of the day; and beneath, on the skyline, +the morning bank was already building, black as ink. We have all +read of the swiftness of the day's coming and departure in low +latitudes; it is a point on which the scientific and sentimental +tourist are at one, and has inspired some tasteful poetry. The +period certainly varies with the season; but here is one case +exactly noted. Although the dawn was thus preparing by four, the +sun was not up till six; and it was half-past five before we could +distinguish our expected islands from the clouds on the horizon. +Eight degrees south, and the day two hours a-coming. The interval +was passed on deck in the silence of expectation, the customary +thrill of landfall heightened by the strangeness of the shores that +we were then approaching. Slowly they took shape in the +attenuating darkness. Ua-huna, piling up to a truncated summit, +appeared the first upon the starboard bow; almost abeam arose our +destination, Nuka-hiva, whelmed in cloud; and betwixt and to the +southward, the first rays of the sun displayed the needles of Ua- +pu. These pricked about the line of the horizon; like the +pinnacles of some ornate and monstrous church, they stood there, in +the sparkling brightness of the morning, the fit signboard of a +world of wonders. + +Not one soul aboard the Casco had set foot upon the islands, or +knew, except by accident, one word of any of the island tongues; +and it was with something perhaps of the same anxious pleasure as +thrilled the bosom of discoverers that we drew near these +problematic shores. The land heaved up in peaks and rising vales; +it fell in cliffs and buttresses; its colour ran through fifty +modulations in a scale of pearl and rose and olive; and it was +crowned above by opalescent clouds. The suffusion of vague hues +deceived the eye; the shadows of clouds were confounded with the +articulations of the mountains; and the isle and its unsubstantial +canopy rose and shimmered before us like a single mass. There was +no beacon, no smoke of towns to be expected, no plying pilot. +Somewhere, in that pale phantasmagoria of cliff and cloud, our +haven lay concealed; and somewhere to the east of it--the only sea- +mark given--a certain headland, known indifferently as Cape Adam +and Eve, or Cape Jack and Jane, and distinguished by two colossal +figures, the gross statuary of nature. These we were to find; for +these we craned and stared, focused glasses, and wrangled over +charts; and the sun was overhead and the land close ahead before we +found them. To a ship approaching, like the Casco, from the north, +they proved indeed the least conspicuous features of a striking +coast; the surf flying high above its base; strange, austere, and +feathered mountains rising behind; and Jack and Jane, or Adam and +Eve, impending like a pair of warts above the breakers. + +Thence we bore away along shore. On our port beam we might hear +the explosions of the surf; a few birds flew fishing under the +prow; there was no other sound or mark of life, whether of man or +beast, in all that quarter of the island. Winged by her own +impetus and the dying breeze, the Casco skimmed under cliffs, +opened out a cove, showed us a beach and some green trees, and +flitted by again, bowing to the swell. The trees, from our +distance, might have been hazel; the beach might have been in +Europe; the mountain forms behind modelled in little from the Alps, +and the forest which clustered on their ramparts a growth no more +considerable than our Scottish heath. Again the cliff yawned, but +now with a deeper entry; and the Casco, hauling her wind, began to +slide into the bay of Anaho. The cocoa-palm, that giraffe of +vegetables, so graceful, so ungainly, to the European eye so +foreign, was to be seen crowding on the beach, and climbing and +fringing the steep sides of mountains. Rude and bare hills +embraced the inlet upon either hand; it was enclosed to the +landward by a bulk of shattered mountains. In every crevice of +that barrier the forest harboured, roosting and nestling there like +birds about a ruin; and far above, it greened and roughened the +razor edges of the summit. + +Under the eastern shore, our schooner, now bereft of any breeze, +continued to creep in: the smart creature, when once under way, +appearing motive in herself. From close aboard arose the bleating +of young lambs; a bird sang in the hillside; the scent of the land +and of a hundred fruits or flowers flowed forth to meet us; and, +presently, a house or two appeared, standing high upon the ankles +of the hills, and one of these surrounded with what seemed a +garden. These conspicuous habitations, that patch of culture, had +we but known it, were a mark of the passage of whites; and we might +have approached a hundred islands and not found their parallel. It +was longer ere we spied the native village, standing (in the +universal fashion) close upon a curve of beach, close under a grove +of palms; the sea in front growling and whitening on a concave arc +of reef. For the cocoa-tree and the island man are both lovers and +neighbours of the surf. 'The coral waxes, the palm grows, but man +departs,' says the sad Tahitian proverb; but they are all three, so +long as they endure, co-haunters of the beach. The mark of +anchorage was a blow-hole in the rocks, near the south-easterly +corner of the bay. Punctually to our use, the blow-hole spouted; +the schooner turned upon her heel; the anchor plunged. It was a +small sound, a great event; my soul went down with these moorings +whence no windlass may extract nor any diver fish it up; and I, and +some part of my ship's company, were from that hour the bondslaves +of the isles of Vivien. + +Before yet the anchor plunged a canoe was already paddling from the +hamlet. It contained two men: one white, one brown and tattooed +across the face with bands of blue, both in immaculate white +European clothes: the resident trader, Mr. Regler, and the native +chief, Taipi-Kikino. 'Captain, is it permitted to come on board?' +were the first words we heard among the islands. Canoe followed +canoe till the ship swarmed with stalwart, six-foot men in every +stage of undress; some in a shirt, some in a loin-cloth, one in a +handkerchief imperfectly adjusted; some, and these the more +considerable, tattooed from head to foot in awful patterns; some +barbarous and knived; one, who sticks in my memory as something +bestial, squatting on his hams in a canoe, sucking an orange and +spitting it out again to alternate sides with ape-like vivacity-- +all talking, and we could not understand one word; all trying to +trade with us who had no thought of trading, or offering us island +curios at prices palpably absurd. There was no word of welcome; no +show of civility; no hand extended save that of the chief and Mr. +Regler. As we still continued to refuse the proffered articles, +complaint ran high and rude; and one, the jester of the party, +railed upon our meanness amid jeering laughter. Amongst other +angry pleasantries--'Here is a mighty fine ship,' said he, 'to have +no money on board!' I own I was inspired with sensible repugnance; +even with alarm. The ship was manifestly in their power; we had +women on board; I knew nothing of my guests beyond the fact that +they were cannibals; the Directory (my only guide) was full of +timid cautions; and as for the trader, whose presence might else +have reassured me, were not whites in the Pacific the usual +instigators and accomplices of native outrage? When he reads this +confession, our kind friend, Mr. Regler, can afford to smile. + +Later in the day, as I sat writing up my journal, the cabin was +filled from end to end with Marquesans: three brown-skinned +generations, squatted cross-legged upon the floor, and regarding me +in silence with embarrassing eyes. The eyes of all Polynesians are +large, luminous, and melting; they are like the eyes of animals and +some Italians. A kind of despair came over me, to sit there +helpless under all these staring orbs, and be thus blocked in a +corner of my cabin by this speechless crowd: and a kind of rage to +think they were beyond the reach of articulate communication, like +furred animals, or folk born deaf, or the dwellers of some alien +planet. + +To cross the Channel is, for a boy of twelve, to change heavens; to +cross the Atlantic, for a man of twenty-four, is hardly to modify +his diet. But I was now escaped out of the shadow of the Roman +empire, under whose toppling monuments we were all cradled, whose +laws and letters are on every hand of us, constraining and +preventing. I was now to see what men might be whose fathers had +never studied Virgil, had never been conquered by Caesar, and never +been ruled by the wisdom of Gaius or Papinian. By the same step I +had journeyed forth out of that comfortable zone of kindred +languages, where the curse of Babel is so easy to be remedied; and +my new fellow-creatures sat before me dumb like images. Methought, +in my travels, all human relation was to be excluded; and when I +returned home (for in those days I still projected my return) I +should have but dipped into a picture-book without a text. Nay, +and I even questioned if my travels should be much prolonged; +perhaps they were destined to a speedy end; perhaps my subsequent +friend, Kauanui, whom I remarked there, sitting silent with the +rest, for a man of some authority, might leap from his hams with an +ear-splitting signal, the ship be carried at a rush, and the ship's +company butchered for the table. + +There could be nothing more natural than these apprehensions, nor +anything more groundless. In my experience of the islands, I had +never again so menacing a reception; were I to meet with such to- +day, I should be more alarmed and tenfold more surprised. The +majority of Polynesians are easy folk to get in touch with, frank, +fond of notice, greedy of the least affection, like amiable, +fawning dogs; and even with the Marquesans, so recently and so +imperfectly redeemed from a blood-boltered barbarism, all were to +become our intimates, and one, at least, was to mourn sincerely our +departure. + + + +CHAPTER II--MAKING FRIENDS + + + +The impediment of tongues was one that I particularly over- +estimated. The languages of Polynesia are easy to smatter, though +hard to speak with elegance. And they are extremely similar, so +that a person who has a tincture of one or two may risk, not +without hope, an attempt upon the others. + +And again, not only is Polynesian easy to smatter, but interpreters +abound. Missionaries, traders, and broken white folk living on the +bounty of the natives, are to be found in almost every isle and +hamlet; and even where these are unserviceable, the natives +themselves have often scraped up a little English, and in the +French zone (though far less commonly) a little French-English, or +an efficient pidgin, what is called to the westward 'Beach-la-Mar,' +comes easy to the Polynesian; it is now taught, besides, in the +schools of Hawaii; and from the multiplicity of British ships, and +the nearness of the States on the one hand and the colonies on the +other, it may be called, and will almost certainly become, the +tongue of the Pacific. I will instance a few examples. I met in +Majuro a Marshall Island boy who spoke excellent English; this he +had learned in the German firm in Jaluit, yet did not speak one +word of German. I heard from a gendarme who had taught school in +Rapa-iti that while the children had the utmost difficulty or +reluctance to learn French, they picked up English on the wayside, +and as if by accident. On one of the most out-of-the-way atolls in +the Carolines, my friend Mr. Benjamin Hird was amazed to find the +lads playing cricket on the beach and talking English; and it was +in English that the crew of the Janet Nicoll, a set of black boys +from different Melanesian islands, communicated with other natives +throughout the cruise, transmitted orders, and sometimes jested +together on the fore-hatch. But what struck me perhaps most of all +was a word I heard on the verandah of the Tribunal at Noumea. A +case had just been heard--a trial for infanticide against an ape- +like native woman; and the audience were smoking cigarettes as they +awaited the verdict. An anxious, amiable French lady, not far from +tears, was eager for acquittal, and declared she would engage the +prisoner to be her children's nurse. The bystanders exclaimed at +the proposal; the woman was a savage, said they, and spoke no +language. 'Mais, vous savez,' objected the fair sentimentalist; +'ils apprennent si vite l'anglais!' + +But to be able to speak to people is not all. And in the first +stage of my relations with natives I was helped by two things. To +begin with, I was the show-man of the Casco. She, her fine lines, +tall spars, and snowy decks, the crimson fittings of the saloon, +and the white, the gilt, and the repeating mirrors of the tiny +cabin, brought us a hundred visitors. The men fathomed out her +dimensions with their arms, as their fathers fathomed out the ships +of Cook; the women declared the cabins more lovely than a church; +bouncing Junos were never weary of sitting in the chairs and +contemplating in the glass their own bland images; and I have seen +one lady strip up her dress, and, with cries of wonder and delight, +rub herself bare-breeched upon the velvet cushions. Biscuit, jam, +and syrup was the entertainment; and, as in European parlours, the +photograph album went the round. This sober gallery, their +everyday costumes and physiognomies, had become transformed, in +three weeks' sailing, into things wonderful and rich and foreign; +alien faces, barbaric dresses, they were now beheld and fingered, +in the swerving cabin, with innocent excitement and surprise. Her +Majesty was often recognised, and I have seen French subjects kiss +her photograph; Captain Speedy--in an Abyssinian war-dress, +supposed to be the uniform of the British army--met with much +acceptance; and the effigies of Mr. Andrew Lang were admired in the +Marquesas. There is the place for him to go when he shall be weary +of Middlesex and Homer. + +It was perhaps yet more important that I had enjoyed in my youth +some knowledge of our Scots folk of the Highlands and the Islands. +Not much beyond a century has passed since these were in the same +convulsive and transitionary state as the Marquesans of to-day. In +both cases an alien authority enforced, the clans disarmed, the +chiefs deposed, new customs introduced, and chiefly that fashion of +regarding money as the means and object of existence. The +commercial age, in each, succeeding at a bound to an age of war +abroad and patriarchal communism at home. In one the cherished +practice of tattooing, in the other a cherished costume, +proscribed. In each a main luxury cut off: beef, driven under +cloud of night from Lowland pastures, denied to the meat-loving +Highlander; long-pig, pirated from the next village, to the man- +eating Kanaka. The grumbling, the secret ferment, the fears and +resentments, the alarms and sudden councils of Marquesan chiefs, +reminded me continually of the days of Lovat and Struan. +Hospitality, tact, natural fine manners, and a touchy punctilio, +are common to both races: common to both tongues the trick of +dropping medial consonants. Here is a table of two widespread +Polynesian words:- + + + House. Love. + +Tahitian FARE AROHA + +New Zealand WHARE + +Samoan FALE TALOFA + +Manihiki FALE ALOHA + +Hawaiian HALE ALOHA + +Marquesan HA'E KAOHA + + +The elision of medial consonants, so marked in these Marquesan +instances, is no less common both in Gaelic and the Lowland Scots. +Stranger still, that prevalent Polynesian sound, the so-called +catch, written with an apostrophe, and often or always the +gravestone of a perished consonant, is to be heard in Scotland to +this day. When a Scot pronounces water, better, or bottle--wa'er, +be'er, or bo'le--the sound is precisely that of the catch; and I +think we may go beyond, and say, that if such a population could be +isolated, and this mispronunciation should become the rule, it +might prove the first stage of transition from t to k, which is the +disease of Polynesian languages. The tendency of the Marquesans, +however, is to urge against consonants, or at least on the very +common letter l, a war of mere extermination. A hiatus is +agreeable to any Polynesian ear; the ear even of the stranger soon +grows used to these barbaric voids; but only in the Marquesan will +you find such names as Haaii and Paaaeua, when each individual +vowel must be separately uttered. + +These points of similarity between a South Sea people and some of +my own folk at home ran much in my head in the islands; and not +only inclined me to view my fresh acquaintances with favour, but +continually modified my judgment. A polite Englishman comes to-day +to the Marquesans and is amazed to find the men tattooed; polite +Italians came not long ago to England and found our fathers stained +with woad; and when I paid the return visit as a little boy, I was +highly diverted with the backwardness of Italy: so insecure, so +much a matter of the day and hour, is the pre-eminence of race. It +was so that I hit upon a means of communication which I recommend +to travellers. When I desired any detail of savage custom, or of +superstitious belief, I cast back in the story of my fathers, and +fished for what I wanted with some trait of equal barbarism: +Michael Scott, Lord Derwentwater's head, the second-sight, the +Water Kelpie,--each of these I have found to be a killing bait; the +black bull's head of Stirling procured me the legend of Rahero; and +what I knew of the Cluny Macphersons, or the Appin Stewarts, +enabled me to learn, and helped me to understand, about the Tevas +of Tahiti. The native was no longer ashamed, his sense of kinship +grew warmer, and his lips were opened. It is this sense of kinship +that the traveller must rouse and share; or he had better content +himself with travels from the blue bed to the brown. And the +presence of one Cockney titterer will cause a whole party to walk +in clouds of darkness. + +The hamlet of Anaho stands on a margin of flat land between the +west of the beach and the spring of the impending mountains. A +grove of palms, perpetually ruffling its green fans, carpets it (as +for a triumph) with fallen branches, and shades it like an arbour. +A road runs from end to end of the covert among beds of flowers, +the milliner's shop of the community; and here and there, in the +grateful twilight, in an air filled with a diversity of scents, and +still within hearing of the surf upon the reef, the native houses +stand in scattered neighbourhood. The same word, as we have seen, +represents in many tongues of Polynesia, with scarce a shade of +difference, the abode of man. But although the word be the same, +the structure itself continually varies; and the Marquesan, among +the most backward and barbarous of islanders, is yet the most +commodiously lodged. The grass huts of Hawaii, the birdcage houses +of Tahiti, or the open shed, with the crazy Venetian blinds, of the +polite Samoan--none of these can be compared with the Marquesan +paepae-hae, or dwelling platform. The paepae is an oblong terrace +built without cement or black volcanic stone, from twenty to fifty +feet in length, raised from four to eight feet from the earth, and +accessible by a broad stair. Along the back of this, and coming to +about half its width, runs the open front of the house, like a +covered gallery: the interior sometimes neat and almost elegant in +its bareness, the sleeping space divided off by an endlong coaming, +some bright raiment perhaps hanging from a nail, and a lamp and one +of White's sewing-machines the only marks of civilization. On the +outside, at one end of the terrace, burns the cooking-fire under a +shed; at the other there is perhaps a pen for pigs; the remainder +is the evening lounge and al fresco banquet-hall of the +inhabitants. To some houses water is brought down the mountains in +bamboo pipes, perforated for the sake of sweetness. With the +Highland comparison in my mind, I was struck to remember the +sluttish mounds of turf and stone in which I have sat and been +entertained in the Hebrides and the North Islands. Two things, I +suppose, explain the contrast. In Scotland wood is rare, and with +materials so rude as turf and stone the very hope of neatness is +excluded. And in Scotland it is cold. Shelter and a hearth are +needs so pressing that a man looks not beyond; he is out all day +after a bare bellyful, and at night when he saith, 'Aha, it is +warm!' he has not appetite for more. Or if for something else, +then something higher; a fine school of poetry and song arose in +these rough shelters, and an air like 'Lochaber no more' is an +evidence of refinement more convincing, as well as more +imperishable, than a palace. + +To one such dwelling platform a considerable troop of relatives and +dependants resort. In the hour of the dusk, when the fire blazes, +and the scent of the cooked breadfruit fills the air, and perhaps +the lamp glints already between the pillars and the house, you +shall behold them silently assemble to this meal, men, women, and +children; and the dogs and pigs frisk together up the terrace +stairway, switching rival tails. The strangers from the ship were +soon equally welcome: welcome to dip their fingers in the wooden +dish, to drink cocoanuts, to share the circulating pipe, and to +hear and hold high debate about the misdeeds of the French, the +Panama Canal, or the geographical position of San Francisco and New +Yo'ko. In a Highland hamlet, quite out of reach of any tourist, I +have met the same plain and dignified hospitality. + +I have mentioned two facts--the distasteful behaviour of our +earliest visitors, and the case of the lady who rubbed herself upon +the cushions--which would give a very false opinion of Marquesan +manners. The great majority of Polynesians are excellently +mannered; but the Marquesan stands apart, annoying and attractive, +wild, shy, and refined. If you make him a present he affects to +forget it, and it must be offered him again at his going: a pretty +formality I have found nowhere else. A hint will get rid of any +one or any number; they are so fiercely proud and modest; while +many of the more lovable but blunter islanders crowd upon a +stranger, and can be no more driven off than flies. A slight or an +insult the Marquesan seems never to forget. I was one day talking +by the wayside with my friend Hoka, when I perceived his eyes +suddenly to flash and his stature to swell. A white horseman was +coming down the mountain, and as he passed, and while he paused to +exchange salutations with myself, Hoka was still staring and +ruffling like a gamecock. It was a Corsican who had years before +called him cochon sauvage--cocon chauvage, as Hoka mispronounced +it. With people so nice and so touchy, it was scarce to be +supposed that our company of greenhorns should not blunder into +offences. Hoka, on one of his visits, fell suddenly in a brooding +silence, and presently after left the ship with cold formality. +When he took me back into favour, he adroitly and pointedly +explained the nature of my offence: I had asked him to sell cocoa- +nuts; and in Hoka's view articles of food were things that a +gentleman should give, not sell; or at least that he should not +sell to any friend. On another occasion I gave my boat's crew a +luncheon of chocolate and biscuits. I had sinned, I could never +learn how, against some point of observance; and though I was drily +thanked, my offerings were left upon the beach. But our worst +mistake was a slight we put on Toma, Hoka's adoptive father, and in +his own eyes the rightful chief of Anaho. In the first place, we +did not call upon him, as perhaps we should, in his fine new +European house, the only one in the hamlet. In the second, when we +came ashore upon a visit to his rival, Taipi-Kikino, it was Toma +whom we saw standing at the head of the beach, a magnificent figure +of a man, magnificently tattooed; and it was of Toma that we asked +our question: 'Where is the chief?' 'What chief?' cried Toma, and +turned his back on the blasphemers. Nor did he forgive us. Hoka +came and went with us daily; but, alone I believe of all the +countryside, neither Toma nor his wife set foot on board the Casco. +The temptation resisted it is hard for a European to compute. The +flying city of Laputa moored for a fortnight in St. James's Park +affords but a pale figure of the Casco anchored before Anaho; for +the Londoner has still his change of pleasures, but the Marquesan +passes to his grave through an unbroken uniformity of days. + +On the afternoon before it was intended we should sail, a +valedictory party came on board: nine of our particular friends +equipped with gifts and dressed as for a festival. Hoka, the chief +dancer and singer, the greatest dandy of Anaho, and one of the +handsomest young fellows in the world-sullen, showy, dramatic, +light as a feather and strong as an ox--it would have been hard, on +that occasion, to recognise, as he sat there stooped and silent, +his face heavy and grey. It was strange to see the lad so much +affected; stranger still to recognise in his last gift one of the +curios we had refused on the first day, and to know our friend, so +gaily dressed, so plainly moved at our departure, for one of the +half-naked crew that had besieged and insulted us on our arrival: +strangest of all, perhaps, to find, in that carved handle of a fan, +the last of those curiosities of the first day which had now all +been given to us by their possessors--their chief merchandise, for +which they had sought to ransom us as long as we were strangers, +which they pressed on us for nothing as soon as we were friends. +The last visit was not long protracted. One after another they +shook hands and got down into their canoe; when Hoka turned his +back immediately upon the ship, so that we saw his face no more. +Taipi, on the other hand, remained standing and facing us with +gracious valedictory gestures; and when Captain Otis dipped the +ensign, the whole party saluted with their hats. This was the +farewell; the episode of our visit to Anaho was held concluded; and +though the Casco remained nearly forty hours at her moorings, not +one returned on board, and I am inclined to think they avoided +appearing on the beach. This reserve and dignity is the finest +trait of the Marquesan. + + + +CHAPTER III--THE MAROON + + + +Of the beauties of Anaho books might be written. I remember waking +about three, to find the air temperate and scented. The long swell +brimmed into the bay, and seemed to fill it full and then subside. +Gently, deeply, and silently the Casco rolled; only at times a +block piped like a bird. Oceanward, the heaven was bright with +stars and the sea with their reflections. If I looked to that +side, I might have sung with the Hawaiian poet: + + +Ua maomao ka lani, ua kahaea luna, +Ua pipi ka maka o ka hoku. +(The heavens were fair, they stretched above, +Many were the eyes of the stars.) + + +And then I turned shoreward, and high squalls were overhead; the +mountains loomed up black; and I could have fancied I had slipped +ten thousand miles away and was anchored in a Highland loch; that +when the day came, it would show pine, and heather, and green fern, +and roofs of turf sending up the smoke of peats; and the alien +speech that should next greet my ears must be Gaelic, not Kanaka. + +And day, when it came, brought other sights and thoughts. I have +watched the morning break in many quarters of the world; it has +been certainly one of the chief joys of my existence, and the dawn +that I saw with most emotion shone upon the bay of Anaho. The +mountains abruptly overhang the port with every variety of surface +and of inclination, lawn, and cliff, and forest. Not one of these +but wore its proper tint of saffron, of sulphur, of the clove, and +of the rose. The lustre was like that of satin; on the lighter +hues there seemed to float an efflorescence; a solemn bloom +appeared on the more dark. The light itself was the ordinary light +of morning, colourless and clean; and on this ground of jewels, +pencilled out the least detail of drawing. Meanwhile, around the +hamlet, under the palms, where the blue shadow lingered, the red +coals of cocoa husk and the light trails of smoke betrayed the +awakening business of the day; along the beach men and women, lads +and lasses, were returning from the bath in bright raiment, red and +blue and green, such as we delighted to see in the coloured little +pictures of our childhood; and presently the sun had cleared the +eastern hill, and the glow of the day was over all. + +The glow continued and increased, the business, from the main part, +ceased before it had begun. Twice in the day there was a certain +stir of shepherding along the seaward hills. At times a canoe went +out to fish. At times a woman or two languidly filled a basket in +the cotton patch. At times a pipe would sound out of the shadow of +a house, ringing the changes on its three notes, with an effect +like Que le jour me dure, repeated endlessly. Or at times, across +a corner of the bay, two natives might communicate in the Marquesan +manner with conventional whistlings. All else was sleep and +silence. The surf broke and shone around the shores; a species of +black crane fished in the broken water; the black pigs were +continually galloping by on some affair; but the people might never +have awaked, or they might all be dead. + +My favourite haunt was opposite the hamlet, where was a landing in +a cove under a lianaed cliff. The beach was lined with palms and a +tree called the purao, something between the fig and mulberry in +growth, and bearing a flower like a great yellow poppy with a +maroon heart. In places rocks encroached upon the sand; the beach +would be all submerged; and the surf would bubble warmly as high as +to my knees, and play with cocoa-nut husks as our more homely ocean +plays with wreck and wrack and bottles. As the reflux drew down, +marvels of colour and design streamed between my feet; which I +would grasp at, miss, or seize: now to find them what they +promised, shells to grace a cabinet or be set in gold upon a lady's +finger; now to catch only maya of coloured sand, pounded fragments +and pebbles, that, as soon as they were dry, became as dull and +homely as the flints upon a garden path. I have toiled at this +childish pleasure for hours in the strong sun, conscious of my +incurable ignorance; but too keenly pleased to be ashamed. +Meanwhile, the blackbird (or his tropical understudy) would be +fluting in the thickets overhead. + +A little further, in the turn of the bay, a streamlet trickled in +the bottom of a den, thence spilling down a stair of rock into the +sea. The draught of air drew down under the foliage in the very +bottom of the den, which was a perfect arbour for coolness. In +front it stood open on the blue bay and the Casco lying there under +her awning and her cheerful colours. Overhead was a thatch of +puraos, and over these again palms brandished their bright fans, as +I have seen a conjurer make himself a halo out of naked swords. +For in this spot, over a neck of low land at the foot of the +mountains, the trade-wind streams into Anaho Bay in a flood of +almost constant volume and velocity, and of a heavenly coolness. + +It chanced one day that I was ashore in the cove, with Mrs. +Stevenson and the ship's cook. Except for the Casco lying outside, +and a crane or two, and the ever-busy wind and sea, the face of the +world was of a prehistoric emptiness; life appeared to stand stock- +still, and the sense of isolation was profound and refreshing. On +a sudden, the trade-wind, coming in a gust over the isthmus, struck +and scattered the fans of the palms above the den; and, behold! in +two of the tops there sat a native, motionless as an idol and +watching us, you would have said, without a wink. The next moment +the tree closed, and the glimpse was gone. This discovery of human +presences latent overhead in a place where we had supposed +ourselves alone, the immobility of our tree-top spies, and the +thought that perhaps at all hours we were similarly supervised, +struck us with a chill. Talk languished on the beach. As for the +cook (whose conscience was not clear), he never afterwards set foot +on shore, and twice, when the Casco appeared to be driving on the +rocks, it was amusing to observe that man's alacrity; death, he was +persuaded, awaiting him upon the beach. It was more than a year +later, in the Gilberts, that the explanation dawned upon myself. +The natives were drawing palm-tree wine, a thing forbidden by law; +and when the wind thus suddenly revealed them, they were doubtless +more troubled than ourselves. + +At the top of the den there dwelt an old, melancholy, grizzled man +of the name of Tari (Charlie) Coffin. He was a native of Oahu, in +the Sandwich Islands; and had gone to sea in his youth in the +American whalers; a circumstance to which he owed his name, his +English, his down-east twang, and the misfortune of his innocent +life. For one captain, sailing out of New Bedford, carried him to +Nuka-hiva and marooned him there among the cannibals. The motive +for this act was inconceivably small; poor Tari's wages, which were +thus economised, would scarce have shook the credit of the New +Bedford owners. And the act itself was simply murder. Tari's life +must have hung in the beginning by a hair. In the grief and terror +of that time, it is not unlikely he went mad, an infirmity to which +he was still liable; or perhaps a child may have taken a fancy to +him and ordained him to be spared. He escaped at least alive, +married in the island, and when I knew him was a widower with a +married son and a granddaughter. But the thought of Oahu haunted +him; its praise was for ever on his lips; he beheld it, looking +back, as a place of ceaseless feasting, song, and dance; and in his +dreams I daresay he revisits it with joy. I wonder what he would +think if he could be carried there indeed, and see the modern town +of Honolulu brisk with traffic, and the palace with its guards, and +the great hotel, and Mr. Berger's band with their uniforms and +outlandish instruments; or what he would think to see the brown +faces grown so few and the white so many; and his father's land +sold, for planting sugar, and his father's house quite perished, or +perhaps the last of them struck leprous and immured between the +surf and the cliffs on Molokai? So simply, even in South Sea +Islands, and so sadly, the changes come. + +Tari was poor, and poorly lodged. His house was a wooden frame, +run up by Europeans; it was indeed his official residence, for Tari +was the shepherd of the promontory sheep. I can give a perfect +inventory of its contents: three kegs, a tin biscuit-box, an iron +saucepan, several cocoa-shell cups, a lantern, and three bottles, +probably containing oil; while the clothes of the family and a few +mats were thrown across the open rafters. Upon my first meeting +with this exile he had conceived for me one of the baseless island +friendships, had given me nuts to drink, and carried me up the den +'to see my house'--the only entertainment that he had to offer. He +liked the 'Amelican,' he said, and the 'Inglisman,' but the +'Flessman' was his abhorrence; and he was careful to explain that +if he had thought us 'Fless,' we should have had none of his nuts, +and never a sight of his house. His distaste for the French I can +partly understand, but not at all his toleration of the Anglo- +Saxon. The next day he brought me a pig, and some days later one +of our party going ashore found him in act to bring a second. We +were still strange to the islands; we were pained by the poor man's +generosity, which he could ill afford, and, by a natural enough but +quite unpardonable blunder, we refused the pig. Had Tari been a +Marquesan we should have seen him no more; being what he was, the +most mild, long-suffering, melancholy man, he took a revenge a +hundred times more painful. Scarce had the canoe with the nine +villagers put off from their farewell before the Casco was boarded +from the other side. It was Tari; coming thus late because he had +no canoe of his own, and had found it hard to borrow one; coming +thus solitary (as indeed we always saw him), because he was a +stranger in the land, and the dreariest of company. The rest of my +family basely fled from the encounter. I must receive our injured +friend alone; and the interview must have lasted hard upon an hour, +for he was loath to tear himself away. 'You go 'way. I see you no +more--no, sir!' he lamented; and then looking about him with rueful +admiration, 'This goodee ship--no, sir!--goodee ship!' he would +exclaim: the 'no, sir,' thrown out sharply through the nose upon a +rising inflection, an echo from New Bedford and the fallacious +whaler. From these expressions of grief and praise, he would +return continually to the case of the rejected pig. 'I like give +present all 'e same you,' he complained; 'only got pig: you no +take him!' He was a poor man; he had no choice of gifts; he had +only a pig, he repeated; and I had refused it. I have rarely been +more wretched than to see him sitting there, so old, so grey, so +poor, so hardly fortuned, of so rueful a countenance, and to +appreciate, with growing keenness, the affront which I had so +innocently dealt him; but it was one of those cases in which speech +is vain. + +Tari's son was smiling and inert; his daughter-in-law, a girl of +sixteen, pretty, gentle, and grave, more intelligent than most +Anaho women, and with a fair share of French; his grandchild, a +mite of a creature at the breast. I went up the den one day when +Tari was from home, and found the son making a cotton sack, and +madame suckling mademoiselle. When I had sat down with them on the +floor, the girl began to question me about England; which I tried +to describe, piling the pan and the cocoa shells one upon another +to represent the houses, and explaining, as best I was able, and by +word and gesture, the over-population, the hunger, and the +perpetual toil. 'Pas de cocotiers? pas do popoi?' she asked. I +told her it was too cold, and went through an elaborate +performance, shutting out draughts, and crouching over an imaginary +fire, to make sure she understood. But she understood right well; +remarked it must be bad for the health, and sat a while gravely +reflecting on that picture of unwonted sorrows. I am sure it +roused her pity, for it struck in her another thought always +uppermost in the Marquesan bosom; and she began with a smiling +sadness, and looking on me out of melancholy eyes, to lament the +decease of her own people. 'Ici pas de Kanaques,' said she; and +taking the baby from her breast, she held it out to me with both +her hands. 'Tenez--a little baby like this; then dead. All the +Kanaques die. Then no more.' The smile, and this instancing by +the girl-mother of her own tiny flesh and blood, affected me +strangely; they spoke of so tranquil a despair. Meanwhile the +husband smilingly made his sack; and the unconscious babe struggled +to reach a pot of raspberry jam, friendship's offering, which I had +just brought up the den; and in a perspective of centuries I saw +their case as ours, death coming in like a tide, and the day +already numbered when there should be no more Beretani, and no more +of any race whatever, and (what oddly touched me) no more literary +works and no more readers. + + + +CHAPTER IV--DEATH + + + +The thought of death, I have said, is uppermost in the mind of the +Marquesan. It would be strange if it were otherwise. The race is +perhaps the handsomest extant. Six feet is about the middle height +of males; they are strongly muscled, free from fat, swift in +action, graceful in repose; and the women, though fatter and +duller, are still comely animals. To judge by the eye, there is no +race more viable; and yet death reaps them with both hands. When +Bishop Dordillon first came to Tai-o-hae, he reckoned the +inhabitants at many thousands; he was but newly dead, and in the +same bay Stanislao Moanatini counted on his fingers eight residual +natives. Or take the valley of Hapaa, known to readers of Herman +Melville under the grotesque misspelling of Hapar. There are but +two writers who have touched the South Seas with any genius, both +Americans: Melville and Charles Warren Stoddard; and at the +christening of the first and greatest, some influential fairy must +have been neglected: 'He shall be able to see,' 'He shall be able +to tell,' 'He shall be able to charm,' said the friendly +godmothers; 'But he shall not be able to hear,' exclaimed the last. +The tribe of Hapaa is said to have numbered some four hundred, when +the small-pox came and reduced them by one-fourth. Six months +later a woman developed tubercular consumption; the disease spread +like a fire about the valley, and in less than a year two +survivors, a man and a woman, fled from that new-created solitude. +A similar Adam and Eve may some day wither among new races, the +tragic residue of Britain. When I first heard this story the date +staggered me; but I am now inclined to think it possible. Early in +the year of my visit, for example, or late the year before, a first +case of phthisis appeared in a household of seventeen persons, and +by the month of August, when the tale was told me, one soul +survived, and that was a boy who had been absent at his schooling. +And depopulation works both ways, the doors of death being set wide +open, and the door of birth almost closed. Thus, in the half-year +ending July 1888 there were twelve deaths and but one birth in the +district of the Hatiheu. Seven or eight more deaths were to be +looked for in the ordinary course; and M. Aussel, the observant +gendarme, knew of but one likely birth. At this rate it is no +matter of surprise if the population in that part should have +declined in forty years from six thousand to less than four +hundred; which are, once more on the authority of M. Aussel, the +estimated figures. And the rate of decline must have even +accelerated towards the end. + +A good way to appreciate the depopulation is to go by land from +Anaho to Hatiheu on the adjacent bay. The road is good travelling, +but cruelly steep. We seemed scarce to have passed the deserted +house which stands highest in Anaho before we were looking dizzily +down upon its roof; the Casco well out in the bay, and rolling for +a wager, shrank visibly; and presently through the gap of Tari's +isthmus, Ua-huna was seen to hang cloudlike on the horizon. Over +the summit, where the wind blew really chill, and whistled in the +reed-like grass, and tossed the grassy fell of the pandanus, we +stepped suddenly, as through a door, into the next vale and bay of +Hatiheu. A bowl of mountains encloses it upon three sides. On the +fourth this rampart has been bombarded into ruins, runs down to +seaward in imminent and shattered crags, and presents the one +practicable breach of the blue bay. The interior of this vessel is +crowded with lovely and valuable trees,--orange, breadfruit, mummy- +apple, cocoa, the island chestnut, and for weeds, the pine and the +banana. Four perennial streams water and keep it green; and along +the dell, first of one, then of another, of these, the road, for a +considerable distance, descends into this fortunate valley. The +song of the waters and the familiar disarray of boulders gave us a +strong sense of home, which the exotic foliage, the daft-like +growth of the pandanus, the buttressed trunk of the banyan, the +black pigs galloping in the bush, and the architecture of the +native houses dissipated ere it could be enjoyed. + +The houses on the Hatiheu side begin high up; higher yet, the more +melancholy spectacle of empty paepaes. When a native habitation is +deserted, the superstructure--pandanus thatch, wattle, unstable +tropical timber--speedily rots, and is speedily scattered by the +wind. Only the stones of the terrace endure; nor can any ruin, +cairn, or standing stone, or vitrified fort present a more stern +appearance of antiquity. We must have passed from six to eight of +these now houseless platforms. On the main road of the island, +where it crosses the valley of Taipi, Mr. Osbourne tells me they +are to be reckoned by the dozen; and as the roads have been made +long posterior to their erection, perhaps to their desertion, and +must simply be regarded as lines drawn at random through the bush, +the forest on either hand must be equally filled with these +survivals: the gravestones of whole families. Such ruins are tapu +in the strictest sense; no native must approach them; they have +become outposts of the kingdom of the grave. It might appear a +natural and pious custom in the hundreds who are left, the +rearguard of perished thousands, that their feet should leave +untrod these hearthstones of their fathers. I believe, in fact, +the custom rests on different and more grim conceptions. But the +house, the grave, and even the body of the dead, have been always +particularly honoured by Marquesans. Until recently the corpse was +sometimes kept in the family and daily oiled and sunned, until, by +gradual and revolting stages, it dried into a kind of mummy. +Offerings are still laid upon the grave. In Traitor's Bay, Mr. +Osbourne saw a man buy a looking-glass to lay upon his son's. And +the sentiment against the desecration of tombs, thoughtlessly +ruffled in the laying down of the new roads, is a chief ingredient +in the native hatred for the French. + +The Marquesan beholds with dismay the approaching extinction of his +race. The thought of death sits down with him to meat, and rises +with him from his bed; he lives and breathes under a shadow of +mortality awful to support; and he is so inured to the apprehension +that he greets the reality with relief. He does not even seek to +support a disappointment; at an affront, at a breach of one of his +fleeting and communistic love-affairs, he seeks an instant refuge +in the grave. Hanging is now the fashion. I heard of three who +had hanged themselves in the west end of Hiva-oa during the first +half of 1888; but though this be a common form of suicide in other +parts of the South Seas, I cannot think it will continue popular in +the Marquesas. Far more suitable to Marquesan sentiment is the old +form of poisoning with the fruit of the eva, which offers to the +native suicide a cruel but deliberate death, and gives time for +those decencies of the last hour, to which he attaches such +remarkable importance. The coffin can thus be at hand, the pigs +killed, the cry of the mourners sounding already through the house; +and then it is, and not before, that the Marquesan is conscious of +achievement, his life all rounded in, his robes (like Caesar's) +adjusted for the final act. Praise not any man till he is dead, +said the ancients; envy not any man till you hear the mourners, +might be the Marquesan parody. The coffin, though of late +introduction, strangely engages their attention. It is to the +mature Marquesan what a watch is to the European schoolboy. For +ten years Queen Vaekehu had dunned the fathers; at last, but the +other day, they let her have her will, gave her her coffin, and the +woman's soul is at rest. I was told a droll instance of the force +of this preoccupation. The Polynesians are subject to a disease +seemingly rather of the will than of the body. I was told the +Tahitians have a word for it, erimatua, but cannot find it in my +dictionary. A gendarme, M. Nouveau, has seen men beginning to +succumb to this insubstantial malady, has routed them from their +houses, turned them on to do their trick upon the roads, and in two +days has seen them cured. But this other remedy is more original: +a Marquesan, dying of this discouragement--perhaps I should rather +say this acquiescence--has been known, at the fulfilment of his +crowning wish, on the mere sight of that desired hermitage, his +coffin--to revive, recover, shake off the hand of death, and be +restored for years to his occupations--carving tikis (idols), let +us say, or braiding old men's beards. From all this it may be +conceived how easily they meet death when it approaches naturally. +I heard one example, grim and picturesque. In the time of the +small-pox in Hapaa, an old man was seized with the disease; he had +no thought of recovery; had his grave dug by a wayside, and lived +in it for near a fortnight, eating, drinking, and smoking with the +passers-by, talking mostly of his end, and equally unconcerned for +himself and careless of the friends whom he infected. + +This proneness to suicide, and loose seat in life, is not peculiar +to the Marquesan. What is peculiar is the widespread depression +and acceptance of the national end. Pleasures are neglected, the +dance languishes, the songs are forgotten. It is true that some, +and perhaps too many, of them are proscribed; but many remain, if +there were spirit to support or to revive them. At the last feast +of the Bastille, Stanislao Moanatini shed tears when he beheld the +inanimate performance of the dancers. When the people sang for us +in Anaho, they must apologise for the smallness of their repertory. +They were only young folk present, they said, and it was only the +old that knew the songs. The whole body of Marquesan poetry and +music was being suffered to die out with a single dispirited +generation. The full import is apparent only to one acquainted +with other Polynesian races; who knows how the Samoan coins a fresh +song for every trifling incident, or who has heard (on Penrhyn, for +instance) a band of little stripling maids from eight to twelve +keep up their minstrelsy for hours upon a stretch, one song +following another without pause. In like manner, the Marquesan, +never industrious, begins now to cease altogether from production. +The exports of the group decline out of all proportion even with +the death-rate of the islanders. 'The coral waxes, the palm grows, +and man departs,' says the Marquesan; and he folds his hands. And +surely this is nature. Fond as it may appear, we labour and +refrain, not for the rewards of any single life, but with a timid +eye upon the lives and memories of our successors; and where no one +is to succeed, of his own family, or his own tongue, I doubt +whether Rothschilds would make money or Cato practise virtue. It +is natural, also, that a temporary stimulus should sometimes rouse +the Marquesan from his lethargy. Over all the landward shore of +Anaho cotton runs like a wild weed; man or woman, whoever comes to +pick it, may earn a dollar in the day; yet when we arrived, the +trader's store-house was entirely empty; and before we left it was +near full. So long as the circus was there, so long as the Casco +was yet anchored in the bay, it behoved every one to make his +visit; and to this end every woman must have a new dress, and every +man a shirt and trousers. Never before, in Mr. Regler's +experience, had they displayed so much activity. + +In their despondency there is an element of dread. The fear of +ghosts and of the dark is very deeply written in the mind of the +Polynesian; not least of the Marquesan. Poor Taipi, the chief of +Anaho, was condemned to ride to Hatiheu on a moonless night. He +borrowed a lantern, sat a long while nerving himself for the +adventure, and when he at last departed, wrung the Cascos by the +hand as for a final separation. Certain presences, called +Vehinehae, frequent and make terrible the nocturnal roadside; I was +told by one they were like so much mist, and as the traveller +walked into them dispersed and dissipated; another described them +as being shaped like men and having eyes like cats; from none could +I obtain the smallest clearness as to what they did, or wherefore +they were dreaded. We may be sure at least they represent the +dead; for the dead, in the minds of the islanders, are all- +pervasive. 'When a native says that he is a man,' writes Dr. +Codrington, 'he means that he is a man and not a ghost; not that he +is a man and not a beast. The intelligent agents of this world are +to his mind the men who are alive, and the ghosts the men who are +dead.' Dr. Codrington speaks of Melanesia; from what I have +learned his words are equally true of the Polynesian. And yet +more. Among cannibal Polynesians a dreadful suspicion rests +generally on the dead; and the Marquesans, the greatest cannibals +of all, are scarce likely to be free from similar beliefs. I +hazard the guess that the Vehinehae are the hungry spirits of the +dead, continuing their life's business of the cannibal ambuscade, +and lying everywhere unseen, and eager to devour the living. +Another superstition I picked up through the troubled medium of +Tari Coffin's English. The dead, he told me, came and danced by +night around the paepae of their former family; the family were +thereupon overcome by some emotion (but whether of pious sorrow or +of fear I could not gather), and must 'make a feast,' of which +fish, pig, and popoi were indispensable ingredients. So far this +is clear enough. But here Tari went on to instance the new house +of Toma and the house-warming feast which was just then in +preparation as instances in point. Dare we indeed string them +together, and add the case of the deserted ruin, as though the dead +continually besieged the paepaes of the living: were kept at +arm's-length, even from the first foundation, only by propitiatory +feasts, and, so soon as the fire of life went out upon the hearth, +swarmed back into possession of their ancient seat? + +I speak by guess of these Marquesan superstitions. On the cannibal +ghost I shall return elsewhere with certainty. And it is enough, +for the present purpose, to remark that the men of the Marquesas, +from whatever reason, fear and shrink from the presence of ghosts. +Conceive how this must tell upon the nerves in islands where the +number of the dead already so far exceeds that of the living, and +the dead multiply and the living dwindle at so swift a rate. +Conceive how the remnant huddles about the embers of the fire of +life; even as old Red Indians, deserted on the march and in the +snow, the kindly tribe all gone, the last flame expiring, and the +night around populous with wolves. + + + +CHAPTER V--DEPOPULATION + + + +Over the whole extent of the South Seas, from one tropic to +another, we find traces of a bygone state of over-population, when +the resources of even a tropical soil were taxed, and even the +improvident Polynesian trembled for the future. We may accept some +of the ideas of Mr. Darwin's theory of coral islands, and suppose a +rise of the sea, or the subsidence of some former continental area, +to have driven into the tops of the mountains multitudes of +refugees. Or we may suppose, more soberly, a people of sea-rovers, +emigrants from a crowded country, to strike upon and settle island +after island, and as time went on to multiply exceedingly in their +new seats. In either case the end must be the same; soon or late +it must grow apparent that the crew are too numerous, and that +famine is at hand. The Polynesians met this emergent danger with +various expedients of activity and prevention. A way was found to +preserve breadfruit by packing it in artificial pits; pits forty +feet in depth and of proportionate bore are still to be seen, I am +told, in the Marquesas; and yet even these were insufficient for +the teeming people, and the annals of the past are gloomy with +famine and cannibalism. Among the Hawaiians--a hardier people, in +a more exacting climate--agriculture was carried far; the land was +irrigated with canals; and the fish-ponds of Molokai prove the +number and diligence of the old inhabitants. Meanwhile, over all +the island world, abortion and infanticide prevailed. On coral +atolls, where the danger was most plainly obvious, these were +enforced by law and sanctioned by punishment. On Vaitupu, in the +Ellices, only two children were allowed to a couple; on Nukufetau, +but one. On the latter the punishment was by fine; and it is +related that the fine was sometimes paid, and the child spared. + +This is characteristic. For no people in the world are so fond or +so long-suffering with children--children make the mirth and the +adornment of their homes, serving them for playthings and for +picture-galleries. 'Happy is the man that has his quiver full of +them.' The stray bastard is contended for by rival families; and +the natural and the adopted children play and grow up together +undistinguished. The spoiling, and I may almost say the +deification, of the child, is nowhere carried so far as in the +eastern islands; and furthest, according to my opportunities of +observation, in the Paumotu group, the so-called Low or Dangerous +Archipelago. I have seen a Paumotuan native turn from me with +embarrassment and disaffection because I suggested that a brat +would be the better for a beating. It is a daily matter in some +eastern islands to see a child strike or even stone its mother, and +the mother, so far from punishing, scarce ventures to resist. In +some, when his child was born, a chief was superseded and resigned +his name; as though, like a drone, he had then fulfilled the +occasion of his being. And in some the lightest words of children +had the weight of oracles. Only the other day, in the Marquesas, +if a child conceived a distaste to any stranger, I am assured the +stranger would be slain. And I shall have to tell in another place +an instance of the opposite: how a child in Manihiki having taken +a fancy to myself, her adoptive parents at once accepted the +situation and loaded me with gifts. + +With such sentiments the necessity for child-destruction would not +fail to clash, and I believe we find the trace of divided feeling +in the Tahitian brotherhood of Oro. At a certain date a new god +was added to the Society-Island Olympus, or an old one refurbished +and made popular. Oro was his name, and he may be compared with +the Bacchus of the ancients. His zealots sailed from bay to bay, +and from island to island; they were everywhere received with +feasting; wore fine clothes; sang, danced, acted; gave exhibitions +of dexterity and strength; and were the artists, the acrobats, the +bards, and the harlots of the group. Their life was public and +epicurean; their initiation a mystery; and the highest in the land +aspired to join the brotherhood. If a couple stood next in line to +a high-chieftaincy, they were suffered, on grounds of policy, to +spare one child; all other children, who had a father or a mother +in the company of Oro, stood condemned from the moment of +conception. A freemasonry, an agnostic sect, a company of artists, +its members all under oath to spread unchastity, and all forbidden +to leave offspring--I do not know how it may appear to others, but +to me the design seems obvious. Famine menacing the islands, and +the needful remedy repulsive, it was recommended to the native mind +by these trappings of mystery, pleasure, and parade. This is the +more probable, and the secret, serious purpose of the institution +appears the more plainly, if it be true that, after a certain +period of life, the obligation of the votary was changed; at first, +bound to be profligate: afterwards, expected to be chaste. + +Here, then, we have one side of the case. Man-eating among kindly +men, child-murder among child-lovers, industry in a race the most +idle, invention in a race the least progressive, this grim, pagan +salvation-army of the brotherhood of Oro, the report of early +voyagers, the widespread vestiges of former habitation, and the +universal tradition of the islands, all point to the same fact of +former crowding and alarm. And to-day we are face to face with the +reverse. To-day in the Marquesas, in the Eight Islands of Hawaii, +in Mangareva, in Easter Island, we find the same race perishing +like flies. Why this change? Or, grant that the coming of the +whites, the change of habits, and the introduction of new maladies +and vices, fully explain the depopulation, why is that depopulation +not universal? The population of Tahiti, after a period of +alarming decrease, has again become stationary. I hear of a +similar result among some Maori tribes; in many of the Paumotus a +slight increase is to be observed; and the Samoans are to-day as +healthy and at least as fruitful as before the change. Grant that +the Tahitians, the Maoris, and the Paumotuans have become inured to +the new conditions; and what are we to make of the Samoans, who +have never suffered? + +Those who are acquainted only with a single group are apt to be +ready with solutions. Thus I have heard the mortality of the +Maoris attributed to their change of residence--from fortified +hill-tops to the low, marshy vicinity of their plantations. How +plausible! And yet the Marquesans are dying out in the same houses +where their fathers multiplied. Or take opium. The Marquesas and +Hawaii are the two groups the most infected with this vice; the +population of the one is the most civilised, that of the other by +far the most barbarous, of Polynesians; and they are two of those +that perish the most rapidly. Here is a strong case against opium. +But let us take unchastity, and we shall find the Marquesas and +Hawaii figuring again upon another count. Thus, Samoans are the +most chaste of Polynesians, and they are to this day entirely +fertile; Marquesans are the most debauched: we have seen how they +are perishing; Hawaiians are notoriously lax, and they begin to be +dotted among deserts. So here is a case stronger still against +unchastity; and here also we have a correction to apply. Whatever +the virtues of the Tahitian, neither friend nor enemy dares call +him chaste; and yet he seems to have outlived the time of danger. +One last example: syphilis has been plausibly credited with much +of the sterility. But the Samoans are, by all accounts, as +fruitful as at first; by some accounts more so; and it is not +seriously to be argued that the Samoans have escaped syphilis. + +These examples show how dangerous it is to reason from any +particular cause, or even from many in a single group. I have in +my eye an able and amiable pamphlet by the Rev. S. E. Bishop: 'Why +are the Hawaiians Dying Out?' Any one interested in the subject +ought to read this tract, which contains real information; and yet +Mr. Bishop's views would have been changed by an acquaintance with +other groups. Samoa is, for the moment, the main and the most +instructive exception to the rule. The people are the most chaste +and one of the most temperate of island peoples. They have never +been tried and depressed with any grave pestilence. Their clothing +has scarce been tampered with; at the simple and becoming tabard of +the girls, Tartuffe, in many another island, would have cried out; +for the cool, healthy, and modest lava-lava or kilt, Tartuffe has +managed in many another island to substitute stifling and +inconvenient trousers. Lastly, and perhaps chiefly, so far from +their amusements having been curtailed, I think they have been, +upon the whole, extended. The Polynesian falls easily into +despondency: bereavement, disappointment, the fear of novel +visitations, the decay or proscription of ancient pleasures, easily +incline him to be sad; and sadness detaches him from life. The +melancholy of the Hawaiian and the emptiness of his new life are +striking; and the remark is yet more apposite to the Marquesas. In +Samoa, on the other hand, perpetual song and dance, perpetual +games, journeys, and pleasures, make an animated and a smiling +picture of the island life. And the Samoans are to-day the gayest +and the best entertained inhabitants of our planet. The importance +of this can scarcely be exaggerated. In a climate and upon a soil +where a livelihood can be had for the stooping, entertainment is a +prime necessity. It is otherwise with us, where life presents us +with a daily problem, and there is a serious interest, and some of +the heat of conflict, in the mere continuing to be. So, in certain +atolls, where there is no great gaiety, but man must bestir himself +with some vigour for his daily bread, public health and the +population are maintained; but in the lotos islands, with the decay +of pleasures, life itself decays. It is from this point of view +that we may instance, among other causes of depression, the decay +of war. We have been so long used in Europe to that dreary +business of war on the great scale, trailing epidemics and leaving +pestilential corpses in its train, that we have almost forgotten +its original, the most healthful, if not the most humane, of all +field sports--hedge-warfare. From this, as well as from the rest +of his amusements and interests, the islander, upon a hundred +islands, has been recently cut off. And to this, as well as to so +many others, the Samoan still makes good a special title. + +Upon the whole, the problem seems to me to stand thus:- Where there +have been fewest changes, important or unimportant, salutary or +hurtful, there the race survives. Where there have been most, +important or unimportant, salutary or hurtful, there it perishes. +Each change, however small, augments the sum of new conditions to +which the race has to become inured. There may seem, a priori, no +comparison between the change from 'sour toddy' to bad gin, and +that from the island kilt to a pair of European trousers. Yet I am +far from persuaded that the one is any more hurtful than the other; +and the unaccustomed race will sometimes die of pin-pricks. We are +here face to face with one of the difficulties of the missionary. +In Polynesian islands he easily obtains pre-eminent authority; the +king becomes his mairedupalais; he can proscribe, he can command; +and the temptation is ever towards too much. Thus (by all +accounts) the Catholics in Mangareva, and thus (to my own +knowledge) the Protestants in Hawaii, have rendered life in a more +or less degree unliveable to their converts. And the mild, +uncomplaining creatures (like children in a prison) yawn and await +death. It is easy to blame the missionary. But it is his business +to make changes. It is surely his business, for example, to +prevent war; and yet I have instanced war itself as one of the +elements of health. On the other hand, it were, perhaps, easy for +the missionary to proceed more gently, and to regard every change +as an affair of weight. I take the average missionary; I am sure I +do him no more than justice when I suppose that he would hesitate +to bombard a village, even in order to convert an archipelago. +Experience begins to show us (at least in Polynesian islands) that +change of habit is bloodier than a bombardment. + +There is one point, ere I have done, where I may go to meet +criticism. I have said nothing of faulty hygiene, bathing during +fevers, mistaken treatment of children, native doctoring, or +abortion--all causes frequently adduced. And I have said nothing +of them because they are conditions common to both epochs, and even +more efficient in the past than in the present. Was it not the +same with unchastity, it may be asked? Was not the Polynesian +always unchaste? Doubtless he was so always: doubtless he is more +so since the coming of his remarkably chaste visitors from Europe. +Take the Hawaiian account of Cook: I have no doubt it is entirely +fair. Take Krusenstern's candid, almost innocent, description of a +Russian man-of-war at the Marquesas; consider the disgraceful +history of missions in Hawaii itself, where (in the war of lust) +the American missionaries were once shelled by an English +adventurer, and once raided and mishandled by the crew of an +American warship; add the practice of whaling fleets to call at the +Marquesas, and carry off a complement of women for the cruise; +consider, besides, how the whites were at first regarded in the +light of demi-gods, as appears plainly in the reception of Cook +upon Hawaii; and again, in the story of the discovery of Tutuila, +when the really decent women of Samoa prostituted themselves in +public to the French; and bear in mind how it was the custom of the +adventurers, and we may almost say the business of the +missionaries, to deride and infract even the most salutary tapus. +Here we see every engine of dissolution directed at once against a +virtue never and nowhere very strong or popular; and the result, +even in the most degraded islands, has been further degradation. +Mr. Lawes, the missionary of Savage Island, told me the standard of +female chastity had declined there since the coming of the whites. +In heathen time, if a girl gave birth to a bastard, her father or +brother would dash the infant down the cliffs; and to-day the +scandal would be small. Or take the Marquesas. Stanislao +Moanatini told me that in his own recollection, the young were +strictly guarded; they were not suffered so much as to look upon +one another in the street, but passed (so my informant put it) like +dogs; and the other day the whole school-children of Nuka-hiva and +Ua-pu escaped in a body to the woods, and lived there for a +fortnight in promiscuous liberty. Readers of travels may perhaps +exclaim at my authority, and declare themselves better informed. I +should prefer the statement of an intelligent native like Stanislao +(even if it stood alone, which it is far from doing) to the report +of the most honest traveller. A ship of war comes to a haven, +anchors, lands a party, receives and returns a visit, and the +captain writes a chapter on the manners of the island. It is not +considered what class is mostly seen. Yet we should not be pleased +if a Lascar foremast hand were to judge England by the ladies who +parade Ratcliffe Highway, and the gentlemen who share with them +their hire. Stanislao's opinion of a decay of virtue even in these +unvirtuous islands has been supported to me by others; his very +example, the progress of dissolution amongst the young, is adduced +by Mr. Bishop in Hawaii. And so far as Marquesans are concerned, +we might have hazarded a guess of some decline in manners. I do +not think that any race could ever have prospered or multiplied +with such as now obtain; I am sure they would have been never at +the pains to count paternal kinship. It is not possible to give +details; suffice it that their manners appear to be imitated from +the dreams of ignorant and vicious children, and their debauches +persevered in until energy, reason, and almost life itself are in +abeyance. + + + +CHAPTER VI--CHIEFS AND TAPUS + + + +We used to admire exceedingly the bland and gallant manners of the +chief called Taipi-Kikino. An elegant guest at table, skilled in +the use of knife and fork, a brave figure when he shouldered a gun +and started for the woods after wild chickens, always serviceable, +always ingratiating and gay, I would sometimes wonder where he +found his cheerfulness. He had enough to sober him, I thought, in +his official budget. His expenses--for he was always seen attired +in virgin white--must have by far exceeded his income of six +dollars in the year, or say two shillings a month. And he was +himself a man of no substance; his house the poorest in the +village. It was currently supposed that his elder brother, +Kauanui, must have helped him out. But how comes it that the elder +brother should succeed to the family estate, and be a wealthy +commoner, and the younger be a poor man, and yet rule as chief in +Anaho? That the one should be wealthy, and the other almost +indigent is probably to be explained by some adoption; for +comparatively few children are brought up in the house or succeed +to the estates of their natural begetters. That the one should be +chief instead of the other must be explained (in a very Irish +fashion) on the ground that neither of them is a chief at all. + +Since the return and the wars of the French, many chiefs have been +deposed, and many so-called chiefs appointed. We have seen, in the +same house, one such upstart drinking in the company of two such +extruded island Bourbons, men, whose word a few years ago was life +and death, now sunk to be peasants like their neighbours. So when +the French overthrew hereditary tyrants, dubbed the commons of the +Marquesas freeborn citizens of the republic, and endowed them with +a vote for a conseiller-general at Tahiti, they probably conceived +themselves upon the path to popularity; and so far from that, they +were revolting public sentiment. The deposition of the chiefs was +perhaps sometimes needful; the appointment of others may have been +needful also; it was at least a delicate business. The Government +of George II. exiled many Highland magnates. It never occurred to +them to manufacture substitutes; and if the French have been more +bold, we have yet to see with what success. + +Our chief at Anaho was always called, he always called himself, +Taipi-Kikino; and yet that was not his name, but only the wand of +his false position. As soon as he was appointed chief, his name-- +which signified, if I remember exactly, PRINCE BORN AMONG FLOWERS-- +fell in abeyance, and he was dubbed instead by the expressive +byword, Taipi-Kikino--HIGHWATER MAN-OF-NO-ACCOUNT--or, Englishing +more boldly, BEGGAR ON HORSEBACK--a witty and a wicked cut. A +nickname in Polynesia destroys almost the memory of the original +name. To-day, if we were Polynesians, Gladstone would be no more +heard of. We should speak of and address our Nestor as the Grand +Old Man, and it is so that himself would sign his correspondence. +Not the prevalence, then, but the significancy of the nickname is +to be noted here. The new authority began with small prestige. +Taipi has now been some time in office; from all I saw he seemed a +person very fit. He is not the least unpopular, and yet his power +is nothing. He is a chief to the French, and goes to breakfast +with the Resident; but for any practical end of chieftaincy a rag +doll were equally efficient. + +We had been but three days in Anaho when we received the visit of +the chief of Hatiheu, a man of weight and fame, late leader of a +war upon the French, late prisoner in Tahiti, and the last eater of +long-pig in Nuka-hiva. Not many years have elapsed since he was +seen striding on the beach of Anaho, a dead man's arm across his +shoulder. 'So does Kooamua to his enemies!' he roared to the +passers-by, and took a bite from the raw flesh. And now behold +this gentleman, very wisely replaced in office by the French, +paying us a morning visit in European clothes. He was the man of +the most character we had yet seen: his manners genial and +decisive, his person tall, his face rugged, astute, formidable, and +with a certain similarity to Mr. Gladstone's--only for the +brownness of the skin, and the high-chief's tattooing, all one side +and much of the other being of an even blue. Further acquaintance +increased our opinion of his sense. He viewed the Casco in a +manner then quite new to us, examining her lines and the running of +the gear; to a piece of knitting on which one of the party was +engaged, he must have devoted ten minutes' patient study; nor did +he desist before he had divined the principles; and he was +interested even to excitement by a type-writer, which he learned to +work. When he departed he carried away with him a list of his +family, with his own name printed by his own hand at the bottom. I +should add that he was plainly much of a humorist, and not a little +of a humbug. He told us, for instance, that he was a person of +exact sobriety; such being the obligation of his high estate: the +commons might be sots, but the chief could not stoop so low. And +not many days after he was to be observed in a state of smiling and +lop-sided imbecility, the Casco ribbon upside down on his +dishonoured hat. + +But his business that morning in Anaho is what concerns us here. +The devil-fish, it seems, were growing scarce upon the reef; it was +judged fit to interpose what we should call a close season; for +that end, in Polynesia, a tapu (vulgarly spelt 'taboo') has to be +declared, and who was to declare it? Taipi might; he ought; it was +a chief part of his duty; but would any one regard the inhibition +of a Beggar on Horse-back? He might plant palm branches: it did +not in the least follow that the spot was sacred. He might recite +the spell: it was shrewdly supposed the spirits would not hearken. +And so the old, legitimate cannibal must ride over the mountains to +do it for him; and the respectable official in white clothes could +but look on and envy. At about the same time, though in a +different manner, Kooamua established a forest law. It was +observed the cocoa-palms were suffering, for the plucking of green +nuts impoverishes and at last endangers the tree. Now Kooamua +could tapu the reef, which was public property, but he could not +tapu other people's palms; and the expedient adopted was +interesting. He tapu'd his own trees, and his example was imitated +over all Hatiheu and Anaho. I fear Taipi might have tapu'd all +that he possessed and found none to follow him. So much for the +esteem in which the dignity of an appointed chief is held by +others; a single circumstance will show what he thinks of it +himself. I never met one, but he took an early opportunity to +explain his situation. True, he was only an appointed chief when I +beheld him; but somewhere else, perhaps upon some other isle, he +was a chieftain by descent: upon which ground, he asked me (so to +say it) to excuse his mushroom honours. + +It will be observed with surprise that both these tapus are for +thoroughly sensible ends. With surprise, I say, because the nature +of that institution is much misunderstood in Europe. It is taken +usually in the sense of a meaningless or wanton prohibition, such +as that which to-day prevents women in some countries from smoking, +or yesterday prevented any one in Scotland from taking a walk on +Sunday. The error is no less natural than it is unjust. The +Polynesians have not been trained in the bracing, practical thought +of ancient Rome; with them the idea of law has not been disengaged +from that of morals or propriety; so that tapu has to cover the +whole field, and implies indifferently that an act is criminal, +immoral, against sound public policy, unbecoming or (as we say) +'not in good form.' Many tapus were in consequence absurd enough, +such as those which deleted words out of the language, and +particularly those which related to women. Tapu encircled women +upon all hands. Many things were forbidden to men; to women we may +say that few were permitted. They must not sit on the paepae; they +must not go up to it by the stair; they must not eat pork; they +must not approach a boat; they must not cook at a fire which any +male had kindled. The other day, after the roads were made, it was +observed the women plunged along margin through the bush, and when +they came to a bridge waded through the water: roads and bridges +were the work of men's hands, and tapu for the foot of women. Even +a man's saddle, if the man be native, is a thing no self-respecting +lady dares to use. Thus on the Anaho side of the island, only two +white men, Mr. Regler and the gendarme, M. Aussel, possess saddles; +and when a woman has a journey to make she must borrow from one or +other. It will be noticed that these prohibitions tend, most of +them, to an increased reserve between the sexes. Regard for female +chastity is the usual excuse for these disabilities that men +delight to lay upon their wives and mothers. Here the regard is +absent; and behold the women still bound hand and foot with +meaningless proprieties! The women themselves, who are survivors +of the old regimen, admit that in those days life was not worth +living. And yet even then there were exceptions. There were +female chiefs and (I am assured) priestesses besides; nice customs +curtseyed to great dames, and in the most sacred enclosure of a +High Place, Father Simeon Delmar was shown a stone, and told it was +the throne of some well-descended lady. How exactly parallel is +this with European practice, when princesses were suffered to +penetrate the strictest cloister, and women could rule over a land +in which they were denied the control of their own children. + +But the tapu is more often the instrument of wise and needful +restrictions. We have seen it as the organ of paternal government. +It serves besides to enforce, in the rare case of some one wishing +to enforce them, rights of private property. Thus a man, weary of +the coming and going of Marquesan visitors, tapus his door; and to +this day you may see the palm-branch signal, even as our great- +grandfathers saw the peeled wand before a Highland inn. Or take +another case. Anaho is known as 'the country without popoi.' The +word popoi serves in different islands to indicate the main food of +the people: thus, in Hawaii, it implies a preparation of taro; in +the Marquesas, of breadfruit. And a Marquesan does not readily +conceive life possible without his favourite diet. A few years ago +a drought killed the breadfruit trees and the bananas in the +district of Anaho; and from this calamity, and the open-handed +customs of the island, a singular state of things arose. Well- +watered Hatiheu had escaped the drought; every householder of Anaho +accordingly crossed the pass, chose some one in Hatiheu, 'gave him +his name'--an onerous gift, but one not to be rejected--and from +this improvised relative proceeded to draw his supplies, for all +the world as though he had paid for them. Hence a continued +traffic on the road. Some stalwart fellow, in a loin-cloth, and +glistening with sweat, may be seen at all hours of the day, a stick +across his bare shoulders, tripping nervously under a double +burthen of green fruits. And on the far side of the gap a dozen +stone posts on the wayside in the shadow of a grove mark the +breathing-space of the popoi-carriers. A little back from the +beach, and not half a mile from Anaho, I was the more amazed to +find a cluster of well-doing breadfruits heavy with their harvest. +'Why do you not take these?' I asked. 'Tapu,' said Hoka; and I +thought to myself (after the manner of dull travellers) what +children and fools these people were to toil over the mountain and +despoil innocent neighbours when the staff of life was thus growing +at their door. I was the more in error. In the general +destruction these surviving trees were enough only for the family +of the proprietor, and by the simple expedient of declaring a tapu +he enforced his right. + +The sanction of the tapu is superstitious; and the punishment of +infraction either a wasting or a deadly sickness. A slow disease +follows on the eating of tapu fish, and can only be cured with the +bones of the same fish burned with the due mysteries. The cocoa- +nut and breadfruit tapu works more swiftly. Suppose you have eaten +tapu fruit at the evening meal, at night your sleep will be uneasy; +in the morning, swelling and a dark discoloration will have +attacked your neck, whence they spread upward to the face; and in +two days, unless the cure be interjected, you must die. This cure +is prepared from the rubbed leaves of the tree from which the +patient stole; so that he cannot be saved without confessing to the +Tahuku the person whom he wronged. In the experience of my +informant, almost no tapu had been put in use, except the two +described: he had thus no opportunity to learn the nature and +operation of the others; and, as the art of making them was +jealously guarded amongst the old men, he believed the mystery +would soon die out. I should add that he was no Marquesan, but a +Chinaman, a resident in the group from boyhood, and a reverent +believer in the spells which he described. White men, amongst whom +Ah Fu included himself, were exempt; but he had a tale of a +Tahitian woman, who had come to the Marquesas, eaten tapu fish, +and, although uninformed of her offence and danger, had been +afflicted and cured exactly like a native. + +Doubtless the belief is strong; doubtless, with this weakly and +fanciful race, it is in many cases strong enough to kill; it should +be strong indeed in those who tapu their trees secretly, so that +they may detect a depredator by his sickness. Or, perhaps, we +should understand the idea of the hidden tapu otherwise, as a +politic device to spread uneasiness and extort confessions: so +that, when a man is ailing, he shall ransack his brain for any +possible offence, and send at once for any proprietor whose rights +he has invaded. 'Had you hidden a tapu?' we may conceive him +asking; and I cannot imagine the proprietor gainsaying it; and this +is perhaps the strangest feature of the system--that it should be +regarded from without with such a mental and implicit awe, and, +when examined from within, should present so many apparent +evidences of design. + +We read in Dr. Campbell's Poenamo of a New Zealand girl, who was +foolishly told that she had eaten a tapu yam, and who instantly +sickened, and died in the two days of simple terror. The period is +the same as in the Marquesas; doubtless the symptoms were so too. +How singular to consider that a superstition of such sway is +possibly a manufactured article; and that, even if it were not +originally invented, its details have plainly been arranged by the +authorities of some Polynesian Scotland Yard. Fitly enough, the +belief is to-day--and was probably always--far from universal. +Hell at home is a strong deterrent with some; a passing thought +with others; with others, again, a theme of public mockery, not +always well assured; and so in the Marquesas with the tapu. Mr. +Regler has seen the two extremes of scepticism and implicit fear. +In the tapu grove he found one fellow stealing breadfruit, cheerful +and impudent as a street arab; and it was only on a menace of +exposure that he showed himself the least discountenanced. The +other case was opposed in every point. Mr. Regler asked a native +to accompany him upon a voyage; the man went gladly enough, but +suddenly perceiving a dead tapu fish in the bottom of the boat, +leaped back with a scream; nor could the promise of a dollar +prevail upon him to advance. + +The Marquesan, it will be observed, adheres to the old idea of the +local circumscription of beliefs and duties. Not only are the +whites exempt from consequences; but their transgressions seem to +be viewed without horror. It was Mr. Regler who had killed the +fish; yet the devout native was not shocked at Mr. Regler--only +refused to join him in his boat. A white is a white: the servant +(so to speak) of other and more liberal gods; and not to be blamed +if he profit by his liberty. The Jews were perhaps the first to +interrupt this ancient comity of faiths; and the Jewish virus is +still strong in Christianity. All the world must respect our +tapus, or we gnash our teeth. + + + +CHAPTER VII--HATIHEU + + + +The bays of Anaho and Hatiheu are divided at their roots by the +knife-edge of a single hill--the pass so often mentioned; but this +isthmus expands to the seaward in a considerable peninsula: very +bare and grassy; haunted by sheep and, at night and morning, by the +piercing cries of the shepherds; wandered over by a few wild goats; +and on its sea-front indented with long, clamorous caves, and faced +with cliffs of the colour and ruinous outline of an old peat-stack. +In one of these echoing and sunless gullies we saw, clustered like +sea-birds on a splashing ledge, shrill as sea-birds in their +salutation to the passing boat, a group of fisherwomen, stripped to +their gaudy under-clothes. (The clash of the surf and the thin +female voices echo in my memory.) We had that day a native crew +and steersman, Kauanui; it was our first experience of Polynesian +seamanship, which consists in hugging every point of land. There +is no thought in this of saving time, for they will pull a long way +in to skirt a point that is embayed. It seems that, as they can +never get their houses near enough the surf upon the one side, so +they can never get their boats near enough upon the other. The +practice in bold water is not so dangerous as it looks--the reflex +from the rocks sending the boat off. Near beaches with a heavy run +of sea, I continue to think it very hazardous, and find the +composure of the natives annoying to behold. We took unmingled +pleasure, on the way out, to see so near at hand the beach and the +wonderful colours of the surf. On the way back, when the sea had +risen and was running strong against us, the fineness of the +steersman's aim grew more embarrassing. As we came abreast of the +sea-front, where the surf broke highest, Kauanui embraced the +occasion to light his pipe, which then made the circuit of the +boat--each man taking a whiff or two, and, ere he passed it on, +filling his lungs and cheeks with smoke. Their faces were all +puffed out like apples as we came abreast of the cliff foot, and +the bursting surge fell back into the boat in showers. At the next +point 'cocanetti' was the word, and the stroke borrowed my knife, +and desisted from his labours to open nuts. These untimely +indulgences may be compared to the tot of grog served out before a +ship goes into action. + +My purpose in this visit led me first to the boys' school, for +Hatiheu is the university of the north islands. The hum of the +lesson came out to meet us. Close by the door, where the draught +blew coolest, sat the lay brother; around him, in a packed half- +circle, some sixty high-coloured faces set with staring eyes; and +in the background of the barn-like room benches were to be seen, +and blackboards with sums on them in chalk. The brother rose to +greet us, sensibly humble. Thirty years he had been there, he +said, and fingered his white locks as a bashful child pulls out his +pinafore. 'Et point de resultats, monsieur, presque pas de +resultats.' He pointed to the scholars: 'You see, sir, all the +youth of Nuka-hiva and Ua-pu. Between the ages of six and fifteen +this is all that remains; and it is but a few years since we had a +hundred and twenty from Nuka-hiva alone. Oui, monsieur, cela se +deperit.' Prayers, and reading and writing, prayers again and +arithmetic, and more prayers to conclude: such appeared to be the +dreary nature of the course. For arithmetic all island people have +a natural taste. In Hawaii they make good progress in mathematics. +In one of the villages on Majuro, and generally in the Marshall +group, the whole population sit about the trader when he is +weighing copra, and each on his own slate takes down the figures +and computes the total. The trader, finding them so apt, +introduced fractions, for which they had been taught no rule. At +first they were quite gravelled but ultimately, by sheer hard +thinking, reasoned out the result, and came one after another to +assure the trader he was right. Not many people in Europe could +have done the like. The course at Hatiheu is therefore less +dispiriting to Polynesians than a stranger might have guessed; and +yet how bald it is at best! I asked the brother if he did not tell +them stories, and he stared at me; if he did not teach them +history, and he said, 'O yes, they had a little Scripture history-- +from the New Testament'; and repeated his lamentations over the +lack of results. I had not the heart to put more questions; I +could but say it must be very discouraging, and resist the impulse +to add that it seemed also very natural. He looked up--'My days +are far spent,' he said; 'heaven awaits me.' May that heaven +forgive me, but I was angry with the old man and his simple +consolation. For think of his opportunity! The youth, from six to +fifteen, are taken from their homes by Government, centralised at +Hatiheu, where they are supported by a weekly tax of food; and, +with the exception of one month in every year, surrendered wholly +to the direction of the priests. Since the escapade already +mentioned the holiday occurs at a different period for the girls +and for the boys; so that a Marquesan brother and sister meet +again, after their education is complete, a pair of strangers. It +is a harsh law, and highly unpopular; but what a power it places in +the hands of the instructors, and how languidly and dully is that +power employed by the mission! Too much concern to make the +natives pious, a design in which they all confess defeat, is, I +suppose, the explanation of their miserable system. But they might +see in the girls' school at Tai-o-hae, under the brisk, housewifely +sisters, a different picture of efficiency, and a scene of +neatness, airiness, and spirited and mirthful occupation that +should shame them into cheerier methods. The sisters themselves +lament their failure. They complain the annual holiday undoes the +whole year's work; they complain particularly of the heartless +indifference of the girls. Out of so many pretty and apparently +affectionate pupils whom they have taught and reared, only two have +ever returned to pay a visit of remembrance to their teachers. +These, indeed, come regularly, but the rest, so soon as their +school-days are over, disappear into the woods like captive +insects. It is hard to imagine anything more discouraging; and yet +I do not believe these ladies need despair. For a certain interval +they keep the girls alive and innocently busy; and if it be at all +possible to save the race, this would be the means. No such praise +can be given to the boys' school at Hatiheu. The day is numbered +already for them all; alike for the teacher and the scholars death +is girt; he is afoot upon the march; and in the frequent interval +they sit and yawn. But in life there seems a thread of purpose +through the least significant; the drowsiest endeavour is not lost, +and even the school at Hatiheu may be more useful than it seems. + +Hatiheu is a place of some pretensions. The end of the bay towards +Anaho may be called the civil compound, for it boasts the house of +Kooamua, and close on the beach, under a great tree, that of the +gendarme, M. Armand Aussel, with his garden, his pictures, his +books, and his excellent table, to which strangers are made +welcome. No more singular contrast is possible than between the +gendarmerie and the priesthood, who are besides in smouldering +opposition and full of mutual complaints. A priest's kitchen in +the eastern islands is a depressing spot to see; and many, or most +of them, make no attempt to keep a garden, sparsely subsisting on +their rations. But you will never dine with a gendarme without +smacking your lips; and M. Aussel's home-made sausage and the salad +from his garden are unforgotten delicacies. Pierre Loti may like +to know that he is M. Aussel's favourite author, and that his books +are read in the fit scenery of Hatiheu bay. + +The other end is all religious. It is here that an overhanging and +tip-tilted horn, a good sea-mark for Hatiheu, bursts naked from the +verdure of the climbing forest, and breaks down shoreward in steep +taluses and cliffs. From the edge of one of the highest, perhaps +seven hundred or a thousand feet above the beach, a Virgin looks +insignificantly down, like a poor lost doll, forgotten there by a +giant child. This laborious symbol of the Catholics is always +strange to Protestants; we conceive with wonder that men should +think it worth while to toil so many days, and clamber so much +about the face of precipices, for an end that makes us smile; and +yet I believe it was the wise Bishop Dordillon who chose the place, +and I know that those who had a hand in the enterprise look back +with pride upon its vanquished dangers. The boys' school is a +recent importation; it was at first in Tai-o-hae, beside the +girls'; and it was only of late, after their joint escapade, that +the width of the island was interposed between the sexes. But +Hatiheu must have been a place of missionary importance from +before. About midway of the beach no less than three churches +stand grouped in a patch of bananas, intermingled with some pine- +apples. Two are of wood: the original church, now in disuse; and +a second that, for some mysterious reason, has never been used. +The new church is of stone, with twin towers, walls flangeing into +buttresses, and sculptured front. The design itself is good, +simple, and shapely; but the character is all in the detail, where +the architect has bloomed into the sculptor. It is impossible to +tell in words of the angels (although they are more like winged +archbishops) that stand guard upon the door, of the cherubs in the +corners, of the scapegoat gargoyles, or the quaint and spirited +relief, where St. Michael (the artist's patron) makes short work of +a protesting Lucifer. We were never weary of viewing the imagery, +so innocent, sometimes so funny, and yet in the best sense--in the +sense of inventive gusto and expression--so artistic. I know not +whether it was more strange to find a building of such merit in a +corner of a barbarous isle, or to see a building so antique still +bright with novelty. The architect, a French lay brother, still +alive and well, and meditating fresh foundations, must have surely +drawn his descent from a master-builder in the age of the +cathedrals; and it was in looking on the church of Hatiheu that I +seemed to perceive the secret charm of mediaeval sculpture; that +combination of the childish courage of the amateur, attempting all +things, like the schoolboy on his slate, with the manly +perseverance of the artist who does not know when he is conquered. + +I had always afterwards a strong wish to meet the architect, +Brother Michel; and one day, when I was talking with the Resident +in Tai-o-hae (the chief port of the island), there were shown in to +us an old, worn, purblind, ascetic-looking priest, and a lay +brother, a type of all that is most sound in France, with a broad, +clever, honest, humorous countenance, an eye very large and bright, +and a strong and healthy body inclining to obesity. But that his +blouse was black and his face shaven clean, you might pick such a +man to-day, toiling cheerfully in his own patch of vines, from half +a dozen provinces of France; and yet he had always for me a +haunting resemblance to an old kind friend of my boyhood, whom I +name in case any of my readers should share with me that memory-- +Dr. Paul, of the West Kirk. Almost at the first word I was sure it +was my architect, and in a moment we were deep in a discussion of +Hatiheu church. Brother Michel spoke always of his labours with a +twinkle of humour, underlying which it was possible to spy a +serious pride, and the change from one to another was often very +human and diverting. 'Et vos gargouilles moyen-age,' cried I; +'comme elles sont originates!' 'N'est-ce pas? Elles sont bien +droles!' he said, smiling broadly; and the next moment, with a +sudden gravity: 'Cependant il y en a une qui a une patte de casse; +il faut que je voie cela.' I asked if he had any model--a point we +much discussed. 'Non,' said he simply; 'c'est une eglise ideale.' +The relievo was his favourite performance, and very justly so. The +angels at the door, he owned, he would like to destroy and replace. +'Ils n'ont pas de vie, ils manquent de vie. Vous devriez voir mon +eglise a la Dominique; j'ai la une Vierge qui est vraiment +gentille.' 'Ah,' I cried, 'they told me you had said you would +never build another church, and I wrote in my journal I could not +believe it.' 'Oui, j'aimerais bien en fairs une autre,' he +confessed, and smiled at the confession. An artist will understand +how much I was attracted by this conversation. There is no bond so +near as a community in that unaffected interest and slightly shame- +faced pride which mark the intelligent man enamoured of an art. He +sees the limitations of his aim, the defects of his practice; he +smiles to be so employed upon the shores of death, yet sees in his +own devotion something worthy. Artists, if they had the same sense +of humour with the Augurs, would smile like them on meeting, but +the smile would not be scornful. + +I had occasion to see much of this excellent man. He sailed with +us from Tai-o-hae to Hiva-oa, a dead beat of ninety miles against a +heavy sea. It was what is called a good passage, and a feather in +the Casco's cap; but among the most miserable forty hours that any +one of us had ever passed. We were swung and tossed together all +that time like shot in a stage thunder-box. The mate was thrown +down and had his head cut open; the captain was sick on deck; the +cook sick in the galley. Of all our party only two sat down to +dinner. I was one. I own that I felt wretchedly; and I can only +say of the other, who professed to feel quite well, that she fled +at an early moment from the table. It was in these circumstances +that we skirted the windward shore of that indescribable island of +Ua-pu; viewing with dizzy eyes the coves, the capes, the breakers, +the climbing forests, and the inaccessible stone needles that +surmount the mountains. The place persists, in a dark corner of +our memories, like a piece of the scenery of nightmares. The end +of this distressful passage, where we were to land our passengers, +was in a similar vein of roughness. The surf ran high on the beach +at Taahauku; the boat broached-to and capsized; and all hands were +submerged. Only the brother himself, who was well used to the +experience, skipped ashore, by some miracle of agility, with scarce +a sprinkling. Thenceforward, during our stay at Hiva-oa, he was +our cicerone and patron; introducing us, taking us excursions, +serving us in every way, and making himself daily more beloved. + +Michel Blanc had been a carpenter by trade; had made money and +retired, supposing his active days quite over; and it was only when +he found idleness dangerous that he placed his capital and +acquirements at the service of the mission. He became their +carpenter, mason, architect, and engineer; added sculpture to his +accomplishments, and was famous for his skill in gardening. He +wore an enviable air of having found a port from life's contentions +and lying there strongly anchored; went about his business with a +jolly simplicity; complained of no lack of results--perhaps shyly +thinking his own statuary result enough; and was altogether a +pattern of the missionary layman. + + + +CHAPTER VIII--THE PORT OF ENTRY + + + +The port--the mart, the civil and religious capital of these rude +islands--is called Tai-o-hae, and lies strung along the beach of a +precipitous green bay in Nuka-hiva. It was midwinter when we came +thither, and the weather was sultry, boisterous, and inconstant. +Now the wind blew squally from the land down gaps of splintered +precipice; now, between the sentinel islets of the entry, it came +in gusts from seaward. Heavy and dark clouds impended on the +summits; the rain roared and ceased; the scuppers of the mountain +gushed; and the next day we would see the sides of the amphitheatre +bearded with white falls. Along the beach the town shows a thin +file of houses, mostly white, and all ensconced in the foliage of +an avenue of green puraos; a pier gives access from the sea across +the belt of breakers; to the eastward there stands, on a projecting +bushy hill, the old fort which is now the calaboose, or prison; +eastward still, alone in a garden, the Residency flies the colours +of France. Just off Calaboose Hill, the tiny Government schooner +rides almost permanently at anchor, marks eight bells in the +morning (there or thereabout) with the unfurling of her flag, and +salutes the setting sun with the report of a musket. + +Here dwell together, and share the comforts of a club (which may be +enumerated as a billiard-board, absinthe, a map of the world on +Mercator's projection, and one of the most agreeable verandahs in +the tropics), a handful of whites of varying nationality, mostly +French officials, German and Scottish merchant clerks, and the +agents of the opium monopoly. There are besides three tavern- +keepers, the shrewd Scot who runs the cotton gin-mill, two white +ladies, and a sprinkling of people 'on the beach'--a South Sea +expression for which there is no exact equivalent. It is a +pleasant society, and a hospitable. But one man, who was often to +be seen seated on the logs at the pier-head, merits a word for the +singularity of his history and appearance. Long ago, it seems, he +fell in love with a native lady, a High Chiefess in Ua-pu. She, on +being approached, declared she could never marry a man who was +untattooed; it looked so naked; whereupon, with some greatness of +soul, our hero put himself in the hands of the Tahukus, and, with +still greater, persevered until the process was complete. He had +certainly to bear a great expense, for the Tahuku will not work +without reward; and certainly exquisite pain. Kooamua, high chief +as he was, and one of the old school, was only part tattooed; he +could not, he told us with lively pantomime, endure the torture to +an end. Our enamoured countryman was more resolved; he was +tattooed from head to foot in the most approved methods of the art; +and at last presented himself before his mistress a new man. The +fickle fair one could never behold him from that day except with +laughter. For my part, I could never see the man without a kind of +admiration; of him it might be said, if ever of any, that he had +loved not wisely, but too well. + +The Residency stands by itself, Calaboose Hill screening it from +the fringe of town along the further bay. The house is commodious, +with wide verandahs; all day it stands open, back and front, and +the trade blows copiously over its bare floors. On a week-day the +garden offers a scene of most untropical animation, half a dozen +convicts toiling there cheerfully with spade and barrow, and +touching hats and smiling to the visitor like old attached family +servants. On Sunday these are gone, and nothing to be seen but +dogs of all ranks and sizes peacefully slumbering in the shady +grounds; for the dogs of Tai-o-hae are very courtly-minded, and +make the seat of Government their promenade and place of siesta. +In front and beyond, a strip of green down loses itself in a low +wood of many species of acacia; and deep in the wood a ruinous wall +encloses the cemetery of the Europeans. English and Scottish sleep +there, and Scandinavians, and French maitres de manoeuvres and +maitres ouvriers: mingling alien dust. Back in the woods, +perhaps, the blackbird, or (as they call him there) the island +nightingale, will be singing home strains; and the ceaseless +requiem of the surf hangs on the ear. I have never seen a resting- +place more quiet; but it was a long thought how far these sleepers +had all travelled, and from what diverse homes they had set forth, +to lie here in the end together. + +On the summit of its promontory hill, the calaboose stands all day +with doors and window-shutters open to the trade. On my first +visit a dog was the only guardian visible. He, indeed, rose with +an attitude so menacing that I was glad to lay hands on an old +barrel-hoop; and I think the weapon must have been familiar, for +the champion instantly retreated, and as I wandered round the court +and through the building, I could see him, with a couple of +companions, humbly dodging me about the corners. The prisoners' +dormitory was a spacious, airy room, devoid of any furniture; its +whitewashed walls covered with inscriptions in Marquesan and rude +drawings: one of the pier, not badly done; one of a murder; +several of French soldiers in uniform. There was one legend in +French: 'Je n'est' (sic) 'pas le sou.' From this noontide +quietude it must not be supposed the prison was untenanted; the +calaboose at Tai-o-hae does a good business. But some of its +occupants were gardening at the Residency, and the rest were +probably at work upon the streets, as free as our scavengers at +home, although not so industrious. On the approach of evening they +would be called in like children from play; and the harbour-master +(who is also the jailer) would go through the form of locking them +up until six the next morning. Should a prisoner have any call in +town, whether of pleasure or affairs, he has but to unhook the +window-shutters; and if he is back again, and the shutter decently +replaced, by the hour of call on the morrow, he may have met the +harbour-master in the avenue, and there will be no complaint, far +less any punishment. But this is not all. The charming French +Resident, M. Delaruelle, carried me one day to the calaboose on an +official visit. In the green court, a very ragged gentleman, his +legs deformed with the island elephantiasis, saluted us smiling. +'One of our political prisoners--an insurgent from Raiatea,' said +the Resident; and then to the jailer: 'I thought I had ordered him +a new pair of trousers.' Meanwhile no other convict was to be +seen--'Eh bien,' said the Resident, 'ou sont vos prisonniers?' +'Monsieur le Resident,' replied the jailer, saluting with soldierly +formality, 'comme c'est jour de fete, je les ai laisse aller a la +chasse.' They were all upon the mountains hunting goats! +Presently we came to the quarters of the women, likewise deserted-- +'Ou sont vos bonnes femmes?' asked the Resident; and the jailer +cheerfully responded: 'Je crois, Monsieur le Resident, qu'elles +sont allees quelquepart faire une visite.' It had been the design +of M. Delaruelle, who was much in love with the whimsicalities of +his small realm, to elicit something comical; but not even he +expected anything so perfect as the last. To complete the picture +of convict life in Tai-o-hae, it remains to be added that these +criminals draw a salary as regularly as the President of the +Republic. Ten sous a day is their hire. Thus they have money, +food, shelter, clothing, and, I was about to write, their liberty. +The French are certainly a good-natured people, and make easy +masters. They are besides inclined to view the Marquesans with an +eye of humorous indulgence. 'They are dying, poor devils!' said M. +Delaruelle: 'the main thing is to let them die in peace.' And it +was not only well said, but I believe expressed the general +thought. Yet there is another element to be considered; for these +convicts are not merely useful, they are almost essential to the +French existence. With a people incurably idle, dispirited by what +can only be called endemic pestilence, and inflamed with ill- +feeling against their new masters, crime and convict labour are a +godsend to the Government. + +Theft is practically the sole crime. Originally petty pilferers, +the men of Tai-o-hae now begin to force locks and attack strong- +boxes. Hundreds of dollars have been taken at a time; though, with +that redeeming moderation so common in Polynesian theft, the +Marquesan burglar will always take a part and leave a part, sharing +(so to speak) with the proprietor. If it be Chilian coin--the +island currency--he will escape; if the sum is in gold, French +silver, or bank-notes, the police wait until the money begins to +come in circulation, and then easily pick out their man. And now +comes the shameful part. In plain English, the prisoner is +tortured until he confesses and (if that be possible) restores the +money. To keep him alone, day and night, in the black hole, is to +inflict on the Marquesan torture inexpressible. Even his robberies +are carried on in the plain daylight, under the open sky, with the +stimulus of enterprise, and the countenance of an accomplice; his +terror of the dark is still insurmountable; conceive, then, what he +endures in his solitary dungeon; conceive how he longs to confess, +become a full-fledged convict, and be allowed to sleep beside his +comrades. While we were in Tai-o-hae a thief was under prevention. +He had entered a house about eight in the morning, forced a trunk, +and stolen eleven hundred francs; and now, under the horrors of +darkness, solitude, and a bedevilled cannibal imagination, he was +reluctantly confessing and giving up his spoil. From one cache, +which he had already pointed out, three hundred francs had been +recovered, and it was expected that he would presently disgorge the +rest. This would be ugly enough if it were all; but I am bound to +say, because it is a matter the French should set at rest, that +worse is continually hinted. I heard that one man was kept six +days with his arms bound backward round a barrel; and it is the +universal report that every gendarme in the South Seas is equipped +with something in the nature of a thumbscrew. I do not know this. +I never had the face to ask any of the gendarmes--pleasant, +intelligent, and kindly fellows--with whom I have been intimate, +and whose hospitality I have enjoyed; and perhaps the tale reposes +(as I hope it does) on a misconstruction of that ingenious cat's- +cradle with which the French agent of police so readily secures a +prisoner. But whether physical or moral, torture is certainly +employed; and by a barbarous injustice, the state of accusation (in +which a man may very well be innocently placed) is positively +painful; the state of conviction (in which all are supposed guilty) +is comparatively free, and positively pleasant. Perhaps worse +still,--not only the accused, but sometimes his wife, his mistress, +or his friend, is subjected to the same hardships. I was admiring, +in the tapu system, the ingenuity of native methods of detection; +there is not much to admire in those of the French, and to lock up +a timid child in a dark room, and, if he proved obstinate, lock up +his sister in the next, is neither novel nor humane. + +The main occasion of these thefts is the new vice of opium-eating. +'Here nobody ever works, and all eat opium,' said a gendarme; and +Ah Fu knew a woman who ate a dollar's worth in a day. The +successful thief will give a handful of money to each of his +friends, a dress to a woman, pass an evening in one of the taverns +of Tai-o-hae, during which he treats all comers, produce a big lump +of opium, and retire to the bush to eat and sleep it off. A +trader, who did not sell opium, confessed to me that he was at his +wit's end. 'I do not sell it, but others do,' said he. 'The +natives only work to buy it; if they walk over to me to sell their +cotton, they have just to walk over to some one else to buy their +opium with my money. And why should they be at the bother of two +walks? There is no use talking,' he added--'opium is the currency +of this country.' + +The man under prevention during my stay at Tai-o-hae lost patience +while the Chinese opium-seller was being examined in his presence. +'Of course he sold me opium!' he broke out; 'all the Chinese here +sell opium. It was only to buy opium that I stole; it is only to +buy opium that anybody steals. And what you ought to do is to let +no opium come here, and no Chinamen.' This is precisely what is +done in Samoa by a native Government; but the French have bound +their own hands, and for forty thousand francs sold native subjects +to crime and death. This horrid traffic may be said to have sprung +up by accident. It was Captain Hart who had the misfortune to be +the means of beginning it, at a time when his plantations +flourished in the Marquesas, and he found a difficulty in keeping +Chinese coolies. To-day the plantations are practically deserted +and the Chinese gone; but in the meanwhile the natives have learned +the vice, the patent brings in a round sum, and the needy +Government at Papeete shut their eyes and open their pockets. Of +course, the patentee is supposed to sell to Chinamen alone; equally +of course, no one could afford to pay forty thousand francs for the +privilege of supplying a scattered handful of Chinese; and every +one knows the truth, and all are ashamed of it. French officials +shake their heads when opium is mentioned; and the agents of the +farmer blush for their employment. Those that live in glass houses +should not throw stones; as a subject of the British crown, I am an +unwilling shareholder in the largest opium business under heaven. +But the British case is highly complicated; it implies the +livelihood of millions; and must be reformed, when it can be +reformed at all, with prudence. This French business, on the other +hand, is a nostrum and a mere excrescence. No native industry was +to be encouraged: the poison is solemnly imported. No native +habit was to be considered: the vice has been gratuitously +introduced. And no creature profits, save the Government at +Papeete--the not very enviable gentlemen who pay them, and the +Chinese underlings who do the dirty work. + + + +CHAPTER IX--THE HOUSE OF TEMOANA + + + +The history of the Marquesas is, of late years, much confused by +the coming and going of the French. At least twice they have +seized the archipelago, at least once deserted it; and in the +meanwhile the natives pursued almost without interruption their +desultory cannibal wars. Through these events and changing +dynasties, a single considerable figure may be seen to move: that +of the high chief, a king, Temoana. Odds and ends of his history +came to my ears: how he was at first a convert to the Protestant +mission; how he was kidnapped or exiled from his native land, +served as cook aboard a whaler, and was shown, for small charge, in +English seaports; how he returned at last to the Marquesas, fell +under the strong and benign influence of the late bishop, extended +his influence in the group, was for a while joint ruler with the +prelate, and died at last the chief supporter of Catholicism and +the French. His widow remains in receipt of two pounds a month +from the French Government. Queen she is usually called, but in +the official almanac she figures as 'Madame Vaekehu, Grande +Chefesse.' His son (natural or adoptive, I know not which), +Stanislao Moanatini, chief of Akaui, serves in Tai-o-hae as a kind +of Minister of Public Works; and the daughter of Stanislao is High +Chiefess of the southern island of Tauata. These, then, are the +greatest folk of the archipelago; we thought them also the most +estimable. This is the rule in Polynesia, with few exceptions; the +higher the family, the better the man--better in sense, better in +manners, and usually taller and stronger in body. A stranger +advances blindfold. He scrapes acquaintance as he can. Save the +tattoo in the Marquesas, nothing indicates the difference of rank; +and yet almost invariably we found, after we had made them, that +our friends were persons of station. I have said 'usually taller +and stronger.' I might have been more absolute,--over all +Polynesia, and a part of Micronesia, the rule holds good; the great +ones of the isle, and even of the village, are greater of bone and +muscle, and often heavier of flesh, than any commoner. The usual +explanation--that the high-born child is more industriously +shampooed, is probably the true one. In New Caledonia, at least, +where the difference does not exist, has never been remarked, the +practice of shampooing seems to be itself unknown. Doctors would +be well employed in a study of the point. + +Vaekehu lives at the other end of the town from the Residency, +beyond the buildings of the mission. Her house is on the European +plan: a table in the midst of the chief room; photographs and +religious pictures on the wall. It commands to either hand a +charming vista: through the front door, a peep of green lawn, +scurrying pigs, the pendent fans of the coco-palm and splendour of +the bursting surf: through the back, mounting forest glades and +coronals of precipice. Here, in the strong thorough-draught, Her +Majesty received us in a simple gown of print, and with no mark of +royalty but the exquisite finish of her tattooed mittens, the +elaboration of her manners, and the gentle falsetto in which all +the highly refined among Marquesan ladies (and Vaekehu above all +others) delight to sing their language. An adopted daughter +interpreted, while we gave the news, and rehearsed by name our +friends of Anaho. As we talked, we could see, through the landward +door, another lady of the household at her toilet under the green +trees; who presently, when her hair was arranged, and her hat +wreathed with flowers, appeared upon the back verandah with +gracious salutations. + +Vaekehu is very deaf; 'merci' is her only word of French; and I do +not know that she seemed clever. An exquisite, kind refinement, +with a shade of quietism, gathered perhaps from the nuns, was what +chiefly struck us. Or rather, upon that first occasion, we were +conscious of a sense as of district-visiting on our part, and +reduced evangelical gentility on the part of our hostess. The +other impression followed after she was more at ease, and came with +Stanislao and his little girl to dine on board the Casco. She had +dressed for the occasion: wore white, which very well became her +strong brown face; and sat among us, eating or smoking her +cigarette, quite cut off from all society, or only now and then +included through the intermediary of her son. It was a position +that might have been ridiculous, and she made it ornamental; making +believe to hear and to be entertained; her face, whenever she met +our eyes, lighting with the smile of good society; her +contributions to the talk, when she made any, and that was seldom, +always complimentary and pleasing. No attention was paid to the +child, for instance, but what she remarked and thanked us for. Her +parting with each, when she came to leave, was gracious and pretty, +as had been every step of her behaviour. When Mrs. Stevenson held +out her hand to say good-bye, Vaekehu took it, held it, and a +moment smiled upon her; dropped it, and then, as upon a kindly +after-thought, and with a sort of warmth of condescension, held out +both hands and kissed my wife upon both cheeks. Given the same +relation of years and of rank, the thing would have been so done on +the boards of the Comedie Francaise; just so might Madame Brohan +have warmed and condescended to Madame Broisat in the Marquis de +Villemer. It was my part to accompany our guests ashore: when I +kissed the little girl good-bye at the pier steps, Vaekehu gave a +cry of gratification, reached down her hand into the boat, took +mine, and pressed it with that flattering softness which seems the +coquetry of the old lady in every quarter of the earth. The next +moment she had taken Stanislao's arm, and they moved off along the +pier in the moonlight, leaving me bewildered. This was a queen of +cannibals; she was tattooed from hand to foot, and perhaps the +greatest masterpiece of that art now extant, so that a while ago, +before she was grown prim, her leg was one of the sights of Tai-o- +hae; she had been passed from chief to chief; she had been fought +for and taken in war; perhaps, being so great a lady, she had sat +on the high place, and throned it there, alone of her sex, while +the drums were going twenty strong and the priests carried up the +blood-stained baskets of long-pig. And now behold her, out of that +past of violence and sickening feasts, step forth, in her age, a +quiet, smooth, elaborate old lady, such as you might find at home +(mittened also, but not often so well-mannered) in a score of +country houses. Only Vaekehu's mittens were of dye, not of silk; +and they had been paid for, not in money, but the cooked flesh of +men. It came in my mind with a clap, what she could think of it +herself, and whether at heart, perhaps, she might not regret and +aspire after the barbarous and stirring past. But when I asked +Stanislao--'Ah!' said he, 'she is content; she is religious, she +passes all her days with the sisters.' + +Stanislao (Stanislaos, with the final consonant evaded after the +Polynesian habit) was sent by Bishop Dordillon to South America, +and there educated by the fathers. His French is fluent, his talk +sensible and spirited, and in his capacity of ganger-in-chief, he +is of excellent service to the French. With the prestige of his +name and family, and with the stick when needful, he keeps the +natives working and the roads passable. Without Stanislao and the +convicts, I am in doubt what would become of the present regimen in +Nuka-hiva; whether the highways might not be suffered to close up, +the pier to wash away, and the Residency to fall piecemeal about +the ears of impotent officials. And yet though the hereditary +favourer, and one of the chief props of French authority, he has +always an eye upon the past. He showed me where the old public +place had stood, still to be traced by random piles of stone; told +me how great and fine it was, and surrounded on all sides by +populous houses, whence, at the beating of the drums, the folk +crowded to make holiday. The drum-beat of the Polynesian has a +strange and gloomy stimulation for the nerves of all. White +persons feel it--at these precipitate sounds their hearts beat +faster; and, according to old residents, its effect on the natives +was extreme. Bishop Dordillon might entreat; Temoana himself +command and threaten; at the note of the drum wild instincts +triumphed. And now it might beat upon these ruins, and who should +assemble? The houses are down, the people dead, their lineage +extinct; and the sweepings and fugitives of distant bays and +islands encamp upon their graves. The decline of the dance +Stanislao especially laments. 'Chaque pays a ses coutumes,' said +he; but in the report of any gendarme, perhaps corruptly eager to +increase the number of delits and the instruments of his own power, +custom after custom is placed on the expurgatorial index. 'Tenez, +une danse qui n'est pas permise,' said Stanislao: 'je ne sais pas +pourquoi, elle est tres jolie, elle va comme ca,' and sticking his +umbrella upright in the road, he sketched the steps and gestures. +All his criticisms of the present, all his regrets for the past, +struck me as temperate and sensible. The short term of office of +the Resident he thought the chief defect of the administration; +that officer having scarce begun to be efficient ere he was +recalled. I thought I gathered, too, that he regarded with some +fear the coming change from a naval to a civil governor. I am sure +at least that I regard it so myself; for the civil servants of +France have never appeared to any foreigner as at all the flower of +their country, while her naval officers may challenge competition +with the world. In all his talk, Stanislao was particular to speak +of his own country as a land of savages; and when he stated an +opinion of his own, it was with some apologetic preface, alleging +that he was 'a savage who had travelled.' There was a deal, in +this elaborate modesty, of honest pride. Yet there was something +in the precaution that saddened me; and I could not but fear he was +only forestalling a taunt that he had heard too often. + +I recall with interest two interviews with Stanislao. The first +was a certain afternoon of tropic rain, which we passed together in +the verandah of the club; talking at times with heightened voices +as the showers redoubled overhead, passing at times into the +billiard-room, to consult, in the dim, cloudy daylight, that map of +the world which forms its chief adornment. He was naturally +ignorant of English history, so that I had much of news to +communicate. The story of Gordon I told him in full, and many +episodes of the Indian Mutiny, Lucknow, the second battle of Cawn- +pore, the relief of Arrah, the death of poor Spottis-woode, and Sir +Hugh Rose's hotspur, midland campaign. He was intent to hear; his +brown face, strongly marked with small-pox, kindled and changed +with each vicissitude. His eyes glowed with the reflected light of +battle; his questions were many and intelligent, and it was chiefly +these that sent us so often to the map. But it is of our parting +that I keep the strongest sense. We were to sail on the morrow, +and the night had fallen, dark, gusty, and rainy, when we stumbled +up the hill to bid farewell to Stanislao. He had already loaded us +with gifts; but more were waiting. We sat about the table over +cigars and green cocoa-nuts; claps of wind blew through the house +and extinguished the lamp, which was always instantly relighted +with a single match; and these recurrent intervals of darkness were +felt as a relief. For there was something painful and embarrassing +in the kindness of that separation. 'Ah, vous devriez rester ici, +mon cher ami!' cried Stanislao. 'Vous etes les gens qu'il faut +pour les Kanaques; vous etes doux, vous et votre famille; vous +seriez obeis dans toutes les iles.' We had been civil; not always +that, my conscience told me, and never anything beyond; and all +this to-do is a measure, not of our considerateness, but of the +want of it in others. The rest of the evening, on to Vaekehu's and +back as far as to the pier, Stanislao walked with my arm and +sheltered me with his umbrella; and after the boat had put off, we +could still distinguish, in the murky darkness, his gestures of +farewell. His words, if there were any, were drowned by the rain +and the loud surf. + +I have mentioned presents, a vexed question in the South Seas; and +one which well illustrates the common, ignorant habit of regarding +races in a lump. In many quarters the Polynesian gives only to +receive. I have visited islands where the population mobbed me for +all the world like dogs after the waggon of cat's-meat; and where +the frequent proposition, 'You my pleni (friend),' or (with more of +pathos) 'You all 'e same my father,' must be received with hearty +laughter and a shout. And perhaps everywhere, among the greedy and +rapacious, a gift is regarded as a sprat to catch a whale. It is +the habit to give gifts and to receive returns, and such +characters, complying with the custom, will look to it nearly that +they do not lose. But for persons of a different stamp the +statement must be reversed. The shabby Polynesian is anxious till +he has received the return gift; the generous is uneasy until he +has made it. The first is disappointed if you have not given more +than he; the second is miserable if he thinks he has given less +than you. This is my experience; if it clash with that of others, +I pity their fortune, and praise mine: the circumstances cannot +change what I have seen, nor lessen what I have received. And +indeed I find that those who oppose me often argue from a ground of +singular presumptions; comparing Polynesians with an ideal person, +compact of generosity and gratitude, whom I never had the pleasure +of encountering; and forgetting that what is almost poverty to us +is wealth almost unthinkable to them. I will give one instance: I +chanced to speak with consideration of these gifts of Stanislao's +with a certain clever man, a great hater and contemner of Kanakas. +'Well! what were they?' he cried. 'A pack of old men's beards. +Trash!' And the same gentleman, some half an hour later, being +upon a different train of thought, dwelt at length on the esteem in +which the Marquesans held that sort of property, how they preferred +it to all others except land, and what fancy prices it would fetch. +Using his own figures, I computed that, in this commodity alone, +the gifts of Vaekehu and Stanislao represented between two and +three hundred dollars; and the queen's official salary is of two +hundred and forty in the year. + +But generosity on the one hand, and conspicuous meanness on the +other, are in the South Seas, as at home, the exception. It is +neither with any hope of gain, nor with any lively wish to please, +that the ordinary Polynesian chooses and presents his gifts. A +plain social duty lies before him, which he performs correctly, but +without the least enthusiasm. And we shall best understand his +attitude of mind, if we examine our own to the cognate absurdity of +marriage presents. There we give without any special thought of a +return; yet if the circumstance arise, and the return be withheld, +we shall judge ourselves insulted. We give them usually without +affection, and almost never with a genuine desire to please; and +our gift is rather a mark of our own status than a measure of our +love to the recipients. So in a great measure and with the common +run of the Polynesians; their gifts are formal; they imply no more +than social recognition; and they are made and reciprocated, as we +pay and return our morning visits. And the practice of marking and +measuring events and sentiments by presents is universal in the +island world. A gift plays with them the part of stamp and seal; +and has entered profoundly into the mind of islanders. Peace and +war, marriage, adoption and naturalisation, are celebrated or +declared by the acceptance or the refusal of gifts; and it is as +natural for the islander to bring a gift as for us to carry a card- +case. + + + +CHAPTER X--A PORTRAIT AND A STORY + + + +I have had occasion several times to name the late bishop, Father +Dordillon, 'Monseigneur,' as he is still almost universally called, +Vicar-Apostolic of the Marquesas and Bishop of Cambysopolis in +partibus. Everywhere in the islands, among all classes and races, +this fine, old, kindly, cheerful fellow is remembered with +affection and respect. His influence with the natives was +paramount. They reckoned him the highest of men--higher than an +admiral; brought him their money to keep; took his advice upon +their purchases; nor would they plant trees upon their own land +till they had the approval of the father of the islands. During +the time of the French exodus he singly represented Europe, living +in the Residency, and ruling by the hand of Temoana. The first +roads were made under his auspices and by his persuasion. The old +road between Hatiheu and Anaho was got under way from either side +on the ground that it would be pleasant for an evening promenade, +and brought to completion by working on the rivalry of the two +villages. The priest would boast in Hatiheu of the progress made +in Anaho, and he would tell the folk of Anaho, 'If you don't take +care, your neighbours will be over the hill before you are at the +top.' It could not be so done to-day; it could then; death, opium, +and depopulation had not gone so far; and the people of Hatiheu, I +was told, still vied with each other in fine attire, and used to go +out by families, in the cool of the evening, boat-sailing and +racing in the bay. There seems some truth at least in the common +view, that this joint reign of Temoana and the bishop was the last +and brief golden age of the Marquesas. But the civil power +returned, the mission was packed out of the Residency at twenty- +four hours' notice, new methods supervened, and the golden age +(whatever it quite was) came to an end. It is the strongest proof +of Father Dordillon's prestige that it survived, seemingly without +loss, this hasty deposition. + +His method with the natives was extremely mild. Among these +barbarous children he still played the part of the smiling father; +and he was careful to observe, in all indifferent matters, the +Marquesan etiquette. Thus, in the singular system of artificial +kinship, the bishop had been adopted by Vaekehu as a grandson; Miss +Fisher, of Hatiheu, as a daughter. From that day, Monseigneur +never addressed the young lady except as his mother, and closed his +letters with the formalities of a dutiful son. With Europeans he +could be strict, even to the extent of harshness. He made no +distinction against heretics, with whom he was on friendly terms; +but the rules of his own Church he would see observed; and once at +least he had a white man clapped in jail for the desecration of a +saint's day. But even this rigour, so intolerable to laymen, so +irritating to Protestants, could not shake his popularity. We +shall best conceive him by examples nearer home; we may all have +known some divine of the old school in Scotland, a literal +Sabbatarian, a stickler for the letter of the law, who was yet in +private modest, innocent, genial and mirthful. Much such a man, it +seems, was Father Dordillon. And his popularity bore a test yet +stronger. He had the name, and probably deserved it, of a shrewd +man in business and one that made the mission pay. Nothing so much +stirs up resentment as the inmixture in commerce of religious +bodies; but even rival traders spoke well of Monseigneur. + +His character is best portrayed in the story of the days of his +decline. A time came when, from the failure of sight, he must +desist from his literary labours: his Marquesan hymns, grammars, +and dictionaries; his scientific papers, lives of saints, and +devotional poetry. He cast about for a new interest: pitched on +gardening, and was to be seen all day, with spade and water-pot, in +his childlike eagerness, actually running between the borders. +Another step of decay, and he must leave his garden also. +Instantly a new occupation was devised, and he sat in the mission +cutting paper flowers and wreaths. His diocese was not great +enough for his activity; the churches of the Marquesas were papered +with his handiwork, and still he must be making more. 'Ah,' said +he, smiling, 'when I am dead what a fine time you will have +clearing out my trash!' He had been dead about six months; but I +was pleased to see some of his trophies still exposed, and looked +upon them with a smile: the tribute (if I have read his cheerful +character aright) which he would have preferred to any useless +tears. Disease continued progressively to disable him; he who had +clambered so stalwartly over the rude rocks of the Marquesas, +bringing peace to warfaring clans, was for some time carried in a +chair between the mission and the church, and at last confined to +bed, impotent with dropsy, and tormented with bed-sores and +sciatica. Here he lay two months without complaint; and on the +11th January 1888, in the seventy-ninth year of his life, and the +thirty-fourth of his labours in the Marquesas, passed away. + +Those who have a taste for hearing missions, Protestant or +Catholic, decried, must seek their pleasure elsewhere than in my +pages. Whether Catholic or Protestant, with all their gross blots, +with all their deficiency of candour, of humour, and of common +sense, the missionaries are the best and the most useful whites in +the Pacific. This is a subject which will follow us throughout; +but there is one part of it that may conveniently be treated here. +The married and the celibate missionary, each has his particular +advantage and defect. The married missionary, taking him at the +best, may offer to the native what he is much in want of--a higher +picture of domestic life; but the woman at his elbow tends to keep +him in touch with Europe and out of touch with Polynesia, and to +perpetuate, and even to ingrain, parochial decencies far best +forgotten. The mind of the female missionary tends, for instance, +to be continually busied about dress. She can be taught with +extreme difficulty to think any costume decent but that to which +she grew accustomed on Clapham Common; and to gratify this +prejudice, the native is put to useless expense, his mind is +tainted with the morbidities of Europe, and his health is set in +danger. The celibate missionary, on the other hand, and whether at +best or worst, falls readily into native ways of life; to which he +adds too commonly what is either a mark of celibate man at large, +or an inheritance from mediaeval saints--I mean slovenly habits and +an unclean person. There are, of course, degrees in this; and the +sister (of course, and all honour to her) is as fresh as a lady at +a ball. For the diet there is nothing to be said--it must amaze +and shock the Polynesian--but for the adoption of native habits +there is much. 'Chaque pays a ses coutumes,' said Stanislao; these +it is the missionary's delicate task to modify; and the more he can +do so from within, and from a native standpoint, the better he will +do his work; and here I think the Catholics have sometimes the +advantage; in the Vicariate of Dordillon, I am sure they had it. I +have heard the bishop blamed for his indulgence to the natives, and +above all because he did not rage with sufficient energy against +cannibalism. It was a part of his policy to live among the natives +like an elder brother; to follow where he could; to lead where it +was necessary; never to drive; and to encourage the growth of new +habits, instead of violently rooting up the old. And it might be +better, in the long-run, if this policy were always followed. + +It might be supposed that native missionaries would prove more +indulgent, but the reverse is found to be the case. The new broom +sweeps clean; and the white missionary of to-day is often +embarrassed by the bigotry of his native coadjutor. What else +should we expect? On some islands, sorcery, polygamy, human +sacrifice, and tobacco-smoking have been prohibited, the dress of +the native has been modified, and himself warned in strong terms +against rival sects of Christianity; all by the same man, at the +same period of time, and with the like authority. By what +criterion is the convert to distinguish the essential from the +unessential? He swallows the nostrum whole; there has been no play +of mind, no instruction, and, except for some brute utility in the +prohibitions, no advance. To call things by their proper names, +this is teaching superstition. It is unfortunate to use the word; +so few people have read history, and so many have dipped into +little atheistic manuals, that the majority will rush to a +conclusion, and suppose the labour lost. And far from that: These +semi-spontaneous superstitions, varying with the sect of the +original evangelist and the customs of the island, are found in +practice to be highly fructifying; and in particular those who have +learned and who go forth again to teach them offer an example to +the world. The best specimen of the Christian hero that I ever met +was one of these native missionaries. He had saved two lives at +the risk of his own; like Nathan, he had bearded a tyrant in his +hour of blood; when a whole white population fled, he alone stood +to his duty; and his behaviour under domestic sorrow with which the +public has no concern filled the beholder with sympathy and +admiration. A poor little smiling laborious man he looked; and you +would have thought he had nothing in him but that of which indeed +he had too much--facile good-nature. + +It chances that the only rivals of Monseigneur and his mission in +the Marquesas were certain of these brown-skinned evangelists, +natives from Hawaii. I know not what they thought of Father +Dordillon: they are the only class I did not question; but I +suspect the prelate to have regarded them askance, for he was +eminently human. During my stay at Tai-o-hae, the time of the +yearly holiday came round at the girls' school; and a whole fleet +of whale-boats came from Ua-pu to take the daughters of that island +home. On board of these was Kauwealoha, one of the pastors, a +fine, rugged old gentleman, of that leonine type so common in +Hawaii. He paid me a visit in the Casco, and there entertained me +with a tale of one of his colleagues, Kekela, a missionary in the +great cannibal isle of Hiva-oa. It appears that shortly after a +kidnapping visit from a Peruvian slaver, the boats of an American +whaler put into a bay upon that island, were attacked, and made +their escape with difficulty, leaving their mate, a Mr. Whalon, in +the hands of the natives. The captive, with his arms bound behind +his back, was cast into a house; and the chief announced the +capture to Kekela. And here I begin to follow the version of +Kauwealoha; it is a good specimen of Kanaka English; and the reader +is to conceive it delivered with violent emphasis and speaking +pantomime. + +'"I got 'Melican mate," the chief he say. "What you go do 'Melican +mate?" Kekela he say. "I go make fire, I go kill, I go eat him," +he say; "you come to-mollow eat piece." "I no WANT eat 'Melican +mate!" Kekela he say; "why you want?" "This bad shippee, this +slave shippee," the chief he say. "One time a shippee he come from +Pelu, he take away plenty Kanaka, he take away my son. 'Melican +mate he bad man. I go eat him; you eat piece." "I no WANT eat +'Melican mate!" Kekela he say; and he CLY--all night he cly! To- +mollow Kekela he get up, he put on blackee coat, he go see chief; +he see Missa Whela, him hand tie' like this. (Pantomime.) Kekela +he cly. He say chief:- "Chief, you like things of mine? you like +whale-boat?" "Yes," he say. "You like file-a'm?" (fire-arms). +"Yes," he say. "You like blackee coat?" "Yes," he say. Kekela he +take Missa Whela by he shoul'a' (shoulder), he take him light out +house; he give chief he whale-boat, he file-a'm, he blackee coat. +He take Missa Whela he house, make him sit down with he wife and +chil'en. Missa Whela all-the-same pelison (prison); he wife, he +chil'en in Amelica; he cly--O, he cly. Kekela he solly. One day +Kekela he see ship. (Pantomime.) He say Missa Whela, "Ma' Whala?" +Missa Whela he say, "Yes." Kanaka they begin go down beach. +Kekela he get eleven Kanaka, get oa' (oars), get evely thing. He +say Missa Whela, "Now you go quick." They jump in whale-boat. +"Now you low!" Kekela he say: "you low quick, quick!" (Violent +pantomime, and a change indicating that the narrator has left the +boat and returned to the beach.) All the Kanaka they say, "How! +'Melican mate he go away?"--jump in boat; low afta. (Violent +pantomime, and change again to boat.) Kekela he say, "Low quick!"' + +Here I think Kauwealoha's pantomime had confused me; I have no more +of his ipsissima verba; and can but add, in my own less spirited +manner, that the ship was reached, Mr. Whalon taken aboard, and +Kekela returned to his charge among the cannibals. But how unjust +it is to repeat the stumblings of a foreigner in a language only +partly acquired! A thoughtless reader might conceive Kauwealoha +and his colleague to be a species of amicable baboon; but I have +here the anti-dote. In return for his act of gallant charity, +Kekela was presented by the American Government with a sum of +money, and by President Lincoln personally with a gold watch. From +his letter of thanks, written in his own tongue, I give the +following extract. I do not envy the man who can read it without +emotion. + + +'When I saw one of your countrymen, a citizen of your great nation, +ill-treated, and about to be baked and eaten, as a pig is eaten, I +ran to save him, full of pity and grief at the evil deed of these +benighted people. I gave my boat for the stranger's life. This +boat came from James Hunnewell, a gift of friendship. It became +the ransom of this countryman of yours, that he might not be eaten +by the savages who knew not Jehovah. This was Mr. Whalon, and the +date, Jan. 14, 1864. + +As to this friendly deed of mine in saving Mr. Whalon, its seed +came from your great land, and was brought by certain of your +countrymen, who had received the love of God. It was planted in +Hawaii, and I brought it to plant in this land and in these dark +regions, that they might receive the root of all that is good and +true, which is LOVE. + +'1. Love to Jehovah. + +'2. Love to self. + +'3. Love to our neighbour. + +'If a man have a sufficiency of these three, he is good and holy, +like his God, Jehovah, in his triune character (Father, Son, and +Holy Ghost), one-three, three-one. If he have two and wants one, +it is not well; and if he have one and wants two, indeed, is not +well; but if he cherishes all three, then is he holy, indeed, after +the manner of the Bible. + +'This is a great thing for your great nation to boast of, before +all the nations of the earth. From your great land a most precious +seed was brought to the land of darkness. It was planted here, not +by means of guns and men-of-war and threatening. It was planted by +means of the ignorant, the neglected, the despised. Such was the +introduction of the word of the Almighty God into this group of +Nuuhiwa. Great is my debt to Americans, who have taught me all +things pertaining to this life and to that which is to come. + +'How shall I repay your great kindness to me? Thus David asked of +Jehovah, and thus I ask of you, the President of the United States. +This is my only payment--that which I have received of the Lord, +love--(aloha).' + + + +CHAPTER XI--LONG-PIG--A CANNIBAL HIGH PLACE + + + +Nothing more strongly arouses our disgust than cannibalism, nothing +so surely unmortars a society; nothing, we might plausibly argue, +will so harden and degrade the minds of those that practise it. +And yet we ourselves make much the same appearance in the eyes of +the Buddhist and the vegetarian. We consume the carcasses of +creatures of like appetites, passions, and organs with ourselves; +we feed on babes, though not our own; and the slaughter-house +resounds daily with screams of pain and fear. We distinguish, +indeed; but the unwillingness of many nations to eat the dog, an +animal with whom we live on terms of the next intimacy, shows how +precariously the distinction is grounded. The pig is the main +element of animal food among the islands; and I had many occasions, +my mind being quickened by my cannibal surroundings, to observe his +character and the manner of his death. Many islanders live with +their pigs as we do with our dogs; both crowd around the hearth +with equal freedom; and the island pig is a fellow of activity, +enterprise, and sense. He husks his own cocoa-nuts, and (I am +told) rolls them into the sun to burst; he is the terror of the +shepherd. Mrs. Stevenson, senior, has seen one fleeing to the +woods with a lamb in his mouth; and I saw another come rapidly (and +erroneously) to the conclusion that the Casco was going down, and +swim through the flush water to the rail in search of an escape. +It was told us in childhood that pigs cannot swim; I have known one +to leap overboard, swim five hundred yards to shore, and return to +the house of his original owner. I was once, at Tautira, a pig- +master on a considerable scale; at first, in my pen, the utmost +good feeling prevailed; a little sow with a belly-ache came and +appealed to us for help in the manner of a child; and there was one +shapely black boar, whom we called Catholicus, for he was a +particular present from the Catholics of the village, and who early +displayed the marks of courage and friendliness; no other animal, +whether dog or pig, was suffered to approach him at his food, and +for human beings he showed a full measure of that toadying fondness +so common in the lower animals, and possibly their chief title to +the name. One day, on visiting my piggery, I was amazed to see +Catholicus draw back from my approach with cries of terror; and if +I was amazed at the change, I was truly embarrassed when I learnt +its reason. One of the pigs had been that morning killed; +Catholicus had seen the murder, he had discovered he was dwelling +in the shambles, and from that time his confidence and his delight +in life were ended. We still reserved him a long while, but he +could not endure the sight of any two-legged creature, nor could +we, under the circumstances, encounter his eye without confusion. +I have assisted besides, by the ear, at the act of butchery itself; +the victim's cries of pain I think I could have borne, but the +execution was mismanaged, and his expression of terror was +contagious: that small heart moved to the same tune with ours. +Upon such 'dread foundations' the life of the European reposes, and +yet the European is among the less cruel of races. The +paraphernalia of murder, the preparatory brutalities of his +existence, are all hid away; an extreme sensibility reigns upon the +surface; and ladies will faint at the recital of one tithe of what +they daily expect of their butchers. Some will be even crying out +upon me in their hearts for the coarseness of this paragraph. And +so with the island cannibals. They were not cruel; apart from this +custom, they are a race of the most kindly; rightly speaking, to +cut a man's flesh after he is dead is far less hateful than to +oppress him whilst he lives; and even the victims of their appetite +were gently used in life and suddenly and painlessly despatched at +last. In island circles of refinement it was doubtless thought bad +taste to expatiate on what was ugly in the practice. + +Cannibalism is traced from end to end of the Pacific, from the +Marquesas to New Guinea, from New Zealand to Hawaii, here in the +lively haunt of its exercise, there by scanty but significant +survivals. Hawaii is the most doubtful. We find cannibalism +chronicled in Hawaii, only in the history of a single war, where it +seems to have been thought exception, as in the case of mountain +outlaws, such as fell by the hand of Theseus. In Tahiti, a single +circumstance survived, but that appears conclusive. In historic +times, when human oblation was made in the marae, the eyes of the +victim were formally offered to the chief: a delicacy to the +leading guest. All Melanesia appears tainted. In Micronesia, in +the Marshalls, with which my acquaintance is no more than that of a +tourist, I could find no trace at all; and even in the Gilbert zone +I long looked and asked in vain. I was told tales indeed of men +who had been eaten in a famine; but these were nothing to my +purpose, for the same thing is done under the same stress by all +kindreds and generations of men. At last, in some manuscript notes +of Dr. Turner's, which I was allowed to consult at Malua, I came on +one damning evidence: on the island of Onoatoa the punishment for +theft was to be killed and eaten. How shall we account for the +universality of the practice over so vast an area, among people of +such varying civilisation, and, with whatever intermixture, of such +different blood? What circumstance is common to them all, but that +they lived on islands destitute, or very nearly so, of animal food? +I can never find it in my appetite that man was meant to live on +vegetables only. When our stores ran low among the islands, I grew +to weary for the recurrent day when economy allowed us to open +another tin of miserable mutton. And in at least one ocean +language, a particular word denotes that a man is 'hungry for +fish,' having reached that stage when vegetables can no longer +satisfy, and his soul, like those of the Hebrews in the desert, +begins to lust after flesh-pots. Add to this the evidences of +over-population and imminent famine already adduced, and I think we +see some ground of indulgence for the island cannibal. + +It is right to look at both sides of any question; but I am far +from making the apology of this worse than bestial vice. The +higher Polynesian races, such as the Tahitians, Hawaiians, and +Samoans, had one and all outgrown, and some of them had in part +forgot, the practice, before Cook or Bougainville had shown a top- +sail in their waters. It lingered only in some low islands where +life was difficult to maintain, and among inveterate savages like +the New-Zealanders or the Marquesans. The Marquesans intertwined +man-eating with the whole texture of their lives; long-pig was in a +sense their currency and sacrament; it formed the hire of the +artist, illustrated public events, and was the occasion and +attraction of a feast. To-day they are paying the penalty of this +bloody commixture. The civil power, in its crusade against man- +eating, has had to examine one after another all Marquesan arts and +pleasures, has found them one after another tainted with a cannibal +element, and one after another has placed them on the proscript +list. Their art of tattooing stood by itself, the execution +exquisite, the designs most beautiful and intricate; nothing more +handsomely sets off a handsome man; it may cost some pain in the +beginning, but I doubt if it be near so painful in the long-run, +and I am sure it is far more becoming than the ignoble European +practice of tight-lacing among women. And now it has been found +needful to forbid the art. Their songs and dances were numerous +(and the law has had to abolish them by the dozen). They now face +empty-handed the tedium of their uneventful days; and who shall +pity them? The least rigorous will say that they were justly +served. + +Death alone could not satisfy Marquesan vengeance: the flesh must +be eaten. The chief who seized Mr. Whalon preferred to eat him; +and he thought he had justified the wish when he explained it was a +vengeance. Two or three years ago, the people of a valley seized +and slew a wretch who had offended them. His offence, it is to be +supposed, was dire; they could not bear to leave their vengeance +incomplete, and, under the eyes of the French, they did not dare to +hold a public festival. The body was accordingly divided; and +every man retired to his own house to consummate the rite in +secret, carrying his proportion of the dreadful meat in a Swedish +match-box. The barbarous substance of the drama and the European +properties employed offer a seizing contrast to the imagination. +Yet more striking is another incident of the very year when I was +there myself, 1888. In the spring, a man and woman skulked about +the school-house in Hiva-oa till they found a particular child +alone. Him they approached with honeyed words and carneying +manners--'You are So-and-so, son of So-and-so?' they asked; and +caressed and beguiled him deeper in the woods. Some instinct woke +in the child's bosom, or some look betrayed the horrid purpose of +his deceivers. He sought to break from them; he screamed; and +they, casting off the mask, seized him the more strongly and began +to run. His cries were heard; his schoolmates, playing not far +off, came running to the rescue; and the sinister couple fled and +vanished in the woods. They were never identified; no prosecution +followed; but it was currently supposed they had some grudge +against the boy's father, and designed to eat him in revenge. All +over the islands, as at home among our own ancestors, it will be +observed that the avenger takes no particular heed to strike an +individual. A family, a class, a village, a whole valley or +island, a whole race of mankind, share equally the guilt of any +member. So, in the above story, the son was to pay the penalty for +his father; so Mr. Whalon, the mate of an American whaler, was to +bleed and be eaten for the misdeeds of a Peruvian slaver. I am +reminded of an incident in Jaluit in the Marshall group, which was +told me by an eye-witness, and which I tell here again for the +strangeness of the scene. Two men had awakened the animosity of +the Jaluit chiefs; and it was their wives who were selected to be +punished. A single native served as executioner. Early in the +morning, in the face of a large concourse of spectators, he waded +out upon the reef between his victims. These neither complained +nor resisted; accompanied their destroyer patiently; stooped down, +when they had waded deep enough, at his command; and he (laying one +hand upon the shoulders of each) held them under water till they +drowned. Doubtless, although my informant did not tell me so, +their families would be lamenting aloud upon the beach. + +It was from Hatiheu that I paid my first visit to a cannibal high +place. + +The day was sultry and clouded. Drenching tropical showers +succeeded bursts of sweltering sunshine. The green pathway of the +road wound steeply upward. As we went, our little schoolboy guide +a little ahead of us, Father Simeon had his portfolio in his hand, +and named the trees for me, and read aloud from his notes the +abstract of their virtues. Presently the road, mounting, showed us +the vale of Hatiheu, on a larger scale; and the priest, with +occasional reference to our guide, pointed out the boundaries and +told me the names of the larger tribes that lived at perpetual war +in the old days: one on the north-east, one along the beach, one +behind upon the mountain. With a survivor of this latter clan +Father Simeon had spoken; until the pacification he had never been +to the sea's edge, nor, if I remember exactly, eaten of sea-fish. +Each in its own district, the septs lived cantoned and beleaguered. +One step without the boundaries was to affront death. If famine +came, the men must out to the woods to gather chestnuts and small +fruits; even as to this day, if the parents are backward in their +weekly doles, school must be broken up and the scholars sent +foraging. But in the old days, when there was trouble in one clan, +there would be activity in all its neighbours; the woods would be +laid full of ambushes; and he who went after vegetables for himself +might remain to be a joint for his hereditary foes. Nor was the +pointed occasion needful. A dozen different natural signs and +social junctures called this people to the war-path and the +cannibal hunt. Let one of chiefly rank have finished his +tattooing, the wife of one be near upon her time, two of the +debauching streams have deviated nearer on the beach of Hatiheu, a +certain bird have been heard to sing, a certain ominous formation +of cloud observed above the northern sea; and instantly the arms +were oiled, and the man-hunters swarmed into the wood to lay their +fratricidal ambuscades. It appears besides that occasionally, +perhaps in famine, the priest would shut himself in his house, +where he lay for a stated period like a person dead. When he came +forth it was to run for three days through the territory of the +clan, naked and starving, and to sleep at night alone in the high +place. It was now the turn of the others to keep the house, for to +encounter the priest upon his rounds was death. On the eve of the +fourth day the time of the running was over; the priest returned to +his roof, the laymen came forth, and in the morning the number of +the victims was announced. I have this tale of the priest on one +authority--I think a good one,--but I set it down with diffidence. +The particulars are so striking that, had they been true, I almost +think I must have heard them oftener referred to. Upon one point +there seems to be no question: that the feast was sometimes +furnished from within the clan. In times of scarcity, all who were +not protected by their family connections--in the Highland +expression, all the commons of the clan--had cause to tremble. It +was vain to resist, it was useless to flee. They were begirt upon +all hands by cannibals; and the oven was ready to smoke for them +abroad in the country of their foes, or at home in the valley of +their fathers. + +At a certain corner of the road our scholar-guide struck off to his +left into the twilight of the forest. We were now on one of the +ancient native roads, plunged in a high vault of wood, and +clambering, it seemed, at random over boulders and dead trees; but +the lad wound in and out and up and down without a check, for these +paths are to the natives as marked as the king's highway is to us; +insomuch that, in the days of the man-hunt, it was their labour +rather to block and deface than to improve them. In the crypt of +the wood the air was clammy and hot and cold; overhead, upon the +leaves, the tropical rain uproariously poured, but only here and +there, as through holes in a leaky roof, a single drop would fall, +and make a spot upon my mackintosh. Presently the huge trunk of a +banyan hove in sight, standing upon what seemed the ruins of an +ancient fort; and our guide, halting and holding forth his arm, +announced that we had reached the paepae tapu. + +Paepae signifies a floor or platform such as a native house is +built on; and even such a paepae--a paepae hae--may be called a +paepae tapu in a lesser sense when it is deserted and becomes the +haunt of spirits; but the public high place, such as I was now +treading, was a thing on a great scale. As far as my eyes could +pierce through the dark undergrowth, the floor of the forest was +all paved. Three tiers of terrace ran on the slope of the hill; in +front, a crumbling parapet contained the main arena; and the +pavement of that was pierced and parcelled out with several wells +and small enclosures. No trace remained of any superstructure, and +the scheme of the amphitheatre was difficult to seize. I visited +another in Hiva-oa, smaller but more perfect, where it was easy to +follow rows of benches, and to distinguish isolated seats of honour +for eminent persons; and where, on the upper platform, a single +joist of the temple or dead-house still remained, its uprights +richly carved. In the old days the high place was sedulously +tended. No tree except the sacred banyan was suffered to encroach +upon its grades, no dead leaf to rot upon the pavement. The stones +were smoothly set, and I am told they were kept bright with oil. +On all sides the guardians lay encamped in their subsidiary huts to +watch and cleanse it. No other foot of man was suffered to draw +near; only the priest, in the days of his running, came there to +sleep--perhaps to dream of his ungodly errand; but, in the time of +the feast, the clan trooped to the high place in a body, and each +had his appointed seat. There were places for the chiefs, the +drummers, the dancers, the women, and the priests. The drums-- +perhaps twenty strong, and some of them twelve feet high-- +continuously throbbed in time. In time the singers kept up their +long-drawn, lugubrious, ululating song; in time, too, the dancers, +tricked out in singular finery, stepped, leaped, swayed, and +gesticulated--their plumed fingers fluttering in the air like +butterflies. The sense of time, in all these ocean races, is +extremely perfect; and I conceive in such a festival that almost +every sound and movement fell in one. So much the more unanimously +must have grown the agitation of the feasters; so much the more +wild must have been the scene to any European who could have beheld +them there, in the strong sun and the strong shadow of the banyan, +rubbed with saffron to throw in a more high relief the arabesque of +the tattoo; the women bleached by days of confinement to a +complexion almost European; the chiefs crowned with silver plumes +of old men's beards and girt with kirtles of the hair of dead +women. All manner of island food was meanwhile spread for the +women and the commons; and, for those who were privileged to eat of +it, there were carried up to the dead-house the baskets of long- +pig. It is told that the feasts were long kept up; the people came +from them brutishly exhausted with debauchery, and the chiefs heavy +with their beastly food. There are certain sentiments which we +call emphatically human--denying the honour of that name to those +who lack them. In such feasts--particularly where the victim has +been slain at home, and men banqueted on the poor clay of a comrade +with whom they had played in infancy, or a woman whose favours they +had shared--the whole body of these sentiments is outraged. To +consider it too closely is to understand, if not to excuse, the +fervours of self-righteous old ship-captains, who would man their +guns, and open fire in passing, on a cannibal island. + +And yet it was strange. There, upon the spot, as I stood under the +high, dripping vault of the forest, with the young priest on the +one hand, in his kilted gown, and the bright-eyed Marquesan +schoolboy on the other, the whole business appeared infinitely +distant, and fallen in the cold perspective and dry light of +history. The bearing of the priest, perhaps, affected me. He +smiled; he jested with the boy, the heir both of these feasters and +their meat; he clapped his hands, and gave me a stave of one of the +old, ill-omened choruses. Centuries might have come and gone since +this slimy theatre was last in operation; and I beheld the place +with no more emotion than I might have felt in visiting Stonehenge. +In Hiva-oa, as I began to appreciate that the thing was still +living and latent about my footsteps, and that it was still within +the bounds of possibility that I might hear the cry of the trapped +victim, my historic attitude entirely failed, and I was sensible of +some repugnance for the natives. But here, too, the priests +maintained their jocular attitude: rallying the cannibals as upon +an eccentricity rather absurd than horrible; seeking, I should say, +to shame them from the practice by good-natured ridicule, as we +shame a child from stealing sugar. We may here recognise the +temperate and sagacious mind of Bishop Dordillon. + + + +CHAPTER XII--THE STORY OF A PLANTATION + + + +Taahauku, on the south-westerly coast of the island of Hiva-oa-- +Tahuku, say the slovenly whites--may be called the port of Atuona. +It is a narrow and small anchorage, set between low cliffy points, +and opening above upon a woody valley: a little French fort, now +disused and deserted, overhangs the valley and the inlet. Atuona +itself, at the head of the next bay, is framed in a theatre of +mountains, which dominate the more immediate settling of Taahauku +and give the salient character of the scene. They are reckoned at +no higher than four thousand feet; but Tahiti with eight thousand, +and Hawaii with fifteen, can offer no such picture of abrupt, +melancholy alps. In the morning, when the sun falls directly on +their front, they stand like a vast wall: green to the summit, if +by any chance the summit should be clear--water-courses here and +there delineated on their face, as narrow as cracks. Towards +afternoon, the light falls more obliquely, and the sculpture of the +range comes in relief, huge gorges sinking into shadow, huge, +tortuous buttresses standing edged with sun. At all hours of the +day they strike the eye with some new beauty, and the mind with the +same menacing gloom. + +The mountains, dividing and deflecting the endless airy deluge of +the Trade, are doubtless answerable for the climate. A strong +draught of wind blew day and night over the anchorage. Day and +night the same fantastic and attenuated clouds fled across the +heavens, the same dusky cap of rain and vapour fell and rose on the +mountain. The land-breezes came very strong and chill, and the +sea, like the air, was in perpetual bustle. The swell crowded into +the narrow anchorage like sheep into a fold; broke all along both +sides, high on the one, low on the other; kept a certain blowhole +sounding and smoking like a cannon; and spent itself at last upon +the beach. + +On the side away from Atuona, the sheltering promontory was a +nursery of coco-trees. Some were mere infants, none had attained +to any size, none had yet begun to shoot skyward with that whip- +like shaft of the mature palm. In the young trees the colour +alters with the age and growth. Now all is of a grass-like hue, +infinitely dainty; next the rib grows golden, the fronds remaining +green as ferns; and then, as the trunk continues to mount and to +assume its final hue of grey, the fans put on manlier and more +decided depths of verdure, stand out dark upon the distance, +glisten against the sun, and flash like silver fountains in the +assault of the wind. In this young wood of Taahauku, all these +hues and combinations were exampled and repeated by the score. The +trees grew pleasantly spaced upon a hilly sward, here and there +interspersed with a rack for drying copra, or a tumble-down hut for +storing it. Every here and there the stroller had a glimpse of the +Casco tossing in the narrow anchorage below; and beyond he had ever +before him the dark amphitheatre of the Atuona mountains and the +cliffy bluff that closes it to seaward. The trade-wind moving in +the fans made a ceaseless noise of summer rain; and from time to +time, with the sound of a sudden and distant drum-beat, the surf +would burst in a sea-cave. + +At the upper end of the inlet, its low, cliffy lining sinks, at +both sides, into a beach. A copra warehouse stands in the shadow +of the shoreside trees, flitted about for ever by a clan of +dwarfish swallows; and a line of rails on a high wooden staging +bends back into the mouth of the valley. Walking on this, the new- +landed traveller becomes aware of a broad fresh-water lagoon (one +arm of which he crosses), and beyond, of a grove of noble palms, +sheltering the house of the trader, Mr. Keane. Overhead, the cocos +join in a continuous and lofty roof; blackbirds are heard lustily +singing; the island cock springs his jubilant rattle and airs his +golden plumage; cow-bells sound far and near in the grove; and when +you sit in the broad verandah, lulled by this symphony, you may say +to yourself, if you are able: 'Better fifty years of Europe . . .' +Farther on, the floor of the valley is flat and green, and dotted +here and there with stripling coco-palms. Through the midst, with +many changes of music, the river trots and brawls; and along its +course, where we should look for willows, puraos grow in clusters, +and make shadowy pools after an angler's heart. A vale more rich +and peaceful, sweeter air, a sweeter voice of rural sounds, I have +found nowhere. One circumstance alone might strike the +experienced: here is a convenient beach, deep soil, good water, +and yet nowhere any paepaes, nowhere any trace of island +habitation. + +It is but a few years since this valley was a place choked with +jungle, the debatable land and battle-ground of cannibals. Two +clans laid claim to it--neither could substantiate the claim, and +the roads lay desert, or were only visited by men in arms. It is +for this very reason that it wears now so smiling an appearance: +cleared, planted, built upon, supplied with railways, boat-houses, +and bath-houses. For, being no man's land, it was the more readily +ceded to a stranger. The stranger was Captain John Hart: Ima +Hati, 'Broken-arm,' the natives call him, because when he first +visited the islands his arm was in a sling. Captain Hart, a man of +English birth, but an American subject, had conceived the idea of +cotton culture in the Marquesas during the American War, and was at +first rewarded with success. His plantation at Anaho was highly +productive; island cotton fetched a high price, and the natives +used to debate which was the stronger power, Ima Hati or the +French: deciding in favour of the captain, because, though the +French had the most ships, he had the more money. + +He marked Taahauku for a suitable site, acquired it, and offered +the superintendence to Mr. Robert Stewart, a Fifeshire man, already +some time in the islands, who had just been ruined by a war on +Tauata. Mr. Stewart was somewhat averse to the adventure, having +some acquaintance with Atuona and its notorious chieftain, Moipu. +He had once landed there, he told me, about dusk, and found the +remains of a man and woman partly eaten. On his starting and +sickening at the sight, one of Moipu's young men picked up a human +foot, and provocatively staring at the stranger, grinned and +nibbled at the heel. None need be surprised if Mr. Stewart fled +incontinently to the bush, lay there all night in a great horror of +mind, and got off to sea again by daylight on the morrow. 'It was +always a bad place, Atuona,' commented Mr. Stewart, in his homely +Fifeshire voice. In spite of this dire introduction, he accepted +the captain's offer, was landed at Taahauku with three Chinamen, +and proceeded to clear the jungle. + +War was pursued at that time, almost without interval, between the +men of Atuona and the men of Haamau; and one day, from the opposite +sides of the valley, battle--or I should rather say the noise of +battle--raged all the afternoon: the shots and insults of the +opposing clans passing from hill to hill over the heads of Mr. +Stewart and his Chinamen. There was no genuine fighting; it was +like a bicker of schoolboys, only some fool had given the children +guns. One man died of his exertions in running, the only casualty. +With night the shots and insults ceased; the men of Haamau +withdrew; and victory, on some occult principle, was scored to +Moipu. Perhaps, in consequence, there came a day when Moipu made a +feast, and a party from Haamau came under safe-conduct to eat of +it. These passed early by Taahauku, and some of Moipu's young men +were there to be a guard of honour. They were not long gone before +there came down from Haamau, a man, his wife, and a girl of twelve, +their daughter, bringing fungus. Several Atuona lads were hanging +round the store; but the day being one of truce none apprehended +danger. The fungus was weighed and paid for; the man of Haamau +proposed he should have his axe ground in the bargain; and Mr. +Stewart demurring at the trouble, some of the Atuona lads offered +to grind it for him, and set it on the wheel. While the axe was +grinding, a friendly native whispered Mr. Stewart to have a care of +himself, for there was trouble in hand; and, all at once, the man +of Haamau was seized, and his head and arm stricken from his body, +the head at one sweep of his own newly sharpened axe. In the first +alert, the girl escaped among the cotton; and Mr. Stewart, having +thrust the wife into the house and locked her in from the outside, +supposed the affair was over. But the business had not passed +without noise, and it reached the ears of an older girl who had +loitered by the way, and who now came hastily down the valley, +crying as she came for her father. Her, too, they seized and +beheaded; I know not what they had done with the axe, it was a +blunt knife that served their butcherly turn upon the girl; and the +blood spurted in fountains and painted them from head to foot. +Thus horrible from crime, the party returned to Atuona, carrying +the heads to Moipu. It may be fancied how the feast broke up; but +it is notable that the guests were honourably suffered to retire. +These passed back through Taahauku in extreme disorder; a little +after the valley began to be overrun with shouting and triumphing +braves; and a letter of warning coming at the same time to Mr. +Stewart, he and his Chinamen took refuge with the Protestant +missionary in Atuona. That night the store was gutted, and the +bodies cast in a pit and covered with leaves. Three days later the +schooner had come in; and things appearing quieter, Mr. Stewart and +the captain landed in Taahauku to compute the damage and to view +the grave, which was already indicated by the stench. While they +were so employed, a party of Moipu's young men, decked with red +flannel to indicate martial sentiments, came over the hills from +Atuona, dug up the bodies, washed them in the river, and carried +them away on sticks. That night the feast began. + +Those who knew Mr. Stewart before this experience declare the man +to be quite altered. He stuck, however, to his post; and somewhat +later, when the plantation was already well established, and gave +employment to sixty Chinamen and seventy natives, he found himself +once more in dangerous times. The men of Haamau, it was reported, +had sworn to plunder and erase the settlement; letters came +continually from the Hawaiian missionary, who acted as intelligence +department; and for six weeks Mr. Stewart and three other whites +slept in the cotton-house at night in a rampart of bales, and (what +was their best defence) ostentatiously practised rifle-shooting by +day upon the beach. Natives were often there to watch them; the +practice was excellent; and the assault was never delivered--if it +ever was intended, which I doubt, for the natives are more famous +for false rumours than for deeds of energy. I was told the late +French war was a case in point; the tribes on the beach accusing +those in the mountains of designs which they had never the +hardihood to entertain. And the same testimony to their +backwardness in open battle reached me from all sides. Captain +Hart once landed after an engagement in a certain bay; one man had +his hand hurt, an old woman and two children had been slain; and +the captain improved the occasion by poulticing the hand, and +taunting both sides upon so wretched an affair. It is true these +wars were often merely formal--comparable with duels to the first +blood. Captain Hart visited a bay where such a war was being +carried on between two brothers, one of whom had been thought +wanting in civility to the guests of the other. About one-half of +the population served day about on alternate sides, so as to be +well with each when the inevitable peace should follow. The forts +of the belligerents were over against each other, and close by. +Pigs were cooking. Well-oiled braves, with well-oiled muskets, +strutted on the paepae or sat down to feast. No business, however +needful, could be done, and all thoughts were supposed to be +centred in this mockery of war. A few days later, by a regrettable +accident, a man was killed; it was felt at once the thing had gone +too far, and the quarrel was instantly patched up. But the more +serious wars were prosecuted in a similar spirit; a gift of pigs +and a feast made their inevitable end; the killing of a single man +was a great victory, and the murder of defenceless solitaries +counted a heroic deed. + +The foot of the cliffs, about all these islands, is the place of +fishing. Between Taahauku and Atuona we saw men, but chiefly +women, some nearly naked, some in thin white or crimson dresses, +perched in little surf-beat promontories--the brown precipice +overhanging them, and the convolvulus overhanging that, as if to +cut them off the more completely from assistance. There they would +angle much of the morning; and as fast as they caught any fish, eat +them, raw and living, where they stood. It was such helpless ones +that the warriors from the opposite island of Tauata slew, and +carried home and ate, and were thereupon accounted mighty men of +valour. Of one such exploit I can give the account of an eye- +witness. 'Portuguese Joe,' Mr. Keane's cook, was once pulling an +oar in an Atuona boat, when they spied a stranger in a canoe with +some fish and a piece of tapu. The Atuona men cried upon him to +draw near and have a smoke. He complied, because, I suppose, he +had no choice; but he knew, poor devil, what he was coming to, and +(as Joe said) 'he didn't seem to care about the smoke.' A few +questions followed, as to where he came from, and what was his +business. These he must needs answer, as he must needs draw at the +unwelcome pipe, his heart the while drying in his bosom. And then, +of a sudden, a big fellow in Joe's boat leaned over, plucked the +stranger from his canoe, struck him with a knife in the neck-- +inward and downward, as Joe showed in pantomime more expressive +than his words--and held him under water, like a fowl, until his +struggles ceased. Whereupon the long-pig was hauled on board, the +boat's head turned about for Atuona, and these Marquesan braves +pulled home rejoicing. Moipu was on the beach and rejoiced with +them on their arrival. Poor Joe toiled at his oar that day with a +white face, yet he had no fear for himself. 'They were very good +to me--gave me plenty grub: never wished to eat white man,' said +he. + +If the most horrible experience was Mr. Stewart's, it was Captain +Hart himself who ran the nearest danger. He had bought a piece of +land from Timau, chief of a neighbouring bay, and put some Chinese +there to work. Visiting the station with one of the Godeffroys, he +found his Chinamen trooping to the beach in terror: Timau had +driven them out, seized their effects, and was in war attire with +his young men. A boat was despatched to Taahauku for +reinforcement; as they awaited her return, they could see, from the +deck of the schooner, Timau and his young men dancing the war-dance +on the hill-top till past twelve at night; and so soon as the boat +came (bringing three gendarmes, armed with chassepots, two white +men from Taahauku station, and some native warriors) the party set +out to seize the chief before he should awake. Day was not come, +and it was a very bright moonlight morning, when they reached the +hill-top where (in a house of palm-leaves) Timau was sleeping off +his debauch. The assailants were fully exposed, the interior of +the hut quite dark; the position far from sound. The gendarmes +knelt with their pieces ready, and Captain Hart advanced alone. As +he drew near the door he heard the snap of a gun cocking from +within, and in sheer self-defence--there being no other escape-- +sprang into the house and grappled Timau. 'Timau, come with me!' +he cried. But Timau--a great fellow, his eyes blood-red with the +abuse of kava, six foot three in stature--cast him on one side; and +the captain, instantly expecting to be either shot or brained, +discharged his pistol in the dark. When they carried Timau out at +the door into the moonlight, he was already dead, and, upon this +unlooked-for termination of their sally, the whites appeared to +have lost all conduct, and retreated to the boats, fired upon by +the natives as they went. Captain Hart, who almost rivals Bishop +Dordillon in popularity, shared with him the policy of extreme +indulgence to the natives, regarding them as children, making light +of their defects, and constantly in favour of mild measures. The +death of Timau has thus somewhat weighed upon his mind; the more +so, as the chieftain's musket was found in the house unloaded. To +a less delicate conscience the matter will seem light. If a +drunken savage elects to cock a fire-arm, a gentleman advancing +towards him in the open cannot wait to make sure if it be charged. + +I have touched on the captain's popularity. It is one of the +things that most strikes a stranger in the Marquesas. He comes +instantly on two names, both new to him, both locally famous, both +mentioned by all with affection and respect--the bishop's and the +captain's. It gave me a strong desire to meet with the survivor, +which was subsequently gratified--to the enrichment of these pages. +Long after that again, in the Place Dolorous--Molokai--I came once +more on the traces of that affectionate popularity. There was a +blind white leper there, an old sailor--'an old tough,' he called +himself--who had long sailed among the eastern islands. Him I used +to visit, and, being fresh from the scenes of his activity, gave +him the news. This (in the true island style) was largely a +chronicle of wrecks; and it chanced I mentioned the case of one not +very successful captain, and how he had lost a vessel for Mr. Hart; +thereupon the blind leper broke forth in lamentation. 'Did he lose +a ship of John Hart's?' he cried; 'poor John Hart! Well, I'm sorry +it was Hart's,' with needless force of epithet, which I neglect to +reproduce. + +Perhaps, if Captain Hart's affairs had continued to prosper, his +popularity might have been different. Success wins glory, but it +kills affection, which misfortune fosters. And the misfortune +which overtook the captain's enterprise was truly singular. He was +at the top of his career. Ile Masse belonged to him, given by the +French as an indemnity for the robberies at Taahauku. But the Ile +Masse was only suitable for cattle; and his two chief stations were +Anaho, in Nuka-hiva, facing the north-east, and Taahauku in Hiva- +oa, some hundred miles to the southward, and facing the south-west. +Both these were on the same day swept by a tidal wave, which was +not felt in any other bay or island of the group. The south coast +of Hiva-oa was bestrewn with building timber and camphor-wood +chests, containing goods; which, on the promise of a reasonable +salvage, the natives very honestly brought back, the chests +apparently not opened, and some of the wood after it had been built +into their houses. But the recovery of such jetsam could not +affect the result. It was impossible the captain should withstand +this partiality of fortune; and with his fall the prosperity of the +Marquesas ended. Anaho is truly extinct, Taahauku but a shadow of +itself; nor has any new plantation arisen in their stead. + + + +CHAPTER XIII--CHARACTERS + + + +There was a certain traffic in our anchorage at Atuona; different +indeed from the dead inertia and quiescence of the sister island, +Nuka-hiva. Sails were seen steering from its mouth; now it would +be a whale-boat manned with native rowdies, and heavy with copra +for sale; now perhaps a single canoe come after commodities to buy. +The anchorage was besides frequented by fishers; not only the lone +females perched in niches of the cliff, but whole parties, who +would sometimes camp and build a fire upon the beach, and sometimes +lie in their canoes in the midst of the haven and jump by turns in +the water; which they would cast eight or nine feet high, to drive, +as we supposed, the fish into their nets. The goods the purchasers +came to buy were sometimes quaint. I remarked one outrigger +returning with a single ham swung from a pole in the stern. And +one day there came into Mr. Keane's store a charming lad, +excellently mannered, speaking French correctly though with a +babyish accent; very handsome too, and much of a dandy, as was +shown not only in his shining raiment, but by the nature of his +purchases. These were five ship-biscuits, a bottle of scent, and +two balls of washing blue. He was from Tauata, whither he returned +the same night in an outrigger, daring the deep with these young- +ladyish treasures. The gross of the native passengers were more +ill-favoured: tall, powerful fellows, well tattooed, and with +disquieting manners. Something coarse and jeering distinguished +them, and I was often reminded of the slums of some great city. +One night, as dusk was falling, a whale-boat put in on that part of +the beach where I chanced to be alone. Six or seven ruffianly +fellows scrambled out; all had enough English to give me 'good- +bye,' which was the ordinary salutation; or 'good-morning,' which +they seemed to regard as an intensitive; jests followed, they +surrounded me with harsh laughter and rude looks, and I was glad to +move away. I had not yet encountered Mr. Stewart, or I should have +been reminded of his first landing at Atuona and the humorist who +nibbled at the heel. But their neighbourhood depressed me; and I +felt, if I had been there a castaway and out of reach of help, my +heart would have been sick. + +Nor was the traffic altogether native. While we lay in the +anchorage there befell a strange coincidence. A schooner was +observed at sea and aiming to enter. We knew all the schooners in +the group, but this appeared larger than any; she was rigged, +besides, after the English manner; and, coming to an anchor some +way outside the Casco, showed at last the blue ensign. There were +at that time, according to rumour, no fewer than four yachts in the +Pacific; but it was strange that any two of them should thus lie +side by side in that outlandish inlet: stranger still that in the +owner of the Nyanza, Captain Dewar, I should find a man of the same +country and the same county with myself, and one whom I had seen +walking as a boy on the shores of the Alpes Maritimes. + +We had besides a white visitor from shore, who came and departed in +a crowded whale-boat manned by natives; having read of yachts in +the Sunday papers, and being fired with the desire to see one. +Captain Chase, they called him, an old whaler-man, thickset and +white-bearded, with a strong Indiana drawl; years old in the +country, a good backer in battle, and one of those dead shots whose +practice at the target struck terror in the braves of Haamau. +Captain Chase dwelt farther east in a bay called Hanamate, with a +Mr. M'Callum; or rather they had dwelt together once, and were now +amicably separated. The captain is to be found near one end of the +bay, in a wreck of a house, and waited on by a Chinese. At the +point of the opposing corner another habitation stands on a tall +paepae. The surf runs there exceeding heavy, seas of seven and +eight feet high bursting under the walls of the house, which is +thus continually filled with their clamour, and rendered fit only +for solitary, or at least for silent, inmates. Here it is that Mr. +M'Callum, with a Shakespeare and a Burns, enjoys the society of the +breakers. His name and his Burns testify to Scottish blood; but he +is an American born, somewhere far east; followed the trade of a +ship-carpenter; and was long employed, the captain of a hundred +Indians, breaking up wrecks about Cape Flattery. Many of the +whites who are to be found scattered in the South Seas represent +the more artistic portion of their class; and not only enjoy the +poetry of that new life, but came there on purpose to enjoy it. I +have been shipmates with a man, no longer young, who sailed upon +that voyage, his first time to sea, for the mere love of Samoa; and +it was a few letters in a newspaper that sent him on that +pilgrimage. Mr. M'Callum was another instance of the same. He had +read of the South Seas; loved to read of them; and let their image +fasten in his heart: till at length he could refrain no longer-- +must set forth, a new Rudel, for that unseen homeland--and has now +dwelt for years in Hiva-oa, and will lay his bones there in the end +with full content; having no desire to behold again the places of +his boyhood, only, perhaps--once, before he dies--the rude and +wintry landscape of Cape Flattery. Yet he is an active man, full +of schemes; has bought land of the natives; has planted five +thousand coco-palms; has a desert island in his eye, which he +desires to lease, and a schooner in the stocks, which he has laid +and built himself, and even hopes to finish. Mr. M'Callum and I +did not meet, but, like gallant troubadours, corresponded in verse. +I hope he will not consider it a breach of copyright if I give here +a specimen of his muse. He and Bishop Dordillon are the two +European bards of the Marquesas. + + +'Sail, ho! Ahoy! Casco, +First among the pleasure fleet +That came around to greet +These isles from San Francisco, + +And first, too; only one +Among the literary men +That this way has ever been - +Welcome, then, to Stevenson. + +Please not offended be +At this little notice +Of the Casco, Captain Otis, +With the novelist's family. + +Avoir une voyage magnifical +Is our wish sincere, +That you'll have from here +Allant sur la Grande Pacifical.' + + +But our chief visitor was one Mapiao, a great Tahuku--which seems +to mean priest, wizard, tattooer, practiser of any art, or, in a +word, esoteric person--and a man famed for his eloquence on public +occasions and witty talk in private. His first appearance was +typical of the man. He came down clamorous to the eastern landing, +where the surf was running very high; scorned all our signals to go +round the bay; carried his point, was brought aboard at some hazard +to our skiff, and set down in one corner of the cockpit to his +appointed task. He had been hired, as one cunning in the art, to +make my old men's beards into a wreath: what a wreath for Celia's +arbour! His own beard (which he carried, for greater safety, in a +sailor's knot) was not merely the adornment of his age, but a +substantial piece of property. One hundred dollars was the +estimated value; and as Brother Michel never knew a native to +deposit a greater sum with Bishop Dordillon, our friend was a rich +man in virtue of his chin. He had something of an East Indian +cast, but taller and stronger: his nose hooked, his face narrow, +his forehead very high, the whole elaborately tattooed. I may say +I have never entertained a guest so trying. In the least +particular he must be waited on; he would not go to the scuttle- +butt for water; he would not even reach to get the glass, it must +be given him in his hand; if aid were denied him, he would fold his +arms, bow his head, and go without: only the work would suffer. +Early the first forenoon he called aloud for biscuit and salmon; +biscuit and ham were brought; he looked on them inscrutably, and +signed they should be set aside. A number of considerations +crowded on my mind; how the sort of work on which he was engaged +was probably tapu in a high degree; should by rights, perhaps, be +transacted on a tapu platform which no female might approach; and +it was possible that fish might be the essential diet. Some salted +fish I therefore brought him, and along with that a glass of rum: +at sight of which Mapiao displayed extraordinary animation, pointed +to the zenith, made a long speech in which I picked up umati--the +word for the sun--and signed to me once more to place these +dainties out of reach. At last I had understood, and every day the +programme was the same. At an early period of the morning his +dinner must be set forth on the roof of the house and at a proper +distance, full in view but just out of reach; and not until the fit +hour, which was the point of noon, would the artificer partake. +This solemnity was the cause of an absurd misadventure. He was +seated plaiting, as usual, at the beards, his dinner arrayed on the +roof, and not far off a glass of water standing. It appears he +desired to drink; was of course far too great a gentleman to rise +and get the water for himself; and spying Mrs. Stevenson, +imperiously signed to her to hand it. The signal was +misunderstood; Mrs. Stevenson was, by this time, prepared for any +eccentricity on the part of our guest; and instead of passing him +the water, flung his dinner overboard. I must do Mapiao justice: +all laughed, but his laughter rang the loudest. + +These troubles of service were at worst occasional; the +embarrassment of the man's talk incessant. He was plainly a +practised conversationalist; the nicety of his inflections, the +elegance of his gestures, and the fine play of his expression, told +us that. We, meanwhile, sat like aliens in a playhouse; we could +see the actors were upon some material business and performing +well, but the plot of the drama remained undiscoverable. Names of +places, the name of Captain Hart, occasional disconnected words, +tantalised without enlightening us; and the less we understood, the +more gallantly, the more copiously, and with still the more +explanatory gestures, Mapiao returned to the assault. We could see +his vanity was on the rack; being come to a place where that fine +jewel of his conversational talent could earn him no respect; and +he had times of despair when he desisted from the endeavour, and +instants of irritation when he regarded us with unconcealed +contempt. Yet for me, as the practitioner of some kindred mystery +to his own, he manifested to the last a measure of respect. As we +sat under the awning in opposite corners of the cockpit, he +braiding hairs from dead men's chins, I forming runes upon a sheet +of folio paper, he would nod across to me as one Tahuku to another, +or, crossing the cockpit, study for a while my shapeless scrawl and +encourage me with a heartfelt 'mitai!--good!' So might a deaf +painter sympathise far off with a musician, as the slave and master +of some uncomprehended and yet kindred art. A silly trade, he +doubtless considered it; but a man must make allowance for +barbarians--chaque pays a ses coutumes--and he felt the principle +was there. + +The time came at last when his labours, which resembled those +rather of Penelope than Hercules, could be no more spun out, and +nothing remained but to pay him and say farewell. After a long, +learned argument in Marquesan, I gathered that his mind was set on +fish-hooks; with three of which, and a brace of dollars, I thought +he was not ill rewarded for passing his forenoons in our cockpit, +eating, drinking, delivering his opinions, and pressing the ship's +company into his menial service. For all that, he was a man of so +high a bearing, and so like an uncle of my own who should have gone +mad and got tattooed, that I applied to him, when we were both on +shore, to know if he were satisfied. 'Mitai ehipe?' I asked. And +he, with rich unction, offering at the same time his hand--'Mitai +ehipe, mitai kaehae; kaoha nui!'--or, to translate freely: 'The +ship is good, the victuals are up to the mark, and we part in +friendship.' Which testimonial uttered, he set off along the beach +with his head bowed and the air of one deeply injured. + +I saw him go, on my side, with relief. It would be more +interesting to learn how our relation seemed to Mapiao. His +exigence, we may suppose, was merely loyal. He had been hired by +the ignorant to do a piece of work; and he was bound that he would +do it the right way. Countless obstacles, continual ignorant +ridicule, availed not to dissuade him. He had his dinner laid out; +watched it, as was fit, the while he worked; ate it at the fit +hour; was in all things served and waited on; and could take his +hire in the end with a clear conscience, telling himself the +mystery was performed duly, the beards rightfully braided, and we +(in spite of ourselves) correctly served. His view of our +stupidity, even he, the mighty talker, must have lacked language to +express. He never interfered with my Tahuku work; civilly praised +it, idle as it seemed; civilly supposed that I was competent in my +own mystery: such being the attitude of the intelligent and the +polite. And we, on the other hand--who had yet the most to gain or +lose, since the product was to be ours--who had professed our +disability by the very act of hiring him to do it--were never weary +of impeding his own more important labours, and sometimes lacked +the sense and the civility to refrain from laughter. + + + +CHAPTER XIV--IN A CANNIBAL VALLEY + + + +The road from Taahauku to Atuona skirted the north-westerly side of +the anchorage, somewhat high up, edged, and sometimes shaded, by +the splendid flowers of the flamboyant--its English name I do not +know. At the turn of the hand, Atuona came in view: a long beach, +a heavy and loud breach of surf, a shore-side village scattered +among trees, and the guttered mountains drawing near on both sides +above a narrow and rich ravine. Its infamous repute perhaps +affected me; but I thought it the loveliest, and by far the most +ominous and gloomy, spot on earth. Beautiful it surely was; and +even more salubrious. The healthfulness of the whole group is +amazing; that of Atuona almost in the nature of a miracle. In +Atuona, a village planted in a shore-side marsh, the houses +standing everywhere intermingled with the pools of a taro-garden, +we find every condition of tropical danger and discomfort; and yet +there are not even mosquitoes--not even the hateful day-fly of +Nuka-hiva--and fever, and its concomitant, the island fe'efe'e, are +unknown. + +This is the chief station of the French on the man-eating isle of +Hiva-oa. The sergeant of gendarmerie enjoys the style of the vice- +resident, and hoists the French colours over a quite extensive +compound. A Chinaman, a waif from the plantation, keeps a +restaurant in the rear quarters of the village; and the mission is +well represented by the sister's school and Brother Michel's +church. Father Orens, a wonderful octogenarian, his frame scarce +bowed, the fire of his eye undimmed, has lived, and trembled, and +suffered in this place since 1843. Again and again, when Moipu had +made coco-brandy, he has been driven from his house into the woods. +'A mouse that dwelt in a cat's ear' had a more easy resting-place; +and yet I have never seen a man that bore less mark of years. He +must show us the church, still decorated with the bishop's artless +ornaments of paper--the last work of industrious old hands, and the +last earthly amusement of a man that was much of a hero. In the +sacristy we must see his sacred vessels, and, in particular, a +vestment which was a 'vraie curiosite,' because it had been given +by a gendarme. To the Protestant there is always something +embarrassing in the eagerness with which grown and holy men regard +these trifles; but it was touching and pretty to see Orens, his +aged eyes shining in his head, display his sacred treasures. + +August 26.--The vale behind the village, narrowing swiftly to a +mere ravine, was choked with profitable trees. A river gushed in +the midst. Overhead, the tall coco-palms made a primary covering; +above that, from one wall of the mountain to another, the ravine +was roofed with cloud; so that we moved below, amid teeming +vegetation, in a covered house of heat. On either hand, at every +hundred yards, instead of the houseless, disembowelling paepaes of +Nuka-hiva, populous houses turned out their inhabitants to cry +'Kaoha!' to the passers-by. The road, too, was busy: strings of +girls, fair and foul, as in less favoured countries; men bearing +breadfruit; the sisters, with a little guard of pupils; a fellow +bestriding a horse--passed and greeted us continually; and now it +was a Chinaman who came to the gate of his flower-yard, and gave us +'Good-day' in excellent English; and a little farther on it would +be some natives who set us down by the wayside, made us a feast of +mummy-apple, and entertained us as we ate with drumming on a tin +case. With all this fine plenty of men and fruit, death is at work +here also. The population, according to the highest estimate, does +not exceed six hundred in the whole vale of Atuona; and yet, when I +once chanced to put the question, Brother Michel counted up ten +whom he knew to be sick beyond recovery. It was here, too, that I +could at last gratify my curiosity with the sight of a native house +in the very article of dissolution. It had fallen flat along the +paepae, its poles sprawling ungainly; the rains and the mites +contended against it; what remained seemed sound enough, but much +was gone already; and it was easy to see how the insects consumed +the walls as if they had been bread, and the air and the rain ate +into them like vitriol. + +A little ahead of us, a young gentleman, very well tattooed, and +dressed in a pair of white trousers and a flannel shirt, had been +marching unconcernedly. Of a sudden, without apparent cause, he +turned back, took us in possession, and led us undissuadably along +a by-path to the river's edge. There, in a nook of the most +attractive amenity, he bade us to sit down: the stream splashing +at our elbow, a shock of nondescript greenery enshrining us from +above; and thither, after a brief absence, he brought us a cocoa- +nut, a lump of sandal-wood, and a stick he had begun to carve: the +nut for present refreshment, the sandal-wood for a precious gift, +and the stick--in the simplicity of his vanity--to harvest +premature praise. Only one section was yet carved, although the +whole was pencil-marked in lengths; and when I proposed to buy it, +Poni (for that was the artist's name) recoiled in horror. But I +was not to be moved, and simply refused restitution, for I had long +wondered why a people who displayed, in their tattooing, so great a +gift of arabesque invention, should display it nowhere else. Here, +at last, I had found something of the same talent in another +medium; and I held the incompleteness, in these days of world-wide +brummagem, for a happy mark of authenticity. Neither my reasons +nor my purpose had I the means of making clear to Poni; I could +only hold on to the stick, and bid the artist follow me to the +gendarmerie, where I should find interpreters and money; but we +gave him, in the meanwhile, a boat-call in return for his sandal- +wood. As he came behind us down the vale he sounded upon this +continually. And continually, from the wayside houses, there +poured forth little groups of girls in crimson, or of men in white. +And to these must Poni pass the news of who the strangers were, of +what they had been doing, of why it was that Poni had a boat- +whistle; and of why he was now being haled to the vice-residency, +uncertain whether to be punished or rewarded, uncertain whether he +had lost a stick or made a bargain, but hopeful on the whole, and +in the meanwhile highly consoled by the boat-whistle. Whereupon he +would tear himself away from this particular group of inquirers, +and once more we would hear the shrill call in our wake. + +August 27.--I made a more extended circuit in the vale with Brother +Michel. We were mounted on a pair of sober nags, suitable to these +rude paths; the weather was exquisite, and the company in which I +found myself no less agreeable than the scenes through which I +passed. We mounted at first by a steep grade along the summit of +one of those twisted spurs that, from a distance, mark out +provinces of sun and shade upon the mountain-side. The ground fell +away on either hand with an extreme declivity. From either hand, +out of profound ravines, mounted the song of falling water and the +smoke of household fires. Here and there the hills of foliage +would divide, and our eye would plunge down upon one of these deep- +nested habitations. And still, high in front, arose the +precipitous barrier of the mountain, greened over where it seemed +that scarce a harebell could find root, barred with the zigzags of +a human road where it seemed that not a goat could scramble. And +in truth, for all the labour that it cost, the road is regarded +even by the Marquesans as impassable; they will not risk a horse on +that ascent; and those who lie to the westward come and go in their +canoes. I never knew a hill to lose so little on a near approach: +a consequence, I must suppose, of its surprising steepness. When +we turned about, I was amazed to behold so deep a view behind, and +so high a shoulder of blue sea, crowned by the whale-like island of +Motane. And yet the wall of mountain had not visibly dwindled, and +I could even have fancied, as I raised my eyes to measure it, that +it loomed higher than before. + +We struck now into covert paths, crossed and heard more near at +hand the bickering of the streams, and tasted the coolness of those +recesses where the houses stood. The birds sang about us as we +descended. All along our path my guide was being hailed by voices: +'Mikael--Kaoha, Mikael!' From the doorstep, from the cotton-patch, +or out of the deep grove of island-chestnuts, these friendly cries +arose, and were cheerily answered as we passed. In a sharp angle +of a glen, on a rushing brook and under fathoms of cool foliage, we +struck a house upon a well-built paepae, the fire brightly burning +under the popoi-shed against the evening meal; and here the cries +became a chorus, and the house folk, running out, obliged us to +dismount and breathe. It seemed a numerous family: we saw eight +at least; and one of these honoured me with a particular attention. +This was the mother, a woman naked to the waist, of an aged +countenance, but with hair still copious and black, and breasts +still erect and youthful. On our arrival I could see she remarked +me, but instead of offering any greeting, disappeared at once into +the bush. Thence she returned with two crimson flowers. 'Good- +bye!' was her salutation, uttered not without coquetry; and as she +said it she pressed the flowers into my hand--'Good-bye! I speak +Inglis.' It was from a whaler-man, who (she informed me) was 'a +plenty good chap,' that she had learned my language; and I could +not but think how handsome she must have been in these times of her +youth, and could not but guess that some memories of the dandy +whaler-man prompted her attentions to myself. Nor could I refrain +from wondering what had befallen her lover; in the rain and mire of +what sea-ports he had tramped since then; in what close and garish +drinking-dens had found his pleasure; and in the ward of what +infirmary dreamed his last of the Marquesas. But she, the more +fortunate, lived on in her green island. The talk, in this lost +house upon the mountains, ran chiefly upon Mapiao and his visits to +the Casco: the news of which had probably gone abroad by then to +all the island, so that there was no paepae in Hiva-oa where they +did not make the subject of excited comment. + +Not much beyond we came upon a high place in the foot of the +ravine. Two roads divided it, and met in the midst. Save for this +intersection the amphitheatre was strangely perfect, and had a +certain ruder air of things Roman. Depths of foliage and the bulk +of the mountain kept it in a grateful shadow. On the benches +several young folk sat clustered or apart. One of these, a girl +perhaps fourteen years of age, buxom and comely, caught the eye of +Brother Michel. Why was she not at school?--she was done with +school now. What was she doing here?--she lived here now. Why +so?--no answer but a deepening blush. There was no severity in +Brother Michel's manner; the girl's own confusion told her story. +'Elle a honte,' was the missionary's comment, as we rode away. +Near by in the stream, a grown girl was bathing naked in a goyle +between two stepping-stones; and it amused me to see with what +alacrity and real alarm she bounded on her many-coloured under- +clothes. Even in these daughters of cannibals shame was eloquent. + +It is in Hiva-oa, owing to the inveterate cannibalism of the +natives, that local beliefs have been most rudely trodden +underfoot. It was here that three religious chiefs were set under +a bridge, and the women of the valley made to defile over their +heads upon the road-way: the poor, dishonoured fellows sitting +there (all observers agree) with streaming tears. Not only was one +road driven across the high place, but two roads intersected in its +midst. There is no reason to suppose that the last was done of +purpose, and perhaps it was impossible entirely to avoid the +numerous sacred places of the islands. But these things are not +done without result. I have spoken already of the regard of +Marquesans for the dead, making (as it does) so strange a contrast +with their unconcern for death. Early on this day's ride, for +instance, we encountered a petty chief, who inquired (of course) +where we were going, and suggested by way of amendment. 'Why do +you not rather show him the cemetery?' I saw it; it was but newly +opened, the third within eight years. They are great builders here +in Hiva-oa; I saw in my ride paepaes that no European dry-stone +mason could have equalled, the black volcanic stones were laid so +justly, the corners were so precise, the levels so true; but the +retaining-wall of the new graveyard stood apart, and seemed to be a +work of love. The sentiment of honour for the dead is therefore +not extinct. And yet observe the consequence of violently +countering men's opinions. Of the four prisoners in Atuona gaol, +three were of course thieves; the fourth was there for sacrilege. +He had levelled up a piece of the graveyard--to give a feast upon, +as he informed the court--and declared he had no thought of doing +wrong. Why should he? He had been forced at the point of the +bayonet to destroy the sacred places of his own piety; when he had +recoiled from the task, he had been jeered at for a superstitious +fool. And now it is supposed he will respect our European +superstitions as by second nature. + + + +CHAPTER XV--THE TWO CHIEFS OF ATUONA + + + +It had chanced (as the Casco beat through the Bordelais Straits for +Taahauku) she approached on one board very near the land in the +opposite isle of Tauata, where houses were to be seen in a grove of +tall coco-palms. Brother Michel pointed out the spot. 'I am at +home now,' said he. 'I believe I have a large share in these +cocoa-nuts; and in that house madame my mother lives with her two +husbands!' 'With two husbands?' somebody inquired. 'C'est ma +honte,' replied the brother drily. + +A word in passing on the two husbands. I conceive the brother to +have expressed himself loosely. It seems common enough to find a +native lady with two consorts; but these are not two husbands. The +first is still the husband; the wife continues to be referred to by +his name; and the position of the coadjutor, or pikio, although +quite regular, appears undoubtedly subordinate. We had +opportunities to observe one household of the sort. The pikio was +recognised; appeared openly along with the husband when the lady +was thought to be insulted, and the pair made common cause like +brothers. At home the inequality was more apparent. The husband +sat to receive and entertain visitors; the pikio was running the +while to fetch cocoa-nuts like a hired servant, and I remarked he +was sent on these errands in preference even to the son. Plainly +we have here no second husband; plainly we have the tolerated +lover. Only, in the Marquesas, instead of carrying his lady's fan +and mantle, he must turn his hand to do the husband's housework. + +The sight of Brother Michel's family estate led the conversation +for some while upon the method and consequence of artificial +kinship. Our curiosity became extremely whetted; the brother +offered to have the whole of us adopted, and some two days later we +became accordingly the children of Paaaeua, appointed chief of +Atuona. I was unable to be present at the ceremony, which was +primitively simple. The two Mrs. Stevensons and Mr. Osbourne, +along with Paaaeua, his wife, and an adopted child of theirs, son +of a shipwrecked Austrian, sat down to an excellent island meal, of +which the principal and the only necessary dish was pig. A +concourse watched them through the apertures of the house; but +none, not even Brother Michel, might partake; for the meal was +sacramental, and either creative or declaratory of the new +relationship. In Tahiti things are not so strictly ordered; when +Ori and I 'made brothers,' both our families sat with us at table, +yet only he and I, who had eaten with intention were supposed to be +affected by the ceremony. For the adoption of an infant I believe +no formality to be required; the child is handed over by the +natural parents, and grows up to inherit the estates of the +adoptive. Presents are doubtless exchanged, as at all junctures of +island life, social or international; but I never heard of any +banquet--the child's presence at the daily board perhaps sufficing. +We may find the rationale in the ancient Arabian idea that a common +diet makes a common blood, with its derivative axiom that 'he is +the father who gives the child its morning draught.' In the +Marquesan practice, the sense would thus be evanescent; from the +Tahitian, a mere survival, it will have entirely fled. An +interesting parallel will probably occur to many of my readers. + +What is the nature of the obligation assumed at such a festival? +It will vary with the characters of those engaged, and with the +circumstances of the case. Thus it would be absurd to take too +seriously our adoption at Atuona. On the part of Paaaeua it was an +affair of social ambition; when he agreed to receive us in his +family the man had not so much as seen us, and knew only that we +were inestimably rich and travelled in a floating palace. We, upon +our side, ate of his baked meats with no true animus affiliandi, +but moved by the single sentiment of curiosity. The affair was +formal, and a matter of parade, as when in Europe sovereigns call +each other cousin. Yet, had we stayed at Atuona, Paaaeua would +have held himself bound to establish us upon his land, and to set +apart young men for our service, and trees for our support. I have +mentioned the Austrian. He sailed in one of two sister ships, +which left the Clyde in coal; both rounded the Horn, and both, at +several hundred miles of distance, though close on the same point +of time, took fire at sea on the Pacific. One was destroyed; the +derelict iron frame of the second, after long, aimless cruising, +was at length recovered, refitted, and hails to-day from San +Francisco. A boat's crew from one of these disasters reached, +after great hardships, the isle of Hiva-oa. Some of these men +vowed they would never again confront the chances of the sea; but +alone of them all the Austrian has been exactly true to his +engagement, remains where he landed, and designs to die where he +has lived. Now, with such a man, falling and taking root among +islanders, the processes described may be compared to a gardener's +graft. He passes bodily into the native stock; ceases wholly to be +alien; has entered the commune of the blood, shares the prosperity +and consideration of his new family, and is expected to impart with +the same generosity the fruits of his European skill and knowledge. +It is this implied engagement that so frequently offends the +ingrafted white. To snatch an immediate advantage--to get (let us +say) a station for his store--he will play upon the native custom +and become a son or a brother for the day, promising himself to +cast down the ladder by which he shall have ascended, and repudiate +the kinship so soon as it shall grow burdensome. And he finds +there are two parties to the bargain. Perhaps his Polynesian +relative is simple, and conceived the blood-bond literally; perhaps +he is shrewd, and himself entered the covenant with a view to gain. +And either way the store is ravaged, the house littered with lazy +natives; and the richer the man grows, the more numerous, the more +idle, and the more affectionate he finds his native relatives. +Most men thus circumstanced contrive to buy or brutally manage to +enforce their independence; but many vegetate without hope, +strangled by parasites. + +We had no cause to blush with Brother Michel. Our new parents were +kind, gentle, well-mannered, and generous in gifts; the wife was a +most motherly woman, the husband a man who stood justly high with +his employers. Enough has been said to show why Moipu should be +deposed; and in Paaaeua the French had found a reputable +substitute. He went always scrupulously dressed, and looked the +picture of propriety, like a dark, handsome, stupid, and probably +religious young man hot from a European funeral. In character he +seemed the ideal of what is known as the good citizen. He wore +gravity like an ornament. None could more nicely represent the +desired character as an appointed chief, the outpost of +civilisation and reform. And yet, were the French to go and native +manners to revive, fancy beholds him crowned with old men's beards +and crowding with the first to a man-eating festival. But I must +not seem to be unjust to Paaaeua. His respectability went deeper +than the skin; his sense of the becoming sometimes nerved him for +unexpected rigours. + +One evening Captain Otis and Mr. Osbourne were on shore in the +village. All was agog; dancing had begun; it was plain it was to +be a night of festival, and our adventurers were overjoyed at their +good fortune. A strong fall of rain drove them for shelter to the +house of Paaaeua, where they were made welcome, wiled into a +chamber, and shut in. Presently the rain took off, the fun was to +begin in earnest, and the young bloods of Atuona came round the +house and called to my fellow-travellers through the interstices of +the wall. Late into the night the calls were continued and +resumed, and sometimes mingled with taunts; late into the night the +prisoners, tantalised by the noises of the festival, renewed their +efforts to escape. But all was vain; right across the door lay +that god-fearing householder, Paaaeua, feigning sleep; and my +friends had to forego their junketing. In this incident, so +delightfully European, we thought we could detect three strands of +sentiment. In the first place, Paaaeua had a charge of souls: +these were young men, and he judged it right to withhold them from +the primrose path. Secondly, he was a public character, and it was +not fitting that his guests should countenance a festival of which +he disapproved. So might some strict clergyman at home address a +worldly visitor: 'Go to the theatre if you like, but, by your +leave, not from my house!' Thirdly, Paaaeua was a man jealous, and +with some cause (as shall be shown) for jealousy; and the feasters +were the satellites of his immediate rival, Moipu. + +For the adoption had caused much excitement in the village; it made +the strangers popular. Paaaeua, in his difficult posture of +appointed chief, drew strength and dignity from their alliance, and +only Moipu and his followers were malcontent. For some reason +nobody (except myself) appears to dislike Moipu. Captain Hart, who +has been robbed and threatened by him; Father Orens, whom he has +fired at, and repeatedly driven to the woods; my own family, and +even the French officials--all seemed smitten with an irrepressible +affection for the man. His fall had been made soft; his son, upon +his death, was to succeed Paaaeua in the chieftaincy; and he lived, +at the time of our visit, in the shoreward part of the village in a +good house, and with a strong following of young men, his late +braves and pot-hunters. In this society, the coming of the Casco, +the adoption, the return feast on board, and the presents exchanged +between the whites and their new parents, were doubtless eagerly +and bitterly canvassed. It was felt that a few years ago the +honours would have gone elsewhere. In this unwonted business, in +this reception of some hitherto undreamed-of and outlandish +potentate--some Prester John or old Assaracus--a few years back it +would have been the part of Moipu to play the hero and the host, +and his young men would have accompanied and adorned the various +celebrations as the acknowledged leaders of society. And now, by a +malign vicissitude of fortune, Moipu must sit in his house quite +unobserved; and his young men could but look in at the door while +their rivals feasted. Perhaps M. Grevy felt a touch of bitterness +towards his successor when he beheld him figure on the broad stage +of the centenary of eighty-nine; the visit of the Casco which Moipu +had missed by so few years was a more unusual occasion in Atuona +than a centenary in France; and the dethroned chief determined to +reassert himself in the public eye. + +Mr. Osbourne had gone into Atuona photographing; the population of +the village had gathered together for the occasion on the place +before the church, and Paaaeua, highly delighted with this new +appearance of his family, played the master of ceremonies. The +church had been taken, with its jolly architect before the door; +the nuns with their pupils; sundry damsels in the ancient and +singularly unbecoming robes of tapa; and Father Orens in the midst +of a group of his parishioners. I know not what else was in hand, +when the photographer became aware of a sensation in the crowd, +and, looking around, beheld a very noble figure of a man appear +upon the margin of a thicket and stroll nonchalantly near. The +nonchalance was visibly affected; it was plain he came there to +arouse attention, and his success was instant. He was introduced; +he was civil, he was obliging, he was always ineffably superior and +certain of himself; a well-graced actor. It was presently +suggested that he should appear in his war costume; he gracefully +consented; and returned in that strange, inappropriate and ill- +omened array (which very well became his handsome person) to strut +in a circle of admirers, and be thenceforth the centre of +photography. Thus had Moipu effected his introduction, as by +accident, to the white strangers, made it a favour to display his +finery, and reduced his rival to a secondary role on the theatre of +the disputed village. Paaaeua felt the blow; and, with a spirit +which we never dreamed he could possess, asserted his priority. It +was found impossible that day to get a photograph of Moipu alone; +for whenever he stood up before the camera his successor placed +himself unbidden by his side, and gently but firmly held to his +position. The portraits of the pair, Jacob and Esau, standing +shoulder to shoulder, one in his careful European dress, one in his +barbaric trappings, figure the past and present of their island. A +graveyard with its humble crosses would be the aptest symbol of the +future. + +We are all impressed with the belief that Moipu had planned his +campaign from the beginning to the end. It is certain that he lost +no time in pushing his advantage. Mr. Osbourne was inveigled to +his house; various gifts were fished out of an old sea-chest; +Father Orens was called into service as interpreter, and Moipu +formally proposed to 'make brothers' with Mata-Galahi--Glass-Eyes,- +-the not very euphonious name under which Mr. Osbourne passed in +the Marquesas. The feast of brotherhood took place on board the +Casco. Paaaeua had arrived with his family, like a plain man; and +his presents, which had been numerous, had followed one another, at +intervals through several days. Moipu, as if to mark at every +point the opposition, came with a certain feudal pomp, attended by +retainers bearing gifts of all descriptions, from plumes of old +men's beard to little, pious, Catholic engravings. + +I had met the man before this in the village, and detested him on +sight; there was something indescribably raffish in his looks and +ways that raised my gorge; and when man-eating was referred to, and +he laughed a low, cruel laugh, part boastful, part bashful, like +one reminded of some dashing peccadillo, my repugnance was mingled +with nausea. This is no very human attitude, nor one at all +becoming in a traveller. And, seen more privately, the man +improved. Something negroid in character and face was still +displeasing; but his ugly mouth became attractive when he smiled, +his figure and bearing were certainly noble, and his eyes superb. +In his appreciation of jams and pickles, in is delight in the +reverberating mirrors of the dining cabin, and consequent endless +repetition of Moipus and Mata-Galahis, he showed himself engagingly +a child. And yet I am not sure; and what seemed childishness may +have been rather courtly art. His manners struck me as beyond the +mark; they were refined and caressing to the point of grossness, +and when I think of the serene absent-mindedness with which he +first strolled in upon our party, and then recall him running on +hands and knees along the cabin sofas, pawing the velvet, dipping +into the beds, and bleating commendatory 'mitais' with exaggerated +emphasis, like some enormous over-mannered ape, I feel the more +sure that both must have been calculated. And I sometimes wonder +next, if Moipu were quite alone in this polite duplicity, and ask +myself whether the Casco were quite so much admired in the +Marquesas as our visitors desired us to suppose. + +I will complete this sketch of an incurable cannibal grandee with +two incongruous traits. His favourite morsel was the human hand, +of which he speaks to-day with an ill-favoured lustfulness. And +when he said good-bye to Mrs. Stevenson, holding her hand, viewing +her with tearful eyes, and chanting his farewell improvisation in +the falsetto of Marquesan high society, he wrote upon her mind a +sentimental impression which I try in vain to share. + + + + +PART II: THE PAUMOTUS + + + + +CHAPTER I--THE DANGEROUS ARCHIPELAGO--ATOLLS AT A DISTANCE + + + +In the early morning of 4th September a whale-boat manned by +natives dragged us down the green lane of the anchorage and round +the spouting promontory. On the shore level it was a hot, +breathless, and yet crystal morning; but high overhead the hills of +Atuona were all cowled in cloud, and the ocean-river of the trades +streamed without pause. As we crawled from under the immediate +shelter of the land, we reached at last the limit of their +influence. The wind fell upon our sails in puffs, which +strengthened and grew more continuous; presently the Casco heeled +down to her day's work; the whale-boat, quite outstripped, clung +for a noisy moment to her quarter; the stipulated bread, rum, and +tobacco were passed in; a moment more and the boat was in our wake, +and our late pilots were cheering our departure. + +This was the more inspiriting as we were bound for scenes so +different, and though on a brief voyage, yet for a new province of +creation. That wide field of ocean, called loosely the South Seas, +extends from tropic to tropic, and from perhaps 123 degrees W. to +150 degrees E., a parallelogram of one hundred degrees by forty- +seven, where degrees are the most spacious. Much of it lies +vacant, much is closely sown with isles, and the isles are of two +sorts. No distinction is so continually dwelt upon in South Sea +talk as that between the 'low' and the 'high' island, and there is +none more broadly marked in nature. The Himalayas are not more +different from the Sahara. On the one hand, and chiefly in groups +of from eight to a dozen, volcanic islands rise above the sea; few +reach an altitude of less than 4000 feet; one exceeds 13,000; their +tops are often obscured in cloud, they are all clothed with various +forests, all abound in food, and are all remarkable for picturesque +and solemn scenery. On the other hand, we have the atoll; a thing +of problematic origin and history, the reputed creature of an +insect apparently unidentified; rudely annular in shape; enclosing +a lagoon; rarely extending beyond a quarter of a mile at its chief +width; often rising at its highest point to less than the stature +of a man--man himself, the rat and the land crab, its chief +inhabitants; not more variously supplied with plants; and offering +to the eye, even when perfect, only a ring of glittering beach and +verdant foliage, enclosing and enclosed by the blue sea. + +In no quarter are the atolls so thickly congregated, in none are +they so varied in size from the greatest to the least, and in none +is navigation so beset with perils, as in that archipelago that we +were now to thread. The huge system of the trades is, for some +reason, quite confounded by this multiplicity of reefs, the wind +intermits, squalls are frequent from the west and south-west, +hurricanes are known. The currents are, besides, inextricably +intermixed; dead reckoning becomes a farce; the charts are not to +be trusted; and such is the number and similarity of these islands +that, even when you have picked one up, you may be none the wiser. +The reputation of the place is consequently infamous; insurance +offices exclude it from their field, and it was not without +misgiving that my captain risked the Casco in such waters. I +believe, indeed, it is almost understood that yachts are to avoid +this baffling archipelago; and it required all my instances--and +all Mr. Otis's private taste for adventure--to deflect our course +across its midst. + +For a few days we sailed with a steady trade, and a steady westerly +current setting us to leeward; and toward sundown of the seventh it +was supposed we should have sighted Takaroa, one of Cook's so- +called King George Islands. The sun set; yet a while longer the +old moon--semi-brilliant herself, and with a silver belly, which +was her successor--sailed among gathering clouds; she, too, +deserted us; stars of every degree of sheen, and clouds of every +variety of form disputed the sub-lustrous night; and still we gazed +in vain for Takaroa. The mate stood on the bowsprit, his tall grey +figure slashing up and down against the stars, and still + + +'nihil astra praeter +Vidit et undas. + + +The rest of us were grouped at the port anchor davit, staring with +no less assiduity, but with far less hope on the obscure horizon. +Islands we beheld in plenty, but they were of 'such stuff as dreams +are made on,' and vanished at a wink, only to appear in other +places; and by and by not only islands, but refulgent and revolving +lights began to stud the darkness; lighthouses of the mind or of +the wearied optic nerve, solemnly shining and winking as we passed. +At length the mate himself despaired, scrambled on board again from +his unrestful perch, and announced that we had missed our +destination. He was the only man of practice in these waters, our +sole pilot, shipped for that end at Tai-o-hae. If he declared we +had missed Takaroa, it was not for us to quarrel with the fact, +but, if we could, to explain it. We had certainly run down our +southing. Our canted wake upon the sea and our somewhat drunken- +looking course upon the chart both testified with no less certainty +to an impetuous westward current. We had no choice but to conclude +we were again set down to leeward; and the best we could do was to +bring the Casco to the wind, keep a good watch, and expect morning. + +I slept that night, as was then my somewhat dangerous practice, on +deck upon the cockpit bench. A stir at last awoke me, to see all +the eastern heaven dyed with faint orange, the binnacle lamp +already dulled against the brightness of the day, and the steersman +leaning eagerly across the wheel. 'There it is, sir!' he cried, +and pointed in the very eyeball of the dawn. For awhile I could +see nothing but the bluish ruins of the morning bank, which lay far +along the horizon, like melting icebergs. Then the sun rose, +pierced a gap in these debris of vapours, and displayed an +inconsiderable islet, flat as a plate upon the sea, and spiked with +palms of disproportioned altitude. + +So far, so good. Here was certainly an atoll; and we were +certainly got among the archipelago. But which? And where? The +isle was too small for either Takaroa: in all our neighbourhood, +indeed, there was none so inconsiderable, save only Tikei; and +Tikei, one of Roggewein's so-called Pernicious Islands, seemed +beside the question. At that rate, instead of drifting to the +west, we must have fetched up thirty miles to windward. And how +about the current? It had been setting us down, by observation, +all these days: by the deflection of our wake, it should be +setting us down that moment. When had it stopped? When had it +begun again? and what kind of torrent was that which had swept us +eastward in the interval? To these questions, so typical of +navigation in that range of isles, I have no answer. Such were at +least the facts; Tikei our island turned out to be; and it was our +first experience of the dangerous archipelago, to make our landfall +thirty miles out. + +The sight of Tikei, thrown direct against the splendour of the +morning, robbed of all its colour, and deformed with +disproportioned trees like bristles on a broom, had scarce prepared +us to be much in love with atolls. Later the same day we saw under +more fit conditions the island of Taiaro. Lost in the Sea is +possibly the meaning of the name. And it was so we saw it; lost in +blue sea and sky: a ring of white beach, green underwood, and +tossing palms, gem-like in colour; of a fairy, of a heavenly +prettiness. The surf ran all around it, white as snow, and broke +at one point, far to seaward, on what seems an uncharted reef. +There was no smoke, no sign of man; indeed, the isle is not +inhabited, only visited at intervals. And yet a trader (Mr. Narii +Salmon) was watching from the shore and wondering at the unexpected +ship. I have spent since then long months upon low islands; I know +the tedium of their undistinguished days; I know the burden of +their diet. With whatever envy we may have looked from the deck on +these green coverts, it was with a tenfold greater that Mr. Salmon +and his comrades saw us steer, in our trim ship, to seaward. + +The night fell lovely in the extreme. After the moon went down, +the heaven was a thing to wonder at for stars. And as I lay in the +cockpit and looked upon the steersman I was haunted by Emerson's +verses: + + +'And the lone seaman all the night +Sails astonished among stars.' + + +By this glittering and imperfect brightness, about four bells in +the first watch we made our third atoll, Raraka. The low line of +the isle lay straight along the sky; so that I was at first +reminded of a towpath, and we seemed to be mounting some engineered +and navigable stream. Presently a red star appeared, about the +height and brightness of a danger signal, and with that my simile +was changed; we seemed rather to skirt the embankment of a railway, +and the eye began to look instinctively for the telegraph-posts, +and the ear to expect the coming of a train. Here and there, but +rarely, faint tree-tops broke the level. And the sound of the surf +accompanied us, now in a drowsy monotone, now with a menacing +swing. + +The isle lay nearly east and west, barring our advance on Fakarava. +We must, therefore, hug the coast until we gained the western end, +where, through a passage eight miles wide, we might sail southward +between Raraka and the next isle, Kauehi. We had the wind free, a +lightish air; but clouds of an inky blackness were beginning to +arise, and at times it lightened--without thunder. Something, I +know not what, continually set us up upon the island. We lay more +and more to the nor'ard; and you would have thought the shore +copied our manoeuvre and outsailed us. Once and twice Raraka headed +us again--again, in the sea fashion, the quite innocent steersman +was abused--and again the Casco kept away. Had I been called on, +with no more light than that of our experience, to draw the +configuration of that island, I should have shown a series of bow- +window promontories, each overlapping the other to the nor'ard, and +the trend of the land from the south-east to the north-west, and +behold, on the chart it lay near east and west in a straight line. + +We had but just repeated our manoeuvre and kept away--for not more +than five minutes the railway embankment had been lost to view and +the surf to hearing--when I was aware of land again, not only on +the weather bow, but dead ahead. I played the part of the +judicious landsman, holding my peace till the last moment; and +presently my mariners perceived it for themselves. + +'Land ahead!' said the steersman. + +'By God, it's Kauehi!' cried the mate. + +And so it was. And with that I began to be sorry for +cartographers. We were scarce doing three and a half; and they +asked me to believe that (in five minutes) we had dropped an +island, passed eight miles of open water, and run almost high and +dry upon the next. But my captain was more sorry for himself to be +afloat in such a labyrinth; laid the Casco to, with the log line up +and down, and sat on the stern rail and watched it till the +morning. He had enough of night in the Paumotus. + +By daylight on the 9th we began to skirt Kauehi, and had now an +opportunity to see near at hand the geography of atolls. Here and +there, where it was high, the farther side loomed up; here and +there the near side dipped entirely and showed a broad path of +water into the lagoon; here and there both sides were equally +abased, and we could look right through the discontinuous ring to +the sea horizon on the south. Conceive, on a vast scale, the +submerged hoop of the duck-hunter, trimmed with green rushes to +conceal his head--water within, water without--you have the image +of the perfect atoll. Conceive one that has been partly plucked of +its rush fringe; you have the atoll of Kauehi. And for either +shore of it at closer quarters, conceive the line of some old Roman +highway traversing a wet morass, and here sunk out of view and +there re-arising, crowned with a green tuft of thicket; only +instead of the stagnant waters of a marsh, the live ocean now +boiled against, now buried the frail barrier. Last night's +impression in the dark was thus confirmed by day, and not +corrected. We sailed indeed by a mere causeway in the sea, of +nature's handiwork, yet of no greater magnitude than many of the +works of man. + +The isle was uninhabited; it was all green brush and white sand, +set in transcendently blue water; even the coco-palms were rare, +though some of these completed the bright harmony of colour by +hanging out a fan of golden yellow. For long there was no sign of +life beyond the vegetable, and no sound but the continuous grumble +of the surf. In silence and desertion these fair shores slipped +past, and were submerged and rose again with clumps of thicket from +the sea. And then a bird or two appeared, hovering and crying; +swiftly these became more numerous, and presently, looking ahead, +we were aware of a vast effervescence of winged life. In this +place the annular isle was mostly under water, carrying here and +there on its submerged line a wooded islet. Over one of these the +birds hung and flew with an incredible density like that of gnats +or hiving bees; the mass flashed white and black, and heaved and +quivered, and the screaming of the creatures rose over the voice of +the surf in a shrill clattering whirr. As you descend some inland +valley a not dissimilar sound announces the nearness of a mill and +pouring river. Some stragglers, as I said, came to meet our +approach; a few still hung about the ship as we departed. The +crying died away, the last pair of wings was left behind, and once +more the low shores of Kauehi streamed past our eyes in silence +like a picture. I supposed at the time that the birds lived, like +ants or citizens, concentred where we saw them. I have been told +since (I know not if correctly) that the whole isle, or much of it, +is similarly peopled; and that the effervescence at a single spot +would be the mark of a boat's crew of egg-hunters from one of the +neighbouring inhabited atolls. So that here at Kauehi, as the day +before at Taiaro, the Casco sailed by under the fire of unsuspected +eyes. And one thing is surely true, that even on these ribbons of +land an army might lie hid and no passing mariner divine its +presence. + + + +CHAPTER II--FAKARAVA: AN ATOLL AT HAND + + + +By a little before noon we were running down the coast of our +destination, Fakarava: the air very light, the sea near smooth; +though still we were accompanied by a continuous murmur from the +beach, like the sound of a distant train. The isle is of a huge +longitude, the enclosed lagoon thirty miles by ten or twelve, and +the coral tow-path, which they call the land, some eighty or ninety +miles by (possibly) one furlong. That part by which we sailed was +all raised; the underwood excellently green, the topping wood of +coco-palms continuous--a mark, if I had known it, of man's +intervention. For once more, and once more unconsciously, we were +within hail of fellow-creatures, and that vacant beach was but a +pistol-shot from the capital city of the archipelago. But the life +of an atoll, unless it be enclosed, passes wholly on the shores of +the lagoon; it is there the villages are seated, there the canoes +ply and are drawn up; and the beach of the ocean is a place +accursed and deserted, the fit scene only for wizardry and +shipwreck, and in the native belief a haunting ground of murderous +spectres. + +By and by we might perceive a breach in the low barrier; the woods +ceased; a glittering point ran into the sea, tipped with an emerald +shoal the mark of entrance. As we drew near we met a little run of +sea--the private sea of the lagoon having there its origin and end, +and here, in the jaws of the gateway, trying vain conclusions with +the more majestic heave of the Pacific. The Casco scarce avowed a +shock; but there are times and circumstances when these harbour +mouths of inland basins vomit floods, deflecting, burying, and +dismasting ships. For, conceive a lagoon perfectly sealed but in +the one point, and that of merely navigable width; conceive the +tide and wind to have heaped for hours together in that coral fold +a superfluity of waters, and the tide to change and the wind fall-- +the open sluice of some great reservoirs at home will give an image +of the unstemmable effluxion. + +We were scarce well headed for the pass before all heads were +craned over the rail. For the water, shoaling under our board, +became changed in a moment to surprising hues of blue and grey; and +in its transparency the coral branched and blossomed, and the fish +of the inland sea cruised visibly below us, stained and striped, +and even beaked like parrots. I have paid in my time to view many +curiosities; never one so curious as that first sight over the +ship's rail in the lagoon of Fakarava. But let not the reader be +deceived with hope. I have since entered, I suppose, some dozen +atolls in different parts of the Pacific, and the experience has +never been repeated. That exquisite hue and transparency of +submarine day, and these shoals of rainbow fish, have not +enraptured me again. + +Before we could raise our eyes from that engaging spectacle the +schooner had slipped betwixt the pierheads of the reef, and was +already quite committed to the sea within. The containing shores +are so little erected, and the lagoon itself is so great, that, for +the more part, it seemed to extend without a check to the horizon. +Here and there, indeed, where the reef carried an inlet, like a +signet-ring upon a finger, there would be a pencilling of palms; +here and there, the green wall of wood ran solid for a length of +miles; and on the port hand, under the highest grove of trees, a +few houses sparkled white--Rotoava, the metropolitan settlement of +the Paumotus. Hither we beat in three tacks, and came to an anchor +close in shore, in the first smooth water since we had left San +Francisco, five fathoms deep, where a man might look overboard all +day at the vanishing cable, the coral patches, and the many- +coloured fish. + +Fakarava was chosen to be the seat of Government from nautical +considerations only. It is eccentrically situate; the productions, +even for a low island, poor; the population neither many nor--for +Low Islanders--industrious. But the lagoon has two good passages, +one to leeward, one to windward, so that in all states of the wind +it can be left and entered, and this advantage, for a government of +scattered islands, was decisive. A pier of coral, landing-stairs, +a harbour light upon a staff and pillar, and two spacious +Government bungalows in a handsome fence, give to the northern end +of Rotoava a great air of consequence. This is confirmed on the +one hand by an empty prison, on the other by a gendarmerie pasted +over with hand-bills in Tahitian, land-law notices from Papeete, +and republican sentiments from Paris, signed (a little after date) +'Jules Grevy, Perihidente.' Quite at the far end a belfried +Catholic chapel concludes the town; and between, on a smooth floor +of white coral sand and under the breezy canopy of coco-palms, the +houses of the natives stand irregularly scattered, now close on the +lagoon for the sake of the breeze, now back under the palms for +love of shadow. + +Not a soul was to be seen. But for the thunder of the surf on the +far side, it seemed you might have heard a pin drop anywhere about +that capital city. There was something thrilling in the unexpected +silence, something yet more so in the unexpected sound. Here +before us a sea reached to the horizon, rippling like an inland +mere; and behold! close at our back another sea assaulted with +assiduous fury the reverse of the position. At night the lantern +was run up and lit a vacant pier. In one house lights were seen +and voices heard, where the population (I was told) sat playing +cards. A little beyond, from deep in the darkness of the palm- +grove, we saw the glow and smelt the aromatic odour of a coal of +cocoa-nut husk, a relic of the evening kitchen. Crickets sang; +some shrill thing whistled in a tuft of weeds; and the mosquito +hummed and stung. There was no other trace that night of man, +bird, or insect in the isle. The moon, now three days old, and as +yet but a silver crescent on a still visible sphere, shone through +the palm canopy with vigorous and scattered lights. The alleys +where we walked were smoothed and weeded like a boulevard; here and +there were plants set out; here and there dusky cottages clustered +in the shadow, some with verandahs. A public garden by night, a +rich and fashionable watering-place in a by-season, offer sights +and vistas not dissimilar. And still, on the one side, stretched +the lapping mere, and from the other the deep sea still growled in +the night. But it was most of all on board, in the dead hours, +when I had been better sleeping, that the spell of Fakarava seized +and held me. The moon was down. The harbour lantern and two of +the greater planets drew vari-coloured wakes on the lagoon. From +shore the cheerful watch-cry of cocks rang out at intervals above +the organ-point of surf. And the thought of this depopulated +capital, this protracted thread of annular island with its crest of +coco-palms and fringe of breakers, and that tranquil inland sea +that stretched before me till it touched the stars, ran in my head +for hours with delight. + +So long as I stayed upon that isle these thoughts were constant. I +lay down to sleep, and woke again with an unblunted sense of my +surroundings. I was never weary of calling up the image of that +narrow causeway, on which I had my dwelling, lying coiled like a +serpent, tail to mouth, in the outrageous ocean, and I was never +weary of passing--a mere quarter-deck parade--from the one side to +the other, from the shady, habitable shores of the lagoon to the +blinding desert and uproarious breakers of the opposite beach. The +sense of insecurity in such a thread of residence is more than +fanciful. Hurricanes and tidal waves over-leap these humble +obstacles; Oceanus remembers his strength, and, where houses stood +and palms flourished, shakes his white beard again over the barren +coral. Fakarava itself has suffered; the trees immediately beyond +my house were all of recent replantation; and Anaa is only now +recovered from a heavier stroke. I knew one who was then dwelling +in the isle. He told me that he and two ship captains walked to +the sea beach. There for a while they viewed the oncoming +breakers, till one of the captains clapped suddenly his hand before +his eyes and cried aloud that he could endure no longer to behold +them. This was in the afternoon; in the dark hours of the night +the sea burst upon the island like a flood; the settlement was +razed all but the church and presbytery; and, when day returned, +the survivors saw themselves clinging in an abattis of uprooted +coco-palms and ruined houses. + +Danger is but a small consideration. But men are more nicely +sensible of a discomfort; and the atoll is a discomfortable home. +There are some, and these probably ancient, where a deep soil has +formed and the most valuable fruit-trees prosper. I have walked in +one, with equal admiration and surprise, through a forest of huge +breadfruits, eating bananas and stumbling among taro as I went. +This was in the atoll of Namorik in the Marshall group, and stands +alone in my experience. To give the opposite extreme, which is yet +far more near the average, I will describe the soil and productions +of Fakarava. The surface of that narrow strip is for the more part +of broken coral lime-stone, like volcanic clinkers, and +excruciating to the naked foot; in some atolls, I believe, not in +Fakarava, it gives a fine metallic ring when struck. Here and +there you come upon a bank of sand, exceeding fine and white, and +these parts are the least productive. The plants (such as they +are) spring from and love the broken coral, whence they grow with +that wonderful verdancy that makes the beauty of the atoll from the +sea. The coco-palm in particular luxuriates in that stern solum, +striking down his roots to the brackish, percolated water, and +bearing his green head in the wind with every evidence of health +and pleasure. And yet even the coco-palm must be helped in infancy +with some extraneous nutriment, and through much of the low +archipelago there is planted with each nut a piece of ship's +biscuit and a rusty nail. The pandanus comes next in importance, +being also a food tree; and he, too, does bravely. A green bush +called miki runs everywhere; occasionally a purao is seen; and +there are several useless weeds. According to M. Cuzent, the whole +number of plants on an atoll such as Fakarava will scarce exceed, +even if it reaches to, one score. Not a blade of grass appears; +not a grain of humus, save when a sack or two has been imported to +make the semblance of a garden; such gardens as bloom in cities on +the window-sill. Insect life is sometimes dense; a cloud o' +mosquitoes, and, what is far worse, a plague of flies blackening +our food, has sometimes driven us from a meal on Apemama; and even +in Fakarava the mosquitoes were a pest. The land crab may be seen +scuttling to his hole, and at night the rats besiege the houses and +the artificial gardens. The crab is good eating; possibly so is +the rat; I have not tried. Pandanus fruit is made, in the +Gilberts, into an agreeable sweetmeat, such as a man may trifle +with at the end of a long dinner; for a substantial meal I have no +use for it. The rest of the food-supply, in a destitute atoll such +as Fakarava, can be summed up in the favourite jest of the +archipelago--cocoa-nut beefsteak. Cocoa-nut green, cocoa-nut ripe, +cocoa-nut germinated; cocoa-nut to eat and cocoa-nut to drink; +cocoa-nut raw and cooked, cocoa-nut hot and cold--such is the bill +of fare. And some of the entrees are no doubt delicious. The +germinated nut, cooked in the shell and eaten with a spoon, forms a +good pudding; cocoa-nut milk--the expressed juice of a ripe nut, +not the water of a green one--goes well in coffee, and is a +valuable adjunct in cookery through the South Seas; and cocoa-nut +salad, if you be a millionaire, and can afford to eat the value of +a field of corn for your dessert, is a dish to be remembered with +affection. But when all is done there is a sameness, and the +Israelites of the low islands murmur at their manna. + +The reader may think I have forgot the sea. The two beaches do +certainly abound in life, and they are strangely different. In the +lagoon the water shallows slowly on a bottom of the fine slimy +sand, dotted with clumps of growing coral. Then comes a strip of +tidal beach on which the ripples lap. In the coral clumps the +great holy-water clam (Tridacna) grows plentifully; a little deeper +lie the beds of the pearl-oyster and sail the resplendent fish that +charmed us at our entrance; and these are all more or less +vigorously coloured. But the other shells are white like lime, or +faintly tinted with a little pink, the palest possible display; +many of them dead besides, and badly rolled. On the ocean side, on +the mounds of the steep beach, over all the width of the reef right +out to where the surf is bursting, in every cranny, under every +scattered fragment of the coral, an incredible plenty of marine +life displays the most wonderful variety and brilliancy of hues. +The reef itself has no passage of colour but is imitated by some +shell. Purple and red and white, and green and yellow, pied and +striped and clouded, the living shells wear in every combination +the livery of the dead reef--if the reef be dead--so that the eye +is continually baffled and the collector continually deceived. I +have taken shells for stones and stones for shells, the one as +often as the other. A prevailing character of the coral is to be +dotted with small spots of red, and it is wonderful how many +varieties of shell have adopted the same fashion and donned the +disguise of the red spot. A shell I had found in plenty in the +Marquesas I found here also unchanged in all things else, but there +were the red spots. A lively little crab wore the same markings. +The case of the hermit or soldier crab was more conclusive, being +the result of conscious choice. This nasty little wrecker, +scavenger, and squatter has learned the value of a spotted house; +so it be of the right colour he will choose the smallest shard, +tuck himself in a mere corner of a broken whorl, and go about the +world half naked; but I never found him in this imperfect armour +unless it was marked with the red spot. + +Some two hundred yards distant is the beach of the lagoon. Collect +the shells from each, set them side by side, and you would suppose +they came from different hemispheres; the one so pale, the other so +brilliant; the one prevalently white, the other of a score of hues, +and infected with the scarlet spot like a disease. This seems the +more strange, since the hermit crabs pass and repass the island, +and I have met them by the Residency well, which is about central, +journeying either way. Without doubt many of the shells in the +lagoon are dead. But why are they dead? Without doubt the living +shells have a very different background set for imitation. But why +are these so different? We are only on the threshold of the +mysteries. + +Either beach, I have said, abounds with life. On the sea-side and +in certain atolls this profusion of vitality is even shocking: the +rock under foot is mined with it. I have broken off--notably in +Funafuti and Arorai--great lumps of ancient weathered rock that +rang under my blows like iron, and the fracture has been full of +pendent worms as long as my hand, as thick as a child's finger, of +a slightly pinkish white, and set as close as three or even four to +the square inch. Even in the lagoon, where certain shell-fish seem +to sicken, others (it is notorious) prosper exceedingly and make +the riches of these islands. Fish, too, abound; the lagoon is a +closed fish-pond, such as might rejoice the fancy of an abbot; +sharks swarm there, and chiefly round the passages, to feast upon +this plenty, and you would suppose that man had only to prepare his +angle. Alas! it is not so. Of these painted fish that came in +hordes about the entering Casco, some bore poisonous spines, and +others were poisonous if eaten. The stranger must refrain, or take +his chance of painful and dangerous sickness. The native, on his +own isle, is a safe guide; transplant him to the next, and he is +helpless as yourself. For it is a question both of time and place. +A fish caught in a lagoon may be deadly; the same fish caught the +same day at sea, and only a few hundred yards without the passage, +will be wholesome eating: in a neighbouring isle perhaps the case +will be reversed; and perhaps a fortnight later you shall be able +to eat of them indifferently from within and from without. +According to the natives, these bewildering vicissitudes are ruled +by the movement of the heavenly bodies. The beautiful planet Venus +plays a great part in all island tales and customs; and among other +functions, some of them more awful, she regulates the season of +good fish. With Venus in one phase, as we had her, certain fish +were poisonous in the lagoon: with Venus in another, the same fish +was harmless and a valued article of diet. White men explain these +changes by the phases of the coral. + +It adds a last touch of horror to the thought of this precarious +annular gangway in the sea, that even what there is of it is not of +honest rock, but organic, part alive, part putrescent; even the +clean sea and the bright fish about it poisoned, the most stubborn +boulder burrowed in by worms, the lightest dust venomous as an +apothecary's drugs. + + + +CHAPTER III--A HOUSE TO LET IN A LOW ISLAND + + + +Never populous, it was yet by a chapter of accidents that I found +the island so deserted that no sound of human life diversified the +hours; that we walked in that trim public garden of a town, among +closed houses, without even a lodging-bill in a window to prove +some tenancy in the back quarters; and, when we visited the +Government bungalow, that Mr. Donat, acting Vice-Resident, greeted +us alone, and entertained us with cocoa-nut punches in the Sessions +Hall and seat of judgment of that widespread archipelago, our +glasses standing arrayed with summonses and census returns. The +unpopularity of a late Vice-Resident had begun the movement of +exodus, his native employes resigning court appointments and +retiring each to his own coco-patch in the remoter districts of the +isle. Upon the back of that, the Governor in Papeete issued a +decree: All land in the Paumotus must be defined and registered by +a certain date. Now, the folk of the archipelago are half nomadic; +a man can scarce be said to belong to a particular atoll; he +belongs to several, perhaps holds a stake and counts cousinship in +half a score; and the inhabitants of Rotoava in particular, man, +woman, and child, and from the gendarme to the Mormon prophet and +the schoolmaster, owned--I was going to say land--owned at least +coral blocks and growing coco-palms in some adjacent isle. +Thither--from the gendarme to the babe in arms, the pastor followed +by his flock, the schoolmaster carrying along with him his +scholars, and the scholars with their books and slates--they had +taken ship some two days previous to our arrival, and were all now +engaged disputing boundaries. Fancy overhears the shrillness of +their disputation mingle with the surf and scatter sea-fowl. It +was admirable to observe the completeness of their flight, like +that of hibernating birds; nothing left but empty houses, like old +nests to be reoccupied in spring; and even the harmless necessary +dominie borne with them in their transmigration. Fifty odd set +out, and only seven, I was informed, remained. But when I made a +feast on board the Casco, more than seven, and nearer seven times +seven, appeared to be my guests. Whence they appeared, how they +were summoned, whither they vanished when the feast was eaten, I +have no guess. In view of Low Island tales, and that awful +frequentation which makes men avoid the seaward beaches of an +atoll, some two score of those that ate with us may have returned, +for the occasion, from the kingdom of the dead. + +It was this solitude that put it in our minds to hire a house, and +become, for the time being, indwellers of the isle--a practice I +have ever since, when it was possible, adhered to. Mr. Donat +placed us, with that intent, under the convoy of one Taniera +Mahinui, who combined the incongruous characters of catechist and +convict. The reader may smile, but I affirm he was well qualified +for either part. For that of convict, first of all, by a good +substantial felony, such as in all lands casts the perpetrator in +chains and dungeons. Taniera was a man of birth--the chief a while +ago, as he loved to tell, of a district in Anaa of 800 souls. In +an evil hour it occurred to the authorities in Papeete to charge +the chiefs with the collection of the taxes. It is a question if +much were collected; it is certain that nothing was handed on; and +Taniera, who had distinguished himself by a visit to Papeete and +some high living in restaurants, was chosen for the scapegoat. The +reader must understand that not Taniera but the authorities in +Papeete were first in fault. The charge imposed was +disproportioned. I have not yet heard of any Polynesian capable of +such a burden; honest and upright Hawaiians--one in particular, who +was admired even by the whites as an inflexible magistrate--have +stumbled in the narrow path of the trustee. And Taniera, when the +pinch came, scorned to denounce accomplices; others had shared the +spoil, he bore the penalty alone. He was condemned in five years. +The period, when I had the pleasure of his friendship, was not yet +expired; he still drew prison rations, the sole and not unwelcome +reminder of his chains, and, I believe, looked forward to the date +of his enfranchisement with mere alarm. For he had no sense of +shame in the position; complained of nothing but the defective +table of his place of exile; regretted nothing but the fowls and +eggs and fish of his own more favoured island. And as for his +parishioners, they did not think one hair the less of him. A +schoolboy, mulcted in ten thousand lines of Greek and dwelling +sequestered in the dormitories, enjoys unabated consideration from +his fellows. So with Taniera: a marked man, not a dishonoured; +having fallen under the lash of the unthinkable gods; a Job, +perhaps, or say a Taniera in the den of lions. Songs are likely +made and sung about this saintly Robin Hood. On the other hand, he +was even highly qualified for his office in the Church; being by +nature a grave, considerate, and kindly man; his face rugged and +serious, his smile bright; the master of several trades, a builder +both of boats and houses; endowed with a fine pulpit voice; endowed +besides with such a gift of eloquence that at the grave of the late +chief of Fakarava he set all the assistants weeping. I never met a +man of a mind more ecclesiastical; he loved to dispute and to +inform himself of doctrine and the history of sects; and when I +showed him the cuts in a volume of Chambers's Encyclopaedia--except +for one of an ape--reserved his whole enthusiasm for cardinals' +hats, censers, candlesticks, and cathedrals. Methought when he +looked upon the cardinal's hat a voice said low in his ear: 'Your +foot is on the ladder.' + +Under the guidance of Taniera we were soon installed in what I +believe to have been the best-appointed private house in Fakarava. +It stood just beyond the church in an oblong patch of cultivation. +More than three hundred sacks of soil were imported from Tahiti for +the Residency garden; and this must shortly be renewed, for the +earth blows away, sinks in crevices of the coral, and is sought for +at last in vain. I know not how much earth had gone to the garden +of my villa; some at least, for an alley of prosperous bananas ran +to the gate, and over the rest of the enclosure, which was covered +with the usual clinker-like fragments of smashed coral, not only +coco-palms and mikis but also fig-trees flourished, all of a +delicious greenness. Of course there was no blade of grass. In +front a picket fence divided us from the white road, the palm- +fringed margin of the lagoon, and the lagoon itself, reflecting +clouds by day and stars by night. At the back, a bulwark of +uncemented coral enclosed us from the narrow belt of bush and the +nigh ocean beach where the seas thundered, the roar and wash of +them still humming in the chambers of the house. + +This itself was of one story, verandahed front and back. It +contained three rooms, three sewing-machines, three sea-chests, +chairs, tables, a pair of beds, a cradle, a double-barrelled gun, a +pair of enlarged coloured photographs, a pair of coloured prints +after Wilkie and Mulready, and a French lithograph with the legend: +'Le brigade du General Lepasset brulant son drapeau devant Metz.' +Under the stilts of the house a stove was rusting, till we drew it +forth and put it in commission. Not far off was the burrow in the +coral whence we supplied ourselves with brackish water. There was +live stock, besides, on the estate--cocks and hens and a brace of +ill-regulated cats, whom Taniera came every morning with the sun to +feed on grated cocoa-nut. His voice was our regular reveille, +ringing pleasantly about the garden: 'Pooty--pooty--poo--poo-- +poo!' + +Far as we were from the public offices, the nearness of the chapel +made our situation what is called eligible in advertisements, and +gave us a side look on some native life. Every morning, as soon as +he had fed the fowls, Taniera set the bell agoing in the small +belfry; and the faithful, who were not very numerous, gathered to +prayers. I was once present: it was the Lord's day, and seven +females and eight males composed the congregation. A woman played +precentor, starting with a longish note; the catechist joined in +upon the second bar; and then the faithful in a body. Some had +printed hymn-books which they followed; some of the rest filled up +with 'eh--eh--eh,' the Paumotuan tol-de-rol. After the hymn, we +had an antiphonal prayer or two; and then Taniera rose from the +front bench, where he had been sitting in his catechist's robes, +passed within the altar-rails, opened his Tahitian Bible, and began +to preach from notes. I understood one word--the name of God; but +the preacher managed his voice with taste, used rare and expressive +gestures, and made a strong impression of sincerity. The plain +service, the vernacular Bible, the hymn-tunes mostly on an English +pattern--'God save the Queen,' I was informed, a special +favourite,--all, save some paper flowers upon the altar, seemed not +merely but austerely Protestant. It is thus the Catholics have met +their low island proselytes half-way. + +Taniera had the keys of our house; it was with him I made my +bargain, if that could be called a bargain in which all was +remitted to my generosity; it was he who fed the cats and poultry, +he who came to call and pick a meal with us like an acknowledged +friend; and we long fondly supposed he was our landlord. This +belief was not to bear the test of experience; and, as my chapter +has to relate, no certainty succeeded it. + +We passed some days of airless quiet and great heat; shell- +gatherers were warned from the ocean beach, where sunstroke waited +them from ten till four; the highest palm hung motionless, there +was no voice audible but that of the sea on the far side. At last, +about four of a certain afternoon, long cat's-paws flawed the face +of the lagoon; and presently in the tree-tops there awoke the +grateful bustle of the trades, and all the houses and alleys of the +island were fanned out. To more than one enchanted ship, that had +lain long becalmed in view of the green shore, the wind brought +deliverance; and by daylight on the morrow a schooner and two +cutters lay moored in the port of Rotoava. Not only in the outer +sea, but in the lagoon itself, a certain traffic woke with the +reviving breeze; and among the rest one Francois, a half-blood, set +sail with the first light in his own half-decked cutter. He had +held before a court appointment; being, I believe, the Residency +sweeper-out. Trouble arising with the unpopular Vice-Resident, he +had thrown his honours down, and fled to the far parts of the atoll +to plant cabbages--or at least coco-palms. Thence he was now +driven by such need as even a Cincinnatus must acknowledge, and +fared for the capital city, the seat of his late functions, to +exchange half a ton of copra for necessary flour. And here, for a +while, the story leaves to tell of his voyaging. + +It must tell, instead, of our house, where, toward seven at night, +the catechist came suddenly in with his pleased air of being +welcome; armed besides with a considerable bunch of keys. These he +proceeded to try on the sea-chests, drawing each in turn from its +place against the wall. Heads of strangers appeared in the doorway +and volunteered suggestions. All in vain. Either they were the +wrong keys or the wrong boxes, or the wrong man was trying them. +For a little Taniera fumed and fretted; then had recourse to the +more summary method of the hatchet; one of the chests was broken +open, and an armful of clothing, male and female, baled out and +handed to the strangers on the verandah. + +These were Francois, his wife, and their child. About eight a.m., +in the midst of the lagoon, their cutter had capsized in jibbing. +They got her righted, and though she was still full of water put +the child on board. The mainsail had been carried away, but the +jib still drew her sluggishly along, and Francois and the woman +swam astern and worked the rudder with their hands. The cold was +cruel; the fatigue, as time went on, became excessive; and in that +preserve of sharks, fear hunted them. Again and again, Francois, +the half-breed, would have desisted and gone down; but the woman, +whole blood of an amphibious race, still supported him with +cheerful words. I am reminded of a woman of Hawaii who swam with +her husband, I dare not say how many miles, in a high sea, and came +ashore at last with his dead body in her arms. It was about five +in the evening, after nine hours' swimming, that Francois and his +wife reached land at Rotoava. The gallant fight was won, and +instantly the more childish side of native character appears. They +had supped, and told and retold their story, dripping as they came; +the flesh of the woman, whom Mrs. Stevenson helped to shift, was +cold as stone; and Francois, having changed to a dry cotton shirt +and trousers, passed the remainder of the evening on my floor and +between open doorways, in a thorough draught. Yet Francois, the +son of a French father, speaks excellent French himself and seems +intelligent. + +It was our first idea that the catechist, true to his evangelical +vocation, was clothing the naked from his superfluity. Then it +came out that Francois was but dealing with his own. The clothes +were his, so was the chest, so was the house. Francois was in fact +the landlord. Yet you observe he had hung back on the verandah +while Taniera tried his 'prentice hand upon the locks: and even +now, when his true character appeared, the only use he made of the +estate was to leave the clothes of his family drying on the fence. +Taniera was still the friend of the house, still fed the poultry, +still came about us on his daily visits, Francois, during the +remainder of his stay, holding bashfully aloof. And there was +stranger matter. Since Francois had lost the whole load of his +cutter, the half ton of copra, an axe, bowls, knives, and clothes-- +since he had in a manner to begin the world again, and his +necessary flour was not yet bought or paid for--I proposed to +advance him what he needed on the rent. To my enduring amazement +he refused, and the reason he gave--if that can be called a reason +which but darkens counsel--was that Taniera was his friend. His +friend, you observe; not his creditor. I inquired into that, and +was assured that Taniera, an exile in a strange isle, might +possibly be in debt himself, but certainly was no man's creditor. + +Very early one morning we were awakened by a bustling presence in +the yard, and found our camp had been surprised by a tall, lean old +native lady, dressed in what were obviously widow's weeds. You +could see at a glance she was a notable woman, a housewife, sternly +practical, alive with energy, and with fine possibilities of +temper. Indeed, there was nothing native about her but the skin; +and the type abounds, and is everywhere respected, nearer home. It +did us good to see her scour the grounds, examining the plants and +chickens; watering, feeding, trimming them; taking angry, purpose- +like possession. When she neared the house our sympathy abated; +when she came to the broken chest I wished I were elsewhere. We +had scarce a word in common; but her whole lean body spoke for her +with indignant eloquence. 'My chest!' it cried, with a stress on +the possessive. 'My chest--broken open! This is a fine state of +things!' I hastened to lay the blame where it belonged--on +Francois and his wife--and found I had made things worse instead of +better. She repeated the names at first with incredulity, then +with despair. A while she seemed stunned, next fell to +disembowelling the box, piling the goods on the floor, and visibly +computing the extent of Francois's ravages; and presently after she +was observed in high speech with Taniera, who seemed to hang an ear +like one reproved. + +Here, then, by all known marks, should be my land-lady at last; +here was every character of the proprietor fully developed. Should +I not approach her on the still depending question of my rent? I +carried the point to an adviser. 'Nonsense!' he cried. 'That's +the old woman, the mother. It doesn't belong to her. I believe +that's the man the house belongs to,' and he pointed to one of the +coloured photographs on the wall. On this I gave up all desire of +understanding; and when the time came for me to leave, in the +judgment-hall of the archipelago, and with the awful countenance of +the acting Governor, I duly paid my rent to Taniera. He was +satisfied, and so was I. But what had he to do with it? Mr. +Donat, acting magistrate and a man of kindred blood, could throw no +light upon the mystery; a plain private person, with a taste for +letters, cannot be expected to do more. + + + +CHAPTER IV--TRAITS AND SECTS IN THE PAUMOTUS + + + +The most careless reader must have remarked a change of air since +the Marquesas. The house, crowded with effects, the bustling +housewife counting her possessions, the serious, indoctrinated +island pastor, the long fight for life in the lagoon: here are +traits of a new world. I read in a pamphlet (I will not give the +author's name) that the Marquesan especially resembles the +Paumotuan. I should take the two races, though so near in +neighbourhood, to be extremes of Polynesian diversity. The +Marquesan is certainly the most beautiful of human races, and one +of the tallest--the Paumotuan averaging a good inch shorter, and +not even handsome; the Marquesan open-handed, inert, insensible to +religion, childishly self-indulgent--the Paumotuan greedy, hardy, +enterprising, a religious disputant, and with a trace of the +ascetic character. + +Yet a few years ago, and the people of the archipelago were crafty +savages. Their isles might be called sirens' isles, not merely +from the attraction they exerted on the passing mariner, but from +the perils that awaited him on shore. Even to this day, in certain +outlying islands, danger lingers; and the civilized Paumotuan +dreads to land and hesitates to accost his backward brother. But, +except in these, to-day the peril is a memory. When our generation +were yet in the cradle and playroom it was still a living fact. +Between 1830 and 1840, Hao, for instance, was a place of the most +dangerous approach, where ships were seized and crews kidnapped. +As late as 1856, the schooner Sarah Ann sailed from Papeete and was +seen no more. She had women on board, and children, the captain's +wife, a nursemaid, a baby, and the two young sons of a Captain +Steven on their way to the mainland for schooling. All were +supposed to have perished in a squall. A year later, the captain +of the Julia, coasting along the island variously called Bligh, +Lagoon, and Tematangi saw armed natives follow the course of his +schooner, clad in many-coloured stuffs. Suspicion was at once +aroused; the mother of the lost children was profuse of money; and +one expedition having found the place deserted, and returned +content with firing a few shots, she raised and herself accompanied +another. None appeared to greet or to oppose them; they roamed a +while among abandoned huts and empty thickets; then formed two +parties and set forth to beat, from end to end, the pandanus jungle +of the island. One man remained alone by the landing-place--Teina, +a chief of Anaa, leader of the armed natives who made the strength +of the expedition. Now that his comrades were departed this way +and that, on their laborious exploration, the silence fell +profound; and this silence was the ruin of the islanders. A sound +of stones rattling caught the ear of Teina. He looked, thinking to +perceive a crab, and saw instead the brown hand of a human being +issue from a fissure in the ground. A shout recalled the search +parties and announced their doom to the buried caitiffs. In the +cave below, sixteen were found crouching among human bones and +singular and horrid curiosities. One was a head of golden hair, +supposed to be a relic of the captain's wife; another was half of +the body of a European child, sun-dried and stuck upon a stick, +doubtless with some design of wizardry. + +The Paumotuan is eager to be rich. He saves, grudges, buries +money, fears not work. For a dollar each, two natives passed the +hours of daylight cleaning our ship's copper. It was strange to +see them so indefatigable and so much at ease in the water--working +at times with their pipes lighted, the smoker at times submerged +and only the glowing bowl above the surface; it was stranger still +to think they were next congeners to the incapable Marquesan. But +the Paumotuan not only saves, grudges, and works, he steals +besides; or, to be more precise, he swindles. He will never deny a +debt, he only flees his creditor. He is always keen for an +advance; so soon as he has fingered it he disappears. He knows +your ship; so soon as it nears one island, he is off to another. +You may think you know his name; he has already changed it. +Pursuit in that infinity of isles were fruitless. The result can +be given in a nutshell. It has been actually proposed in a +Government report to secure debts by taking a photograph of the +debtor; and the other day in Papeete credits on the Paumotus to the +amount of sixteen thousand pounds were sold for less than forty-- +quatre cent mille francs pour moins de mille francs. Even so, the +purchase was thought hazardous; and only the man who made it and +who had special opportunities could have dared to give so much. + +The Paumotuan is sincerely attached to those of his own blood and +household. A touching affection sometimes unites wife and husband. +Their children, while they are alive, completely rule them; after +they are dead, their bones or their mummies are often jealously +preserved and carried from atoll to atoll in the wanderings of the +family. I was told there were many houses in Fakarava with the +mummy of a child locked in a sea-chest; after I heard it, I would +glance a little jealously at those by my own bed; in that cupboard, +also, it was possible there was a tiny skeleton. + +The race seems in a fair way to survive. From fifteen islands, +whose rolls I had occasion to consult, I found a proportion of 59 +births to 47 deaths for 1887. Dropping three out of the fifteen, +there remained for the other twelve the comfortable ratio of 50 +births to 32 deaths. Long habits of hardship and activity +doubtless explain the contrast with Marquesan figures. But the +Paumotuan displays, besides, a certain concern for health and the +rudiments of a sanitary discipline. Public talk with these free- +spoken people plays the part of the Contagious Diseases Act; in- +comers to fresh islands anxiously inquire if all be well; and +syphilis, when contracted, is successfully treated with indigenous +herbs. Like their neighbours of Tahiti, from whom they have +perhaps imbibed the error, they regard leprosy with comparative +indifference, elephantiasis with disproportionate fear. But, +unlike indeed to the Tahitian, their alarm puts on the guise of +self-defence. Any one stricken with this painful and ugly malady +is confined to the ends of villages, denied the use of paths and +highways, and condemned to transport himself between his house and +coco-patch by water only, his very footprint being held infectious. +Fe'efe'e, being a creature of marshes and the sequel of malarial +fever, is not original in atolls. On the single isle of Makatea, +where the lagoon is now a marsh, the disease has made a home. Many +suffer; they are excluded (if Mr. Wilmot be right) from much of the +comfort of society; and it is believed they take a secret +vengeance. The defections of the sick are considered highly +poisonous. Early in the morning, it is narrated, aged and +malicious persons creep into the sleeping village, and stealthily +make water at the doors of the houses of young men. Thus they +propagate disease; thus they breathe on and obliterate comeliness +and health, the objects of their envy. Whether horrid fact or more +abominable legend, it equally depicts that something bitter and +energetic which distinguishes Paumotuan man. + +The archipelago is divided between two main religions, Catholic and +Mormon. They front each other proudly with a false air of +permanence; yet are but shapes, their membership in a perpetual +flux. The Mormon attends mass with devotion: the Catholic sits +attentive at a Mormon sermon, and to-morrow each may have +transferred allegiance. One man had been a pillar of the Church of +Rome for fifteen years; his wife dying, he decided that must be a +poor religion that could not save a man his wife, and turned +Mormon. According to one informant, Catholicism was the more +fashionable in health, but on the approach of sickness it was +judged prudent to secede. As a Mormon, there were five chances out +of six you might recover; as a Catholic, your hopes were small; and +this opinion is perhaps founded on the comfortable rite of unction. + +We all know what Catholics are, whether in the Paumotus or at home. +But the Paumotuan Mormon seemed a phenomenon apart. He marries but +the one wife, uses the Protestant Bible, observes Protestant forms +of worship, forbids the use of liquor and tobacco, practises adult +baptism by immersion, and after every public sin, rechristens the +backslider. I advised with Mahinui, whom I found well informed in +the history of the American Mormons, and he declared against the +least connection. 'Pour moi,' said he, with a fine charity, 'les +Mormons ici un petit Catholiques.' Some months later I had an +opportunity to consult an orthodox fellow-countryman, an old +dissenting Highlander, long settled in Tahiti, but still breathing +of the heather of Tiree. 'Why do they call themselves Mormons?' I +asked. 'My dear, and that is my question!' he exclaimed. 'For by +all that I can hear of their doctrine, I have nothing to say +against it, and their life, it is above reproach.' And for all +that, Mormons they are, but of the earlier sowing: the so-called +Josephites, the followers of Joseph Smith, the opponents of Brigham +Young. + +Grant, then, the Mormons to be Mormons. Fresh points at once +arise: What are the Israelites? and what the Kanitus? For a long +while back the sect had been divided into Mormons proper and so- +called Israelites, I never could hear why. A few years since there +came a visiting missionary of the name of Williams, who made an +excellent collection, and retired, leaving fresh disruption +imminent. Something irregular (as I was told) in his way of +'opening the service' had raised partisans and enemies; the church +was once more rent asunder; and a new sect, the Kanitu, issued from +the division. Since then Kanitus and Israelites, like the +Cameronians and the United Presbyterians, have made common cause; +and the ecclesiastical history of the Paumotus is, for the moment, +uneventful. There will be more doing before long, and these isles +bid fair to be the Scotland of the South. Two things I could never +learn. The nature of the innovations of the Rev. Mr. Williams none +would tell me, and of the meaning of the name Kanitu none had a +guess. It was not Tahitian, it was not Marquesan; it formed no +part of that ancient speech of the Paumotus, now passing swiftly +into obsolescence. One man, a priest, God bless him! said it was +the Latin for a little dog. I have found it since as the name of a +god in New Guinea; it must be a bolder man than I who should hint +at a connection. Here, then, is a singular thing: a brand-new +sect, arising by popular acclamation, and a nonsense word invented +for its name. + +The design of mystery seems obvious, and according to a very +intelligent observer, Mr. Magee of Mangareva, this element of the +mysterious is a chief attraction of the Mormon Church. It enjoys +some of the status of Freemasonry at home, and there is for the +convert some of the exhilaration of adventure. Other attractions +are certainly conjoined. Perpetual rebaptism, leading to a +succession of baptismal feasts, is found, both from the social and +the spiritual side, a pleasing feature. More important is the fact +that all the faithful enjoy office; perhaps more important still, +the strictness of the discipline. 'The veto on liquor,' said Mr. +Magee, 'brings them plenty members.' There is no doubt these +islanders are fond of drink, and no doubt they refrain from the +indulgence; a bout on a feast-day, for instance, may be followed by +a week or a month of rigorous sobriety. Mr. Wilmot attributes this +to Paumotuan frugality and the love of hoarding; it goes far +deeper. I have mentioned that I made a feast on board the Casco. +To wash down ship's bread and jam, each guest was given the choice +of rum or syrup, and out of the whole number only one man voted--in +a defiant tone, and amid shouts of mirth--for 'Trum'! This was in +public. I had the meanness to repeat the experiment, whenever I +had a chance, within the four walls of my house; and three at +least, who had refused at the festival, greedily drank rum behind a +door. But there were others thoroughly consistent. I said the +virtues of the race were bourgeois and puritan; and how bourgeois +is this! how puritanic! how Scottish! and how Yankee!--the +temptation, the resistance, the public hypocritical conformity, the +Pharisees, the Holy Willies, and the true disciples. With such a +people the popularity of an ascetic Church appears legitimate; in +these strict rules, in this perpetual supervision, the weak find +their advantage, the strong a certain pleasure; and the doctrine of +rebaptism, a clean bill and a fresh start, will comfort many +staggering professors. + +There is yet another sect, or what is called a sect--no doubt +improperly--that of the Whistlers. Duncan Cameron, so clear in +favour of the Mormons, was no less loud in condemnation of the +Whistlers. Yet I do not know; I still fancy there is some +connection, perhaps fortuitous, probably disavowed. Here at least +are some doings in the house of an Israelite clergyman (or prophet) +in the island of Anaa, of which I am equally sure that Duncan would +disclaim and the Whistlers hail them for an imitation of their own. +My informant, a Tahitian and a Catholic, occupied one part of the +house; the prophet and his family lived in the other. Night after +night the Mormons, in the one end, held their evening sacrifice of +song; night after night, in the other, the wife of the Tahitian lay +awake and listened to their singing with amazement. At length she +could contain herself no longer, woke her husband, and asked him +what he heard. 'I hear several persons singing hymns,' said he. +'Yes,' she returned, 'but listen again! Do you not hear something +supernatural?' His attention thus directed, he was aware of a +strange buzzing voice--and yet he declared it was beautiful--which +justly accompanied the singers. The next day he made inquiries. +'It is a spirit,' said the prophet, with entire simplicity, 'which +has lately made a practice of joining us at family worship.' It +did not appear the thing was visible, and like other spirits raised +nearer home in these degenerate days, it was rudely ignorant, at +first could only buzz, and had only learned of late to bear a part +correctly in the music. + +The performances of the Whistlers are more business-like. Their +meetings are held publicly with open doors, all being 'cordially +invited to attend.' The faithful sit about the room--according to +one informant, singing hymns; according to another, now singing and +now whistling; the leader, the wizard--let me rather say, the +medium--sits in the midst, enveloped in a sheet and silent; and +presently, from just above his head, or sometimes from the midst of +the roof, an aerial whistling proceeds, appalling to the +inexperienced. This, it appears, is the language of the dead; its +purport is taken down progressively by one of the experts, writing, +I was told, 'as fast as a telegraph operator'; and the +communications are at last made public. They are of the baldest +triviality; a schooner is, perhaps, announced, some idle gossip +reported of a neighbour, or if the spirit shall have been called to +consultation on a case of sickness, a remedy may be suggested. One +of these, immersion in scalding water, not long ago proved fatal to +the patient. The whole business is very dreary, very silly, and +very European; it has none of the picturesque qualities of similar +conjurations in New Zealand; it seems to possess no kernel of +possible sense, like some that I shall describe among the Gilbert +islanders. Yet I was told that many hardy, intelligent natives +were inveterate Whistlers. 'Like Mahinui?' I asked, willing to +have a standard; and I was told 'Yes.' Why should I wonder? Men +more enlightened than my convict-catechist sit down at home to +follies equally sterile and dull. + +The medium is sometimes female. It was a woman, for instance, who +introduced these practices on the north coast of Taiarapu, to the +scandal of her own connections, her brother-in-law in particular +declaring she was drunk. But what shocked Tahiti might seem fit +enough in the Paumotus, the more so as certain women there possess, +by the gift of nature, singular and useful powers. They say they +are honest, well-intentioned ladies, some of them embarrassed by +their weird inheritance. And indeed the trouble caused by this +endowment is so great, and the protection afforded so +infinitesimally small, that I hesitate whether to call it a gift or +a hereditary curse. You may rob this lady's coco-patch, steal her +canoes, burn down her house, and slay her family scatheless; but +one thing you must not do: you must not lay a hand upon her +sleeping-mat, or your belly will swell, and you can only be cured +by the lady or her husband. Here is the report of an eye-witness, +Tasmanian born, educated, a man who has made money--certainly no +fool. In 1886 he was present in a house on Makatea, where two lads +began to skylark on the mats, and were (I think) ejected. +Instantly after, their bellies began to swell; pains took hold on +them; all manner of island remedies were exhibited in vain, and +rubbing only magnified their sufferings. The man of the house was +called, explained the nature of the visitation, and prepared the +cure. A cocoa-nut was husked, filled with herbs, and with all the +ceremonies of a launch, and the utterance of spells in the +Paumotuan language, committed to the sea. From that moment the +pains began to grow more easy and the swelling to subside. The +reader may stare. I can assure him, if he moved much among old +residents of the archipelago, he would be driven to admit one thing +of two--either that there is something in the swollen bellies or +nothing in the evidence of man. + +I have not met these gifted ladies; but I had an experience of my +own, for I have played, for one night only, the part of the +whistling spirit. It had been blowing wearily all day, but with +the fall of night the wind abated, and the moon, which was then +full, rolled in a clear sky. We went southward down the island on +the side of the lagoon, walking through long-drawn forest aisles of +palm, and on a floor of snowy sand. No life was abroad, nor sound +of life; till in a clear part of the isle we spied the embers of a +fire, and not far off, in a dark house, heard natives talking +softly. To sit without a light, even in company, and under cover, +is for a Paumotuan a somewhat hazardous extreme. The whole scene-- +the strong moonlight and crude shadows on the sand, the scattered +coals, the sound of the low voices from the house, and the lap of +the lagoon along the beach--put me (I know not how) on thoughts of +superstition. I was barefoot, I observed my steps were noiseless, +and drawing near to the dark house, but keeping well in shadow, +began to whistle. 'The Heaving of the Lead' was my air--no very +tragic piece. With the first note the conversation and all +movement ceased; silence accompanied me while I continued; and when +I passed that way on my return I found the lamp was lighted in the +house, but the tongues were still mute. All night, as I now think, +the wretches shivered and were silent. For indeed, I had no guess +at the time at the nature and magnitude of the terrors I inflicted, +or with what grisly images the notes of that old song had peopled +the dark house. + + + +CHAPTER V--A PAUMOTUAN FUNERAL + + + +No, I had no guess of these men's terrors. Yet I had received ere +that a hint, if I had understood; and the occasion was a funeral. + +A little apart in the main avenue of Rotoava, in a low hut of +leaves that opened on a small enclosure, like a pigsty on a pen, an +old man dwelt solitary with his aged wife. Perhaps they were too +old to migrate with the others; perhaps they were too poor, and had +no possessions to dispute. At least they had remained behind; and +it thus befell that they were invited to my feast. I dare say it +was quite a piece of politics in the pigsty whether to come or not +to come, and the husband long swithered between curiosity and age, +till curiosity conquered, and they came, and in the midst of that +last merrymaking death tapped him on the shoulder. For some days, +when the sky was bright and the wind cool, his mat would be spread +in the main highway of the village, and he was to be seen lying +there inert, a mere handful of a man, his wife inertly seated by +his head. They seemed to have outgrown alike our needs and +faculties; they neither spoke nor listened; they suffered us to +pass without a glance; the wife did not fan, she seemed not to +attend upon her husband, and the two poor antiques sat juxtaposed +under the high canopy of palms, the human tragedy reduced to its +bare elements, a sight beyond pathos, stirring a thrill of +curiosity. And yet there was one touch of the pathetic haunted me: +that so much youth and expectation should have run in these starved +veins, and the man should have squandered all his lees of life on a +pleasure party. + +On the morning of 17th September the sufferer died, and, time +pressing, he was buried the same day at four. The cemetery lies to +seaward behind Government House; broken coral, like so much road- +metal, forms the surface; a few wooden crosses, a few +inconsiderable upright stones, designate graves; a mortared wall, +high enough to lean on, rings it about; a clustering shrub +surrounds it with pale leaves. Here was the grave dug that +morning, doubtless by uneasy diggers, to the sound of the nigh sea +and the cries of sea-birds; meanwhile the dead man waited in his +house, and the widow and another aged woman leaned on the fence +before the door, no speech upon their lips, no speculation in their +eyes. + +Sharp at the hour the procession was in march, the coffin wrapped +in white and carried by four bearers; mourners behind--not many, +for not many remained in Rotoava, and not many in black, for these +were poor; the men in straw hats, white coats, and blue trousers or +the gorgeous parti-coloured pariu, the Tahitian kilt; the women, +with a few exceptions, brightly habited. Far in the rear came the +widow, painfully carrying the dead man's mat; a creature aged +beyond humanity, to the likeness of some missing link. + +The dead man had been a Mormon; but the Mormon clergyman was gone +with the rest to wrangle over boundaries in the adjacent isle, and +a layman took his office. Standing at the head of the open grave, +in a white coat and blue pariu, his Tahitian Bible in his hand and +one eye bound with a red handkerchief, he read solemnly that +chapter in Job which has been read and heard over the bones of so +many of our fathers, and with a good voice offered up two prayers. +The wind and the surf bore a burthen. By the cemetery gate a +mother in crimson suckled an infant rolled in blue. In the midst +the widow sat upon the ground and polished one of the coffin- +stretchers with a piece of coral; a little later she had turned her +back to the grave and was playing with a leaf. Did she understand? +God knows. The officiant paused a moment, stooped, and gathered +and threw reverently on the coffin a handful of rattling coral. +Dust to dust: but the grains of this dust were gross like +cherries, and the true dust that was to follow sat near by, still +cohering (as by a miracle) in the tragic semblance of a female ape. + +So far, Mormon or not, it was a Christian funeral. The well-known +passage had been read from Job, the prayers had been rehearsed, the +grave was filled, the mourners straggled homeward. With a little +coarser grain of covering earth, a little nearer outcry of the sea, +a stronger glare of sunlight on the rude enclosure, and some +incongruous colours of attire, the well-remembered form had been +observed. + +By rights it should have been otherwise. The mat should have been +buried with its owner; but, the family being poor, it was thriftily +reserved for a fresh service. The widow should have flung herself +upon the grave and raised the voice of official grief, the +neighbours have chimed in, and the narrow isle rung for a space +with lamentation. But the widow was old; perhaps she had +forgotten, perhaps never understood, and she played like a child +with leaves and coffin-stretchers. In all ways my guest was buried +with maimed rites. Strange to think that his last conscious +pleasure was the Casco and my feast; strange to think that he had +limped there, an old child, looking for some new good. And the +good thing, rest, had been allotted him. + +But though the widow had neglected much, there was one part she +must not utterly neglect. She came away with the dispersing +funeral; but the dead man's mat was left behind upon the grave, and +I learned that by set of sun she must return to sleep there. This +vigil is imperative. From sundown till the rising of the morning +star the Paumotuan must hold his watch above the ashes of his +kindred. Many friends, if the dead have been a man of mark, will +keep the watchers company; they will be well supplied with +coverings against the weather; I believe they bring food, and the +rite is persevered in for two weeks. Our poor survivor, if, +indeed, she properly survived, had little to cover, and few to sit +with her; on the night of the funeral a strong squall chased her +from her place of watch; for days the weather held uncertain and +outrageous; and ere seven nights were up she had desisted, and +returned to sleep in her low roof. That she should be at the pains +of returning for so short a visit to a solitary house, that this +borderer of the grave should fear a little wind and a wet blanket, +filled me at the time with musings. I could not say she was +indifferent; she was so far beyond me in experience that the court +of my criticism waived jurisdiction; but I forged excuses, telling +myself she had perhaps little to lament, perhaps suffered much, +perhaps understood nothing. And lo! in the whole affair there was +no question whether of tenderness or piety, and the sturdy return +of this old remnant was a mark either of uncommon sense or of +uncommon fortitude. + +Yet one thing had occurred that partly set me on the trail. I have +said the funeral passed much as at home. But when all was over, +when we were trooping in decent silence from the graveyard gate and +down the path to the settlement, a sudden inbreak of a different +spirit startled and perhaps dismayed us. Two people walked not far +apart in our procession: my friend Mr. Donat--Donat-Rimarau: +'Donat the much-handed'--acting Vice-Resident, present ruler of the +archipelago, by far the man of chief importance on the scene, but +known besides for one of an unshakable good temper; and a certain +comely, strapping young Paumotuan woman, the comeliest on the isle, +not (let us hope) the bravest or the most polite. Of a sudden, ere +yet the grave silence of the funeral was broken, she made a leap at +the Resident, with pointed finger, shrieked a few words, and fell +back again with a laughter, not a natural mirth. 'What did she say +to you?' I asked. 'She did not speak to ME,' said Donat, a shade +perturbed; 'she spoke to the ghost of the dead man.' And the +purport of her speech was this: 'See there! Donat will be a fine +feast for you to-night.' + +'M. Donat called it a jest,' I wrote at the time in my diary. 'It +seemed to me more in the nature of a terrified conjuration, as +though she would divert the ghost's attention from herself. A +cannibal race may well have cannibal phantoms.' The guesses of the +traveller appear foredoomed to be erroneous; yet in these I was +precisely right. The woman had stood by in terror at the funeral, +being then in a dread spot, the graveyard. She looked on in terror +to the coming night, with that ogre, a new spirit, loosed upon the +isle. And the words she had cried in Donat's face were indeed a +terrified conjuration, basely to shield herself, basely to dedicate +another in her stead. One thing is to be said in her excuse. +Doubtless she partly chose Donat because he was a man of great +good-nature, but partly, too, because he was a man of the half- +caste. For I believe all natives regard white blood as a kind of +talisman against the powers of hell. In no other way can they +explain the unpunished recklessness of Europeans. + + + +CHAPTER VI--GRAVEYARD STORIES + + + +WITH my superstitious friend, the islander, I fear I am not wholly +frank, often leading the way with stories of my own, and being +always a grave and sometimes an excited hearer. But the deceit is +scarce mortal, since I am as pleased to hear as he to tell, as +pleased with the story as he with the belief; and, besides, it is +entirely needful. For it is scarce possible to exaggerate the +extent and empire of his superstitions; they mould his life, they +colour his thinking; and when he does not speak to me of ghosts, +and gods, and devils, he is playing the dissembler and talking only +with his lips. With thoughts so different, one must indulge the +other; and I would rather that I should indulge his superstition +than he my incredulity. Of one thing, besides, I may be sure: Let +me indulge it as I please, I shall not hear the whole; for he is +already on his guard with me, and the amount of the lore is +boundless. + +I will give but a few instances at random, chiefly from my own +doorstep in Upolu, during the past month (October 1890). One of my +workmen was sent the other day to the banana patch, there to dig; +this is a hollow of the mountain, buried in woods, out of all sight +and cry of mankind; and long before dusk Lafaele was back again +beside the cook-house with embarrassed looks; he dared not longer +stay alone, he was afraid of 'spirits in the bush.' It seems these +are the souls of the unburied dead, haunting where they fell, and +wearing woodland shapes of pig, or bird, or insect; the bush is +full of them, they seem to eat nothing, slay solitary wanderers +apparently in spite, and at times, in human form, go down to +villages and consort with the inhabitants undetected. So much I +learned a day or so after, walking in the bush with a very +intelligent youth, a native. It was a little before noon; a grey +day and squally; and perhaps I had spoken lightly. A dark squall +burst on the side of the mountain; the woods shook and cried; the +dead leaves rose from the ground in clouds, like butterflies; and +my companion came suddenly to a full stop. He was afraid, he said, +of the trees falling; but as soon as I had changed the subject of +our talk he proceeded with alacrity. A day or two before a +messenger came up the mountain from Apia with a letter; I was in +the bush, he must await my return, then wait till I had answered: +and before I was done his voice sounded shrill with terror of the +coming night and the long forest road. These are the commons. +Take the chiefs. There has been a great coming and going of signs +and omens in our group. One river ran down blood; red eels were +captured in another; an unknown fish was thrown upon the coast, an +ominous word found written on its scales. So far we might be +reading in a monkish chronicle; now we come on a fresh note, at +once modern and Polynesian. The gods of Upolu and Savaii, our two +chief islands, contended recently at cricket. Since then they are +at war. Sounds of battle are heard to roll along the coast. A +woman saw a man swim from the high seas and plunge direct into the +bush; he was no man of that neighbourhood; and it was known he was +one of the gods, speeding to a council. Most perspicuous of all, a +missionary on Savaii, who is also a medical man, was disturbed late +in the night by knocking; it was no hour for the dispensary, but at +length he woke his servant and sent him to inquire; the servant, +looking from a window, beheld crowds of persons, all with grievous +wounds, lopped limbs, broken heads, and bleeding bullet-holes; but +when the door was opened all had disappeared. They were gods from +the field of battle. Now these reports have certainly +significance; it is not hard to trace them to political grumblers +or to read in them a threat of coming trouble; from that merely +human side I found them ominous myself. But it was the spiritual +side of their significance that was discussed in secret council by +my rulers. I shall best depict this mingled habit of the +Polynesian mind by two connected instances. I once lived in a +village, the name of which I do not mean to tell. The chief and +his sister were persons perfectly intelligent: gentlefolk, apt of +speech. The sister was very religious, a great church-goer, one +that used to reprove me if I stayed away; I found afterwards that +she privately worshipped a shark. The chief himself was somewhat +of a freethinker; at the least, a latitudinarian: he was a man, +besides, filled with European knowledge and accomplishments; of an +impassive, ironical habit; and I should as soon have expected +superstition in Mr. Herbert Spencer. Hear the sequel. I had +discovered by unmistakable signs that they buried too shallow in +the village graveyard, and I took my friend, as the responsible +authority, to task. 'There is something wrong about your +graveyard,' said I, 'which you must attend to, or it may have very +bad results.' 'Something wrong? What is it?' he asked, with an +emotion that surprised me. 'If you care to go along there any +evening about nine o'clock you can see for yourself,' said I. He +stepped backward. 'A ghost!' he cried. + +In short, in the whole field of the South Seas, there is not one to +blame another. Half blood and whole, pious and debauched, +intelligent and dull, all men believe in ghosts, all men combine +with their recent Christianity fear of and a lingering faith in the +old island deities. So, in Europe, the gods of Olympus slowly +dwindled into village bogies; so to-day, the theological Highlander +sneaks from under the eye of the Free Church divine to lay an +offering by a sacred well. + +I try to deal with the whole matter here because of a particular +quality in Paumotuan superstitions. It is true I heard them told +by a man with a genius for such narrations. Close about our +evening lamp, within sound of the island surf, we hung on his +words, thrilling. The reader, in far other scenes, must listen +close for the faint echo. + +This bundle of weird stories sprang from the burial and the woman's +selfish conjuration. I was dissatisfied with what I heard, harped +upon questions, and struck at last this vein of metal. It is from +sundown to about four in the morning that the kinsfolk camp upon +the grave; and these are the hours of the spirits' wanderings. At +any time of the night--it may be earlier, it may be later--a sound +is to be heard below, which is the noise of his liberation; at four +sharp, another and a louder marks the instant of the re- +imprisonment; between-whiles, he goes his malignant rounds. 'Did +you ever see an evil spirit?' was once asked of a Paumotuan. +'Once.' 'Under what form?' 'It was in the form of a crane.' 'And +how did you know that crane to be a spirit?' was asked. 'I will +tell you,' he answered; and this was the purport of his +inconclusive narrative. His father had been dead nearly a +fortnight; others had wearied of the watch; and as the sun was +setting, he found himself by the grave alone. It was not yet dark, +rather the hour of the afterglow, when he was aware of a snow-white +crane upon the coral mound; presently more cranes came, some white, +some black; then the cranes vanished, and he saw in their place a +white cat, to which there was silently joined a great company of +cats of every hue conceivable; then these also disappeared, and he +was left astonished. + +This was an anodyne appearance. Take instead the experience of +Rua-a-mariterangi on the isle of Katiu. He had a need for some +pandanus, and crossed the isle to the sea-beach, where it chiefly +flourishes. The day was still, and Rua was surprised to hear a +crashing sound among the thickets, and then the fall of a +considerable tree. Here must be some one building a canoe; and he +entered the margin of the wood to find and pass the time of day +with this chance neighbour. The crashing sounded more at hand; and +then he was aware of something drawing swiftly near among the tree- +tops. It swung by its heels downward, like an ape, so that its +hands were free for murder; it depended safely by the slightest +twigs; the speed of its coming was incredible; and soon Rua +recognised it for a corpse, horrible with age, its bowels hanging +as it came. Prayer was the weapon of Christian in the Valley of +the Shadow, and it is to prayer that Rua-a-mariterangi attributes +his escape. No merely human expedition had availed. + +This demon was plainly from the grave; yet you will observe he was +abroad by day. And inconsistent as it may seem with the hours of +the night watch and the many references to the rising of the +morning star, it is no singular exception. I could never find a +case of another who had seen this ghost, diurnal and arboreal in +its habits; but others have heard the fall of the tree, which seems +the signal of its coming. Mr. Donat was once pearling on the +uninhabited isle of Haraiki. It was a day without a breath of +wind, such as alternate in the archipelago with days of +contumelious breezes. The divers were in the midst of the lagoon +upon their employment; the cook, a boy of ten, was over his pots in +the camp. Thus were all souls accounted for except a single native +who accompanied Donat into the wood in quest of sea-fowls' eggs. +In a moment, out of the stillness, came the sound of the fall of a +great tree. Donat would have passed on to find the cause. 'No,' +cried his companion, 'that was no tree. It was something NOT +RIGHT. Let us go back to camp.' Next Sunday the divers were +turned on, all that part of the isle was thoroughly examined, and +sure enough no tree had fallen. A little later Mr. Donat saw one +of his divers flee from a similar sound, in similar unaffected +panic, on the same isle. But neither would explain, and it was not +till afterwards, when he met with Rua, that he learned the occasion +of their terrors. + +But whether by day or night, the purpose of the dead in these +abhorred activities is still the same. In Samoa, my informant had +no idea of the food of the bush spirits; no such ambiguity would +exist in the mind of a Paumotuan. In that hungry archipelago, +living and dead must alike toil for nutriment; and the race having +been cannibal in the past, the spirits are so still. When the +living ate the dead, horrified nocturnal imagination drew the +shocking inference that the dead might eat the living. Doubtless +they slay men, doubtless even mutilate them, in mere malice. +Marquesan spirits sometimes tear out the eyes of travellers; but +even that may be more practical than appears, for the eye is a +cannibal dainty. And certainly the root-idea of the dead, at least +in the far eastern islands, is to prowl for food. It was as a +dainty morsel for a meal that the woman denounced Donat at the +funeral. There are spirits besides who prey in particular not on +the bodies but on the souls of the dead. The point is clearly made +in a Tahitian story. A child fell sick, grew swiftly worse, and at +last showed signs of death. The mother hastened to the house of a +sorcerer, who lived hard by. 'You are yet in time,' said he; 'a +spirit has just run past my door carrying the soul of your child +wrapped in the leaf of a purao; but I have a spirit stronger and +swifter who will run him down ere he has time to eat it.' Wrapped +in a leaf: like other things edible and corruptible. + +Or take an experience of Mr. Donat's on the island of Anaa. It was +a night of a high wind, with violent squalls; his child was very +sick, and the father, though he had gone to bed, lay wakeful, +hearkening to the gale. All at once a fowl was violently dashed on +the house wall. Supposing he had forgot to put it in shelter with +the rest, Donat arose, found the bird (a cock) lying on the +verandah, and put it in the hen-house, the door of which he +securely fastened. Fifteen minutes later the business was +repeated, only this time, as it was being dashed against the wall, +the bird crew. Again Donat replaced it, examining the hen-house +thoroughly and finding it quite perfect; as he was so engaged the +wind puffed out his light, and he must grope back to the door a +good deal shaken. Yet a third time the bird was dashed upon the +wall; a third time Donat set it, now near dead, beside its mates; +and he was scarce returned before there came a rush, like that of a +furious strong man, against the door, and a whistle as loud as that +of a railway engine rang about the house. The sceptical reader may +here detect the finger of the tempest; but the women gave up all +for lost and clustered on the beds lamenting. Nothing followed, +and I must suppose the gale somewhat abated, for presently after a +chief came visiting. He was a bold man to be abroad so late, but +doubtless carried a bright lantern. And he was certainly a man of +counsel, for as soon as he heard the details of these disturbances +he was in a position to explain their nature. 'Your child,' said +he, 'must certainly die. This is the evil spirit of our island who +lies in wait to eat the spirits of the newly dead.' And then he +went on to expatiate on the strangeness of the spirit's conduct. +He was not usually, he explained, so open of assault, but sat +silent on the house-top waiting, in the guise of a bird, while +within the people tended the dying and bewailed the dead, and had +no thought of peril. But when the day came and the doors were +opened, and men began to go abroad, blood-stains on the wall +betrayed the tragedy. + +This is the quality I admire in Paumotuan legend. In Tahiti the +spirit-eater is said to assume a vesture which has much more of +pomp, but how much less of horror. It has been seen by all sorts +and conditions, native and foreign; only the last insist it is a +meteor. My authority was not so sure. He was riding with his wife +about two in the morning; both were near asleep, and the horses not +much better. It was a brilliant and still night, and the road +wound over a mountain, near by a deserted marae (old Tahitian +temple). All at once the appearance passed above them: a form of +light; the head round and greenish; the body long, red, and with a +focus of yet redder brilliancy about the midst. A buzzing hoot +accompanied its passage; it flew direct out of one marae, and +direct for another down the mountain side. And this, as my +informant argued, is suggestive. For why should a mere meteor +frequent the altars of abominable gods? The horses, I should say, +were equally dismayed with their riders. Now I am not dismayed at +all--not even agreeably. Give me rather the bird upon the house- +top and the morning blood-gouts on the wall. + +But the dead are not exclusive in their diet. They carry with them +to the grave, in particular, the Polynesian taste for fish, and +enter at times with the living into a partnership in fishery. Rua- +a-mariterangi is again my authority; I feel it diminishes the +credit of the fact, but how it builds up the image of this +inveterate ghost-seer! He belongs to the miserably poor island of +Taenga, yet his father's house was always well supplied. As Rua +grew up he was called at last to go a-fishing with this fortunate +parent. They rowed the lagoon at dusk, to an unlikely place, and +the lay down in the stern, and the father began vainly to cast his +line over the bows. It is to be supposed that Rua slept; and when +he awoke there was the figure of another beside his father, and his +father was pulling in the fish hand over hand. 'Who is that man, +father?' Rua asked. 'It is none of your business,' said the +father; and Rua supposed the stranger had swum off to them from +shore. Night after night they fared into the lagoon, often to the +most unlikely places; night after night the stranger would suddenly +be seen on board, and as suddenly be missed; and morning after +morning the canoe returned laden with fish. 'My father is a very +lucky man,' thought Rua. At last, one fine day, there came first +one boat party and then another, who must be entertained; father +and son put off later than usual into the lagoon; and before the +canoe was landed it was four o'clock, and the morning star was +close on the horizon. Then the stranger appeared seized with some +distress; turned about, showing for the first time his face, which +was that of one long dead, with shining eyes; stared into the east, +set the tips of his fingers to his mouth like one a-cold, uttered a +strange, shuddering sound between a whistle and a moan--a thing to +freeze the blood; and, the day-star just rising from the sea, he +suddenly was not. Then Rua understood why his father prospered, +why his fishes rotted early in the day, and why some were always +carried to the cemetery and laid upon the graves. My informant is +a man not certainly averse to superstition, but he keeps his head, +and takes a certain superior interest, which I may be allowed to +call scientific. The last point reminding him of some parallel +practice in Tahiti, he asked Rua if the fish were left, or carried +home again after a formal dedication. It appears old Mariterangi +practised both methods; sometimes treating his shadowy partner to a +mere oblation, sometimes honestly leaving his fish to rot upon the +grave. + +It is plain we have in Europe stories of a similar complexion; and +the Polynesian varua ino or aitu o le vao is clearly the near +kinsman of the Transylvanian vampire. Here is a tale in which the +kinship appears broadly marked. On the atoll of Penrhyn, then +still partly savage, a certain chief was long the salutary terror +of the natives. He died, he was buried; and his late neighbours +had scarce tasted the delights of licence ere his ghost appeared +about the village. Fear seized upon all; a council was held of the +chief men and sorcerers; and with the approval of the Rarotongan +missionary, who was as frightened as the rest, and in the presence +of several whites--my friend Mr. Ben Hird being one--the grave was +opened, deepened until water came, and the body re-interred face +down. The still recent staking of suicides in England and the +decapitation of vampires in the east of Europe form close +parallels. + +So in Samoa only the spirits of the unburied awake fear. During +the late war many fell in the bush; their bodies, sometimes +headless, were brought back by native pastors and interred; but +this (I know not why) was insufficient, and the spirit still +lingered on the theatre of death. When peace returned a singular +scene was enacted in many places, and chiefly round the high gorges +of Lotoanuu, where the struggle was long centred and the loss had +been severe. Kinswomen of the dead came carrying a mat or sheet +and guided by survivors of the fight. The place of death was +earnestly sought out; the sheet was spread upon the ground; and the +women, moved with pious anxiety, sat about and watched it. If any +living thing alighted it was twice brushed away; upon the third +coming it was known to be the spirit of the dead, was folded in, +carried home and buried beside the body; and the aitu rested. The +rite was practised beyond doubt in simple piety; the repose of the +soul was its object: its motive, reverent affection. The present +king disowns indeed all knowledge of a dangerous aitu; he declares +the souls of the unburied were only wanderers in limbo, lacking an +entrance to the proper country of the dead, unhappy, nowise +hurtful. And this severely classic opinion doubtless represents +the views of the enlightened. But the flight of my Lafaele marks +the grosser terrors of the ignorant. + +This belief in the exorcising efficacy of funeral rites perhaps +explains a fact, otherwise amazing, that no Polynesian seems at all +to share our European horror of human bones and mummies. Of the +first they made their cherished ornaments; they preserved them in +houses or in mortuary caves; and the watchers of royal sepulchres +dwelt with their children among the bones of generations. The +mummy, even in the making, was as little feared. In the Marquesas, +on the extreme coast, it was made by the household with continual +unction and exposure to the sun; in the Carolines, upon the +farthest west, it is still cured in the smoke of the family hearth. +Head-hunting, besides, still lives around my doorstep in Samoa. +And not ten years ago, in the Gilberts, the widow must disinter, +cleanse, polish, and thenceforth carry about her, by day and night, +the head of her dead husband. In all these cases we may suppose +the process, whether of cleansing or drying, to have fully +exorcised the aitu. + +But the Paumotuan belief is more obscure. Here the man is duly +buried, and he has to be watched. He is duly watched, and the +spirit goes abroad in spite of watches. Indeed, it is not the +purpose of the vigils to prevent these wanderings; only to mollify +by polite attention the inveterate malignity of the dead. Neglect +(it is supposed) may irritate and thus invite his visits, and the +aged and weakly sometimes balance risks and stay at home. Observe, +it is the dead man's kindred and next friends who thus deprecate +his fury with nocturnal watchings. Even the placatory vigil is +held perilous, except in company, and a boy was pointed out to me +in Rotoava, because he had watched alone by his own father. Not +the ties of the dead, nor yet their proved character, affect the +issue. A late Resident, who died in Fakarava of sunstroke, was +beloved in life and is still remembered with affection; none the +less his spirit went about the island clothed with terrors, and the +neighbourhood of Government House was still avoided after dark. We +may sum up the cheerful doctrine thus: All men become vampires, +and the vampire spares none. And here we come face to face with a +tempting inconsistency. For the whistling spirits are notoriously +clannish; I understood them to wait upon and to enlighten kinsfolk +only, and that the medium was always of the race of the +communicating spirit. Here, then, we have the bonds of the family, +on the one hand, severed at the hour of death; on the other, +helpfully persisting. + +The child's soul in the Tahitian tale was wrapped in leaves. It is +the spirits of the newly dead that are the dainty. When they are +slain, the house is stained with blood. Rua's dead fisherman was +decomposed; so--and horribly--was his arboreal demon. The spirit, +then, is a thing material; and it is by the material ensigns of +corruption that he is distinguished from the living man. This +opinion is widespread, adds a gross terror to the more ugly +Polynesian tales, and sometimes defaces the more engaging with a +painful and incongruous touch. I will give two examples +sufficiently wide apart, one from Tahiti, one from Samoa. + +And first from Tahiti. A man went to visit the husband of his +sister, then some time dead. In her life the sister had been +dainty in the island fashion, and went always adorned with a +coronet of flowers. In the midst of the night the brother awoke +and was aware of a heavenly fragrance going to and fro in the dark +house. The lamp I must suppose to have burned out; no Tahitian +would have lain down without one lighted. A while he lay wondering +and delighted; then called upon the rest. 'Do none of you smell +flowers?' he asked. 'O,' said his brother-in-law, 'we are used to +that here.' The next morning these two men went walking, and the +widower confessed that his dead wife came about the house +continually, and that he had even seen her. She was shaped and +dressed and crowned with flowers as in her lifetime; only she moved +a few inches above the earth with a very easy progress, and flitted +dryshod above the surface of the river. And now comes my point: +It was always in a back view that she appeared; and these brothers- +in-law, debating the affair, agreed that this was to conceal the +inroads of corruption. + +Now for the Samoan story. I owe it to the kindness of Dr. F. Otto +Sierich, whose collection of folk-tales I expect with a high degree +of interest. A man in Manu'a was married to two wives and had no +issue. He went to Savaii, married there a third, and was more +fortunate. When his wife was near her time he remembered he was in +a strange island, like a poor man; and when his child was born he +must be shamed for lack of gifts. It was in vain his wife +dissuaded him. He returned to his father in Manu'a seeking help; +and with what he could get he set off in the night to re-embark. +Now his wives heard of his coming; they were incensed that he did +not stay to visit them; and on the beach, by his canoe, intercepted +and slew him. Now the third wife lay asleep in Savaii;--her babe +was born and slept by her side; and she was awakened by the spirit +of her husband. 'Get up,' he said, 'my father is sick in Manu'a +and we must go to visit him.' 'It is well,' said she; 'take you +the child, while I carry its mats.' 'I cannot carry the child,' +said the spirit; 'I am too cold from the sea.' When they were got +on board the canoe the wife smelt carrion. 'How is this?' she +said. 'What have you in the canoe that I should smell carrion?' +'It is nothing in the canoe,' said the spirit. 'It is the land- +wind blowing down the mountains, where some beast lies dead.' It +appears it was still night when they reached Manu'a--the swiftest +passage on record--and as they entered the reef the bale-fires +burned in the village. Again she asked him to carry the child; but +now he need no more dissemble. 'I cannot carry your child,' said +he, 'for I am dead, and the fires you see are burning for my +funeral.' + +The curious may learn in Dr. Sierich's book the unexpected sequel +of the tale. Here is enough for my purpose. Though the man was +but new dead, the ghost was already putrefied, as though +putrefaction were the mark and of the essence of a spirit. The +vigil on the Paumotuan grave does not extend beyond two weeks, and +they told me this period was thought to coincide with that of the +resolution of the body. The ghost always marked with decay--the +danger seemingly ending with the process of dissolution--here is +tempting matter for the theorist. But it will not do. The lady of +the flowers had been long dead, and her spirit was still supposed +to bear the brand of perishability. The Resident had been more +than a fortnight buried, and his vampire was still supposed to go +the rounds. + +Of the lost state of the dead, from the lurid Mangaian legend, in +which infernal deities hocus and destroy the souls of all, to the +various submarine and aerial limbos where the dead feast, float +idle, or resume the occupations of their life on earth, it would be +wearisome to tell. One story I give, for it is singular in itself, +is well-known in Tahiti, and has this of interest, that it is post- +Christian, dating indeed from but a few years back. A princess of +the reigning house died; was transported to the neighbouring isle +of Raiatea; fell there under the empire of a spirit who condemned +her to climb coco-palms all day and bring him the nuts; was found +after some time in this miserable servitude by a second spirit, one +of her own house; and by him, upon her lamentations, reconveyed to +Tahiti, where she found her body still waked, but already swollen +with the approaches of corruption. It is a lively point in the +tale that, on the sight of this dishonoured tabernacle, the +princess prayed she might continue to be numbered with the dead. +But it seems it was too late, her spirit was replaced by the least +dignified of entrances, and her startled family beheld the body +move. The seemingly purgatorial labours, the helpful kindred +spirit, and the horror of the princess at the sight of her tainted +body, are all points to be remarked. + +The truth is, the tales are not necessarily consistent in +themselves; and they are further darkened for the stranger by an +ambiguity of language. Ghosts, vampires, spirits, and gods are all +confounded. And yet I seem to perceive that (with exceptions) +those whom we would count gods were less maleficent. Permanent +spirits haunt and do murder in corners of Samoa; but those +legitimate gods of Upolu and Savaii, whose wars and cricketings of +late convulsed society, I did not gather to be dreaded, or not with +a like fear. The spirit of Aana that ate souls is certainly a +fearsome inmate; but the high gods, even of the archipelago, seem +helpful. Mahinui--from whom our convict-catechist had been named-- +the spirit of the sea, like a Proteus endowed with endless avatars, +came to the assistance of the shipwrecked and carried them ashore +in the guise of a ray fish. The same divinity bore priests from +isle to isle about the archipelago, and by his aid, within the +century, persons have been seen to fly. The tutelar deity of each +isle is likewise helpful, and by a particular form of wedge-shaped +cloud on the horizon announces the coming of a ship. + +To one who conceives of these atolls, so narrow, so barren, so +beset with sea, here would seem a superfluity of ghostly denizens. +And yet there are more. In the various brackish pools and ponds, +beautiful women with long red hair are seen to rise and bathe; only +(timid as mice) on the first sound of feet upon the coral they dive +again for ever. They are known to be healthy and harmless living +people, dwellers of an underworld; and the same fancy is current in +Tahiti, where also they have the hair red. Tetea is the Tahitian +name; the Paumotuan, Mokurea. + + + + +PART III: THE GILBERTS + + + + +CHAPTER I--BUTARITARI + + + +At Honolulu we had said farewell to the Casco and to Captain Otis, +and our next adventure was made in changed conditions. Passage was +taken for myself, my wife, Mr. Osbourne, and my China boy, Ah Fu, +on a pigmy trading schooner, the Equator, Captain Dennis Reid; and +on a certain bright June day in 1889, adorned in the Hawaiian +fashion with the garlands of departure, we drew out of port and +bore with a fair wind for Micronesia. + +The whole extent of the South Seas is a desert of ships; more +especially that part where we were now to sail. No post runs in +these islands; communication is by accident; where you may have +designed to go is one thing, where you shall be able to arrive +another. It was my hope, for instance, to have reached the +Carolines, and returned to the light of day by way of Manila and +the China ports; and it was in Samoa that we were destined to re- +appear and be once more refreshed with the sight of mountains. +Since the sunset faded from the peaks of Oahu six months had +intervened, and we had seen no spot of earth so high as an ordinary +cottage. Our path had been still on the flat sea, our dwellings +upon unerected coral, our diet from the pickle-tub or out of tins; +I had learned to welcome shark's flesh for a variety; and a +mountain, an onion, an Irish potato or a beef-steak, had been long +lost to sense and dear to aspiration. + +The two chief places of our stay, Butaritari and Apemama, lie near +the line; the latter within thirty miles. Both enjoy a superb +ocean climate, days of blinding sun and bracing wind, nights of a +heavenly brightness. Both are somewhat wider than Fakarava, +measuring perhaps (at the widest) a quarter of a mile from beach to +beach. In both, a coarse kind of taro thrives; its culture is a +chief business of the natives, and the consequent mounds and +ditches make miniature scenery and amuse the eye. In all else they +show the customary features of an atoll: the low horizon, the +expanse of the lagoon, the sedge-like rim of palm-tops, the +sameness and smallness of the land, the hugely superior size and +interest of sea and sky. Life on such islands is in many points +like life on shipboard. The atoll, like the ship, is soon taken +for granted; and the islanders, like the ship's crew, become soon +the centre of attention. The isles are populous, independent, +seats of kinglets, recently civilised, little visited. In the last +decade many changes have crept in; women no longer go unclothed +till marriage; the widow no longer sleeps at night and goes abroad +by day with the skull of her dead husband; and, fire-arms being +introduced, the spear and the shark-tooth sword are sold for +curiosities. Ten years ago all these things and practices were to +be seen in use; yet ten years more, and the old society will have +entirely vanished. We came in a happy moment to see its +institutions still erect and (in Apemama) scarce decayed. + +Populous and independent--warrens of men, ruled over with some +rustic pomp--such was the first and still the recurring impression +of these tiny lands. As we stood across the lagoon for the town of +Butaritari, a stretch of the low shore was seen to be crowded with +the brown roofs of houses; those of the palace and king's summer +parlour (which are of corrugated iron) glittered near one end +conspicuously bright; the royal colours flew hard by on a tall +flagstaff; in front, on an artificial islet, the gaol played the +part of a martello. Even upon this first and distant view, the +place had scarce the air of what it truly was, a village; rather of +that which it was also, a petty metropolis, a city rustic and yet +royal. + +The lagoon is shoal. The tide being out, we waded for some quarter +of a mile in tepid shallows, and stepped ashore at last into a +flagrant stagnancy of sun and heat. The lee side of a line island +after noon is indeed a breathless place; on the ocean beach the +trade will be still blowing, boisterous and cool; out in the lagoon +it will be blowing also, speeding the canoes; but the screen of +bush completely intercepts it from the shore, and sleep and silence +and companies of mosquitoes brood upon the towns. + +We may thus be said to have taken Butaritari by surprise. A few +inhabitants were still abroad in the north end, at which we landed. +As we advanced, we were soon done with encounter, and seemed to +explore a city of the dead. Only, between the posts of open +houses, we could see the townsfolk stretched in the siesta, +sometimes a family together veiled in a mosquito-net, sometimes a +single sleeper on a platform like a corpse on a bier. + +The houses were of all dimensions, from those of toys to those of +churches. Some might hold a battalion, some were so minute they +could scarce receive a pair of lovers; only in the playroom, when +the toys are mingled, do we meet such incongruities of scale. Many +were open sheds; some took the form of roofed stages; others were +walled and the walls pierced with little windows. A few were +perched on piles in the lagoon; the rest stood at random on a +green, through which the roadway made a ribbon of sand, or along +the embankments of a sheet of water like a shallow dock. One and +all were the creatures of a single tree; palm-tree wood and palm- +tree leaf their materials; no nail had been driven, no hammer +sounded, in their building, and they were held together by lashings +of palm-tree sinnet. + +In the midst of the thoroughfare, the church stands like an island, +a lofty and dim house with rows of windows; a rich tracery of +framing sustains the roof; and through the door at either end the +street shows in a vista. The proportions of the place, in such +surroundings, and built of such materials, appeared august; and we +threaded the nave with a sentiment befitting visitors in a +cathedral. Benches run along either side. In the midst, on a +crazy dais, two chairs stand ready for the king and queen when they +shall choose to worship; over their heads a hoop, apparently from a +hogshead, depends by a strip of red cotton; and the hoop (which +hangs askew) is dressed with streamers of the same material, red +and white. + +This was our first advertisement of the royal dignity, and +presently we stood before its seat and centre. The palace is built +of imported wood upon a European plan; the roof of corrugated iron, +the yard enclosed with walls, the gate surmounted by a sort of +lych-house. It cannot be called spacious; a labourer in the States +is sometimes more commodiously lodged; but when we had the chance +to see it within, we found it was enriched (beyond all island +expectation) with coloured advertisements and cuts from the +illustrated papers. Even before the gate some of the treasures of +the crown stand public: a bell of a good magnitude, two pieces of +cannon, and a single shell. The bell cannot be rung nor the guns +fired; they are curiosities, proofs of wealth, a part of the parade +of the royalty, and stand to be admired like statues in a square. +A straight gut of water like a canal runs almost to the palace +door; the containing quay-walls excellently built of coral; over +against the mouth, by what seems an effect of landscape art, the +martello-like islet of the gaol breaks the lagoon. Vassal chiefs +with tribute, neighbour monarchs come a-roving, might here sail in, +view with surprise these extensive public works, and be awed by +these mouths of silent cannon. It was impossible to see the place +and not to fancy it designed for pageantry. But the elaborate +theatre then stood empty; the royal house deserted, its doors and +windows gaping; the whole quarter of the town immersed in silence. +On the opposite bank of the canal, on a roofed stage, an ancient +gentleman slept publicly, sole visible inhabitant; and beyond on +the lagoon a canoe spread a striped lateen, the sole thing moving. + +The canal is formed on the south by a pier or causeway with a +parapet. At the far end the parapet stops, and the quay expands +into an oblong peninsula in the lagoon, the breathing-place and +summer parlour of the king. The midst is occupied by an open house +or permanent marquee--called here a maniapa, or, as the word is now +pronounced, a maniap'--at the lowest estimation forty feet by +sixty. The iron roof, lofty but exceedingly low-browed, so that a +woman must stoop to enter, is supported externally on pillars of +coral, within by a frame of wood. The floor is of broken coral, +divided in aisles by the uprights of the frame; the house far +enough from shore to catch the breeze, which enters freely and +disperses the mosquitoes; and under the low eaves the sun is seen +to glitter and the waves to dance on the lagoon. + +It was now some while since we had met any but slumberers; and when +we had wandered down the pier and stumbled at last into this bright +shed, we were surprised to find it occupied by a society of wakeful +people, some twenty souls in all, the court and guardsmen of +Butaritari. The court ladies were busy making mats; the guardsmen +yawned and sprawled. Half a dozen rifles lay on a rock and a +cutlass was leaned against a pillar: the armoury of these drowsy +musketeers. At the far end, a little closed house of wood +displayed some tinsel curtains, and proved, upon examination, to be +a privy on the European model. In front of this, upon some mats, +lolled Tebureimoa, the king; behind him, on the panels of the +house, two crossed rifles represented fasces. He wore pyjamas +which sorrowfully misbecame his bulk; his nose was hooked and +cruel, his body overcome with sodden corpulence, his eye timorous +and dull: he seemed at once oppressed with drowsiness and held +awake by apprehension: a pepper rajah muddled with opium, and +listening for the march of a Dutch army, looks perhaps not +otherwise. We were to grow better acquainted, and first and last I +had the same impression; he seemed always drowsy, yet always to +hearken and start; and, whether from remorse or fear, there is no +doubt he seeks a refuge in the abuse of drugs. + +The rajah displayed no sign of interest in our coming. But the +queen, who sat beside him in a purple sacque, was more accessible; +and there was present an interpreter so willing that his volubility +became at last the cause of our departure. He had greeted us upon +our entrance:- 'That is the honourable King, and I am his +interpreter,' he had said, with more stateliness than truth. For +he held no appointment in the court, seemed extremely ill- +acquainted with the island language, and was present, like +ourselves, upon a visit of civility. Mr. Williams was his name: +an American darkey, runaway ship's cook, and bar-keeper at The Land +we Live in tavern, Butaritari. I never knew a man who had more +words in his command or less truth to communicate; neither the +gloom of the monarch, nor my own efforts to be distant, could in +the least abash him; and when the scene closed, the darkey was left +talking. + +The town still slumbered, or had but just begun to turn and stretch +itself; it was still plunged in heat and silence. So much the more +vivid was the impression that we carried away of the house upon the +islet, the Micronesian Saul wakeful amid his guards, and his +unmelodious David, Mr. Williams, chattering through the drowsy +hours. + + + +CHAPTER II--THE FOUR BROTHERS + + + +The kingdom of Tebureimoa includes two islands, Great and Little +Makin; some two thousand subjects pay him tribute, and two semi- +independent chieftains do him qualified homage. The importance of +the office is measured by the man; he may be a nobody, he may be +absolute; and both extremes have been exemplified within the memory +of residents. + +On the death of king Tetimararoa, Tebureimoa's father, Nakaeia, the +eldest son, succeeded. He was a fellow of huge physical strength, +masterful, violent, with a certain barbaric thrift and some +intelligence of men and business. Alone in his islands, it was he +who dealt and profited; he was the planter and the merchant; and +his subjects toiled for his behoof in servitude. When they wrought +long and well their taskmaster declared a holiday, and supplied and +shared a general debauch. The scale of his providing was at times +magnificent; six hundred dollars' worth of gin and brandy was set +forth at once; the narrow land resounded with the noise of revelry: +and it was a common thing to see the subjects (staggering +themselves) parade their drunken sovereign on the fore-hatch of a +wrecked vessel, king and commons howling and singing as they went. +At a word from Nakaeia's mouth the revel ended; Makin became once +more an isle of slaves and of teetotalers; and on the morrow all +the population must be on the roads or in the taro-patches toiling +under his bloodshot eye. + +The fear of Nakaeia filled the land. No regularity of justice was +affected; there was no trial, there were no officers of the law; it +seems there was but one penalty, the capital; and daylight assault +and midnight murder were the forms of process. The king himself +would play the executioner: and his blows were dealt by stealth, +and with the help and countenance of none but his own wives. These +were his oarswomen; one that caught a crab, he slew incontinently +with the tiller; thus disciplined, they pulled him by night to the +scene of his vengeance, which he would then execute alone and +return well-pleased with his connubial crew. The inmates of the +harem held a station hard for us to conceive. Beasts of draught, +and driven by the fear of death, they were yet implicitly trusted +with their sovereign's life; they were still wives and queens, and +it was supposed that no man should behold their faces. They killed +by the sight like basilisks; a chance view of one of those +boatwomen was a crime to be wiped out with blood. In the days of +Nakaeia the palace was beset with some tall coco-palms which +commanded the enclosure. It chanced one evening, while Nakaeia sat +below at supper with his wives, that the owner of the grove was in +a tree-top drawing palm-tree wine; it chanced that he looked down, +and the king at the same moment looking up, their eyes encountered. +Instant flight preserved the involuntary criminal. But during the +remainder of that reign he must lurk and be hid by friends in +remote parts of the isle; Nakaeia hunted him without remission, +although still in vain; and the palms, accessories to the fact, +were ruthlessly cut down. Such was the ideal of wifely purity in +an isle where nubile virgins went naked as in paradise. And yet +scandal found its way into Nakaeia's well-guarded harem. He was at +that time the owner of a schooner, which he used for a pleasure- +house, lodging on board as she lay anchored; and thither one day he +summoned a new wife. She was one that had been sealed to him; that +is to say (I presume), that he was married to her sister, for the +husband of an elder sister has the call of the cadets. She would +be arrayed for the occasion; she would come scented, garlanded, +decked with fine mats and family jewels, for marriage, as her +friends supposed; for death, as she well knew. 'Tell me the man's +name, and I will spare you,' said Nakaeia. But the girl was +staunch; she held her peace, saved her lover and the queens +strangled her between the mats. + +Nakaeia was feared; it does not appear that he was hated. Deeds +that smell to us of murder wore to his subjects the reverend face +of justice; his orgies made him popular; natives to this day recall +with respect the firmness of his government; and even the whites, +whom he long opposed and kept at arm's-length, give him the name +(in the canonical South Sea phrase) of 'a perfect gentleman when +sober.' + +When he came to lie, without issue, on the bed of death, he +summoned his next brother, Nanteitei, made him a discourse on royal +policy, and warned him he was too weak to reign. The warning was +taken to heart, and for some while the government moved on the +model of Nakaeia's. Nanteitei dispensed with guards, and walked +abroad alone with a revolver in a leather mail-bag. To conceal his +weakness he affected a rude silence; you might talk to him all day; +advice, reproof, appeal, and menace alike remained unanswered. + +The number of his wives was seventeen, many of them heiresses; for +the royal house is poor, and marriage was in these days a chief +means of buttressing the throne. Nakaeia kept his harem busy for +himself; Nanteitei hired it out to others. In his days, for +instance, Messrs. Wightman built a pier with a verandah at the +north end of the town. The masonry was the work of the seventeen +queens, who toiled and waded there like fisher lasses; but the man +who was to do the roofing durst not begin till they had finished, +lest by chance he should look down and see them. + +It was perhaps the last appearance of the harem gang. For some +time already Hawaiian missionaries had been seated at Butaritari-- +Maka and Kanoa, two brave childlike men. Nakaeia would none of +their doctrine; he was perhaps jealous of their presence; being +human, he had some affection for their persons. In the house, +before the eyes of Kanoa, he slew with his own hand three sailors +of Oahu, crouching on their backs to knife them, and menacing the +missionary if he interfered; yet he not only spared him at the +moment, but recalled him afterwards (when he had fled) with some +expressions of respect. Nanteitei, the weaker man, fell more +completely under the spell. Maka, a light-hearted, lovable, yet in +his own trade very rigorous man, gained and improved an influence +on the king which soon grew paramount. Nanteitei, with the royal +house, was publicly converted; and, with a severity which liberal +missionaries disavow, the harem was at once reduced. It was a +compendious act. The throne was thus impoverished, its influence +shaken, the queen's relatives mortified, and sixteen chief women +(some of great possessions) cast in a body on the market. I have +been shipmates with a Hawaiian sailor who was successively married +to two of these impromptu widows, and successively divorced by both +for misconduct. That two great and rich ladies (for both of these +were rich) should have married 'a man from another island' marks +the dissolution of society. The laws besides were wholly +remodelled, not always for the better. I love Maka as a man; as a +legislator he has two defects: weak in the punishment of crime, +stern to repress innocent pleasures. + +War and revolution are the common successors of reform; yet +Nanteitei died (of an overdose of chloroform), in quiet possession +of the throne, and it was in the reign of the third brother, +Nabakatokia, a man brave in body and feeble of character, that the +storm burst. The rule of the high chiefs and notables seems to +have always underlain and perhaps alternated with monarchy. The +Old Men (as they were called) have a right to sit with the king in +the Speak House and debate: and the king's chief superiority is a +form of closure--'The Speaking is over.' After the long monocracy +of Nakaeia and the changes of Nanteitei, the Old Men were doubtless +grown impatient of obscurity, and they were beyond question jealous +of the influence of Maka. Calumny, or rather caricature, was +called in use; a spoken cartoon ran round society; Maka was +reported to have said in church that the king was the first man in +the island and himself the second; and, stung by the supposed +affront, the chiefs broke into rebellion and armed gatherings. In +the space of one forenoon the throne of Nakaeia was humbled in the +dust. The king sat in the maniap' before the palace gate expecting +his recruits; Maka by his side, both anxious men; and meanwhile, in +the door of a house at the north entry of the town, a chief had +taken post and diverted the succours as they came. They came +singly or in groups, each with his gun or pistol slung about his +neck. 'Where are you going?' asked the chief. 'The king called +us,' they would reply. 'Here is your place. Sit down,' returned +the chief. With incredible disloyalty, all obeyed; and sufficient +force being thus got together from both sides, Nabakatokia was +summoned and surrendered. About this period, in almost every part +of the group, the kings were murdered; and on Tapituea, the +skeleton of the last hangs to this day in the chief Speak House of +the isle, a menace to ambition. Nabakatokia was more fortunate; +his life and the royal style were spared to him, but he was +stripped of power. The Old Men enjoyed a festival of public +speaking; the laws were continually changed, never enforced; the +commons had an opportunity to regret the merits of Nakaeia; and the +king, denied the resource of rich marriages and the service of a +troop of wives, fell not only in disconsideration but in debt. + +He died some months before my arrival on the islands, and no one +regretted him; rather all looked hopefully to his successor. This +was by repute the hero of the family. Alone of the four brothers, +he had issue, a grown son, Natiata, and a daughter three years old; +it was to him, in the hour of the revolution, that Nabakatokia +turned too late for help; and in earlier days he had been the right +hand of the vigorous Nakaeia. Nontemat', Mr. Corpse, was his +appalling nickname, and he had earned it well. Again and again, at +the command of Nakaeia, he had surrounded houses in the dead of +night, cut down the mosquito bars and butchered families. Here was +the hand of iron; here was Nakaeia redux. He came, summoned from +the tributary rule of Little Makin: he was installed, he proved a +puppet and a trembler, the unwieldy shuttlecock of orators; and the +reader has seen the remains of him in his summer parlour under the +name of Tebureimoa. + +The change in the man's character was much commented on in the +island, and variously explained by opium and Christianity. To my +eyes, there seemed no change at all, rather an extreme consistency. +Mr. Corpse was afraid of his brother: King Tebureimoa is afraid of +the Old Men. Terror of the first nerved him for deeds of +desperation; fear of the second disables him for the least act of +government. He played his part of bravo in the past, following the +line of least resistance, butchering others in his own defence: +to-day, grown elderly and heavy, a convert, a reader of the Bible, +perhaps a penitent, conscious at least of accumulated hatreds, and +his memory charged with images of violence and blood, he +capitulates to the Old Men, fuddles himself with opium, and sits +among his guards in dreadful expectation. The same cowardice that +put into his hand the knife of the assassin deprives him of the +sceptre of a king. + +A tale that I was told, a trifling incident that fell in my +observation, depicts him in his two capacities. A chief in Little +Makin asked, in an hour of lightness, 'Who is Kaeia?' A bird +carried the saying; and Nakaeia placed the matter in the hands of a +committee of three. Mr. Corpse was chairman; the second +commissioner died before my arrival; the third was yet alive and +green, and presented so venerable an appearance that we gave him +the name of Abou ben Adhem. Mr. Corpse was troubled with a +scruple; the man from Little Makin was his adopted brother; in such +a case it was not very delicate to appear at all, to strike the +blow (which it seems was otherwise expected of him) would be worse +than awkward. 'I will strike the blow,' said the venerable Abou; +and Mr. Corpse (surely with a sigh) accepted the compromise. The +quarry was decoyed into the bush; he was set to carrying a log; and +while his arms were raised Abou ripped up his belly at a blow. +Justice being thus done, the commission, in a childish horror, +turned to flee. But their victim recalled them to his side. 'You +need not run away now,' he said. 'You have done this thing to me. +Stay.' He was some twenty minutes dying, and his murderers sat +with him the while: a scene for Shakespeare. All the stages of a +violent death, the blood, the failing voice, the decomposing +features, the changed hue, are thus present in the memory of Mr. +Corpse; and since he studied them in the brother he betrayed, he +has some reason to reflect on the possibilities of treachery. I +was never more sure of anything than the tragic quality of the +king's thoughts; and yet I had but the one sight of him at +unawares. I had once an errand for his ear. It was once more the +hour of the siesta; but there were loiterers abroad, and these +directed us to a closed house on the bank of the canal where +Tebureimoa lay unguarded. We entered without ceremony, being in +some haste. He lay on the floor upon a bed of mats, reading in his +Gilbert Island Bible with compunction. On our sudden entrance the +unwieldy man reared himself half-sitting so that the Bible rolled +on the floor, stared on us a moment with blank eyes, and, having +recognised his visitors, sank again upon the mats. So Eglon looked +on Ehud. + +The justice of facts is strange, and strangely just; Nakaeia, the +author of these deeds, died at peace discoursing on the craft of +kings; his tool suffers daily death for his enforced complicity. +Not the nature, but the congruity of men's deeds and circumstances +damn and save them; and Tebureimoa from the first has been +incongruously placed. At home, in a quiet bystreet of a village, +the man had been a worthy carpenter, and, even bedevilled as he is, +he shows some private virtues. He has no lands, only the use of +such as are impignorate for fines; he cannot enrich himself in the +old way by marriages; thrift is the chief pillar of his future, and +he knows and uses it. Eleven foreign traders pay him a patent of a +hundred dollars, some two thousand subjects pay capitation at the +rate of a dollar for a man, half a dollar for a woman, and a +shilling for a child: allowing for the exchange, perhaps a total +of three hundred pounds a year. He had been some nine months on +the throne: had bought his wife a silk dress and hat, figure +unknown, and himself a uniform at three hundred dollars; had sent +his brother's photograph to be enlarged in San Francisco at two +hundred and fifty dollars; had greatly reduced that brother's +legacy of debt and had still sovereigns in his pocket. An +affectionate brother, a good economist; he was besides a handy +carpenter, and cobbled occasionally on the woodwork of the palace. +It is not wonderful that Mr. Corpse has virtues; that Tebureimoa +should have a diversion filled me with surprise. + + + +CHAPTER III--AROUND OUR HOUSE + + + +When we left the palace we were still but seafarers ashore; and +within the hour we had installed our goods in one of the six +foreign houses of Butaritari, namely, that usually occupied by +Maka, the Hawaiian missionary. Two San Francisco firms are here +established, Messrs. Crawford and Messrs. Wightman Brothers; the +first hard by the palace of the mid town, the second at the north +entry; each with a store and bar-room. Our house was in the +Wightman compound, betwixt the store and bar, within a fenced +enclosure. Across the road a few native houses nestled in the +margin of the bush, and the green wall of palms rose solid, +shutting out the breeze. A little sandy cove of the lagoon ran in +behind, sheltered by a verandah pier, the labour of queens' hands. +Here, when the tide was high, sailed boats lay to be loaded; when +the tide was low, the boats took ground some half a mile away, and +an endless series of natives descended the pier stair, tailed +across the sand in strings and clusters, waded to the waist with +the bags of copra, and loitered backward to renew their charge. +The mystery of the copra trade tormented me, as I sat and watched +the profits drip on the stair and the sands. + +In front, from shortly after four in the morning until nine at +night, the folk of the town streamed by us intermittingly along the +road: families going up the island to make copra on their lands; +women bound for the bush to gather flowers against the evening +toilet; and, twice a day, the toddy-cutters, each with his knife +and shell. In the first grey of the morning, and again late in the +afternoon, these would straggle past about their tree-top business, +strike off here and there into the bush, and vanish from the face +of the earth. At about the same hour, if the tide be low in the +lagoon, you are likely to be bound yourself across the island for a +bath, and may enter close at their heels alleys of the palm wood. +Right in front, although the sun is not yet risen, the east is +already lighted with preparatory fires, and the huge accumulations +of the trade-wind cloud glow with and heliograph the coming day. +The breeze is in your face; overhead in the tops of the palms, its +playthings, it maintains a lively bustle; look where you will, +above or below, there is no human presence, only the earth and +shaken forest. And right overhead the song of an invisible singer +breaks from the thick leaves; from farther on a second tree-top +answers; and beyond again, in the bosom of the woods, a still more +distant minstrel perches and sways and sings. So, all round the +isle, the toddy-cutters sit on high, and are rocked by the trade, +and have a view far to seaward, where they keep watch for sails, +and like huge birds utter their songs in the morning. They sing +with a certain lustiness and Bacchic glee; the volume of sound and +the articulate melody fall unexpected from the tree-top, whence we +anticipate the chattering of fowls. And yet in a sense these songs +also are but chatter; the words are ancient, obsolete, and sacred; +few comprehend them, perhaps no one perfectly; but it was +understood the cutters 'prayed to have good toddy, and sang of +their old wars.' The prayer is at least answered; and when the +foaming shell is brought to your door, you have a beverage well +'worthy of a grace.' All forenoon you may return and taste; it +only sparkles, and sharpens, and grows to be a new drink, not less +delicious; but with the progress of the day the fermentation +quickens and grows acid; in twelve hours it will be yeast for +bread, in two days more a devilish intoxicant, the counsellor of +crime. + +The men are of a marked Arabian cast of features, often bearded and +mustached, often gaily dressed, some with bracelets and anklets, +all stalking hidalgo-like, and accepting salutations with a haughty +lip. The hair (with the dandies of either sex) is worn turban-wise +in a frizzled bush; and like the daggers of the Japanese a pointed +stick (used for a comb) is thrust gallantly among the curls. The +women from this bush of hair look forth enticingly: the race +cannot be compared with the Tahitian for female beauty; I doubt +even if the average be high; but some of the prettiest girls, and +one of the handsomest women I ever saw, were Gilbertines. +Butaritari, being the commercial centre of the group, is +Europeanised; the coloured sacque or the white shift are common +wear, the latter for the evening; the trade hat, loaded with +flowers, fruit, and ribbons, is unfortunately not unknown; and the +characteristic female dress of the Gilberts no longer universal. +The ridi is its name: a cutty petticoat or fringe of the smoked +fibre of cocoa-nut leaf, not unlike tarry string: the lower edge +not reaching the mid-thigh, the upper adjusted so low upon the +haunches that it seems to cling by accident. A sneeze, you think, +and the lady must surely be left destitute. 'The perilous, +hairbreadth ridi' was our word for it; and in the conflict that +rages over women's dress it has the misfortune to please neither +side, the prudish condemning it as insufficient, the more frivolous +finding it unlovely in itself. Yet if a pretty Gilbertine would +look her best, that must be her costume. In that and naked +otherwise, she moves with an incomparable liberty and grace and +life, that marks the poetry of Micronesia. Bundle her in a gown, +the charm is fled, and she wriggles like an Englishwoman. + +Towards dusk the passers-by became more gorgeous. The men broke +out in all the colours of the rainbow--or at least of the trade- +room,--and both men and women began to be adorned and scented with +new flowers. A small white blossom is the favourite, sometimes +sown singly in a woman's hair like little stars, now composed in a +thick wreath. With the night, the crowd sometimes thickened in the +road, and the padding and brushing of bare feet became continuous; +the promenades mostly grave, the silence only interrupted by some +giggling and scampering of girls; even the children quiet. At +nine, bed-time struck on a bell from the cathedral, and the life of +the town ceased. At four the next morning the signal is repeated +in the darkness, and the innocent prisoners set free; but for seven +hours all must lie--I was about to say within doors, of a place +where doors, and even walls, are an exception--housed, at least, +under their airy roofs and clustered in the tents of the mosquito- +nets. Suppose a necessary errand to occur, suppose it imperative +to send abroad, the messenger must then go openly, advertising +himself to the police with a huge brand of cocoa-nut, which flares +from house to house like a moving bonfire. Only the police +themselves go darkling, and grope in the night for misdemeanants. +I used to hate their treacherous presence; their captain in +particular, a crafty old man in white, lurked nightly about my +premises till I could have found it in my heart to beat him. But +the rogue was privileged. + +Not one of the eleven resident traders came to town, no captain +cast anchor in the lagoon, but we saw him ere the hour was out. +This was owing to our position between the store and the bar--the +Sans Souci, as the last was called. Mr. Rick was not only Messrs. +Wightman's manager, but consular agent for the States; Mrs. Rick +was the only white woman on the island, and one of the only two in +the archipelago; their house besides, with its cool verandahs, its +bookshelves, its comfortable furniture, could not be rivalled +nearer than Jaluit or Honolulu. Every one called in consequence, +save such as might be prosecuting a South Sea quarrel, hingeing on +the price of copra and the odd cent, or perhaps a difference about +poultry. Even these, if they did not appear upon the north, would +be presently visible to the southward, the Sans Souci drawing them +as with cords. In an island with a total population of twelve +white persons, one of the two drinking-shops might seem +superfluous: but every bullet has its billet, and the double +accommodation of Butaritari is found in practice highly convenient +by the captains and the crews of ships: The Land we Live in being +tacitly resigned to the forecastle, the Sans Souci tacitly reserved +for the afterguard. So aristocratic were my habits, so commanding +was my fear of Mr. Williams, that I have never visited the first; +but in the other, which was the club or rather the casino of the +island, I regularly passed my evenings. It was small, but neatly +fitted, and at night (when the lamp was lit) sparkled with glass +and glowed with coloured pictures like a theatre at Christmas. The +pictures were advertisements, the glass coarse enough, the +carpentry amateur; but the effect, in that incongruous isle, was of +unbridled luxury and inestimable expense. Here songs were sung, +tales told, tricks performed, games played. The Ricks, ourselves, +Norwegian Tom the bar-keeper, a captain or two from the ships, and +perhaps three or four traders come down the island in their boats +or by the road on foot, made up the usual company. The traders, +all bred to the sea, take a humorous pride in their new business; +'South Sea Merchants' is the title they prefer. 'We are all +sailors here'--'Merchants, if you please'--'South Sea Merchants,'-- +was a piece of conversation endlessly repeated, that never seemed +to lose in savour. We found them at all times simple, genial, gay, +gallant, and obliging; and, across some interval of time, recall +with pleasure the traders of Butaritari. There was one black sheep +indeed. I tell of him here where he lived, against my rule; for in +this case I have no measure to preserve, and the man is typical of +a class of ruffians that once disgraced the whole field of the +South Seas, and still linger in the rarely visited isles of +Micronesia. He had the name on the beach of 'a perfect gentleman +when sober,' but I never saw him otherwise than drunk. The few +shocking and savage traits of the Micronesian he has singled out +with the skill of a collector, and planted in the soil of his +original baseness. He has been accused and acquitted of a +treacherous murder; and has since boastfully owned it, which +inclines me to suppose him innocent. His daughter is defaced by +his erroneous cruelty, for it was his wife he had intended to +disfigure, and in the darkness of the night and the frenzy of coco- +brandy, fastened on the wrong victim. The wife has since fled and +harbours in the bush with natives; and the husband still demands +from deaf ears her forcible restoration. The best of his business +is to make natives drink, and then advance the money for the fine +upon a lucrative mortgage. 'Respect for whites' is the man's word: +'What is the matter with this island is the want of respect for +whites.' On his way to Butaritari, while I was there, he spied his +wife in the bush with certain natives and made a dash to capture +her; whereupon one of her companions drew a knife and the husband +retreated: 'Do you call that proper respect for whites?' he cried. +At an early stage of the acquaintance we proved our respect for his +kind of white by forbidding him our enclosure under pain of death. +Thenceforth he lingered often in the neighbourhood with I knew not +what sense of envy or design of mischief; his white, handsome face +(which I beheld with loathing) looked in upon us at all hours +across the fence; and once, from a safe distance, he avenged +himself by shouting a recondite island insult, to us quite +inoffensive, on his English lips incredibly incongruous. + +Our enclosure, round which this composite of degradations wandered, +was of some extent. In one corner was a trellis with a long table +of rough boards. Here the Fourth of July feast had been held not +long before with memorable consequences, yet to be set forth; here +we took our meals; here entertained to a dinner the king and +notables of Makin. In the midst was the house, with a verandah +front and back, and three is rooms within. In the verandah we +slung our man-of-war hammocks, worked there by day, and slept at +night. Within were beds, chairs, a round table, a fine hanging +lamp, and portraits of the royal family of Hawaii. Queen Victoria +proves nothing; Kalakaua and Mrs. Bishop are diagnostic; and the +truth is we were the stealthy tenants of the parsonage. On the day +of our arrival Maka was away; faithless trustees unlocked his +doors; and the dear rigorous man, the sworn foe of liquor and +tobacco, returned to find his verandah littered with cigarettes and +his parlour horrible with bottles. He made but one condition--on +the round table, which he used in the celebration of the +sacraments, he begged us to refrain from setting liquor; in all +else he bowed to the accomplished fact, refused rent, retired +across the way into a native house, and, plying in his boat, beat +the remotest quarters of the isle for provender. He found us pigs- +-I could not fancy where--no other pigs were visible; he brought us +fowls and taro; when we gave our feast to the monarch and gentry, +it was he who supplied the wherewithal, he who superintended the +cooking, he who asked grace at table, and when the king's health +was proposed, he also started the cheering with an English hip-hip- +hip. There was never a more fortunate conception; the heart of the +fatted king exulted in his bosom at the sound. + +Take him for all in all, I have never known a more engaging +creature than this parson of Butaritari: his mirth, his kindness, +his noble, friendly feelings, brimmed from the man in speech and +gesture. He loved to exaggerate, to act and overact the momentary +part, to exercise his lungs and muscles, and to speak and laugh +with his whole body. He had the morning cheerfulness of birds and +healthy children; and his humour was infectious. We were next +neighbours and met daily, yet our salutations lasted minutes at a +stretch--shaking hands, slapping shoulders, capering like a pair of +Merry-Andrews, laughing to split our sides upon some pleasantry +that would scarce raise a titter in an infant-school. It might be +five in the morning, the toddy-cutters just gone by, the road +empty, the shade of the island lying far on the lagoon: and the +ebullition cheered me for the day. + +Yet I always suspected Maka of a secret melancholy--these jubilant +extremes could scarce be constantly maintained. He was besides +long, and lean, and lined, and corded, and a trifle grizzled; and +his Sabbath countenance was even saturnine. On that day we made a +procession to the church, or (as I must always call it) the +cathedral: Maka (a blot on the hot landscape) in tall hat, black +frock-coat, black trousers; under his arm the hymn-book and the +Bible; in his face, a reverent gravity:- beside him Mary his wife, +a quiet, wise, and handsome elderly lady, seriously attired:- +myself following with singular and moving thoughts. Long before, +to the sound of bells and streams and birds, through a green +Lothian glen, I had accompanied Sunday by Sunday a minister in +whose house I lodged; and the likeness, and the difference, and the +series of years and deaths, profoundly touched me. In the great, +dusky, palm-tree cathedral the congregation rarely numbered thirty: +the men on one side, the women on the other, myself posted (for a +privilege) amongst the women, and the small missionary contingent +gathered close around the platform, we were lost in that round +vault. The lessons were read antiphonally, the flock was +catechised, a blind youth repeated weekly a long string of psalms, +hymns were sung--I never heard worse singing,--and the sermon +followed. To say I understood nothing were untrue; there were +points that I learned to expect with certainty; the name of +Honolulu, that of Kalakaua, the word Cap'n-man-o'-wa', the word +ship, and a description of a storm at sea, infallibly occurred; and +I was not seldom rewarded with the name of my own Sovereign in the +bargain. The rest was but sound to the ears, silence for the mind: +a plain expanse of tedium, rendered unbearable by heat, a hard +chair, and the sight through the wide doors of the more happy +heathen on the green. Sleep breathed on my joints and eyelids, +sleep hummed in my ears; it reigned in the dim cathedral. The +congregation stirred and stretched; they moaned, they groaned +aloud; they yawned upon a singing note, as you may sometimes hear a +dog when he has reached the tragic bitterest of boredom. In vain +the preacher thumped the table; in vain he singled and addressed by +name particular hearers. I was myself perhaps a more effective +excitant; and at least to one old gentleman the spectacle of my +successful struggles against sleep--and I hope they were +successful--cheered the flight of time. He, when he was not +catching flies or playing tricks upon his neighbours, gloated with +a fixed, truculent eye upon the stages of my agony; and once, when +the service was drawing towards a close, he winked at me across the +church. + +I write of the service with a smile; yet I was always there--always +with respect for Maka, always with admiration for his deep +seriousness, his burning energy, the fire of his roused eye, the +sincere and various accents of his voice. To see him weekly +flogging a dead horse and blowing a cold fire was a lesson in +fortitude and constancy. It may be a question whether if the +mission were fully supported, and he was set free from business +avocations, more might not result; I think otherwise myself; I +think not neglect but rigour has reduced his flock, that rigour +which has once provoked a revolution, and which to-day, in a man so +lively and engaging, amazes the beholder. No song, no dance, no +tobacco, no liquor, no alleviative of life--only toil and church- +going; so says a voice from his face; and the face is the face of +the Polynesian Esau, but the voice is the voice of a Jacob from a +different world. And a Polynesian at the best makes a singular +missionary in the Gilberts, coming from a country recklessly +unchaste to one conspicuously strict; from a race hag-ridden with +bogies to one comparatively bold against the terrors of the dark. +The thought was stamped one morning in my mind, when I chanced to +be abroad by moonlight, and saw all the town lightless, but the +lamp faithfully burning by the missionary's bed. It requires no +law, no fire, and no scouting police, to withhold Maka and his +countrymen from wandering in the night unlighted. + + + +CHAPTER IV--A TALE OF A TAPU + + + +On the morrow of our arrival (Sunday, 14th July 1889) our +photographers were early stirring. Once more we traversed a silent +town; many were yet abed and asleep; some sat drowsily in their +open houses; there was no sound of intercourse or business. In +that hour before the shadows, the quarter of the palace and canal +seemed like a landing-place in the Arabian Nights or from the +classic poets; here were the fit destination of some 'faery +frigot,' here some adventurous prince might step ashore among new +characters and incidents; and the island prison, where it floated +on the luminous face of the lagoon, might have passed for the +repository of the Grail. In such a scene, and at such an hour, the +impression received was not so much of foreign travel--rather of +past ages; it seemed not so much degrees of latitude that we had +crossed, as centuries of time that we had re-ascended; leaving, by +the same steps, home and to-day. A few children followed us, +mostly nude, all silent; in the clear, weedy waters of the canal +some silent damsels waded, baring their brown thighs; and to one of +the maniap's before the palace gate we were attracted by a low but +stirring hum of speech. + +The oval shed was full of men sitting cross-legged. The king was +there in striped pyjamas, his rear protected by four guards with +Winchesters, his air and bearing marked by unwonted spirit and +decision; tumblers and black bottles went the round; and the talk, +throughout loud, was general and animated. I was inclined at first +to view this scene with suspicion. But the hour appeared +unsuitable for a carouse; drink was besides forbidden equally by +the law of the land and the canons of the church; and while I was +yet hesitating, the king's rigorous attitude disposed of my last +doubt. We had come, thinking to photograph him surrounded by his +guards, and at the first word of the design his piety revolted. We +were reminded of the day--the Sabbath, in which thou shalt take no +photographs--and returned with a flea in our ear, bearing the +rejected camera. + +At church, a little later, I was struck to find the throne +unoccupied. So nice a Sabbatarian might have found the means to be +present; perhaps my doubts revived; and before I got home they were +transformed to certainties. Tom, the bar-keeper of the Sans Souci, +was in conversation with two emissaries from the court. The +'keen,' they said, wanted 'din,' failing which 'perandi.' No din, +was Tom's reply, and no perandi; but 'pira' if they pleased. It +seems they had no use for beer, and departed sorrowing. + +'Why, what is the meaning of all this?' I asked. 'Is the island on +the spree?' + +Such was the fact. On the 4th of July a feast had been made, and +the king, at the suggestion of the whites, had raised the tapu +against liquor. There is a proverb about horses; it scarce applies +to the superior animal, of whom it may be rather said, that any one +can start him drinking, not any twenty can prevail on him to stop. +The tapu, raised ten days before, was not yet re-imposed; for ten +days the town had been passing the bottle or lying (as we had seen +it the afternoon before) in hoggish sleep; and the king, moved by +the Old Men and his own appetites, continued to maintain the +liberty, to squander his savings on liquor, and to join in and lead +the debauch. The whites were the authors of this crisis; it was +upon their own proposal that the freedom had been granted at the +first; and for a while, in the interests of trade, they were +doubtless pleased it should continue. That pleasure had now +sometime ceased; the bout had been prolonged (it was conceded) +unduly; and it now began to be a question how it might conclude. +Hence Tom's refusal. Yet that refusal was avowedly only for the +moment, and it was avowedly unavailing; the king's foragers, denied +by Tom at the Sans Souci, would be supplied at The Land we Live in +by the gobbling Mr. Williams. + +The degree of the peril was not easy to measure at the time, and I +am inclined to think now it was easy to exaggerate. Yet the +conduct of drunkards even at home is always matter for anxiety; and +at home our populations are not armed from the highest to the +lowest with revolvers and repeating rifles, neither do we go on a +debauch by the whole townful--and I might rather say, by the whole +polity--king, magistrates, police, and army joining in one common +scene of drunkenness. It must be thought besides that we were here +in barbarous islands, rarely visited, lately and partly civilised. +First and last, a really considerable number of whites have +perished in the Gilberts, chiefly through their own misconduct; and +the natives have displayed in at least one instance a disposition +to conceal an accident under a butchery, and leave nothing but dumb +bones. This last was the chief consideration against a sudden +closing of the bars; the bar-keepers stood in the immediate breach +and dealt direct with madmen; too surly a refusal might at any +moment precipitate a blow, and the blow might prove the signal for +a massacre. + +Monday, 15th.--At the same hour we returned to the same muniap'. +Kummel (of all drinks) was served in tumblers; in the midst sat the +crown prince, a fatted youth, surrounded by fresh bottles and +busily plying the corkscrew; and king, chief, and commons showed +the loose mouth, the uncertain joints, and the blurred and animated +eye of the early drinker. It was plain we were impatiently +expected; the king retired with alacrity to dress, the guards were +despatched after their uniforms; and we were left to await the +issue of these preparations with a shedful of tipsy natives. The +orgie had proceeded further than on Sunday. The day promised to be +of great heat; it was already sultry, the courtiers were already +fuddled; and still the kummel continued to go round, and the crown +prince to play butler. Flemish freedom followed upon Flemish +excess; and a funny dog, a handsome fellow, gaily dressed, and with +a full turban of frizzed hair, delighted the company with a +humorous courtship of a lady in a manner not to be described. It +was our diversion, in this time of waiting, to observe the +gathering of the guards. They have European arms, European +uniforms, and (to their sorrow) European shoes. We saw one warrior +(like Mars) in the article of being armed; two men and a stalwart +woman were scarce strong enough to boot him; and after a single +appearance on parade the army is crippled for a week. + +At last, the gates under the king's house opened; the army issued, +one behind another, with guns and epaulettes; the colours stooped +under the gateway; majesty followed in his uniform bedizened with +gold lace; majesty's wife came next in a hat and feathers, and an +ample trained silk gown; the royal imps succeeded; there stood the +pageantry of Makin marshalled on its chosen theatre. Dickens might +have told how serious they were; how tipsy; how the king melted and +streamed under his cocked hat; how he took station by the larger of +his two cannons--austere, majestic, but not truly vertical; how the +troops huddled, and were straightened out, and clubbed again; how +they and their firelocks raked at various inclinations like the +masts of ships; and how an amateur photographer reviewed, arrayed, +and adjusted them, to see his dispositions change before he reached +the camera. + +The business was funny to see; I do not know that it is graceful to +laugh at; and our report of these transactions was received on our +return with the shaking of grave heads. + +The day had begun ill; eleven hours divided us from sunset; and at +any moment, on the most trifling chance, the trouble might begin. +The Wightman compound was in a military sense untenable, commanded +on three sides by houses and thick bush; the town was computed to +contain over a thousand stand of excellent new arms; and retreat to +the ships, in the case of an alert, was a recourse not to be +thought of. Our talk that morning must have closely reproduced the +talk in English garrisons before the Sepoy mutiny; the sturdy doubt +that any mischief was in prospect, the sure belief that (should any +come) there was nothing left but to go down fighting, the half- +amused, half-anxious attitude of mind in which we were awaiting +fresh developments. + +The kummel soon ran out; we were scarce returned before the king +had followed us in quest of more. Mr. Corpse was now divested of +his more awful attitude, the lawless bulk of him again encased in +striped pyjamas; a guardsman brought up the rear with his rifle at +the trail: and his majesty was further accompanied by a Rarotongan +whalerman and the playful courtier with the turban of frizzed hair. +There was never a more lively deputation. The whalerman was +gapingly, tearfully tipsy: the courtier walked on air; the king +himself was even sportive. Seated in a chair in the Ricks' +sitting-room, he bore the brunt of our prayers and menaces unmoved. +He was even rated, plied with historic instances, threatened with +the men-of-war, ordered to restore the tapu on the spot--and +nothing in the least affected him. It should be done to-morrow, he +said; to-day it was beyond his power, to-day he durst not. 'Is +that royal?' cried indignant Mr. Rick. No, it was not royal; had +the king been of a royal character we should ourselves have held a +different language; and royal or not, he had the best of the +dispute. The terms indeed were hardly equal; for the king was the +only man who could restore the tapu, but the Ricks were not the +only people who sold drink. He had but to hold his ground on the +first question, and they were sure to weaken on the second. A +little struggle they still made for the fashion's sake; and then +one exceedingly tipsy deputation departed, greatly rejoicing, a +case of brandy wheeling beside them in a barrow. The Rarotongan +(whom I had never seen before) wrung me by the hand like a man +bound on a far voyage. 'My dear frien'!' he cried, 'good-bye, my +dear frien'!'--tears of kummel standing in his eyes; the king +lurched as he went, the courtier ambled,--a strange party of +intoxicated children to be entrusted with that barrowful of +madness. + +You could never say the town was quiet; all morning there was a +ferment in the air, an aimless movement and congregation of natives +in the street. But it was not before half-past one that a sudden +hubbub of voices called us from the house, to find the whole white +colony already gathered on the spot as by concerted signal. The +Sans Souci was overrun with rabble, the stair and verandah +thronged. From all these throats an inarticulate babbling cry went +up incessantly; it sounded like the bleating of young lambs, but +angrier. In the road his royal highness (whom I had seen so lately +in the part of butler) stood crying upon Tom; on the top step, +tossed in the hurly-burly, Tom was shouting to the prince. Yet a +while the pack swayed about the bar, vociferous. Then came a +brutal impulse; the mob reeled, and returned, and was rejected; the +stair showed a stream of heads; and there shot into view, through +the disbanding ranks, three men violently dragging in their midst a +fourth. By his hair and his hands, his head forced as low as his +knees, his face concealed, he was wrenched from the verandah and +whisked along the road into the village, howling as he disappeared. +Had his face been raised, we should have seen it bloodied, and the +blood was not his own. The courtier with the turban of frizzed +hair had paid the costs of this disturbance with the lower part of +one ear. + +So the brawl passed with no other casualty than might seem comic to +the inhumane. Yet we looked round on serious faces and--a fact +that spoke volumes--Tom was putting up the shutters on the bar. +Custom might go elsewhere, Mr. Williams might profit as he pleased, +but Tom had had enough of bar-keeping for that day. Indeed the +event had hung on a hair. A man had sought to draw a revolver--on +what quarrel I could never learn, and perhaps he himself could not +have told; one shot, when the room was so crowded, could scarce +have failed to take effect; where many were armed and all tipsy, it +could scarce have failed to draw others; and the woman who spied +the weapon and the man who seized it may very well have saved the +white community. + +The mob insensibly melted from the scene; and for the rest of the +day our neighbourhood was left in peace and a good deal in +solitude. But the tranquillity was only local; din and perandi +still flowed in other quarters: and we had one more sight of +Gilbert Island violence. In the church, where we had wandered +photographing, we were startled by a sudden piercing outcry. The +scene, looking forth from the doors of that great hall of shadow, +was unforgettable. The palms, the quaint and scattered houses, the +flag of the island streaming from its tall staff, glowed with +intolerable sunshine. In the midst two women rolled fighting on +the grass. The combatants were the more easy to be distinguished, +because the one was stripped to the ridi and the other wore a +holoku (sacque) of some lively colour. The first was uppermost, +her teeth locked in her adversary's face, shaking her like a dog; +the other impotently fought and scratched. So for a moment we saw +them wallow and grapple there like vermin; then the mob closed and +shut them in. + +It was a serious question that night if we should sleep ashore. +But we were travellers, folk that had come far in quest of the +adventurous; on the first sign of an adventure it would have been a +singular inconsistency to have withdrawn; and we sent on board +instead for our revolvers. Mindful of Taahauku, Mr. Rick, Mr. +Osbourne, and Mrs. Stevenson held an assault of arms on the public +highway, and fired at bottles to the admiration of the natives. +Captain Reid of the Equator stayed on shore with us to be at hand +in case of trouble, and we retired to bed at the accustomed hour, +agreeably excited by the day's events. The night was exquisite, +the silence enchanting; yet as I lay in my hammock looking on the +strong moonshine and the quiescent palms, one ugly picture haunted +me of the two women, the naked and the clad, locked in that hostile +embrace. The harm done was probably not much, yet I could have +looked on death and massacre with less revolt. The return to these +primeval weapons, the vision of man's beastliness, of his ferality, +shocked in me a deeper sense than that with which we count the cost +of battles. There are elements in our state and history which it +is a pleasure to forget, which it is perhaps the better wisdom not +to dwell on. Crime, pestilence, and death are in the day's work; +the imagination readily accepts them. It instinctively rejects, on +the contrary, whatever shall call up the image of our race upon its +lowest terms, as the partner of beasts, beastly itself, dwelling +pell-mell and hugger-mugger, hairy man with hairy woman, in the +caves of old. And yet to be just to barbarous islanders we must +not forget the slums and dens of our cities; I must not forget that +I have passed dinnerward through Soho, and seen that which cured me +of my dinner. + + + +CHAPTER V--A TALE OF A TAPU--continued + + + +Tuesday, July 16.--It rained in the night, sudden and loud, in +Gilbert Island fashion. Before the day, the crowing of a cock +aroused me and I wandered in the compound and along the street. +The squall was blown by, the moon shone with incomparable lustre, +the air lay dead as in a room, and yet all the isle sounded as +under a strong shower, the eaves thickly pattering, the lofty palms +dripping at larger intervals and with a louder note. In this bold +nocturnal light the interior of the houses lay inscrutable, one +lump of blackness, save when the moon glinted under the roof, and +made a belt of silver, and drew the slanting shadows of the pillars +on the floor. Nowhere in all the town was any lamp or ember; not a +creature stirred; I thought I was alone to be awake; but the police +were faithful to their duty; secretly vigilant, keeping account of +time; and a little later, the watchman struck slowly and repeatedly +on the cathedral bell; four o'clock, the warning signal. It seemed +strange that, in a town resigned to drunkenness and tumult, curfew +and reveille should still be sounded and still obeyed. + +The day came, and brought little change. The place still lay +silent; the people slept, the town slept. Even the few who were +awake, mostly women and children, held their peace and kept within +under the strong shadow of the thatch, where you must stop and peer +to see them. Through the deserted streets, and past the sleeping +houses, a deputation took its way at an early hour to the palace; +the king was suddenly awakened, and must listen (probably with a +headache) to unpalatable truths. Mrs. Rick, being a sufficient +mistress of that difficult tongue, was spokeswoman; she explained +to the sick monarch that I was an intimate personal friend of Queen +Victoria's; that immediately on my return I should make her a +report upon Butaritari; and that if my house should have been again +invaded by natives, a man-of-war would be despatched to make +reprisals. It was scarce the fact--rather a just and necessary +parable of the fact, corrected for latitude; and it certainly told +upon the king. He was much affected; he had conceived the notion +(he said) that I was a man of some importance, but not dreamed it +was as bad as this; and the missionary house was tapu'd under a +fine of fifty dollars. + +So much was announced on the return of the deputation; not any +more; and I gathered subsequently that much more had passed. The +protection gained was welcome. It had been the most annoying and +not the least alarming feature of the day before, that our house +was periodically filled with tipsy natives, twenty or thirty at a +time, begging drink, fingering our goods, hard to be dislodged, +awkward to quarrel with. Queen Victoria's friend (who was soon +promoted to be her son) was free from these intrusions. Not only +my house, but my neighbourhood as well, was left in peace; even on +our walks abroad we were guarded and prepared for; and, like great +persons visiting a hospital, saw only the fair side. For the +matter of a week we were thus suffered to go out and in and live in +a fool's paradise, supposing the king to have kept his word, the +tapu to be revived and the island once more sober. + +Tuesday, July 23.--We dined under a bare trellis erected for the +Fourth of July; and here we used to linger by lamplight over coffee +and tobacco. In that climate evening approaches without sensible +chill; the wind dies out before sunset; heaven glows a while and +fades, and darkens into the blueness of the tropical night; swiftly +and insensibly the shadows thicken, the stars multiply their +number; you look around you and the day is gone. It was then that +we would see our Chinaman draw near across the compound in a +lurching sphere of light, divided by his shadows; and with the +coming of the lamp the night closed about the table. The faces of +the company, the spars of the trellis, stood out suddenly bright on +a ground of blue and silver, faintly designed with palm-tops and +the peaked roofs of houses. Here and there the gloss upon a leaf, +or the fracture of a stone, returned an isolated sparkle. All else +had vanished. We hung there, illuminated like a galaxy of stars in +vacuo; we sat, manifest and blind, amid the general ambush of the +darkness; and the islanders, passing with light footfalls and low +voices in the sand of the road, lingered to observe us, unseen. + +On Tuesday the dusk had fallen, the lamp had just been brought, +when a missile struck the table with a rattling smack and rebounded +past my ear. Three inches to one side and this page had never been +written; for the thing travelled like a cannon ball. It was +supposed at the time to be a nut, though even at the time I thought +it seemed a small one and fell strangely. + +Wednesday, July 24.--The dusk had fallen once more, and the lamp +been just brought out, when the same business was repeated. And +again the missile whistled past my ear. One nut I had been willing +to accept; a second, I rejected utterly. A cocoa-nut does not come +slinging along on a windless evening, making an angle of about +fifteen degrees with the horizon; cocoa-nuts do not fall on +successive nights at the same hour and spot; in both cases, +besides, a specific moment seemed to have been chosen, that when +the lamp was just carried out, a specific person threatened, and +that the head of the family. I may have been right or wrong, but I +believed I was the mark of some intimidation; believed the missile +was a stone, aimed not to hit, but to frighten. + +No idea makes a man more angry. I ran into the road, where the +natives were as usual promenading in the dark; Maka joined me with +a lantern; and I ran from one to another, glared in quite innocent +faces, put useless questions, and proffered idle threats. Thence I +carried my wrath (which was worthy the son of any queen in history) +to the Ricks. They heard me with depression, assured me this trick +of throwing a stone into a family dinner was not new; that it meant +mischief, and was of a piece with the alarming disposition of the +natives. And then the truth, so long concealed from us, came out. +The king had broken his promise, he had defied the deputation; the +tapu was still dormant, The Land we Live in still selling drink, +and that quarter of the town disturbed and menaced by perpetual +broils. But there was worse ahead: a feast was now preparing for +the birthday of the little princess; and the tributary chiefs of +Kuma and Little Makin were expected daily. Strong in a following +of numerous and somewhat savage clansmen, each of these was +believed, like a Douglas of old, to be of doubtful loyalty. Kuma +(a little pot-bellied fellow) never visited the palace, never +entered the town, but sat on the beach on a mat, his gun across his +knees, parading his mistrust and scorn; Karaiti of Makin, although +he was more bold, was not supposed to be more friendly; and not +only were these vassals jealous of the throne, but the followers on +either side shared in the animosity. Brawls had already taken +place; blows had passed which might at any moment be repaid in +blood. Some of the strangers were already here and already +drinking; if the debauch continued after the bulk of them had come, +a collision, perhaps a revolution, was to be expected. + +The sale of drink is in this group a measure of the jealousy of +traders; one begins, the others are constrained to follow; and to +him who has the most gin, and sells it the most recklessly, the +lion's share of copra is assured. It is felt by all to be an +extreme expedient, neither safe, decent, nor dignified. A trader +on Tarawa, heated by an eager rivalry, brought many cases of gin. +He told me he sat afterwards day and night in his house till it was +finished, not daring to arrest the sale, not venturing to go forth, +the bush all round him filled with howling drunkards. At night, +above all, when he was afraid to sleep, and heard shots and voices +about him in the darkness, his remorse was black. + +'My God!' he reflected, 'if I was to lose my life on such a +wretched business!' Often and often, in the story of the Gilberts, +this scene has been repeated; and the remorseful trader sat beside +his lamp, longing for the day, listening with agony for the sound +of murder, registering resolutions for the future. For the +business is easy to begin, but hazardous to stop. The natives are +in their way a just and law-abiding people, mindful of their debts, +docile to the voice of their own institutions; when the tapu is re- +enforced they will cease drinking; but the white who seeks to +antedate the movement by refusing liquor does so at his peril. + +Hence, in some degree, the anxiety and helplessness of Mr. Rick. +He and Tom, alarmed by the rabblement of the Sans Souci, had +stopped the sale; they had done so without danger, because The Land +we Live in still continued selling; it was claimed, besides, that +they had been the first to begin. What step could be taken? Could +Mr. Rick visit Mr. Muller (with whom he was not on terms) and +address him thus: 'I was getting ahead of you, now you are getting +ahead of me, and I ask you to forego your profit. I got my place +closed in safety, thanks to your continuing; but now I think you +have continued long enough. I begin to be alarmed; and because I +am afraid I ask you to confront a certain danger'? It was not to +be thought of. Something else had to be found; and there was one +person at one end of the town who was at least not interested in +copra. There was little else to be said in favour of myself as an +ambassador. I had arrived in the Wightman schooner, I was living +in the Wightman compound, I was the daily associate of the Wightman +coterie. It was egregious enough that I should now intrude unasked +in the private affairs of Crawford's agent, and press upon him the +sacrifice of his interests and the venture of his life. But bad as +I might be, there was none better; since the affair of the stone I +was, besides, sharp-set to be doing, the idea of a delicate +interview attracted me, and I thought it policy to show myself +abroad. + +The night was very dark. There was service in the church, and the +building glimmered through all its crevices like a dim Kirk +Allowa'. I saw few other lights, but was indistinctly aware of +many people stirring in the darkness, and a hum and sputter of low +talk that sounded stealthy. I believe (in the old phrase) my beard +was sometimes on my shoulder as I went. Muller's was but partly +lighted, and quite silent, and the gate was fastened. I could by +no means manage to undo the latch. No wonder, since I found it +afterwards to be four or five feet long--a fortification in itself. +As I still fumbled, a dog came on the inside and sniffed +suspiciously at my hands, so that I was reduced to calling 'House +ahoy!' Mr. Muller came down and put his chin across the paling in +the dark. 'Who is that?' said he, like one who has no mind to +welcome strangers. + +'My name is Stevenson,' said I. + +'O, Mr. Stevens! I didn't know you. Come inside.' We stepped +into the dark store, when I leaned upon the counter and he against +the wall. All the light came from the sleeping-room, where I saw +his family being put to bed; it struck full in my face, but Mr. +Muller stood in shadow. No doubt he expected what was Coming, and +sought the advantage of position; but for a man who wished to +persuade and had nothing to conceal, mine was the preferable. + +'Look here,' I began, 'I hear you are selling to the natives.' + +'Others have done that before me,' he returned pointedly. + +'No doubt,' said I, 'and I have nothing to do with the past, but +the future. I want you to promise you will handle these spirits +carefully.' + +'Now what is your motive in this?' he asked, and then, with a +sneer, 'Are you afraid of your life?' + +'That is nothing to the purpose,' I replied. 'I know, and you +know, these spirits ought not to be used at all.' + +'Tom and Mr. Rick have sold them before.' + +'I have nothing to do with Tom and Mr. Rick. All I know is I have +heard them both refuse.' + +'No, I suppose you have nothing to do with them. Then you are just +afraid of your life.' + +'Come now,' I cried, being perhaps a little stung, 'you know in +your heart I am asking a reasonable thing. I don't ask you to lose +your profit--though I would prefer to see no spirits brought here, +as you would--' + +'I don't say I wouldn't. I didn't begin this,' he interjected. + +'No, I don't suppose you did,' said I. 'And I don't ask you to +lose; I ask you to give me your word, man to man, that you will +make no native drunk.' + +Up to now Mr. Muller had maintained an attitude very trying to my +temper; but he had maintained it with difficulty, his sentiment +being all upon my side; and here he changed ground for the worse. +'It isn't me that sells,' said he. + +'No, it's that nigger,' I agreed. 'But he's yours to buy and sell; +you have your hand on the nape of his neck; and I ask you--I have +my wife here--to use the authority you have.' + +He hastily returned to his old ward. 'I don't deny I could if I +wanted,' said he. 'But there's no danger, the natives are all +quiet. You're just afraid of your life.' + +I do not like to be called a coward, even by implication; and here +I lost my temper and propounded an untimely ultimatum. 'You had +better put it plain,' I cried. 'Do you mean to refuse me what I +ask?' + +'I don't want either to refuse it or grant it,' he replied. + +'You'll find you have to do the one thing or the other, and right +now!' I cried, and then, striking into a happier vein, 'Come,' said +I, 'you're a better sort than that. I see what's wrong with you-- +you think I came from the opposite camp. I see the sort of man you +are, and you know that what I ask is right.' + +Again he changed ground. 'If the natives get any drink, it isn't +safe to stop them,' he objected. + +'I'll be answerable for the bar,' I said. 'We are three men and +four revolvers; we'll come at a word, and hold the place against +the village.' + +'You don't know what you're talking about; it's too dangerous!' he +cried. + +'Look here,' said I, 'I don't mind much about losing that life you +talk so much of; but I mean to lose it the way I want to, and that +is, putting a stop to all this beastliness.' + +He talked a while about his duty to the firm; I minded not at all, +I was secure of victory. He was but waiting to capitulate, and +looked about for any potent to relieve the strain. In the gush of +light from the bedroom door I spied a cigar-holder on the desk. +'That is well coloured,' said I. + +'Will you take a cigar?' said he. + +I took it and held it up unlighted. 'Now,' said I, 'you promise +me.' + +'I promise you you won't have any trouble from natives that have +drunk at my place,' he replied. + +'That is all I ask,' said I, and showed it was not by immediately +offering to try his stock. + +So far as it was anyway critical our interview here ended. Mr. +Muller had thenceforth ceased to regard me as an emissary from his +rivals, dropped his defensive attitude, and spoke as he believed. +I could make out that he would already, had he dared, have stopped +the sale himself. Not quite daring, it may be imagined how he +resented the idea of interference from those who had (by his own +statement) first led him on, then deserted him in the breach, and +now (sitting themselves in safety) egged him on to a new peril, +which was all gain to them, all loss to him! I asked him what he +thought of the danger from the feast. + +'I think worse of it than any of you,' he answered. 'They were +shooting around here last night, and I heard the balls too. I said +to myself, "That's bad." What gets me is why you should be making +this row up at your end. I should be the first to go.' + +It was a thoughtless wonder. The consolation of being second is +not great; the fact, not the order of going--there was our concern. + +Scott talks moderately of looking forward to a time of fighting +'with a feeling that resembled pleasure.' The resemblance seems +rather an identity. In modern life, contact is ended; man grows +impatient of endless manoeuvres; and to approach the fact, to find +ourselves where we can push an advantage home, and stand a fair +risk, and see at last what we are made of, stirs the blood. It was +so at least with all my family, who bubbled with delight at the +approach of trouble; and we sat deep into the night like a pack of +schoolboys, preparing the revolvers and arranging plans against the +morrow. It promised certainly to be a busy and eventful day. The +Old Men were to be summoned to confront me on the question of the +tapu; Muller might call us at any moment to garrison his bar; and +suppose Muller to fail, we decided in a family council to take that +matter into our own hands, The Land we Live in at the pistol's +mouth, and with the polysyllabic Williams, dance to a new tune. As +I recall our humour I think it would have gone hard with the +mulatto. + +Wednesday, July 24.--It was as well, and yet it was disappointing +that these thunder-clouds rolled off in silence. Whether the Old +Men recoiled from an interview with Queen Victoria's son, whether +Muller had secretly intervened, or whether the step flowed +naturally from the fears of the king and the nearness of the feast, +the tapu was early that morning re-enforced; not a day too soon, +from the manner the boats began to arrive thickly, and the town was +filled with the big rowdy vassals of Karaiti. + +The effect lingered for some time on the minds of the traders; it +was with the approval of all present that I helped to draw up a +petition to the United States, praying for a law against the liquor +trade in the Gilberts; and it was at this request that I added, +under my own name, a brief testimony of what had passed;--useless +pains; since the whole reposes, probably unread and possibly +unopened, in a pigeon-hole at Washington. + +Sunday, July 28.--This day we had the afterpiece of the debauch. +The king and queen, in European clothes, and followed by armed +guards, attended church for the first time, and sat perched aloft +in a precarious dignity under the barrel-hoops. Before sermon his +majesty clambered from the dais, stood lopsidedly upon the gravel +floor, and in a few words abjured drinking. The queen followed +suit with a yet briefer allocution. All the men in church were +next addressed in turn; each held up his right hand, and the affair +was over--throne and church were reconciled. + + + +CHAPTER VI--THE FIVE DAYS' FESTIVAL + + + +Thursday, July 25.--The street was this day much enlivened by the +presence of the men from Little Makin; they average taller than +Butaritarians, and being on a holiday, went wreathed with yellow +leaves and gorgeous in vivid colours. They are said to be more +savage, and to be proud of the distinction. Indeed, it seemed to +us they swaggered in the town, like plaided Highlanders upon the +streets of Inverness, conscious of barbaric virtues. + +In the afternoon the summer parlour was observed to be packed with +people; others standing outside and stooping to peer under the +eaves, like children at home about a circus. It was the Makin +company, rehearsing for the day of competition. Karaiti sat in the +front row close to the singers, where we were summoned (I suppose +in honour of Queen Victoria) to join him. A strong breathless heat +reigned under the iron roof, and the air was heavy with the scent +of wreaths. The singers, with fine mats about their loins, cocoa- +nut feathers set in rings upon their fingers, and their heads +crowned with yellow leaves, sat on the floor by companies. A +varying number of soloists stood up for different songs; and these +bore the chief part in the music. But the full force of the +companies, even when not singing, contributed continuously to the +effect, and marked the ictus of the measure, mimicking, grimacing, +casting up their heads and eyes, fluttering the feathers on their +fingers, clapping hands, or beating (loud as a kettledrum) on the +left breast; the time was exquisite, the music barbarous, but full +of conscious art. I noted some devices constantly employed. A +sudden change would be introduced (I think of key) with no break of +the measure, but emphasised by a sudden dramatic heightening of the +voice and a swinging, general gesticulation. The voices of the +soloists would begin far apart in a rude discord, and gradually +draw together to a unison; which, when, they had reached, they were +joined and drowned by the full chorus. The ordinary, hurried, +barking unmelodious movement of the voices would at times be broken +and glorified by a psalm-like strain of melody, often well +constructed, or seeming so by contrast. There was much variety of +measure, and towards the end of each piece, when the fun became +fast and furious, a recourse to this figure - + +[Musical notation which cannot be produced. It means two/four time +with quaver, quaver, crotchet repeated for three bars.] + +It is difficult to conceive what fire and devilry they get into +these hammering finales; all go together, voices, hands, eyes, +leaves, and fluttering finger-rings; the chorus swings to the eye, +the song throbs on the ear; the faces are convulsed with enthusiasm +and effort. + +Presently the troop stood up in a body, the drums forming a half- +circle for the soloists, who were sometimes five or even more in +number. The songs that followed were highly dramatic; though I had +none to give me any explanation, I would at times make out some +shadowy but decisive outline of a plot; and I was continually +reminded of certain quarrelsome concerted scenes in grand operas at +home; just so the single voices issue from and fall again into the +general volume; just so do the performers separate and crowd +together, brandish the raised hand, and roll the eye to heaven--or +the gallery. Already this is beyond the Thespian model; the art of +this people is already past the embryo: song, dance, drums, +quartette and solo--it is the drama full developed although still +in miniature. Of all so-called dancing in the South Seas, that +which I saw in Butaritari stands easily the first. The hula, as it +may be viewed by the speedy globe-trotter in Honolulu, is surely +the most dull of man's inventions, and the spectator yawns under +its length as at a college lecture or a parliamentary debate. But +the Gilbert Island dance leads on the mind; it thrills, rouses, +subjugates; it has the essence of all art, an unexplored imminent +significance. Where so many are engaged, and where all must make +(at a given moment) the same swift, elaborate, and often arbitrary +movement, the toil of rehearsal is of course extreme. But they +begin as children. A child and a man may often be seen together in +a maniap': the man sings and gesticulates, the child stands before +him with streaming tears and tremulously copies him in act and +sound; it is the Gilbert Island artist learning (as all artists +must) his art in sorrow. + +I may seem to praise too much; here is a passage from my wife's +diary, which proves that I was not alone in being moved, and +completes the picture:- 'The conductor gave the cue, and all the +dancers, waving their arms, swaying their bodies, and clapping +their breasts in perfect time, opened with an introductory. The +performers remained seated, except two, and once three, and twice a +single soloist. These stood in the group, making a slight movement +with the feet and rhythmical quiver of the body as they sang. +There was a pause after the introductory, and then the real +business of the opera--for it was no less--began; an opera where +every singer was an accomplished actor. The leading man, in an +impassioned ecstasy which possessed him from head to foot, seemed +transfigured; once it was as though a strong wind had swept over +the stage--their arms, their feathered fingers thrilling with an +emotion that shook my nerves as well: heads and bodies followed +like a field of grain before a gust. My blood came hot and cold, +tears pricked my eyes, my head whirled, I felt an almost +irresistible impulse to join the dancers. One drama, I think, I +very nearly understood. A fierce and savage old man took the solo +part. He sang of the birth of a prince, and how he was tenderly +rocked in his mother's arms; of his boyhood, when he excelled his +fellows in swimming, climbing, and all athletic sports; of his +youth, when he went out to sea with his boat and fished; of his +manhood, when he married a wife who cradled a son of his own in her +arms. Then came the alarm of war, and a great battle, of which for +a time the issue was doubtful; but the hero conquered, as he always +does, and with a tremendous burst of the victors the piece closed. +There were also comic pieces, which caused great amusement. During +one, an old man behind me clutched me by the arm, shook his finger +in my face with a roguish smile, and said something with a chuckle, +which I took to be the equivalent of "O, you women, you women; it +is true of you all!" I fear it was not complimentary. At no time +was there the least sign of the ugly indecency of the eastern +islands. All was poetry pure and simple. The music itself was as +complex as our own, though constructed on an entirely different +basis; once or twice I was startled by a bit of something very like +the best English sacred music, but it was only for an instant. At +last there was a longer pause, and this time the dancers were all +on their feet. As the drama went on, the interest grew. The +performers appealed to each other, to the audience, to the heaven +above; they took counsel with each other, the conspirators drew +together in a knot; it was just an opera, the drums coming in at +proper intervals, the tenor, baritone, and bass all where they +should be--except that the voices were all of the same calibre. A +woman once sang from the back row with a very fine contralto voice +spoilt by being made artificially nasal; I notice all the women +affect that unpleasantness. At one time a boy of angelic beauty +was the soloist; and at another, a child of six or eight, doubtless +an infant phenomenon being trained, was placed in the centre. The +little fellow was desperately frightened and embarrassed at first, +but towards the close warmed up to his work and showed much +dramatic talent. The changing expressions on the faces of the +dancers were so speaking, that it seemed a great stupidity not to +understand them.' + +Our neighbour at this performance, Karaiti, somewhat favours his +Butaritarian majesty in shape and feature, being, like him, portly, +bearded, and Oriental. In character he seems the reverse: alert, +smiling, jovial, jocular, industrious. At home in his own island, +he labours himself like a slave, and makes his people labour like a +slave-driver. He takes an interest in ideas. George the trader +told him about flying-machines. 'Is that true, George?' he asked. +'It is in the papers,' replied George. 'Well,' said Karaiti, 'if +that man can do it with machinery, I can do it without'; and he +designed and made a pair of wings, strapped them on his shoulders, +went to the end of a pier, launched himself into space, and fell +bulkily into the sea. His wives fished him out, for his wings +hindered him in swimming. 'George,' said he, pausing as he went up +to change, 'George, you lie.' He had eight wives, for his small +realm still follows ancient customs; but he showed embarrassment +when this was mentioned to my wife. 'Tell her I have only brought +one here,' he said anxiously. Altogether the Black Douglas pleased +us much; and as we heard fresh details of the king's uneasiness, +and saw for ourselves that all the weapons in the summer parlour +had been hid, we watched with the more admiration the cause of all +this anxiety rolling on his big legs, with his big smiling face, +apparently unarmed, and certainly unattended, through the hostile +town. The Red Douglas, pot-bellied Kuma, having perhaps heard word +of the debauch, remained upon his fief; his vassals thus came +uncommanded to the feast, and swelled the following of Karaiti. + +Friday, July 26.--At night in the dark, the singers of Makin +paraded in the road before our house and sang the song of the +princess. 'This is the day; she was born to-day; Nei Kamaunave was +born to-day--a beautiful princess, Queen of Butaritari.' So I was +told it went in endless iteration. The song was of course out of +season, and the performance only a rehearsal. But it was a +serenade besides; a delicate attention to ourselves from our new +friend, Karaiti. + +Saturday, July 27.--We had announced a performance of the magic +lantern to-night in church; and this brought the king to visit us. +In honour of the Black Douglas (I suppose) his usual two guardsmen +were now increased to four; and the squad made an outlandish figure +as they straggled after him, in straw hats, kilts and jackets. +Three carried their arms reversed, the butts over their shoulders, +the muzzles menacing the king's plump back; the fourth had passed +his weapon behind his neck, and held it there with arms extended +like a backboard. The visit was extraordinarily long. The king, +no longer galvanised with gin, said and did nothing. He sat +collapsed in a chair and let a cigar go out. It was hot, it was +sleepy, it was cruel dull; there was no resource but to spy in the +countenance of Tebureimoa for some remaining trait of Mr. Corpse +the butcher. His hawk nose, crudely depressed and flattened at the +point, did truly seem to us to smell of midnight murder. When he +took his leave, Maka bade me observe him going down the stair (or +rather ladder) from the verandah. 'Old man,' said Maka. 'Yes,' +said I, 'and yet I suppose not old man.' 'Young man,' returned +Maka, 'perhaps fo'ty.' And I have heard since he is most likely +younger. + +While the magic lantern was showing, I skulked without in the dark. +The voice of Maka, excitedly explaining the Scripture slides, +seemed to fill not the church only, but the neighbourhood. All +else was silent. Presently a distant sound of singing arose and +approached; and a procession drew near along the road, the hot +clean smell of the men and women striking in my face delightfully. +At the corner, arrested by the voice of Maka and the lightening and +darkening of the church, they paused. They had no mind to go +nearer, that was plain. They were Makin people, I believe, +probably staunch heathens, contemners of the missionary and his +works. Of a sudden, however, a man broke from their company, took +to his heels, and fled into the church; next moment three had +followed him; the next it was a covey of near upon a score, all +pelting for their lives. So the little band of the heathen paused +irresolute at the corner, and melted before the attractions of a +magic lantern, like a glacier in spring. The more staunch vainly +taunted the deserters; three fled in a guilty silence, but still +fled; and when at length the leader found the wit or the authority +to get his troop in motion and revive the singing, it was with much +diminished forces that they passed musically on up the dark road. + +Meanwhile inside the luminous pictures brightened and faded. I +stood for some while unobserved in the rear of the spectators, when +I could hear just in front of me a pair of lovers following the +show with interest, the male playing the part of interpreter and +(like Adam) mingling caresses with his lecture. The wild animals, +a tiger in particular, and that old school-treat favourite, the +sleeper and the mouse, were hailed with joy; but the chief marvel +and delight was in the gospel series. Maka, in the opinion of his +aggrieved wife, did not properly rise to the occasion. 'What is +the matter with the man? Why can't he talk?' she cried. The +matter with the man, I think, was the greatness of the opportunity; +he reeled under his good fortune; and whether he did ill or well, +the exposure of these pious 'phantoms' did as a matter of fact +silence in all that part of the island the voice of the scoffer. +'Why then,' the word went round, 'why then, the Bible is true!' +And on our return afterwards we were told the impression was yet +lively, and those who had seen might be heard telling those who had +not, 'O yes, it is all true; these things all happened, we have +seen the pictures.' The argument is not so childish as it seems; +for I doubt if these islanders are acquainted with any other mode +of representation but photography; so that the picture of an event +(on the old melodrama principle that 'the camera cannot lie, +Joseph,') would appear strong proof of its occurrence. The fact +amused us the more because our slides were some of them ludicrously +silly, and one (Christ before Pilate) was received with shouts of +merriment, in which even Maka was constrained to join. + +Sunday, July 28.--Karaiti came to ask for a repetition of the +'phantoms'--this was the accepted word--and, having received a +promise, turned and left my humble roof without the shadow of a +salutation. I felt it impolite to have the least appearance of +pocketing a slight; the times had been too difficult, and were +still too doubtful; and Queen Victoria's son was bound to maintain +the honour of his house. Karaiti was accordingly summoned that +evening to the Ricks, where Mrs. Rick fell foul of him in words, +and Queen Victoria's son assailed him with indignant looks. I was +the ass with the lion's skin; I could not roar in the language of +the Gilbert Islands; but I could stare. Karaiti declared he had +meant no offence; apologised in a sound, hearty, gentlemanly +manner; and became at once at his ease. He had in a dagger to +examine, and announced he would come to price it on the morrow, to- +day being Sunday; this nicety in a heathen with eight wives +surprised me. The dagger was 'good for killing fish,' he said +roguishly; and was supposed to have his eye upon fish upon two +legs. It is at least odd that in Eastern Polynesia fish was the +accepted euphemism for the human sacrifice. Asked as to the +population of his island, Karaiti called out to his vassals who sat +waiting him outside the door, and they put it at four hundred and +fifty; but (added Karaiti jovially) there will soon be plenty more, +for all the women are in the family way. Long before we separated +I had quite forgotten his offence. He, however, still bore it in +mind; and with a very courteous inspiration returned early on the +next day, paid us a long visit, and punctiliously said farewell +when he departed. + +Monday, July 29.--The great day came round at last. In the first +hours the night was startled by the sound of clapping hands and the +chant of Nei Kamaunava; its melancholy, slow, and somewhat menacing +measures broken at intervals by a formidable shout. The little +morsel of humanity thus celebrated in the dark hours was observed +at midday playing on the green entirely naked, and equally +unobserved and unconcerned. + +The summer parlour on its artificial islet, relieved against the +shimmering lagoon, and shimmering itself with sun and tinned iron, +was all day crowded about by eager men and women. Within, it was +boxed full of islanders, of any age and size, and in every degree +of nudity and finery. So close we squatted, that at one time I had +a mighty handsome woman on my knees, two little naked urchins +having their feet against my back. There might be a dame in full +attire of holoku and hat and flowers; and her next neighbour might +the next moment strip some little rag of a shift from her fat +shoulders and come out a monument of flesh, painted rather than +covered by the hairbreadth ridi. Little ladies who thought +themselves too great to appear undraped upon so high a festival +were seen to pause outside in the bright sunshine, their miniature +ridis in their hand; a moment more and they were full-dressed and +entered the concert-room. + +At either end stood up to sing, or sat down to rest, the alternate +companies of singers; Kuma and Little Makin on the north, +Butaritari and its conjunct hamlets on the south; both groups +conspicuous in barbaric bravery. In the midst, between these rival +camps of troubadours, a bench was placed; and here the king and +queen throned it, some two or three feet above the crowded audience +on the floor--Tebureimoa as usual in his striped pyjamas with a +satchel strapped across one shoulder, doubtless (in the island +fashion) to contain his pistols; the queen in a purple holoku, her +abundant hair let down, a fan in her hand. The bench was turned +facing to the strangers, a piece of well-considered civility; and +when it was the turn of Butaritari to sing, the pair must twist +round on the bench, lean their elbows on the rail, and turn to us +the spectacle of their broad backs. The royal couple occasionally +solaced themselves with a clay pipe; and the pomp of state was +further heightened by the rifles of a picket of the guard. + +With this kingly countenance, and ourselves squatted on the ground, +we heard several songs from one side or the other. Then royalty +and its guards withdrew, and Queen Victoria's son and daughter-in- +law were summoned by acclamation to the vacant throne. Our pride +was perhaps a little modified when we were joined on our high +places by a certain thriftless loafer of a white; and yet I was +glad too, for the man had a smattering of native, and could give me +some idea of the subject of the songs. One was patriotic, and +dared Tembinok' of Apemama, the terror of the group, to an +invasion. One mixed the planting of taro and the harvest-home. +Some were historical, and commemorated kings and the illustrious +chances of their time, such as a bout of drinking or a war. One, +at least, was a drama of domestic interest, excellently played by +the troop from Makin. It told the story of a man who has lost his +wife, at first bewails her loss, then seeks another: the earlier +strains (or acts) are played exclusively by men; but towards the +end a woman appears, who has just lost her husband; and I suppose +the pair console each other, for the finale seemed of happy omen. +Of some of the songs my informant told me briefly they were 'like +about the weemen'; this I could have guessed myself. Each side (I +should have said) was strengthened by one or two women. They were +all soloists, did not very often join in the performance, but stood +disengaged at the back part of the stage, and looked (in ridi, +necklace, and dressed hair) for all the world like European ballet- +dancers. When the song was anyway broad these ladies came +particularly to the front; and it was singular to see that, after +each entry, the premiere danseuse pretended to be overcome by +shame, as though led on beyond what she had meant, and her male +assistants made a feint of driving her away like one who had +disgraced herself. Similar affectations accompany certain truly +obscene dances of Samoa, where they are very well in place. Here +it was different. The words, perhaps, in this free-spoken world, +were gross enough to make a carter blush; and the most suggestive +feature was this feint of shame. For such parts the women showed +some disposition; they were pert, they were neat, they were +acrobatic, they were at times really amusing, and some of them were +pretty. But this is not the artist's field; there is the whole +width of heaven between such capering and ogling, and the strange +rhythmic gestures, and strange, rapturous, frenzied faces with +which the best of the male dancers held us spellbound through a +Gilbert Island ballet. + +Almost from the first it was apparent that the people of the city +were defeated. I might have thought them even good, only I had the +other troop before my eyes to correct my standard, and remind me +continually of 'the little more, and how much it is.' Perceiving +themselves worsted, the choir of Butaritari grew confused, +blundered, and broke down; amid this hubbub of unfamiliar intervals +I should not myself have recognised the slip, but the audience were +quick to catch it, and to jeer. To crown all, the Makin company +began a dance of truly superlative merit. I know not what it was +about, I was too much absorbed to ask. In one act a part of the +chorus, squealing in some strange falsetto, produced very much the +effect of our orchestra; in another, the dancers, leaping like +jumping-jacks, with arms extended, passed through and through each +other's ranks with extraordinary speed, neatness, and humour. A +more laughable effect I never saw; in any European theatre it would +have brought the house down, and the island audience roared with +laughter and applause. This filled up the measure for the rival +company, and they forgot themselves and decency. After each act or +figure of the ballet, the performers pause a moment standing, and +the next is introduced by the clapping of hands in triplets. Not +until the end of the whole ballet do they sit down, which is the +signal for the rivals to stand up. But now all rules were to be +broken. During the interval following on this great applause, the +company of Butaritari leaped suddenly to their feet and most +unhandsomely began a performance of their own. It was strange to +see the men of Makin staring; I have seen a tenor in Europe stare +with the same blank dignity into a hissing theatre; but presently, +to my surprise, they sobered down, gave up the unsung remainder of +their ballet, resumed their seats, and suffered their ungallant +adversaries to go on and finish. Nothing would suffice. Again, at +the first interval, Butaritari unhandsomely cut in; Makin, +irritated in turn, followed the example; and the two companies of +dancers remained permanently standing, continuously clapping hands, +and regularly cutting across each other at each pause. I expected +blows to begin with any moment; and our position in the midst was +highly unstrategical. But the Makin people had a better thought; +and upon a fresh interruption turned and trooped out of the house. +We followed them, first because these were the artists, second +because they were guests and had been scurvily ill-used. A large +population of our neighbours did the same, so that the causeway was +filled from end to end by the procession of deserters; and the +Butaritari choir was left to sing for its own pleasure in an empty +house, having gained the point and lost the audience. It was +surely fortunate that there was no one drunk; but, drunk or sober, +where else would a scene so irritating have concluded without +blows? + +The last stage and glory of this auspicious day was of our own +providing--the second and positively the last appearance of the +phantoms. All round the church, groups sat outside, in the night, +where they could see nothing; perhaps ashamed to enter, certainly +finding some shadowy pleasure in the mere proximity. Within, about +one-half of the great shed was densely packed with people. In the +midst, on the royal dais, the lantern luminously smoked; chance +rays of light struck out the earnest countenance of our Chinaman +grinding the hand-organ; a fainter glimmer showed off the rafters +and their shadows in the hollow of the roof; the pictures shone and +vanished on the screen; and as each appeared, there would run a +hush, a whisper, a strong shuddering rustle, and a chorus of small +cries among the crowd. There sat by me the mate of a wrecked +schooner. 'They would think this a strange sight in Europe or the +States,' said he, 'going on in a building like this, all tied with +bits of string.' + + + +CHAPTER VII--HUSBAND AND WIFE + + + +The trader accustomed to the manners of Eastern Polynesia has a +lesson to learn among the Gilberts. The ridi is but a spare +attire; as late as thirty years back the women went naked until +marriage; within ten years the custom lingered; and these facts, +above all when heard in description, conveyed a very false idea of +the manners of the group. A very intelligent missionary described +it (in its former state) as a 'Paradise of naked women' for the +resident whites. It was at least a platonic Paradise, where +Lothario ventured at his peril. Since 1860, fourteen whites have +perished on a single island, all for the same cause, all found +where they had no business, and speared by some indignant father of +a family; the figure was given me by one of their contemporaries +who had been more prudent and survived. The strange persistence of +these fourteen martyrs might seem to point to monomania or a series +of romantic passions; gin is the more likely key. The poor +buzzards sat alone in their houses by an open case; they drank; +their brain was fired; they stumbled towards the nearest houses on +chance; and the dart went through their liver. In place of a +Paradise the trader found an archipelago of fierce husbands and of +virtuous women. 'Of course if you wish to make love to them, it's +the same as anywhere else,' observed a trader innocently; but he +and his companions rarely so choose. + +The trader must be credited with a virtue: he often makes a kind +and loyal husband. Some of the worst beachcombers in the Pacific, +some of the last of the old school, have fallen in my path, and +some of them were admirable to their native wives, and one made a +despairing widower. The position of a trader's wife in the +Gilberts is, besides, unusually enviable. She shares the +immunities of her husband. Curfew in Butaritari sounds for her in +vain. Long after the bell is rung and the great island ladies are +confined for the night to their own roof, this chartered libertine +may scamper and giggle through the deserted streets or go down to +bathe in the dark. The resources of the store are at her hand; she +goes arrayed like a queen, and feasts delicately everyday upon +tinned meats. And she who was perhaps of no regard or station +among natives sits with captains, and is entertained on board of +schooners. Five of these privileged dames were some time our +neighbours. Four were handsome skittish lasses, gamesome like +children, and like children liable to fits of pouting. They wore +dresses by day, but there was a tendency after dark to strip these +lendings and to career and squall about the compound in the +aboriginal ridi. Games of cards were continually played, with +shells for counters; their course was much marred by cheating; and +the end of a round (above all if a man was of the party) resolved +itself into a scrimmage for the counters. The fifth was a matron. +It was a picture to see her sail to church on a Sunday, a parasol +in hand, a nursemaid following, and the baby buried in a trade hat +and armed with a patent feeding-bottle. The service was enlivened +by her continual supervision and correction of the maid. It was +impossible not to fancy the baby was a doll, and the church some +European playroom. All these women were legitimately married. It +is true that the certificate of one, when she proudly showed it, +proved to run thus, that she was 'married for one night,' and her +gracious partner was at liberty to 'send her to hell' the next +morning; but she was none the wiser or the worse for the dastardly +trick. Another, I heard, was married on a work of mine in a +pirated edition; it answered the purpose as well as a Hall Bible. +Notwithstanding all these allurements of social distinction, rare +food and raiment, a comparative vacation from toil, and legitimate +marriage contracted on a pirated edition, the trader must sometimes +seek long before he can be mated. While I was in the group one had +been eight months on the quest, and he was still a bachelor. + +Within strictly native society the old laws and practices were +harsh, but not without a certain stamp of high-mindedness. +Stealthy adultery was punished with death; open elopement was +properly considered virtue in comparison, and compounded for a fine +in land. The male adulterer alone seems to have been punished. It +is correct manners for a jealous man to hang himself; a jealous +woman has a different remedy--she bites her rival. Ten or twenty +years ago it was a capital offence to raise a woman's ridi; to this +day it is still punished with a heavy fine; and the garment itself +is still symbolically sacred. Suppose a piece of land to be +disputed in Butaritari, the claimant who shall first hang a ridi on +the tapu-post has gained his cause, since no one can remove or +touch it but himself. + +The ridi was the badge not of the woman but the wife, the mark not +of her sex but of her station. It was the collar on the slave's +neck, the brand on merchandise. The adulterous woman seems to have +been spared; were the husband offended, it would be a poor +consolation to send his draught cattle to the shambles. Karaiti, +to this day, calls his eight wives 'his horses,' some trader having +explained to him the employment of these animals on farms; and +Nanteitei hired out his wives to do mason-work. Husbands, at least +when of high rank, had the power of life and death; even whites +seem to have possessed it; and their wives, when they had +transgressed beyond forgiveness, made haste to pronounce the +formula of deprecation--I KANA KIM. This form of words had so much +virtue that a condemned criminal repeating it on a particular day +to the king who had condemned him, must be instantly released. It +is an offer of abasement, and, strangely enough, the reverse--the +imitation--is a common vulgar insult in Great Britain to this day. +I give a scene between a trader and his Gilbert Island wife, as it +was told me by the husband, now one of the oldest residents, but +then a freshman in the group. + +'Go and light a fire,' said the trader, 'and when I have brought +this oil I will cook some fish.' The woman grunted at him, island +fashion. 'I am not a pig that you should grunt at me,' said he. + +'I know you are not a pig,' said the woman, 'neither am I your +slave.' + +'To be sure you are not my slave, and if you do not care to stop +with me, you had better go home to your people,' said he. 'But in +the mean time go and light the fire; and when I have brought this +oil I will cook some fish.' + +She went as if to obey; and presently when the trader looked she +had built a fire so big that the cook-house was catching in flames. + +'I Kana Kim!' she cried, as she saw him coming; but he recked not, +and hit her with a cooking-pot. The leg pierced her skull, blood +spouted, it was thought she was a dead woman, and the natives +surrounded the house in a menacing expectation. Another white was +present, a man of older experience. 'You will have us both killed +if you go on like this,' he cried. 'She had said I Kana Kim!' If +she had not said I Kana Kim he might have struck her with a +caldron. It was not the blow that made the crime, but the +disregard of an accepted formula. + +Polygamy, the particular sacredness of wives, their semi-servile +state, their seclusion in kings' harems, even their privilege of +biting, all would seem to indicate a Mohammedan society and the +opinion of the soullessness of woman. And not so in the least. It +is a mere appearance. After you have studied these extremes in one +house, you may go to the next and find all reversed, the woman the +mistress, the man only the first of her thralls. The authority is +not with the husband as such, nor the wife as such. It resides in +the chief or the chief-woman; in him or her who has inherited the +lands of the clan, and stands to the clansman in the place of +parent, exacting their service, answerable for their fines. There +is but the one source of power and the one ground of dignity--rank. +The king married a chief-woman; she became his menial, and must +work with her hands on Messrs. Wightman's pier. The king divorced +her; she regained at once her former state and power. She married +the Hawaiian sailor, and behold the man is her flunkey and can be +shown the door at pleasure. Nay, and such low-born lords are even +corrected physically, and, like grown but dutiful children, must +endure the discipline. + +We were intimate in one such household, that of Nei Takauti and Nan +Tok'; I put the lady first of necessity. During one week of fool's +paradise, Mrs. Stevenson had gone alone to the sea-side of the +island after shells. I am very sure the proceeding was unsafe; and +she soon perceived a man and woman watching her. Do what she +would, her guardians held her steadily in view; and when the +afternoon began to fall, and they thought she had stayed long +enough, took her in charge, and by signs and broken English ordered +her home. On the way the lady drew from her earring-hole a clay +pipe, the husband lighted it, and it was handed to my unfortunate +wife, who knew not how to refuse the incommodious favour; and when +they were all come to our house, the pair sat down beside her on +the floor, and improved the occasion with prayer. From that day +they were our family friends; bringing thrice a day the beautiful +island garlands of white flowers, visiting us any evening, and +frequently carrying us down to their own maniap' in return, the +woman leading Mrs. Stevenson by the hand like one child with +another. + +Nan Tok', the husband, was young, extremely handsome, of the most +approved good humour, and suffering in his precarious station from +suppressed high spirits. Nei Takauti, the wife, was getting old; +her grown son by a former marriage had just hanged himself before +his mother's eyes in despair at a well-merited rebuke. Perhaps she +had never been beautiful, but her face was full of character, her +eye of sombre fire. She was a high chief-woman, but by a strange +exception for a person of her rank, was small, spare, and sinewy, +with lean small hands and corded neck. Her full dress of an +evening was invariably a white chemise--and for adornment, green +leaves (or sometimes white blossoms) stuck in her hair and thrust +through her huge earring-holes. The husband on the contrary +changed to view like a kaleidoscope. Whatever pretty thing my wife +might have given to Nei Takauti--a string of beads, a ribbon, a +piece of bright fabric--appeared the next evening on the person of +Nan Tok'. It was plain he was a clothes-horse; that he wore +livery; that, in a word, he was his wife's wife. They reversed the +parts indeed, down to the least particular; it was the husband who +showed himself the ministering angel in the hour of pain, while the +wife displayed the apathy and heartlessness of the proverbial man. + +When Nei Takauti had a headache Nan Tok' was full of attention and +concern. When the husband had a cold and a racking toothache the +wife heeded not, except to jeer. It is always the woman's part to +fill and light the pipe; Nei Takauti handed hers in silence to the +wedded page; but she carried it herself, as though the page were +not entirely trusted. Thus she kept the money, but it was he who +ran the errands, anxiously sedulous. A cloud on her face dimmed +instantly his beaming looks; on an early visit to their maniap' my +wife saw he had cause to be wary. Nan Tok' had a friend with him, +a giddy young thing, of his own age and sex; and they had worked +themselves into that stage of jocularity when consequences are too +often disregarded. Nei Takauti mentioned her own name. Instantly +Nan Tok' held up two fingers, his friend did likewise, both in an +ecstasy of slyness. It was plain the lady had two names; and from +the nature of their merriment, and the wrath that gathered on her +brow, there must be something ticklish in the second. The husband +pronounced it; a well-directed cocoa-nut from the hand of his wife +caught him on the side of the head, and the voices and the mirth of +these indiscreet young gentlemen ceased for the day. + +The people of Eastern Polynesia are never at a loss; their +etiquette is absolute and plenary; in every circumstance it tells +them what to do and how to do it. The Gilbertines are seemingly +more free, and pay for their freedom (like ourselves) in frequent +perplexity. This was often the case with the topsy-turvy couple. +We had once supplied them during a visit with a pipe and tobacco; +and when they had smoked and were about to leave, they found +themselves confronted with a problem: should they take or leave +what remained of the tobacco? The piece of plug was taken up, it +was laid down again, it was handed back and forth, and argued over, +till the wife began to look haggard and the husband elderly. They +ended by taking it, and I wager were not yet clear of the compound +before they were sure they had decided wrong. Another time they +had been given each a liberal cup of coffee, and Nan Tok' with +difficulty and disaffection made an end of his. Nei Takauti had +taken some, she had no mind for more, plainly conceived it would be +a breach of manners to set down the cup unfinished, and ordered her +wedded retainer to dispose of what was left. 'I have swallowed all +I can, I cannot swallow more, it is a physical impossibility,' he +seemed to say; and his stern officer reiterated her commands with +secret imperative signals. Luckless dog! but in mere humanity we +came to the rescue and removed the cup. + +I cannot but smile over this funny household; yet I remember the +good souls with affection and respect. Their attention to +ourselves was surprising. The garlands are much esteemed, the +blossoms must be sought far and wide; and though they had many +retainers to call to their aid, we often saw themselves passing +afield after the blossoms, and the wife engaged with her own in +putting them together. It was no want of only that disregard so +incident to husbands, that made Nei Takauti despise the sufferings +of Nan Tok'. When my wife was unwell she proved a diligent and +kindly nurse; and the pair, to the extreme embarrassment of the +sufferer, became fixtures in the sick-room. This rugged, capable, +imperious old dame, with the wild eyes, had deep and tender +qualities: her pride in her young husband it seemed that she +dissembled, fearing possibly to spoil him; and when she spoke of +her dead son there came something tragic in her face. But I seemed +to trace in the Gilbertines a virility of sense and sentiment which +distinguishes them (like their harsh and uncouth language) from +their brother islanders in the east. + + + + +PART IV: THE GILBERTS--APEMAMA + + + + +CHAPTER I--THE KING OF APEMAMA: THE ROYAL TRADER + + + +There is one great personage in the Gilberts: Tembinok' of +Apemama: solely conspicuous, the hero of song, the butt of gossip. +Through the rest of the group the kings are slain or fallen in +tutelage: Tembinok' alone remains, the last tyrant, the last erect +vestige of a dead society. The white man is everywhere else, +building his houses, drinking his gin, getting in and out of +trouble with the weak native governments. There is only one white +on Apemama, and he on sufferance, living far from court, and +hearkening and watching his conduct like a mouse in a cat's ear. +Through all the other islands a stream of native visitors comes and +goes, travelling by families, spending years on the grand tour. +Apemama alone is left upon one side, the tourist dreading to risk +himself within the clutch of Tembinok'. And fear of the same +Gorgon follows and troubles them at home. Maiana once paid him +tribute; he once fell upon and seized Nonuti: first steps to the +empire of the archipelago. A British warship coming on the scene, +the conqueror was driven to disgorge, his career checked in the +outset, his dear-bought armoury sunk in his own lagoon. But the +impression had been made; periodical fear of him still shakes the +islands; rumour depicts him mustering his canoes for a fresh +onfall; rumour can name his destination; and Tembinok' figures in +the patriotic war-songs of the Gilberts like Napoleon in those of +our grandfathers. + +We were at sea, bound from Mariki to Nonuti and Tapituea, when the +wind came suddenly fair for Apemama. The course was at once +changed; all hands were turned-to to clean ship, the decks holy- +stoned, all the cabin washed, the trade-room overhauled. In all +our cruising we never saw the Equator so smart as she was made for +Tembinok'. Nor was Captain Reid alone in these coquetries; for, +another schooner chancing to arrive during my stay in Apemama, I +found that she also was dandified for the occasion. And the two +cases stand alone in my experience of South Sea traders. + +We had on board a family of native tourists, from the grandsire to +the babe in arms, trying (against an extraordinary series of ill- +luck) to regain their native island of Peru. Five times already +they had paid their fare and taken ship; five times they had been +disappointed, dropped penniless upon strange islands, or carried +back to Butaritari, whence they sailed. This last attempt had been +no better-starred; their provisions were exhausted. Peru was +beyond hope, and they had cheerfully made up their minds to a fresh +stage of exile in Tapituea or Nonuti. With this slant of wind +their random destination became once more changed; and like the +Calendar's pilot, when the 'black mountains' hove in view, they +changed colour and beat upon their breasts. Their camp, which was +on deck in the ship's waist, resounded with complaint. They would +be set to work, they must become slaves, escape was hopeless, they +must live and toil and die in Apemama, in the tyrant's den. With +this sort of talk they so greatly terrified their children, that +one (a big hulking boy) must at last be torn screaming from the +schooner's side. And their fears were wholly groundless. I have +little doubt they were not suffered to be idle; but I can vouch for +it that they were kindly and generously used. For, the matter of a +year later, I was once more shipmate with these inconsistent +wanderers on board the Janet Nicoll. Their fare was paid by +Tembinok'; they who had gone ashore from the Equator destitute, +reappeared upon the Janet with new clothes, laden with mats and +presents, and bringing with them a magazine of food, on which they +lived like fighting-cocks throughout the voyage; I saw them at +length repatriated, and I must say they showed more concern on +quitting Apemama than delight at reaching home. + +We entered by the north passage (Sunday, September 1st), dodging +among shoals. It was a day of fierce equatorial sunshine; but the +breeze was strong and chill; and the mate, who conned the schooner +from the cross-trees, returned shivering to the deck. The lagoon +was thick with many-tinted wavelets; a continuous roaring of the +outer sea overhung the anchorage; and the long, hollow crescent of +palm ruffled and sparkled in the wind. Opposite our berth the +beach was seen to be surmounted for some distance by a terrace of +white coral seven or eight feet high and crowned in turn by the +scattered and incongruous buildings of the palace. The village +adjoins on the south, a cluster of high-roofed maniap's. And +village and palace seemed deserted. + +We were scarce yet moored, however, before distant and busy figures +appeared upon the beach, a boat was launched, and a crew pulled out +to us bringing the king's ladder. Tembinok' had once an accident; +has feared ever since to entrust his person to the rotten chandlery +of South Sea traders; and devised in consequence a frame of wood, +which is brought on board a ship as soon as she appears, and +remains lashed to her side until she leave. The boat's crew, +having applied this engine, returned at once to shore. They might +not come on board; neither might we land, or not without danger of +offence; the king giving pratique in person. An interval followed, +during which dinner was delayed for the great man--the prelude of +the ladder, giving us some notion of his weighty body and sensible, +ingenious character, had highly whetted our curiosity; and it was +with something like excitement that we saw the beach and terrace +suddenly blacken with attendant vassals, the king and party embark, +the boat (a man-of-war gig) come flying towards us dead before the +wind, and the royal coxswain lay us cleverly aboard, mount the +ladder with a jealous diffidence, and descend heavily on deck. + +Not long ago he was overgrown with fat, obscured to view, and a +burthen to himself. Captains visiting the island advised him to +walk; and though it broke the habits of a life and the traditions +of his rank, he practised the remedy with benefit. His corpulence +is now portable; you would call him lusty rather than fat; but his +gait is still dull, stumbling, and elephantine. He neither stops +nor hastens, but goes about his business with an implacable +deliberation. We could never see him and not be struck with his +extraordinary natural means for the theatre: a beaked profile like +Dante's in the mask, a mane of long black hair, the eye brilliant, +imperious, and inquiring: for certain parts, and to one who could +have used it, the face was a fortune. His voice matched it well, +being shrill, powerful, and uncanny, with a note like a sea-bird's. +Where there are no fashions, none to set them, few to follow them +if they were set, and none to criticise, he dresses--as Sir Charles +Grandison lived--'to his own heart.' Now he wears a woman's frock, +now a naval uniform; now (and more usually) figures in a masquerade +costume of his own design: trousers and a singular jacket with +shirt tails, the cut and fit wonderful for island workmanship, the +material always handsome, sometimes green velvet, sometimes +cardinal red silk. This masquerade becomes him admirably. In the +woman's frock he looks ominous and weird beyond belief. I see him +now come pacing towards me in the cruel sun, solitary, a figure out +of Hoffmann. + +A visit on board ship, such as that at which we now assisted, makes +a chief part and by far the chief diversion of the life of +Tembinok'. He is not only the sole ruler, he is the sole merchant +of his triple kingdom, Apemama, Aranuka, and Kuria, well-planted +islands. The taro goes to the chiefs, who divide as they please +among their immediate adherents; but certain fish, turtles--which +abound in Kuria,--and the whole produce of the coco-palm, belong +exclusively to Tembinok'. 'A' cobra berong me,' observed his +majesty with a wave of his hand; and he counts and sells it by the +houseful. 'You got copra, king?' I have heard a trader ask. 'I +got two, three outches,' his majesty replied: 'I think three.' +Hence the commercial importance of Apemama, the trade of three +islands being centred there in a single hand; hence it is that so +many whites have tried in vain to gain or to preserve a footing; +hence ships are adorned, cooks have special orders, and captains +array themselves in smiles, to greet the king. If he be pleased +with his welcome and the fare he may pass days on board, and, every +day, and sometimes every hour, will be of profit to the ship. He +oscillates between the cabin, where he is entertained with strange +meats, and the trade-room, where he enjoys the pleasures of +shopping on a scale to match his person. A few obsequious +attendants squat by the house door, awaiting his least signal. In +the boat, which has been suffered to drop astern, one or two of his +wives lie covered from the sun under mats, tossed by the short sea +of the lagoon, and enduring agonies of heat and tedium. This +severity is now and then relaxed and the wives allowed on board. +Three or four were thus favoured on the day of our arrival: +substantial ladies airily attired in ridis. Each had a share of +copra, her peculium, to dispose of for herself. The display in the +trade-room--hats, ribbbons, dresses, scents, tins of salmon--the +pride of the eye and the lust of the flesh--tempted them in vain. +They had but the one idea--tobacco, the island currency, tantamount +to minted gold; returned to shore with it, burthened but rejoicing; +and late into the night, on the royal terrace, were to be seen +counting the sticks by lamplight in the open air. + +The king is no such economist. He is greedy of things new and +foreign. House after house, chest after chest, in the palace +precinct, is already crammed with clocks, musical boxes, blue +spectacles, umbrellas, knitted waistcoats, bolts of stuff, tools, +rifles, fowling-pieces, medicines, European foods, sewing-machines, +and, what is more extraordinary, stoves: all that ever caught his +eye, tickled his appetite, pleased him for its use, or puzzled him +with its apparent inutility. And still his lust is unabated. He +is possessed by the seven devils of the collector. He hears a +thing spoken of, and a shadow comes on his face. 'I think I no got +him,' he will say; and the treasures he has seem worthless in +comparison. If a ship be bound for Apemama, the merchant racks his +brain to hit upon some novelty. This he leaves carelessly in the +main cabin or partly conceals in his own berth, so that the king +shall spy it for himself. 'How much you want?' inquires Tembinok', +passing and pointing. 'No, king; that too dear,' returns the +trader. 'I think I like him,' says the king. This was a bowl of +gold-fish. On another occasion it was scented soap. 'No, king; +that cost too much,' said the trader; 'too good for a Kanaka.' +'How much you got? I take him all,' replied his majesty, and +became the lord of seventeen boxes at two dollars a cake. Or +again, the merchant feigns the article is not for sale, is private +property, an heirloom or a gift; and the trick infallibly succeeds. +Thwart the king and you hold him. His autocratic nature rears at +the affront of opposition. He accepts it for a challenge; sets his +teeth like a hunter going at a fence; and with no mark of emotion, +scarce even of interest, stolidly piles up the price. Thus, for +our sins, he took a fancy to my wife's dressing-bag, a thing +entirely useless to the man, and sadly battered by years of +service. Early one forenoon he came to our house, sat down, and +abruptly offered to purchase it. I told him I sold nothing, and +the bag at any rate was a present from a friend; but he was +acquainted with these pretexts from of old, and knew what they were +worth and how to meet them. Adopting what I believe is called 'the +object method,' he drew out a bag of English gold, sovereigns and +half-sovereigns, and began to lay them one by one in silence on the +table; at each fresh piece reading our faces with a look. In vain +I continued to protest I was no trader; he deigned not to reply. +There must have been twenty pounds on the table, he was still going +on, and irritation had begun to mingle with our embarrassment, when +a happy idea came to our delivery. Since his majesty thought so +much of the bag, we said, we must beg him to accept it as a +present. It was the most surprising turn in Tembinok's experience. +He perceived too late that his persistence was unmannerly; hung his +head a while in silence; then, lifting up a sheepish countenance, +'I 'shamed,' said the tyrant. It was the first and the last time +we heard him own to a flaw in his behaviour. Half an hour after he +sent us a camphor-wood chest worth only a few dollars--but then +heaven knows what Tembinok' had paid for it. + +Cunning by nature, and versed for forty years in the government of +men, it must not be supposed that he is cheated blindly, or has +resigned himself without resistance to be the milch-cow of the +passing trader. His efforts have been even heroic. Like Nakaeia +of Makin, he has owned schooners. More fortunate than Nakaeia, he +has found captains. Ships of his have sailed as far as to the +colonies. He has trafficked direct, in his own bottoms, with New +Zealand. And even so, even there, the world-enveloping dishonesty +of the white man prevented him; his profit melted, his ship +returned in debt, the money for the insurance was embezzled, and +when the Coronet came to be lost, he was astonished to find he had +lost all. At this he dropped his weapons; owned he might as +hopefully wrestle with the winds of heaven; and like an experienced +sheep, submitted his fleece thenceforward to the shearers. He is +the last man in the world to waste anger on the incurable; accepts +it with cynical composure; asks no more in those he deals with than +a certain decency of moderation; drives as good a bargain as he +can; and when he considers he is more than usually swindled, writes +it in his memory against the merchant's name. He once ran over to +me a list of captains and supercargoes with whom he had done +business, classing them under three heads: 'He cheat a litty'--'He +cheat plenty'--and 'I think he cheat too much.' For the first two +classes he expressed perfect toleration; sometimes, but not always, +for the third. I was present when a certain merchant was turned +about his business, and was the means (having a considerable +influence ever since the bag) of patching up the dispute. Even on +the day of our arrival there was like to have been a hitch with +Captain Reid: the ground of which is perhaps worth recital. Among +goods exported specially for Tembinok' there is a beverage known +(and labelled) as Hennessy's brandy. It is neither Hennessy, nor +even brandy; is about the colour of sherry, but is not sherry; +tastes of kirsch, and yet neither is it kirsch. The king, at +least, has grown used to this amazing brand, and rather prides +himself upon the taste; and any substitution is a double offence, +being at once to cheat him and to cast a doubt upon his palate. A +similar weakness is to be observed in all connoisseurs. Now the +last case sold by the Equator was found to contain a different and +I would fondly fancy a superior distillation; and the conversation +opened very black for Captain Reid. But Tembinok' is a moderate +man. He was reminded and admitted that all men were liable to +error, even himself; accepted the principle that a fault handsomely +acknowledged should be condoned; and wound the matter up with this +proposal: 'Tuppoti I mi'take, you 'peakee me. Tuppoti you +mi'take, I 'peakee you. Mo' betta.' + +After dinner and supper in the cabin, a glass or two of 'Hennetti'- +-the genuine article this time, with the kirsch bouquet,--and five +hours' lounging on the trade-room counter, royalty embarked for +home. Three tacks grounded the boat before the palace; the wives +were carried ashore on the backs of vassals; Tembinok' stepped on a +railed platform like a steamer's gangway, and was borne shoulder +high through the shallows, up the beach, and by an inclined plane, +paved with pebbles, to the glaring terrace where he dwells. + + + +CHAPTER II--THE KING OF APEMAMA: FOUNDATION OF EQUATOR TOWN + + + +Our first sight of Tembinok' was a matter of concern, almost alarm, +to my whole party. We had a favour to seek; we must approach in +the proper courtly attitude of a suitor; and must either please him +or fail in the main purpose of our voyage. It was our wish to land +and live in Apemama, and see more near at hand the odd character of +the man and the odd (or rather ancient) condition of his island. +In all other isles of the South Seas a white man may land with his +chest, and set up house for a lifetime, if he choose, and if he +have the money or the trade; no hindrance is conceivable. But +Apemama is a close island, lying there in the sea with closed +doors; the king himself, like a vigilant officer, ready at the +wicket to scrutinise and reject intrenching visitors. Hence the +attraction of our enterprise; not merely because it was a little +difficult, but because this social quarantine, a curiosity in +itself, has been the preservative of others. + +Tembinok', like most tyrants, is a conservative; like many +conservatives, he eagerly welcomes new ideas, and, except in the +field of politics, leans to practical reform. When the +missionaries came, professing a knowledge of the truth, he readily +received them; attended their worship, acquired the accomplishment +of public prayer, and made himself a student at their feet. It is +thus--it is by the cultivation of similar passing chances--that he +has learned to read, to write, to cipher, and to speak his queer, +personal English, so different from ordinary 'Beach de Mar,' so +much more obscure, expressive, and condensed. His education +attended to, he found time to become critical of the new inmates. +Like Nakaeia of Makin, he is an admirer of silence in the island; +broods over it like a great ear; has spies who report daily; and +had rather his subjects sang than talked. The service, and in +particular the sermon, were thus sure to become offences: 'Here, +in my island, _I_ 'peak,' he once observed to me. 'My chieps no +'peak--do what I talk.' He looked at the missionary, and what did +he see? 'See Kanaka 'peak in a big outch!' he cried, with a strong +ring of sarcasm. Yet he endured the subversive spectacle, and +might even have continued to endure it, had not a fresh point +arisen. He looked again, to employ his own figure; and the Kanaka +was no longer speaking, he was doing worse--he was building a +copra-house. The king was touched in his chief interests; revenue +and prerogative were threatened. He considered besides (and some +think with him) that trade is incompatible with the missionary +claims. 'Tuppoti mitonary think "good man": very good. Tuppoti +he think "cobra": no good. I send him away ship.' Such was his +abrupt history of the evangelist in Apemama. + +Similar deportations are common: 'I send him away ship' is the +epitaph of not a few, his majesty paying the exile's fare to the +next place of call. For instance, being passionately fond of +European food, he has several times added to his household a white +cook, and one after another these have been deported. They, on +their side, swear they were not paid their wages; he, on his, that +they robbed and swindled him beyond endurance: both perhaps +justly. A more important case was that of an agent, despatched (as +I heard the story) by a firm of merchants to worm his way into the +king's good graces, become, if possible, premier, and handle the +copra in the interest of his employers. He obtained authority to +land, practised his fascinations, was patiently listened to by +Tembinok', supposed himself on the highway to success; and behold! +when the next ship touched at Apemama, the would-be premier was +flung into a boat--had on board--his fare paid, and so good-bye. +But it is needless to multiply examples; the proof of the pudding +is in the eating. When we came to Apemama, of so many white men +who have scrambled for a place in that rich market, one remained--a +silent, sober, solitary, niggardly recluse, of whom the king +remarks, 'I think he good; he no 'peak.' + +I was warned at the outset we might very well fail in our design: +yet never dreamed of what proved to be the fact, that we should be +left four-and-twenty hours in suspense and come within an ace of +ultimate rejection. Captain Reid had primed himself; no sooner was +the king on board, and the Hennetti question amicably settled, than +he proceeded to express my request and give an abstract of my +claims and virtues. The gammon about Queen Victoria's son might do +for Butaritari; it was out of the question here; and I now figured +as 'one of the Old Men of England,' a person of deep knowledge, +come expressly to visit Tembinok's dominion, and eager to report +upon it to the no less eager Queen Victoria. The king made no +shadow of an answer, and presently began upon a different subject. +We might have thought that he had not heard, or not understood; +only that we found ourselves the subject of a constant study. As +we sat at meals, he took us in series and fixed upon each, for near +a minute at a time, the same hard and thoughtful stare. As he thus +looked he seemed to forget himself, the subject and the company, +and to become absorbed in the process of his thought; the look was +wholly impersonal; I have seen the same in the eyes of portrait- +painters. The counts upon which whites have been deported are +mainly four: cheating Tembinok', meddling overmuch with copra, +which is the source of his wealth, and one of the sinews of his +power, 'PEAKING, and political intrigue. I felt guiltless upon +all; but how to show it? I would not have taken copra in a gift: +how to express that quality by my dinner-table bearing? The rest +of the party shared my innocence and my embarrassment. They shared +also in my mortification when after two whole meal-times and the +odd moments of an afternoon devoted to this reconnoitring, +Tembinok' took his leave in silence. Next morning, the same +undisguised study, the same silence, was resumed; and the second +day had come to its maturity before I was informed abruptly that I +had stood the ordeal. 'I look your eye. You good man. You no +lie,' said the king: a doubtful compliment to a writer of romance. +Later he explained he did not quite judge by the eye only, but the +mouth as well. 'Tuppoti I see man,' he explained. 'I no tavvy +good man, bad man. I look eye, look mouth. Then I tavvy. Look +EYE, look mouth,' he repeated. And indeed in our case the mouth +had the most to do with it, and it was by our talk that we gained +admission to the island; the king promising himself (and I believe +really amassing) a vast amount of useful knowledge ere we left. + +The terms of our admission were as follows: We were to choose a +site, and the king should there build us a town. His people should +work for us, but the king only was to give them orders. One of his +cooks should come daily to help mine, and to learn of him. In case +our stores ran out, he would supply us, and be repaid on the return +of the Equator. On the other hand, he was to come to meals with us +when so inclined; when he stayed at home, a dish was to be sent him +from our table; and I solemnly engaged to give his subjects no +liquor or money (both of which they are forbidden to possess) and +no tobacco, which they were to receive only from the royal hand. I +think I remember to have protested against the stringency of this +last article; at least, it was relaxed, and when a man worked for +me I was allowed to give him a pipe of tobacco on the premises, but +none to take away. + +The site of Equator City--we named our city for the schooner--was +soon chosen. The immediate shores of the lagoon are windy and +blinding; Tembinok' himself is glad to grope blue-spectacled on his +terrace; and we fled the neighbourhood of the red conjunctiva, the +suppurating eyeball, and the beggar who pursues and beseeches the +passing foreigner for eye wash. Behind the town the country is +diversified; here open, sandy, uneven, and dotted with dwarfish +palms; here cut up with taro trenches, deep and shallow, and, +according to the growth of the plants, presenting now the +appearance of a sandy tannery, now of an alleyed and green garden. +A path leads towards the sea, mounting abruptly to the main level +of the island--twenty or even thirty feet, although Findlay gives +five; and just hard by the top of the rise, where the coco-palms +begin to be well grown, we found a grove of pandanus, and a piece +of soil pleasantly covered with green underbush. A well was not +far off under a rustic well-house; nearer still, in a sandy cup of +the land, a pond where we might wash our clothes. The place was +out of the wind, out of the sun, and out of sight of the village. +It was shown to the king, and the town promised for the morrow. + +The morrow came, Mr. Osbourne landed, found nothing done, and +carried his complaint to Tembinok'. He heard it, rose, called for +a Winchester, stepped without the royal palisade, and fired two +shots in the air. A shot in the air is the first Apemama warning; +it has the force of a proclamation in more loquacious countries; +and his majesty remarked agreeably that it would make his labourers +'mo' bright.' In less than thirty minutes, accordingly, the men +had mustered, the work was begun, and we were told that we might +bring our baggage when we pleased. + +It was two in the afternoon ere the first boat was beached, and the +long procession of chests and crates and sacks began to straggle +through the sandy desert towards Equator Town. The grove of +pandanus was practically a thing of the past. Fire surrounded and +smoke rose in the green underbush. In a wide circuit the axes were +still crashing. Those very advantages for which the place was +chosen, it had been the king's first idea to abolish; and in the +midst of this devastation there stood already a good-sized maniap' +and a small closed house. A mat was spread near by for Tembinok'; +here he sat superintending, in cardinal red, a pith helmet on his +head, a meerschaum pipe in his mouth, a wife stretched at his back +with custody of the matches and tobacco. Twenty or thirty feet in +front of him the bulk of the workers squatted on the ground; some +of the bush here survived and in this the commons sat nearly to +their shoulders, and presented only an arc of brown faces, black +heads, and attentive eyes fixed on his majesty. Long pauses +reigned, during which the subjects stared and the king smoked. +Then Tembinok' would raise his voice and speak shrilly and briefly. +There was never a response in words; but if the speech were +jesting, there came by way of answer discreet, obsequious laughter- +-such laughter as we hear in schoolrooms; and if it were practical, +the sudden uprising and departure of the squad. Twice they so +disappeared, and returned with further elements of the city: a +second house and a second maniap'. It was singular to spy, far off +through the coco stems, the silent oncoming of the maniap', at +first (it seemed) swimming spontaneously in the air--but on a +nearer view betraying under the eaves many score of moving naked +legs. In all the affair servile obedience was no less remarkable +than servile deliberation. The gang had here mustered by the note +of a deadly weapon; the man who looked on was the unquestioned +master of their lives; and except for civility, they bestirred +themselves like so many American hotel clerks. The spectator was +aware of an unobtrusive yet invincible inertia, at which the +skipper of a trading dandy might have torn his hair. + +Yet the work was accomplished. By dusk, when his majesty withdrew, +the town was founded and complete, a new and ruder Amphion having +called it from nothing with three cracks of a rifle. And the next +morning the same conjurer obliged us with a further miracle: a +mystic rampart fencing us, so that the path which ran by our doors +became suddenly impassable, the inhabitants who had business across +the isle must fetch a wide circuit, and we sat in the midst in a +transparent privacy, seeing, seen, but unapproachable, like bees in +a glass hive. The outward and visible sign of this glamour was no +more than a few ragged coco-leaf garlands round the stems of the +outlying palms; but its significance reposed on the tremendous +sanction of the tapu and the guns of Tembinok'. + +We made our first meal that night in the improvised city, where we +were to stay two months, and which--so soon as we had done with it- +-was to vanish in a day as it appeared, its elements returning +whence they came, the tapu raised, the traffic on the path resumed, +the sun and the moon peering in vain between the palm-trees for the +bygone work, the wind blowing over an empty site. Yet the place, +which is now only an episode in some memories, seemed to have been +built, and to be destined to endure, for years. It was a busy +hamlet. One of the maniap's we made our dining-room, one the +kitchen. The houses we reserved for sleeping. They were on the +admirable Apemama plan: out and away the best house in the South +Seas; standing some three feet above the ground on posts; the sides +of woven flaps, which can be raised to admit light and air, or +lowered to shut out the wind and the rain: airy, healthy, clean, +and watertight. We had a hen of a remarkable kind: almost unique +in my experience, being a hen that occasionally laid eggs. Not far +off, Mrs. Stevenson tended a garden of salad and shalots. The +salad was devoured by the hen--which was her bane. The shalots +were served out a leaf at a time, and welcomed and relished like +peaches. Toddy and green cocoa-nuts were brought us daily. We +once had a present of fish from the king, and once of a turtle. +Sometimes we shot so-called plover along on the shore, sometimes +wild chicken in the bush. The rest of our diet was from tins. + +Our occupations were very various. While some of the party would +be away sketching, Mr. Osbourne and I hammered away at a novel. We +read Gibbon and Carlyle aloud; we blew on flageolets, we strummed +on guitars; we took photographs by the light of the sun, the moon, +and flash-powder; sometimes we played cards. Pot-hunting engaged a +part of our leisure. I have myself passed afternoons in the +exciting but innocuous pursuit of winged animals with a revolver; +and it was fortunate there were better shots of the party, and +fortunate the king could lend us a more suitable weapon, in the +form of an excellent fowling-piece, or our spare diet had been +sparer still. + +Night was the time to see our city, after the moon was up, after +the lamps were lighted, and so long as the fire sparkled in the +cook-house. We suffered from a plague of flies and mosquitoes, +comparable to that of Egypt; our dinner-table (lent, like all our +furniture, by the king) must be enclosed in a tent of netting, our +citadel and refuge; and this became all luminous, and bulged and +beaconed under the eaves, like the globe of some monstrous lamp +under the margin of its shade. Our cabins, the sides being propped +at a variety of inclinations, spelled out strange, angular patterns +of brightness. In his roofed and open kitchen, Ah Fu was to be +seen by lamp and firelight, dabbling among pots. Over all, there +fell in the season an extraordinary splendour of mellow moonshine. +The sand sparkled as with the dust of diamonds; the stars had +vanished. At intervals, a dusky night-bird, slow and low flying, +passed in the colonnade of the tree stems and uttered a hoarse +croaking cry. + + + +CHAPTER III--THE KING OF APEMAMA: THE PALACE OF MANY WOMEN + + + +The palace, or rather the ground which it includes, is several +acres in extent. A terrace encloses it toward the lagoon; on the +side of the land, a palisade with several gates. These are scarce +intended for defence; a man, if he were strong, might easily pluck +down the palisade; he need not be specially active to leap from the +beach upon the terrace. There is no parade of guards, soldiers, or +weapons; the armoury is under lock and key; and the only sentinels +are certain inconspicuous old women lurking day and night before +the gates. By day, these crones were often engaged in boiling +syrup or the like household occupation; by night, they lay ambushed +in the shadow or crouched along the palisade, filling the office of +eunuchs to this harem, sole guards upon a tyrant life. + +Female wardens made a fit outpost for this palace of many women. +Of the number of the king's wives I have no guess; and but a loose +idea of their function. He himself displayed embarrassment when +they were referred to as his wives, called them himself 'my +pamily,' and explained they were his 'cutcheons'--cousins. We +distinguished four of the crowd: the king's mother; his sister, a +grave, trenchant woman, with much of her brother's intelligence; +the queen proper, to whom (and to whom alone) my wife was formally +presented; and the favourite of the hour, a pretty, graceful girl, +who sat with the king daily, and once (when he shed tears) consoled +him with caresses. I am assured that even with her his relations +are platonic. In the background figured a multitude of ladies, the +lean, the plump, and the elephantine, some in sacque frocks, some +in the hairbreadth ridi; high-born and low, slave and mistress; +from the queen to the scullion, from the favourite to the scraggy +sentries at the palisade. Not all of these of course are of 'my +pamily,'--many are mere attendants; yet a surprising number shared +the responsibility of the king's trust. These were key-bearers, +treasurers, wardens of the armoury, the napery, and the stores. +Each knew and did her part to admiration. Should anything be +required--a particular gun, perhaps, or a particular bolt of +stuff,--the right queen was summoned; she came bringing the right +chest, opened it in the king's presence, and displayed her charge +in perfect preservation--the gun cleaned and oiled, the goods duly +folded. Without delay or haste, and with the minimum of speech, +the whole great establishment turned on wheels like a machine. +Nowhere have I seen order more complete and pervasive. And yet I +was always reminded of Norse tales of trolls and ogres who kept +their hearts buried in the ground for the mere safety, and must +confide the secret to their wives. For these weapons are the life +of Tembinok'. He does not aim at popularity; but drives and braves +his subjects, with a simplicity of domination which it is +impossible not to admire, hard not to sympathise with. Should one +out of so many prove faithless, should the armoury be secretly +unlocked, should the crones have dozed by the palisade and the +weapons find their way unseen into the village, revolution would be +nearly certain, death the most probable result, and the spirit of +the tyrant of Apemama flit to rejoin his predecessors of Mariki and +Tapituea. Yet those whom he so trusts are all women, and all +rivals. + +There is indeed a ministry and staff of males: cook, steward, +carpenter, and supercargoes: the hierarchy of a schooner. The +spies, 'his majesty's daily papers,' as we called them, come every +morning to report, and go again. The cook and steward are +concerned with the table only. The supercargoes, whose business it +is to keep tally of the copra at three pounds a month and a +percentage, are rarely in the palace; and two at least are in the +other islands. The carpenter, indeed, shrewd and jolly old Rubam-- +query, Reuben?--promoted on my last visit to the greater dignity of +governor, is daily present, altering, extending, embellishing, +pursuing the endless series of the king's inventions; and his +majesty will sometimes pass an afternoon watching and talking with +Rubam at his work. But the males are still outsiders; none seems +to be armed, none is entrusted with a key; by dusk they are all +usually departed from the palace; and the weight of the monarchy +and of the monarch's life reposes unshared on the women. + +Here is a household unlike, indeed, to one of ours; more unlike +still to the Oriental harem: that of an elderly childless man, his +days menaced, dwelling alone amid a bevy of women of all ages, +ranks, and relationships,--the mother, the sister, the cousin, the +legitimate wife, the concubine, the favourite, the eldest born, and +she of yesterday; he, in their midst, the only master, the only +male, the sole dispenser of honours, clothes, and luxuries, the +sole mark of multitudinous ambitions and desires. I doubt if you +could find a man in Europe so bold as to attempt this piece of tact +and government. And seemingly Tembinok' himself had trouble in the +beginning. I hear of him shooting at a wife for some levity on +board a schooner. Another, on some more serious offence, he slew +outright; he exposed her body in an open box, and (to make the +warning more memorable) suffered it to putrefy before the palace +gate. Doubtless his growing years have come to his assistance; for +upon so large a scale it is more easy to play the father than the +husband. And to-day, at least to the eye of a stranger, all seems +to go smoothly, and the wives to be proud of their trust, proud of +their rank, and proud of their cunning lord. + +I conceived they made rather a hero of the man. A popular master +in a girls' school might, perhaps, offer a figure of his +preponderating station. But then the master does not eat, sleep, +live, and wash his dirty linen in the midst of his admirers; he +escapes, he has a room of his own, he leads a private life; if he +had nothing else, he has the holidays, and the more unhappy +Tembinok' is always on the stage and on the stretch. + +In all my coming and going, I never heard him speak harshly or +express the least displeasure. An extreme, rather heavy, +benignity--the benignity of one sure to be obeyed--marked his +demeanour; so that I was at times reminded of Samual Richardson in +his circle of admiring women. The wives spoke up and seemed to +volunteer opinions, like our wives at home--or, say, like doting +but respectable aunts. Altogether, I conclude that he rules his +seraglio much more by art than terror; and those who give a +different account (and who have none of them enjoyed my +opportunities of observation) perhaps failed to distinguish between +degrees of rank, between 'my pamily' and the hangers-on, +laundresses, and prostitutes. + +A notable feature is the evening game of cards when lamps are set +forth upon the terrace, and 'I and my pamily' play for tobacco by +the hour. It is highly characteristic of Tembinok' that he must +invent a game for himself; highly characteristic of his worshipping +household that they should swear by the absurd invention. It is +founded on poker, played with the honours out of many packs, and +inconceivably dreary. But I have a passion for all games, studied +it, and am supposed to be the only white who ever fairly grasped +its principle: a fact for which the wives (with whom I was not +otherwise popular) admired me with acclamation. It was impossible +to be deceived; this was a genuine feeling: they were proud of +their private game, had been cut to the quick by the want of +interest shown in it by others, and expanded under the flattery of +my attention. Tembinok' puts up a double stake, and receives in +return two hands to choose from: a shallow artifice which the +wives (in all these years) have not yet fathomed. He himself, when +talking with me privately, made not the least secret that he was +secure of winning; and it was thus he explained his recent +liberality on board the Equator. He let the wives buy their own +tobacco, which pleased them at the moment. He won it back at +cards, which made him once more, and without fresh expense, that +which he ought to be,--the sole fount of all indulgences. And he +summed the matter up in that phrase with which he almost always +concludes any account of his policy: 'Mo' betta.' + +The palace compound is laid with broken coral, excruciating to the +eyes and the bare feet, but exquisitely raked and weeded. A score +or more of buildings lie in a sort of street along the palisade and +scattered on the margin of the terrace; dwelling-houses for the +wives and the attendants, storehouses for the king's curios and +treasures, spacious maniap's for feast or council, some on pillars +of wood, some on piers of masonry. One was still in hand, a new +invention, the king's latest born: a European frame-house built +for coolness inside a lofty maniap': its roof planked like a +ship's deck to be a raised, shady, and yet private promenade. It +was here the king spent hours with Rubam; here I would sometimes +join them; the place had a most singular appearance; and I must say +I was greatly taken with the fancy, and joined with relish in the +counsels of the architects. + +Suppose we had business with his majesty by day: we strolled over +the sand and by the dwarfish palms, exchanged a 'Konamaori' with +the crone on duty, and entered the compound. The wide sheet of +coral glared before us deserted; all having stowed themselves in +dark canvas from the excess of room. I have gone to and fro in +that labyrinth of a place, seeking the king; and the only breathing +creature I could find was when I peered under the eaves of a +maniap', and saw the brawny body of one of the wives stretched on +the floor, a naked Amazon plunged in noiseless slumber. If it were +still the hour of the 'morning papers' the quest would be more +easy, the half-dozen obsequious, sly dogs squatting on the ground +outside a house, crammed as far as possible in its narrow shadow, +and turning to the king a row of leering faces. Tembinok' would be +within, the flaps of the cabin raised, the trade blowing through, +hearing their report. Like journalists nearer home, when the day's +news were scanty, these would make the more of it in words; and I +have known one to fill up a barren morning with an imaginary +conversation of two dogs. Sometimes the king deigns to laugh, +sometimes to question or jest with them, his voice sounding shrilly +from the cabin. By his side he may have the heir-apparent, Paul, +his nephew and adopted son, six years old, stark naked, and a model +of young human beauty. And there will always be the favourite and +perhaps two other wives awake; four more lying supine under mats +and whelmed in slumber. Or perhaps we came later, fell on a more +private hour, and found Tembinok' retired in the house with the +favourite, an earthenware spittoon, a leaden inkpot, and a +commercial ledger. In the last, lying on his belly, he writes from +day to day the uneventful history of his reign; and when thus +employed he betrayed a touch of fretfulness on interruption with +which I was well able to sympathise. The royal annalist once read +me a page or so, translating as he went; but the passage being +genealogical, and the author boggling extremely in his version, I +own I have been sometimes better entertained. Nor does he confine +himself to prose, but touches the lyre, too, in his leisure +moments, and passes for the chief bard of his kingdom, as he is its +sole public character, leading architect, and only merchant. + +His competence, however, does not reach to music; and his verses, +when they are ready, are taught to a professional musician, who +sets them and instructs the chorus. Asked what his songs were +about, Tembinok' replied, 'Sweethearts and trees and the sea. Not +all the same true, all the same lie.' For a condensed view of +lyrical poetry (except that he seems to have forgot the stars and +flowers) this would be hard to mend. These multifarious +occupations bespeak (in a native and an absolute prince) unusual +activity of mind. + +The palace court at noon is a spot to be remembered with awe, the +visitor scrambling there, on the loose stones, through a splendid +nightmare of light and heat; but the sweep of the wind delivers it +from flies and mosquitoes; and with the set of sun it became +heavenly. I remember it best on moonless nights. The air was like +a bath of milk. Countless shining stars were overhead, the lagoon +paved with them. Herds of wives squatted by companies on the +gravel, softly chatting. Tembinok' would doff his jacket, and sit +bare and silent, perhaps meditating songs; the favourite usually by +him, silent also. Meanwhile in the midst of the court, the palace +lanterns were being lit and marshalled in rank upon the ground--six +or eight square yards of them; a sight that gave one strange ideas +of the number of 'my pamily': such a sight as may be seen about +dusk in a corner of some great terminus at home. Presently these +fared off into all corners of the precinct, lighting the last +labours of the day, lighting one after another to their rest that +prodigious company of women. A few lingered in the middle of the +court for the card-party, and saw the honours shuffled and dealt, +and Tembinok' deliberating between his two; hands, and the queens +losing their tobacco. Then these also were scattered and +extinguished; and their place was taken by a great bonfire, the +night-light of the palace. When this was no more, smaller fires +burned likewise at the gates. These were tended by the crones, +unseen, unsleeping--not always unheard. Should any approach in the +dark hours, a guarded alert made the circuit of the palisade; each +sentry signalled her neighbour with a stone; the rattle of falling +pebbles passed and died away; and the wardens of Tembinok' crouched +in their places silent as before. + + + +CHAPTER IV--THE KING OF APEMAMA: EQUATOR TOWN AND THE PALACE + + + +Five persons were detailed to wait upon us. Uncle Parker, who +brought us toddy and green nuts, was an elderly, almost an old man, +with the spirits, the industry, and the morals of a boy of ten. +His face was ancient, droll, and diabolical, the skin stretched +over taut sinews, like a sail on the guide-rope; and he smiled with +every muscle of his head. His nuts must be counted every day, or +he would deceive us in the tale; they must be daily examined, or +some would prove to be unhusked; nothing but the king's name, and +scarcely that, would hold him to his duty. After his toils were +over he was given a pipe, matches, and tobacco, and sat on the +floor in the maniap' to smoke. He would not seem to move from his +position, and yet every day, when the things fell to be returned +the plug had disappeared; he had found the means to conceal it in +the roof, whence he could radiantly produce it on the morrow. +Although this piece of legerdemain was performed regularly before +three or four pairs of eyes, we could never catch him in the fact; +although we searched after he was gone, we could never find the +tobacco. Such were the diversions of Uncle Parker, a man nearing +sixty. But he was punished according unto his deeds: Mrs. +Stevenson took a fancy to paint him, and the sufferings of the +sitter were beyond description. + +Three lasses came from the palace to do our washing and racket with +Ah Fu. They were of the lowest class, hangers-on kept for the +convenience of merchant skippers, probably low-born, perhaps out- +islanders, with little refinement whether of manner or appearance, +but likely and jolly enough wenches in their way. We called one +Guttersnipe, for you may find her image in the slums of any city; +the same lean, dark-eyed, eager, vulgar face, the same sudden, +hoarse guffaws, the same forward and yet anxious manner, as with a +tail of an eye on the policeman: only the policeman here was a +live king, and his truncheon a rifle. I doubt if you could find +anywhere out of the islands, or often there, the parallel of Fatty, +a mountain of a girl, who must have weighed near as many stones as +she counted summers, could have given a good account of a life- +guardsman, had the face of a baby, and applied her vast mechanical +forces almost exclusively to play. But they were all three of the +same merry spirit. Our washing was conducted in a game of romps; +and they fled and pursued, and splashed, and pelted, and rolled +each other in the sand, and kept up a continuous noise of cries and +laughter like holiday children. Indeed, and however strange their +own function in that austere establishment, were they not escaped +for the day from the largest and strictest Ladies' School in the +South Seas? + +Our fifth attendant was no less a person than the royal cook. He +was strikingly handsome both in face and body, lazy as a slave, and +insolent as a butcher's boy. He slept and smoked on our premises +in various graceful attitudes; but so far from helping Ah Fu, he +was not at the pains to watch him. It may be said of him that he +came to learn, and remained to teach; and his lessons were at times +difficult to stomach. For example, he was sent to fill a bucket +from the well. About half-way he found my wife watering her +onions, changed buckets with her, and leaving her the empty, +returned to the kitchen with the full. On another occasion he was +given a dish of dumplings for the king, was told they must be eaten +hot, and that he should carry them as fast as possible. The wretch +set off at the rate of about a mile in the hour, head in air, toes +turned out. My patience, after a month of trial, failed me at the +sight. I pursued, caught him by his two big shoulders, and +thrusting him before me, ran with him down the hill, over the +sands, and through the applauding village, to the Speak House, +where the king was then holding a pow-wow. He had the impudence to +pretend he was internally injured by my violence, and to profess +serious apprehensions for his life. + +All this we endured; for the ways of Tembinok' are summary, and I +was not yet ripe to take a hand in the man's death. But in the +meanwhile, here was my unfortunate China boy slaving for the pair, +and presently he fell sick. I was now in the position of Cimondain +Lantenac, and indeed all the characters in Quatre-Vingt-Treize: to +continue to spare the guilty, I must sacrifice the innocent. I +took the usual course and tried to save both, with the usual +consequence of failure. Well rehearsed, I went down to the palace, +found the king alone, and obliged him with a vast amount of +rigmarole. The cook was too old to learn: I feared he was not +making progress; how if we had a boy instead?--boys were more +teachable. It was all in vain; the king pierced through my +disguises to the root of the fact; saw that the cook had +desperately misbehaved; and sat a while glooming. 'I think he +tavvy too much,' he said at last, with grim concision; and +immediately turned the talk to other subjects. The same day +another high officer, the steward, appeared in the cook's place, +and, I am bound to say, proved civil and industrious. + +As soon as I left, it seems the king called for a Winchester and +strolled outside the palisade, awaiting the defaulter. That day +Tembinok' wore the woman's frock; as like as not, his make-up was +completed by a pith helmet and blue spectacles. Conceive the +glaring stretch of sandhills, the dwarf palms with their noon-day +shadows, the line of the palisade, the crone sentries (each by a +small clear fire) cooking syrup on their posts--and this chimaera +waiting with his deadly engine. To him, enter at last the cook, +strolling down the sandhill from Equator Town, listless, vain and +graceful; with no thought of alarm. As soon as he was well within +range, the travestied monarch fired the six shots over his head, at +his feet, and on either hand of him: the second Apemama warning, +startling in itself, fatal in significance, for the next time his +majesty will aim to hit. I am told the king is a crack shot; that +when he aims to kill, the grave may be got ready; and when he aims +to miss, misses by so near a margin that the culprit tastes six +times the bitterness of death. The effect upon the cook I had an +opportunity of seeing for myself. My wife and I were returning +from the sea-side of the island, when we spied one coming to meet +us at a very quick, disordered pace, between a walk and a run. As +we drew nearer we saw it was the cook, beside himself with some +emotion, his usual warm, mulatto colour declined into a bluish +pallor. He passed us without word or gesture, staring on us with +the face of a Satan, and plunged on across the wood for the +unpeopled quarter of the island and the long, desert beach, where +he might rage to and fro unseen, and froth out the vials of his +wrath, fear, and humiliation. Doubtless in the curses that he +there uttered to the bursting surf and the tropic birds, the name +of the Kaupoi--the rich man--was frequently repeated. I had made +him the laughing-stock of the village in the affair of the king's +dumplings; I had brought him by my machinations into disgrace and +the immediate jeopardy of his days; last, and perhaps bitterest, he +had found me there by the way to spy upon him in the hour of his +disorder. + +Time passed, and we saw no more of him. The season of the full +moon came round, when a man thinks shame to lie sleeping; and I +continued until late--perhaps till twelve or one in the morning--to +walk on the bright sand and in the tossing shadow of the palms. I +played, as I wandered, on a flageolet, which occupied much of my +attention; the fans overhead rattled in the wind with a metallic +chatter; and a bare foot falls at any rate almost noiseless on that +shifting soil. Yet when I got back to Equator Town, where all the +lights were out, and my wife (who was still awake, and had been +looking forth) asked me who it was that followed me, I thought she +spoke in jest. 'Not at all,' she said. 'I saw him twice as you +passed, walking close at your heels. He only left you at the +corner of the maniap'; he must be still behind the cook-house.' +Thither I ran--like a fool, without any weapon--and came face to +face with the cook. He was within my tapu-line, which was death in +itself; he could have no business there at such an hour but either +to steal or to kill; guilt made him timorous; and he turned and +fled before me in the night in silence. As he went I kicked him in +that place where honour lies, and he gave tongue faintly like an +injured mouse. At the moment I daresay he supposed it was a deadly +instrument that touched him. + +What had the man been after? I have found my music better +qualified to scatter than to collect an audience. Amateur as I +was, I could not suppose him interested in my reading of the +Carnival of Venice, or that he would deny himself his natural rest +to follow my variations on The Ploughboy. And whatever his design, +it was impossible I should suffer him to prowl by night among the +houses. A word to the king, and the man were not, his case being +far beyond pardon. But it is one thing to kill a man yourself; +quite another to bear tales behind his back and have him shot by a +third party; and I determined to deal with the fellow in some +method of my own. I told Ah Fu the story, and bade him fetch me +the cook whenever he should find him. I had supposed this would be +a matter of difficulty; and far from that, he came of his own +accord: an act really of desperation, since his life hung by my +silence, and the best he could hope was to be forgotten. Yet he +came with an assured countenance, volunteered no apology or +explanation, complained of injuries received, and pretended he was +unable to sit down. I suppose I am the weakest man God made; I had +kicked him in the least vulnerable part of his big carcase; my foot +was bare, and I had not even hurt my foot. Ah Fu could not control +his merriment. On my side, knowing what must be the nature of his +apprehensions, I found in so much impudence a kind of gallantry, +and secretly admired the man. I told him I should say nothing of +his night's adventure to the king; that I should still allow him, +when he had an errand, to come within my tapu-line by day; but if +ever I found him there after the set of the sun I would shoot him +on the spot; and to the proof showed him a revolver. He must have +been incredibly relieved; but he showed no sign of it, took himself +off with his usual dandy nonchalance, and was scarce seen by us +again. + +These five, then, with the substitution of the steward for the +cook, came and went, and were our only visitors. The circle of the +tapu held at arm's-length the inhabitants of the village. As for +'my pamily,' they dwelt like nuns in their enclosure; only once +have I met one of them abroad, and she was the king's sister, and +the place in which I found her (the island infirmary) was very +likely privileged. There remains only the king to be accounted +for. He would come strolling over, always alone, a little before a +meal-time, take a chair, and talk and eat with us like an old +family friend. Gilbertine etiquette appears defective on the point +of leave-taking. It may be remembered we had trouble in the matter +with Karaiti; and there was something childish and disconcerting in +Tembinok's abrupt 'I want go home now,' accompanied by a kind of +ducking rise, and followed by an unadorned retreat. It was the +only blot upon his manners, which were otherwise plain, decent, +sensible, and dignified. He never stayed long nor drank much, and +copied our behaviour where he perceived it to differ from his own. +Very early in the day, for instance, he ceased eating with his +knife. It was plain he was determined in all things to wring +profit from our visit, and chiefly upon etiquette. The quality of +his white visitors puzzled and concerned him; he would bring up +name after name, and ask if its bearer were a 'big chiep,' or even +a 'chiep' at all--which, as some were my excellent good friends, +and none were actually born in the purple, became at times +embarrassing. He was struck to learn that our classes were +distinguishable by their speech, and that certain words (for +instance) were tapu on the quarter-deck of a man-of-war; and he +begged in consequence that we should watch and correct him on the +point. We were able to assure him that he was beyond correction. +His vocabulary is apt and ample to an extraordinary degree. God +knows where he collected it, but by some instinct or some accident +he has avoided all profane or gross expressions. 'Obliged,' +'stabbed,' 'gnaw,' 'lodge,' 'power,' 'company,' 'slender,' +'smooth,' and 'wonderful,' are a few of the unexpected words that +enrich his dialect. Perhaps what pleased him most was to hear +about saluting the quarter-deck of a man-of-war. In his gratitude +for this hint he became fulsome. 'Schooner cap'n no tell me,' he +cried; 'I think no tavvy! You tavvy too much; tavvy 'teama', tavvy +man-a-wa'. I think you tavvy everything.' Yet he gravelled me +often enough with his perpetual questions; and the false Mr. Barlow +stood frequently exposed before the royal Sandford. I remember +once in particular. We were showing the magic-lantern; a slide of +Windsor Castle was put in, and I told him there was the 'outch' of +Victoreea. 'How many pathom he high?' he asked, and I was dumb +before him. It was the builder, the indefatigable architect of +palaces, that spoke; collector though he was, he did not collect +useless information; and all his questions had a purpose. After +etiquette, government, law, the police, money, and medicine were +his chief interests--things vitally important to himself as a king +and the father of his people. It was my part not only to supply +new information, but to correct the old. 'My patha he tell me,' or +'White man he tell me,' would be his constant beginning; 'You think +he lie?' Sometimes I thought he did. Tembinok' once brought me a +difficulty of this kind, which I was long of comprehending. A +schooner captain had told him of Captain Cook; the king was much +interested in the story; and turned for more information--not to +Mr. Stephen's Dictionary, not to the Britannica, but to the Bible +in the Gilbert Island version (which consists chiefly of the New +Testament and the Psalms). Here he sought long and earnestly; Paul +he found, and Festus and Alexander the coppersmith: no word of +Cook. The inference was obvious: the explorer was a myth. So +hard it is, even for a man of great natural parts like Tembinok', +to grasp the ideas of a new society and culture. + + + +CHAPTER V--KING AND COMMONS + + + +We saw but little of the commons of the isle. At first we met them +at the well, where they washed their linen and we drew water for +the table. The combination was distasteful; and, having a tyrant +at command, we applied to the king and had the place enclosed in +our tapu. It was one of the few favours which Tembinok' visibly +boggled about granting, and it may be conceived how little popular +it made the strangers. Many villagers passed us daily going +afield; but they fetched a wide circuit round our tapu, and seemed +to avert their looks. At times we went ourselves into the village- +-a strange place. Dutch by its canals, Oriental by the height and +steepness of the roofs, which looked at dusk like temples; but we +were rarely called into a house: no welcome, no friendship, was +offered us; and of home life we had but the one view: the waking +of a corpse, a frigid, painful scene: the widow holding on her lap +the cold, bluish body of her husband, and now partaking of the +refreshments which made the round of the company, now weeping and +kissing the pale mouth. ('I fear you feel this affliction deeply,' +said the Scottish minister. 'Eh, sir, and that I do!' replied the +widow. 'I've been greetin' a' nicht; an' noo I'm just gaun to sup +this bit parritch, and then I'll begin an' greet again.') In our +walks abroad I have always supposed the islanders avoided us, +perhaps from distaste, perhaps by order; and those whom we met we +took generally by surprise. The surface of the isle is diversified +with palm groves, thickets, and romantic dingles four feet deep, +relics of old taro plantation; and it is thus possible to stumble +unawares on folk resting or hiding from their work. About pistol- +shot from our township there lay a pond in the bottom of a jungle; +here the maids of the isle came to bathe, and were several times +alarmed by our intrusion. Not for them are the bright cold rivers +of Tahiti or Upolu, not for them to splash and laugh in the hour of +the dusk with a villageful of gay companions; but to steal here +solitary, to crouch in a place like a cow-wallow, and wash (if that +can be called washing) in lukewarm mud, brown as their own skins. +Other, but still rare, encounters occur to my memory. I was +several times arrested by a tender sound in the bush of voices +talking, soft as flutes and with quiet intonations. Hope told a +flattering tale; I put aside the leaves; and behold! in place of +the expected dryads, a pair of all too solid ladies squatting over +a clay pipe in the ungraceful ridi. The beauty of the voice and +the eye was all that remained to those vast dames; but that of the +voice was indeed exquisite. It is strange I should have never +heard a more winning sound of speech, yet the dialect should be one +remarkable for violent, ugly, and outlandish vocables; so that +Tembinok' himself declared it made him weary, and professed to find +repose in talking English. + +The state of this folk, of whom I saw so little, I can merely guess +at. The king himself explains the situation with some art. 'No; I +no pay them,' he once said. 'I give them tobacco. They work for +me ALL THE SAME BROTHERS.' It is true there was a brother once in +Arden! But we prefer the shorter word. They bear every servile +mark,--levity like a child's, incurable idleness, incurious +content. The insolence of the cook was a trait of his own; not so +his levity, which he shared with the innocent Uncle Parker. With +equal unconcern both gambolled under the shadow of the gallows, and +took liberties with death that might have surprised a careless +student of man's nature. I wrote of Parker that he behaved like a +boy of ten: what was he else, being a slave of sixty? He had +passed all his years in school, fed, clad, thought for, commanded; +and had grown familiar and coquetted with the fear of punishment. +By terror you may drive men long, but not far. Here, in Apemama, +they work at the constant and the instant peril of their lives; and +are plunged in a kind of lethargy of laziness. It is common to see +one go afield in his stiff mat ungirt, so that he walks elbows-in +like a trussed fowl; and whatsoever his right hand findeth to do, +the other must be off duty holding on his clothes. It is common to +see two men carrying between them on a pole a single bucket of +water. To make two bites of a cherry is good enough: to make two +burthens of a soldier's kit, for a distance of perhaps half a +furlong, passes measure. Woman, being the less childish animal, is +less relaxed by servile conditions. Even in the king's absence, +even when they were alone, I have seen Apemama women work with +constancy. But the outside to be hoped for in a man is that he may +attack his task in little languid fits, and lounge between-whiles. +So I have seen a painter, with his pipe going, and a friend by the +studio fireside. You might suppose the race to lack civility, even +vitality, until you saw them in the dance. Night after night, and +sometimes day after day, they rolled out their choruses in the +great Speak House--solemn andantes and adagios, led by the clapped +hand, and delivered with an energy that shook the roof. The time +was not so slow, though it was slow for the islands; but I have +chosen rather to indicate the effect upon the hearer. Their music +had a church-like character from near at hand, and seemed to +European ears more regular than the run of island music. Twice I +have heard a discord regularly solved. From farther off, heard at +Equator Town for instance, the measures rose and fell and +crepitated like the barking of hounds in a distant kennel. + +The slaves are certainly not overworked--children of ten do more +without fatigue--and the Apemama labourers have holidays, when the +singing begins early in the afternoon. The diet is hard; copra and +a sweetmeat of pounded pandanus are the only dishes I observed +outside the palace; but there seems no defect in quantity, and the +king shares with them his turtles. Three came in a boat from Kuria +during our stay; one was kept for the palace, one sent to us, one +presented to the village. It is the habit of the islanders to cook +the turtle in its carapace; we had been promised the shells, and we +asked a tapu on this foolish practice. The face of Tembinok' +darkened and he answered nothing. Hesitation in the question of +the well I could understand, for water is scarce on a low island; +that he should refuse to interfere upon a point of cookery was more +than I had dreamed of; and I gathered (rightly or wrongly) that he +was scrupulous of touching in the least degree the private life and +habits of his slaves. So that even here, in full despotism, public +opinion has weight; even here, in the midst of slavery, freedom has +a corner. + +Orderly, sober, and innocent, life flows in the isle from day to +day as in a model plantation under a model planter. It is +impossible to doubt the beneficence of that stern rule. A curious +politeness, a soft and gracious manner, something effeminate and +courtly, distinguishes the islanders of Apemama; it is talked of by +all the traders, it was felt even by residents so little beloved as +ourselves, and noticeable even in the cook, and even in that +scoundrel's hours of insolence. The king, with his manly and plain +bearing, stood out alone; you might say he was the only Gilbert +Islander in Apemama. Violence, so common in Butaritari, seems +unknown. So are theft and drunkenness. I am assured the +experiment has been made of leaving sovereigns on the beach before +the village; they lay there untouched. In all our time on the +island I was but once asked for drink. This was by a mighty +plausible fellow, wearing European clothes and speaking excellent +English--Tamaiti his name, or, as the whites have now corrupted it, +'Tom White': one of the king's supercargoes at three pounds a +month and a percentage, a medical man besides, and in his private +hours a wizard. He found me one day in the outskirts of the +village, in a secluded place, hot and private, where the taro-pits +are deep and the plants high. Here he buttonholed me, and, looking +about him like a conspirator, inquired if I had gin. + +I told him I had. He remarked that gin was forbidden, lauded the +prohibition a while, and then went on to explain that he was a +doctor, or 'dogstar' as he pronounced the word, that gin was +necessary to him for his medical infusions, that he was quite out +of it, and that he would be obliged to me for some in a bottle. I +told him I had passed the king my word on landing; but since his +case was so exceptional, I would go down to the palace at once, and +had no doubt that Tembinok' would set me free. Tom White was +immediately overwhelmed with embarrassment and terror, besought me +in the most moving terms not to betray him, and fled my +neighbourhood. He had none of the cook's valour; it was weeks +before he dared to meet my eye; and then only by the order of the +king and on particular business. + +The more I viewed and admired this triumph of firm rule, the more I +was haunted and troubled by a problem, the problem (perhaps) of to- +morrow for ourselves. Here was a people protected from all serious +misfortune, relieved of all serious anxieties, and deprived of what +we call our liberty. Did they like it? and what was their +sentiment toward the ruler? The first question I could not of +course ask, nor perhaps the natives answer. Even the second was +delicate; yet at last, and under charming and strange +circumstances, I found my opportunity to put it and a man to reply. +It was near the full of the moon, with a delicious breeze; the isle +was bright as day--to sleep would have been sacrilege; and I walked +in the bush, playing my pipe. It must have been the sound of what +I am pleased to call my music that attracted in my direction +another wanderer of the night. This was a young man attired in a +fine mat, and with a garland on his hair, for he was new come from +dancing and singing in the public hall; and his body, his face, and +his eyes were all of an enchanting beauty. Every here and there in +the Gilberts youths are to be found of this absurd perfection; I +have seen five of us pass half an hour in admiration of a boy at +Mariki; and Te Kop (my friend in the fine mat and garland) I had +already several times remarked, and long ago set down as the +loveliest animal in Apemama. The philtre of admiration must be +very strong, or these natives specially susceptible to its effects, +for I have scarce ever admired a person in the islands but what he +has sought my particular acquaintance. So it was with Te Kop. He +led me to the ocean side; and for an hour or two we sat smoking and +talking on the resplendent sand and under the ineffable brightness +of the moon. My friend showed himself very sensible of the beauty +and amenity of the hour. 'Good night! Good wind!' he kept +exclaiming, and as he said the words he seemed to hug myself. I +had long before invented such reiterated expressions of delight for +a character (Felipe, in the story of Olalla) intended to be partly +bestial. But there was nothing bestial in Te Kop; only a childish +pleasure in the moment. He was no less pleased with his companion, +or was good enough to say so; honoured me, before he left, by +calling me Te Kop; apostrophised me as 'My name!' with an +intonation exquisitely tender, laying his hand at the same time +swiftly on my knee; and after we had risen, and our paths began to +separate in the bush, twice cried to me with a sort of gentle +ecstasy, 'I like you too much!' From the beginning he had made no +secret of his terror of the king; would not sit down nor speak +above a whisper till he had put the whole breadth of the isle +between himself and his monarch, then harmlessly asleep; and even +there, even within a stone-cast of the outer sea, our talk covered +by the sound of the surf and the rattle of the wind among the +palms, continued to speak guardedly, softening his silver voice +(which rang loud enough in the chorus) and looking about him like a +man in fear of spies. The strange thing is that I should have +beheld him no more. In any other island in the whole South Seas, +if I had advanced half as far with any native, he would have been +at my door next morning, bringing and expecting gifts. But Te Kop +vanished in the bush for ever. My house, of course, was +unapproachable; but he knew where to find me on the ocean beach, +where I went daily. I was the Kaupoi, the rich man; my tobacco and +trade were known to be endless: he was sure of a present. I am at +a loss how to explain his behaviour, unless it be supposed that he +recalled with terror and regret a passage in our interview. Here +it is: + +'The king, he good man?' I asked. + +'Suppose he like you, he good man,' replied Te Kop: 'no like, no +good.' + +That is one way of putting it, of course. Te Kop himself was +probably no favourite, for he scarce appealed to my judgment as a +type of industry. And there must be many others whom the king (to +adhere to the formula) does not like. Do these unfortunates like +the king? Or is not rather the repulsion mutual? and the +conscientious Tembinok', like the conscientious Braxfield before +him, and many other conscientious rulers and judges before either, +surrounded by a considerable body of 'grumbletonians'? Take the +cook, for instance, when he passed us by, blue with rage and +terror. He was very wroth with me; I think by all the old +principles of human nature he was not very well pleased with his +sovereign. It was the rich man he sought to waylay: I think it +must have been by the turn of a hair that it was not the king he +waylaid instead. And the king gives, or seems to give, plenty of +opportunities; day and night he goes abroad alone, whether armed or +not I can but guess; and the taro-patches, where his business must +so often carry him, seem designed for assassination. The case of +the cook was heavy indeed to my conscience. I did not like to kill +my enemy at second-hand; but had I a right to conceal from the +king, who had trusted me, the dangerous secret character of his +attendant? And suppose the king should fall, what would be the +fate of the king's friends? It was our opinion at the time that we +should pay dear for the closing of the well; that our breath was in +the king's nostrils; that if the king should by any chance be +bludgeoned in a taro-patch, the philosophical and musical +inhabitants of Equator Town might lay aside their pleasant +instruments, and betake themselves to what defence they had, with a +very dim prospect of success. These speculations were forced upon +us by an incident which I am ashamed to betray. The schooner H. L. +Haseltine (since capsized at sea, with the loss of eleven lives) +put into Apemama in a good hour for us, who had near exhausted our +supplies. The king, after his habit, spent day after day on board; +the gin proved unhappily to his taste; he brought a store of it +ashore with him; and for some time the sole tyrant of the isle was +half-seas-over. He was not drunk--the man is not a drunkard, he +has always stores of liquor at hand, which he uses with +moderation,--but he was muzzy, dull, and confused. He came one day +to lunch with us, and while the cloth was being laid fell asleep in +his chair. His confusion, when he awoke and found he had been +detected, was equalled by our uneasiness. When he was gone we sat +and spoke of his peril, which we thought to be in some degree our +own; of how easily the man might be surprised in such a state by +grumbletonians; of the strange scenes that would follow--the royal +treasures and stores at the mercy of the rabble, the palace +overrun, the garrison of women turned adrift. And as we talked we +were startled by a gun-shot and a sudden, barbaric outcry. I +believe we all changed colour; but it was only the king firing at a +dog and the chorus striking up in the Speak House. A day or two +later I learned the king was very sick; went down, diagnosed the +case; and took at once the highest medical degree by the exhibition +of bicarbonate of soda. Within the hour Richard was himself again; +and I found him at the unfinished house, enjoying the double +pleasure of directing Rubam and making a dinner of cocoa-nut +dumplings, and all eagerness to have the formula of this new sort +of pain-killer--for pain-killer in the islands is the generic name +of medicine. So ended the king's modest spree and our anxiety. + +On the face of things, I ought to say, loyalty appeared unshaken. +When the schooner at last returned for us, after much experience of +baffling winds, she brought a rumour that Tebureimoa had declared +war on Apemama. Tembinok' became a new man; his face radiant; his +attitude, as I saw him preside over a council of chiefs in one of +the palace maniap's, eager as a boy's; his voice sounding abroad, +shrill and jubilant, over half the compound. War is what he wants, +and here was his chance. The English captain, when he flung his +arms in the lagoon, had forbidden him (except in one case) all +military adventures in the future: here was the case arrived. All +morning the council sat; men were drilled, arms were bought, the +sound of firing disturbed the afternoon; the king devised and +communicated to me his plan of campaign, which was highly elaborate +and ingenious, but perhaps a trifle fine-spun for the rough and +random vicissitudes of war. And in all this bustle the temper of +the people appeared excellent, an unwonted animation in every face, +and even Uncle Parker burning with military zeal. + +Of course it was a false alarm. Tebureimoa had other fish to fry. +The ambassador who accompanied us on our return to Butaritari found +him retired to a small island on the reef, in a huff with the Old +Men, a tiff with the traders, and more fear of insurrection at home +than appetite for wars abroad. The plenipotentiary had been placed +under my protection; and we solemnly saluted when we met. He +proved an excellent fisherman, and caught bonito over the ship's +side. He pulled a good oar, and made himself useful for a whole +fiery afternoon, towing the becalmed Equator off Mariki. He went +to his post and did no good. He returned home again, having done +no harm. O si sic omnes! + + + +CHAPTER VI--THE KING OF APEMAMA: DEVIL-WORK + + + +The ocean beach of Apemama was our daily resort. The coast is +broken by shallow bays. The reef is detached, elevated, and +includes a lagoon about knee-deep, the unrestful spending-basin of +the surf. The beach is now of fine sand, now of broken coral. The +trend of the coast being convex, scarce a quarter of a mile of it +is to be seen at once; the land being so low, the horizon appears +within a stone-cast; and the narrow prospect enhances the sense of +privacy. Man avoids the place--even his footprints are uncommon; +but a great number of birds hover and pipe there fishing, and leave +crooked tracks upon the sand. Apart from these, the only sound +(and I was going to say the only society), is that of the breakers +on the reef. + +On each projection of the coast, the bank of coral clinkers +immediately above the beach has been levelled, and a pillar built, +perhaps breast-high. These are not sepulchral; all the dead being +buried on the inhabited side of the island, close to men's houses, +and (what is worse) to their wells. I was told they were to +protect the isle against inroads from the sea--divine or diabolical +martellos, probably sacred to Taburik, God of Thunder. + +The bay immediately opposite Equator Town, which we called Fu Bay, +in honour of our cook, was thus fortified on either horn. It was +well sheltered by the reef, the enclosed water clear and tranquil, +the enclosing beach curved like a horseshoe, and both steep and +broad. The path debouched about the midst of the re-entrant angle, +the woods stopping some distance inland. In front, between the +fringe of the wood and the crown of the beach, there had been +designed a regular figure, like the court for some new variety of +tennis, with borders of round stones imbedded, and pointed at the +angles with low posts, likewise of stone. This was the king's Pray +Place. When he prayed, what he prayed for, and to whom he +addressed his supplications I could never learn. The ground was +tapu. + +In the angle, by the mouth of the path, stood a deserted maniap'. +Near by there had been a house before our coming, which was now +transported and figured for the moment in Equator Town. It had +been, and it would be again when we departed, the residence of the +guardian and wizard of the spot--Tamaiti. Here, in this lone +place, within sound of the sea, he had his dwelling and uncanny +duties. I cannot call to mind another case of a man living on the +ocean side of any open atoll; and Tamaiti must have had strong +nerves, the greater confidence in his own spells, or, what I +believe to be the truth, an enviable scepticism. Whether Tamaiti +had any guardianship of the Pray Place I never heard. But his own +particular chapel stood farther back in the fringe of the wood. It +was a tree of respectable growth. Around it there was drawn a +circle of stones like those that enclosed the Pray Place; in front, +facing towards the sea, a stone of a much greater size, and +somewhat hollowed, like a piscina, stood close against the trunk; +in front of that again a conical pile of gravel. In the hollow of +what I have called the piscina (though it proved to be a magic +seat) lay an offering of green cocoa-nuts; and when you looked up +you found the boughs of the tree to be laden with strange fruit: +palm-branches elaborately plaited, and beautiful models of canoes, +finished and rigged to the least detail. The whole had the +appearance of a mid-summer and sylvan Christmas-tree al fresco. +Yet we were already well enough acquainted in the Gilberts to +recognise it, at the first sight, for a piece of wizardry, or, as +they say in the group, of Devil-work. + +The plaited palms were what we recognised. We had seen them before +on Apaiang, the most christianised of all these islands; where +excellent Mr. Bingham lived and laboured and has left golden +memories; whence all the education in the northern Gilberts traces +its descent; and where we were boarded by little native Sunday- +school misses in clean frocks, with demure faces, and singing hymns +as to the manner born. + +Our experience of Devil-work at Apaiang had been as follows:- It +chanced we were benighted at the house of Captain Tierney. My wife +and I lodged with a Chinaman some half a mile away; and thither +Captain Reid and a native boy escorted us by torch-light. On the +way the torch went out, and we took shelter in a small and lonely +Christian chapel to rekindle it. Stuck in the rafters of the +chapel was a branch of knotted palm. 'What is that?' I asked. 'O, +that's Devil-work,' said the Captain. 'And what is Devil-work?' I +inquired. 'If you like, I'll show you some when we get to +Johnnie's,' he replied. 'Johnnie's' was a quaint little house upon +the crest of the beach, raised some three feet on posts, approached +by stairs; part walled, part trellised. Trophies of advertisement- +photographs were hung up within for decoration. There was a table +and a recess-bed, in which Mrs. Stevenson slept; while I camped on +the matted floor with Johnnie, Mrs. Johnnie, her sister, and the +devil's own regiment of cockroaches. Hither was summoned an old +witch, who looked the part to horror. The lamp was set on the +floor; the crone squatted on the threshold, a green palm-branch in +her hand, the light striking full on her aged features and picking +out behind her, from the black night, timorous faces of spectators. +Our sorceress began with a chanted incantation; it was in the old +tongue, for which I had no interpreter; but ever and again there +ran among the crowd outside that laugh which every traveller in the +islands learns so soon to recognise,--the laugh of terror. +Doubtless these half-Christian folk were shocked, these half- +heathen folk alarmed. Chench or Taburik thus invoked, we put our +questions; the witch knotted the leaves, here a leaf and there a +leaf, plainly on some arithmetical system; studied the result with +great apparent contention of mind; and gave the answers. Sidney +Colvin was in robust health and gone a journey; and we should have +a fair wind upon the morrow: that was the result of our +consultation, for which we paid a dollar. The next day dawned +cloudless and breathless; but I think Captain Reid placed a secret +reliance on the sibyl, for the schooner was got ready for sea. By +eight the lagoon was flawed with long cat's-paws, and the palms +tossed and rustled; before ten we were clear of the passage and +skimming under all plain sail, with bubbling scuppers. So we had +the breeze, which was well worth a dollar in itself; but the +bulletin about my friend in England proved, some six months later, +when I got my mail, to have been groundless. Perhaps London lies +beyond the horizon of the island gods. + +Tembinok', in his first dealings, showed himself sternly averse +from superstition: and had not the Equator delayed, we might have +left the island and still supposed him an agnostic. It chanced one +day, however, that he came to our maniap', and found Mrs. Stevenson +in the midst of a game of patience. She explained the game as well +as she was able, and wound up jocularly by telling him this was her +devil-work, and if she won, the Equator would arrive next day. +Tembinok' must have drawn a long breath; we were not so high-and- +dry after all; he need no longer dissemble, and he plunged at once +into confessions. He made devil-work every day, he told us, to +know if ships were coming in; and thereafter brought us regular +reports of the results. It was surprising how regularly he was +wrong; but he always had an explanation ready. There had been some +schooner in the offing out of view; but either she was not bound +for Apemama, or had changed her course, or lay becalmed. I used to +regard the king with veneration as he thus publicly deceived +himself. I saw behind him all the fathers of the Church, all the +philosophers and men of science of the past; before him, all those +that are to come; himself in the midst; the whole visionary series +bowed over the same task of welding incongruities. To the end +Tembinok' spoke reluctantly of the island gods and their worship, +and I learned but little. Taburik is the god of thunder, and deals +in wind and weather. A while since there were wizards who could +call him down in the form of lightning. 'My patha he tell me he +see: you think he lie?' Tienti--pronounced something like +'Chench,' and identified by his majesty with the devil--sends and +removes bodily sickness. He is whistled for in the Paumotuan +manner, and is said to appear; but the king has never seen him. +The doctors treat disease by the aid of Chench: eclectic Tembinok' +at the same time administering 'pain-killer' from his medicine- +chest, so as to give the sufferer both chances. 'I think mo' +betta,' observed his majesty, with more than his usual self- +approval. Apparently the gods are not jealous, and placidly enjoy +both shrine and priest in common. On Tamaiti's medicine-tree, for +instance, the model canoes are hung up ex voto for a prosperous +voyage, and must therefore be dedicated to Taburik, god of the +weather; but the stone in front is the place of sick folk come to +pacify Chench. + +It chanced, by great good luck, that even as we spoke of these +affairs, I found myself threatened with a cold. I do not suppose I +was ever glad of a cold before, or shall ever be again; but the +opportunity to see the sorcerers at work was priceless, and I +called in the faculty of Apemama. They came in a body, all in +their Sunday's best and hung with wreaths and shells, the insignia +of the devil-worker. Tamaiti I knew already: Terutak' I saw for +the first time--a tall, lank, raw-boned, serious North-Sea +fisherman turned brown; and there was a third in their company +whose name I never heard, and who played to Tamaiti the part of +famulus. Tamaiti took me in hand first, and led me, conversing +agreeably, to the shores of Fu Bay. The famulus climbed a tree for +some green cocoa-nuts. Tamaiti himself disappeared a while in the +bush and returned with coco tinder, dry leaves, and a spray of +waxberry. I was placed on the stone, with my back to the tree and +my face to windward; between me and the gravel-heap one of the +green nuts was set; and then Tamaiti (having previously bared his +feet, for he had come in canvas shoes, which tortured him) joined +me within the magic circle, hollowed out the top of the gravel- +heap, built his fire in the bottom, and applied a match: it was +one of Bryant and May's. The flame was slow to catch, and the +irreverent sorcerer filled in the time with talk of foreign places- +-of London, and 'companies,' and how much money they had; of San +Francisco, and the nefarious fogs, 'all the same smoke,' which had +been so nearly the occasion of his death. I tried vainly to lead +him to the matter in hand. 'Everybody make medicine,' he said +lightly. And when I asked him if he were himself a good +practitioner--'No savvy,' he replied, more lightly still. At +length the leaves burst in a flame, which he continued to feed; a +thick, light smoke blew in my face, and the flames streamed against +and scorched my clothes. He in the meanwhile addressed, or +affected to address, the evil spirit, his lips moving fast, but +without sound; at the same time he waved in the air and twice +struck me on the breast with his green spray. So soon as the +leaves were consumed the ashes were buried, the green spray was +imbedded in the gravel, and the ceremony was at an end. + +A reader of the Arabian Nights felt quite at home. Here was the +suffumigation; here was the muttering wizard; here was the desert +place to which Aladdin was decoyed by the false uncle. But they +manage these things better in fiction. The effect was marred by +the levity of the magician, entertaining his patient with small +talk like an affable dentist, and by the incongruous presence of +Mr. Osbourne with a camera. As for my cold, it was neither better +nor worse. + +I was now handed over to Terutak', the leading practitioner or +medical baronet of Apemama. His place is on the lagoon side of the +island, hard by the palace. A rail of light wood, some two feet +high, encloses an oblong piece of gravel like the king's Pray +Place; in the midst is a green tree; below, a stone table bears a +pair of boxes covered with a fine mat; and in front of these an +offering of food, a cocoa-nut, a piece of taro or a fish, is placed +daily. On two sides the enclosure is lined with maniap's; and one +of our party, who had been there to sketch, had remarked a daily +concourse of people and an extraordinary number of sick children; +for this is in fact the infirmary of Apemama. The doctor and +myself entered the sacred place alone; the boxes and the mat were +displaced; and I was enthroned in their stead upon the stone, +facing once more to the east. For a while the sorcerer remained +unseen behind me, making passes in the air with a branch of palm. +Then he struck lightly on the brim of my straw hat; and this blow +he continued to repeat at intervals, sometimes brushing instead my +arm and shoulder. I have had people try to mesmerise me a dozen +times, and never with the least result. But at the first tap--on a +quarter no more vital than my hat-brim, and from nothing more +virtuous than a switch of palm wielded by a man I could not even +see--sleep rushed upon me like an armed man. My sinews fainted, my +eyes closed, my brain hummed, with drowsiness. I resisted, at +first instinctively, then with a certain flurry of despair, in the +end successfully; if that were indeed success which enabled me to +scramble to my feet, to stumble home somnambulous, to cast myself +at once upon my bed, and sink at once into a dreamless stupor. +When I awoke my cold was gone. So I leave a matter that I do not +understand. + +Meanwhile my appetite for curiosities (not usually very keen) had +been strangely whetted by the sacred boxes. They were of pandanus +wood, oblong in shape, with an effect of pillaring along the sides +like straw work, lightly fringed with hair or fibre and standing on +four legs. The outside was neat as a toy; the inside a mystery I +was resolved to penetrate. But there was a lion in the path. I +might not approach Terutak', since I had promised to buy nothing in +the island; I dared not have recourse to the king, for I had +already received from him more gifts than I knew how to repay. In +this dilemma (the schooner being at last returned) we hit on a +device. Captain Reid came forward in my stead, professed an +unbridled passion for the boxes, and asked and obtained leave to +bargain for them with the wizard. That same afternoon the captain +and I made haste to the infirmary, entered the enclosure, raised +the mat, and had begun to examine the boxes at our leisure, when +Terutak's wife bounced out of one of the nigh houses, fell upon us, +swept up the treasures, and was gone. There was never a more +absolute surprise. She came, she took, she vanished, we had not a +guess whither; and we remained, with foolish looks and laughter on +the empty field. Such was the fit prologue of our memorable +bargaining. + +Presently Terutak' came, bringing Tamaiti along with him, both +smiling; and we four squatted without the rail. In the three +maniap's of the infirmary a certain audience was gathered: the +family of a sick child under treatment, the king's sister playing +cards, a pretty girl, who swore I was the image of her father; in +all perhaps a score. Terutak's wife had returned (even as she had +vanished) unseen, and now sat, breathless and watchful, by her +husband's side. Perhaps some rumour of our quest had gone abroad, +or perhaps we had given the alert by our unseemly freedom: +certain, at least, that in the faces of all present, expectation +and alarm were mingled. + +Captain Reid announced, without preface or disguise, that I was +come to purchase; Terutak', with sudden gravity, refused to sell. +He was pressed; he persisted. It was explained we only wanted one: +no matter, two were necessary for the healing of the sick. He was +rallied, he was reasoned with: in vain. He sat there, serious and +still, and refused. All this was only a preliminary skirmish; +hitherto no sum of money had been mentioned; but now the captain +brought his great guns to bear. He named a pound, then two, then +three. Out of the maniap's one person after another came to join +the group, some with mere excitement, others with consternation in +their faces. The pretty girl crept to my side; it was then that-- +surely with the most artless flattery--she informed me of my +likeness to her father. Tamaiti the infidel sat with hanging head +and every mark of dejection. Terutak' streamed with sweat, his eye +was glazed, his face wore a painful rictus, his chest heaved like +that of one spent with running. The man must have been by nature +covetous; and I doubt if ever I saw moral agony more tragically +displayed. His wife by his side passionately encouraged his +resistance. + +And now came the charge of the old guard. The captain, making a +skip, named the surprising figure of five pounds. At the word the +maniap's were emptied. The king's sister flung down her cards and +came to the front to listen, a cloud on her brow. The pretty girl +beat her breast and cried with wearisome iteration that if the box +were hers I should have it. Terutak's wife was beside herself with +pious fear, her face discomposed, her voice (which scarce ceased +from warning and encouragement) shrill as a whistle. Even Terutak' +lost that image-like immobility which he had hitherto maintained. +He rocked on his mat, threw up his closed knees alternately, and +struck himself on the breast after the manner of dancers. But he +came gold out of the furnace; and with what voice was left him +continued to reject the bribe. + +And now came a timely interjection. 'Money will not heal the +sick,' observed the king's sister sententiously; and as soon as I +heard the remark translated my eyes were unsealed, and I began to +blush for my employment. Here was a sick child, and I sought, in +the view of its parents, to remove the medicine-box. Here was the +priest of a religion, and I (a heathen millionaire) was corrupting +him to sacrilege. Here was a greedy man, torn in twain betwixt +greed and conscience; and I sat by and relished, and lustfully +renewed his torments. Ave, Caesar! Smothered in a corner, dormant +but not dead, we have all the one touch of nature: an infant +passion for the sand and blood of the arena. So I brought to an +end my first and last experience of the joys of the millionaire, +and departed amid silent awe. Nowhere else can I expect to stir +the depths of human nature by an offer of five pounds; nowhere +else, even at the expense of millions, could I hope to see the evil +of riches stand so legibly exposed. Of all the bystanders, none +but the king's sister retained any memory of the gravity and danger +of the thing in hand. Their eyes glowed, the girl beat her breast, +in senseless animal excitement. Nothing was offered them; they +stood neither to gain nor to lose; at the mere name and wind of +these great sums Satan possessed them. + +From this singular interview I went straight to the palace; found +the king; confessed what I had been doing; begged him, in my name, +to compliment Terutak' on his virtue, and to have a similar box +made for me against the return of the schooner. Tembinok', Rubam, +and one of the Daily Papers--him we used to call 'the Facetiae +Column'--laboured for a while of some idea, which was at last +intelligibly delivered. They feared I thought the box would cure +me; whereas, without the wizard, it was useless; and when I was +threatened with another cold I should do better to rely on pain- +killer. I explained I merely wished to keep it in my 'outch' as a +thing made in Apemama and these honest men were much relieved. + +Late the same evening, my wife, crossing the isle to windward, was +aware of singing in the bush. Nothing is more common in that hour +and place than the jubilant carol of the toddy-cutter, swinging +high overhead, beholding below him the narrow ribbon of the isle, +the surrounding field of ocean, and the fires of the sunset. But +this was of a graver character, and seemed to proceed from the +ground-level. Advancing a little in the thicket, Mrs. Stevenson +saw a clear space, a fine mat spread in the midst, and on the mat a +wreath of white flowers and one of the devil-work boxes. A woman-- +whom we guess to have been Mrs. Terutak'--sat in front, now +drooping over the box like a mother over a cradle, now lifting her +face and directing her song to heaven. A passing toddy-cutter told +my wife that she was praying. Probably she did not so much pray as +deprecate; and perhaps even the ceremony was one of disenchantment. +For the box was already doomed; it was to pass from its green +medicine-tree, reverend precinct, and devout attendants; to be +handled by the profane; to cross three seas; to come to land under +the foolscap of St. Paul's; to be domesticated within the hail of +Lillie Bridge; there to be dusted by the British housemaid, and to +take perhaps the roar of London for the voice of the outer sea +along the reef. Before even we had finished dinner Chench had +begun his journey, and one of the newspapers had already placed the +box upon my table as the gift of Tembinok'. + +I made haste to the palace, thanked the king, but offered to +restore the box, for I could not bear that the sick of the island +should be made to suffer. I was amazed by his reply. Terutak', it +appeared, had still three or four in reserve against an accident; +and his reluctance, and the dread painted at first on every face, +was not in the least occasioned by the prospect of medical +destitution, but by the immediate divinity of Chench. How much +more did I respect the king's command, which had been able to +extort in a moment and for nothing a sacrilegious favour that I had +in vain solicited with millions! But now I had a difficult task in +front of me; it was not in my view that Terutak' should suffer by +his virtue; and I must persuade the king to share my opinion, to +let me enrich one of his subjects, and (what was yet more delicate) +to pay for my present. Nothing shows the king in a more becoming +light than the fact that I succeeded. He demurred at the +principle; he exclaimed, when he heard it, at the sum. 'Plenty +money!' cried he, with contemptuous displeasure. But his +resistance was never serious; and when he had blown off his ill- +humour--'A' right,' said he. 'You give him. Mo' betta.' + +Armed with this permission, I made straight for the infirmary. The +night was now come, cool, dark, and starry. On a mat hard by a +clear fire of wood and coco shell, Terutak' lay beside his wife. +Both were smiling; the agony was over, the king's command had +reconciled (I must suppose) their agitating scruples; and I was +bidden to sit by them and share the circulating pipe. I was a +little moved myself when I placed five gold sovereigns in the +wizard's hand; but there was no sign of emotion in Terutak' as he +returned them, pointed to the palace, and named Tembinok'. It was +a changed scene when I had managed to explain. Terutak', long, +dour Scots fisherman as he was, expressed his satisfaction within +bounds; but the wife beamed; and there was an old gentleman +present--her father, I suppose--who seemed nigh translated. His +eyes stood out of his head; 'Kaupoi, Kaupoi--rich, rich!' ran on +his lips like a refrain; and he could not meet my eye but what he +gurgled into foolish laughter. + +I might now go home, leaving that fire-lit family party gloating +over their new millions, and consider my strange day. I had tried +and rewarded the virtue of Terutak'. I had played the millionaire, +had behaved abominably, and then in some degree repaired my +thoughtlessness. And now I had my box, and could open it and look +within. It contained a miniature sleeping-mat and a white shell. +Tamaiti, interrogated next day as to the shell, explained it was +not exactly Chench, but a cell, or body, which he would at times +inhabit. Asked why there was a sleeping-mat, he retorted +indignantly, 'Why have you mats?' And this was the sceptical +Tamaiti! But island scepticism is never deeper than the lips. + + + +CHAPTER VII--THE KING OF APEMAMA + + + +Thus all things on the island, even the priests of the gods, obey +the word of Tembinok'. He can give and take, and slay, and allay +the scruples of the conscientious, and do all things (apparently) +but interfere in the cookery of a turtle. 'I got power' is his +favourite word; it interlards his conversation; the thought haunts +him and is ever fresh; and when be has asked and meditates of +foreign countries, he looks up with a smile and reminds you, '_I_ +got POWER.' Nor is his delight only in the possession, but in the +exercise. He rejoices in the crooked and violent paths of kingship +like a strong man to run a race, or like an artist in his art. To +feel, to use his power, to embellish his island and the picture of +the island life after a private ideal, to milk the island +vigorously, to extend his singular museum--these employ +delightfully the sum of his abilities. I never saw a man more +patently in the right trade. + +It would be natural to suppose this monarchy inherited intact +through generations. And so far from that, it is a thing of +yesterday. I was already a boy at school while Apemama was yet +republican, ruled by a noisy council of Old Men, and torn with +incurable feuds. And Tembinok' is no Bourbon; rather the son of a +Napoleon. Of course he is well-born. No man need aspire high in +the isles of the Pacific unless his pedigree be long and in the +upper regions mythical. And our king counts cousinship with most +of the high families in the archipelago, and traces his descent to +a shark and a heroic woman. Directed by an oracle, she swam beyond +sight of land to meet her revolting paramour, and received at sea +the seed of a predestined family. 'I think lie,' is the king's +emphatic commentary; yet he is proud of the legend. From this +illustrious beginning the fortunes of the race must have declined; +and Tenkoruti, the grandfather of Tembinok', was the chief of a +village at the north end of the island. Kuria and Aranuka were yet +independent; Apemama itself the arena of devastating feuds. +Through this perturbed period of history the figure of Tenkoruti +stalks memorable. In war he was swift and bloody; several towns +fell to his spear, and the inhabitants were butchered to a man. In +civil life this arrogance was unheard of. When the council of Old +Men was summoned, he went to the Speak House, delivered his mind, +and left without waiting to be answered. Wisdom had spoken: let +others opine according to their folly. He was feared and hated, +and this was his pleasure. He was no poet; he cared not for arts +or knowledge. 'My gran'patha one thing savvy, savvy pight,' +observed the king. In some lull of their own disputes the Old Men +of Apemama adventured on the conquest of Apemama; and this unlicked +Caius Marcius was elected general of the united troops. Success +attended him; the islands were reduced, and Tenkoruti returned to +his own government, glorious and detested. He died about 1860, in +the seventieth year of his age and the full odour of unpopularity. +He was tall and lean, says his grandson, looked extremely old, and +'walked all the same young man.' The same observer gave me a +significant detail. The survivors of that rough epoch were all +defaced with spearmarks; there was none on the body of this skilful +fighter. 'I see old man, no got a spear,' said the king. + +Tenkoruti left two sons, Tembaitake and Tembinatake. Tembaitake, +our king's father, was short, middling stout, a poet, a good +genealogist, and something of a fighter; it seems he took himself +seriously, and was perhaps scarce conscious that he was in all +things the creature and nursling of his brother. There was no +shadow of dispute between the pair: the greater man filled with +alacrity and content the second place; held the breach in war, and +all the portfolios in the time of peace; and, when his brother +rated him, listened in silence, looking on the ground. Like +Tenkoruti, he was tall and lean and a swift talker--a rare trait in +the islands. He possessed every accomplishment. He knew sorcery, +he was the best genealogist of his day, he was a poet, he could +dance and make canoes and armour; and the famous mast of Apemama, +which ran one joint higher than the mainmast of a full-rigged ship, +was of his conception and design. But these were avocations, and +the man's trade was war. 'When my uncle go make wa', he laugh,' +said Tembinok'. He forbade the use of field fortification, that +protractor of native hostilities; his men must fight in the open, +and win or be beaten out of hand; his own activity inspired his +followers; and the swiftness of his blows beat down, in one +lifetime, the resistance of three islands. He made his brother +sovereign, he left his nephew absolute. 'My uncle make all +smooth,' said Tembinok'. 'I mo' king than my patha: I got power,' +he said, with formidable relish. + +Such is the portrait of the uncle drawn by the nephew. I can set +beside it another by a different artist, who has often--I may say +always--delighted me with his romantic taste in narrative, but not +always--and I may say not often--persuaded me of his exactitude. I +have already denied myself the use of so much excellent matter from +the same source, that I begin to think it time to reward good +resolution; and his account of Tembinatake agrees so well with the +king's, that it may very well be (what I hope it is) the record of +a fact, and not (what I suspect) the pleasing exercise of an +imagination more than sailorly. A., for so I had perhaps better +call him, was walking up the island after dusk, when he came on a +lighted village of some size, was directed to the chief's house, +and asked leave to rest and smoke a pipe. 'You will sit down, and +smoke a pipe, and wash, and eat, and sleep,' replied the chief, +'and to-morrow you will go again.' Food was brought, prayers were +held (for this was in the brief day of Christianity), and the chief +himself prayed with eloquence and seeming sincerity. All evening +A. sat and admired the man by the firelight. He was six feet high, +lean, with the appearance of many years, and an extraordinary air +of breeding and command. 'He looked like a man who would kill you +laughing,' said A., in singular echo of one of the king's +expressions. And again: 'I had been reading the Musketeer books, +and he reminded me of Aramis.' Such is the portrait of +Tembinatake, drawn by an expert romancer. + +We had heard many tales of 'my patha'; never a word of my uncle +till two days before we left. As the time approached for our +departure Tembinok' became greatly changed; a softer, a more +melancholy, and, in particular, a more confidential man appeared in +his stead. To my wife he contrived laboriously to explain that +though he knew he must lose his father in the course of nature, he +had not minded nor realised it till the moment came; and that now +he was to lose us he repeated the experience. We showed fireworks +one evening on the terrace. It was a heavy business; the sense of +separation was in all our minds, and the talk languished. The king +was specially affected, sat disconsolate on his mat, and often +sighed. Of a sudden one of the wives stepped forth from a cluster, +came and kissed him in silence, and silently went again. It was +just such a caress as we might give to a disconsolate child, and +the king received it with a child's simplicity. Presently after we +said good-night and withdrew; but Tembinok' detained Mr. Osbourne, +patting the mat by his side and saying: 'Sit down. I feel bad, I +like talk.' Osbourne sat down by him. 'You like some beer?' said +he; and one of the wives produced a bottle. The king did not +partake, but sat sighing and smoking a meerschaum pipe. 'I very +sorry you go,' he said at last. 'Miss Stlevens he good man, woman +he good man, boy he good man; all good man. Woman he smart all the +same man. My woman' (glancing towards his wives) 'he good woman, +no very smart. I think Miss Stlevens he is chiep all the same +cap'n man-o-wa'. I think Miss Stlevens he rich man all the same +me. All go schoona. I very sorry. My patha he go, my uncle he +go, my cutcheons he go, Miss Stlevens he go: all go. You no see +king cry before. King all the same man: feel bad, he cry. I very +sorry.' + +In the morning it was the common topic in the village that the king +had wept. To me he said: 'Last night I no can 'peak: too much +here,' laying his hand upon his bosom. 'Now you go away all the +same my pamily. My brothers, my uncle go away. All the same.' +This was said with a dejection almost passionate. And it was the +first time I had heard him name his uncle, or indeed employ the +word. The same day he sent me a present of two corselets, made in +the island fashion of plaited fibre, heavy and strong. One had +been worn by Tenkoruti, one by Tembaitake; and the gift being +gratefully received, he sent me, on the return of his messengers, a +third--that of Tembinatake. My curiosity was roused; I begged for +information as to the three wearers; and the king entered with +gusto into the details already given. Here was a strange thing, +that he should have talked so much of his family, and not once +mentioned that relative of whom he was plainly the most proud. +Nay, more: he had hitherto boasted of his father; thenceforth he +had little to say of him; and the qualities for which he had +praised him in the past were now attributed where they were due,-- +to the uncle. A confusion might be natural enough among islanders, +who call all the sons of their grandfather by the common name of +father. But this was not the case with Tembinok'. Now the ice was +broken the word uncle was perpetually in his mouth; he who had been +so ready to confound was now careful to distinguish; and the father +sank gradually into a self-complacent ordinary man, while the uncle +rose to his true stature as the hero and founder of the race. + +The more I heard and the more I considered, the more this mystery +of Tembinok's behaviour puzzled and attracted me. And the +explanation, when it came, was one to strike the imagination of a +dramatist. Tembinok' had two brothers. One, detected in private +trading, was banished, then forgiven, lives to this day in the +island, and is the father of the heir-apparent, Paul. The other +fell beyond forgiveness. I have heard it was a love-affair with +one of the king's wives, and the thing is highly possible in that +romantic archipelago. War was attempted to be levied; but +Tembinok' was too swift for the rebels, and the guilty brother +escaped in a canoe. He did not go alone. Tembinatake had a hand +in the rebellion, and the man who had gained a kingdom for a +weakling brother was banished by that brother's son. The fugitives +came to shore in other islands, but Tembinok' remains to this day +ignorant of their fate. + +So far history. And now a moment for conjecture. Tembinok' +confused habitually, not only the attributes and merits of his +father and his uncle, but their diverse personal appearance. +Before he had even spoken, or thought to speak, of Tembinatake, he +had told me often of a tall, lean father, skilled in war, and his +own schoolmaster in genealogy and island arts. How if both were +fathers, one natural, one adoptive? How if the heir of Tembaitake, +like the heir of Tembinok' himself, were not a son, but an adopted +nephew? How if the founder of the monarchy, while he worked for +his brother, worked at the same time for the child of his loins? +How if on the death of Tembaitake, the two stronger natures, father +and son, king and kingmaker, clashed, and Tembinok', when he drove +out his uncle, drove out the author of his days? Here is at least +a tragedy four-square. + +The king took us on board in his own gig, dressed for the occasion +in the naval uniform. He had little to say, he refused +refreshments, shook us briefly by the hand, and went ashore again. +That night the palm-tops of Apemama had dipped behind the sea, and +the schooner sailed solitary under the stars. + + + + + +*** END OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK, IN THE SOUTH SEAS *** + +This file should be named sseas10.txt or sseas10.zip +Corrected EDITIONS of our eBooks get a new NUMBER, sseas11.txt +VERSIONS based on separate sources get new LETTER, sseas10a.txt + +Project Gutenberg eBooks are often created from several printed +editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the US +unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we usually do not +keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition. + +We are now trying to release all our eBooks one year in advance +of the official release dates, leaving time for better editing. +Please be encouraged to tell us about any error or corrections, +even years after the official publication date. + +Please note neither this listing nor its contents are final til +midnight of the last day of the month of any such announcement. +The official release date of all Project Gutenberg eBooks is at +Midnight, Central Time, of the last day of the stated month. A +preliminary version may often be posted for suggestion, comment +and editing by those who wish to do so. + +Most people start at our Web sites at: +http://gutenberg.net or +http://promo.net/pg + +These Web sites include award-winning information about Project +Gutenberg, including how to donate, how to help produce our new +eBooks, and how to subscribe to our email newsletter (free!). + + +Those of you who want to download any eBook before announcement +can get to them as follows, and just download by date. This is +also a good way to get them instantly upon announcement, as the +indexes our cataloguers produce obviously take a while after an +announcement goes out in the Project Gutenberg Newsletter. + +http://www.ibiblio.org/gutenberg/etext04 or +ftp://ftp.ibiblio.org/pub/docs/books/gutenberg/etext04 + +Or /etext03, 02, 01, 00, 99, 98, 97, 96, 95, 94, 93, 92, 92, 91 or 90 + +Just search by the first five letters of the filename you want, +as it appears in our Newsletters. + + +Information about Project Gutenberg (one page) + +We produce about two million dollars for each hour we work. The +time it takes us, a rather conservative estimate, is fifty hours +to get any eBook selected, entered, proofread, edited, copyright +searched and analyzed, the copyright letters written, etc. Our +projected audience is one hundred million readers. If the value +per text is nominally estimated at one dollar then we produce $2 +million dollars per hour in 2002 as we release over 100 new text +files per month: 1240 more eBooks in 2001 for a total of 4000+ +We are already on our way to trying for 2000 more eBooks in 2002 +If they reach just 1-2% of the world's population then the total +will reach over half a trillion eBooks given away by year's end. + +The Goal of Project Gutenberg is to Give Away 1 Trillion eBooks! +This is ten thousand titles each to one hundred million readers, +which is only about 4% of the present number of computer users. + +Here is the briefest record of our progress (* means estimated): + +eBooks Year Month + + 1 1971 July + 10 1991 January + 100 1994 January + 1000 1997 August + 1500 1998 October + 2000 1999 December + 2500 2000 December + 3000 2001 November + 4000 2001 October/November + 6000 2002 December* + 9000 2003 November* +10000 2004 January* + + +The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation has been created +to secure a future for Project Gutenberg into the next millennium. + +We need your donations more than ever! + +As of February, 2002, contributions are being solicited from people +and organizations in: Alabama, Alaska, Arkansas, Connecticut, +Delaware, District of Columbia, Florida, Georgia, Hawaii, Illinois, +Indiana, Iowa, Kansas, Kentucky, Louisiana, Maine, Massachusetts, +Michigan, Mississippi, Missouri, Montana, Nebraska, Nevada, New +Hampshire, New Jersey, New Mexico, New York, North Carolina, Ohio, +Oklahoma, Oregon, Pennsylvania, Rhode Island, South Carolina, South +Dakota, Tennessee, Texas, Utah, Vermont, Virginia, Washington, West +Virginia, Wisconsin, and Wyoming. + +We have filed in all 50 states now, but these are the only ones +that have responded. + +As the requirements for other states are met, additions to this list +will be made and fund raising will begin in the additional states. +Please feel free to ask to check the status of your state. + +In answer to various questions we have received on this: + +We are constantly working on finishing the paperwork to legally +request donations in all 50 states. If your state is not listed and +you would like to know if we have added it since the list you have, +just ask. + +While we cannot solicit donations from people in states where we are +not yet registered, we know of no prohibition against accepting +donations from donors in these states who approach us with an offer to +donate. + +International donations are accepted, but we don't know ANYTHING about +how to make them tax-deductible, or even if they CAN be made +deductible, and don't have the staff to handle it even if there are +ways. + +Donations by check or money order may be sent to: + +Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation +PMB 113 +1739 University Ave. +Oxford, MS 38655-4109 + +Contact us if you want to arrange for a wire transfer or payment +method other than by check or money order. + +The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation has been approved by +the US Internal Revenue Service as a 501(c)(3) organization with EIN +[Employee Identification Number] 64-622154. Donations are +tax-deductible to the maximum extent permitted by law. As fund-raising +requirements for other states are met, additions to this list will be +made and fund-raising will begin in the additional states. + +We need your donations more than ever! + +You can get up to date donation information online at: + +http://www.gutenberg.net/donation.html + + +*** + +If you can't reach Project Gutenberg, +you can always email directly to: + +Michael S. Hart <hart@pobox.com> + +Prof. Hart will answer or forward your message. + +We would prefer to send you information by email. + + +**The Legal Small Print** + + +(Three Pages) + +***START**THE SMALL PRINT!**FOR PUBLIC DOMAIN EBOOKS**START*** +Why is this "Small Print!" statement here? You know: lawyers. +They tell us you might sue us if there is something wrong with +your copy of this eBook, even if you got it for free from +someone other than us, and even if what's wrong is not our +fault. So, among other things, this "Small Print!" statement +disclaims most of our liability to you. It also tells you how +you may distribute copies of this eBook if you want to. + +*BEFORE!* YOU USE OR READ THIS EBOOK +By using or reading any part of this PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm +eBook, you indicate that you understand, agree to and accept +this "Small Print!" statement. If you do not, you can receive +a refund of the money (if any) you paid for this eBook by +sending a request within 30 days of receiving it to the person +you got it from. If you received this eBook on a physical +medium (such as a disk), you must return it with your request. + +ABOUT PROJECT GUTENBERG-TM EBOOKS +This PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm eBook, like most PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm eBooks, +is a "public domain" work distributed by Professor Michael S. Hart +through the Project Gutenberg Association (the "Project"). +Among other things, this means that no one owns a United States copyright +on or for this work, so the Project (and you!) can copy and +distribute it in the United States without permission and +without paying copyright royalties. Special rules, set forth +below, apply if you wish to copy and distribute this eBook +under the "PROJECT GUTENBERG" trademark. + +Please do not use the "PROJECT GUTENBERG" trademark to market +any commercial products without permission. + +To create these eBooks, the Project expends considerable +efforts to identify, transcribe and proofread public domain +works. Despite these efforts, the Project's eBooks and any +medium they may be on may contain "Defects". Among other +things, Defects may take the form of incomplete, inaccurate or +corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other +intellectual property infringement, a defective or damaged +disk or other eBook medium, a computer virus, or computer +codes that damage or cannot be read by your equipment. + +LIMITED WARRANTY; DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES +But for the "Right of Replacement or Refund" described below, +[1] Michael Hart and the Foundation (and any other party you may +receive this eBook from as a PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm eBook) disclaims +all liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including +legal fees, and [2] YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE OR +UNDER STRICT LIABILITY, OR FOR BREACH OF WARRANTY OR CONTRACT, +INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE +OR INCIDENTAL DAMAGES, EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE +POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES. + +If you discover a Defect in this eBook within 90 days of +receiving it, you can receive a refund of the money (if any) +you paid for it by sending an explanatory note within that +time to the person you received it from. If you received it +on a physical medium, you must return it with your note, and +such person may choose to alternatively give you a replacement +copy. If you received it electronically, such person may +choose to alternatively give you a second opportunity to +receive it electronically. + +THIS EBOOK IS OTHERWISE PROVIDED TO YOU "AS-IS". NO OTHER +WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, ARE MADE TO YOU AS +TO THE EBOOK OR ANY MEDIUM IT MAY BE ON, INCLUDING BUT NOT +LIMITED TO WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A +PARTICULAR PURPOSE. + +Some states do not allow disclaimers of implied warranties or +the exclusion or limitation of consequential damages, so the +above disclaimers and exclusions may not apply to you, and you +may have other legal rights. + +INDEMNITY +You will indemnify and hold Michael Hart, the Foundation, +and its trustees and agents, and any volunteers associated +with the production and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm +texts harmless, from all liability, cost and expense, including +legal fees, that arise directly or indirectly from any of the +following that you do or cause: [1] distribution of this eBook, +[2] alteration, modification, or addition to the eBook, +or [3] any Defect. + +DISTRIBUTION UNDER "PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm" +You may distribute copies of this eBook electronically, or by +disk, book or any other medium if you either delete this +"Small Print!" and all other references to Project Gutenberg, +or: + +[1] Only give exact copies of it. Among other things, this + requires that you do not remove, alter or modify the + eBook or this "small print!" statement. You may however, + if you wish, distribute this eBook in machine readable + binary, compressed, mark-up, or proprietary form, + including any form resulting from conversion by word + processing or hypertext software, but only so long as + *EITHER*: + + [*] The eBook, when displayed, is clearly readable, and + does *not* contain characters other than those + intended by the author of the work, although tilde + (~), asterisk (*) and underline (_) characters may + be used to convey punctuation intended by the + author, and additional characters may be used to + indicate hypertext links; OR + + [*] The eBook may be readily converted by the reader at + no expense into plain ASCII, EBCDIC or equivalent + form by the program that displays the eBook (as is + the case, for instance, with most word processors); + OR + + [*] You provide, or agree to also provide on request at + no additional cost, fee or expense, a copy of the + eBook in its original plain ASCII form (or in EBCDIC + or other equivalent proprietary form). + +[2] Honor the eBook refund and replacement provisions of this + "Small Print!" statement. + +[3] Pay a trademark license fee to the Foundation of 20% of the + gross profits you derive calculated using the method you + already use to calculate your applicable taxes. If you + don't derive profits, no royalty is due. Royalties are + payable to "Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation" + the 60 days following each date you prepare (or were + legally required to prepare) your annual (or equivalent + periodic) tax return. Please contact us beforehand to + let us know your plans and to work out the details. + +WHAT IF YOU *WANT* TO SEND MONEY EVEN IF YOU DON'T HAVE TO? +Project Gutenberg is dedicated to increasing the number of +public domain and licensed works that can be freely distributed +in machine readable form. + +The Project gratefully accepts contributions of money, time, +public domain materials, or royalty free copyright licenses. +Money should be paid to the: +"Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation." + +If you are interested in contributing scanning equipment or +software or other items, please contact Michael Hart at: +hart@pobox.com + +[Portions of this eBook's header and trailer may be reprinted only +when distributed free of all fees. Copyright (C) 2001, 2002 by +Michael S. Hart. Project Gutenberg is a TradeMark and may not be +used in any sales of Project Gutenberg eBooks or other materials be +they hardware or software or any other related product without +express permission.] + +*END THE SMALL PRINT! FOR PUBLIC DOMAIN EBOOKS*Ver.02/11/02*END* + diff --git a/old/sseas10.zip b/old/sseas10.zip Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000..709a609 --- /dev/null +++ b/old/sseas10.zip diff --git a/old/sseas10h.htm b/old/sseas10h.htm new file mode 100644 index 0000000..86d0518 --- /dev/null +++ b/old/sseas10h.htm @@ -0,0 +1,9701 @@ +<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01//EN"> +<html> +<head> +<meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=US-ASCII"> +<title>In the South Seas</title> +</head> +<body> +<h2> +<a href="#startoftext">In the South Seas, by Robert Louis Stevenson</a> +</h2> +<pre> +The Project Gutenberg EBook of In the South Seas, by Robert Louis Stevenson +(#20 in our series by Robert Louis Stevenson) + +Copyright laws are changing all over the world. Be sure to check the +copyright laws for your country before downloading or redistributing +this or any other Project Gutenberg eBook. + +This header should be the first thing seen when viewing this Project +Gutenberg file. Please do not remove it. Do not change or edit the +header without written permission. + +Please read the "legal small print," and other information about the +eBook and Project Gutenberg at the bottom of this file. Included is +important information about your specific rights and restrictions in +how the file may be used. You can also find out about how to make a +donation to Project Gutenberg, and how to get involved. + + +**Welcome To The World of Free Plain Vanilla Electronic Texts** + +**eBooks Readable By Both Humans and By Computers, Since 1971** + +*****These eBooks Were Prepared By Thousands of Volunteers!***** + + +Title: In the South Seas + +Author: Robert Louis Stevenson + +Release Date: March, 1996 [EBook #464] +[This file was first posted on January 23, 1996] +[Most recently updated: August 18, 2002] + +Edition: 10 + +Language: English + +Character set encoding: ASCII +</pre> +<p> +<a name="startoftext"></a> +Transcribed from the 1908 Chatto & Windus edition by David Price, +email ccx074@coventry.ac.uk<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +IN THE SOUTH SEAS<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +PART 1: THE MARQUESAS<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +CHAPTER I - AN ISLAND LANDFALL<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +For nearly ten years my health had been declining; and for some while +before I set forth upon my voyage, I believed I was come to the afterpiece +of life, and had only the nurse and undertaker to expect. It was +suggested that I should try the South Seas; and I was not unwilling +to visit like a ghost, and be carried like a bale, among scenes that +had attracted me in youth and health. I chartered accordingly +Dr. Merrit’s schooner yacht, the <i>Casco</i>, seventy-four tons +register; sailed from San Francisco towards the end of June 1888, visited +the eastern islands, and was left early the next year at Honolulu. +Hence, lacking courage to return to my old life of the house and sick-room, +I set forth to leeward in a trading schooner, the <i>Equator</i>, of +a little over seventy tons, spent four months among the atolls (low +coral islands) of the Gilbert group, and reached Samoa towards the close +of ‘89. By that time gratitude and habit were beginning +to attach me to the islands; I had gained a competency of strength; +I had made friends; I had learned new interests; the time of my voyages +had passed like days in fairyland; and I decided to remain. I +began to prepare these pages at sea, on a third cruise, in the trading +steamer <i>Janet Nicoll</i>. If more days are granted me, they +shall be passed where I have found life most pleasant and man most interesting; +the axes of my black boys are already clearing the foundations of my +future house; and I must learn to address readers from the uttermost +parts of the sea.<br> +<br> +That I should thus have reversed the verdict of Lord Tennyson’s +hero is less eccentric than appears. Few men who come to the islands +leave them; they grow grey where they alighted; the palm shades and +the trade-wind fans them till they die, perhaps cherishing to the last +the fancy of a visit home, which is rarely made, more rarely enjoyed, +and yet more rarely repeated. No part of the world exerts the +same attractive power upon the visitor, and the task before me is to +communicate to fireside travellers some sense of its seduction, and +to describe the life, at sea and ashore, of many hundred thousand persons, +some of our own blood and language, all our contemporaries, and yet +as remote in thought and habit as Rob Roy or Barbarossa, the Apostles +or the Caesars.<br> +<br> +The first experience can never be repeated. The first love, the +first sunrise, the first South Sea island, are memories apart and touched +a virginity of sense. On the 28th of July 1888 the moon was an +hour down by four in the morning. In the east a radiating centre +of brightness told of the day; and beneath, on the skyline, the morning +bank was already building, black as ink. We have all read of the +swiftness of the day’s coming and departure in low latitudes; +it is a point on which the scientific and sentimental tourist are at +one, and has inspired some tasteful poetry. The period certainly +varies with the season; but here is one case exactly noted. Although +the dawn was thus preparing by four, the sun was not up till six; and +it was half-past five before we could distinguish our expected islands +from the clouds on the horizon. Eight degrees south, and the day +two hours a-coming. The interval was passed on deck in the silence +of expectation, the customary thrill of landfall heightened by the strangeness +of the shores that we were then approaching. Slowly they took +shape in the attenuating darkness. Ua-huna, piling up to a truncated +summit, appeared the first upon the starboard bow; almost abeam arose +our destination, Nuka-hiva, whelmed in cloud; and betwixt and to the +southward, the first rays of the sun displayed the needles of Ua-pu. +These pricked about the line of the horizon; like the pinnacles of some +ornate and monstrous church, they stood there, in the sparkling brightness +of the morning, the fit signboard of a world of wonders.<br> +<br> +Not one soul aboard the <i>Casco</i> had set foot upon the islands, +or knew, except by accident, one word of any of the island tongues; +and it was with something perhaps of the same anxious pleasure as thrilled +the bosom of discoverers that we drew near these problematic shores. +The land heaved up in peaks and rising vales; it fell in cliffs and +buttresses; its colour ran through fifty modulations in a scale of pearl +and rose and olive; and it was crowned above by opalescent clouds. +The suffusion of vague hues deceived the eye; the shadows of clouds +were confounded with the articulations of the mountains; and the isle +and its unsubstantial canopy rose and shimmered before us like a single +mass. There was no beacon, no smoke of towns to be expected, no +plying pilot. Somewhere, in that pale phantasmagoria of cliff +and cloud, our haven lay concealed; and somewhere to the east of it +- the only sea-mark given - a certain headland, known indifferently +as Cape Adam and Eve, or Cape Jack and Jane, and distinguished by two +colossal figures, the gross statuary of nature. These we were +to find; for these we craned and stared, focused glasses, and wrangled +over charts; and the sun was overhead and the land close ahead before +we found them. To a ship approaching, like the <i>Casco</i>, from +the north, they proved indeed the least conspicuous features of a striking +coast; the surf flying high above its base; strange, austere, and feathered +mountains rising behind; and Jack and Jane, or Adam and Eve, impending +like a pair of warts above the breakers.<br> +<br> +Thence we bore away along shore. On our port beam we might hear +the explosions of the surf; a few birds flew fishing under the prow; +there was no other sound or mark of life, whether of man or beast, in +all that quarter of the island. Winged by her own impetus and +the dying breeze, the <i>Casco</i> skimmed under cliffs, opened out +a cove, showed us a beach and some green trees, and flitted by again, +bowing to the swell. The trees, from our distance, might have +been hazel; the beach might have been in Europe; the mountain forms +behind modelled in little from the Alps, and the forest which clustered +on their ramparts a growth no more considerable than our Scottish heath. +Again the cliff yawned, but now with a deeper entry; and the <i>Casco</i>, +hauling her wind, began to slide into the bay of Anaho. The cocoa-palm, +that giraffe of vegetables, so graceful, so ungainly, to the European +eye so foreign, was to be seen crowding on the beach, and climbing and +fringing the steep sides of mountains. Rude and bare hills embraced +the inlet upon either hand; it was enclosed to the landward by a bulk +of shattered mountains. In every crevice of that barrier the forest +harboured, roosting and nestling there like birds about a ruin; and +far above, it greened and roughened the razor edges of the summit.<br> +<br> +Under the eastern shore, our schooner, now bereft of any breeze, continued +to creep in: the smart creature, when once under way, appearing motive +in herself. From close aboard arose the bleating of young lambs; +a bird sang in the hillside; the scent of the land and of a hundred +fruits or flowers flowed forth to meet us; and, presently, a house or +two appeared, standing high upon the ankles of the hills, and one of +these surrounded with what seemed a garden. These conspicuous +habitations, that patch of culture, had we but known it, were a mark +of the passage of whites; and we might have approached a hundred islands +and not found their parallel. It was longer ere we spied the native +village, standing (in the universal fashion) close upon a curve of beach, +close under a grove of palms; the sea in front growling and whitening +on a concave arc of reef. For the cocoa-tree and the island man +are both lovers and neighbours of the surf. ‘The coral waxes, +the palm grows, but man departs,’ says the sad Tahitian proverb; +but they are all three, so long as they endure, co-haunters of the beach. +The mark of anchorage was a blow-hole in the rocks, near the south-easterly +corner of the bay. Punctually to our use, the blow-hole spouted; +the schooner turned upon her heel; the anchor plunged. It was +a small sound, a great event; my soul went down with these moorings +whence no windlass may extract nor any diver fish it up; and I, and +some part of my ship’s company, were from that hour the bondslaves +of the isles of Vivien.<br> +<br> +Before yet the anchor plunged a canoe was already paddling from the +hamlet. It contained two men: one white, one brown and tattooed +across the face with bands of blue, both in immaculate white European +clothes: the resident trader, Mr. Regler, and the native chief, Taipi-Kikino. +‘Captain, is it permitted to come on board?’ were the first +words we heard among the islands. Canoe followed canoe till the +ship swarmed with stalwart, six-foot men in every stage of undress; +some in a shirt, some in a loin-cloth, one in a handkerchief imperfectly +adjusted; some, and these the more considerable, tattooed from head +to foot in awful patterns; some barbarous and knived; one, who sticks +in my memory as something bestial, squatting on his hams in a canoe, +sucking an orange and spitting it out again to alternate sides with +ape-like vivacity - all talking, and we could not understand one word; +all trying to trade with us who had no thought of trading, or offering +us island curios at prices palpably absurd. There was no word +of welcome; no show of civility; no hand extended save that of the chief +and Mr. Regler. As we still continued to refuse the proffered +articles, complaint ran high and rude; and one, the jester of the party, +railed upon our meanness amid jeering laughter. Amongst other +angry pleasantries - ‘Here is a mighty fine ship,’ said +he, ‘to have no money on board!’ I own I was inspired +with sensible repugnance; even with alarm. The ship was manifestly +in their power; we had women on board; I knew nothing of my guests beyond +the fact that they were cannibals; the Directory (my only guide) was +full of timid cautions; and as for the trader, whose presence might +else have reassured me, were not whites in the Pacific the usual instigators +and accomplices of native outrage? When he reads this confession, +our kind friend, Mr. Regler, can afford to smile.<br> +<br> +Later in the day, as I sat writing up my journal, the cabin was filled +from end to end with Marquesans: three brown-skinned generations, squatted +cross-legged upon the floor, and regarding me in silence with embarrassing +eyes. The eyes of all Polynesians are large, luminous, and melting; +they are like the eyes of animals and some Italians. A kind of +despair came over me, to sit there helpless under all these staring +orbs, and be thus blocked in a corner of my cabin by this speechless +crowd: and a kind of rage to think they were beyond the reach of articulate +communication, like furred animals, or folk born deaf, or the dwellers +of some alien planet.<br> +<br> +To cross the Channel is, for a boy of twelve, to change heavens; to +cross the Atlantic, for a man of twenty-four, is hardly to modify his +diet. But I was now escaped out of the shadow of the Roman empire, +under whose toppling monuments we were all cradled, whose laws and letters +are on every hand of us, constraining and preventing. I was now +to see what men might be whose fathers had never studied Virgil, had +never been conquered by Caesar, and never been ruled by the wisdom of +Gaius or Papinian. By the same step I had journeyed forth out +of that comfortable zone of kindred languages, where the curse of Babel +is so easy to be remedied; and my new fellow-creatures sat before me +dumb like images. Methought, in my travels, all human relation +was to be excluded; and when I returned home (for in those days I still +projected my return) I should have but dipped into a picture-book without +a text. Nay, and I even questioned if my travels should be much +prolonged; perhaps they were destined to a speedy end; perhaps my subsequent +friend, Kauanui, whom I remarked there, sitting silent with the rest, +for a man of some authority, might leap from his hams with an ear-splitting +signal, the ship be carried at a rush, and the ship’s company +butchered for the table.<br> +<br> +There could be nothing more natural than these apprehensions, nor anything +more groundless. In my experience of the islands, I had never +again so menacing a reception; were I to meet with such to-day, I should +be more alarmed and tenfold more surprised. The majority of Polynesians +are easy folk to get in touch with, frank, fond of notice, greedy of +the least affection, like amiable, fawning dogs; and even with the Marquesans, +so recently and so imperfectly redeemed from a blood-boltered barbarism, +all were to become our intimates, and one, at least, was to mourn sincerely +our departure.<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +CHAPTER II - MAKING FRIENDS<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +The impediment of tongues was one that I particularly over-estimated. +The languages of Polynesia are easy to smatter, though hard to speak +with elegance. And they are extremely similar, so that a person +who has a tincture of one or two may risk, not without hope, an attempt +upon the others.<br> +<br> +And again, not only is Polynesian easy to smatter, but interpreters +abound. Missionaries, traders, and broken white folk living on +the bounty of the natives, are to be found in almost every isle and +hamlet; and even where these are unserviceable, the natives themselves +have often scraped up a little English, and in the French zone (though +far less commonly) a little French-English, or an efficient pidgin, +what is called to the westward ‘Beach-la-Mar,’ comes easy +to the Polynesian; it is now taught, besides, in the schools of Hawaii; +and from the multiplicity of British ships, and the nearness of the +States on the one hand and the colonies on the other, it may be called, +and will almost certainly become, the tongue of the Pacific. I +will instance a few examples. I met in Majuro a Marshall Island +boy who spoke excellent English; this he had learned in the German firm +in Jaluit, yet did not speak one word of German. I heard from +a gendarme who had taught school in Rapa-iti that while the children +had the utmost difficulty or reluctance to learn French, they picked +up English on the wayside, and as if by accident. On one of the +most out-of-the-way atolls in the Carolines, my friend Mr. Benjamin +Hird was amazed to find the lads playing cricket on the beach and talking +English; and it was in English that the crew of the <i>Janet Nicoll</i>, +a set of black boys from different Melanesian islands, communicated +with other natives throughout the cruise, transmitted orders, and sometimes +jested together on the fore-hatch. But what struck me perhaps +most of all was a word I heard on the verandah of the Tribunal at Noumea. +A case had just been heard - a trial for infanticide against an ape-like +native woman; and the audience were smoking cigarettes as they awaited +the verdict. An anxious, amiable French lady, not far from tears, +was eager for acquittal, and declared she would engage the prisoner +to be her children’s nurse. The bystanders exclaimed at +the proposal; the woman was a savage, said they, and spoke no language. +‘<i>Mais, vous savez</i>,’ objected the fair sentimentalist; +‘<i>ils apprennent si vite l’anglais</i>!’<br> +<br> +But to be able to speak to people is not all. And in the first +stage of my relations with natives I was helped by two things. +To begin with, I was the show-man of the <i>Casco</i>. She, her +fine lines, tall spars, and snowy decks, the crimson fittings of the +saloon, and the white, the gilt, and the repeating mirrors of the tiny +cabin, brought us a hundred visitors. The men fathomed out her +dimensions with their arms, as their fathers fathomed out the ships +of Cook; the women declared the cabins more lovely than a church; bouncing +Junos were never weary of sitting in the chairs and contemplating in +the glass their own bland images; and I have seen one lady strip up +her dress, and, with cries of wonder and delight, rub herself bare-breeched +upon the velvet cushions. Biscuit, jam, and syrup was the entertainment; +and, as in European parlours, the photograph album went the round. +This sober gallery, their everyday costumes and physiognomies, had become +transformed, in three weeks’ sailing, into things wonderful and +rich and foreign; alien faces, barbaric dresses, they were now beheld +and fingered, in the swerving cabin, with innocent excitement and surprise. +Her Majesty was often recognised, and I have seen French subjects kiss +her photograph; Captain Speedy - in an Abyssinian war-dress, supposed +to be the uniform of the British army - met with much acceptance; and +the effigies of Mr. Andrew Lang were admired in the Marquesas. +There is the place for him to go when he shall be weary of Middlesex +and Homer.<br> +<br> +It was perhaps yet more important that I had enjoyed in my youth some +knowledge of our Scots folk of the Highlands and the Islands. +Not much beyond a century has passed since these were in the same convulsive +and transitionary state as the Marquesans of to-day. In both cases +an alien authority enforced, the clans disarmed, the chiefs deposed, +new customs introduced, and chiefly that fashion of regarding money +as the means and object of existence. The commercial age, in each, +succeeding at a bound to an age of war abroad and patriarchal communism +at home. In one the cherished practice of tattooing, in the other +a cherished costume, proscribed. In each a main luxury cut off: +beef, driven under cloud of night from Lowland pastures, denied to the +meat-loving Highlander; long-pig, pirated from the next village, to +the man-eating Kanaka. The grumbling, the secret ferment, the +fears and resentments, the alarms and sudden councils of Marquesan chiefs, +reminded me continually of the days of Lovat and Struan. Hospitality, +tact, natural fine manners, and a touchy punctilio, are common to both +races: common to both tongues the trick of dropping medial consonants. +Here is a table of two widespread Polynesian words:-<br> +<br> +<br> +<pre> </pre><pre><i>House</i></pre><pre>. </pre><pre><i>Love. + +</i></pre><pre>Tahitian FARE AROHA + +New Zealand WHARE + +Samoan FALE TALOFA + +Manihiki FALE ALOHA + +Hawaiian HALE ALOHA + +Marquesan HA’E KAOHA + + +</pre><p>The elision of medial consonants, so marked in these Marquesan +instances, is no less common both in Gaelic and the Lowland Scots. +Stranger still, that prevalent Polynesian sound, the so-called catch, +written with an apostrophe, and often or always the gravestone of a +perished consonant, is to be heard in Scotland to this day. When +a Scot pronounces water, better, or bottle - <i>wa’er, be’er</i>, +or <i>bo’le</i> - the sound is precisely that of the catch; and +I think we may go beyond, and say, that if such a population could be +isolated, and this mispronunciation should become the rule, it might +prove the first stage of transition from <i>t</i> to <i>k</i>, which +is the disease of Polynesian languages. The tendency of the Marquesans, +however, is to urge against consonants, or at least on the very common +letter <i>l</i>, a war of mere extermination. A hiatus is agreeable +to any Polynesian ear; the ear even of the stranger soon grows used +to these barbaric voids; but only in the Marquesan will you find such +names as <i>Haaii</i> and <i>Paaaeua</i>, when each individual vowel +must be separately uttered.<br> +<br> +These points of similarity between a South Sea people and some of my +own folk at home ran much in my head in the islands; and not only inclined +me to view my fresh acquaintances with favour, but continually modified +my judgment. A polite Englishman comes to-day to the Marquesans +and is amazed to find the men tattooed; polite Italians came not long +ago to England and found our fathers stained with woad; and when I paid +the return visit as a little boy, I was highly diverted with the backwardness +of Italy: so insecure, so much a matter of the day and hour, is the +pre-eminence of race. It was so that I hit upon a means of communication +which I recommend to travellers. When I desired any detail of +savage custom, or of superstitious belief, I cast back in the story +of my fathers, and fished for what I wanted with some trait of equal +barbarism: Michael Scott, Lord Derwentwater’s head, the second-sight, +the Water Kelpie, - each of these I have found to be a killing bait; +the black bull’s head of Stirling procured me the legend of <i>Rahero</i>; +and what I knew of the Cluny Macphersons, or the Appin Stewarts, enabled +me to learn, and helped me to understand, about the <i>Tevas</i> of +Tahiti. The native was no longer ashamed, his sense of kinship +grew warmer, and his lips were opened. It is this sense of kinship +that the traveller must rouse and share; or he had better content himself +with travels from the blue bed to the brown. And the presence +of one Cockney titterer will cause a whole party to walk in clouds of +darkness.<br> +<br> +The hamlet of Anaho stands on a margin of flat land between the west +of the beach and the spring of the impending mountains. A grove +of palms, perpetually ruffling its green fans, carpets it (as for a +triumph) with fallen branches, and shades it like an arbour. A +road runs from end to end of the covert among beds of flowers, the milliner’s +shop of the community; and here and there, in the grateful twilight, +in an air filled with a diversity of scents, and still within hearing +of the surf upon the reef, the native houses stand in scattered neighbourhood. +The same word, as we have seen, represents in many tongues of Polynesia, +with scarce a shade of difference, the abode of man. But although +the word be the same, the structure itself continually varies; and the +Marquesan, among the most backward and barbarous of islanders, is yet +the most commodiously lodged. The grass huts of Hawaii, the birdcage +houses of Tahiti, or the open shed, with the crazy Venetian blinds, +of the polite Samoan - none of these can be compared with the Marquesan +<i>paepae-hae</i>, or dwelling platform. The paepae is an oblong +terrace built without cement or black volcanic stone, from twenty to +fifty feet in length, raised from four to eight feet from the earth, +and accessible by a broad stair. Along the back of this, and coming +to about half its width, runs the open front of the house, like a covered +gallery: the interior sometimes neat and almost elegant in its bareness, +the sleeping space divided off by an endlong coaming, some bright raiment +perhaps hanging from a nail, and a lamp and one of White’s sewing-machines +the only marks of civilization. On the outside, at one end of +the terrace, burns the cooking-fire under a shed; at the other there +is perhaps a pen for pigs; the remainder is the evening lounge and <i>al +fresco</i> banquet-hall of the inhabitants. To some houses water +is brought down the mountains in bamboo pipes, perforated for the sake +of sweetness. With the Highland comparison in my mind, I was struck +to remember the sluttish mounds of turf and stone in which I have sat +and been entertained in the Hebrides and the North Islands. Two +things, I suppose, explain the contrast. In Scotland wood is rare, +and with materials so rude as turf and stone the very hope of neatness +is excluded. And in Scotland it is cold. Shelter and a hearth +are needs so pressing that a man looks not beyond; he is out all day +after a bare bellyful, and at night when he saith, ‘Aha, it is +warm!’ he has not appetite for more. Or if for something +else, then something higher; a fine school of poetry and song arose +in these rough shelters, and an air like ‘<i>Lochaber no more</i>’ +is an evidence of refinement more convincing, as well as more imperishable, +than a palace.<br> +<br> +To one such dwelling platform a considerable troop of relatives and +dependants resort. In the hour of the dusk, when the fire blazes, +and the scent of the cooked breadfruit fills the air, and perhaps the +lamp glints already between the pillars and the house, you shall behold +them silently assemble to this meal, men, women, and children; and the +dogs and pigs frisk together up the terrace stairway, switching rival +tails. The strangers from the ship were soon equally welcome: +welcome to dip their fingers in the wooden dish, to drink cocoanuts, +to share the circulating pipe, and to hear and hold high debate about +the misdeeds of the French, the Panama Canal, or the geographical position +of San Francisco and New Yo’ko. In a Highland hamlet, quite +out of reach of any tourist, I have met the same plain and dignified +hospitality.<br> +<br> +I have mentioned two facts - the distasteful behaviour of our earliest +visitors, and the case of the lady who rubbed herself upon the cushions +- which would give a very false opinion of Marquesan manners. +The great majority of Polynesians are excellently mannered; but the +Marquesan stands apart, annoying and attractive, wild, shy, and refined. +If you make him a present he affects to forget it, and it must be offered +him again at his going: a pretty formality I have found nowhere else. +A hint will get rid of any one or any number; they are so fiercely proud +and modest; while many of the more lovable but blunter islanders crowd +upon a stranger, and can be no more driven off than flies. A slight +or an insult the Marquesan seems never to forget. I was one day +talking by the wayside with my friend Hoka, when I perceived his eyes +suddenly to flash and his stature to swell. A white horseman was +coming down the mountain, and as he passed, and while he paused to exchange +salutations with myself, Hoka was still staring and ruffling like a +gamecock. It was a Corsican who had years before called him <i>cochon +sauvage - coçon chauvage</i>, as Hoka mispronounced it. +With people so nice and so touchy, it was scarce to be supposed that +our company of greenhorns should not blunder into offences. Hoka, +on one of his visits, fell suddenly in a brooding silence, and presently +after left the ship with cold formality. When he took me back +into favour, he adroitly and pointedly explained the nature of my offence: +I had asked him to sell cocoa-nuts; and in Hoka’s view articles +of food were things that a gentleman should give, not sell; or at least +that he should not sell to any friend. On another occasion I gave +my boat’s crew a luncheon of chocolate and biscuits. I had +sinned, I could never learn how, against some point of observance; and +though I was drily thanked, my offerings were left upon the beach. +But our worst mistake was a slight we put on Toma, Hoka’s adoptive +father, and in his own eyes the rightful chief of Anaho. In the +first place, we did not call upon him, as perhaps we should, in his +fine new European house, the only one in the hamlet. In the second, +when we came ashore upon a visit to his rival, Taipi-Kikino, it was +Toma whom we saw standing at the head of the beach, a magnificent figure +of a man, magnificently tattooed; and it was of Toma that we asked our +question: ‘Where is the chief?’ ‘What chief?’ +cried Toma, and turned his back on the blasphemers. Nor did he +forgive us. Hoka came and went with us daily; but, alone I believe +of all the countryside, neither Toma nor his wife set foot on board +the <i>Casco</i>. The temptation resisted it is hard for a European +to compute. The flying city of Laputa moored for a fortnight in +St. James’s Park affords but a pale figure of the <i>Casco</i> +anchored before Anaho; for the Londoner has still his change of pleasures, +but the Marquesan passes to his grave through an unbroken uniformity +of days.<br> +<br> +On the afternoon before it was intended we should sail, a valedictory +party came on board: nine of our particular friends equipped with gifts +and dressed as for a festival. Hoka, the chief dancer and singer, +the greatest dandy of Anaho, and one of the handsomest young fellows +in the world-sullen, showy, dramatic, light as a feather and strong +as an ox - it would have been hard, on that occasion, to recognise, +as he sat there stooped and silent, his face heavy and grey. It +was strange to see the lad so much affected; stranger still to recognise +in his last gift one of the curios we had refused on the first day, +and to know our friend, so gaily dressed, so plainly moved at our departure, +for one of the half-naked crew that had besieged and insulted us on +our arrival: strangest of all, perhaps, to find, in that carved handle +of a fan, the last of those curiosities of the first day which had now +all been given to us by their possessors - their chief merchandise, +for which they had sought to ransom us as long as we were strangers, +which they pressed on us for nothing as soon as we were friends. +The last visit was not long protracted. One after another they +shook hands and got down into their canoe; when Hoka turned his back +immediately upon the ship, so that we saw his face no more. Taipi, +on the other hand, remained standing and facing us with gracious valedictory +gestures; and when Captain Otis dipped the ensign, the whole party saluted +with their hats. This was the farewell; the episode of our visit +to Anaho was held concluded; and though the <i>Casco</i> remained nearly +forty hours at her moorings, not one returned on board, and I am inclined +to think they avoided appearing on the beach. This reserve and +dignity is the finest trait of the Marquesan.<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +CHAPTER III - THE MAROON<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +Of the beauties of Anaho books might be written. I remember waking +about three, to find the air temperate and scented. The long swell +brimmed into the bay, and seemed to fill it full and then subside. +Gently, deeply, and silently the <i>Casco</i> rolled; only at times +a block piped like a bird. Oceanward, the heaven was bright with +stars and the sea with their reflections. If I looked to that +side, I might have sung with the Hawaiian poet:<br> +<br> +<br> +<i>Ua maomao ka lani, ua kahaea luna,<br> +Ua pipi ka maka o ka hoku.<br> +</i>(The heavens were fair, they stretched above,<br> +Many were the eyes of the stars.)<br> +<br> +<br> +And then I turned shoreward, and high squalls were overhead; the mountains +loomed up black; and I could have fancied I had slipped ten thousand +miles away and was anchored in a Highland loch; that when the day came, +it would show pine, and heather, and green fern, and roofs of turf sending +up the smoke of peats; and the alien speech that should next greet my +ears must be Gaelic, not Kanaka.<br> +<br> +And day, when it came, brought other sights and thoughts. I have +watched the morning break in many quarters of the world; it has been +certainly one of the chief joys of my existence, and the dawn that I +saw with most emotion shone upon the bay of Anaho. The mountains +abruptly overhang the port with every variety of surface and of inclination, +lawn, and cliff, and forest. Not one of these but wore its proper +tint of saffron, of sulphur, of the clove, and of the rose. The +lustre was like that of satin; on the lighter hues there seemed to float +an efflorescence; a solemn bloom appeared on the more dark. The +light itself was the ordinary light of morning, colourless and clean; +and on this ground of jewels, pencilled out the least detail of drawing. +Meanwhile, around the hamlet, under the palms, where the blue shadow +lingered, the red coals of cocoa husk and the light trails of smoke +betrayed the awakening business of the day; along the beach men and +women, lads and lasses, were returning from the bath in bright raiment, +red and blue and green, such as we delighted to see in the coloured +little pictures of our childhood; and presently the sun had cleared +the eastern hill, and the glow of the day was over all.<br> +<br> +The glow continued and increased, the business, from the main part, +ceased before it had begun. Twice in the day there was a certain +stir of shepherding along the seaward hills. At times a canoe +went out to fish. At times a woman or two languidly filled a basket +in the cotton patch. At times a pipe would sound out of the shadow +of a house, ringing the changes on its three notes, with an effect like +<i>Que le</i> <i>jour me dure</i>, repeated endlessly. Or at times, +across a corner of the bay, two natives might communicate in the Marquesan +manner with conventional whistlings. All else was sleep and silence. +The surf broke and shone around the shores; a species of black crane +fished in the broken water; the black pigs were continually galloping +by on some affair; but the people might never have awaked, or they might +all be dead.<br> +<br> +My favourite haunt was opposite the hamlet, where was a landing in a +cove under a lianaed cliff. The beach was lined with palms and +a tree called the purao, something between the fig and mulberry in growth, +and bearing a flower like a great yellow poppy with a maroon heart. +In places rocks encroached upon the sand; the beach would be all submerged; +and the surf would bubble warmly as high as to my knees, and play with +cocoa-nut husks as our more homely ocean plays with wreck and wrack +and bottles. As the reflux drew down, marvels of colour and design +streamed between my feet; which I would grasp at, miss, or seize: now +to find them what they promised, shells to grace a cabinet or be set +in gold upon a lady’s finger; now to catch only <i>maya</i> of +coloured sand, pounded fragments and pebbles, that, as soon as they +were dry, became as dull and homely as the flints upon a garden path. +I have toiled at this childish pleasure for hours in the strong sun, +conscious of my incurable ignorance; but too keenly pleased to be ashamed. +Meanwhile, the blackbird (or his tropical understudy) would be fluting +in the thickets overhead.<br> +<br> +A little further, in the turn of the bay, a streamlet trickled in the +bottom of a den, thence spilling down a stair of rock into the sea. +The draught of air drew down under the foliage in the very bottom of +the den, which was a perfect arbour for coolness. In front it +stood open on the blue bay and the <i>Casco</i> lying there under her +awning and her cheerful colours. Overhead was a thatch of puraos, +and over these again palms brandished their bright fans, as I have seen +a conjurer make himself a halo out of naked swords. For in this +spot, over a neck of low land at the foot of the mountains, the trade-wind +streams into Anaho Bay in a flood of almost constant volume and velocity, +and of a heavenly coolness.<br> +<br> +It chanced one day that I was ashore in the cove, with Mrs. Stevenson +and the ship’s cook. Except for the <i>Casco</i> lying outside, +and a crane or two, and the ever-busy wind and sea, the face of the +world was of a prehistoric emptiness; life appeared to stand stock-still, +and the sense of isolation was profound and refreshing. On a sudden, +the trade-wind, coming in a gust over the isthmus, struck and scattered +the fans of the palms above the den; and, behold! in two of the tops +there sat a native, motionless as an idol and watching us, you would +have said, without a wink. The next moment the tree closed, and +the glimpse was gone. This discovery of human presences latent +overhead in a place where we had supposed ourselves alone, the immobility +of our tree-top spies, and the thought that perhaps at all hours we +were similarly supervised, struck us with a chill. Talk languished +on the beach. As for the cook (whose conscience was not clear), +he never afterwards set foot on shore, and twice, when the <i>Casco</i> +appeared to be driving on the rocks, it was amusing to observe that +man’s alacrity; death, he was persuaded, awaiting him upon the +beach. It was more than a year later, in the Gilberts, that the +explanation dawned upon myself. The natives were drawing palm-tree +wine, a thing forbidden by law; and when the wind thus suddenly revealed +them, they were doubtless more troubled than ourselves.<br> +<br> +At the top of the den there dwelt an old, melancholy, grizzled man of +the name of Tari (Charlie) Coffin. He was a native of Oahu, in +the Sandwich Islands; and had gone to sea in his youth in the American +whalers; a circumstance to which he owed his name, his English, his +down-east twang, and the misfortune of his innocent life. For +one captain, sailing out of New Bedford, carried him to Nuka-hiva and +marooned him there among the cannibals. The motive for this act +was inconceivably small; poor Tari’s wages, which were thus economised, +would scarce have shook the credit of the New Bedford owners. +And the act itself was simply murder. Tari’s life must have +hung in the beginning by a hair. In the grief and terror of that +time, it is not unlikely he went mad, an infirmity to which he was still +liable; or perhaps a child may have taken a fancy to him and ordained +him to be spared. He escaped at least alive, married in the island, +and when I knew him was a widower with a married son and a granddaughter. +But the thought of Oahu haunted him; its praise was for ever on his +lips; he beheld it, looking back, as a place of ceaseless feasting, +song, and dance; and in his dreams I daresay he revisits it with joy. +I wonder what he would think if he could be carried there indeed, and +see the modern town of Honolulu brisk with traffic, and the palace with +its guards, and the great hotel, and Mr. Berger’s band with their +uniforms and outlandish instruments; or what he would think to see the +brown faces grown so few and the white so many; and his father’s +land sold, for planting sugar, and his father’s house quite perished, +or perhaps the last of them struck leprous and immured between the surf +and the cliffs on Molokai? So simply, even in South Sea Islands, +and so sadly, the changes come.<br> +<br> +Tari was poor, and poorly lodged. His house was a wooden frame, +run up by Europeans; it was indeed his official residence, for Tari +was the shepherd of the promontory sheep. I can give a perfect +inventory of its contents: three kegs, a tin biscuit-box, an iron saucepan, +several cocoa-shell cups, a lantern, and three bottles, probably containing +oil; while the clothes of the family and a few mats were thrown across +the open rafters. Upon my first meeting with this exile he had +conceived for me one of the baseless island friendships, had given me +nuts to drink, and carried me up the den ‘to see my house’ +- the only entertainment that he had to offer. He liked the ‘Amelican,’ +he said, and the ‘Inglisman,’ but the ‘Flessman’ +was his abhorrence; and he was careful to explain that if he had thought +us ‘Fless,’ we should have had none of his nuts, and never +a sight of his house. His distaste for the French I can partly +understand, but not at all his toleration of the Anglo-Saxon. +The next day he brought me a pig, and some days later one of our party +going ashore found him in act to bring a second. We were still +strange to the islands; we were pained by the poor man’s generosity, +which he could ill afford, and, by a natural enough but quite unpardonable +blunder, we refused the pig. Had Tari been a Marquesan we should +have seen him no more; being what he was, the most mild, long-suffering, +melancholy man, he took a revenge a hundred times more painful. +Scarce had the canoe with the nine villagers put off from their farewell +before the <i>Casco</i> was boarded from the other side. It was +Tari; coming thus late because he had no canoe of his own, and had found +it hard to borrow one; coming thus solitary (as indeed we always saw +him), because he was a stranger in the land, and the dreariest of company. +The rest of my family basely fled from the encounter. I must receive +our injured friend alone; and the interview must have lasted hard upon +an hour, for he was loath to tear himself away. ‘You go +’way. I see you no more - no, sir!’ he lamented; and +then looking about him with rueful admiration, ‘This goodee ship +- no, sir! - goodee ship!’ he would exclaim: the ‘no, sir,’ +thrown out sharply through the nose upon a rising inflection, an echo +from New Bedford and the fallacious whaler. From these expressions +of grief and praise, he would return continually to the case of the +rejected pig. ‘I like give present all ‘e same you,’ +he complained; ‘only got pig: you no take him!’ He +was a poor man; he had no choice of gifts; he had only a pig, he repeated; +and I had refused it. I have rarely been more wretched than to +see him sitting there, so old, so grey, so poor, so hardly fortuned, +of so rueful a countenance, and to appreciate, with growing keenness, +the affront which I had so innocently dealt him; but it was one of those +cases in which speech is vain.<br> +<br> +Tari’s son was smiling and inert; his daughter-in-law, a girl +of sixteen, pretty, gentle, and grave, more intelligent than most Anaho +women, and with a fair share of French; his grandchild, a mite of a +creature at the breast. I went up the den one day when Tari was +from home, and found the son making a cotton sack, and madame suckling +mademoiselle. When I had sat down with them on the floor, the +girl began to question me about England; which I tried to describe, +piling the pan and the cocoa shells one upon another to represent the +houses, and explaining, as best I was able, and by word and gesture, +the over-population, the hunger, and the perpetual toil. ‘<i>Pas</i> +<i>de cocotiers? pas do popoi</i>?’ she asked. I told her +it was too cold, and went through an elaborate performance, shutting +out draughts, and crouching over an imaginary fire, to make sure she +understood. But she understood right well; remarked it must be +bad for the health, and sat a while gravely reflecting on that picture +of unwonted sorrows. I am sure it roused her pity, for it struck +in her another thought always uppermost in the Marquesan bosom; and +she began with a smiling sadness, and looking on me out of melancholy +eyes, to lament the decease of her own people. ‘<i>Ici pas +de</i> <i>Kanaques</i>,’ said she; and taking the baby from her +breast, she held it out to me with both her hands. ‘<i>Tenez</i> +- a little baby like this; then dead. All the Kanaques die. +Then no more.’ The smile, and this instancing by the girl-mother +of her own tiny flesh and blood, affected me strangely; they spoke of +so tranquil a despair. Meanwhile the husband smilingly made his +sack; and the unconscious babe struggled to reach a pot of raspberry +jam, friendship’s offering, which I had just brought up the den; +and in a perspective of centuries I saw their case as ours, death coming +in like a tide, and the day already numbered when there should be no +more Beretani, and no more of any race whatever, and (what oddly touched +me) no more literary works and no more readers.<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +CHAPTER IV - DEATH<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +The thought of death, I have said, is uppermost in the mind of the Marquesan. +It would be strange if it were otherwise. The race is perhaps +the handsomest extant. Six feet is about the middle height of +males; they are strongly muscled, free from fat, swift in action, graceful +in repose; and the women, though fatter and duller, are still comely +animals. To judge by the eye, there is no race more viable; and +yet death reaps them with both hands. When Bishop Dordillon first +came to Tai-o-hae, he reckoned the inhabitants at many thousands; he +was but newly dead, and in the same bay Stanislao Moanatini counted +on his fingers eight residual natives. Or take the valley of Hapaa, +known to readers of Herman Melville under the grotesque misspelling +of Hapar. There are but two writers who have touched the South +Seas with any genius, both Americans: Melville and Charles Warren Stoddard; +and at the christening of the first and greatest, some influential fairy +must have been neglected: ‘He shall be able to see,’ ‘He +shall be able to tell,’ ‘He shall be able to charm,’ +said the friendly godmothers; ‘But he shall not be able to hear,’ +exclaimed the last. The tribe of Hapaa is said to have numbered +some four hundred, when the small-pox came and reduced them by one-fourth. +Six months later a woman developed tubercular consumption; the disease +spread like a fire about the valley, and in less than a year two survivors, +a man and a woman, fled from that new-created solitude. A similar +Adam and Eve may some day wither among new races, the tragic residue +of Britain. When I first heard this story the date staggered me; +but I am now inclined to think it possible. Early in the year +of my visit, for example, or late the year before, a first case of phthisis +appeared in a household of seventeen persons, and by the month of August, +when the tale was told me, one soul survived, and that was a boy who +had been absent at his schooling. And depopulation works both +ways, the doors of death being set wide open, and the door of birth +almost closed. Thus, in the half-year ending July 1888 there were +twelve deaths and but one birth in the district of the Hatiheu. +Seven or eight more deaths were to be looked for in the ordinary course; +and M. Aussel, the observant gendarme, knew of but one likely birth. +At this rate it is no matter of surprise if the population in that part +should have declined in forty years from six thousand to less than four +hundred; which are, once more on the authority of M. Aussel, the estimated +figures. And the rate of decline must have even accelerated towards +the end.<br> +<br> +A good way to appreciate the depopulation is to go by land from Anaho +to Hatiheu on the adjacent bay. The road is good travelling, but +cruelly steep. We seemed scarce to have passed the deserted house +which stands highest in Anaho before we were looking dizzily down upon +its roof; the <i>Casco</i> well out in the bay, and rolling for a wager, +shrank visibly; and presently through the gap of Tari’s isthmus, +Ua-huna was seen to hang cloudlike on the horizon. Over the summit, +where the wind blew really chill, and whistled in the reed-like grass, +and tossed the grassy fell of the pandanus, we stepped suddenly, as +through a door, into the next vale and bay of Hatiheu. A bowl +of mountains encloses it upon three sides. On the fourth this +rampart has been bombarded into ruins, runs down to seaward in imminent +and shattered crags, and presents the one practicable breach of the +blue bay. The interior of this vessel is crowded with lovely and +valuable trees, - orange, breadfruit, mummy-apple, cocoa, the island +chestnut, and for weeds, the pine and the banana. Four perennial +streams water and keep it green; and along the dell, first of one, then +of another, of these, the road, for a considerable distance, descends +into this fortunate valley. The song of the waters and the familiar +disarray of boulders gave us a strong sense of home, which the exotic +foliage, the daft-like growth of the pandanus, the buttressed trunk +of the banyan, the black pigs galloping in the bush, and the architecture +of the native houses dissipated ere it could be enjoyed.<br> +<br> +The houses on the Hatiheu side begin high up; higher yet, the more melancholy +spectacle of empty paepaes. When a native habitation is deserted, +the superstructure - pandanus thatch, wattle, unstable tropical timber +- speedily rots, and is speedily scattered by the wind. Only the +stones of the terrace endure; nor can any ruin, cairn, or standing stone, +or vitrified fort present a more stern appearance of antiquity. +We must have passed from six to eight of these now houseless platforms. +On the main road of the island, where it crosses the valley of Taipi, +Mr. Osbourne tells me they are to be reckoned by the dozen; and as the +roads have been made long posterior to their erection, perhaps to their +desertion, and must simply be regarded as lines drawn at random through +the bush, the forest on either hand must be equally filled with these +survivals: the gravestones of whole families. Such ruins are tapu +in the strictest sense; no native must approach them; they have become +outposts of the kingdom of the grave. It might appear a natural +and pious custom in the hundreds who are left, the rearguard of perished +thousands, that their feet should leave untrod these hearthstones of +their fathers. I believe, in fact, the custom rests on different +and more grim conceptions. But the house, the grave, and even +the body of the dead, have been always particularly honoured by Marquesans. +Until recently the corpse was sometimes kept in the family and daily +oiled and sunned, until, by gradual and revolting stages, it dried into +a kind of mummy. Offerings are still laid upon the grave. +In Traitor’s Bay, Mr. Osbourne saw a man buy a looking-glass to +lay upon his son’s. And the sentiment against the desecration +of tombs, thoughtlessly ruffled in the laying down of the new roads, +is a chief ingredient in the native hatred for the French.<br> +<br> +The Marquesan beholds with dismay the approaching extinction of his +race. The thought of death sits down with him to meat, and rises +with him from his bed; he lives and breathes under a shadow of mortality +awful to support; and he is so inured to the apprehension that he greets +the reality with relief. He does not even seek to support a disappointment; +at an affront, at a breach of one of his fleeting and communistic love-affairs, +he seeks an instant refuge in the grave. Hanging is now the fashion. +I heard of three who had hanged themselves in the west end of Hiva-oa +during the first half of 1888; but though this be a common form of suicide +in other parts of the South Seas, I cannot think it will continue popular +in the Marquesas. Far more suitable to Marquesan sentiment is +the old form of poisoning with the fruit of the eva, which offers to +the native suicide a cruel but deliberate death, and gives time for +those decencies of the last hour, to which he attaches such remarkable +importance. The coffin can thus be at hand, the pigs killed, the +cry of the mourners sounding already through the house; and then it +is, and not before, that the Marquesan is conscious of achievement, +his life all rounded in, his robes (like Caesar’s) adjusted for +the final act. Praise not any man till he is dead, said the ancients; +envy not any man till you hear the mourners, might be the Marquesan +parody. The coffin, though of late introduction, strangely engages +their attention. It is to the mature Marquesan what a watch is +to the European schoolboy. For ten years Queen Vaekehu had dunned +the fathers; at last, but the other day, they let her have her will, +gave her her coffin, and the woman’s soul is at rest. I +was told a droll instance of the force of this preoccupation. +The Polynesians are subject to a disease seemingly rather of the will +than of the body. I was told the Tahitians have a word for it, +<i>erimatua</i>, but cannot find it in my dictionary. A gendarme, +M. Nouveau, has seen men beginning to succumb to this insubstantial +malady, has routed them from their houses, turned them on to do their +trick upon the roads, and in two days has seen them cured. But +this other remedy is more original: a Marquesan, dying of this discouragement +- perhaps I should rather say this acquiescence - has been known, at +the fulfilment of his crowning wish, on the mere sight of that desired +hermitage, his coffin - to revive, recover, shake off the hand of death, +and be restored for years to his occupations - carving tikis (idols), +let us say, or braiding old men’s beards. From all this +it may be conceived how easily they meet death when it approaches naturally. +I heard one example, grim and picturesque. In the time of the +small-pox in Hapaa, an old man was seized with the disease; he had no +thought of recovery; had his grave dug by a wayside, and lived in it +for near a fortnight, eating, drinking, and smoking with the passers-by, +talking mostly of his end, and equally unconcerned for himself and careless +of the friends whom he infected.<br> +<br> +This proneness to suicide, and loose seat in life, is not peculiar to +the Marquesan. What is peculiar is the widespread depression and +acceptance of the national end. Pleasures are neglected, the dance +languishes, the songs are forgotten. It is true that some, and +perhaps too many, of them are proscribed; but many remain, if there +were spirit to support or to revive them. At the last feast of +the Bastille, Stanislao Moanatini shed tears when he beheld the inanimate +performance of the dancers. When the people sang for us in Anaho, +they must apologise for the smallness of their repertory. They +were only young folk present, they said, and it was only the old that +knew the songs. The whole body of Marquesan poetry and music was +being suffered to die out with a single dispirited generation. +The full import is apparent only to one acquainted with other Polynesian +races; who knows how the Samoan coins a fresh song for every trifling +incident, or who has heard (on Penrhyn, for instance) a band of little +stripling maids from eight to twelve keep up their minstrelsy for hours +upon a stretch, one song following another without pause. In like +manner, the Marquesan, never industrious, begins now to cease altogether +from production. The exports of the group decline out of all proportion +even with the death-rate of the islanders. ‘The coral waxes, +the palm grows, and man departs,’ says the Marquesan; and he folds +his hands. And surely this is nature. Fond as it may appear, +we labour and refrain, not for the rewards of any single life, but with +a timid eye upon the lives and memories of our successors; and where +no one is to succeed, of his own family, or his own tongue, I doubt +whether Rothschilds would make money or Cato practise virtue. +It is natural, also, that a temporary stimulus should sometimes rouse +the Marquesan from his lethargy. Over all the landward shore of +Anaho cotton runs like a wild weed; man or woman, whoever comes to pick +it, may earn a dollar in the day; yet when we arrived, the trader’s +store-house was entirely empty; and before we left it was near full. +So long as the circus was there, so long as the <i>Casco</i> was yet +anchored in the bay, it behoved every one to make his visit; and to +this end every woman must have a new dress, and every man a shirt and +trousers. Never before, in Mr. Regler’s experience, had +they displayed so much activity.<br> +<br> +In their despondency there is an element of dread. The fear of +ghosts and of the dark is very deeply written in the mind of the Polynesian; +not least of the Marquesan. Poor Taipi, the chief of Anaho, was +condemned to ride to Hatiheu on a moonless night. He borrowed +a lantern, sat a long while nerving himself for the adventure, and when +he at last departed, wrung the <i>Cascos</i> by the hand as for a final +separation. Certain presences, called Vehinehae, frequent and +make terrible the nocturnal roadside; I was told by one they were like +so much mist, and as the traveller walked into them dispersed and dissipated; +another described them as being shaped like men and having eyes like +cats; from none could I obtain the smallest clearness as to what they +did, or wherefore they were dreaded. We may be sure at least they +represent the dead; for the dead, in the minds of the islanders, are +all-pervasive. ‘When a native says that he is a man,’ +writes Dr. Codrington, ‘he means that he is a man and not a ghost; +not that he is a man and not a beast. The intelligent agents of +this world are to his mind the men who are alive, and the ghosts the +men who are dead.’ Dr. Codrington speaks of Melanesia; from +what I have learned his words are equally true of the Polynesian. +And yet more. Among cannibal Polynesians a dreadful suspicion +rests generally on the dead; and the Marquesans, the greatest cannibals +of all, are scarce likely to be free from similar beliefs. I hazard +the guess that the Vehinehae are the hungry spirits of the dead, continuing +their life’s business of the cannibal ambuscade, and lying everywhere +unseen, and eager to devour the living. Another superstition I +picked up through the troubled medium of Tari Coffin’s English. +The dead, he told me, came and danced by night around the paepae of +their former family; the family were thereupon overcome by some emotion +(but whether of pious sorrow or of fear I could not gather), and must +‘make a feast,’ of which fish, pig, and popoi were indispensable +ingredients. So far this is clear enough. But here Tari +went on to instance the new house of Toma and the house-warming feast +which was just then in preparation as instances in point. Dare +we indeed string them together, and add the case of the deserted ruin, +as though the dead continually besieged the paepaes of the living: were +kept at arm’s-length, even from the first foundation, only by +propitiatory feasts, and, so soon as the fire of life went out upon +the hearth, swarmed back into possession of their ancient seat?<br> +<br> +I speak by guess of these Marquesan superstitions. On the cannibal +ghost I shall return elsewhere with certainty. And it is enough, +for the present purpose, to remark that the men of the Marquesas, from +whatever reason, fear and shrink from the presence of ghosts. +Conceive how this must tell upon the nerves in islands where the number +of the dead already so far exceeds that of the living, and the dead +multiply and the living dwindle at so swift a rate. Conceive how +the remnant huddles about the embers of the fire of life; even as old +Red Indians, deserted on the march and in the snow, the kindly tribe +all gone, the last flame expiring, and the night around populous with +wolves.<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +CHAPTER V - DEPOPULATION<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +Over the whole extent of the South Seas, from one tropic to another, +we find traces of a bygone state of over-population, when the resources +of even a tropical soil were taxed, and even the improvident Polynesian +trembled for the future. We may accept some of the ideas of Mr. +Darwin’s theory of coral islands, and suppose a rise of the sea, +or the subsidence of some former continental area, to have driven into +the tops of the mountains multitudes of refugees. Or we may suppose, +more soberly, a people of sea-rovers, emigrants from a crowded country, +to strike upon and settle island after island, and as time went on to +multiply exceedingly in their new seats. In either case the end +must be the same; soon or late it must grow apparent that the crew are +too numerous, and that famine is at hand. The Polynesians met +this emergent danger with various expedients of activity and prevention. +A way was found to preserve breadfruit by packing it in artificial pits; +pits forty feet in depth and of proportionate bore are still to be seen, +I am told, in the Marquesas; and yet even these were insufficient for +the teeming people, and the annals of the past are gloomy with famine +and cannibalism. Among the Hawaiians - a hardier people, in a +more exacting climate - agriculture was carried far; the land was irrigated +with canals; and the fish-ponds of Molokai prove the number and diligence +of the old inhabitants. Meanwhile, over all the island world, +abortion and infanticide prevailed. On coral atolls, where the +danger was most plainly obvious, these were enforced by law and sanctioned +by punishment. On Vaitupu, in the Ellices, only two children were +allowed to a couple; on Nukufetau, but one. On the latter the +punishment was by fine; and it is related that the fine was sometimes +paid, and the child spared.<br> +<br> +This is characteristic. For no people in the world are so fond +or so long-suffering with children - children make the mirth and the +adornment of their homes, serving them for playthings and for picture-galleries. +‘Happy is the man that has his quiver full of them.’ +The stray bastard is contended for by rival families; and the natural +and the adopted children play and grow up together undistinguished. +The spoiling, and I may almost say the deification, of the child, is +nowhere carried so far as in the eastern islands; and furthest, according +to my opportunities of observation, in the Paumotu group, the so-called +Low or Dangerous Archipelago. I have seen a Paumotuan native turn +from me with embarrassment and disaffection because I suggested that +a brat would be the better for a beating. It is a daily matter +in some eastern islands to see a child strike or even stone its mother, +and the mother, so far from punishing, scarce ventures to resist. +In some, when his child was born, a chief was superseded and resigned +his name; as though, like a drone, he had then fulfilled the occasion +of his being. And in some the lightest words of children had the +weight of oracles. Only the other day, in the Marquesas, if a +child conceived a distaste to any stranger, I am assured the stranger +would be slain. And I shall have to tell in another place an instance +of the opposite: how a child in Manihiki having taken a fancy to myself, +her adoptive parents at once accepted the situation and loaded me with +gifts.<br> +<br> +With such sentiments the necessity for child-destruction would not fail +to clash, and I believe we find the trace of divided feeling in the +Tahitian brotherhood of Oro. At a certain date a new god was added +to the Society-Island Olympus, or an old one refurbished and made popular. +Oro was his name, and he may be compared with the Bacchus of the ancients. +His zealots sailed from bay to bay, and from island to island; they +were everywhere received with feasting; wore fine clothes; sang, danced, +acted; gave exhibitions of dexterity and strength; and were the artists, +the acrobats, the bards, and the harlots of the group. Their life +was public and epicurean; their initiation a mystery; and the highest +in the land aspired to join the brotherhood. If a couple stood +next in line to a high-chieftaincy, they were suffered, on grounds of +policy, to spare one child; all other children, who had a father or +a mother in the company of Oro, stood condemned from the moment of conception. +A freemasonry, an agnostic sect, a company of artists, its members all +under oath to spread unchastity, and all forbidden to leave offspring +- I do not know how it may appear to others, but to me the design seems +obvious. Famine menacing the islands, and the needful remedy repulsive, +it was recommended to the native mind by these trappings of mystery, +pleasure, and parade. This is the more probable, and the secret, +serious purpose of the institution appears the more plainly, if it be +true that, after a certain period of life, the obligation of the votary +was changed; at first, bound to be profligate: afterwards, expected +to be chaste.<br> +<br> +Here, then, we have one side of the case. Man-eating among kindly +men, child-murder among child-lovers, industry in a race the most idle, +invention in a race the least progressive, this grim, pagan salvation-army +of the brotherhood of Oro, the report of early voyagers, the widespread +vestiges of former habitation, and the universal tradition of the islands, +all point to the same fact of former crowding and alarm. And to-day +we are face to face with the reverse. To-day in the Marquesas, +in the Eight Islands of Hawaii, in Mangareva, in Easter Island, we find +the same race perishing like flies. Why this change? Or, +grant that the coming of the whites, the change of habits, and the introduction +of new maladies and vices, fully explain the depopulation, why is that +depopulation not universal? The population of Tahiti, after a +period of alarming decrease, has again become stationary. I hear +of a similar result among some Maori tribes; in many of the Paumotus +a slight increase is to be observed; and the Samoans are to-day as healthy +and at least as fruitful as before the change. Grant that the +Tahitians, the Maoris, and the Paumotuans have become inured to the +new conditions; and what are we to make of the Samoans, who have never +suffered?<br> +<br> +Those who are acquainted only with a single group are apt to be ready +with solutions. Thus I have heard the mortality of the Maoris +attributed to their change of residence - from fortified hill-tops to +the low, marshy vicinity of their plantations. How plausible! +And yet the Marquesans are dying out in the same houses where their +fathers multiplied. Or take opium. The Marquesas and Hawaii +are the two groups the most infected with this vice; the population +of the one is the most civilised, that of the other by far the most +barbarous, of Polynesians; and they are two of those that perish the +most rapidly. Here is a strong case against opium. But let +us take unchastity, and we shall find the Marquesas and Hawaii figuring +again upon another count. Thus, Samoans are the most chaste of +Polynesians, and they are to this day entirely fertile; Marquesans are +the most debauched: we have seen how they are perishing; Hawaiians are +notoriously lax, and they begin to be dotted among deserts. So +here is a case stronger still against unchastity; and here also we have +a correction to apply. Whatever the virtues of the Tahitian, neither +friend nor enemy dares call him chaste; and yet he seems to have outlived +the time of danger. One last example: syphilis has been plausibly +credited with much of the sterility. But the Samoans are, by all +accounts, as fruitful as at first; by some accounts more so; and it +is not seriously to be argued that the Samoans have escaped syphilis.<br> +<br> +These examples show how dangerous it is to reason from any particular +cause, or even from many in a single group. I have in my eye an +able and amiable pamphlet by the Rev. S. E. Bishop: ‘Why are the +Hawaiians Dying Out?’ Any one interested in the subject +ought to read this tract, which contains real information; and yet Mr. +Bishop’s views would have been changed by an acquaintance with +other groups. Samoa is, for the moment, the main and the most +instructive exception to the rule. The people are the most chaste +and one of the most temperate of island peoples. They have never +been tried and depressed with any grave pestilence. Their clothing +has scarce been tampered with; at the simple and becoming tabard of +the girls, Tartuffe, in many another island, would have cried out; for +the cool, healthy, and modest lava-lava or kilt, Tartuffe has managed +in many another island to substitute stifling and inconvenient trousers. +Lastly, and perhaps chiefly, so far from their amusements having been +curtailed, I think they have been, upon the whole, extended. The +Polynesian falls easily into despondency: bereavement, disappointment, +the fear of novel visitations, the decay or proscription of ancient +pleasures, easily incline him to be sad; and sadness detaches him from +life. The melancholy of the Hawaiian and the emptiness of his +new life are striking; and the remark is yet more apposite to the Marquesas. +In Samoa, on the other hand, perpetual song and dance, perpetual games, +journeys, and pleasures, make an animated and a smiling picture of the +island life. And the Samoans are to-day the gayest and the best +entertained inhabitants of our planet. The importance of this +can scarcely be exaggerated. In a climate and upon a soil where +a livelihood can be had for the stooping, entertainment is a prime necessity. +It is otherwise with us, where life presents us with a daily problem, +and there is a serious interest, and some of the heat of conflict, in +the mere continuing to be. So, in certain atolls, where there +is no great gaiety, but man must bestir himself with some vigour for +his daily bread, public health and the population are maintained; but +in the lotos islands, with the decay of pleasures, life itself decays. +It is from this point of view that we may instance, among other causes +of depression, the decay of war. We have been so long used in +Europe to that dreary business of war on the great scale, trailing epidemics +and leaving pestilential corpses in its train, that we have almost forgotten +its original, the most healthful, if not the most humane, of all field +sports - hedge-warfare. From this, as well as from the rest of +his amusements and interests, the islander, upon a hundred islands, +has been recently cut off. And to this, as well as to so many +others, the Samoan still makes good a special title.<br> +<br> +Upon the whole, the problem seems to me to stand thus:- Where there +have been fewest changes, important or unimportant, salutary or hurtful, +there the race survives. Where there have been most, important +or unimportant, salutary or hurtful, there it perishes. Each change, +however small, augments the sum of new conditions to which the race +has to become inured. There may seem, <i>a priori</i>, no comparison +between the change from ‘sour toddy’ to bad gin, and that +from the island kilt to a pair of European trousers. Yet I am +far from persuaded that the one is any more hurtful than the other; +and the unaccustomed race will sometimes die of pin-pricks. We +are here face to face with one of the difficulties of the missionary. +In Polynesian islands he easily obtains pre-eminent authority; the king +becomes his <i>mairedupalais</i>; he can proscribe, he can command; +and the temptation is ever towards too much. Thus (by all accounts) +the Catholics in Mangareva, and thus (to my own knowledge) the Protestants +in Hawaii, have rendered life in a more or less degree unliveable to +their converts. And the mild, uncomplaining creatures (like children +in a prison) yawn and await death. It is easy to blame the missionary. +But it is his business to make changes. It is surely his business, +for example, to prevent war; and yet I have instanced war itself as +one of the elements of health. On the other hand, it were, perhaps, +easy for the missionary to proceed more gently, and to regard every +change as an affair of weight. I take the average missionary; +I am sure I do him no more than justice when I suppose that he would +hesitate to bombard a village, even in order to convert an archipelago. +Experience begins to show us (at least in Polynesian islands) that change +of habit is bloodier than a bombardment.<br> +<br> +There is one point, ere I have done, where I may go to meet criticism. +I have said nothing of faulty hygiene, bathing during fevers, mistaken +treatment of children, native doctoring, or abortion - all causes frequently +adduced. And I have said nothing of them because they are conditions +common to both epochs, and even more efficient in the past than in the +present. Was it not the same with unchastity, it may be asked? +Was not the Polynesian always unchaste? Doubtless he was so always: +doubtless he is more so since the coming of his remarkably chaste visitors +from Europe. Take the Hawaiian account of Cook: I have no doubt +it is entirely fair. Take Krusenstern’s candid, almost innocent, +description of a Russian man-of-war at the Marquesas; consider the disgraceful +history of missions in Hawaii itself, where (in the war of lust) the +American missionaries were once shelled by an English adventurer, and +once raided and mishandled by the crew of an American warship; add the +practice of whaling fleets to call at the Marquesas, and carry off a +complement of women for the cruise; consider, besides, how the whites +were at first regarded in the light of demi-gods, as appears plainly +in the reception of Cook upon Hawaii; and again, in the story of the +discovery of Tutuila, when the really decent women of Samoa prostituted +themselves in public to the French; and bear in mind how it was the +custom of the adventurers, and we may almost say the business of the +missionaries, to deride and infract even the most salutary tapus. +Here we see every engine of dissolution directed at once against a virtue +never and nowhere very strong or popular; and the result, even in the +most degraded islands, has been further degradation. Mr. Lawes, +the missionary of Savage Island, told me the standard of female chastity +had declined there since the coming of the whites. In heathen +time, if a girl gave birth to a bastard, her father or brother would +dash the infant down the cliffs; and to-day the scandal would be small. +Or take the Marquesas. Stanislao Moanatini told me that in his +own recollection, the young were strictly guarded; they were not suffered +so much as to look upon one another in the street, but passed (so my +informant put it) like dogs; and the other day the whole school-children +of Nuka-hiva and Ua-pu escaped in a body to the woods, and lived there +for a fortnight in promiscuous liberty. Readers of travels may +perhaps exclaim at my authority, and declare themselves better informed. +I should prefer the statement of an intelligent native like Stanislao +(even if it stood alone, which it is far from doing) to the report of +the most honest traveller. A ship of war comes to a haven, anchors, +lands a party, receives and returns a visit, and the captain writes +a chapter on the manners of the island. It is not considered what +class is mostly seen. Yet we should not be pleased if a Lascar +foremast hand were to judge England by the ladies who parade Ratcliffe +Highway, and the gentlemen who share with them their hire. Stanislao’s +opinion of a decay of virtue even in these unvirtuous islands has been +supported to me by others; his very example, the progress of dissolution +amongst the young, is adduced by Mr. Bishop in Hawaii. And so +far as Marquesans are concerned, we might have hazarded a guess of some +decline in manners. I do not think that any race could ever have +prospered or multiplied with such as now obtain; I am sure they would +have been never at the pains to count paternal kinship. It is +not possible to give details; suffice it that their manners appear to +be imitated from the dreams of ignorant and vicious children, and their +debauches persevered in until energy, reason, and almost life itself +are in abeyance.<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +CHAPTER VI - CHIEFS AND TAPUS<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +We used to admire exceedingly the bland and gallant manners of the chief +called Taipi-Kikino. An elegant guest at table, skilled in the +use of knife and fork, a brave figure when he shouldered a gun and started +for the woods after wild chickens, always serviceable, always ingratiating +and gay, I would sometimes wonder where he found his cheerfulness. +He had enough to sober him, I thought, in his official budget. +His expenses - for he was always seen attired in virgin white - must +have by far exceeded his income of six dollars in the year, or say two +shillings a month. And he was himself a man of no substance; his +house the poorest in the village. It was currently supposed that +his elder brother, Kauanui, must have helped him out. But how +comes it that the elder brother should succeed to the family estate, +and be a wealthy commoner, and the younger be a poor man, and yet rule +as chief in Anaho? That the one should be wealthy, and the other +almost indigent is probably to be explained by some adoption; for comparatively +few children are brought up in the house or succeed to the estates of +their natural begetters. That the one should be chief instead +of the other must be explained (in a very Irish fashion) on the ground +that neither of them is a chief at all.<br> +<br> +Since the return and the wars of the French, many chiefs have been deposed, +and many so-called chiefs appointed. We have seen, in the same +house, one such upstart drinking in the company of two such extruded +island Bourbons, men, whose word a few years ago was life and death, +now sunk to be peasants like their neighbours. So when the French +overthrew hereditary tyrants, dubbed the commons of the Marquesas freeborn +citizens of the republic, and endowed them with a vote for a <i>conseiller-général</i> +at Tahiti, they probably conceived themselves upon the path to popularity; +and so far from that, they were revolting public sentiment. The +deposition of the chiefs was perhaps sometimes needful; the appointment +of others may have been needful also; it was at least a delicate business. +The Government of George II. exiled many Highland magnates. It +never occurred to them to manufacture substitutes; and if the French +have been more bold, we have yet to see with what success.<br> +<br> +Our chief at Anaho was always called, he always called himself, Taipi-Kikino; +and yet that was not his name, but only the wand of his false position. +As soon as he was appointed chief, his name - which signified, if I +remember exactly, <i>Prince born among</i> <i>flowers</i> - fell in +abeyance, and he was dubbed instead by the expressive byword, Taipi-Kikino +- <i>Highwater man-of-no-account</i> - or, Englishing more boldly, <i>Beggar</i> +<i>on horseback</i> - a witty and a wicked cut. A nickname in +Polynesia destroys almost the memory of the original name. To-day, +if we were Polynesians, Gladstone would be no more heard of. We +should speak of and address our Nestor as the Grand Old Man, and it +is so that himself would sign his correspondence. Not the prevalence, +then, but the significancy of the nickname is to be noted here. +The new authority began with small prestige. Taipi has now been +some time in office; from all I saw he seemed a person very fit. +He is not the least unpopular, and yet his power is nothing. He +is a chief to the French, and goes to breakfast with the Resident; but +for any practical end of chieftaincy a rag doll were equally efficient.<br> +<br> +We had been but three days in Anaho when we received the visit of the +chief of Hatiheu, a man of weight and fame, late leader of a war upon +the French, late prisoner in Tahiti, and the last eater of long-pig +in Nuka-hiva. Not many years have elapsed since he was seen striding +on the beach of Anaho, a dead man’s arm across his shoulder. +‘So does Kooamua to his enemies!’ he roared to the passers-by, +and took a bite from the raw flesh. And now behold this gentleman, +very wisely replaced in office by the French, paying us a morning visit +in European clothes. He was the man of the most character we had +yet seen: his manners genial and decisive, his person tall, his face +rugged, astute, formidable, and with a certain similarity to Mr. Gladstone’s +- only for the brownness of the skin, and the high-chief’s tattooing, +all one side and much of the other being of an even blue. Further +acquaintance increased our opinion of his sense. He viewed the +<i>Casco</i> in a manner then quite new to us, examining her lines and +the running of the gear; to a piece of knitting on which one of the +party was engaged, he must have devoted ten minutes’ patient study; +nor did he desist before he had divined the principles; and he was interested +even to excitement by a type-writer, which he learned to work. +When he departed he carried away with him a list of his family, with +his own name printed by his own hand at the bottom. I should add +that he was plainly much of a humorist, and not a little of a humbug. +He told us, for instance, that he was a person of exact sobriety; such +being the obligation of his high estate: the commons might be sots, +but the chief could not stoop so low. And not many days after +he was to be observed in a state of smiling and lop-sided imbecility, +the <i>Casco</i> ribbon upside down on his dishonoured hat.<br> +<br> +But his business that morning in Anaho is what concerns us here. +The devil-fish, it seems, were growing scarce upon the reef; it was +judged fit to interpose what we should call a close season; for that +end, in Polynesia, a tapu (vulgarly spelt ‘taboo’) has to +be declared, and who was to declare it? Taipi might; he ought; +it was a chief part of his duty; but would any one regard the inhibition +of a Beggar on Horse-back? He might plant palm branches: it did +not in the least follow that the spot was sacred. He might recite +the spell: it was shrewdly supposed the spirits would not hearken. +And so the old, legitimate cannibal must ride over the mountains to +do it for him; and the respectable official in white clothes could but +look on and envy. At about the same time, though in a different +manner, Kooamua established a forest law. It was observed the +cocoa-palms were suffering, for the plucking of green nuts impoverishes +and at last endangers the tree. Now Kooamua could tapu the reef, +which was public property, but he could not tapu other people’s +palms; and the expedient adopted was interesting. He tapu’d +his own trees, and his example was imitated over all Hatiheu and Anaho. +I fear Taipi might have tapu’d all that he possessed and found +none to follow him. So much for the esteem in which the dignity +of an appointed chief is held by others; a single circumstance will +show what he thinks of it himself. I never met one, but he took +an early opportunity to explain his situation. True, he was only +an appointed chief when I beheld him; but somewhere else, perhaps upon +some other isle, he was a chieftain by descent: upon which ground, he +asked me (so to say it) to excuse his mushroom honours.<br> +<br> +It will be observed with surprise that both these tapus are for thoroughly +sensible ends. With surprise, I say, because the nature of that +institution is much misunderstood in Europe. It is taken usually +in the sense of a meaningless or wanton prohibition, such as that which +to-day prevents women in some countries from smoking, or yesterday prevented +any one in Scotland from taking a walk on Sunday. The error is +no less natural than it is unjust. The Polynesians have not been +trained in the bracing, practical thought of ancient Rome; with them +the idea of law has not been disengaged from that of morals or propriety; +so that tapu has to cover the whole field, and implies indifferently +that an act is criminal, immoral, against sound public policy, unbecoming +or (as we say) ‘not in good form.’ Many tapus were +in consequence absurd enough, such as those which deleted words out +of the language, and particularly those which related to women. +Tapu encircled women upon all hands. Many things were forbidden +to men; to women we may say that few were permitted. They must +not sit on the paepae; they must not go up to it by the stair; they +must not eat pork; they must not approach a boat; they must not cook +at a fire which any male had kindled. The other day, after the +roads were made, it was observed the women plunged along margin through +the bush, and when they came to a bridge waded through the water: roads +and bridges were the work of men’s hands, and tapu for the foot +of women. Even a man’s saddle, if the man be native, is +a thing no self-respecting lady dares to use. Thus on the Anaho +side of the island, only two white men, Mr. Regler and the gendarme, +M. Aussel, possess saddles; and when a woman has a journey to make she +must borrow from one or other. It will be noticed that these prohibitions +tend, most of them, to an increased reserve between the sexes. +Regard for female chastity is the usual excuse for these disabilities +that men delight to lay upon their wives and mothers. Here the +regard is absent; and behold the women still bound hand and foot with +meaningless proprieties! The women themselves, who are survivors +of the old regimen, admit that in those days life was not worth living. +And yet even then there were exceptions. There were female chiefs +and (I am assured) priestesses besides; nice customs curtseyed to great +dames, and in the most sacred enclosure of a High Place, Father Siméon +Delmar was shown a stone, and told it was the throne of some well-descended +lady. How exactly parallel is this with European practice, when +princesses were suffered to penetrate the strictest cloister, and women +could rule over a land in which they were denied the control of their +own children.<br> +<br> +But the tapu is more often the instrument of wise and needful restrictions. +We have seen it as the organ of paternal government. It serves +besides to enforce, in the rare case of some one wishing to enforce +them, rights of private property. Thus a man, weary of the coming +and going of Marquesan visitors, tapus his door; and to this day you +may see the palm-branch signal, even as our great-grandfathers saw the +peeled wand before a Highland inn. Or take another case. +Anaho is known as ‘the country without popoi.’ The +word popoi serves in different islands to indicate the main food of +the people: thus, in Hawaii, it implies a preparation of taro; in the +Marquesas, of breadfruit. And a Marquesan does not readily conceive +life possible without his favourite diet. A few years ago a drought +killed the breadfruit trees and the bananas in the district of Anaho; +and from this calamity, and the open-handed customs of the island, a +singular state of things arose. Well-watered Hatiheu had escaped +the drought; every householder of Anaho accordingly crossed the pass, +chose some one in Hatiheu, ‘gave him his name’ - an onerous +gift, but one not to be rejected - and from this improvised relative +proceeded to draw his supplies, for all the world as though he had paid +for them. Hence a continued traffic on the road. Some stalwart +fellow, in a loin-cloth, and glistening with sweat, may be seen at all +hours of the day, a stick across his bare shoulders, tripping nervously +under a double burthen of green fruits. And on the far side of +the gap a dozen stone posts on the wayside in the shadow of a grove +mark the breathing-space of the popoi-carriers. A little back +from the beach, and not half a mile from Anaho, I was the more amazed +to find a cluster of well-doing breadfruits heavy with their harvest. +‘Why do you not take these?’ I asked. ‘Tapu,’ +said Hoka; and I thought to myself (after the manner of dull travellers) +what children and fools these people were to toil over the mountain +and despoil innocent neighbours when the staff of life was thus growing +at their door. I was the more in error. In the general destruction +these surviving trees were enough only for the family of the proprietor, +and by the simple expedient of declaring a tapu he enforced his right.<br> +<br> +The sanction of the tapu is superstitious; and the punishment of infraction +either a wasting or a deadly sickness. A slow disease follows +on the eating of tapu fish, and can only be cured with the bones of +the same fish burned with the due mysteries. The cocoa-nut and +breadfruit tapu works more swiftly. Suppose you have eaten tapu +fruit at the evening meal, at night your sleep will be uneasy; in the +morning, swelling and a dark discoloration will have attacked your neck, +whence they spread upward to the face; and in two days, unless the cure +be interjected, you must die. This cure is prepared from the rubbed +leaves of the tree from which the patient stole; so that he cannot be +saved without confessing to the Tahuku the person whom he wronged. +In the experience of my informant, almost no tapu had been put in use, +except the two described: he had thus no opportunity to learn the nature +and operation of the others; and, as the art of making them was jealously +guarded amongst the old men, he believed the mystery would soon die +out. I should add that he was no Marquesan, but a Chinaman, a +resident in the group from boyhood, and a reverent believer in the spells +which he described. White men, amongst whom Ah Fu included himself, +were exempt; but he had a tale of a Tahitian woman, who had come to +the Marquesas, eaten tapu fish, and, although uninformed of her offence +and danger, had been afflicted and cured exactly like a native.<br> +<br> +Doubtless the belief is strong; doubtless, with this weakly and fanciful +race, it is in many cases strong enough to kill; it should be strong +indeed in those who tapu their trees secretly, so that they may detect +a depredator by his sickness. Or, perhaps, we should understand +the idea of the hidden tapu otherwise, as a politic device to spread +uneasiness and extort confessions: so that, when a man is ailing, he +shall ransack his brain for any possible offence, and send at once for +any proprietor whose rights he has invaded. ‘Had you hidden +a tapu?’ we may conceive him asking; and I cannot imagine the +proprietor gainsaying it; and this is perhaps the strangest feature +of the system - that it should be regarded from without with such a +mental and implicit awe, and, when examined from within, should present +so many apparent evidences of design.<br> +<br> +We read in Dr. Campbell’s <i>Poenamo</i> of a New Zealand girl, +who was foolishly told that she had eaten a tapu yam, and who instantly +sickened, and died in the two days of simple terror. The period +is the same as in the Marquesas; doubtless the symptoms were so too. +How singular to consider that a superstition of such sway is possibly +a manufactured article; and that, even if it were not originally invented, +its details have plainly been arranged by the authorities of some Polynesian +Scotland Yard. Fitly enough, the belief is to-day - and was probably +always - far from universal. Hell at home is a strong deterrent +with some; a passing thought with others; with others, again, a theme +of public mockery, not always well assured; and so in the Marquesas +with the tapu. Mr. Regler has seen the two extremes of scepticism +and implicit fear. In the tapu grove he found one fellow stealing +breadfruit, cheerful and impudent as a street arab; and it was only +on a menace of exposure that he showed himself the least discountenanced. +The other case was opposed in every point. Mr. Regler asked a +native to accompany him upon a voyage; the man went gladly enough, but +suddenly perceiving a dead tapu fish in the bottom of the boat, leaped +back with a scream; nor could the promise of a dollar prevail upon him +to advance.<br> +<br> +The Marquesan, it will be observed, adheres to the old idea of the local +circumscription of beliefs and duties. Not only are the whites +exempt from consequences; but their transgressions seem to be viewed +without horror. It was Mr. Regler who had killed the fish; yet +the devout native was not shocked at Mr. Regler - only refused to join +him in his boat. A white is a white: the servant (so to speak) +of other and more liberal gods; and not to be blamed if he profit by +his liberty. The Jews were perhaps the first to interrupt this +ancient comity of faiths; and the Jewish virus is still strong in Christianity. +All the world must respect our tapus, or we gnash our teeth.<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +CHAPTER VII - HATIHEU<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +The bays of Anaho and Hatiheu are divided at their roots by the knife-edge +of a single hill - the pass so often mentioned; but this isthmus expands +to the seaward in a considerable peninsula: very bare and grassy; haunted +by sheep and, at night and morning, by the piercing cries of the shepherds; +wandered over by a few wild goats; and on its sea-front indented with +long, clamorous caves, and faced with cliffs of the colour and ruinous +outline of an old peat-stack. In one of these echoing and sunless +gullies we saw, clustered like sea-birds on a splashing ledge, shrill +as sea-birds in their salutation to the passing boat, a group of fisherwomen, +stripped to their gaudy under-clothes. (The clash of the surf +and the thin female voices echo in my memory.) We had that day +a native crew and steersman, Kauanui; it was our first experience of +Polynesian seamanship, which consists in hugging every point of land. +There is no thought in this of saving time, for they will pull a long +way in to skirt a point that is embayed. It seems that, as they +can never get their houses near enough the surf upon the one side, so +they can never get their boats near enough upon the other. The +practice in bold water is not so dangerous as it looks - the reflex +from the rocks sending the boat off. Near beaches with a heavy +run of sea, I continue to think it very hazardous, and find the composure +of the natives annoying to behold. We took unmingled pleasure, +on the way out, to see so near at hand the beach and the wonderful colours +of the surf. On the way back, when the sea had risen and was running +strong against us, the fineness of the steersman’s aim grew more +embarrassing. As we came abreast of the sea-front, where the surf +broke highest, Kauanui embraced the occasion to light his pipe, which +then made the circuit of the boat - each man taking a whiff or two, +and, ere he passed it on, filling his lungs and cheeks with smoke. +Their faces were all puffed out like apples as we came abreast of the +cliff foot, and the bursting surge fell back into the boat in showers. +At the next point ‘cocanetti’ was the word, and the stroke +borrowed my knife, and desisted from his labours to open nuts. +These untimely indulgences may be compared to the tot of grog served +out before a ship goes into action.<br> +<br> +My purpose in this visit led me first to the boys’ school, for +Hatiheu is the university of the north islands. The hum of the +lesson came out to meet us. Close by the door, where the draught +blew coolest, sat the lay brother; around him, in a packed half-circle, +some sixty high-coloured faces set with staring eyes; and in the background +of the barn-like room benches were to be seen, and blackboards with +sums on them in chalk. The brother rose to greet us, sensibly +humble. Thirty years he had been there, he said, and fingered +his white locks as a bashful child pulls out his pinafore. <i>‘Et +point de résultats, monsieur, presque pas de résultats</i>.’ +He pointed to the scholars: ‘You see, sir, all the youth of Nuka-hiva +and Ua-pu. Between the ages of six and fifteen this is all that +remains; and it is but a few years since we had a hundred and twenty +from Nuka-hiva alone. <i>Oui, monsieur, cela se dépérit</i>.’ +Prayers, and reading and writing, prayers again and arithmetic, and +more prayers to conclude: such appeared to be the dreary nature of the +course. For arithmetic all island people have a natural taste. +In Hawaii they make good progress in mathematics. In one of the +villages on Majuro, and generally in the Marshall group, the whole population +sit about the trader when he is weighing copra, and each on his own +slate takes down the figures and computes the total. The trader, +finding them so apt, introduced fractions, for which they had been taught +no rule. At first they were quite gravelled but ultimately, by +sheer hard thinking, reasoned out the result, and came one after another +to assure the trader he was right. Not many people in Europe could +have done the like. The course at Hatiheu is therefore less dispiriting +to Polynesians than a stranger might have guessed; and yet how bald +it is at best! I asked the brother if he did not tell them stories, +and he stared at me; if he did not teach them history, and he said, +‘O yes, they had a little Scripture history - from the New Testament’; +and repeated his lamentations over the lack of results. I had +not the heart to put more questions; I could but say it must be very +discouraging, and resist the impulse to add that it seemed also very +natural. He looked up - ‘My days are far spent,’ he +said; ‘heaven awaits me.’ May that heaven forgive +me, but I was angry with the old man and his simple consolation. +For think of his opportunity! The youth, from six to fifteen, +are taken from their homes by Government, centralised at Hatiheu, where +they are supported by a weekly tax of food; and, with the exception +of one month in every year, surrendered wholly to the direction of the +priests. Since the escapade already mentioned the holiday occurs +at a different period for the girls and for the boys; so that a Marquesan +brother and sister meet again, after their education is complete, a +pair of strangers. It is a harsh law, and highly unpopular; but +what a power it places in the hands of the instructors, and how languidly +and dully is that power employed by the mission! Too much concern +to make the natives pious, a design in which they all confess defeat, +is, I suppose, the explanation of their miserable system. But +they might see in the girls’ school at Tai-o-hae, under the brisk, +housewifely sisters, a different picture of efficiency, and a scene +of neatness, airiness, and spirited and mirthful occupation that should +shame them into cheerier methods. The sisters themselves lament +their failure. They complain the annual holiday undoes the whole +year’s work; they complain particularly of the heartless indifference +of the girls. Out of so many pretty and apparently affectionate +pupils whom they have taught and reared, only two have ever returned +to pay a visit of remembrance to their teachers. These, indeed, +come regularly, but the rest, so soon as their school-days are over, +disappear into the woods like captive insects. It is hard to imagine +anything more discouraging; and yet I do not believe these ladies need +despair. For a certain interval they keep the girls alive and +innocently busy; and if it be at all possible to save the race, this +would be the means. No such praise can be given to the boys’ +school at Hatiheu. The day is numbered already for them all; alike +for the teacher and the scholars death is girt; he is afoot upon the +march; and in the frequent interval they sit and yawn. But in +life there seems a thread of purpose through the least significant; +the drowsiest endeavour is not lost, and even the school at Hatiheu +may be more useful than it seems.<br> +<br> +Hatiheu is a place of some pretensions. The end of the bay towards +Anaho may be called the civil compound, for it boasts the house of Kooamua, +and close on the beach, under a great tree, that of the gendarme, M. +Armand Aussel, with his garden, his pictures, his books, and his excellent +table, to which strangers are made welcome. No more singular contrast +is possible than between the gendarmerie and the priesthood, who are +besides in smouldering opposition and full of mutual complaints. +A priest’s kitchen in the eastern islands is a depressing spot +to see; and many, or most of them, make no attempt to keep a garden, +sparsely subsisting on their rations. But you will never dine +with a gendarme without smacking your lips; and M. Aussel’s home-made +sausage and the salad from his garden are unforgotten delicacies. +Pierre Loti may like to know that he is M. Aussel’s favourite +author, and that his books are read in the fit scenery of Hatiheu bay.<br> +<br> +The other end is all religious. It is here that an overhanging +and tip-tilted horn, a good sea-mark for Hatiheu, bursts naked from +the verdure of the climbing forest, and breaks down shoreward in steep +taluses and cliffs. From the edge of one of the highest, perhaps +seven hundred or a thousand feet above the beach, a Virgin looks insignificantly +down, like a poor lost doll, forgotten there by a giant child. +This laborious symbol of the Catholics is always strange to Protestants; +we conceive with wonder that men should think it worth while to toil +so many days, and clamber so much about the face of precipices, for +an end that makes us smile; and yet I believe it was the wise Bishop +Dordillon who chose the place, and I know that those who had a hand +in the enterprise look back with pride upon its vanquished dangers. +The boys’ school is a recent importation; it was at first in Tai-o-hae, +beside the girls’; and it was only of late, after their joint +escapade, that the width of the island was interposed between the sexes. +But Hatiheu must have been a place of missionary importance from before. +About midway of the beach no less than three churches stand grouped +in a patch of bananas, intermingled with some pine-apples. Two +are of wood: the original church, now in disuse; and a second that, +for some mysterious reason, has never been used. The new church +is of stone, with twin towers, walls flangeing into buttresses, and +sculptured front. The design itself is good, simple, and shapely; +but the character is all in the detail, where the architect has bloomed +into the sculptor. It is impossible to tell in words of the angels +(although they are more like winged archbishops) that stand guard upon +the door, of the cherubs in the corners, of the scapegoat gargoyles, +or the quaint and spirited relief, where St. Michael (the artist’s +patron) makes short work of a protesting Lucifer. We were never +weary of viewing the imagery, so innocent, sometimes so funny, and yet +in the best sense - in the sense of inventive gusto and expression - +so artistic. I know not whether it was more strange to find a +building of such merit in a corner of a barbarous isle, or to see a +building so antique still bright with novelty. The architect, +a French lay brother, still alive and well, and meditating fresh foundations, +must have surely drawn his descent from a master-builder in the age +of the cathedrals; and it was in looking on the church of Hatiheu that +I seemed to perceive the secret charm of mediaeval sculpture; that combination +of the childish courage of the amateur, attempting all things, like +the schoolboy on his slate, with the manly perseverance of the artist +who does not know when he is conquered.<br> +<br> +I had always afterwards a strong wish to meet the architect, Brother +Michel; and one day, when I was talking with the Resident in Tai-o-hae +(the chief port of the island), there were shown in to us an old, worn, +purblind, ascetic-looking priest, and a lay brother, a type of all that +is most sound in France, with a broad, clever, honest, humorous countenance, +an eye very large and bright, and a strong and healthy body inclining +to obesity. But that his blouse was black and his face shaven +clean, you might pick such a man to-day, toiling cheerfully in his own +patch of vines, from half a dozen provinces of France; and yet he had +always for me a haunting resemblance to an old kind friend of my boyhood, +whom I name in case any of my readers should share with me that memory +- Dr. Paul, of the West Kirk. Almost at the first word I was sure +it was my architect, and in a moment we were deep in a discussion of +Hatiheu church. Brother Michel spoke always of his labours with +a twinkle of humour, underlying which it was possible to spy a serious +pride, and the change from one to another was often very human and diverting. +‘<i>Et vos gargouilles</i> <i>moyen-âge</i>,’ cried +I; ‘<i>comme elles sont originates</i>!’ ‘<i>N’est</i>-<i>ce +pas? Elles sont bien drôles</i>!’ he said, smiling +broadly; and the next moment, with a sudden gravity: ‘<i>Cependant +il y en a une qui a une patte de cassé</i>; <i>il faut que je +voie</i> <i>cela</i>.’ I asked if he had any model - a point +we much discussed. ‘<i>Non</i>,’ said he simply; ‘<i>c’est +une église idéale</i>.’ The relievo was his +favourite performance, and very justly so. The angels at the door, +he owned, he would like to destroy and replace. ‘<i>Ils +n’ont pas de vie, ils</i> <i>manquent de vie. Vous devriez +voir mon église à la Dominique; j’ai là une +Vierge qui est vraiment gentille</i>.’ ‘Ah,’ +I cried, ‘they told me you had said you would never build another +church, and I wrote in my journal I could not believe it.’ +‘<i>Oui, j’aimerais bien en fairs une autre</i>,’ +he confessed, and smiled at the confession. An artist will understand +how much I was attracted by this conversation. There is no bond +so near as a community in that unaffected interest and slightly shame-faced +pride which mark the intelligent man enamoured of an art. He sees +the limitations of his aim, the defects of his practice; he smiles to +be so employed upon the shores of death, yet sees in his own devotion +something worthy. Artists, if they had the same sense of humour +with the Augurs, would smile like them on meeting, but the smile would +not be scornful.<br> +<br> +I had occasion to see much of this excellent man. He sailed with +us from Tai-o-hae to Hiva-oa, a dead beat of ninety miles against a +heavy sea. It was what is called a good passage, and a feather +in the <i>Casco’s</i> cap; but among the most miserable forty +hours that any one of us had ever passed. We were swung and tossed +together all that time like shot in a stage thunder-box. The mate +was thrown down and had his head cut open; the captain was sick on deck; +the cook sick in the galley. Of all our party only two sat down +to dinner. I was one. I own that I felt wretchedly; and +I can only say of the other, who professed to feel quite well, that +she fled at an early moment from the table. It was in these circumstances +that we skirted the windward shore of that indescribable island of Ua-pu; +viewing with dizzy eyes the coves, the capes, the breakers, the climbing +forests, and the inaccessible stone needles that surmount the mountains. +The place persists, in a dark corner of our memories, like a piece of +the scenery of nightmares. The end of this distressful passage, +where we were to land our passengers, was in a similar vein of roughness. +The surf ran high on the beach at Taahauku; the boat broached-to and +capsized; and all hands were submerged. Only the brother himself, +who was well used to the experience, skipped ashore, by some miracle +of agility, with scarce a sprinkling. Thenceforward, during our +stay at Hiva-oa, he was our cicerone and patron; introducing us, taking +us excursions, serving us in every way, and making himself daily more +beloved.<br> +<br> +Michel Blanc had been a carpenter by trade; had made money and retired, +supposing his active days quite over; and it was only when he found +idleness dangerous that he placed his capital and acquirements at the +service of the mission. He became their carpenter, mason, architect, +and engineer; added sculpture to his accomplishments, and was famous +for his skill in gardening. He wore an enviable air of having +found a port from life’s contentions and lying there strongly +anchored; went about his business with a jolly simplicity; complained +of no lack of results - perhaps shyly thinking his own statuary result +enough; and was altogether a pattern of the missionary layman.<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +CHAPTER VIII - THE PORT OF ENTRY<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +The port - the mart, the civil and religious capital of these rude islands +- is called Tai-o-hae, and lies strung along the beach of a precipitous +green bay in Nuka-hiva. It was midwinter when we came thither, +and the weather was sultry, boisterous, and inconstant. Now the +wind blew squally from the land down gaps of splintered precipice; now, +between the sentinel islets of the entry, it came in gusts from seaward. +Heavy and dark clouds impended on the summits; the rain roared and ceased; +the scuppers of the mountain gushed; and the next day we would see the +sides of the amphitheatre bearded with white falls. Along the +beach the town shows a thin file of houses, mostly white, and all ensconced +in the foliage of an avenue of green puraos; a pier gives access from +the sea across the belt of breakers; to the eastward there stands, on +a projecting bushy hill, the old fort which is now the calaboose, or +prison; eastward still, alone in a garden, the Residency flies the colours +of France. Just off Calaboose Hill, the tiny Government schooner +rides almost permanently at anchor, marks eight bells in the morning +(there or thereabout) with the unfurling of her flag, and salutes the +setting sun with the report of a musket.<br> +<br> +Here dwell together, and share the comforts of a club (which may be +enumerated as a billiard-board, absinthe, a map of the world on Mercator’s +projection, and one of the most agreeable verandahs in the tropics), +a handful of whites of varying nationality, mostly French officials, +German and Scottish merchant clerks, and the agents of the opium monopoly. +There are besides three tavern-keepers, the shrewd Scot who runs the +cotton gin-mill, two white ladies, and a sprinkling of people ‘on +the beach’ - a South Sea expression for which there is no exact +equivalent. It is a pleasant society, and a hospitable. +But one man, who was often to be seen seated on the logs at the pier-head, +merits a word for the singularity of his history and appearance. +Long ago, it seems, he fell in love with a native lady, a High Chiefess +in Ua-pu. She, on being approached, declared she could never marry +a man who was untattooed; it looked so naked; whereupon, with some greatness +of soul, our hero put himself in the hands of the Tahukus, and, with +still greater, persevered until the process was complete. He had +certainly to bear a great expense, for the Tahuku will not work without +reward; and certainly exquisite pain. Kooamua, high chief as he +was, and one of the old school, was only part tattooed; he could not, +he told us with lively pantomime, endure the torture to an end. +Our enamoured countryman was more resolved; he was tattooed from head +to foot in the most approved methods of the art; and at last presented +himself before his mistress a new man. The fickle fair one could +never behold him from that day except with laughter. For my part, +I could never see the man without a kind of admiration; of him it might +be said, if ever of any, that he had loved not wisely, but too well.<br> +<br> +The Residency stands by itself, Calaboose Hill screening it from the +fringe of town along the further bay. The house is commodious, +with wide verandahs; all day it stands open, back and front, and the +trade blows copiously over its bare floors. On a week-day the +garden offers a scene of most untropical animation, half a dozen convicts +toiling there cheerfully with spade and barrow, and touching hats and +smiling to the visitor like old attached family servants. On Sunday +these are gone, and nothing to be seen but dogs of all ranks and sizes +peacefully slumbering in the shady grounds; for the dogs of Tai-o-hae +are very courtly-minded, and make the seat of Government their promenade +and place of siesta. In front and beyond, a strip of green down +loses itself in a low wood of many species of acacia; and deep in the +wood a ruinous wall encloses the cemetery of the Europeans. English +and Scottish sleep there, and Scandinavians, and French <i>maîtres +de manoeuvres</i> and <i>maîtres ouvriers</i>: mingling alien +dust. Back in the woods, perhaps, the blackbird, or (as they call +him there) the island nightingale, will be singing home strains; and +the ceaseless requiem of the surf hangs on the ear. I have never +seen a resting-place more quiet; but it was a long thought how far these +sleepers had all travelled, and from what diverse homes they had set +forth, to lie here in the end together.<br> +<br> +On the summit of its promontory hill, the calaboose stands all day with +doors and window-shutters open to the trade. On my first visit +a dog was the only guardian visible. He, indeed, rose with an +attitude so menacing that I was glad to lay hands on an old barrel-hoop; +and I think the weapon must have been familiar, for the champion instantly +retreated, and as I wandered round the court and through the building, +I could see him, with a couple of companions, humbly dodging me about +the corners. The prisoners’ dormitory was a spacious, airy +room, devoid of any furniture; its whitewashed walls covered with inscriptions +in Marquesan and rude drawings: one of the pier, not badly done; one +of a murder; several of French soldiers in uniform. There was +one legend in French: ‘<i>Je n’est</i>’ (sic) ‘<i>pas +le sou</i>.’ From this noontide quietude it must not be +supposed the prison was untenanted; the calaboose at Tai-o-hae does +a good business. But some of its occupants were gardening at the +Residency, and the rest were probably at work upon the streets, as free +as our scavengers at home, although not so industrious. On the +approach of evening they would be called in like children from play; +and the harbour-master (who is also the jailer) would go through the +form of locking them up until six the next morning. Should a prisoner +have any call in town, whether of pleasure or affairs, he has but to +unhook the window-shutters; and if he is back again, and the shutter +decently replaced, by the hour of call on the morrow, he may have met +the harbour-master in the avenue, and there will be no complaint, far +less any punishment. But this is not all. The charming French +Resident, M. Delaruelle, carried me one day to the calaboose on an official +visit. In the green court, a very ragged gentleman, his legs deformed +with the island elephantiasis, saluted us smiling. ‘One +of our political prisoners - an insurgent from Raiatea,’ said +the Resident; and then to the jailer: ‘I thought I had ordered +him a new pair of trousers.’ Meanwhile no other convict +was to be seen - ‘<i>Eh bien</i>,’ said the Resident<i>, +‘où sont vos prisonniers</i>?’ ‘<i>Monsieur +le Résident</i>,’ replied the jailer, saluting with soldierly +formality, <i>‘comme c’est jour de fête, je les ai +laissé aller à la chasse</i>.’ They were all +upon the mountains hunting goats! Presently we came to the quarters +of the women, likewise deserted - ‘<i>Où</i> <i>sont vos +bonnes femmes</i>?’ asked the Resident; and the jailer cheerfully +responded: ‘<i>Je crois, Monsieur le Résident, qu’elles +sont allées quelquepart faire une visite</i>.’ It +had been the design of M. Delaruelle, who was much in love with the +whimsicalities of his small realm, to elicit something comical; but +not even he expected anything so perfect as the last. To complete +the picture of convict life in Tai-o-hae, it remains to be added that +these criminals draw a salary as regularly as the President of the Republic. +Ten sous a day is their hire. Thus they have money, food, shelter, +clothing, and, I was about to write, their liberty. The French +are certainly a good-natured people, and make easy masters. They +are besides inclined to view the Marquesans with an eye of humorous +indulgence. ‘They are dying, poor devils!’ said M. +Delaruelle: ‘the main thing is to let them die in peace.’ +And it was not only well said, but I believe expressed the general thought. +Yet there is another element to be considered; for these convicts are +not merely useful, they are almost essential to the French existence. +With a people incurably idle, dispirited by what can only be called +endemic pestilence, and inflamed with ill-feeling against their new +masters, crime and convict labour are a godsend to the Government.<br> +<br> +Theft is practically the sole crime. Originally petty pilferers, +the men of Tai-o-hae now begin to force locks and attack strong-boxes. +Hundreds of dollars have been taken at a time; though, with that redeeming +moderation so common in Polynesian theft, the Marquesan burglar will +always take a part and leave a part, sharing (so to speak) with the +proprietor. If it be Chilian coin - the island currency - he will +escape; if the sum is in gold, French silver, or bank-notes, the police +wait until the money begins to come in circulation, and then easily +pick out their man. And now comes the shameful part. In +plain English, the prisoner is tortured until he confesses and (if that +be possible) restores the money. To keep him alone, day and night, +in the black hole, is to inflict on the Marquesan torture inexpressible. +Even his robberies are carried on in the plain daylight, under the open +sky, with the stimulus of enterprise, and the countenance of an accomplice; +his terror of the dark is still insurmountable; conceive, then, what +he endures in his solitary dungeon; conceive how he longs to confess, +become a full-fledged convict, and be allowed to sleep beside his comrades. +While we were in Tai-o-hae a thief was under prevention. He had +entered a house about eight in the morning, forced a trunk, and stolen +eleven hundred francs; and now, under the horrors of darkness, solitude, +and a bedevilled cannibal imagination, he was reluctantly confessing +and giving up his spoil. From one cache, which he had already +pointed out, three hundred francs had been recovered, and it was expected +that he would presently disgorge the rest. This would be ugly +enough if it were all; but I am bound to say, because it is a matter +the French should set at rest, that worse is continually hinted. +I heard that one man was kept six days with his arms bound backward +round a barrel; and it is the universal report that every gendarme in +the South Seas is equipped with something in the nature of a thumbscrew. +I do not know this. I never had the face to ask any of the gendarmes +- pleasant, intelligent, and kindly fellows - with whom I have been +intimate, and whose hospitality I have enjoyed; and perhaps the tale +reposes (as I hope it does) on a misconstruction of that ingenious cat’s-cradle +with which the French agent of police so readily secures a prisoner. +But whether physical or moral, torture is certainly employed; and by +a barbarous injustice, the state of accusation (in which a man may very +well be innocently placed) is positively painful; the state of conviction +(in which all are supposed guilty) is comparatively free, and positively +pleasant. Perhaps worse still, - not only the accused, but sometimes +his wife, his mistress, or his friend, is subjected to the same hardships. +I was admiring, in the tapu system, the ingenuity of native methods +of detection; there is not much to admire in those of the French, and +to lock up a timid child in a dark room, and, if he proved obstinate, +lock up his sister in the next, is neither novel nor humane.<br> +<br> +The main occasion of these thefts is the new vice of opium-eating. +‘Here nobody ever works, and all eat opium,’ said a gendarme; +and Ah Fu knew a woman who ate a dollar’s worth in a day. +The successful thief will give a handful of money to each of his friends, +a dress to a woman, pass an evening in one of the taverns of Tai-o-hae, +during which he treats all comers, produce a big lump of opium, and +retire to the bush to eat and sleep it off. A trader, who did +not sell opium, confessed to me that he was at his wit’s end. +‘I do not sell it, but others do,’ said he. ‘The +natives only work to buy it; if they walk over to me to sell their cotton, +they have just to walk over to some one else to buy their opium with +my money. And why should they be at the bother of two walks? +There is no use talking,’ he added - ‘opium is the currency +of this country.’<br> +<br> +The man under prevention during my stay at Tai-o-hae lost patience while +the Chinese opium-seller was being examined in his presence. ‘Of +course he sold me opium!’ he broke out; ‘all the Chinese +here sell opium. It was only to buy opium that I stole; it is +only to buy opium that anybody steals. And what you ought to do +is to let no opium come here, and no Chinamen.’ This is +precisely what is done in Samoa by a native Government; but the French +have bound their own hands, and for forty thousand francs sold native +subjects to crime and death. This horrid traffic may be said to +have sprung up by accident. It was Captain Hart who had the misfortune +to be the means of beginning it, at a time when his plantations flourished +in the Marquesas, and he found a difficulty in keeping Chinese coolies. +To-day the plantations are practically deserted and the Chinese gone; +but in the meanwhile the natives have learned the vice, the patent brings +in a round sum, and the needy Government at Papeete shut their eyes +and open their pockets. Of course, the patentee is supposed to +sell to Chinamen alone; equally of course, no one could afford to pay +forty thousand francs for the privilege of supplying a scattered handful +of Chinese; and every one knows the truth, and all are ashamed of it. +French officials shake their heads when opium is mentioned; and the +agents of the farmer blush for their employment. Those that live +in glass houses should not throw stones; as a subject of the British +crown, I am an unwilling shareholder in the largest opium business under +heaven. But the British case is highly complicated; it implies +the livelihood of millions; and must be reformed, when it can be reformed +at all, with prudence. This French business, on the other hand, +is a nostrum and a mere excrescence. No native industry was to +be encouraged: the poison is solemnly imported. No native habit +was to be considered: the vice has been gratuitously introduced. +And no creature profits, save the Government at Papeete - the not very +enviable gentlemen who pay them, and the Chinese underlings who do the +dirty work.<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +CHAPTER IX - THE HOUSE OF TEMOANA<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +The history of the Marquesas is, of late years, much confused by the +coming and going of the French. At least twice they have seized +the archipelago, at least once deserted it; and in the meanwhile the +natives pursued almost without interruption their desultory cannibal +wars. Through these events and changing dynasties, a single considerable +figure may be seen to move: that of the high chief, a king, Temoana. +Odds and ends of his history came to my ears: how he was at first a +convert to the Protestant mission; how he was kidnapped or exiled from +his native land, served as cook aboard a whaler, and was shown, for +small charge, in English seaports; how he returned at last to the Marquesas, +fell under the strong and benign influence of the late bishop, extended +his influence in the group, was for a while joint ruler with the prelate, +and died at last the chief supporter of Catholicism and the French. +His widow remains in receipt of two pounds a month from the French Government. +Queen she is usually called, but in the official almanac she figures +as ‘<i>Madame Vaekehu, Grande Chefesse</i>.’ His son +(natural or adoptive, I know not which), Stanislao Moanatini, chief +of Akaui, serves in Tai-o-hae as a kind of Minister of Public Works; +and the daughter of Stanislao is High Chiefess of the southern island +of Tauata. These, then, are the greatest folk of the archipelago; +we thought them also the most estimable. This is the rule in Polynesia, +with few exceptions; the higher the family, the better the man - better +in sense, better in manners, and usually taller and stronger in body. +A stranger advances blindfold. He scrapes acquaintance as he can. +Save the tattoo in the Marquesas, nothing indicates the difference of +rank; and yet almost invariably we found, after we had made them, that +our friends were persons of station. I have said ‘usually +taller and stronger.’ I might have been more absolute, - +over all Polynesia, and a part of Micronesia, the rule holds good; the +great ones of the isle, and even of the village, are greater of bone +and muscle, and often heavier of flesh, than any commoner. The +usual explanation - that the high-born child is more industriously shampooed, +is probably the true one. In New Caledonia, at least, where the +difference does not exist, has never been remarked, the practice of +shampooing seems to be itself unknown. Doctors would be well employed +in a study of the point.<br> +<br> +Vaekehu lives at the other end of the town from the Residency, beyond +the buildings of the mission. Her house is on the European plan: +a table in the midst of the chief room; photographs and religious pictures +on the wall. It commands to either hand a charming vista: through +the front door, a peep of green lawn, scurrying pigs, the pendent fans +of the coco-palm and splendour of the bursting surf: through the back, +mounting forest glades and coronals of precipice. Here, in the +strong thorough-draught, Her Majesty received us in a simple gown of +print, and with no mark of royalty but the exquisite finish of her tattooed +mittens, the elaboration of her manners, and the gentle falsetto in +which all the highly refined among Marquesan ladies (and Vaekehu above +all others) delight to sing their language. An adopted daughter +interpreted, while we gave the news, and rehearsed by name our friends +of Anaho. As we talked, we could see, through the landward door, +another lady of the household at her toilet under the green trees; who +presently, when her hair was arranged, and her hat wreathed with flowers, +appeared upon the back verandah with gracious salutations.<br> +<br> +Vaekehu is very deaf; ‘<i>merci</i>’ is her only word of +French; and I do not know that she seemed clever. An exquisite, +kind refinement, with a shade of quietism, gathered perhaps from the +nuns, was what chiefly struck us. Or rather, upon that first occasion, +we were conscious of a sense as of district-visiting on our part, and +reduced evangelical gentility on the part of our hostess. The +other impression followed after she was more at ease, and came with +Stanislao and his little girl to dine on board the <i>Casco</i>. +She had dressed for the occasion: wore white, which very well became +her strong brown face; and sat among us, eating or smoking her cigarette, +quite cut off from all society, or only now and then included through +the intermediary of her son. It was a position that might have +been ridiculous, and she made it ornamental; making believe to hear +and to be entertained; her face, whenever she met our eyes, lighting +with the smile of good society; her contributions to the talk, when +she made any, and that was seldom, always complimentary and pleasing. +No attention was paid to the child, for instance, but what she remarked +and thanked us for. Her parting with each, when she came to leave, +was gracious and pretty, as had been every step of her behaviour. +When Mrs. Stevenson held out her hand to say good-bye, Vaekehu took +it, held it, and a moment smiled upon her; dropped it, and then, as +upon a kindly after-thought, and with a sort of warmth of condescension, +held out both hands and kissed my wife upon both cheeks. Given +the same relation of years and of rank, the thing would have been so +done on the boards of the <i>Comédie Française</i>; just +so might Madame Brohan have warmed and condescended to Madame Broisat +in the <i>Marquis de Villemer</i>. It was my part to accompany +our guests ashore: when I kissed the little girl good-bye at the pier +steps, Vaekehu gave a cry of gratification, reached down her hand into +the boat, took mine, and pressed it with that flattering softness which +seems the coquetry of the old lady in every quarter of the earth. +The next moment she had taken Stanislao’s arm, and they moved +off along the pier in the moonlight, leaving me bewildered. This +was a queen of cannibals; she was tattooed from hand to foot, and perhaps +the greatest masterpiece of that art now extant, so that a while ago, +before she was grown prim, her leg was one of the sights of Tai-o-hae; +she had been passed from chief to chief; she had been fought for and +taken in war; perhaps, being so great a lady, she had sat on the high +place, and throned it there, alone of her sex, while the drums were +going twenty strong and the priests carried up the blood-stained baskets +of long-pig. And now behold her, out of that past of violence +and sickening feasts, step forth, in her age, a quiet, smooth, elaborate +old lady, such as you might find at home (mittened also, but not often +so well-mannered) in a score of country houses. Only Vaekehu’s +mittens were of dye, not of silk; and they had been paid for, not in +money, but the cooked flesh of men. It came in my mind with a +clap, what she could think of it herself, and whether at heart, perhaps, +she might not regret and aspire after the barbarous and stirring past. +But when I asked Stanislao - ‘Ah!’ said he, ‘she is +content; she is religious, she passes all her days with the sisters.’<br> +<br> +Stanislao (Stanislaos, with the final consonant evaded after the Polynesian +habit) was sent by Bishop Dordillon to South America, and there educated +by the fathers. His French is fluent, his talk sensible and spirited, +and in his capacity of ganger-in-chief, he is of excellent service to +the French. With the prestige of his name and family, and with +the stick when needful, he keeps the natives working and the roads passable. +Without Stanislao and the convicts, I am in doubt what would become +of the present regimen in Nuka-hiva; whether the highways might not +be suffered to close up, the pier to wash away, and the Residency to +fall piecemeal about the ears of impotent officials. And yet though +the hereditary favourer, and one of the chief props of French authority, +he has always an eye upon the past. He showed me where the old +public place had stood, still to be traced by random piles of stone; +told me how great and fine it was, and surrounded on all sides by populous +houses, whence, at the beating of the drums, the folk crowded to make +holiday. The drum-beat of the Polynesian has a strange and gloomy +stimulation for the nerves of all. White persons feel it - at +these precipitate sounds their hearts beat faster; and, according to +old residents, its effect on the natives was extreme. Bishop Dordillon +might entreat; Temoana himself command and threaten; at the note of +the drum wild instincts triumphed. And now it might beat upon +these ruins, and who should assemble? The houses are down, the +people dead, their lineage extinct; and the sweepings and fugitives +of distant bays and islands encamp upon their graves. The decline +of the dance Stanislao especially laments. ‘<i>Chaque pays +a ses coutumes</i>,’ said he; but in the report of any gendarme, +perhaps corruptly eager to increase the number of <i>délits</i> +and the instruments of his own power, custom after custom is placed +on the expurgatorial index. ‘<i>Tenez, une</i> <i>danse +qui n’est pas permise</i>,’ said Stanislao: ‘<i>je +ne sais</i> <i>pas pourquoi, elle est très jolie, elle va comme +ça</i>,’ and sticking his umbrella upright in the road, +he sketched the steps and gestures. All his criticisms of the +present, all his regrets for the past, struck me as temperate and sensible. +The short term of office of the Resident he thought the chief defect +of the administration; that officer having scarce begun to be efficient +ere he was recalled. I thought I gathered, too, that he regarded +with some fear the coming change from a naval to a civil governor. +I am sure at least that I regard it so myself; for the civil servants +of France have never appeared to any foreigner as at all the flower +of their country, while her naval officers may challenge competition +with the world. In all his talk, Stanislao was particular to speak +of his own country as a land of savages; and when he stated an opinion +of his own, it was with some apologetic preface, alleging that he was +‘a savage who had travelled.’ There was a deal, in +this elaborate modesty, of honest pride. Yet there was something +in the precaution that saddened me; and I could not but fear he was +only forestalling a taunt that he had heard too often.<br> +<br> +I recall with interest two interviews with Stanislao. The first +was a certain afternoon of tropic rain, which we passed together in +the verandah of the club; talking at times with heightened voices as +the showers redoubled overhead, passing at times into the billiard-room, +to consult, in the dim, cloudy daylight, that map of the world which +forms its chief adornment. He was naturally ignorant of English +history, so that I had much of news to communicate. The story +of Gordon I told him in full, and many episodes of the Indian Mutiny, +Lucknow, the second battle of Cawn-pore, the relief of Arrah, the death +of poor Spottis-woode, and Sir Hugh Rose’s hotspur, midland campaign. +He was intent to hear; his brown face, strongly marked with small-pox, +kindled and changed with each vicissitude. His eyes glowed with +the reflected light of battle; his questions were many and intelligent, +and it was chiefly these that sent us so often to the map. But +it is of our parting that I keep the strongest sense. We were +to sail on the morrow, and the night had fallen, dark, gusty, and rainy, +when we stumbled up the hill to bid farewell to Stanislao. He +had already loaded us with gifts; but more were waiting. We sat +about the table over cigars and green cocoa-nuts; claps of wind blew +through the house and extinguished the lamp, which was always instantly +relighted with a single match; and these recurrent intervals of darkness +were felt as a relief. For there was something painful and embarrassing +in the kindness of that separation. ‘<i>Ah, vous devriez +rester ici, mon</i> <i>cher ami</i>!’ cried Stanislao. ‘<i>Vous +êtes les gens qu’il faut pour les Kanaques; vous êtes +doux, vous et votre famille</i>; <i>vous seriez obéis dans toutes +les îles</i>.’ We had been civil; not always that, +my conscience told me, and never anything beyond; and all this to-do +is a measure, not of our considerateness, but of the want of it in others. +The rest of the evening, on to Vaekehu’s and back as far as to +the pier, Stanislao walked with my arm and sheltered me with his umbrella; +and after the boat had put off, we could still distinguish, in the murky +darkness, his gestures of farewell. His words, if there were any, +were drowned by the rain and the loud surf.<br> +<br> +I have mentioned presents, a vexed question in the South Seas; and one +which well illustrates the common, ignorant habit of regarding races +in a lump. In many quarters the Polynesian gives only to receive. +I have visited islands where the population mobbed me for all the world +like dogs after the waggon of cat’s-meat; and where the frequent +proposition, ‘You my pleni (friend),’ or (with more of pathos) +‘You all ‘e same my father,’ must be received with +hearty laughter and a shout. And perhaps everywhere, among the +greedy and rapacious, a gift is regarded as a sprat to catch a whale. +It is the habit to give gifts and to receive returns, and such characters, +complying with the custom, will look to it nearly that they do not lose. +But for persons of a different stamp the statement must be reversed. +The shabby Polynesian is anxious till he has received the return gift; +the generous is uneasy until he has made it. The first is disappointed +if you have not given more than he; the second is miserable if he thinks +he has given less than you. This is my experience; if it clash +with that of others, I pity their fortune, and praise mine: the circumstances +cannot change what I have seen, nor lessen what I have received. +And indeed I find that those who oppose me often argue from a ground +of singular presumptions; comparing Polynesians with an ideal person, +compact of generosity and gratitude, whom I never had the pleasure of +encountering; and forgetting that what is almost poverty to us is wealth +almost unthinkable to them. I will give one instance: I chanced +to speak with consideration of these gifts of Stanislao’s with +a certain clever man, a great hater and contemner of Kanakas. +‘Well! what were they?’ he cried. ‘A pack of +old men’s beards. Trash!’ And the same gentleman, +some half an hour later, being upon a different train of thought, dwelt +at length on the esteem in which the Marquesans held that sort of property, +how they preferred it to all others except land, and what fancy prices +it would fetch. Using his own figures, I computed that, in this +commodity alone, the gifts of Vaekehu and Stanislao represented between +two and three hundred dollars; and the queen’s official salary +is of two hundred and forty in the year.<br> +<br> +But generosity on the one hand, and conspicuous meanness on the other, +are in the South Seas, as at home, the exception. It is neither +with any hope of gain, nor with any lively wish to please, that the +ordinary Polynesian chooses and presents his gifts. A plain social +duty lies before him, which he performs correctly, but without the least +enthusiasm. And we shall best understand his attitude of mind, +if we examine our own to the cognate absurdity of marriage presents. +There we give without any special thought of a return; yet if the circumstance +arise, and the return be withheld, we shall judge ourselves insulted. +We give them usually without affection, and almost never with a genuine +desire to please; and our gift is rather a mark of our own status than +a measure of our love to the recipients. So in a great measure +and with the common run of the Polynesians; their gifts are formal; +they imply no more than social recognition; and they are made and reciprocated, +as we pay and return our morning visits. And the practice of marking +and measuring events and sentiments by presents is universal in the +island world. A gift plays with them the part of stamp and seal; +and has entered profoundly into the mind of islanders. Peace and +war, marriage, adoption and naturalisation, are celebrated or declared +by the acceptance or the refusal of gifts; and it is as natural for +the islander to bring a gift as for us to carry a card-case.<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +CHAPTER X - A PORTRAIT AND A STORY<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +I have had occasion several times to name the late bishop, Father Dordillon, +‘Monseigneur,’ as he is still almost universally called, +Vicar-Apostolic of the Marquesas and Bishop of Cambysopolis <i>in partibus</i>. +Everywhere in the islands, among all classes and races, this fine, old, +kindly, cheerful fellow is remembered with affection and respect. +His influence with the natives was paramount. They reckoned him +the highest of men - higher than an admiral; brought him their money +to keep; took his advice upon their purchases; nor would they plant +trees upon their own land till they had the approval of the father of +the islands. During the time of the French exodus he singly represented +Europe, living in the Residency, and ruling by the hand of Temoana. +The first roads were made under his auspices and by his persuasion. +The old road between Hatiheu and Anaho was got under way from either +side on the ground that it would be pleasant for an evening promenade, +and brought to completion by working on the rivalry of the two villages. +The priest would boast in Hatiheu of the progress made in Anaho, and +he would tell the folk of Anaho, ‘If you don’t take care, +your neighbours will be over the hill before you are at the top.’ +It could not be so done to-day; it could then; death, opium, and depopulation +had not gone so far; and the people of Hatiheu, I was told, still vied +with each other in fine attire, and used to go out by families, in the +cool of the evening, boat-sailing and racing in the bay. There +seems some truth at least in the common view, that this joint reign +of Temoana and the bishop was the last and brief golden age of the Marquesas. +But the civil power returned, the mission was packed out of the Residency +at twenty-four hours’ notice, new methods supervened, and the +golden age (whatever it quite was) came to an end. It is the strongest +proof of Father Dordillon’s prestige that it survived, seemingly +without loss, this hasty deposition.<br> +<br> +His method with the natives was extremely mild. Among these barbarous +children he still played the part of the smiling father; and he was +careful to observe, in all indifferent matters, the Marquesan etiquette. +Thus, in the singular system of artificial kinship, the bishop had been +adopted by Vaekehu as a grandson; Miss Fisher, of Hatiheu, as a daughter. +From that day, Monseigneur never addressed the young lady except as +his mother, and closed his letters with the formalities of a dutiful +son. With Europeans he could be strict, even to the extent of +harshness. He made no distinction against heretics, with whom +he was on friendly terms; but the rules of his own Church he would see +observed; and once at least he had a white man clapped in jail for the +desecration of a saint’s day. But even this rigour, so intolerable +to laymen, so irritating to Protestants, could not shake his popularity. +We shall best conceive him by examples nearer home; we may all have +known some divine of the old school in Scotland, a literal Sabbatarian, +a stickler for the letter of the law, who was yet in private modest, +innocent, genial and mirthful. Much such a man, it seems, was +Father Dordillon. And his popularity bore a test yet stronger. +He had the name, and probably deserved it, of a shrewd man in business +and one that made the mission pay. Nothing so much stirs up resentment +as the inmixture in commerce of religious bodies; but even rival traders +spoke well of Monseigneur.<br> +<br> +His character is best portrayed in the story of the days of his decline. +A time came when, from the failure of sight, he must desist from his +literary labours: his Marquesan hymns, grammars, and dictionaries; his +scientific papers, lives of saints, and devotional poetry. He +cast about for a new interest: pitched on gardening, and was to be seen +all day, with spade and water-pot, in his childlike eagerness, actually +running between the borders. Another step of decay, and he must +leave his garden also. Instantly a new occupation was devised, +and he sat in the mission cutting paper flowers and wreaths. His +diocese was not great enough for his activity; the churches of the Marquesas +were papered with his handiwork, and still he must be making more. +‘Ah,’ said he, smiling, ‘when I am dead what a fine +time you will have clearing out my trash!’ He had been dead +about six months; but I was pleased to see some of his trophies still +exposed, and looked upon them with a smile: the tribute (if I have read +his cheerful character aright) which he would have preferred to any +useless tears. Disease continued progressively to disable him; +he who had clambered so stalwartly over the rude rocks of the Marquesas, +bringing peace to warfaring clans, was for some time carried in a chair +between the mission and the church, and at last confined to bed, impotent +with dropsy, and tormented with bed-sores and sciatica. Here he +lay two months without complaint; and on the 11th January 1888, in the +seventy-ninth year of his life, and the thirty-fourth of his labours +in the Marquesas, passed away.<br> +<br> +Those who have a taste for hearing missions, Protestant or Catholic, +decried, must seek their pleasure elsewhere than in my pages. +Whether Catholic or Protestant, with all their gross blots, with all +their deficiency of candour, of humour, and of common sense, the missionaries +are the best and the most useful whites in the Pacific. This is +a subject which will follow us throughout; but there is one part of +it that may conveniently be treated here. The married and the +celibate missionary, each has his particular advantage and defect. +The married missionary, taking him at the best, may offer to the native +what he is much in want of - a higher picture of domestic life; but +the woman at his elbow tends to keep him in touch with Europe and out +of touch with Polynesia, and to perpetuate, and even to ingrain, parochial +decencies far best forgotten. The mind of the female missionary +tends, for instance, to be continually busied about dress. She +can be taught with extreme difficulty to think any costume decent but +that to which she grew accustomed on Clapham Common; and to gratify +this prejudice, the native is put to useless expense, his mind is tainted +with the morbidities of Europe, and his health is set in danger. +The celibate missionary, on the other hand, and whether at best or worst, +falls readily into native ways of life; to which he adds too commonly +what is either a mark of celibate man at large, or an inheritance from +mediaeval saints - I mean slovenly habits and an unclean person. +There are, of course, degrees in this; and the sister (of course, and +all honour to her) is as fresh as a lady at a ball. For the diet +there is nothing to be said - it must amaze and shock the Polynesian +- but for the adoption of native habits there is much. ‘<i>Chaque +pays a ses coutumes</i>,’ said Stanislao; these it is the missionary’s +delicate task to modify; and the more he can do so from within, and +from a native standpoint, the better he will do his work; and here I +think the Catholics have sometimes the advantage; in the Vicariate of +Dordillon, I am sure they had it. I have heard the bishop blamed +for his indulgence to the natives, and above all because he did not +rage with sufficient energy against cannibalism. It was a part +of his policy to live among the natives like an elder brother; to follow +where he could; to lead where it was necessary; never to drive; and +to encourage the growth of new habits, instead of violently rooting +up the old. And it might be better, in the long-run, if this policy +were always followed.<br> +<br> +It might be supposed that native missionaries would prove more indulgent, +but the reverse is found to be the case. The new broom sweeps +clean; and the white missionary of to-day is often embarrassed by the +bigotry of his native coadjutor. What else should we expect? +On some islands, sorcery, polygamy, human sacrifice, and tobacco-smoking +have been prohibited, the dress of the native has been modified, and +himself warned in strong terms against rival sects of Christianity; +all by the same man, at the same period of time, and with the like authority. +By what criterion is the convert to distinguish the essential from the +unessential? He swallows the nostrum whole; there has been no +play of mind, no instruction, and, except for some brute utility in +the prohibitions, no advance. To call things by their proper names, +this is teaching superstition. It is unfortunate to use the word; +so few people have read history, and so many have dipped into little +atheistic manuals, that the majority will rush to a conclusion, and +suppose the labour lost. And far from that: These semi-spontaneous +superstitions, varying with the sect of the original evangelist and +the customs of the island, are found in practice to be highly fructifying; +and in particular those who have learned and who go forth again to teach +them offer an example to the world. The best specimen of the Christian +hero that I ever met was one of these native missionaries. He +had saved two lives at the risk of his own; like Nathan, he had bearded +a tyrant in his hour of blood; when a whole white population fled, he +alone stood to his duty; and his behaviour under domestic sorrow with +which the public has no concern filled the beholder with sympathy and +admiration. A poor little smiling laborious man he looked; and +you would have thought he had nothing in him but that of which indeed +he had too much - facile good-nature.<br> +<br> +It chances that the only rivals of Monseigneur and his mission in the +Marquesas were certain of these brown-skinned evangelists, natives from +Hawaii. I know not what they thought of Father Dordillon: they +are the only class I did not question; but I suspect the prelate to +have regarded them askance, for he was eminently human. During +my stay at Tai-o-hae, the time of the yearly holiday came round at the +girls’ school; and a whole fleet of whale-boats came from Ua-pu +to take the daughters of that island home. On board of these was +Kauwealoha, one of the pastors, a fine, rugged old gentleman, of that +leonine type so common in Hawaii. He paid me a visit in the <i>Casco</i>, +and there entertained me with a tale of one of his colleagues, Kekela, +a missionary in the great cannibal isle of Hiva-oa. It appears +that shortly after a kidnapping visit from a Peruvian slaver, the boats +of an American whaler put into a bay upon that island, were attacked, +and made their escape with difficulty, leaving their mate, a Mr. Whalon, +in the hands of the natives. The captive, with his arms bound +behind his back, was cast into a house; and the chief announced the +capture to Kekela. And here I begin to follow the version of Kauwealoha; +it is a good specimen of Kanaka English; and the reader is to conceive +it delivered with violent emphasis and speaking pantomime.<br> +<br> +‘“I got ‘Melican mate,” the chief he say. +“What you go do ‘Melican mate?” Kekela he say. +“I go make fire, I go kill, I go eat him,” he say; “you +come to-mollow eat piece.” “I no <i>want</i> eat ‘Melican +mate!” Kekela he say; “why you want?” “This +bad shippee, this slave shippee,” the chief he say. “One +time a shippee he come from Pelu, he take away plenty Kanaka, he take +away my son. ‘Melican mate he bad man. I go eat him; +you eat piece.” “I no <i>want</i> eat ‘Melican +mate!” Kekela he say; and he <i>cly</i> - all night he cly! +To-mollow Kekela he get up, he put on blackee coat, he go see chief; +he see Missa Whela, him hand tie’ like this. (<i>Pantomime</i>.) +Kekela he cly. He say chief:- “Chief, you like things of +mine? you like whale-boat?” “Yes,” he say. +“You like file-a’m?” (fire-arms). “Yes,” +he say. “You like blackee coat?” “Yes,” +he say. Kekela he take Missa Whela by he shoul’a’ +(shoulder), he take him light out house; he give chief he whale-boat, +he file-a’m, he blackee coat. He take Missa Whela he house, +make him sit down with he wife and chil’en. Missa Whela +all-the-same pelison (prison); he wife, he chil’en in Amelica; +he cly - O, he cly. Kekela he solly. One day Kekela he see +ship. (<i>Pantomime</i>.) He say Missa Whela, “Ma’ +Whala?” Missa Whela he say, “Yes.” Kanaka +they begin go down beach. Kekela he get eleven Kanaka, get oa’ +(oars), get evely thing. He say Missa Whela, “Now you go +quick.” They jump in whale-boat. “Now you low!” +Kekela he say: “you low quick, quick!” (<i>Violent +pantomime</i>, <i>and a change indicating that the narrator has left +the boat</i> <i>and returned to the beach</i>.) All the Kanaka +they say, “How! ‘Melican mate he go away?” - +jump in boat; low afta. (<i>Violent pantomime, and change again +to boat</i>.) Kekela he say, “Low quick!”’<br> +<br> +Here I think Kauwealoha’s pantomime had confused me; I have no +more of his <i>ipsissima verba</i>; and can but add, in my own less +spirited manner, that the ship was reached, Mr. Whalon taken aboard, +and Kekela returned to his charge among the cannibals. But how +unjust it is to repeat the stumblings of a foreigner in a language only +partly acquired! A thoughtless reader might conceive Kauwealoha +and his colleague to be a species of amicable baboon; but I have here +the anti-dote. In return for his act of gallant charity, Kekela +was presented by the American Government with a sum of money, and by +President Lincoln personally with a gold watch. From his letter +of thanks, written in his own tongue, I give the following extract. +I do not envy the man who can read it without emotion.<br> +<br> +<br> +‘When I saw one of your countrymen, a citizen of your great nation, +ill-treated, and about to be baked and eaten, as a pig is eaten, I ran +to save him, full of pity and grief at the evil deed of these benighted +people. I gave my boat for the stranger’s life. This +boat came from James Hunnewell, a gift of friendship. It became +the ransom of this countryman of yours, that he might not be eaten by +the savages who knew not Jehovah. This was Mr. Whalon, and the +date, Jan. 14, 1864.<br> +<br> +As to this friendly deed of mine in saving Mr. Whalon, its seed came +from your great land, and was brought by certain of your countrymen, +who had received the love of God. It was planted in Hawaii, and +I brought it to plant in this land and in these dark regions, that they +might receive the root of all that is good and true, which is <i>love.<br> +<br> +</i>‘1. Love to Jehovah.<br> +<br> +‘2. Love to self.<br> +<br> +‘3. Love to our neighbour.<br> +<br> +‘If a man have a sufficiency of these three, he is good and holy, +like his God, Jehovah, in his triune character (Father, Son, and Holy +Ghost), one-three, three-one. If he have two and wants one, it +is not well; and if he have one and wants two, indeed, is not well; +but if he cherishes all three, then is he holy, indeed, after the manner +of the Bible.<br> +<br> +‘This is a great thing for your great nation to boast of, before +all the nations of the earth. From your great land a most precious +seed was brought to the land of darkness. It was planted here, +not by means of guns and men-of-war and threatening. It was planted +by means of the ignorant, the neglected, the despised. Such was +the introduction of the word of the Almighty God into this group of +Nuuhiwa. Great is my debt to Americans, who have taught me all +things pertaining to this life and to that which is to come.<br> +<br> +‘How shall I repay your great kindness to me? Thus David +asked of Jehovah, and thus I ask of you, the President of the United +States. This is my only payment - that which I have received of +the Lord, love - (aloha).’<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +CHAPTER XI - LONG-PIG - A CANNIBAL HIGH PLACE<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +Nothing more strongly arouses our disgust than cannibalism, nothing +so surely unmortars a society; nothing, we might plausibly argue, will +so harden and degrade the minds of those that practise it. And +yet we ourselves make much the same appearance in the eyes of the Buddhist +and the vegetarian. We consume the carcasses of creatures of like +appetites, passions, and organs with ourselves; we feed on babes, though +not our own; and the slaughter-house resounds daily with screams of +pain and fear. We distinguish, indeed; but the unwillingness of +many nations to eat the dog, an animal with whom we live on terms of +the next intimacy, shows how precariously the distinction is grounded. +The pig is the main element of animal food among the islands; and I +had many occasions, my mind being quickened by my cannibal surroundings, +to observe his character and the manner of his death. Many islanders +live with their pigs as we do with our dogs; both crowd around the hearth +with equal freedom; and the island pig is a fellow of activity, enterprise, +and sense. He husks his own cocoa-nuts, and (I am told) rolls +them into the sun to burst; he is the terror of the shepherd. +Mrs. Stevenson, senior, has seen one fleeing to the woods with a lamb +in his mouth; and I saw another come rapidly (and erroneously) to the +conclusion that the <i>Casco</i> was going down, and swim through the +flush water to the rail in search of an escape. It was told us +in childhood that pigs cannot swim; I have known one to leap overboard, +swim five hundred yards to shore, and return to the house of his original +owner. I was once, at Tautira, a pig-master on a considerable +scale; at first, in my pen, the utmost good feeling prevailed; a little +sow with a belly-ache came and appealed to us for help in the manner +of a child; and there was one shapely black boar, whom we called Catholicus, +for he was a particular present from the Catholics of the village, and +who early displayed the marks of courage and friendliness; no other +animal, whether dog or pig, was suffered to approach him at his food, +and for human beings he showed a full measure of that toadying fondness +so common in the lower animals, and possibly their chief title to the +name. One day, on visiting my piggery, I was amazed to see Catholicus +draw back from my approach with cries of terror; and if I was amazed +at the change, I was truly embarrassed when I learnt its reason. +One of the pigs had been that morning killed; Catholicus had seen the +murder, he had discovered he was dwelling in the shambles, and from +that time his confidence and his delight in life were ended. We +still reserved him a long while, but he could not endure the sight of +any two-legged creature, nor could we, under the circumstances, encounter +his eye without confusion. I have assisted besides, by the ear, +at the act of butchery itself; the victim’s cries of pain I think +I could have borne, but the execution was mismanaged, and his expression +of terror was contagious: that small heart moved to the same tune with +ours. Upon such ‘dread foundations’ the life of the +European reposes, and yet the European is among the less cruel of races. +The paraphernalia of murder, the preparatory brutalities of his existence, +are all hid away; an extreme sensibility reigns upon the surface; and +ladies will faint at the recital of one tithe of what they daily expect +of their butchers. Some will be even crying out upon me in their +hearts for the coarseness of this paragraph. And so with the island +cannibals. They were not cruel; apart from this custom, they are +a race of the most kindly; rightly speaking, to cut a man’s flesh +after he is dead is far less hateful than to oppress him whilst he lives; +and even the victims of their appetite were gently used in life and +suddenly and painlessly despatched at last. In island circles +of refinement it was doubtless thought bad taste to expatiate on what +was ugly in the practice.<br> +<br> +Cannibalism is traced from end to end of the Pacific, from the Marquesas +to New Guinea, from New Zealand to Hawaii, here in the lively haunt +of its exercise, there by scanty but significant survivals. Hawaii +is the most doubtful. We find cannibalism chronicled in Hawaii, +only in the history of a single war, where it seems to have been thought +exception, as in the case of mountain outlaws, such as fell by the hand +of Theseus. In Tahiti, a single circumstance survived, but that +appears conclusive. In historic times, when human oblation was +made in the marae, the eyes of the victim were formally offered to the +chief: a delicacy to the leading guest. All Melanesia appears +tainted. In Micronesia, in the Marshalls, with which my acquaintance +is no more than that of a tourist, I could find no trace at all; and +even in the Gilbert zone I long looked and asked in vain. I was +told tales indeed of men who had been eaten in a famine; but these were +nothing to my purpose, for the same thing is done under the same stress +by all kindreds and generations of men. At last, in some manuscript +notes of Dr. Turner’s, which I was allowed to consult at Malua, +I came on one damning evidence: on the island of Onoatoa the punishment +for theft was to be killed and eaten. How shall we account for +the universality of the practice over so vast an area, among people +of such varying civilisation, and, with whatever intermixture, of such +different blood? What circumstance is common to them all, but +that they lived on islands destitute, or very nearly so, of animal food? +I can never find it in my appetite that man was meant to live on vegetables +only. When our stores ran low among the islands, I grew to weary +for the recurrent day when economy allowed us to open another tin of +miserable mutton. And in at least one ocean language, a particular +word denotes that a man is ‘hungry for fish,’ having reached +that stage when vegetables can no longer satisfy, and his soul, like +those of the Hebrews in the desert, begins to lust after flesh-pots. +Add to this the evidences of over-population and imminent famine already +adduced, and I think we see some ground of indulgence for the island +cannibal.<br> +<br> +It is right to look at both sides of any question; but I am far from +making the apology of this worse than bestial vice. The higher +Polynesian races, such as the Tahitians, Hawaiians, and Samoans, had +one and all outgrown, and some of them had in part forgot, the practice, +before Cook or Bougainville had shown a top-sail in their waters. +It lingered only in some low islands where life was difficult to maintain, +and among inveterate savages like the New-Zealanders or the Marquesans. +The Marquesans intertwined man-eating with the whole texture of their +lives; long-pig was in a sense their currency and sacrament; it formed +the hire of the artist, illustrated public events, and was the occasion +and attraction of a feast. To-day they are paying the penalty +of this bloody commixture. The civil power, in its crusade against +man-eating, has had to examine one after another all Marquesan arts +and pleasures, has found them one after another tainted with a cannibal +element, and one after another has placed them on the proscript list. +Their art of tattooing stood by itself, the execution exquisite, the +designs most beautiful and intricate; nothing more handsomely sets off +a handsome man; it may cost some pain in the beginning, but I doubt +if it be near so painful in the long-run, and I am sure it is far more +becoming than the ignoble European practice of tight-lacing among women. +And now it has been found needful to forbid the art. Their songs +and dances were numerous (and the law has had to abolish them by the +dozen). They now face empty-handed the tedium of their uneventful +days; and who shall pity them? The least rigorous will say that +they were justly served.<br> +<br> +Death alone could not satisfy Marquesan vengeance: the flesh must be +eaten. The chief who seized Mr. Whalon preferred to eat him; and +he thought he had justified the wish when he explained it was a vengeance. +Two or three years ago, the people of a valley seized and slew a wretch +who had offended them. His offence, it is to be supposed, was +dire; they could not bear to leave their vengeance incomplete, and, +under the eyes of the French, they did not dare to hold a public festival. +The body was accordingly divided; and every man retired to his own house +to consummate the rite in secret, carrying his proportion of the dreadful +meat in a Swedish match-box. The barbarous substance of the drama +and the European properties employed offer a seizing contrast to the +imagination. Yet more striking is another incident of the very +year when I was there myself, 1888. In the spring, a man and woman +skulked about the school-house in Hiva-oa till they found a particular +child alone. Him they approached with honeyed words and carneying +manners - ‘You are So-and-so, son of So-and-so?’ they asked; +and caressed and beguiled him deeper in the woods. Some instinct +woke in the child’s bosom, or some look betrayed the horrid purpose +of his deceivers. He sought to break from them; he screamed; and +they, casting off the mask, seized him the more strongly and began to +run. His cries were heard; his schoolmates, playing not far off, +came running to the rescue; and the sinister couple fled and vanished +in the woods. They were never identified; no prosecution followed; +but it was currently supposed they had some grudge against the boy’s +father, and designed to eat him in revenge. All over the islands, +as at home among our own ancestors, it will be observed that the avenger +takes no particular heed to strike an individual. A family, a +class, a village, a whole valley or island, a whole race of mankind, +share equally the guilt of any member. So, in the above story, +the son was to pay the penalty for his father; so Mr. Whalon, the mate +of an American whaler, was to bleed and be eaten for the misdeeds of +a Peruvian slaver. I am reminded of an incident in Jaluit in the +Marshall group, which was told me by an eye-witness, and which I tell +here again for the strangeness of the scene. Two men had awakened +the animosity of the Jaluit chiefs; and it was their wives who were +selected to be punished. A single native served as executioner. +Early in the morning, in the face of a large concourse of spectators, +he waded out upon the reef between his victims. These neither +complained nor resisted; accompanied their destroyer patiently; stooped +down, when they had waded deep enough, at his command; and he (laying +one hand upon the shoulders of each) held them under water till they +drowned. Doubtless, although my informant did not tell me so, +their families would be lamenting aloud upon the beach.<br> +<br> +It was from Hatiheu that I paid my first visit to a cannibal high place.<br> +<br> +The day was sultry and clouded. Drenching tropical showers succeeded +bursts of sweltering sunshine. The green pathway of the road wound +steeply upward. As we went, our little schoolboy guide a little +ahead of us, Father Simeon had his portfolio in his hand, and named +the trees for me, and read aloud from his notes the abstract of their +virtues. Presently the road, mounting, showed us the vale of Hatiheu, +on a larger scale; and the priest, with occasional reference to our +guide, pointed out the boundaries and told me the names of the larger +tribes that lived at perpetual war in the old days: one on the north-east, +one along the beach, one behind upon the mountain. With a survivor +of this latter clan Father Simeon had spoken; until the pacification +he had never been to the sea’s edge, nor, if I remember exactly, +eaten of sea-fish. Each in its own district, the septs lived cantoned +and beleaguered. One step without the boundaries was to affront +death. If famine came, the men must out to the woods to gather +chestnuts and small fruits; even as to this day, if the parents are +backward in their weekly doles, school must be broken up and the scholars +sent foraging. But in the old days, when there was trouble in +one clan, there would be activity in all its neighbours; the woods would +be laid full of ambushes; and he who went after vegetables for himself +might remain to be a joint for his hereditary foes. Nor was the +pointed occasion needful. A dozen different natural signs and +social junctures called this people to the war-path and the cannibal +hunt. Let one of chiefly rank have finished his tattooing, the +wife of one be near upon her time, two of the debauching streams have +deviated nearer on the beach of Hatiheu, a certain bird have been heard +to sing, a certain ominous formation of cloud observed above the northern +sea; and instantly the arms were oiled, and the man-hunters swarmed +into the wood to lay their fratricidal ambuscades. It appears +besides that occasionally, perhaps in famine, the priest would shut +himself in his house, where he lay for a stated period like a person +dead. When he came forth it was to run for three days through +the territory of the clan, naked and starving, and to sleep at night +alone in the high place. It was now the turn of the others to +keep the house, for to encounter the priest upon his rounds was death. +On the eve of the fourth day the time of the running was over; the priest +returned to his roof, the laymen came forth, and in the morning the +number of the victims was announced. I have this tale of the priest +on one authority - I think a good one, - but I set it down with diffidence. +The particulars are so striking that, had they been true, I almost think +I must have heard them oftener referred to. Upon one point there +seems to be no question: that the feast was sometimes furnished from +within the clan. In times of scarcity, all who were not protected +by their family connections - in the Highland expression, all the commons +of the clan - had cause to tremble. It was vain to resist, it +was useless to flee. They were begirt upon all hands by cannibals; +and the oven was ready to smoke for them abroad in the country of their +foes, or at home in the valley of their fathers.<br> +<br> +At a certain corner of the road our scholar-guide struck off to his +left into the twilight of the forest. We were now on one of the +ancient native roads, plunged in a high vault of wood, and clambering, +it seemed, at random over boulders and dead trees; but the lad wound +in and out and up and down without a check, for these paths are to the +natives as marked as the king’s highway is to us; insomuch that, +in the days of the man-hunt, it was their labour rather to block and +deface than to improve them. In the crypt of the wood the air +was clammy and hot and cold; overhead, upon the leaves, the tropical +rain uproariously poured, but only here and there, as through holes +in a leaky roof, a single drop would fall, and make a spot upon my mackintosh. +Presently the huge trunk of a banyan hove in sight, standing upon what +seemed the ruins of an ancient fort; and our guide, halting and holding +forth his arm, announced that we had reached the <i>paepae tapu.<br> +<br> +Paepae</i> signifies a floor or platform such as a native house is built +on; and even such a paepae - a paepae hae - may be called a paepae tapu +in a lesser sense when it is deserted and becomes the haunt of spirits; +but the public high place, such as I was now treading, was a thing on +a great scale. As far as my eyes could pierce through the dark +undergrowth, the floor of the forest was all paved. Three tiers +of terrace ran on the slope of the hill; in front, a crumbling parapet +contained the main arena; and the pavement of that was pierced and parcelled +out with several wells and small enclosures. No trace remained +of any superstructure, and the scheme of the amphitheatre was difficult +to seize. I visited another in Hiva-oa, smaller but more perfect, +where it was easy to follow rows of benches, and to distinguish isolated +seats of honour for eminent persons; and where, on the upper platform, +a single joist of the temple or dead-house still remained, its uprights +richly carved. In the old days the high place was sedulously tended. +No tree except the sacred banyan was suffered to encroach upon its grades, +no dead leaf to rot upon the pavement. The stones were smoothly +set, and I am told they were kept bright with oil. On all sides +the guardians lay encamped in their subsidiary huts to watch and cleanse +it. No other foot of man was suffered to draw near; only the priest, +in the days of his running, came there to sleep - perhaps to dream of +his ungodly errand; but, in the time of the feast, the clan trooped +to the high place in a body, and each had his appointed seat. +There were places for the chiefs, the drummers, the dancers, the women, +and the priests. The drums - perhaps twenty strong, and some of +them twelve feet high - continuously throbbed in time. In time +the singers kept up their long-drawn, lugubrious, ululating song; in +time, too, the dancers, tricked out in singular finery, stepped, leaped, +swayed, and gesticulated - their plumed fingers fluttering in the air +like butterflies. The sense of time, in all these ocean races, +is extremely perfect; and I conceive in such a festival that almost +every sound and movement fell in one. So much the more unanimously +must have grown the agitation of the feasters; so much the more wild +must have been the scene to any European who could have beheld them +there, in the strong sun and the strong shadow of the banyan, rubbed +with saffron to throw in a more high relief the arabesque of the tattoo; +the women bleached by days of confinement to a complexion almost European; +the chiefs crowned with silver plumes of old men’s beards and +girt with kirtles of the hair of dead women. All manner of island +food was meanwhile spread for the women and the commons; and, for those +who were privileged to eat of it, there were carried up to the dead-house +the baskets of long-pig. It is told that the feasts were long +kept up; the people came from them brutishly exhausted with debauchery, +and the chiefs heavy with their beastly food. There are certain +sentiments which we call emphatically human - denying the honour of +that name to those who lack them. In such feasts - particularly +where the victim has been slain at home, and men banqueted on the poor +clay of a comrade with whom they had played in infancy, or a woman whose +favours they had shared - the whole body of these sentiments is outraged. +To consider it too closely is to understand, if not to excuse, the fervours +of self-righteous old ship-captains, who would man their guns, and open +fire in passing, on a cannibal island.<br> +<br> +And yet it was strange. There, upon the spot, as I stood under +the high, dripping vault of the forest, with the young priest on the +one hand, in his kilted gown, and the bright-eyed Marquesan schoolboy +on the other, the whole business appeared infinitely distant, and fallen +in the cold perspective and dry light of history. The bearing +of the priest, perhaps, affected me. He smiled; he jested with the boy, +the heir both of these feasters and their meat; he clapped his hands, +and gave me a stave of one of the old, ill-omened choruses. Centuries +might have come and gone since this slimy theatre was last in operation; +and I beheld the place with no more emotion than I might have felt in +visiting Stonehenge. In Hiva-oa, as I began to appreciate that +the thing was still living and latent about my footsteps, and that it +was still within the bounds of possibility that I might hear the cry +of the trapped victim, my historic attitude entirely failed, and I was +sensible of some repugnance for the natives. But here, too, the +priests maintained their jocular attitude: rallying the cannibals as +upon an eccentricity rather absurd than horrible; seeking, I should +say, to shame them from the practice by good-natured ridicule, as we +shame a child from stealing sugar. We may here recognise the temperate +and sagacious mind of Bishop Dordillon.<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +CHAPTER XII - THE STORY OF A PLANTATION<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +Taahauku, on the south-westerly coast of the island of Hiva-oa - Tahuku, +say the slovenly whites - may be called the port of Atuona. It +is a narrow and small anchorage, set between low cliffy points, and +opening above upon a woody valley: a little French fort, now disused +and deserted, overhangs the valley and the inlet. Atuona itself, +at the head of the next bay, is framed in a theatre of mountains, which +dominate the more immediate settling of Taahauku and give the salient +character of the scene. They are reckoned at no higher than four +thousand feet; but Tahiti with eight thousand, and Hawaii with fifteen, +can offer no such picture of abrupt, melancholy alps. In the morning, +when the sun falls directly on their front, they stand like a vast wall: +green to the summit, if by any chance the summit should be clear - water-courses +here and there delineated on their face, as narrow as cracks. +Towards afternoon, the light falls more obliquely, and the sculpture +of the range comes in relief, huge gorges sinking into shadow, huge, +tortuous buttresses standing edged with sun. At all hours of the +day they strike the eye with some new beauty, and the mind with the +same menacing gloom.<br> +<br> +The mountains, dividing and deflecting the endless airy deluge of the +Trade, are doubtless answerable for the climate. A strong draught +of wind blew day and night over the anchorage. Day and night the +same fantastic and attenuated clouds fled across the heavens, the same +dusky cap of rain and vapour fell and rose on the mountain. The +land-breezes came very strong and chill, and the sea, like the air, +was in perpetual bustle. The swell crowded into the narrow anchorage +like sheep into a fold; broke all along both sides, high on the one, +low on the other; kept a certain blowhole sounding and smoking like +a cannon; and spent itself at last upon the beach.<br> +<br> +On the side away from Atuona, the sheltering promontory was a nursery +of coco-trees. Some were mere infants, none had attained to any +size, none had yet begun to shoot skyward with that whip-like shaft +of the mature palm. In the young trees the colour alters with +the age and growth. Now all is of a grass-like hue, infinitely +dainty; next the rib grows golden, the fronds remaining green as ferns; +and then, as the trunk continues to mount and to assume its final hue +of grey, the fans put on manlier and more decided depths of verdure, +stand out dark upon the distance, glisten against the sun, and flash +like silver fountains in the assault of the wind. In this young +wood of Taahauku, all these hues and combinations were exampled and +repeated by the score. The trees grew pleasantly spaced upon a +hilly sward, here and there interspersed with a rack for drying copra, +or a tumble-down hut for storing it. Every here and there the +stroller had a glimpse of the <i>Casco</i> tossing in the narrow anchorage +below; and beyond he had ever before him the dark amphitheatre of the +Atuona mountains and the cliffy bluff that closes it to seaward. +The trade-wind moving in the fans made a ceaseless noise of summer rain; +and from time to time, with the sound of a sudden and distant drum-beat, +the surf would burst in a sea-cave.<br> +<br> +At the upper end of the inlet, its low, cliffy lining sinks, at both +sides, into a beach. A copra warehouse stands in the shadow of +the shoreside trees, flitted about for ever by a clan of dwarfish swallows; +and a line of rails on a high wooden staging bends back into the mouth +of the valley. Walking on this, the new-landed traveller becomes +aware of a broad fresh-water lagoon (one arm of which he crosses), and +beyond, of a grove of noble palms, sheltering the house of the trader, +Mr. Keane. Overhead, the cocos join in a continuous and lofty +roof; blackbirds are heard lustily singing; the island cock springs +his jubilant rattle and airs his golden plumage; cow-bells sound far +and near in the grove; and when you sit in the broad verandah, lulled +by this symphony, you may say to yourself, if you are able: ‘Better +fifty years of Europe . . .’ Farther on, the floor of the +valley is flat and green, and dotted here and there with stripling coco-palms. +Through the midst, with many changes of music, the river trots and brawls; +and along its course, where we should look for willows, puraos grow +in clusters, and make shadowy pools after an angler’s heart. +A vale more rich and peaceful, sweeter air, a sweeter voice of rural +sounds, I have found nowhere. One circumstance alone might strike +the experienced: here is a convenient beach, deep soil, good water, +and yet nowhere any paepaes, nowhere any trace of island habitation.<br> +<br> +It is but a few years since this valley was a place choked with jungle, +the debatable land and battle-ground of cannibals. Two clans laid +claim to it - neither could substantiate the claim, and the roads lay +desert, or were only visited by men in arms. It is for this very +reason that it wears now so smiling an appearance: cleared, planted, +built upon, supplied with railways, boat-houses, and bath-houses. +For, being no man’s land, it was the more readily ceded to a stranger. +The stranger was Captain John Hart: Ima Hati, ‘Broken-arm,’ +the natives call him, because when he first visited the islands his +arm was in a sling. Captain Hart, a man of English birth, but +an American subject, had conceived the idea of cotton culture in the +Marquesas during the American War, and was at first rewarded with success. +His plantation at Anaho was highly productive; island cotton fetched +a high price, and the natives used to debate which was the stronger +power, Ima Hati or the French: deciding in favour of the captain, because, +though the French had the most ships, he had the more money.<br> +<br> +He marked Taahauku for a suitable site, acquired it, and offered the +superintendence to Mr. Robert Stewart, a Fifeshire man, already some +time in the islands, who had just been ruined by a war on Tauata. +Mr. Stewart was somewhat averse to the adventure, having some acquaintance +with Atuona and its notorious chieftain, Moipu. He had once landed +there, he told me, about dusk, and found the remains of a man and woman +partly eaten. On his starting and sickening at the sight, one +of Moipu’s young men picked up a human foot, and provocatively +staring at the stranger, grinned and nibbled at the heel. None +need be surprised if Mr. Stewart fled incontinently to the bush, lay +there all night in a great horror of mind, and got off to sea again +by daylight on the morrow. ‘It was always a bad place, Atuona,’ +commented Mr. Stewart, in his homely Fifeshire voice. In spite +of this dire introduction, he accepted the captain’s offer, was +landed at Taahauku with three Chinamen, and proceeded to clear the jungle.<br> +<br> +War was pursued at that time, almost without interval, between the men +of Atuona and the men of Haamau; and one day, from the opposite sides +of the valley, battle - or I should rather say the noise of battle - +raged all the afternoon: the shots and insults of the opposing clans +passing from hill to hill over the heads of Mr. Stewart and his Chinamen. +There was no genuine fighting; it was like a bicker of schoolboys, only +some fool had given the children guns. One man died of his exertions +in running, the only casualty. With night the shots and insults +ceased; the men of Haamau withdrew; and victory, on some occult principle, +was scored to Moipu. Perhaps, in consequence, there came a day +when Moipu made a feast, and a party from Haamau came under safe-conduct +to eat of it. These passed early by Taahauku, and some of Moipu’s +young men were there to be a guard of honour. They were not long +gone before there came down from Haamau, a man, his wife, and a girl +of twelve, their daughter, bringing fungus. Several Atuona lads +were hanging round the store; but the day being one of truce none apprehended +danger. The fungus was weighed and paid for; the man of Haamau +proposed he should have his axe ground in the bargain; and Mr. Stewart +demurring at the trouble, some of the Atuona lads offered to grind it +for him, and set it on the wheel. While the axe was grinding, +a friendly native whispered Mr. Stewart to have a care of himself, for +there was trouble in hand; and, all at once, the man of Haamau was seized, +and his head and arm stricken from his body, the head at one sweep of +his own newly sharpened axe. In the first alert, the girl escaped +among the cotton; and Mr. Stewart, having thrust the wife into the house +and locked her in from the outside, supposed the affair was over. +But the business had not passed without noise, and it reached the ears +of an older girl who had loitered by the way, and who now came hastily +down the valley, crying as she came for her father. Her, too, +they seized and beheaded; I know not what they had done with the axe, +it was a blunt knife that served their butcherly turn upon the girl; +and the blood spurted in fountains and painted them from head to foot. +Thus horrible from crime, the party returned to Atuona, carrying the +heads to Moipu. It may be fancied how the feast broke up; but +it is notable that the guests were honourably suffered to retire. +These passed back through Taahauku in extreme disorder; a little after +the valley began to be overrun with shouting and triumphing braves; +and a letter of warning coming at the same time to Mr. Stewart, he and +his Chinamen took refuge with the Protestant missionary in Atuona. +That night the store was gutted, and the bodies cast in a pit and covered +with leaves. Three days later the schooner had come in; and things +appearing quieter, Mr. Stewart and the captain landed in Taahauku to +compute the damage and to view the grave, which was already indicated +by the stench. While they were so employed, a party of Moipu’s +young men, decked with red flannel to indicate martial sentiments, came +over the hills from Atuona, dug up the bodies, washed them in the river, +and carried them away on sticks. That night the feast began.<br> +<br> +Those who knew Mr. Stewart before this experience declare the man to +be quite altered. He stuck, however, to his post; and somewhat +later, when the plantation was already well established, and gave employment +to sixty Chinamen and seventy natives, he found himself once more in +dangerous times. The men of Haamau, it was reported, had sworn +to plunder and erase the settlement; letters came continually from the +Hawaiian missionary, who acted as intelligence department; and for six +weeks Mr. Stewart and three other whites slept in the cotton-house at +night in a rampart of bales, and (what was their best defence) ostentatiously +practised rifle-shooting by day upon the beach. Natives were often +there to watch them; the practice was excellent; and the assault was +never delivered - if it ever was intended, which I doubt, for the natives +are more famous for false rumours than for deeds of energy. I +was told the late French war was a case in point; the tribes on the +beach accusing those in the mountains of designs which they had never +the hardihood to entertain. And the same testimony to their backwardness +in open battle reached me from all sides. Captain Hart once landed +after an engagement in a certain bay; one man had his hand hurt, an +old woman and two children had been slain; and the captain improved +the occasion by poulticing the hand, and taunting both sides upon so +wretched an affair. It is true these wars were often merely formal +- comparable with duels to the first blood. Captain Hart visited +a bay where such a war was being carried on between two brothers, one +of whom had been thought wanting in civility to the guests of the other. +About one-half of the population served day about on alternate sides, +so as to be well with each when the inevitable peace should follow. +The forts of the belligerents were over against each other, and close +by. Pigs were cooking. Well-oiled braves, with well-oiled +muskets, strutted on the paepae or sat down to feast. No business, +however needful, could be done, and all thoughts were supposed to be +centred in this mockery of war. A few days later, by a regrettable +accident, a man was killed; it was felt at once the thing had gone too +far, and the quarrel was instantly patched up. But the more serious +wars were prosecuted in a similar spirit; a gift of pigs and a feast +made their inevitable end; the killing of a single man was a great victory, +and the murder of defenceless solitaries counted a heroic deed.<br> +<br> +The foot of the cliffs, about all these islands, is the place of fishing. +Between Taahauku and Atuona we saw men, but chiefly women, some nearly +naked, some in thin white or crimson dresses, perched in little surf-beat +promontories - the brown precipice overhanging them, and the convolvulus +overhanging that, as if to cut them off the more completely from assistance. +There they would angle much of the morning; and as fast as they caught +any fish, eat them, raw and living, where they stood. It was such +helpless ones that the warriors from the opposite island of Tauata slew, +and carried home and ate, and were thereupon accounted mighty men of +valour. Of one such exploit I can give the account of an eye-witness. +‘Portuguese Joe,’ Mr. Keane’s cook, was once pulling +an oar in an Atuona boat, when they spied a stranger in a canoe with +some fish and a piece of tapu. The Atuona men cried upon him to +draw near and have a smoke. He complied, because, I suppose, he +had no choice; but he knew, poor devil, what he was coming to, and (as +Joe said) ‘he didn’t seem to care about the smoke.’ +A few questions followed, as to where he came from, and what was his +business. These he must needs answer, as he must needs draw at +the unwelcome pipe, his heart the while drying in his bosom. And +then, of a sudden, a big fellow in Joe’s boat leaned over, plucked +the stranger from his canoe, struck him with a knife in the neck - inward +and downward, as Joe showed in pantomime more expressive than his words +- and held him under water, like a fowl, until his struggles ceased. +Whereupon the long-pig was hauled on board, the boat’s head turned +about for Atuona, and these Marquesan braves pulled home rejoicing. +Moipu was on the beach and rejoiced with them on their arrival. +Poor Joe toiled at his oar that day with a white face, yet he had no +fear for himself. ‘They were very good to me - gave me plenty +grub: never wished to eat white man,’ said he.<br> +<br> +If the most horrible experience was Mr. Stewart’s, it was Captain +Hart himself who ran the nearest danger. He had bought a piece +of land from Timau, chief of a neighbouring bay, and put some Chinese +there to work. Visiting the station with one of the Godeffroys, +he found his Chinamen trooping to the beach in terror: Timau had driven +them out, seized their effects, and was in war attire with his young +men. A boat was despatched to Taahauku for reinforcement; as they +awaited her return, they could see, from the deck of the schooner, Timau +and his young men dancing the war-dance on the hill-top till past twelve +at night; and so soon as the boat came (bringing three gendarmes, armed +with chassepots, two white men from Taahauku station, and some native +warriors) the party set out to seize the chief before he should awake. +Day was not come, and it was a very bright moonlight morning, when they +reached the hill-top where (in a house of palm-leaves) Timau was sleeping +off his debauch. The assailants were fully exposed, the interior +of the hut quite dark; the position far from sound. The gendarmes +knelt with their pieces ready, and Captain Hart advanced alone. +As he drew near the door he heard the snap of a gun cocking from within, +and in sheer self-defence - there being no other escape - sprang into +the house and grappled Timau. ‘Timau, come with me!’ +he cried. But Timau - a great fellow, his eyes blood-red with +the abuse of kava, six foot three in stature - cast him on one side; +and the captain, instantly expecting to be either shot or brained, discharged +his pistol in the dark. When they carried Timau out at the door +into the moonlight, he was already dead, and, upon this unlooked-for +termination of their sally, the whites appeared to have lost all conduct, +and retreated to the boats, fired upon by the natives as they went. +Captain Hart, who almost rivals Bishop Dordillon in popularity, shared +with him the policy of extreme indulgence to the natives, regarding +them as children, making light of their defects, and constantly in favour +of mild measures. The death of Timau has thus somewhat weighed +upon his mind; the more so, as the chieftain’s musket was found +in the house unloaded. To a less delicate conscience the matter +will seem light. If a drunken savage elects to cock a fire-arm, +a gentleman advancing towards him in the open cannot wait to make sure +if it be charged.<br> +<br> +I have touched on the captain’s popularity. It is one of +the things that most strikes a stranger in the Marquesas. He comes +instantly on two names, both new to him, both locally famous, both mentioned +by all with affection and respect - the bishop’s and the captain’s. +It gave me a strong desire to meet with the survivor, which was subsequently +gratified - to the enrichment of these pages. Long after that +again, in the Place Dolorous - Molokai - I came once more on the traces +of that affectionate popularity. There was a blind white leper +there, an old sailor - ‘an old tough,’ he called himself +- who had long sailed among the eastern islands. Him I used to +visit, and, being fresh from the scenes of his activity, gave him the +news. This (in the true island style) was largely a chronicle +of wrecks; and it chanced I mentioned the case of one not very successful +captain, and how he had lost a vessel for Mr. Hart; thereupon the blind +leper broke forth in lamentation. ‘Did he lose a ship of +John Hart’s?’ he cried; ‘poor John Hart! Well, +I’m sorry it was Hart’s,’ with needless force of epithet, +which I neglect to reproduce.<br> +<br> +Perhaps, if Captain Hart’s affairs had continued to prosper, his +popularity might have been different. Success wins glory, but +it kills affection, which misfortune fosters. And the misfortune +which overtook the captain’s enterprise was truly singular. +He was at the top of his career. Ile Masse belonged to him, given +by the French as an indemnity for the robberies at Taahauku. But +the Ile Masse was only suitable for cattle; and his two chief stations +were Anaho, in Nuka-hiva, facing the north-east, and Taahauku in Hiva-oa, +some hundred miles to the southward, and facing the south-west. +Both these were on the same day swept by a tidal wave, which was not +felt in any other bay or island of the group. The south coast +of Hiva-oa was bestrewn with building timber and camphor-wood chests, +containing goods; which, on the promise of a reasonable salvage, the +natives very honestly brought back, the chests apparently not opened, +and some of the wood after it had been built into their houses. +But the recovery of such jetsam could not affect the result. It +was impossible the captain should withstand this partiality of fortune; +and with his fall the prosperity of the Marquesas ended. Anaho +is truly extinct, Taahauku but a shadow of itself; nor has any new plantation +arisen in their stead.<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +CHAPTER XIII - CHARACTERS<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +There was a certain traffic in our anchorage at Atuona; different indeed +from the dead inertia and quiescence of the sister island, Nuka-hiva. +Sails were seen steering from its mouth; now it would be a whale-boat +manned with native rowdies, and heavy with copra for sale; now perhaps +a single canoe come after commodities to buy. The anchorage was +besides frequented by fishers; not only the lone females perched in +niches of the cliff, but whole parties, who would sometimes camp and +build a fire upon the beach, and sometimes lie in their canoes in the +midst of the haven and jump by turns in the water; which they would +cast eight or nine feet high, to drive, as we supposed, the fish into +their nets. The goods the purchasers came to buy were sometimes +quaint. I remarked one outrigger returning with a single ham swung +from a pole in the stern. And one day there came into Mr. Keane’s +store a charming lad, excellently mannered, speaking French correctly +though with a babyish accent; very handsome too, and much of a dandy, +as was shown not only in his shining raiment, but by the nature of his +purchases. These were five ship-biscuits, a bottle of scent, and +two balls of washing blue. He was from Tauata, whither he returned +the same night in an outrigger, daring the deep with these young-ladyish +treasures. The gross of the native passengers were more ill-favoured: +tall, powerful fellows, well tattooed, and with disquieting manners. +Something coarse and jeering distinguished them, and I was often reminded +of the slums of some great city. One night, as dusk was falling, +a whale-boat put in on that part of the beach where I chanced to be +alone. Six or seven ruffianly fellows scrambled out; all had enough +English to give me ‘good-bye,’ which was the ordinary salutation; +or ‘good-morning,’ which they seemed to regard as an intensitive; +jests followed, they surrounded me with harsh laughter and rude looks, +and I was glad to move away. I had not yet encountered Mr. Stewart, +or I should have been reminded of his first landing at Atuona and the +humorist who nibbled at the heel. But their neighbourhood depressed +me; and I felt, if I had been there a castaway and out of reach of help, +my heart would have been sick.<br> +<br> +Nor was the traffic altogether native. While we lay in the anchorage +there befell a strange coincidence. A schooner was observed at +sea and aiming to enter. We knew all the schooners in the group, +but this appeared larger than any; she was rigged, besides, after the +English manner; and, coming to an anchor some way outside the <i>Casco</i>, +showed at last the blue ensign. There were at that time, according +to rumour, no fewer than four yachts in the Pacific; but it was strange +that any two of them should thus lie side by side in that outlandish +inlet: stranger still that in the owner of the <i>Nyanza</i>, Captain +Dewar, I should find a man of the same country and the same county with +myself, and one whom I had seen walking as a boy on the shores of the +Alpes Maritimes.<br> +<br> +We had besides a white visitor from shore, who came and departed in +a crowded whale-boat manned by natives; having read of yachts in the +Sunday papers, and being fired with the desire to see one. Captain +Chase, they called him, an old whaler-man, thickset and white-bearded, +with a strong Indiana drawl; years old in the country, a good backer +in battle, and one of those dead shots whose practice at the target +struck terror in the braves of Haamau. Captain Chase dwelt farther +east in a bay called Hanamate, with a Mr. M’Callum; or rather +they had dwelt together once, and were now amicably separated. +The captain is to be found near one end of the bay, in a wreck of a +house, and waited on by a Chinese. At the point of the opposing +corner another habitation stands on a tall paepae. The surf runs +there exceeding heavy, seas of seven and eight feet high bursting under +the walls of the house, which is thus continually filled with their +clamour, and rendered fit only for solitary, or at least for silent, +inmates. Here it is that Mr. M’Callum, with a Shakespeare +and a Burns, enjoys the society of the breakers. His name and +his Burns testify to Scottish blood; but he is an American born, somewhere +far east; followed the trade of a ship-carpenter; and was long employed, +the captain of a hundred Indians, breaking up wrecks about Cape Flattery. +Many of the whites who are to be found scattered in the South Seas represent +the more artistic portion of their class; and not only enjoy the poetry +of that new life, but came there on purpose to enjoy it. I have +been shipmates with a man, no longer young, who sailed upon that voyage, +his first time to sea, for the mere love of Samoa; and it was a few +letters in a newspaper that sent him on that pilgrimage. Mr. M’Callum +was another instance of the same. He had read of the South Seas; +loved to read of them; and let their image fasten in his heart: till +at length he could refrain no longer - must set forth, a new Rudel, +for that unseen homeland - and has now dwelt for years in Hiva-oa, and +will lay his bones there in the end with full content; having no desire +to behold again the places of his boyhood, only, perhaps - once, before +he dies - the rude and wintry landscape of Cape Flattery. Yet +he is an active man, full of schemes; has bought land of the natives; +has planted five thousand coco-palms; has a desert island in his eye, +which he desires to lease, and a schooner in the stocks, which he has +laid and built himself, and even hopes to finish. Mr. M’Callum +and I did not meet, but, like gallant troubadours, corresponded in verse. +I hope he will not consider it a breach of copyright if I give here +a specimen of his muse. He and Bishop Dordillon are the two European +bards of the Marquesas.<br> +<br> +<br> +‘Sail, ho! Ahoy! <i>Casco,<br> +</i>First among the pleasure fleet<br> +That came around to greet<br> +These isles from San Francisco,<br> +<br> +And first, too; only one<br> +Among the literary men<br> +That this way has ever been -<br> +Welcome, then, to Stevenson.<br> +<br> +Please not offended be<br> +At this little notice<br> +Of the <i>Casco</i>, Captain Otis,<br> +With the novelist’s family.<br> +<br> +<i>Avoir une voyage magnifical<br> +</i>Is our wish sincere,<br> +That you’ll have from here<br> +<i>Allant sur la Grande Pacifical</i>.’<br> +<br> +<br> +But our chief visitor was one Mapiao, a great Tahuku - which seems to +mean priest, wizard, tattooer, practiser of any art, or, in a word, +esoteric person - and a man famed for his eloquence on public occasions +and witty talk in private. His first appearance was typical of +the man. He came down clamorous to the eastern landing, where +the surf was running very high; scorned all our signals to go round +the bay; carried his point, was brought aboard at some hazard to our +skiff, and set down in one corner of the cockpit to his appointed task. +He had been hired, as one cunning in the art, to make my old men’s +beards into a wreath: what a wreath for Celia’s arbour! +His own beard (which he carried, for greater safety, in a sailor’s +knot) was not merely the adornment of his age, but a substantial piece +of property. One hundred dollars was the estimated value; and +as Brother Michel never knew a native to deposit a greater sum with +Bishop Dordillon, our friend was a rich man in virtue of his chin. +He had something of an East Indian cast, but taller and stronger: his +nose hooked, his face narrow, his forehead very high, the whole elaborately +tattooed. I may say I have never entertained a guest so trying. +In the least particular he must be waited on; he would not go to the +scuttle-butt for water; he would not even reach to get the glass, it +must be given him in his hand; if aid were denied him, he would fold +his arms, bow his head, and go without: only the work would suffer. +Early the first forenoon he called aloud for biscuit and salmon; biscuit +and ham were brought; he looked on them inscrutably, and signed they +should be set aside. A number of considerations crowded on my +mind; how the sort of work on which he was engaged was probably tapu +in a high degree; should by rights, perhaps, be transacted on a tapu +platform which no female might approach; and it was possible that fish +might be the essential diet. Some salted fish I therefore brought +him, and along with that a glass of rum: at sight of which Mapiao displayed +extraordinary animation, pointed to the zenith, made a long speech in +which I picked up <i>umati</i> - the word for the sun - and signed to +me once more to place these dainties out of reach. At last I had +understood, and every day the programme was the same. At an early +period of the morning his dinner must be set forth on the roof of the +house and at a proper distance, full in view but just out of reach; +and not until the fit hour, which was the point of noon, would the artificer +partake. This solemnity was the cause of an absurd misadventure. +He was seated plaiting, as usual, at the beards, his dinner arrayed +on the roof, and not far off a glass of water standing. It appears +he desired to drink; was of course far too great a gentleman to rise +and get the water for himself; and spying Mrs. Stevenson, imperiously +signed to her to hand it. The signal was misunderstood; Mrs. Stevenson +was, by this time, prepared for any eccentricity on the part of our +guest; and instead of passing him the water, flung his dinner overboard. +I must do Mapiao justice: all laughed, but his laughter rang the loudest.<br> +<br> +These troubles of service were at worst occasional; the embarrassment +of the man’s talk incessant. He was plainly a practised +conversationalist; the nicety of his inflections, the elegance of his +gestures, and the fine play of his expression, told us that. We, +meanwhile, sat like aliens in a playhouse; we could see the actors were +upon some material business and performing well, but the plot of the +drama remained undiscoverable. Names of places, the name of Captain +Hart, occasional disconnected words, tantalised without enlightening +us; and the less we understood, the more gallantly, the more copiously, +and with still the more explanatory gestures, Mapiao returned to the +assault. We could see his vanity was on the rack; being come to +a place where that fine jewel of his conversational talent could earn +him no respect; and he had times of despair when he desisted from the +endeavour, and instants of irritation when he regarded us with unconcealed +contempt. Yet for me, as the practitioner of some kindred mystery +to his own, he manifested to the last a measure of respect. As +we sat under the awning in opposite corners of the cockpit, he braiding +hairs from dead men’s chins, I forming runes upon a sheet of folio +paper, he would nod across to me as one Tahuku to another, or, crossing +the cockpit, study for a while my shapeless scrawl and encourage me +with a heartfelt ‘<i>mitai</i>! - good!’ So might +a deaf painter sympathise far off with a musician, as the slave and +master of some uncomprehended and yet kindred art. A silly trade, +he doubtless considered it; but a man must make allowance for barbarians +- <i>chaque pays a ses coutumes</i> - and he felt the principle was +there.<br> +<br> +The time came at last when his labours, which resembled those rather +of Penelope than Hercules, could be no more spun out, and nothing remained +but to pay him and say farewell. After a long, learned argument +in Marquesan, I gathered that his mind was set on fish-hooks; with three +of which, and a brace of dollars, I thought he was not ill rewarded +for passing his forenoons in our cockpit, eating, drinking, delivering +his opinions, and pressing the ship’s company into his menial +service. For all that, he was a man of so high a bearing, and +so like an uncle of my own who should have gone mad and got tattooed, +that I applied to him, when we were both on shore, to know if he were +satisfied. ‘<i>Mitai ehipe</i>?’ I asked. And +he, with rich unction, offering at the same time his hand - ‘<i>Mitai +ehipe, mitai</i> <i>kaehae; kaoha nui</i>!’ - or, to translate +freely: ‘The ship is good, the victuals are up to the mark, and +we part in friendship.’ Which testimonial uttered, he set +off along the beach with his head bowed and the air of one deeply injured.<br> +<br> +I saw him go, on my side, with relief. It would be more interesting +to learn how our relation seemed to Mapiao. His exigence, we may +suppose, was merely loyal. He had been hired by the ignorant to +do a piece of work; and he was bound that he would do it the right way. +Countless obstacles, continual ignorant ridicule, availed not to dissuade +him. He had his dinner laid out; watched it, as was fit, the while +he worked; ate it at the fit hour; was in all things served and waited +on; and could take his hire in the end with a clear conscience, telling +himself the mystery was performed duly, the beards rightfully braided, +and we (in spite of ourselves) correctly served. His view of our +stupidity, even he, the mighty talker, must have lacked language to +express. He never interfered with my Tahuku work; civilly praised +it, idle as it seemed; civilly supposed that I was competent in my own +mystery: such being the attitude of the intelligent and the polite. +And we, on the other hand - who had yet the most to gain or lose, since +the product was to be ours - who had professed our disability by the +very act of hiring him to do it - were never weary of impeding his own +more important labours, and sometimes lacked the sense and the civility +to refrain from laughter.<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +CHAPTER XIV - IN A CANNIBAL VALLEY<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +The road from Taahauku to Atuona skirted the north-westerly side of +the anchorage, somewhat high up, edged, and sometimes shaded, by the +splendid flowers of the <i>flamboyant</i> - its English name I do not +know. At the turn of the hand, Atuona came in view: a long beach, +a heavy and loud breach of surf, a shore-side village scattered among +trees, and the guttered mountains drawing near on both sides above a +narrow and rich ravine. Its infamous repute perhaps affected me; +but I thought it the loveliest, and by far the most ominous and gloomy, +spot on earth. Beautiful it surely was; and even more salubrious. +The healthfulness of the whole group is amazing; that of Atuona almost +in the nature of a miracle. In Atuona, a village planted in a +shore-side marsh, the houses standing everywhere intermingled with the +pools of a taro-garden, we find every condition of tropical danger and +discomfort; and yet there are not even mosquitoes - not even the hateful +day-fly of Nuka-hiva - and fever, and its concomitant, the island fe’efe’e, +are unknown.<br> +<br> +This is the chief station of the French on the man-eating isle of Hiva-oa. +The sergeant of gendarmerie enjoys the style of the vice-resident, and +hoists the French colours over a quite extensive compound. A Chinaman, +a waif from the plantation, keeps a restaurant in the rear quarters +of the village; and the mission is well represented by the sister’s +school and Brother Michel’s church. Father Orens, a wonderful +octogenarian, his frame scarce bowed, the fire of his eye undimmed, +has lived, and trembled, and suffered in this place since 1843. +Again and again, when Moipu had made coco-brandy, he has been driven +from his house into the woods. ‘A mouse that dwelt in a +cat’s ear’ had a more easy resting-place; and yet I have +never seen a man that bore less mark of years. He must show us +the church, still decorated with the bishop’s artless ornaments +of paper - the last work of industrious old hands, and the last earthly +amusement of a man that was much of a hero. In the sacristy we +must see his sacred vessels, and, in particular, a vestment which was +a ‘<i>vraie curiosité</i>,’ because it had been given +by a gendarme. To the Protestant there is always something embarrassing +in the eagerness with which grown and holy men regard these trifles; +but it was touching and pretty to see Orens, his aged eyes shining in +his head, display his sacred treasures.<br> +<br> +<i>August</i> 26. - The vale behind the village, narrowing swiftly to +a mere ravine, was choked with profitable trees. A river gushed +in the midst. Overhead, the tall coco-palms made a primary covering; +above that, from one wall of the mountain to another, the ravine was +roofed with cloud; so that we moved below, amid teeming vegetation, +in a covered house of heat. On either hand, at every hundred yards, +instead of the houseless, disembowelling paepaes of Nuka-hiva, populous +houses turned out their inhabitants to cry ‘Kaoha!’ to the +passers-by. The road, too, was busy: strings of girls, fair and +foul, as in less favoured countries; men bearing breadfruit; the sisters, +with a little guard of pupils; a fellow bestriding a horse - passed +and greeted us continually; and now it was a Chinaman who came to the +gate of his flower-yard, and gave us ‘Good-day’ in excellent +English; and a little farther on it would be some natives who set us +down by the wayside, made us a feast of mummy-apple, and entertained +us as we ate with drumming on a tin case. With all this fine plenty +of men and fruit, death is at work here also. The population, +according to the highest estimate, does not exceed six hundred in the +whole vale of Atuona; and yet, when I once chanced to put the question, +Brother Michel counted up ten whom he knew to be sick beyond recovery. +It was here, too, that I could at last gratify my curiosity with the +sight of a native house in the very article of dissolution. It +had fallen flat along the paepae, its poles sprawling ungainly; the +rains and the mites contended against it; what remained seemed sound +enough, but much was gone already; and it was easy to see how the insects +consumed the walls as if they had been bread, and the air and the rain +ate into them like vitriol.<br> +<br> +A little ahead of us, a young gentleman, very well tattooed, and dressed +in a pair of white trousers and a flannel shirt, had been marching unconcernedly. +Of a sudden, without apparent cause, he turned back, took us in possession, +and led us undissuadably along a by-path to the river’s edge. +There, in a nook of the most attractive amenity, he bade us to sit down: +the stream splashing at our elbow, a shock of nondescript greenery enshrining +us from above; and thither, after a brief absence, he brought us a cocoa-nut, +a lump of sandal-wood, and a stick he had begun to carve: the nut for +present refreshment, the sandal-wood for a precious gift, and the stick +- in the simplicity of his vanity - to harvest premature praise. +Only one section was yet carved, although the whole was pencil-marked +in lengths; and when I proposed to buy it, Poni (for that was the artist’s +name) recoiled in horror. But I was not to be moved, and simply +refused restitution, for I had long wondered why a people who displayed, +in their tattooing, so great a gift of arabesque invention, should display +it nowhere else. Here, at last, I had found something of the same +talent in another medium; and I held the incompleteness, in these days +of world-wide brummagem, for a happy mark of authenticity. Neither +my reasons nor my purpose had I the means of making clear to Poni; I +could only hold on to the stick, and bid the artist follow me to the +gendarmerie, where I should find interpreters and money; but we gave +him, in the meanwhile, a boat-call in return for his sandal-wood. +As he came behind us down the vale he sounded upon this continually. +And continually, from the wayside houses, there poured forth little +groups of girls in crimson, or of men in white. And to these must +Poni pass the news of who the strangers were, of what they had been +doing, of why it was that Poni had a boat-whistle; and of why he was +now being haled to the vice-residency, uncertain whether to be punished +or rewarded, uncertain whether he had lost a stick or made a bargain, +but hopeful on the whole, and in the meanwhile highly consoled by the +boat-whistle. Whereupon he would tear himself away from this particular +group of inquirers, and once more we would hear the shrill call in our +wake.<br> +<br> +<i>August</i> 27. - I made a more extended circuit in the vale with +Brother Michel. We were mounted on a pair of sober nags, suitable +to these rude paths; the weather was exquisite, and the company in which +I found myself no less agreeable than the scenes through which I passed. +We mounted at first by a steep grade along the summit of one of those +twisted spurs that, from a distance, mark out provinces of sun and shade +upon the mountain-side. The ground fell away on either hand with +an extreme declivity. From either hand, out of profound ravines, +mounted the song of falling water and the smoke of household fires. +Here and there the hills of foliage would divide, and our eye would +plunge down upon one of these deep-nested habitations. And still, +high in front, arose the precipitous barrier of the mountain, greened +over where it seemed that scarce a harebell could find root, barred +with the zigzags of a human road where it seemed that not a goat could +scramble. And in truth, for all the labour that it cost, the road +is regarded even by the Marquesans as impassable; they will not risk +a horse on that ascent; and those who lie to the westward come and go +in their canoes. I never knew a hill to lose so little on a near +approach: a consequence, I must suppose, of its surprising steepness. +When we turned about, I was amazed to behold so deep a view behind, +and so high a shoulder of blue sea, crowned by the whale-like island +of Motane. And yet the wall of mountain had not visibly dwindled, +and I could even have fancied, as I raised my eyes to measure it, that +it loomed higher than before.<br> +<br> +We struck now into covert paths, crossed and heard more near at hand +the bickering of the streams, and tasted the coolness of those recesses +where the houses stood. The birds sang about us as we descended. +All along our path my guide was being hailed by voices: ‘Mikaël +- Kaoha, Mikaël!’ From the doorstep, from the cotton-patch, +or out of the deep grove of island-chestnuts, these friendly cries arose, +and were cheerily answered as we passed. In a sharp angle of a +glen, on a rushing brook and under fathoms of cool foliage, we struck +a house upon a well-built paepae, the fire brightly burning under the +popoi-shed against the evening meal; and here the cries became a chorus, +and the house folk, running out, obliged us to dismount and breathe. +It seemed a numerous family: we saw eight at least; and one of these +honoured me with a particular attention. This was the mother, +a woman naked to the waist, of an aged countenance, but with hair still +copious and black, and breasts still erect and youthful. On our +arrival I could see she remarked me, but instead of offering any greeting, +disappeared at once into the bush. Thence she returned with two +crimson flowers. ‘Good-bye!’ was her salutation, uttered +not without coquetry; and as she said it she pressed the flowers into +my hand - ‘Good-bye! I speak Inglis.’ It was +from a whaler-man, who (she informed me) was ‘a plenty good chap,’ +that she had learned my language; and I could not but think how handsome +she must have been in these times of her youth, and could not but guess +that some memories of the dandy whaler-man prompted her attentions to +myself. Nor could I refrain from wondering what had befallen her +lover; in the rain and mire of what sea-ports he had tramped since then; +in what close and garish drinking-dens had found his pleasure; and in +the ward of what infirmary dreamed his last of the Marquesas. +But she, the more fortunate, lived on in her green island. The +talk, in this lost house upon the mountains, ran chiefly upon Mapiao +and his visits to the <i>Casco</i>: the news of which had probably gone +abroad by then to all the island, so that there was no paepae in Hiva-oa +where they did not make the subject of excited comment.<br> +<br> +Not much beyond we came upon a high place in the foot of the ravine. +Two roads divided it, and met in the midst. Save for this intersection +the amphitheatre was strangely perfect, and had a certain ruder air +of things Roman. Depths of foliage and the bulk of the mountain +kept it in a grateful shadow. On the benches several young folk +sat clustered or apart. One of these, a girl perhaps fourteen +years of age, buxom and comely, caught the eye of Brother Michel. +Why was she not at school? - she was done with school now. What +was she doing here? - she lived here now. Why so? - no answer +but a deepening blush. There was no severity in Brother Michel’s +manner; the girl’s own confusion told her story. ‘<i>Elle +a honte</i>,’ was the missionary’s comment, as we rode away. +Near by in the stream, a grown girl was bathing naked in a goyle between +two stepping-stones; and it amused me to see with what alacrity and +real alarm she bounded on her many-coloured under-clothes. Even +in these daughters of cannibals shame was eloquent.<br> +<br> +It is in Hiva-oa, owing to the inveterate cannibalism of the natives, +that local beliefs have been most rudely trodden underfoot. It +was here that three religious chiefs were set under a bridge, and the +women of the valley made to defile over their heads upon the road-way: +the poor, dishonoured fellows sitting there (all observers agree) with +streaming tears. Not only was one road driven across the high +place, but two roads intersected in its midst. There is no reason +to suppose that the last was done of purpose, and perhaps it was impossible +entirely to avoid the numerous sacred places of the islands. But +these things are not done without result. I have spoken already +of the regard of Marquesans for the dead, making (as it does) so strange +a contrast with their unconcern for death. Early on this day’s +ride, for instance, we encountered a petty chief, who inquired (of course) +where we were going, and suggested by way of amendment. ‘Why +do you not rather show him the cemetery?’ I saw it; it was +but newly opened, the third within eight years. They are great +builders here in Hiva-oa; I saw in my ride paepaes that no European +dry-stone mason could have equalled, the black volcanic stones were +laid so justly, the corners were so precise, the levels so true; but +the retaining-wall of the new graveyard stood apart, and seemed to be +a work of love. The sentiment of honour for the dead is therefore +not extinct. And yet observe the consequence of violently countering +men’s opinions. Of the four prisoners in Atuona gaol, three +were of course thieves; the fourth was there for sacrilege. He +had levelled up a piece of the graveyard - to give a feast upon, as +he informed the court - and declared he had no thought of doing wrong. +Why should he? He had been forced at the point of the bayonet +to destroy the sacred places of his own piety; when he had recoiled +from the task, he had been jeered at for a superstitious fool. +And now it is supposed he will respect our European superstitions as +by second nature.<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +CHAPTER XV - THE TWO CHIEFS OF ATUONA<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +It had chanced (as the <i>Casco</i> beat through the Bordelais Straits +for Taahauku) she approached on one board very near the land in the +opposite isle of Tauata, where houses were to be seen in a grove of +tall coco-palms. Brother Michel pointed out the spot. ‘I +am at home now,’ said he. ‘I believe I have a large +share in these cocoa-nuts; and in that house madame my mother lives +with her two husbands!’ ‘With two husbands?’ +somebody inquired. ‘<i>C’est ma honte</i>,’ +replied the brother drily.<br> +<br> +A word in passing on the two husbands. I conceive the brother +to have expressed himself loosely. It seems common enough to find +a native lady with two consorts; but these are not two husbands. +The first is still the husband; the wife continues to be referred to +by his name; and the position of the coadjutor, or <i>pikio</i>, although +quite regular, appears undoubtedly subordinate. We had opportunities +to observe one household of the sort. The <i>pikio</i> was recognised; +appeared openly along with the husband when the lady was thought to +be insulted, and the pair made common cause like brothers. At +home the inequality was more apparent. The husband sat to receive +and entertain visitors; the <i>pikio</i> was running the while to fetch +cocoa-nuts like a hired servant, and I remarked he was sent on these +errands in preference even to the son. Plainly we have here no +second husband; plainly we have the tolerated lover. Only, in +the Marquesas, instead of carrying his lady’s fan and mantle, +he must turn his hand to do the husband’s housework.<br> +<br> +The sight of Brother Michel’s family estate led the conversation +for some while upon the method and consequence of artificial kinship. +Our curiosity became extremely whetted; the brother offered to have +the whole of us adopted, and some two days later we became accordingly +the children of Paaaeua, appointed chief of Atuona. I was unable +to be present at the ceremony, which was primitively simple. The +two Mrs. Stevensons and Mr. Osbourne, along with Paaaeua, his wife, +and an adopted child of theirs, son of a shipwrecked Austrian, sat down +to an excellent island meal, of which the principal and the only necessary +dish was pig. A concourse watched them through the apertures of +the house; but none, not even Brother Michel, might partake; for the +meal was sacramental, and either creative or declaratory of the new +relationship. In Tahiti things are not so strictly ordered; when +Ori and I ‘made brothers,’ both our families sat with us +at table, yet only he and I, who had eaten with intention were supposed +to be affected by the ceremony. For the adoption of an infant +I believe no formality to be required; the child is handed over by the +natural parents, and grows up to inherit the estates of the adoptive. +Presents are doubtless exchanged, as at all junctures of island life, +social or international; but I never heard of any banquet - the child’s +presence at the daily board perhaps sufficing. We may find the +rationale in the ancient Arabian idea that a common diet makes a common +blood, with its derivative axiom that ‘he is the father who gives +the child its morning draught.’ In the Marquesan practice, +the sense would thus be evanescent; from the Tahitian, a mere survival, +it will have entirely fled. An interesting parallel will probably +occur to many of my readers.<br> +<br> +What is the nature of the obligation assumed at such a festival? +It will vary with the characters of those engaged, and with the circumstances +of the case. Thus it would be absurd to take too seriously our +adoption at Atuona. On the part of Paaaeua it was an affair of +social ambition; when he agreed to receive us in his family the man +had not so much as seen us, and knew only that we were inestimably rich +and travelled in a floating palace. We, upon our side, ate of +his baked meats with no true <i>animus affiliandi</i>, but moved by +the single sentiment of curiosity. The affair was formal, and +a matter of parade, as when in Europe sovereigns call each other cousin. +Yet, had we stayed at Atuona, Paaaeua would have held himself bound +to establish us upon his land, and to set apart young men for our service, +and trees for our support. I have mentioned the Austrian. +He sailed in one of two sister ships, which left the Clyde in coal; +both rounded the Horn, and both, at several hundred miles of distance, +though close on the same point of time, took fire at sea on the Pacific. +One was destroyed; the derelict iron frame of the second, after long, +aimless cruising, was at length recovered, refitted, and hails to-day +from San Francisco. A boat’s crew from one of these disasters +reached, after great hardships, the isle of Hiva-oa. Some of these +men vowed they would never again confront the chances of the sea; but +alone of them all the Austrian has been exactly true to his engagement, +remains where he landed, and designs to die where he has lived. +Now, with such a man, falling and taking root among islanders, the processes +described may be compared to a gardener’s graft. He passes +bodily into the native stock; ceases wholly to be alien; has entered +the commune of the blood, shares the prosperity and consideration of +his new family, and is expected to impart with the same generosity the +fruits of his European skill and knowledge. It is this implied +engagement that so frequently offends the ingrafted white. To +snatch an immediate advantage - to get (let us say) a station for his +store - he will play upon the native custom and become a son or a brother +for the day, promising himself to cast down the ladder by which he shall +have ascended, and repudiate the kinship so soon as it shall grow burdensome. +And he finds there are two parties to the bargain. Perhaps his +Polynesian relative is simple, and conceived the blood-bond literally; +perhaps he is shrewd, and himself entered the covenant with a view to +gain. And either way the store is ravaged, the house littered +with lazy natives; and the richer the man grows, the more numerous, +the more idle, and the more affectionate he finds his native relatives. +Most men thus circumstanced contrive to buy or brutally manage to enforce +their independence; but many vegetate without hope, strangled by parasites.<br> +<br> +We had no cause to blush with Brother Michel. Our new parents +were kind, gentle, well-mannered, and generous in gifts; the wife was +a most motherly woman, the husband a man who stood justly high with +his employers. Enough has been said to show why Moipu should be +deposed; and in Paaaeua the French had found a reputable substitute. +He went always scrupulously dressed, and looked the picture of propriety, +like a dark, handsome, stupid, and probably religious young man hot +from a European funeral. In character he seemed the ideal of what +is known as the good citizen. He wore gravity like an ornament. +None could more nicely represent the desired character as an appointed +chief, the outpost of civilisation and reform. And yet, were the +French to go and native manners to revive, fancy beholds him crowned +with old men’s beards and crowding with the first to a man-eating +festival. But I must not seem to be unjust to Paaaeua. His +respectability went deeper than the skin; his sense of the becoming +sometimes nerved him for unexpected rigours.<br> +<br> +One evening Captain Otis and Mr. Osbourne were on shore in the village. +All was agog; dancing had begun; it was plain it was to be a night of +festival, and our adventurers were overjoyed at their good fortune. +A strong fall of rain drove them for shelter to the house of Paaaeua, +where they were made welcome, wiled into a chamber, and shut in. +Presently the rain took off, the fun was to begin in earnest, and the +young bloods of Atuona came round the house and called to my fellow-travellers +through the interstices of the wall. Late into the night the calls +were continued and resumed, and sometimes mingled with taunts; late +into the night the prisoners, tantalised by the noises of the festival, +renewed their efforts to escape. But all was vain; right across +the door lay that god-fearing householder, Paaaeua, feigning sleep; +and my friends had to forego their junketing. In this incident, +so delightfully European, we thought we could detect three strands of +sentiment. In the first place, Paaaeua had a charge of souls: +these were young men, and he judged it right to withhold them from the +primrose path. Secondly, he was a public character, and it was +not fitting that his guests should countenance a festival of which he +disapproved. So might some strict clergyman at home address a +worldly visitor: ‘Go to the theatre if you like, but, by your +leave, not from my house!’ Thirdly, Paaaeua was a man jealous, +and with some cause (as shall be shown) for jealousy; and the feasters +were the satellites of his immediate rival, Moipu.<br> +<br> +For the adoption had caused much excitement in the village; it made +the strangers popular. Paaaeua, in his difficult posture of appointed +chief, drew strength and dignity from their alliance, and only Moipu +and his followers were malcontent. For some reason nobody (except +myself) appears to dislike Moipu. Captain Hart, who has been robbed +and threatened by him; Father Orens, whom he has fired at, and repeatedly +driven to the woods; my own family, and even the French officials - +all seemed smitten with an irrepressible affection for the man. +His fall had been made soft; his son, upon his death, was to succeed +Paaaeua in the chieftaincy; and he lived, at the time of our visit, +in the shoreward part of the village in a good house, and with a strong +following of young men, his late braves and pot-hunters. In this +society, the coming of the <i>Casco</i>, the adoption, the return feast +on board, and the presents exchanged between the whites and their new +parents, were doubtless eagerly and bitterly canvassed. It was +felt that a few years ago the honours would have gone elsewhere. +In this unwonted business, in this reception of some hitherto undreamed-of +and outlandish potentate - some Prester John or old Assaracus - a few +years back it would have been the part of Moipu to play the hero and +the host, and his young men would have accompanied and adorned the various +celebrations as the acknowledged leaders of society. And now, +by a malign vicissitude of fortune, Moipu must sit in his house quite +unobserved; and his young men could but look in at the door while their +rivals feasted. Perhaps M. Grévy felt a touch of bitterness +towards his successor when he beheld him figure on the broad stage of +the centenary of eighty-nine; the visit of the <i>Casco</i> which Moipu +had missed by so few years was a more unusual occasion in Atuona than +a centenary in France; and the dethroned chief determined to reassert +himself in the public eye.<br> +<br> +Mr. Osbourne had gone into Atuona photographing; the population of the +village had gathered together for the occasion on the place before the +church, and Paaaeua, highly delighted with this new appearance of his +family, played the master of ceremonies. The church had been taken, +with its jolly architect before the door; the nuns with their pupils; +sundry damsels in the ancient and singularly unbecoming robes of tapa; +and Father Orens in the midst of a group of his parishioners. +I know not what else was in hand, when the photographer became aware +of a sensation in the crowd, and, looking around, beheld a very noble +figure of a man appear upon the margin of a thicket and stroll nonchalantly +near. The nonchalance was visibly affected; it was plain he came +there to arouse attention, and his success was instant. He was +introduced; he was civil, he was obliging, he was always ineffably superior +and certain of himself; a well-graced actor. It was presently +suggested that he should appear in his war costume; he gracefully consented; +and returned in that strange, inappropriate and ill-omened array (which +very well became his handsome person) to strut in a circle of admirers, +and be thenceforth the centre of photography. Thus had Moipu effected +his introduction, as by accident, to the white strangers, made it a +favour to display his finery, and reduced his rival to a secondary <i>rôle</i> +on the theatre of the disputed village. Paaaeua felt the blow; +and, with a spirit which we never dreamed he could possess, asserted +his priority. It was found impossible that day to get a photograph +of Moipu alone; for whenever he stood up before the camera his successor +placed himself unbidden by his side, and gently but firmly held to his +position. The portraits of the pair, Jacob and Esau, standing +shoulder to shoulder, one in his careful European dress, one in his +barbaric trappings, figure the past and present of their island. +A graveyard with its humble crosses would be the aptest symbol of the +future.<br> +<br> +We are all impressed with the belief that Moipu had planned his campaign +from the beginning to the end. It is certain that he lost no time +in pushing his advantage. Mr. Osbourne was inveigled to his house; +various gifts were fished out of an old sea-chest; Father Orens was +called into service as interpreter, and Moipu formally proposed to ‘make +brothers’ with Mata-Galahi - Glass-Eyes, - the not very euphonious +name under which Mr. Osbourne passed in the Marquesas. The feast +of brotherhood took place on board the <i>Casco</i>. Paaaeua had +arrived with his family, like a plain man; and his presents, which had +been numerous, had followed one another, at intervals through several +days. Moipu, as if to mark at every point the opposition, came +with a certain feudal pomp, attended by retainers bearing gifts of all +descriptions, from plumes of old men’s beard to little, pious, +Catholic engravings.<br> +<br> +I had met the man before this in the village, and detested him on sight; +there was something indescribably raffish in his looks and ways that +raised my gorge; and when man-eating was referred to, and he laughed +a low, cruel laugh, part boastful, part bashful, like one reminded of +some dashing peccadillo, my repugnance was mingled with nausea. +This is no very human attitude, nor one at all becoming in a traveller. +And, seen more privately, the man improved. Something negroid +in character and face was still displeasing; but his ugly mouth became +attractive when he smiled, his figure and bearing were certainly noble, +and his eyes superb. In his appreciation of jams and pickles, +in is delight in the reverberating mirrors of the dining cabin, and +consequent endless repetition of Moipus and Mata-Galahis, he showed +himself engagingly a child. And yet I am not sure; and what seemed +childishness may have been rather courtly art. His manners struck +me as beyond the mark; they were refined and caressing to the point +of grossness, and when I think of the serene absent-mindedness with +which he first strolled in upon our party, and then recall him running +on hands and knees along the cabin sofas, pawing the velvet, dipping +into the beds, and bleating commendatory ‘<i>mitais</i>’ +with exaggerated emphasis, like some enormous over-mannered ape, I feel +the more sure that both must have been calculated. And I sometimes +wonder next, if Moipu were quite alone in this polite duplicity, and +ask myself whether the <i>Casco</i> were quite so much admired in the +Marquesas as our visitors desired us to suppose.<br> +<br> +I will complete this sketch of an incurable cannibal grandee with two +incongruous traits. His favourite morsel was the human hand, of +which he speaks to-day with an ill-favoured lustfulness. And when +he said good-bye to Mrs. Stevenson, holding her hand, viewing her with +tearful eyes, and chanting his farewell improvisation in the falsetto +of Marquesan high society, he wrote upon her mind a sentimental impression +which I try in vain to share.<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +PART II: THE PAUMOTUS<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +CHAPTER I - THE DANGEROUS ARCHIPELAGO - ATOLLS AT A DISTANCE<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +In the early morning of 4th September a whale-boat manned by natives +dragged us down the green lane of the anchorage and round the spouting +promontory. On the shore level it was a hot, breathless, and yet +crystal morning; but high overhead the hills of Atuona were all cowled +in cloud, and the ocean-river of the trades streamed without pause. +As we crawled from under the immediate shelter of the land, we reached +at last the limit of their influence. The wind fell upon our sails +in puffs, which strengthened and grew more continuous; presently the +<i>Casco</i> heeled down to her day’s work; the whale-boat, quite +outstripped, clung for a noisy moment to her quarter; the stipulated +bread, rum, and tobacco were passed in; a moment more and the boat was +in our wake, and our late pilots were cheering our departure.<br> +<br> +This was the more inspiriting as we were bound for scenes so different, +and though on a brief voyage, yet for a new province of creation. +That wide field of ocean, called loosely the South Seas, extends from +tropic to tropic, and from perhaps 123 degrees W. to 150 degrees E., +a parallelogram of one hundred degrees by forty-seven, where degrees +are the most spacious. Much of it lies vacant, much is closely +sown with isles, and the isles are of two sorts. No distinction +is so continually dwelt upon in South Sea talk as that between the ‘low’ +and the ‘high’ island, and there is none more broadly marked +in nature. The Himalayas are not more different from the Sahara. +On the one hand, and chiefly in groups of from eight to a dozen, volcanic +islands rise above the sea; few reach an altitude of less than 4000 +feet; one exceeds 13,000; their tops are often obscured in cloud, they +are all clothed with various forests, all abound in food, and are all +remarkable for picturesque and solemn scenery. On the other hand, +we have the atoll; a thing of problematic origin and history, the reputed +creature of an insect apparently unidentified; rudely annular in shape; +enclosing a lagoon; rarely extending beyond a quarter of a mile at its +chief width; often rising at its highest point to less than the stature +of a man - man himself, the rat and the land crab, its chief inhabitants; +not more variously supplied with plants; and offering to the eye, even +when perfect, only a ring of glittering beach and verdant foliage, enclosing +and enclosed by the blue sea.<br> +<br> +In no quarter are the atolls so thickly congregated, in none are they +so varied in size from the greatest to the least, and in none is navigation +so beset with perils, as in that archipelago that we were now to thread. +The huge system of the trades is, for some reason, quite confounded +by this multiplicity of reefs, the wind intermits, squalls are frequent +from the west and south-west, hurricanes are known. The currents +are, besides, inextricably intermixed; dead reckoning becomes a farce; +the charts are not to be trusted; and such is the number and similarity +of these islands that, even when you have picked one up, you may be +none the wiser. The reputation of the place is consequently infamous; +insurance offices exclude it from their field, and it was not without +misgiving that my captain risked the <i>Casco</i> in such waters. +I believe, indeed, it is almost understood that yachts are to avoid +this baffling archipelago; and it required all my instances - and all +Mr. Otis’s private taste for adventure - to deflect our course +across its midst.<br> +<br> +For a few days we sailed with a steady trade, and a steady westerly +current setting us to leeward; and toward sundown of the seventh it +was supposed we should have sighted Takaroa, one of Cook’s so-called +King George Islands. The sun set; yet a while longer the old moon +- semi-brilliant herself, and with a silver belly, which was her successor +- sailed among gathering clouds; she, too, deserted us; stars of every +degree of sheen, and clouds of every variety of form disputed the sub-lustrous +night; and still we gazed in vain for Takaroa. The mate stood +on the bowsprit, his tall grey figure slashing up and down against the +stars, and still<br> +<br> +<br> +‘nihil astra praeter<br> +Vidit et undas.<br> +<br> +<br> +The rest of us were grouped at the port anchor davit, staring with no +less assiduity, but with far less hope on the obscure horizon. +Islands we beheld in plenty, but they were of ‘such stuff as dreams +are made on,’ and vanished at a wink, only to appear in other +places; and by and by not only islands, but refulgent and revolving +lights began to stud the darkness; lighthouses of the mind or of the +wearied optic nerve, solemnly shining and winking as we passed. +At length the mate himself despaired, scrambled on board again from +his unrestful perch, and announced that we had missed our destination. +He was the only man of practice in these waters, our sole pilot, shipped +for that end at Tai-o-hae. If he declared we had missed Takaroa, +it was not for us to quarrel with the fact, but, if we could, to explain +it. We had certainly run down our southing. Our canted wake +upon the sea and our somewhat drunken-looking course upon the chart +both testified with no less certainty to an impetuous westward current. +We had no choice but to conclude we were again set down to leeward; +and the best we could do was to bring the <i>Casco</i> to the wind, +keep a good watch, and expect morning.<br> +<br> +I slept that night, as was then my somewhat dangerous practice, on deck +upon the cockpit bench. A stir at last awoke me, to see all the +eastern heaven dyed with faint orange, the binnacle lamp already dulled +against the brightness of the day, and the steersman leaning eagerly +across the wheel. ‘There it is, sir!’ he cried, and +pointed in the very eyeball of the dawn. For awhile I could see +nothing but the bluish ruins of the morning bank, which lay far along +the horizon, like melting icebergs. Then the sun rose, pierced +a gap in these <i>débris</i> of vapours, and displayed an inconsiderable +islet, flat as a plate upon the sea, and spiked with palms of disproportioned +altitude.<br> +<br> +So far, so good. Here was certainly an atoll; and we were certainly +got among the archipelago. But which? And where? The +isle was too small for either Takaroa: in all our neighbourhood, indeed, +there was none so inconsiderable, save only Tikei; and Tikei, one of +Roggewein’s so-called Pernicious Islands, seemed beside the question. +At that rate, instead of drifting to the west, we must have fetched +up thirty miles to windward. And how about the current? +It had been setting us down, by observation, all these days: by the +deflection of our wake, it should be setting us down that moment. +When had it stopped? When had it begun again? and what kind of +torrent was that which had swept us eastward in the interval? +To these questions, so typical of navigation in that range of isles, +I have no answer. Such were at least the facts; Tikei our island +turned out to be; and it was our first experience of the dangerous archipelago, +to make our landfall thirty miles out.<br> +<br> +The sight of Tikei, thrown direct against the splendour of the morning, +robbed of all its colour, and deformed with disproportioned trees like +bristles on a broom, had scarce prepared us to be much in love with +atolls. Later the same day we saw under more fit conditions the +island of Taiaro. <i>Lost in the Sea</i> is possibly the meaning +of the name. And it was so we saw it; lost in blue sea and sky: +a ring of white beach, green underwood, and tossing palms, gem-like +in colour; of a fairy, of a heavenly prettiness. The surf ran +all around it, white as snow, and broke at one point, far to seaward, +on what seems an uncharted reef. There was no smoke, no sign of +man; indeed, the isle is not inhabited, only visited at intervals. +And yet a trader (Mr. Narii Salmon) was watching from the shore +and wondering at the unexpected ship. I have spent since then +long months upon low islands; I know the tedium of their undistinguished +days; I know the burden of their diet. With whatever envy we may +have looked from the deck on these green coverts, it was with a tenfold +greater that Mr. Salmon and his comrades saw us steer, in our trim ship, +to seaward.<br> +<br> +The night fell lovely in the extreme. After the moon went down, +the heaven was a thing to wonder at for stars. And as I lay in +the cockpit and looked upon the steersman I was haunted by Emerson’s +verses:<br> +<br> +<br> +‘And the lone seaman all the night<br> +Sails astonished among stars.’<br> +<br> +<br> +By this glittering and imperfect brightness, about four bells in the +first watch we made our third atoll, Raraka. The low line of the +isle lay straight along the sky; so that I was at first reminded of +a towpath, and we seemed to be mounting some engineered and navigable +stream. Presently a red star appeared, about the height and brightness +of a danger signal, and with that my simile was changed; we seemed rather +to skirt the embankment of a railway, and the eye began to look instinctively +for the telegraph-posts, and the ear to expect the coming of a train. +Here and there, but rarely, faint tree-tops broke the level. And +the sound of the surf accompanied us, now in a drowsy monotone, now +with a menacing swing.<br> +<br> +The isle lay nearly east and west, barring our advance on Fakarava. +We must, therefore, hug the coast until we gained the western end, where, +through a passage eight miles wide, we might sail southward between +Raraka and the next isle, Kauehi. We had the wind free, a lightish +air; but clouds of an inky blackness were beginning to arise, and at +times it lightened - without thunder. Something, I know not what, +continually set us up upon the island. We lay more and more to +the nor’ard; and you would have thought the shore copied our manoeuvre +and outsailed us. Once and twice Raraka headed us again - again, in +the sea fashion, the quite innocent steersman was abused - and again +the <i>Casco</i> kept away. Had I been called on, with no more +light than that of our experience, to draw the configuration of that +island, I should have shown a series of bow-window promontories, each +overlapping the other to the nor’ard, and the trend of the land +from the south-east to the north-west, and behold, on the chart it lay +near east and west in a straight line.<br> +<br> +We had but just repeated our manoeuvre and kept away - for not more +than five minutes the railway embankment had been lost to view and the +surf to hearing - when I was aware of land again, not only on the weather +bow, but dead ahead. I played the part of the judicious landsman, +holding my peace till the last moment; and presently my mariners perceived +it for themselves.<br> +<br> +‘Land ahead!’ said the steersman.<br> +<br> +‘By God, it’s Kauehi!’ cried the mate.<br> +<br> +And so it was. And with that I began to be sorry for cartographers. +We were scarce doing three and a half; and they asked me to believe +that (in five minutes) we had dropped an island, passed eight miles +of open water, and run almost high and dry upon the next. But +my captain was more sorry for himself to be afloat in such a labyrinth; +laid the <i>Casco</i> to, with the log line up and down, and sat on +the stern rail and watched it till the morning. He had enough +of night in the Paumotus.<br> +<br> +By daylight on the 9th we began to skirt Kauehi, and had now an opportunity +to see near at hand the geography of atolls. Here and there, where +it was high, the farther side loomed up; here and there the near side +dipped entirely and showed a broad path of water into the lagoon; here +and there both sides were equally abased, and we could look right through +the discontinuous ring to the sea horizon on the south. Conceive, +on a vast scale, the submerged hoop of the duck-hunter, trimmed with +green rushes to conceal his head - water within, water without - you +have the image of the perfect atoll. Conceive one that has been +partly plucked of its rush fringe; you have the atoll of Kauehi. +And for either shore of it at closer quarters, conceive the line of +some old Roman highway traversing a wet morass, and here sunk out of +view and there re-arising, crowned with a green tuft of thicket; only +instead of the stagnant waters of a marsh, the live ocean now boiled +against, now buried the frail barrier. Last night’s impression +in the dark was thus confirmed by day, and not corrected. We sailed +indeed by a mere causeway in the sea, of nature’s handiwork, yet +of no greater magnitude than many of the works of man.<br> +<br> +The isle was uninhabited; it was all green brush and white sand, set +in transcendently blue water; even the coco-palms were rare, though +some of these completed the bright harmony of colour by hanging out +a fan of golden yellow. For long there was no sign of life beyond +the vegetable, and no sound but the continuous grumble of the surf. +In silence and desertion these fair shores slipped past, and were submerged +and rose again with clumps of thicket from the sea. And then a +bird or two appeared, hovering and crying; swiftly these became more +numerous, and presently, looking ahead, we were aware of a vast effervescence +of winged life. In this place the annular isle was mostly under +water, carrying here and there on its submerged line a wooded islet. +Over one of these the birds hung and flew with an incredible density +like that of gnats or hiving bees; the mass flashed white and black, +and heaved and quivered, and the screaming of the creatures rose over +the voice of the surf in a shrill clattering whirr. As you descend +some inland valley a not dissimilar sound announces the nearness of +a mill and pouring river. Some stragglers, as I said, came to +meet our approach; a few still hung about the ship as we departed. +The crying died away, the last pair of wings was left behind, and once +more the low shores of Kauehi streamed past our eyes in silence like +a picture. I supposed at the time that the birds lived, like ants +or citizens, concentred where we saw them. I have been told since +(I know not if correctly) that the whole isle, or much of it, is similarly +peopled; and that the effervescence at a single spot would be the mark +of a boat’s crew of egg-hunters from one of the neighbouring inhabited +atolls. So that here at Kauehi, as the day before at Taiaro, the +<i>Casco</i> sailed by under the fire of unsuspected eyes. And +one thing is surely true, that even on these ribbons of land an army +might lie hid and no passing mariner divine its presence.<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +CHAPTER II - FAKARAVA: AN ATOLL AT HAND<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +By a little before noon we were running down the coast of our destination, +Fakarava: the air very light, the sea near smooth; though still we were +accompanied by a continuous murmur from the beach, like the sound of +a distant train. The isle is of a huge longitude, the enclosed +lagoon thirty miles by ten or twelve, and the coral tow-path, which +they call the land, some eighty or ninety miles by (possibly) one furlong. +That part by which we sailed was all raised; the underwood excellently +green, the topping wood of coco-palms continuous - a mark, if I had +known it, of man’s intervention. For once more, and once +more unconsciously, we were within hail of fellow-creatures, and that +vacant beach was but a pistol-shot from the capital city of the archipelago. +But the life of an atoll, unless it be enclosed, passes wholly on the +shores of the lagoon; it is there the villages are seated, there the +canoes ply and are drawn up; and the beach of the ocean is a place accursed +and deserted, the fit scene only for wizardry and shipwreck, and in +the native belief a haunting ground of murderous spectres.<br> +<br> +By and by we might perceive a breach in the low barrier; the woods ceased; +a glittering point ran into the sea, tipped with an emerald shoal the +mark of entrance. As we drew near we met a little run of sea - +the private sea of the lagoon having there its origin and end, and here, +in the jaws of the gateway, trying vain conclusions with the more majestic +heave of the Pacific. The <i>Casco</i> scarce avowed a shock; +but there are times and circumstances when these harbour mouths of inland +basins vomit floods, deflecting, burying, and dismasting ships. +For, conceive a lagoon perfectly sealed but in the one point, and that +of merely navigable width; conceive the tide and wind to have heaped +for hours together in that coral fold a superfluity of waters, and the +tide to change and the wind fall - the open sluice of some great reservoirs +at home will give an image of the unstemmable effluxion.<br> +<br> +We were scarce well headed for the pass before all heads were craned +over the rail. For the water, shoaling under our board, became +changed in a moment to surprising hues of blue and grey; and in its +transparency the coral branched and blossomed, and the fish of the inland +sea cruised visibly below us, stained and striped, and even beaked like +parrots. I have paid in my time to view many curiosities; never +one so curious as that first sight over the ship’s rail in the +lagoon of Fakarava. But let not the reader be deceived with hope. +I have since entered, I suppose, some dozen atolls in different parts +of the Pacific, and the experience has never been repeated. That +exquisite hue and transparency of submarine day, and these shoals of +rainbow fish, have not enraptured me again.<br> +<br> +Before we could raise our eyes from that engaging spectacle the schooner +had slipped betwixt the pierheads of the reef, and was already quite +committed to the sea within. The containing shores are so little +erected, and the lagoon itself is so great, that, for the more part, +it seemed to extend without a check to the horizon. Here and there, +indeed, where the reef carried an inlet, like a signet-ring upon a finger, +there would be a pencilling of palms; here and there, the green wall +of wood ran solid for a length of miles; and on the port hand, under +the highest grove of trees, a few houses sparkled white - Rotoava, the +metropolitan settlement of the Paumotus. Hither we beat in three +tacks, and came to an anchor close in shore, in the first smooth water +since we had left San Francisco, five fathoms deep, where a man might +look overboard all day at the vanishing cable, the coral patches, and +the many-coloured fish.<br> +<br> +Fakarava was chosen to be the seat of Government from nautical considerations +only. It is eccentrically situate; the productions, even for a +low island, poor; the population neither many nor - for Low Islanders +- industrious. But the lagoon has two good passages, one to leeward, +one to windward, so that in all states of the wind it can be left and +entered, and this advantage, for a government of scattered islands, +was decisive. A pier of coral, landing-stairs, a harbour light +upon a staff and pillar, and two spacious Government bungalows in a +handsome fence, give to the northern end of Rotoava a great air of consequence. +This is confirmed on the one hand by an empty prison, on the other by +a gendarmerie pasted over with hand-bills in Tahitian, land-law notices +from Papeete, and republican sentiments from Paris, signed (a little +after date) ‘Jules Grévy, <i>Perihidente</i>.’ +Quite at the far end a belfried Catholic chapel concludes the town; +and between, on a smooth floor of white coral sand and under the breezy +canopy of coco-palms, the houses of the natives stand irregularly scattered, +now close on the lagoon for the sake of the breeze, now back under the +palms for love of shadow.<br> +<br> +Not a soul was to be seen. But for the thunder of the surf on +the far side, it seemed you might have heard a pin drop anywhere about +that capital city. There was something thrilling in the unexpected +silence, something yet more so in the unexpected sound. Here before +us a sea reached to the horizon, rippling like an inland mere; and behold! +close at our back another sea assaulted with assiduous fury the reverse +of the position. At night the lantern was run up and lit a vacant +pier. In one house lights were seen and voices heard, where the +population (I was told) sat playing cards. A little beyond, from +deep in the darkness of the palm-grove, we saw the glow and smelt the +aromatic odour of a coal of cocoa-nut husk, a relic of the evening kitchen. +Crickets sang; some shrill thing whistled in a tuft of weeds; and the +mosquito hummed and stung. There was no other trace that night +of man, bird, or insect in the isle. The moon, now three days +old, and as yet but a silver crescent on a still visible sphere, shone +through the palm canopy with vigorous and scattered lights. The +alleys where we walked were smoothed and weeded like a boulevard; here +and there were plants set out; here and there dusky cottages clustered +in the shadow, some with verandahs. A public garden by night, +a rich and fashionable watering-place in a by-season, offer sights and +vistas not dissimilar. And still, on the one side, stretched the +lapping mere, and from the other the deep sea still growled in the night. +But it was most of all on board, in the dead hours, when I had been +better sleeping, that the spell of Fakarava seized and held me. +The moon was down. The harbour lantern and two of the greater +planets drew vari-coloured wakes on the lagoon. From shore the +cheerful watch-cry of cocks rang out at intervals above the organ-point +of surf. And the thought of this depopulated capital, this protracted +thread of annular island with its crest of coco-palms and fringe of +breakers, and that tranquil inland sea that stretched before me till +it touched the stars, ran in my head for hours with delight.<br> +<br> +So long as I stayed upon that isle these thoughts were constant. +I lay down to sleep, and woke again with an unblunted sense of my surroundings. +I was never weary of calling up the image of that narrow causeway, on +which I had my dwelling, lying coiled like a serpent, tail to mouth, +in the outrageous ocean, and I was never weary of passing - a mere quarter-deck +parade - from the one side to the other, from the shady, habitable shores +of the lagoon to the blinding desert and uproarious breakers of the +opposite beach. The sense of insecurity in such a thread of residence +is more than fanciful. Hurricanes and tidal waves over-leap these +humble obstacles; Oceanus remembers his strength, and, where houses +stood and palms flourished, shakes his white beard again over the barren +coral. Fakarava itself has suffered; the trees immediately beyond +my house were all of recent replantation; and Anaa is only now recovered +from a heavier stroke. I knew one who was then dwelling in the +isle. He told me that he and two ship captains walked to the sea +beach. There for a while they viewed the oncoming breakers, till +one of the captains clapped suddenly his hand before his eyes and cried +aloud that he could endure no longer to behold them. This was +in the afternoon; in the dark hours of the night the sea burst upon +the island like a flood; the settlement was razed all but the church +and presbytery; and, when day returned, the survivors saw themselves +clinging in an abattis of uprooted coco-palms and ruined houses.<br> +<br> +Danger is but a small consideration. But men are more nicely sensible +of a discomfort; and the atoll is a discomfortable home. There +are some, and these probably ancient, where a deep soil has formed and +the most valuable fruit-trees prosper. I have walked in one, with +equal admiration and surprise, through a forest of huge breadfruits, +eating bananas and stumbling among taro as I went. This was in +the atoll of Namorik in the Marshall group, and stands alone in my experience. +To give the opposite extreme, which is yet far more near the average, +I will describe the soil and productions of Fakarava. The surface +of that narrow strip is for the more part of broken coral lime-stone, +like volcanic clinkers, and excruciating to the naked foot; in some +atolls, I believe, not in Fakarava, it gives a fine metallic ring when +struck. Here and there you come upon a bank of sand, exceeding +fine and white, and these parts are the least productive. The +plants (such as they are) spring from and love the broken coral, whence +they grow with that wonderful verdancy that makes the beauty of the +atoll from the sea. The coco-palm in particular luxuriates in +that stern <i>solum</i>, striking down his roots to the brackish, percolated +water, and bearing his green head in the wind with every evidence of +health and pleasure. And yet even the coco-palm must be helped +in infancy with some extraneous nutriment, and through much of the low +archipelago there is planted with each nut a piece of ship’s biscuit +and a rusty nail. The pandanus comes next in importance, being +also a food tree; and he, too, does bravely. A green bush called +<i>miki</i> runs everywhere; occasionally a purao is seen; and there +are several useless weeds. According to M. Cuzent, the whole number +of plants on an atoll such as Fakarava will scarce exceed, even if it +reaches to, one score. Not a blade of grass appears; not a grain +of humus, save when a sack or two has been imported to make the semblance +of a garden; such gardens as bloom in cities on the window-sill. +Insect life is sometimes dense; a cloud o’ mosquitoes, and, what +is far worse, a plague of flies blackening our food, has sometimes driven +us from a meal on Apemama; and even in Fakarava the mosquitoes were +a pest. The land crab may be seen scuttling to his hole, and at +night the rats besiege the houses and the artificial gardens. +The crab is good eating; possibly so is the rat; I have not tried. +Pandanus fruit is made, in the Gilberts, into an agreeable sweetmeat, +such as a man may trifle with at the end of a long dinner; for a substantial +meal I have no use for it. The rest of the food-supply, in a destitute +atoll such as Fakarava, can be summed up in the favourite jest of the +archipelago - cocoa-nut beefsteak. Cocoa-nut green, cocoa-nut +ripe, cocoa-nut germinated; cocoa-nut to eat and cocoa-nut to drink; +cocoa-nut raw and cooked, cocoa-nut hot and cold - such is the bill +of fare. And some of the entrées are no doubt delicious. +The germinated nut, cooked in the shell and eaten with a spoon, forms +a good pudding; cocoa-nut milk - the expressed juice of a ripe nut, +not the water of a green one - goes well in coffee, and is a valuable +adjunct in cookery through the South Seas; and cocoa-nut salad, if you +be a millionaire, and can afford to eat the value of a field of corn +for your dessert, is a dish to be remembered with affection. But +when all is done there is a sameness, and the Israelites of the low +islands murmur at their manna.<br> +<br> +The reader may think I have forgot the sea. The two beaches do +certainly abound in life, and they are strangely different. In +the lagoon the water shallows slowly on a bottom of the fine slimy sand, +dotted with clumps of growing coral. Then comes a strip of tidal +beach on which the ripples lap. In the coral clumps the great +holy-water clam <i>(Tridacna</i>) grows plentifully; a little deeper +lie the beds of the pearl-oyster and sail the resplendent fish that +charmed us at our entrance; and these are all more or less vigorously +coloured. But the other shells are white like lime, or faintly +tinted with a little pink, the palest possible display; many of them +dead besides, and badly rolled. On the ocean side, on the mounds +of the steep beach, over all the width of the reef right out to where +the surf is bursting, in every cranny, under every scattered fragment +of the coral, an incredible plenty of marine life displays the most +wonderful variety and brilliancy of hues. The reef itself has +no passage of colour but is imitated by some shell. Purple and +red and white, and green and yellow, pied and striped and clouded, the +living shells wear in every combination the livery of the dead reef +- if the reef be dead - so that the eye is continually baffled and the +collector continually deceived. I have taken shells for stones +and stones for shells, the one as often as the other. A prevailing +character of the coral is to be dotted with small spots of red, and +it is wonderful how many varieties of shell have adopted the same fashion +and donned the disguise of the red spot. A shell I had found in +plenty in the Marquesas I found here also unchanged in all things else, +but there were the red spots. A lively little crab wore the same +markings. The case of the hermit or soldier crab was more conclusive, +being the result of conscious choice. This nasty little wrecker, +scavenger, and squatter has learned the value of a spotted house; so +it be of the right colour he will choose the smallest shard, tuck himself +in a mere corner of a broken whorl, and go about the world half naked; +but I never found him in this imperfect armour unless it was marked +with the red spot.<br> +<br> +Some two hundred yards distant is the beach of the lagoon. Collect +the shells from each, set them side by side, and you would suppose they +came from different hemispheres; the one so pale, the other so brilliant; +the one prevalently white, the other of a score of hues, and infected +with the scarlet spot like a disease. This seems the more strange, +since the hermit crabs pass and repass the island, and I have met them +by the Residency well, which is about central, journeying either way. +Without doubt many of the shells in the lagoon are dead. But why +are they dead? Without doubt the living shells have a very different +background set for imitation. But why are these so different? +We are only on the threshold of the mysteries.<br> +<br> +Either beach, I have said, abounds with life. On the sea-side +and in certain atolls this profusion of vitality is even shocking: the +rock under foot is mined with it. I have broken off - notably +in Funafuti and Arorai - great lumps of ancient weathered rock that +rang under my blows like iron, and the fracture has been full of pendent +worms as long as my hand, as thick as a child’s finger, of a slightly +pinkish white, and set as close as three or even four to the square +inch. Even in the lagoon, where certain shell-fish seem to sicken, +others (it is notorious) prosper exceedingly and make the riches of +these islands. Fish, too, abound; the lagoon is a closed fish-pond, +such as might rejoice the fancy of an abbot; sharks swarm there, and +chiefly round the passages, to feast upon this plenty, and you would +suppose that man had only to prepare his angle. Alas! it is not +so. Of these painted fish that came in hordes about the entering +<i>Casco</i>, some bore poisonous spines, and others were poisonous +if eaten. The stranger must refrain, or take his chance of painful +and dangerous sickness. The native, on his own isle, is a safe +guide; transplant him to the next, and he is helpless as yourself. +For it is a question both of time and place. A fish caught in +a lagoon may be deadly; the same fish caught the same day at sea, and +only a few hundred yards without the passage, will be wholesome eating: +in a neighbouring isle perhaps the case will be reversed; and perhaps +a fortnight later you shall be able to eat of them indifferently from +within and from without. According to the natives, these bewildering +vicissitudes are ruled by the movement of the heavenly bodies. +The beautiful planet Venus plays a great part in all island tales and +customs; and among other functions, some of them more awful, she regulates +the season of good fish. With Venus in one phase, as we had her, +certain fish were poisonous in the lagoon: with Venus in another, the +same fish was harmless and a valued article of diet. White men +explain these changes by the phases of the coral.<br> +<br> +It adds a last touch of horror to the thought of this precarious annular +gangway in the sea, that even what there is of it is not of honest rock, +but organic, part alive, part putrescent; even the clean sea and the +bright fish about it poisoned, the most stubborn boulder burrowed in +by worms, the lightest dust venomous as an apothecary’s drugs.<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +CHAPTER III - A HOUSE TO LET IN A LOW ISLAND<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +Never populous, it was yet by a chapter of accidents that I found the +island so deserted that no sound of human life diversified the hours; +that we walked in that trim public garden of a town, among closed houses, +without even a lodging-bill in a window to prove some tenancy in the +back quarters; and, when we visited the Government bungalow, that Mr. +Donat, acting Vice-Resident, greeted us alone, and entertained us with +cocoa-nut punches in the Sessions Hall and seat of judgment of that +widespread archipelago, our glasses standing arrayed with summonses +and census returns. The unpopularity of a late Vice-Resident had +begun the movement of exodus, his native employés resigning court +appointments and retiring each to his own coco-patch in the remoter +districts of the isle. Upon the back of that, the Governor in +Papeete issued a decree: All land in the Paumotus must be defined and +registered by a certain date. Now, the folk of the archipelago +are half nomadic; a man can scarce be said to belong to a particular +atoll; he belongs to several, perhaps holds a stake and counts cousinship +in half a score; and the inhabitants of Rotoava in particular, man, +woman, and child, and from the gendarme to the Mormon prophet and the +schoolmaster, owned - I was going to say land - owned at least coral +blocks and growing coco-palms in some adjacent isle. Thither - +from the gendarme to the babe in arms, the pastor followed by his flock, +the schoolmaster carrying along with him his scholars, and the scholars +with their books and slates - they had taken ship some two days previous +to our arrival, and were all now engaged disputing boundaries. +Fancy overhears the shrillness of their disputation mingle with the +surf and scatter sea-fowl. It was admirable to observe the completeness +of their flight, like that of hibernating birds; nothing left but empty +houses, like old nests to be reoccupied in spring; and even the harmless +necessary dominie borne with them in their transmigration. Fifty +odd set out, and only seven, I was informed, remained. But when +I made a feast on board the <i>Casco</i>, more than seven, and nearer +seven times seven, appeared to be my guests. Whence they appeared, +how they were summoned, whither they vanished when the feast was eaten, +I have no guess. In view of Low Island tales, and that awful frequentation +which makes men avoid the seaward beaches of an atoll, some two score +of those that ate with us may have returned, for the occasion, from +the kingdom of the dead.<br> +<br> +It was this solitude that put it in our minds to hire a house, and become, +for the time being, indwellers of the isle - a practice I have ever +since, when it was possible, adhered to. Mr. Donat placed us, +with that intent, under the convoy of one Taniera Mahinui, who combined +the incongruous characters of catechist and convict. The reader +may smile, but I affirm he was well qualified for either part. +For that of convict, first of all, by a good substantial felony, such +as in all lands casts the perpetrator in chains and dungeons. +Taniera was a man of birth - the chief a while ago, as he loved to tell, +of a district in Anaa of 800 souls. In an evil hour it occurred +to the authorities in Papeete to charge the chiefs with the collection +of the taxes. It is a question if much were collected; it is certain +that nothing was handed on; and Taniera, who had distinguished himself +by a visit to Papeete and some high living in restaurants, was chosen +for the scapegoat. The reader must understand that not Taniera +but the authorities in Papeete were first in fault. The charge +imposed was disproportioned. I have not yet heard of any Polynesian +capable of such a burden; honest and upright Hawaiians - one in particular, +who was admired even by the whites as an inflexible magistrate - have +stumbled in the narrow path of the trustee. And Taniera, when +the pinch came, scorned to denounce accomplices; others had shared the +spoil, he bore the penalty alone. He was condemned in five years. +The period, when I had the pleasure of his friendship, was not yet expired; +he still drew prison rations, the sole and not unwelcome reminder of +his chains, and, I believe, looked forward to the date of his enfranchisement +with mere alarm. For he had no sense of shame in the position; +complained of nothing but the defective table of his place of exile; +regretted nothing but the fowls and eggs and fish of his own more favoured +island. And as for his parishioners, they did not think one hair +the less of him. A schoolboy, mulcted in ten thousand lines of +Greek and dwelling sequestered in the dormitories, enjoys unabated consideration +from his fellows. So with Taniera: a marked man, not a dishonoured; +having fallen under the lash of the unthinkable gods; a Job, perhaps, +or say a Taniera in the den of lions. Songs are likely made and +sung about this saintly Robin Hood. On the other hand, he was +even highly qualified for his office in the Church; being by nature +a grave, considerate, and kindly man; his face rugged and serious, his +smile bright; the master of several trades, a builder both of boats +and houses; endowed with a fine pulpit voice; endowed besides with such +a gift of eloquence that at the grave of the late chief of Fakarava +he set all the assistants weeping. I never met a man of a mind +more ecclesiastical; he loved to dispute and to inform himself of doctrine +and the history of sects; and when I showed him the cuts in a volume +of Chambers’s <i>Encyclopaedia</i> - except for one of an ape +- reserved his whole enthusiasm for cardinals’ hats, censers, +candlesticks, and cathedrals. Methought when he looked upon the +cardinal’s hat a voice said low in his ear: ‘Your foot is +on the ladder.’<br> +<br> +Under the guidance of Taniera we were soon installed in what I believe +to have been the best-appointed private house in Fakarava. It +stood just beyond the church in an oblong patch of cultivation. +More than three hundred sacks of soil were imported from Tahiti for +the Residency garden; and this must shortly be renewed, for the earth +blows away, sinks in crevices of the coral, and is sought for at last +in vain. I know not how much earth had gone to the garden of my +villa; some at least, for an alley of prosperous bananas ran to the +gate, and over the rest of the enclosure, which was covered with the +usual clinker-like fragments of smashed coral, not only coco-palms and +mikis but also fig-trees flourished, all of a delicious greenness. +Of course there was no blade of grass. In front a picket fence +divided us from the white road, the palm-fringed margin of the lagoon, +and the lagoon itself, reflecting clouds by day and stars by night. +At the back, a bulwark of uncemented coral enclosed us from the narrow +belt of bush and the nigh ocean beach where the seas thundered, the +roar and wash of them still humming in the chambers of the house.<br> +<br> +This itself was of one story, verandahed front and back. It contained +three rooms, three sewing-machines, three sea-chests, chairs, tables, +a pair of beds, a cradle, a double-barrelled gun, a pair of enlarged +coloured photographs, a pair of coloured prints after Wilkie and Mulready, +and a French lithograph with the legend: ‘<i>Le brigade du Général +Lepasset brûlant son drapeau</i> <i>devant Metz</i>.’ +Under the stilts of the house a stove was rusting, till we drew it forth +and put it in commission. Not far off was the burrow in the coral +whence we supplied ourselves with brackish water. There was live +stock, besides, on the estate - cocks and hens and a brace of ill-regulated +cats, whom Taniera came every morning with the sun to feed on grated +cocoa-nut. His voice was our regular réveille, ringing +pleasantly about the garden: ‘Pooty - pooty - poo - poo - poo!’<br> +<br> +Far as we were from the public offices, the nearness of the chapel made +our situation what is called eligible in advertisements, and gave us +a side look on some native life. Every morning, as soon as he +had fed the fowls, Taniera set the bell agoing in the small belfry; +and the faithful, who were not very numerous, gathered to prayers. +I was once present: it was the Lord’s day, and seven females and +eight males composed the congregation. A woman played precentor, +starting with a longish note; the catechist joined in upon the second +bar; and then the faithful in a body. Some had printed hymn-books +which they followed; some of the rest filled up with ‘eh - eh +- eh,’ the Paumotuan tol-de-rol. After the hymn, we had +an antiphonal prayer or two; and then Taniera rose from the front bench, +where he had been sitting in his catechist’s robes, passed within +the altar-rails, opened his Tahitian Bible, and began to preach from +notes. I understood one word - the name of God; but the preacher +managed his voice with taste, used rare and expressive gestures, and +made a strong impression of sincerity. The plain service, the +vernacular Bible, the hymn-tunes mostly on an English pattern - ‘God +save the Queen,’ I was informed, a special favourite, - all, save +some paper flowers upon the altar, seemed not merely but austerely Protestant. +It is thus the Catholics have met their low island proselytes half-way.<br> +<br> +Taniera had the keys of our house; it was with him I made my bargain, +if that could be called a bargain in which all was remitted to my generosity; +it was he who fed the cats and poultry, he who came to call and pick +a meal with us like an acknowledged friend; and we long fondly supposed +he was our landlord. This belief was not to bear the test of experience; +and, as my chapter has to relate, no certainty succeeded it.<br> +<br> +We passed some days of airless quiet and great heat; shell-gatherers +were warned from the ocean beach, where sunstroke waited them from ten +till four; the highest palm hung motionless, there was no voice audible +but that of the sea on the far side. At last, about four of a +certain afternoon, long cat’s-paws flawed the face of the lagoon; +and presently in the tree-tops there awoke the grateful bustle of the +trades, and all the houses and alleys of the island were fanned out. +To more than one enchanted ship, that had lain long becalmed in view +of the green shore, the wind brought deliverance; and by daylight on +the morrow a schooner and two cutters lay moored in the port of Rotoava. +Not only in the outer sea, but in the lagoon itself, a certain traffic +woke with the reviving breeze; and among the rest one François, +a half-blood, set sail with the first light in his own half-decked cutter. +He had held before a court appointment; being, I believe, the Residency +sweeper-out. Trouble arising with the unpopular Vice-Resident, +he had thrown his honours down, and fled to the far parts of the atoll +to plant cabbages - or at least coco-palms. Thence he was now +driven by such need as even a Cincinnatus must acknowledge, and fared +for the capital city, the seat of his late functions, to exchange half +a ton of copra for necessary flour. And here, for a while, the +story leaves to tell of his voyaging.<br> +<br> +It must tell, instead, of our house, where, toward seven at night, the +catechist came suddenly in with his pleased air of being welcome; armed +besides with a considerable bunch of keys. These he proceeded +to try on the sea-chests, drawing each in turn from its place against +the wall. Heads of strangers appeared in the doorway and volunteered +suggestions. All in vain. Either they were the wrong keys +or the wrong boxes, or the wrong man was trying them. For a little +Taniera fumed and fretted; then had recourse to the more summary method +of the hatchet; one of the chests was broken open, and an armful of +clothing, male and female, baled out and handed to the strangers on +the verandah.<br> +<br> +These were François, his wife, and their child. About eight +a.m., in the midst of the lagoon, their cutter had capsized in jibbing. +They got her righted, and though she was still full of water put the +child on board. The mainsail had been carried away, but the jib +still drew her sluggishly along, and François and the woman swam +astern and worked the rudder with their hands. The cold was cruel; +the fatigue, as time went on, became excessive; and in that preserve +of sharks, fear hunted them. Again and again, François, +the half-breed, would have desisted and gone down; but the woman, whole +blood of an amphibious race, still supported him with cheerful words. +I am reminded of a woman of Hawaii who swam with her husband, I dare +not say how many miles, in a high sea, and came ashore at last with +his dead body in her arms. It was about five in the evening, after +nine hours’ swimming, that François and his wife reached +land at Rotoava. The gallant fight was won, and instantly the +more childish side of native character appears. They had supped, +and told and retold their story, dripping as they came; the flesh of +the woman, whom Mrs. Stevenson helped to shift, was cold as stone; and +François, having changed to a dry cotton shirt and trousers, +passed the remainder of the evening on my floor and between open doorways, +in a thorough draught. Yet François, the son of a French +father, speaks excellent French himself and seems intelligent.<br> +<br> +It was our first idea that the catechist, true to his evangelical vocation, +was clothing the naked from his superfluity. Then it came out +that François was but dealing with his own. The clothes +were his, so was the chest, so was the house. François +was in fact the landlord. Yet you observe he had hung back on +the verandah while Taniera tried his ‘prentice hand upon the locks: +and even now, when his true character appeared, the only use he made +of the estate was to leave the clothes of his family drying on the fence. +Taniera was still the friend of the house, still fed the poultry, still +came about us on his daily visits, François, during the remainder +of his stay, holding bashfully aloof. And there was stranger matter. +Since François had lost the whole load of his cutter, the half +ton of copra, an axe, bowls, knives, and clothes - since he had in a +manner to begin the world again, and his necessary flour was not yet +bought or paid for - I proposed to advance him what he needed on the +rent. To my enduring amazement he refused, and the reason he gave +- if that can be called a reason which but darkens counsel - was that +Taniera was his friend. His friend, you observe; not his creditor. +I inquired into that, and was assured that Taniera, an exile in a strange +isle, might possibly be in debt himself, but certainly was no man’s +creditor.<br> +<br> +Very early one morning we were awakened by a bustling presence in the +yard, and found our camp had been surprised by a tall, lean old native +lady, dressed in what were obviously widow’s weeds. You +could see at a glance she was a notable woman, a housewife, sternly +practical, alive with energy, and with fine possibilities of temper. +Indeed, there was nothing native about her but the skin; and the type +abounds, and is everywhere respected, nearer home. It did us good +to see her scour the grounds, examining the plants and chickens; watering, +feeding, trimming them; taking angry, purpose-like possession. +When she neared the house our sympathy abated; when she came to the +broken chest I wished I were elsewhere. We had scarce a word in +common; but her whole lean body spoke for her with indignant eloquence. +‘My chest!’ it cried, with a stress on the possessive. +‘My chest - broken open! This is a fine state of things!’ +I hastened to lay the blame where it belonged - on François and +his wife - and found I had made things worse instead of better. +She repeated the names at first with incredulity, then with despair. +A while she seemed stunned, next fell to disembowelling the box, piling +the goods on the floor, and visibly computing the extent of François’s +ravages; and presently after she was observed in high speech with Taniera, +who seemed to hang an ear like one reproved.<br> +<br> +Here, then, by all known marks, should be my land-lady at last; here +was every character of the proprietor fully developed. Should +I not approach her on the still depending question of my rent? +I carried the point to an adviser. ‘Nonsense!’ he +cried. ‘That’s the old woman, the mother. It +doesn’t belong to her. I believe that’s the man the +house belongs to,’ and he pointed to one of the coloured photographs +on the wall. On this I gave up all desire of understanding; and +when the time came for me to leave, in the judgment-hall of the archipelago, +and with the awful countenance of the acting Governor, I duly paid my +rent to Taniera. He was satisfied, and so was I. But what +had he to do with it? Mr. Donat, acting magistrate and a man of +kindred blood, could throw no light upon the mystery; a plain private +person, with a taste for letters, cannot be expected to do more.<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +CHAPTER IV - TRAITS AND SECTS IN THE PAUMOTUS<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +The most careless reader must have remarked a change of air since the +Marquesas. The house, crowded with effects, the bustling housewife +counting her possessions, the serious, indoctrinated island pastor, +the long fight for life in the lagoon: here are traits of a new world. +I read in a pamphlet (I will not give the author’s name) that +the Marquesan especially resembles the Paumotuan. I should take +the two races, though so near in neighbourhood, to be extremes of Polynesian +diversity. The Marquesan is certainly the most beautiful of human +races, and one of the tallest - the Paumotuan averaging a good inch +shorter, and not even handsome; the Marquesan open-handed, inert, insensible +to religion, childishly self-indulgent - the Paumotuan greedy, hardy, +enterprising, a religious disputant, and with a trace of the ascetic +character.<br> +<br> +Yet a few years ago, and the people of the archipelago were crafty savages. +Their isles might be called sirens’ isles, not merely from the +attraction they exerted on the passing mariner, but from the perils +that awaited him on shore. Even to this day, in certain outlying +islands, danger lingers; and the civilized Paumotuan dreads to land +and hesitates to accost his backward brother. But, except in these, +to-day the peril is a memory. When our generation were yet in +the cradle and playroom it was still a living fact. Between 1830 +and 1840, Hao, for instance, was a place of the most dangerous approach, +where ships were seized and crews kidnapped. As late as 1856, +the schooner <i>Sarah Ann</i> sailed from Papeete and was seen no more. +She had women on board, and children, the captain’s wife, a nursemaid, +a baby, and the two young sons of a Captain Steven on their way to the +mainland for schooling. All were supposed to have perished in +a squall. A year later, the captain of the <i>Julia</i>, coasting +along the island variously called Bligh, Lagoon, and Tematangi saw armed +natives follow the course of his schooner, clad in many-coloured stuffs. +Suspicion was at once aroused; the mother of the lost children was profuse +of money; and one expedition having found the place deserted, and returned +content with firing a few shots, she raised and herself accompanied +another. None appeared to greet or to oppose them; they roamed +a while among abandoned huts and empty thickets; then formed two parties +and set forth to beat, from end to end, the pandanus jungle of the island. +One man remained alone by the landing-place - Teina, a chief of Anaa, +leader of the armed natives who made the strength of the expedition. +Now that his comrades were departed this way and that, on their laborious +exploration, the silence fell profound; and this silence was the ruin +of the islanders. A sound of stones rattling caught the ear of +Teina. He looked, thinking to perceive a crab, and saw instead +the brown hand of a human being issue from a fissure in the ground. +A shout recalled the search parties and announced their doom to the +buried caitiffs. In the cave below, sixteen were found crouching +among human bones and singular and horrid curiosities. One was +a head of golden hair, supposed to be a relic of the captain’s +wife; another was half of the body of a European child, sun-dried and +stuck upon a stick, doubtless with some design of wizardry.<br> +<br> +The Paumotuan is eager to be rich. He saves, grudges, buries money, +fears not work. For a dollar each, two natives passed the hours +of daylight cleaning our ship’s copper. It was strange to +see them so indefatigable and so much at ease in the water - working +at times with their pipes lighted, the smoker at times submerged and +only the glowing bowl above the surface; it was stranger still to think +they were next congeners to the incapable Marquesan. But the Paumotuan +not only saves, grudges, and works, he steals besides; or, to be more +precise, he swindles. He will never deny a debt, he only flees +his creditor. He is always keen for an advance; so soon as he +has fingered it he disappears. He knows your ship; so soon as +it nears one island, he is off to another. You may think you know +his name; he has already changed it. Pursuit in that infinity +of isles were fruitless. The result can be given in a nutshell. +It has been actually proposed in a Government report to secure debts +by taking a photograph of the debtor; and the other day in Papeete credits +on the Paumotus to the amount of sixteen thousand pounds were sold for +less than forty - <i>quatre cent mille francs pour moins de mille</i> +<i>francs</i>. Even so, the purchase was thought hazardous; and +only the man who made it and who had special opportunities could have +dared to give so much.<br> +<br> +The Paumotuan is sincerely attached to those of his own blood and household. +A touching affection sometimes unites wife and husband. Their +children, while they are alive, completely rule them; after they are +dead, their bones or their mummies are often jealously preserved and +carried from atoll to atoll in the wanderings of the family. I +was told there were many houses in Fakarava with the mummy of a child +locked in a sea-chest; after I heard it, I would glance a little jealously +at those by my own bed; in that cupboard, also, it was possible there +was a tiny skeleton.<br> +<br> +The race seems in a fair way to survive. From fifteen islands, +whose rolls I had occasion to consult, I found a proportion of 59 births +to 47 deaths for 1887. Dropping three out of the fifteen, there +remained for the other twelve the comfortable ratio of 50 births to +32 deaths. Long habits of hardship and activity doubtless explain +the contrast with Marquesan figures. But the Paumotuan displays, +besides, a certain concern for health and the rudiments of a sanitary +discipline. Public talk with these free-spoken people plays the +part of the Contagious Diseases Act; in-comers to fresh islands anxiously +inquire if all be well; and syphilis, when contracted, is successfully +treated with indigenous herbs. Like their neighbours of Tahiti, +from whom they have perhaps imbibed the error, they regard leprosy with +comparative indifference, elephantiasis with disproportionate fear. +But, unlike indeed to the Tahitian, their alarm puts on the guise of +self-defence. Any one stricken with this painful and ugly malady +is confined to the ends of villages, denied the use of paths and highways, +and condemned to transport himself between his house and coco-patch +by water only, his very footprint being held infectious. Fe’efe’e, +being a creature of marshes and the sequel of malarial fever, is not +original in atolls. On the single isle of Makatea, where the lagoon +is now a marsh, the disease has made a home. Many suffer; they +are excluded (if Mr. Wilmot be right) from much of the comfort of society; +and it is believed they take a secret vengeance. The defections +of the sick are considered highly poisonous. Early in the morning, +it is narrated, aged and malicious persons creep into the sleeping village, +and stealthily make water at the doors of the houses of young men. +Thus they propagate disease; thus they breathe on and obliterate comeliness +and health, the objects of their envy. Whether horrid fact or +more abominable legend, it equally depicts that something bitter and +energetic which distinguishes Paumotuan man.<br> +<br> +The archipelago is divided between two main religions, Catholic and +Mormon. They front each other proudly with a false air of permanence; +yet are but shapes, their membership in a perpetual flux. The +Mormon attends mass with devotion: the Catholic sits attentive at a +Mormon sermon, and to-morrow each may have transferred allegiance. +One man had been a pillar of the Church of Rome for fifteen years; his +wife dying, he decided that must be a poor religion that could not save +a man his wife, and turned Mormon. According to one informant, +Catholicism was the more fashionable in health, but on the approach +of sickness it was judged prudent to secede. As a Mormon, there +were five chances out of six you might recover; as a Catholic, your +hopes were small; and this opinion is perhaps founded on the comfortable +rite of unction.<br> +<br> +We all know what Catholics are, whether in the Paumotus or at home. +But the Paumotuan Mormon seemed a phenomenon apart. He marries +but the one wife, uses the Protestant Bible, observes Protestant forms +of worship, forbids the use of liquor and tobacco, practises adult baptism +by immersion, and after every public sin, rechristens the backslider. +I advised with Mahinui, whom I found well informed in the history of +the American Mormons, and he declared against the least connection. +‘<i>Pour moi</i>,’ said he, with a fine charity, ‘<i>les +Mormons ici un petit Catholiques</i>.’ Some months later +I had an opportunity to consult an orthodox fellow-countryman, an old +dissenting Highlander, long settled in Tahiti, but still breathing of +the heather of Tiree. ‘Why do they call themselves Mormons?’ +I asked. ‘My dear, and that is my question!’ he exclaimed. +‘For by all that I can hear of their doctrine, I have nothing +to say against it, and their life, it is above reproach.’ +And for all that, Mormons they are, but of the earlier sowing: the so-called +Josephites, the followers of Joseph Smith, the opponents of Brigham +Young.<br> +<br> +Grant, then, the Mormons to be Mormons. Fresh points at once arise: +What are the Israelites? and what the Kanitus? For a long while +back the sect had been divided into Mormons proper and so-called Israelites, +I never could hear why. A few years since there came a visiting +missionary of the name of Williams, who made an excellent collection, +and retired, leaving fresh disruption imminent. Something irregular +(as I was told) in his way of ‘opening the service’ had +raised partisans and enemies; the church was once more rent asunder; +and a new sect, the Kanitu, issued from the division. Since then +Kanitus and Israelites, like the Cameronians and the United Presbyterians, +have made common cause; and the ecclesiastical history of the Paumotus +is, for the moment, uneventful. There will be more doing before +long, and these isles bid fair to be the Scotland of the South. +Two things I could never learn. The nature of the innovations +of the Rev. Mr. Williams none would tell me, and of the meaning of the +name Kanitu none had a guess. It was not Tahitian, it was not +Marquesan; it formed no part of that ancient speech of the Paumotus, +now passing swiftly into obsolescence. One man, a priest, God +bless him! said it was the Latin for a little dog. I have found +it since as the name of a god in New Guinea; it must be a bolder man +than I who should hint at a connection. Here, then, is a singular +thing: a brand-new sect, arising by popular acclamation, and a nonsense +word invented for its name.<br> +<br> +The design of mystery seems obvious, and according to a very intelligent +observer, Mr. Magee of Mangareva, this element of the mysterious is +a chief attraction of the Mormon Church. It enjoys some of the +status of Freemasonry at home, and there is for the convert some of +the exhilaration of adventure. Other attractions are certainly +conjoined. Perpetual rebaptism, leading to a succession of baptismal +feasts, is found, both from the social and the spiritual side, a pleasing +feature. More important is the fact that all the faithful enjoy +office; perhaps more important still, the strictness of the discipline. +‘The veto on liquor,’ said Mr. Magee, ‘brings them +plenty members.’ There is no doubt these islanders are fond +of drink, and no doubt they refrain from the indulgence; a bout on a +feast-day, for instance, may be followed by a week or a month of rigorous +sobriety. Mr. Wilmot attributes this to Paumotuan frugality and +the love of hoarding; it goes far deeper. I have mentioned that +I made a feast on board the <i>Casco</i>. To wash down ship’s +bread and jam, each guest was given the choice of rum or syrup, and +out of the whole number only one man voted - in a defiant tone, and +amid shouts of mirth - for ‘Trum’! This was in public. +I had the meanness to repeat the experiment, whenever I had a chance, +within the four walls of my house; and three at least, who had refused +at the festival, greedily drank rum behind a door. But there were +others thoroughly consistent. I said the virtues of the race were +bourgeois and puritan; and how bourgeois is this! how puritanic! how +Scottish! and how Yankee! - the temptation, the resistance, the public +hypocritical conformity, the Pharisees, the Holy Willies, and the true +disciples. With such a people the popularity of an ascetic Church +appears legitimate; in these strict rules, in this perpetual supervision, +the weak find their advantage, the strong a certain pleasure; and the +doctrine of rebaptism, a clean bill and a fresh start, will comfort +many staggering professors.<br> +<br> +There is yet another sect, or what is called a sect - no doubt improperly +- that of the Whistlers. Duncan Cameron, so clear in favour of +the Mormons, was no less loud in condemnation of the Whistlers. +Yet I do not know; I still fancy there is some connection, perhaps fortuitous, +probably disavowed. Here at least are some doings in the house +of an Israelite clergyman (or prophet) in the island of Anaa, of which +I am equally sure that Duncan would disclaim and the Whistlers hail +them for an imitation of their own. My informant, a Tahitian and +a Catholic, occupied one part of the house; the prophet and his family +lived in the other. Night after night the Mormons, in the one +end, held their evening sacrifice of song; night after night, in the +other, the wife of the Tahitian lay awake and listened to their singing +with amazement. At length she could contain herself no longer, +woke her husband, and asked him what he heard. ‘I hear several +persons singing hymns,’ said he. ‘Yes,’ she +returned, ‘but listen again! Do you not hear something supernatural?’ +His attention thus directed, he was aware of a strange buzzing voice +- and yet he declared it was beautiful - which justly accompanied the +singers. The next day he made inquiries. ‘It is a +spirit,’ said the prophet, with entire simplicity, ‘which +has lately made a practice of joining us at family worship.’ +It did not appear the thing was visible, and like other spirits raised +nearer home in these degenerate days, it was rudely ignorant, at first +could only buzz, and had only learned of late to bear a part correctly +in the music.<br> +<br> +The performances of the Whistlers are more business-like. Their +meetings are held publicly with open doors, all being ‘cordially +invited to attend.’ The faithful sit about the room - according +to one informant, singing hymns; according to another, now singing and +now whistling; the leader, the wizard - let me rather say, the medium +- sits in the midst, enveloped in a sheet and silent; and presently, +from just above his head, or sometimes from the midst of the roof, an +aerial whistling proceeds, appalling to the inexperienced. This, +it appears, is the language of the dead; its purport is taken down progressively +by one of the experts, writing, I was told, ‘as fast as a telegraph +operator’; and the communications are at last made public. +They are of the baldest triviality; a schooner is, perhaps, announced, +some idle gossip reported of a neighbour, or if the spirit shall have +been called to consultation on a case of sickness, a remedy may be suggested. +One of these, immersion in scalding water, not long ago proved fatal +to the patient. The whole business is very dreary, very silly, +and very European; it has none of the picturesque qualities of similar +conjurations in New Zealand; it seems to possess no kernel of possible +sense, like some that I shall describe among the Gilbert islanders. +Yet I was told that many hardy, intelligent natives were inveterate +Whistlers. ‘Like Mahinui?’ I asked, willing to have +a standard; and I was told ‘Yes.’ Why should I wonder? +Men more enlightened than my convict-catechist sit down at home to follies +equally sterile and dull.<br> +<br> +The medium is sometimes female. It was a woman, for instance, +who introduced these practices on the north coast of Taiarapu, to the +scandal of her own connections, her brother-in-law in particular declaring +she was drunk. But what shocked Tahiti might seem fit enough in +the Paumotus, the more so as certain women there possess, by the gift +of nature, singular and useful powers. They say they are honest, +well-intentioned ladies, some of them embarrassed by their weird inheritance. +And indeed the trouble caused by this endowment is so great, and the +protection afforded so infinitesimally small, that I hesitate whether +to call it a gift or a hereditary curse. You may rob this lady’s +coco-patch, steal her canoes, burn down her house, and slay her family +scatheless; but one thing you must not do: you must not lay a hand upon +her sleeping-mat, or your belly will swell, and you can only be cured +by the lady or her husband. Here is the report of an eye-witness, +Tasmanian born, educated, a man who has made money - certainly no fool. +In 1886 he was present in a house on Makatea, where two lads began to +skylark on the mats, and were (I think) ejected. Instantly after, +their bellies began to swell; pains took hold on them; all manner of +island remedies were exhibited in vain, and rubbing only magnified their +sufferings. The man of the house was called, explained the nature +of the visitation, and prepared the cure. A cocoa-nut was husked, +filled with herbs, and with all the ceremonies of a launch, and the +utterance of spells in the Paumotuan language, committed to the sea. +From that moment the pains began to grow more easy and the swelling +to subside. The reader may stare. I can assure him, if he +moved much among old residents of the archipelago, he would be driven +to admit one thing of two - either that there is something in the swollen +bellies or nothing in the evidence of man.<br> +<br> +I have not met these gifted ladies; but I had an experience of my own, +for I have played, for one night only, the part of the whistling spirit. +It had been blowing wearily all day, but with the fall of night the +wind abated, and the moon, which was then full, rolled in a clear sky. +We went southward down the island on the side of the lagoon, walking +through long-drawn forest aisles of palm, and on a floor of snowy sand. +No life was abroad, nor sound of life; till in a clear part of the isle +we spied the embers of a fire, and not far off, in a dark house, heard +natives talking softly. To sit without a light, even in company, +and under cover, is for a Paumotuan a somewhat hazardous extreme. +The whole scene - the strong moonlight and crude shadows on the sand, +the scattered coals, the sound of the low voices from the house, and +the lap of the lagoon along the beach - put me (I know not how) on thoughts +of superstition. I was barefoot, I observed my steps were noiseless, +and drawing near to the dark house, but keeping well in shadow, began +to whistle. ‘The Heaving of the Lead’ was my air - +no very tragic piece. With the first note the conversation and +all movement ceased; silence accompanied me while I continued; and when +I passed that way on my return I found the lamp was lighted in the house, +but the tongues were still mute. All night, as I now think, the +wretches shivered and were silent. For indeed, I had no guess +at the time at the nature and magnitude of the terrors I inflicted, +or with what grisly images the notes of that old song had peopled the +dark house.<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +CHAPTER V - A PAUMOTUAN FUNERAL<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +No, I had no guess of these men’s terrors. Yet I had received +ere that a hint, if I had understood; and the occasion was a funeral.<br> +<br> +A little apart in the main avenue of Rotoava, in a low hut of leaves +that opened on a small enclosure, like a pigsty on a pen, an old man +dwelt solitary with his aged wife. Perhaps they were too old to +migrate with the others; perhaps they were too poor, and had no possessions +to dispute. At least they had remained behind; and it thus befell +that they were invited to my feast. I dare say it was quite a +piece of politics in the pigsty whether to come or not to come, and +the husband long swithered between curiosity and age, till curiosity +conquered, and they came, and in the midst of that last merrymaking +death tapped him on the shoulder. For some days, when the sky +was bright and the wind cool, his mat would be spread in the main highway +of the village, and he was to be seen lying there inert, a mere handful +of a man, his wife inertly seated by his head. They seemed to +have outgrown alike our needs and faculties; they neither spoke nor +listened; they suffered us to pass without a glance; the wife did not +fan, she seemed not to attend upon her husband, and the two poor antiques +sat juxtaposed under the high canopy of palms, the human tragedy reduced +to its bare elements, a sight beyond pathos, stirring a thrill of curiosity. +And yet there was one touch of the pathetic haunted me: that so much +youth and expectation should have run in these starved veins, and the +man should have squandered all his lees of life on a pleasure party.<br> +<br> +On the morning of 17th September the sufferer died, and, time pressing, +he was buried the same day at four. The cemetery lies to seaward +behind Government House; broken coral, like so much road-metal, forms +the surface; a few wooden crosses, a few inconsiderable upright stones, +designate graves; a mortared wall, high enough to lean on, rings it +about; a clustering shrub surrounds it with pale leaves. Here +was the grave dug that morning, doubtless by uneasy diggers, to the +sound of the nigh sea and the cries of sea-birds; meanwhile the dead +man waited in his house, and the widow and another aged woman leaned +on the fence before the door, no speech upon their lips, no speculation +in their eyes.<br> +<br> +Sharp at the hour the procession was in march, the coffin wrapped in +white and carried by four bearers; mourners behind - not many, for not +many remained in Rotoava, and not many in black, for these were poor; +the men in straw hats, white coats, and blue trousers or the gorgeous +parti-coloured pariu, the Tahitian kilt; the women, with a few exceptions, +brightly habited. Far in the rear came the widow, painfully carrying +the dead man’s mat; a creature aged beyond humanity, to the likeness +of some missing link.<br> +<br> +The dead man had been a Mormon; but the Mormon clergyman was gone with +the rest to wrangle over boundaries in the adjacent isle, and a layman +took his office. Standing at the head of the open grave, in a +white coat and blue pariu, his Tahitian Bible in his hand and one eye +bound with a red handkerchief, he read solemnly that chapter in Job +which has been read and heard over the bones of so many of our fathers, +and with a good voice offered up two prayers. The wind and the +surf bore a burthen. By the cemetery gate a mother in crimson +suckled an infant rolled in blue. In the midst the widow sat upon +the ground and polished one of the coffin-stretchers with a piece of +coral; a little later she had turned her back to the grave and was playing +with a leaf. Did she understand? God knows. The officiant +paused a moment, stooped, and gathered and threw reverently on the coffin +a handful of rattling coral. Dust to dust: but the grains of this +dust were gross like cherries, and the true dust that was to follow +sat near by, still cohering (as by a miracle) in the tragic semblance +of a female ape.<br> +<br> +So far, Mormon or not, it was a Christian funeral. The well-known +passage had been read from Job, the prayers had been rehearsed, the +grave was filled, the mourners straggled homeward. With a little +coarser grain of covering earth, a little nearer outcry of the sea, +a stronger glare of sunlight on the rude enclosure, and some incongruous +colours of attire, the well-remembered form had been observed.<br> +<br> +By rights it should have been otherwise. The mat should have been +buried with its owner; but, the family being poor, it was thriftily +reserved for a fresh service. The widow should have flung herself +upon the grave and raised the voice of official grief, the neighbours +have chimed in, and the narrow isle rung for a space with lamentation. +But the widow was old; perhaps she had forgotten, perhaps never understood, +and she played like a child with leaves and coffin-stretchers. +In all ways my guest was buried with maimed rites. Strange to +think that his last conscious pleasure was the <i>Casco</i> and my feast; +strange to think that he had limped there, an old child, looking for +some new good. And the good thing, rest, had been allotted him.<br> +<br> +But though the widow had neglected much, there was one part she must +not utterly neglect. She came away with the dispersing funeral; +but the dead man’s mat was left behind upon the grave, and I learned +that by set of sun she must return to sleep there. This vigil +is imperative. From sundown till the rising of the morning star +the Paumotuan must hold his watch above the ashes of his kindred. +Many friends, if the dead have been a man of mark, will keep the watchers +company; they will be well supplied with coverings against the weather; +I believe they bring food, and the rite is persevered in for two weeks. +Our poor survivor, if, indeed, she properly survived, had little to +cover, and few to sit with her; on the night of the funeral a strong +squall chased her from her place of watch; for days the weather held +uncertain and outrageous; and ere seven nights were up she had desisted, +and returned to sleep in her low roof. That she should be at the +pains of returning for so short a visit to a solitary house, that this +borderer of the grave should fear a little wind and a wet blanket, filled +me at the time with musings. I could not say she was indifferent; +she was so far beyond me in experience that the court of my criticism +waived jurisdiction; but I forged excuses, telling myself she had perhaps +little to lament, perhaps suffered much, perhaps understood nothing. +And lo! in the whole affair there was no question whether of tenderness +or piety, and the sturdy return of this old remnant was a mark either +of uncommon sense or of uncommon fortitude.<br> +<br> +Yet one thing had occurred that partly set me on the trail. I +have said the funeral passed much as at home. But when all was +over, when we were trooping in decent silence from the graveyard gate +and down the path to the settlement, a sudden inbreak of a different +spirit startled and perhaps dismayed us. Two people walked not +far apart in our procession: my friend Mr. Donat - Donat-Rimarau: ‘Donat +the much-handed’ - acting Vice-Resident, present ruler of the +archipelago, by far the man of chief importance on the scene, but known +besides for one of an unshakable good temper; and a certain comely, +strapping young Paumotuan woman, the comeliest on the isle, not (let +us hope) the bravest or the most polite. Of a sudden, ere yet +the grave silence of the funeral was broken, she made a leap at the +Resident, with pointed finger, shrieked a few words, and fell back again +with a laughter, not a natural mirth. ‘What did she say +to you?’ I asked. ‘She did not speak to <i>me</i>,’ +said Donat, a shade perturbed; ‘she spoke to the ghost of the +dead man.’ And the purport of her speech was this: ‘See +there! Donat will be a fine feast for you to-night.’<br> +<br> +‘M. Donat called it a jest,’ I wrote at the time in my diary. +‘It seemed to me more in the nature of a terrified conjuration, +as though she would divert the ghost’s attention from herself. +A cannibal race may well have cannibal phantoms.’ The guesses +of the traveller appear foredoomed to be erroneous; yet in these I was +precisely right. The woman had stood by in terror at the funeral, +being then in a dread spot, the graveyard. She looked on in terror +to the coming night, with that ogre, a new spirit, loosed upon the isle. +And the words she had cried in Donat’s face were indeed a terrified +conjuration, basely to shield herself, basely to dedicate another in +her stead. One thing is to be said in her excuse. Doubtless +she partly chose Donat because he was a man of great good-nature, but +partly, too, because he was a man of the half-caste. For I believe +all natives regard white blood as a kind of talisman against the powers +of hell. In no other way can they explain the unpunished recklessness +of Europeans.<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +CHAPTER VI - GRAVEYARD STORIES<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +WITH my superstitious friend, the islander, I fear I am not wholly frank, +often leading the way with stories of my own, and being always a grave +and sometimes an excited hearer. But the deceit is scarce mortal, +since I am as pleased to hear as he to tell, as pleased with the story +as he with the belief; and, besides, it is entirely needful. For +it is scarce possible to exaggerate the extent and empire of his superstitions; +they mould his life, they colour his thinking; and when he does not +speak to me of ghosts, and gods, and devils, he is playing the dissembler +and talking only with his lips. With thoughts so different, one +must indulge the other; and I would rather that I should indulge his +superstition than he my incredulity. Of one thing, besides, I +may be sure: Let me indulge it as I please, I shall not hear the whole; +for he is already on his guard with me, and the amount of the lore is +boundless.<br> +<br> +I will give but a few instances at random, chiefly from my own doorstep +in Upolu, during the past month (October 1890). One of my workmen +was sent the other day to the banana patch, there to dig; this is a +hollow of the mountain, buried in woods, out of all sight and cry of +mankind; and long before dusk Lafaele was back again beside the cook-house +with embarrassed looks; he dared not longer stay alone, he was afraid +of ‘spirits in the bush.’ It seems these are the souls +of the unburied dead, haunting where they fell, and wearing woodland +shapes of pig, or bird, or insect; the bush is full of them, they seem +to eat nothing, slay solitary wanderers apparently in spite, and at +times, in human form, go down to villages and consort with the inhabitants +undetected. So much I learned a day or so after, walking in the +bush with a very intelligent youth, a native. It was a little +before noon; a grey day and squally; and perhaps I had spoken lightly. +A dark squall burst on the side of the mountain; the woods shook and +cried; the dead leaves rose from the ground in clouds, like butterflies; +and my companion came suddenly to a full stop. He was afraid, +he said, of the trees falling; but as soon as I had changed the subject +of our talk he proceeded with alacrity. A day or two before a +messenger came up the mountain from Apia with a letter; I was in the +bush, he must await my return, then wait till I had answered: and before +I was done his voice sounded shrill with terror of the coming night +and the long forest road. These are the commons. Take the +chiefs. There has been a great coming and going of signs and omens +in our group. One river ran down blood; red eels were captured +in another; an unknown fish was thrown upon the coast, an ominous word +found written on its scales. So far we might be reading in a monkish +chronicle; now we come on a fresh note, at once modern and Polynesian. +The gods of Upolu and Savaii, our two chief islands, contended recently +at cricket. Since then they are at war. Sounds of battle +are heard to roll along the coast. A woman saw a man swim from +the high seas and plunge direct into the bush; he was no man of that +neighbourhood; and it was known he was one of the gods, speeding to +a council. Most perspicuous of all, a missionary on Savaii, who +is also a medical man, was disturbed late in the night by knocking; +it was no hour for the dispensary, but at length he woke his servant +and sent him to inquire; the servant, looking from a window, beheld +crowds of persons, all with grievous wounds, lopped limbs, broken heads, +and bleeding bullet-holes; but when the door was opened all had disappeared. +They were gods from the field of battle. Now these reports have +certainly significance; it is not hard to trace them to political grumblers +or to read in them a threat of coming trouble; from that merely human +side I found them ominous myself. But it was the spiritual side +of their significance that was discussed in secret council by my rulers. +I shall best depict this mingled habit of the Polynesian mind by two +connected instances. I once lived in a village, the name of which +I do not mean to tell. The chief and his sister were persons perfectly +intelligent: gentlefolk, apt of speech. The sister was very religious, +a great church-goer, one that used to reprove me if I stayed away; I +found afterwards that she privately worshipped a shark. The chief +himself was somewhat of a freethinker; at the least, a latitudinarian: +he was a man, besides, filled with European knowledge and accomplishments; +of an impassive, ironical habit; and I should as soon have expected +superstition in Mr. Herbert Spencer. Hear the sequel. I +had discovered by unmistakable signs that they buried too shallow in +the village graveyard, and I took my friend, as the responsible authority, +to task. ‘There is something wrong about your graveyard,’ +said I, ‘which you must attend to, or it may have very bad results.’ +‘Something wrong? What is it?’ he asked, with an emotion +that surprised me. ‘If you care to go along there any evening +about nine o’clock you can see for yourself,’ said I. +He stepped backward. ‘A ghost!’ he cried.<br> +<br> +In short, in the whole field of the South Seas, there is not one to +blame another. Half blood and whole, pious and debauched, intelligent +and dull, all men believe in ghosts, all men combine with their recent +Christianity fear of and a lingering faith in the old island deities. +So, in Europe, the gods of Olympus slowly dwindled into village bogies; +so to-day, the theological Highlander sneaks from under the eye of the +Free Church divine to lay an offering by a sacred well.<br> +<br> +I try to deal with the whole matter here because of a particular quality +in Paumotuan superstitions. It is true I heard them told by a +man with a genius for such narrations. Close about our evening +lamp, within sound of the island surf, we hung on his words, thrilling. +The reader, in far other scenes, must listen close for the faint echo.<br> +<br> +This bundle of weird stories sprang from the burial and the woman’s +selfish conjuration. I was dissatisfied with what I heard, harped +upon questions, and struck at last this vein of metal. It is from +sundown to about four in the morning that the kinsfolk camp upon the +grave; and these are the hours of the spirits’ wanderings. +At any time of the night - it may be earlier, it may be later - a sound +is to be heard below, which is the noise of his liberation; at four +sharp, another and a louder marks the instant of the re-imprisonment; +between-whiles, he goes his malignant rounds. ‘Did you ever +see an evil spirit?’ was once asked of a Paumotuan. ‘Once.’ +‘Under what form?’ ‘It was in the form of a +crane.’ ‘And how did you know that crane to be a spirit?’ +was asked. ‘I will tell you,’ he answered; and this +was the purport of his inconclusive narrative. His father had +been dead nearly a fortnight; others had wearied of the watch; and as +the sun was setting, he found himself by the grave alone. It was +not yet dark, rather the hour of the afterglow, when he was aware of +a snow-white crane upon the coral mound; presently more cranes came, +some white, some black; then the cranes vanished, and he saw in their +place a white cat, to which there was silently joined a great company +of cats of every hue conceivable; then these also disappeared, and he +was left astonished.<br> +<br> +This was an anodyne appearance. Take instead the experience of +Rua-a-mariterangi on the isle of Katiu. He had a need for some +pandanus, and crossed the isle to the sea-beach, where it chiefly flourishes. +The day was still, and Rua was surprised to hear a crashing sound among +the thickets, and then the fall of a considerable tree. Here must +be some one building a canoe; and he entered the margin of the wood +to find and pass the time of day with this chance neighbour. The +crashing sounded more at hand; and then he was aware of something drawing +swiftly near among the tree-tops. It swung by its heels downward, +like an ape, so that its hands were free for murder; it depended safely +by the slightest twigs; the speed of its coming was incredible; and +soon Rua recognised it for a corpse, horrible with age, its bowels hanging +as it came. Prayer was the weapon of Christian in the Valley of +the Shadow, and it is to prayer that Rua-a-mariterangi attributes his +escape. No merely human expedition had availed.<br> +<br> +This demon was plainly from the grave; yet you will observe he was abroad +by day. And inconsistent as it may seem with the hours of the +night watch and the many references to the rising of the morning star, +it is no singular exception. I could never find a case of another +who had seen this ghost, diurnal and arboreal in its habits; but others +have heard the fall of the tree, which seems the signal of its coming. +Mr. Donat was once pearling on the uninhabited isle of Haraiki. +It was a day without a breath of wind, such as alternate in the archipelago +with days of contumelious breezes. The divers were in the midst +of the lagoon upon their employment; the cook, a boy of ten, was over +his pots in the camp. Thus were all souls accounted for except +a single native who accompanied Donat into the wood in quest of sea-fowls’ +eggs. In a moment, out of the stillness, came the sound of the +fall of a great tree. Donat would have passed on to find the cause. +‘No,’ cried his companion, ‘that was no tree. +It was something <i>not right</i>. Let us go back to camp.’ +Next Sunday the divers were turned on, all that part of the isle was +thoroughly examined, and sure enough no tree had fallen. A little +later Mr. Donat saw one of his divers flee from a similar sound, in +similar unaffected panic, on the same isle. But neither would +explain, and it was not till afterwards, when he met with Rua, that +he learned the occasion of their terrors.<br> +<br> +But whether by day or night, the purpose of the dead in these abhorred +activities is still the same. In Samoa, my informant had no idea +of the food of the bush spirits; no such ambiguity would exist in the +mind of a Paumotuan. In that hungry archipelago, living and dead +must alike toil for nutriment; and the race having been cannibal in +the past, the spirits are so still. When the living ate the dead, +horrified nocturnal imagination drew the shocking inference that the +dead might eat the living. Doubtless they slay men, doubtless +even mutilate them, in mere malice. Marquesan spirits sometimes +tear out the eyes of travellers; but even that may be more practical +than appears, for the eye is a cannibal dainty. And certainly +the root-idea of the dead, at least in the far eastern islands, is to +prowl for food. It was as a dainty morsel for a meal that the +woman denounced Donat at the funeral. There are spirits besides +who prey in particular not on the bodies but on the souls of the dead. +The point is clearly made in a Tahitian story. A child fell sick, +grew swiftly worse, and at last showed signs of death. The mother +hastened to the house of a sorcerer, who lived hard by. ‘You +are yet in time,’ said he; ‘a spirit has just run past my +door carrying the soul of your child wrapped in the leaf of a purao; +but I have a spirit stronger and swifter who will run him down ere he +has time to eat it.’ Wrapped in a leaf: like other things +edible and corruptible.<br> +<br> +Or take an experience of Mr. Donat’s on the island of Anaa. +It was a night of a high wind, with violent squalls; his child was very +sick, and the father, though he had gone to bed, lay wakeful, hearkening +to the gale. All at once a fowl was violently dashed on the house +wall. Supposing he had forgot to put it in shelter with the rest, +Donat arose, found the bird (a cock) lying on the verandah, and put +it in the hen-house, the door of which he securely fastened. Fifteen +minutes later the business was repeated, only this time, as it was being +dashed against the wall, the bird crew. Again Donat replaced it, +examining the hen-house thoroughly and finding it quite perfect; as +he was so engaged the wind puffed out his light, and he must grope back +to the door a good deal shaken. Yet a third time the bird was +dashed upon the wall; a third time Donat set it, now near dead, beside +its mates; and he was scarce returned before there came a rush, like +that of a furious strong man, against the door, and a whistle as loud +as that of a railway engine rang about the house. The sceptical +reader may here detect the finger of the tempest; but the women gave +up all for lost and clustered on the beds lamenting. Nothing followed, +and I must suppose the gale somewhat abated, for presently after a chief +came visiting. He was a bold man to be abroad so late, but doubtless +carried a bright lantern. And he was certainly a man of counsel, +for as soon as he heard the details of these disturbances he was in +a position to explain their nature. ‘Your child,’ +said he, ‘must certainly die. This is the evil spirit of +our island who lies in wait to eat the spirits of the newly dead.’ +And then he went on to expatiate on the strangeness of the spirit’s +conduct. He was not usually, he explained, so open of assault, +but sat silent on the house-top waiting, in the guise of a bird, while +within the people tended the dying and bewailed the dead, and had no +thought of peril. But when the day came and the doors were opened, +and men began to go abroad, blood-stains on the wall betrayed the tragedy.<br> +<br> +This is the quality I admire in Paumotuan legend. In Tahiti the +spirit-eater is said to assume a vesture which has much more of pomp, +but how much less of horror. It has been seen by all sorts and +conditions, native and foreign; only the last insist it is a meteor. +My authority was not so sure. He was riding with his wife about +two in the morning; both were near asleep, and the horses not much better. +It was a brilliant and still night, and the road wound over a mountain, +near by a deserted marae (old Tahitian temple). All at once the +appearance passed above them: a form of light; the head round and greenish; +the body long, red, and with a focus of yet redder brilliancy about +the midst. A buzzing hoot accompanied its passage; it flew direct +out of one marae, and direct for another down the mountain side. +And this, as my informant argued, is suggestive. For why should +a mere meteor frequent the altars of abominable gods? The horses, +I should say, were equally dismayed with their riders. Now I am +not dismayed at all - not even agreeably. Give me rather the bird +upon the house-top and the morning blood-gouts on the wall.<br> +<br> +But the dead are not exclusive in their diet. They carry with +them to the grave, in particular, the Polynesian taste for fish, and +enter at times with the living into a partnership in fishery. +Rua-a-mariterangi is again my authority; I feel it diminishes the credit +of the fact, but how it builds up the image of this inveterate ghost-seer! +He belongs to the miserably poor island of Taenga, yet his father’s +house was always well supplied. As Rua grew up he was called at +last to go a-fishing with this fortunate parent. They rowed the +lagoon at dusk, to an unlikely place, and the lay down in the stern, +and the father began vainly to cast his line over the bows. It +is to be supposed that Rua slept; and when he awoke there was the figure +of another beside his father, and his father was pulling in the fish +hand over hand. ‘Who is that man, father?’ Rua asked. +‘It is none of your business,’ said the father; and Rua +supposed the stranger had swum off to them from shore. Night after +night they fared into the lagoon, often to the most unlikely places; +night after night the stranger would suddenly be seen on board, and +as suddenly be missed; and morning after morning the canoe returned +laden with fish. ‘My father is a very lucky man,’ +thought Rua. At last, one fine day, there came first one boat +party and then another, who must be entertained; father and son put +off later than usual into the lagoon; and before the canoe was landed +it was four o’clock, and the morning star was close on the horizon. +Then the stranger appeared seized with some distress; turned about, +showing for the first time his face, which was that of one long dead, +with shining eyes; stared into the east, set the tips of his fingers +to his mouth like one a-cold, uttered a strange, shuddering sound between +a whistle and a moan - a thing to freeze the blood; and, the day-star +just rising from the sea, he suddenly was not. Then Rua understood +why his father prospered, why his fishes rotted early in the day, and +why some were always carried to the cemetery and laid upon the graves. +My informant is a man not certainly averse to superstition, but he keeps +his head, and takes a certain superior interest, which I may be allowed +to call scientific. The last point reminding him of some parallel +practice in Tahiti, he asked Rua if the fish were left, or carried home +again after a formal dedication. It appears old Mariterangi practised +both methods; sometimes treating his shadowy partner to a mere oblation, +sometimes honestly leaving his fish to rot upon the grave.<br> +<br> +It is plain we have in Europe stories of a similar complexion; and the +Polynesian <i>varua ino</i> or <i>aitu o le</i> <i>vao</i> is clearly +the near kinsman of the Transylvanian vampire. Here is a tale +in which the kinship appears broadly marked. On the atoll of Penrhyn, +then still partly savage, a certain chief was long the salutary terror +of the natives. He died, he was buried; and his late neighbours +had scarce tasted the delights of licence ere his ghost appeared about +the village. Fear seized upon all; a council was held of the chief +men and sorcerers; and with the approval of the Rarotongan missionary, +who was as frightened as the rest, and in the presence of several whites +- my friend Mr. Ben Hird being one - the grave was opened, deepened +until water came, and the body re-interred face down. The still +recent staking of suicides in England and the decapitation of vampires +in the east of Europe form close parallels.<br> +<br> +So in Samoa only the spirits of the unburied awake fear. During +the late war many fell in the bush; their bodies, sometimes headless, +were brought back by native pastors and interred; but this (I know not +why) was insufficient, and the spirit still lingered on the theatre +of death. When peace returned a singular scene was enacted in +many places, and chiefly round the high gorges of Lotoanuu, where the +struggle was long centred and the loss had been severe. Kinswomen +of the dead came carrying a mat or sheet and guided by survivors of +the fight. The place of death was earnestly sought out; the sheet +was spread upon the ground; and the women, moved with pious anxiety, +sat about and watched it. If any living thing alighted it was +twice brushed away; upon the third coming it was known to be the spirit +of the dead, was folded in, carried home and buried beside the body; +and the aitu rested. The rite was practised beyond doubt in simple +piety; the repose of the soul was its object: its motive, reverent affection. +The present king disowns indeed all knowledge of a dangerous aitu; he +declares the souls of the unburied were only wanderers in limbo, lacking +an entrance to the proper country of the dead, unhappy, nowise hurtful. +And this severely classic opinion doubtless represents the views of +the enlightened. But the flight of my Lafaele marks the grosser +terrors of the ignorant.<br> +<br> +This belief in the exorcising efficacy of funeral rites perhaps explains +a fact, otherwise amazing, that no Polynesian seems at all to share +our European horror of human bones and mummies. Of the first they +made their cherished ornaments; they preserved them in houses or in +mortuary caves; and the watchers of royal sepulchres dwelt with their +children among the bones of generations. The mummy, even in the +making, was as little feared. In the Marquesas, on the extreme +coast, it was made by the household with continual unction and exposure +to the sun; in the Carolines, upon the farthest west, it is still cured +in the smoke of the family hearth. Head-hunting, besides, still +lives around my doorstep in Samoa. And not ten years ago, in the +Gilberts, the widow must disinter, cleanse, polish, and thenceforth +carry about her, by day and night, the head of her dead husband. +In all these cases we may suppose the process, whether of cleansing +or drying, to have fully exorcised the aitu.<br> +<br> +But the Paumotuan belief is more obscure. Here the man is duly +buried, and he has to be watched. He is duly watched, and the +spirit goes abroad in spite of watches. Indeed, it is not the +purpose of the vigils to prevent these wanderings; only to mollify by +polite attention the inveterate malignity of the dead. Neglect +(it is supposed) may irritate and thus invite his visits, and the aged +and weakly sometimes balance risks and stay at home. Observe, +it is the dead man’s kindred and next friends who thus deprecate +his fury with nocturnal watchings. Even the placatory vigil is +held perilous, except in company, and a boy was pointed out to me in +Rotoava, because he had watched alone by his own father. Not the +ties of the dead, nor yet their proved character, affect the issue. +A late Resident, who died in Fakarava of sunstroke, was beloved in life +and is still remembered with affection; none the less his spirit went +about the island clothed with terrors, and the neighbourhood of Government +House was still avoided after dark. We may sum up the cheerful +doctrine thus: All men become vampires, and the vampire spares none. +And here we come face to face with a tempting inconsistency. For +the whistling spirits are notoriously clannish; I understood them to +wait upon and to enlighten kinsfolk only, and that the medium was always +of the race of the communicating spirit. Here, then, we have the +bonds of the family, on the one hand, severed at the hour of death; +on the other, helpfully persisting.<br> +<br> +The child’s soul in the Tahitian tale was wrapped in leaves. +It is the spirits of the newly dead that are the dainty. When +they are slain, the house is stained with blood. Rua’s dead +fisherman was decomposed; so - and horribly - was his arboreal demon. +The spirit, then, is a thing material; and it is by the material ensigns +of corruption that he is distinguished from the living man. This +opinion is widespread, adds a gross terror to the more ugly Polynesian +tales, and sometimes defaces the more engaging with a painful and incongruous +touch. I will give two examples sufficiently wide apart, one from +Tahiti, one from Samoa.<br> +<br> +And first from Tahiti. A man went to visit the husband of his +sister, then some time dead. In her life the sister had been dainty +in the island fashion, and went always adorned with a coronet of flowers. +In the midst of the night the brother awoke and was aware of a heavenly +fragrance going to and fro in the dark house. The lamp I must +suppose to have burned out; no Tahitian would have lain down without +one lighted. A while he lay wondering and delighted; then called +upon the rest. ‘Do none of you smell flowers?’ he +asked. ‘O,’ said his brother-in-law, ‘we are +used to that here.’ The next morning these two men went +walking, and the widower confessed that his dead wife came about the +house continually, and that he had even seen her. She was shaped +and dressed and crowned with flowers as in her lifetime; only she moved +a few inches above the earth with a very easy progress, and flitted +dryshod above the surface of the river. And now comes my point: +It was always in a back view that she appeared; and these brothers-in-law, +debating the affair, agreed that this was to conceal the inroads of +corruption.<br> +<br> +Now for the Samoan story. I owe it to the kindness of Dr. F. Otto +Sierich, whose collection of folk-tales I expect with a high degree +of interest. A man in Manu’a was married to two wives and +had no issue. He went to Savaii, married there a third, and was +more fortunate. When his wife was near her time he remembered +he was in a strange island, like a poor man; and when his child was +born he must be shamed for lack of gifts. It was in vain his wife +dissuaded him. He returned to his father in Manu’a seeking +help; and with what he could get he set off in the night to re-embark. +Now his wives heard of his coming; they were incensed that he did not +stay to visit them; and on the beach, by his canoe, intercepted and +slew him. Now the third wife lay asleep in Savaii; - her babe +was born and slept by her side; and she was awakened by the spirit of +her husband. ‘Get up,’ he said, ‘my father is +sick in Manu’a and we must go to visit him.’ ‘It +is well,’ said she; ‘take you the child, while I carry its +mats.’ ‘I cannot carry the child,’ said the +spirit; ‘I am too cold from the sea.’ When they were +got on board the canoe the wife smelt carrion. ‘How is this?’ +she said. ‘What have you in the canoe that I should smell +carrion?’ ‘It is nothing in the canoe,’ said +the spirit. ‘It is the land-wind blowing down the mountains, +where some beast lies dead.’ It appears it was still night +when they reached Manu’a - the swiftest passage on record - and +as they entered the reef the bale-fires burned in the village. +Again she asked him to carry the child; but now he need no more dissemble. +‘I cannot carry your child,’ said he, ‘for I am dead, +and the fires you see are burning for my funeral.’<br> +<br> +The curious may learn in Dr. Sierich’s book the unexpected sequel +of the tale. Here is enough for my purpose. Though the man +was but new dead, the ghost was already putrefied, as though putrefaction +were the mark and of the essence of a spirit. The vigil on the +Paumotuan grave does not extend beyond two weeks, and they told me this +period was thought to coincide with that of the resolution of the body. +The ghost always marked with decay - the danger seemingly ending with +the process of dissolution - here is tempting matter for the theorist. +But it will not do. The lady of the flowers had been long dead, +and her spirit was still supposed to bear the brand of perishability. +The Resident had been more than a fortnight buried, and his vampire +was still supposed to go the rounds.<br> +<br> +Of the lost state of the dead, from the lurid Mangaian legend, in which +infernal deities hocus and destroy the souls of all, to the various +submarine and aerial limbos where the dead feast, float idle, or resume +the occupations of their life on earth, it would be wearisome to tell. +One story I give, for it is singular in itself, is well-known in Tahiti, +and has this of interest, that it is post-Christian, dating indeed from +but a few years back. A princess of the reigning house died; was +transported to the neighbouring isle of Raiatea; fell there under the +empire of a spirit who condemned her to climb coco-palms all day and +bring him the nuts; was found after some time in this miserable servitude +by a second spirit, one of her own house; and by him, upon her lamentations, +reconveyed to Tahiti, where she found her body still waked, but already +swollen with the approaches of corruption. It is a lively point +in the tale that, on the sight of this dishonoured tabernacle, the princess +prayed she might continue to be numbered with the dead. But it +seems it was too late, her spirit was replaced by the least dignified +of entrances, and her startled family beheld the body move. The +seemingly purgatorial labours, the helpful kindred spirit, and the horror +of the princess at the sight of her tainted body, are all points to +be remarked.<br> +<br> +The truth is, the tales are not necessarily consistent in themselves; +and they are further darkened for the stranger by an ambiguity of language. +Ghosts, vampires, spirits, and gods are all confounded. And yet +I seem to perceive that (with exceptions) those whom we would count +gods were less maleficent. Permanent spirits haunt and do murder +in corners of Samoa; but those legitimate gods of Upolu and Savaii, +whose wars and cricketings of late convulsed society, I did not gather +to be dreaded, or not with a like fear. The spirit of Aana that +ate souls is certainly a fearsome inmate; but the high gods, even of +the archipelago, seem helpful. Mahinui - from whom our convict-catechist +had been named - the spirit of the sea, like a Proteus endowed with +endless avatars, came to the assistance of the shipwrecked and carried +them ashore in the guise of a ray fish. The same divinity bore +priests from isle to isle about the archipelago, and by his aid, within +the century, persons have been seen to fly. The tutelar deity +of each isle is likewise helpful, and by a particular form of wedge-shaped +cloud on the horizon announces the coming of a ship.<br> +<br> +To one who conceives of these atolls, so narrow, so barren, so beset +with sea, here would seem a superfluity of ghostly denizens. And +yet there are more. In the various brackish pools and ponds, beautiful +women with long red hair are seen to rise and bathe; only (timid as +mice) on the first sound of feet upon the coral they dive again for +ever. They are known to be healthy and harmless living people, +dwellers of an underworld; and the same fancy is current in Tahiti, +where also they have the hair red. <i>Tetea</i> is the Tahitian +name; the Paumotuan, <i>Mokurea</i>.<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +PART III: THE GILBERTS<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +CHAPTER I - BUTARITARI<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +At Honolulu we had said farewell to the <i>Casco</i> and to Captain +Otis, and our next adventure was made in changed conditions. Passage +was taken for myself, my wife, Mr. Osbourne, and my China boy, Ah Fu, +on a pigmy trading schooner, the <i>Equator</i>, Captain Dennis Reid; +and on a certain bright June day in 1889, adorned in the Hawaiian fashion +with the garlands of departure, we drew out of port and bore with a +fair wind for Micronesia.<br> +<br> +The whole extent of the South Seas is a desert of ships; more especially +that part where we were now to sail. No post runs in these islands; +communication is by accident; where you may have designed to go is one +thing, where you shall be able to arrive another. It was my hope, +for instance, to have reached the Carolines, and returned to the light +of day by way of Manila and the China ports; and it was in Samoa that +we were destined to re-appear and be once more refreshed with the sight +of mountains. Since the sunset faded from the peaks of Oahu six +months had intervened, and we had seen no spot of earth so high as an +ordinary cottage. Our path had been still on the flat sea, our +dwellings upon unerected coral, our diet from the pickle-tub or out +of tins; I had learned to welcome shark’s flesh for a variety; +and a mountain, an onion, an Irish potato or a beef-steak, had been +long lost to sense and dear to aspiration.<br> +<br> +The two chief places of our stay, Butaritari and Apemama, lie near the +line; the latter within thirty miles. Both enjoy a superb ocean +climate, days of blinding sun and bracing wind, nights of a heavenly +brightness. Both are somewhat wider than Fakarava, measuring perhaps +(at the widest) a quarter of a mile from beach to beach. In both, +a coarse kind of <i>taro</i> thrives; its culture is a chief business +of the natives, and the consequent mounds and ditches make miniature +scenery and amuse the eye. In all else they show the customary +features of an atoll: the low horizon, the expanse of the lagoon, the +sedge-like rim of palm-tops, the sameness and smallness of the land, +the hugely superior size and interest of sea and sky. Life on +such islands is in many points like life on shipboard. The atoll, +like the ship, is soon taken for granted; and the islanders, like the +ship’s crew, become soon the centre of attention. The isles +are populous, independent, seats of kinglets, recently civilised, little +visited. In the last decade many changes have crept in; women +no longer go unclothed till marriage; the widow no longer sleeps at +night and goes abroad by day with the skull of her dead husband; and, +fire-arms being introduced, the spear and the shark-tooth sword are +sold for curiosities. Ten years ago all these things and practices +were to be seen in use; yet ten years more, and the old society will +have entirely vanished. We came in a happy moment to see its institutions +still erect and (in Apemama) scarce decayed.<br> +<br> +Populous and independent - warrens of men, ruled over with some rustic +pomp - such was the first and still the recurring impression of these +tiny lands. As we stood across the lagoon for the town of Butaritari, +a stretch of the low shore was seen to be crowded with the brown roofs +of houses; those of the palace and king’s summer parlour (which +are of corrugated iron) glittered near one end conspicuously bright; +the royal colours flew hard by on a tall flagstaff; in front, on an +artificial islet, the gaol played the part of a martello. Even +upon this first and distant view, the place had scarce the air of what +it truly was, a village; rather of that which it was also, a petty metropolis, +a city rustic and yet royal.<br> +<br> +The lagoon is shoal. The tide being out, we waded for some quarter +of a mile in tepid shallows, and stepped ashore at last into a flagrant +stagnancy of sun and heat. The lee side of a line island after +noon is indeed a breathless place; on the ocean beach the trade will +be still blowing, boisterous and cool; out in the lagoon it will be +blowing also, speeding the canoes; but the screen of bush completely +intercepts it from the shore, and sleep and silence and companies of +mosquitoes brood upon the towns.<br> +<br> +We may thus be said to have taken Butaritari by surprise. A few +inhabitants were still abroad in the north end, at which we landed. +As we advanced, we were soon done with encounter, and seemed to explore +a city of the dead. Only, between the posts of open houses, we +could see the townsfolk stretched in the siesta, sometimes a family +together veiled in a mosquito-net, sometimes a single sleeper on a platform +like a corpse on a bier.<br> +<br> +The houses were of all dimensions, from those of toys to those of churches. +Some might hold a battalion, some were so minute they could scarce receive +a pair of lovers; only in the playroom, when the toys are mingled, do +we meet such incongruities of scale. Many were open sheds; some +took the form of roofed stages; others were walled and the walls pierced +with little windows. A few were perched on piles in the lagoon; +the rest stood at random on a green, through which the roadway made +a ribbon of sand, or along the embankments of a sheet of water like +a shallow dock. One and all were the creatures of a single tree; +palm-tree wood and palm-tree leaf their materials; no nail had been +driven, no hammer sounded, in their building, and they were held together +by lashings of palm-tree sinnet.<br> +<br> +In the midst of the thoroughfare, the church stands like an island, +a lofty and dim house with rows of windows; a rich tracery of framing +sustains the roof; and through the door at either end the street shows +in a vista. The proportions of the place, in such surroundings, +and built of such materials, appeared august; and we threaded the nave +with a sentiment befitting visitors in a cathedral. Benches run +along either side. In the midst, on a crazy dais, two chairs stand +ready for the king and queen when they shall choose to worship; over +their heads a hoop, apparently from a hogshead, depends by a strip of +red cotton; and the hoop (which hangs askew) is dressed with streamers +of the same material, red and white.<br> +<br> +This was our first advertisement of the royal dignity, and presently +we stood before its seat and centre. The palace is built of imported +wood upon a European plan; the roof of corrugated iron, the yard enclosed +with walls, the gate surmounted by a sort of lych-house. It cannot +be called spacious; a labourer in the States is sometimes more commodiously +lodged; but when we had the chance to see it within, we found it was +enriched (beyond all island expectation) with coloured advertisements +and cuts from the illustrated papers. Even before the gate some +of the treasures of the crown stand public: a bell of a good magnitude, +two pieces of cannon, and a single shell. The bell cannot be rung +nor the guns fired; they are curiosities, proofs of wealth, a part of +the parade of the royalty, and stand to be admired like statues in a +square. A straight gut of water like a canal runs almost to the +palace door; the containing quay-walls excellently built of coral; over +against the mouth, by what seems an effect of landscape art, the martello-like +islet of the gaol breaks the lagoon. Vassal chiefs with tribute, +neighbour monarchs come a-roving, might here sail in, view with surprise +these extensive public works, and be awed by these mouths of silent +cannon. It was impossible to see the place and not to fancy it +designed for pageantry. But the elaborate theatre then stood empty; +the royal house deserted, its doors and windows gaping; the whole quarter +of the town immersed in silence. On the opposite bank of the canal, +on a roofed stage, an ancient gentleman slept publicly, sole visible +inhabitant; and beyond on the lagoon a canoe spread a striped lateen, +the sole thing moving.<br> +<br> +The canal is formed on the south by a pier or causeway with a parapet. +At the far end the parapet stops, and the quay expands into an oblong +peninsula in the lagoon, the breathing-place and summer parlour of the +king. The midst is occupied by an open house or permanent marquee +- called here a maniapa, or, as the word is now pronounced, a maniap’ +- at the lowest estimation forty feet by sixty. The iron roof, +lofty but exceedingly low-browed, so that a woman must stoop to enter, +is supported externally on pillars of coral, within by a frame of wood. +The floor is of broken coral, divided in aisles by the uprights of the +frame; the house far enough from shore to catch the breeze, which enters +freely and disperses the mosquitoes; and under the low eaves the sun +is seen to glitter and the waves to dance on the lagoon.<br> +<br> +It was now some while since we had met any but slumberers; and when +we had wandered down the pier and stumbled at last into this bright +shed, we were surprised to find it occupied by a society of wakeful +people, some twenty souls in all, the court and guardsmen of Butaritari. +The court ladies were busy making mats; the guardsmen yawned and sprawled. +Half a dozen rifles lay on a rock and a cutlass was leaned against a +pillar: the armoury of these drowsy musketeers. At the far end, +a little closed house of wood displayed some tinsel curtains, and proved, +upon examination, to be a privy on the European model. In front +of this, upon some mats, lolled Tebureimoa, the king; behind him, on +the panels of the house, two crossed rifles represented fasces. +He wore pyjamas which sorrowfully misbecame his bulk; his nose was hooked +and cruel, his body overcome with sodden corpulence, his eye timorous +and dull: he seemed at once oppressed with drowsiness and held awake +by apprehension: a pepper rajah muddled with opium, and listening for +the march of a Dutch army, looks perhaps not otherwise. We were +to grow better acquainted, and first and last I had the same impression; +he seemed always drowsy, yet always to hearken and start; and, whether +from remorse or fear, there is no doubt he seeks a refuge in the abuse +of drugs.<br> +<br> +The rajah displayed no sign of interest in our coming. But the +queen, who sat beside him in a purple sacque, was more accessible; and +there was present an interpreter so willing that his volubility became +at last the cause of our departure. He had greeted us upon our +entrance:- ‘That is the honourable King, and I am his interpreter,’ +he had said, with more stateliness than truth. For he held no +appointment in the court, seemed extremely ill-acquainted with the island +language, and was present, like ourselves, upon a visit of civility. +Mr. Williams was his name: an American darkey, runaway ship’s +cook, and bar-keeper at <i>The Land we Live in</i> tavern, Butaritari. +I never knew a man who had more words in his command or less truth to +communicate; neither the gloom of the monarch, nor my own efforts to +be distant, could in the least abash him; and when the scene closed, +the darkey was left talking.<br> +<br> +The town still slumbered, or had but just begun to turn and stretch +itself; it was still plunged in heat and silence. So much the +more vivid was the impression that we carried away of the house upon +the islet, the Micronesian Saul wakeful amid his guards, and his unmelodious +David, Mr. Williams, chattering through the drowsy hours.<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +CHAPTER II - THE FOUR BROTHERS<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +The kingdom of Tebureimoa includes two islands, Great and Little Makin; +some two thousand subjects pay him tribute, and two semi-independent +chieftains do him qualified homage. The importance of the office +is measured by the man; he may be a nobody, he may be absolute; and +both extremes have been exemplified within the memory of residents.<br> +<br> +On the death of king Tetimararoa, Tebureimoa’s father, Nakaeia, +the eldest son, succeeded. He was a fellow of huge physical strength, +masterful, violent, with a certain barbaric thrift and some intelligence +of men and business. Alone in his islands, it was he who dealt +and profited; he was the planter and the merchant; and his subjects +toiled for his behoof in servitude. When they wrought long and +well their taskmaster declared a holiday, and supplied and shared a +general debauch. The scale of his providing was at times magnificent; +six hundred dollars’ worth of gin and brandy was set forth at +once; the narrow land resounded with the noise of revelry: and it was +a common thing to see the subjects (staggering themselves) parade their +drunken sovereign on the fore-hatch of a wrecked vessel, king and commons +howling and singing as they went. At a word from Nakaeia’s +mouth the revel ended; Makin became once more an isle of slaves and +of teetotalers; and on the morrow all the population must be on the +roads or in the taro-patches toiling under his bloodshot eye.<br> +<br> +The fear of Nakaeia filled the land. No regularity of justice +was affected; there was no trial, there were no officers of the law; +it seems there was but one penalty, the capital; and daylight assault +and midnight murder were the forms of process. The king himself +would play the executioner: and his blows were dealt by stealth, and +with the help and countenance of none but his own wives. These +were his oarswomen; one that caught a crab, he slew incontinently with +the tiller; thus disciplined, they pulled him by night to the scene +of his vengeance, which he would then execute alone and return well-pleased +with his connubial crew. The inmates of the harem held a station +hard for us to conceive. Beasts of draught, and driven by the +fear of death, they were yet implicitly trusted with their sovereign’s +life; they were still wives and queens, and it was supposed that no +man should behold their faces. They killed by the sight like basilisks; +a chance view of one of those boatwomen was a crime to be wiped out +with blood. In the days of Nakaeia the palace was beset with some +tall coco-palms which commanded the enclosure. It chanced one +evening, while Nakaeia sat below at supper with his wives, that the +owner of the grove was in a tree-top drawing palm-tree wine; it chanced +that he looked down, and the king at the same moment looking up, their +eyes encountered. Instant flight preserved the involuntary criminal. +But during the remainder of that reign he must lurk and be hid by friends +in remote parts of the isle; Nakaeia hunted him without remission, although +still in vain; and the palms, accessories to the fact, were ruthlessly +cut down. Such was the ideal of wifely purity in an isle where +nubile virgins went naked as in paradise. And yet scandal found +its way into Nakaeia’s well-guarded harem. He was at that +time the owner of a schooner, which he used for a pleasure-house, lodging +on board as she lay anchored; and thither one day he summoned a new +wife. She was one that had been sealed to him; that is to say +(I presume), that he was married to her sister, for the husband of an +elder sister has the call of the cadets. She would be arrayed +for the occasion; she would come scented, garlanded, decked with fine +mats and family jewels, for marriage, as her friends supposed; for death, +as she well knew. ‘Tell me the man’s name, and I will +spare you,’ said Nakaeia. But the girl was staunch; she +held her peace, saved her lover and the queens strangled her between +the mats.<br> +<br> +Nakaeia was feared; it does not appear that he was hated. Deeds +that smell to us of murder wore to his subjects the reverend face of +justice; his orgies made him popular; natives to this day recall with +respect the firmness of his government; and even the whites, whom he +long opposed and kept at arm’s-length, give him the name (in the +canonical South Sea phrase) of ‘a perfect gentleman when sober.’<br> +<br> +When he came to lie, without issue, on the bed of death, he summoned +his next brother, Nanteitei, made him a discourse on royal policy, and +warned him he was too weak to reign. The warning was taken to +heart, and for some while the government moved on the model of Nakaeia’s. +Nanteitei dispensed with guards, and walked abroad alone with a revolver +in a leather mail-bag. To conceal his weakness he affected a rude +silence; you might talk to him all day; advice, reproof, appeal, and +menace alike remained unanswered.<br> +<br> +The number of his wives was seventeen, many of them heiresses; for the +royal house is poor, and marriage was in these days a chief means of +buttressing the throne. Nakaeia kept his harem busy for himself; +Nanteitei hired it out to others. In his days, for instance, Messrs. +Wightman built a pier with a verandah at the north end of the town. +The masonry was the work of the seventeen queens, who toiled and waded +there like fisher lasses; but the man who was to do the roofing durst +not begin till they had finished, lest by chance he should look down +and see them.<br> +<br> +It was perhaps the last appearance of the harem gang. For some +time already Hawaiian missionaries had been seated at Butaritari - Maka +and Kanoa, two brave childlike men. Nakaeia would none of their +doctrine; he was perhaps jealous of their presence; being human, he +had some affection for their persons. In the house, before the +eyes of Kanoa, he slew with his own hand three sailors of Oahu, crouching +on their backs to knife them, and menacing the missionary if he interfered; +yet he not only spared him at the moment, but recalled him afterwards +(when he had fled) with some expressions of respect. Nanteitei, +the weaker man, fell more completely under the spell. Maka, a +light-hearted, lovable, yet in his own trade very rigorous man, gained +and improved an influence on the king which soon grew paramount. +Nanteitei, with the royal house, was publicly converted; and, with a +severity which liberal missionaries disavow, the harem was at once reduced. +It was a compendious act. The throne was thus impoverished, its +influence shaken, the queen’s relatives mortified, and sixteen +chief women (some of great possessions) cast in a body on the market. +I have been shipmates with a Hawaiian sailor who was successively married +to two of these <i>impromptu</i> widows, and successively divorced by +both for misconduct. That two great and rich ladies (for both +of these were rich) should have married ‘a man from another island’ +marks the dissolution of society. The laws besides were wholly +remodelled, not always for the better. I love Maka as a man; as +a legislator he has two defects: weak in the punishment of crime, stern +to repress innocent pleasures.<br> +<br> +War and revolution are the common successors of reform; yet Nanteitei +died (of an overdose of chloroform), in quiet possession of the throne, +and it was in the reign of the third brother, Nabakatokia, a man brave +in body and feeble of character, that the storm burst. The rule +of the high chiefs and notables seems to have always underlain and perhaps +alternated with monarchy. The Old Men (as they were called) have +a right to sit with the king in the Speak House and debate: and the +king’s chief superiority is a form of closure - ‘The Speaking +is over.’ After the long monocracy of Nakaeia and the changes +of Nanteitei, the Old Men were doubtless grown impatient of obscurity, +and they were beyond question jealous of the influence of Maka. +Calumny, or rather caricature, was called in use; a spoken cartoon ran +round society; Maka was reported to have said in church that the king +was the first man in the island and himself the second; and, stung by +the supposed affront, the chiefs broke into rebellion and armed gatherings. +In the space of one forenoon the throne of Nakaeia was humbled in the +dust. The king sat in the maniap’ before the palace gate +expecting his recruits; Maka by his side, both anxious men; and meanwhile, +in the door of a house at the north entry of the town, a chief had taken +post and diverted the succours as they came. They came singly +or in groups, each with his gun or pistol slung about his neck. +‘Where are you going?’ asked the chief. ‘The +king called us,’ they would reply. ‘Here is your place. +Sit down,’ returned the chief. With incredible disloyalty, +all obeyed; and sufficient force being thus got together from both sides, +Nabakatokia was summoned and surrendered. About this period, in +almost every part of the group, the kings were murdered; and on Tapituea, +the skeleton of the last hangs to this day in the chief Speak House +of the isle, a menace to ambition. Nabakatokia was more fortunate; +his life and the royal style were spared to him, but he was stripped +of power. The Old Men enjoyed a festival of public speaking; the +laws were continually changed, never enforced; the commons had an opportunity +to regret the merits of Nakaeia; and the king, denied the resource of +rich marriages and the service of a troop of wives, fell not only in +disconsideration but in debt.<br> +<br> +He died some months before my arrival on the islands, and no one regretted +him; rather all looked hopefully to his successor. This was by +repute the hero of the family. Alone of the four brothers, he +had issue, a grown son, Natiata, and a daughter three years old; it +was to him, in the hour of the revolution, that Nabakatokia turned too +late for help; and in earlier days he had been the right hand of the +vigorous Nakaeia. Nontemat’, <i>Mr. Corpse</i>, was his +appalling nickname, and he had earned it well. Again and again, +at the command of Nakaeia, he had surrounded houses in the dead of night, +cut down the mosquito bars and butchered families. Here was the +hand of iron; here was Nakaeia <i>redux</i>. He came, summoned +from the tributary rule of Little Makin: he was installed, he proved +a puppet and a trembler, the unwieldy shuttlecock of orators; and the +reader has seen the remains of him in his summer parlour under the name +of Tebureimoa.<br> +<br> +The change in the man’s character was much commented on in the +island, and variously explained by opium and Christianity. To +my eyes, there seemed no change at all, rather an extreme consistency. +Mr. Corpse was afraid of his brother: King Tebureimoa is afraid of the +Old Men. Terror of the first nerved him for deeds of desperation; +fear of the second disables him for the least act of government. +He played his part of bravo in the past, following the line of least +resistance, butchering others in his own defence: to-day, grown elderly +and heavy, a convert, a reader of the Bible, perhaps a penitent, conscious +at least of accumulated hatreds, and his memory charged with images +of violence and blood, he capitulates to the Old Men, fuddles himself +with opium, and sits among his guards in dreadful expectation. +The same cowardice that put into his hand the knife of the assassin +deprives him of the sceptre of a king.<br> +<br> +A tale that I was told, a trifling incident that fell in my observation, +depicts him in his two capacities. A chief in Little Makin asked, +in an hour of lightness, ‘Who is Kaeia?’ A bird carried +the saying; and Nakaeia placed the matter in the hands of a committee +of three. Mr. Corpse was chairman; the second commissioner died +before my arrival; the third was yet alive and green, and presented +so venerable an appearance that we gave him the name of Abou ben Adhem. +Mr. Corpse was troubled with a scruple; the man from Little Makin was +his adopted brother; in such a case it was not very delicate to appear +at all, to strike the blow (which it seems was otherwise expected of +him) would be worse than awkward. ‘I will strike the blow,’ +said the venerable Abou; and Mr. Corpse (surely with a sigh) accepted +the compromise. The quarry was decoyed into the bush; he was set +to carrying a log; and while his arms were raised Abou ripped up his +belly at a blow. Justice being thus done, the commission, in a +childish horror, turned to flee. But their victim recalled them +to his side. ‘You need not run away now,’ he said. +‘You have done this thing to me. Stay.’ He was +some twenty minutes dying, and his murderers sat with him the while: +a scene for Shakespeare. All the stages of a violent death, the +blood, the failing voice, the decomposing features, the changed hue, +are thus present in the memory of Mr. Corpse; and since he studied them +in the brother he betrayed, he has some reason to reflect on the possibilities +of treachery. I was never more sure of anything than the tragic +quality of the king’s thoughts; and yet I had but the one sight +of him at unawares. I had once an errand for his ear. It +was once more the hour of the siesta; but there were loiterers abroad, +and these directed us to a closed house on the bank of the canal where +Tebureimoa lay unguarded. We entered without ceremony, being in +some haste. He lay on the floor upon a bed of mats, reading in +his Gilbert Island Bible with compunction. On our sudden entrance +the unwieldy man reared himself half-sitting so that the Bible rolled +on the floor, stared on us a moment with blank eyes, and, having recognised +his visitors, sank again upon the mats. So Eglon looked on Ehud.<br> +<br> +The justice of facts is strange, and strangely just; Nakaeia, the author +of these deeds, died at peace discoursing on the craft of kings; his +tool suffers daily death for his enforced complicity. Not the +nature, but the congruity of men’s deeds and circumstances damn +and save them; and Tebureimoa from the first has been incongruously +placed. At home, in a quiet bystreet of a village, the man had +been a worthy carpenter, and, even bedevilled as he is, he shows some +private virtues. He has no lands, only the use of such as are +impignorate for fines; he cannot enrich himself in the old way by marriages; +thrift is the chief pillar of his future, and he knows and uses it. +Eleven foreign traders pay him a patent of a hundred dollars, some two +thousand subjects pay capitation at the rate of a dollar for a man, +half a dollar for a woman, and a shilling for a child: allowing for +the exchange, perhaps a total of three hundred pounds a year. +He had been some nine months on the throne: had bought his wife a silk +dress and hat, figure unknown, and himself a uniform at three hundred +dollars; had sent his brother’s photograph to be enlarged in San +Francisco at two hundred and fifty dollars; had greatly reduced that +brother’s legacy of debt and had still sovereigns in his pocket. +An affectionate brother, a good economist; he was besides a handy carpenter, +and cobbled occasionally on the woodwork of the palace. It is +not wonderful that Mr. Corpse has virtues; that Tebureimoa should have +a diversion filled me with surprise.<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +CHAPTER III - AROUND OUR HOUSE<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +When we left the palace we were still but seafarers ashore; and within +the hour we had installed our goods in one of the six foreign houses +of Butaritari, namely, that usually occupied by Maka, the Hawaiian missionary. +Two San Francisco firms are here established, Messrs. Crawford and Messrs. +Wightman Brothers; the first hard by the palace of the mid town, the +second at the north entry; each with a store and bar-room. Our +house was in the Wightman compound, betwixt the store and bar, within +a fenced enclosure. Across the road a few native houses nestled +in the margin of the bush, and the green wall of palms rose solid, shutting +out the breeze. A little sandy cove of the lagoon ran in behind, +sheltered by a verandah pier, the labour of queens’ hands. +Here, when the tide was high, sailed boats lay to be loaded; when the +tide was low, the boats took ground some half a mile away, and an endless +series of natives descended the pier stair, tailed across the sand in +strings and clusters, waded to the waist with the bags of copra, and +loitered backward to renew their charge. The mystery of the copra +trade tormented me, as I sat and watched the profits drip on the stair +and the sands.<br> +<br> +In front, from shortly after four in the morning until nine at night, +the folk of the town streamed by us intermittingly along the road: families +going up the island to make copra on their lands; women bound for the +bush to gather flowers against the evening toilet; and, twice a day, +the toddy-cutters, each with his knife and shell. In the first +grey of the morning, and again late in the afternoon, these would straggle +past about their tree-top business, strike off here and there into the +bush, and vanish from the face of the earth. At about the same +hour, if the tide be low in the lagoon, you are likely to be bound yourself +across the island for a bath, and may enter close at their heels alleys +of the palm wood. Right in front, although the sun is not yet +risen, the east is already lighted with preparatory fires, and the huge +accumulations of the trade-wind cloud glow with and heliograph the coming +day. The breeze is in your face; overhead in the tops of the palms, +its playthings, it maintains a lively bustle; look where you will, above +or below, there is no human presence, only the earth and shaken forest. +And right overhead the song of an invisible singer breaks from the thick +leaves; from farther on a second tree-top answers; and beyond again, +in the bosom of the woods, a still more distant minstrel perches and +sways and sings. So, all round the isle, the toddy-cutters sit +on high, and are rocked by the trade, and have a view far to seaward, +where they keep watch for sails, and like huge birds utter their songs +in the morning. They sing with a certain lustiness and Bacchic +glee; the volume of sound and the articulate melody fall unexpected +from the tree-top, whence we anticipate the chattering of fowls. +And yet in a sense these songs also are but chatter; the words are ancient, +obsolete, and sacred; few comprehend them, perhaps no one perfectly; +but it was understood the cutters ‘prayed to have good toddy, +and sang of their old wars.’ The prayer is at least answered; +and when the foaming shell is brought to your door, you have a beverage +well ‘worthy of a grace.’ All forenoon you may return +and taste; it only sparkles, and sharpens, and grows to be a new drink, +not less delicious; but with the progress of the day the fermentation +quickens and grows acid; in twelve hours it will be yeast for bread, +in two days more a devilish intoxicant, the counsellor of crime.<br> +<br> +The men are of a marked Arabian cast of features, often bearded and +mustached, often gaily dressed, some with bracelets and anklets, all +stalking hidalgo-like, and accepting salutations with a haughty lip. +The hair (with the dandies of either sex) is worn turban-wise in a frizzled +bush; and like the daggers of the Japanese a pointed stick (used for +a comb) is thrust gallantly among the curls. The women from this +bush of hair look forth enticingly: the race cannot be compared with +the Tahitian for female beauty; I doubt even if the average be high; +but some of the prettiest girls, and one of the handsomest women I ever +saw, were Gilbertines. Butaritari, being the commercial centre +of the group, is Europeanised; the coloured sacque or the white shift +are common wear, the latter for the evening; the trade hat, loaded with +flowers, fruit, and ribbons, is unfortunately not unknown; and the characteristic +female dress of the Gilberts no longer universal. The <i>ridi</i> +is its name: a cutty petticoat or fringe of the smoked fibre of cocoa-nut +leaf, not unlike tarry string: the lower edge not reaching the mid-thigh, +the upper adjusted so low upon the haunches that it seems to cling by +accident. A sneeze, you think, and the lady must surely be left +destitute. ‘The perilous, hairbreadth ridi’ was our +word for it; and in the conflict that rages over women’s dress +it has the misfortune to please neither side, the prudish condemning +it as insufficient, the more frivolous finding it unlovely in itself. +Yet if a pretty Gilbertine would look her best, that must be her costume. +In that and naked otherwise, she moves with an incomparable liberty +and grace and life, that marks the poetry of Micronesia. Bundle +her in a gown, the charm is fled, and she wriggles like an Englishwoman.<br> +<br> +Towards dusk the passers-by became more gorgeous. The men broke +out in all the colours of the rainbow - or at least of the trade-room, +- and both men and women began to be adorned and scented with new flowers. +A small white blossom is the favourite, sometimes sown singly in a woman’s +hair like little stars, now composed in a thick wreath. With the +night, the crowd sometimes thickened in the road, and the padding and +brushing of bare feet became continuous; the promenades mostly grave, +the silence only interrupted by some giggling and scampering of girls; +even the children quiet. At nine, bed-time struck on a bell from +the cathedral, and the life of the town ceased. At four the next +morning the signal is repeated in the darkness, and the innocent prisoners +set free; but for seven hours all must lie - I was about to say within +doors, of a place where doors, and even walls, are an exception - housed, +at least, under their airy roofs and clustered in the tents of the mosquito-nets. +Suppose a necessary errand to occur, suppose it imperative to send abroad, +the messenger must then go openly, advertising himself to the police +with a huge brand of cocoa-nut, which flares from house to house like +a moving bonfire. Only the police themselves go darkling, and +grope in the night for misdemeanants. I used to hate their treacherous +presence; their captain in particular, a crafty old man in white, lurked +nightly about my premises till I could have found it in my heart to +beat him. But the rogue was privileged.<br> +<br> +Not one of the eleven resident traders came to town, no captain cast +anchor in the lagoon, but we saw him ere the hour was out. This +was owing to our position between the store and the bar - the <i>Sans +Souci</i>, as the last was called. Mr. Rick was not only Messrs. +Wightman’s manager, but consular agent for the States; Mrs. Rick +was the only white woman on the island, and one of the only two in the +archipelago; their house besides, with its cool verandahs, its bookshelves, +its comfortable furniture, could not be rivalled nearer than Jaluit +or Honolulu. Every one called in consequence, save such as might +be prosecuting a South Sea quarrel, hingeing on the price of copra and +the odd cent, or perhaps a difference about poultry. Even these, +if they did not appear upon the north, would be presently visible to +the southward, the <i>Sans Souci</i> drawing them as with cords. +In an island with a total population of twelve white persons, one of +the two drinking-shops might seem superfluous: but every bullet has +its billet, and the double accommodation of Butaritari is found in practice +highly convenient by the captains and the crews of ships: <i>The Land +we Live in</i> being tacitly resigned to the forecastle, the <i>Sans +Souci</i> tacitly reserved for the afterguard. So aristocratic +were my habits, so commanding was my fear of Mr. Williams, that I have +never visited the first; but in the other, which was the club or rather +the casino of the island, I regularly passed my evenings. It was +small, but neatly fitted, and at night (when the lamp was lit) sparkled +with glass and glowed with coloured pictures like a theatre at Christmas. +The pictures were advertisements, the glass coarse enough, the carpentry +amateur; but the effect, in that incongruous isle, was of unbridled +luxury and inestimable expense. Here songs were sung, tales told, +tricks performed, games played. The Ricks, ourselves, Norwegian +Tom the bar-keeper, a captain or two from the ships, and perhaps three +or four traders come down the island in their boats or by the road on +foot, made up the usual company. The traders, all bred to the +sea, take a humorous pride in their new business; ‘South Sea Merchants’ +is the title they prefer. ‘We are all sailors here’ +- ‘Merchants, if you please’ - ‘<i>South Sea</i> Merchants,’ +- was a piece of conversation endlessly repeated, that never seemed +to lose in savour. We found them at all times simple, genial, +gay, gallant, and obliging; and, across some interval of time, recall +with pleasure the traders of Butaritari. There was one black sheep +indeed. I tell of him here where he lived, against my rule; for +in this case I have no measure to preserve, and the man is typical of +a class of ruffians that once disgraced the whole field of the South +Seas, and still linger in the rarely visited isles of Micronesia. +He had the name on the beach of ‘a perfect gentleman when sober,’ +but I never saw him otherwise than drunk. The few shocking and +savage traits of the Micronesian he has singled out with the skill of +a collector, and planted in the soil of his original baseness. +He has been accused and acquitted of a treacherous murder; and has since +boastfully owned it, which inclines me to suppose him innocent. +His daughter is defaced by his erroneous cruelty, for it was his wife +he had intended to disfigure, and in the darkness of the night and the +frenzy of coco-brandy, fastened on the wrong victim. The wife +has since fled and harbours in the bush with natives; and the husband +still demands from deaf ears her forcible restoration. The best +of his business is to make natives drink, and then advance the money +for the fine upon a lucrative mortgage. ‘Respect for whites’ +is the man’s word: ‘What is the matter with this island +is the want of respect for whites.’ On his way to Butaritari, +while I was there, he spied his wife in the bush with certain natives +and made a dash to capture her; whereupon one of her companions drew +a knife and the husband retreated: ‘Do you call that proper respect +for whites?’ he cried. At an early stage of the acquaintance +we proved our respect for his kind of white by forbidding him our enclosure +under pain of death. Thenceforth he lingered often in the neighbourhood +with I knew not what sense of envy or design of mischief; his white, +handsome face (which I beheld with loathing) looked in upon us at all +hours across the fence; and once, from a safe distance, he avenged himself +by shouting a recondite island insult, to us quite inoffensive, on his +English lips incredibly incongruous.<br> +<br> +Our enclosure, round which this composite of degradations wandered, +was of some extent. In one corner was a trellis with a long table +of rough boards. Here the Fourth of July feast had been held not +long before with memorable consequences, yet to be set forth; here we +took our meals; here entertained to a dinner the king and notables of +Makin. In the midst was the house, with a verandah front and back, +and three is rooms within. In the verandah we slung our man-of-war +hammocks, worked there by day, and slept at night. Within were +beds, chairs, a round table, a fine hanging lamp, and portraits of the +royal family of Hawaii. Queen Victoria proves nothing; Kalakaua +and Mrs. Bishop are diagnostic; and the truth is we were the stealthy +tenants of the parsonage. On the day of our arrival Maka was away; +faithless trustees unlocked his doors; and the dear rigorous man, the +sworn foe of liquor and tobacco, returned to find his verandah littered +with cigarettes and his parlour horrible with bottles. He made +but one condition - on the round table, which he used in the celebration +of the sacraments, he begged us to refrain from setting liquor; in all +else he bowed to the accomplished fact, refused rent, retired across +the way into a native house, and, plying in his boat, beat the remotest +quarters of the isle for provender. He found us pigs - I could +not fancy where - no other pigs were visible; he brought us fowls and +taro; when we gave our feast to the monarch and gentry, it was he who +supplied the wherewithal, he who superintended the cooking, he who asked +grace at table, and when the king’s health was proposed, he also +started the cheering with an English hip-hip-hip. There was never +a more fortunate conception; the heart of the fatted king exulted in +his bosom at the sound.<br> +<br> +Take him for all in all, I have never known a more engaging creature +than this parson of Butaritari: his mirth, his kindness, his noble, +friendly feelings, brimmed from the man in speech and gesture. +He loved to exaggerate, to act and overact the momentary part, to exercise +his lungs and muscles, and to speak and laugh with his whole body. +He had the morning cheerfulness of birds and healthy children; and his +humour was infectious. We were next neighbours and met daily, +yet our salutations lasted minutes at a stretch - shaking hands, slapping +shoulders, capering like a pair of Merry-Andrews, laughing to split +our sides upon some pleasantry that would scarce raise a titter in an +infant-school. It might be five in the morning, the toddy-cutters +just gone by, the road empty, the shade of the island lying far on the +lagoon: and the ebullition cheered me for the day.<br> +<br> +Yet I always suspected Maka of a secret melancholy - these jubilant +extremes could scarce be constantly maintained. He was besides +long, and lean, and lined, and corded, and a trifle grizzled; and his +Sabbath countenance was even saturnine. On that day we made a +procession to the church, or (as I must always call it) the cathedral: +Maka (a blot on the hot landscape) in tall hat, black frock-coat, black +trousers; under his arm the hymn-book and the Bible; in his face, a +reverent gravity:- beside him Mary his wife, a quiet, wise, and handsome +elderly lady, seriously attired:- myself following with singular and +moving thoughts. Long before, to the sound of bells and streams +and birds, through a green Lothian glen, I had accompanied Sunday by +Sunday a minister in whose house I lodged; and the likeness, and the +difference, and the series of years and deaths, profoundly touched me. +In the great, dusky, palm-tree cathedral the congregation rarely numbered +thirty: the men on one side, the women on the other, myself posted (for +a privilege) amongst the women, and the small missionary contingent +gathered close around the platform, we were lost in that round vault. +The lessons were read antiphonally, the flock was catechised, a blind +youth repeated weekly a long string of psalms, hymns were sung - I never +heard worse singing, - and the sermon followed. To say I understood +nothing were untrue; there were points that I learned to expect with +certainty; the name of Honolulu, that of Kalakaua, the word Cap’n-man-o’-wa’, +the word ship, and a description of a storm at sea, infallibly occurred; +and I was not seldom rewarded with the name of my own Sovereign in the +bargain. The rest was but sound to the ears, silence for the mind: +a plain expanse of tedium, rendered unbearable by heat, a hard chair, +and the sight through the wide doors of the more happy heathen on the +green. Sleep breathed on my joints and eyelids, sleep hummed in +my ears; it reigned in the dim cathedral. The congregation stirred +and stretched; they moaned, they groaned aloud; they yawned upon a singing +note, as you may sometimes hear a dog when he has reached the tragic +bitterest of boredom. In vain the preacher thumped the table; +in vain he singled and addressed by name particular hearers. I +was myself perhaps a more effective excitant; and at least to one old +gentleman the spectacle of my successful struggles against sleep - and +I hope they were successful - cheered the flight of time. He, +when he was not catching flies or playing tricks upon his neighbours, +gloated with a fixed, truculent eye upon the stages of my agony; and +once, when the service was drawing towards a close, he winked at me +across the church.<br> +<br> +I write of the service with a smile; yet I was always there - always +with respect for Maka, always with admiration for his deep seriousness, +his burning energy, the fire of his roused eye, the sincere and various +accents of his voice. To see him weekly flogging a dead horse +and blowing a cold fire was a lesson in fortitude and constancy. +It may be a question whether if the mission were fully supported, and +he was set free from business avocations, more might not result; I think +otherwise myself; I think not neglect but rigour has reduced his flock, +that rigour which has once provoked a revolution, and which to-day, +in a man so lively and engaging, amazes the beholder. No song, +no dance, no tobacco, no liquor, no alleviative of life - only toil +and church-going; so says a voice from his face; and the face is the +face of the Polynesian Esau, but the voice is the voice of a Jacob from +a different world. And a Polynesian at the best makes a singular +missionary in the Gilberts, coming from a country recklessly unchaste +to one conspicuously strict; from a race hag-ridden with bogies to one +comparatively bold against the terrors of the dark. The thought +was stamped one morning in my mind, when I chanced to be abroad by moonlight, +and saw all the town lightless, but the lamp faithfully burning by the +missionary’s bed. It requires no law, no fire, and no scouting +police, to withhold Maka and his countrymen from wandering in the night +unlighted.<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +CHAPTER IV - A TALE OF A TAPU<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +On the morrow of our arrival (Sunday, 14th July 1889) our photographers +were early stirring. Once more we traversed a silent town; many +were yet abed and asleep; some sat drowsily in their open houses; there +was no sound of intercourse or business. In that hour before the +shadows, the quarter of the palace and canal seemed like a landing-place +in the <i>Arabian Nights</i> or from the classic poets; here were the +fit destination of some ‘faery frigot,’ here some adventurous +prince might step ashore among new characters and incidents; and the +island prison, where it floated on the luminous face of the lagoon, +might have passed for the repository of the Grail. In such a scene, +and at such an hour, the impression received was not so much of foreign +travel - rather of past ages; it seemed not so much degrees of latitude +that we had crossed, as centuries of time that we had re-ascended; leaving, +by the same steps, home and to-day. A few children followed us, +mostly nude, all silent; in the clear, weedy waters of the canal some +silent damsels waded, baring their brown thighs; and to one of the maniap’s +before the palace gate we were attracted by a low but stirring hum of +speech.<br> +<br> +The oval shed was full of men sitting cross-legged. The king was +there in striped pyjamas, his rear protected by four guards with Winchesters, +his air and bearing marked by unwonted spirit and decision; tumblers +and black bottles went the round; and the talk, throughout loud, was +general and animated. I was inclined at first to view this scene +with suspicion. But the hour appeared unsuitable for a carouse; +drink was besides forbidden equally by the law of the land and the canons +of the church; and while I was yet hesitating, the king’s rigorous +attitude disposed of my last doubt. We had come, thinking to photograph +him surrounded by his guards, and at the first word of the design his +piety revolted. We were reminded of the day - the Sabbath, in +which thou shalt take no photographs - and returned with a flea in our +ear, bearing the rejected camera.<br> +<br> +At church, a little later, I was struck to find the throne unoccupied. +So nice a Sabbatarian might have found the means to be present; perhaps +my doubts revived; and before I got home they were transformed to certainties. +Tom, the bar-keeper of the <i>Sans Souci</i>, was in conversation with +two emissaries from the court. The ‘keen,’ they said, +wanted ‘din,’ failing which ‘perandi.’ +No din, was Tom’s reply, and no perandi; but ‘pira’ +if they pleased. It seems they had no use for beer, and departed +sorrowing.<br> +<br> +‘Why, what is the meaning of all this?’ I asked. ‘Is +the island on the spree?’<br> +<br> +Such was the fact. On the 4th of July a feast had been made, and +the king, at the suggestion of the whites, had raised the tapu against +liquor. There is a proverb about horses; it scarce applies to +the superior animal, of whom it may be rather said, that any one can +start him drinking, not any twenty can prevail on him to stop. +The tapu, raised ten days before, was not yet re-imposed; for ten days +the town had been passing the bottle or lying (as we had seen it the +afternoon before) in hoggish sleep; and the king, moved by the Old Men +and his own appetites, continued to maintain the liberty, to squander +his savings on liquor, and to join in and lead the debauch. The +whites were the authors of this crisis; it was upon their own proposal +that the freedom had been granted at the first; and for a while, in +the interests of trade, they were doubtless pleased it should continue. +That pleasure had now sometime ceased; the bout had been prolonged (it +was conceded) unduly; and it now began to be a question how it might +conclude. Hence Tom’s refusal. Yet that refusal was +avowedly only for the moment, and it was avowedly unavailing; the king’s +foragers, denied by Tom at the <i>Sans Souci</i>, would be supplied +at <i>The Land we Live in</i> by the gobbling Mr. Williams.<br> +<br> +The degree of the peril was not easy to measure at the time, and I am +inclined to think now it was easy to exaggerate. Yet the conduct +of drunkards even at home is always matter for anxiety; and at home +our populations are not armed from the highest to the lowest with revolvers +and repeating rifles, neither do we go on a debauch by the whole townful +- and I might rather say, by the whole polity - king, magistrates, police, +and army joining in one common scene of drunkenness. It must be +thought besides that we were here in barbarous islands, rarely visited, +lately and partly civilised. First and last, a really considerable +number of whites have perished in the Gilberts, chiefly through their +own misconduct; and the natives have displayed in at least one instance +a disposition to conceal an accident under a butchery, and leave nothing +but dumb bones. This last was the chief consideration against +a sudden closing of the bars; the bar-keepers stood in the immediate +breach and dealt direct with madmen; too surly a refusal might at any +moment precipitate a blow, and the blow might prove the signal for a +massacre.<br> +<br> +<i>Monday</i>, 15th. - At the same hour we returned to the same muniap’. +Kümmel (of all drinks) was served in tumblers; in the midst sat +the crown prince, a fatted youth, surrounded by fresh bottles and busily +plying the corkscrew; and king, chief, and commons showed the loose +mouth, the uncertain joints, and the blurred and animated eye of the +early drinker. It was plain we were impatiently expected; the +king retired with alacrity to dress, the guards were despatched after +their uniforms; and we were left to await the issue of these preparations +with a shedful of tipsy natives. The orgie had proceeded further +than on Sunday. The day promised to be of great heat; it was already +sultry, the courtiers were already fuddled; and still the kümmel +continued to go round, and the crown prince to play butler. Flemish +freedom followed upon Flemish excess; and a funny dog, a handsome fellow, +gaily dressed, and with a full turban of frizzed hair, delighted the +company with a humorous courtship of a lady in a manner not to be described. +It was our diversion, in this time of waiting, to observe the gathering +of the guards. They have European arms, European uniforms, and +(to their sorrow) European shoes. We saw one warrior (like Mars) +in the article of being armed; two men and a stalwart woman were scarce +strong enough to boot him; and after a single appearance on parade the +army is crippled for a week.<br> +<br> +At last, the gates under the king’s house opened; the army issued, +one behind another, with guns and epaulettes; the colours stooped under +the gateway; majesty followed in his uniform bedizened with gold lace; +majesty’s wife came next in a hat and feathers, and an ample trained +silk gown; the royal imps succeeded; there stood the pageantry of Makin +marshalled on its chosen theatre. Dickens might have told how +serious they were; how tipsy; how the king melted and streamed under +his cocked hat; how he took station by the larger of his two cannons +- austere, majestic, but not truly vertical; how the troops huddled, +and were straightened out, and clubbed again; how they and their firelocks +raked at various inclinations like the masts of ships; and how an amateur +photographer reviewed, arrayed, and adjusted them, to see his dispositions +change before he reached the camera.<br> +<br> +The business was funny to see; I do not know that it is graceful to +laugh at; and our report of these transactions was received on our return +with the shaking of grave heads.<br> +<br> +The day had begun ill; eleven hours divided us from sunset; and at any +moment, on the most trifling chance, the trouble might begin. +The Wightman compound was in a military sense untenable, commanded on +three sides by houses and thick bush; the town was computed to contain +over a thousand stand of excellent new arms; and retreat to the ships, +in the case of an alert, was a recourse not to be thought of. +Our talk that morning must have closely reproduced the talk in English +garrisons before the Sepoy mutiny; the sturdy doubt that any mischief +was in prospect, the sure belief that (should any come) there was nothing +left but to go down fighting, the half-amused, half-anxious attitude +of mind in which we were awaiting fresh developments.<br> +<br> +The kümmel soon ran out; we were scarce returned before the king +had followed us in quest of more. Mr. Corpse was now divested +of his more awful attitude, the lawless bulk of him again encased in +striped pyjamas; a guardsman brought up the rear with his rifle at the +trail: and his majesty was further accompanied by a Rarotongan whalerman +and the playful courtier with the turban of frizzed hair. There +was never a more lively deputation. The whalerman was gapingly, +tearfully tipsy: the courtier walked on air; the king himself was even +sportive. Seated in a chair in the Ricks’ sitting-room, +he bore the brunt of our prayers and menaces unmoved. He was even +rated, plied with historic instances, threatened with the men-of-war, +ordered to restore the tapu on the spot - and nothing in the least affected +him. It should be done to-morrow, he said; to-day it was beyond +his power, to-day he durst not. ‘Is that royal?’ cried +indignant Mr. Rick. No, it was not royal; had the king been of +a royal character we should ourselves have held a different language; +and royal or not, he had the best of the dispute. The terms indeed +were hardly equal; for the king was the only man who could restore the +tapu, but the Ricks were not the only people who sold drink. He +had but to hold his ground on the first question, and they were sure +to weaken on the second. A little struggle they still made for +the fashion’s sake; and then one exceedingly tipsy deputation +departed, greatly rejoicing, a case of brandy wheeling beside them in +a barrow. The Rarotongan (whom I had never seen before) wrung +me by the hand like a man bound on a far voyage. ‘My dear +frien’!’ he cried, ‘good-bye, my dear frien’!’ +- tears of kümmel standing in his eyes; the king lurched as he +went, the courtier ambled, - a strange party of intoxicated children +to be entrusted with that barrowful of madness.<br> +<br> +You could never say the town was quiet; all morning there was a ferment +in the air, an aimless movement and congregation of natives in the street. +But it was not before half-past one that a sudden hubbub of voices called +us from the house, to find the whole white colony already gathered on +the spot as by concerted signal. The <i>Sans Souci</i> was overrun +with rabble, the stair and verandah thronged. From all these throats +an inarticulate babbling cry went up incessantly; it sounded like the +bleating of young lambs, but angrier. In the road his royal highness +(whom I had seen so lately in the part of butler) stood crying upon +Tom; on the top step, tossed in the hurly-burly, Tom was shouting to +the prince. Yet a while the pack swayed about the bar, vociferous. +Then came a brutal impulse; the mob reeled, and returned, and was rejected; +the stair showed a stream of heads; and there shot into view, through +the disbanding ranks, three men violently dragging in their midst a +fourth. By his hair and his hands, his head forced as low as his +knees, his face concealed, he was wrenched from the verandah and whisked +along the road into the village, howling as he disappeared. Had +his face been raised, we should have seen it bloodied, and the blood +was not his own. The courtier with the turban of frizzed hair +had paid the costs of this disturbance with the lower part of one ear.<br> +<br> +So the brawl passed with no other casualty than might seem comic to +the inhumane. Yet we looked round on serious faces and - a fact +that spoke volumes - Tom was putting up the shutters on the bar. +Custom might go elsewhere, Mr. Williams might profit as he pleased, +but Tom had had enough of bar-keeping for that day. Indeed the +event had hung on a hair. A man had sought to draw a revolver +- on what quarrel I could never learn, and perhaps he himself could +not have told; one shot, when the room was so crowded, could scarce +have failed to take effect; where many were armed and all tipsy, it +could scarce have failed to draw others; and the woman who spied the +weapon and the man who seized it may very well have saved the white +community.<br> +<br> +The mob insensibly melted from the scene; and for the rest of the day +our neighbourhood was left in peace and a good deal in solitude. +But the tranquillity was only local; <i>din</i> and<i> perandi</i> still +flowed in other quarters: and we had one more sight of Gilbert Island +violence. In the church, where we had wandered photographing, +we were startled by a sudden piercing outcry. The scene, looking +forth from the doors of that great hall of shadow, was unforgettable. +The palms, the quaint and scattered houses, the flag of the island streaming +from its tall staff, glowed with intolerable sunshine. In the +midst two women rolled fighting on the grass. The combatants were +the more easy to be distinguished, because the one was stripped to the +<i>ridi</i> and the other wore a holoku (sacque) of some lively colour. +The first was uppermost, her teeth locked in her adversary’s face, +shaking her like a dog; the other impotently fought and scratched. +So for a moment we saw them wallow and grapple there like vermin; then +the mob closed and shut them in.<br> +<br> +It was a serious question that night if we should sleep ashore. +But we were travellers, folk that had come far in quest of the adventurous; +on the first sign of an adventure it would have been a singular inconsistency +to have withdrawn; and we sent on board instead for our revolvers. +Mindful of Taahauku, Mr. Rick, Mr. Osbourne, and Mrs. Stevenson held +an assault of arms on the public highway, and fired at bottles to the +admiration of the natives. Captain Reid of the <i>Equator</i> +stayed on shore with us to be at hand in case of trouble, and we retired +to bed at the accustomed hour, agreeably excited by the day’s +events. The night was exquisite, the silence enchanting; yet as +I lay in my hammock looking on the strong moonshine and the quiescent +palms, one ugly picture haunted me of the two women, the naked and the +clad, locked in that hostile embrace. The harm done was probably +not much, yet I could have looked on death and massacre with less revolt. +The return to these primeval weapons, the vision of man’s beastliness, +of his ferality, shocked in me a deeper sense than that with which we +count the cost of battles. There are elements in our state and +history which it is a pleasure to forget, which it is perhaps the better +wisdom not to dwell on. Crime, pestilence, and death are in the +day’s work; the imagination readily accepts them. It instinctively +rejects, on the contrary, whatever shall call up the image of our race +upon its lowest terms, as the partner of beasts, beastly itself, dwelling +pell-mell and hugger-mugger, hairy man with hairy woman, in the caves +of old. And yet to be just to barbarous islanders we must not +forget the slums and dens of our cities; I must not forget that I have +passed dinnerward through Soho, and seen that which cured me of my dinner.<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +CHAPTER V - A TALE OF A TAPU - <i>continued<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +Tuesday, July</i> 16. - It rained in the night, sudden and loud, in +Gilbert Island fashion. Before the day, the crowing of a cock +aroused me and I wandered in the compound and along the street. +The squall was blown by, the moon shone with incomparable lustre, the +air lay dead as in a room, and yet all the isle sounded as under a strong +shower, the eaves thickly pattering, the lofty palms dripping at larger +intervals and with a louder note. In this bold nocturnal light +the interior of the houses lay inscrutable, one lump of blackness, save +when the moon glinted under the roof, and made a belt of silver, and +drew the slanting shadows of the pillars on the floor. Nowhere +in all the town was any lamp or ember; not a creature stirred; I thought +I was alone to be awake; but the police were faithful to their duty; +secretly vigilant, keeping account of time; and a little later, the +watchman struck slowly and repeatedly on the cathedral bell; four o’clock, +the warning signal. It seemed strange that, in a town resigned +to drunkenness and tumult, curfew and réveille should still be +sounded and still obeyed.<br> +<br> +The day came, and brought little change. The place still lay silent; +the people slept, the town slept. Even the few who were awake, +mostly women and children, held their peace and kept within under the +strong shadow of the thatch, where you must stop and peer to see them. +Through the deserted streets, and past the sleeping houses, a deputation +took its way at an early hour to the palace; the king was suddenly awakened, +and must listen (probably with a headache) to unpalatable truths. +Mrs. Rick, being a sufficient mistress of that difficult tongue, was +spokeswoman; she explained to the sick monarch that I was an intimate +personal friend of Queen Victoria’s; that immediately on my return +I should make her a report upon Butaritari; and that if my house should +have been again invaded by natives, a man-of-war would be despatched +to make reprisals. It was scarce the fact - rather a just and +necessary parable of the fact, corrected for latitude; and it certainly +told upon the king. He was much affected; he had conceived the +notion (he said) that I was a man of some importance, but not dreamed +it was as bad as this; and the missionary house was tapu’d under +a fine of fifty dollars.<br> +<br> +So much was announced on the return of the deputation; not any more; +and I gathered subsequently that much more had passed. The protection +gained was welcome. It had been the most annoying and not the +least alarming feature of the day before, that our house was periodically +filled with tipsy natives, twenty or thirty at a time, begging drink, +fingering our goods, hard to be dislodged, awkward to quarrel with. +Queen Victoria’s friend (who was soon promoted to be her son) +was free from these intrusions. Not only my house, but my neighbourhood +as well, was left in peace; even on our walks abroad we were guarded +and prepared for; and, like great persons visiting a hospital, saw only +the fair side. For the matter of a week we were thus suffered +to go out and in and live in a fool’s paradise, supposing the +king to have kept his word, the tapu to be revived and the island once +more sober.<br> +<br> +<i>Tuesday, July</i> 23. - We dined under a bare trellis erected for +the Fourth of July; and here we used to linger by lamplight over coffee +and tobacco. In that climate evening approaches without sensible +chill; the wind dies out before sunset; heaven glows a while and fades, +and darkens into the blueness of the tropical night; swiftly and insensibly +the shadows thicken, the stars multiply their number; you look around +you and the day is gone. It was then that we would see our Chinaman +draw near across the compound in a lurching sphere of light, divided +by his shadows; and with the coming of the lamp the night closed about +the table. The faces of the company, the spars of the trellis, +stood out suddenly bright on a ground of blue and silver, faintly designed +with palm-tops and the peaked roofs of houses. Here and there +the gloss upon a leaf, or the fracture of a stone, returned an isolated +sparkle. All else had vanished. We hung there, illuminated +like a galaxy of stars <i>in</i> <i>vacuo</i>; we sat, manifest and +blind, amid the general ambush of the darkness; and the islanders, passing +with light footfalls and low voices in the sand of the road, lingered +to observe us, unseen.<br> +<br> +On Tuesday the dusk had fallen, the lamp had just been brought, when +a missile struck the table with a rattling smack and rebounded past +my ear. Three inches to one side and this page had never been +written; for the thing travelled like a cannon ball. It was supposed +at the time to be a nut, though even at the time I thought it seemed +a small one and fell strangely.<br> +<br> +<i>Wednesday, July</i> 24. - The dusk had fallen once more, and the +lamp been just brought out, when the same business was repeated. +And again the missile whistled past my ear. One nut I had been +willing to accept; a second, I rejected utterly. A cocoa-nut does +not come slinging along on a windless evening, making an angle of about +fifteen degrees with the horizon; cocoa-nuts do not fall on successive +nights at the same hour and spot; in both cases, besides, a specific +moment seemed to have been chosen, that when the lamp was just carried +out, a specific person threatened, and that the head of the family. +I may have been right or wrong, but I believed I was the mark of some +intimidation; believed the missile was a stone, aimed not to hit, but +to frighten.<br> +<br> +No idea makes a man more angry. I ran into the road, where the +natives were as usual promenading in the dark; Maka joined me with a +lantern; and I ran from one to another, glared in quite innocent faces, +put useless questions, and proffered idle threats. Thence I carried +my wrath (which was worthy the son of any queen in history) to the Ricks. +They heard me with depression, assured me this trick of throwing a stone +into a family dinner was not new; that it meant mischief, and was of +a piece with the alarming disposition of the natives. And then +the truth, so long concealed from us, came out. The king had broken +his promise, he had defied the deputation; the tapu was still dormant, +<i>The Land we Live in</i> still selling drink, and that quarter of +the town disturbed and menaced by perpetual broils. But there +was worse ahead: a feast was now preparing for the birthday of the little +princess; and the tributary chiefs of Kuma and Little Makin were expected +daily. Strong in a following of numerous and somewhat savage clansmen, +each of these was believed, like a Douglas of old, to be of doubtful +loyalty. Kuma (a little pot-bellied fellow) never visited the +palace, never entered the town, but sat on the beach on a mat, his gun +across his knees, parading his mistrust and scorn; Karaiti of Makin, +although he was more bold, was not supposed to be more friendly; and +not only were these vassals jealous of the throne, but the followers +on either side shared in the animosity. Brawls had already taken +place; blows had passed which might at any moment be repaid in blood. +Some of the strangers were already here and already drinking; if the +debauch continued after the bulk of them had come, a collision, perhaps +a revolution, was to be expected.<br> +<br> +The sale of drink is in this group a measure of the jealousy of traders; +one begins, the others are constrained to follow; and to him who has +the most gin, and sells it the most recklessly, the lion’s share +of copra is assured. It is felt by all to be an extreme expedient, +neither safe, decent, nor dignified. A trader on Tarawa, heated +by an eager rivalry, brought many cases of gin. He told me he +sat afterwards day and night in his house till it was finished, not +daring to arrest the sale, not venturing to go forth, the bush all round +him filled with howling drunkards. At night, above all, when he +was afraid to sleep, and heard shots and voices about him in the darkness, +his remorse was black.<br> +<br> +‘My God!’ he reflected, ‘if I was to lose my life +on such a wretched business!’ Often and often, in the story +of the Gilberts, this scene has been repeated; and the remorseful trader +sat beside his lamp, longing for the day, listening with agony for the +sound of murder, registering resolutions for the future. For the +business is easy to begin, but hazardous to stop. The natives +are in their way a just and law-abiding people, mindful of their debts, +docile to the voice of their own institutions; when the tapu is re-enforced +they will cease drinking; but the white who seeks to antedate the movement +by refusing liquor does so at his peril.<br> +<br> +Hence, in some degree, the anxiety and helplessness of Mr. Rick. +He and Tom, alarmed by the rabblement of the <i>Sans Souci</i>, had +stopped the sale; they had done so without danger, because <i>The Land +we Live in</i> still continued selling; it was claimed, besides, that +they had been the first to begin. What step could be taken? +Could Mr. Rick visit Mr. Muller (with whom he was not on terms) and +address him thus: ‘I was getting ahead of you, now you are getting +ahead of me, and I ask you to forego your profit. I got my place +closed in safety, thanks to your continuing; but now I think you have +continued long enough. I begin to be alarmed; and because I am +afraid I ask you to confront a certain danger’? It was not +to be thought of. Something else had to be found; and there was +one person at one end of the town who was at least not interested in +copra. There was little else to be said in favour of myself as +an ambassador. I had arrived in the Wightman schooner, I was living +in the Wightman compound, I was the daily associate of the Wightman +coterie. It was egregious enough that I should now intrude unasked +in the private affairs of Crawford’s agent, and press upon him +the sacrifice of his interests and the venture of his life. But +bad as I might be, there was none better; since the affair of the stone +I was, besides, sharp-set to be doing, the idea of a delicate interview +attracted me, and I thought it policy to show myself abroad.<br> +<br> +The night was very dark. There was service in the church, and +the building glimmered through all its crevices like a dim Kirk Allowa’. +I saw few other lights, but was indistinctly aware of many people stirring +in the darkness, and a hum and sputter of low talk that sounded stealthy. +I believe (in the old phrase) my beard was sometimes on my shoulder +as I went. Muller’s was but partly lighted, and quite silent, +and the gate was fastened. I could by no means manage to undo +the latch. No wonder, since I found it afterwards to be four or +five feet long - a fortification in itself. As I still fumbled, +a dog came on the inside and sniffed suspiciously at my hands, so that +I was reduced to calling ‘House ahoy!’ Mr. Muller +came down and put his chin across the paling in the dark. ‘Who +is that?’ said he, like one who has no mind to welcome strangers.<br> +<br> +‘My name is Stevenson,’ said I.<br> +<br> +‘O, Mr. Stevens! I didn’t know you. Come inside.’ +We stepped into the dark store, when I leaned upon the counter and he +against the wall. All the light came from the sleeping-room, where +I saw his family being put to bed; it struck full in my face, but Mr. +Muller stood in shadow. No doubt he expected what was Coming, +and sought the advantage of position; but for a man who wished to persuade +and had nothing to conceal, mine was the preferable.<br> +<br> +‘Look here,’ I began, ‘I hear you are selling to the +natives.’<br> +<br> +‘Others have done that before me,’ he returned pointedly.<br> +<br> +‘No doubt,’ said I, ‘and I have nothing to do with +the past, but the future. I want you to promise you will handle +these spirits carefully.’<br> +<br> +‘Now what is your motive in this?’ he asked, and then, with +a sneer, ‘Are you afraid of your life?’<br> +<br> +‘That is nothing to the purpose,’ I replied. ‘I +know, and you know, these spirits ought not to be used at all.’<br> +<br> +‘Tom and Mr. Rick have sold them before.’<br> +<br> +‘I have nothing to do with Tom and Mr. Rick. All I know +is I have heard them both refuse.’<br> +<br> +‘No, I suppose you have nothing to do with them. Then you +are just afraid of your life.’<br> +<br> +‘Come now,’ I cried, being perhaps a little stung, ‘you +know in your heart I am asking a reasonable thing. I don’t +ask you to lose your profit - though I would prefer to see no spirits +brought here, as you would - ’<br> +<br> +‘I don’t say I wouldn’t. I didn’t begin +this,’ he interjected.<br> +<br> +‘No, I don’t suppose you did,’ said I. ‘And +I don’t ask you to lose; I ask you to give me your word, man to +man, that you will make no native drunk.’<br> +<br> +Up to now Mr. Muller had maintained an attitude very trying to my temper; +but he had maintained it with difficulty, his sentiment being all upon +my side; and here he changed ground for the worse. ‘It isn’t +me that sells,’ said he.<br> +<br> +‘No, it’s that nigger,’ I agreed. ‘But +he’s yours to buy and sell; you have your hand on the nape of +his neck; and I ask you - I have my wife here - to use the authority +you have.’<br> +<br> +He hastily returned to his old ward. ‘I don’t deny +I could if I wanted,’ said he. ‘But there’s +no danger, the natives are all quiet. You’re just afraid +of your life.’<br> +<br> +I do not like to be called a coward, even by implication; and here I +lost my temper and propounded an untimely ultimatum. ‘You +had better put it plain,’ I cried. ‘Do you mean to +refuse me what I ask?’<br> +<br> +‘I don’t want either to refuse it or grant it,’ he +replied.<br> +<br> +‘You’ll find you have to do the one thing or the other, +and right now!’ I cried, and then, striking into a happier vein, +‘Come,’ said I, ‘you’re a better sort than that. +I see what’s wrong with you - you think I came from the opposite +camp. I see the sort of man you are, and you know that what I +ask is right.’<br> +<br> +Again he changed ground. ‘If the natives get any drink, +it isn’t safe to stop them,’ he objected.<br> +<br> +‘I’ll be answerable for the bar,’ I said. ‘We +are three men and four revolvers; we’ll come at a word, and hold +the place against the village.’<br> +<br> +‘You don’t know what you’re talking about; it’s +too dangerous!’ he cried.<br> +<br> +‘Look here,’ said I, ‘I don’t mind much about +losing that life you talk so much of; but I mean to lose it the way +I want to, and that is, putting a stop to all this beastliness.’<br> +<br> +He talked a while about his duty to the firm; I minded not at all, I +was secure of victory. He was but waiting to capitulate, and looked +about for any potent to relieve the strain. In the gush of light +from the bedroom door I spied a cigar-holder on the desk. ‘That +is well coloured,’ said I.<br> +<br> +‘Will you take a cigar?’ said he.<br> +<br> +I took it and held it up unlighted. ‘Now,’ said I, +‘you promise me.’<br> +<br> +‘I promise you you won’t have any trouble from natives that +have drunk at my place,’ he replied.<br> +<br> +‘That is all I ask,’ said I, and showed it was not by immediately +offering to try his stock.<br> +<br> +So far as it was anyway critical our interview here ended. Mr. +Muller had thenceforth ceased to regard me as an emissary from his rivals, +dropped his defensive attitude, and spoke as he believed. I could +make out that he would already, had he dared, have stopped the sale +himself. Not quite daring, it may be imagined how he resented +the idea of interference from those who had (by his own statement) first +led him on, then deserted him in the breach, and now (sitting themselves +in safety) egged him on to a new peril, which was all gain to them, +all loss to him! I asked him what he thought of the danger from +the feast.<br> +<br> +‘I think worse of it than any of you,’ he answered. +‘They were shooting around here last night, and I heard the balls +too. I said to myself, “That’s bad.” What +gets me is why you should be making this row up at your end. I +should be the first to go.’<br> +<br> +It was a thoughtless wonder. The consolation of being second is +not great; the fact, not the order of going - there was our concern.<br> +<br> +Scott talks moderately of looking forward to a time of fighting ‘with +a feeling that resembled pleasure.’ The resemblance seems +rather an identity. In modern life, contact is ended; man grows +impatient of endless manoeuvres; and to approach the fact, to find ourselves +where we can push an advantage home, and stand a fair risk, and see +at last what we are made of, stirs the blood. It was so at least +with all my family, who bubbled with delight at the approach of trouble; +and we sat deep into the night like a pack of schoolboys, preparing +the revolvers and arranging plans against the morrow. It promised +certainly to be a busy and eventful day. The Old Men were to be +summoned to confront me on the question of the tapu; Muller might call +us at any moment to garrison his bar; and suppose Muller to fail, we +decided in a family council to take that matter into our own hands, +<i>The Land we Live</i> <i>in</i> at the pistol’s mouth, and with +the polysyllabic Williams, dance to a new tune. As I recall our +humour I think it would have gone hard with the mulatto.<br> +<br> +<i>Wednesday</i>, <i>July</i> 24. - It was as well, and yet it was disappointing +that these thunder-clouds rolled off in silence. Whether the Old +Men recoiled from an interview with Queen Victoria’s son, whether +Muller had secretly intervened, or whether the step flowed naturally +from the fears of the king and the nearness of the feast, the tapu was +early that morning re-enforced; not a day too soon, from the manner +the boats began to arrive thickly, and the town was filled with the +big rowdy vassals of Karaiti.<br> +<br> +The effect lingered for some time on the minds of the traders; it was +with the approval of all present that I helped to draw up a petition +to the United States, praying for a law against the liquor trade in +the Gilberts; and it was at this request that I added, under my own +name, a brief testimony of what had passed; - useless pains; since the +whole reposes, probably unread and possibly unopened, in a pigeon-hole +at Washington.<br> +<br> +<i>Sunday, July</i> 28. - This day we had the afterpiece of the debauch. +The king and queen, in European clothes, and followed by armed guards, +attended church for the first time, and sat perched aloft in a precarious +dignity under the barrel-hoops. Before sermon his majesty clambered +from the dais, stood lopsidedly upon the gravel floor, and in a few +words abjured drinking. The queen followed suit with a yet briefer +allocution. All the men in church were next addressed in turn; +each held up his right hand, and the affair was over - throne and church +were reconciled.<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +CHAPTER VI - THE FIVE DAYS’ FESTIVAL<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +<i>Thursday, July</i> 25. - The street was this day much enlivened by +the presence of the men from Little Makin; they average taller than +Butaritarians, and being on a holiday, went wreathed with yellow leaves +and gorgeous in vivid colours. They are said to be more savage, +and to be proud of the distinction. Indeed, it seemed to us they +swaggered in the town, like plaided Highlanders upon the streets of +Inverness, conscious of barbaric virtues.<br> +<br> +In the afternoon the summer parlour was observed to be packed with people; +others standing outside and stooping to peer under the eaves, like children +at home about a circus. It was the Makin company, rehearsing for +the day of competition. Karaiti sat in the front row close to +the singers, where we were summoned (I suppose in honour of Queen Victoria) +to join him. A strong breathless heat reigned under the iron roof, +and the air was heavy with the scent of wreaths. The singers, +with fine mats about their loins, cocoa-nut feathers set in rings upon +their fingers, and their heads crowned with yellow leaves, sat on the +floor by companies. A varying number of soloists stood up for +different songs; and these bore the chief part in the music. But +the full force of the companies, even when not singing, contributed +continuously to the effect, and marked the ictus of the measure, mimicking, +grimacing, casting up their heads and eyes, fluttering the feathers +on their fingers, clapping hands, or beating (loud as a kettledrum) +on the left breast; the time was exquisite, the music barbarous, but +full of conscious art. I noted some devices constantly employed. +A sudden change would be introduced (I think of key) with no break of +the measure, but emphasised by a sudden dramatic heightening of the +voice and a swinging, general gesticulation. The voices of the +soloists would begin far apart in a rude discord, and gradually draw +together to a unison; which, when, they had reached, they were joined +and drowned by the full chorus. The ordinary, hurried, barking +unmelodious movement of the voices would at times be broken and glorified +by a psalm-like strain of melody, often well constructed, or seeming +so by contrast. There was much variety of measure, and towards +the end of each piece, when the fun became fast and furious, a recourse +to this figure -<br> +<br> +[Musical notation which cannot be produced. It means two/four +time with quaver, quaver, crotchet repeated for three bars.]<br> +<br> +It is difficult to conceive what fire and devilry they get into these +hammering finales; all go together, voices, hands, eyes, leaves, and +fluttering finger-rings; the chorus swings to the eye, the song throbs +on the ear; the faces are convulsed with enthusiasm and effort.<br> +<br> +Presently the troop stood up in a body, the drums forming a half-circle +for the soloists, who were sometimes five or even more in number. +The songs that followed were highly dramatic; though I had none to give +me any explanation, I would at times make out some shadowy but decisive +outline of a plot; and I was continually reminded of certain quarrelsome +concerted scenes in grand operas at home; just so the single voices +issue from and fall again into the general volume; just so do the performers +separate and crowd together, brandish the raised hand, and roll the +eye to heaven - or the gallery. Already this is beyond the Thespian +model; the art of this people is already past the embryo: song, dance, +drums, quartette and solo - it is the drama full developed although +still in miniature. Of all so-called dancing in the South Seas, +that which I saw in Butaritari stands easily the first. The <i>hula</i>, +as it may be viewed by the speedy globe-trotter in Honolulu, is surely +the most dull of man’s inventions, and the spectator yawns under +its length as at a college lecture or a parliamentary debate. +But the Gilbert Island dance leads on the mind; it thrills, rouses, +subjugates; it has the essence of all art, an unexplored imminent significance. +Where so many are engaged, and where all must make (at a given moment) +the same swift, elaborate, and often arbitrary movement, the toil of +rehearsal is of course extreme. But they begin as children. +A child and a man may often be seen together in a maniap’: the +man sings and gesticulates, the child stands before him with streaming +tears and tremulously copies him in act and sound; it is the Gilbert +Island artist learning (as all artists must) his art in sorrow.<br> +<br> +I may seem to praise too much; here is a passage from my wife’s +diary, which proves that I was not alone in being moved, and completes +the picture:- ‘The conductor gave the cue, and all the dancers, +waving their arms, swaying their bodies, and clapping their breasts +in perfect time, opened with an introductory. The performers remained +seated, except two, and once three, and twice a single soloist. +These stood in the group, making a slight movement with the feet and +rhythmical quiver of the body as they sang. There was a pause +after the introductory, and then the real business of the opera - for +it was no less - began; an opera where every singer was an accomplished +actor. The leading man, in an impassioned ecstasy which possessed +him from head to foot, seemed transfigured; once it was as though a +strong wind had swept over the stage - their arms, their feathered fingers +thrilling with an emotion that shook my nerves as well: heads and bodies +followed like a field of grain before a gust. My blood came hot +and cold, tears pricked my eyes, my head whirled, I felt an almost irresistible +impulse to join the dancers. One drama, I think, I very nearly +understood. A fierce and savage old man took the solo part. +He sang of the birth of a prince, and how he was tenderly rocked in +his mother’s arms; of his boyhood, when he excelled his fellows +in swimming, climbing, and all athletic sports; of his youth, when he +went out to sea with his boat and fished; of his manhood, when he married +a wife who cradled a son of his own in her arms. Then came the +alarm of war, and a great battle, of which for a time the issue was +doubtful; but the hero conquered, as he always does, and with a tremendous +burst of the victors the piece closed. There were also comic pieces, +which caused great amusement. During one, an old man behind me +clutched me by the arm, shook his finger in my face with a roguish smile, +and said something with a chuckle, which I took to be the equivalent +of “O, you women, you women; it is true of you all!” +I fear it was not complimentary. At no time was there the least +sign of the ugly indecency of the eastern islands. All was poetry +pure and simple. The music itself was as complex as our own, though +constructed on an entirely different basis; once or twice I was startled +by a bit of something very like the best English sacred music, but it +was only for an instant. At last there was a longer pause, and +this time the dancers were all on their feet. As the drama went +on, the interest grew. The performers appealed to each other, +to the audience, to the heaven above; they took counsel with each other, +the conspirators drew together in a knot; it was just an opera, the +drums coming in at proper intervals, the tenor, baritone, and bass all +where they should be - except that the voices were all of the same calibre. +A woman once sang from the back row with a very fine contralto voice +spoilt by being made artificially nasal; I notice all the women affect +that unpleasantness. At one time a boy of angelic beauty was the +soloist; and at another, a child of six or eight, doubtless an infant +phenomenon being trained, was placed in the centre. The little +fellow was desperately frightened and embarrassed at first, but towards +the close warmed up to his work and showed much dramatic talent. +The changing expressions on the faces of the dancers were so speaking, +that it seemed a great stupidity not to understand them.’<br> +<br> +Our neighbour at this performance, Karaiti, somewhat favours his Butaritarian +majesty in shape and feature, being, like him, portly, bearded, and +Oriental. In character he seems the reverse: alert, smiling, jovial, +jocular, industrious. At home in his own island, he labours himself +like a slave, and makes his people labour like a slave-driver. +He takes an interest in ideas. George the trader told him about +flying-machines. ‘Is that true, George?’ he asked. +‘It is in the papers,’ replied George. ‘Well,’ +said Karaiti, ‘if that man can do it with machinery, I can do +it without’; and he designed and made a pair of wings, strapped +them on his shoulders, went to the end of a pier, launched himself into +space, and fell bulkily into the sea. His wives fished him out, +for his wings hindered him in swimming. ‘George,’ +said he, pausing as he went up to change, ‘George, you lie.’ +He had eight wives, for his small realm still follows ancient customs; +but he showed embarrassment when this was mentioned to my wife. +‘Tell her I have only brought one here,’ he said anxiously. +Altogether the Black Douglas pleased us much; and as we heard fresh +details of the king’s uneasiness, and saw for ourselves that all +the weapons in the summer parlour had been hid, we watched with the +more admiration the cause of all this anxiety rolling on his big legs, +with his big smiling face, apparently unarmed, and certainly unattended, +through the hostile town. The Red Douglas, pot-bellied Kuma, having +perhaps heard word of the debauch, remained upon his fief; his vassals +thus came uncommanded to the feast, and swelled the following of Karaiti.<br> +<br> +<i>Friday</i>, <i>July</i> 26. - At night in the dark, the singers of +Makin paraded in the road before our house and sang the song of the +princess. ‘This is the day; she was born to-day; Nei Kamaunave +was born to-day - a beautiful princess, Queen of Butaritari.’ +So I was told it went in endless iteration. The song was of course +out of season, and the performance only a rehearsal. But it was +a serenade besides; a delicate attention to ourselves from our new friend, +Karaiti.<br> +<br> +<i>Saturday</i>, <i>July</i> 27. - We had announced a performance of +the magic lantern to-night in church; and this brought the king to visit +us. In honour of the Black Douglas (I suppose) his usual two guardsmen +were now increased to four; and the squad made an outlandish figure +as they straggled after him, in straw hats, kilts and jackets. +Three carried their arms reversed, the butts over their shoulders, the +muzzles menacing the king’s plump back; the fourth had passed +his weapon behind his neck, and held it there with arms extended like +a backboard. The visit was extraordinarily long. The king, +no longer galvanised with gin, said and did nothing. He sat collapsed +in a chair and let a cigar go out. It was hot, it was sleepy, +it was cruel dull; there was no resource but to spy in the countenance +of Tebureimoa for some remaining trait of <i>Mr. Corpse</i> the butcher. +His hawk nose, crudely depressed and flattened at the point, did truly +seem to us to smell of midnight murder. When he took his leave, +Maka bade me observe him going down the stair (or rather ladder) from +the verandah. ‘Old man,’ said Maka. ‘Yes,’ +said I, ‘and yet I suppose not old man.’ ‘Young +man,’ returned Maka, ‘perhaps fo’ty.’ +And I have heard since he is most likely younger.<br> +<br> +While the magic lantern was showing, I skulked without in the dark. +The voice of Maka, excitedly explaining the Scripture slides, seemed +to fill not the church only, but the neighbourhood. All else was +silent. Presently a distant sound of singing arose and approached; +and a procession drew near along the road, the hot clean smell of the +men and women striking in my face delightfully. At the corner, +arrested by the voice of Maka and the lightening and darkening of the +church, they paused. They had no mind to go nearer, that was plain. +They were Makin people, I believe, probably staunch heathens, contemners +of the missionary and his works. Of a sudden, however, a man broke +from their company, took to his heels, and fled into the church; next +moment three had followed him; the next it was a covey of near upon +a score, all pelting for their lives. So the little band of the +heathen paused irresolute at the corner, and melted before the attractions +of a magic lantern, like a glacier in spring. The more staunch +vainly taunted the deserters; three fled in a guilty silence, but still +fled; and when at length the leader found the wit or the authority to +get his troop in motion and revive the singing, it was with much diminished +forces that they passed musically on up the dark road.<br> +<br> +Meanwhile inside the luminous pictures brightened and faded. I +stood for some while unobserved in the rear of the spectators, when +I could hear just in front of me a pair of lovers following the show +with interest, the male playing the part of interpreter and (like Adam) +mingling caresses with his lecture. The wild animals, a tiger +in particular, and that old school-treat favourite, the sleeper and +the mouse, were hailed with joy; but the chief marvel and delight was +in the gospel series. Maka, in the opinion of his aggrieved wife, +did not properly rise to the occasion. ‘What is the matter +with the man? Why can’t he talk?’ she cried. +The matter with the man, I think, was the greatness of the opportunity; +he reeled under his good fortune; and whether he did ill or well, the +exposure of these pious ‘phantoms’ did as a matter of fact +silence in all that part of the island the voice of the scoffer. +‘Why then,’ the word went round, ‘why then, the Bible +is true!’ And on our return afterwards we were told the +impression was yet lively, and those who had seen might be heard telling +those who had not, ‘O yes, it is all true; these things all happened, +we have seen the pictures.’ The argument is not so childish +as it seems; for I doubt if these islanders are acquainted with any +other mode of representation but photography; so that the picture of +an event (on the old melodrama principle that ‘the camera cannot +lie, Joseph,’) would appear strong proof of its occurrence. +The fact amused us the more because our slides were some of them ludicrously +silly, and one (Christ before Pilate) was received with shouts of merriment, +in which even Maka was constrained to join.<br> +<br> +<i>Sunday</i>, <i>July</i> 28. - Karaiti came to ask for a repetition +of the ‘phantoms’ - this was the accepted word - and, having +received a promise, turned and left my humble roof without the shadow +of a salutation. I felt it impolite to have the least appearance +of pocketing a slight; the times had been too difficult, and were still +too doubtful; and Queen Victoria’s son was bound to maintain the +honour of his house. Karaiti was accordingly summoned that evening +to the Ricks, where Mrs. Rick fell foul of him in words, and Queen Victoria’s +son assailed him with indignant looks. I was the ass with the +lion’s skin; I could not roar in the language of the Gilbert Islands; +but I could stare. Karaiti declared he had meant no offence; apologised +in a sound, hearty, gentlemanly manner; and became at once at his ease. +He had in a dagger to examine, and announced he would come to price +it on the morrow, to-day being Sunday; this nicety in a heathen with +eight wives surprised me. The dagger was ‘good for killing +fish,’ he said roguishly; and was supposed to have his eye upon +fish upon two legs. It is at least odd that in Eastern Polynesia +fish was the accepted euphemism for the human sacrifice. Asked +as to the population of his island, Karaiti called out to his vassals +who sat waiting him outside the door, and they put it at four hundred +and fifty; but (added Karaiti jovially) there will soon be plenty more, +for all the women are in the family way. Long before we separated +I had quite forgotten his offence. He, however, still bore it +in mind; and with a very courteous inspiration returned early on the +next day, paid us a long visit, and punctiliously said farewell when +he departed.<br> +<br> +<i>Monday</i>, <i>July</i> 29. - The great day came round at last. +In the first hours the night was startled by the sound of clapping hands +and the chant of Nei Kamaunava; its melancholy, slow, and somewhat menacing +measures broken at intervals by a formidable shout. The little +morsel of humanity thus celebrated in the dark hours was observed at +midday playing on the green entirely naked, and equally unobserved and +unconcerned.<br> +<br> +The summer parlour on its artificial islet, relieved against the shimmering +lagoon, and shimmering itself with sun and tinned iron, was all day +crowded about by eager men and women. Within, it was boxed full +of islanders, of any age and size, and in every degree of nudity and +finery. So close we squatted, that at one time I had a mighty +handsome woman on my knees, two little naked urchins having their feet +against my back. There might be a dame in full attire of <i>holoku</i> +and hat and flowers; and her next neighbour might the next moment strip +some little rag of a shift from her fat shoulders and come out a monument +of flesh, painted rather than covered by the hairbreadth <i>ridi</i>. +Little ladies who thought themselves too great to appear undraped upon +so high a festival were seen to pause outside in the bright sunshine, +their miniature ridis in their hand; a moment more and they were full-dressed +and entered the concert-room.<br> +<br> +At either end stood up to sing, or sat down to rest, the alternate companies +of singers; Kuma and Little Makin on the north, Butaritari and its conjunct +hamlets on the south; both groups conspicuous in barbaric bravery. +In the midst, between these rival camps of troubadours, a bench was +placed; and here the king and queen throned it, some two or three feet +above the crowded audience on the floor - Tebureimoa as usual in his +striped pyjamas with a satchel strapped across one shoulder, doubtless +(in the island fashion) to contain his pistols; the queen in a purple +<i>holoku</i>, her abundant hair let down, a fan in her hand. +The bench was turned facing to the strangers, a piece of well-considered +civility; and when it was the turn of Butaritari to sing, the pair must +twist round on the bench, lean their elbows on the rail, and turn to +us the spectacle of their broad backs. The royal couple occasionally +solaced themselves with a clay pipe; and the pomp of state was further +heightened by the rifles of a picket of the guard.<br> +<br> +With this kingly countenance, and ourselves squatted on the ground, +we heard several songs from one side or the other. Then royalty +and its guards withdrew, and Queen Victoria’s son and daughter-in-law +were summoned by acclamation to the vacant throne. Our pride was +perhaps a little modified when we were joined on our high places by +a certain thriftless loafer of a white; and yet I was glad too, for +the man had a smattering of native, and could give me some idea of the +subject of the songs. One was patriotic, and dared Tembinok’ +of Apemama, the terror of the group, to an invasion. One mixed +the planting of taro and the harvest-home. Some were historical, +and commemorated kings and the illustrious chances of their time, such +as a bout of drinking or a war. One, at least, was a drama of +domestic interest, excellently played by the troop from Makin. +It told the story of a man who has lost his wife, at first bewails her +loss, then seeks another: the earlier strains (or acts) are played exclusively +by men; but towards the end a woman appears, who has just lost her husband; +and I suppose the pair console each other, for the finale seemed of +happy omen. Of some of the songs my informant told me briefly +they were ‘like about the <i>weemen</i>’; this I could have +guessed myself. Each side (I should have said) was strengthened +by one or two women. They were all soloists, did not very often +join in the performance, but stood disengaged at the back part of the +stage, and looked (in <i>ridi</i>, necklace, and dressed hair) for all +the world like European ballet-dancers. When the song was anyway +broad these ladies came particularly to the front; and it was singular +to see that, after each entry, the <i>première</i> <i>danseuse</i> +pretended to be overcome by shame, as though led on beyond what she +had meant, and her male assistants made a feint of driving her away +like one who had disgraced herself. Similar affectations accompany +certain truly obscene dances of Samoa, where they are very well in place. +Here it was different. The words, perhaps, in this free-spoken +world, were gross enough to make a carter blush; and the most suggestive +feature was this feint of shame. For such parts the women showed +some disposition; they were pert, they were neat, they were acrobatic, +they were at times really amusing, and some of them were pretty. +But this is not the artist’s field; there is the whole width of +heaven between such capering and ogling, and the strange rhythmic gestures, +and strange, rapturous, frenzied faces with which the best of the male +dancers held us spellbound through a Gilbert Island ballet.<br> +<br> +Almost from the first it was apparent that the people of the city were +defeated. I might have thought them even good, only I had the +other troop before my eyes to correct my standard, and remind me continually +of ‘the little more, and how much it is.’ Perceiving +themselves worsted, the choir of Butaritari grew confused, blundered, +and broke down; amid this hubbub of unfamiliar intervals I should not +myself have recognised the slip, but the audience were quick to catch +it, and to jeer. To crown all, the Makin company began a dance +of truly superlative merit. I know not what it was about, I was +too much absorbed to ask. In one act a part of the chorus, squealing +in some strange falsetto, produced very much the effect of our orchestra; +in another, the dancers, leaping like jumping-jacks, with arms extended, +passed through and through each other’s ranks with extraordinary +speed, neatness, and humour. A more laughable effect I never saw; +in any European theatre it would have brought the house down, and the +island audience roared with laughter and applause. This filled +up the measure for the rival company, and they forgot themselves and +decency. After each act or figure of the ballet, the performers +pause a moment standing, and the next is introduced by the clapping +of hands in triplets. Not until the end of the whole ballet do +they sit down, which is the signal for the rivals to stand up. +But now all rules were to be broken. During the interval following +on this great applause, the company of Butaritari leaped suddenly to +their feet and most unhandsomely began a performance of their own. +It was strange to see the men of Makin staring; I have seen a tenor +in Europe stare with the same blank dignity into a hissing theatre; +but presently, to my surprise, they sobered down, gave up the unsung +remainder of their ballet, resumed their seats, and suffered their ungallant +adversaries to go on and finish. Nothing would suffice. +Again, at the first interval, Butaritari unhandsomely cut in; Makin, +irritated in turn, followed the example; and the two companies of dancers +remained permanently standing, continuously clapping hands, and regularly +cutting across each other at each pause. I expected blows to begin +with any moment; and our position in the midst was highly unstrategical. +But the Makin people had a better thought; and upon a fresh interruption +turned and trooped out of the house. We followed them, first because +these were the artists, second because they were guests and had been +scurvily ill-used. A large population of our neighbours did the +same, so that the causeway was filled from end to end by the procession +of deserters; and the Butaritari choir was left to sing for its own +pleasure in an empty house, having gained the point and lost the audience. +It was surely fortunate that there was no one drunk; but, drunk or sober, +where else would a scene so irritating have concluded without blows?<br> +<br> +The last stage and glory of this auspicious day was of our own providing +- the second and positively the last appearance of the phantoms. +All round the church, groups sat outside, in the night, where they could +see nothing; perhaps ashamed to enter, certainly finding some shadowy +pleasure in the mere proximity. Within, about one-half of the +great shed was densely packed with people. In the midst, on the +royal dais, the lantern luminously smoked; chance rays of light struck +out the earnest countenance of our Chinaman grinding the hand-organ; +a fainter glimmer showed off the rafters and their shadows in the hollow +of the roof; the pictures shone and vanished on the screen; and as each +appeared, there would run a hush, a whisper, a strong shuddering rustle, +and a chorus of small cries among the crowd. There sat by me the +mate of a wrecked schooner. ‘They would think this a strange +sight in Europe or the States,’ said he, ‘going on in a +building like this, all tied with bits of string.’<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +CHAPTER VII - HUSBAND AND WIFE<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +The trader accustomed to the manners of Eastern Polynesia has a lesson +to learn among the Gilberts. The <i>ridi</i> is but a spare attire; +as late as thirty years back the women went naked until marriage; within +ten years the custom lingered; and these facts, above all when heard +in description, conveyed a very false idea of the manners of the group. +A very intelligent missionary described it (in its former state) as +a ‘Paradise of naked women’ for the resident whites. +It was at least a platonic Paradise, where Lothario ventured at his +peril. Since 1860, fourteen whites have perished on a single island, +all for the same cause, all found where they had no business, and speared +by some indignant father of a family; the figure was given me by one +of their contemporaries who had been more prudent and survived. +The strange persistence of these fourteen martyrs might seem to point +to monomania or a series of romantic passions; gin is the more likely +key. The poor buzzards sat alone in their houses by an open case; +they drank; their brain was fired; they stumbled towards the nearest +houses on chance; and the dart went through their liver. In place +of a Paradise the trader found an archipelago of fierce husbands and +of virtuous women. ‘Of course if you wish to make love to +them, it’s the same as anywhere else,’ observed a trader +innocently; but he and his companions rarely so choose.<br> +<br> +The trader must be credited with a virtue: he often makes a kind and +loyal husband. Some of the worst beachcombers in the Pacific, +some of the last of the old school, have fallen in my path, and some +of them were admirable to their native wives, and one made a despairing +widower. The position of a trader’s wife in the Gilberts +is, besides, unusually enviable. She shares the immunities of +her husband. Curfew in Butaritari sounds for her in vain. +Long after the bell is rung and the great island ladies are confined +for the night to their own roof, this chartered libertine may scamper +and giggle through the deserted streets or go down to bathe in the dark. +The resources of the store are at her hand; she goes arrayed like a +queen, and feasts delicately everyday upon tinned meats. And she +who was perhaps of no regard or station among natives sits with captains, +and is entertained on board of schooners. Five of these privileged +dames were some time our neighbours. Four were handsome skittish +lasses, gamesome like children, and like children liable to fits of +pouting. They wore dresses by day, but there was a tendency after +dark to strip these lendings and to career and squall about the compound +in the aboriginal <i>ridi</i>. Games of cards were continually +played, with shells for counters; their course was much marred by cheating; +and the end of a round (above all if a man was of the party) resolved +itself into a scrimmage for the counters. The fifth was a matron. +It was a picture to see her sail to church on a Sunday, a parasol in +hand, a nursemaid following, and the baby buried in a trade hat and +armed with a patent feeding-bottle. The service was enlivened +by her continual supervision and correction of the maid. It was +impossible not to fancy the baby was a doll, and the church some European +playroom. All these women were legitimately married. It +is true that the certificate of one, when she proudly showed it, proved +to run thus, that she was ‘married for one night,’ and her +gracious partner was at liberty to ‘send her to hell’ the +next morning; but she was none the wiser or the worse for the dastardly +trick. Another, I heard, was married on a work of mine in a pirated +edition; it answered the purpose as well as a Hall Bible. Notwithstanding +all these allurements of social distinction, rare food and raiment, +a comparative vacation from toil, and legitimate marriage contracted +on a pirated edition, the trader must sometimes seek long before he +can be mated. While I was in the group one had been eight months +on the quest, and he was still a bachelor.<br> +<br> +Within strictly native society the old laws and practices were harsh, +but not without a certain stamp of high-mindedness. Stealthy adultery +was punished with death; open elopement was properly considered virtue +in comparison, and compounded for a fine in land. The male adulterer +alone seems to have been punished. It is correct manners for a +jealous man to hang himself; a jealous woman has a different remedy +- she bites her rival. Ten or twenty years ago it was a capital +offence to raise a woman’s <i>ridi</i>; to this day it is still +punished with a heavy fine; and the garment itself is still symbolically +sacred. Suppose a piece of land to be disputed in Butaritari, +the claimant who shall first hang a <i>ridi</i> on the tapu-post has +gained his cause, since no one can remove or touch it but himself.<br> +<br> +The <i>ridi</i> was the badge not of the woman but the wife, the mark +not of her sex but of her station. It was the collar on the slave’s +neck, the brand on merchandise. The adulterous woman seems to +have been spared; were the husband offended, it would be a poor consolation +to send his draught cattle to the shambles. Karaiti, to this day, +calls his eight wives ‘his horses,’ some trader having explained +to him the employment of these animals on farms; and Nanteitei hired +out his wives to do mason-work. Husbands, at least when of high +rank, had the power of life and death; even whites seem to have possessed +it; and their wives, when they had transgressed beyond forgiveness, +made haste to pronounce the formula of deprecation - <i>I Kana Kim</i>. +This form of words had so much virtue that a condemned criminal repeating +it on a particular day to the king who had condemned him, must be instantly +released. It is an offer of abasement, and, strangely enough, +the reverse - the imitation - is a common vulgar insult in Great Britain +to this day. I give a scene between a trader and his Gilbert Island +wife, as it was told me by the husband, now one of the oldest residents, +but then a freshman in the group.<br> +<br> +‘Go and light a fire,’ said the trader, ‘and when +I have brought this oil I will cook some fish.’ The woman +grunted at him, island fashion. ‘I am not a pig that you +should grunt at me,’ said he.<br> +<br> +‘I know you are not a pig,’ said the woman, ‘neither +am I your slave.’<br> +<br> +‘To be sure you are not my slave, and if you do not care to stop +with me, you had better go home to your people,’ said he. +‘But in the mean time go and light the fire; and when I have brought +this oil I will cook some fish.’<br> +<br> +She went as if to obey; and presently when the trader looked she had +built a fire so big that the cook-house was catching in flames.<br> +<br> +‘<i>I Kana Kim</i>!’ she cried, as she saw him coming; but +he recked not, and hit her with a cooking-pot. The leg pierced +her skull, blood spouted, it was thought she was a dead woman, and the +natives surrounded the house in a menacing expectation. Another +white was present, a man of older experience. ‘You will +have us both killed if you go on like this,’ he cried. ‘She +had said <i>I Kana Kim</i>!’ If she had not said <i>I Kana +Kim</i> he might have struck her with a caldron. It was not the +blow that made the crime, but the disregard of an accepted formula.<br> +<br> +Polygamy, the particular sacredness of wives, their semi-servile state, +their seclusion in kings’ harems, even their privilege of biting, +all would seem to indicate a Mohammedan society and the opinion of the +soullessness of woman. And not so in the least. It is a +mere appearance. After you have studied these extremes in one +house, you may go to the next and find all reversed, the woman the mistress, +the man only the first of her thralls. The authority is not with +the husband as such, nor the wife as such. It resides in the chief +or the chief-woman; in him or her who has inherited the lands of the +clan, and stands to the clansman in the place of parent, exacting their +service, answerable for their fines. There is but the one source +of power and the one ground of dignity - rank. The king married +a chief-woman; she became his menial, and must work with her hands on +Messrs. Wightman’s pier. The king divorced her; she regained +at once her former state and power. She married the Hawaiian sailor, +and behold the man is her flunkey and can be shown the door at pleasure. +Nay, and such low-born lords are even corrected physically, and, like +grown but dutiful children, must endure the discipline.<br> +<br> +We were intimate in one such household, that of Nei Takauti and Nan +Tok’; I put the lady first of necessity. During one week +of fool’s paradise, Mrs. Stevenson had gone alone to the sea-side +of the island after shells. I am very sure the proceeding was +unsafe; and she soon perceived a man and woman watching her. Do +what she would, her guardians held her steadily in view; and when the +afternoon began to fall, and they thought she had stayed long enough, +took her in charge, and by signs and broken English ordered her home. +On the way the lady drew from her earring-hole a clay pipe, the husband +lighted it, and it was handed to my unfortunate wife, who knew not how +to refuse the incommodious favour; and when they were all come to our +house, the pair sat down beside her on the floor, and improved the occasion +with prayer. From that day they were our family friends; bringing +thrice a day the beautiful island garlands of white flowers, visiting +us any evening, and frequently carrying us down to their own maniap’ +in return, the woman leading Mrs. Stevenson by the hand like one child +with another.<br> +<br> +Nan Tok’, the husband, was young, extremely handsome, of the most +approved good humour, and suffering in his precarious station from suppressed +high spirits. Nei Takauti, the wife, was getting old; her grown +son by a former marriage had just hanged himself before his mother’s +eyes in despair at a well-merited rebuke. Perhaps she had never +been beautiful, but her face was full of character, her eye of sombre +fire. She was a high chief-woman, but by a strange exception for +a person of her rank, was small, spare, and sinewy, with lean small +hands and corded neck. Her full dress of an evening was invariably +a white chemise - and for adornment, green leaves (or sometimes white +blossoms) stuck in her hair and thrust through her huge earring-holes. +The husband on the contrary changed to view like a kaleidoscope. +Whatever pretty thing my wife might have given to Nei Takauti - a string +of beads, a ribbon, a piece of bright fabric - appeared the next evening +on the person of Nan Tok’. It was plain he was a clothes-horse; +that he wore livery; that, in a word, he was his wife’s wife. +They reversed the parts indeed, down to the least particular; it was +the husband who showed himself the ministering angel in the hour of +pain, while the wife displayed the apathy and heartlessness of the proverbial +man.<br> +<br> +When Nei Takauti had a headache Nan Tok’ was full of attention +and concern. When the husband had a cold and a racking toothache +the wife heeded not, except to jeer. It is always the woman’s +part to fill and light the pipe; Nei Takauti handed hers in silence +to the wedded page; but she carried it herself, as though the page were +not entirely trusted. Thus she kept the money, but it was he who +ran the errands, anxiously sedulous. A cloud on her face dimmed +instantly his beaming looks; on an early visit to their maniap’ +my wife saw he had cause to be wary. Nan Tok’ had a friend +with him, a giddy young thing, of his own age and sex; and they had +worked themselves into that stage of jocularity when consequences are +too often disregarded. Nei Takauti mentioned her own name. +Instantly Nan Tok’ held up two fingers, his friend did likewise, +both in an ecstasy of slyness. It was plain the lady had two names; +and from the nature of their merriment, and the wrath that gathered +on her brow, there must be something ticklish in the second. The +husband pronounced it; a well-directed cocoa-nut from the hand of his +wife caught him on the side of the head, and the voices and the mirth +of these indiscreet young gentlemen ceased for the day.<br> +<br> +The people of Eastern Polynesia are never at a loss; their etiquette +is absolute and plenary; in every circumstance it tells them what to +do and how to do it. The Gilbertines are seemingly more free, +and pay for their freedom (like ourselves) in frequent perplexity. +This was often the case with the topsy-turvy couple. We had once +supplied them during a visit with a pipe and tobacco; and when they +had smoked and were about to leave, they found themselves confronted +with a problem: should they take or leave what remained of the tobacco? +The piece of plug was taken up, it was laid down again, it was handed +back and forth, and argued over, till the wife began to look haggard +and the husband elderly. They ended by taking it, and I wager +were not yet clear of the compound before they were sure they had decided +wrong. Another time they had been given each a liberal cup of +coffee, and Nan Tok’ with difficulty and disaffection made an +end of his. Nei Takauti had taken some, she had no mind for more, +plainly conceived it would be a breach of manners to set down the cup +unfinished, and ordered her wedded retainer to dispose of what was left. +‘I have swallowed all I can, I cannot swallow more, it is a physical +impossibility,’ he seemed to say; and his stern officer reiterated +her commands with secret imperative signals. Luckless dog! but +in mere humanity we came to the rescue and removed the cup.<br> +<br> +I cannot but smile over this funny household; yet I remember the good +souls with affection and respect. Their attention to ourselves +was surprising. The garlands are much esteemed, the blossoms must +be sought far and wide; and though they had many retainers to call to +their aid, we often saw themselves passing afield after the blossoms, +and the wife engaged with her own in putting them together. It +was no want of only that disregard so incident to husbands, that made +Nei Takauti despise the sufferings of Nan Tok’. When my +wife was unwell she proved a diligent and kindly nurse; and the pair, +to the extreme embarrassment of the sufferer, became fixtures in the +sick-room. This rugged, capable, imperious old dame, with the +wild eyes, had deep and tender qualities: her pride in her young husband +it seemed that she dissembled, fearing possibly to spoil him; and when +she spoke of her dead son there came something tragic in her face. +But I seemed to trace in the Gilbertines a virility of sense and sentiment +which distinguishes them (like their harsh and uncouth language) from +their brother islanders in the east.<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +PART IV: THE GILBERTS - APEMAMA<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +CHAPTER I - THE KING OF APEMAMA: THE ROYAL TRADER<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +There is one great personage in the Gilberts: Tembinok’ of Apemama: +solely conspicuous, the hero of song, the butt of gossip. Through +the rest of the group the kings are slain or fallen in tutelage: Tembinok’ +alone remains, the last tyrant, the last erect vestige of a dead society. +The white man is everywhere else, building his houses, drinking his +gin, getting in and out of trouble with the weak native governments. +There is only one white on Apemama, and he on sufferance, living far +from court, and hearkening and watching his conduct like a mouse in +a cat’s ear. Through all the other islands a stream of native +visitors comes and goes, travelling by families, spending years on the +grand tour. Apemama alone is left upon one side, the tourist dreading +to risk himself within the clutch of Tembinok’. And fear +of the same Gorgon follows and troubles them at home. Maiana once +paid him tribute; he once fell upon and seized Nonuti: first steps to +the empire of the archipelago. A British warship coming on the +scene, the conqueror was driven to disgorge, his career checked in the +outset, his dear-bought armoury sunk in his own lagoon. But the +impression had been made; periodical fear of him still shakes the islands; +rumour depicts him mustering his canoes for a fresh onfall; rumour can +name his destination; and Tembinok’ figures in the patriotic war-songs +of the Gilberts like Napoleon in those of our grandfathers.<br> +<br> +We were at sea, bound from Mariki to Nonuti and Tapituea, when the wind +came suddenly fair for Apemama. The course was at once changed; +all hands were turned-to to clean ship, the decks holy-stoned, all the +cabin washed, the trade-room overhauled. In all our cruising we +never saw the <i>Equator</i> so smart as she was made for Tembinok’. +Nor was Captain Reid alone in these coquetries; for, another schooner +chancing to arrive during my stay in Apemama, I found that she also +was dandified for the occasion. And the two cases stand alone +in my experience of South Sea traders.<br> +<br> +We had on board a family of native tourists, from the grandsire to the +babe in arms, trying (against an extraordinary series of ill-luck) to +regain their native island of Peru. Five times already they had +paid their fare and taken ship; five times they had been disappointed, +dropped penniless upon strange islands, or carried back to Butaritari, +whence they sailed. This last attempt had been no better-starred; +their provisions were exhausted. Peru was beyond hope, and they +had cheerfully made up their minds to a fresh stage of exile in Tapituea +or Nonuti. With this slant of wind their random destination became +once more changed; and like the Calendar’s pilot, when the ‘black +mountains’ hove in view, they changed colour and beat upon their +breasts. Their camp, which was on deck in the ship’s waist, +resounded with complaint. They would be set to work, they must +become slaves, escape was hopeless, they must live and toil and die +in Apemama, in the tyrant’s den. With this sort of talk +they so greatly terrified their children, that one (a big hulking boy) +must at last be torn screaming from the schooner’s side. +And their fears were wholly groundless. I have little doubt they +were not suffered to be idle; but I can vouch for it that they were +kindly and generously used. For, the matter of a year later, I +was once more shipmate with these inconsistent wanderers on board the +<i>Janet Nicoll</i>. Their fare was paid by Tembinok’; they +who had gone ashore from the <i>Equator</i> destitute, reappeared upon +the <i>Janet</i> with new clothes, laden with mats and presents, and +bringing with them a magazine of food, on which they lived like fighting-cocks +throughout the voyage; I saw them at length repatriated, and I must +say they showed more concern on quitting Apemama than delight at reaching +home.<br> +<br> +We entered by the north passage (Sunday, September 1st), dodging among +shoals. It was a day of fierce equatorial sunshine; but the breeze +was strong and chill; and the mate, who conned the schooner from the +cross-trees, returned shivering to the deck. The lagoon was thick +with many-tinted wavelets; a continuous roaring of the outer sea overhung +the anchorage; and the long, hollow crescent of palm ruffled and sparkled +in the wind. Opposite our berth the beach was seen to be surmounted +for some distance by a terrace of white coral seven or eight feet high +and crowned in turn by the scattered and incongruous buildings of the +palace. The village adjoins on the south, a cluster of high-roofed +maniap’s. And village and palace seemed deserted.<br> +<br> +We were scarce yet moored, however, before distant and busy figures +appeared upon the beach, a boat was launched, and a crew pulled out +to us bringing the king’s ladder. Tembinok’ had once +an accident; has feared ever since to entrust his person to the rotten +chandlery of South Sea traders; and devised in consequence a frame of +wood, which is brought on board a ship as soon as she appears, and remains +lashed to her side until she leave. The boat’s crew, having +applied this engine, returned at once to shore. They might not +come on board; neither might we land, or not without danger of offence; +the king giving pratique in person. An interval followed, during +which dinner was delayed for the great man - the prelude of the ladder, +giving us some notion of his weighty body and sensible, ingenious character, +had highly whetted our curiosity; and it was with something like excitement +that we saw the beach and terrace suddenly blacken with attendant vassals, +the king and party embark, the boat (a man-of-war gig) come flying towards +us dead before the wind, and the royal coxswain lay us cleverly aboard, +mount the ladder with a jealous diffidence, and descend heavily on deck.<br> +<br> +Not long ago he was overgrown with fat, obscured to view, and a burthen +to himself. Captains visiting the island advised him to walk; +and though it broke the habits of a life and the traditions of his rank, +he practised the remedy with benefit. His corpulence is now portable; +you would call him lusty rather than fat; but his gait is still dull, +stumbling, and elephantine. He neither stops nor hastens, but +goes about his business with an implacable deliberation. We could +never see him and not be struck with his extraordinary natural means +for the theatre: a beaked profile like Dante’s in the mask, a +mane of long black hair, the eye brilliant, imperious, and inquiring: +for certain parts, and to one who could have used it, the face was a +fortune. His voice matched it well, being shrill, powerful, and +uncanny, with a note like a sea-bird’s. Where there are +no fashions, none to set them, few to follow them if they were set, +and none to criticise, he dresses - as Sir Charles Grandison lived - +‘to his own heart.’ Now he wears a woman’s frock, +now a naval uniform; now (and more usually) figures in a masquerade +costume of his own design: trousers and a singular jacket with shirt +tails, the cut and fit wonderful for island workmanship, the material +always handsome, sometimes green velvet, sometimes cardinal red silk. +This masquerade becomes him admirably. In the woman’s frock +he looks ominous and weird beyond belief. I see him now come pacing +towards me in the cruel sun, solitary, a figure out of Hoffmann.<br> +<br> +A visit on board ship, such as that at which we now assisted, makes +a chief part and by far the chief diversion of the life of Tembinok’. +He is not only the sole ruler, he is the sole merchant of his triple +kingdom, Apemama, Aranuka, and Kuria, well-planted islands. The +taro goes to the chiefs, who divide as they please among their immediate +adherents; but certain fish, turtles - which abound in Kuria, - and +the whole produce of the coco-palm, belong exclusively to Tembinok’. +‘A’ cobra berong me,’ observed his majesty with a +wave of his hand; and he counts and sells it by the houseful. +‘You got copra, king?’ I have heard a trader ask. +‘I got two, three outches,’ his majesty replied: ‘I +think three.’ Hence the commercial importance of Apemama, +the trade of three islands being centred there in a single hand; hence +it is that so many whites have tried in vain to gain or to preserve +a footing; hence ships are adorned, cooks have special orders, and captains +array themselves in smiles, to greet the king. If he be pleased +with his welcome and the fare he may pass days on board, and, every +day, and sometimes every hour, will be of profit to the ship. +He oscillates between the cabin, where he is entertained with strange +meats, and the trade-room, where he enjoys the pleasures of shopping +on a scale to match his person. A few obsequious attendants squat +by the house door, awaiting his least signal. In the boat, which +has been suffered to drop astern, one or two of his wives lie covered +from the sun under mats, tossed by the short sea of the lagoon, and +enduring agonies of heat and tedium. This severity is now and +then relaxed and the wives allowed on board. Three or four were +thus favoured on the day of our arrival: substantial ladies airily attired +in <i>ridis</i>. Each had a share of copra, her <i>peculium</i>, +to dispose of for herself. The display in the trade-room - hats, +ribbbons, dresses, scents, tins of salmon - the pride of the eye and +the lust of the flesh - tempted them in vain. They had but the +one idea - tobacco, the island currency, tantamount to minted gold; +returned to shore with it, burthened but rejoicing; and late into the +night, on the royal terrace, were to be seen counting the sticks by +lamplight in the open air.<br> +<br> +The king is no such economist. He is greedy of things new and +foreign. House after house, chest after chest, in the palace precinct, +is already crammed with clocks, musical boxes, blue spectacles, umbrellas, +knitted waistcoats, bolts of stuff, tools, rifles, fowling-pieces, medicines, +European foods, sewing-machines, and, what is more extraordinary, stoves: +all that ever caught his eye, tickled his appetite, pleased him for +its use, or puzzled him with its apparent inutility. And still +his lust is unabated. He is possessed by the seven devils of the +collector. He hears a thing spoken of, and a shadow comes on his +face. ‘I think I no got him,’ he will say; and the +treasures he has seem worthless in comparison. If a ship be bound +for Apemama, the merchant racks his brain to hit upon some novelty. +This he leaves carelessly in the main cabin or partly conceals in his +own berth, so that the king shall spy it for himself. ‘How +much you want?’ inquires Tembinok’, passing and pointing. +‘No, king; that too dear,’ returns the trader. ‘I +think I like him,’ says the king. This was a bowl of gold-fish. +On another occasion it was scented soap. ‘No, king; that +cost too much,’ said the trader; ‘too good for a Kanaka.’ +‘How much you got? I take him all,’ replied his majesty, +and became the lord of seventeen boxes at two dollars a cake. +Or again, the merchant feigns the article is not for sale, is private +property, an heirloom or a gift; and the trick infallibly succeeds. +Thwart the king and you hold him. His autocratic nature rears +at the affront of opposition. He accepts it for a challenge; sets +his teeth like a hunter going at a fence; and with no mark of emotion, +scarce even of interest, stolidly piles up the price. Thus, for +our sins, he took a fancy to my wife’s dressing-bag, a thing entirely +useless to the man, and sadly battered by years of service. Early +one forenoon he came to our house, sat down, and abruptly offered to +purchase it. I told him I sold nothing, and the bag at any rate +was a present from a friend; but he was acquainted with these pretexts +from of old, and knew what they were worth and how to meet them. +Adopting what I believe is called ‘the object method,’ he +drew out a bag of English gold, sovereigns and half-sovereigns, and +began to lay them one by one in silence on the table; at each fresh +piece reading our faces with a look. In vain I continued to protest +I was no trader; he deigned not to reply. There must have been +twenty pounds on the table, he was still going on, and irritation had +begun to mingle with our embarrassment, when a happy idea came to our +delivery. Since his majesty thought so much of the bag, we said, +we must beg him to accept it as a present. It was the most surprising +turn in Tembinok’s experience. He perceived too late that +his persistence was unmannerly; hung his head a while in silence; then, +lifting up a sheepish countenance, ‘I ‘shamed,’ said +the tyrant. It was the first and the last time we heard him own +to a flaw in his behaviour. Half an hour after he sent us a camphor-wood +chest worth only a few dollars - but then heaven knows what Tembinok’ +had paid for it.<br> +<br> +Cunning by nature, and versed for forty years in the government of men, +it must not be supposed that he is cheated blindly, or has resigned +himself without resistance to be the milch-cow of the passing trader. +His efforts have been even heroic. Like Nakaeia of Makin, he has +owned schooners. More fortunate than Nakaeia, he has found captains. +Ships of his have sailed as far as to the colonies. He has trafficked +direct, in his own bottoms, with New Zealand. And even so, even +there, the world-enveloping dishonesty of the white man prevented him; +his profit melted, his ship returned in debt, the money for the insurance +was embezzled, and when the <i>Coronet</i> came to be lost, he was astonished +to find he had lost all. At this he dropped his weapons; owned +he might as hopefully wrestle with the winds of heaven; and like an +experienced sheep, submitted his fleece thenceforward to the shearers. +He is the last man in the world to waste anger on the incurable; accepts +it with cynical composure; asks no more in those he deals with than +a certain decency of moderation; drives as good a bargain as he can; +and when he considers he is more than usually swindled, writes it in +his memory against the merchant’s name. He once ran over +to me a list of captains and supercargoes with whom he had done business, +classing them under three heads: ‘He cheat a litty’ - ‘He +cheat plenty’ - and ‘I think he cheat too much.’ +For the first two classes he expressed perfect toleration; sometimes, +but not always, for the third. I was present when a certain merchant +was turned about his business, and was the means (having a considerable +influence ever since the bag) of patching up the dispute. Even +on the day of our arrival there was like to have been a hitch with Captain +Reid: the ground of which is perhaps worth recital. Among goods +exported specially for Tembinok’ there is a beverage known (and +labelled) as Hennessy’s brandy. It is neither Hennessy, +nor even brandy; is about the colour of sherry, but is not sherry; tastes +of kirsch, and yet neither is it kirsch. The king, at least, has +grown used to this amazing brand, and rather prides himself upon the +taste; and any substitution is a double offence, being at once to cheat +him and to cast a doubt upon his palate. A similar weakness is +to be observed in all connoisseurs. Now the last case sold by +the <i>Equator</i> was found to contain a different and I would fondly +fancy a superior distillation; and the conversation opened very black +for Captain Reid. But Tembinok’ is a moderate man. +He was reminded and admitted that all men were liable to error, even +himself; accepted the principle that a fault handsomely acknowledged +should be condoned; and wound the matter up with this proposal: ‘Tuppoti +I mi’take, you ‘peakee me. Tuppoti you mi’take, +I ‘peakee you. Mo’ betta.’<br> +<br> +After dinner and supper in the cabin, a glass or two of ‘Hennetti’ +- the genuine article this time, with the kirsch bouquet, - and five +hours’ lounging on the trade-room counter, royalty embarked for +home. Three tacks grounded the boat before the palace; the wives +were carried ashore on the backs of vassals; Tembinok’ stepped +on a railed platform like a steamer’s gangway, and was borne shoulder +high through the shallows, up the beach, and by an inclined plane, paved +with pebbles, to the glaring terrace where he dwells.<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +CHAPTER II - THE KING OF APEMAMA: FOUNDATION OF EQUATOR TOWN<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +Our first sight of Tembinok’ was a matter of concern, almost alarm, +to my whole party. We had a favour to seek; we must approach in +the proper courtly attitude of a suitor; and must either please him +or fail in the main purpose of our voyage. It was our wish to +land and live in Apemama, and see more near at hand the odd character +of the man and the odd (or rather ancient) condition of his island. +In all other isles of the South Seas a white man may land with his chest, +and set up house for a lifetime, if he choose, and if he have the money +or the trade; no hindrance is conceivable. But Apemama is a close +island, lying there in the sea with closed doors; the king himself, +like a vigilant officer, ready at the wicket to scrutinise and reject +intrenching visitors. Hence the attraction of our enterprise; +not merely because it was a little difficult, but because this social +quarantine, a curiosity in itself, has been the preservative of others.<br> +<br> +Tembinok’, like most tyrants, is a conservative; like many conservatives, +he eagerly welcomes new ideas, and, except in the field of politics, +leans to practical reform. When the missionaries came, professing +a knowledge of the truth, he readily received them; attended their worship, +acquired the accomplishment of public prayer, and made himself a student +at their feet. It is thus - it is by the cultivation of similar +passing chances - that he has learned to read, to write, to cipher, +and to speak his queer, personal English, so different from ordinary +‘Beach de Mar,’ so much more obscure, expressive, and condensed. +His education attended to, he found time to become critical of the new +inmates. Like Nakaeia of Makin, he is an admirer of silence in +the island; broods over it like a great ear; has spies who report daily; +and had rather his subjects sang than talked. The service, and +in particular the sermon, were thus sure to become offences: ‘Here, +in my island, <i>I</i> ‘peak,’ he once observed to me. +‘My chieps no ‘peak - do what I talk.’ He looked +at the missionary, and what did he see? ‘See Kanaka ‘peak +in a big outch!’ he cried, with a strong ring of sarcasm. +Yet he endured the subversive spectacle, and might even have continued +to endure it, had not a fresh point arisen. He looked again, to +employ his own figure; and the Kanaka was no longer speaking, he was +doing worse - he was building a copra-house. The king was touched +in his chief interests; revenue and prerogative were threatened. +He considered besides (and some think with him) that trade is incompatible +with the missionary claims. ‘Tuppoti mitonary think “good +man”: very good. Tuppoti he think “cobra”: no +good. I send him away ship.’ Such was his abrupt history +of the evangelist in Apemama.<br> +<br> +Similar deportations are common: ‘I send him away ship’ +is the epitaph of not a few, his majesty paying the exile’s fare +to the next place of call. For instance, being passionately fond +of European food, he has several times added to his household a white +cook, and one after another these have been deported. They, on +their side, swear they were not paid their wages; he, on his, that they +robbed and swindled him beyond endurance: both perhaps justly. +A more important case was that of an agent, despatched (as I heard the +story) by a firm of merchants to worm his way into the king’s +good graces, become, if possible, premier, and handle the copra in the +interest of his employers. He obtained authority to land, practised +his fascinations, was patiently listened to by Tembinok’, supposed +himself on the highway to success; and behold! when the next ship touched +at Apemama, the would-be premier was flung into a boat - had on board +- his fare paid, and so good-bye. But it is needless to multiply +examples; the proof of the pudding is in the eating. When we came +to Apemama, of so many white men who have scrambled for a place in that +rich market, one remained - a silent, sober, solitary, niggardly recluse, +of whom the king remarks, ‘I think he good; he no ‘peak.’<br> +<br> +I was warned at the outset we might very well fail in our design: yet +never dreamed of what proved to be the fact, that we should be left +four-and-twenty hours in suspense and come within an ace of ultimate +rejection. Captain Reid had primed himself; no sooner was the +king on board, and the Hennetti question amicably settled, than he proceeded +to express my request and give an abstract of my claims and virtues. +The gammon about Queen Victoria’s son might do for Butaritari; +it was out of the question here; and I now figured as ‘one of +the Old Men of England,’ a person of deep knowledge, come expressly +to visit Tembinok’s dominion, and eager to report upon it to the +no less eager Queen Victoria. The king made no shadow of an answer, +and presently began upon a different subject. We might have thought +that he had not heard, or not understood; only that we found ourselves +the subject of a constant study. As we sat at meals, he took us +in series and fixed upon each, for near a minute at a time, the same +hard and thoughtful stare. As he thus looked he seemed to forget +himself, the subject and the company, and to become absorbed in the +process of his thought; the look was wholly impersonal; I have seen +the same in the eyes of portrait-painters. The counts upon which +whites have been deported are mainly four: cheating Tembinok’, +meddling overmuch with copra, which is the source of his wealth, and +one of the sinews of his power, <i>‘peaking</i>, and political +intrigue. I felt guiltless upon all; but how to show it? +I would not have taken copra in a gift: how to express that quality +by my dinner-table bearing? The rest of the party shared my innocence +and my embarrassment. They shared also in my mortification when +after two whole meal-times and the odd moments of an afternoon devoted +to this reconnoitring, Tembinok’ took his leave in silence. +Next morning, the same undisguised study, the same silence, was resumed; +and the second day had come to its maturity before I was informed abruptly +that I had stood the ordeal. ‘I look your eye. You +good man. You no lie,’ said the king: a doubtful compliment +to a writer of romance. Later he explained he did not quite judge +by the eye only, but the mouth as well. ‘Tuppoti I see man,’ +he explained. ‘I no tavvy good man, bad man. I look +eye, look mouth. Then I tavvy. Look <i>eye</i>, look mouth,’ +he repeated. And indeed in our case the mouth had the most to +do with it, and it was by our talk that we gained admission to the island; +the king promising himself (and I believe really amassing) a vast amount +of useful knowledge ere we left.<br> +<br> +The terms of our admission were as follows: We were to choose a site, +and the king should there build us a town. His people should work +for us, but the king only was to give them orders. One of his +cooks should come daily to help mine, and to learn of him. In +case our stores ran out, he would supply us, and be repaid on the return +of the <i>Equator</i>. On the other hand, he was to come to meals +with us when so inclined; when he stayed at home, a dish was to be sent +him from our table; and I solemnly engaged to give his subjects no liquor +or money (both of which they are forbidden to possess) and no tobacco, +which they were to receive only from the royal hand. I think I +remember to have protested against the stringency of this last article; +at least, it was relaxed, and when a man worked for me I was allowed +to give him a pipe of tobacco on the premises, but none to take away.<br> +<br> +The site of Equator City - we named our city for the schooner - was +soon chosen. The immediate shores of the lagoon are windy and +blinding; Tembinok’ himself is glad to grope blue-spectacled on +his terrace; and we fled the neighbourhood of the red <i>conjunctiva</i>, +the suppurating eyeball, and the beggar who pursues and beseeches the +passing foreigner for eye wash. Behind the town the country is +diversified; here open, sandy, uneven, and dotted with dwarfish palms; +here cut up with taro trenches, deep and shallow, and, according to +the growth of the plants, presenting now the appearance of a sandy tannery, +now of an alleyed and green garden. A path leads towards the sea, +mounting abruptly to the main level of the island - twenty or even thirty +feet, although Findlay gives five; and just hard by the top of the rise, +where the coco-palms begin to be well grown, we found a grove of pandanus, +and a piece of soil pleasantly covered with green underbush. A +well was not far off under a rustic well-house; nearer still, in a sandy +cup of the land, a pond where we might wash our clothes. The place +was out of the wind, out of the sun, and out of sight of the village. +It was shown to the king, and the town promised for the morrow.<br> +<br> +The morrow came, Mr. Osbourne landed, found nothing done, and carried +his complaint to Tembinok’. He heard it, rose, called for +a Winchester, stepped without the royal palisade, and fired two shots +in the air. A shot in the air is the first Apemama warning; it +has the force of a proclamation in more loquacious countries; and his +majesty remarked agreeably that it would make his labourers ‘mo’ +bright.’ In less than thirty minutes, accordingly, the men +had mustered, the work was begun, and we were told that we might bring +our baggage when we pleased.<br> +<br> +It was two in the afternoon ere the first boat was beached, and the +long procession of chests and crates and sacks began to straggle through +the sandy desert towards Equator Town. The grove of pandanus was +practically a thing of the past. Fire surrounded and smoke rose +in the green underbush. In a wide circuit the axes were still +crashing. Those very advantages for which the place was chosen, +it had been the king’s first idea to abolish; and in the midst +of this devastation there stood already a good-sized maniap’ and +a small closed house. A mat was spread near by for Tembinok’; +here he sat superintending, in cardinal red, a pith helmet on his head, +a meerschaum pipe in his mouth, a wife stretched at his back with custody +of the matches and tobacco. Twenty or thirty feet in front of +him the bulk of the workers squatted on the ground; some of the bush +here survived and in this the commons sat nearly to their shoulders, +and presented only an arc of brown faces, black heads, and attentive +eyes fixed on his majesty. Long pauses reigned, during which the +subjects stared and the king smoked. Then Tembinok’ would +raise his voice and speak shrilly and briefly. There was never +a response in words; but if the speech were jesting, there came by way +of answer discreet, obsequious laughter - such laughter as we hear in +schoolrooms; and if it were practical, the sudden uprising and departure +of the squad. Twice they so disappeared, and returned with further +elements of the city: a second house and a second maniap’. +It was singular to spy, far off through the coco stems, the silent oncoming +of the maniap’, at first (it seemed) swimming spontaneously in +the air - but on a nearer view betraying under the eaves many score +of moving naked legs. In all the affair servile obedience was +no less remarkable than servile deliberation. The gang had here +mustered by the note of a deadly weapon; the man who looked on was the +unquestioned master of their lives; and except for civility, they bestirred +themselves like so many American hotel clerks. The spectator was +aware of an unobtrusive yet invincible inertia, at which the skipper +of a trading dandy might have torn his hair.<br> +<br> +Yet the work was accomplished. By dusk, when his majesty withdrew, +the town was founded and complete, a new and ruder Amphion having called +it from nothing with three cracks of a rifle. And the next morning +the same conjurer obliged us with a further miracle: a mystic rampart +fencing us, so that the path which ran by our doors became suddenly +impassable, the inhabitants who had business across the isle must fetch +a wide circuit, and we sat in the midst in a transparent privacy, seeing, +seen, but unapproachable, like bees in a glass hive. The outward +and visible sign of this glamour was no more than a few ragged coco-leaf +garlands round the stems of the outlying palms; but its significance +reposed on the tremendous sanction of the tapu and the guns of Tembinok’.<br> +<br> +We made our first meal that night in the improvised city, where we were +to stay two months, and which - so soon as we had done with it - was +to vanish in a day as it appeared, its elements returning whence they +came, the tapu raised, the traffic on the path resumed, the sun and +the moon peering in vain between the palm-trees for the bygone work, +the wind blowing over an empty site. Yet the place, which is now +only an episode in some memories, seemed to have been built, and to +be destined to endure, for years. It was a busy hamlet. +One of the maniap’s we made our dining-room, one the kitchen. +The houses we reserved for sleeping. They were on the admirable +Apemama plan: out and away the best house in the South Seas; standing +some three feet above the ground on posts; the sides of woven flaps, +which can be raised to admit light and air, or lowered to shut out the +wind and the rain: airy, healthy, clean, and watertight. We had +a hen of a remarkable kind: almost unique in my experience, being a +hen that occasionally laid eggs. Not far off, Mrs. Stevenson tended +a garden of salad and shalots. The salad was devoured by the hen +- which was her bane. The shalots were served out a leaf at a +time, and welcomed and relished like peaches. Toddy and green +cocoa-nuts were brought us daily. We once had a present of fish +from the king, and once of a turtle. Sometimes we shot so-called +plover along on the shore, sometimes wild chicken in the bush. +The rest of our diet was from tins.<br> +<br> +Our occupations were very various. While some of the party would +be away sketching, Mr. Osbourne and I hammered away at a novel. +We read Gibbon and Carlyle aloud; we blew on flageolets, we strummed +on guitars; we took photographs by the light of the sun, the moon, and +flash-powder; sometimes we played cards. Pot-hunting engaged a +part of our leisure. I have myself passed afternoons in the exciting +but innocuous pursuit of winged animals with a revolver; and it was +fortunate there were better shots of the party, and fortunate the king +could lend us a more suitable weapon, in the form of an excellent fowling-piece, +or our spare diet had been sparer still.<br> +<br> +Night was the time to see our city, after the moon was up, after the +lamps were lighted, and so long as the fire sparkled in the cook-house. +We suffered from a plague of flies and mosquitoes, comparable to that +of Egypt; our dinner-table (lent, like all our furniture, by the king) +must be enclosed in a tent of netting, our citadel and refuge; and this +became all luminous, and bulged and beaconed under the eaves, like the +globe of some monstrous lamp under the margin of its shade. Our +cabins, the sides being propped at a variety of inclinations, spelled +out strange, angular patterns of brightness. In his roofed and +open kitchen, Ah Fu was to be seen by lamp and firelight, dabbling among +pots. Over all, there fell in the season an extraordinary splendour +of mellow moonshine. The sand sparkled as with the dust of diamonds; +the stars had vanished. At intervals, a dusky night-bird, slow +and low flying, passed in the colonnade of the tree stems and uttered +a hoarse croaking cry.<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +CHAPTER III - THE KING OF APEMAMA: THE PALACE OF MANY WOMEN<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +The palace, or rather the ground which it includes, is several acres +in extent. A terrace encloses it toward the lagoon; on the side +of the land, a palisade with several gates. These are scarce intended +for defence; a man, if he were strong, might easily pluck down the palisade; +he need not be specially active to leap from the beach upon the terrace. +There is no parade of guards, soldiers, or weapons; the armoury is under +lock and key; and the only sentinels are certain inconspicuous old women +lurking day and night before the gates. By day, these crones were +often engaged in boiling syrup or the like household occupation; by +night, they lay ambushed in the shadow or crouched along the palisade, +filling the office of eunuchs to this harem, sole guards upon a tyrant +life.<br> +<br> +Female wardens made a fit outpost for this palace of many women. +Of the number of the king’s wives I have no guess; and but a loose +idea of their function. He himself displayed embarrassment when +they were referred to as his wives, called them himself ‘my pamily,’ +and explained they were his ‘cutcheons’ - cousins. +We distinguished four of the crowd: the king’s mother; his sister, +a grave, trenchant woman, with much of her brother’s intelligence; +the queen proper, to whom (and to whom alone) my wife was formally presented; +and the favourite of the hour, a pretty, graceful girl, who sat with +the king daily, and once (when he shed tears) consoled him with caresses. +I am assured that even with her his relations are platonic. In +the background figured a multitude of ladies, the lean, the plump, and +the elephantine, some in sacque frocks, some in the hairbreadth <i>ridi</i>; +high-born and low, slave and mistress; from the queen to the scullion, +from the favourite to the scraggy sentries at the palisade. Not +all of these of course are of ‘my pamily,’ - many are mere +attendants; yet a surprising number shared the responsibility of the +king’s trust. These were key-bearers, treasurers, wardens +of the armoury, the napery, and the stores. Each knew and did +her part to admiration. Should anything be required - a particular +gun, perhaps, or a particular bolt of stuff, - the right queen was summoned; +she came bringing the right chest, opened it in the king’s presence, +and displayed her charge in perfect preservation - the gun cleaned and +oiled, the goods duly folded. Without delay or haste, and with +the minimum of speech, the whole great establishment turned on wheels +like a machine. Nowhere have I seen order more complete and pervasive. +And yet I was always reminded of Norse tales of trolls and ogres who +kept their hearts buried in the ground for the mere safety, and must +confide the secret to their wives. For these weapons are the life +of Tembinok’. He does not aim at popularity; but drives +and braves his subjects, with a simplicity of domination which it is +impossible not to admire, hard not to sympathise with. Should +one out of so many prove faithless, should the armoury be secretly unlocked, +should the crones have dozed by the palisade and the weapons find their +way unseen into the village, revolution would be nearly certain, death +the most probable result, and the spirit of the tyrant of Apemama flit +to rejoin his predecessors of Mariki and Tapituea. Yet those whom +he so trusts are all women, and all rivals.<br> +<br> +There is indeed a ministry and staff of males: cook, steward, carpenter, +and supercargoes: the hierarchy of a schooner. The spies, ‘his +majesty’s daily papers,’ as we called them, come every morning +to report, and go again. The cook and steward are concerned with +the table only. The supercargoes, whose business it is to keep +tally of the copra at three pounds a month and a percentage, are rarely +in the palace; and two at least are in the other islands. The +carpenter, indeed, shrewd and jolly old Rubam - query, Reuben? - promoted +on my last visit to the greater dignity of governor, is daily present, +altering, extending, embellishing, pursuing the endless series of the +king’s inventions; and his majesty will sometimes pass an afternoon +watching and talking with Rubam at his work. But the males are +still outsiders; none seems to be armed, none is entrusted with a key; +by dusk they are all usually departed from the palace; and the weight +of the monarchy and of the monarch’s life reposes unshared on +the women.<br> +<br> +Here is a household unlike, indeed, to one of ours; more unlike still +to the Oriental harem: that of an elderly childless man, his days menaced, +dwelling alone amid a bevy of women of all ages, ranks, and relationships, +- the mother, the sister, the cousin, the legitimate wife, the concubine, +the favourite, the eldest born, and she of yesterday; he, in their midst, +the only master, the only male, the sole dispenser of honours, clothes, +and luxuries, the sole mark of multitudinous ambitions and desires. +I doubt if you could find a man in Europe so bold as to attempt this +piece of tact and government. And seemingly Tembinok’ himself +had trouble in the beginning. I hear of him shooting at a wife +for some levity on board a schooner. Another, on some more serious +offence, he slew outright; he exposed her body in an open box, and (to +make the warning more memorable) suffered it to putrefy before the palace +gate. Doubtless his growing years have come to his assistance; +for upon so large a scale it is more easy to play the father than the +husband. And to-day, at least to the eye of a stranger, all seems +to go smoothly, and the wives to be proud of their trust, proud of their +rank, and proud of their cunning lord.<br> +<br> +I conceived they made rather a hero of the man. A popular master +in a girls’ school might, perhaps, offer a figure of his preponderating +station. But then the master does not eat, sleep, live, and wash +his dirty linen in the midst of his admirers; he escapes, he has a room +of his own, he leads a private life; if he had nothing else, he has +the holidays, and the more unhappy Tembinok’ is always on the +stage and on the stretch.<br> +<br> +In all my coming and going, I never heard him speak harshly or express +the least displeasure. An extreme, rather heavy, benignity - the +benignity of one sure to be obeyed - marked his demeanour; so that I +was at times reminded of Samual Richardson in his circle of admiring +women. The wives spoke up and seemed to volunteer opinions, like +our wives at home - or, say, like doting but respectable aunts. +Altogether, I conclude that he rules his seraglio much more by art than +terror; and those who give a different account (and who have none of +them enjoyed my opportunities of observation) perhaps failed to distinguish +between degrees of rank, between ‘my pamily’ and the hangers-on, +laundresses, and prostitutes.<br> +<br> +A notable feature is the evening game of cards when lamps are set forth +upon the terrace, and ‘I and my pamily’ play for tobacco +by the hour. It is highly characteristic of Tembinok’ that +he must invent a game for himself; highly characteristic of his worshipping +household that they should swear by the absurd invention. It is +founded on poker, played with the honours out of many packs, and inconceivably +dreary. But I have a passion for all games, studied it, and am +supposed to be the only white who ever fairly grasped its principle: +a fact for which the wives (with whom I was not otherwise popular) admired +me with acclamation. It was impossible to be deceived; this was +a genuine feeling: they were proud of their private game, had been cut +to the quick by the want of interest shown in it by others, and expanded +under the flattery of my attention. Tembinok’ puts up a +double stake, and receives in return two hands to choose from: a shallow +artifice which the wives (in all these years) have not yet fathomed. +He himself, when talking with me privately, made not the least secret +that he was secure of winning; and it was thus he explained his recent +liberality on board the <i>Equator</i>. He let the wives buy their +own tobacco, which pleased them at the moment. He won it back +at cards, which made him once more, and without fresh expense, that +which he ought to be, - the sole fount of all indulgences. And +he summed the matter up in that phrase with which he almost always concludes +any account of his policy: ‘Mo’ betta.’<br> +<br> +The palace compound is laid with broken coral, excruciating to the eyes +and the bare feet, but exquisitely raked and weeded. A score or +more of buildings lie in a sort of street along the palisade and scattered +on the margin of the terrace; dwelling-houses for the wives and the +attendants, storehouses for the king’s curios and treasures, spacious +maniap’s for feast or council, some on pillars of wood, some on +piers of masonry. One was still in hand, a new invention, the +king’s latest born: a European frame-house built for coolness +inside a lofty maniap’: its roof planked like a ship’s deck +to be a raised, shady, and yet private promenade. It was here +the king spent hours with Rubam; here I would sometimes join them; the +place had a most singular appearance; and I must say I was greatly taken +with the fancy, and joined with relish in the counsels of the architects.<br> +<br> +Suppose we had business with his majesty by day: we strolled over the +sand and by the dwarfish palms, exchanged a ‘<i>Kõnamaori</i>’ +with the crone on duty, and entered the compound. The wide sheet +of coral glared before us deserted; all having stowed themselves in +dark canvas from the excess of room. I have gone to and fro in +that labyrinth of a place, seeking the king; and the only breathing +creature I could find was when I peered under the eaves of a maniap’, +and saw the brawny body of one of the wives stretched on the floor, +a naked Amazon plunged in noiseless slumber. If it were still +the hour of the ‘morning papers’ the quest would be more +easy, the half-dozen obsequious, sly dogs squatting on the ground outside +a house, crammed as far as possible in its narrow shadow, and turning +to the king a row of leering faces. Tembinok’ would be within, +the flaps of the cabin raised, the trade blowing through, hearing their +report. Like journalists nearer home, when the day’s news +were scanty, these would make the more of it in words; and I have known +one to fill up a barren morning with an imaginary conversation of two +dogs. Sometimes the king deigns to laugh, sometimes to question +or jest with them, his voice sounding shrilly from the cabin. +By his side he may have the heir-apparent, Paul, his nephew and adopted +son, six years old, stark naked, and a model of young human beauty. +And there will always be the favourite and perhaps two other wives awake; +four more lying supine under mats and whelmed in slumber. Or perhaps +we came later, fell on a more private hour, and found Tembinok’ +retired in the house with the favourite, an earthenware spittoon, a +leaden inkpot, and a commercial ledger. In the last, lying on +his belly, he writes from day to day the uneventful history of his reign; +and when thus employed he betrayed a touch of fretfulness on interruption +with which I was well able to sympathise. The royal annalist once +read me a page or so, translating as he went; but the passage being +genealogical, and the author boggling extremely in his version, I own +I have been sometimes better entertained. Nor does he confine +himself to prose, but touches the lyre, too, in his leisure moments, +and passes for the chief bard of his kingdom, as he is its sole public +character, leading architect, and only merchant.<br> +<br> +His competence, however, does not reach to music; and his verses, when +they are ready, are taught to a professional musician, who sets them +and instructs the chorus. Asked what his songs were about, Tembinok’ +replied, ‘Sweethearts and trees and the sea. Not all the +same true, all the same lie.’ For a condensed view of lyrical +poetry (except that he seems to have forgot the stars and flowers) this +would be hard to mend. These multifarious occupations bespeak +(in a native and an absolute prince) unusual activity of mind.<br> +<br> +The palace court at noon is a spot to be remembered with awe, the visitor +scrambling there, on the loose stones, through a splendid nightmare +of light and heat; but the sweep of the wind delivers it from flies +and mosquitoes; and with the set of sun it became heavenly. I +remember it best on moonless nights. The air was like a bath of +milk. Countless shining stars were overhead, the lagoon paved +with them. Herds of wives squatted by companies on the gravel, +softly chatting. Tembinok’ would doff his jacket, and sit +bare and silent, perhaps meditating songs; the favourite usually by +him, silent also. Meanwhile in the midst of the court, the palace +lanterns were being lit and marshalled in rank upon the ground - six +or eight square yards of them; a sight that gave one strange ideas of +the number of ‘my pamily’: such a sight as may be seen about +dusk in a corner of some great terminus at home. Presently these +fared off into all corners of the precinct, lighting the last labours +of the day, lighting one after another to their rest that prodigious +company of women. A few lingered in the middle of the court for +the card-party, and saw the honours shuffled and dealt, and Tembinok’ +deliberating between his two; hands, and the queens losing their tobacco. +Then these also were scattered and extinguished; and their place was +taken by a great bonfire, the night-light of the palace. When +this was no more, smaller fires burned likewise at the gates. +These were tended by the crones, unseen, unsleeping - not always unheard. +Should any approach in the dark hours, a guarded alert made the circuit +of the palisade; each sentry signalled her neighbour with a stone; the +rattle of falling pebbles passed and died away; and the wardens of Tembinok’ +crouched in their places silent as before.<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +CHAPTER IV - THE KING OF APEMAMA: EQUATOR TOWN AND THE PALACE<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +Five persons were detailed to wait upon us. Uncle Parker, who +brought us toddy and green nuts, was an elderly, almost an old man, +with the spirits, the industry, and the morals of a boy of ten. +His face was ancient, droll, and diabolical, the skin stretched over +taut sinews, like a sail on the guide-rope; and he smiled with every +muscle of his head. His nuts must be counted every day, or he +would deceive us in the tale; they must be daily examined, or some would +prove to be unhusked; nothing but the king’s name, and scarcely +that, would hold him to his duty. After his toils were over he +was given a pipe, matches, and tobacco, and sat on the floor in the +maniap’ to smoke. He would not seem to move from his position, +and yet every day, when the things fell to be returned the plug had +disappeared; he had found the means to conceal it in the roof, whence +he could radiantly produce it on the morrow. Although this piece +of legerdemain was performed regularly before three or four pairs of +eyes, we could never catch him in the fact; although we searched after +he was gone, we could never find the tobacco. Such were the diversions +of Uncle Parker, a man nearing sixty. But he was punished according +unto his deeds: Mrs. Stevenson took a fancy to paint him, and the sufferings +of the sitter were beyond description.<br> +<br> +Three lasses came from the palace to do our washing and racket with +Ah Fu. They were of the lowest class, hangers-on kept for the +convenience of merchant skippers, probably low-born, perhaps out-islanders, +with little refinement whether of manner or appearance, but likely and +jolly enough wenches in their way. We called one <i>Guttersnipe</i>, +for you may find her image in the slums of any city; the same lean, +dark-eyed, eager, vulgar face, the same sudden, hoarse guffaws, the +same forward and yet anxious manner, as with a tail of an eye on the +policeman: only the policeman here was a live king, and his truncheon +a rifle. I doubt if you could find anywhere out of the islands, +or often there, the parallel of <i>Fatty</i>, a mountain of a girl, +who must have weighed near as many stones as she counted summers, could +have given a good account of a life-guardsman, had the face of a baby, +and applied her vast mechanical forces almost exclusively to play. +But they were all three of the same merry spirit. Our washing +was conducted in a game of romps; and they fled and pursued, and splashed, +and pelted, and rolled each other in the sand, and kept up a continuous +noise of cries and laughter like holiday children. Indeed, and +however strange their own function in that austere establishment, were +they not escaped for the day from the largest and strictest Ladies’ +School in the South Seas?<br> +<br> +Our fifth attendant was no less a person than the royal cook. +He was strikingly handsome both in face and body, lazy as a slave, and +insolent as a butcher’s boy. He slept and smoked on our +premises in various graceful attitudes; but so far from helping Ah Fu, +he was not at the pains to watch him. It may be said of him that +he came to learn, and remained to teach; and his lessons were at times +difficult to stomach. For example, he was sent to fill a bucket +from the well. About half-way he found my wife watering her onions, +changed buckets with her, and leaving her the empty, returned to the +kitchen with the full. On another occasion he was given a dish +of dumplings for the king, was told they must be eaten hot, and that +he should carry them as fast as possible. The wretch set off at +the rate of about a mile in the hour, head in air, toes turned out. +My patience, after a month of trial, failed me at the sight. I +pursued, caught him by his two big shoulders, and thrusting him before +me, ran with him down the hill, over the sands, and through the applauding +village, to the Speak House, where the king was then holding a pow-wow. +He had the impudence to pretend he was internally injured by my violence, +and to profess serious apprehensions for his life.<br> +<br> +All this we endured; for the ways of Tembinok’ are summary, and +I was not yet ripe to take a hand in the man’s death. But +in the meanwhile, here was my unfortunate China boy slaving for the +pair, and presently he fell sick. I was now in the position of +Cimondain Lantenac, and indeed all the characters in <i>Quatre-Vingt-Treize</i>: +to continue to spare the guilty, I must sacrifice the innocent. +I took the usual course and tried to save both, with the usual consequence +of failure. Well rehearsed, I went down to the palace, found the +king alone, and obliged him with a vast amount of rigmarole. The +cook was too old to learn: I feared he was not making progress; how +if we had a boy instead? - boys were more teachable. It was all +in vain; the king pierced through my disguises to the root of the fact; +saw that the cook had desperately misbehaved; and sat a while glooming. +‘I think he tavvy too much,’ he said at last, with grim +concision; and immediately turned the talk to other subjects. +The same day another high officer, the steward, appeared in the cook’s +place, and, I am bound to say, proved civil and industrious.<br> +<br> +As soon as I left, it seems the king called for a Winchester and strolled +outside the palisade, awaiting the defaulter. That day Tembinok’ +wore the woman’s frock; as like as not, his make-up was completed +by a pith helmet and blue spectacles. Conceive the glaring stretch +of sandhills, the dwarf palms with their noon-day shadows, the line +of the palisade, the crone sentries (each by a small clear fire) cooking +syrup on their posts - and this chimaera waiting with his deadly engine. +To him, enter at last the cook, strolling down the sandhill from Equator +Town, listless, vain and graceful; with no thought of alarm. As +soon as he was well within range, the travestied monarch fired the six +shots over his head, at his feet, and on either hand of him: the second +Apemama warning, startling in itself, fatal in significance, for the +next time his majesty will aim to hit. I am told the king is a +crack shot; that when he aims to kill, the grave may be got ready; and +when he aims to miss, misses by so near a margin that the culprit tastes +six times the bitterness of death. The effect upon the cook I +had an opportunity of seeing for myself. My wife and I were returning +from the sea-side of the island, when we spied one coming to meet us +at a very quick, disordered pace, between a walk and a run. As +we drew nearer we saw it was the cook, beside himself with some emotion, +his usual warm, mulatto colour declined into a bluish pallor. +He passed us without word or gesture, staring on us with the face of +a Satan, and plunged on across the wood for the unpeopled quarter of +the island and the long, desert beach, where he might rage to and fro +unseen, and froth out the vials of his wrath, fear, and humiliation. +Doubtless in the curses that he there uttered to the bursting surf and +the tropic birds, the name of the Kaupoi - the rich man - was frequently +repeated. I had made him the laughing-stock of the village in +the affair of the king’s dumplings; I had brought him by my machinations +into disgrace and the immediate jeopardy of his days; last, and perhaps +bitterest, he had found me there by the way to spy upon him in the hour +of his disorder.<br> +<br> +Time passed, and we saw no more of him. The season of the full +moon came round, when a man thinks shame to lie sleeping; and I continued +until late - perhaps till twelve or one in the morning - to walk on +the bright sand and in the tossing shadow of the palms. I played, +as I wandered, on a flageolet, which occupied much of my attention; +the fans overhead rattled in the wind with a metallic chatter; and a +bare foot falls at any rate almost noiseless on that shifting soil. +Yet when I got back to Equator Town, where all the lights were out, +and my wife (who was still awake, and had been looking forth) asked +me who it was that followed me, I thought she spoke in jest. ‘Not +at all,’ she said. ‘I saw him twice as you passed, +walking close at your heels. He only left you at the corner of +the maniap’; he must be still behind the cook-house.’ +Thither I ran - like a fool, without any weapon - and came face to face +with the cook. He was within my tapu-line, which was death in +itself; he could have no business there at such an hour but either to +steal or to kill; guilt made him timorous; and he turned and fled before +me in the night in silence. As he went I kicked him in that place +where honour lies, and he gave tongue faintly like an injured mouse. +At the moment I daresay he supposed it was a deadly instrument that +touched him.<br> +<br> +What had the man been after? I have found my music better qualified +to scatter than to collect an audience. Amateur as I was, I could +not suppose him interested in my reading of the <i>Carnival of Venice</i>, +or that he would deny himself his natural rest to follow my variations +on <i>The Ploughboy</i>. And whatever his design, it was impossible +I should suffer him to prowl by night among the houses. A word +to the king, and the man were not, his case being far beyond pardon. +But it is one thing to kill a man yourself; quite another to bear tales +behind his back and have him shot by a third party; and I determined +to deal with the fellow in some method of my own. I told Ah Fu +the story, and bade him fetch me the cook whenever he should find him. +I had supposed this would be a matter of difficulty; and far from that, +he came of his own accord: an act really of desperation, since his life +hung by my silence, and the best he could hope was to be forgotten. +Yet he came with an assured countenance, volunteered no apology or explanation, +complained of injuries received, and pretended he was unable to sit +down. I suppose I am the weakest man God made; I had kicked him +in the least vulnerable part of his big carcase; my foot was bare, and +I had not even hurt my foot. Ah Fu could not control his merriment. +On my side, knowing what must be the nature of his apprehensions, I +found in so much impudence a kind of gallantry, and secretly admired +the man. I told him I should say nothing of his night’s +adventure to the king; that I should still allow him, when he had an +errand, to come within my tapu-line by day; but if ever I found him +there after the set of the sun I would shoot him on the spot; and to +the proof showed him a revolver. He must have been incredibly +relieved; but he showed no sign of it, took himself off with his usual +dandy nonchalance, and was scarce seen by us again.<br> +<br> +These five, then, with the substitution of the steward for the cook, +came and went, and were our only visitors. The circle of the tapu +held at arm’s-length the inhabitants of the village. As +for ‘my pamily,’ they dwelt like nuns in their enclosure; +only once have I met one of them abroad, and she was the king’s +sister, and the place in which I found her (the island infirmary) was +very likely privileged. There remains only the king to be accounted +for. He would come strolling over, always alone, a little before +a meal-time, take a chair, and talk and eat with us like an old family +friend. Gilbertine etiquette appears defective on the point of +leave-taking. It may be remembered we had trouble in the matter +with Karaiti; and there was something childish and disconcerting in +Tembinok’s abrupt ‘I want go home now,’ accompanied +by a kind of ducking rise, and followed by an unadorned retreat. +It was the only blot upon his manners, which were otherwise plain, decent, +sensible, and dignified. He never stayed long nor drank much, +and copied our behaviour where he perceived it to differ from his own. +Very early in the day, for instance, he ceased eating with his knife. +It was plain he was determined in all things to wring profit from our +visit, and chiefly upon etiquette. The quality of his white visitors +puzzled and concerned him; he would bring up name after name, and ask +if its bearer were a ‘big chiep,’ or even a ‘chiep’ +at all - which, as some were my excellent good friends, and none were +actually born in the purple, became at times embarrassing. He +was struck to learn that our classes were distinguishable by their speech, +and that certain words (for instance) were tapu on the quarter-deck +of a man-of-war; and he begged in consequence that we should watch and +correct him on the point. We were able to assure him that he was +beyond correction. His vocabulary is apt and ample to an extraordinary +degree. God knows where he collected it, but by some instinct +or some accident he has avoided all profane or gross expressions. +‘Obliged,’ ‘stabbed,’ ‘gnaw,’ ‘lodge,’ +‘power,’ ‘company,’ ‘slender,’ ‘smooth,’ +and ‘wonderful,’ are a few of the unexpected words that +enrich his dialect. Perhaps what pleased him most was to hear +about saluting the quarter-deck of a man-of-war. In his gratitude +for this hint he became fulsome. ‘Schooner cap’n no +tell me,’ he cried; ‘I think no tavvy! You tavvy too +much; tavvy ‘teama’, tavvy man-a-wa’. I think +you tavvy everything.’ Yet he gravelled me often enough with his +perpetual questions; and the false Mr. Barlow stood frequently exposed +before the royal Sandford. I remember once in particular. +We were showing the magic-lantern; a slide of Windsor Castle was put +in, and I told him there was the ‘outch’ of Victoreea. +‘How many pathom he high?’ he asked, and I was dumb before +him. It was the builder, the indefatigable architect of palaces, +that spoke; collector though he was, he did not collect useless information; +and all his questions had a purpose. After etiquette, government, +law, the police, money, and medicine were his chief interests - things +vitally important to himself as a king and the father of his people. +It was my part not only to supply new information, but to correct the +old. ‘My patha he tell me,’ or ‘White man he +tell me,’ would be his constant beginning; ‘You think he +lie?’ Sometimes I thought he did. Tembinok’ +once brought me a difficulty of this kind, which I was long of comprehending. +A schooner captain had told him of Captain Cook; the king was much interested +in the story; and turned for more information - not to Mr. Stephen’s +Dictionary, not to the <i>Britannica</i>, but to the Bible in the Gilbert +Island version (which consists chiefly of the New Testament and the +Psalms). Here he sought long and earnestly; Paul he found, and +Festus and Alexander the coppersmith: no word of Cook. The inference +was obvious: the explorer was a myth. So hard it is, even for +a man of great natural parts like Tembinok’, to grasp the ideas +of a new society and culture.<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +CHAPTER V - KING AND COMMONS<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +We saw but little of the commons of the isle. At first we met +them at the well, where they washed their linen and we drew water for +the table. The combination was distasteful; and, having a tyrant +at command, we applied to the king and had the place enclosed in our +tapu. It was one of the few favours which Tembinok’ visibly +boggled about granting, and it may be conceived how little popular it +made the strangers. Many villagers passed us daily going afield; +but they fetched a wide circuit round our tapu, and seemed to avert +their looks. At times we went ourselves into the village - a strange +place. Dutch by its canals, Oriental by the height and steepness +of the roofs, which looked at dusk like temples; but we were rarely +called into a house: no welcome, no friendship, was offered us; and +of home life we had but the one view: the waking of a corpse, a frigid, +painful scene: the widow holding on her lap the cold, bluish body of +her husband, and now partaking of the refreshments which made the round +of the company, now weeping and kissing the pale mouth. (‘I +fear you feel this affliction deeply,’ said the Scottish minister. +‘Eh, sir, and that I do!’ replied the widow. ‘I’ve +been greetin’ a’ nicht; an’ noo I’m just gaun +to sup this bit parritch, and then I’ll begin an’ greet +again.’) In our walks abroad I have always supposed the +islanders avoided us, perhaps from distaste, perhaps by order; and those +whom we met we took generally by surprise. The surface of the +isle is diversified with palm groves, thickets, and romantic dingles +four feet deep, relics of old taro plantation; and it is thus possible +to stumble unawares on folk resting or hiding from their work. +About pistol-shot from our township there lay a pond in the bottom of +a jungle; here the maids of the isle came to bathe, and were several +times alarmed by our intrusion. Not for them are the bright cold +rivers of Tahiti or Upolu, not for them to splash and laugh in the hour +of the dusk with a villageful of gay companions; but to steal here solitary, +to crouch in a place like a cow-wallow, and wash (if that can be called +washing) in lukewarm mud, brown as their own skins. Other, but +still rare, encounters occur to my memory. I was several times +arrested by a tender sound in the bush of voices talking, soft as flutes +and with quiet intonations. Hope told a flattering tale; I put +aside the leaves; and behold! in place of the expected dryads, a pair +of all too solid ladies squatting over a clay pipe in the ungraceful +<i>ridi</i>. The beauty of the voice and the eye was all that +remained to those vast dames; but that of the voice was indeed exquisite. +It is strange I should have never heard a more winning sound of speech, +yet the dialect should be one remarkable for violent, ugly, and outlandish +vocables; so that Tembinok’ himself declared it made him weary, +and professed to find repose in talking English.<br> +<br> +The state of this folk, of whom I saw so little, I can merely guess +at. The king himself explains the situation with some art. +‘No; I no pay them,’ he once said. ‘I give them +tobacco. They work for me <i>all the same brothers</i>.’ +It is true there was a brother once in Arden! But we prefer the +shorter word. They bear every servile mark, - levity like a child’s, +incurable idleness, incurious content. The insolence of the cook +was a trait of his own; not so his levity, which he shared with the +innocent Uncle Parker. With equal unconcern both gambolled under +the shadow of the gallows, and took liberties with death that might +have surprised a careless student of man’s nature. I wrote +of Parker that he behaved like a boy of ten: what was he else, being +a slave of sixty? He had passed all his years in school, fed, +clad, thought for, commanded; and had grown familiar and coquetted with +the fear of punishment. By terror you may drive men long, but +not far. Here, in Apemama, they work at the constant and the instant +peril of their lives; and are plunged in a kind of lethargy of laziness. +It is common to see one go afield in his stiff mat ungirt, so that he +walks elbows-in like a trussed fowl; and whatsoever his right hand findeth +to do, the other must be off duty holding on his clothes. It is +common to see two men carrying between them on a pole a single bucket +of water. To make two bites of a cherry is good enough: to make +two burthens of a soldier’s kit, for a distance of perhaps half +a furlong, passes measure. Woman, being the less childish animal, +is less relaxed by servile conditions. Even in the king’s +absence, even when they were alone, I have seen Apemama women work with +constancy. But the outside to be hoped for in a man is that he +may attack his task in little languid fits, and lounge between-whiles. +So I have seen a painter, with his pipe going, and a friend by the studio +fireside. You might suppose the race to lack civility, even vitality, +until you saw them in the dance. Night after night, and sometimes +day after day, they rolled out their choruses in the great Speak House +- solemn andantes and adagios, led by the clapped hand, and delivered +with an energy that shook the roof. The time was not so slow, +though it was slow for the islands; but I have chosen rather to indicate +the effect upon the hearer. Their music had a church-like character +from near at hand, and seemed to European ears more regular than the +run of island music. Twice I have heard a discord regularly solved. +From farther off, heard at Equator Town for instance, the measures rose +and fell and crepitated like the barking of hounds in a distant kennel.<br> +<br> +The slaves are certainly not overworked - children of ten do more without +fatigue - and the Apemama labourers have holidays, when the singing +begins early in the afternoon. The diet is hard; copra and a sweetmeat +of pounded pandanus are the only dishes I observed outside the palace; +but there seems no defect in quantity, and the king shares with them +his turtles. Three came in a boat from Kuria during our stay; +one was kept for the palace, one sent to us, one presented to the village. +It is the habit of the islanders to cook the turtle in its carapace; +we had been promised the shells, and we asked a tapu on this foolish +practice. The face of Tembinok’ darkened and he answered +nothing. Hesitation in the question of the well I could understand, +for water is scarce on a low island; that he should refuse to interfere +upon a point of cookery was more than I had dreamed of; and I gathered +(rightly or wrongly) that he was scrupulous of touching in the least +degree the private life and habits of his slaves. So that even +here, in full despotism, public opinion has weight; even here, in the +midst of slavery, freedom has a corner.<br> +<br> +Orderly, sober, and innocent, life flows in the isle from day to day +as in a model plantation under a model planter. It is impossible +to doubt the beneficence of that stern rule. A curious politeness, +a soft and gracious manner, something effeminate and courtly, distinguishes +the islanders of Apemama; it is talked of by all the traders, it was +felt even by residents so little beloved as ourselves, and noticeable +even in the cook, and even in that scoundrel’s hours of insolence. +The king, with his manly and plain bearing, stood out alone; you might +say he was the only Gilbert Islander in Apemama. Violence, so +common in Butaritari, seems unknown. So are theft and drunkenness. +I am assured the experiment has been made of leaving sovereigns on the +beach before the village; they lay there untouched. In all our +time on the island I was but once asked for drink. This was by +a mighty plausible fellow, wearing European clothes and speaking excellent +English - Tamaiti his name, or, as the whites have now corrupted it, +‘Tom White’: one of the king’s supercargoes at three +pounds a month and a percentage, a medical man besides, and in his private +hours a wizard. He found me one day in the outskirts of the village, +in a secluded place, hot and private, where the taro-pits are deep and +the plants high. Here he buttonholed me, and, looking about him +like a conspirator, inquired if I had gin.<br> +<br> +I told him I had. He remarked that gin was forbidden, lauded the +prohibition a while, and then went on to explain that he was a doctor, +or ‘dogstar’ as he pronounced the word, that gin was necessary +to him for his medical infusions, that he was quite out of it, and that +he would be obliged to me for some in a bottle. I told him I had +passed the king my word on landing; but since his case was so exceptional, +I would go down to the palace at once, and had no doubt that Tembinok’ +would set me free. Tom White was immediately overwhelmed with +embarrassment and terror, besought me in the most moving terms not to +betray him, and fled my neighbourhood. He had none of the cook’s +valour; it was weeks before he dared to meet my eye; and then only by +the order of the king and on particular business.<br> +<br> +The more I viewed and admired this triumph of firm rule, the more I +was haunted and troubled by a problem, the problem (perhaps) of to-morrow +for ourselves. Here was a people protected from all serious misfortune, +relieved of all serious anxieties, and deprived of what we call our +liberty. Did they like it? and what was their sentiment toward +the ruler? The first question I could not of course ask, nor perhaps +the natives answer. Even the second was delicate; yet at last, +and under charming and strange circumstances, I found my opportunity +to put it and a man to reply. It was near the full of the moon, +with a delicious breeze; the isle was bright as day - to sleep would +have been sacrilege; and I walked in the bush, playing my pipe. +It must have been the sound of what I am pleased to call my music that +attracted in my direction another wanderer of the night. This +was a young man attired in a fine mat, and with a garland on his hair, +for he was new come from dancing and singing in the public hall; and +his body, his face, and his eyes were all of an enchanting beauty. +Every here and there in the Gilberts youths are to be found of this +absurd perfection; I have seen five of us pass half an hour in admiration +of a boy at Mariki; and Te Kop (my friend in the fine mat and garland) +I had already several times remarked, and long ago set down as the loveliest +animal in Apemama. The philtre of admiration must be very strong, +or these natives specially susceptible to its effects, for I have scarce +ever admired a person in the islands but what he has sought my particular +acquaintance. So it was with Te Kop. He led me to the ocean +side; and for an hour or two we sat smoking and talking on the resplendent +sand and under the ineffable brightness of the moon. My friend +showed himself very sensible of the beauty and amenity of the hour. +‘Good night! Good wind!’ he kept exclaiming, and as he said +the words he seemed to hug myself. I had long before invented +such reiterated expressions of delight for a character (Felipe, in the +story of <i>Olalla</i>) intended to be partly bestial. But there +was nothing bestial in Te Kop; only a childish pleasure in the moment. +He was no less pleased with his companion, or was good enough to say +so; honoured me, before he left, by calling me Te Kop; apostrophised +me as ‘My name!’ with an intonation exquisitely tender, +laying his hand at the same time swiftly on my knee; and after we had +risen, and our paths began to separate in the bush, twice cried to me +with a sort of gentle ecstasy, ‘I like you too much!’ +From the beginning he had made no secret of his terror of the king; +would not sit down nor speak above a whisper till he had put the whole +breadth of the isle between himself and his monarch, then harmlessly +asleep; and even there, even within a stone-cast of the outer sea, our +talk covered by the sound of the surf and the rattle of the wind among +the palms, continued to speak guardedly, softening his silver voice +(which rang loud enough in the chorus) and looking about him like a +man in fear of spies. The strange thing is that I should have +beheld him no more. In any other island in the whole South Seas, +if I had advanced half as far with any native, he would have been at +my door next morning, bringing and expecting gifts. But Te Kop +vanished in the bush for ever. My house, of course, was unapproachable; +but he knew where to find me on the ocean beach, where I went daily. +I was the <i>Kaupoi</i>, the rich man; my tobacco and trade were known +to be endless: he was sure of a present. I am at a loss how to +explain his behaviour, unless it be supposed that he recalled with terror +and regret a passage in our interview. Here it is:<br> +<br> +‘The king, he good man?’ I asked.<br> +<br> +‘Suppose he like you, he good man,’ replied Te Kop: ‘no +like, no good.’<br> +<br> +That is one way of putting it, of course. Te Kop himself was probably +no favourite, for he scarce appealed to my judgment as a type of industry. +And there must be many others whom the king (to adhere to the formula) +does not like. Do these unfortunates like the king? Or is +not rather the repulsion mutual? and the conscientious Tembinok’, +like the conscientious Braxfield before him, and many other conscientious +rulers and judges before either, surrounded by a considerable body of +‘grumbletonians’? Take the cook, for instance, when +he passed us by, blue with rage and terror. He was very wroth +with me; I think by all the old principles of human nature he was not +very well pleased with his sovereign. It was the rich man he sought +to waylay: I think it must have been by the turn of a hair that it was +not the king he waylaid instead. And the king gives, or seems +to give, plenty of opportunities; day and night he goes abroad alone, +whether armed or not I can but guess; and the taro-patches, where his +business must so often carry him, seem designed for assassination. +The case of the cook was heavy indeed to my conscience. I did +not like to kill my enemy at second-hand; but had I a right to conceal +from the king, who had trusted me, the dangerous secret character of +his attendant? And suppose the king should fall, what would be +the fate of the king’s friends? It was our opinion at the +time that we should pay dear for the closing of the well; that our breath +was in the king’s nostrils; that if the king should by any chance +be bludgeoned in a taro-patch, the philosophical and musical inhabitants +of Equator Town might lay aside their pleasant instruments, and betake +themselves to what defence they had, with a very dim prospect of success. +These speculations were forced upon us by an incident which I am ashamed +to betray. The schooner <i>H. L. Haseltine</i> (since capsized +at sea, with the loss of eleven lives) put into Apemama in a good hour +for us, who had near exhausted our supplies. The king, after his +habit, spent day after day on board; the gin proved unhappily to his +taste; he brought a store of it ashore with him; and for some time the +sole tyrant of the isle was half-seas-over. He was not drunk - +the man is not a drunkard, he has always stores of liquor at hand, which +he uses with moderation, - but he was muzzy, dull, and confused. +He came one day to lunch with us, and while the cloth was being laid +fell asleep in his chair. His confusion, when he awoke and found +he had been detected, was equalled by our uneasiness. When he +was gone we sat and spoke of his peril, which we thought to be in some +degree our own; of how easily the man might be surprised in such a state +by <i>grumbletonians</i>; of the strange scenes that would follow - +the royal treasures and stores at the mercy of the rabble, the palace +overrun, the garrison of women turned adrift. And as we talked +we were startled by a gun-shot and a sudden, barbaric outcry. +I believe we all changed colour; but it was only the king firing at +a dog and the chorus striking up in the Speak House. A day or +two later I learned the king was very sick; went down, diagnosed the +case; and took at once the highest medical degree by the exhibition +of bicarbonate of soda. Within the hour Richard was himself again; +and I found him at the unfinished house, enjoying the double pleasure +of directing Rubam and making a dinner of cocoa-nut dumplings, and all +eagerness to have the formula of this new sort of <i>pain-killer</i> +- for <i>pain-killer</i> in the islands is the generic name of medicine. +So ended the king’s modest spree and our anxiety.<br> +<br> +On the face of things, I ought to say, loyalty appeared unshaken. +When the schooner at last returned for us, after much experience of +baffling winds, she brought a rumour that Tebureimoa had declared war +on Apemama. Tembinok’ became a new man; his face radiant; +his attitude, as I saw him preside over a council of chiefs in one of +the palace maniap’s, eager as a boy’s; his voice sounding +abroad, shrill and jubilant, over half the compound. War is what +he wants, and here was his chance. The English captain, when he +flung his arms in the lagoon, had forbidden him (except in one case) +all military adventures in the future: here was the case arrived. +All morning the council sat; men were drilled, arms were bought, the +sound of firing disturbed the afternoon; the king devised and communicated +to me his plan of campaign, which was highly elaborate and ingenious, +but perhaps a trifle fine-spun for the rough and random vicissitudes +of war. And in all this bustle the temper of the people appeared +excellent, an unwonted animation in every face, and even Uncle Parker +burning with military zeal.<br> +<br> +Of course it was a false alarm. Tebureimoa had other fish to fry. +The ambassador who accompanied us on our return to Butaritari found +him retired to a small island on the reef, in a huff with the Old Men, +a tiff with the traders, and more fear of insurrection at home than +appetite for wars abroad. The plenipotentiary had been placed +under my protection; and we solemnly saluted when we met. He proved +an excellent fisherman, and caught bonito over the ship’s side. +He pulled a good oar, and made himself useful for a whole fiery afternoon, +towing the becalmed <i>Equator</i> off Mariki. He went to his +post and did no good. He returned home again, having done no harm. +<i>O si sic omnes</i>!<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +CHAPTER VI - THE KING OF APEMAMA: DEVIL-WORK<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +The ocean beach of Apemama was our daily resort. The coast is +broken by shallow bays. The reef is detached, elevated, and includes +a lagoon about knee-deep, the unrestful spending-basin of the surf. +The beach is now of fine sand, now of broken coral. The trend +of the coast being convex, scarce a quarter of a mile of it is to be +seen at once; the land being so low, the horizon appears within a stone-cast; +and the narrow prospect enhances the sense of privacy. Man avoids +the place - even his footprints are uncommon; but a great number of +birds hover and pipe there fishing, and leave crooked tracks upon the +sand. Apart from these, the only sound (and I was going to say +the only society), is that of the breakers on the reef.<br> +<br> +On each projection of the coast, the bank of coral clinkers immediately +above the beach has been levelled, and a pillar built, perhaps breast-high. +These are not sepulchral; all the dead being buried on the inhabited +side of the island, close to men’s houses, and (what is worse) +to their wells. I was told they were to protect the isle against +inroads from the sea - divine or diabolical martellos, probably sacred +to Taburik, God of Thunder.<br> +<br> +The bay immediately opposite Equator Town, which we called Fu Bay, in +honour of our cook, was thus fortified on either horn. It was +well sheltered by the reef, the enclosed water clear and tranquil, the +enclosing beach curved like a horseshoe, and both steep and broad. +The path debouched about the midst of the re-entrant angle, the woods +stopping some distance inland. In front, between the fringe of +the wood and the crown of the beach, there had been designed a regular +figure, like the court for some new variety of tennis, with borders +of round stones imbedded, and pointed at the angles with low posts, +likewise of stone. This was the king’s Pray Place. +When he prayed, what he prayed for, and to whom he addressed his supplications +I could never learn. The ground was tapu.<br> +<br> +In the angle, by the mouth of the path, stood a deserted maniap’. +Near by there had been a house before our coming, which was now transported +and figured for the moment in Equator Town. It had been, and it +would be again when we departed, the residence of the guardian and wizard +of the spot - Tamaiti. Here, in this lone place, within sound +of the sea, he had his dwelling and uncanny duties. I cannot call +to mind another case of a man living on the ocean side of any open atoll; +and Tamaiti must have had strong nerves, the greater confidence in his +own spells, or, what I believe to be the truth, an enviable scepticism. +Whether Tamaiti had any guardianship of the Pray Place I never heard. +But his own particular chapel stood farther back in the fringe of the +wood. It was a tree of respectable growth. Around it there +was drawn a circle of stones like those that enclosed the Pray Place; +in front, facing towards the sea, a stone of a much greater size, and +somewhat hollowed, like a piscina, stood close against the trunk; in +front of that again a conical pile of gravel. In the hollow of +what I have called the piscina (though it proved to be a magic seat) +lay an offering of green cocoa-nuts; and when you looked up you found +the boughs of the tree to be laden with strange fruit: palm-branches +elaborately plaited, and beautiful models of canoes, finished and rigged +to the least detail. The whole had the appearance of a mid-summer +and sylvan Christmas-tree <i>al fresco</i>. Yet we were already +well enough acquainted in the Gilberts to recognise it, at the first +sight, for a piece of wizardry, or, as they say in the group, of Devil-work.<br> +<br> +The plaited palms were what we recognised. We had seen them before +on Apaiang, the most christianised of all these islands; where excellent +Mr. Bingham lived and laboured and has left golden memories; whence +all the education in the northern Gilberts traces its descent; and where +we were boarded by little native Sunday-school misses in clean frocks, +with demure faces, and singing hymns as to the manner born.<br> +<br> +Our experience of Devil-work at Apaiang had been as follows:- It chanced +we were benighted at the house of Captain Tierney. My wife and +I lodged with a Chinaman some half a mile away; and thither Captain +Reid and a native boy escorted us by torch-light. On the way the +torch went out, and we took shelter in a small and lonely Christian +chapel to rekindle it. Stuck in the rafters of the chapel was +a branch of knotted palm. ‘What is that?’ I asked. +‘O, that’s Devil-work,’ said the Captain. ‘And +what is Devil-work?’ I inquired. ‘If you like, I’ll +show you some when we get to Johnnie’s,’ he replied. +‘Johnnie’s’ was a quaint little house upon the crest +of the beach, raised some three feet on posts, approached by stairs; +part walled, part trellised. Trophies of advertisement-photographs +were hung up within for decoration. There was a table and a recess-bed, +in which Mrs. Stevenson slept; while I camped on the matted floor with +Johnnie, Mrs. Johnnie, her sister, and the devil’s own regiment +of cockroaches. Hither was summoned an old witch, who looked the +part to horror. The lamp was set on the floor; the crone squatted +on the threshold, a green palm-branch in her hand, the light striking +full on her aged features and picking out behind her, from the black +night, timorous faces of spectators. Our sorceress began with +a chanted incantation; it was in the old tongue, for which I had no +interpreter; but ever and again there ran among the crowd outside that +laugh which every traveller in the islands learns so soon to recognise, +- the laugh of terror. Doubtless these half-Christian folk were +shocked, these half-heathen folk alarmed. Chench or Taburik thus +invoked, we put our questions; the witch knotted the leaves, here a +leaf and there a leaf, plainly on some arithmetical system; studied +the result with great apparent contention of mind; and gave the answers. +Sidney Colvin was in robust health and gone a journey; and we should +have a fair wind upon the morrow: that was the result of our consultation, +for which we paid a dollar. The next day dawned cloudless and +breathless; but I think Captain Reid placed a secret reliance on the +sibyl, for the schooner was got ready for sea. By eight the lagoon +was flawed with long cat’s-paws, and the palms tossed and rustled; +before ten we were clear of the passage and skimming under all plain +sail, with bubbling scuppers. So we had the breeze, which was +well worth a dollar in itself; but the bulletin about my friend in England +proved, some six months later, when I got my mail, to have been groundless. +Perhaps London lies beyond the horizon of the island gods.<br> +<br> +Tembinok’, in his first dealings, showed himself sternly averse +from superstition: and had not the <i>Equator</i> delayed, we might +have left the island and still supposed him an agnostic. It chanced +one day, however, that he came to our maniap’, and found Mrs. +Stevenson in the midst of a game of patience. She explained the +game as well as she was able, and wound up jocularly by telling him +this was her devil-work, and if she won, the <i>Equator</i> would arrive +next day. Tembinok’ must have drawn a long breath; we were +not so high-and-dry after all; he need no longer dissemble, and he plunged +at once into confessions. He made devil-work every day, he told +us, to know if ships were coming in; and thereafter brought us regular +reports of the results. It was surprising how regularly he was +wrong; but he always had an explanation ready. There had been +some schooner in the offing out of view; but either she was not bound +for Apemama, or had changed her course, or lay becalmed. I used +to regard the king with veneration as he thus publicly deceived himself. +I saw behind him all the fathers of the Church, all the philosophers +and men of science of the past; before him, all those that are to come; +himself in the midst; the whole visionary series bowed over the same +task of welding incongruities. To the end Tembinok’ spoke +reluctantly of the island gods and their worship, and I learned but +little. Taburik is the god of thunder, and deals in wind and weather. +A while since there were wizards who could call him down in the form +of lightning. ‘My patha he tell me he see: you think he +lie?’ Tienti - pronounced something like ‘Chench,’ +and identified by his majesty with the devil - sends and removes bodily +sickness. He is whistled for in the Paumotuan manner, and is said +to appear; but the king has never seen him. The doctors treat +disease by the aid of Chench: eclectic Tembinok’ at the same time +administering ‘pain-killer’ from his medicine-chest, so +as to give the sufferer both chances. ‘I think mo’ +betta,’ observed his majesty, with more than his usual self-approval. +Apparently the gods are not jealous, and placidly enjoy both shrine +and priest in common. On Tamaiti’s medicine-tree, for instance, +the model canoes are hung up <i>ex voto</i> for a prosperous voyage, +and must therefore be dedicated to Taburik, god of the weather; but +the stone in front is the place of sick folk come to pacify Chench.<br> +<br> +It chanced, by great good luck, that even as we spoke of these affairs, +I found myself threatened with a cold. I do not suppose I was +ever glad of a cold before, or shall ever be again; but the opportunity +to see the sorcerers at work was priceless, and I called in the faculty +of Apemama. They came in a body, all in their Sunday’s best +and hung with wreaths and shells, the insignia of the devil-worker. +Tamaiti I knew already: Terutak’ I saw for the first time - a +tall, lank, raw-boned, serious North-Sea fisherman turned brown; and +there was a third in their company whose name I never heard, and who +played to Tamaiti the part of <i>famulus</i>. Tamaiti took me +in hand first, and led me, conversing agreeably, to the shores of Fu +Bay. The <i>famulus</i> climbed a tree for some green cocoa-nuts. +Tamaiti himself disappeared a while in the bush and returned with coco +tinder, dry leaves, and a spray of waxberry. I was placed on the +stone, with my back to the tree and my face to windward; between me +and the gravel-heap one of the green nuts was set; and then Tamaiti +(having previously bared his feet, for he had come in canvas shoes, +which tortured him) joined me within the magic circle, hollowed out +the top of the gravel-heap, built his fire in the bottom, and applied +a match: it was one of Bryant and May’s. The flame was slow +to catch, and the irreverent sorcerer filled in the time with talk of +foreign places - of London, and ‘companies,’ and how much +money they had; of San Francisco, and the nefarious fogs, ‘all +the same smoke,’ which had been so nearly the occasion of his +death. I tried vainly to lead him to the matter in hand. +‘Everybody make medicine,’ he said lightly. And when +I asked him if he were himself a good practitioner - ‘No savvy,’ +he replied, more lightly still. At length the leaves burst in +a flame, which he continued to feed; a thick, light smoke blew in my +face, and the flames streamed against and scorched my clothes. +He in the meanwhile addressed, or affected to address, the evil spirit, +his lips moving fast, but without sound; at the same time he waved in +the air and twice struck me on the breast with his green spray. +So soon as the leaves were consumed the ashes were buried, the green +spray was imbedded in the gravel, and the ceremony was at an end.<br> +<br> +A reader of the <i>Arabian Nights</i> felt quite at home. Here +was the suffumigation; here was the muttering wizard; here was the desert +place to which Aladdin was decoyed by the false uncle. But they +manage these things better in fiction. The effect was marred by +the levity of the magician, entertaining his patient with small talk +like an affable dentist, and by the incongruous presence of Mr. Osbourne +with a camera. As for my cold, it was neither better nor worse.<br> +<br> +I was now handed over to Terutak’, the leading practitioner or +medical baronet of Apemama. His place is on the lagoon side of +the island, hard by the palace. A rail of light wood, some two +feet high, encloses an oblong piece of gravel like the king’s +Pray Place; in the midst is a green tree; below, a stone table bears +a pair of boxes covered with a fine mat; and in front of these an offering +of food, a cocoa-nut, a piece of taro or a fish, is placed daily. +On two sides the enclosure is lined with maniap’s; and one of +our party, who had been there to sketch, had remarked a daily concourse +of people and an extraordinary number of sick children; for this is +in fact the infirmary of Apemama. The doctor and myself entered +the sacred place alone; the boxes and the mat were displaced; and I +was enthroned in their stead upon the stone, facing once more to the +east. For a while the sorcerer remained unseen behind me, making +passes in the air with a branch of palm. Then he struck lightly +on the brim of my straw hat; and this blow he continued to repeat at +intervals, sometimes brushing instead my arm and shoulder. I have +had people try to mesmerise me a dozen times, and never with the least +result. But at the first tap - on a quarter no more vital than +my hat-brim, and from nothing more virtuous than a switch of palm wielded +by a man I could not even see - sleep rushed upon me like an armed man. +My sinews fainted, my eyes closed, my brain hummed, with drowsiness. +I resisted, at first instinctively, then with a certain flurry of despair, +in the end successfully; if that were indeed success which enabled me +to scramble to my feet, to stumble home somnambulous, to cast myself +at once upon my bed, and sink at once into a dreamless stupor. +When I awoke my cold was gone. So I leave a matter that I do not +understand.<br> +<br> +Meanwhile my appetite for curiosities (not usually very keen) had been +strangely whetted by the sacred boxes. They were of pandanus wood, +oblong in shape, with an effect of pillaring along the sides like straw +work, lightly fringed with hair or fibre and standing on four legs. +The outside was neat as a toy; the inside a mystery I was resolved to +penetrate. But there was a lion in the path. I might not +approach Terutak’, since I had promised to buy nothing in the +island; I dared not have recourse to the king, for I had already received +from him more gifts than I knew how to repay. In this dilemma +(the schooner being at last returned) we hit on a device. Captain +Reid came forward in my stead, professed an unbridled passion for the +boxes, and asked and obtained leave to bargain for them with the wizard. +That same afternoon the captain and I made haste to the infirmary, entered +the enclosure, raised the mat, and had begun to examine the boxes at +our leisure, when Terutak’s wife bounced out of one of the nigh +houses, fell upon us, swept up the treasures, and was gone. There +was never a more absolute surprise. She came, she took, she vanished, +we had not a guess whither; and we remained, with foolish looks and +laughter on the empty field. Such was the fit prologue of our +memorable bargaining.<br> +<br> +Presently Terutak’ came, bringing Tamaiti along with him, both +smiling; and we four squatted without the rail. In the three maniap’s +of the infirmary a certain audience was gathered: the family of a sick +child under treatment, the king’s sister playing cards, a pretty +girl, who swore I was the image of her father; in all perhaps a score. +Terutak’s wife had returned (even as she had vanished) unseen, +and now sat, breathless and watchful, by her husband’s side. +Perhaps some rumour of our quest had gone abroad, or perhaps we had +given the alert by our unseemly freedom: certain, at least, that in +the faces of all present, expectation and alarm were mingled.<br> +<br> +Captain Reid announced, without preface or disguise, that I was come +to purchase; Terutak’, with sudden gravity, refused to sell. +He was pressed; he persisted. It was explained we only wanted +one: no matter, two were necessary for the healing of the sick. +He was rallied, he was reasoned with: in vain. He sat there, serious +and still, and refused. All this was only a preliminary skirmish; +hitherto no sum of money had been mentioned; but now the captain brought +his great guns to bear. He named a pound, then two, then three. +Out of the maniap’s one person after another came to join the +group, some with mere excitement, others with consternation in their +faces. The pretty girl crept to my side; it was then that - surely +with the most artless flattery - she informed me of my likeness to her +father. Tamaiti the infidel sat with hanging head and every mark +of dejection. Terutak’ streamed with sweat, his eye was +glazed, his face wore a painful rictus, his chest heaved like that of +one spent with running. The man must have been by nature covetous; +and I doubt if ever I saw moral agony more tragically displayed. +His wife by his side passionately encouraged his resistance.<br> +<br> +And now came the charge of the old guard. The captain, making +a skip, named the surprising figure of five pounds. At the word +the maniap’s were emptied. The king’s sister flung +down her cards and came to the front to listen, a cloud on her brow. +The pretty girl beat her breast and cried with wearisome iteration that +if the box were hers I should have it. Terutak’s wife was +beside herself with pious fear, her face discomposed, her voice (which +scarce ceased from warning and encouragement) shrill as a whistle. +Even Terutak’ lost that image-like immobility which he had hitherto +maintained. He rocked on his mat, threw up his closed knees alternately, +and struck himself on the breast after the manner of dancers. +But he came gold out of the furnace; and with what voice was left him +continued to reject the bribe.<br> +<br> +And now came a timely interjection. ‘Money will not heal +the sick,’ observed the king’s sister sententiously; and +as soon as I heard the remark translated my eyes were unsealed, and +I began to blush for my employment. Here was a sick child, and +I sought, in the view of its parents, to remove the medicine-box. +Here was the priest of a religion, and I (a heathen millionaire) was +corrupting him to sacrilege. Here was a greedy man, torn in twain +betwixt greed and conscience; and I sat by and relished, and lustfully +renewed his torments. <i>Ave, Caesar</i>! Smothered in a +corner, dormant but not dead, we have all the one touch of nature: an +infant passion for the sand and blood of the arena. So I brought +to an end my first and last experience of the joys of the millionaire, +and departed amid silent awe. Nowhere else can I expect to stir +the depths of human nature by an offer of five pounds; nowhere else, +even at the expense of millions, could I hope to see the evil of riches +stand so legibly exposed. Of all the bystanders, none but the +king’s sister retained any memory of the gravity and danger of +the thing in hand. Their eyes glowed, the girl beat her breast, +in senseless animal excitement. Nothing was offered them; they +stood neither to gain nor to lose; at the mere name and wind of these +great sums Satan possessed them.<br> +<br> +From this singular interview I went straight to the palace; found the +king; confessed what I had been doing; begged him, in my name, to compliment +Terutak’ on his virtue, and to have a similar box made for me +against the return of the schooner. Tembinok’, Rubam, and +one of the Daily Papers - him we used to call ‘the Facetiae Column’ +- laboured for a while of some idea, which was at last intelligibly +delivered. They feared I thought the box would cure me; whereas, +without the wizard, it was useless; and when I was threatened with another +cold I should do better to rely on pain-killer. I explained I +merely wished to keep it in my ‘outch’ as a thing made in +Apemama and these honest men were much relieved.<br> +<br> +Late the same evening, my wife, crossing the isle to windward, was aware +of singing in the bush. Nothing is more common in that hour and +place than the jubilant carol of the toddy-cutter, swinging high overhead, +beholding below him the narrow ribbon of the isle, the surrounding field +of ocean, and the fires of the sunset. But this was of a graver +character, and seemed to proceed from the ground-level. Advancing +a little in the thicket, Mrs. Stevenson saw a clear space, a fine mat +spread in the midst, and on the mat a wreath of white flowers and one +of the devil-work boxes. A woman - whom we guess to have been +Mrs. Terutak’ - sat in front, now drooping over the box like a +mother over a cradle, now lifting her face and directing her song to +heaven. A passing toddy-cutter told my wife that she was praying. +Probably she did not so much pray as deprecate; and perhaps even the +ceremony was one of disenchantment. For the box was already doomed; +it was to pass from its green medicine-tree, reverend precinct, and +devout attendants; to be handled by the profane; to cross three seas; +to come to land under the foolscap of St. Paul’s; to be domesticated +within the hail of Lillie Bridge; there to be dusted by the British +housemaid, and to take perhaps the roar of London for the voice of the +outer sea along the reef. Before even we had finished dinner Chench +had begun his journey, and one of the newspapers had already placed +the box upon my table as the gift of Tembinok’.<br> +<br> +I made haste to the palace, thanked the king, but offered to restore +the box, for I could not bear that the sick of the island should be +made to suffer. I was amazed by his reply. Terutak’, +it appeared, had still three or four in reserve against an accident; +and his reluctance, and the dread painted at first on every face, was +not in the least occasioned by the prospect of medical destitution, +but by the immediate divinity of Chench. How much more did I respect +the king’s command, which had been able to extort in a moment +and for nothing a sacrilegious favour that I had in vain solicited with +millions! But now I had a difficult task in front of me; it was +not in my view that Terutak’ should suffer by his virtue; and +I must persuade the king to share my opinion, to let me enrich one of +his subjects, and (what was yet more delicate) to pay for my present. +Nothing shows the king in a more becoming light than the fact that I +succeeded. He demurred at the principle; he exclaimed, when he +heard it, at the sum. ‘Plenty money!’ cried he, with +contemptuous displeasure. But his resistance was never serious; +and when he had blown off his ill-humour - ‘A’ right,’ +said he. ‘You give him. Mo’ betta.’<br> +<br> +Armed with this permission, I made straight for the infirmary. +The night was now come, cool, dark, and starry. On a mat hard +by a clear fire of wood and coco shell, Terutak’ lay beside his +wife. Both were smiling; the agony was over, the king’s +command had reconciled (I must suppose) their agitating scruples; and +I was bidden to sit by them and share the circulating pipe. I +was a little moved myself when I placed five gold sovereigns in the +wizard’s hand; but there was no sign of emotion in Terutak’ +as he returned them, pointed to the palace, and named Tembinok’. +It was a changed scene when I had managed to explain. Terutak’, +long, dour Scots fisherman as he was, expressed his satisfaction within +bounds; but the wife beamed; and there was an old gentleman present +- her father, I suppose - who seemed nigh translated. His eyes +stood out of his head; ‘<i>Kaupoi, Kaupoi</i> - rich, rich!’ +ran on his lips like a refrain; and he could not meet my eye but what +he gurgled into foolish laughter.<br> +<br> +I might now go home, leaving that fire-lit family party gloating over +their new millions, and consider my strange day. I had tried and +rewarded the virtue of Terutak’. I had played the millionaire, +had behaved abominably, and then in some degree repaired my thoughtlessness. +And now I had my box, and could open it and look within. It contained +a miniature sleeping-mat and a white shell. Tamaiti, interrogated +next day as to the shell, explained it was not exactly Chench, but a +cell, or body, which he would at times inhabit. Asked why there +was a sleeping-mat, he retorted indignantly, ‘Why have you mats?’ +And this was the sceptical Tamaiti! But island scepticism is never +deeper than the lips.<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +CHAPTER VII - THE KING OF APEMAMA<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +Thus all things on the island, even the priests of the gods, obey the +word of Tembinok’. He can give and take, and slay, and allay +the scruples of the conscientious, and do all things (apparently) but +interfere in the cookery of a turtle. ‘I got power’ +is his favourite word; it interlards his conversation; the thought haunts +him and is ever fresh; and when be has asked and meditates of foreign +countries, he looks up with a smile and reminds you, ‘<i>I</i> +got<i> Power</i>.’ Nor is his delight only in the possession, +but in the exercise. He rejoices in the crooked and violent paths +of kingship like a strong man to run a race, or like an artist in his +art. To feel, to use his power, to embellish his island and the +picture of the island life after a private ideal, to milk the island +vigorously, to extend his singular museum - these employ delightfully +the sum of his abilities. I never saw a man more patently in the +right trade.<br> +<br> +It would be natural to suppose this monarchy inherited intact through +generations. And so far from that, it is a thing of yesterday. +I was already a boy at school while Apemama was yet republican, ruled +by a noisy council of Old Men, and torn with incurable feuds. +And Tembinok’ is no Bourbon; rather the son of a Napoleon. +Of course he is well-born. No man need aspire high in the isles +of the Pacific unless his pedigree be long and in the upper regions +mythical. And our king counts cousinship with most of the high +families in the archipelago, and traces his descent to a shark and a +heroic woman. Directed by an oracle, she swam beyond sight of +land to meet her revolting paramour, and received at sea the seed of +a predestined family. ‘I think lie,’ is the king’s +emphatic commentary; yet he is proud of the legend. From this +illustrious beginning the fortunes of the race must have declined; and +Teñkoruti, the grandfather of Tembinok’, was the chief +of a village at the north end of the island. Kuria and Aranuka +were yet independent; Apemama itself the arena of devastating feuds. +Through this perturbed period of history the figure of Teñkoruti +stalks memorable. In war he was swift and bloody; several towns +fell to his spear, and the inhabitants were butchered to a man. +In civil life this arrogance was unheard of. When the council +of Old Men was summoned, he went to the Speak House, delivered his mind, +and left without waiting to be answered. Wisdom had spoken: let +others opine according to their folly. He was feared and hated, +and this was his pleasure. He was no poet; he cared not for arts +or knowledge. ‘My gran’patha one thing savvy, savvy +pight,’ observed the king. In some lull of their own disputes +the Old Men of Apemama adventured on the conquest of Apemama; and this +unlicked Caius Marcius was elected general of the united troops. +Success attended him; the islands were reduced, and Teñkoruti +returned to his own government, glorious and detested. He died +about 1860, in the seventieth year of his age and the full odour of +unpopularity. He was tall and lean, says his grandson, looked +extremely old, and ‘walked all the same young man.’ +The same observer gave me a significant detail. The survivors +of that rough epoch were all defaced with spearmarks; there was none +on the body of this skilful fighter. ‘I see old man, no +got a spear,’ said the king.<br> +<br> +Teñkoruti left two sons, Tembaitake and Tembinatake. Tembaitake, +our king’s father, was short, middling stout, a poet, a good genealogist, +and something of a fighter; it seems he took himself seriously, and +was perhaps scarce conscious that he was in all things the creature +and nursling of his brother. There was no shadow of dispute between +the pair: the greater man filled with alacrity and content the second +place; held the breach in war, and all the portfolios in the time of +peace; and, when his brother rated him, listened in silence, looking +on the ground. Like Teñkoruti, he was tall and lean and +a swift talker - a rare trait in the islands. He possessed every +accomplishment. He knew sorcery, he was the best genealogist of +his day, he was a poet, he could dance and make canoes and armour; and +the famous mast of Apemama, which ran one joint higher than the mainmast +of a full-rigged ship, was of his conception and design. But these +were avocations, and the man’s trade was war. ‘When +my uncle go make wa’, he laugh,’ said Tembinok’. +He forbade the use of field fortification, that protractor of native +hostilities; his men must fight in the open, and win or be beaten out +of hand; his own activity inspired his followers; and the swiftness +of his blows beat down, in one lifetime, the resistance of three islands. +He made his brother sovereign, he left his nephew absolute. ‘My +uncle make all smooth,’ said Tembinok’. ‘I mo’ +king than my patha: I got power,’ he said, with formidable relish.<br> +<br> +Such is the portrait of the uncle drawn by the nephew. I can set +beside it another by a different artist, who has often - I may say always +- delighted me with his romantic taste in narrative, but not always +- and I may say not often - persuaded me of his exactitude. I +have already denied myself the use of so much excellent matter from +the same source, that I begin to think it time to reward good resolution; +and his account of Tembinatake agrees so well with the king’s, +that it may very well be (what I hope it is) the record of a fact, and +not (what I suspect) the pleasing exercise of an imagination more than +sailorly. A., for so I had perhaps better call him, was walking +up the island after dusk, when he came on a lighted village of some +size, was directed to the chief’s house, and asked leave to rest +and smoke a pipe. ‘You will sit down, and smoke a pipe, +and wash, and eat, and sleep,’ replied the chief, ‘and to-morrow +you will go again.’ Food was brought, prayers were held +(for this was in the brief day of Christianity), and the chief himself +prayed with eloquence and seeming sincerity. All evening A. sat +and admired the man by the firelight. He was six feet high, lean, +with the appearance of many years, and an extraordinary air of breeding +and command. ‘He looked like a man who would kill you laughing,’ +said A., in singular echo of one of the king’s expressions. +And again: ‘I had been reading the Musketeer books, and he reminded +me of Aramis.’ Such is the portrait of Tembinatake, drawn +by an expert romancer.<br> +<br> +We had heard many tales of ‘my patha’; never a word of my +uncle till two days before we left. As the time approached for +our departure Tembinok’ became greatly changed; a softer, a more +melancholy, and, in particular, a more confidential man appeared in +his stead. To my wife he contrived laboriously to explain that +though he knew he must lose his father in the course of nature, he had +not minded nor realised it till the moment came; and that now he was +to lose us he repeated the experience. We showed fireworks one +evening on the terrace. It was a heavy business; the sense of +separation was in all our minds, and the talk languished. The +king was specially affected, sat disconsolate on his mat, and often +sighed. Of a sudden one of the wives stepped forth from a cluster, +came and kissed him in silence, and silently went again. It was +just such a caress as we might give to a disconsolate child, and the +king received it with a child’s simplicity. Presently after +we said good-night and withdrew; but Tembinok’ detained Mr. Osbourne, +patting the mat by his side and saying: ‘Sit down. I feel +bad, I like talk.’ Osbourne sat down by him. ‘You +like some beer?’ said he; and one of the wives produced a bottle. +The king did not partake, but sat sighing and smoking a meerschaum pipe. +‘I very sorry you go,’ he said at last. ‘Miss +Stlevens he good man, woman he good man, boy he good man; all good man. +Woman he smart all the same man. My woman’ (glancing towards +his wives) ‘he good woman, no very smart. I think Miss Stlevens +he is chiep all the same cap’n man-o-wa’. I think +Miss Stlevens he rich man all the same me. All go schoona. +I very sorry. My patha he go, my uncle he go, my cutcheons he +go, Miss Stlevens he go: all go. You no see king cry before. +King all the same man: feel bad, he cry. I very sorry.’<br> +<br> +In the morning it was the common topic in the village that the king +had wept. To me he said: ‘Last night I no can ‘peak: +too much here,’ laying his hand upon his bosom. ‘Now +you go away all the same my pamily. My brothers, my uncle go away. +All the same.’ This was said with a dejection almost passionate. +And it was the first time I had heard him name his uncle, or indeed +employ the word. The same day he sent me a present of two corselets, +made in the island fashion of plaited fibre, heavy and strong. +One had been worn by Teñkoruti, one by Tembaitake; and the gift +being gratefully received, he sent me, on the return of his messengers, +a third - that of Tembinatake. My curiosity was roused; I begged +for information as to the three wearers; and the king entered with gusto +into the details already given. Here was a strange thing, that +he should have talked so much of his family, and not once mentioned +that relative of whom he was plainly the most proud. Nay, more: +he had hitherto boasted of his father; thenceforth he had little to +say of him; and the qualities for which he had praised him in the past +were now attributed where they were due, - to the uncle. A confusion +might be natural enough among islanders, who call all the sons of their +grandfather by the common name of father. But this was not the +case with Tembinok’. Now the ice was broken the word uncle +was perpetually in his mouth; he who had been so ready to confound was +now careful to distinguish; and the father sank gradually into a self-complacent +ordinary man, while the uncle rose to his true stature as the hero and +founder of the race.<br> +<br> +The more I heard and the more I considered, the more this mystery of +Tembinok’s behaviour puzzled and attracted me. And the explanation, +when it came, was one to strike the imagination of a dramatist. +Tembinok’ had two brothers. One, detected in private trading, +was banished, then forgiven, lives to this day in the island, and is +the father of the heir-apparent, Paul. The other fell beyond forgiveness. +I have heard it was a love-affair with one of the king’s wives, +and the thing is highly possible in that romantic archipelago. +War was attempted to be levied; but Tembinok’ was too swift for +the rebels, and the guilty brother escaped in a canoe. He did +not go alone. Tembinatake had a hand in the rebellion, and the +man who had gained a kingdom for a weakling brother was banished by +that brother’s son. The fugitives came to shore in other +islands, but Tembinok’ remains to this day ignorant of their fate.<br> +<br> +So far history. And now a moment for conjecture. Tembinok’ +confused habitually, not only the attributes and merits of his father +and his uncle, but their diverse personal appearance. Before he +had even spoken, or thought to speak, of Tembinatake, he had told me +often of a tall, lean father, skilled in war, and his own schoolmaster +in genealogy and island arts. How if both were fathers, one natural, +one adoptive? How if the heir of Tembaitake, like the heir of +Tembinok’ himself, were not a son, but an adopted nephew? +How if the founder of the monarchy, while he worked for his brother, +worked at the same time for the child of his loins? + How if on the death of Tembaitake, the two stronger natures, +father and son, king and kingmaker, clashed, and Tembinok’, when +he drove out his uncle, drove out the author of his days? Here +is at least a tragedy four-square.<br> +<br> +The king took us on board in his own gig, dressed for the occasion in +the naval uniform. He had little to say, he refused refreshments, +shook us briefly by the hand, and went ashore again. That night +the palm-tops of Apemama had dipped behind the sea, and the schooner +sailed solitary under the stars.<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +<br> +*** END OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK, IN THE SOUTH SEAS ***<br> +<pre> + +******This file should be named sseas10h.htm or sseas10h.zip****** +Corrected EDITIONS of our EBooks get a new NUMBER, sseas11h.htm +VERSIONS based on separate sources get new LETTER, sseas10ah.htm + +Project Gutenberg eBooks are often created from several printed +editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the US +unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we usually do not +keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition. + +We are now trying to release all our eBooks one year in advance +of the official release dates, leaving time for better editing. +Please be encouraged to tell us about any error or corrections, +even years after the official publication date. + +Please note neither this listing nor its contents are final til +midnight of the last day of the month of any such announcement. +The official release date of all Project Gutenberg eBooks is at +Midnight, Central Time, of the last day of the stated month. A +preliminary version may often be posted for suggestion, comment +and editing by those who wish to do so. + +Most people start at our Web sites at: +http://gutenberg.net or +http://promo.net/pg + +These Web sites include award-winning information about Project +Gutenberg, including how to donate, how to help produce our new +eBooks, and how to subscribe to our email newsletter (free!). + + +Those of you who want to download any eBook before announcement +can get to them as follows, and just download by date. This is +also a good way to get them instantly upon announcement, as the +indexes our cataloguers produce obviously take a while after an +announcement goes out in the Project Gutenberg Newsletter. + +http://www.ibiblio.org/gutenberg/etext04 or +ftp://ftp.ibiblio.org/pub/docs/books/gutenberg/etext04 + +Or /etext03, 02, 01, 00, 99, 98, 97, 96, 95, 94, 93, 92, 92, 91 or 90 + +Just search by the first five letters of the filename you want, +as it appears in our Newsletters. + + +Information about Project Gutenberg (one page) + +We produce about two million dollars for each hour we work. The +time it takes us, a rather conservative estimate, is fifty hours +to get any eBook selected, entered, proofread, edited, copyright +searched and analyzed, the copyright letters written, etc. Our +projected audience is one hundred million readers. If the value +per text is nominally estimated at one dollar then we produce $2 +million dollars per hour in 2002 as we release over 100 new text +files per month: 1240 more eBooks in 2001 for a total of 4000+ +We are already on our way to trying for 2000 more eBooks in 2002 +If they reach just 1-2% of the world's population then the total +will reach over half a trillion eBooks given away by year's end. + +The Goal of Project Gutenberg is to Give Away 1 Trillion eBooks! +This is ten thousand titles each to one hundred million readers, +which is only about 4% of the present number of computer users. + +Here is the briefest record of our progress (* means estimated): + +eBooks Year Month + + 1 1971 July + 10 1991 January + 100 1994 January + 1000 1997 August + 1500 1998 October + 2000 1999 December + 2500 2000 December + 3000 2001 November + 4000 2001 October/November + 6000 2002 December* + 9000 2003 November* +10000 2004 January* + + +The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation has been created +to secure a future for Project Gutenberg into the next millennium. + +We need your donations more than ever! + +As of February, 2002, contributions are being solicited from people +and organizations in: Alabama, Alaska, Arkansas, Connecticut, +Delaware, District of Columbia, Florida, Georgia, Hawaii, Illinois, +Indiana, Iowa, Kansas, Kentucky, Louisiana, Maine, Massachusetts, +Michigan, Mississippi, Missouri, Montana, Nebraska, Nevada, New +Hampshire, New Jersey, New Mexico, New York, North Carolina, Ohio, +Oklahoma, Oregon, Pennsylvania, Rhode Island, South Carolina, South +Dakota, Tennessee, Texas, Utah, Vermont, Virginia, Washington, West +Virginia, Wisconsin, and Wyoming. + +We have filed in all 50 states now, but these are the only ones +that have responded. + +As the requirements for other states are met, additions to this list +will be made and fund raising will begin in the additional states. +Please feel free to ask to check the status of your state. + +In answer to various questions we have received on this: + +We are constantly working on finishing the paperwork to legally +request donations in all 50 states. If your state is not listed and +you would like to know if we have added it since the list you have, +just ask. + +While we cannot solicit donations from people in states where we are +not yet registered, we know of no prohibition against accepting +donations from donors in these states who approach us with an offer to +donate. + +International donations are accepted, but we don't know ANYTHING about +how to make them tax-deductible, or even if they CAN be made +deductible, and don't have the staff to handle it even if there are +ways. + +Donations by check or money order may be sent to: + +Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation +PMB 113 +1739 University Ave. +Oxford, MS 38655-4109 + +Contact us if you want to arrange for a wire transfer or payment +method other than by check or money order. + +The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation has been approved by +the US Internal Revenue Service as a 501(c)(3) organization with EIN +[Employee Identification Number] 64-622154. Donations are +tax-deductible to the maximum extent permitted by law. As fund-raising +requirements for other states are met, additions to this list will be +made and fund-raising will begin in the additional states. + +We need your donations more than ever! + +You can get up to date donation information online at: + +http://www.gutenberg.net/donation.html + + +*** + +If you can't reach Project Gutenberg, +you can always email directly to: + +Michael S. Hart hart@pobox.com + +Prof. Hart will answer or forward your message. + +We would prefer to send you information by email. + + +**The Legal Small Print** + + +(Three Pages) + +***START**THE SMALL PRINT!**FOR PUBLIC DOMAIN EBOOKS**START*** +Why is this "Small Print!" statement here? You know: lawyers. +They tell us you might sue us if there is something wrong with +your copy of this eBook, even if you got it for free from +someone other than us, and even if what's wrong is not our +fault. So, among other things, this "Small Print!" statement +disclaims most of our liability to you. It also tells you how +you may distribute copies of this eBook if you want to. + +*BEFORE!* YOU USE OR READ THIS EBOOK +By using or reading any part of this PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm +eBook, you indicate that you understand, agree to and accept +this "Small Print!" statement. If you do not, you can receive +a refund of the money (if any) you paid for this eBook by +sending a request within 30 days of receiving it to the person +you got it from. If you received this eBook on a physical +medium (such as a disk), you must return it with your request. + +ABOUT PROJECT GUTENBERG-TM EBOOKS +This PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm eBook, like most PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm eBooks, +is a "public domain" work distributed by Professor Michael S. Hart +through the Project Gutenberg Association (the "Project"). +Among other things, this means that no one owns a United States copyright +on or for this work, so the Project (and you!) can copy and +distribute it in the United States without permission and +without paying copyright royalties. Special rules, set forth +below, apply if you wish to copy and distribute this eBook +under the "PROJECT GUTENBERG" trademark. + +Please do not use the "PROJECT GUTENBERG" trademark to market +any commercial products without permission. + +To create these eBooks, the Project expends considerable +efforts to identify, transcribe and proofread public domain +works. Despite these efforts, the Project's eBooks and any +medium they may be on may contain "Defects". Among other +things, Defects may take the form of incomplete, inaccurate or +corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other +intellectual property infringement, a defective or damaged +disk or other eBook medium, a computer virus, or computer +codes that damage or cannot be read by your equipment. + +LIMITED WARRANTY; DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES +But for the "Right of Replacement or Refund" described below, +[1] Michael Hart and the Foundation (and any other party you may +receive this eBook from as a PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm eBook) disclaims +all liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including +legal fees, and [2] YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE OR +UNDER STRICT LIABILITY, OR FOR BREACH OF WARRANTY OR CONTRACT, +INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE +OR INCIDENTAL DAMAGES, EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE +POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES. + +If you discover a Defect in this eBook within 90 days of +receiving it, you can receive a refund of the money (if any) +you paid for it by sending an explanatory note within that +time to the person you received it from. If you received it +on a physical medium, you must return it with your note, and +such person may choose to alternatively give you a replacement +copy. If you received it electronically, such person may +choose to alternatively give you a second opportunity to +receive it electronically. + +THIS EBOOK IS OTHERWISE PROVIDED TO YOU "AS-IS". NO OTHER +WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, ARE MADE TO YOU AS +TO THE EBOOK OR ANY MEDIUM IT MAY BE ON, INCLUDING BUT NOT +LIMITED TO WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A +PARTICULAR PURPOSE. + +Some states do not allow disclaimers of implied warranties or +the exclusion or limitation of consequential damages, so the +above disclaimers and exclusions may not apply to you, and you +may have other legal rights. + +INDEMNITY +You will indemnify and hold Michael Hart, the Foundation, +and its trustees and agents, and any volunteers associated +with the production and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm +texts harmless, from all liability, cost and expense, including +legal fees, that arise directly or indirectly from any of the +following that you do or cause: [1] distribution of this eBook, +[2] alteration, modification, or addition to the eBook, +or [3] any Defect. + +DISTRIBUTION UNDER "PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm" +You may distribute copies of this eBook electronically, or by +disk, book or any other medium if you either delete this +"Small Print!" and all other references to Project Gutenberg, +or: + +[1] Only give exact copies of it. Among other things, this + requires that you do not remove, alter or modify the + eBook or this "small print!" statement. You may however, + if you wish, distribute this eBook in machine readable + binary, compressed, mark-up, or proprietary form, + including any form resulting from conversion by word + processing or hypertext software, but only so long as + *EITHER*: + + [*] The eBook, when displayed, is clearly readable, and + does *not* contain characters other than those + intended by the author of the work, although tilde + (~), asterisk (*) and underline (_) characters may + be used to convey punctuation intended by the + author, and additional characters may be used to + indicate hypertext links; OR + + [*] The eBook may be readily converted by the reader at + no expense into plain ASCII, EBCDIC or equivalent + form by the program that displays the eBook (as is + the case, for instance, with most word processors); + OR + + [*] You provide, or agree to also provide on request at + no additional cost, fee or expense, a copy of the + eBook in its original plain ASCII form (or in EBCDIC + or other equivalent proprietary form). + +[2] Honor the eBook refund and replacement provisions of this + "Small Print!" statement. + +[3] Pay a trademark license fee to the Foundation of 20% of the + gross profits you derive calculated using the method you + already use to calculate your applicable taxes. If you + don't derive profits, no royalty is due. Royalties are + payable to "Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation" + the 60 days following each date you prepare (or were + legally required to prepare) your annual (or equivalent + periodic) tax return. Please contact us beforehand to + let us know your plans and to work out the details. + +WHAT IF YOU *WANT* TO SEND MONEY EVEN IF YOU DON'T HAVE TO? +Project Gutenberg is dedicated to increasing the number of +public domain and licensed works that can be freely distributed +in machine readable form. + +The Project gratefully accepts contributions of money, time, +public domain materials, or royalty free copyright licenses. +Money should be paid to the: +"Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation." + +If you are interested in contributing scanning equipment or +software or other items, please contact Michael Hart at: +hart@pobox.com + +[Portions of this eBook's header and trailer may be reprinted only +when distributed free of all fees. Copyright (C) 2001, 2002 by +Michael S. Hart. Project Gutenberg is a TradeMark and may not be +used in any sales of Project Gutenberg eBooks or other materials be +they hardware or software or any other related product without +express permission.] + +*END THE SMALL PRINT! FOR PUBLIC DOMAIN EBOOKS*Ver.02/11/02*END* +</pre></body> +</html> diff --git a/old/sseas10h.zip b/old/sseas10h.zip Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000..e7c327c --- /dev/null +++ b/old/sseas10h.zip |
